diff options
| -rw-r--r-- | .gitattributes | 3 | ||||
| -rw-r--r-- | 395-0.txt | 9533 | ||||
| -rw-r--r-- | 395-0.zip | bin | 0 -> 199023 bytes | |||
| -rw-r--r-- | 395-h.zip | bin | 0 -> 208037 bytes | |||
| -rw-r--r-- | 395-h/395-h.htm | 10029 | ||||
| -rw-r--r-- | 395-h/images/p0b.jpg | bin | 0 -> 6013 bytes | |||
| -rw-r--r-- | 395-h/images/p0s.jpg | bin | 0 -> 1477 bytes | |||
| -rw-r--r-- | LICENSE.txt | 11 | ||||
| -rw-r--r-- | README.md | 2 | ||||
| -rw-r--r-- | old/hlywr10.txt | 10093 | ||||
| -rw-r--r-- | old/hlywr10.zip | bin | 0 -> 197157 bytes | |||
| -rw-r--r-- | old/hlywr10h.htm | 9715 | ||||
| -rw-r--r-- | old/hlywr10h.zip | bin | 0 -> 197253 bytes |
13 files changed, 39386 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/.gitattributes b/.gitattributes new file mode 100644 index 0000000..6833f05 --- /dev/null +++ b/.gitattributes @@ -0,0 +1,3 @@ +* text=auto +*.txt text +*.md text diff --git a/395-0.txt b/395-0.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000..f63111c --- /dev/null +++ b/395-0.txt @@ -0,0 +1,9533 @@ +The Project Gutenberg eBook, The Holy War made by Shaddai upon Diabolus, +by John Bunyan + + +This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with +almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or +re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included +with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org + + + + + +Title: The Holy War made by Shaddai upon Diabolus + + +Author: John Bunyan + + + +Release Date: February 9, 2013 [eBook #395] +[This file was first posted on December 7, 1995] + +Language: English + +Character set encoding: UTF-8 + + +***START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK THE HOLY WAR MADE BY SHADDAI UPON +DIABOLUS*** + + +Transcribed from the 1907 Religious Tract Society edition by David Price, +email ccx074@pglaf.org + + + + + + THE HOLY WAR MADE + BY SHADDI UPON + DIABOLUS FOR THE + REGAINING OF THE METROPOLIS + OF THE WORLD OR THE LOSING + AND TAKING AGAIN OF THE TOWN + OF MANSOUL. BY JOHN BUNYAN + + + * * * * * + + WITH THREE + COLOURED ILLUSTRATIONS + BY VICTOR PROUT {0} + + * * * * * + + “I have used similitudes.” Hosea xii. 10 + + * * * * * + + [Picture: Decorative design] + + London + THE RELIGIOUS TRACT SOCIETY + 4 Bouverie Street and 65 St Paul’s Churchyard + 1907 + + * * * * * + + PRINTED BY + HAZELL, WATSON AND VINEY, LD. + LONDON AND AYLESBURY. + + + + +PREFACE. + + +_IN the year 1682 there was published by Dorman Newman_, ‘_at the King’s +Arms in the Poultry_,’_ and Benjamin Alsop_, ‘_at the Angel and Bible in +the Poultry_,’_ a volume entitled_ ‘_The Holy War_, _made by Shaddai upon +Diabolus for the regaining of the Metropolis of the World; or the Losing +and Taking again of the Town of Mansoul_.’_ It was the work of John +Bunyan_, _who_, _sixteen years before_, _had published the story of his +own spiritual struggle under the title of_ ‘_Grace abounding to the Chief +of Sinners_’;_ and_, _but four years before_, _had produced_ ‘_The +Pilgrim’s Progress_’ (_Part I_). _Bunyan had speedily followed the issue +of the_ ‘_Pilgrim’s Progress_’ _with the_ ‘_Life and Death of Mr. +Badman_,’_ picture of English life and character as he had seen it_, +_grimly faithful to fact_. _In_ ‘_The Holy War_’_ Bunyan returned to +allegory_. _As a piece of literature the book is in no way inferior to +the_ ‘_Pilgrim’s Progress_.’_ If Bunyan had written nothing else_, ‘_The +Holy War_’ _would have sufficed to establish his claim to a place amongst +the masters of English prose_. _As an appeal to the conscience it is not +a whit less effective than the_ ‘_Pilgrim’s Progress_’; _but in the power +of seizing and retaining the reader’s attention it is scarcely so +successful_. _Nevertheless Macaulay held that_ ‘_if there had been no_ +“_Pilgrim’s Progress_” “_The Holy War_” _would have been the first of +religious allegories_.’ + +_In working out the details of_ ‘_The Holy War_’ _Bunyan seems to have +kept in mind his own experience_. _The fortifications of the city_, _the +movements of the opposing forces_, _the changes in the municipal offices +of Mansoul were reproductions of scenes and events that had but recently +gone on under Bunyan’s eyes_. _He adapted them with extraordinary +success to the presentation both of the doctrines of grace and of the +temptations which attend the Christian life_. _The characters and the +incidents are_, _in effect_, _the characters and incidents of every age_. +_It is this which gives to the story of Mansoul its undying freshness_, +_and suits it to the needs of men in all climes_. ‘_The Holy War_’ _has +been translated into many languages_, _including some of those with the +scantiest of literature_. _Indeed_, _as this edition is being prepared +for the press_, _assistance is being rendered by the Religious Tract +Society in the printing of_ ‘_The Holy War_’ _in Kongo_. + + _A. R. BUCKLAND_. + + + + +TO THE READER. + + + ’Tis strange to me, that they that love to tell + Things done of old, yea, and that do excel + Their equals in historiology, + Speak not of Mansoul’s wars, but let them lie + Dead, like old fables, or such worthless things, + That to the reader no advantage brings: + When men, let them make what they will their own, + Till they know this, are to themselves unknown. + Of stories, I well know, there’s divers sorts, + Some foreign, some domestic; and reports + Are thereof made as fancy leads the writers: + (By books a man may guess at the inditers.) + Some will again of that which never was, + Nor will be, feign (and that without a cause) + Such matter, raise such mountains, tell such things + Of men, of laws, of countries, and of kings; + And in their story seem to be so sage, + And with such gravity clothe every page, + That though their frontispiece says all is vain, + Yet to their way disciples they obtain. + But, readers, I have somewhat else to do, + Than with vain stories thus to trouble you. + What here I say, some men do know so well, + They can with tears and joy the story tell. + The town of Mansoul is well known to many, + Nor are her troubles doubted of by any + That are acquainted with those Histories + That Mansoul and her wars anatomize. + Then lend thine ear to what I do relate, + Touching the town of Mansoul and her state: + How she was lost, took captive, made a slave: + And how against him set, that should her save; + Yea, how by hostile ways she did oppose + Her Lord, and with his enemy did close. + For they are true: he that will them deny + Must needs the best of records vilify. + For my part, I myself was in the town, + Both when ’twas set up, and when pulling down. + I saw Diabolus in his possession, + And Mansoul also under his oppression. + Yea, I was there when she own’d him for lord, + And to him did submit with one accord. + When Mansoul trampled upon things divine, + And wallowed in filth as doth a swine; + When she betook herself unto her arms, + Fought her Emmanuel, despis’d his charms; + Then I was there, and did rejoice to see + Diabolus and Mansoul so agree. + Let no men, then, count me a fable-maker, + Nor make my name or credit a partaker + Of their derision: what is here in view, + Of mine own knowledge, I dare say is true. + I saw the Prince’s armed men come down + By troops, by thousands, to besiege the town; + I saw the captains, heard the trumpets sound, + And how his forces covered all the ground. + Yea, how they set themselves in battle-’ray, + I shall remember to my dying day. + I saw the colours waving in the wind, + And they within to mischief how combin’d + To ruin Mansoul, and to make away + Her primum mobile without delay. + I saw the mounts cast up against the town, + And how the slings were placed to beat it down: + I heard the stones fly whizzing by mine ears, + (What longer kept in mind than got in fears?) + I heard them fall, and saw what work they made. + And how old Mors did cover with his shade + The face of Mansoul; and I heard her cry, + ‘Woe worth the day, in dying I shall die!’ + I saw the battering-rams, and how they play’d + To beat open Ear-gate; and I was afraid + Not only Ear-gate, but the very town + Would by those battering-rams be beaten down. + I saw the fights, and heard the captains shout, + And in each battle saw who faced about; + I saw who wounded were, and who were slain; + And who, when dead, would come to life again. + I heard the cries of those that wounded were, + (While others fought like men bereft of fear,) + And while the cry, ‘Kill, kill,’ was in mine ears, + The gutters ran, not so with blood as tears. + Indeed, the captains did not always fight, + But then they would molest us day and night; + Their cry, ‘Up, fall on, let us take the town,’ + Kept us from sleeping, or from lying down. + I was there when the gates were broken ope, + And saw how Mansoul then was stripp’d of hope; + I saw the captains march into the town, + How there they fought, and did their foes cut down. + I heard the Prince bid Boanerges go + Up to the castle, and there seize his foe; + And saw him and his fellows bring him down, + In chains of great contempt quite through the town. + I saw Emmanuel, when he possess’d + His town of Mansoul; and how greatly blest + A town his gallant town of Mansoul was, + When she received his pardon, loved his laws. + When the Diabolonians were caught, + When tried, and when to execution brought, + Then I was there; yea, I was standing by + When Mansoul did the rebels crucify. + I also saw Mansoul clad all in white, + I heard her Prince call her his heart’s delight. + I saw him put upon her chains of gold, + And rings, and bracelets, goodly to behold. + What shall I say? I heard the people’s cries, + And saw the Prince wipe tears from Mansoul’s eyes. + And heard the groans, and saw the joy of many: + Tell you of all, I neither will, nor can I. + But by what here I say, you well may see + That Mansoul’s matchless wars no fables be. + Mansoul, the desire of both princes was: + One keep his gain would, t’other gain his loss. + Diabolus would cry, ‘The town is mine!’ + Emmanuel would plead a right divine + Unto his Mansoul: then to blows they go, + And Mansoul cries, ‘These wars will me undo.’ + Mansoul! her wars seemed endless in her eyes; + She’s lost by one, becomes another’s prize: + And he again that lost her last would swear, + ‘Have her I will, or her in pieces tear.’ + Mansoul! it was the very seat of war; + Wherefore her troubles greater were by far + Than only where the noise of war is heard, + Or where the shaking of a sword is fear’d; + Or only where small skirmishes are fought, + Or where the fancy fighteth with a thought. + She saw the swords of fighting men made red, + And heard the cries of those with them wounded: + Must not her frights, then, be much more by far + Than theirs that to such doings strangers are? + Or theirs that hear the beating of a drum, + But not made fly for fear from house and home? + Mansoul not only heard the trumpet’s sound, + But saw her gallants gasping on the ground: + Wherefore we must not think that she could rest + With them, whose greatest earnest is but jest: + Or where the blust’ring threat’ning of great wars + Do end in parlies, or in wording jars. + Mansoul! her mighty wars, they did portend + Her weal or woe, and that world without end: + Wherefore she must be more concern’d than they + Whose fears begin, and end the selfsame day; + Or where none other harm doth come to him + That is engaged, but loss of life or limb, + As all must needs confess that now do dwell + In Universe, and can this story tell. + Count me not, then, with them that, to amaze + The people, set them on the stars to gaze, + Insinuating with much confidence, + That each of them is now the residence + Of some brave creatures: yea, a world they will + Have in each star, though it be past their skill + To make it manifest to any man, + That reason hath, or tell his fingers can. + But I have too long held thee in the porch, + And kept thee from the sunshine with a torch, + Well, now go forward, step within the door, + And there behold five hundred times much more + Of all sorts of such inward rarities + As please the mind will, and will feed the eyes + With those, which, if a Christian, thou wilt see + Not small, but things of greatest moment be. + Nor do thou go to work without my key; + (In mysteries men soon do lose their way;) + And also turn it right, if thou wouldst know + My riddle, and wouldst with my heifer plough; + It lies there in the window. Fare thee well, + My next may be to ring thy passing-bell. + + JOHN BUNYAN. + + + + +AN ADVERTISEMENT TO THE READER. + + + SOME say the ‘Pilgrim’s Progress’ is not mine, + Insinuating as if I would shine + In name and fame by the worth of another, + Like some made rich by robbing of their brother. + Or that so fond I am of being sire, + I’ll father bastards; or, if need require, + I’ll tell a lie in print to get applause. + I scorn it: John such dirt-heap never was, + Since God converted him. Let this suffice + To show why I my ‘Pilgrim’ patronize. + It came from mine own heart, so to my head, + And thence into my fingers trickled; + Then to my pen, from whence immediately + On paper I did dribble it daintily. + Manner and matter, too, was all mine own, + Nor was it unto any mortal known + Till I had done it; nor did any then + By books, by wits, by tongues, or hand, or pen, + Add five words to it, or write half a line + Thereof: the whole, and every whit is mine. + Also for THIS, thine eye is now upon, + The matter in this manner came from none + But the same heart, and head, fingers, and pen, + As did the other. Witness all good men; + For none in all the world, without a lie, + Can say that this is mine, excepting I + I write not this of my ostentation, + Nor ‘cause I seek of men their commendation; + I do it to keep them from such surmise, + As tempt them will my name to scandalize. + Witness my name, if anagram’d to thee, + The letters make—‘Nu hony in a B.’ + + JOHN BUNYAN. + + + + +A RELATION OF THE HOLY WAR. + + +IN my travels, as I walked through many regions and countries, it was my +chance to happen into that famous continent of Universe. A very large +and spacious country it is: it lieth between the two poles, and just +amidst the four points of the heavens. It is a place well watered, and +richly adorned with hills and valleys, bravely situate, and for the most +part, at least where I was, very fruitful, also well peopled, and a very +sweet air. + +The people are not all of one complexion, nor yet of one language, mode, +or way of religion, but differ as much as, it is said, do the planets +themselves. Some are right, and some are wrong, even as it happeneth to +be in lesser regions. + +In this country, as I said, it was my lot to travel; and there travel I +did, and that so long, even till I learned much of their mother tongue, +together with the customs and manners of them among whom I was. And, to +speak truth, I was much delighted to see and hear many things which I saw +and heard among them; yea, I had, to be sure, even lived and died a +native among them, (so was I taken with them and their doings,) had not +my master sent for me home to his house, there to do business for him, +and to oversee business done. + +Now there is in this gallant country of Universe a fair and delicate +town, a corporation called Mansoul; a town for its building so curious, +for its situation so commodious, for its privileges so advantageous, (I +mean with reference to its origin,) that I may say of it, as was said +before of the continent in which it is placed, There is not its equal +under the whole heaven. + +As to the situation of this town, it lieth just between the two worlds; +and the first founder and builder of it, so far as by the best and most +authentic records I can gather, was one Shaddai; and he built it for his +own delight. He made it the mirror and glory of all that he made, even +the top-piece, beyond anything else that he did in that country. Yea, so +goodly a town was Mansoul when first built, that it is said by some, the +gods, at the setting up thereof, came down to see it, and sang for joy. +And as he made it goodly to behold, so also mighty to have dominion over +all the country round about. Yea, all were commanded to acknowledge +Mansoul for their metropolitan, all were enjoined to do homage to it. +Aye, the town itself had positive commission and power from her King to +demand service of all, and also to subdue any that anyways denied to do +it. + +There was reared up in the midst of this town a most famous and stately +palace; for strength, it might be called a castle; for pleasantness, a +paradise; for largeness, a place so copious as to contain all the world. +This place the King Shaddai intended but for himself alone, and not +another with him; partly because of his own delights, and partly because +he would not that the terror of strangers should be upon the town. This +place Shaddai made also a garrison of, but committed the keeping of it +only to the men of the town. + +The walls of the town were well built, yea, so fast and firm were they +knit and compact together, that, had it not been for the townsmen +themselves, they could not have been shaken or broken for ever. For here +lay the excellent wisdom of him that builded Mansoul, that the walls +could never be broken down nor hurt by the most mighty adverse potentate, +unless the townsmen gave consent thereto. + +This famous town of Mansoul had five gates, in at which to come, out at +which to go; and these were made likewise answerable to the walls, to +wit, impregnable, and such as could never be opened nor forced but by the +will and leave of those within. The names of the gates were these: +Ear-gate, Eye-gate, Mouth-gate, Nose-gate, and Feel-gate. + +Other things there were that belonged to the town of Mansoul, which if +you adjoin to these, will yet give farther demonstration to all, of the +glory and strength of the place. It had always a sufficiency of +provision within its walls; it had the best, most wholesome, and +excellent law that then was extant in the world. There was not a rascal, +rogue, or traitorous person then within its walls; they were all true +men, and fast joined together; and this, you know, is a great matter. +And to all these, it had always (so long as it had the goodness to keep +true to Shaddai the King) his countenance, his protection, and it was his +delight, etc. + +Well, upon a time, there was one Diabolus, a mighty giant, made an +assault upon this famous town of Mansoul, to take it, and make it his own +habitation. This giant was king of the blacks, and a most raving prince +he was. We will, if you please, first discourse of the origin of this +Diabolus, and then of his taking of this famous town of Mansoul. + +This Diabolus is indeed a great and mighty prince, and yet both poor and +beggarly. As to his origin, he was at first one of the servants of King +Shaddai, made, and taken, and put by him into most high and mighty place; +yea, was put into such principalities as belonged to the best of his +territories and dominions. This Diabolus was made ‘son of the morning,’ +and a brave place he had of it: it brought him much glory, and gave him +much brightness, an income that might have contented his Luciferian +heart, had it not been insatiable, and enlarged as hell itself. + +Well, he seeing himself thus exalted to greatness and honour, and raging +in his mind for higher state and degree, what doth he but begins to think +with himself how he might be set up as lord over all, and have the sole +power under Shaddai. (Now that did the King reserve for his Son, yea, +and had already bestowed it upon him.) Wherefore he first consults with +himself what had best to be done; and then breaks his mind to some other +of his companions, to the which they also agreed. So, in fine, they came +to this issue that they should make an attempt upon the King’s Son to +destroy him, that the inheritance might be theirs. Well, to be short, +the treason, as I said, was concluded, the time appointed, the word +given, the rebels rendezvoused, and the assault attempted. Now the King +and his Son being all and always eye, could not but discern all passages +in his dominions; and he, having always love for his Son as for himself, +could not at what he saw but be greatly provoked and offended: wherefore +what does he, but takes them in the very nick and first trip that they +made towards their design, convicts them of the treason, horrid +rebellion, and conspiracy that they had devised, and now attempted to put +into practice, and casts them altogether out of all place of trust, +benefit, honour, and preferment. This done, he banishes them the court, +turns them down into the horrible pits, as fast bound in chains, never +more to expect the least favour from his hands, but to abide the judgment +that he had appointed, and that for ever. + +Now they being thus cast out of all place of trust, profit, and honour, +and also knowing that they had lost their prince’s favour for ever, +(being banished his court, and cast down to the horrible pits,) you may +he sure they would now add to their former pride what malice and rage +against Shaddai, and against his Son, they could. Wherefore, roving and +ranging in much fury from place to place, if, perhaps, they might find +something that was the King’s, by spoiling of that, to revenge themselves +on him; at last they happened into this spacious country of Universe, and +steer their course towards the town of Mansoul; and considering that that +town was one of the chief works and delights of King Shaddai, what do +they but, after counsel taken, make an assault upon that. I say, they +knew that Mansoul belonged unto Shaddai; for they were there when he +built it and beautified it for himself. So when they had found the +place, they shouted horribly for joy, and roared on it as a lion upon the +prey, saying, ‘Now we have found the prize, and how to be revenged on +King Shaddai for what he hath done to us.’ So they sat down and called a +council of war, and considered with themselves what ways and methods they +had best to engage in for the winning to themselves this famous town of +Mansoul, and these four things were then propounded to be considered of. + +First. Whether they had best all of them to show themselves in this +design to the town of Mansoul. + +Secondly. Whether they had best to go and sit down against Mansoul in +their now ragged and beggarly guise. + +Thirdly. Whether they had best show to Mansoul their intentions, and +what design they came about, or whether to assault it with words and ways +of deceit. + +Fourthly. Whether they had not best to some of their companions to give +out private orders to take the advantage, if they see one or more of the +principal townsmen, to shoot them, if thereby they shall judge their +cause and design will the better be promoted. + +1. It was answered to the first of these proposals in the negative, to +wit, that it would not be best that all should show themselves before the +town, because the appearance of many of them might alarm and frighten the +town; whereas a few or but one of them was not so likely to do it. And +to enforce this advice to take place it was added further, that if +Mansoul was frighted, or did take the alarm, ‘It is impossible,’ said +Diabolus (for he spake now), ‘that we should take the town: for that none +can enter into it without its own consent. Let, therefore, but few, or +but one, assault Mansoul; and in mine opinion,’ said Diabolus, ‘let me be +he.’ Wherefore to this they all agreed. + +2. And then to the second proposal they came, namely, Whether they had +best go and sit down before Mansoul in their now ragged and beggarly +guise. To which it was answered also in the negative, By no means; and +that because, though the town of Mansoul had been made to know, and to +have to do, before now, with things that are invisible, they did never as +yet see any of their fellow-creatures in so sad and rascally condition as +they; and this was the advice of that fierce Alecto. Then said Apollyon, +‘The advice is pertinent; for even one of us appearing to them as we are +now, must needs both beget and multiply such thoughts in them as will +both put them into a consternation of spirit, and necessitate them to put +themselves upon their guard. And if so,’ said he, ‘then, as my Lord +Diabolus said but now, it is in vain for us to think of taking the town.’ +Then said that mighty giant Beelzebub, ‘The advice that already is given +is safe; for though the men of Mansoul have seen such things as we once +were, yet hitherto they did never behold such things as we now are; and +it is best, in mine opinion, to come upon them in such a guise as is +common to, and most familiar among them.’ To this, when they had +consented, the next thing to be considered was, in what shape, hue, or +guise Diabolus had best to show himself when he went about to make +Mansoul his own. Then one said one thing, and another the contrary. At +last Lucifer answered, that, in his opinion, it was best that his +lordship should assume the body of some of those creatures that they of +the town had dominion over; ‘for,’ quoth he, ‘these are not only familiar +to them, but, being under them, they will never imagine that an attempt +should by them be made upon the town; and, to blind all, let him assume +the body of one of those beasts that Mansoul deems to be wiser than any +of the rest.’ This advice was applauded of all: so it was determined +that the giant Diabolus should assume the dragon, for that he was in +those days as familiar with the town of Mansoul as now is the bird with +the boy; for nothing that was in its primitive state was at all amazing +to them. Then they proceeded to the third thing, which was: + +3. Whether they had best to show their intentions, or the design of his +coming, to Mansoul, or no. This also was answered in the negative, +because of the weight that was in the former reasons, to wit, for that +Mansoul were a strong people, a strong people in a strong town, whose +wall and gates were impregnable, (to say nothing of their castle,) nor +can they by any means be won but by their own consent. ‘Besides,’ said +Legion, (for he gave answer to this,) ‘a discovery of our intentions may +make them send to their king for aid; and if that be done, I know quickly +what time of day it will be with us. Therefore let us assault them in +all pretended fairness, covering our intentions with all manner of lies, +flatteries, delusive words; feigning things that never will be, and +promising that to them that they shall never find. This is the way to +win Mansoul, and to make them of themselves open their gates to us; yea, +and to desire us too to come in to them. And the reason why I think that +this project will do is, because the people of Mansoul now are, every +one, simple and innocent, all honest and true; nor do they as yet know +what it is to be assaulted with fraud, guile, and hypocrisy. They are +strangers to lying and dissembling lips; wherefore we cannot, if thus we +be disguised, by them at all be discerned; our lies shall go for true +sayings, and our dissimulations for upright dealings. What we promise +them they will in that believe us, especially if, in all our lies and +feigned words, we pretend great love to them, and that our design is only +their advantage and honour.’ Now there was not one bit of a reply +against this; this went as current down as doth the water down a steep +descent. Wherefore they go to consider of the last proposal, which was: + +4. Whether they had not best to give out orders to some of their company +to shoot some one or more of the principal of the townsmen, if they judge +that their cause may be promoted thereby. This was carried in the +affirmative, and the man that was designed by this stratagem to be +destroyed was one Mr. Resistance, otherwise called Captain Resistance. +And a great man in Mansoul this Captain Resistance was, and a man that +the giant Diabolus and his band more feared than they feared the whole +town of Mansoul besides. Now who should be the actor to do the murder? +That was the next, and they appointed one Tisiphone, a fury of the lake, +to do it. + +They thus having ended their council of war, rose up, and essayed to do +as they had determined; they marched towards Mansoul, but all in a manner +invisible, save one, only one; nor did he approach the town in his own +likeness, but under the shade and in the body of the dragon. + +So they drew up and sat down before Ear-gate, for that was the place of +hearing for all without the town, as Eye-gate was the place of +perspection. So, as I said, he came up with his train to the gate, and +laid his ambuscado for Captain Resistance within bow-shot of the town. +This done, the giant ascended up close to the gate, and called to the +town of Mansoul for audience. Nor took he any with him but one +Ill-pause, who was his orator in all difficult matters. Now, as I said, +he being come up to the gate, (as the manner of those times was,) sounded +his trumpet for audience; at which the chief of the town of Mansoul, such +as my Lord Innocent, my Lord Willbewill, my Lord Mayor, Mr. Recorder, and +Captain Resistance, came down to the wall to see who was there, and what +was the matter. And my Lord Willbewill, when he had looked over and saw +who stood at the gate, demanded what he was, wherefore he was come, and +why he roused the town of Mansoul with so unusual a sound. + +Diabolus, then, as if he had been a lamb, began his oration, and said: +‘Gentlemen of the famous town of Mansoul, I am, as you may perceive, no +far dweller from you, but near, and one that is bound by the king to do +you my homage and what service I can; wherefore, that I may be faithful +to myself and to you, I have somewhat of concern to impart unto you. +Wherefore, grant me your audience, and hear me patiently. And first, I +will assure you, it is not myself, but you—not mine, but your advantage +that I seek by what I now do, as will full well be made manifest, by that +I have opened my mind unto you. For, gentlemen, I am (to tell you the +truth) come to show you how you may obtain great and ample deliverance +from a bondage that, unawares to yourselves, you are captivated and +enslaved under.’ At this the town of Mansoul began to prick up its ears. +And ‘What is it? Pray what is it?’ thought they. And he said, ‘I have +somewhat to say to you concerning your King, concerning his law, and also +touching yourselves. Touching your King, I know he is great and potent; +but yet all that he hath said to you is neither true nor yet for your +advantage. 1. It is not true, for that wherewith he hath hitherto awed +you, shall not come to pass, nor be fulfilled, though you do the thing +that he hath forbidden. But if there was danger, what a slavery is it to +live always in fear of the greatest of punishments, for doing so small +and trivial a thing as eating of a little fruit is. 2. Touching his +laws, this I say further, they are both unreasonable, intricate, and +intolerable. Unreasonable, as was hinted before; for that the punishment +is not proportioned to the offence: there is great difference and +disproportion between the life and an apple; yet the one must go for the +other by the law of your Shaddai. But it is also intricate, in that he +saith, first, you may eat of all; and yet after forbids the eating of +one. And then, in the last place, it must needs be intolerable, +forasmuch as that fruit which you are forbidden to eat of (if you are +forbidden any) is that, and that alone, which is able, by your eating, to +minister to you a good as yet unknown by you. This is manifest by the +very name of the tree; it is called the “tree of knowledge of good and +evil;” and have you that knowledge as yet? No, no; nor can you conceive +how good, how pleasant, and how much to be desired to make one wise it +is, so long as you stand by your King’s commandment. Why should you be +holden in ignorance and blindness? Why should you not be enlarged in +knowledge and understanding? And now, O ye inhabitants of the famous +town of Mansoul, to speak more particularly to yourselves you are not a +free people! You are kept both in bondage and slavery, and that by a +grievous threat; no reason being annexed but, “So I will have it; so it +shall be.” And is it not grievous to think on, that that very thing +which you are forbidden to do might you but do it, would yield you both +wisdom and honour? for then your eyes will be opened, and you shall be as +gods. Now, since this is thus,’ quoth he, ‘can you be kept by any prince +in more slavery and in greater bondage than you are under this day? You +are made underlings, and are wrapped up in inconveniences, as I have well +made appear. For what bondage greater than to be kept in blindness? +Will not reason tell you that it is better to have eyes than to be +without them? and so to be at liberty to be better than to be shut up in +a dark and stinking cave?’ + +And just now, while Diabolus was speaking these words to Mansoul, +Tisiphone shot at Captain Resistance, where he stood on the gate, and +mortally wounded him in the head; so that he, to the amazement of the +townsmen, and the encouragement of Diabolus, fell down dead quite over +the wall. Now, when Captain Resistance was dead, (and he was the only +man of war in the town,) poor Mansoul was wholly left naked of courage, +nor had she now any heart to resist. But this was as the devil would +have it. Then stood forth he, Mr. Ill-pause, that Diabolus brought with +him, who was his orator; and he addressed himself to speak to the town of +Mansoul; the tenour of whose speech here follows:— + +‘Gentlemen,’ quoth he, ‘it is my master’s happiness that he has this day +a quiet and teachable auditory; and it is hoped by us that we shall +prevail with you not to cast off good advice. My master has a very great +love for you; and although, as he very well knows, that he runs the +hazard of the anger of King Shaddai, yet love to you will make him do +more than that. Nor doth there need that a word more should be spoken to +confirm for truth what he hath said; there is not a word but carries with +it self-evidence in its bowels; the very name of the tree may put an end +to all controversy in this matter. I therefore, at this time, shall only +add this advice to you, under and by the leave of my lord;’ (and with +that he made Diabolus a very low congee;) ‘consider his words, look on +the tree and the promising fruit thereof; remember also that yet you know +but little, and that this is the way to know more: and if your reasons be +not conquered to accept of such good counsel, you are not the men that I +took you to be.’ + +But when the townsfolk saw that the tree was good for food, and that it +was pleasant to the eye, and a tree to be desired to make one wise, they +did as old Ill-pause advised; they took and did eat thereof. Now this I +should have told you before, that even then, when this Ill-pause was +making his speech to the townsmen, my Lord Innocency (whether by a shot +from the camp of the giant, or from some sinking qualm that suddenly took +him, or whether by the stinking breath of that treacherous villain old +Ill-pause, for so I am most apt to think) sunk down in the place where he +stood, nor could be brought to life again. Thus these two brave men +died—brave men, I call them; for they were the beauty and glory of +Mansoul, so long as they lived therein; nor did there now remain any more +a noble spirit in Mansoul; they all fell down and yielded obedience to +Diabolus; and became his slaves and vassals, as you shall hear. + +Now these being dead, what do the rest of the townsfolk, but, as men that +had found a fool’s paradise, they presently, as afore was hinted, fall to +prove the truth of the giant’s words. And, first, they did as Ill-pause +had taught them; they looked, they considered they were taken with the +forbidden fruit; they took thereof, and did eat; and having eaten, they +became immediately drunken therewith. So they open the gate, both +Ear-gate and Eye-gate, and let in Diabolus with all his bands, quite +forgetting their good Shaddai, his law, and the judgment that he had +annexed, with solemn threatening, to the breach thereof. + +Diabolus, having now obtained entrance in at the gates of the town, +marches up to the middle thereof, to make his conquest as sure as he +could; and finding, by this time, the affections of the people warmly +inclining to him, he, as thinking it was best striking while the iron is +hot, made this further deceivable speech unto them, saying, ‘Alas, my +poor Mansoul! I have done thee indeed this service, as to promote thee +to honour, and to greaten thy liberty; but, alas! alas! poor Mansoul, +thou wantest now one to defend thee; for assure thyself that when Shaddai +shall hear what is done, he will come; for sorry will he be that thou +hast broken his bonds, and cast his cords away from thee. What wilt thou +do? Wilt thou, after enlargement, suffer thy privileges to be invaded +and taken away, or what wilt resolve with thyself?’ + +Then they all with one consent said to this bramble, ‘Do thou reign over +us.’ So he accepted the motion, and became the king of the town of +Mansoul. This being done, the next thing was to give him possession of +the castle, and so of the whole strength of the town. Wherefore, into +the castle he goes; it was that which Shaddai built in Mansoul for his +own delight and pleasure; this now was become a den and hold for the +giant Diabolus. + +Now, having got possession of this stately palace or castle, what doth he +but makes it a garrison for himself, and strengthens and fortifies it +with all sorts of provision, against the King Shaddai, or those that +should endeavour the regaining of it to him and his obedience again. + +This done, but not thinking himself yet secure enough, in the next place +he bethinks himself of new modelling the town; and so he does, setting up +one, and putting down another at pleasure. Wherefore my Lord Mayor, +whose name was my Lord Understanding, and Mr. Recorder, whose name was +Mr. Conscience, these he put out of place and power. + +As for my Lord Mayor, though he was an understanding man, and one too +that had complied with the rest of the town of Mansoul in admitting the +giant into the town, yet Diabolus thought not fit to let him abide in his +former lustre and glory, because he was a seeing man. Wherefore he +darkened him, not only by taking from him his office and power, but by +building a high and strong tower, just between the sun’s reflections and +the windows of my lord’s palace; by which means his house and all, and +the whole of his habitation, were made as dark as darkness itself. And +thus, being alienated from the light, he became as one that was born +blind. To this, his house, my lord was confined as to a prison; nor +might he, upon his parole, go farther than within his own bounds. And +now, had he had a heart to do for Mansoul, what could he do for it, or +wherein could he be profitable to her? So then, so long as Mansoul was +under the power and government of Diabolus, (and so long it was under +him, as it was obedient to him, which was even until by a war it was +rescued out of his hand,) so long my Lord Mayor was rather an impediment +in, than an advantage to the famous town of Mansoul. + +As for Mr. Recorder, before the town was taken, he was a man well read in +the laws of his king, and also a man of courage and faithfulness to speak +truth at every occasion; and he had a tongue as bravely hung as he had a +head filled with judgment. Now, this man Diabolus could by no means +abide, because, though he gave his consent to his coming into the town, +yet he could not, by all the wiles, trials, stratagems, and devices that +he could use, make him wholly his own. True, he was much degenerated +from his former king, and also much pleased with many of the giant’s laws +and service; but all this would not do, forasmuch as he was not wholly +his. He would now and then think upon Shaddai, and have dread of his law +upon him, and then he would speak against Diabolus with a voice as great +as when a lion roareth. Yea, and would also at certain times, when his +fits were upon him, (for you must know that sometimes he had terrible +fits,) make the whole town of Mansoul shake with his voice: and therefore +the now king of Mansoul could not abide him. + +Diabolus, therefore, feared the Recorder more than any that was left +alive in the town of Mansoul, because, as I said, his words did shake the +whole town; they were like the rattling thunder, and also like +thunder-claps. Since, therefore, the giant could not make him wholly his +own, what doth he do but studies all that he could to debauch the old +gentleman, and by debauchery to stupefy his mind, and more harden his +heart in the ways of vanity. And as he attempted, so he accomplished his +design: he debauched the man, and by little and little so drew him into +sin and wickedness, that at last he was not only debauched, as at first, +and so by consequence defiled, but was almost (at last, I say) past all +conscience of sin. And this was the farthest Diabolus could go. +Wherefore he bethinks him of another project, and that was, to persuade +the men of the town that Mr. Recorder was mad, and so not to be regarded. +And for this he urged his fits, and said, ‘If he be himself, why doth he +not do thus always? But,’ quoth he, ‘as all mad folks have their fits, +and in them their raving language, so hath this old and doating +gentleman.’ + +Thus, by one means or another, he quickly got Mansoul to slight, neglect, +and despise whatever Mr. Recorder could say. For, besides what already +you have heard, Diabolus had a way to make the old gentleman, when he was +merry, unsay and deny what he in his fits had affirmed. And, indeed, +this was the next way to make himself ridiculous, and to cause that no +man should regard him. Also now he never spake freely for King Shaddai, +but also by force and constraint. Besides, he would at one time be hot +against that at which, at another, he would hold his peace; so uneven was +he now in his doings. Sometimes he would be as if fast asleep, and again +sometimes as dead, even then when the whole town of Mansoul was in her +career after vanity, and in her dance after the giant’s pipe. + +Wherefore, sometimes when Mansoul did use to be frighted with the +thundering voice of the Recorder that was, and when they did tell +Diabolus of it, he would answer, that what the old gentleman said was +neither of love to him nor pity to them, but of a foolish fondness that +he had to be prating; and so would hush, still, and put all to quiet +again. And that he might leave no argument unurged that might tend to +make them secure, he said, and said it often, ‘O Mansoul! consider that, +notwithstanding the old gentleman’s rage, and the rattle of his high and +thundering words, you hear nothing of Shaddai himself;’ when, liar and +deceiver that he was, every outcry of Mr. Recorder against the sin of +Mansoul was the voice of God in him to them. But he goes on, and says, +‘You see that he values not the loss nor rebellion of the town of +Mansoul, nor will he trouble himself with calling his town to a reckoning +for their giving themselves to me. He knows that though you were his, +now you are lawfully mine; so, leaving us one to another, he now hath +shaken his hands of us. + +‘Moreover, O Mansoul!’ quoth he, ‘consider how I have served you, even to +the uttermost of my power; and that with the best that I have, could get, +or procure for you in all the world: besides, I dare say that the laws +and customs that you now are under, and by which you do homage to me, do +yield you more solace and content than did the paradise that at first you +possessed. Your liberty also, as yourselves do very well know, has been +greatly widened and enlarged by me; whereas I found you a penned-up +people. I have not laid any restraint upon you; you have no law, +statute, or judgment of mine to fright you; I call none of you to account +for your doings, except the madman—you know who I mean; I have granted +you to live, each man like a prince in his own, even with as little +control from me as I myself have from you.’ + +And thus would Diabolus hush up and quiet the town of Mansoul, when the +Recorder that was, did at times molest them: yea, and with such cursed +orations as these, would set the whole town in a rage and fury against +the old gentleman. Yea, the rascal crew at some times would be for +destroying him. They have often wished, in my hearing, that he had lived +a thousand miles off from them: his company, his words, yea, the sight of +him, and specially when they remembered how in old times he did use to +threaten and condemn them, (for all he was now so debauched,) did terrify +and afflict them sore. + +But all wishes were vain, for I do not know how, unless by the power of +Shaddai, and his wisdom, he was preserved in being amongst them. +Besides, his house was as strong as a castle, and stood hard by a +stronghold of the town: moreover, if at any time any of the crew or +rabble attempted to make him away, he could pull up the sluices, and let +in such floods as would drown all round about him. + +But to leave Mr. Recorder, and to come to my Lord Willbewill, another of +the gentry of the famous town of Mansoul. This Willbewill was as +high-born as any man in Mansoul, and was as much, if not more, a +freeholder than many of them were; besides, if I remember my tale aright, +he had some privileges peculiar to himself in the famous town of Mansoul. +Now, together with these, he was a man of great strength, resolution, and +courage, nor in his occasion could any turn him away. But I say, whether +he was proud of his estate, privileges, strength, or what, (but sure it +was through pride of something,) he scorns now to be a slave in Mansoul; +and therefore resolves to bear office under Diabolus, that he might (such +an one as he was) be a petty ruler and governor in Mansoul. And, +headstrong man that he was! thus he began betimes; for this man, when +Diabolus did make his oration at Ear-gate, was one of the first that was +for consenting to his words, and for accepting his counsel at wholesome, +and that was for the opening of the gate, and for letting him into the +town; wherefore Diabolus had a kindness for him, and therefore he +designed for him a place. And perceiving the valour and stoutness of the +man, he coveted to have him for one of his great ones, to act and do in +matters of the highest concern. + +So he sent for him, and talked with him of that secret matter that lay in +his breast, but there needed not much persuasion in the case. For as at +first he was willing that Diabolus should be let into the town, so now he +was as willing to serve him there. When the tyrant, therefore, perceived +the willingness of my lord to serve him, and that his mind stood bending +that way, he forthwith made him the captain of the castle, governor of +the wall, and keeper of the gates of Mansoul: yea, there was a clause in +his commission, that nothing without him should be done in all the town +of Mansoul. So that now, next to Diabolus himself, who but my Lord +Willbewill in all the town of Mansoul! nor could anything now be done, +but at his will and pleasure, throughout the town of Mansoul. He had +also one Mr. Mind for his clerk, a man to speak on every way like his +master: for he and his lord were in principle one, and in practice not +far asunder. And now was Mansoul brought under to purpose, and made to +fulfil the lusts of the will, and of the mind. + +But it will not out of my thoughts what a desperate one this Willbewill +was when power was put into his hand. First, he flatly denied that he +owed any suit or service to his former prince and liege lord. This done, +in the next place he took an oath, and swore fidelity to his great master +Diabolus, and then, being stated and settled in his places, offices, +advancements, and preferments, oh! you cannot think, unless you had seen +it, the strange work that this workman made in the town of Mansoul. + +First, he maligned Mr. Recorder to death; he would neither endure to see +him, nor hear the words of his mouth; he would shut his eyes when he saw +him, and stop his ears when he heard him speak. Also he could not endure +that so much as a fragment of the law of Shaddai should be anywhere seen +in the town. For example, his clerk, Mr. Mind, had some old, rent, and +torn parchments of the law of Shaddai in his house, but when Willbewill +saw them, he cast them behind his back. True, Mr. Recorder had some of +the laws in his study; but my lord could by no means come at them. He +also thought and said, that the windows of my old Lord Mayor’s house were +always too light for the profit of the town of Mansoul. The light of a +candle he could not endure. Now nothing at all pleased Willbewill but +what pleased Diabolus his lord. + +There was none like him to trumpet about the streets the brave nature, +the wise conduct, and great glory of the king Diabolus. He would range +and rove throughout all the streets of Mansoul to cry up his illustrious +lord, and would make himself even as an abject, among the base and rascal +crew, to cry up his valiant prince. And I say, when and wheresoever he +found these vassals, he would even make himself as one of them. In all +ill courses he would act without bidding, and do mischief without +commandment. + +The Lord Willbewill also had a deputy under him, and his name was Mr. +Affection, one that was also greatly debauched in his principles, and +answerable thereto in his life: he was wholly given to the flesh, and +therefore they called him Vile-Affection. Now there was he and one +Carnal-Lust, the daughter of Mr. Mind, (like to like,) that fell in love, +and made a match, and were married; and, as I take it, they had several +children, as Impudent, Blackmouth, and Hate-Reproof. These three were +black boys. And besides these they had three daughters, as Scorn-Truth +and Slight-God, and the name of the youngest was Revenge. These were all +married in the town, and also begot and yielded many bad brats, too many +to be here inserted. But to pass by this. + +When the giant had thus engarrisoned himself in the town of Mansoul, and +had put down and set up whom he thought good, he betakes himself to +defacing. Now there was in the market-place in Mansoul, and also upon +the gates of the castle, an image of the blessed King Shaddai. This +image was so exactly engraven, (and it was engraven in gold,) that it did +the most resemble Shaddai himself of anything that then was extant in the +world. This he basely commanded to be defaced, and it was as basely done +by the hand of Mr. No-Truth. Now you must know that, as Diabolus had +commanded, and that by the hand of Mr. No-Truth, the image of Shaddai was +defaced, he likewise gave order that the same Mr. No-Truth should set up +in its stead the horrid and formidable image of Diabolus, to the great +contempt of the former King, and debasing of his town of Mansoul. + +Moreover, Diabolus made havoc of all remains of the laws and statutes of +Shaddai that could be found in the town of Mansoul; to wit, such as +contained either the doctrines of morals, with all civil and natural +documents. Also relative severities he sought to extinguish. To be +short, there was nothing of the remains of good in Mansoul which he and +Willbewill sought not to destroy; for their design was to turn Mansoul +into a brute, and to make it like to the sensual sow, by the hand of Mr. +No-Truth. + +When he had destroyed what law and good orders he could, then further to +effect his design, namely, to alienate Mansoul from Shaddai her King, he +commands, and they set up his own vain edicts, statutes, and +commandments, in all places of resort or concourse in Mansoul, to wit, +such as gave liberty to the lusts of the flesh, the lusts of the eyes, +and the pride of life, which are not of Shaddai, but of the world. He +encouraged, countenanced, and promoted lasciviousness, and all +ungodliness there. Yea, much more did Diabolus to encourage wickedness +in the town of Mansoul; he promised them peace, content, joy, and bliss, +in doing his commands, and that they should never be called to an account +for their not doing the contrary. And let this serve to give a taste to +them that love to hear tell of what is done beyond their knowledge afar +off in other countries. + +Now Mansoul being wholly at his beck, and brought wholly to his bow, +nothing was heard or seen therein but that which tended to set up him. + +But now he, having disabled the Lord Mayor and Mr. Recorder from bearing +of office in Mansoul, and seeing that the town, before he came to it, was +the most ancient of corporations in the world, and fearing, if he did not +maintain greatness, they at any time should object that he had done them +an injury; therefore, I say, (that they might see that he did not intend +to lessen their grandeur, or to take from them any of their advantageous +things,) he did choose for them a Lord Mayor and a Recorder himself, and +such as contented them at the heart, and such also as pleased him +wondrous well. + +The name of the Mayor that was of Diabolus’ making was the Lord Lustings, +a man that had neither eyes nor ears. All that he did, whether as a man +or an officer, he did it naturally, as doth the beast. And that which +made him yet the more ignoble, though not to Mansoul, yet to them that +beheld and were grieved for its ruin, was, that he never could favour +good, but evil. + +The Recorder was one whose name was Forget-Good, and a very sorry fellow +he was. He could remember nothing but mischief, and to do it with +delight. He was naturally prone to do things that were hurtful, even +hurtful to the town of Mansoul, and to all the dwellers there. These +two, therefore, by their power and practice, examples, and smiles upon +evil, did much more grammar and settle the common people in hurtful ways. +For who doth not perceive that when those that sit aloft are vile and +corrupt themselves, they corrupt the whole region and country where they +are? + +Besides these, Diabolus made several burgesses and aldermen in Mansoul, +such as out of whom the town, when it needed, might choose them officers, +governors, and magistrates. And these are the names of the chief of +them: Mr. Incredulity, Mr. Haughty, Mr. Swearing, Mr. Whoring, Mr. +Hard-Heart, Mr. Pitiless, Mr. Fury, Mr. No-Truth, Mr. Stand-to-Lies, Mr. +False-Peace, Mr. Drunkenness, Mr. Cheating, Mr. Atheism—thirteen in all. +Mr. Incredulity is the eldest, and Mr. Atheism the youngest of the +company. + +There was also an election of common councilmen and others, as bailiffs, +sergeants, constables, and others; but all of them like to those +afore-named, being either fathers, brothers, cousins, or nephews to them, +whose names, for brevity’s sake, I omit to mention. + +When the giant had thus far proceeded in his work, in the next place, he +betook him to build some strongholds in the town, and he built three that +seemed to be impregnable. The first he called the Hold of Defiance, +because it was made to command the whole town, and to keep it from the +knowledge of its ancient King. The second he called Midnight Hold, +because it was built on purpose to keep Mansoul from the true knowledge +of itself. The third was called Sweet-Sin Hold, because by that he +fortified Mansoul against all desires of good. The first of these holds +stood close by Eye-gate, that, as much might be, light might be darkened +there; the second was built hard by the old castle, to the end that that +might be made more blind, if possible; and the third stood in the +market-place. + +He that Diabolus made governor over the first of these was one Spite-God, +a most blasphemous wretch: he came with the whole rabble of them that +came against Mansoul at first, and was himself one of themselves. He +that was made the governor of Midnight Hold was one Love-no-Light; he was +also of them that came first against the town. And he that was made the +governor of the hold called Sweet-Sin Hold was one whose name was +Love-Flesh: he was also a very lewd fellow, but not of that country where +the other are bound. This fellow could find more sweetness when he stood +sucking of a lust than he did in all the paradise of God. + +And now Diabolus thought himself safe. He had taken Mansoul, he had +engarrisoned himself therein; he had put down the old officers, and had +set up new ones; he had defaced the image of Shaddai, and had set up his +own; he had spoiled the old law books, and had promoted his own vain +lies; he had made him new magistrates, and set up new aldermen; he had +builded him new holds, and had manned them for himself: and all this he +did to make himself secure, in case the good Shaddai, or his Son, should +come to make an incursion upon him. + +Now you may well think, that long before this time, word, by some one or +other, could not but be carried to the good King Shaddai, how his +Mansoul, in the continent of Universe, was lost; and that the runagate +giant Diabolus, once one of his Majesty’s servants, had, in rebellion +against the King, made sure thereof for himself. Yea, tidings were +carried and brought to the King thereof, and that to a very circumstance. + +At first, how Diabolus came upon Mansoul (they being a simple people and +innocent) with craft, subtlety, lies, and guile. _Item_, that he had +treacherously slain the right noble and valiant captain, their Captain +Resistance, as he stood upon the gate with the rest of the townsmen. +_Item_, how my brave Lord Innocent fell down dead (with grief, some say, +or with being poisoned with the stinking breath of one Ill-Pause, as say +others) at the hearing of his just lord and rightful prince, Shaddai, so +abused by the mouth of so filthy a Diabolian as that varlet Ill-Pause +was. The messenger further told, that after this Ill-Pause had made a +short oration to the townsmen in behalf of Diabolus, his master; the +simple town, believing that what was said was true, with one consent did +open Ear-gate, the chief gate of the corporation, and did let him, with +his crew, into a possession of the famous town of Mansoul. He further +showed how Diabolus had served the Lord Mayor and Mr. Recorder, to wit, +that he had put them from all place of power and trust. _Item_, he +showed also that my Lord Willbewill was turned a very rebel, and +runagate, and that so was one Mr. Mind, his clerk; and that they two did +range and revel it all the town over, and teach the wicked ones their +ways. He said, moreover, that this Willbewill was put into great trust, +and particularly that Diabolus had put into Willbewill’s hand all the +strong places in Mansoul; and that Mr. Affection was made my Lord +Willbewill’s deputy in his most rebellious affairs. ‘Yea,’ said the +messenger, ‘this monster, Lord Willbewill, has openly disavowed his King +Shaddai, and hath horribly given his faith and plighted his troth to +Diabolus.’ + +‘Also,’ said the messenger, ‘besides all this, the new king, or rather +rebellious tyrant, over the once famous, but now perishing town of +Mansoul, has set up a Lord Mayor and a Recorder of his own. For Mayor, +he has set up one Mr. Lustings; and for Recorder, Mr. Forget-Good; two of +the vilest of all the town of Mansoul.’ This faithful messenger also +proceeded, and told what a sort of new burgesses Diabolus had made; also +that he had built several strong forts, towers, and strongholds in +Mansoul. He told, too, the which I had almost forgot, how Diabolus had +put the town of Mansoul into arms, the better to capacitate them, on his +behalf, to make resistance against Shaddai their King, should he come to +reduce them to their former obedience. + +Now this tidings-teller did not deliver his relation of things in +private, but in open court, the King and his Son, high lords, chief +captains, and nobles, being all there present to hear. But by that they +had heard the whole of the story, it would have amazed one to have seen, +had he been there to behold it, what sorrow and grief, and compunction of +spirit, there was among all sorts, to think that famous Mansoul was now +taken: only the King and his Son foresaw all this long before, yea, and +sufficiently provided for the relief of Mansoul, though they told not +everybody thereof. Yet because they also would have a share in condoling +of the Misery of Mansoul, therefore they also did, and that at a rate of +the highest degree, bewail the losing of Mansoul. The King said plainly +that it grieved him at the heart, and you may be sure that his Son was +not a whit behind him. Thus gave they conviction to all about them that +they had love and compassion for the famous town of Mansoul. Well, when +the King and his Son were retired into the privy chamber, there they +again consulted about what they had designed before, to wit, that as +Mansoul should in time be suffered to be lost, so as certainly it should +be recovered again; recovered, I say, in such a way, as that both the +King and his Son would get themselves eternal fame and glory thereby. +Wherefore, after this consult, the Son of Shaddai (a sweet and comely +Person, and one that had always great affection for those that were in +affliction, but one that had mortal enmity in his heart against Diabolus, +because he was designed for it, and because he sought his crown and +dignity)—this Son of Shaddai, I say, having stricken hands with his +Father and promised that he would be his servant to recover his Mansoul +again, stood by his resolution, nor would he repent of the same. The +purport of which agreement was this: to wit, that at a certain time, +prefixed by both, the King’s Son should take a journey into the country +of Universe, and there, in a way of justice and equity, by making amends +for the follies of Mansoul, he should lay a foundation of perfect +deliverance from Diabolus and from his tyranny. + +Moreover Emmanuel resolved to make, at a time convenient, a war upon the +giant Diabolus, even while he was possessed of the town of Mansoul; and +that he would fairly by strength of hand drive him out of his hold, his +nest, and take it to himself to be his habitation. + +This now being resolved upon, order was given to the Lord Chief Secretary +to draw up a fair record of what was determined, and to cause that it +should be published in all the corners of the kingdom of Universe. A +short breviate of the contents thereof you may, if you please, take here +as follows: + +‘Let all men know who are concerned, that the Son of Shaddai, the great +King, is engaged by covenant to his Father to bring his Mansoul to him +again; yea, and to put Mansoul, too, through the power of his matchless +love, into a far better and more happy condition than it was in before it +was taken by Diabolus.’ + +These papers, therefore, were published in several places, to the no +little molestation of the tyrant Diabolus; ‘for now,’ thought he, ‘I +shall be molested, and my habitation will be taken from me.’ + +But when this matter, I mean this purpose of the King and his Son, did at +first take air at court, who can tell how the high lords, chief captains, +and noble princes that were there, were taken with the business! First, +they whispered it one to another, and after that it began to ring out +through the King’s palace, all wondering at the glorious design that +between the King and his Son was on foot for the miserable town of +Mansoul. Yea, the courtiers could scarce do anything either for the King +or kingdom, but they would mix, with the doing thereof, a noise of the +love of the King and his Son, that they had for the town of Mansoul. + +Nor could these lords, high captains, and princes be content to keep this +news at court; yea, before the records thereof were perfected, themselves +came down and told it in Universe. At last it came to the ears, as I +said, of Diabolus, to his no little discontent; for you must think it +would perplex him to hear of such a design against him. Well, but after +a few casts in his mind, he concluded upon these four things. + +First, that this news, these good tidings, (if possible,) should be kept +from the ears of the town of Mansoul; ‘for,’ said he, ‘if they should +once come to the knowledge that Shaddai, their former King, and Emmanuel +his Son, are contriving good for the town of Mansoul, what can be +expected by me, but that Mansoul will make a revolt from under my hand +and government, and return again to him?’ + +Now, to accomplish this his design, he renews his flattery with my Lord +Willbewill, and also gives him strict charge and command, that he should +keep watch by day and by night at all the gates of the town, especially +Ear-gate and Eye-gate; ‘for I hear of a design,’ quoth he, ‘a design to +make us all traitors, and that Mansoul must be reduced to its first +bondage again. I hope they are but flying stories,’ quoth he; ‘however, +let no such news by any means be let into Mansoul, lest the people be +dejected thereat. I think, my lord, it can be no welcome news to you; I +am sure it is none to me; and I think that, at this time, it should be +all our wisdom and care to nip the head of all such rumours as shall tend +to trouble our people. Wherefore I desire, my lord, that you will in +this matter do as I say. Let there be strong guards daily kept at every +gate of the town. Stop also and examine from whence such come that you +perceive do from far come hither to trade, nor let them by any means be +admitted into Mansoul, unless you shall plainly perceive that they are +favourers of our excellent government. I command, moreover,’ said +Diabolus, ‘that there be spies continually walking up and down the town +of Mansoul, and let them have power to suppress and destroy any that they +shall perceive to be plotting against us, or that shall prate of what by +Shaddai and Emmanuel is intended.’ + +This, therefore, was accordingly done; my Lord Willbewill hearkened to +his lord and master, went willingly after the commandment, and, with all +the diligence he could, kept any that would from going out abroad, or +that sought to bring these tidings to Mansoul, from coming into the town. + +Secondly, this done, in the next place, Diabolus, that he might make +Mansoul as sure as he could, frames and imposes a new oath and horrible +covenant upon the townsfolk:—To wit, that they should never desert him +nor his government, nor yet betray him, nor seek to alter his laws; but +that they should own, confess, stand by, and acknowledge him for their +rightful king, in defiance to any that do or hereafter shall, by any +pretence, law, or title whatever, lay claim to the town of Mansoul; +thinking, belike, that Shaddai had not power to absolve them from this +covenant with death, and agreement with hell. Nor did the silly Mansoul +stick or boggle at all at this most monstrous engagement; but, as if it +had been a sprat in the mouth of a whale, they swallowed it without any +chewing. Were they troubled at all? Nay, they rather bragged and +boasted of their so brave fidelity to the tyrant, their pretended king, +swearing that they would never be changelings, nor forsake their old lord +for a new. Thus did Diabolus tie poor Mansoul fast. + +Thirdly. But jealousy, that never thinks itself strong enough, put him, +in the next place, upon another exploit, which was, yet more, if +possible, to debauch this town of Mansoul. Wherefore he caused, by the +hand of one Mr. Filth, an odious, nasty, lascivious piece of beastliness +to be drawn up in writing, and to be set upon the castle gates; whereby +he granted and gave license to all his true and trusty sons in Mansoul to +do whatsoever their lustful appetites prompted them to do; and that no +man was to let, hinder, or control them, upon pain of incurring the +displeasure of their prince. + +Now this he did for these reasons:— + +1. That the town of Mansoul might be yet made weaker and weaker, and so +more unable, should tidings come that their redemption was designed, to +believe, hope, or consent to the truth thereof; for reason says, The +bigger the sinner, the less grounds of hopes of mercy. + +2. The second reason was, if perhaps Emmanuel, the Son of Shaddai their +King, by seeing the horrible and profane doings of the town of Mansoul, +might repent, though entered into a covenant of redeeming them, of +pursuing that covenant of their redemption; for he knew that Shaddai was +holy, and that his Son Emmanuel was holy; yea, he knew it by woeful +experience, for for his iniquity and sin was Diabolus cast from the +highest orbs. Wherefore what more rational than for him to conclude that +thus, for sin, it might fare with Mansoul? But fearing also lest this +knot should break, he bethinks himself of another, to wit:— + +Fourthly. To endeavour to possess all hearts in the town of Mansoul that +Shaddai was raising an army, to come to overthrow and utterly to destroy +this town of Mansoul. And this he did to forestall any tidings that +might come to their ears of their deliverance: ‘For,’ thought he, ‘if I +first bruit this, the tidings that shall come after will all be swallowed +up of this; for what else will Mansoul say, when they shall hear that +they must be delivered, but that the true meaning is, Shaddai intends to +destroy them? Wherefore he summons the whole town into the market-place, +and there, with deceitful tongue, thus he addressed himself unto them:— + +‘Gentlemen, and my very good friends, you are all, as you know, my legal +subjects, and men of the famous town of Mansoul. You know how, from the +first day that I have been with you until now, I have behaved myself +among you, and what liberty and great privileges you have enjoyed under +my government, I hope to your honour and mine, and also to your content +and delight. Now, my famous Mansoul, a noise of trouble there is abroad, +of trouble to the town of Mansoul; sorry I am thereof for your sakes: for +I received but now by the post from my Lord Lucifer, (and he useth to +have good intelligence,) that your old King Shaddai is raising an army to +come against you, to destroy you root and branch; and this, O Mansoul, is +now the cause that at this time I have called you together, namely, to +advise what in this juncture is best to be done. For my part, I am but +one, and can with ease shift for myself, did I list to seek my own case, +and to leave my Mansoul in all the danger; but my heart is so firmly +united to you, and so unwilling am I to leave you, that I am willing to +stand and fall with you, to the utmost hazard that shall befall me. What +say you, O my Mansoul? Will you now desert your old friend, or do you +think of standing by me?’ + +Then, as one man, with one mouth, they cried out together, ‘Let him die +the death that will not.’ + +Then said Diabolus again, ‘It is in vain for us to hope for quarter, for +this King knows not how to show it. True, perhaps, he, at his first +sitting down before us, will talk of and pretend to mercy, that thereby, +with the more ease, and less trouble, he may again make himself the +master of Mansoul. Whatever, therefore, he shall say, believe not one +syllable or tittle of it; for all such language is but to overcome us, +and to make us, while we wallow in our blood, the trophies of his +merciless victory. My mind is, therefore, that we resolve to the last +man to resist him, and not to believe him upon any terms, for in at that +door will come our danger. But shall we be flattered out of our lives? +I hope you know more of the rudiments of politics than to suffer +yourselves so pitifully to be served. + +‘But suppose he should, if he get us to yield, save some of our lives, or +the lives of some of them that are underlings in Mansoul, what help will +that be to you that are the chief of the town, especially you whom I have +set up and whose greatness has been procured by you through your faithful +sticking to me? And suppose, again, that he should give quarter to every +one of you, be sure he will bring you into that bondage under which you +were captivated before, or a worse, and then what good will your lives do +you? Shall you with him live in pleasure as you do now? No, no; you +must be bound by laws that will pinch you, and be made to do that which +at present is hateful to you. I am for you, if you are for me; and it is +better to die valiantly than to live like pitiful slaves. But, I say, +the life of a slave will be counted a life too good for Mansoul now. +Blood, blood, nothing but blood is in every blast of Shaddai’s trumpet +against poor Mansoul now. Pray, be concerned; I hear he is coming. Up, +and stand to your arms that now, while you have any leisure, I may learn +you some feats of war. Armour for you I have, and by me it is; yea, and +it is sufficient for Mansoul from top to toe; nor can you be hurt by what +his force can do, if you shall keep it well girt and fastened about you. +Come, therefore, to my castle, and welcome, and harness yourselves for +the war. There is helmet, breastplate, sword, and shield, and what not, +that will make you fight like men. + +‘1. My helmet, otherwise called an head-piece, is in hope of doing well +at last, what lives soever you live. This is that which they had who +said, that they should have peace, though they walked in the wickedness +of their heart, to add drunkenness to thirst. A piece of approved armour +this is, and whoever has it, and can hold it, so long no arrow, dart, +sword, or shield can hurt him. This, therefore, keep on, and thou wilt +keep off many a blow, my Mansoul. + +‘2. My breastplate is a breastplate of iron. I had it forged in mine own +country, and all my soldiers are armed therewith. In plain language, it +is a hard heart, a heart as hard as iron, and as much past feeling as a +stone; the which if you get and keep, neither mercy shall win you, nor +judgment fright you. This therefore, is a piece of armour most necessary +for all to put on that hate Shaddai, and that would fight against him +under my banner. + +‘3. My sword is a tongue that is set on fire of hell, and that can bend +itself to speak evil of Shaddai, his Son, his ways, and people. Use +this; it has been tried a thousand times twice told. Whoever hath it, +keeps it, and makes that use of it as I would have him, can never be +conquered by mine enemy. + +‘4. My, shield is unbelief, or calling into question the truth of the +word, or all the sayings that speak of the judgment that Shaddai has +appointed for wicked men. Use this shield; many attempts he has made +upon it, and sometimes, it is true, it has been bruised; but they that +have writ of the wars of Emmanuel against my servants, have testified +that he could do no mighty work there because of their unbelief. Now, to +handle this weapon of mine aright, it is not to believe things because +they are true, of what sort or by whomsoever asserted. If he speaks of +judgment, care not for it; if he speaks of mercy, care not for it; if he +promises, if he swears that he would do to Mansoul, if it turns, no hurt, +but good, regard not what is said, question the truth of all, for it is +to wield the shield of unbelief aright, and as my servants ought and do; +and he that doth otherwise loves me not, nor do I count him but an enemy +to me. + +‘5. Another part or piece,’ said Diabolus, ‘of mine excellent armour is a +dumb and prayerless spirit, a spirit that scorns to cry for mercy: +wherefore be you, my Mansoul, sure that you make use of this. What! cry +for quarter! Never do that, if you would be mine. I know you are stout +men, and am sure that I have clad you with that which is armour of proof. +Wherefore, to cry to Shaddai for mercy, let that be far from you. +Besides all this, I have a maul, firebrands, arrows, and death, all good +hand-weapons, and such as will do execution.’ + +After he had thus furnished his men with armour and arms, he addressed +himself to them in such like words as these: ‘Remember,’ quoth he, ‘that +I am your rightful king, and that you have taken an oath and entered into +covenant to be true to me and my cause: I say, remember this, and show +yourselves stout and valiant men of Mansoul. Remember also the kindness +that I have always showed to you, and that without your petition I have +granted to you external things; wherefore the privileges, grants, +immunities, profits, and honours wherewith I have endowed you do call +for, at your hands, returns of loyalty, my lion-like men of Mansoul: and +when so fit a time to show it as when another shall seek to take my +dominion over you into his own hands? One word more, and I have done. +Can we but stand, and overcome this one shock or brunt, I doubt not but +in little time all the world will be ours; and when that day comes, my +true hearts, I will make you kings, princes, and captains, and what brave +days shall we have then!’ + +Diabolus having thus armed and forearmed his servants and vassals in +Mansoul against their good and lawful King Shaddai, in the next place, he +doubleth his guards at the gates of the town, and he takes himself to the +castle, which was his stronghold. His vassals also, to show their wills, +and supposed (but ignoble) gallantry, exercise themselves in their arms +every day, and teach one another feats of war; they also defied their +enemies, and sang up the praises of their tyrant; they threatened also +what men they would be if ever things should rise so high as a war +between Shaddai and their king. + +Now all this time the good King, the King Shaddai, was preparing to send +an army to recover the town of Mansoul again from under the tyranny of +their pretended king Diabolus; but he thought good, at first, not to send +them by the hand and conduct of brave Emmanuel his Son, but under the +hand of some of his servants, to see first by them the temper of Mansoul, +and whether by them they would be won to the obedience of their King. +The army consisted of above forty thousand, all true men, for they came +from the King’s own court, and were those of his own choosing. + +They came up to Mansoul under the conduct of four stout generals, each +man being a captain of ten thousand men, and these are their names and +their ensigns. The name of the first was Boanerges, the name of the +second was Captain Conviction, the name of the third was Captain +Judgment, and the name of the fourth was Captain Execution. These were +the captains that Shaddai sent to regain Mansoul. + +These four captains, as was said, the King thought fit, in the first +place, to send to Mansoul, to make an attempt upon it; for indeed +generally in all his wars he did use to send these four captains in the +van, for they were very stout and rough-hewn men, men that were fit to +break the ice, and to make their way by dint of sword, and their men were +like themselves. + +To each of these captains the King gave a banner, that it might be +displayed, because of the goodness of his cause, and because of the right +that he had to Mansoul. + +First, to Captain Boanerges, for he was the chief, to him, I say, were +given ten thousand men. His ensign was Mr. Thunder; he bare the black +colours, and his scutcheon was the three burning thunderbolts. + +The second captain was Captain Conviction; to him also were given ten +thousand men. His ensign’s name was Mr. Sorrow; he did bear the pale +colours, and his scutcheon was the book of the law wide open, from whence +issued a flame of fire. + +The third captain was Captain Judgment; to him were given ten thousand +men. His ensign’s name was Mr. Terror; he bare the red colours, and his +scutcheon was a burning fiery furnace. + +The fourth captain was Captain Execution; to him were given ten thousand +men. His ensign was one Mr. Justice; he also bare the red colours, and +his scutcheon was a fruitless tree, with an axe lying at the root +thereof. + +These four captains, as I said, had every one of them under his command +ten thousand men, all of good fidelity to the King, and stout at their +military actions. + +Well, the captains and their forces, their men and under officers, being +had upon a day by Shaddai into the field, and there called all over by +their names, were then and there put into such harness as became their +degree and that service which now they were going about for their King. + +Now, when the King had mustered his forces, (for it is he that mustereth +the host to the battle,) he gave unto the captains their several +commissions, with charge and commandment in the audience of all the +soldiers, that they should take heed faithfully and courageously to do +and execute the same. Their commissions were, for the substance of them, +the same in form, though, as to name, title, place and degree of the +captains, there might be some, but very small variation. And here let me +give you an account of the matter and sum contained in their commission. + + _A Commission from the great Shaddai_, _King of Mansoul_, _to his + trusty and noble Captain_, _the Captain Boanerges_, _for his making + War upon the town of Mansoul_. + + ‘O, thou Boanerges, one of my stout and thundering captains over one + ten thousand of my valiant and faithful servants, go thou in my name, + with this thy force, to the miserable town of Mansoul; and when thou + comest thither, offer them first conditions of peace; and command + them that, casting off the yoke and tyranny of the wicked Diabolus, + they return to me, their rightful Prince and Lord. Command them also + that they cleanse themselves from all that is his in the town of + Mansoul, and look to thyself, that thou hast good satisfaction + touching the truth of their obedience. Thus when thou hast commanded + them, (if they in truth submit thereto,) then do thou, to the + uttermost of thy power, what in thee lies to set up for me a garrison + in the famous town of Mansoul; nor do thou hurt the least native that + moveth or breatheth therein, if they will submit themselves to me, + but treat thou such as if they were thy friend or brother; for all + such I love, and they shall be dear unto me, and tell them that I + will take a time to come unto them, and to let them know that I am + merciful. + + ‘But if they shall, notwithstanding thy summons and the producing of + thy authority, resist, stand out against thee, and rebel, then do I + command thee to make use of all thy cunning, power, might, and force, + to bring them under by strength of hand. Farewell.’ + +Thus you see the sum of their commissions; for, as I said before, for the +substance of them, they were the same that the rest of the noble captains +had. + +Wherefore they, having received each commander his authority at the hand +of their King, the day being appointed, and the place of their rendezvous +prefixed, each commander appeared in such gallantry as became his cause +and calling. So, after a new entertainment from Shaddai, with flying +colours they set forward to march towards the famous town of Mansoul. +Captain Boanerges led the van, Captain Conviction and Captain Judgment +made up the main body, and Captain Execution brought up the rear. They +then, having a great way to go, (for the town of Mansoul was far off from +the court of Shaddai,) marched through the regions and countries of many +people, not hurting or abusing any, but blessing wherever they came. +They also lived upon the King’s cost in all the way they went. + +Having travelled thus for many days, at last they came within sight of +Mansoul; the which when they saw, the captains could for their hearts do +no less than for a while bewail the condition of the town; for they +quickly saw how that it was prostrate to the will of Diabolus, and to his +ways and designs. + +Well, to be short, the captains came up before the town, march up to +Ear-gate, sit down there (for that was the place of hearing). So, when +they had pitched their tents and entrenched themselves, they addressed +themselves to make their assault. + +Now the townsfolk at first, beholding so gallant a company, so bravely +accoutred, and so excellently disciplined, having on their glittering +armour, and displaying of their flying colours, could not but come out of +their houses and gaze. But the cunning fox Diabolus, fearing that the +people, after this sight, should, on a sudden summons, open the gates to +the captains, came down with all haste from the castle, and made them +retire into the body of the town, who, when he had them there, made this +lying and deceivable speech unto them: + +‘Gentlemen,’ quoth he, ‘although you are my trusty and well-beloved +friends, yet I cannot but a little chide you for your late uncircumspect +action, in going out to gaze on that great and mighty force that but +yesterday sat down before, and have now entrenched themselves in order to +the maintaining of a siege against the famous town of Mansoul. Do you +know who they are, whence they come, and what is their purpose in sitting +down before the town of Mansoul? They are they of whom I have told you +long ago, that they would come to destroy this town, and against whom I +have been at the cost to arm you with _cap-a-pie_ for your body, besides +great fortifications for your mind. Wherefore, then, did you not rather, +even at the first appearance of them, cry out, “Fire the beacons!” and +give the whole town an alarm concerning them, that we might all have been +in a posture of defence, and been ready to have received them with the +highest acts of defiance? Then had you showed yourselves men to my +liking; whereas, by what you have done, you have made me half afraid—I +say, half afraid—that when they and we shall come to push a pike, I shall +find you want courage to stand it out any longer. Wherefore have I +commanded a watch, and that you should double your guards at the gates? +Wherefore have I endeavoured to make you as hard as iron, and your hearts +as a piece of the nether millstone? Was it, think you, that you might +show yourselves women, and that you might go out like a company of +innocents to gaze on your mortal foes? Fie, fie! put yourselves into a +posture of defence, beat up the drum, gather together in warlike manner, +that our foes may know that, before they shall conquer this corporation, +there are valiant men in the town of Mansoul. + +‘I will leave off now to chide, and will not further rebuke you; but I +charge you, that henceforwards you let me see no more such actions. Let +not henceforward a man of you, without order first obtained from me, so +much as show his head over the wall of the town of Mansoul. You have now +heard me; do as I have commanded, and you shall cause me that I dwell +securely with you, and that I take care, as for myself, so for your +safety and honour also. Farewell.’ + +Now were the townsmen strangely altered; they were as men stricken with a +panic fear; they ran to and fro through the streets of the town of +Mansoul, crying out, ‘Help, help! the men that turn the world upside down +are come hither also.’ Nor could any of them be quiet after; but still, +as men bereft of wit, they cried out, ‘The destroyers of our peace and +people are come.’ This went down with Diabolus. ‘Ah,’ quoth he to +himself, ‘this I like well: now it is as I would have it; now you show +your obedience to your prince. Hold you but here, and then let them take +the town if they can.’ + +Well, before the King’s forces had sat before Mansoul three days, Captain +Boanerges commanded his trumpeter to go down to Ear-gate, and there, in +the name of the great Shaddai, to summon Mansoul to give audience to the +message that he, in his Master’s name, was to them commanded to deliver. +So the trumpeter, whose name was Take-heed-what-you-hear, went up, as he +was commanded, to Ear-gate, and there sounded his trumpet for a hearing; +but there was none that appeared that gave answer or regard, for so had +Diabolus commanded. So the trumpeter returned to his captain, and told +him what he had done, and also how he had sped; whereat the captain was +grieved, but bid the trumpeter go to his tent. + +Again Captain Boanerges sendeth his trumpeter to Ear-gate, to sound as +before for a hearing; but they again kept close, came not out, nor would +they give him an answer, so observant were they of the command of +Diabolus their king. + +Then the captains and other field officers called a council of war, to +consider what further was to be done for the gaining of the town of +Mansoul; and, after some close and thorough debate upon the contents of +their commissions, they concluded yet to give to the town, by the hand of +the fore-named trumpeter, another summons to hear; but if that shall be +refused, said they, and that the town shall stand it out still, then they +determined, and bid the trumpeter tell them so, that they would +endeavour, by what means they could, to compel them by force to the +obedience of their King. + +So Captain Boanerges commanded his trumpeter to go up to Ear-gate again, +and, in the name of the great King Shaddai, to give it a very loud +summons to come down without delay to Ear-gate, there to give audience to +the King’s most noble captains. So the trumpeter went, and did as he was +commanded: he went up to Ear-gate, and sounded his trumpet, and gave a +third summons to Mansoul. He said, moreover, that if this they should +still refuse to do, the captains of his prince would with might come down +upon them, and endeavour to reduce them to their obedience by force. + +Then stood up my Lord Willbewill, who was the governor of the town, (this +Willbewill was that apostate of whom mention was made before,) and the +keeper of the gates of Mansoul. He therefore, with big and ruffling +words, demanded of the trumpeter who he was, whence he came, and what was +the cause of his making so hideous a noise at the gate, and speaking such +insufferable words against the town of Mansoul. + +The trumpeter answered, ‘I am servant to the most noble captain, Captain +Boanerges, general of the forces of the great King Shaddai, against whom +both thyself, with the whole town of Mansoul, have rebelled, and lift up +the heel; and my master, the captain, hath a special message to this +town, and to thee, as a member thereof; the which if you of Mansoul shall +peaceably hear, so; and if not, you must take what follows.’ + +Then said the Lord Willbewill, ‘I will carry thy words to my lord, and +will know what he will say.’ + +But the trumpeter soon replied, saying. ‘Our message is not to the giant +Diabolus, but to the miserable town of Mansoul; nor shall we at all +regard what answer by him is made, nor yet by any for him. We are sent +to this town to recover it from under his cruel tyranny, and to persuade +it to submit, as in former times it did, to the most excellent King +Shaddai.’ + +Then said the Lord Willbewill, ‘I will do your errand to the town.’ + +The trumpeter then replied, ‘Sir, do not deceive us, lest, in so doing, +you deceive yourselves much more.’ He added, moreover, ‘For we are +resolved, if in peaceable manner you do not submit yourselves, then to +make a war upon you, and to bring you under by force. And of the truth +of what I now say, this shall be a sign unto you,—you shall see the black +flag, with its hot, burning thunder-bolts, set upon the mount to-morrow, +as a token of defiance against your prince, and of our resolutions to +reduce you to your Lord and rightful King.’ + +So the said Lord Willbewill returned from off the wall, and the trumpeter +came into the camp. When the trumpeter was come into the camp, the +captains and officers of the mighty King Shaddai came together to know if +he had obtained a hearing, and what was the effect of his errand. So the +trumpeter told, saying, ‘When I had sounded my trumpet, and had called +aloud to the town for a hearing, my Lord Willbewill, the governor of the +town, and he that hath charge of the gates, came up when he heard me +sound, and, looking over the wall, he asked me what I was, whence I came, +and what was the cause of my making this noise. So I told him my errand, +and by whose authority I brought it. “Then,” said he, “I will tell it to +the governor and to Mansoul;” and then I returned to my lords.’ + +Then said the brave Boanerges, ‘Let us yet for a while lie still in our +trenches, and see what these rebels will do.’ + +Now when the time drew nigh that audience by Mansoul must be given to the +brave Boanerges and his companions, it was commanded that all the men of +war throughout the whole camp of Shaddai should as one man stand to their +arms, and make themselves ready, if the town of Mansoul shall hear, to +receive it forthwith to mercy; but if not, to force a subjection. So the +day being come, the trumpeters sounded, and that throughout the whole +camp, that the men of war might be in a readiness for that which then +should be the work of the day. But when they that were in the town of +Mansoul heard the sound of the trumpets throughout the camp of Shaddai, +and thinking no other but that it must be in order to storm the +corporation, they at first were put to great consternation of spirit; but +after they a little were settled again, they also made what preparation +they could for a war, if they did storm; else, to secure themselves. + +Well, when the utmost time was come, Boanerges was resolved to hear their +answer; wherefore he sent out his trumpeter again to summon Mansoul to a +hearing of the message that they had brought from Shaddai. + +So he went and sounded, and the townsmen came up, but made Ear-gate as +sure as they could. Now when they were come up to the top of the wall, +Captain Boanerges desired to see the Lord Mayor; but my Lord Incredulity +was then Lord Mayor, for he came in the room of my Lord Lustings. So +Incredulity came up and showed himself over the wall; but when the +Captain Boanerges had set his eyes upon him, he cried out aloud, ‘This is +not he: where is my Lord Understanding, the ancient Lord Mayor of the +town of Mansoul? for to him I would deliver my message.’ + +Then said the giant (for Diabolus was also come down) to the captain, +‘Mr. Captain, you have by your boldness given to Mansoul at least four +summonses to subject herself to your King, by whose authority I know not, +nor will I dispute that now. I ask, therefore, what is the reason of all +this ado, or what would you be at if you knew yourselves?’ + +Then Captain Boanerges, whose were the black colours, and whose scutcheon +was the three burning thunderbolts, taking no notice of the giant or of +his speech, thus addressed himself to the town of Mansoul: ‘Be it known +unto you, O unhappy and rebellious Mansoul, that the most gracious King, +the great King Shaddai, my Master, hath sent me unto you with commission’ +(and so he showed to the town his broad seal) ‘to reduce you to his +obedience; and he hath commanded me, in case you yield upon my summons, +to carry it to you as if you were my friends or brethren; but he also +hath bid, that if, after summons to submit you still stand out and rebel, +we should endeavour to take you by force.’ + +Then stood forth Captain Conviction, and said, (his were the pale +colours, and for a scutcheon he had the book of the law wide open, etc.,) +‘Hear, O Mansoul! Thou, O Mansoul, wast once famous for innocency, but +now thou art degenerated into lies and deceit. Thou hast heard what my +brother, the Captain Boanerges, hath said; and it is your wisdom, and +will be your happiness, to stoop to, and accept of conditions of peace +and mercy when offered, specially when offered by one against whom thou +hast rebelled, and one who is of power to tear thee in pieces, for so is +Shaddai, our King; nor, when he is angry, can anything stand before him. +If you say you have not sinned, or acted rebellion against our King, the +whole of your doings since the day that you cast off his service (and +there was the beginning of your sin) will sufficiently testify against +you. What else means your hearkening to the tyrant, and your receiving +him for your king? What means else your rejecting of the laws of +Shaddai, and your obeying of Diabolus? Yea, what means this your taking +up of arms against, and the shutting of your gates upon us, the faithful +servants of your King? Be ruled then, and accept of my brother’s +invitation, and overstand not the time of mercy, but agree with thine +adversary quickly. Ah, Mansoul! suffer not thyself to be kept from +mercy, and to be run into a thousand miseries, by the flattering wiles of +Diabolus. Perhaps that piece of deceit may attempt to make you believe +that we seek our own profit in this our service, but know it is obedience +to our King, and love to your happiness, that is the cause of this +undertaking of ours. + +‘Again I say to thee, O Mansoul, consider if it be not amazing grace that +Shaddai should so humble himself as he doth: now he, by us, reasons with +you, in a way of entreaty and sweet persuasions, that you would subject +yourselves to him. Has he that need of you that we are sure you have of +him? No, no; but he is merciful, and will not that Mansoul should die, +but turn to him and live.’ + +Then stood forth Captain Judgment, whose were the red colours, and for a +scutcheon he had the burning fiery furnace, and he said, ‘O ye, the +inhabitants of the town of Mansoul, that have lived so long in rebellion +and acts of treason against the King Shaddai, know that we come not +to-day to this place, in this manner, with our message of our own minds, +or to revenge our own quarrel; it is the King, my Master, that hath sent +us to reduce you to your obedience to him; the which if you refuse in a +peaceable way to yield, we have commission to compel you thereto. And +never think of yourselves, nor yet suffer the tyrant Diabolus to persuade +you to think, that our King, by his power, is not able to bring you down, +and to lay you under his feet; for he is the former of all things, and if +he touches the mountains, they smoke. Nor will the gate of the King’s +clemency stand always open; for the day that shall burn like an oven is +before him; yea, it hasteth greatly, it slumbereth not. + +‘O Mansoul, is it little in thine eyes that our King doth offer thee +mercy, and that after so many provocations? Yea, he still holdeth out +his golden sceptre to thee, and will not yet suffer his gate to be shut +against thee: wilt thou provoke him to do it? If so, consider of what I +say; to thee it is opened no more for ever. If thou sayest thou shalt +not see him, yet judgment is before him; therefore trust thou in him. +Yea, because there is wrath, beware lest he take thee away with his +stroke; then a great ransom cannot deliver thee. Will he esteem thy +riches? No, not gold, nor all the forces of strength. He hath prepared +his throne for judgment, for he will come with fire, and with his +chariots like a whirlwind, to render his anger with fury, and his rebukes +with flames of fire. Therefore, O Mansoul, take heed lest, after thou +hast fulfilled the judgment of the wicked, justice and judgment should +take hold of thee.’ + +Now while the Captain Judgment was making this oration to the town of +Mansoul, it was observed by some that Diabolus trembled; but he proceeded +in his parable and said, ‘O thou woful town of Mansoul, wilt thou not yet +set open thy gate to receive us, the deputies of thy King, and those that +would rejoice to see thee live? Can thine heart endure, or can thy hands +be strong, in the day that he shall deal in judgment with thee? I say, +canst thou endure to be forced to drink, as one would drink sweet wine, +the sea of wrath that our King has prepared for Diabolus and his angels? +Consider, betimes consider.’ + +Then stood forth the fourth captain, the noble Captain Execution, and +said, ‘O town of Mansoul, once famous, but now like the fruitless bough, +once the delight of the high ones, but now a den for Diabolus, hearken +also to me, and to the words that I shall speak to thee in the name of +the great Shaddai. Behold, the axe is laid to the root of the trees: +every tree, therefore, that bringeth not forth good fruit, is hewn down +and cast into the fire. + +‘Thou, O town of Mansoul, hast hitherto been this fruitless tree; thou +bearest nought but thorns and briars. Thy evil fruit bespeaks thee not +to be a good tree; thy grapes are grapes of gall, thy clusters are +bitter. Thou hast rebelled against thy King; and, lo! we, the power and +force of Shaddai, are the axe that is laid to thy root. What sayest +thou? Wilt thou turn? I say again, tell me, before the first blow is +given, wilt thou turn? Our axe must first be laid _to_ thy root before +it be laid _at_ thy root; it must first be laid _to_ thy root in a way of +threatening, before it is laid _at_ thy root by way of execution; and +between these two is required thy repentance, and this is all the time +that thou hast. What wilt thou do? Wilt thou turn, or shall I smite? +If I fetch my blow, Mansoul, down you go; for I have commission to lay my +axe _at_ as well as _to_ thy roots, nor will anything but yielding to our +King prevent doing of execution. What art thou fit for, O Mansoul, if +mercy preventeth not, but to be hewn down, and cast into the fire and +burned? + +‘O Mansoul, patience and forbearance do not act for ever: a year, or two, +or three, they may; but if thou provoke by a three years’ rebellion, (and +thou hast already done more than this,) then what follows but, ‘Cut it +down’? nay, ‘After that thou shalt cut it down.’ And dost thou think +that these are but threatenings, or that our King has not power to +execute his words? O Mansoul, thou wilt find that in the words of our +King, when they are by sinners made little or light of, there is not only +threatening, but burning coals of fire. + +‘Thou hast been a cumber-ground long already, and wilt thou continue so +still? Thy sin has brought this army to thy walls, and shall it bring it +in judgment to do execution into thy town? Thou hast heard what the +captains have said, but as yet thou shuttest thy gates. Speak out, +Mansoul; wilt thou do so still, or wilt thou accept of conditions of +peace?’ + +These brave speeches of these four noble captains the town of Mansoul +refused to hear; yet a sound thereof did beat against Ear-gate, though +the force thereof could not break it open. In fine, the town desired a +time to prepare their answer to these demands. The captains then told +them, that if they would throw out to them one Ill-Pause that was in the +town, that they might reward him according to his works, then they would +give them time to consider; but if they would not cast him to them over +the wall of Mansoul, then they would give them none; ‘for,’ said they, +‘we know that, so long as Ill-Pause draws breath in Mansoul, all good +consideration will be confounded, and nothing but mischief will come +thereon.’ + +Then Diabolus, who was there present, being loath to lose his Ill-Pause, +because he was his orator, (and yet be sure he had, could the captains +have laid their fingers on him,) was resolved at this instant to give +them answer by himself; but then changing his mind, he commanded the then +Lord Mayor, the Lord Incredulity, to do it, saying, ‘My lord, do you give +these runagates an answer, and speak out, that Mansoul may hear and +understand you.’ + +So Incredulity, at Diabolus’ command, began, and said, ‘Gentlemen, you +have here, as we do behold, to the disturbance of our prince and the +molestation of the town of Mansoul, camped against it: but from whence +you come, we will not know; and what you are, we will not believe. +Indeed, you tell us in your terrible speech that you have this authority +from Shaddai, but by what right he commands you to do it, of that we +shall yet be ignorant. + +‘You have also, by the authority aforesaid, summoned this town to desert +her lord, and, for protection, to yield up herself to the great Shaddai, +your King; flatteringly telling her, that if she will do it, he will pass +by and not charge her with her past offences. + +‘Further, you have also, to the terror of the town of Mansoul, threatened +with great and sore destructions to punish this corporation, if she +consents not to do as your wills would have her. + +‘Now, captains, from whencesoever you come, and though your designs be +ever so right, yet know ye that neither my Lord Diabolus, nor I, his +servant, Incredulity, nor yet our brave Mansoul, doth regard either your +persons, message, or the King that you say hath sent you. His power, his +greatness, his vengeance, we fear not; nor will we yield at all to your +summons. + +‘As for the war that you threaten to make upon us, we must therein defend +ourselves as well as we can; and know ye, that we are not without +wherewithal to bid defiance to you; and, in short, (for I will not be +tedious,) I tell you, that we take you to be some vagabond runagate crew, +that having shaken off all obedience to your King, have gotten together +in tumultuous manner, and are ranging from place to place to see if, +through the flatteries you are skilled to make on the one side, and +threats wherewith you think to fright on the other, to make some silly +town, city, or country, desert their place, and leave it to you; but +Mansoul is none of them. + +‘To conclude: we dread you not, we fear you not, nor will we obey your +summons. Our gates we will shut upon you, our place we will keep you out +of. Nor will we long thus suffer you to sit down before us: our people +must live in quiet: your appearance doth disturb them. Wherefore arise +with bag and baggage, and begone, or we will let fly from the walls +against you.’ + +This oration, made by old Incredulity, was seconded by desperate +Willbewill, in words to this effect: ‘Gentlemen, we have heard your +demands, and the noise of your threats, and have heard the sound of your +summons; but we fear not your force, we regard not your threats, but will +still abide as you found us. And we command you, that in three days’ +time you cease to appear in these parts, or you shall know what it is +once to dare offer to rouse the lion Diabolus when asleep in his town of +Mansoul.’ + +The Recorder, whose name was Forget-Good, he also added as followeth: +‘Gentlemen, my lords, as you see, have with mild and gentle words +answered your rough and angry speeches: they have, moreover, in my +hearing, given you leave quietly to depart as you came; wherefore, take +their kindness and be gone. We might have come out with force upon you, +and have caused you to feel the dint of our swords; but as we love ease +and quiet ourselves, so we love not to hurt or molest others.’ + +Then did the town of Mansoul shout for joy, as if by Diabolus and his +crew some great advantage had been gotten of the captains. They also +rang the bells, and made merry, and danced upon the walls. + +Diabolus also returned to the castle, and the Lord Mayor and Recorder to +their place; but the Lord Willbewill took special care that the gates +should be secured with double guards, double bolts, and double locks and +bars; and that Ear-gate especially might the better be looked to, for +that was the gate in at which the King’s forces sought most to enter. +The Lord Willbewill made one old Mr. Prejudice, an angry and +ill-conditioned fellow, captain of the ward at that gate, and put under +his power sixty men, called deaf men; men advantageous for that service, +forasmuch as they mattered no words of the captains, nor of the soldiers. + +Now when the captains saw the answer of the great ones, and that they +could not get a hearing from the old natives of the town, and that +Mansoul was resolved to give the King’s army battle, they prepared +themselves to receive them, and to try it out by the power of the arm. +And, first, they made their force more formidable against Ear-gate; for +they knew that, unless they could penetrate that, no good could be done +upon the town. This done, they put the rest of their men in their +places; after which, they gave out the word, which was, ‘YE MUST BE BORN +AGAIN.’ Then they sounded the trumpet; then they in the town made them +answer, with shout against shout, charge against charge, and so the +battle began. Now they in the town had planted upon the tower over +Ear-gate two great guns, the one called High-mind, and the other Heady. +Unto these two guns they trusted much; they were cast in the castle by +Diabolus’ founder, whose name was Mr. Puff-up, and mischievous pieces +they were. But so vigilant and watchful, when the captains saw them, +were they, that though sometimes their shot would go by their ears with a +whiz, yet they did them no harm. By these two guns the townsfolk made no +question but greatly to annoy the camp of Shaddai, and well enough to +secure the gate; but they had not much cause to boast of what execution +they did, as by what follows will be gathered. + +The famous Mansoul had also some other small pieces in it, of the which +they made use against the camp of Shaddai. + +They from the camp also did as stoutly, and with as much of that as may +in truth be called valour, let fly as fast at the town and at Ear-gate; +for they saw that, unless they could break open Ear-gate, it would be but +in vain to batter the wall. Now the King’s captains had brought with +them several slings, and two or three battering-rams; with their slings, +therefore, they battered the houses and people of the town, and with +their rams they sought to break Ear-gate open. + +The camp and the town had several skirmishes and brisk encounters, while +the captains with their engines made many brave attempts to break open or +beat down the tower that was over Ear-gate, and at the said gate to make +their entrance; but Mansoul stood it out so lustily, through the rage of +Diabolus, the valour of the Lord Willbewill, and the conduct of old +Incredulity, the Mayor, and Mr. Forget-Good, the Recorder, that the +charge and expense of that summer’s wars, on the King’s side, seemed to +be almost quite lost, and the advantage to return to Mansoul. But when +the captains saw how it was they made a fair retreat, and entrenched +themselves in their winter quarters. Now, in this war, you must needs +think there was much loss on both sides, of which be pleased to accept of +this brief account following. + +The King’s captains, when they marched from the court to come up against +Mansoul to war, as they came crossing over the country, they happened to +light upon three young fellows that had a mind to go for soldiers: proper +men they were, and men of courage and skill, to appearance. Their names +were Mr. Tradition, Mr. Human-Wisdom, and Mr. Man’s-Invention. So they +came up to the captains, and proffered their service to Shaddai. The +captains then told them of their design, and bid them not to be rash in +their offers; but the young men told them they had considered the thing +before, and that hearing they were upon their march for such a design, +came hither on purpose to meet them, that they might be listed under +their excellencies. Then Captain Boanerges, for that they were men of +courage, listed them into his company, and so away they went to the war. + +Now, when the war was begun, in one of the briskest skirmishes, so it +was, that a company of the Lord Willbewill’s men sallied out at the +sallyport or postern of the town, and fell in upon the rear of Captain +Boanerges’ men, where these three fellows happened to be; so they took +them prisoners, and away they carried them into the town, where they had +not lain long in durance, but it began to be noised about the streets of +the town what three notable prisoners the Lord Willbewill’s men had +taken, and brought in prisoners out of the camp of Shaddai. At length +tidings thereof were carried to Diabolus to the castle, to wit what my +Lord Willbewill’s men had done, and whom they had taken prisoners. + +Then Diabolus called for Willbewill, to know the certainty of this +matter. So he asked him, and he told him. Then did the giant send for +the prisoners, and, when they were come, demanded of them who they were, +whence they came, and what they did in the camp of Shaddai; and they told +him. Then he sent them to ward again. Not many days after, he sent for +them to him again, and then asked them if they would be willing to serve +him against their former captains. They then told him that they did not +so much live by religion as by the fates of fortune; and that since his +lordship was willing to entertain them, they should be willing to serve +him. Now while things were thus in hand, there was one Captain Anything, +a great doer, in the town of Mansoul; and to this Captain Anything did +Diabolus send these men, and a note under his hand, to receive them into +his company, the contents of which letter were thus: + +‘Anything, my darling,—The three men that are the bearers of this letter +have a desire to serve me in the war; nor know I better to whose conduct +to commit them than to thine. Receive them, therefore, in my name, and, +as need shall require, make use of them against Shaddai and his men. +Farewell.’ + +So they came, and he received them; and he made of two of them sergeants; +but he made Mr. Man’s-Invention his ancient-bearer. But thus much for +this, and now to return to the camp. + +They of the camp did also some execution upon the town; for they did beat +down the roof of the Lord Mayor’s house, and so laid him more open than +he was before. They had almost, with a sling, slain my Lord Willbewill +outright; but he made a shift to recover again. But they made a notable +slaughter among the aldermen, for with one only shot they cut off six of +them; to wit, Mr. Swearing, Mr. Whoring, Mr. Fury, Mr. Stand-to-Lies, Mr. +Drunkenness, and Mr. Cheating. + +They also dismounted the two guns that stood upon the tower over +Ear-gate, and laid them flat in the dirt. I told you before that the +King’s noble captains had drawn off to their winter quarters, and had +there entrenched themselves and their carriages, so as with the best +advantage to their King, and the greatest annoyance to the enemy, they +might give seasonable and warm alarms to the town of Mansoul. And this +design of them did so hit, that I may say they did almost what they would +to the molestation of the corporation. For now could not Mansoul sleep +securely as before, nor could they now go to their debaucheries with that +quietness as in times past; for they had from the camp of Shaddai such +frequent, warm, and terrifying alarms, yea, alarms upon alarms, first at +one gate and then at another, and again at all the gates at once, that +they were broken as to former peace. Yea, they had their alarms so +frequently, and that when the nights were at longest, the weather +coldest, and so consequently the season most unseasonable, that that +winter was to the town of Mansoul a winter by itself. Sometimes the +trumpets would sound, and sometimes the slings would whirl the stones +into the town. Sometimes ten thousand of the King’s soldiers would be +running round the walls of Mansoul at midnight, shouting and lifting up +the voice for the battle. Sometimes, again, some of them in the town +would be wounded, and their cry and lamentable voice would be heard, to +the great molestation of the now languishing town of Mansoul. Yea, so +distressed with those that laid siege against them were they, that, I +dare say, Diabolus, their king, had in these days his rest much broken. + +In these days, as I was informed, new thoughts, and thoughts that began +to run counter one to another, began to possess the minds of the men of +the town of Mansoul. Some would say, ‘There is no living thus.’ Others +would then reply, ‘This will be over shortly.’ Then would a third stand +up and answer, ‘Let us turn to the King Shaddai, and so put an end to +these troubles.’ And a fourth would come in with a fear, saying, ‘I +doubt he will not receive us.’ The old gentleman, too, the Recorder, +that was so before Diabolus took Mansoul, he also began to talk aloud, +and his words were now to the town of Mansoul as if they were great claps +of thunder. No noise now so terrible to Mansoul as was his, with the +noise of the soldiers and shoutings of the captains. + +Also things began to grow scarce in Mansoul; now the things that her soul +lusted after were departing from her. Upon all her pleasant things there +was a blast, and burning instead of beauty. Wrinkles now, and some shows +of the shadow of death, were upon the inhabitants of Mansoul. And now, O +how glad would Mansoul have been to have enjoyed quietness and +satisfaction of mind, though joined with the meanest condition in the +world! + +The captains also, in the deep of this winter, did send by the mouth of +Boanerges’ trumpeter a summons to Mansoul to yield up herself to the +King, the great King Shaddai. They sent it once, and twice, and thrice; +not knowing but that at some times there might be in Mansoul some +willingness to surrender up themselves unto them, might they but have the +colour of an invitation to do it under. Yea, so far as I could gather, +the town had been surrendered up to them before now, had it not been for +the opposition of old Incredulity, and the fickleness of the thoughts of +my Lord Willbewill. Diabolus also began to rave; wherefore Mansoul, as +to yielding, was not yet all of one mind; therefore they still lay +distressed under these perplexing fears. + +I told you but now that they of the King’s army had this winter sent +three times to Mansoul to submit herself. + +The first time the trumpeter went he went with words of peace, telling +them that the captains, the noble captains of Shaddai, did pity and +bewail the misery of the now perishing town of Mansoul, and were troubled +to see them so much to stand in the way of their own deliverance. He +said, moreover, that the captains bid him tell them, that if now poor +Mansoul would humble herself and turn, her former rebellions and most +notorious treasons should by their merciful King be forgiven them, yea, +and forgotten too. And having bid them beware that they stood not in +their own way, that they opposed not themselves, nor made themselves +their own losers, he returned again into the camp. + +The second time the trumpeter went, he did treat them a little more +roughly; for, after sound of trumpet, he told them that their continuing +in their rebellion did but chafe and heat the spirit of the captains, and +that they were resolved to make a conquest of Mansoul, or to lay their +bones before the town walls. + +He went again the third time, and dealt with them yet more roughly; +telling them that now, since they had been so horribly profane, he did +not know, not certainly know, whether the captains were inclining to +mercy or judgment. ‘Only,’ said he, ‘they commanded me to give you a +summons to open the gates unto them.’ So he returned, and went into the +camp. + +These three summonses, and especially the last two, did so distress the +town that they presently call a consultation, the result of which was +this—That my Lord Willbewill should go up to Ear-gate, and there, with +sound of trumpet, call to the captains of the camp for a parley. Well, +the Lord Willbewill sounded upon the wall; so the captains came up in +their harness, with their ten thousands at their feet. The townsmen then +told the captains that they had heard and considered their summons, and +would come to an agreement with them, and with their King Shaddai, upon +such certain terms, articles, and propositions as, with and by the order +of their prince, they to them were appointed to propound; to wit, they +would agree upon these grounds to be one people with them. + +1. If that those of their own company, as the now Lord Mayor and their +Mr. Forget-Good, with then brave Lord Willbewill, might, under Shaddai, +be still the governors of the town, castle, and gates of Mansoul. + +2. Provided that no man that now serveth under their great giant Diabolus +be by Shaddai cast out of house, harbour, or the freedom that he hath +hitherto enjoyed in the famous town of Mansoul. + +3. That it shall be granted them, that they of the town of Mansoul shall +enjoy certain of their rights and privileges; to wit, such as have +formerly been granted them, and that they have long lived in the +enjoyment of, under the reign of their king Diabolus, that now is, and +long has been, their only lord and great defender. + +4. That no new law, officer, or executioner of law or office, shall have +any power over them, without their own choice and consent. + +‘These be our propositions, or conditions of peace; and upon these +terms,’ said they, ‘we will submit to your King.’ + +But when the captains had heard this weak and feeble offer of the town of +Mansoul, and their high and bold demands, they made to them again, by +their noble captain, the Captain Boanerges, this speech following: + +‘O ye inhabitants of the town of Mansoul, when I heard your trumpet sound +for a parley with us, I can truly say I was glad; but when you said you +were willing to submit yourselves to our King and Lord, then I was yet +more glad; but when, by your silly provisos and foolish cavils, you laid +the stumbling-block of your iniquity before your own faces, then was my +gladness turned into sorrows, and my hopeful beginnings of your return, +into languishing fainting fears. + +‘I count that old Ill-Pause, the ancient enemy of Mansoul, did draw up +those proposals that now you present us with as terms of an agreement; +but they deserve not to be admitted to sound in the ear of any man that +pretends to have service for Shaddai. We do therefore jointly, and that +with the highest disdain, refuse and reject such things, as the greatest +of iniquities. + +‘But, O Mansoul, if you will give yourselves into our hands, or rather +into the hands of our King, and will trust him to make such terms with +and for you as shall seem good in his eyes, (and I dare say they shall be +such as you shall find to be most profitable to you,) then we will +receive you, and be at peace with you; but if you like not to trust +yourselves in the arms of Shaddai our King, then things are but where +they were before, and we know also what we have to do.’ + +Then cried out old Incredulity, the Lord Mayor, and said, ‘And who, being +out of the hands of their enemies, as ye see we are now, will be so +foolish as to put the staff out of their own hands into the hands of they +know not who? I, for my part, will never yield to so unlimited a +proposition. Do we know the manner and temper of their King? It is said +by some that he will be angry with his subjects if but the breadth of an +hair they chance to step out of the way; and by others, that he requireth +of them much more than they can perform. Wherefore, it seems, O Mansoul, +to be thy wisdom to take good heed what thou dost in this matter; for if +you once yield, you give up yourselves to another, and so you are no more +your own. Wherefore, to give up yourselves to an unlimited power, is the +greatest folly in the world; for now you indeed may repent, but can never +justly complain. But do you indeed know, when you are his, which of you +he will kill, and which of you he will save alive; or whether he will not +cut off every one of us, and send out of his own country another new +people, and cause them to inhabit this town?’ + +This speech of the Lord Mayor undid all, and threw flat to the ground +their hopes of an accord. Wherefore the captains returned to their +trenches, to their tents, and to their men, as they were; and the Mayor +to the castle and to his King. + +Now Diabolus had waited for his return, for he had heard that they had +been at their points. So, when he was come into the chamber of state, +Diabolus saluted him with—‘Welcome, my lord. How went matters betwixt +you to-day?’ So the Lord Incredulity, with a low congee, told him the +whole of the matter, saying, ‘Thus and thus said the captains of Shaddai, +and thus and thus said I.’ The which when it was told to Diabolus, he +was very glad to hear it, and said, ‘My Lord Mayor, my faithful +Incredulity, I have proved thy fidelity above ten times already, but +never yet found thee false. I do promise thee, if we rub over this +brunt, to prefer thee to a place of honour, a place far better than to be +Lord Mayor of Mansoul. I will make thee my universal deputy, and thou +shalt, next to me, have all nations under thy hand; yea, and thou shalt +lay bands upon them, that they may not resist thee; nor shall any of our +vassals walk more at liberty, but those that shall be content to walk in +thy fetters.’ + +Now came the Lord Mayor out from Diabolus, as if he had obtained a favour +indeed. Wherefore to his habitation he goes in great state, and thinks +to feed himself well enough with hopes, until the time came that his +greatness should be enlarged. + +But now, though the Lord Mayor and Diabolus did thus well agree, yet this +repulse to the brave captains put Mansoul into a mutiny. For while old +Incredulity went into the castle to congratulate his lord with what had +passed, the old Lord Mayor, that was so before Diabolus came to the town, +to wit, my Lord Understanding, and the old Recorder, Mr. Conscience, +getting intelligence of what had passed at Ear-gate, (for you must know +that they might not be suffered to be at that debate, lest they should +then have mutinied for the captains; but, I say, they got intelligence of +what had passed there, and were much concerned therewith,) wherefore +they, getting some of the town together, began to possess them with the +reasonableness of the noble captains’ demands, and with the bad +consequences that would follow upon the speech of old Incredulity, the +Lord Mayor; to wit how little reverence he showed therein either to the +captains or to their King; also how he implicitly charged them with +unfaithfulness and treachery. ‘For what less,’ quoth they, ‘could be +made of his words, when he said he would not yield to their proposition; +and added, moreover, a supposition that he would destroy us, when before +he had sent us word that he would show us mercy!’ The multitude, being +now possessed with the conviction of the evil that old Incredulity had +done, began to run together by companies in all places, and in every +corner of the streets of Mansoul; and first they began to mutter, then to +talk openly, and after that they run to and fro, and cried as they run, +‘Oh the brave captains of Shaddai! would we were under the government of +the captains, and of Shaddai their King!’ When the Lord Mayor had +intelligence that Mansoul was in an uproar, down he comes to appease the +people, and thought to have quashed their heat with the bigness and the +show of his countenance; but when they saw him, they came running upon +him, and had doubtless done him a mischief, had he not betaken himself to +house. However, they strongly assaulted the house where he was, to have +pulled it down about his ears; but the place was too strong, so they +failed of that. So he, taking some courage, addressed himself, out at a +window, to the people in this manner: + +‘Gentlemen, what is the reason that there is here such an uproar to-day?’ + +Then answered my Lord Understanding, ‘It is even because that thou and +thy master have carried it not rightly, and as you should, to the +captains of Shaddai; for in three things you are faulty. First, in that +you would not let Mr. Conscience and myself be at the hearing of your +discourse. Secondly, in that you propounded such terms of peace to the +captains that by no means could be granted, unless they had intended that +their Shaddai should have been only a titular prince, and that Mansoul +should still have had power by law to have lived in all lewdness and +vanity before him, and so by consequence Diabolus should still here be +king in power, and the other only king in name. Thirdly, for that thou +didst thyself, after the captains had showed us upon what conditions they +would have received us to mercy, even undo all again with thy unsavoury, +unseasonable, and ungodly speech.’ + +When old Incredulity had heard this speech, he cried out, ‘Treason! +treason! To your arms! to your arms! O ye, the trusty friends of +Diabolus in Mansoul.’ + +_Und._—Sir, you may put upon my words what meaning you please; but I am +sure that the captains of such an high lord as theirs is, deserved a +better treatment at your hands. + +Then said old Incredulity, ‘This is but little better. But, Sir,’ quoth +he, ‘what I spake I spake for my prince, for his government, and the +quieting of the people, whom by your unlawful actions you have this day +set to mutiny against us.’ + +Then replied the old Recorder, whose name was Mr. Conscience, and said, +‘Sir, you ought not thus to retort upon what my Lord Understanding hath +said. It is evident enough that he hath spoken the truth, and that you +are an enemy to Mansoul. Be convinced, then, of the evil of your saucy +and malapert language, and of the grief that you have put the captains +to; yea, and of the damages that you have done to Mansoul thereby. Had +you accepted of the conditions, the sound of the trumpet and the alarm of +war had now ceased about the town of Mansoul; but that dreadful sound +abides, and your want of wisdom in your speech has been the cause of it.’ + +Then said old Incredulity, ‘Sir, if I live, I will do your errand to +Diabolus, and there you shall have an answer to your words. Meanwhile we +will seek the good of the town, and not ask counsel of you.’ + +_Und._—Sir, your prince and you are both foreigners to Mansoul, and not +the natives thereof; and who can tell but that, when you have brought us +into greater straits, (when you also shall see that yourselves can be +safe by no other means than by flight,) you may leave us and shift for +yourselves, or set us on fire, and go away in the smoke, or by the light +of our burning, and so leave us in our ruins? + +_Incred._—Sir, you forget that you are under a governor, and that you +ought to demean yourself like a subject; and know ye, when my lord the +king shall hear of this day’s work, he will give you but little thanks +for your labour. + +Now while these gentlemen were thus in their chiding words, down come +from the walls and gates of the town the Lord Willbewill, Mr. Prejudice, +old Ill-Pause, and several of the new-made aldermen and burgesses, and +they asked the reason of the hubbub and tumult; and with that every man +began to tell his own tale, so that nothing could be heard distinctly. +Then was a silence commanded, and the old fox Incredulity began to speak. +‘My lord,’ quoth he, ‘here are a couple of peevish gentlemen, that have, +as a fruit of their bad dispositions, and, as I fear, through the advice +of one Mr. Discontent, tumultuously gathered this company against me this +day, and also attempted to run the town into acts of rebellion against +our prince.’ + +Then stood up all the Diabolonians that were present, and affirmed these +things to be true. + +Now when they that took part with my Lord Understanding and with Mr. +Conscience perceived that they were like to come to the worst, for that +force and power was on the other side, they came in for their help and +relief; so a great company was on both sides. Then they on Incredulity’s +side would have had the two old gentlemen presently away to prison; but +they on the other side said they should not. Then they began to cry up +parties again: the Diabolonians cried up old Incredulity, Forget-Good, +the new aldermen, and their great one Diabolus; and the other party, they +as fast cried up Shaddai, the captains, his laws, their mercifulness, and +applauded their conditions and ways. Thus the bickerment went awhile; at +last they passed from words to blows, and now there were knocks on both +sides. The good old gentleman, Mr. Conscience, was knocked down twice by +one of the Diabolonians, whose name was Mr. Benumbing; and my Lord +Understanding had like to have been slain with an arquebuse, but that he +that shot did not take his aim aright. Nor did the other side wholly +escape; for there was one Mr. Rashhead, a Diabolonian, that had his +brains beaten out by Mr. Mind, the Lord Willbewill’s servant; and it made +me laugh to see how old Mr. Prejudice was kicked and tumbled about in the +dirt; for though, a while since, he was made captain of a company of the +Diabolonians, to the hurt and damage of the town, yet now they had got +him under their feet, and, I’ll assure you, he had, by some of the Lord +Understanding’s party, his crown cracked to boot. Mr. Anything also, he +became a brisk man in the broil; but both sides were against him, because +he was true to none. Yet he had, for his malapertness, one of his legs +broken, and he that did it wished it had been his neck. Much more harm +was done on both sides, but this must not be forgotten; it was now a +wonder to see my Lord Willbewill so indifferent as he was: he did not +seem to take one side more than another, only it was perceived that he +smiled to see how old Prejudice was tumbled up and down in the dirt. +Also, when Captain Anything came halting up before him, he seemed to take +but little notice of him. + +Now, when the uproar was over, Diabolus sends for my Lord Understanding +and Mr. Conscience, and claps them both up in prison as the ringleaders +and managers of this most heavy, riotous rout in Mansoul. So now the +town began to be quiet again, and the prisoners were used hardly; yea, he +thought to have made them away, but that the present juncture did not +serve for that purpose, for that war was in all their gates. + +But let us return again to our story. The captains, when they were gone +back from the gate, and were come into the camp again, called a council +of war, to consult what was further for them to do. Now, some said, ‘Let +us go up presently, and fall upon the town;’ but the greatest part +thought rather better it would be to give them another summons to yield; +and the reason why they thought this to be best was, because that, so far +as could be perceived, the town of Mansoul now was more inclinable than +heretofore. ‘And if,’ said they, ‘while some of them are in a way of +inclination, we should by ruggedness give them distaste, we may set them +further from closing with our summons than we would be willing they +should.’ Wherefore to this advice they agreed, and called a trumpeter, +put words into his mouth, set him his time, and bid him God speed. Well, +many hours were not expired before the trumpeter addressed himself to his +journey. Wherefore, coming up to the wall of the town, he steereth his +course to Ear-gate, and there sounded, as he was commanded. They then +that were within came out to see what was the matter, and the trumpeter +made them this speech following: + +‘O hard-hearted and deplorable town of Mansoul, how long wilt thou love +thy sinful, sinful simplicity, and, ye fools, delight in your scorning? +As yet despise you the offers of peace and deliverance? As yet will ye +refuse the golden offers of Shaddai, and trust to the lies and falsehoods +of Diabolus? Think you, when Shaddai shall have conquered you, that the +remembrance of these your carriages towards him will yield you peace and +comfort, or that by ruffling language you can make him afraid as a +grasshopper? Doth he entreat you for fear of you? Do you think that you +are stronger than he? Look to the heavens, and behold and consider the +stars, how high are they? Can you stop the sun from running his course, +and hinder the moon from giving her light? Can you count the number of +the stars, or stay the bottles of heaven? Can you call for the waters of +the sea, and cause them to cover the face of the ground? Can you behold +every one that is proud, and abase him, and bind their faces in secret? +Yet these are some of the works of our King, in whose name this day we +come up unto you, that you may be brought under his authority. In his +name, therefore, I summon you again to yield up yourselves to his +captains.’ + +At this summons the Mansoulians seemed to be at a stand, and knew not +what answer to make. Wherefore Diabolus forthwith appeared, and took +upon him to do it himself; and thus he begins, but turns his speech to +them of Mansoul. + +‘Gentlemen,’ quoth he, ‘and my faithful subjects, if it is true that this +summoner hath said concerning the greatness of their King, by his terror +you will always be kept in bondage, and so be made to sneak. Yea, how +can you now, though he is at a distance, endure to think of such a mighty +one? And if not to think of him while at a distance, how can you endure +to be in his presence? I, your prince, am familiar with you, and you may +play with me as you would with a grasshopper. Consider, therefore, what +is for your profit, and remember the immunities that I have granted you. + +‘Farther, if all be true that this man hath said, how comes it to pass +that the subjects of Shaddai are so enslaved in all places where they +come? None in the universe so unhappy as they, none so trampled upon as +they. + +‘Consider, my Mansoul: would thou wert as loath to leave me as I am loath +to leave thee. But consider, I say, the ball is yet at thy foot; liberty +you have, if you know how to use it; yea, a king you have too, if you can +tell how to love and obey him.’ + +Upon this speech, the town of Mansoul did again harden their hearts yet +more against the captains of Shaddai. The thoughts of his greatness did +quite quash them, and the thoughts of his holiness sunk them in despair. +Wherefore, after a short consult, they (of the Diabolonian party they +were) sent back this word by the trumpeter, That, for their parts, they +were resolved to stick to their king, but never to yield to Shaddai; so +it was but in vain to give them any further summons, for they had rather +die upon the place than yield. And now things seemed to be gone quite +back, and Mansoul to be out of reach or call, yet the captains who knew +what their Lord could do, would not yet be beat out of heart; they +therefore sent them another summons, more sharp and severe than the last; +but the oftener they were sent to, to reconcile to Shaddai, the further +off they were. ‘As they called them, so they went from them—yea, though +they called them to the Most High.’ + +So they ceased that way to deal with them any more, and inclined to think +of another way. The captains, therefore, did gather themselves together, +to have free conference among themselves, to know what was yet to be done +to gain the town, and to deliver it from the tyranny of Diabolus; and one +said after this manner, and another after that. Then stood up the right +noble the Captain Conviction, and said, ‘My brethren, mine opinion is +this: + +‘First, that we continually play our slings into the town, and keep it in +a continual alarm, molesting them day and night. By thus doing, we shall +stop the growth of their rampant spirit; for a lion may be tamed by +continual molestation. + +‘Secondly, this done, I advise that, in the next place, we with one +consent draw up a petition to our Lord Shaddai, by which, after we have +showed our King the condition of Mansoul and of affairs here, and have +begged his pardon for our no better success, we will earnestly implore +his Majesty’s help, and that he will please to send us more force and +power, and some gallant and well-spoken commander to head them, that so +his Majesty may not lose the benefit of these his good beginnings, but +may complete his conquest upon the town of Mansoul.’ + +To this speech of the noble Captain Conviction they as one man consented, +and agreed that a petition should forthwith be drawn up, and sent by a +fit man away to Shaddai with speed. The contents of the petition were +thus:— + +‘Most gracious and glorious King, the Lord of the best world, and the +builder of the town of Mansoul, we have, dread Sovereign, at thy +commandment, put our lives in jeopardy, and at thy bidding made a war +upon the famous town of Mansoul. When we went up against it, we did, +according to our commission, first offer conditions of peace unto it. +But they, great King, set light by our counsel, and would none of our +reproof. They were for shutting their gates, and for keeping us out of +the town. They also mounted their guns, they sallied out upon us, and +have done us what damage they could; but we pursued them with alarm upon +alarm, requiting them with such retribution as was meet, and have done +some execution upon the town. + +‘Diabolus, Incredulity, and Willbewill are the great doers against us: +now we are in our winter quarters, but so as that we do yet with an high +hand molest and distress the town. + +‘Once, as we think, had we had but one substantial friend in the town, +such as would but have seconded the sound of our summons as they ought, +the people might have yielded themselves; but there were none but enemies +there, nor any to speak in behalf of our Lord to the town. Wherefore, +though we have done as we could, yet Mansoul abides in a state of +rebellion against thee. + +‘Now, King of kings, let it please thee to pardon the unsuccessfulness of +thy servants, who have been no more advantageous in so desirable a work +as the conquering of Mansoul is. And send, Lord, as we now desire, more +forces to Mansoul, that it may be subdued; and a man to head them, that +the town may both love and fear. + +‘We do not thus speak because we are willing to relinquish the wars, (for +we are for laying of our bones against the place,) but that the town of +Mansoul may be won for thy Majesty. We also pray thy Majesty, for +expedition in this matter, that, after their conquest, we may be at +liberty to be sent about other thy gracious designs. Amen.’ + +The petition, thus drawn up, was sent away with haste to the King by the +hand of that good man, Mr. Love-to-Mansoul. + +When this petition was come to the palace of the King, who should it be +delivered to but to the King’s Son? So he took it and read it, and +because the contents of it pleased him well, he mended, and also in some +things added to the petition himself. So, after he had made such +amendments and additions as he thought convenient, with his own hand, he +carried it in to the King; to whom, when he had with obeisance delivered +it, he put on authority, and spake to it himself. + +Now the King, at the sight of the petition, was glad; but how much more, +think you, when it was seconded by his Son! It pleased him also to hear +that his servants who camped against Mansoul were so hearty in the work, +and so steadfast in their resolves, and that they had already got some +ground upon the famous town of Mansoul. + +Wherefore the King called to him Emmanuel, his Son, who said, ‘Here am I, +my Father.’ Then said the King, ‘Thou knowest, as I do myself, the +condition of the town of Mansoul, and what we have purposed, and what +thou hast done to redeem it. Come now, therefore, my Son, and prepare +thyself for the war, for thou shalt go to my camp at Mansoul. Thou shalt +also there prosper and prevail, and conquer the town of Mansoul.’ + +Then said the King’s Son, ‘Thy law is within my heart: I delight to do +thy will. This is the day that I have longed for, and the work that I +have waited for all this while. Grant me, therefore, what force thou +shalt in thy wisdom think meet; and I will go and will deliver from +Diabolus, and from his power, thy perishing town of Mansoul. My heart +has been often pained within me for the miserable town of Mansoul; but +now it is rejoiced, but now it is glad.’ + +And with that he leaped over the mountains for joy, saying, ‘I have not, +in my heart, thought anything too dear for Mansoul: the day of vengeance +is in mine heart for thee, my Mansoul: and glad am I that thou, my +Father, hast made me the Captain of their salvation. And I will now +begin to plague all those that have been a plague to my town of Mansoul, +and will deliver it from their hand.’ + +When the King’s Son had said thus to his Father, it presently flew like +lightning round about at court; yea, it there became the only talk what +Emmanuel was to go to do for the famous town of Mansoul. But you cannot +think how the courtiers, too, were taken with this design of the Prince; +yea, so affected were they with this work, and with the justness of the +war, that the highest lord and greatest peer of the kingdom did covet to +have commissions under Emmanuel, to go to help to recover again to +Shaddai the miserable town of Mansoul. + +Then was it concluded that some should go and carry tidings to the camp, +that Emmanuel was to come to recover Mansoul, and that he would bring +along with him so mighty, so impregnable a force, that he could not be +resisted. But, oh! how ready were the high ones at court to run like +lackeys to carry these tidings to the camp that was at Mansoul. Now, +when the captains perceived that the King would send Emmanuel his Son, +and that it also delighted the Son to be sent on this errand by the great +Shaddai his Father, they also, to show how they were pleased at the +thoughts of his coming gave a shout that made the earth rend at the sound +thereof. Yea, the mountains did answer again by echo, and Diabolus +himself did totter and shake. + +For you must know, that though the town of Mansoul itself was not much, +if at all concerned with the project, (for, alas for them! they were +wofully besotted, for they chiefly regarded their pleasure and their +lusts,) yet Diabolus their governor was; for he had his spies continually +abroad, who brought him intelligence of all things, and they told him +what was doing at court against him, and that Emmanuel would shortly +certainly come with a power to invade him. Nor was there any man at +court, nor peer of the kingdom, that Diabolus so feared as he feared this +Prince; for, if you remember, I showed you before that Diabolus had felt +the weight of his hand already; so that, since it was he that was to +come, this made him the more afraid. + +Well, you see how I have told you that the King’s Son was engaged to come +from the court to save Mansoul, and that his Father had made him the +Captain of the forces. The time, therefore, of his setting forth being +now expired, he addressed himself for his march, and taketh with him, for +his power, five noble captains and their forces. + +1. The first was that famous captain, the noble Captain Credence. His +were the red colours, and Mr. Promise bare them; and for a scutcheon he +had the holy lamb and golden shield; and he had ten thousand men at his +feet. + +2. The second was that famous captain, the Captain Good-Hope. His were +the blue colours; his standard-bearer was Mr. Expectation, and for his +scutcheon he had the three golden anchors; and he had ten thousand men at +his feet. + +3. The third was that valiant captain, the Captain Charity. His +standard-bearer was Mr. Pitiful: his were the green colours, and for his +scutcheon he had three naked orphans embraced in the bosom; and he had +ten thousand men at his feet. + +4. The fourth was that gallant commander, the Captain Innocent. His +standard-bearer was Mr. Harmless: his were the white colours, and for his +scutcheon he had the three golden doves. + +5. The fifth was the truly loyal and well-beloved captain, the Captain +Patience. His standard-bearer was Mr. Suffer-Long: his were the black +colours, and for a scutcheon he had three arrows through the golden +heart. + +These were Emmanuel’s captains; these their standard-bearers, their +colours, and their scutcheons; and these the men under their command. +So, as was said, the brave Prince took his march to go to the town of +Mansoul. Captain Credence led the van, and Captain Patience brought up +the rear; so the other three, with their men, made up the main body, the +Prince himself riding in his chariot at the head of them. + +But when they set out for their march, oh, how the trumpets sounded, +their armour glittered, and how the colours waved in the wind! The +Prince’s armour was all of gold, and it shone like the sun in the +firmament; the captains’ armour was of proof, and was in appearance like +the glittering stars. There were also some from the court that rode +reformades for the love that they had to the King Shaddai, and for the +happy deliverance of the town of Mansoul. + +Emmanuel also, when he had thus set forwards to go to recover the town of +Mansoul, took with him, at the commandment of his Father, fifty-four +battering-rams, and twelve slings to whirl stones withal. Every one of +these was made of pure gold, and these they carried with them, in the +heart and body of their army, all along as they went to Mansoul. + +So they marched till they came within less than a league of the town; +there they lay till the first four captains came thither to acquaint them +with matters. Then they took their journey to go to the town of Mansoul, +and unto Mansoul they came; but when the old soldiers that were in the +camp saw that they had new forces to join with, they again gave such a +shout before the walls of the town of Mansoul, that it put Diabolus into +another fright. So they sat down before the town, not now as the other +four captains did, to wit, against the gates of Mansoul only; but they +environed it round on every side, and beset it behind and before; so that +now, let Mansoul look which way it will, it saw force and power lie in +siege against it. Besides, there were mounts cast up against it. The +Mount Gracious was on the one side, and Mount Justice was on the other. +Further, there were several small banks and advance-grounds, as +Plain-Truth Hill and No-Sin Banks, where many of the slings were placed +against the town. Upon Mount Gracious were planted four, and upon Mount +Justice were placed as many, and the rest were conveniently placed in +several parts round about the town. Five of the best battering-rams, +that is, of the biggest of them, were placed upon Mount Hearken, a mount +cast up hard by Ear-gate, with intent to break that open. + +Now when the men of the town saw the multitude of the soldiers that were +come up against the place, and the rams and slings, and the mounts on +which they were planted, together with the glittering of the armour and +the waving of their colours, they were forced to shift, and shift, and +again to shift their thoughts; but they hardly changed for thoughts more +stout, but rather for thoughts more faint; for though before they thought +themselves sufficiently guarded, yet now they began to think that no man +knew what would be their hap or lot. + +When the good Prince Emmanuel had thus beleaguered Mansoul, in the first +place he hangs out the white flag, which he caused to be set up among the +golden slings that were planted upon Mount Gracious. And this he did for +two reasons: 1. To give notice to Mansoul that he could and would yet be +gracious if they turned to him. 2. And that he might leave them the more +without excuse, should he destroy them, they continuing in their +rebellion. + +So the white flag, with the three golden doves in it, was hung out for +two days together, to give them time and space to consider; but they, as +was hinted before, as if they were unconcerned, made no reply to the +favourable signal of the Prince. + +Then he commanded, and they set the red flag upon that mount called Mount +Justice. It was the red flag of Captain Judgment, whose scutcheon was +the burning fiery furnace; and this also stood waving before them in the +wind for several days together. But look how they carried it under the +white flag, when that was hung out, so did they also when the red one +was; and yet he took no advantage of them. + +Then he commanded again that his servants should hang out the black flag +of defiance against them, whose scutcheon was the three burning +thunderbolts; but as unconcerned was Mansoul at this as at those that +went before. But when the Prince saw that neither mercy nor judgment, +nor execution of judgment, would or could come near the heart of Mansoul, +he was touched with much compunction, and said, ‘Surely this strange +carriage of the town of Mansoul doth rather arise from ignorance of the +manner and feats of war, than from a secret defiance of us, and +abhorrence of their own lives; or if they know the manner of the war of +their own, yet not the rites and ceremonies of the wars in which we are +concerned, when I make wars upon mine enemy Diabolus.’ + +Therefore he sent to the town of Mansoul, to let them know what he meant +by those signs and ceremonies of the flag; and also to know of them which +of the things they would choose, whether grace and mercy, or judgment and +the execution of judgment. All this while they kept their gates shut +with locks, bolts, and bars, as fast as they could. Their guards also +were doubled, and their watch made as strong as they could. Diabolus +also did pluck up what heart he could, to encourage the town to make +resistance. + +The townsmen also made answer to the Prince’s messenger, in substance +according to that which follows:— + +‘Great Sir,—As to what, by your messenger, you have signified to us, +whether we will accept of your mercy, or fall by your justice, we are +bound by the law and custom of this place, and can give you no positive +answer; for it is against the law, government, and the prerogative royal +of our king, to make either peace or war without him. But this we will +do,—we will petition that our prince will come down to the wall, and +there give you such treatment as he shall think fit and profitable for +us.’ + +When the good Prince Emmanuel heard this answer, and saw the slavery and +bondage of the people, and how much content they were to abide in the +chains of the tyrant Diabolus, it grieved him at the heart; and, indeed, +when at any time he perceived that any were contented under the slavery +of the giant, he would be affected with it. + +But to return again to our purpose. After the town had carried this news +to Diabolus, and had told him, moreover, that the Prince, that lay in the +leaguer without the wall, waited upon them for an answer, he refused, and +huffed as well as he could; but in heart he was afraid. + +Then said he, ‘I will go down to the gates myself, and give him such an +answer as I think fit.’ So he went down to Mouth-gate, and there +addressed himself to speak to Emmanuel, (but in such language as the town +understood not,) the contents whereof were as follows:— + +‘O thou great Emmanuel, Lord of all the world, I know thee, that thou art +the Son of the great Shaddai! Wherefore art thou come to torment me, and +to cast me out of my possession? This town of Mansoul, as thou very well +knowest, is mine, and that by a twofold right. 1. It is mine by right of +conquest; I won it in the open field; and shall the prey be taken from +the mighty, or the lawful captive be delivered? 2. This town of Mansoul +is mine also by their subjection. They have opened the gates of their +town unto me; they have sworn fidelity to me, and have openly chosen me +to be their king; they have also given their castle into my hands; yea, +they have put the whole strength of Mansoul under me. + +‘Moreover, this town of Mansoul hath disavowed thee, yea, they have cast +thy law, thy name, thy image, and all that is thine, behind their back, +and have accepted and set up in their room my law, my name, my image, and +all that ever is mine. Ask else thy captains, and they will tell thee +that Mansoul hath, in answer to all their summonses, shown love and +loyalty to me, but always disdain, despite, contempt, and scorn to thee +and thine. Now, thou art the Just One and the Holy, and shouldest do no +iniquity. Depart, then, I pray thee, therefore, from me, and leave me to +my just inheritance peaceably.’ + +This oration was made in the language of Diabolus himself; for although +he can, to every man, speak in their own language, (else he could not +tempt them all as he does,) yet he has a language proper to himself, and +it is the language of the infernal cave, or black pit. + +Wherefore the town of Mansoul (poor hearts!) understood him not; nor did +they see how he crouched and cringed while he stood before Emmanuel, +their Prince. + +Yea, they all this while took him to be one of that power and force that +by no means could be resisted. Wherefore, while he was thus entreating +that he might have yet his residence there, and that Emmanuel would not +take it from him by force, the inhabitants boasted even of his valour, +saying, ‘Who is able to make war with him?’ + +Well, when this pretended king had made an end of what he would say, +Emmanuel, the golden Prince, stood up and spake; the contents of whose +words follow:— + +‘Thou deceiving one,’ said he, ‘I have, in my Father’s name, in mine own +name, and on the behalf and for the good of this wretched town of +Mansoul, somewhat to say unto thee. Thou pretendest a right, a lawful +right, to the deplorable town of Mansoul, when it is most apparent to all +my Father’s court that the entrance which thou hast obtained in at the +gates of Mansoul was through thy lie and falsehood; thou beliedst my +Father, thou beliedst his law, and so deceivedst the people of Mansoul. +Thou pretendest that the people have accepted thee for their king, their +captain, and right liege lord; but that also was by the exercise of +deceit and guile. Now, if lying, wiliness, sinful craft, and all manner +of horrible hypocrisy, will go in my Father’s court (in which court thou +must be tried) for equity and right, then will I confess unto thee that +thou hast made a lawful conquest. But, alas! what thief, what tyrant, +what devil is there that may not conquer after this sort? But I can make +it appear, O Diabolus, that thou, in all thy pretences to a conquest of +Mansoul, hast nothing of truth to say. Thinkest thou this to be right, +that that didst put the lie upon my Father, and madest him (to Mansoul) +the greatest deluder in the world? And what sayest thou to thy +perverting knowingly the right purport and intent of the law? Was it +good also that thou madest a prey of the innocency and simplicity of the +now miserable town of Mansoul? Yea, thou didst overcome Mansoul by +promising to them happiness in their transgressions against my Father’s +law, when thou knewest, and couldest not but know, hadst thou consulted +nothing but thine own experience, that that was the way to undo them. +Thou hast also thyself, O thou master of enmity, of spite defaced my +Father’s image in Mansoul, and set up thy own in its place, to the great +contempt of my Father, the heightening of thy sin, and to the intolerable +damage of the perishing town of Mansoul. + +‘Thou hast, moreover, (as if all these were but little things with thee,) +not only deluded and undone this place, but, by thy lies and fradulent +carriage, hast set them against their own deliverance. How hast thou +stirred them up against my Father’s captains, and made them to fight +against those that were sent of him to deliver them from their bondage! +All these things, and very many more, thou hast done against thy light, +and in contempt of my Father and of his law, yea, and with design to +bring under his displeasure for ever the miserable town of Mansoul. I am +therefore come to avenge the wrong that thou hast done to my Father, and +to deal with thee for the blasphemies wherewith thou hast made poor +Mansoul blaspheme his name. Yea, upon thy head, thou prince of the +infernal cave, will I requite it. + +‘As for myself, O Diabolus, I am come against thee by lawful power, and +to take, by strength of hand, this town of Mansoul out of thy burning +fingers; for this town of Mansoul is mine, O Diabolus, and that by +undoubted right, as all shall see that will diligently search the most +ancient and most authentic records, and I will plead my title to it, to +the confusion of thy face. + +‘First, for the town of Mansoul, my Father built and did fashion it with +his hand. The palace also that is in the midst of that town, he built it +for his own delight. This town of Mansoul, therefore, is my Father’s, +and that by the best of titles, and he that gainsays the truth of this +must lie against his soul. + +‘Secondly, O thou master of the lie, this town of Mansoul is mine. + +‘1. For that I am my Father’s heir, his firstborn, and the only delight +of his heart. I am therefore come up against thee in mine own right, +even to recover mine own inheritance out of thine hand. + +‘2. But further, as I have a right and title to Mansoul by being my +Father’s heir, so I have also by my Father’s donation. His it was, and +he gave it me; nor have I at any time offended my Father, that he should +take it from me, and give it to thee. Nor have I been forced, by playing +the bankrupt, to sell or set to sale to thee my beloved town of Mansoul. +Mansoul is my desire, my delight, and the joy of my heart. But, + +‘3. Mansoul is mine by right of purchase. I have bought it, O Diabolus, +I have bought it to myself. Now, since it was my Father’s and mine, as I +was his heir, and since also I have made it mine by virtue of a great +purchase, it followeth that, by all lawful right, the town of Mansoul is +mine, and that thou art an usurper, a tyrant, and traitor, in thy holding +possession thereof. Now, the cause of my purchasing of it was this: +Mansoul had trespassed against my Father; now my Father had said, that in +the day that they broke his law they should die. Now, it is more +possible for heaven and earth to pass away than for my Father to break +his word. Wherefore when Mansoul had sinned indeed by hearkening to thy +lie, I put in and became a surety to my Father, body for body, and soul +for soul, that I would make amends for Mansoul’s transgressions, and my +Father did accept thereof. So, when the time appointed was come, I gave +body for body, soul for soul, life for life, blood for blood, and so +redeemed my beloved Mansoul. + +‘4. Nor did I do this by halves: my Father’s law and justice, that were +both concerned in the threatening upon transgression, are both now +satisfied, and very well content that Mansoul should be delivered. + +‘5. Nor am I come out this day against thee, but by commandment of my +Father; it was he that said unto me, “Go down and deliver Mansoul.” + +‘Wherefore be it known unto thee, O thou fountain of deceit, and be it +also known to the foolish town of Mansoul, that I am not come against +thee this day without my Father. + +‘And now,’ said the golden-headed Prince, ‘I have a word to the town of +Mansoul.’ But so soon as mention was made that he had a word to speak to +the besotted town of Mansoul, the gates were double-guarded, and all men +commanded not to give him audience. So he proceeded and said, ‘O unhappy +town of Mansoul, I cannot but be touched with pity and compassion for +thee. Thou hast accepted of Diabolus for thy king, and art become a +nurse and minister of Diabolonians against thy sovereign Lord. Thy gates +thou hast opened to him, but hast shut them fast against me; thou hast +given him an hearing, but hast stopped thine ears at my cry. He brought +to thee thy destruction, and thou didst receive both him and it: I am +come to thee bringing salvation, but thou regardest me not. Besides, +thou hast, as with sacrilegious hands, taken thyself, with all that was +mine in thee, and hast given all to my foe, and to the greatest enemy my +Father has. You have bowed and subjected yourselves to him, you have +vowed and sworn yourselves to be his. Poor Mansoul! what shall I do unto +thee? Shall I save thee?—shall I destroy thee? What shall I do unto +thee? Shall I fall upon thee, and grind thee to powder, or make thee a +monument of the richest grace? What shall I do unto thee? Hearken, +therefore, thou town of Mansoul, hearken to my word, and thou shalt live. +I am merciful, Mansoul, and thou shalt find me so: shut me not out of thy +gates. + +‘O Mansoul, neither is my commission nor inclination at all to do thee +hurt. Why fliest thou so fast from thy friend, and stickest so close to +thine enemy? Indeed, I would have thee, because it becomes thee to be +sorry for thy sin, but do not despair of life; this great force is not to +hurt thee, but to deliver thee from thy bondage, and to reduce thee to +thy obedience. + +‘My commission, indeed, is to make a war upon Diabolus thy king, and upon +all Diabolonians with him; for he is the strong man armed that keeps the +house, and I will have him out: his spoils I must divide, his armour I +must take from him, his hold I must cast him out of, and must make it a +habitation for myself. And this, O Mansoul, shall Diabolus know when he +shall be made to follow me in chains, and when Mansoul shall rejoice to +see it so. + +‘I could, would I now put forth my might, cause that forthwith he should +leave you and depart; but I have it in my heart so to deal with him, as +that the justice of the war that I shall make upon him may be seen and +acknowledged by all. He hath taken Mansoul by fraud, and keeps it by +violence and deceit, and I will make him bare and naked in the eyes of +all observers. + +‘All my words are true. I am mighty to save, and will deliver my Mansoul +out of his hand.’ + +This speech was intended chiefly for Mansoul, but Mansoul would not have +the hearing of it. They shut up Ear-gate, they barricaded it up, they +kept it locked and bolted, they set a guard thereat, and commanded that +no Mansoulonian should go out to him, nor that any from the camp should +be admitted into the town. All this they did, so horribly had Diabolus +enchanted them to do, and seek to do for him, against their rightful Lord +and Prince; wherefore no man, nor voice, nor sound of man that belonged +to the glorious host, was to come into the town. + +So when Emmanuel saw that Mansoul was thus involved in sin, he calls his +army together, (since now also his words were despised,) and gave out a +commandment throughout all his host to be ready against the time +appointed. Now, forasmuch as there was no way lawfully to take the town +of Mansoul but to get in by the gates, and at Ear-gate as the chief, +therefore he commanded his captains and commanders to bring their rams, +their slings and their men, and place them at Eye-gate and Ear-gate, in +order to his taking the town. + +When Emmanuel had put all things in a readiness to give Diabolus battle, +he sent again to know of the town of Mansoul, if in peaceable manner they +would yield themselves, or whether they were yet resolved to put him to +try the utmost extremity? They then, together with Diabolus their king, +called a council of war, and resolved upon certain propositions that +should be offered to Emmanuel, if he will accept thereof, so they agreed; +and then the next was, who should be sent on this errand. Now, there was +in the town of Mansoul an old man, a Diabolonian, and his name was Mr. +Loth-to-stoop, a stiff man in his way, and a great doer for Diabolus; +him, therefore, they sent, and put into his mouth what he should say. So +he went and came to the camp to Emmanuel, and when he was come, a time +was appointed to give him audience. So at the time he came, and after a +Diabolonian ceremony or two, he thus began and said, ‘Great sir, that it +may be known unto all men how good-natured a prince my master is, he has +sent me to tell your lordship that he is very willing, rather than go to +war, to deliver up into your hands one half of the town of Mansoul. I am +therefore to know if your Mightiness will accept of this proposition.’ + +Then said Emmanuel, ‘The whole is mine by gift and purchase, wherefore I +will never lose one half.’ + +Then said Mr. Loth-to-stoop, ‘Sir, my master hath said that he will be +content that you shall be the nominal and titular Lord of all, if he may +possess but a part.’ + +Then Emmanuel answered, ‘The whole is mine really, not in name and word +only; wherefore I will be the sole lord and possessor of all, or of none +at all, of Mansoul.’ + +Then Mr. Loth-to-stoop said again, ‘Sir, behold the condescension of my +master! He says, that he will be content, if he may but have assigned to +him some place in Mansoul as a place to live privately in, and you shall +be Lord of all the rest.’ + +Then said the golden Prince, ‘All that the Father giveth me shall come to +me; and of all that he giveth me I will lose nothing—no, not a hoof nor a +hair. I will not, therefore, grant him, no, not the least corner of +Mansoul to dwell in; I will have all to myself.’ + +Then Loth-to-stoop said again, ‘But, sir, suppose that my Lord should +resign the whole town to you, only with this proviso, that he sometimes, +when he comes into this country, may, for old acquaintance’ sake, be +entertained as a wayfaring man for two days, or ten days or a month, or +so. May not this small matter be granted?’ + +Then said Emmanuel, ‘No. He came as a wayfaring man to David, nor did he +stay long with him, and yet it had like to have cost David his soul. I +will not consent that he ever should have any harbour more there.’ + +Then said Mr. Loth-to-stoop, ‘Sir, you seem to be very hard. Suppose my +master should yield to all that your lordship hath said, provided that +his friends and kindred in Mansoul may have liberty to trade in the town, +and to enjoy their present dwellings. May not that be granted, sir?’ + +Then said Emmanuel, ‘No; that is contrary to my Father’s will; for all, +and all manner of Diabolonians that now are, or that at any time shall be +found in Mansoul, shall not only lose their lands and liberties, but also +their lives.’ + +Then said Mr. Loth-to-stoop again, ‘But, sir, may not my master and great +lord, by letters, by passengers, by accidental opportunities, and the +like, maintain, if he shall deliver up all unto thee, some kind of old +friendship with Mansoul?’ + +Emmanuel answered, ‘No, by no means; forasmuch as any such fellowship, +friendship, intimacy, or acquaintance, in what way, sort, or mode soever +maintained, will tend to the corrupting of Mansoul, the alienating of +their affections from me, and the endangering of their peace with my +Father.’ + +Mr. Loth-to-stoop yet added further, saying, ‘But, great sir, since my +master hath many friends, and those that are dear to him, in Mansoul, may +he not, if he shall depart from them, even of his bounty and good-nature, +bestow upon them, as he sees fit, some tokens of his love and kindness +that he had for them, to the end that Mansoul, when he is gone, may look +upon such tokens of kindness once received from their old friend, and +remember him who was once their king, and the merry times that they +sometimes enjoyed one with another, while he and they lived in peace +together?’ + +Then said Emmanuel, ‘No; for if Mansoul come to be mine, I shall not +admit of nor consent that there should be the least scrap, shred, or dust +of Diabolus left behind, as tokens of gifts bestowed upon any in Mansoul, +thereby to call to remembrance the horrible communion that was betwixt +them and him.’ + +‘Well, sir,’ said Mr. Loth-to-stoop, ‘I have one thing more to propound, +and then I am got to the end of my commission. Suppose that, when my +master is gone from Mansoul, any that shall yet live in the town should +have such business of high concerns to do, that if they be neglected the +party shall be undone; and suppose, sir, that nobody can help in that +case so well as my master and lord, may not now my master be sent for +upon so urgent an occasion as this? Or if he may not be admitted into +the town, may not he and the person concerned meet in some of the +villages near Mansoul, and there lay their heads together, and there +consult of matters?’ + +This was the last of those ensnaring propositions that Mr. Loth-to-stoop +had to propound to Emmanuel on behalf of his master Diabolus; but +Emmanuel would not grant it; for he said, ‘There can be no case, or +thing, or matter fall out in Mansoul, when thy master shall be gone, that +may not be solved by my Father; besides, it will be a great disparagement +to my Father’s wisdom and skill to admit any from Mansoul to go out to +Diabolus for advice, when they are bid before, in everything, by prayer +and supplication to let their requests be made known to my Father. +Further, this, should it be granted, would be to grant that a door should +be set open for Diabolus, and the Diabolonians in Mansoul, to hatch, and +plot, and bring to pass treasonable designs, to the grief of my Father +and me, and to the utter destruction of Mansoul.’ + +When Mr. Loth-to-stoop had heard this answer, he took his leave of +Emmanuel, and departed, saying that he would carry word to his master +concerning this whole affair. So he departed, and came to Diabolus to +Mansoul, and told him the whole of the matter, and how Emmanuel would not +admit, no, not by any means, that he, when he was once gone out, should +for ever have anything more to do either in, or with any that are of the +town of Mansoul. When Mansoul and Diabolus had heard this relation of +things, they with one consent concluded to use their best endeavour to +keep Emmanuel out of Mansoul, and sent old Ill-Pause, of whom you have +heard before, to tell the Prince and his captains so. So the old +gentleman came up to the top of Ear-gate, and called to the camp for a +hearing, who when they gave audience, he said, ‘I have in commandment +from my high lord to bid you tell it to your Prince Emmanuel, that +Mansoul and their king are resolved to stand and fall together; and that +it is in vain for your Prince to think of ever having Mansoul in his +hand, unless he can take it by force.’ So some went and told to Emmanuel +what old Ill-Pause, a Diabolonian in Mansoul, had said. Then said the +Prince, ‘I must try the power of my sword, for I will not (for all the +rebellions and repulses that Mansoul has made against me) raise my siege +and depart, but will assuredly take my Mansoul, and deliver it from the +hand of her enemy.’ And with that he gave out a commandment that Captain +Boanerges, Captain Conviction, Captain Judgment, and Captain Execution +should forthwith march up to Ear-gate with trumpets sounding, colours +flying, and with shouting for the battle. Also he would that Captain +Credence should join himself with them. Emmanuel, moreover, gave order +that Captain Good-Hope and Captain Charity should draw themselves up +before Eye-gate. He bid also that the rest of his captains and their men +should place themselves for the best of their advantage against the enemy +round about the town; and all was done as he had commanded. + +Then he bid that the word should be given forth, and the word was at that +time, ‘EMMANUEL.’ Then was an alarm sounded, and the battering-rams were +played, and the slings did whirl stones into the town amain, and thus the +battle began. Now Diabolus himself did manage the townsmen in the war, +and that at every gate; wherefore their resistance was the more forcible, +hellish, and offensive to Emmanuel. Thus was the good Prince engaged and +entertained by Diabolus and Mansoul for several days together; and a +sight worth seeing it was to behold how the captains of Shaddai behaved +themselves in this war. + +And first for Captain Boanerges, (not to under-value the rest,) he made +three most fierce assaults, one after another, upon Ear-gate, to the +shaking of the posts thereof. Captain Conviction, he also made up as +fast with Boanerges as possibly he could, and both discerning that the +gate began to yield, they commanded that the rams should still be played +against it. Now, Captain Conviction, going up very near to the gate, was +with great force driven back, and received three wounds in the mouth. +And those that rode reformades, they went about to encourage the +captains. + +For the valour of the two captains, made mention of before, the Prince +sent for them to his pavilion, and commanded that a while they should +rest themselves, and that with somewhat they should be refreshed. Care +also was taken for Captain Conviction, that he should be healed of his +wounds. The Prince also gave to each of them a chain of gold, and bid +them yet be of good courage. + +Nor did Captain Good-Hope nor Captain Charity come behind in this most +desperate fight, for they so well did behave themselves at Eye-gate, that +they had almost broken it quite open. These also had a reward from their +Prince, as also had the rest of the captains, because they did valiantly +round about the town. + +In this engagement several of the officers of Diabolus were slain, and +some of the townsmen wounded. For the officers, there was one Captain +Boasting slain. This Boasting thought that nobody could have shaken the +posts of Ear-gate, nor have shaken the heart of Diabolus. Next to him +there was one Captain Secure slain: this Secure used to say that the +blind and lame in Mansoul were able to keep the gates of the town against +Emmanuel’s army. This Captain Secure did Captain Conviction cleave down +the head with a two-handed sword, when he received himself three wounds +in his mouth. + +Besides these there was one Captain Bragman, a very desperate fellow, and +he was captain over a band of those that threw firebrands, arrows, and +death: he also received, by the hand of Captain Good-Hope at Eye-gate, a +mortal wound in the breast. + +There was, moreover, one Mr. Feeling; but he was no captain, but a great +stickler to encourage Mansoul to rebellion. He received a wound in the +eye by the hand of one of Boanerges’ soldiers, and had by the captain +himself been slain, but that he made a sudden retreat. + +But I never saw Willbewill so daunted in all my life; he was not able to +do as he was wont, and some say that he also received a wound in the leg, +and that some of the men in the Prince’s army have certainly seen him +limp as he afterwards walked on the wall. + +I shall not give you a particular account of the names of the soldiers +that were slain in the town, for many were maimed, and wounded, and +slain; for when they saw that the posts of Ear-gate did shake, and +Eye-gate was well-nigh broken quite open, and also that their captains +were slain, this took away the hearts of many of the Diabolonians; they +fell also by the force of the shot that were sent by the golden slings +into the midst of the town of Mansoul. + +Of the townsmen, there was one Love-no-Good; he was a townsman, but a +Diabolonian; he also received his mortal wound in Mansoul, but he died +not very soon. + +Mr. Ill-Pause also, who was the man that came along with Diabolus when at +first he attempted the taking of Mansoul, he also received a grievous +wound in the head; some say that his brain-pan was cracked. This I have +taken notice of, that he was never after this able to do that mischief to +Mansoul as he had done in times past. Also old Prejudice and Mr. +Anything fled. + +Now, when the battle was over, the Prince commanded that yet once more +the white flag should be set upon Mount Gracious in sight of the town of +Mansoul, to show that yet Emmanuel had grace for the wretched town of +Mansoul. + +When Diabolus saw the white flag hung out again, and knowing that it was +not for him, but Mansoul, he cast in his mind to play another prank, to +wit, to see if Emmanuel would raise his siege and begone, upon promise of +reformation. So he comes down to the gate one evening, a good while +after the sun was gone down, and calls to speak with Emmanuel, who +presently came down to the gate, and Diabolus saith unto him: + +‘Forasmuch as thou makest it appear by thy white flag that thou art +wholly given to peace and quiet, I thought meet to acquaint thee that we +are ready to accept thereof upon terms which thou mayest admit. + +‘I know that thou art given to devotion, and that holiness pleaseth thee; +yea, that thy great end in making a war upon Mansoul is, that it may be a +holy habitation. Well, draw off thy forces from the town, and I will +bend Mansoul to thy bow. + +‘First, I will lay down all acts of hostility against thee, and will be +willing to become thy deputy, and will, as I have formerly been against +thee, now serve thee in the town of Mansoul. And more particularly, + +‘1. I will persuade Mansoul to receive thee for their Lord; and I know +that they will do it the sooner when they shall understand that I am thy +deputy. + +‘2. I will show them wherein they have erred, and that transgression +stands in the way to life. + +‘3. I will show them the holy law unto which they must conform, even that +which they have broken. + +‘4. I will press upon them the necessity of a reformation according to +thy law. + +‘5. And, moreover, that none of these things may fail, I myself, at my +own proper cost and charge, will set up and maintain a sufficient +ministry, besides lectures, in Mansoul. + +‘6. Thou shalt receive, as a token of our subjection to thee, year by +year, what thou shalt think fit to lay and levy upon us in token of our +subjection to thee.’ + +Then said Emmanuel to him, ‘O full of deceit, how movable are thy ways! +How often hast thou changed and rechanged, if so be thou mightest still +keep possession of my Mansoul, though, as has been plainly declared +before, I am the right heir thereof! Often hast thou made thy proposals +already, nor is this last a whit better than they. And failing to +deceive when thou showedst thyself in thy black, thou hast now +transformed thyself into an angel of light, and wouldst, to deceive, be +now as a minister of righteousness. + +‘But know thou, O Diabolus, that nothing must be regarded that thou canst +propound, for nothing is done by thee but to deceive. Thou neither hast +conscience to God, nor love to the town of Mansoul; whence, then, should +these thy sayings arise but from sinful craft and deceit? He that can of +list and will propound what he pleases, and that wherewith he may destroy +them that believe him, is to be abandoned, with all that he shall say. +But if righteousness be such a beauty-spot in thine eyes now, how is it +that wickedness was so closely stuck to by thee before? But this is +by-the-bye. + +‘Thou talkest now of a reformation in Mansoul, and that thou thyself, if +I will please, wilt be at the head of that reformation; all the while +knowing that the greatest proficiency that man can make in the law, and +the righteousness thereof, will amount to no more, for the taking away of +the curse from Mansoul, than just nothing at all; for a law being broken +by Mansoul, that had before, upon a supposition of the breach thereof, a +curse pronounced against him for it of God, can never, by his obeying of +the law, deliver himself therefrom (to say nothing of what a reformation +is like to be set up in Mansoul when the devil is become corrector of +vice). Thou knowest that all that thou hast now said in this matter is +nothing but guile and deceit; and is, as it was the first, so is it the +last card that thou hast to play. Many there be that do soon discern +thee when thou showest them thy cloven foot; but in thy white, thy light, +and in thy transformation, thou art seen but of a few. But thou shalt +not do thus with my Mansoul, O Diabolus; for I do still love my Mansoul. + +‘Besides, I am not come to put Mansoul upon works to live thereby; should +I do so, I should be like unto thee: but I am come that by me, and by +what I have and shall do for Mansoul, they may to my Father be +reconciled, though by their sin they have provoked him to anger, and +though by the law they cannot obtain mercy. + +‘Thou talkest of subjecting of this town to good, when none desireth it +at thy hands. I am sent by my Father to possess it myself, and to guide +it by the skilfulness of my hands into such a conformity to him as shall +be pleasing in his sight. I will therefore possess it myself; I will +dispossess and cast thee out; I will set up mine own standard in the +midst of them; I will also govern them by new laws, new officers, new +motives, and new ways; yea, I will pull down this town, and build it +again; and it shall be as though it had not been, and it shall then be +the glory of the whole universe.’ + +When Diabolus heard this, and perceived that he was discovered in all his +deceits, he was confounded, and utterly put to a nonplus; but having in +himself the fountain of iniquity, rage, and malice against both Shaddai +and his Son, and the beloved town of Mansoul, what doth he but strengthen +himself what he could to give fresh battle to the noble Prince Emmanuel? +So, then, now we must have another fight before the town of Mansoul is +taken. Come up, then, to the mountains, you that love to see military +actions, and behold by both sides how the fatal blow is given, while one +seeks to hold, and the other seeks to make himself master of the famous +town of Mansoul. + +Diabolus, therefore, having withdrawn himself from the wall to his force +that was in the heart of the town of Mansoul, Emmanuel also returned to +the camp; and both of them, after their divers ways, put themselves into +a posture fit to give battle one to another. + +Diabolus, as filled with despair of retaining in his hands the famous +town of Mansoul, resolved to do what mischief he could (if, indeed, he +could do any) to the army of the Prince and to the famous town of +Mansoul; for, alas! it was not the happiness of the silly town of Mansoul +that was designed by Diabolus, but the utter ruin and overthrow thereof, +as now is enough in view. Wherefore, he commands his officers that they +should then, when they see that they could hold the town no longer, do it +what harm and mischief they could, rendering and tearing men, women, and +children. ‘For,’ said he, ‘we had better quite demolish the place, and +leave it like a ruinous heap, than so leave it that it may be an +habitation for Emmanuel.’ + +Emmanuel again, knowing that the next battle would issue in his being +made master of the place, gave out a royal commandment to all his +officers, high captains, and men of war, to be sure to show themselves +men of war against Diabolus and all Diabolonians; but favourable, +merciful, and meek to the old inhabitants of Mansoul. ‘Bend, therefore,’ +said the noble Prince, ‘the hottest front of the battle against Diabolus +and his men.’ + +So the day being come, the command was given, and the Prince’s men did +bravely stand to their arms, and did, as before, bend their main force +against Ear-gate and Eye-gate. The word was then, ‘Mansoul is won!’ so +they made their assault upon the town. Diabolus also, as fast as he +could, with the main of his power, made resistance from within; and his +high lords and chief captains for a time fought very cruelly against the +Prince’s army. + +But after three or four notable charges by the Prince and his noble +captains, Ear-gate was broken open, and the bars and bolts wherewith it +was used to be fast shut up against the Prince, were broken into a +thousand pieces. Then did the Prince’s trumpets sound, the captains +shout, the town shake, and Diabolus retreat to his hold. Well, when the +Prince’s forces had broken open the gate, himself came up and did set his +throne in it; also he set his standard thereby, upon a mount that before +by his men was cast up to place the mighty slings thereon. The mount was +called Mount Hear-well. There, therefore, the Prince abode, to wit, hard +by the going in at the gate. He commanded also that the golden slings +should yet be played upon the town, especially against the castle, +because for shelter thither was Diabolus retreated. Now, from Ear-gate +the street was straight even to the house of Mr. Recorder that so was +before Diabolus took the town; and hard by his house stood the castle, +which Diabolus for a long time had made his irksome den. The captains, +therefore, did quickly clear that street by the use of their slings, so +that way was made up to the heart of the town. Then did the Prince +command that Captain Boanerges, Captain Conviction, and Captain Judgment, +should forthwith march up the town to the old gentleman’s gate. Then did +the captains in the most warlike manner enter into the town of Mansoul, +and marching in with flying colours, they came up to the Recorder’s +house, and that was almost as strong as was the castle. Battering-rams +they took also with them, to plant against the castle gates. When they +were come to the house of Mr. Conscience, they knocked, and demanded +entrance. Now, the old gentleman, not knowing as yet fully their design, +kept his gates shut all the time of this fight. Wherefore Boanerges +demanded entrance at his gates; and no man making answer, he gave it one +stroke with the head of a ram, and this made the old gentleman shake, and +his house to tremble and totter. Then came Mr. Recorder down to the +gates, and, as he could, with quivering lips he asked who was there? +Boanerges answered, ‘We are the captains and commanders of the great +Shaddai and of the blessed Emmanuel, his Son, and we demand possession of +your house for the use of our noble Prince.’ And with that the +battering-ram gave the gate another shake. This made the old gentleman +tremble the more, yet durst he not but open the gate: then the King’s +forces marched in, namely, the three brave captains mentioned before. +Now, the Recorder’s house was a place of much convenience for Emmanuel, +not only because it was near to the castle and strong, but also because +it was large, and fronted the castle, the den where now Diabolus was, for +he was now afraid to come out of his hold. As for Mr. Recorder, the +captains carried it very reservedly to him; as yet he knew nothing of the +great designs of Emmanuel, so that he did not know what judgment to make, +nor what would be the end of such thundering beginnings. It was also +presently noised in the town how the Recorder’s house was possessed, his +rooms taken up, and his palace made the seat of the war; and no sooner +was it noised abroad, but they took the alarm as warmly, and gave it out +to others of his friends, and you know, as a snowball loses nothing by +rolling, so in little time the whole town was possessed that they must +expect nothing from the Prince but destruction; and the ground of the +business was this, the Recorder was afraid, the Recorder trembled, and +the captains carried it strangely to the Recorder. So many came to see, +but when they with their own eyes did behold the captains in the palace, +and their battering-rams ever playing at the castle gates to beat them +down, they were riveted in their fears, and it made them all in amaze. +And, as I said, the man of the house would increase all this; for whoever +came to him, or discoursed with him, nothing would he talk of, tell them, +or hear, but that death and destruction now attended Mansoul. + +‘For,’ quoth the old gentleman, ‘you are all of you sensible that we all +have been traitors to that once despised, but now famously victorious and +glorious Prince Emmanuel; for he now, as you see, doth not only lie in +close siege about us, but hath forced his entrance in at our gates. +Moreover, Diabolus flees before him; and he hath, as you behold, made of +my house a garrison against the castle where he is. I, for my part, have +transgressed greatly, and he that is clean, it is well for him. But I +say I have transgressed greatly in keeping silence when I should have +spoken, and in perverting justice when I should have executed the same. +True, I have suffered something at the hand of Diabolus for taking part +with the laws of King Shaddai; but that, alas! what will that do? Will +that make compensation for the rebellions and treasons that I have done, +and have suffered without gainsaying to be committed in the town of +Mansoul? Oh! I tremble to think what will be the end of this so dreadful +and so ireful a beginning!’ + +Now, while these brave captains were thus busy in the house of the old +Recorder, Captain Execution was as busy in other parts of the town, in +securing the back streets and the walls. He also hunted the Lord +Willbewill sorely; he suffered him not to rest in any corner; he pursued +him so hard that he drove his men from him, and made him glad to thrust +his head into a hole. Also this mighty warrior did cut three of the Lord +Willbewill’s officers down to the ground: one was old Mr. Prejudice, he +that had his crown cracked in the mutiny. This man was made by Lord +Willbewill keeper of the Ear-gate, and fell by the hand of Captain +Execution. There was also one Mr. Backward-to-all-but-naught, and he +also was one of Lord Willbewill’s officers, and was the captain of the +two guns that once were mounted on the top of Ear-gate; he also was cut +down to the ground by the hands of Captain Execution. Besides these two +there was another, a third, and his name was Captain Treacherous; a vile +man this was, but one that Willbewill did put a great deal of confidence +in; but him also did this Captain Execution cut down to the ground with +the rest. + +He also made a very great slaughter among my Lord Willbewill’s soldiers, +killing many that were stout and sturdy, and wounding many that for +Diabolus were nimble and active. But all these were Diabolonians; there +was not a man, a native of Mansoul, hurt. + +Other feats of war were also likewise performed by other of the captains, +as at Eye-gate, where Captain Good-Hope and Captain Charity had a charge, +was great execution done; for the Captain Good-Hope, with his own hands, +slew one Captain Blindfold, the keeper of that gate. This Blindfold was +captain of a thousand men, and they were they that fought with mauls; he +also pursued his men, slew many, and wounded more, and made the rest hide +their heads in corners. + +There was also at that gate Mr. Ill-Pause, of whom you have heard before. +He was an old man, and had a beard that reached down to his girdle: the +same was he that was orator to Diabolus: he did much mischief in the town +of Mansoul, and fell by the hand of Captain Good-Hope. + +What shall I say? The Diabolonians in these days lay dead in every +corner, though too many yet were alive in Mansoul. + +Now, the old Recorder and my Lord Understanding, with some others of the +chief of the town, to wit, such as knew they must stand and fall with the +famous town of Mansoul, came together upon a day, and after consultation +had, did jointly agree to draw up a petition, and to send it to Emmanuel, +now while he sat in the gate of Mansoul. So they drew up their petition +to Emmanuel, the contents whereof were these: That they, the old +inhabitants of the now deplorable town of Mansoul, confessed their sin, +and were sorry that they had offended his princely Majesty, and prayed +that he would spare their lives. + +Unto this petition he gave no answer at all, and that did trouble them +yet so much the more. Now, all this while the captains that were in the +Recorder’s house were playing with the battering-rams at the gates of the +castle, to beat them down. So after some time, labour, and travail, the +gate of the castle that was called Impregnable was beaten open, and +broken into several splinters, and so a way made to go up to the hold in +which Diabolus had hid himself. Then were tidings sent down to Ear-gate, +for Emmanuel still abode there, to let him know that a way was made in at +the gates of the castle of Mansoul. But, oh! how the trumpets at the +tidings sounded throughout the Prince’s camp, for that now the war was so +near an end, and Mansoul itself of being set free. + +Then the Prince arose from the place where he was, and took with him such +of his men of war as were fittest for that expedition, and marched up the +street of Mansoul to the old Recorder’s house. + +Now, the Prince himself was clad all in armour of gold, and so he marched +up the town with his standard borne before him; but he kept his +countenance much reserved all the way as he went, so that the people +could not tell how to gather to themselves love or hatred by his looks. +Now, as he marched up the street, the townsfolk came out at every door to +see, and could not but be taken with his person and the glory thereof, +but wondered at the reservedness of his countenance; for as yet he spake +more to them by his actions and works than he did by words or smiles. +But also poor Mansoul, (as in such cases all are apt to do,) they +interpreted the carriage of Emmanuel to them as did Joseph’s brethren his +to them, even all the quite contrary way. ‘For,’ thought they, ‘if +Emmanuel loved us, he would show it to us by word of carriage; but none +of these he doth, therefore Emmanuel hates us. Now, if Emmanuel hates +us, then Mansoul shall be slain, then Mansoul shall become a dunghill.’ +They knew that they had transgressed his Father’s law, and that against +him they had been in with Diabolus, his enemy. They also knew that the +Prince Emmanuel knew all this; for they were convinced that he was an +angel of God, to know all things that are done in the earth; and this +made them think that their condition was miserable, and that the good +Prince would make them desolate. + +‘And,’ thought they, ‘what time so fit to do this in as now, when he has +the bridle of Mansoul in his hand?’ And this I took special notice of, +that the inhabitants, notwithstanding all this, could not—no, they could +not, when they see him march through the town, but cringe, bow, bend, and +were ready to lick the dust of his feet. They also wished a thousand +times over that he would become their Prince and Captain, and would +become their protection. They would also one to another talk of the +comeliness of his person, and how much for glory and valour he +outstripped the great ones of the world. But, poor hearts, as to +themselves, their thoughts would chance, and go upon all manner of +extremes. Yea, through the working of them backward and forward, Mansoul +became as a ball tossed, and as a rolling thing before the whirlwind. + +Now, when he was come to the castle gates, he commanded Diabolus to +appear, and to surrender himself into his hands. But, oh! how loath was +the beast to appear! how he stuck at it! how he shrank! how he cringed! +yet out he came to the Prince. Then Emmanuel commanded, and they took +Diabolus and bound him fast in chains, the better to reserve him to the +judgment that he had appointed for him. But Diabolus stood up to entreat +for himself that Emmanuel would not send him into the deep, but suffer +him to depart out of Mansoul in peace. + +When Emmanuel had taken him and bound him in chains, he led him into the +marketplace, and there, before Mansoul, stripped him of his armour in +which he boasted so much before. This now was one of the acts of triumph +of Emmanuel over his enemy; and all the while that the giant was +stripping, the trumpets of the golden Prince did sound amain; the +captains also shouted, and the soldiers did sing for joy. + +Then was Mansoul called upon to behold the beginning of Emmanuel’s +triumph over him in whom they so much had trusted, and of whom they so +much had boasted in the days when he flattered them. + +Thus having made Diabolus naked in the eyes of Mansoul, and before the +commanders of the Prince, in the next place, he commands that Diabolus +should be bound with chains to his chariot wheels. Then leaving some of +his forces, to wit, Captain Boanerges and Captain Conviction, as a guard +for the castle-gates, that resistance might be made on his behalf, (if +any that heretofore followed Diabolus should make an attempt to possess +it,) he did ride in triumph over him quite through the town of Mansoul, +and so out at and before the gate called Eye-gate, to the plain where his +camp did lie. + +But you cannot think, unless you had been there, as I was, what a shout +there was in Emmanuel’s camp when they saw the tyrant bound by the hand +of their noble Prince, and tied to his chariot wheels! + +And they said, ‘He hath led captivity captive, he hath spoiled +principalities and powers. Diabolus is subjected to the power of his +sword, and made the object of all derision.’ + +Those also that rode reformades, and that came down to see the battle, +they shouted with that greatness of voice, and sung with such melodious +notes, that they caused them that dwell in the highest orbs to open their +windows, put out their heads, and look to see the cause of that glory. + +The townsmen also, so many of them as saw this sight, were, as it were, +while they looked, betwixt the earth and the heavens. True, they could +not tell what would be the issue of things as to them; but all things +were done in such excellent methods, and I cannot tell how, but things in +the management of them seemed to cast a smile towards the town, so that +their eyes, their heads, their hearts, and their minds, and all that they +had, were taken and held while they observed Emmanuel’s order. + +So, when the brave Prince had finished this part of his triumph over +Diabolus his foe, he turned him up in the midst of his contempt and +shame, having given him a charge no more to be a possessor of Mansoul. +Then went he from Emmanuel, and out of the midst of his camp, to inherit +the parched places in a salt land, seeking rest, but finding none. + +Now, Captain Boanerges and Captain Conviction were, both of them, men of +very great majesty; their faces were like the faces of lions, and their +words like the roaring of the sea; and they still quartered in Mr. +Conscience’s house, of whom mention was made before. When, therefore, +the high and mighty Prince had thus far finished his triumph over +Diabolus, the townsmen had more leisure to view and to behold the actions +of these noble captains. But the captains carried it with that terror +and dread in all that they did, (and you may be sure that they had +private instructions so to do,) that they kept the town under continual +heart-aching, and caused (in their apprehension) the well-being of +Mansoul for the future to hang in doubt before them, so that for some +considerable time they neither knew what rest, or ease, or peace, or hope +meant. + +Nor did the Prince himself as yet abide in the town of Mansoul, but in +his royal pavilion in the camp, and in the midst of his Father’s forces. +So, at a time convenient, he sent special orders to Captain Boanerges to +summons Mansoul, the whole of the townsmen, into the castle-yard, and +then and there, before their faces, to take my Lord Understanding, Mr. +Conscience, and that notable one, the Lord Willbewill, and put them all +three in ward, and that they should set a strong guard upon them there, +until his pleasure concerning them was further known: the which orders, +when the captains had put them in execution, made no small addition to +the fears of the town of Mansoul; for now, to their thinking, were their +former fears of the ruin of Mansoul confirmed. Now, what death they +should die, and how long they should be in dying, was that which most +perplexed their heads and hearts; yea, they were afraid that Emmanuel +would command them all into the deep, the place that the prince Diabolus +was afraid of, for they knew that they had deserved it. Also to die by +the sword in the face of the town, and in the open way of disgrace, from +the hand of so good and so holy a prince, that, too, troubled them sore. +The town was also greatly troubled for the men that were committed to +ward, for that they were their stay and their guide, and for that they +believed that, if those men were cut off, their execution would be but +the beginning of the ruin of the town of Mansoul. Wherefore, what do +they, but, together with the men in prison, draw up a petition to the +Prince, and sent it to Emmanuel by the hand of Mr. Would-live. So he +went, and came to the Prince’s quarters, and presented the petition, the +sum of which was this: + +‘Great and wonderful Potentate, victor over Diabolus, and conqueror of +the town of Mansoul, We, the miserable inhabitants of that most woful +corporation, do humbly beg that we may find favour in thy sight, and +remember not against us former transgressions, nor yet the sins of the +chief of our town: but spare us according to the greatness of thy mercy, +and let us not die, but live in thy sight. So shall we be willing to be +thy servants, and, if thou shalt think fit, to gather our meat under thy +table. Amen.’ + +So the petitioner went, as was said, with his petition to the Prince; and +the Prince took it at his hand, but sent him away with silence. This +still afflicted the town of Mansoul; but yet, considering that now they +must either petition or die, for now they could not do anything else, +therefore they consulted again, and sent another petition; and this +petition was much after the form and method of the former. + +But when the petition was drawn up, By whom should they send it? was the +next question; for they would not send this by him by whom they sent the +first, for they thought that the Prince had taken some offence at the +manner of his deportment before him: so they attempted to make Captain +Conviction their messenger with it; but he said that he neither durst nor +would petition Emmanuel for traitors, nor be to the Prince an advocate +for rebels. ‘Yet withal,’ said he, ‘our Prince is good, and you may +adventure to send it by the hand of one of your town, provided he went +with a rope about his head, and pleaded nothing but mercy.’ + +Well, they made, through fear, their delays as long as they could, and +longer than delays were good; but fearing at last the dangerousness of +them, they thought, but with many a fainting in their minds, to send +their petition by Mr. Desires-awake; so they sent for Mr. Desires-awake. +Now he dwelt in a very mean cottage in Mansoul, and he came at his +neighbour’s request. So they told him what they had done, and what they +would do, concerning petitioning, and that they did desire of him that he +would go therewith to the Prince. + +Then said Mr. Desires-awake, ‘Why should not I do the best I can to save +so famous a town as Mansoul from deserved destruction?’ They therefore +delivered the petition to him, and told him how he must address himself +to the Prince, and wished him ten thousand good speeds. So he comes to +the Prince’s pavilion, as the first, and asked to speak with his Majesty. +So word was carried to Emmanuel, and the Prince came out to the man. +When Mr. Desires-awake saw the Prince, he fell flat with his face to the +ground, and cried out, ‘Oh that Mansoul might live before thee!’ and with +that he presented the petition; the which when the Prince had read, he +turned away for a while and wept; but refraining himself, he turned again +to the man, who all this while lay crying at his feet, as at the first, +and said to him, ‘Go thy way to thy place, and I will consider of thy +requests.’ + +Now, you may think that they of Mansoul that had sent him, what with +guilt, and what with fear lest their petition should be rejected, could +not but look with many a long look, and that, too, with strange workings +of heart, to see what would become of their petition. At last they saw +their messenger coming back. So, when he was come, they asked him how he +fared, what Emmanuel said, and what was become of the petition. But he +told them that he would be silent till he came to the prison to my Lord +Mayor, my Lord Willbewill, and Mr. Recorder. So he went forwards towards +the prison-house, where the men of Mansoul lay bound. But, oh! what a +multitude flocked after, to hear what the messenger said. So, when he +was come, and had shown himself at the gate of the prison, my Lord Mayor +himself looked as white as a clout; the Recorder also did quake. But +they asked and said, ‘Come, good sir, what did the great Prince say to +you?’ Then said Mr. Desires-awake, ‘When I came to my Lord’s pavilion, I +called, and he came forth. So I fell prostrate at his feet, and +delivered to him my petition; for the greatness of his person, and the +glory of his countenance, would not suffer me to stand upon my legs. +Now, as he received the petition, I cried, “Oh that Mansoul might live +before thee!” So, when for a while he had looked thereon, he turned him +about, and said to his servant, “Go thy way to thy place again, and I +will consider of thy requests.”’ The messenger added, moreover, and +said, ‘The Prince to whom you sent me is such a one for beauty and glory, +that whoso sees him must both love and fear him. I, for my part, can do +no less; but I know not what will be the end of these things.’ + +At this answer they were all at a stand, both they in prison, and they +that followed the messenger thither to hear the news; nor knew they what, +or what manner of interpretation to put upon what the Prince had said. +Now, when the prison was cleared of the throng, the prisoners among +themselves began to comment upon Emmanuel’s words. My Lord Mayor said, +that the answer did not look with a rugged face; but Willbewill said that +it betokened evil; and the Recorder, that it was a messenger of death. +Now, they that were left, and that stood behind, and so could not so well +hear what the prisoners said, some of them catched hold of one piece of a +sentence, and some on a bit of another; some took hold of what the +messenger said, and some of the prisoners’ judgment thereon; so none had +the right understanding of things. But you cannot imagine what work +these people made, and what a confusion there was in Mansoul now. + +For presently they that had heard what was said flew about the town, one +crying one thing, and another the quite contrary; and both were sure +enough they told true; for they did hear, they said, with their ears what +was said, and therefore could not be deceived. One would say, ‘We must +all be killed;’ another would say, ‘We must all be saved;’ and a third +would say that the Prince would not be concerned with Mansoul; and a +fourth, that the prisoners must be suddenly put to death. And, as I +said, every one stood to it that he told his tale the rightest, and that +all others but he were out. Wherefore Mansoul had now molestation upon +molestation, nor could any man know on what to rest the sole of his foot; +for one would go by now, and as he went, if he heard his neighbour tell +his tale, to be sure he would tell the quite contrary, and both would +stand in it that he told the truth. Nay, some of them had got this story +by the end, that the Prince did intend to put Mansoul to the sword. And +now it began to be dark, wherefore poor Mansoul was in sad perplexity all +that night until the morning. + +But, so far as I could gather by the best information that I could get, +all this hubbub came through the words that the Recorder said when he +told them that, in his judgment, the Prince’s answer was a messenger of +death. It was this that fired the town, and that began the fright in +Mansoul; for Mansoul in former times did use to count that Mr. Recorder +was a seer, and that his sentence was equal to the best of orators; and +thus was Mansoul a terror to itself. + +And now did they begin to feel what were the effects of stubborn +rebellion, and unlawful resistance against their Prince. I say, they now +began to feel the effects thereof by guilt and fear, that now had +swallowed them up; and who more involved in the one but they that were +most in the other, to wit, the chief of the town of Mansoul? + +To be brief: when the fame of the fright was out of the town, and the +prisoners had a little recovered themselves, they take to themselves some +heart, and think to petition the Prince for life again. So they did draw +up a third petition, the contents whereof were these:— + +‘Prince Emmanuel the Great, Lord of all worlds, and Master of mercy, we, +thy poor, wretched, miserable, dying town of Mansoul, do confess unto thy +great and glorious Majesty that we have sinned against thy Father and +thee, and are no more worthy to be called thy Mansoul, but rather to be +cast into the pit. If thou wilt slay us, we have deserved it. If thou +wilt condemn us to the deep, we cannot but say thou art righteous. We +cannot complain whatever thou dost, or however thou carriest it towards +us. But, oh! let mercy reign, and let it be extended to us! Oh! let +mercy take hold upon us, and free us from our transgressions, and we will +sing of thy mercy and of thy judgment. Amen.’ + +This petition, when drawn up, was designed to be sent to the Prince as +the first. But who should carry it?—that was the question. Some said, +‘Let him do it that went with the first,’ but others thought not good to +do that, and that because he sped no better. Now, there was an old man +in the town, and his name was Mr. Good-Deed; a man that bare only the +name, but had nothing of the nature of the thing. Now, some were for +sending him; but the Recorder was by no means for that. ‘For,’ said he, +‘we now stand in need of, and are pleading for mercy: wherefore, to send +our petition by a man of this name, will seem to cross the petition +itself. Should we make Mr. Good-Deed our messenger, when our petition +cries for mercy? + +‘Besides,’ quoth the old gentleman, ‘should the Prince now, as he +receives the petition, ask him, and say, “What is thy name?” as nobody +knows but he will, and he should say, “Old Good-Deed,” what, think you, +would Emmanuel say but this? “Ay! is old Good-Deed yet alive in Mansoul? +then let old Good-Deed save you from your distresses.” And if he says +so, I am sure we are lost; nor can a thousand of old Good-Deeds save +Mansoul.’ + +After the Recorder had given in his reasons why old Good-Deed should not +go with this petition to Emmanuel, the rest of the prisoners and chief of +Mansoul opposed it also, and so old Good-Deed was laid aside, and they +agreed to send Mr. Desires-awake again. So they sent for him, and +desired him that he would a second time go with their petition to the +Prince, and he readily told them he would. But they bid him that in +anywise he should take heed that in no word or carriage he gave offence +to the Prince; ‘For by doing so, for ought we can tell, you may bring +Mansoul into utter destruction,’ said they. + +Now Mr. Desires-awake, when he saw that he must go on this errand, +besought that they would grant that Mr. Wet-Eyes might go with him. Now +this Mr. Wet-Eyes was a near neighbour of Mr. Desires, a poor man, a man +of a broken spirit, yet one that could speak well to a petition; so they +granted that he should go with him. Wherefore, they address themselves +to their business: Mr. Desires put a rope upon his head, and Mr. Wet-Eyes +went with his hands wringing together. Thus they went to the Prince’s +pavilion. + +Now, when they went to petition this third time, they were not without +thoughts that, by often coming, they might be a burden to the Prince. +Wherefore, when they were come to the door of his pavilion, they first +made their apology for themselves, and for their coming to trouble +Emmanuel so often; and they said, that they came not hither to-day for +that they delighted in being troublesome, or for that they delighted to +hear themselves talk, but for that necessity caused them to come to his +Majesty. They could, they said, have no rest day nor night because of +their transgressions against Shaddai and against Emmanuel, his Son. They +also thought that some misbehaviour of Mr. Desires-awake the last time +might give distaste to his Highness, and so cause that he returned from +so merciful a Prince empty, and without countenance. So, when they had +made this apology, Mr. Desires-awake cast himself prostrate upon the +ground, as at the first, at the feet of the mighty Prince, saying, ‘Oh! +that Mansoul might live before thee!’ and so he delivered his petition. +The Prince then, having read the petition, turned aside awhile as before, +and coming again to the place where the petitioner lay on the ground, he +demanded what his name was, and of what esteem in the account of Mansoul, +for that he, above all the multitude in Mansoul, should be sent to him +upon such an errand. Then said the man to the Prince, ‘Oh let not my +Lord be angry; and why inquirest thou after the name of such a dead do—as +I am? Pass by, I pray thee, and take not notice of who I am, because +there is, as thou very well knowest, so great a disproportion between me +and thee. Why the townsmen chose to send me on this errand to my Lord is +best known to themselves, but it could not be for that they thought that +I had favour with my Lord. For my part, I am out of charity with myself; +who, then, should be in love with me? Yet live I would, and so would I +that my townsmen should; and because both they and myself are guilty of +great transgressions, therefore they have sent me, and I am come in their +names to beg of my Lord for mercy. Let it please thee, therefore, to +incline to mercy; but ask not what thy servants are.’ + +Then said the Prince, ‘And what is he that is become thy companion in +this so weighty a matter?’ So Mr. Desires told Emmanuel that he was a +poor neighbour of his, and one of his most intimate associates. ‘And his +name,’ said he, ‘may it please your most excellent Majesty, is Wet-Eyes, +of the town of Mansoul, I know that there are many of that name that are +naught; but I hope it will be no offence to my Lord that I have brought +my poor neighbour with me.’ + +Then Mr. Wet-Eyes fell on his face to the ground, and made this apology +for his coming with his neighbour to his Lord:— + +‘O, my Lord,’ quoth he, ‘what I am I know not myself, nor whether my name +be feigned or true, especially when I begin to think what some have said, +namely, That this name was given me because Mr. Repentance was my father. +Good men have bad children, and the sincere do oftentimes beget +hypocrites. My mother also called me by this name from the cradle; but +whether because of the moistness of my brain, or because of the softness +of my heart, I cannot tell. I see dirt in mine own tears, and filthiness +in the bottom of my prayers. But I pray thee (and all this while the +gentleman wept) that thou wouldest not remember against us our +transgressions, nor take offence at the unqualifiedness of thy servants, +but mercifully pass by the sin of Mansoul, and refrain from the +glorifying of thy grace no longer.’ + +So at his bidding they arose, and both stood trembling before him, and he +spake to them to this purpose:— + +‘The town of Mansoul hath grievously rebelled against my Father, in that +they have rejected him from being their King, and did choose to +themselves for their captain a liar, a murderer, and a runagate slave. +For this Diabolus, your pretended prince, though once so highly accounted +of by you, made rebellion against my Father and me, even in our palace +and highest court there, thinking to become a prince and king. But being +there timely discovered and apprehended, and for his wickedness bound in +chains, and separated to the pit with those that were his companions, he +offered himself to you, and you have received him. + +‘Now this is, and for a long time hath been, a high affront to my Father; +wherefore my Father sent to you a powerful army to reduce you to your +obedience. But you know how these men, their captains and their +counsels, were esteemed of you, and what they received at your hand. You +rebelled against them, you shut your gates upon them, you bid them +battle, you fought them, and fought for Diabolus against them. So they +sent to my Father for more power, and I, with my men, are come to subdue +you. But as you treated the servants, so you treated their Lord. You +stood up in hostile manner against me, you shut up your gates against me, +you turned the deaf ear to me, and resisted as long as you could; but now +I have made a conquest of you. Did you cry me mercy so long as you had +hopes that you might prevail against me? But now I have taken the town, +you cry; but why did you not cry before, when the white flag of my mercy, +the red flag of justice, and the black flag that threatened execution, +were set up to cite you to it? Now I have conquered your Diabolus, you +come to me for favour; but why did you not help me against the mighty? +Yet I will consider your petition, and will answer it so as will be for +my glory. + +‘Go, bid Captain Boanerges and Captain Conviction bring the prisoners out +to me into the camp to-morrow, and say you to Captain Judgment and +Captain Execution, “Stay you in the castle, and take good heed to +yourselves that you keep all quiet in Mansoul until you shall hear +further from me.”’ And with that he turned himself from them, and went +into his royal pavilion again. + +So the petitioners, having received this answer from the Prince, +returned, as at the first, to go to their companions again. But they had +not gone far, but thoughts began to work in their minds that no mercy as +yet was intended by the Prince to Mansoul. So they went to the place +where the prisoners lay bound; but these workings of mind about what +would become of Mansoul had such strong power over them, that by that +they were come unto them that sent them, they were scarce able to deliver +their message. + +But they came at length to the gates of the town, (now the townsmen with +earnestness were waiting for their return,) where many met them, to know +what answer was made to the petition. Then they cried out to those that +were sent, ‘What news from the Prince? and what hath Emmanuel said?’ But +they said that they must, as afore, go up to the prison, and there +deliver their message. So away they went to the prison, with a multitude +at their heels. Now, when they were come to the gates of the prison, +they told the first part of Emmanuel’s speech to the prisoners, to wit, +how he reflected upon their disloyalty to his Father and himself, and how +they had chosen and closed with Diabolus, had fought for him, hearkened +to him, and been ruled by him; but had despised him and his men. This +made the prisoners look pale; but the messengers proceeded and said, ‘He, +the Prince, said, moreover, that yet he would consider your petition, and +give such answer thereto as would stand with his glory.’ And as these +words were spoken, Mr. Wet-Eyes gave a great sigh. At this they were all +of them struck into their dumps, and could not tell what to say: fear +also possessed them in a marvellous manner, and death seemed to sit upon +some of their eyebrows. Now, there was in the company a notable, +sharp-witted fellow, a mean man of estate, and his name was old +Inquisitive. This man asked the petitioners if they had told out every +whit of what Emmanuel said, and they answered, ‘Verily, no.’ Then said +Inquisitive, ‘I thought so, indeed. Pray, what was it more that he said +unto you?’ Then they paused awhile; but at last they brought out all, +saying, ‘The Prince bade us bid Captain Boanerges and Captain Conviction +bring the prisoners down to him to-morrow; and that Captain Judgment and +Captain Execution should take charge of the castle and town till they +should hear further from him. They said also that when the Prince had +commanded them thus to do, he immediately turned his back upon them, and +went into his royal pavilion. + +But, oh! how this return, and specially this last clause of it, that the +prisoners must go out to the Prince into the camp, brake all their loins +in pieces! Wherefore, with one voice they set up a cry that reached up +to the heavens. This done, each of the three prepared himself to die; +(and the Recorder said unto them, ‘This was the thing that I feared;’) +for they concluded that to-morrow, by that the sun went down, they should +be tumbled out of the world. The whole town also counted of no other, +but that, in their time and order, they must all drink of the same cup. +Wherefore the town of Mansoul spent that night in mourning, and sackcloth +and ashes. The prisoners also, when the time was come for them to go +down before the Prince, dressed themselves in mourning attire, with ropes +upon their heads. The whole town of Mansoul also showed themselves upon +the wall, all clad in mourning weeds, if, perhaps, the Prince with the +sight thereof might be moved with compassion. But, oh! how the +busy-bodies that were in the town of Mansoul did now concern themselves! +They did run here and there through the streets of the town by companies, +crying out as they ran in tumultuous wise, one after one manner, and +another the quite contrary, to the almost utter distraction of Mansoul. + +Well, the time is come that the prisoners must go down to the camp, and +appear before the Prince. And thus was the manner of their going down: +Captain Boanerges went with a guard before them, and Captain Conviction +came behind, and the prisoners went down, bound in chains, in the midst. +So I say, the prisoners went in the midst, and the guard went with flying +colours behind and before, but the prisoners went with drooping spirits. + +Or, more particularly, thus: The prisoners went down all in mourning: +they put ropes upon themselves; they went on, smiting themselves on the +breasts, but durst not lift up their eyes to heaven. Thus they went out +at the gate of Mansoul, till they came into the midst of the Prince’s +army, the sight and glory of which did greatly heighten their affliction. +Nor could they now longer forbear, but cry out aloud, ‘O unhappy men! O +wretched men of Mansoul!’ Their chains, still mixing their dolorous +notes with the cries of the prisoners, made the noise more lamentable. + +So, when they were come to the door of the Prince’s pavilion, they cast +themselves prostrate upon the place; then one went in and told his Lord +that the prisoners were come down. The Prince then ascended a throne of +state, and sent for the prisoners in; who, when they came, did tremble +before him, also they covered their faces with shame. Now, as they drew +near to the place where he sat, they threw themselves down before him. +Then said the Prince to the Captain Boanerges, ‘Bid the prisoners stand +upon their feet.’ Then they stood trembling before him, and he said, +‘Are you the men that heretofore were the servants of Shaddai?’ And they +said, ‘Yes, Lord, yes.’ Then said the Prince again, ‘Are you the men +that did suffer yourselves to be corrupted and defiled by that abominable +one, Diabolus?’ And they said, ‘We did more than suffer it, Lord; for we +chose it of our own mind.’ The Prince asked further, saying, ‘Could you +have been content that your slavery should have continued under his +tyranny as long as you had lived?’ Then said the prisoners, ‘Yes, Lord, +yes; for his ways were pleasing to our flesh, and we were grown aliens to +a better state.’—‘And did you,’ said he, ‘when I came up against this +town of Mansoul, heartily wish that I might not have the victory over +you?’—‘Yes, Lord, yes,’ said they. Then said the Prince, ‘And what +punishment is it, think you, that you deserve at my hand, for these and +other your high and mighty sins?’—And they said, ‘Both death and the +deep, Lord; for we have deserved no less.’ He asked again if they had +aught to say for themselves why the sentence, that they confessed that +they had deserved, should not be passed upon them? And they said, ‘We +can say nothing, Lord: thou art just, for we have sinned.’ Then said the +Prince, ‘And for what are those ropes on your heads?’ The prisoners +answered, ‘These ropes are to bind us withal to the place of execution, +if mercy be not pleasing in thy sight.’ So he further asked if all the +men in the town of Mansoul were in this confession, as they? And they +answered, ‘All the natives, Lord; but for the Diabolonians that came into +our town when the tyrant got possession of us, we can say nothing for +them.’ + +Then the Prince commanded that a herald should be called, and that he +should, in the midst and throughout the camp of Emmanuel, proclaim, and +that with sound of trumpet, that the Prince, the Son of Shaddai, had, in +his Father’s name, and for his Father’s glory, gotten a perfect conquest +and victory over Mansoul; and that the prisoners should follow him, and +say Amen. So, this was done as he had commanded. And presently the +music that was in the upper region sounded melodiously, the captains that +were in the camp shouted, and the soldiers did sing songs of triumph to +the Prince; the colours waved in the wind, and great joy was everywhere, +only it was wanting as yet in the hearts of the men of Mansoul. + +Then the Prince called for the prisoners to come and to stand again +before him, and they came and stood trembling. And he said unto them, +‘The sins, trespasses, iniquities, that you, with the whole town of +Mansoul, have from time to time committed against my Father and me, I +have power and commandment from my Father to forgive to the town of +Mansoul, and do forgive you accordingly.’ And having so said, he gave +them, written in parchment, and sealed with seven seals, a large and +general pardon, commanding my Lord Mayor, my Lord Willbewill, and Mr. +Recorder, to proclaim and cause it to be proclaimed to-morrow, by that +the sun is up, throughout the whole town of Mansoul. + +Moreover, the Prince stripped the prisoners of their mourning weeds, and +gave them beauty for ashes, the oil of joy for mourning, and the garment +of praise for the spirit of heaviness. + +Then he gave to each of the three jewels of gold and precious stones, and +took away their ropes, and put chains of gold about their necks, and +ear-rings in their ears. Now, the prisoners, when they did hear the +gracious words of Prince Emmanuel, and had beheld all that was done unto +them, fainted almost quite away; for the grace, the benefit, the pardon, +was sudden, glorious, and so big, that they were not able, without +staggering, to stand up under it. Yea, my Lord Willbewill swooned +outright; but the Prince stepped to him, put his everlasting arms under +him, embraced him, kissed him, and bid him be of good cheer, for all +should be performed according to his word. He also did kiss, and +embrace, and smile upon the other two that were Willbewill’s companions, +saying, ‘Take these as further tokens of my love, favour, and compassions +to you; and I charge you that you, Mr. Recorder, tell in the town of +Mansoul what you have heard and seen.’ + +Then were their fetters broken to pieces before their faces, and cast +into the air, and their steps were enlarged under them. Then they fell +down at the feet of the Prince, and kissed his feet, and wetted them with +tears: also they cried out with a mighty strong voice, saying, ‘Blessed +be the glory of the Lord from this place.’ So they were bid rise up, and +go to the town, and tell to Mansoul what the Prince had done. He +commanded also that one with a pipe and tabor should go and play before +them all the way into the town of Mansoul. Then was fulfilled what they +never looked for, and they were made to possess that which they never +dreamed of. + +The Prince also called for the noble Captain Credence, and commanded that +he and some of his officers should march before the noble men of Mansoul +with flying colours into the town. He gave also unto Captain Credence a +charge, that about that time that the Recorder did read the general +pardon in the town of Mansoul, that at that very time he should with +flying colours march in at Eye-gate with his ten thousands at his feet +and that he should so go until he came by the high street of the town, up +to the castle gates, and that himself should take possession thereof +against his Lord came thither. He commanded, moreover, that he should +bid Captain Judgment and Captain Execution to leave the stronghold to +him, and to withdraw from Mansoul, and to return into the camp with speed +unto the Prince. + +And now was the town of Mansoul also delivered from the terror of the +first four captains and their men. + +Well, I told you before how the prisoners were entertained by the noble +Prince Emmanuel, and how they behaved themselves before him, and how he +sent them away to their home with pipe and tabor going before them. And +now you must think that those of the town that had all this while waited +to hear of their death, could not but be exercised with sadness of mind, +and with thoughts that pricked like thorns. Nor could their thoughts be +kept to any one point; the wind blew with them all this while at great +uncertainties; yea, their hearts were like a balance that had been +disquieted with a shaking hand. But at last, as they with many a long +look looked over the wall of Mansoul, they thought that they saw some +returning to the town; and thought again, Who should they be, too? Who +should they be? At last they discerned that they were the prisoners: but +can you imagine how their hearts were surprised with wonder, specially +when they perceived also in what equipage and with what honour they were +sent home. They went down to the camp in black, but they came back to +the town in white; they went down to the camp in ropes, they came back in +chains of gold; they went down to the camp with their feet in fetters, +but came back with their steps enlarged under them; they went also to the +camp looking for death, but they came back from thence with assurance of +life; they went down to the camp with heavy hearts, but came back again +with pipe and tabor playing before them. So as soon as they were come to +Eye-gate, the poor and tottering town of Mansoul adventured to give a +shout; and they gave such a shout as made the captains in the Prince’s +army leap at the sound thereof. Alas! for them, poor hearts! who could +blame them? since their dead friends were come to life again; for it was +to them as life from the dead to see the ancients of the town of Mansoul +shine in such splendour. They looked for nothing but the axe and the +block; but, behold, joy and gladness, comfort and consolation, and such +melodious notes attending them that was sufficient to make a sick man +well. + +So, when they came up, they saluted each other with, ‘Welcome, welcome! +and blessed be he that has spared you!’ They added also, ‘We see it is +well with you; but how must it go with the town of Mansoul? And will it +go well with the town of Mansoul?’ said they. Then answered them the +Recorder and my Lord Mayor, ‘Oh! tidings! glad tidings! good tidings of +good, and of great joy to poor Mansoul!’ Then they gave another shout, +that made the earth to ring again. After this, they inquired yet more +particularly how things went in the camp, and what message they had from +Emmanuel to the town. So they told them all passages that had happened +to them at the camp, and everything that the Prince did to them. This +made Mansoul wonder at the wisdom and grace of the Prince Emmanuel. Then +they told them what they had received at his hands for the whole town of +Mansoul, and the Recorder delivered it in these words: ‘PARDON, PARDON, +PARDON for Mansoul! and this shall Mansoul know to-morrow!’ Then he +commanded, and they went and summoned Mansoul to meet together in the +market-place to-morrow, then to hear their general pardon read. + +But who can think what a turn, what a change, what an alteration this +hint of things did make in the countenance of the town of Mansoul! No +man of Mansoul could sleep that night for joy; in every house there was +joy and music, singing and making merry: telling and hearing of Mansoul’s +happiness was then all that Mansoul had to do; and this was the burden of +all their song: ‘Oh! more of this at the rising of the sun! more of this +to-morrow!’ ‘Who thought yesterday,’ would one say, ‘that this day would +have been such a day to us? And who thought, that saw our prisoners go +down in irons, that they would have returned in chains of gold? Yea, +they that judged themselves as they went to be judged of their judge, +were by his mouth acquitted, not for that they were innocent, but of the +Prince’s mercy, and sent home with pipe and tabor. But is this the +common custom of princes? Do they use to show such kind of favours to +traitors? No; this is only peculiar to Shaddai, and unto Emmanuel, his +Son!’ + +Now morning drew on apace; wherefore the Lord Mayor, the Lord Willbewill, +and Mr. Recorder came down to the market-place at the time that the +Prince had appointed, where the townsfolk were waiting for them: and when +they came, they came in that attire, and in that glory that the Prince +had put them into the day before, and the street was lightened with their +glory. So the Mayor, Recorder, and my Lord Willbewill drew down to +Mouth-gate, which was at the lower end of the market-place, because that +of old time was the place where they used to read public matters. +Thither, therefore, they came in their robes, and their tabrets went +before them. Now, the eagerness of the people to know the full of the +matter was great. + +Then the Recorder stood up upon his feet, and, first beckoning with his +hand for silence, he read out with a loud voice the pardon. But when he +came to these words: ‘The Lord, the Lord God, merciful and gracious, +pardoning iniquity, transgressions, and sins, and to them all manner of +sin and blasphemy shall be forgiven,’ etc., they could not forbear +leaping for joy. For this you must know, that there was conjoined +herewith every man’s name in Mansoul; also the seals of the pardon made a +brave show. + +When the Recorder had made an end of reading the pardon, the townsmen ran +up upon the walls of the town, and leaped and skipped thereon for joy, +and bowed themselves seven times with their faces toward Emmanuel’s +pavilion, and shouted out aloud for joy, and said, ‘Let Emmanuel live for +ever!’ Then order was given to the young men in Mansoul that they should +ring the bells for joy. So the bells did ring, and the people sing, and +the music go in every house in Mansoul. + +When the Prince had sent home the three prisoners of Mansoul with joy, +and pipe and tabor, he commanded his captains, with all the field +officers and soldiers throughout his army, to be ready in that morning, +that the Recorder should read the pardon in Mansoul, to do his further +pleasure. So the morning, as I have showed, being come, just as the +Recorder had made an end of reading the pardon, Emmanuel commanded that +all the trumpets in the camp should sound, that the colours should be +displayed, half of them upon Mount Gracious, and half of them upon Mount +Justice. He commanded also that all the captains should show themselves +in all their harness, and that the soldiers should shout for joy. Nor +was Captain Credence, though in the castle, silent in such a day; but he, +from the top of the hold, showed himself with sound of trumpet to Mansoul +and to the Prince’s camp. + +Thus have I showed you the manner and way that Emmanuel took to recover +the town of Mansoul from under the hand and power of the tyrant Diabolus. + +Now, when the Prince had completed these, the outward ceremonies of his +joy, he again commanded that his captains and soldiers should show unto +Mansoul some feats of war: so they presently addressed themselves to this +work. But oh! with what agility, nimbleness, dexterity, and bravery did +these military men discover their skill in feats of war to the now gazing +town of Mansoul! + +They marched, they counter-marched; they opened to the right and left; +they divided and subdivided; they closed, they wheeled, made good their +front and rear with their right and left wings, and twenty things more, +with that aptness, and then were all as the were again, that they +took—yea, ravished, the hearts that were in Mansoul to behold it. But +add to this, the handling of their arms, the managing of their weapons of +war, were marvellously taking to Mansoul and me. + +When this action was over, the whole town of Mansoul came out as one man +to the Prince in the camp to thank him, and praise him for his abundant +favour, and to beg that it would please his grace to come unto Mansoul +with his men, and there to take up their quarters for ever: and this they +did in most humble manner, bowing themselves seven times to the ground +before him. Then said he, ‘All peace be to you.’ So the town came nigh, +and touched with the hand the top of his golden sceptre; and they said, +‘Oh! that the Prince Emmanuel, with his captains and men of war, would +dwell in Mansoul for ever; and that his battering-rams and slings might +be lodged in her for the use and service of the Prince, and for the help +and strength of Mansoul. For,’ said they, ‘we have room for thee, we +have room for thy men, we have also room for thy weapons of war, and a +place to make a magazine for thy carriages. Do it, Emmanuel, and thou +shalt be King and Captain in Mansoul for ever. Yea, govern thou also +according to all the desire of thy soul, and make thou governors and +princes under thee of thy captains and men of war, and we will become thy +servants, and thy laws shall be our direction.’ + +They added, moreover, and prayed his Majesty to consider thereof; ‘for,’ +said they, ‘if now, after all this grace bestowed upon us, thy miserable +town of Mansoul, thou shouldest withdraw, thou and thy captains, from us, +the town of Mansoul will die. Yea,’ said they, ‘our blessed Emmanuel, if +thou shouldest depart from us now, now thou hast done so much good for +us, and showed so much mercy unto us, what will follow but that our joy +will be as if it had not been, and our enemies will a second time come +upon us with more rage than at the first? Wherefore, we beseech thee, O +thou, the desire of our eyes, and the strength and life of our poor town, +accept of this motion that now we have made unto our Lord, and come and +dwell in the midst of us, and let us be thy people. Besides, Lord, we do +not know but that to this day many Diabolonians may be yet lurking in the +town of Mansoul, and they will betray us, when thou shalt leave us, into +the hand of Diabolus again; and who knows what designs, plots, or +contrivances have passed betwixt them about these things already? Loath +we are to fall again into his horrible hands. Wherefore, let it please +thee to accept of our palace for thy place of residence, and of the +houses of the best men in our town for the reception of thy soldiers and +their furniture.’ + +Then said the Prince, ‘If I come to your town, will you suffer me further +to prosecute that which is in mine heart against mine enemies and +yours?—yea, will you help me in such undertakings?’ + +They answered, ‘We know not what we shall do; we did not think once that +we should have been such traitors to Shaddai as we have proved to be. +What, then, shall we say to our Lord? Let him put no trust in his +saints; let the Prince dwell in our castle, and make of our town a +garrison; let him set his noble captains and his warlike soldiers over +us; yea, let him conquer us with his love, and overcome us with his +grace, and then surely shall he be but with us, and help us, as he was +and did that morning that our pardon was read unto us. We shall comply +with this our Lord, and with his ways, and fall in with his word against +the mighty. + +‘One word more, and thy servants have done, and in this will trouble our +Lord no more. We know not the depth of the wisdom of thee, our Prince. +Who could have thought, that had been ruled by his reason, that so much +sweet as we do now enjoy should have come out of those bitter trials +wherewith we were tried at the first! But, Lord, let light go before, +and let love come after: yea, take us by the hand, and lead us by thy +counsels, and let this always abide upon us, that all things shall be the +best for thy servants, and come to our Mansoul, and do as it pleaseth +thee. Or, Lord, come to our Mansoul, do what thou wilt, so thou keepest +us from sinning, and makest us serviceable to thy Majesty.’ + +Then said the Prince to the town of Mansoul again, ‘Go, return to your +houses in peace. I will willingly in this comply with your desires; I +will remove my royal pavilion, I will draw up my forces before Eye-gate +to-morrow, and so will march forwards into the town of Mansoul. I will +possess myself of your castle of Mansoul, and will set my soldiers over +you: yea, I will yet do things in Mansoul that cannot be paralleled in +any nation, country, or kingdom under heaven.’ Then did the men of +Mansoul give a shout, and returned unto their houses in peace; they also +told to their kindred and friends the good that Emmanuel had promised to +Mansoul. ‘And to-morrow,’ said they, ‘he will march into our town, and +take up his dwelling, he and his men, in Mansoul.’ + +Then went out the inhabitants of the town of Mansoul with haste to the +green trees and to the meadows, to gather boughs and flowers, therewith +to strew the streets against their Prince, the Son of Shaddai, should +come; they also made garlands and other fine works to betoken how joyful +they were, and should be to receive their Emmanuel into Mansoul; yea, +they strewed the street quite from Eye-gate to the castle-gate, the place +where the Prince should be. They also prepared for his coming what music +the town of Mansoul would afford, that they might play before him to the +palace, his habitation. + +So, at the time appointed he makes his approach to Mansoul, and the gates +were set open for him; there also the ancients and elders of Mansoul met +him to salute him with a thousand welcomes. Then he arose and entered +Mansoul, he and all his servants. The elders of Mansoul did also go +dancing before him till he came to the castle gates. And this was the +manner of his going up thither:—He was clad in his golden armour, he rode +in his royal chariot, the trumpets sounded about him, the colours were +displayed, his ten thousands went up at his feet, and the elders of +Mansoul danced before him. And now were the walls of the famous town of +Mansoul filled with the tramplings of the inhabitants thereof, who went +up thither to view the approach of the blessed Prince and his royal army. +Also the casements, windows, balconies, and tops of the houses, were all +now filled with persons of all sorts, to behold how their town was to be +filled with good. + +Now, when he was come so far into the town as to the Recorder’s house, he +commanded that one should go to Captain Credence, to know whether the +castle of Mansoul was prepared to entertain his royal presence (for the +preparation of that was left to that captain), and word was brought that +it was. Then was Captain Credence commanded also to come forth with his +power to meet the Prince, the which was, as he had commanded, done; and +he conducted him into the castle. This done, the Prince that night did +lodge in the castle with his mighty captains and men of war, to the joy +of the town of Mansoul. + +Now, the next care of the townsfolk was, how the captains and soldiers of +the Prince’s army should be quartered among them; and the care was not +how they should shut their hands of them, but how they should fill their +houses with them; for every man in Mansoul now had that esteem of +Emmanuel and his men that nothing grieved them more than because they +were not enlarged enough, every one of them to receive the whole army of +the Prince; yea, they counted it their glory to be waiting upon them, and +would, in those days, run at their bidding like lackeys. + +At last they came to this result:— + +1. That Captain Innocency should quarter at Mr. Reason’s. + +2. That Captain Patience should quarter at Mr. Mind’s. This Mr. Mind was +formerly the Lord Willbewill’s clerk in time of the late rebellion. + +3. It was ordered that Captain Charity should quarter at Mr. Affection’s +house. + +4. That Captain Good-Hope should quarter at my Lord Mayor’s. Now, for +the house of the Recorder, himself desired, because his house was next to +the castle, and because from him it was ordered by the Prince that, if +need be, the alarm should be given to Mansoul,—it was, I say, desired by +him that Captain Boanerges and Captain Conviction should take up their +quarters with him, even they and all their men. + +5. As for Captain Judgment and Captain Execution, my Lord Willbewill took +them and their men to him, because he was to rule under the Prince for +the good of the town of Mansoul now, as he had before under the tyrant +Diabolus for the hurt and damage thereof. + +6. And throughout the rest of the town were quartered Emmanuel’s forces; +but Captain Credence, with his men, abode still in the castle. So the +Prince, his captains, and his soldiers, were lodged in the town of +Mansoul. + +Now, the ancients and elders of the town of Mansoul thought that they +never should have enough of the Prince Emmanuel; his person, his actions, +his words, and behaviour, were so pleasing, so taking, so desirable to +them. Wherefore they prayed him, that though the castle of Mansoul was +his place of residence, (and they desired that he might dwell there for +ever,) yet that he would often visit the streets, houses, and people of +Mansoul. ‘For,’ said they, ‘dread Sovereign, thy presence, thy looks, +thy smiles, thy words, are the life, and strength, and sinews of the town +of Mansoul.’ + +Besides this, they craved that they might have, without difficulty or +interruption, continual access unto him, (so for that very purpose he +commanded that the gates should stand open,) that they might there see +the manner of his doings, the fortifications of the place, and the royal +mansion-house of the Prince. + +When he spake, they all stopped their mouths and gave audience; and when +he walked, it was their delight to imitate him in his goings. + +Now, upon a time, Emmanuel made a feast for the town of Mansoul; and upon +the feasting-day the townsfolk were come to the castle to partake of his +banquet; and he feasted them with all manner of outlandish food;—food +that grew not in the fields of Mansoul; nor in all the whole Kingdom of +Universe; it was food that came from his Father’s court. And so there +was dish after dish set before them, and they were commanded freely to +eat. But still, when a fresh dish was set before them, they would +whisperingly say to each other, ‘What is it?’ for they wist not what to +call it. They drank also of the water that was made wine, and were very +merry with him. There was music also all the while at the table; and man +did eat angels’ food, and had honey given him out of the rock. So +Mansoul did eat the food that was peculiar to the court; yea, they had +now thereof to the full. + +I must not forget to tell you, that as at this table there were +musicians, so they were not those of the country, nor yet of the town of +Mansoul; but they were the masters of the songs that were sung at the +court of Shaddai. + +Now, after the feast was over, Emmanuel was for entertaining the town of +Mansoul with some curious riddles of secrets drawn up by his Father’s +secretary, by the skill and wisdom of Shaddai; the like to these there is +not in any kingdom. These riddles were made upon the King Shaddai +himself, and upon Emmanuel his Son, and upon his wars and doings with +Mansoul. + +Emmanuel also expounded unto them some of those riddles himself; but, oh! +how they were lightened! They saw what they never saw; they could not +have thought that such rarities could have been couched in so few and +such ordinary words. I told you before, whom these riddles did concern; +and as they were opened, the people did evidently see it was so. Yea, +they did gather that the things themselves were a kind of a portraiture, +and that of Emmanuel himself; for when they read in the scheme where the +riddles were writ, and looked in the face of the Prince, things looked so +like the one to the other, that Mansoul could not forbear but say, ‘This +is the lamb! this is the sacrifice! this is the rock! this is the red +cow! this is the door! and this is the way!’ with a great many other +things more. + +And thus he dismissed the town of Mansoul. But can you imagine how the +people of the corporation were taken with this entertainment! Oh! they +were transported with joy, they were drowned with wonderment, while they +saw and understood, and considered what their Emmanuel entertained them +withal, and what mysteries he opened to them. And when they were at home +in their houses, and in their most retired places, they could not but +sing of him and of his actions. Yea, so taken were the townsmen now with +their Prince, that they would sing of him in their sleep. + +Now, it was in the heart of the Prince Emmanuel to new-model the town of +Mansoul, and to put it into such a condition as might be most pleasing to +him, and that might best stand with the profit and security of the now +flourishing town of Mansoul. He provided also against insurrections at +home, and invasions from abroad, such love had he for the famous town of +Mansoul. + +Wherefore he first of all commanded that the great slings that were +brought from his Father’s court, when he came to the war of Mansoul, +should be mounted, some upon the battlements of the castle, some upon the +towers; for there were towers in the town of Mansoul, towers, new-built +by Emmanuel since he came hither. There was also an instrument, invented +by Emmanuel, that was to throw stones from the castle of Mansoul, out at +Mouth-gate; an instrument that could not be resisted, nor that would miss +of execution. Wherefore, for the wonderful exploits that it did when +used, it went without a name; and it was committed to the care of, and to +be managed by the brave captain, the Captain Credence, in case of war. + +This done, Emmanuel called the Lord Willbewill to him, and gave him in +commandment to take care of the gates, the wall, and towers in Mansoul; +also the Prince gave him the militia into his hand, and a special charge +to withstand all insurrections and tumults that might be made in Mansoul +against the peace of our Lord the King, and the peace and tranquillity of +the town of Mansoul. He also gave him in commission, that if he found +any of the Diabolonians lurking in any corner of the famous town of +Mansoul, he should forthwith apprehend them, and stay them, or commit +them to safe custody, that they may be proceeded against according to +law. + +Then he called unto him the Lord Understanding, who was the old Lord +Mayor, he that was put out of place when Diabolus took the town, and put +him into his former office again, and it became his place for his +lifetime. He bid him also that he should build him a palace near +Eye-gate; and that he should build it in fashion like a tower for +defence. He bid him also that he should read in the Revelation of +Mysteries all the days of his life, that he might know how to perform his +office aright. + +He also made Mr. Knowledge the Recorder, not of contempt to old Mr. +Conscience, who had been Recorder before, but for that it was in his +princely mind to confer upon Mr. Conscience another employ, of which he +told the old gentleman he should know more hereafter. + +Then he commanded that the image of Diabolus should be taken down from +the place where it was set up, and that they should destroy it utterly, +beating it into powder, and casting it into the wind without the town +wall; and that the image of Shaddai, his Father, should be set up again, +with his own, upon the castle gates; and that it should be more fairly +drawn than ever, forasmuch as both his Father and himself were come to +Mansoul in more grace and mercy than heretofore. He would also that his +name should be fairly engraven upon the front of the town, and that it +should be done in the best of gold, for the honour of the town of +Mansoul. + +After this was done, Emmanuel gave out a commandment that those three +great Diabolonians should be apprehended, namely, the two late Lord +Mayors, to wit, Mr. Incredulity, Mr. Lustings, and Mr. Forget-Good, the +Recorder. Besides these, there were some of them that Diabolus made +burgesses and aldermen in Mansoul, that were committed to ward by the +hand of the now valiant and now right noble, the brave Lord Willbewill. + +And these were their names: Alderman Atheism, Alderman Hard-Heart, and +Alderman False-Peace. The burgesses were, Mr. No-Truth, Mr. Pitiless, +Mr. Haughty, with the like. These were committed to close custody, and +the gaoler’s name was Mr. True-Man. This True-Man was one of those that +Emmanuel brought with him from his Father’s court when at the first he +made a war upon Diabolus in the town or Mansoul. + +After this, the Prince gave a charge that the three strongholds that, at +the command of Diabolus, the Diabolonians built in Mansoul, should be +demolished and utterly pulled down; of which holds and their names, with +their captains and governors, you read a little before. But this was +long in doing, because of the largeness of the places, and because the +stones, the timber, the iron, and all rubbish, was to be carried without +the town. + +When this was done, the Prince gave order that the Lord Mayor and +aldermen of Mansoul should call a court of judicature for the trial and +execution of the Diabolonians in the corporation now under the charge of +Mr. True-Man, the gaoler. + +Now, when the time was come, and the court set, commandment was sent to +Mr. True-Man, the gaoler, to bring the prisoners down to the bar. Then +were the prisoners brought down, pinioned and chained together, as the +custom of the town of Mansoul was. So, when they were presented before +the Lord Mayor, the Recorder, and the rest of the honourable bench, +first, the jury was empannelled, and then the witnesses sworn. The names +of the jury were these: Mr. Belief, Mr. True-Heart, Mr. Upright, Mr. +Hate-Bad, Mr. Love-God, Mr. See-Truth, Mr. Heavenly-Mind, Mr. Moderate, +Mr. Thankful, Mr. Good-Work, Mr. Zeal-for-God, and Mr. Humble. + +The names of the witnesses were—Mr. Know-All, Mr. Tell-True, Mr. +Hate-Lies, with my Lord Willbewill and his man, if need were. + +So the prisoners were set to the bar. Then said Mr. Do-Right, (for he +was the Town-Clerk,) ‘Set Atheism to the bar, gaoler.’ So he was set to +the bar. Then said the Clerk, ‘Atheism, hold up thy hand. Thou art here +indicted by the name of Atheism, (an intruder upon the town of Mansoul,) +for that thou hast perniciously and doltishly taught and maintained that +there is no God, and so no heed to be taken to religion. This thou hast +done against the being, honour, and glory of the King, and against the +peace and safety of the town of Mansoul. What sayest thou? Art thou +guilty of this indictment, or not? + +_Atheism_. Not guilty. + +_Crier_. Call Mr. Know-All, Mr. Tell-True, and Mr. Hate-Lies into the +court. + +So they were called, and they appeared. + +Then said the Clerk, ‘You, the witnesses for the King, look upon the +prisoner at the bar; do you know him?’ + +Then said Mr. Know-All, ‘Yes, my lord, we know him; his name is Atheism; +he has been a very pestilent fellow for many years in the miserable town +of Mansoul.’ + +_Clerk_. You are sure you know him? + +_Know_. Know him! Yes my lord; I have heretofore too often been in his +company to be at this time ignorant of him. He is a Diabolonian, the son +of a Diabolonian: I knew his grandfather and his father. + +_Clerk_. Well said. He standeth here indicted by the name of Atheism, +etc., and is charged that he hath maintained and taught that there is no +God, and so no heed need be taken to any religion. What say you, the +King’s witnesses, to this? Is he guilty or not? + +_Know_. My lord, I and he were once in Villain’s Lane together, and he +at that time did briskly talk of divers opinions; and then and there I +heard him say, that, for his part, he did believe that there was no God. +‘But,’ said he, ‘I can profess one, and be as religious too, if the +company I am in, and the circumstances of other things,’ said he, ‘shall +put me upon it.’ + +_Clerk_. You are sure you heard him say thus? + +_Know_. Upon mine oath, I heard him say thus. + +Then said the Clerk, ‘Mr. Tell-True, what say you to the King’s judges +touching the prisoner at the bar?’ + +_Tell_. My lord, I formerly was a great companion of his, for the which +I now repent me, and I have often heard him say, and that with very great +stomachfulness, that he believed there was neither God, angel, nor +spirit. + +_Clerk_. Where did you hear him say so? + +_Tell_. In Blackmouth Lane and in Blasphemer’s Row, and in many other +places besides. + +_Clerk_. Have you much knowledge of him? + +_Tell_. I know him to be a Diabolonian, the son of a Diabolonian, and a +horrible man to deny a Deity. His father’s name was Never-be-good, and +he had more children than this Atheism. I have no more to say. + +_Clerk_. Mr. Hate-Lies, look upon the prisoner at the bar; do you know +him? + +_Hate_. My lord, this Atheism is one of the vilest wretches that ever I +came near, or had to do with in my life. I have heard him say that there +is no God; I have heard him say that there is no world to come, no sin, +nor punishment hereafter, and, moreover, I have heard him say that it was +as good to go to a whore-house as to go to hear a sermon. + +_Clerk_. Where did you hear him say these things? + +_Hate_. In Drunkard’s Row, just at Rascal-Lane’s End, at a house in +which Mr. Impiety lived. + +_Clerk_. Set him by, gaoler, and set Mr. Lustings to the bar. Mr. +Lustings, thou art here indicted by the name of Lustings, (an intruder +upon the town of Mansoul,) for that thou hast devilishly and traitorously +taught, by practice and filthy words, that it is lawful and profitable to +man to give way to his carnal desires; and that thou, for thy part, hast +not, nor never wilt, deny thyself of any sinful delight as long as thy +name is Lustings. How sayest thou? Art thou guilty of this indictment, +or not? + +Then said Mr. Lustings, ‘My lord, I am a man of high birth, and have been +used to pleasures and pastimes of greatness. I have not been wont to be +snubbed for my doings, but have been left to follow my will as if it were +law. And it seems strange to me that I should this day be called into +question for that, that not only I, but almost all men, do either +secretly or openly countenance, love, and approve of.’ + +_Clerk_. Sir, we concern not ourselves with your greatness; (though the +higher, the better you should have been;) but we are concerned, and so +are you now, about an indictment preferred against you. How say you? +Are you guilty of it, or not? + +_Lust_. Not guilty. + +_Clerk_. Crier, call upon the witnesses to stand forth and give their +evidence. + +_Crier_. Gentlemen, you, the witnesses for the King, come in and give in +your evidence for our Lord the King against the prisoner at the bar. + +_Clerk_. Come, Mr. Know-All, look upon the prisoner at the bar; do you +know him? + +_Know_. Yes, my lord, I know him. + +_Clerk_. What is his name? + +_Know_. His name is Lustings; he was the son of one Beastly, and his +mother bare him in Flesh Street: she was one Evil-Concupiscence’s +daughter. I knew all the generation of them. + +_Clerk_. Well said. You have heard his indictment; what say you to it? +Is he guilty of the things charged against him, or not? + +_Know_. My lord, he has, as he saith, been a great man indeed, and +greater in wickedness than by pedigree more than a thousandfold. + +_Clerk_. But what do you know of his particular actions, and especially +with reference to his indictment? + +_Know_. I know him to be a swearer, a liar, a Sabbath-breaker; I know +him to be a fornicator and an unclean person; I know him to be guilty of +abundance of evils. He has been, to my knowledge, a very filthy man. + +_Clerk_. But where did he use to commit his wickedness? in some private +corners, or more open and shamelessly? + +_Know_. All the town over, my lord. + +_Clerk_. Come, Mr. Tell-True, what have you to say for our Lord the King +against the prisoner at the bar? + +_Tell_. My lord, all that the first witness has said I know to be true, +and a great deal more besides. + +_Clerk_. Mr. Lustings, do you hear what these gentlemen say? + +_Lust_. I was ever of opinion that the happiest life that a man could +live on earth was to keep himself back from nothing that he desired in +the world; nor have I been false at any time to this opinion of mine, but +have lived in the love of my notions all my days. Nor was I ever so +churlish, having found such sweetness in them myself, as to keep the +commendations of them from others. + +Then said the Court, ‘There hath proceeded enough from his own mouth to +lay him open to condemnation; wherefore, set him by, gaoler, and set Mr. +Incredulity to the bar.’ + +Incredulity set to the bar. + +_Clerk_. Mr. Incredulity, thou art here indicted by the name of +Incredulity, (an intruder upon the town of Mansoul,) for that thou hast +feloniously and wickedly, and that when thou wert an officer in the town +of Mansoul, made head against the captains of the great King Shaddai when +they came and demanded possession of Mansoul; yea, thou didst bid +defiance to the name, forces, and cause of the King, and didst also, as +did Diabolus thy captain, stir up and encourage the town of Mansoul to +make head against and resist the said force of the King. What sayest +thou to this indictment? Art thou guilty of it, or not? + +Then said Incredulity, ‘I know not Shaddai; I love my old prince; I +thought it my duty to be true to my trust, and to do what I could to +possess the minds of the men of Mansoul to do their utmost to resist +strangers and foreigners, and with might to fight against them. Nor have +I, nor shall I, change mine opinion for fear of trouble, though you at +present are possessed of place and power.’ + +Then said the Court, ‘The man, as you see, is incorrigible; he is for +maintaining his villainies by stoutness of words, and his rebellion with +impudent confidence; and therefore set him by, gaoler, and set Mr. +Forget-Good to the bar. + +Forget-Good set to the bar. + +_Clerk_. Mr. Forget-Good, thou art here indicted by the name of +Forget-Good, (an intruder upon the town of Mansoul,) for that thou, when +the whole affairs of the town of Mansoul were in thy hand, didst utterly +forget to serve them in what was good, and didst fall in with the tyrant +Diabolus against Shaddai the King, against his captains, and all his +host, to the dishonour of Shaddai, the breach of his law, and the +endangering of the destruction of the famous town of Mansoul. What +sayest thou to this indictment? Art thou guilty or not guilty? + +Then said Forget-Good: ‘Gentlemen, and at this time my judges, as to the +indictment by which I stand of several crimes accused before you, pray +attribute my forgetfulness to mine age, and not to my wilfulness; to the +craziness of my brain, and not to the carelessness of my mind; and then I +hope I may be by your charity excused from great punishment, though I be +guilty.’ + +Then said the Court, ‘Forget-Good, Forget-Good, thy forgetfulness of good +was not simply of frailty, but of purpose, and for that thou didst loathe +to keep virtuous things in thy mind. What was bad thou couldst retain, +but what was good thou couldst not abide to think of; thy age, therefore, +and thy pretended craziness, thou makest use of to blind the court +withal, and as a cloak to cover thy knavery. But let us hear what the +witnesses have to say for the King against the prisoner at the bar. Is +he guilty of this indictment, or not?’ + +_Hate_. My lord, I have heard this Forget-Good say, that he could never +abide to think of goodness, no, not for a quarter of an hour. + +_Clerk_. Where did you hear him say so? + +_Hate_. In All-base Lane, at a house next door to the sign of the +Conscience seared with a hot iron. + +_Clerk_. Mr. Know-All, what can you say for our Lord the King against +the prisoner at the bar? + +_Know_. My lord, I know this man well. He is a Diabolonian, the son of +a Diabolonian: his father’s name was Love-Naught; and for him, I have +often heard him say, that he counted the very thoughts of goodness the +most burdensome thing in the world. + +_Clerk_. Where have you heard him say these words? + +_Know_. In Flesh Lane, right opposite to the church. + +Then said the Clerk, ‘Come, Mr. Tell-True, give in your evidence +concerning the prisoner at the bar, about that for which he stands here, +as you see, indicted by this honourable Court.’ + +_Tell_. My lord, I have heard him often say he had rather think of the +vilest thing than of what is contained in the Holy Scriptures. + +_Clerk_. Where did you hear him say such grievous words? + +_Tell_. Where?—in a great many places, particularly in Nauseous Street, +in the house of one Shameless, and in Filth Lane, at the sign of the +Reprobate, next door to the Descent into the Pit. + +_Court_. Gentlemen, you have heard the indictment, his plea, and the +testimony of the witnesses. Gaoler, set Mr. Hard-Heart to the bar. + +He is set to the bar. + +_Clerk_. Mr. Hard-Heart, thou art here indicted by the name of +Hard-Heart, (an intruder upon the town of Mansoul,) for that thou didst +most desperately and wickedly possess the town of Mansoul with +impenitency and obdurateness; and didst keep them from remorse and sorrow +for their evils, all the time of their apostacy from and rebellion +against the blessed King Shaddai. What sayest thou to this indictment? +Art thou guilty, or not guilty? + +_Hard_. My lord, I never knew what remorse or sorrow meant in all my +life. I am impenetrable. I care for no man; nor can I be pierced with +men’s griefs; their groans will not enter into my heart. Whomsoever I +mischief, whomsoever I wrong, to me it is music, when to others mourning. + +_Court_. You see the man is a right Diabolonian, and has convicted +himself. Set him by, gaoler, and set Mr. False-Peace to the bar. + +False-Peace set to the bar. + +‘Mr. False-Peace, thou art here indicted by the name of False-Peace, (an +intruder upon the town of Mansoul,) for that thou didst most wickedly and +satanically bring, hold, and keep the town of Mansoul, both in her +apostacy and in her hellish rebellion, in a false, groundless, and +dangerous peace, and damnable security, to the dishonour of the King, the +transgression of his law, and the great damage of the town of Mansoul. +What sayest thou? Art thou guilty of this indictment, or not? + +Then said Mr. False-Peace: ‘Gentlemen, and you now appointed to be my +judges, I acknowledge that my name is Mr. Peace; but that my name is +False-Peace I utterly deny. If your honours shall please to send for any +that do intimately know me, or for the midwife that laid my mother of me, +or for the gossips that were at my christening, they will, any or all of +them, prove that my name is not False-Peace, but Peace. Wherefore I +cannot plead to this indictment, forasmuch as my name is not inserted +therein; and as is my true name, so are also my conditions. I was always +a man that loved to live at quiet, and what I loved myself, that I +thought others might love also. Wherefore, when I saw any of my +neighbours to labour under a disquieted mind, I endeavoured to help them +what I could; and instances of this good temper of mine many I could +give; as, + +‘1. When, at the beginning, our town of Mansoul did decline the ways of +Shaddai, they, some of them, afterwards began to have disquieting +reflections upon themselves for what they had done; but I, as one +troubled to see them disquieted, presently sought out means to get them +quiet again. + +‘2. When the ways of the old world, and of Sodom, were in fashion, if +anything happened to molest those that were for the customs of the +present times, I laboured to make them quiet again, and to cause them to +act without molestation. + +‘3. To come nearer home: when the wars fell out between Shaddai and +Diabolus, if at any time I saw any of the town of Mansoul afraid of +destruction, I often used, by some way, device, invention, or other, to +labour to bring them to peace again. Wherefore, since I have been always +a man of so virtuous a temper as some say a peace-maker is, and if a +peace-maker be so deserving a man as some have been bold to attest he is, +then let me, gentlemen, be accounted by you, who have a great name for +justice and equity in Mansoul, for a man that deserveth not this inhuman +way of treatment, but liberty, and also a license to seek damage of those +that have been my accusers.’ + +Then said the clerk, ‘Crier, make a proclamation.’ + +_Crier_. Oyes! Forasmuch as the prisoner at the bar hath denied his +name to be that which is mentioned in the indictment, the Court requireth +that if there be any in this place that can give information to the Court +of the original and right name of the prisoner, they would come forth and +give in their evidence; for the prisoner stands upon his own innocency. + +Then came two into the court, and desired that they might have leave to +speak what they knew concerning the prisoner at the bar: the name of the +one was Search-Truth, and the name of the other Vouch-Truth. So the +Court demanded of these men if they knew the prisoner, and what they +could say concerning him, ‘for he stands,’ said they, ‘upon his own +vindication.’ + +Then said Mr. Search-Truth, ‘My Lord, I—’ + +_Court_. Hold! give him his oath. + +Then they sware him. So he proceeded. + +_Search_. My lord, I know and have known this man from a child, and can +attest that his name is False-Peace. I know his father; his name was Mr. +Flatter: and his mother, before she was married, was called by the name +of Mrs. Sooth-Up: and these two, when they came together, lived not long +without this son; and when he was born, they called his name False-Peace. +I was his play-fellow, only I was somewhat older than he; and when his +mother did use to call him home from his play, she used to say, +‘False-Peace, False-Peace, come home quick, or I’ll fetch you.’ Yea, I +knew him when he sucked; and though I was then but little, yet I can +remember that when his mother did use to sit at the door with him, or did +play with him in her arms, she would call him, twenty times together, ‘My +little False-Peace! my pretty False-Peace!’ and, ‘Oh! my sweet rogue, +False-Peace!’ and again, ‘Oh! my little bird, False-Peace!’ and ‘How do I +love my child!’ The gossips also know it is thus, though he has had the +face to deny it in open court. + +Then Mr. Vouch-Truth was called upon to speak what he knew of him. So +they sware him. + +Then said Mr. Vouch-Truth, ‘My lord, all that the former witness hath +said is true. His name is False-Peace, the son of Mr. Flatter, and of +Mrs. Sooth-Up, his mother: and I have in former times seen him angry with +those that have called him anything else but False-Peace, for he would +say that all such did mock and nickname him; but this was in the time +when Mr. False-Peace was a great man, and when the Diabolonians were the +brave men in Mansoul. + +_Court_. Gentlemen, you have heard what these two men have sworn against +the prisoner at the bar. And now, Mr. False-Peace, to you: you have +denied your name to be False-Peace, yet you see that these honest men +have sworn that that is your name. As to your plea, in that you are +quite besides the matter of your indictment, you are not by it charged +for evil-doing because you are a man of peace, or a peace-maker among +your neighbours; but for that you did wickedly and satanically bring, +keep, and hold the town of Mansoul, both under its apostasy from, and in +its rebellion against its King, in a false, lying, and damnable peace, +contrary to the law of Shaddai, and to the hazard of the destruction of +the then miserable town of Mansoul. All that you have pleaded for +yourself is, that you have denied your name, etc.; but here, you see, we +have witnesses to prove that you are the man. For the peace that you so +much boast of making among your neighbours, know that peace that is not a +companion of truth and holiness, but that which is without this +foundation, is grounded upon a lie, and is both deceitful and damnable, +as also the great Shaddai hath said. Thy plea, therefore, has not +delivered thee from what by the indictment thou art charged with, but +rather it doth fasten all upon thee. But thou shalt have very fair play. +Let us call the witnesses that are to testify as to matter of fact, and +see what they have to say for our Lord the King against the prisoner at +the bar. + +_Clerk_. Mr. Know-All, what say you for our Lord the King against the +prisoner at the bar? + +_Know_. My lord, this man hath of a long time made it, to my knowledge, +his business to keep the town of Mansoul in a sinful quietness in the +midst of all her lewdness, filthiness, and turmoils, and hath said, and +that in my hearing, Come, come, let us fly from all trouble, on what +ground soever it comes, and let us be for a quiet and peaceable life, +though it wanteth a good foundation. + +_Clerk_. Come, Mr. Hate-Lies, what have you to say? + +_Hate_. My lord, I have heard him say, that peace, though in a way of +unrighteousness, is better than trouble with truth. + +_Clerk_. Where did you hear him say this? + +_Hate_. I heard him say it in Folly-yard, at the house of one Mr. +Simple, next door to the sign of the Self-deceiver. Yea, he hath said +this to my knowledge twenty times in that place. + +_Clerk_. We may spare further witness; this evidence is plain and full. +Set him by, gaoler, and set Mr. No-Truth to the bar. Mr. No-Truth, thou +art here indicted by the name of No-Truth, (an intruder upon the town of +Mansoul,) for that thou hast always, to the dishonour of Shaddai, and the +endangering of the utter ruin of the famous town of Mansoul, set thyself +to deface, and utterly to spoil, all the remainders of the law and image +of Shaddai that have been found in Mansoul after her deep apostasy from +her king to Diabolus, the envious tyrant. What sayest thou, art thou +guilty of this indictment, or not? + +_No_. Not guilty, my lord. + +Then the witnesses were called, and Mr. Know-All did first give in his +evidence against him. + +_Know_. My lord, this man was at the pulling down of the image of +Shaddai; yea, this is he that did it with his own hands. I myself stood +by and saw him do it, and he did it at the commandment of Diabolus. Yea, +this Mr. No-Truth did more than this, he did also set up the horned image +of the beast Diabolus in the same place. This also is he that, at the +bidding of Diabolus, did rend and tear, and cause to be consumed, all +that he could of the remainders of the law of the King, even whatever he +could lay his hands on in Mansoul. + +_Clerk_. Who saw him do this besides yourself? + +_Hate_. I did, my lord, and so did many more besides; for this was not +done by stealth, or in a corner, but in the open view of all; yea, he +chose himself to do it publicly, for he delighted in the doing of it. + +_Clerk_. Mr. No-Truth, how could you have the face to plead not guilty, +when you were so manifestly the doer of all this wickedness? + +_No_. Sir, I thought I must say something, and as my name is, so I +speak. I have been advantaged thereby before now, and did not know but +by speaking no truth, I might have reaped the same benefit now. + +_Clerk_. Set him by, gaoler, and set Mr. Pitiless to the bar. Mr. +Pitiless, thou art here indicted by the name of Pitiless, (an intruder +upon the town of Mansoul,) for that thou didst most traitorously and +wickedly shut up all bowels of compassion, and wouldest not suffer poor +Mansoul to condole her own misery when she had apostatised from her +rightful King, but didst evade, and at all times turn her mind awry from +those thoughts that had in them a tendency to lead her to repentance. +What sayest thou to this indictment? Guilty or not guilty? + +‘Not guilty of pitilessness: all I did was to cheer up, according to my +name, for my name is not Pitiless, but Cheer-up; and I could not abide to +see Mansoul inclined to melancholy.’ + +_Clerk_. How! do you deny your name, and say it is not Pitiless, but +Cheer-up? Call for the witnesses. What say you, the witnesses, to this +plea? + +_Know_. My lord, his name is Pitiless; so he hath written himself in all +papers of concern wherein he has had to do. But these Diabolonians love +to counterfeit their names: Mr. Covetousness covers himself with the name +of Good-Husbandry, or the like; Mr. Pride can, when need is, call himself +Mr. Neat, Mr. Handsome, or the like; and so of all the rest of them. + +_Clerk_. Mr. Tell-True, what say you? + +_Tell_. His name is Pitiless, my lord. I have known him from a child, +and he hath done all that wickedness whereof he stands charged in the +indictment; but there is a company of them that are not acquainted with +the danger of damning, therefore they call all those melancholy that have +serious thoughts how that state should be shunned by them. + +_Clerk_. Set Mr. Haughty to the bar, gaoler. Mr. Haughty, thou art here +indicted by the name of Haughty, (an intruder upon the town of Mansoul,) +for that thou didst most traitorously and devilishly teach the town of +Mansoul to carry it loftily and stoutly against the summons that was +given them by the captains of the King Shaddai. Thou didst also teach +the town of Mansoul to speak contemptuously and vilifyingly of their +great King Shaddai; and didst moreover encourage, both by words and +examples, Mansoul, to take up arms both against the King and his son +Emmanuel. How sayest thou, art thou guilty of this indictment, or not? + +_Haughty_. Gentlemen, I have always been a man of courage and valour, +and have not used, when under the greatest clouds, to sneak or hang down +the head like a bulrush; nor did it at all at any time please me to see +men veil their bonnets to those that have opposed them; yea, though their +adversaries seemed to have ten times the advantage of them. I did not +use to consider who was my foe, nor what the cause was in which I was +engaged. It was enough to me if I carried it bravely, fought like a man, +and came off a victor. + +_Court_. Mr. Haughty, you are not here indicted for that you have been a +valiant man, nor for your courage and stoutness in times of distress, but +for that you have made use of this your pretended valour to draw the town +of Mansoul into acts of rebellion both against the great King, and +Emmanuel his Son. This is the crime and the thing wherewith thou art +charged in and by the indictment. + +But he made no answer to that. + +Now when the Court had thus far proceeded against the prisoners at the +bar, then they put them over to the verdict of their jury, to whom they +did apply themselves after this manner: + +‘Gentlemen of the jury, you have been here, and have seen these men; you +have heard their indictments, their pleas, and what the witnesses have +testified against them: now what remains, is, that you do forthwith +withdraw yourselves to some place, where without confusion you may +consider of what verdict, in a way of truth and righteousness, you ought +to bring in for the King against them, and so bring it in accordingly.’ + +Then the jury, to wit, Mr. Belief, Mr. True-Heart, Mr. Upright, Mr. +Hate-bad, Mr. Love-God, Mr. See-Truth, Mr. Heavenly-Mind, Mr. Moderate, +Mr. Thankful, Mr. Humble, Mr. Good-Work, and Mr. Zeal-for-God, withdrew +themselves in order to their work. Now when they were shut up by +themselves, they fell to discourse among themselves in order to the +drawing up of their verdict. + +And thus Mr. Belief (for he was the foreman) began: ‘Gentlemen,’ quoth +he, ‘for the men, the prisoners at the bar, for my part I believe that +they all deserve death.’ ‘Very right,’ said Mr. True-Heart; ‘I am wholly +of your opinion.’ ‘Oh what a mercy is it,’ said Mr. Hate-Bad, ‘that such +villains as these are apprehended!’ ‘Ay! ay!’ said Mr. Love-God, ‘this +is one of the joyfullest days that ever I saw in my life.’ Then said Mr. +See-Truth, ‘I know that if we judge them to death, our verdict shall +stand before Shaddai himself’ ‘Nor do I at all question it,’ said Mr. +Heavenly-Mind; he said, moreover, ‘When all such beasts as these are cast +out of Mansoul, what a goodly town will it be then!’ ‘Then,’ said Mr. +Moderate, ‘it is not my manner to pass my judgment with rashness; but for +these their crimes are so notorious, and the witness so palpable, that +that man must be wilfully blind who saith the prisoners ought not to +die.’ ‘Blessed be God,’ said Mr. Thankful, ‘that the traitors are in +safe custody.’ ‘And I join with you in this upon my bare knees,’ said +Mr. Humble. ‘I am glad also,’ said Mr. Good-Work. Then said the warm +man, and true-hearted Mr. Zeal-for-God, ‘Cut them off; they have been the +plague, and have sought the destruction of Mansoul.’ + +Thus, therefore, being all agreed in their verdict, they come instantly +into the Court. + +_Clerk_. Gentlemen of the jury, answer all to your names: Mr. Belief, +one; Mr. True-Heart, two; Mr. Upright, three; Mr. Hate-Bad, four; Mr. +Love-God, five; Mr. See-Truth, six; Mr. Heavenly-mind, seven; Mr. +Moderate, eight; Mr. Thankful, nine; Mr. Humble, ten; Mr. Good-Work, +eleven; and Mr. Zeal-for-God, twelve. Good men and true, stand together +in your verdict: are you all agreed? + +_Jury_. Yes, my lord. + +_Clerk_. Who shall speak for you? + +_Jury_. Our foreman. + +_Clerk_. You, the gentlemen of the jury, being empannelled for our Lord +the King, to serve here in a matter of life and death, have heard the +trials of each of these men, the prisoners at the bar: what say you? are +they guilty of that, and those crimes for which they stand here indicted, +or are they not guilty? + +_Foreman_. Guilty, my lord. + +_Clerk_. Look to your prisoners, gaoler. + +This was done in the morning, and in the afternoon they received the +sentence of death according to the law. + +The gaoler, therefore, having received such a charge, put them all in the +inward prison, to preserve them there till the day of execution, which +was to be the next day in the morning. + +But now to see how it happened, one of the prisoners, Incredulity by +name, in the interim betwixt the sentence and the time of execution, +brake prison and made his escape, and gets him away quite out of the town +of Mansoul, and lay lurking in such places and holes as he might, until +he should again have opportunity to do the town of Mansoul a mischief for +their thus handling of him as they did. + +Now when Mr. Trueman, the gaoler, perceived that he had lost his +prisoner, he was in a heavy taking, because that prisoner was, to speak +on, the very worst of all the gang: wherefore first he goes and acquaints +my Lord Mayor, Mr. Recorder, and my Lord Willbewill, with the matter, and +to get of them an order to make search for him throughout the town of +Mansoul. So an order he got, and search was made, but no such man could +now be found in all the town of Mansoul. + +All that could be gathered was, that he had lurked a while about the +outside of the town, and that here and there one or other had a glimpse +of him as he did make his escape out of Mansoul; one or two also did +affirm that they saw him without the town, going apace quite over the +plain. Now when he was quite gone, it was affirmed by one Mr. Did-see, +that he ranged all over dry places, till he met with Diabolus, his +friend, and where should they meet one another but just upon Hell-gate +hill. + +But oh! what a lamentable story did the old gentleman tell to Diabolus +concerning what sad alteration Emmanuel had made in Mansoul! + +As, first, how Mansoul had, after some delays, received a general pardon +at the hands of Emmanuel, and that they had invited him into the town, +and that they had given him the castle for his possession. He said, +moreover, that they had called his soldiers into the town, coveted who +should quarter the most of them; they also entertained him with the +timbrel, song, and dance. ‘But that,’ said Incredulity, ‘which is the +sorest vexation to me is, that he hath pulled down, O father, thy image, +and set up his own; pulled down thy officers and set up his own. Yea, +and Willbewill, that rebel, who, one would have thought, should never +have turned from us, he is now in as great favour with Emmanuel as ever +he was with thee. But, besides all this, this Willbewill has received a +special commission from his master to search for, to apprehend, and to +put to death all, and all manner of Diabolonians that he shall find in +Mansoul: yea, and this Willbewill has taken and committed to prison +already eight of my Lord’s most trusty friends in Mansoul. Nay, further, +my Lord, with grief I speak it, they have been all arraigned, condemned, +and, I doubt, before this executed in Mansoul. I told my Lord of eight, +and myself was the ninth, who should assuredly have drunk of the same +cup, but that through craft, I, as thou seest, have made mine escape from +them.’ + +When Diabolus had heard this lamentable story, he yelled and snuffed up +the wind like a dragon, and made the sky to look dark with his roaring; +he also sware that he would try to be revenged on Mansoul for this. So +they, both he and his old friend Incredulity, concluded to enter into +great consultation, how they might get the town of Mansoul again. + +Now, before this time, the day was come in which the prisoners in Mansoul +were to be executed. So they were brought to the cross, and that by +Mansoul, in most solemn manner; for the Prince said that this should be +done by the hand of the town of Mansoul, ‘that I may see,’ said he, ‘the +forwardness of my now redeemed Mansoul to keep my word, and to do my +commandments; and that I may bless Mansoul in doing this deed. Proof of +sincerity pleases me well; let Mansoul therefore first lay their hands +upon these Diabolonians to destroy them.’ + +So the town of Mansoul slew them, according to the word of their Prince; +but when the prisoners were brought to the cross to die, you can hardly +believe what troublesome work Mansoul had of it to put the Diabolonians +to death; for the men, knowing that they must die, and every of them +having implacable enmity in their hearts to Mansoul, what did they but +took courage at the cross, and there resisted the men of the town of +Mansoul? Wherefore the men of Mansoul were forced to cry out for help to +the captains and men of war. Now the great Shaddai had a secretary in +the town, and he was a great lover of the men of Mansoul, and he was at +the place of execution also; so he, hearing the men of Mansoul cry out +against the strugglings and unruliness of the prisoners, rose up from his +place, and came and put his hands upon the hands of the men of Mansoul. +So they crucified the Diabolonians that had been a plague, a grief, and +an offence to the town of Mansoul. + +Now, when this good work was done, the Prince came down to see, to visit, +and to speak comfortably to the men of Mansoul, and to strengthen their +hands in such work. And he said to them that, by this act of theirs he +had proved them, and found them to be lovers of his person, observers of +his laws, and such as had also respect to his honour. He said, moreover, +(to show them that they by this should not be losers, nor their town +weakened by the loss of them,) that he would make them another captain, +and that of one of themselves. And that this captain should be the ruler +of a thousand, for the good and benefit of the now flourishing town of +Mansoul. + +So he called one to him whose name was Waiting, and bid him, ‘Go quickly +up to the castle gate, and inquire there for one Mr. Experience, that +waiteth upon that noble captain, the Captain Credence, and bid him come +hither to me.’ So the messenger that waited upon the good Prince +Emmanuel went and said as he was commanded. Now the young gentleman was +waiting to see the captain train and muster his men in the castle yard. +Then said Mr. Waiting to him, ‘Sir, the Prince would that you should come +down to his highness forthwith.’ So he brought him down to Emmanuel, and +he came and made obeisance before him. Now the men of the town knew Mr. +Experience well, for he was born and bred in Mansoul; they also knew him +to be a man of conduct, of valour, and a person prudent in matters; he +was also a comely person, well-spoken, and very successful in his +undertakings. + +Wherefore the hearts of the townsmen were transported with joy when they +saw that the Prince himself was so taken with Mr. Experience, that he +would needs make him a captain over a band of men. + +So with one consent they bowed the knee before Emmanuel, and with a shout +said, ‘Let Emmanuel live for ever!’ Then said the Prince to the young +gentleman, whose name was Mr. Experience, ‘I have thought good to confer +upon thee a place of trust and honour in this my town of Mansoul.’ Then +the young man bowed his head and worshipped. ‘It is,’ said Emmanuel, +‘that thou shouldest be a captain, a captain over a thousand men in my +beloved town of Mansoul.’ Then said the captain, ‘Let the King live!’ +So the Prince gave out orders forthwith to the King’s secretary, that he +should draw up for Mr. Experience a commission to make him a captain over +a thousand men. ‘And let it be brought to me,’ said he, ‘that I may set +to my seal.’ So it was done as it was commanded. The commission was +drawn up, brought to Emmanuel, and he set his seal thereto. Then, by the +hand of Mr. Waiting, he sent it away to the captain. + +Now as soon as the captain had received his commission, he sounded his +trumpet for volunteers, and young men came to him apace; yea, the +greatest and chief men in the town sent their sons, to be listed under +his command. Thus Captain Experience came under command to Emmanuel, for +the good of the town of Mansoul. He had for his lieutenant one Mr. +Skilful, and for his cornet one Mr. Memory. His under officers I need +not name. His colours were the white colours for the town of Mansoul; +and his scutcheon was the dead lion and dead bear. So the Prince +returned to his royal palace again. + +Now when he was returned thither, the elders of the town of Mansoul, to +wit, the Lord Mayor, the Recorder, and the Lord Willbewill, went to +congratulate him, and in special way to thank him for his love, care, and +the tender compassion which he showed to his ever-obliged town of +Mansoul. So after a while, and some sweet communion between them, the +townsmen having solemnly ended their ceremony, returned to their place +again. + +Emmanuel also at this time appointed them a day wherein he would renew +their charter, yea, wherein he would renew and enlarge it, mending +several faults therein, that Mansoul’s yoke might be yet more easy. And +this he did without any desire of theirs, even of his own frankness and +noble mind. So when he had sent for and seen their old one, he laid it +by, and said, ‘Now that which decayeth and waxeth old is ready to vanish +away.’ He said, moreover, ‘The town of Mansoul shall have another, a +better, a new one, more steady and firm by far.’ An epitome hereof take +as follows:— + +‘Emmanuel, Prince of Peace, and a great lover of the town of Mansoul, I +do in the name of my Father, and of mine own clemency, give, grant, and +bequeath to my beloved town of Mansoul. + +‘First. Free, full, and everlasting forgiveness of all wrongs, injuries, +and offences done by them against my Father, me, their neighbour, or +themselves. + +‘Second. I do give them the holy law and my testament, with all that +therein is contained, for their everlasting comfort and consolation. + +‘Third. I do also give them a portion of the self-same grace and +goodness that dwells in my Father’s heart and mine. + +‘Fourth. I do give, grant, and bestow upon them freely, the world and +what is therein, for their good; and they shall have that power over +them, as shall stand with the honour of my Father, my glory, and their +comfort: yea, I grant them the benefits of life and death, and of things +present, and things to come. This privilege no other city, town, or +corporation, shall have, but my Mansoul only. + +‘Fifth. I do give and grant them leave, and free access to me in my +palace at all seasons—to my palace above or below—there to make known +their wants to me, and I give them, moreover, a promise that I will hear +and redress all their grievances. + +‘Sixth. I do give, grant to, and invest the town of Mansoul with full +power and authority to seek out, take, enslave, and destroy all, and all +manner of Diabolonians that at any time, from whencesoever, shall be +found straggling in or about the town of Mansoul. + +‘Seventh. I do further grant to my beloved town of Mansoul, that they +shall have authority not to suffer any foreigner, or stranger, or their +seed, to be free in, and of the blessed town of Mansoul, nor to share in +the excellent privileges thereof. But that all the grants, privileges, +and immunities that I bestow upon the famous town of Mansoul, shall be +for those the old natives, and true inhabitants thereof; to them, I say, +and to their right seed after them. + +‘But all Diabolonians, of what sort, birth, country, or kingdom soever, +shall be debarred a share therein.’ + +So when the town of Mansoul had received at the hand of Emmanuel their +gracious charter, (which in itself is infinitely more large than by this +lean epitome is set before you,) they carried it to audience, that is, to +the market place, and there Mr. Recorder read it in the presence of all +the people. This being done, it was had back to the castle gates, and +there fairly engraven upon the doors thereof, and laid in letters of +gold, to the end that the town of Mansoul, with all the people thereof, +might have it always in their view, or might go where they might see what +a blessed freedom their Prince had bestowed upon them, that their joy +might be increased in themselves, and their love renewed to their great +and good Emmanuel. + +But what joy, what comfort, what consolation, think you, did now possess +the hearts of the men of Mansoul! The bells rung, the minstrels played, +the people danced, the captains shouted, the colours waved in the wind, +and the silver trumpets sounded; and the Diabolonians now were glad to +hide their heads, for they looked like them that had been long dead. + +When this was over, the Prince sent again for the elders of the town of +Mansoul, and communed with them about a ministry that he intended to +establish among them; such a ministry that might open unto them, and that +might instruct them in the things that did concern their present and +future state. + +‘For,’ said he, ‘you, of yourselves, unless you have teachers and guides, +will not be able to know, and, if not to know, to be sure not to do the +will of my Father.’ + +At this news, when the elders of Mansoul brought it to the people, the +whole town came running together, (for it pleased them well, as whatever +the Prince now did pleased the people,) and all with one consent implored +his Majesty that he would forthwith establish such a ministry among them +as might teach them both law and judgment, statute and commandment; that +they might be documented in all good and wholesome things. So he told +them that he would grant them their requests, and would establish two +among them; one that was of his Father’s court, and one that was a native +of Mansoul. + +‘He that is from the court,’ said he, ‘is a person of no less quality and +dignity than my Father and I; and he is the Lord Chief Secretary of my +Father’s house: for he is, and always has been, the chief dictator of all +my Father’s laws, a person altogether well skilled in all mysteries, and +knowledge of mysteries, as is my Father, or as myself is. Indeed he is +one with us in nature, and also as to loving of, and being faithful to, +and in the eternal concerns of the town of Mansoul. + +‘And this is he,’ said the Prince, ‘that must be your chief teacher; for +it is he, and he only, that can teach you clearly in all high and +supernatural things. He, and he only, it is that knows the ways and +methods of my Father at court, nor can any like him show how the heart of +my Father is at all times, in all things, upon all occasions, towards +Mansoul; for as no man knows the things of a man but that spirit of a man +which is in him, so the things of my Father knows no man but this his +high and mighty Secretary. Nor can any, as he, tell Mansoul how and what +they shall do to keep themselves in the love of my Father. He also it is +that can bring lost things to your remembrance, and that can tell you +things to come. This teacher, therefore, must of necessity have the +pre-eminence, both in your affections and judgment, before your other +teacher; his personal dignity, the excellency of his teaching, also the +great dexterity that he hath to help you to make and draw up petitions to +my Father for your help, and to his pleasing, must lay obligations upon +you to love him, fear him, and to take heed that you grieve him not. + +‘This person can put life and vigour into all he says; yea, and can also +put it into your heart. This person can make seers of you, and can make +you tell what shall be hereafter. By this person you must frame all your +petitions to my Father and me; and without his advice and counsel first +obtained, let nothing enter into the town or castle of Mansoul, for that +may disgust and grieve this noble person. + +‘Take heed, I say, that you do not grieve this minister; for if you do, +he may fight against you; and should he once be moved by you to set +himself against you in battle array, that will distress you more than if +twelve legions should from my Father’s court be sent to make war upon +you. + +‘But, as I said, if you shall hearken unto him, and shall love him; if +you shall devote yourselves to his teaching, and shall seek to have +converse, and to maintain communion with him, you shall find him ten +times better than is the whole world to any; yea, he will shed abroad the +love of my Father in your hearts, and Mansoul will be the wisest, and +most blessed of all people.’ + +Then did the Prince call unto him the old gentleman, who before had been +the Recorder of Mansoul, Mr. Conscience by name, and told him, That, +forasmuch as he was well skilled in the law and government of the town of +Mansoul, and was also well-spoken, and could pertinently deliver to them +his Master’s will in all terrene and domestic matters, therefore he would +also make him a minister for, in, and to the goodly town of Mansoul, in +all the laws, statutes, and judgments of the famous town of Mansoul. +‘And thou must,’ said the Prince, ‘confine thyself to the teaching of +moral virtues, to civil and natural duties; but thou must not attempt to +presume to be a revealer of those high and supernatural mysteries that +are kept close in the bosom of Shaddai, my Father: for those things knows +no man, nor can any reveal them but my Father’s Secretary only. + +‘Thou art a native of the town of Mansoul, but the Lord Secretary is a +native with my Father; wherefore, as thou hast knowledge of the laws and +customs of the corporation, so he of the things and will of my Father. + +‘Wherefore, O Mr. Conscience, although I have made thee a minister and a +preacher to the town of Mansoul, yet as to the things which the Lord +Secretary knoweth, and shall teach to this people, there thou must be his +scholar and a learner, even as the rest of Mansoul are. + +‘Thou must therefore, in all high and supernatural things, go to him for +information and knowledge; for though there be a spirit in man, this +person’s inspiration must give him understanding. Wherefore, O thou Mr. +Recorder, keep low and be humble, and remember that the Diabolonians that +kept not their first charge, but left their own standing, are now made +prisoners in the pit. Be therefore content with thy station. + +‘I have made thee my Father’s vicegerent on earth, in such things of +which I have made mention before: and thou, take thou power to teach them +to Mansoul, yea, and to impose them with whips and chastisements, if they +shall not willingly hearken to do thy commandments. + +‘And, Mr. Recorder, because thou art old, and through many abuses made +feeble; therefore I give thee leave and license to go when thou wilt to +my fountain, my conduit, and there to drink freely of the blood of my +grape, for my conduit doth always run wine. Thus doing, thou shalt drive +from thine heart and stomach all foul, gross, and hurtful humours. It +will also lighten thine eyes, and will strengthen thy memory for the +reception and keeping of all that the King’s most noble Secretary +teacheth.’ + +When the Prince had thus put Mr. Recorder (that once so was) into the +place and office of a minister to Mansoul, and the man had thankfully +accepted thereof, then did Emmanuel address himself in a particular +speech to the townsmen themselves. + +‘Behold,’ said the Prince to Mansoul, ‘my love and care towards you; I +have added to all that is past, this mercy, to appoint you preachers; the +most noble Secretary to teach you in all high and sublime mysteries; and +this gentleman,’ pointing to Mr. Conscience, ‘is to teach you in all +things human and domestic, for therein lieth his work. He is not, by +what I have said, debarred of telling to Mansoul anything that he hath +heard and received at the mouth of the lord high Secretary; only he shall +not attempt to presume to pretend to be a revealer of those high +mysteries himself; for the breaking of them up, and the discovery of them +to Mansoul lieth only in the power, authority, and skill of the lord high +Secretary himself. Talk of them he may, and so may the rest of the town +of Mansoul; yea, and may, as occasion gives them opportunity, press them +upon each other for the benefit of the whole. These things, therefore, I +would have you observe and do, for it is for your life, and the +lengthening of your days. + +‘And one thing more to my beloved Mr. Recorder, and to all the town of +Mansoul: You must not dwell in, nor stay upon, anything of that which he +hath in commission to teach you, as to your trust and expectation of the +next world; (of the next world, I say, for I purpose to give another to +Mansoul, when this with them is worn out;) but for that you must wholly +and solely have recourse to, and make stay upon his doctrine that is your +Teacher after the first order. Yea, Mr. Recorder himself must not look +for life from that which he himself revealeth; his dependence for that +must be founded in the doctrine of the other preacher. Let Mr. Recorder +also take heed that he receive not any doctrine, or point of doctrine, +that is not communicated to him by his Superior Teacher, nor yet within +the precincts of his own formal knowledge.’ + +Now, after the Prince had thus settled things in the famous town of +Mansoul, he proceeded to give to the elders of the corporation a +necessary caution, to wit, how they should carry it to the high and noble +captains that he had, from his Father’s court, sent or brought with him, +to the famous town of Mansoul. + +‘These captains,’ said he, ‘do love the town of Mansoul, and they are +picked men, picked out of abundance, as men that best suit, and that will +most faithfully serve in the wars of Shaddai against the Diabolonians, +for the preservation of the town of Mansoul. ‘I charge you therefore,’ +said he, ‘O ye inhabitants of the now flourishing town of Mansoul, that +you carry it not ruggedly or untowardly to my captains, or their men; +since, as I said, they are picked and choice men—men chosen out of many +for the good of the town of Mansoul. I say, I charge you, that you carry +it not untowardly to them: for though they have the hearts and faces of +lions, when at any time they shall be called forth to engage and fight +with the King’s foes, and the enemies of the town of Mansoul; yet a +little discountenance cast upon them from the town of Mansoul will deject +and cast down their faces, will weaken and take away their courage. Do +not, therefore, O my beloved, carry it unkindly to my valiant captains +and courageous men of war, but love them, nourish them, succour them, and +lay them in your bosoms; and they will not only fight for you, but cause +to fly from you all those the Diabolonians that seek, and will, if +possible, be, your utter destruction. + +‘If, therefore, any of them should at any time be sick or weak, and so +not able to perform that office of love, which, with all their hearts, +they are willing to do (and will do also when well and in health), slight +them not, nor despise them, but rather strengthen them and encourage +them, though weak and ready to die, for they are your fence, and your +guard, your wall, your gates, your locks, and your bars. And although, +when they are weak, they can do but little, but rather need to be helped +by you, than that you should then expect great things from them, yet, +when well, you know what exploits, what feats and warlike achievements +they are able to do, and will perform for you. + +‘Besides, if they be weak, the town of Mansoul cannot be strong; if they +be strong, then Mansoul cannot be weak; your safety, therefore, doth lie +in their health, and in your countenancing them. Remember, also, that if +they be sick, they catch that disease of the town of Mansoul itself. + +‘These things I have said unto you because I love your welfare and your +honour: observe, therefore, O my Mansoul, to be punctual in all things +that I have given in charge unto you, and that not only as a town +corporate, and so to your officers and guard, and guides in chief, but to +you as you are a people whose well-being, as single persons, depends on +the observation of the orders and commandments of their Lord. + +‘Next, O my Mansoul, I do warn you of that, of which, notwithstanding +that reformation that at present is wrought among you, you have need to +be warned about: wherefore hearken diligently unto me. I am now sure, +and you will know hereafter, that there are yet of the Diabolonians +remaining in the town of Mansoul, Diabolonians that are sturdy and +implacable, and that do already while I am with you, and that will yet +more when I am from you, study, plot, contrive, invent, and jointly +attempt to bring you to desolation, and so to a state far worse than that +of the Egyptian bondage; they are the avowed friends of Diabolus, +therefore look about you. They used heretofore to lodge with their +Prince in the Castle, when Incredulity was the Lord Mayor of this town; +but since my coming hither, they lie more in the outsides and walls, and +have made themselves dens, and caves, and holes, and strongholds therein. +Wherefore, O Mansoul! thy work, as to this, will be so much the more +difficult and hard; that is, to take, mortify, and put them to death +according to the will of my Father. Nor can you utterly rid yourselves +of them, unless you should pull down the walls of your town, the which I +am by no means willing you should. Do you ask me, What shall we do then? +Why, be you diligent, and quit you like men; observe their holes; find +out their haunts; assault them, and make no peace with them. Wherever +they haunt, lurk, or abide, and what terms of peace soever they offer +you, abhor, and all shall be well betwixt you and me. And that you may +the better know them from those that are the natives of Mansoul, I will +give you this brief schedule of the names of the chief of them; and they +are these that follow:—The Lord Fornication, the Lord Adultery, the Lord +Murder, the Lord Anger, the Lord Lasciviousness, the Lord Deceit, the +Lord Evil-Eye, Mr. Drunkenness, Mr. Revelling, Mr. Idolatry, Mr. +Witch-craft, Mr. Variance, Mr. Emulation, Mr. Wrath, Mr. Strife, Mr. +Sedition, and Mr. Heresy. These are some of the chief, O Mansoul! of +those that will seek to overthrow thee for ever. These, I say, are the +skulkers in Mansoul; but look thou well into the law of thy King, and +there thou shalt find their physiognomy, and such other characteristical +notes of them, by which they certainly may be known. + +‘These, O my Mansoul, (and I would gladly that you should certainly know +it,) if they be suffered to run and range about the town as they would, +will quickly, like vipers, eat out your bowels; yea, poison your +captains, cut the sinews of your soldiers, break the bars and bolts of +your gates, and turn your now most flourishing Mansoul into a barren and +desolate wilderness, and ruinous heap. Wherefore, that you may take +courage to yourselves to apprehend these villains wherever you find them, +I give to you, my Lord Mayor, my Lord Willbewill, and Mr. Recorder, with +all the inhabitants of the town of Mansoul, full power and commission to +seek out, to take, and to cause to be put to death by the cross, all, and +all manner of Diabolonians, when and wherever you shall find them to lurk +within, or to range without the walls of the town of Mansoul. + +‘I told you before that I had placed a standing ministry among you; not +that you have but these with you, for my first four captains who came +against the master and lord of the Diabolonians that was in Mansoul, they +can, and if need be, and if they be required, will not only privately +inform, but publicly preach to the corporation both good and wholesome +doctrine, and such as shall lead you in the way. Yea, they will set up a +weekly, yea, if need be, a daily lecture in thee, O Mansoul! and will +instruct thee in such profitable lessons, that, if heeded, will do thee +good at the end. And take good heed that you spare not the men that you +have a commission to take and crucify. + +‘Now, as I have set before your eyes the vagrants and runagates by name, +so I will tell you, that among yourselves, some of them shall creep in to +beguile you, even such as would seem, and that in appearance are, very +rife and hot for religion. And they, if you watch not, will do you a +mischief, such an one as at present you cannot think of. + +‘These, as I said, will show themselves to you in another hue than those +under description before. Wherefore, Mansoul, watch and be sober, and +suffer not thyself to be betrayed.’ + +When the Prince had thus far new modelled the town of Mansoul, and had +instructed them in such matters as were profitable for them to know, then +he appointed another day in which he intended, when the townsfolk came +together, to bestow a further badge of honour upon the town of Mansoul,—a +badge that should distinguish them from all the people, kindreds, and +tongues that dwell in the kingdom of Universe. Now it was not long +before the day appointed was come, and the Prince and his people met in +the King’s palace, where first Emmanuel made a short speech unto them, +and then did for them as he had said, and unto them as he had promised. + +‘My Mansoul,’ said he, ‘that which I now am about to do, is to make you +known to the world to be mine, and to distinguish you also in your own +eyes, from all false traitors that may creep in among you.’ + +Then he commanded that those that waited upon him should go and bring +forth out of his treasury those white and glistening robes ‘that I,’ said +he, ‘have provided and laid up in store for my Mansoul.’ So the white +garments were fetched out of his treasury, and laid forth to the eyes of +the people. Moreover, it was granted to them that they should take them +and put them on, ‘according,’ said he, ‘to your size and stature.’ So +the people were put into white, into fine linen, white and clean. + +Then said the Prince unto them, ‘This, O Mansoul, is my livery, and the +badge by which mine are known from the servants of others. Yea, it is +that which I grant to all that are mine, and without which no man is +permitted to see my face. Wear them, therefore, for my sake, who gave +them unto you; and also if you would be known by the world to be mine.’ + +But now! can you think how Mansoul shone? It was fair as the sun, clear +as the moon, and terrible as an army with banners. + +The Prince added further, and said, ‘No prince, potentate, or mighty one +of Universe, giveth this livery but myself: behold, therefore, as I said +before, you shall be known by it to be mine. + +‘And now,’ said he, ‘I have given you my livery, let me give you also in +commandment concerning them; and be sure that you take good heed to my +words. + +‘First. Wear them daily, day by day, lest you should at sometimes appear +to others as if you were none of mine. + +‘Second. Keep them always white; for if they be soiled, it is dishonour +to me. + +‘Third. Wherefore gird them up from the ground, and let them not lag +with dust and dirt. + +‘Fourth. Take heed that you lose them not, lest you walk naked, and they +see your shame. + +‘Fifth. But if you should sully them, if you should defile them, the +which I am greatly unwilling you should, and the prince Diabolus will be +glad if you would, then speed you to do that which is written in my law, +that yet you may stand, and befall before me, and before my throne. +Also, this is the way to cause that I may not leave you, nor forsake you +while here, but may dwell in this town of Mansoul for ever.’ + +And now was Mansoul, and the inhabitants of it, as the signet upon +Emmanuel’s right hand. Where was there now a town, a city, a +corporation, that could compare with Mansoul! a town redeemed from the +hand, and from the power of Diabolus! a town that the King Shaddai loved, +and that he sent Emmanuel to regain from the Prince of the infernal cave; +yea, a town that Emmanuel loved to dwell in, and that he chose for his +royal habitation; a town that he fortified for himself, and made strong +by the force of his army. What shall I say, Mansoul has now a most +excellent Prince, golden captains and men of war, weapons proved, and +garments as white as snow. Nor are these benefits to be counted little, +but great; can the town of Mansoul esteem them so, and improve them to +that end and purpose for which they are bestowed upon them? + +When the Prince had thus completed the modelling of the town, to show +that he had great delight in the work of his hands and took pleasure in +the good that he had wrought for the famous and flourishing Mansoul, he +commanded, and they set his standard upon the battlements of the castle. +And then, + +First. He gave them frequent visits; not a day now but the elders of +Mansoul must come to him, or he to them, into his palace. Now they must +walk and talk together of all the great things that he had done, and yet +further promised to do, for the town of Mansoul. Thus would he often do +with the Lord Mayor, my Lord Willbewill, and the honest subordinate +preacher Mr. Conscience, and Mr. Recorder. But oh, how graciously, how +lovingly, how courteously, and tenderly did this blessed Prince now carry +it towards the town of Mansoul! In all the streets, gardens, orchards, +and other places where he came, to be sure the poor should have his +blessing and benediction; yea, he would kiss them, and if they were ill +he would lay hands on them, and make them well. The captains, also, he +would daily, yea, sometimes hourly, encourage with his presence and +goodly words. For you must know that a smile from him upon them would +put more vigour, more life, and stoutness into them, than would anything +else under heaven. + +The Prince would now also feast them, and be with them continually: +hardly a week would pass but a banquet must be had betwixt him and them. +You may remember that, some pages before, we make mention of one feast +that they had together; but now to feast them was a thing more common: +every day with Mansoul was a feast-day now. Nor did he, when they +returned to their places, send them empty away, either they must have a +ring, a gold chain, a bracelet, a white stone, or something; so dear was +Mansoul to him now; so lovely was Mansoul in his eyes. + +Second. When the elders and townsmen did not come to him, he would send +in much plenty of provision unto them; meat that came from court, wine +and bread that were prepared for his Father’s table; yea, such delicates +would he send unto them, and therewith would so cover their table, that +whoever saw it confessed that the like could not be seen in any kingdom. + +Third. If Mansoul did not frequently visit him as he desired they +should, he would walk out to them, knock at their doors, and desire +entrance, that amity might be maintained betwixt them and him; if they +did hear and open to him, as commonly they would, if they were at home, +then would he renew his former love, and confirm it too with some new +tokens, and signs of continued favour. + +And was it not now amazing to behold, that in that very place where +sometimes Diabolus had his abode, and entertained his Diabolonians to the +almost utter destruction of Mansoul, the Prince of princes should sit +eating and drinking with them, while all his mighty captains, men of war, +trumpeters, with the singing-men and singing-women of his Father, stood +round about to wait upon them! Now did Mansoul’s cup run over, now did +her conduits run sweet wine, now did she eat the finest of the wheat, and +drink milk and honey out of the rock! Now, she said, How great is his +goodness! for since I found favour in his eyes, how honourable have I +been! + +The blessed Prince did also ordain a new officer in the town, and a +goodly person he was; his name was Mr. God’s-Peace: this man was set over +my Lord Willbewill, my Lord Mayor, Mr. Recorder, the subordinate +preacher, Mr. Mind, and over all the natives of the town of Mansoul. +Himself was not a native of it, but came with the Prince Emmanuel from +the court. He was a great acquaintance of Captain Credence and Captain +Good-Hope; some say they were kin, and I am of that opinion too. This +man, as I said, was made governor of the town in general, especially over +the castle, and Captain Credence was to help him there. And I made great +observation of it, that so long as all things went in Mansoul as this +sweet-natured gentleman would, the town was in most happy condition. Now +there were no jars, no chiding, no interferings, no unfaithful doings in +all the town of Mansoul; every man in Mansoul kept close to his own +employment. The gentry, the officers, the soldiers, and all in place +observed their order. And as for the women and children of the town, +they followed their business joyfully; they would work and sing, work and +sing, from morning till night: so that quite through the town of Mansoul +now nothing was to be found but harmony, quietness, joy, and health. And +this lasted all that summer. + +But there was a man in the town of Mansoul, and his name was Mr. +Carnal-Security; this man did, after all this mercy bestowed on this +corporation, bring the town of Mansoul into great and grievous slavery +and bondage. A brief account of him and of his doings take as +followeth:— + +When Diabolus at first took possession of the town of Mansoul, he brought +thither, with himself, a great number of Diabolonians, men of his own +conditions. Now among these there was one whose name was Mr. +Self-Conceit, and a notable brisk man he was, as any that in those days +did possess the town of Mansoul. Diabolus, then, perceiving this man to +be active and bold, sent him upon many desperate designs, the which he +managed better, and more to the pleasing of his lord, than most that came +with him from the dens could do. Wherefore, finding him so fit for his +purpose, he preferred him, and made him next to the great Lord +Willbewill, of whom we have written so much before. Now the Lord +Willbewill being in those days very well pleased with him, and with his +achievements, gave him his daughter, the Lady Fear-Nothing, to wife. +Now, of my Lady Fear-nothing, did this Mr. Self-Conceit beget this +gentleman, Mr. Carnal-Security. Wherefore, there being then in Mansoul +those strange kinds of mixtures, it was hard for them, in some cases, to +find out who were natives, who not, for Mr. Carnal-Security sprang from +my Lord Willbewill by mother’s side, though he had for his father a +Diabolonian by nature. + +Well, this Carnal-Security took much after his father and mother; he was +self-conceited, he feared nothing, he was also a very busy man: nothing +of news, nothing of doctrine, nothing of alteration, or talk of +alteration, could at any time be on foot in Mansoul, but be sure Mr. +Carnal-Security would be at the head or tail of it: but, to be sure, he +would decline those that he deemed the weakest, and stood always with +them in his way of standing, that he supposed was the strongest side. + +Now, when Shaddai the mighty, and Emmanuel his Son, made war upon +Mansoul, to take it, this Mr. Carnal-Security was then in town, and was a +great doer among the people, encouraging them in their rebellion, putting +them upon hardening themselves in their resisting the King’s forces: but +when he saw that the town of Mansoul was taken, and converted to the use +of the glorious Prince Emmanuel; and when he also saw what was become of +Diabolus, and how he was unroosted, and made to quit the castle in the +greatest contempt and scorn; and that the town of Mansoul was well lined +with captains, engines of war, and men, and also provision; what doth he +but slyly wheel about also; and as he had served Diabolus against the +good Prince, so he feigned that he would serve the Prince against his +foes. + +And having got some little smattering of Emmanuel’s things by the end, +being bold, he ventures himself into the company of the townsmen, any +attempts also to chat among them. Now he knew that the power and +strength of the town of Mansoul was great, and that it could not but be +pleasing to the people, if he cried up their might and their glory. +Wherefore he beginneth his tale with the power and strength of Mansoul, +and affirmed that it was impregnable; now magnifying their captains and +their slings, and their rams; then crying up their fortifications and +strongholds; and, lastly, the assurances that they had from their Prince, +that Mansoul should be happy for ever. But when he saw that some of the +men of the town were tickled and taken with his discourse, he makes it +his business, and walking from street to street, house to house, and man +to man, he at last brought Mansoul to dance after his pipe, and to grow +almost as carnally secure as himself; so from talking they went to +feasting, and from feasting to sporting; and so to some other matters. +Now Emmanuel was yet in the town of Mansoul, and he wisely observed their +doings. My Lord Mayor, my Lord Willbewill, and Mr. Recorder were also +all taken with the words of this tattling Diabolonian gentleman, +forgetting that their Prince had given them warning before to take heed +that they were not beguiled with any Diabolonian sleight; he had further +told them that the security of the now flourishing town of Mansoul did +not so much lie in her present fortifications and force, as in her so +using of what she had, as might oblige her Emmanuel to abide within her +castle. For the right doctrine of Emmanuel was, that the town of Mansoul +should take heed that they forgot not his Father’s love and his; also, +that they should so demean themselves as to continue to keep themselves +therein. Now this was not the way to do it, namely, to fall in love with +one of the Diabolonians, and with such an one too as Mr. Carnal-Security +was, and to be led up and down by the nose by him; they should have heard +their Prince, feared their Prince, loved their Prince, and have stoned +this naughty pack to death, and took care to have walked in the ways of +their Prince’s prescribing: for then should their peace have been as a +river, when their righteousness had been like the waves of the sea. + +Now when Emmanuel perceived that through the policy of Mr. +Carnal-Security the hearts of the men of Mansoul were chilled and abated +in their practical love to him, + +First. He bemoans them, and, condoles their state with the Secretary, +saying, ‘Oh that my people had hearkened unto me, and that Mansoul had +walked in my ways! I would have fed them with the finest of the wheat; +and with honey out of the rock would I have sustained them.’ This done, +he said in his heart, ‘I will return to the court, and go to my place, +till Mansoul shall consider and acknowledge their offence.’ And he did +so, and the cause and manner of his going away from them was, that +Mansoul declined him, as is manifest in these particulars. + +‘1. They left off their former way of visiting him, they came not to his +royal palace as afore. + +‘2. They did not regard, nor yet take notice, that he came or came not to +visit them. + +‘3. The love-feasts that had wont to be between their Prince and them, +though he made them still, and called them to them, yet they neglected to +come to them, or to be delighted with them. + +‘4. They waited not for his counsels, but began to be headstrong and +confident in themselves, concluding that now they were strong and +invincible, and that Mansoul was secure, and beyond all reach of the foe, +and that her state must needs be unalterable for ever.’ + +Now, as was said, Emmanuel perceiving that by the craft of Mr. +Carnal-Security, the town of Mansoul was taken off from their dependence +upon him, and upon his Father by him, and set upon what by them was +bestowed upon it; he first, as I said, bemoaned their state, then he used +means to make them understand that the way that they went on in was +dangerous: for he sent my Lord High Secretary to them, to forbid them +such ways; but twice when he came to them, he found them at dinner in Mr. +Carnal-Security’s parlour; and perceiving also that they were not willing +to reason about matters concerning their good, he took grief and went his +way; the which when he had told to the Prince Emmanuel, he took offence, +and was grieved also, and so made provision to return to his Father’s +court. + +Now, the methods of his withdrawing, as I was saying before, were thus:— + +‘1. Even while he was yet with them in Mansoul, he kept himself close, +and more retired than formerly. + +‘2. His speech was not now, if he came in their company, so pleasant and +familiar as formerly. + +‘3. Nor did he, as in times past, send to Mansoul, from his table, those +dainty bits which he was wont to do. + +‘4. Nor when they came to visit him, as now and then they would, would he +be so easily spoken with as they found him to be in times past. They +might now knock once, yea, twice, but he would seem not at all to regard +them; whereas formerly at the sound of their feet he would up and run, +and meet them halfway, and take them too, and lay them in his bosom.’ + +But thus Emmanuel carried it now, and by this his carriage he sought to +make them bethink themselves, and return to him. But, alas! they did not +consider, they did not know his ways, they regarded not, they were not +touched with these, nor with the true remembrance of former favours. +Wherefore what does he but in private manner withdraw himself, first from +his palace, then to the gate of the town, and so away from Mansoul he +goes, till they should acknowledge their offence, and more earnestly seek +his face. Mr. God’s-Peace also laid down his commission, and would for +the present act no longer in the town of Mansoul. + +Thus they walked contrary to him, and he again, by way of retaliation, +walked contrary to them. But, alas! by this time they were so hardened +in their way, and had so drunk in the doctrine of Mr. Carnal-Security, +that the departing of their Prince touched them not, nor was he +remembered by them when gone; and so, of consequence, his absence not +condoled by them. + +Now, there was a day wherein this old gentleman, Mr. Carnal-Security, did +again make a feast for the town of Mansoul; and there was at that time in +the town one Mr. Godly-Fear, one now but little set by, though formerly +one of great request. This man, old Carnal-Security, had a mind, if +possible, to gull, and debauch, and abuse, as he did the rest, and +therefore he now bids him to the feast with his neighbours. So the day +being come, they prepare, and he goes and appears with the rest of the +guests; and being all set at the table, they did eat and drink, and were +merry, even all but this one man: for Mr. Godly-Fear sat like a stranger, +and did neither eat nor was merry. The which, when Mr. Carnal-Security +perceived, he presently addressed himself in a speech thus to him:— + +‘Mr. Godly-Fear, are you not well? You seem to be ill of body or mind, +or both. I have a cordial of Mr. Forget-Good’s making, the which, sir, +if you will take a dram of, I hope it may make you bonny and blithe, and +so make you more fit for us, feasting companions.’ + +Unto whom the good old gentleman discreetly replied, ‘Sir, I thank you +for all things courteous and civil; but for your cordial I have no list +thereto. But a word to the natives of Mansoul: You, the elders and chief +of Mansoul, to me it is strange to see you so jocund and merry, when the +town of Mansoul is in such woeful case.’ + +Then said Mr. Carnal-Security, ‘You want sleep, good air, I doubt. If +you please, lie down, and take a nap, and we meanwhile will be merry.’ + +Then said the good man as follows: ‘Sir, if you were not destitute of an +honest heart, you could not do as you have done and do.’ + +Then said Mr. Carnal-Security, ‘Why?’ + +_Godly_. Nay, pray interrupt me not. It is true the town of Mansoul was +strong, and, with a _proviso_, impregnable; but you, the townsmen, have +weakened it, and it now lies obnoxious to its foes. Nor is it a time to +flatter, or be silent; it is you, Mr. Carnal-Security, that have wilily +stripped Mansoul, and driven her glory from her; you have pulled down her +towers, you have broken down her gates, you have spoiled her locks and +bars. + +And now, to explain myself: from that time that my lords of Mansoul, and +you, sir, grew so great, from that time the Strength of Mansoul has been +offended, and now he is arisen and is gone. If any shall question the +truth of my words, I will answer him by this, and suchlike questions. +‘Where is the Prince Emmanuel? When did a man or woman in Mansoul see +him? When did you hear from him, or taste any of his dainty bits?’ You +are now a feasting with this Diabolonian monster, but he is not your +Prince. I say, therefore, though enemies from without, had you taken +heed, could not have made a prey of you, yet since you have sinned +against your Prince, your enemies within have been too hard for you. + +Then said Mr. Carnal-Security, ‘Fie! fie! Mr. Godly-Fear, fie!—will you +never shake off your _timorousness_? Are you afraid of being +sparrow-blasted? Who hath hurt you? Behold, I am on your side; only you +are for doubting, and I am for being confident. Besides, is this a time +to be sad in? A feast is made for mirth; why, then, do you now, to your +shame, and our trouble, break out into such passionate melancholy +language, when you should eat and drink, and be merry?’ + +Then said Mr. Godly-Fear again, ‘I may well be sad, for Emmanuel is gone +from Mansoul. I say again, he is gone, and you, sir, are the man that +has driven him away; yea, he is gone without so much as acquainting the +nobles of Mansoul with his going; and if that is not a sign of his anger, +I am not acquainted with the methods of godliness. + +‘And now, my lords and gentlemen, for my speech is still to you, your +gradual declining from him did provoke him gradually to depart from you, +the which he did for some time, if perhaps you would have been made +sensible thereby, and have been renewed by humbling yourselves; but when +he saw that none would regard, nor lay these fearful beginnings of his +anger and judgment to heart, he went away from this place; and this I saw +with mine eye. Wherefore now, while you boast, your strength is gone; +you are like the man that had lost his locks that before did wave about +his shoulders. You may, with this lord of your feast, shake yourselves, +and conclude to do as at other times; but since without him you can do +nothing, and he is departed from you, turn your feast into a sigh, and +your mirth into lamentation.’ + +Then the subordinate preacher, old Mr. Conscience by name, he that of old +was Recorder of Mansoul, being startled at what was said, began to second +it thus:— + +‘Indeed, my brethren,’ quoth he, ‘I fear that Mr. Godly-Fear tells us +true: I, for my part, have not seen my Prince a long season. I cannot +remember the day, for my part; nor can I answer Mr. Godly-Fear’s +question. I doubt, I am afraid that all is nought with Mansoul.’ + +_Godly_. Nay, I know that you shall not find him in Mansoul, for he is +departed and gone; yea, and gone for the faults of the elders, and for +that they rewarded his grace with unsufferable unkindness. + +Then did the subordinate preacher look as if he would fall down dead at +the table; also all there present, except the man of the house, began to +look pale and wan. But having a little recovered themselves, and jointly +agreeing to believe Mr. Godly-Fear and his sayings, they began to consult +what was best to be done, (now Mr. Carnal-Security was gone into his +withdrawing-room, for he liked not such dumpish doings,) both to the man +of the house for drawing them into evil, and also to recover Emmanuel’s +love. + +And, with that, that saying of their Prince came very hot into their +minds, which he had bidden them do to such as were false prophets that +should arise to delude the town of Mansoul. So they took Mr. +Carnal-Security (concluding that he must be he) and burned his house upon +him with fire; for he also was a Diabolonian by nature. + +So when this was passed and over, they bespeed themselves to look for +Emmanuel their Prince; and they sought him, but they found him not. Then +were they more confirmed in the truth of Mr. Godly-Fear’s sayings, and +began also severely to reflect upon themselves for their so vile and +ungodly doings; for they concluded now that it was through them that +their Prince had left them. + +Then they agreed and went to my Lord Secretary, (him whom before they +refused to hear—him whom they had grieved with their doings,) to know of +him, for he was a seer, and could tell where Emmanuel was, and how they +might direct a petition to him. But the Lord Secretary would not admit +them to a conference about this matter, nor would admit them to his royal +place of abode, nor come out to them to show them his face or +intelligence. + +And now was it a day gloomy and dark, a day of clouds and of thick +darkness with Mansoul. Now they saw that they had been foolish, and +began to perceive what the company and prattle of Mr. Carnal-Security had +done, and what desperate damage his swaggering words had brought poor +Mansoul into. But what further it was likely to cost them they were +ignorant of. Now Mr. Godly-Fear began again to be in repute with the men +of the town; yea, they were ready to look upon him as a prophet. + +Well, when the Sabbath day was come, they went to hear their subordinate +preacher; but oh, how he did thunder and lighten this day! His text was +that in the prophet Jonah: ‘They that observe lying vanities forsake +their own mercy.’ But there was then such power and authority in that +sermon, and such a dejection seen in the countenances of the people that +day, that the like hath seldom been heard or seen. The people, when +sermon was done, were scarce able to go to their homes, or to betake +themselves to their employs the week after; they were so sermon-smitten, +and also so sermon-sick by being smitten, that they knew not what to do. + +He did not only show to Mansoul their sin, but did tremble before them, +under the sense of his own, still crying out of himself, as he preached +to them, ‘Unhappy man that I am! that I should do so wicked a thing! +That I, a preacher! whom the Prince did set up to teach to Mansoul his +law, should myself live senseless and sottishly here, and be one of the +first found in transgression! This transgression also fell within my +precincts; I should have cried out against the wickedness; but I let +Mansoul lie wallowing in it, until it had driven Emmanuel from its +borders!’ With these things he also charged all the lords and gentry of +Mansoul, to the almost distracting of them. + +About this time, also, there was a great sickness in the town of Mansoul, +and most of the inhabitants were greatly afflicted. Yea, the captains +also, and men of war, were brought thereby to a languishing condition, +and that for a long time together; so that in case of an invasion, +nothing could to purpose now have been done, either by the townsmen or +field officers. Oh, how many pale faces, weak hands, feeble knees, and +staggering men were now seen to walk the streets of Mansoul! Here were +groans, there pants, and yonder lay those that were ready to faint. + +The garments, too, which Emmanuel had given them were but in a sorry +case; some were rent, some were torn, and all in a nasty condition; some +also did hang so loosely upon them, that the next bush they came at was +ready to pluck them off. + +After some time spent in this sad and desolate condition, the subordinate +preacher called for a day of fasting, and to humble themselves for being +so wicked against the great Shaddai and his Son. And he desired that +Captain Boanerges would preach. So he consented to do it; and the day +being come, and his text was this, ‘Cut it down, why cumbereth it the +ground?’ And a very smart sermon he made upon the place. First, he +showed what was the occasion of the words, namely, because the fig-tree +was barren; then he showed what was contained in the sentence, namely, +repentance, or utter desolation. He then showed, also, by whose +authority this sentence was pronounced, and that was by Shaddai himself. +And, lastly, he showed the reasons of the point, and then concluded his +sermon. But he was very pertinent in the application, insomuch that he +made poor Mansoul tremble. For this sermon, as well as the former, +wrought much upon the hearts of the men of Mansoul; yea, it greatly +helped to keep awake those that were roused by the preaching that went +before. So that now throughout the whole town, there was little or +nothing to be heard or seen but sorrow, and mourning, and woe. + +Now, after sermon, they got together and consulted what was best to be +done. ‘But,’ said the subordinate preacher, ‘I will do nothing of mine +own head, without advising with my neighbour Mr. Godly-Fear. For if he +had aforehand understood more of the mind of our Prince than we, I do not +know but he also may have it now, even now we are turning again to +virtue.’ + +So they called and sent for Mr. Godly-Fear, and he forthwith appeared. +Then they desired that he would further show his opinion about what they +had best to do. Then said the old gentleman as followeth: ‘It is my +opinion that this town of Mansoul should, in this day of her distress, +draw up and send an humble petition to their offended Prince Emmanuel, +that he, in his favour and grace, will turn again unto you, and not keep +anger for ever.’ + +When the townsmen had heard this speech, they did, with one consent, +agree to his advice; so they did presently draw up their request, and the +next was, But who shall carry it? At last they did all agree to send it +by my Lord Mayor. So he accepted of the service, and addressed himself +to his journey; and went and came to the court of Shaddai, whither +Emmanuel the Prince of Mansoul was gone. But the gate was shut, and a +strict watch kept thereat; so that the petitioner was forced to stand +without for a great while together. Then he desired that some would go +into the Prince and tell him who stood at the gate, and what his business +was. So one went and told to Shaddai, and to Emmanuel his Son, that the +Lord Mayor of the town of Mansoul stood without at the gate of the King’s +court, desiring to be admitted into the presence of the Prince, the +King’s Son. He also told what was the Lord Mayor’s errand, both to the +King and his Son Emmanuel. But the Prince would not come down, nor admit +that the gate should be opened to him, but sent him an answer to this +effect: ‘They have turned their back unto me, and not their face; but now +in the time of their trouble they say to me, Arise, and save us. But can +they not now go to Mr. Carnal-Security, to whom they went when they +turned from me, and make him their leader, their lord, and their +protection now in their trouble; why now in their trouble do they visit +me, since in their prosperity they went astray?’ + +The answer made my Lord Mayor look black in the face; it troubled, it +perplexed, it rent him sore. And now he began again to see what it was +to be familiar with Diabolonians, such as Mr. Carnal-Security was. When +he saw that at court, as yet, there was little help to be expected, +either for himself or friends in Mansoul, he smote upon his breast, and +returned weeping, and all the way bewailing the lamentable state of +Mansoul. + +Well, when he was come within sight of the town, the elders and chief of +the people of Mansoul went out at the gate to meet him, and to salute +him, and to know how he sped at court. But he told them his tale in so +doleful a manner, that they all cried out, and mourned, and wept. +Wherefore they threw ashes and dust upon their heads, and put sackcloth +upon their loins, and went crying out through the town of Mansoul; the +which, when the rest of the townsfolk saw, they all mourned and wept. +This, therefore, was a day of rebuke and trouble, and of anguish to the +town of Mansoul, and also of great distress. + +After some time, when they had somewhat refrained themselves, they came +together to consult again what by them was yet to be done; and they asked +advice, as they did before, of that reverend Mr. Godly-Fear, who told +them that there was no way better than to do as they had done, nor would +he that they should be discouraged at all with that they had met with at +court; yea, though several of their petitions should be answered with +nought but silence or rebuke: ‘For,’ said he, ‘it is the way of the wise +Shaddai to make men wait and to exercise patience, and it should be the +way of them in want, to be willing to stay his leisure. + +Then they took courage, and sent again and again, and again, and again; +for there was not now one day, nor an hour that went over Mansoul’s head, +wherein a man might not have met upon the road one or other riding post, +sounding the horn from Mansoul to the court of the King Shaddai; and all +with letters petitionary in behalf of, and for the Prince’s return to +Mansoul. The road, I say, was now full of messengers, going and +returning, and meeting one another; some from the court, and some from +Mansoul; and this was the work of the miserable town of Mansoul, all that +long, that sharp, that cold and tedious winter. + +Now if you have not forgot, you may yet remember that I told you before, +that after Emmanuel had taken Mansoul, yea, and after that he had new +modelled the town, there remained in several lurking places of the +corporation many of the old Diabolonians, that either came with the +tyrant when he invaded and took the town, or that had there, by reason of +unlawful mixtures, their birth and breeding, and bringing up. And their +holes, dens, and lurking places were in, under, or about the wall of the +town. Some of their names are the Lord Fornication, the Lord Adultery, +the Lord Murder, the Lord Anger, the Lord Lasciviousness, the Lord +Deceit, the Lord Evil-eye, the Lord Blasphemy, and that horrible villain, +the old and dangerous Lord Covetousness. These, as I told you, with many +more, had yet their abode in the town of Mansoul, and that after that +Emmanuel had driven their prince Diabolus out of the castle. + +Against these the good Prince did grant a commission to the Lord +Willbewill and others, yea, to the whole town of Mansoul, to seek, take, +secure, and destroy any or all that they could lay hands of, for that +they were Diabolonians by nature, enemies to the Prince, and those that +sought to ruin the blessed town of Mansoul. But the town of Mansoul did +not pursue this warrant, but neglected to look after, to apprehend, to +secure, and to destroy these Diabolonians. Wherefore what do these +villains but by degrees take courage to put forth their heads, and to +show themselves to the inhabitants of the town. Yea, and as I was told, +some of the men of Mansoul grew too familiar with some of them, to the +sorrow of the corporation, as you yet will hear more of in time and +place. + +Well, when the Diabolonian lords that were left perceived that Mansoul +had, through sinning, offended Emmanuel their Prince, and that he had +withdrawn himself and was gone, what do they but plot the ruin of the +town of Mansoul. So upon a time they met together at the hold of one Mr. +Mischief, who was also a Diabolonian, and there consulted how they might +deliver up Mansoul into the hands of Diabolus again. Now some advised +one way, and some another, every man according to his own liking. At +last my Lord Lasciviousness propounded, whether it might not be best, in +the first place, for some of those that were Diabolonians in Mansoul, to +adventure to offer themselves for servants to some of the natives of the +town; ‘for,’ said he, ‘if they so do, and Mansoul shall accept of them, +they may for us, and for Diabolus our Lord, make the taking of the town +of Mansoul more easy than otherwise it will be.’ But then stood up the +Lord Murder, and said, ‘This may not be done at this time; for Mansoul is +now in a kind of a rage, because by our friend, Mr. Carnal-Security, she +hath been once ensnared already, and made to offend against her Prince; +and how shall she reconcile herself unto her lord again, but by the heads +of these men? Besides, we know that they have in commission to take and +slay us wherever they shall find us; let us, therefore, be wise as foxes: +when we are dead, we can do them no hurt; but while we live, we may.’ +Thus, when they had tossed the matter to and fro, they jointly agreed +that a letter should forthwith be sent away to Diabolus in their name, by +which the state of the town of Mansoul should be showed him, and how much +it is under the frowns of their Prince. ‘We may also,’ said some, ‘let +him know our intentions, and ask of him his advice in the case.’ + +So a letter was presently framed, the contents of which were these:— + +‘To our great lord, the Prince Diabolus, dwelling below in the infernal +cave: + +‘O great father, and mighty Prince Diabolus, we, the true Diabolonians +yet remaining in the rebellious town of Mansoul, having received our +beings from thee, and our nourishment at thy hands, cannot with content +and quiet endure to behold, as we do this day, how thou art dispraised, +disgraced, and reproached among the inhabitants of this town; nor is thy +long absence at all delightful to us, because greatly to our detriment. + +‘The reason of this our writing unto our lord, is for that we are not +altogether without hope that this town may become thy habitation again; +for it is greatly declined from its Prince Emmanuel; and he is uprisen, +and is departed from them: yea, and though they send, and send, and send, +and send after him to return to them, yet can they not prevail, nor get +good words from him. + +‘There has been also of late, and is yet remaining, a very great sickness +and fainting among them; and that not only upon the poorer sort of the +town, but upon the lords, captains, and chief gentry of the place, (we +only who are of the Diabolonians by nature remain well, lively, and +strong,) so that through their great transgression on the one hand, and +their dangerous sickness on the other, we judge they lie open to thy hand +and power. If, therefore, it shall stand with thy horrible cunning, and +with the cunning of the rest of the princes with thee, to come and make +an attempt to take Mansoul again, send us word, and we shall to our +utmost power be ready to deliver it into thy hand. Or if what we have +said shall not by thy fatherhood be thought best and most meet to be +done, send us thy mind in a few words, and we are all ready to follow thy +counsel to the hazarding of our lives, and what else we have. + +‘Given under our hands the day and date above-written, after a close +consultation at the house of Mr. Mischief, who yet is alive and hath his +place in our desirable town of Mansoul.’ + +When Mr. Profane (for he was the carrier) was come with his letter to +Hell-Gate Hill, he knocked at the brazen gates for entrance. Then did +Cerberus, the porter, for he is the keeper of that gate, open to Mr. +Profane, to whom he delivered his letter, which he had brought from the +Diabolonians in Mansoul. So he carried it in, and presented it to +Diabolus his lord, and said, ‘Tidings, my lord, from Mansoul, from our +trusty friends in Mansoul.’ + +Then came together from all places of the den Beelzebub, Lucifer, +Apollyon, with the rest of the rabblement there, to hear what news from +Mansoul. So the letter was broken up and read, and Cerberus he stood by. +When the letter was openly read, and the contents thereof spread into all +the corners of the den, command was given that, without let or stop, +dead-man’s bell should be rung for joy. So the bell was rung, and the +princes rejoiced that Mansoul was likely to come to ruin. Now, the +clapper of the bell went, ‘The town of Mansoul is coming to dwell with +us: make room for the town of Mansoul.’ This bell therefore they did +ring, because they did hope that they should have Mansoul again. + +Now, when they had performed this their horrible ceremony, they got +together again to consult what answer to send to their friends in +Mansoul; and some advised one thing, and some another: but at length, +because the business required haste, they left the whole business to the +prince Diabolus, judging him the most proper lord of the place. So he +drew up a letter as he thought fit, in answer to what Mr. Profane had +brought, and sent it to the Diabolonians that did dwell in Mansoul, by +the same hand that had brought theirs to him; and these were the contents +thereof:— + +‘To our offspring, the high and mighty Diabolonians that yet dwell in the +town of Mansoul, Diabolus, the great prince of Mansoul, wisheth a +prosperous issue and conclusion of those many brave enterprises, +conspiracies, and designs, that you, of your love and respect to our +honour, have in your hearts to attempt to do against Mansoul. Beloved +children and disciples, my Lord Fornication, Adultery, and the rest, we +have here, in our desolate den, received, to our highest joy and content, +your welcome letter, by the hand of our trusty Mr. Profane; and to show +how acceptable your tidings were, we rang out our bell for gladness; for +we rejoiced as much as we could, when we perceived that yet we had +friends in Mansoul, and such as sought our honour and revenge in the ruin +of the town of Mansoul. We also rejoiced to hear that they are in a +degenerated condition, and that they have offended their Prince, and that +he is gone. Their sickness also pleaseth us, as does also your health, +might, and strength. Glad also would we be, right horribly beloved, +could we get this town into our clutches again. Nor will we be sparing +of spending our wit, our cunning, our craft, and hellish inventions to +bring to a wished conclusion this your brave beginning in order thereto. + +‘And take this for your comfort, (our birth, and our offspring,) that +shall we again surprise it and take it, we will attempt to put all your +foes to the sword, and will make you the great lords and captains of the +place. Nor need you fear, if ever we get it again, that we after that +shall be cast out any more; for we will come with more strength, and so +lay far more fast hold than at the first we did. Besides, it is the law +of that Prince that now they own, that if we get them a second time, they +shall be ours for ever. + +‘Do you, therefore, our trusty Diabolonians, yet more pry into, and +endeavour to spy out the weakness of the town of Mansoul. We also would +that you yourselves do attempt to weaken them more and more. Send us +word also by what means you think we had best to attempt the regaining +thereof: namely, whether by persuasion to a vain and loose life; or, +whether by tempting them to doubt and despair; or, whether by blowing up +of the town by the gunpowder of pride, and self-conceit. Do you also, O +ye brave Diabolonians, and true sons of the pit, be always in a readiness +to make a most hideous assault within, when we shall be ready to storm it +without. Now speed you in your project, and we in our desires, to the +utmost power of our gates, which is the wish of your great Diabolus, +Mansoul’s enemy, and him that trembles when he thinks of judgment to +come. All the blessings of the pit be upon you, and so we close up our +letter. + +‘Given at the pit’s mouth, by the joint consent of all the princes of +darkness, to be sent, to the force and power that we have yet remaining +in Mansoul, by the hand of Mr. Profane, by me, Diabolus.’ + +This letter, as was said, was sent to Mansoul, to the Diabolonians that +yet remained there, and that yet inhabited the wall, from the dark +dungeon of Diabolus, by the hand of Mr. Profane, by whom they also in +Mansoul sent theirs to the pit. Now, when this Mr. Profane had made his +return, and was come to Mansoul again, he went and came as he was wont to +the house of Mr. Mischief, for there was the conclave, and the place +where the contrivers were met. Now, when they saw that their messenger +was returned safe and sound, they were greatly gladded thereat. Then he +presented them with his letter which he had brought from Diabolus for +them; the which, when they had read and considered, did much augment +their gladness. They asked him after the welfare of their friends, as +how their Lord Diabolus, Lucifer, and Beelzebub did, with the rest of +those of the den. To which this Profane made answer, ‘Well, well, my +lords; they are well, even as well as can be in their place. They also,’ +said he, ‘did ring for joy at the reading of your letter, as you well +perceived by this when you read it.’ + +Now, as was said, when they had read their letter, and perceived that it +encouraged them in their work, they fell to their way of contriving +again, namely, how they might complete their Diabolonian design upon +Mansoul. And the first thing that they agreed upon was to keep all +things from Mansoul as close as they could. ‘Let it not be known, let +not Mansoul be acquainted with what we design against it.’ The next +thing was, how, or by what means, they should try to bring to pass the +ruin and overthrow of Mansoul; and one said after this manner, and +another said after that. Then stood up Mr. Deceit, and said, ‘My right +Diabolonian friends, our lords, and the high ones of the deep dungeon, do +propound unto us these three ways. + +‘1. Whether we had best to seek its ruin by making Mansoul loose and +vain. + +‘2. Or whether by driving them to doubt and despair. + +‘3. Or whether by endeavouring to blow them up by the gunpowder of pride +and self-conceit. + +‘Now, I think, if we shall tempt them to pride, that may do something; +and if we tempt them to wantonness, that may help. But, in my mind, if +we could drive them into desperation, that would knock the nail on the +head; for then we should have them, in the first place, question the +truth of the love of the heart of their Prince towards them, and that +will disgust him much. This, if it works well, will make them leave off +quickly their way of sending petitions to him; then farewell earnest +solicitations for help and supply; for then this conclusion lies +naturally before them, “As good do nothing, as do to no purpose.”’ So to +Mr. Deceit they unanimously did consent. + +Then the next question was, But how shall we do to bring this our project +to pass? and it was answered by the same gentleman—that this might be the +best way to do it: ‘Even let,’ quoth he, ‘so many of our friends as are +willing to venture themselves for the promoting of their prince’s cause, +disguise themselves with apparel, change their names, and go into the +market like far country-men, and proffer to let themselves for servants +to the famous town of Mansoul, and let them pretend to do for their +masters as beneficially as may be; for by so doing they may, if Mansoul +shall hire them, in little time so corrupt and defile the corporation, +that her now Prince shall be not only further offended with them, but in +conclusion shall spue them out of his mouth. And when this is done, our +prince Diabolus shall prey upon them with ease: yea, of themselves they +shall fall into the mouth of the eater.’ + +This project was no sooner propounded, but was as highly accepted, and +forward were all Diabolonians now to engage in so delicate an enterprise: +but it was not thought fit that all should do thus; wherefore they +pitched upon two or three, namely, the Lord Covetousness, the Lord +Lasciviousness, and the Lord Anger. The Lord Covetousness called himself +by the name of Prudent-Thrifty; the Lord Lasciviousness called himself by +the name of Harmless-Mirth; and the Lord Anger called himself by the name +of Good-Zeal. + +So upon a market-day they came into the market-place, three lusty fellows +they were to look on, and they were clothed in sheep’s russet, which was +also now in a manner as white as were the white robes of the men of +Mansoul. Now the men could speak the language of Mansoul well. So when +they were come into the market-place, and had offered to let themselves +to the townsmen, they were presently taken up; for they asked but little +wages, and promised to do their masters great service. + +Mr. Mind hired Prudent-Thrifty, and Mr. Godly-Fear hired Good-Zeal. +True, this fellow Harmless-Mirth did hang a little in hand, and could not +so soon get him a master as the others did, because the town of Mansoul +was now in Lent, but after a while, because Lent was almost out, the Lord +Willbewill hired Harmless-Mirth to be both his waiting man and his +lackey: and thus they got them masters. + +These villains now being got thus far into the houses of the men of +Mansoul, quickly began to do great mischief therein; for, being filthy, +arch, and sly, they quickly corrupted the families where they were; yea, +they tainted their masters much, especially this Prudent-Thrifty, and him +they call Harmless-Mirth. True, he that went under the visor of +Good-Zeal, was not so well liked of his master; for he quickly found that +he was but a counterfeit rascal; the which when the fellow perceived, +with speed he made his escape from the house, or I doubt not but his +master had hanged him. + +Well, when these vagabonds had thus far carried on their design, and had +corrupted the town as much as they could, in the next place they +considered with themselves at what time their prince Diabolus without, +and themselves within the town, should make an attempt to seize upon +Mansoul; and they all agreed upon this, that a market-day would be best +for that work; for why? Then will the townsfolk be busy in their ways: +and always take this for a rule, when people are most busy in the world, +they least fear a surprise. ‘We also then,’ said they, ‘shall be able +with less suspicion to gather ourselves together for the work of our +friends and lords; yea, and in such a day, if we shall attempt our work, +and miss it, we may, when they shall give us the rout, the better hide +ourselves in the crowd, and escape.’ + +These things being thus far agreed upon by them, they wrote another +letter to Diabolus, and sent it by the hand to Mr. Profane, the contents +of which were these:— + +‘The lords of Looseness send to the great and high Diabolus from our +dens, caves, holes, and strongholds, in and about the wall of the town of +Mansoul, greeting: + +‘Our great lord, and the nourisher of our lives, Diabolus—how glad we +were when we heard of your fatherhood’s readiness to comply with us, and +help forward our design in our attempts to ruin Mansoul, none can tell +but those who, as we do, set themselves against all appearance of good, +when and wheresoever we find it. + +‘Touching the encouragement that your greatness is pleased to give us to +continue to devise, contrive, and study the utter desolation of Mansoul, +that we are not solicitous about: for we know right well that it cannot +but be pleasing and profitable to us to see our enemies, and them that +seek our lives, die at our feet, or fly before us. We therefore are +still contriving, and that to the best of our cunning, to make this work +most facile and easy to your lordships, and to us. + +‘First, we considered of that most hellishly cunning, compacted, +threefold project, that by you was propounded to us in your last; and +have concluded, that though to blow them up with the gunpowder of pride +would do well, and to do it by tempting them to be loose and vain will +help on, yet to contrive to bring them into the gulf of desperation, we +think will do best of all. Now we, who are at your beck, have thought or +two ways to do this: first we, for our parts, will make them as vile as +we can, and then you with us, at a time appointed, shall be ready to fall +upon them with the utmost force. And of all the nations that are at your +whistle, we think that an army of doubters may be the most likely to +attack and overcome the town of Mansoul. Thus shall we overcome these +enemies, else the pit shall open her mouth upon them, and desperation +shall thrust them down into it. We have also, to effect this so much by +us desired design, sent already three of our trusty Diabolonians among +them; they are disguised in garb, they have changed their names, and are +now accepted of them; namely, Covetousness, Lasciviousness, and Anger. +The name of Covetousness is changed to Prudent-Thrifty, and him Mr. Mind +has hired, and is almost become as bad as our friend. Lasciviousness has +changed his name to Harmless-Mirth, and he is got to be the Lord +Willbewill’s lackey; but he has made his master very wanton. Anger +changed his name into Good-Zeal, and was entertained by Mr. Godly-Fear; +but the peevish old gentleman took pepper in the nose, and turned our +companion out of his house. Nay, he has informed us since that he ran +away from him, or else his old master had hanged him up for his labour. + +‘Now these have much helped forward our work and design upon Mansoul; for +notwithstanding the spite and quarrelsome temper of the old gentleman +last mentioned, the other two ply their business well, and are likely to +ripen the work apace. + +‘Our next project is, that it be concluded that you come upon the town +upon a market-day, and that when they are upon the heat of their +business; for then, to be sure, they will be most secure, and least think +that an assault will be made upon them. They will also at such a time be +less able to defend themselves, and to offend you in the prosecution of +our design. And we your trusty (and we are sure your beloved) ones +shall, when you shall make your furious assault without, be ready to +second the business within. So shall we, in all likelihood, be able to +put Mansoul to utter confusion, and to swallow them up before they can +come to themselves. If your serpentine heads, most subtile dragons, and +our highly esteemed lords can find out a better way than this, let us +quickly know your minds. + +‘To the monsters of the infernal cave, from the house of Mr. Mischief in +Mansoul, by the hand of Mr. Profane.’ + +Now all the while that the raging runagates and hellish Diabolonians were +thus contriving the ruin of the town of Mansoul, they (namely, the poor +town itself) was in a sad and woeful case; partly because they had so +grievously offended Shaddai and his Son, and partly because that the +enemies thereby got strength within them afresh; and also because, though +they had by many petitions made suit to the Prince Emmanuel, and to his +Father Shaddai by him, for their pardon and favour, yet hitherto obtained +they not one smile; but contrariwise, through the craft and subtilty of +the domestic Diabolonians, their cloud was made to grow blacker and +blacker, and their Emmanuel to stand at further distance. + +The sickness also did still greatly rage in Mansoul, both among the +captains and the inhabitants of the town; and their enemies only were now +lively and strong, and likely to become the head, whilst Mansoul was made +the tail. + +By this time the letter last mentioned, that was written by the +Diabolonians that yet lurked in the town of Mansoul, was conveyed to +Diabolus in the black den, by the hand of Mr. Profane. He carried the +letter by Hell-Gate Hill as afore, and conveyed it by Cerberus to his +lord. + +But when Cerberus and Mr. Profane did meet, they were presently as great +as beggars, and thus they fell into discourse about Mansoul, and about +the project against her. + +‘Ah! old friend,’ quoth Cerberus, ‘art thou come to Hell-Gate Hill again? +By St. Mary, I am glad to see thee!’ + +_Prof._ Yes, my lord, I am come again about the concerns of the town of +Mansoul. + +_Cerb._ Prithee, tell me what condition is that town of Mansoul in at +present? + +_Prof._ In a brave condition, my lord, for us, and for my lords, the +lords of this place, I trow for they are greatly decayed as to godliness, +and that is as well as our heart can wish; their Lord is greatly out with +them, and that doth also please us well. We have already also a foot in +their dish, for our Diabolonian friends are laid in their bosoms, and +what do we lack but to be masters of the place! Besides, our trusty +friends in Mansoul are daily plotting to betray it to the lords of this +town; also the sickness rages bitterly among them; and that which makes +up all, we hope at last to prevail.’ + +Then said the dog of Hell-Gate, ‘No time like this to assault them. I +wish that the enterprise be followed close, and that the success desired +may be soon effected: yea, I wish it for the poor Diabolonians’ sakes, +that live in the continual fear of their lives in that traitorous town of +Mansoul.’ + +_Prof._ The contrivance is almost finished, the lords in Mansoul that +are Diabolonians are at it day and night, and the other are like silly +doves; they want heart to be concerned with their state and to consider +that ruin is at hand. Besides you may, yea, must think, when you put all +things together, that there are many reasons that prevail with Diabolus +to make what haste he can. + +_Cerb._ Thou hast said as it is; I am glad things are at this pass. Go +in, my brave Profane, to my lords, they will give thee for thy welcome as +good a _coranto_ as the whole of this kingdom will afford. I have sent +thy letter in already. + +Then Mr. Profane went into the den, and his lord Diabolus met him, and +saluted him with, ‘Welcome, my trusty servant: I have been made glad with +thy letter.’ The rest of the lords of the pit gave him also their +salutations. Then Profane, after obeisance made to them all, said, ‘Let +Mansoul be given to my lord Diabolus, and let him be her king for ever.’ +And with that, the hollow belly and yawning gorge of hell gave so loud +and hideous a groan, (for that is the music of that place,) that it made +the mountains about it totter, as if they would fall in pieces. + +Now, after they had read and considered the letter, they consulted what +answer to return; and the first that did speak to it was Lucifer. + +Then said he, ‘The first project of the Diabolonians in Mansoul is likely +to be lucky, and to take; namely, that they will, by all the ways and +means they can, make Mansoul yet more vile and filthy: no way to destroy +a soul like this. Our old friend Balaam went this way and prospered many +years ago; let this therefore stand with us for a maxim, and be to +Diabolonians for a general rule in all ages; for nothing can make this to +fail but grace, in which I would hope that this town has no share. But +whether to fall upon them on a market-day, because of their cumber in +business, that I would should be under debate. And there is more reason +why this head should be debated, than why some other should; because upon +this will turn the whole of what we shall attempt. If we time not our +business well, our whole project may fail. Our friends, the +Diabolonians, say that a market-day is best; for then will Mansoul be +most busy, and have fewest thoughts of a surprise. But what if also they +should double their guards on those days? (and methinks nature and reason +should teach them to do it;) and what if they should keep such a watch on +those days as the necessity of their present case doth require? yea, what +if their men should be always in arms on those days? then you may, my +lords, be disappointed in your attempts, and may bring our friends in the +town to utter danger of unavoidable ruin.’ + +Then said the great Beelzebub, ‘There is something in what my lord hath +said; but his conjecture may, or may not fall out. Nor hath my lord laid +it down as that which must not be receded from; for I know that he said +it only to provoke to a warm debate thereabout. Therefore we must +understand, if we can, whether the town of Mansoul has such sense and +knowledge of her decayed state, and of the design that we have on foot +against her, as doth provoke her to set watch and ward at her gates, and +to double them on market-days. But if, after inquiry made, it shall be +found that they are asleep, then any day will do, but a market-day is +best; and this is my judgment in this case.’ + +Then quoth Diabolus, ‘How should we know this?’ and it was answered, +‘Inquire about it at the mouth of Mr. Profane.’ So Profane was called +in, and asked the question, and he made his answer as follows:— + +_Prof._ My lords, so far as I can gather, this is at present the +condition of the town of Mansoul: they are decayed in their faith and +love; Emmanuel, their Prince, has given them the back; they send often by +petition to fetch him again, but he maketh not haste to answer their +request, nor is there much reformation among them. + +_Diab._ I am glad that they are backward in a reformation, but yet I am +afraid of their petitioning. However, their looseness of life is a sign +that there is not much heart in what they do, and without the heart +things are little worth. But go on, my masters; I will divert you, my +lords, no longer. + +_Beel._ If the case be so with Mansoul, as Mr. Profane has described it +to be, it will be no great matter what day we assault it; not their +prayers, nor their power will do them much service. + +When Beelzebub had ended his oration, then Apollyon did begin. ‘My +opinion,’ said he, ‘concerning this matter, is, that we go on fair and +softly, not doing things in a hurry. Let our friends in Mansoul go on +still to pollute and defile it, by seeking to draw it yet more into sin +(for there is nothing like sin to devour Mansoul). If this be done, and +it takes effect, Mansoul, of itself, will leave off to watch, to +petition, or anything else that should tend to her security and safety; +for she will forget her Emmanuel, she will not desire his company, and +can she be gotten thus to live, her Prince will not come to her in haste. +Our trusty friend, Mr. Carnal-Security, with one of his tricks did drive +him out of the town; and why may not my Lord Covetousness, and my Lord +Lasciviousness, by what they may do, keep him out of the town? And this +I will tell you, (not because you know it not,) that two or three +Diabolonians, if entertained and countenanced by the town of Mansoul, +will do more to the keeping of Emmanuel from them, and towards making the +town of Mansoul your own, than can an army of a legion that should be +sent out from us to withstand him. Let, therefore, this first project +that our friends in Mansoul have set on foot, be strongly and diligently +carried on, with all cunning and craft imaginable; and let them send +continually, under one guise or another, more and other of their men to +play with the people of Mansoul; and then, perhaps, we shall not need to +be at the charge of making a war upon them; or if that must of necessity +be done, yet the more sinful they are, the more unable, to be sure, they +will be to resist us, and then the more easily we shall overcome them. +And besides, suppose (and that is the worst that can be supposed) that +Emmanuel should come to them again, why may not the same means, or the +like, drive him from them once more? Yea, why may he not, by their lapse +into that sin again, be driven from them for ever, for the sake of which +he was at the first driven from them for a season? And if this should +happen, then away go with him his rams, his slings, his captains, his +soldiers, and he leaveth Mansoul naked and bare. Yea, will not this +town, when she sees herself utterly forsaken of her Prince, of her own +accord open her gates again unto you, and make of you as in the days of +old? But this must be done by time, a few days will not effect so great +a work as this.’ + +So soon as Apollyon had made an end of speaking, Diabolus began to blow +out his own malice, and to plead his own cause; and he said, ‘My lords, +and powers of the cave, my true and trusty friends, I have with much +impatience, as becomes me, given ear to your long and tedious orations. +But my furious gorge, and empty paunch, so lusteth after a repossession +of my famous town of Mansoul, that whatever comes out, I can wait no +longer to see the events of lingering projects. I must, and that without +further delay, seek, by all means I can, to fill my insatiable gulf with +the soul and body of the town of Mansoul. Therefore lend me your heads, +your hearts, and your help, now I am going to recover my town of +Mansoul.’ + +When the lords and princes of the pit saw the flaming desire that was in +Diabolus to devour the miserable town of Mansoul, they left off to raise +any more objections, but consented to lend him what strength they could, +though had Apollyon’s advice been taken, they had far more fearfully +distressed the town of Mansoul. But, I say, they were willing to lend +him what strength they could, not knowing what need they might have of +him, when they should engage for themselves, as he. Wherefore they fell +to advising about the next thing propounded, namely, what soldiers they +were, and also how many, with whom Diabolus should go against the town of +Mansoul to take it; and after some debate, it was concluded, according as +in the letter the Diabolonians had suggested, that none were more fit for +that expedition than an army of terrible doubters. They therefore +concluded to send against Mansoul an army of sturdy doubters. The number +thought fit to be employed in that service was between twenty and thirty +thousand. So then the result of that great council of those high and +mighty lords was—That Diabolus should even now, out of hand, beat up his +drum for men in the land of Doubting, which land lieth upon the confines +of the place called Hell-Gate Hill, for men that might be employed by him +against the miserable town of Mansoul. It was also concluded, that these +lords themselves should help him in the war, and that they would to that +end head and manage his men. So they drew up a letter, and sent back to +the Diabolonians that lurked in Mansoul, and that waited for the +back-coming of Mr. Profane, to signify to them into what method and +forwardness they at present had put their design. The contents whereof +now follow:— + +‘From the dark and horrible dungeon of hell, Diabolus with all the +society of the princes of darkness, sends to our trusty ones, in and +about the walls of the town of Mansoul, now impatiently waiting for our +most devilish answer to their venomous and most poisonous design against +the town of Mansoul. + +‘Our native ones, in whom from day to day we boast, and in whose actions +all the year long we do greatly delight ourselves, we received your +welcome, because highly esteemed letter, at the hand of our trusty and +greatly beloved, the old gentleman, Mr. Profane. And do give you to +understand, that when we had broken it up, and had read the contents +thereof, to your amazing memory be it spoken, our yawning hollow-bellied +place, where we are, made so hideous and yelling a noise for joy, that +the mountains that stand round about Hell-Gate Hill, had like to have +been shaken to pieces at the sound thereof. + +‘We could also do no less than admire your faithfulness to us, with the +greatness of that subtilty that now hath showed itself to be in your +heads to serve us against the town of Mansoul. For you have invented for +us so excellent a method for our proceeding against that rebellious +people, a more effectual cannot be thought of by all the wits of hell. +The proposals, therefore, which now, at last, you have sent us, since we +saw them, we have done little else but highly approved and admired them. + +‘Nay, we shall, to encourage you in the profundity of your craft, let you +know, that, at a full assembly and conclave of our princes and +principalities of this place, your project was discoursed and tossed from +one side of our cave to the other by their mightinesses; but a better, +and as was by themselves judged, a more fit and proper way by all their +wits, could not be invented, to surprise, take, and make our own, the +rebellious town of Mansoul. + +‘Wherefore, in fine, all that was said that varied from what you had in +your letter propounded, fell of itself to the ground, and yours only was +stuck to by Diabolus, the prince; yea, his gaping gorge and yawning +paunch was on fire to put your invention into execution. + +‘We therefore give you to understand that our stout, furious, and +unmerciful Diabolus is raising, for your relief, and the ruin of the +rebellious town of Mansoul, more than twenty thousand doubters to come +against that people. They are all stout and sturdy men, and men that of +old have been accustomed to war, and that can therefore well endure the +drum. I say, he is doing this work of his with all the possible speed he +can; for his heart and spirit is engaged in it. We desire, therefore, +that, as you have hitherto stuck to us, and given us both advice and +encouragement thus far, you still will prosecute our design; nor shall +you lose, but be gainers thereby; yea, we intend to make you the lords of +Mansoul. + +‘One thing may not by any means be omitted, that is, those with us do +desire that every one of you that are in Mansoul would still use all your +power, cunning, and skill, with delusive persuasions, yet to draw the +town of Mansoul into more sin and wickedness, even that sin may be +finished and bring forth death. + +‘For thus it is concluded with us, that the more vile, sinful, and +debauched the town of Mansoul is, more backward will be their Emmanuel to +come to their help, either by presence or other relief; yea, the more +sinful, the more weak, and so the more unable will they be to make +resistance when we shall make our assault upon them to swallow them up. +Yea, that may cause that their mighty Shaddai himself may cast them out +of his protection; yea, and send for his captains and soldiers home, with +his slings and rams, and leave them naked and bare; and then the town of +Mansoul will of itself open to us, and fall as the fig into the mouth of +the eater. Yea, to be sure that we then with a great deal of ease shall +come upon her and overcome her. + +‘As to the time of our coming upon Mansoul, we, as yet, have not fully +resolved upon that, though at present some of us think as you, that a +market-day, or a market-day at night, will certainly be the best. +However, do you be ready, and when you shall hear our roaring drum +without, do you be as busy to make the most horrible confusion within. +So shall Mansoul certainly be distressed before and behind, and shall not +know which way to betake herself for help. My Lord Lucifer, my Lord +Beelzebub, my Lord Apollyon, my Lord Legion, with the rest, salute you, +as does also my Lord Diabolus; and we wish both you, with all that you +do, or shall possess, the very self-same fruit and success for their +doing as we ourselves at present enjoy for ours. + +‘From our dreadful confines in the most fearful pit, we salute you, and +so do those many legions here with us, wishing you may be as hellishly +prosperous as we desire to be ourselves. By the letter-carrier, Mr. +Profane.’ + +Then Mr. Profane addressed himself for his return to Mansoul, with his +errand from the horrible pit to the Diabolonians that dwelt in that town. +So he came up the stairs from the deep to the mouth of the cave where +Cerberus was. Now when Cerberus saw him, he asked how did matters go +below, about and against the town of Mansoul. + +_Prof._ Things go as well as we can expect. The letter that I carried +thither was highly approved, and well liked by all my lords, and I am +returning to tell our Diabolonians so. I have an answer to it here in my +bosom, that I am sure will make our masters that sent me glad; for the +contents thereof are to encourage them to pursue their design to the +utmost, and to be ready also to fall on within, when they shall see my +Lord Diabolus beleaguering the town of Mansoul. + +_Cerb._ But does he intend to go against them himself? + +_Prof._ Does he! Ay! and he will take along with him more than twenty +thousand, all sturdy Doubters, and men of war, picked men from the land +of Doubting, to serve him in the expedition. + +Then was Cerberus glad, and said, ‘And is there such brave preparations +a-making to go against the miserable town of Mansoul? And would I might +be put at the head of a thousand of them, that I might also show my +valour against the famous town of Mansoul.’ + +_Prof._ Your wish may come to pass; you look like one that has mettle +enough, and my lord will have with him those that are valiant and stout. +But my business requires haste. + +_Cerb._ Ay, so it does. Speed thee to the town of Mansoul, with all the +deepest mischiefs that this place can afford thee. And when thou shalt +come to the house of Mr. Mischief, the place where the Diabolonians meet +to plot, tell them that Cerberus doth wish them his service, and that if +he may, he will with the army come up against the famous town of Mansoul. + +_Prof._ That I will. And I know that my lords that are there will be +glad to hear it, and to see you also. + +So after a few more such kind of compliments, Mr. Profane took his leave +of his friend Cerberus; and Cerberus again, with a thousand of their +pit-wishes, bid him haste, with all speed, to his masters. The which +when he had heard, he made obeisance, and began to gather up his heels to +run. + +Thus, therefore, he returned, and went and came to Mansoul; and going, as +afore, to the house of Mr. Mischief, there he found the Diabolonians +assembled, and waiting for his return. Now when he was come, and had +presented himself, he also delivered to them his letter, and adjoined +this compliment to them therewith: ‘My lords, from the confines of the +pit, the high and mighty principalities and powers of the den salute you +here, the true Diabolonians of the town of Mansoul. Wishing you always +the most proper of their benedictions, for the great service, high +attempts, and brave achievements that you have put yourselves upon, for +the restoring to our prince Diabolus the famous town of Mansoul.’ + +This was therefore the present state of the miserable town of Mansoul: +she had offended her Prince, and he was gone; she had encouraged the +powers of hell, by her foolishness, to come against her to seek her utter +destruction. + +True, the town of Mansoul was somewhat made sensible of her sin, but the +Diabolonians were gotten into her bowels; she cried, but Emmanuel was +gone, and her cries did not fetch him as yet again. Besides, she knew +not now whether, ever or never, he would return and come to his Mansoul +again; nor did they know the power and industry of the enemy, nor how +forward they were to put in execution that plot of hell that they had +devised against her. + +They did, indeed, still send petition after petition to the Prince, but +he answered all with silence. They did neglect reformation, and that was +as Diabolus would have it; for he knew, if they regarded iniquity in +their heart, their King would not hear their prayer; they therefore did +still grow weaker and weaker, and were as a rolling thing before the +whirlwind. They cried to their King for help, and laid Diabolonians in +their bosoms: what therefore should a King do to them? Yea, there seemed +now to be a mixture in Mansoul; the Diabolonians and the Mansoulians +would walk the streets together. Yea, they began to seek their peace; +for they thought that, since the sickness had been so mortal in Mansoul, +it was in vain to go to handygripes with them. Besides, the weakness of +Mansoul was the strength of their enemies; and the sins of Mansoul, the +advantage of the Diabolonians. The foes of Mansoul did also now begin to +promise themselves the town for a possession: there was no great +difference now betwixt Mansoulians and Diabolonians: both seemed to be +masters of Mansoul. Yea, the Diabolonians increased and grew, but the +town of Mansoul diminished greatly. There were more than eleven thousand +men, women, and children that died by the sickness in Mansoul. + +But now, as Shaddai would have it, there was one whose name was Mr. +Prywell, a great lover of the people of Mansoul. And he, as his manner +was, did go listening up and down in Mansoul to see, and to hear, if at +any time he might, whether there was any design against it or no. For he +was always a jealous man, and feared some mischief sometime would befal +it, either from the Diabolonians within, or from some power without. Now +upon a time it so happened, as Mr. Prywell went listening here and there, +that he lighted upon a place called Vilehill, in Mansoul, where +Diabolonians used to meet; so hearing a muttering, (you must know that it +was in the night,) he softly drew near to hear; nor had he stood long +under the house-end, (for there stood a house there,) but he heard one +confidently affirm, that it was not, or would not be long before Diabolus +should possess himself again of Mansoul; and that then the Diabolonians +did intend to put all Mansoulians to the sword, and would kill and +destroy the King’s captains, and drive all his soldiers out of the town. +He said, moreover, that he knew there were above twenty thousand fighting +men prepared by Diabolus for the accomplishing of this design, and that +it would not be months before they all should see it. + +When Mr. Prywell had heard this story, he did quickly believe it was +true: wherefore he went forthwith to my Lord Mayor’s house, and +acquainted him therewith; who, sending for the subordinate preacher, +brake the business to him; and he as soon gave the alarm to the town; for +he was now the chief preacher in Mansoul, because, as yet, my Lord +Secretary was ill at ease. And this was the way that the subordinate +preacher did take to alarm the town therewith. The same hour he caused +the lecture bell to be rung; so the people came together: he gave them +then a short exhortation to watchfulness, and made Mr. Prywell’s news the +argument thereof. ‘For,’ said he, ‘an horrible plot is contrived against +Mansoul, even to massacre us all in a day, nor is this story to be +slighted; for Mr. Prywell is the author thereof. Mr. Prywell was always +a lover of Mansoul, a sober and judicious man, a man that is no tattler, +nor raiser of false reports, but one that loves to look into the very +bottom of matters, and talks nothing of news, but by very solid +arguments. + +‘I will call him, and you shall hear him your own selves;’ so he called +him, and he came and told his tale so punctually, and affirmed its truth +with such ample grounds, that Mansoul fell presently under a conviction +of the truth of what he said. The preacher did also back him, saying, +‘Sirs, it is not irrational for us to believe it, for we have provoked +Shaddai to anger, and have sinned Emmanuel out of the town; we have had +too much correspondence with Diabolonians, and have forsaken our former +mercies: no marvel then, if the enemy both within and without should +design and plot our ruin; and what time like this to do it? The sickness +is now in the town, and we have been made weak thereby. Many a good +meaning man is dead, and the Diabolonians of late grow stronger and +stronger. + +‘Besides,’ quoth the subordinate preacher, ‘I have received from this +good truth-teller this one inkling further, that he understood by those +that he overheard, that several letters have lately passed between the +furies and the Diabolonians in order to our destruction.’ When Mansoul +heard all this, and not being able to gainsay it, they lift up their +voice and wept. Mr. Prywell did also, in the presence of the townsmen, +confirm all that their subordinate preacher had said. Wherefore they now +set afresh to bewail their folly, and to a doubling of petitions to +Shaddai and his Son. They also brake the business to the captains, high +commanders, and men of war in the town of Mansoul, entreating them to use +the means to be strong, and to take good courage; and that they would +look after their harness, and make themselves ready to give Diabolus +battle by night and by day, shall he come, as they are informed he will, +to beleaguer the town of Mansoul. + +When the captains heard this, they being always true lovers of the town +of Mansoul, what do they but like so many Samsons they shake themselves, +and come together to consult and contrive how to defeat those bold and +hellish contrivances that were upon the wheel by the means of Diabolus +and his friends against the now sickly, weakly, and much impoverished +town of Mansoul; and they agreed upon these following particulars:— + +1. That the gates of Mansoul should be kept shut, and made fast with bars +and locks, and that all persons that went out, or came in, should be very +strictly examined by the captains of the guards, ‘to the end,’ said they, +‘that those that are managers of the plot amongst us, may, either coming +or going, be taken; and that we may also find out who are the great +contrivers, amongst us, of our ruin.’ + +2. The next thing was, that a strict search should be made for all kind +of Diabolonians throughout the whole town of Mansoul; and that every +man’s house from top to bottom should be looked into, and that, too, +house by house, that if possible a further discovery might be made of all +such among them as had a hand in these designs. + +3. It was further concluded upon, that wheresoever or with whomsoever any +of the Diabolonians were found, that even those of the town of Mansoul +that had given them house and harbour, should to their shame, and the +warning of others, take penance in the open place. + +4. It was, moreover, resolved by the famous town of Mansoul, that a +public fast, and a day of humiliation, should be kept throughout the +whole corporation, to the justifying of their Prince, the abasing of +themselves before him for their transgressions against him, and against +Shaddai, his Father. It was further resolved, that all such in Mansoul +as did not on that day endeavour to keep that fast, and to humble +themselves for their faults, but that should mind their worldly employs, +or be found wandering up and down the streets, should be taken for +Diabolonians, and should suffer as Diabolonians for such their wicked +doings. + +5. It was further concluded then, that with what speed, and with what +warmth of mind they could, they would renew their humiliation for sin, +and their petitions to Shaddai for help; they also resolved, to send +tidings to the court of all that Mr. Prywell had told them. + +6. It was also determined, that thanks should be given by the town of +Mansoul to Mr. Prywell, for his diligent seeking of the welfare of their +town: and further, that forasmuch as he was so naturally inclined to seek +their good, and also to undermine their foes, they gave him a commission +of scout-master-general, for the good of the town of Mansoul. + +When the corporation, with their captains, had thus concluded, they did +as they had said; they shut up their gates, they made for Diabolonians +strict search, they made those with whom any were found to take penance +in the open place: they kept their fast, and renewed their petitions to +their Prince, and Mr. Prywell managed his charge and the trust that +Mansoul had put in his hands, with great conscience and good fidelity; +for he gave himself wholly up to his employ, and that not only within the +town, but he went out to pry, to see, and to hear. + +And not many days after he provided for his journey, and went towards +Hell-Gate Hill, into the country where the Doubters were, where he heard +of all that had been talked of in Mansoul, and he perceived also that +Diabolus was almost ready for his march, etc. So he came back with +speed, and, calling the captains and elders of Mansoul together, he told +them where he had been, what he had heard, and what he had seen. +Particularly, he told them that Diabolus was almost ready for his march, +and that he had made old Mr. Incredulity, that once brake prison in +Mansoul, the general of his army; that his army consisted all of +Doubters, and that their number was above twenty thousand. He told, +moreover, that Diabolus did intend to bring with him the chief princes of +the infernal pit, and that he would make them chief captains over his +Doubters. He told them, moreover, that it was certainly true that +several of the black den would, with Diabolus, ride reformades to reduce +the town of Mansoul to the obedience of Diabolus, their prince. + +He said, moreover, that he understood by the Doubters, among whom he had +been, that the reason why old Incredulity was made general of the whole +army, was because none truer than he to the tyrant; and because he had an +implacable spite against the welfare of the town of Mansoul. Besides, +said he, he remembers the affronts that Mansoul has given him, and he is +resolved to be revenged of them. + +But the black princes shall be made high commanders, only Incredulity +shall be over them all; because, which I had almost forgot, he can more +easily, and more dexterously, beleaguer the town of Mansoul, than can any +of the princes besides. + +Now, when the captains of Mansoul, with the elders of the town, had heard +the tidings that Mr. Prywell did bring, they thought it expedient, +without further delay, to put into execution the laws that against the +Diabolonians their Prince had made for them, and given them in +commandment to manage against them. Wherefore, forthwith a diligent and +impartial search was made in all houses in Mansoul, for all and all +manner of Diabolonians. Now, in the house of Mr. Mind, and in the house +of the great Lord Willbewill, were two Diabolonians found. In Mr. Mind’s +house was one Lord Covetousness found; but he had changed his name to +Prudent-Thrifty. In my Lord Willbewill’s house, one Lasciviousness was +found; but he had changed his name to Harmless-Mirth. These two the +captains and elders of the town of Mansoul took, and committed them to +custody under the hand of Mr. Trueman, the gaoler; and this man handled +them so severely, and loaded them so well with irons, that in time they +both fell into a very deep consumption, and died in the prison-house; +their masters also, according to the agreement of the captains and +elders, were brought to take penance in the open place to their shame, +and for a warning to the rest of the town of Mansoul. + +Now, this was the manner of penance in those days: the persons offending +being made sensible of the evil of their doings, were enjoined open +confession of their faults, and a strict amendment of their lives. + +After this, the captains and elders of Mansoul sought yet to find out +more Diabolonians, wherever they lurked, whether in dens, caves, holes, +vaults, or where else they could, in or about the wall or town of +Mansoul. But though they could plainly see their footing, and so follow +them by their track and smell to their holds, even to the mouths of their +caves and dens, yet take them, hold them, and do justice upon them, they +could not; their ways were so crooked, their holds so strong, and they so +quick to take sanctuary there. + +But Mansoul did now with so stiff an hand rule over the Diabolonians that +were left, that they were glad to shrink into corners: time was when they +durst walk openly, and in the day; but now they were forced to embrace +privacy and the night: time was when a Mansoulian was their companion; +but now they counted them deadly enemies. This good change did Mr. +Prywell’s intelligence make in the famous town of Mansoul. + +By this time, Diabolus had finished his army which he intended to bring +with him for the ruin of Mansoul; and had set over them captains, and +other field officers, such as liked his furious stomach best: himself was +lord paramount, Incredulity was general of his army, their highest +captains shall be named afterwards; but now for their officers, colours, +and scutcheons. + +1. Their first captain was Captain Rage: he was captain over the election +doubters, his were the red colours; his standard-bearer was Mr. +Destructive, and the great red dragon he had for his scutcheon. + +2. The second captain was Captain Fury: he was captain over the vocation +doubters; his standard-bearer was Mr. Darkness, his colours were those +that were pale, and he had for his scutcheon the fiery flying serpent. + +3. The third captain was Captain Damnation: he was captain over the grace +doubters; his were the red colours, Mr. No-Life bare them, and he had for +his scutcheon the black den. + +4. The fourth captain was Captain Insatiable; he was captain over the +faith doubters: his were the red colours, Mr. Devourer bare them, and he +had for a scutcheon the yawning jaws. + +5. The fifth captain was Captain Brimstone: he was captain over the +perseverance doubters; his also were the red colours, Mr. Burning bare +them, and his scutcheon was the blue and stinking flame. + +6. The sixth captain was Captain Torment: he was captain over the +resurrection doubters; his colours were those that were pale; Mr. Gnaw +was his standard-bearer, and he had the black worm for his scutcheon. + +7. The seventh captain was Captain No-Ease; he was captain over the +salvation doubters; his were the red colours, Mr. Restless bare them, and +his scutcheon was the ghastly picture of death. + +8. The eighth captain was the Captain Sepulchre: he was captain over the +glory doubters; his also were the pale colours, Mr. Corruption was his +standard-bearer, and he had for his scutcheon a skull, and dead men’s +bones. + +9. The ninth captain was Captain Past-Hope; he was captain of those that +are called the felicity doubters; his standard-bearer was Mr. Despair; +his also were the red colours, and his scutcheon was a hot iron and the +hard heart. + +These were his captains, and these were their forces, these were their +standards, these were their colours, and these were their scutcheons. +Now, over these did the great Diabolus make superior captains, and they +were in number seven: as, namely, the Lord Beelzebub, the Lord Lucifer, +the Lord Legion, the Lord Apollyon, the Lord Python, the Lord Cerberus, +and the Lord Belial; these seven he set over the captains, and +Incredulity was lord-general, and, Diabolus was king. The reformades +also, such as were like themselves, were made some of them captains of +hundreds, and some of them captains of more. And thus was the army of +Incredulity completed. + +So they set out at Hell-Gate Hill, for there they had their rendezvous, +from whence they came with a straight course upon their march toward the +town of Mansoul. Now, as was hinted before, the town had, as Shaddai +would have it, received from the mouth of Mr. Prywell the alarm of their +coming before. Wherefore they set a strong watch at the gates, and had +also doubled their guards: they also mounted their slings in good places, +where they might conveniently cast out their great stones to the +annoyance of their furious enemy. + +Nor could those Diabolonians that were in the town do that hurt as was +designed they should; for Mansoul was now awake. But alas! poor people, +they were sorely affrighted at the first appearance of their foes, and at +their sitting down before the town, especially when they heard the +roaring of their drum. This, to speak truth, was amazingly hideous to +hear; it frighted all men seven miles round, if they were but awake and +heard it. The streaming of their colours was also terrible and dejecting +to behold. + +When Diabolus was come up against the town, first he made his approach to +Ear-gate, and gave it a furious assault, supposing, as it seems, that his +friends in Mansoul had been ready to do the work within; but care was +taken of that before, by the vigilance of the captains. Wherefore, +missing of the help that he expected from them, and finding his army +warmly attended with the stones that the slingers did sling, (for that I +will say for the captains, that considering the weakness that yet was +upon them by reason of the long sickness that had annoyed the town of +Mansoul, they did gallantly behave themselves,) he was forced to make +some retreat from Mansoul, and to entrench himself and his men in the +field without the reach of the slings of the town. + +Now having entrenched himself, he did cast up four mounts against the +town: the first he called Mount Diabolus, putting his own name thereon, +the more to affright the town of Mansoul; the other three he called +thus—Mount Alecto, Mount Megara, and Mount Tisiphone; for these are the +names of the dreadful furies of hell. Thus he began to play his game +with Mansoul, and to serve it as doth the lion his prey, even to make it +fall before his terror. But, as I said, the captains and soldiers +resisted so stoutly, and did do such execution with their stones, that +they made him, though against stomach, to retreat, wherefore Mansoul +began to take courage. + +Now upon Mount Diabolus, which was raised on the north side of the town, +there did the tyrant set up his standard, and a fearful thing it was to +behold; for he had wrought in it by devilish art, after the manner of a +scutcheon, a flaming flame fearful to behold, and the picture of Mansoul +burning in it. + +When Diabolus had thus done, he commanded that his drummer should every +night approach the walls of the town of Mansoul, and so to beat a parley; +the command was to do it at nights, for in the daytime they annoyed him +with their slings; for the tyrant said, that he had a mind to parley with +the now trembling town of Mansoul, and he commanded that the drums should +beat every night, that through weariness they might at last, if possible, +(at the first they were unwilling yet,) be forced to do it. + +So this drummer did as commanded: he arose, and did beat his drum. But +when his drum did go, if one looked toward the town of Mansoul, ‘Behold +darkness and sorrow, and the light was darkened in the heaven thereof.’ +No noise was ever heard upon earth more terrible, except the voice of +Shaddai when he speaketh. But how did Mansoul tremble! it now looked for +nothing but forthwith to be swallowed up. + +When this drummer had beaten for a parley, he made this speech to +Mansoul: ‘My master has bid me tell you, that if you will willingly +submit, you shall have the good of the earth; but if you shall be +stubborn, he is resolved to take you by force.’ But by that the fugitive +had done beating his drum, the people of Mansoul had betaken themselves +to the captains that were in the castle, so that there was none to +regard, nor to give this drummer an answer; so he proceeded no further +that night, but returned again to his master to the camp. + +When Diabolus saw that by drumming he could not work out Mansoul to his +will, the next night he sendeth his drummer without his drum, still to +let the townsmen know that he had a mind to parley with them. But when +all came to all, his parley was turned into a summons to the town to +deliver up themselves: but they gave him neither heed nor hearing: for +they remembered what at first it cost them to hear him a few words. + +The next night he sends again, and then who should be his messenger to +Mansoul but the terrible Captain Sepulchre; so Captain Sepulchre came up +to the walls of Mansoul, and made this oration to the town:— + +‘O ye inhabitants of the rebellious town of Mansoul! I summon you in the +name of the Prince Diabolus, that, without any more ado, you set open the +gates of your town, and admit the great lord to come in. But if you +shall still rebel, when we have taken to us the town by force, we will +swallow you up as the grave; wherefore if you will hearken to my summons, +say so, and if not then let me know. + +‘The reason of this my summons,’ quoth he, ‘is, for that my lord is your +undoubted prince and lord, as you yourselves have formerly owned. Nor +shall that assault that was given to my lord, when Emmanuel dealt so +dishonourably by him, prevail with him to lose his right, and to forbear +to attempt to recover his own. Consider, then, O Mansoul, with thyself, +wilt thou show thyself peaceable, or no? If thou shalt quietly yield up +thyself, then our old friendship shall be renewed; but if thou shalt yet +refuse and rebel, then expect nothing but fire and sword.’ + +When the languishing town of Mansoul had heard this summoner and his +summons, they were yet more put to their dumps, but made to the captain +no answer at all; so away he went as he came. + +But, after some consultation among themselves, as also with some of their +captains, they applied themselves afresh to the Lord Secretary for +counsel and advice from him; for this Lord Secretary was their chief +preacher, (as also is mentioned some pages before,) only now he was ill +at ease; and of him they begged favour in these two or three things— + +1. That he would look comfortably upon them, and not keep himself so much +retired from them as formerly. Also, that he would be prevailed with to +give them a hearing, while they should make known their miserable +condition to him. But to this he told them as before, that ‘as yet he +was but ill at ease, and therefore could not do as he had formerly done.’ + +2. The second thing that they desired was, that he would be pleased to +give them his advice about their now so important affairs, for that +Diabolus was come and set down before the town with no less than twenty +thousand doubters. They said, moreover, that both he and his captains +were cruel men, and that they were afraid of them. But to this he said, +‘You must look to the law of the Prince, and there see what is laid upon +you to do.’ + +3. Then they desired that his highness would help them to frame a +petition to Shaddai, and unto Emmanuel his Son, and that he would set his +own hand thereto as a token that he was one with them in it: ‘For,’ said +they, ‘my Lord, many a one have we sent, but can get no answer of peace; +but now, surely, one with thy hand unto it may obtain good for Mansoul.’ + +But all the answer that he gave to this was, ‘that they had offended +their Emmanuel, and had also grieved himself, and that therefore they +must as yet partake of their own devices.’ + +This answer of the Lord Secretary fell like a millstone upon them; yea, +it crushed them so that they could not tell what to do; yet they durst +not comply with the demands of Diabolus, nor with the demands of his +captain. So then here were the straits that the town of Mansoul was +betwixt, when the enemy came upon her: her foes were ready to swallow her +up, and her friends did forbear to help her. + +Then stood up my Lord Mayor, whose name was my Lord Understanding, and he +began to pick and pick, until he had picked comfort out of that seemingly +bitter saying of the Lord Secretary; for thus he descanted upon it: +‘First,’ said he, ‘this unavoidably follows upon the saying of my Lord, +“that we must yet suffer for our sins.” Secondly, But,’ quoth he, ‘the +words yet sound as if at last we should be saved from our enemies, and +that after a few more sorrows, Emmanuel will come and be our help.’ Now +the Lord Mayor was the more critical in his dealing with the Secretary’s +words, because my lord was more than a prophet, and because none of his +words were such, but that at all times they were most exactly +significant; and the townsmen were allowed to pry into them, and to +expound them to their best advantage. + +So they took their leaves of my lord, and returned, and went, and came to +the captains, to whom they did tell what my Lord High Secretary had said; +who, when they had heard it, were all of the same opinion as was my Lord +Mayor himself. The captains, therefore, began to take some courage unto +them, and to prepare to make some brave attempt upon the camp of the +enemy, and to destroy all that were Diabolonians, with the roving +doubters that the tyrant had brought with him to destroy the poor town of +Mansoul. + +So all betook themselves forthwith to their places—the Captains to +theirs, the Lord Mayor to his, the subordinate preacher to his, and my +Lord Willbewill to his. The captains longed to be at some work for their +prince; for they delighted in warlike achievements. The next day, +therefore, they came together and consulted; and after consultation had, +they resolved to give an answer to the captain of Diabolus with slings; +and so they did at the rising of the sun on the morrow; for Diabolus had +adventured to come nearer again, but the sling-stones were to him and his +like hornets. For as there is nothing to the town of Mansoul so terrible +as the roaring of Diabolus’s drum, so there is nothing to Diabolus so +terrible as the well playing of Emmanuel’s slings. Wherefore Diabolus +was forced to make another retreat, yet further off from the famous town +of Mansoul. Then did the Lord Mayor of Mansoul cause the bells to be +rung, ‘and that thanks should be sent to the Lord High Secretary by the +mouth of the subordinate preacher; for that by his words the captains and +elders of Mansoul had been strengthened against Diabolus.’ + +When Diabolus saw that his captains and soldiers, high lords and +renowned, were frightened, and beaten down by the stones that came from +the golden slings of the Prince of the town of Mansoul, he bethought +himself, and said, ‘I will try to catch them by fawning, I will try to +flatter them into my net.’ + +Wherefore, after a while, he came down again to the wall, not now with +his drum, nor with Captain Sepulchre; but having all besugared his lips, +he seemed to be a very sweet-mouthed, peaceable prince, designing nothing +for humour’s sake, nor to be revenged on Mansoul for injuries by them +done to him; but the welfare, and good, and advantage of the town and +people therein was now, as he said, his only design. Wherefore, after he +had called for audience, and desired that the townsfolk would give it to +him, he proceeded in his oration, and said:— + +‘Oh, the desire of my heart, the famous town of Mansoul! how many nights +have I watched, and how many weary steps have I taken, if perhaps I might +do thee good! Far be it, far be it from me to desire to make a war upon +you; if ye will but willingly and quietly deliver up yourselves unto me. +You know that you were mine of old. Remember also, that so long as you +enjoyed me for your lord, and that I enjoyed you for my subjects, you +wanted for nothing of all the delights of the earth, that I, your lord +and prince, could get for you, or that I could invent to make you bonny +and blithe withal. Consider, you never had so many hard, dark, +troublesome, and heart-afflicting hours, while you were mine, as you have +had since you revolted from me; nor shall you ever have peace again, +until you and I become one as before. But, be but prevailed with to +embrace me again, and I will grant, yea, enlarge your old charter with +abundance of privileges; so that your license and liberty shall be to +take, hold, enjoy, and make your own all that is pleasant from the east +to the west. Nor shall any of those incivilities, wherewith you have +offended me, be ever charged upon you by me, so long as the sun and moon +endure. Nor shall any of those dear friends of mine that now, for the +fear of you, lie lurking in dens, and holes, and caves in Mansoul, be +hurtful to you any more; yea, they shall be your servants, and shall +minister unto you of their substance, and of whatever shall come to hand. +I need speak no more; you know them, and have sometime since been much +delighted in their company. Why, then, should we abide at such odds? +Let us renew our old acquaintance and friendship again. + +‘Bear with your friend; I take the liberty at this time to speak thus +freely unto you. The love that I have to you presses me to do it, as +also does the zeal of my heart for my friends with you: put me not +therefore to further trouble, nor yourselves to further fears and +frights. Have you I will, in a way of peace or war; nor do you flatter +yourselves with the power and force of your captains, or that your +Emmanuel will shortly come in to your help; for such strength will do you +no pleasure. + +‘I am come against you with a stout and valiant army, and all the chief +princes of the den are even at the head of it. Besides, my captains are +swifter than eagles, stronger than lions, and more greedy of prey than +are the evening wolves. What is Og of Bashan! what is Goliath of Gath! +and what are an hundred more of them, to one of the least of my captains! +How, then, shall Mansoul think to escape my hand and force?’ + +Diabolus having thus handed his flattering, fawning, deceitful, and lying +speech to the famous town of Mansoul, the Lord Mayor replied to him as +follows: ‘O Diabolus, prince of darkness, and master of all deceit; thy +lying flatteries we have had and made sufficient probation of, and have +tasted too deeply of that destructive cup already. Should we therefore +again hearken unto thee, and so break the commandments of our great +Shaddai, to join in affinity with thee, would not our Prince reject us, +and cast us off for ever? And, being cast off by him, can the place that +he has prepared for thee be a place of rest for us? Besides, O thou that +art empty and void of all truth, we are rather ready to die by thy hand, +than to fall in with thy flattering and lying deceits.’ + +When the tyrant saw that there was little to be got by parleying with my +Lord Mayor, he fell into an hellish rage, and resolved that again, with +his army of doubters, he would another time assault the town of Mansoul. + +So he called for his drummer, who beat up for his men (and while he did +beat, Mansoul did shake) to be in a readiness to give battle to the +corporation: then Diabolus drew near with his army, and thus disposed of +his men. Captain Cruel and Captain Torment, these he drew up and placed +against Feel-gate, and commanded them to sit down there for the war. And +he also appointed that, if need were, Captain No-Ease should come in to +their relief. At Nose-gate he placed the Captain Brimstone and Captain +Sepulchre, and bid them look well to their ward, on that side of the town +of Mansoul. But at Eye-gate he placed that grim-faced one, the Captain +Past-Hope, and there also now he did set up his terrible standard. + +Now Captain Insatiable, he was to look to the carriages of Diabolus, and +was also appointed to take into custody that, or those persons and +things, that should at any time as prey be taken from the enemy. + +Now Mouth-gate the inhabitants of Mansoul kept for a sally-port; +wherefore that they kept strong; for that it was it by and out at which +the townsfolk did send their petitions to Emmanuel their Prince. That +also was the gate from the top of which the captains did play their +slings at the enemies; for that gate stood somewhat ascending, so that +the placing of them there, and the letting of them fly from that place, +did much execution against the tyrant’s army. Wherefore, for these +causes, with others, Diabolus sought, if possible, to land up Mouth-gate +with dirt. + +Now, as Diabolus was busy and industrious in preparing to make his +assault upon the town of Mansoul, without, so the captains and soldiers +in the corporation were as busy in preparing within; they mounted their +slings, they set up their banners, they sounded their trumpets, and put +themselves in such order as was judged most for the annoyance of the +enemy, and for the advantage of Mansoul, and gave to their soldiers +orders to be ready at the sound of the trumpet for war. The Lord +Willbewill also, he took the charge of watching against the rebels +within, and to do what he could to take them while without, or to stifle +them within their caves, dens, and holes in the town-wall of Mansoul. +And, to speak the truth of him, ever since he took penance for his fault, +he has showed as much honesty and bravery of spirit as any he in Mansoul; +for he took one Jolly, and his brother Griggish, the two sons of his +servant Harmless-Mirth, (for to that day, though the father was committed +to ward, the sons had a dwelling in the house of my lord,)—I say, he took +them, and with his own hands put them to the cross. And this was the +reason why he hanged them up: after their father was put into the hands +of Mr. True-Man the gaoler, they, his sons, began to play his pranks, and +to be ticking and toying with the daughters of their lord; nay, it was +jealoused that they were too familiar with them, the which was brought to +his lordship’s ear. Now his lordship being unwilling unadvisedly to put +any man to death, did not suddenly fall upon them, but set watch and +spies to see if the thing was true; of the which he was soon informed, +for his two servants, whose names were Find-Out and Tell-All, catched +them together in uncivil manner more than once or twice, and went and +told their lord. So when my Lord Willbewill had sufficient ground to +believe the thing was true, he takes the two young Diabolonians, (for +such they were, for their father was a Diabolonian born,) and has them to +Eye-gate, where he raised a very high cross, just in the face of +Diabolus, and of his army, and there he hanged the young villains, in +defiance to Captain Past-Hope, and of the horrible standard of the +tyrant. + +Now this Christian act of the brave Lord Willbewill did greatly abash +Captain Past-Hope, discouraged the army of Diabolus, put fear into the +Diabolonian runagates in Mansoul, and put strength and courage into the +captains that belonged to Emmanuel, the Prince; for they without did +gather, and that by this very act of my Lord, that Mansoul was resolved +to fight, and that the Diabolonians within the town could not do such +things as Diabolus had hopes they would. Nor was this the only proof of +the brave Lord Willbewill’s honesty to the town, nor of his loyalty to +his Prince, as will afterwards appear. + +Now, when the children of Prudent-Thrifty, who dwelt with Mr. Mind, (for +Thrift left children with Mr. Mind, when he was also committed to prison, +and their names were Gripe and Rake-All; these he begat of Mr. Mind’s +bastard daughter, whose name was Mrs. Hold-fast-Bad;)—I say, when his +children perceived how the Lord Willbewill had served them that dwelt +with him, what do they but, lest they should drink of the same cup, +endeavour to make their escape. But Mr. Mind, being wary of it, took +them and put them in hold in his house till morning; (for this was done +over night;) and remembering that by the law of Mansoul all Diabolonians +were to die, (and to be sure they were at least by father’s side such, +and some say by mother’s side too,) what does he but takes them and puts +them in chains, and carries them to the selfsame place where my lord +hanged his two before, and there he hanged them. + +The townsmen also took great encouragement at this act of Mr. Mind, and +did what they could to have taken some more of these Diabolonian +troublers of Mansoul; but at that time the rest lay so squat and close, +that they could not be apprehended; so they set against them a diligent +watch, and went every man to his place. + +I told you a little before, that Diabolus and his army were somewhat +abashed and discouraged at the sight of what my Lord Willbewill did, when +he hanged up those two young Diabolonians; but his discouragement quickly +turned itself into furious madness and rage against the town of Mansoul, +and fight it he would. Also the townsmen and captains within, they had +their hopes and their expectations heightened, believing at last the day +would be theirs; so they feared them the less. Their subordinate +preacher, too, made a sermon about it; and he took that theme for his +text, ‘Gad, a troop shall overcome him: but he shall overcome at the +last.’ Whence he showed, that though Mansoul should be sorely put to it +at the first, yet the victory should most certainly be Mansoul’s at the +last. + +So Diabolus commanded that his drummer should beat a charge against the +town; and the captains also that were in the town sounded a charge +against them, but they had no drum: they were trumpets of silver with +which they sounded against them. Then they which were of the camp of +Diabolus came down to the town to take it, and the captains in the +castle, with the slingers at Mouth-gate, played upon them amain. And now +there was nothing heard in the camp of Diabolus but horrible rage and +blasphemy; but in the town good words, prayer, and singing of psalms. +The enemy replied with horrible objections, and the terribleness of their +drum; but the town made answer with the slapping of their slings, and the +melodious noise of their trumpets. And thus the fight lasted for several +days together, only now and then they had some small intermission, in the +which the townsmen refreshed themselves, and the captains made ready for +another assault. + +The captains of Emmanuel were clad in silver armour, and the soldiers in +that which was of proof; the soldiers of Diabolus were clad in iron which +was made to give place to Emmanuel’s engine-shot. In the town, some were +hurt, and some were greatly wounded. Now, the worst of it was, a +chirurgeon was scarce in Mansoul, for that Emmanuel at present was +absent. Howbeit, with the leaves of a tree the wounded were kept from +dying; yet their wounds did greatly putrefy, and some did grievously +stink. Of the townsmen, these were wounded, namely, my Lord Reason; he +was wounded in the head. Another that was wounded was the brave Lord +Mayor; he was wounded in the eye. Another that was wounded was Mr. Mind; +he received his wound about the stomach. The honest subordinate preacher +also, he received a shot not far off the heart but none of these were +mortal. + +Many also of the inferior sort were not only wounded but slain outright. + +Now, in the camp of Diabolus were wounded and slain a considerable +number; for instance, Captain Rage, he was wounded, and so was Captain +Cruel. Captain Damnation was made to retreat, and to intrench himself +further off of Mansoul. The standard also of Diabolus was beaten down, +and his standard-bearer, Captain Much-Hurt, had his brains beat out with +a sling-stone, to the no little grief and shame of his prince Diabolus. + +Many also of the doubters were slain outright, though enough of them were +left alive to make Mansoul shake and totter. Now the victory that day +being turned to Mansoul, did put great valour into the townsmen and +captains, and did cover Diabolus’s camp with a cloud, but withal it made +them far more furious. So the next day Mansoul rested, and commanded +that the bells should be rung; the trumpets also joyfully sounded, and +the captains shouted round the town. + +My Lord Willbewill also was not idle, but did notable service within +against the domestics, or the Diabolonians that were in the town, not +only by keeping them in awe, for he lighted on one at last whose name was +Mr. Anything, a fellow of whom mention was made before; for it was he, if +you remember, that brought the three fellows to Diabolus, whom the +Diabolonians took out of Captain Boanerges’s companies, and that +persuaded them to list themselves under the tyrant, to fight against the +army of Shaddai. My Lord Willbewill did also take a notable Diabolonian, +whose name was Loose-Foot: this Loose-Foot was a scout to the vagabonds +in Mansoul, and that did use to carry tidings out of Mansoul to the camp, +and out of the camp to those of the enemies in Mansoul. Both these my +lord sent away safe to Mr. True-Man, the gaoler, with a commandment to +keep them in irons; for he intended then to have them out to be +crucified, when it would be for the best to the corporation, and most for +the discouragement of the camp of the enemies. + +My Lord Mayor also, though he could not stir about so much as formerly, +because of the wound that he lately received, yet gave he out orders to +all that were the natives of Mansoul, to look to their watch, and stand +upon their guard, and, as occasion should offer, to prove themselves men. + +Mr. Conscience, the preacher, he also did his utmost to keep all his good +documents alive upon the hearts of the people of Mansoul. + +Well, awhile after, the captains and stout ones of the town of Mansoul +agreed and resolved upon a time to make a sally out upon the camp of +Diabolus, and this must be done in the night; and there was the folly of +Mansoul, (for the night is always the best for the enemy, but the worst +for Mansoul to fight in,) but yet they would do it, their courage was so +high; their last victory also still stuck in their memories. + +So the night appointed being come, the Prince’s brave captains cast lots +who should lead the van in this new and desperate expedition against +Diabolus, and against his Diabolonian army; and the lot fell to Captain +Credence, to Captain Experience, and to Captain Good-Hope, to lead the +forlorn hope. (This Captain Experience the Prince created such when +himself did reside in the town of Mansoul.) So, as I said, they made +their sally out upon the army that lay in the siege against them; and +their hap was to fall in with the main body of their enemies. Now +Diabolus and his men being expertly accustomed to night-work, took the +alarm presently, and were as ready to give them battle, as if they had +sent them word of their coming. Wherefore to it they went amain, and +blows were hard on every side; the hell drum also was beat most +furiously, while the trumpets of the Prince most sweetly sounded. And +thus the battle was joined; and Captain Insatiable looked to the enemy’s +carriages, and waited when he should receive some prey. + +The Prince’s captains fought it stoutly, beyond what indeed could be +expected they should; they wounded many; they made the whole army of +Diabolus to make a retreat. But I cannot tell how, but the brave Captain +Credence, Captain Good-Hope, and Captain Experience, as they were upon +the pursuit, cutting down, and following hard after the enemy in the +rear, Captain Credence stumbled and fell, by which fall he caught so +great a hurt, that he could not rise till Captain Experience did help him +up, at which their men were put in disorder. The captain also was so +full of pain, that he could not forbear but aloud to cry out: at this, +the other two captains fainted, supposing that Captain Credence had +received his mortal wound; their men also were more disordered, and had +no list to fight. Now Diabolus being very observing, though at this time +as yet he was put to the worst, perceiving that a halt was made among the +men that were the pursuers, what does he but, taking it for granted that +the captains were either wounded or dead, he therefore makes at first a +stand, then faces about, and so comes up upon the Prince’s army with as +much of his fury as hell could help him to; and his hap was to fall in +just among the three captains, Captain Credence, Captain Good-Hope, and +Captain Experience, and did cut, wound, and pierce them so dreadfully, +that what through discouragement, what through disorder, and what through +the wounds that they had received, and also the loss of much blood, they +scarce were able, though they had for their power the three best hands in +Mansoul, to get safe into the hold again. + +Now, when the body of the Prince’s army saw how these three captains were +put to the worst, they thought it their wisdom to make as safe and good a +retreat as they could, and so returned by the sally-port again; and so +there was an end of this present action. But Diabolus was so flushed +with this night’s work, that he promised himself, in few days, an easy +and complete conquest over the town of Mansoul; wherefore, on the day +following, he comes up to the sides thereof with great boldness, and +demands entrance, and that forthwith they deliver themselves up to his +government. The Diabolonians, too, that were within, they began to be +somewhat brisk, as we shall show afterward. + +But the valiant Lord Mayor replied, that what he got he must get by +force; for as long as Emmanuel, their Prince, was alive, (though he at +present was not so with them as they wished,) they should never consent +to yield Mansoul up to another. + +And with that the Lord Willbewill stood up, and said, ‘Diabolus, thou +master of the den, and enemy to all that is good, we poor inhabitants of +the town of Mansoul are too well acquainted with thy rule and government, +and with the end of those things that for certain will follow submitting +to thee, to do it. Wherefore though while we were without knowledge we +suffered thee to take us, (as the bird that saw not the snare fell into +the hands of the fowler,) yet since we have been turned from darkness to +light, we have also been turned from the power of Satan to God. And +though through thy subtlety, and also the subtlety of the Diabolonians +within, we have sustained much loss, and also plunged ourselves into much +perplexity, yet give up ourselves, lay down our arms, and yield to so +horrid a tyrant as thou, we shall not; die upon the place we choose +rather to do. Besides, we have hopes that in time deliverance will come +from court unto us, and therefore we yet will maintain a war against +thee.’ + +This brave speech of the Lord Willbewill, with that also of the Lord +Mayor, did somewhat abate the boldness of Diabolus, though it kindled the +fury of his rage. It also succoured the townsmen and captains; yea, it +was as a plaster to the brave Captain Credence’s wound; for you must know +that a brave speech now (when the captains of the town with their men of +war came home routed, and when the enemy took courage and boldness at the +success that he had obtained to draw up to the walls, and demand +entrance, as he did) was in season, and also advantageous. + +The Lord Willbewill also did play the man within; for while the captains +and soldiers were in the field, he was in arms in the town, and wherever +by him there was a Diabolonian found, they were forced to feel the weight +of his heavy hand, and also the edge of his penetrating sword: many +therefore of the Diabolonians he wounded, as the Lord Cavil, the Lord +Brisk, the Lord Pragmatic, and the Lord Murmur; several also of the +meaner sort he did sorely maim; though there cannot at this time an +account be given you of any that he slew outright. The cause, or rather +the advantage that my Lord Willbewill had at this time to do thus, was +for that the captains were gone out to fight the enemy in the field. +‘For now,’ thought the Diabolonians within, ‘is our time to stir and make +an uproar in the town.’ What do they therefore but quickly get +themselves into a body, and fall forthwith to hurricaning in Mansoul, as +if now nothing but whirlwind and tempest should be there. Wherefore, as +I said, he takes this opportunity to fall in among them with his men, +cutting and slashing with courage that was undaunted; at which the +Diabolonians with all haste dispersed themselves to their holds, and my +lord to his place as before. + +This brave act of my lord did somewhat revenge the wrong done by Diabolus +to the captains, and also did let them know that Mansoul was not to be +parted with for the loss of a victory or two; wherefore the wing of the +tyrant was clipped again, as to boasting,—I mean in comparison of what he +would have done, if the Diabolonians had put the town to the same plight +to which he had put the captains. + +Well, Diabolus yet resolves to have the other bout with Mansoul. ‘For,’ +thought he, ‘since I beat them once, I may beat them twice.’ Wherefore +he commanded his men to be ready at such an hour of the night, to make a +fresh assault upon the town; and he gave it out in special that they +should bend all their force against Feel-gate, and attempt to break into +the town through that. The word that then he did give to his officers +and soldiers was Hell-fire. ‘And,’ said he, ‘if we break in upon them, +as I wish we do, either with some, or with all our force, let them that +break in look to it, that they forget not the word. And let nothing be +heard in the town of Mansoul but, “Hell-fire! Hell-fire! Hell-fire!”’ +The drummer was also to beat without ceasing, and the standard-bearers +were to display their colours; the soldiers, too, were to put on what +courage they could, and to see that they played manfully their parts +against the town. + +So when night was come, and all things by the tyrant made ready for the +work, he suddenly makes his assault upon Feel-gate, and after he had +awhile struggled there, he throws the gate wide open: for the truth is, +those gates were but weak, and so most easily made to yield. When +Diabolus had thus far made his attempt, he placed his captains (namely, +Torment and No-Ease) there; so he attempted to press forward, but the +Prince’s captains came down upon him, and made his entrance more +difficult than he desired. And, to speak truth, they made what +resistance they could; but the three of their best and most valiant +captains being wounded, and by their wounds made much incapable of doing +the town that service they would, (and all the rest having more than +their hands full of the doubters, and their captains that did follow +Diabolus,) they were overpowered with force, nor could they keep them out +of the town. Wherefore the Prince’s men and their captains betook +themselves to the castle, as to the stronghold of the town: and this they +did partly for their own security, partly for the security of the town, +and partly, or rather chiefly, to preserve to Emmanuel the +prerogative-royal of Mansoul; for so was the castle of Mansoul. + +The captains therefore being fled into the castle, the enemy, without +much resistance, possess themselves of the rest of the town, and +spreading themselves as they went into every corner, they cried out as +they marched, according to the command of the tyrant, ‘Hell-fire! +Hell-fire! Hell-fire!’ so that nothing for a while throughout the town of +Mansoul could be heard but the direful noise of ‘Hell-fire!’ together +with the roaring of Diabolus’s drum. And now did the clouds hang black +over Mansoul, nor to reason did anything but ruin seem to attend it. +Diabolus also quartered his soldiers in the houses of the inhabitants of +the town of Mansoul. Yea, the subordinate preacher’s house was as full +of these outlandish doubters as ever it could hold, and so was my Lord +Mayor’s, and my Lord Willbewill’s also. Yea, where was there a corner, a +cottage, a barn, or a hogstye, that now was not full of these vermin? +Yea, they turned the men of the town out of their houses, and would lie +in their beds, and sit at their tables themselves. Ah, poor Mansoul! now +thou feelest the fruits of sin, yea, what venom was in the flattering +words of Mr. Carnal-Security! They made great havoc of whatever they +laid their hands on; yea, they fired the town in several places; many +young children also were by them dashed in pieces; and those that were +yet unborn they destroyed in their mothers’ wombs: for you must needs +think that it could not now be otherwise; for what conscience, what pity, +what bowels of compassion can any expect at the hands of outlandish +doubters? Many in Mansoul that were women, both young and old, they +forced, ravished, and beastlike abused, so that they swooned, miscarried, +and many of them died, and so lay at the top of every street, and in all +by-places of the town. + +And now did Mansoul seem to be nothing but a den of dragons, an emblem of +hell, and a place of total darkness. Now did Mansoul lie almost like the +barren wilderness; nothing but nettles, briars, thorns, weeds, and +stinking things seemed now to cover the face of Mansoul. I told you +before, how that these Diabolonian doubters turned the men of Mansoul out +of their beds, and now I will add, they wounded them, they mauled them, +yea, and almost brained many of them. Many did I say, yea most, if not +all of them. Mr. Conscience they so wounded, yea, and his wounds so +festered, that he could have no ease day nor night, but lay as if +continually upon a rack; but that Shaddai rules all, certainly they had +slain him outright. Mr. Lord Mayor they so abused that they almost put +out his eyes; and had not my Lord Willbewill got into the castle, they +intended to have chopped him all to pieces; for they did look upon him, +as his heart now stood, to be one of the very worst that was in Mansoul +against Diabolus and his crew. And indeed he hath shown himself a man, +and more of his exploits you will hear of afterwards. + +Now, a man might have walked for days together in Mansoul, and scarcely +have seen one in the town that looked like a religious man. Oh, the +fearful state of Mansoul now! now every corner swarmed with outlandish +doubters; red-coats and black-coats walked the town by clusters, and +filled up all the houses with hideous noises, vain songs, lying stories, +and blasphemous language against Shaddai and his Son. Now also those +Diabolonians that lurked in the walls and dens and holes that were in the +town of Mansoul, came forth and showed themselves; yea, walked with open +face in company with the doubters that were in Mansoul. Yea, they had +more boldness now to walk the streets, to haunt the houses, and to show +themselves abroad, than had any of the honest inhabitants of the now +woful town of Mansoul. + +But Diabolus and his outlandish men were not at peace in Mansoul; for +they were not there entertained as were the captains and forces of +Emmanuel: the townsmen did browbeat them what they could; nor did they +partake or make stroy of any of the necessaries of Mansoul, but that +which they seized on against the townsmen’s will: what they could, they +hid from them, and what they could not, they had with an ill-will. They, +poor hearts! had rather have had their room than their company; but they +were at present their captives, and their captives for the present they +were forced to be. But, I say, they discountenanced them as much as they +were able, and showed them all the dislike that they could. + +The captains also from the castle did hold them in continual play with +their slings, to the chafing and fretting of the minds of the enemies. +True, Diabolus made a great many attempts to have broken open the gates +of the castle, but Mr. Godly-Fear was made the keeper of that; and he was +a man of that courage, conduct, and valour, that it was in vain, as long +as life lasted within him, to think to do that work, though mostly +desired; wherefore all the attempts that Diabolus made against him were +fruitless. I have wished sometimes that that man had had the whole rule +of the town of Mansoul. + +Well, this was the condition of the town of Mansoul for about two years +and a half: the body of the town was the seat of war, the people of the +town were driven into holes, and the glory of Mansoul was laid in the +dust. What rest, then, could be to the inhabitants, what peace could +Mansoul have, and what sun could shine upon it? Had the enemy lain so +long without in the plain against the town, it had been enough to have +famished them: but now, when they shall be within, when the town shall be +their tent, their trench and fort against the castle that was in the +town; when the town shall be against the town, and shall serve to be a +defence to the enemies of her strength and life: I say, when they shall +make use of the forts and town-holds to secure themselves in, even till +they shall take, spoil, and demolish the castle,—this was terrible! and +yet this was now the state of the town of Mansoul. + +After the town of Mansoul had been in this sad and lamentable condition, +for so long a time as I have told you, and no petitions that they +presented their Prince with, all this while, could prevail, the +inhabitants of the town, namely, the elders and chief of Mansoul, +gathered together, and, after some time spent in condoling their +miserable state and this miserable judgment coming upon them, they agreed +together to draw up yet another petition, and to send it away to Emmanuel +for relief. But Mr. Godly-Fear stood up and answered, that he knew that +his Lord the Prince never did nor ever would receive a petition for these +matters, from the hand of any whoever, unless the Lord Secretary’s hand +was to it; ‘and this,’ quoth he, ‘is the reason that you prevailed not +all this while.’ Then they said they would draw up one, and get the Lord +Secretary’s hand unto it. But Mr. Godly-Fear answered again, that he +knew also that the Lord Secretary would not set his hand to any petition +that himself had not an hand in composing and drawing up. ‘And besides,’ +said he, ‘the Prince doth know my Lord Secretary’s hand from all the +hands in the world; wherefore he cannot be deceived by any pretence +whatever. Wherefore my advice is that you go to my Lord, and implore him +to lend you his aid.’ (Now he did yet abide in the castle, where all the +captains and men-at-arms were.) + +So they heartily thanked Mr. Godly-Fear, took his counsel, and did as he +had bidden them. So they went and came to my Lord, and made known the +cause of their coming to him; namely, that since Mansoul was in so +deplorable a condition, his Highness would be pleased to undertake to +draw up a petition for them to Emmanuel, the Son of the mighty Shaddai, +and to their King and his Father by him. + +Then said the Secretary to them, ‘What petition is it that you would have +me draw up for you?’ But they said, ‘Our Lord knows best the state and +condition of the town of Mansoul; and how we are backslidden and +degenerated from the Prince: thou also knowest who is come up to war +against us, and how Mansoul is now the seat of war. My Lord knows, +moreover, what barbarous usages our men, women, and children have +suffered at their hands; and how our homebred Diabolonians do walk now +with more boldness than dare the townsmen in the streets of Mansoul. Let +our Lord therefore, according to the wisdom of God that is in him, draw +up a petition for his poor servants to our Prince Emmanuel.’ ‘Well,’ +said the Lord Secretary, ‘I will draw up a petition for you, and will +also set my hand thereto.’ Then said they, ‘But when shall we call for +it at the hands of our Lord?’ But he answered, ‘Yourselves must be +present at the doing of it; yea, you must put your desires to it. True, +the hand and pen shall be mine, but the ink and paper must be yours; else +how can you say it is your petition? Nor have I need to petition for +myself, because I have not offended.’ He also added as followeth: ‘No +petition goes from me in my name to the Prince, and so to his Father by +him, but when the people that are chiefly concerned therein do join in +heart and soul in the matter, for that must be inserted therein.’ + +So they did heartily agree with the sentence of the Lord, and a petition +was forthwith drawn up for them. But now, who should carry it? that was +next. But the Secretary advised that Captain Credence should carry it; +for he was a well-spoken man. They therefore called for him, and +propounded to him the business. ‘Well,’ said the captain, ‘I gladly +accept of the motion; and though I am lame, I will do this business for +you with as much speed, and as well as I can.’ + +The contents of the petition were to this purpose + +‘O our Lord, and Sovereign Prince Emmanuel, the potent, the +long-suffering Prince! grace is poured into thy lips, and to thee belong +mercy and forgiveness, though we have rebelled against thee. We, who are +no more worthy to be called thy Mansoul, nor yet fit to partake of common +benefits, do beseech thee, and thy Father by thee, to do away our +transgressions. We confess that thou mightest cast us away for them; but +do it not for thy name’s sake: let the Lord rather take an opportunity, +at our miserable condition, to let out his bowels and compassions to us. +We are compassed on every side, Lord; our own backslidings reprove us; +our Diabolonians within our town fright us; and the army of the angel of +the bottomless pit distresses us. Thy grace can be our salvation, and +whither to go but to thee we know not. + +‘Furthermore, O gracious Prince, we have weakened our captains, and they +are discouraged, sick, and, of late, some of them grievously worsted and +beaten out of the field by the power and force of the tyrant. Yea, even +those of our captains, in whose valour we did formerly use to put most of +our confidence, they are as wounded men. Besides, Lord, our enemies are +lively, and they are strong; they vaunt and boast themselves, and do +threaten to part us among themselves for a booty. They are fallen also +upon us, Lord, with many thousand doubters, such as with whom we cannot +tell what to do; they are all grim-looked and unmerciful ones, and they +bid defiance to us and thee. + +‘Our wisdom is gone, our power is gone, because thou art departed from +us; nor have we what we may call ours but sin, shame, and confusion of +face for sin. Take pity upon us, O Lord, take pity upon us, thy +miserable town of Mansoul, and save us out of the hands of our enemies. +Amen.’ + +This petition, as was touched afore, was handed by the Lord Secretary, +and carried to the court by the brave and most stout Captain Credence. +Now he carried it out at Mouth-gate, (for that, as I said, was the +sally-port of the town,) and he went and came to Emmanuel with it. Now +how it came out, I do not know; but for certain it did, and that so far +as to reach the ears of Diabolus. Thus I conclude, because that the +tyrant had it presently by the end, and charged the town of Mansoul with +it, saying, ‘Thou rebellious and stubborn-hearted Mansoul, I will make +thee to leave off petitioning. Art thou yet for petitioning? I will +make thee to leave.’ Yea, he also knew who the messenger was that +carried the petition to the Prince, and it made him both to fear and +rage. + +Wherefore he commanded that his drum should be beat again, a thing that +Mansoul could not abide to hear: but when Diabolus will have his drum +beat, Mansoul must abide the noise. Well, the drum was beat, and the +Diabolonians were gathered together. + +Then said Diabolus, ‘O ye stout Diabolonians, be it known unto you, that +there is treachery hatched against us in the rebellious town of Mansoul; +for albeit the town is in our possession, as you see, yet these miserable +Mansoulians have attempted to dare, and have been so hardy as yet to send +to the court to Emmanuel for help. This I give you to understand, that +ye may yet know how to carry it to the wretched town of Mansoul. +Wherefore, O my trusty Diabolonians, I command that yet more and more ye +distress this town of Mansoul, and vex it with your wiles, ravish their +women, deflower their virgins, slay their children, brain their ancients, +fire their town, and what other mischief you can; and let this be the +reward of the Mansoulians from me, for their desperate rebellions against +me.’ + +This, you see, was the charge; but something stepped in betwixt that and +execution, for as yet there was but little more done than to rage. + +Moreover, when Diabolus had done thus, he went the next way up to the +castle gates, and demanded that, upon pain of death, the gates should be +opened to him, and that entrance should be given him and his men that +followed after. To whom Mr. Godly-Fear replied, (for he it was that had +the charge of that gate,) that the gate should not be opened unto him, +nor to the men that followed after him. He said, moreover, that Mansoul, +when she had suffered awhile, should be made perfect, strengthened, +settled. + +Then said Diabolus, ‘Deliver me, then, the men that have petitioned +against me, especially Captain Credence, that carried it to your Prince; +deliver that varlet into my hands, and I will depart from the town.’ + +Then up starts a Diabolonian, whose name was Mr. Fooling, and said, ‘My +lord offereth you fair: it is better for you that one man perish, than +that your whole Mansoul should be undone.’ + +But Mr. Godly-Fear made him this replication, ‘How long will Mansoul be +kept out of the dungeon, when she hath given up her faith to Diabolus! +As good lose the town, as lose Captain Credence; for if one be gone the +other must follow.’ But to that Mr. Fooling said nothing. + +Then did my Lord Mayor reply, and said, ‘O thou devouring tyrant, be it +known unto thee, we shall hearken to none of thy words; we are resolved +to resist thee as long as a captain, a man, a sling, and a stone to throw +at thee shall be found in the town of Mansoul.’ But Diabolus answered, +‘Do you hope, do you wait, do you look for help and deliverance? You +have sent to Emmanuel, but your wickedness sticks too close in your +skirts, to let innocent prayers come out of your lips. Think you that +you shall be prevailers and prosper in this design? You will fail in +your wish, you will fail in your attempts; for it is not only I, but your +Emmanuel is against you: yea, it is he that hath sent me against you to +subdue you. For what, then, do you hope? or by what means will you +escape?’ + +Then said the Lord Mayor, ‘We have sinned indeed; but that shall be no +help to thee, for our Emmanuel hath said it, and that in great +faithfulness, “and him that cometh to me I will in no wise cast out.” He +hath also told us, O our enemy, that “all manner of sin and blasphemy +shall be forgiven” to the sons of men. Therefore we dare not despair, +but will look for, wait for, and hope for deliverance still.’ + +Now, by this time, Captain Credence was returned and come from the court +from Emmanuel to the castle of Mansoul, and he returned to them with a +packet. So my Lord Mayor, hearing that Captain Credence was come, +withdrew himself from the noise of the roaring of the tyrant, and left +him to yell at the wall of the town, or against the gates of the castle. +So he came up to the captain’s lodgings, and saluting him, he asked him +of his welfare, and what was the best news at court. But when he asked +Captain Credence that, the water stood in his eyes. Then said the +captain, ‘Cheer up, my lord, for all will be well in time.’ And with +that he first produced his packet, and laid it by; but that the Lord +Mayor, and the rest of the captains, took for sign of good tidings. Now +a season of grace being come, he sent for all the captains and elders of +the town, that were here and there in their lodgings in the castle and +upon their guard, to let them know that Captain Credence was returned +from the court, and that he had something in general, and something in +special, to communicate to them. So they all came up to him, and saluted +him, and asked him concerning his journey, and what was the best news at +the court. And he answered them as he had done the Lord Mayor before, +that all would be well at last. Now, when the captain had thus saluted +them, he opened his packet, and thence did draw out his several notes for +those that he had sent for. + +And the first note was for my Lord Mayor, wherein was signified:—That the +Prince Emmanuel had taken it well that my Lord Mayor had been so true and +trusty in his office, and the great concerns that lay upon him for the +town and people of Mansoul. Also, he bid him to know, that he took it +well that he had been so bold for his Prince Emmanuel, and had engaged so +faithfully in his cause against Diabolus. He also signified, at the +close of his letter, that he should shortly receive his reward. + +The second note that came out, was for the noble Lord Willbewill, wherein +there was signified:—That his Prince Emmanuel did well understand how +valiant and courageous he had been for the honour of his Lord, now in his +absence, and when his name was under contempt by Diabolus. There was +signified also, that his Prince had taken it well that he had been so +faithful to the town of Mansoul, in his keeping of so strict a hand and +eye over and so strict a rein upon the neck of the Diabolonians, that did +still lie lurking in their several holes in the famous town of Mansoul. +He signified, moreover, how that he understood that my Lord had, with his +own hand, done great execution upon some of the chief of the rebels +there, to the great discouragement of the adverse party and to the good +example of the whole town of Mansoul; and that shortly his lordship +should have his reward. + +The third note came out for the subordinate preacher, wherein was +signified:—That his Prince took it well from him, that he had so honestly +and so faithfully performed his office, and executed the trust committed +to him by his Lord, while he exhorted, rebuked, and forewarned Mansoul +according to the laws of the town. He signified, moreover, that he took +it well at his hand that he called to fasting, to sackcloth, and ashes, +when Mansoul was under her revolt. Also, that he called for the aid of +the Captain Boanerges to help in so weighty a work; and that shortly he +also should receive his reward. + +The fourth note came out for Mr. Godly-Fear, wherein his Lord thus +signified:—That his Lordship observed, that he was the first of all the +men in Mansoul that detected Mr. Carnal-Security as the only one that, +through his subtlety and cunning, had obtained for Diabolus a defection +and decay of goodness in the blessed town of Mansoul. Moreover, his Lord +gave him to understand, that he still remembered his tears and mourning +for the state of Mansoul. It was also observed, by the same note, that +his Lord took notice of his detecting of this Mr. Carnal-Security, at his +own table among his guests, in his own house, and that in the midst of +his jolliness, even while he was seeking to perfect his villanies against +the town of Mansoul. Emmanuel also took notice that this reverend +person, Mr. Godly-Fear, stood stoutly to it, at the gates of the castle, +against all the threats and attempts of the tyrant; and that he had put +the townsmen in a way to make their petition to their Prince, so as that +he might accept thereof, and as they might obtain an answer of peace; and +that therefore shortly he should receive his reward. + +After all this, there was yet produced a note which was written to the +whole town of Mansoul, whereby they perceived—That their Lord took notice +of their so often repeating of petitions to him; and that they should see +more of the fruits of such their doings in time to come. Their Prince +did also therein tell them, that he took it well, that their heart and +mind, now at last, abode fixed upon him and his ways, though Diabolus had +made such inroads upon them; and that neither flatteries on the one hand, +nor hardships on the other, could make them yield to serve his cruel +designs. There was also inserted at the bottom of this note—That his +Lordship had left the town of Mansoul in the hands of the Lord Secretary, +and under the conduct of Captain Credence, saying, ‘Beware that you yet +yield yourselves unto their governance; and in due time you shall receive +your reward.’ + +So, after the brave Captain Credence had delivered his notes to those to +whom they belonged, he retired himself to my Lord Secretary’s lodgings, +and there spends time in conversing with him; for they too were very +great one with another, and did indeed know more how things would go with +Mansoul than did all the townsmen besides. The Lord Secretary also loved +the Captain Credence dearly; yea, many a good bit was sent him from my +Lord’s table; also, he might have a show of countenance, when the rest of +Mansoul lay under the clouds: so, after some time for converse was spent, +the captain betook himself to his chambers to rest. But it was not long +after when my Lord did send for the captain again; so the captain came to +him, and they greeted one another with usual salutations. Then said the +captain to the Lord Secretary, ‘What hath my Lord to say to his servant?’ +So the Lord Secretary took him and had him aside, and after a sign or two +of more favour, he said, ‘I have made thee the Lord’s lieutenant over all +the forces in Mansoul; so that, from this day forward, all men in Mansoul +shall be at thy word; and thou shalt be he that shall lead in, and that +shall lead out Mansoul. Thou shalt therefore manage, according to thy +place, the war for thy Prince, and for the town of Mansoul, against the +force and power of Diabolus; and at thy command shall the rest of the +captains be.’ + +Now the townsmen began to perceive what interest the captain had, both +with the court, and also with the Lord Secretary in Mansoul; for no man +before could speed when sent, nor bring such good news from Emmanuel as +he. Wherefore what do they, after some lamentation that they made no +more use of him in their distresses, but send by their subordinate +preacher to the Lord Secretary, to desire him that all that ever they +were and had might be put under the government, care, custody, and +conduct of Captain Credence. + +So their preacher went and did his errand, and received this answer from +the mouth of his Lord: that Captain Credence should be the great doer in +all the King’s army, against the King’s enemies, and also for the welfare +of Mansoul. So he bowed to the ground, and thanked his Lordship, and +returned and told his news to the townsfolk. But all this was done with +all imaginable secrecy, because the foes had yet great strength in the +town. But to return to our story again. + +When Diabolus saw himself thus boldly confronted by the Lord Mayor, and +perceived the stoutness of Mr. Godly-Fear, he fell into a rage, and +forthwith called a council of war, that he might be revenged on Mansoul. +So all the princes of the pit came together, and old Incredulity at the +head of them, with all the captains of his army. So they consult what to +do. Now the effect and conclusion of the council that day was how they +might take the castle, because they could not conclude themselves masters +of the town so long as that was in the possession of their enemies. + +So one advised this way, and another advised that; but when they could +not agree in their verdict, Apollyon, that president of the council, +stood up, and thus he began: ‘My brotherhood,’ quoth he, ‘I have two +things to propound unto you; and my first is this. Let us withdraw +ourselves from the town into the plain again, for our presence here will +do us no good, because the castle is yet in our enemies’ hands; nor is it +possible that we should take that, so long as so many brave captains are +in it, and that this bold fellow, Godly-Fear, is made the keeper of the +gates of it. Now, when we have withdrawn ourselves into the plain, they, +of their own accord, will be glad of some little ease; and it may be, of +their own accord, they again may begin to be remiss, and even their so +being will give them a bigger blow than we can possibly give them +ourselves. But if that should fail, our going forth of the town may draw +the captains out after us; and you know what it cost them when we fought +them in the field before. Besides, can we but draw them out into the +field, we may lay an ambush behind the town, which shall, when they are +come forth abroad, rush in and take possession of the castle.’ + +But Beelzebub stood up, and replied, saying: ‘It is impossible to draw +them all off from the castle; some, you may be sure, will lie there to +keep that; wherefore it will be but in vain thus to attempt, unless we +were sure that they will all come out.’ He therefore concluded that what +was done must be done by some other means. And the most likely means +that the greatest of their heads could invent, was that which Apollyon +had advised to before, namely, to get the townsmen again to sin. ‘For,’ +said he, ‘it is not our being in the town, nor in the field, nor our +fighting, nor our killing of their men, that can make us the masters of +Mansoul; for so long as one in the town is able to lift up his finger +against us, Emmanuel will take their parts; and if he shall take their +parts, we know what time of day it will be with us. Wherefore, for my +part,’ quoth he, ‘there is, in my judgment, no way to bring them into +bondage to us, like inventing a way to make them sin. Had we,’ said he, +‘left all our doubters at home, we had done as well as we have done now, +unless we could have made them the masters and governors of the castle; +for doubters at a distance are but like objections refelled with +arguments. Indeed, can we but get them into the hold, and make them +possessors of that, the day will be our own. Let us, therefore, withdraw +ourselves into the plain, (not expecting that the captains in Mansoul +should follow us,) but yet, I say, let us do this, and before we so do, +let us advise again with our trusty Diabolonians that are yet in their +holds of Mansoul, and set them to work to betray the town to us; for they +indeed must do it, or it will be left undone for ever.’ By these sayings +of Beelzebub, (for I think it was he that gave this counsel,) the whole +conclave was forced to be of his opinion, namely, that the way to get the +castle was to get the town to sin. Then they fell to inventing by what +means they might do this thing. + +Then Lucifer stood up, and said: ‘The counsel of Beelzebub is pertinent. +Now, the way to bring this to pass, in mine opinion, is this: let us +withdraw our force from the town of Mansoul; let us do this, and let us +terrify them no more, either with summons, or threats, or with the noise +of our drum, or any other awakening means. Only let us lie in the field +at a distance, and be as if we regarded them not; for frights, I see, do +but awaken them, and make them more stand to their arms. I have also +another stratagem in my head: you know Mansoul is a market-town, and a +town that delights in commerce; what, therefore, if some of our +Diabolonians shall feign themselves far-country men, and shall go out and +bring to the market of Mansoul some of our wares to sell; and what matter +at what rates they sell their wares, though it be but for half the worth? +Now, let those that thus shall trade in their market be those that are +witty and true to us, and I will lay my crown to pawn it will do. There +are two that are come to my thoughts already, that I think will be arch +at this work, and they are Mr. Penny-wise-pound-foolish, and Mr. +Get-i’the-hundred-and-lose-i’the-shire; nor is this man with the long +name at all inferior to the other. What, also, if you join with them Mr. +Sweet-world and Mr. Present-good; they are men that are civil and +cunning, but our true friends and helpers. Let these, with as many more, +engage in this business for us, and let Mansoul be taken up in much +business, and let them grow full and rich, and this is the way to get +ground of them. Remember ye not that thus we prevailed upon Laodicea, +and how many at present do we hold in this snare? Now, when they begin +to grow full, they will forget their misery; and if we shall not affright +them, they may happen to fall asleep, and so be got to neglect their town +watch, their castle watch, as well as their watch at the gates. + +‘Yea, may we not, by this means, so cumber Mansoul with abundance, that +they shall be forced to make of their castle a warehouse, instead of a +garrison fortified against us, and a receptacle for men of war. Thus, if +we get our goods and commodities thither, I reckon that the castle is +more than half ours. Besides, could we so order it that it shall be +filled with such kind of wares, then if we made a sudden assault upon +them, it would be hard for the captains to take shelter there. Do you +not know that of the parable, “The deceitfulness of riches choke the +word”? and again, “When the heart is over-charged with surfeiting and +drunkenness, and the cares of this life,” all mischief comes upon them at +unawares? + +‘Furthermore, my lords,’ quoth he, ‘you very well know that it is not +easy for a people to be filled with our things, and not to have some of +our Diabolonians as retainers to their houses and services. Where is a +Mansoulian that is full of this world, that has not for his servants and +waiting-men, Mr. Profuse, or Mr. Prodigality, or some other of our +Diabolonian gang, as Mr. Voluptuous, Mr. Pragmatical, Mr. Ostentation, or +the like? Now these can take the castle of Mansoul, or blow it up, or +make it unfit for a garrison for Emmanuel, and any of these will do. +Yea, these, for aught I know, may do it for us sooner than an army of +twenty thousand men. Wherefore, to end as I began, my advice is, that we +quietly withdraw ourselves, not offering any further force, or forcible +attempts, upon the castle, at least at this time; and let us set on foot +our new project, and let us see if that will not make them destroy +themselves.’ + +This advice was highly applauded by them all, and was accounted the very +masterpiece of hell, namely, to choke Mansoul with a fulness of this +world, and to surfeit her heart with the good things thereof. But see +how things meet together! Just as this Diabolonian council was broken +up, Captain Credence received a letter from Emmanuel, the contents of +which were these: That upon the third day he would meet him in the field +in the plains about Mansoul. ‘Meet me in the field!’ quoth the Captain; +‘what meaneth my lord by this? I know not what he meaneth by meeting me +in the field.’ So he took the note in his hand, and did carry it to my +Lord Secretary, to ask his thoughts thereupon; for my Lord was a seer in +all matters concerning the King, and also for the good and comfort of the +town of Mansoul. So he showed my Lord the note, and desired his opinion +thereof. ‘For my part,’ quoth Captain Credence, ‘I know not the meaning +thereof.’ So my lord did take and read it and, after a little pause, he +said, ‘The Diabolonians have had against Mansoul a great consultation +to-day; they have, I say, this day been contriving the utter ruin of the +town; and the result of their council is, to set Mansoul into such a way +which, if taken, will surely make her destroy herself. And, to this end, +they are making ready for their own departure out of the town, intending +to betake themselves to the field again,’ and there to lie till they +shall see whether this their project will take or no. But be thou ready +with the men of thy Lord, (for on the third day they will be in the +plain,) there to fall upon the Diabolonians; for the Prince will by that +time be in the field; yea, by that it is break of day, sun-rising, or +before, and that with a mighty force against them. So he shall be before +them, and thou shalt be behind them, and betwixt you both their army +shall be destroyed.’ + +When Captain Credence heard this, away goes he to the rest of the +captains, and tells them what a note he had a while since received from +the hand of Emmanuel. ‘And,’ said he, ‘that which was dark therein hath +my lord the Lord Secretary expounded unto me.’ He told them, moreover, +what by himself and by them must be done to answer the mind of their +Lord. Then were the captains glad; and Captain Credence commanded that +all the King’s trumpeters should ascend to the battlements of the castle, +and there, in the audience of Diabolus and of the whole town of Mansoul, +make the best music that heart could invent. The trumpeters then did as +they were commanded. They got themselves up to the top of the castle, +and thus they began to sound. Then did Diabolus start, and said, ‘What +can be the meaning of this? they neither sound Boot-and-saddle, nor +Horse-and-away, nor a charge. What do these madmen mean that yet they +should be so merry and glad?’ Then answered one of themselves and said, +‘This is for joy that their Prince Emmanuel is coming to relieve the town +of Mansoul; and to this end he is at the head of an army, and that this +relief is near.’ + +The men of Mansoul also were greatly concerned at this melodious charm of +the trumpets; they said, yea, they answered one another, saying, ‘This +can be no harm to us; surely this can be no harm to us.’ Then said the +Diabolonians, ‘What had we best to do?’ and it was answered, ‘It was best +to quit the town;’ and ‘that,’ said one, ‘ye may do in pursuance of your +last counsel, and by so doing also be better able to give the enemy +battle, should an army from without come upon us. So, on the second day, +they withdrew themselves from Mansoul, and abode in the plains without; +but they encamped themselves before Eye-gate, in what terrene and +terrible manner they could. The reason why they would not abide in the +town (besides the reasons that were debated in their late conclave) was, +for that they were not possessed of the stronghold, and ‘because,’ said +they, ‘we shall have more convenience to fight, and also to fly, if need +be, when we are encamped in the open plains.’ Besides, the town would +have been a pit for them rather than a place of defence, had the Prince +come up and inclosed them fast therein. Therefore they betook themselves +to the field, that they might also be out of the reach of the slings, by +which they were much annoyed all the while that they were in the town. + +Well, the time that the captains were to fall upon the Diabolonians being +come, they eagerly prepared themselves for action; for Captain Credence +had told the captains over night, that they should meet their Prince in +the field to-morrow. This, therefore, made them yet far more desirous to +be engaging the enemy; for ‘You shall see the Prince in the field +to-morrow’ was like oil to a flaming fire, for of a long time they had +been at a distance: they therefore were for this the more earnest and +desirous of the work. So, as I said, the hour being come, Captain +Credence, with the rest of the men of war, drew out their forces before +it was day by the sally-port of the town. And, being all ready, Captain +Credence went up to the head of the army, and gave to the rest of the +captains the word, and so they to their under-officers and soldiers: the +word was ‘The sword of the Prince Emmanuel, and the shield of Captain +Credence;’ which is, in the Mansoulian tongue, ‘The word of God and +faith.’ Then the captains fell on, and began roundly to front, and +flank, and rear Diabolus’s camp. + +Now, they left Captain Experience in the town, because he was yet ill of +his wounds, which the Diabolonians had given him in the last fight. But +when he perceived that the captains were at it, what does he but, calling +for his crutches with haste, gets up, and away he goes to the battle, +saying, ‘Shall I lie here, when my brethren are in the fight, and when +Emmanuel, the Prince, will show himself in the field to his servants?’ +But when the enemy saw the man come with his crutches, they were daunted +yet the more; ‘for,’ thought they, ‘what spirit has possessed these +Mansoulians, that they fight us upon their crutches?’ Well, the +captains, as I said, fell on, and did bravely handle their weapons, still +crying out and shouting, as they laid on blows, ‘The sword of the Prince +Emmanuel, and the shield of Captain Credence!’ + +Now, when Diabolus saw that the captains were come out, and that so +valiantly they surrounded his men, he concluded that, for the present, +nothing from them was to be looked for but blows, and the dints of their +‘two-edged sword.’ + +Wherefore he also falls on upon the Prince’s army with all his deadly +force: so the battle was joined. Now who was it that at first Diabolus +met with in the fight, but Captain Credence on the one hand, and the Lord +Willbewill on the other: now Willbewill’s blows were like the blows of a +giant, for that man had a strong arm, and he fell in upon the election +doubters, for they were the life-guard of Diabolus, and he kept them in +play a good while, cutting and battering shrewdly. Now when Captain +Credence saw my lord engaged, he did stoutly fall on, on the other hand, +upon the same company also; so they put them to great disorder. Now +Captain Good-Hope had engaged the vocation doubters, and they were sturdy +men; but the captain was a valiant man: Captain Experience did also send +him some aid; so he made the vocation doubters to retreat. The rest of +the armies were hotly engaged, and that on every side, and the +Diabolonians did fight stoutly. Then did my Lord Secretary command that +the slings from the castle should be played; and his men could throw +stones at an hair’s breadth. But, after a while, those that were made to +fly before the captains of the Prince, did begin to rally again, and they +came up stoutly upon the rear of the Prince’s army: wherefore the +Prince’s army began to faint; but, remembering that they should see the +face of their Prince by-and-by, they took courage, and a very fierce +battle was fought. Then shouted the captains, saying, ‘The sword of the +Prince Emmanuel, and the shield of Captain Credence!’ and with that +Diabolus gave back, thinking that more aid had been come. But no +Emmanuel as yet appeared. Moreover, the battle did hang in doubt; and +they made a little retreat on both sides. Now, in the time of respite, +Captain Credence bravely encouraged his men to stand to it; and Diabolus +did the like, as well as he could. But Captain Credence made a brave +speech to his soldiers, the contents whereof here follow:— + +‘Gentlemen soldiers, and my brethren in this design, it rejoiceth me much +to see in the field for our Prince, this day, so stout and so valiant an +army, and such faithful lovers of Mansoul. You have hitherto, as hath +become you, shown yourselves men of truth and courage against the +Diabolonian forces; so that, for all their boast, they have not yet much +cause to boast of their gettings. Now take to yourselves your wonted +courage, and show yourselves men even this once only; for in a few +minutes after the next engagement, this time, you shall see your Prince +show himself in the field; for we must make this second assault upon this +tyrant Diabolus, and then Emmanuel comes.’ + +No sooner had the captain made this speech to his soldiers, but one Mr. +Speedy came post to the captain from the Prince, to tell him that +Emmanuel was at hand. This news when the captain had received, he +communicated to the other field-officers, and they again to their +soldiers and men of war. Wherefore, like men raised from the dead, so +the captains and their men arose, made up to the enemy, and cried as +before, ‘The sword of the Prince Emmanuel, and the shield of Captain +Credence!’ + +The Diabolonians also bestirred themselves, and made resistance as well +as they could; but in this last engagement the Diabolonians lost their +courage, and many of the doubters fell down dead to the ground. Now, +when they had been in heat of battle about an hour or more, Captain +Credence lift up his eyes and saw, and, behold, Emmanuel came; and he +came with colours flying, trumpets sounding, and the feet of his men +scarce touched the ground, they hasted with that celerity towards the +captains that were engaged. Then did Credence wind with his men to the +townward, and gave to Diabolus the field: so Emmanuel came upon him on +the one side, and the enemies’ place was betwixt them both. Then again +they fell to it afresh; and now it was but a little while more but +Emmanuel and Captain Credence met, still trampling down the slain as they +came. + +But when the captains saw that the Prince was come, and that he fell upon +the Diabolonians on the other side, and that Captain Credence and his +Highness had got them up betwixt them, they shouted, (they so shouted +that the ground rent again,) saying, ‘The sword of Emmanuel, and the +shield of Captain Credence!’ Now, when Diabolus saw that he and his +forces were so hard beset by the Prince and his princely army, what does +he, and the lords of the pit that were with him, but make their escape, +and forsake their army, and leave them to fall by the hand of Emmanuel, +and of his noble Captain Credence: so they fell all down slain before +them, before the Prince, and before his royal army; there was not left so +much as one doubter alive; they lay spread upon the ground dead men, as +one would spread dung upon the land. + +When the battle was over, all things came into order in the camp. Then +the captains and elders of Mansoul came together to salute Emmanuel, +while without the corporation: so they saluted him, and welcomed him, and +that with a thousand welcomes, for that he was come to the borders of +Mansoul again. So he smiled upon them, and said, ‘Peace be to you.’ +Then they addressed themselves to go to the town; they went then to go up +to Mansoul, they, the Prince, with all the new forces that now he had +brought with him to the war. Also all the gates of the town were set +open for his reception, so glad were they of his blessed return. And +this was the manner and order of this going of his into Mansoul: + +First. As I said, all the gates of the town were set open, yea, the +gates of the castle also; the elders, too, of the town of Mansoul placed +themselves at the gates of the town, to salute him at his entrance +thither: and so they did; for, as he drew near, and approached towards +the gates, they said, ‘Lift up your heads, O ye gates; and be ye lift up, +ye everlasting doors; and the King of glory shall come in.’ And they +answered again, ‘Who is the King of glory?’ and they made return to +themselves, ‘The Lord, strong and mighty; the Lord mighty in battle. +Lift up your heads, O ye gates; even lift them up, ye everlasting doors,’ +etc. + +Secondly. It was ordered also, by those of Mansoul, that all the way +from the town gates to those of the castle, his blessed Majesty should be +entertained with the song, by them that had the best skill in music in +all the town of Mansoul: then did the elders, and the rest of the men of +Mansoul, answer one another as Emmanuel entered the town, till he came at +the castle gates, with songs and sound of trumpets, saying, ‘They have +seen thy goings, O God; even the goings of my God, my King, in the +sanctuary. So the singers went before, the players on instruments +followed after, and among them were the damsels playing on timbrels.’ + +Thirdly. Then the captains, (for I would speak a word of them,) they in +their order waited on the Prince, as he entered into the gates of +Mansoul. Captain Credence went before, and Captain Good-Hope with him; +Captain Charity came behind with other of his companions, and Captain +Patience followed after all; and the rest of the captains, some on the +right hand, and some on the left, accompanied Emmanuel into Mansoul. And +all the while the colours were displayed, the trumpets sounded, and +continual shoutings were among the soldiers. The Prince himself rode +into the town in his armour, which was all of beaten gold, and in his +chariot—the pillars of it were of silver, the bottom thereof of gold, the +covering of it was of purple, the midst thereof being paved with love for +the daughters of the town of Mansoul. + +Fourthly. When the Prince was come to the entrance of Mansoul, he found +all the streets strewed with lilies and flowers, curiously decked with +boughs and branches from the green trees that stood round about the town. +Every door also was filled with persons, who had adorned every one their +fore-part against their house with something of variety and singular +excellency, to entertain him withal as he passed in the streets: they +also themselves, as Emmanuel passed by, did welcome him with shouts and +acclamations of joy, saying, ‘Blessed be the Prince that cometh in the +name of his Father Shaddai.’ + +Fifthly. At the castle gates the elders of Mansoul, namely, the Lord +Mayor, the Lord Willbewill, the subordinate preacher, Mr. Knowledge, and +Mr. Mind, with other of the gentry of the place, saluted Emmanuel again. +They bowed before him, they kissed the dust of his feet, they thanked, +they blessed, and praised his Highness for not taking advantage against +them for their sins, but rather had pity upon them in their misery, and +returned to them with mercies, and to build up their Mansoul for ever. +Thus was he had up straightway to the castle; for that was the royal +palace, and the place where his honour was to dwell; the which was ready +prepared for his Highness by the presence of the Lord Secretary, and the +work of Captain Credence. So he entered in. + +Sixthly. Then the people and commonalty of the town of Mansoul came to +him into the castle to mourn, and to weep, and to lament for their +wickedness, by which they had forced him out of the town. So when they +were come, bowed themselves to the ground seven times; they also wept, +they wept aloud, and asked forgiveness of the Prince, and prayed that he +would again, as of old, confirm his love to Mansoul. + +To the which the great Prince replied, ‘Weep not, but go your way, eat +the fat, and drink the sweet, and send portions to them for whom nought +is prepared; for the joy of your Lord is your strength. I am returned to +Mansoul with mercies, and my name shall be set up, exalted, and magnified +by it.’ He also took these inhabitants, and kissed them, and laid them +in his bosom. + +Moreover, he gave to the elders of Mansoul, and to each town officer, a +chain of gold and a signet. He also sent to their wives earrings and +jewels, and bracelets, and other things. He also bestowed upon the +true-born children of Mansoul many precious things. + +When Emmanuel, the Prince, had done all these things for the famous town +of Mansoul, then he said unto them, first, ‘Wash your garments, then put +on your ornaments, and then come to me into the castle of Mansoul.’ So +they went to the fountain that was set open for Judah and Jerusalem to +wash in; and there they washed, and there they made their ‘garments +white,’ and came again to the Prince into the castle, and thus they stood +before him. + +And now there was music and dancing throughout the whole town of Mansoul, +and that because their Prince had again granted to them his presence and +the light of his countenance; the bells also did ring, and the sun shone +comfortably upon them for a great while together. + +The town of Mansoul did also now more thoroughly seek the destruction and +ruin of all remaining Diabolonians that abode in the walls, and the dens +that they had in the town of Mansoul; for there was of them that had, to +this day, escaped with life and limb from the hand of their suppressors +in the famous town of Mansoul. + +But my Lord Willbewill was a greater terror to them now than ever he had +been before; forasmuch as his heart was yet more fully bent to seek, +contrive, and pursue them to the death; he pursued them night and day, +and did put them now to sore distress, as will afterwards appear. + +After things were thus far put into order in the famous town of Mansoul, +care was taken, and order given by the blessed Prince Emmanuel, that the +townsmen should, without further delay, appoint some to go forth into the +plain to bury the dead that were there,—the dead that fell by the sword +of Emmanuel, and by the shield of the Captain Credence,—lest the fumes +and ill savours that would arise from them might infect the air, and so +annoy the famous town of Mansoul. This also was a reason of this order, +namely, that, as much as in Mansoul lay, they might cut off the name, and +being, and remembrance of those enemies from the thought of the famous +town of Mansoul and its inhabitants. + +So order was given out by the Lord Mayor, that wise and trusty friend of +the town of Mansoul, that persons should be employed about this necessary +business; and Mr. Godly-Fear, and one Mr. Upright, were to be overseers +about this matter: so persons were put under them to work in the fields, +and to bury the slain that lay dead in the plains. And these were their +places of employment: some were to make the graves, some to bury the +dead, and some were to go to and fro in the plains, and also round about +the borders of Mansoul, to see if a skull, or a bone, or a piece of a +bone of a doubter, was yet to be found above ground anywhere near the +corporation; and if any were found, it was ordered, that the searchers +that searched should set up a mark thereby, and a sign, that those that +were appointed to bury them might find it, and bury it out of sight, that +the name and remembrance of a Diabolonian doubter might be blotted out +from under heaven; and that the children, and they that were to be born +in Mansoul, might not know, if possible, what a skull, what a bone, or a +piece of a bone of a doubter was. So the buriers, and those that were +appointed for that purpose, did as they were commanded: they buried the +doubters, and all the skulls and bones, and pieces of bones of doubters, +wherever they found them; and so they cleansed the plains. Now also Mr. +God’s-Peace took up his commission, and acted again as in former days. + +Thus they buried in the plains about Mansoul the election doubters, the +vocation doubters, the grace doubters, the perseverance doubters, the +resurrection doubters, the salvation doubters, and the glory doubters; +whose captains were Captain Rage, Captain Cruel, Captain Damnation, +Captain Insatiable, Captain Brimstone, Captain Torment, Captain No-Ease, +Captain Sepulchre, and Captain Past-Hope; and old Incredulity was, under +Diabolus, their general. There were also the seven heads of their army; +and they were the Lord Beelzebub, the Lord Lucifer, the Lord Legion, the +Lord Apollyon, the Lord Python, the Lord Cerberus, and the Lord Belial. +But the princes and the captains, with old Incredulity, their general, +did all of them make their escape: so their men fell down slain by the +power of the Prince’s forces, and by the hands of the men of the town of +Mansoul. They also were buried as is afore related, to the exceeding +great joy of the now famous town of Mansoul. They that buried them +buried also with them their arms, which were cruel instruments of death: +(their weapons were arrows, darts, mauls, firebrands, and the like). +They buried also their armour, their colours, banners, with the standard +of Diabolus, and what else soever they could find that did but smell of a +Diabolonian doubter. + +Now when the tyrant had arrived at Hell-Gate Hill, with his old friend +Incredulity, they immediately descended the den, and having there with +their fellows for a while condoled their misfortune and great loss that +they sustained against the town of Mansoul, they fell at length into a +passion, and revenged they would be for the loss that they sustained +before the town of Mansoul. Wherefore they presently call a council to +contrive yet further what was to be done against the famous town of +Mansoul; for their yawning paunches could not wait to see the result of +their Lord Lucifer’s and their Lord Apollyon’s counsel that they had +given before; for their raging gorge thought every day, even as long as a +short for ever, until they were filled with the body and soul, with the +flesh and bones, and with all the delicates of Mansoul. They therefore +resolve to make another attempt upon the town of Mansoul, and that by an +army mixed and made up partly of doubters, and partly of blood-men. A +more particular account now take of both. + +The doubters are such as have their name from their nature, as well as +from the land and kingdom where they are born: their nature is to put a +question upon every one of the truths of Emmanuel; and their country is +called the land of Doubting, and that land lieth off, and farthest remote +to the north, between the land of Darkness and that called the ‘valley of +the shadow of death.’ For though the land of Darkness, and that called +‘the valley of the shadow of death,’ be sometimes called as if they were +one and the self-same place, yet indeed they are two, lying but a little +way asunder, and the land of Doubting points in, and lieth between them. +This is the land of Doubting; and these that came with Diabolus to ruin +the town of Mansoul are the natives of that country. + +The blood-men are a people that have their name derived from the +malignity of their nature, and from the fury that is in them to execute +it upon the town of Mansoul: their land lieth under the dog-star, and by +that they are governed as to their intellectuals. The name of their +country is the province of Loath-good: the remote parts of it are far +distant from the land of Doubting, yet they do both butt and bound upon +the hill called Hell-Gate Hill. These people are always in league with +the doubters, for they jointly do make question of the faith and fidelity +of the men of the town of Mansoul, and so are both alike qualified for +the service of their prince. + +Now of these two countries did Diabolus, by the beating of his drum, +raise another army against the town of Mansoul, of five-and-twenty +thousand strong. There were ten thousand doubters, and fifteen thousand +blood-men, and they were put under several captains for the war; and old +Incredulity was again made general of the army. + +As for the doubters, their captains were five of the seven that were +heads of the last Diabolonian army, and these are their names: Captain +Beelzebub, Captain Lucifer, Captain Apollyon, Captain Legion, and Captain +Cerberus; and the captains that they had before were some of them made +lieutenants, and some ensigns of the army. + +But Diabolus did not count that, in this expedition of his, these +doubters would prove his principal men, for their manhood had been tried +before; also the Mansoulians had put them to the worst: only he did bring +them to multiply a number, and to help, if need was, at a pinch. But his +trust he put in his blood-men, for that they were all rugged villains, +and he knew that they had done feats heretofore. + +As for the blood-men, they also were under command and the names of their +captains were, Captain Cain, Captain Nimrod, Captain Ishmael, Captain +Esau, Captain Saul, Captain Absalom, Captain Judas, and Captain Pope. + +1. Captain Cain was over two bands, namely, the zealous and the angry +blood-men: his standard-bearer bare the red colours, and his scutcheon +was the murdering club. + +2. Captain Nimrod was captain over two bands, namely, the tyrannical and +encroaching blood-men: his standard-bearer bare the red colours, and his +scutcheon was the great bloodhound. + +3. Captain Ishmael was captain over two bands, namely, the mocking and +scorning blood-men: his standard-bearer bare the red colours, and his +scutcheon was one mocking at Abraham’s Isaac. + +4. Captain Esau was captain over two bands, namely, the blood-men that +grudged that another should have the blessing; also over the blood-men +that are for executing their private revenge upon others: his +standard-bearer bare the red colours, and his scutcheon was one privately +lurking to murder Jacob. + +5. Captain Saul was captain over two bands, namely, the groundlessly +jealous and the devilishly furious blood-men: his standard-bearer bare +the red colours, and his scutcheon was three bloody darts cast at +harmless David. + +6. Captain Absalom was captain over two bands, namely, over the blood-men +that will kill a father or a friend for the glory of this world; also +over those blood-men that will hold one fair in hand with words, till +they shall have pierced him with their swords: his standard-bearer did +bear the red colours, and his scutcheon was the son pursuing the father’s +blood. + +7. Captain Judas was over two bands, namely, the blood-men that will sell +a man’s life for money, and those also that will betray their friend with +a kiss: his standard-bearer bare the red colours, and his scutcheon was +thirty pieces of silver and the halter. + +8. Captain Pope was captain over one band, for all these spirits are +joined in one under him: his standard-bearer bare the red colours, and +his scutcheon was the stake, the flame, and the good man in it. + +Now, the reason why Diabolus did so soon rally another force, after he +had been beaten out of the field, was, for that he put mighty confidence +in this army of blood-men; for he put a great deal of more trust in them +than he did before in his army of doubters; though they had also often +done great service for him in the strengthening of him in his kingdom. +But these blood-men, he had proved them often, and their sword did seldom +return empty. Besides, he knew that these, like mastiffs, would fasten +upon any; upon father, mother, brother, sister, prince, or governor, yea +upon the Prince of princes. And that which encouraged him the more was, +for that they once did force Emmanuel out of the kingdom of Universe; +‘And why,’ thought he, ‘may they not also drive him from the town of +Mansoul?’ + +So this army of five-and-twenty thousand strong was, by their general, +the great Lord Incredulity, led up against the town of Mansoul. Now Mr. +Prywell, the scoutmaster-general, did himself go out to spy, and he did +bring Mansoul tidings of their coming. Wherefore they shut up their +gates, and put themselves in a posture of defence against these new +Diabolonians that came up against the town. + +So Diabolus brought up his army, and beleaguered the town of Mansoul; the +doubters were placed about Feel-gate, and the blood-men set down before +Eye-gate and Ear-gate. + +Now when this army had thus encamped themselves, Incredulity did, in the +name of Diabolus, his own name, and in the name of the blood-men and the +rest that were with him, send a summons as hot as a red-hot iron to +Mansoul, to yield to their demands; threatening, that if they still stood +it out against them, they would presently burn down Mansoul with fire. +For you must know that, as for the blood-men, they were not so much that +Mansoul should be surrendered, as that Mansoul should be destroyed, and +cut off out of the land of the living. True, they send to them to +surrender; but should they so do, that would not stench or quench the +thirsts of these men. They must have blood, the blood of Mansoul, else +they die; and it is from hence that they have their name. Wherefore +these blood-men he reserved while now that they might, when all his +engines proved ineffectual, as his last and sure card be played against +the town of Mansoul. + +Now, when the townsmen had received this red-hot summons, it begat in +them at present some changing and interchanging thoughts; but they +jointly agreed, in less than half an hour, to carry the summons to the +Prince, the which they did when they had writ at the bottom of it, ‘Lord, +save Mansoul from bloody men!’ + +So he took it, and looked upon it, and considered it, and took notice +also of that short petition that the men of Mansoul had written at the +bottom of it, and called to him the noble Captain Credence, and bid him +go and take Captain Patience with him, and go and take care of that side +of Mansoul that was beleaguered by the blood-men. So they went and did +as they were commanded: the Captain Credence went and took Captain +Patience, and they both secured that side of Mansoul that was besieged by +the blood-men. + +Then he commanded that Captain Good-hope and Captain Charity, and my Lord +Willbewill, should take charge of the other side of the town. ‘And I,’ +said the Prince, ‘will set my standard upon the battlements of your +castle, and do you three watch against the doubters.’ This done, he +again commanded that the brave captain, the Captain Experience, should +draw up his men in the market-place, and that there he should exercise +them day by day before the people of the town of Mansoul. Now this siege +was long, and many a fierce attempt did the enemy, especially those +called the blood-men, make upon the town of Mansoul; and many a shrewd +brush did some of the townsmen meet with from them, especially Captain +Self-Denial, who, I should have told you before, was commanded to take +the care of Ear-gate and Eye-gate now against the blood-men. This +Captain Self-Denial was a young man, but stout, and a townsman in +Mansoul, as Captain Experience also was. And Emmanuel, at his second +return to Mansoul, made him a captain over a thousand of the Mansoulians, +for the good of the corporation. This captain, therefore, being an hardy +man, and a man of great courage, and willing to venture himself for the +good of the town of Mansoul, would now and then sally out upon the +blood-men, and give them many notable alarms, and entered several brisk +skirmishes with them, and also did some execution upon them; but you must +think that this could not easily be done, but he must meet with brushes +himself, for he carried several of their marks in his face; yea, and some +in some other parts of his body. + +So, after some time spent for the trial of the faith, and hope, and love +of the town of Mansoul, the Prince Emmanuel upon a day calls his captains +and men of war together, and divides them into two companies; this done, +he commands them at a time appointed, and that in the morning very early, +to sally out upon the enemy, saying: ‘Let half of you fall upon the +doubters, and half of you fall upon the blood-men. Those of you that go +out against the doubters, kill and slay, and cause to perish so many of +them as by any means you can lay hands on; but for you that go out +against the blood-men, slay them not, but take them alive.’ + +So, at the time appointed, betimes in the morning, the captains went out +as they were commanded, against the enemies. Captain Good-Hope, Captain +Charity, and those that were joined with them, as Captain Innocent and +Captain Experience, went out against the doubters; and Captain Credence, +and Captain Patience, with Captain Self-Denial, and the rest that were to +join with them, went out against the blood-men. + +Now, those that went out against the doubters drew up into a body before +the plain, and marched on to bid them battle. But the doubters, +remembering their last success, made a retreat, not daring to stand the +shock, but fled from the Prince’s men; wherefore they pursued them, and +in their pursuit slew many, but they could not catch them all. Now those +that escaped went some of them home; and the rest by fives, nines, and +seventeens, like wanderers, went straggling up and down the country, +where they upon the barbarous people showed and exercised many of their +Diabolonian actions: nor did these people rise up in arms against them, +but suffered themselves to be enslaved by them. They would also after +this show themselves in companies before the town of Mansoul, but never +to abide in it; for if Captain Credence, Captain Good-Hope, or Captain +Experience did but show themselves, they fled. + +Those that went out against the blood-men did as they were commanded: +they forbore to slay any, but sought to compass them about. But the +blood-men, when they saw that no Emmanuel was in the field, concluded +also that no Emmanuel was in Mansoul; wherefore they, looking upon what +the captains did to be, as they called it, a fruit of the extravagancy of +their wild and foolish fancies, rather despised them than feared them. +But the captains, minding their business, at last did compass them round; +they also that had routed the doubters came in amain to their aid: so, in +fine, after some little struggling, (for the blood-men also would have +run for it, only now it was too late; for though they are mischievous and +cruel, where they can overcome, yet all blood-men are chicken-hearted +men, when they once come to see themselves matched and equalled,)—so the +captains took them, and brought them to the Prince. + +Now when they were taken, had before the Prince, and examined, he found +them to be of three several counties, though they all came out of one +land. + +1. One sort of them came out of Blind-man-shire, and they were such as +did ignorantly what they did. + +2. Another sort of them came out of Blind-zeal-shire, and they did +superstitiously what they did. + +3. The third sort of them came out of the town of Malice, in the county +of Envy, and they did what they did out of spite and implacableness. + +For the first of these, namely, they that came out of Blind-man-shire, +when they saw where they were, and against whom they had fought, they +trembled and cried, as they stood before him; and as many of these as +asked him mercy, he touched their lips with his golden sceptre. + +They that came out of Blind-zeal-shire, they did not as their fellows +did; for they pleaded that they had a right to do what they did, because +Mansoul was a town whose laws and customs were diverse from all that +dwelt thereabouts. Very few of these could be brought to see their evil; +but those that did, and asked mercy, they also obtained favour. + +Now, they that came out of the town of Malice, that is in the county of +Envy, they neither wept, nor disputed, nor repented, but stood gnawing +their tongues before him for anguish and madness, because they could not +have their will upon Mansoul. Now these last, with all those of the +other two sorts that did not unfeignedly ask pardon for their +faults,—those he made to enter into sufficient bond to answer for what +they had done against Mansoul, and against her King, at the great and +general assizes to be holden for our Lord the King, where he himself +should appoint for the country and kingdom of Universe. So they became +bound each man for himself, to come in, when called upon, to answer +before our Lord the King for what they had done as before. + +And thus much concerning this second army that was sent by Diabolus to +overthrow Mansoul. + +But there were three of those that came from the land of Doubting, who, +after they had wandered and ranged the country a while, and perceived +that they had escaped, were so hardy as to thrust themselves, knowing +that yet there were in the town Diabolonians,—I say, they were so hardy +as to thrust themselves into Mansoul among them. (Three, did I say? I +think there were four.) Now, to whose house should these Diabolonian +doubters go, but to the house of an old Diabolonian in Mansoul, whose +name was Evil-Questioning, a very great enemy he was to Mansoul, and a +great doer among the Diabolonians there. Well, to this +Evil-Questioning’s house, as was said, did these Diabolonians come (you +may be sure that they had directions how to find the way thither), so he +made them welcome, pitied their misfortune, and succoured them with the +best that he had in his house. Now, after a little acquaintance (and it +was not long before they had that), this old Evil-Questioning asked the +doubters if they were all of a town (he knew that they were all of one +kingdom), and they answered: ‘No, nor not of one shire neither; for I,’ +said one, ‘am an election doubter:’ ‘I,’ said another, ‘am a vocation +doubter:’ then said the third, ‘I am a salvation doubter:’ and the fourth +said he was a grace doubter. ‘Well,’ quoth the old gentleman, ‘be of +what shire you will, I am persuaded that you are down, boys: you have the +very length of my foot, are one with my heart, and shall be welcome to +me.’ So they thanked him, and were glad that they had found themselves +an harbour in Mansoul. + +Then said Evil-Questioning to them: ‘How many of your company might there +be that came with you to the siege of Mansoul?’ and they answered: ‘There +were but ten thousand doubters in all, for the rest of the army consisted +of fifteen thousand blood-men. These blood-men,’ quoth they, ‘border +upon our country; but, poor men! as we hear, they were every one taken by +Emmanuel’s forces.’ ‘Ten thousand!’ quoth the old gentleman; ‘I will +promise you, that is a round company. But how came it to pass, since you +were so mighty a number, that you fainted, and durst not fight your +foes?’ ‘Our general,’ said they, ‘was the first man that did run for +it.’ ‘Pray,’ quoth their landlord, ‘who was that, your cowardly +general?’ ‘He was once the Lord Mayor of Mansoul,’ said they: ‘but pray +call him not a cowardly general; for whether any from the east to the +west has done more service for our prince Diabolus, than has my Lord +Incredulity, will be a hard question for you to answer. But had they +catched him, they would for certain have hanged him; and we promise you, +hanging is but a bad business.’ Then said the old gentleman, ‘I would +that all the ten thousand doubters were now well armed in Mansoul, and +myself at the head of them; I would see what I could do.’ ‘Ay,’ said +they, ‘that would be well if we could see that; but wishes, alas! what +are they?’ and these words were spoken aloud. ‘Well,’ said old +Evil-Questioning, ‘take heed that you talk not too loud; you must be quat +and close, and must take care of yourselves while you are here, or, I +will assure you, you will be snapped.’ ‘Why?’ quoth the doubters. +‘Why!’ quoth the old gentleman; ‘why! because both the Prince and Lord +Secretary, and their captains and soldiers, are all at present in town; +yea, the town is as full of them as ever it can hold. And besides, there +is one whose name is Willbewill, a most cruel enemy of ours, and him the +Prince has made keeper of the gates, and has commanded him that, with all +the diligence he can, he should look for, search out, and destroy all, +and all manner of Diabolonians. And if he lighteth upon you, down you +go, though your heads were made of gold.’ + +And now, to see how it happened, one of the Lord Willbewill’s faithful +soldiers, whose name was Mr. Diligence, stood all this while listening +under old Evil-Questioning’s eaves, and heard all the talk that had been +betwixt him and the doubters that he entertained under his roof. + +The soldier was a man that my lord had much confidence in, and that he +loved dearly; and that both because he was a man of courage, and also a +man that was unwearied in seeking after Diabolonians to apprehend them. + +Now this man, as I told you, heard all the talk that was between old +Evil-Questioning and these Diabolonians; wherefore what does he but goes +to his lord, and tells him what he had heard. ‘And sayest thou so, my +trusty?’ quoth my lord. ‘Ay,’ quoth Diligence, ‘that I do; and if your +lordship will be pleased to go with me, you shall find it as I have +said.’ ‘And are they there?’ quoth my lord. ‘I know Evil-Questioning +well, for he and I were great in the time of our apostasy: but I know not +now where he dwells.’ ‘But I do,’ said his man, ‘and if your lordship +will go, I will lead you the way to his den.’ ‘Go!’ quoth my lord, ‘that +I will. Come, my Diligence, let us go find them out.’ + +So my lord and his man went together the direct way to his house. Now +his man went before to show him his way, and they went till they came +even under old Mr. Evil-Questioning’s wall. Then said Diligence, ‘Hark! +my lord, do you know the old gentleman’s tongue when you hear it?’ +‘Yes,’ said my lord, ‘I know it well, but I have not seen him many a day. +This I know, he is cunning; I wish he doth not give us the slip.’ ‘Let +me alone for that,’ said his servant Diligence. ‘But how shall we find +the door?’ quoth my lord. ‘Let me alone for that, too,’ said his man. +So he had my Lord Willbewill about, and showed him the way to the door. +Then my lord, without more ado, broke open the door, rushed into the +house, and caught them all five together, even as Diligence his man had +told him. So my lord apprehended them, and led them away, and committed +them to the hand of Mr. Trueman, the gaoler, and commanded, and he did +put them in ward. This done, my Lord Mayor was acquainted in the morning +with what my Lord Willbewill had done over night, and his lordship +rejoiced much at the news, not only because there were doubters +apprehended, but because that old Evil-Questioning was taken; for he had +been a very great trouble to Mansoul, and much affliction to my Lord +Mayor himself. He had also been sought for often, but no hand could ever +be laid upon him till now. + +Well, the next thing was to make preparation to try these five that by my +lord had been apprehended, and that were in the hands of Mr. Trueman, the +gaoler. So the day was set, and the court called and come together, and +the prisoners brought to the bar. My Lord Willbewill had power to have +slain them when at first he took them, and that without any more ado; but +he thought it at this time more for the honour of the Prince, the comfort +of Mansoul, and the discouragement of the enemy, to bring them forth to +public judgment. + +But, I say, Mr. Trueman brought them in chains to the bar; to the +town-hall, for that was the place of judgment. So, to be short, the jury +was panelled, the witnesses sworn, and the prisoners tried for their +lives: the jury was the same that tried Mr. No-Truth, Pitiless, Haughty, +and the rest of their companions. + +And, first, old Questioning himself was set to the bar for he was the +receiver, the entertainer, and comforter of these doubters, that by +nation were outlandish men: then he was bid to hearken to his charge, and +was told that he had liberty to object, if he had ought to say for +himself. So his indictment was read: the manner and form here follows. + +‘Mr. Questioning, Thou art here indicted by the name of Evil-Questioning, +an intruder upon the town of Mansoul, for that thou art a Diabolonian by +nature, and also a hater of the Prince Emmanuel, and one that hast +studied the ruin of the town of Mansoul. Thou art also here indicted for +countenancing the King’s enemies, after wholesome laws made to the +contrary: for, 1. Thou hast questioned the truth of her doctrine and +state: 2. In wishing that ten thousand doubters were in her: 3. In +receiving, in entertaining, and encouraging of her enemies, that came +from their army unto thee. What sayest thou to this indictment? art thou +guilty or not guilty?’ + +‘My lord,’ quoth he, ‘I know not the meaning of this indictment, +forasmuch as I am not the man concerned in it; the man that standeth by +this charge accused before this bench is called by the name of +Evil-Questioning, which name I deny to be mine, mine being +Honest-Inquiry. The one indeed sounds like the other; but, I trow, your +lordships know that between these two there is a wide difference; for I +hope that a man, even in the worst of times, and that, too, amongst the +worst of men, may make an honest inquiry after things, without running +the danger of death.’ + +Then spake my Lord Willbewill, for he was one of the witnesses: ‘My lord, +and you the honourable bench and magistrates of the town of Mansoul, you +all have heard with your ears that the prisoner at the bar has denied his +name, and so thinks to shift from the charge of the indictment. But I +know him to be the man concerned, and that his proper name is +Evil-Questioning. I have known him, my lord, above these thirty years, +for he and I (a shame it is for me to speak it) were great acquaintance, +when Diabolus, that tyrant, had the government of Mansoul; and I testify +that he is a Diabolonian by nature, an enemy to our Prince, and a hater +of the blessed town of Mansoul. He has, in times of rebellion, been at +and lain in my house, my lord, not so little as twenty nights together, +and we did use to talk then, for the substance of talk, as he and his +doubters have talked of late: true, I have not seen him many a day. I +suppose that the coming of Emmanuel to Mansoul has made him change his +lodgings, as this indictment has driven him to change his name; but this +is the man, my lord.’ + +Then said the court unto him, ‘Hast thou any more to say?’ + +‘Yes,’ quoth the old gentleman, ‘that I have; for all that as yet has +been said against me, is but by the mouth of one witness; and it is not +lawful for the famous town of Mansoul, at the mouth of one witness, to +put any man to death.’ + +Then stood forth Mr. Diligence, and said, ‘My lord, as I was upon my +watch such a night at the head of Bad Street, in this town, I chanced to +hear a muttering within this gentleman’s house. Then, thought I, what is +to do here? So I went up close, but very softly, to the side of the +house to listen, thinking, as indeed it fell out, that there I might +light upon some Diabolonian conventicle. So, as I said, I drew nearer +and nearer; and when I was got up close to the wall, it was but a while +before I perceived that there were outlandish men in the house; but I did +well understand their speech, for I have been a traveller myself. Now, +hearing such language in such a tottering cottage as this old gentleman +dwelt in, I clapped mine ear to a hole in the window, and there heard +them talk as followeth. This old Mr. Questioning asked these doubters +what they were, whence they came, and what was their business in these +parts; and they told him to all these questions, yet he did entertain +them. He also asked what numbers there were of them; and they told him +ten thousand men. He then asked them, why they made no more manly +assault upon Mansoul; and they told him: so he called their general +coward, for marching off when he should have fought for his prince. +Further, this old Evil-Questioning wished, and I heard him wish, would +all the ten thousand doubters were now in Mansoul, and himself at the +head of them. He bid them also to take heed and lie quat; for if they +were taken they must die, although they had heads of gold.’ Then said +the court: ‘Mr. Evil-Questioning, here is now another witness against +you, and his testimony is full: 1. He swears that you did receive these +men into your house, and that you did nourish them there, though you knew +that they were Diabolonians, and the King’s enemies. 2. He swears that +you did wish ten thousand of them in Mansoul. 3. He swears that you did +give them advice to be quat and close, lest they were taken by the King’s +servants. All which manifesteth that thou art a Diabolonian; but hadst +thou been a friend to the King, thou wouldst have apprehended them.’ + +Then said Evil-Questioning: ‘To the first of these I answer, The men that +came into mine house were strangers, and I took them in; and is it now +become a crime in Mansoul for a man to entertain strangers? That I did +also nourish them is true; and why should my charity be blamed? As for +the reason why I wished ten thousand of them in Mansoul, I never told it +to the witnesses, nor to themselves. I might wish them to be taken, and +so my wish might mean well to Mansoul, for aught that any yet knows. I +did also bid them take heed that they fell not into the captains’ hands; +but that might be because I am unwilling that any man should be slain, +and not because I would have the King’s enemies as such escape.’ + +My Lord Mayor then replied: ‘That though it was a virtue to entertain +strangers, yet it was treason to entertain the King’s enemies. And for +what else thou hast said, thou dost by words but labour to evade and +defer the execution of judgment. But could there be no more proved +against thee but that thou art a Diabolonian, thou must for that die the +death by the law; but to be a receiver, a nourisher, a countenancer, and +a harbourer of others of them, yea, of outlandish Diabolonians, yea, of +them that came from far on purpose to cut off and destroy our +Mansoul—this must not be borne.’ + +Then said Evil-Questioning: ‘I see how the game will go: I must die for +my name, and for my charity.’ And so he held his peace. + +Then they called the outlandish doubters to the bar, and the first of +them that was arraigned was the election doubter. So his indictment was +read; and because he was an outlandish man, the substance of it was told +him by an interpreter; namely, ‘That he was there charged with being an +enemy of Emmanuel the Prince, a hater of the town of Mansoul, and an +opposer of her most wholesome doctrine.’ + +Then the judge asked him if he would plead? but he said only this—That he +confessed that he was an election doubter, and that that was the religion +that he had ever been brought up in. And said, moreover, ‘If I must die +for my religion, I trow, I shall die a martyr, and so I care the less.’ + +_Judge_. Then it was replied: ‘To question election, is to overthrow a +great doctrine of the gospel, namely, the omnisciency, and power, and +will of God; to take away the liberty of God with his creature, to +stumble the faith of the town of Mansoul, and to make salvation to depend +upon works, and not upon grace. It also belied the word, and disquieted +the minds of the men of Mansoul; therefore by the best of laws he must +die.’ + +Then was the vocation doubter called, and set to the bar; and his +indictment for substance was the same with the other, only he was +particularly charged with denying the calling of Mansoul. + +The judge asked him also what he had to say for himself? + +So he replied: ‘That he never believed that there was any such thing as a +distinct and powerful call of God to Mansoul; otherwise than by the +general voice of the word, nor by that neither, otherwise than as it +exhorted them to forbear evil, and to do that which is good, and in so +doing a promise of happiness is annexed.’ + +Then said the judge: ‘Thou art a Diabolonian, and hast denied a great +part of one of the most experimental truths of the Prince of the town of +Mansoul; for he has called, and she has heard a most distinct and +powerful call of her Emmanuel, by which she has been quickened, awakened, +and possessed with heavenly grace to desire to have communion with her +Prince, to serve him, and to do his will, and to look for her happiness +merely of his good pleasure. And for thine abhorrence of this good +doctrine, thou must die the death.’ + +Then the grace doubter was called, and his indictment was read and he +replied thereto: ‘That though he was of the land of doubting, his father +was the offspring of a Pharisee, and lived in good fashion among his +neighbours, and that he taught him to believe, and believe it I do, and +will, that Mansoul shall never be saved freely by grace.’ + +Then said the judge: ‘Why, the law of the Prince is plain: 1. Negatively, +“not of works:” 2. Positively, “by grace you are saved.” And thy +religion settleth in and upon the works of the flesh; for the works of +the law are the works of the flesh. Besides, in saying as thou hast +done, thou hast robbed God of His glory, and given it to a sinful man; +thou hast robbed Christ of the necessity of His undertaking, and the +sufficiency thereof, and hast given both these to the works of the flesh. +Thou hast despised the work of the Holy Ghost, and hast magnified the +will of the flesh, and of the legal mind. Thou art a Diabolonian, the +son of a Diabolonian; and for thy Diabolonian principles thou must die.’ + +The court then, having proceeded thus far with them, sent out the jury, +who forthwith brought them in guilty of death. Then stood up the +Recorder, and addressed himself to the prisoners: ‘You, the prisoners at +the bar, you have been here indicted, and proved guilty of high crimes +against Emmanuel our Prince, and against the welfare of the famous town +of Mansoul, crimes for which you must be put to death, and die ye +accordingly.’ So they were sentenced to the death of the cross. The +place assigned them for execution, was that where Diabolus drew up his +last army against Mansoul; save only that old Evil-Questioning was hanged +at the top of Bad Street, just over against his own door. + +When the town of Mansoul had thus far rid themselves of their enemies, +and of the troublers of their peace, in the next place a strict +commandment was given out, that yet my Lord Willbewill should, with +Diligence his man, search for, and do his best to apprehend what town +Diabolonians were yet left alive in Mansoul. The names of several of +them were, Mr. Fooling, Mr. Let-Good-Slip, Mr. Slavish-Fear, Mr. No-Love, +Mr. Mistrust, Mr. Flesh, and Mr. Sloth. It was also commanded, that he +should apprehend Mr. Evil-Questioning’s children, that he left behind +him, and that they should demolish his house. The children that he left +behind him were these: Mr. Doubt, and he was his eldest son; the next to +him was Legal-Life, Unbelief, Wrong-Thoughts-of-Christ, Clip-Promise, +Carnal-Sense, Live-by-Feeling, Self-Love. All these he had by one wife, +and her name was No-Hope; she was the kinswoman of old Incredulity, for +he was her uncle; and when her father, old Dark, was dead, he took her +and brought her up, and when she was marriageable, he gave her to this +old Evil-Questioning to wife. + +Now the Lord Willbewill did put into execution his commission, with great +Diligence, his man. He took Fooling in the streets, and hanged him up in +Want-wit-Alley, over against his own house. This Fooling was he that +would have had the town of Mansoul deliver up Captain Credence into the +hands of Diabolus, provided that then he would have withdrawn his force +out of the town. He also took Mr. Let-Good-Slip one day as he was busy +in the market, and executed him according to law. Now there was an +honest poor man in Mansoul, and his name was Mr. Meditation, one of no +great account in the days of apostasy, but now of repute with the best of +the town. This man, therefore, they were willing to prefer. Now Mr. +Let-Good-Slip had a great deal of wealth heretofore in Mansoul, and, at +Emmanuel’s coming, it was sequestered to the use of the Prince: this, +therefore, was now given to Mr. Meditation, to improve for the common +good, and after him to his son, Mr. Think-Well; this Think-Well he had by +Mrs. Piety his wife, and she was the daughter of Mr. Recorder. + +After this, my lord apprehended Clip-Promise: now because he was a +notorious villain, for by his doings much of the King’s coin was abused, +therefore he was made a public example. He was arraigned and judged to +be first set in the pillory, then to be whipped by all the children and +servants in Mansoul, and then to be hanged till he was dead. Some may +wonder at the severity of this man’s punishment; but those that are +honest traders in Mansoul, are sensible of the great abuse that one +clipper of promises in little time may do to the town of Mansoul. And +truly my judgment is, that all those of his name and life should be +served even as he. + +He also apprehended Carnal-Sense, and put him in hold; but how it came +about, I cannot tell, but he brake prison, and made his escape: yea, and +the bold villain will not yet quit the town, but lurks in the Diabolonian +dens a days, and haunts like a ghost honest men’s houses a nights. +Wherefore, there was a proclamation set up in the market-place in +Mansoul, signifying that whosoever could discover Carnal-Sense, and +apprehend him and slay him, should be admitted daily to the Prince’s +table, and should be made keeper of the treasure of Mansoul. Many, +therefore, did bend themselves to do this thing, but take him and slay +him they could not, though often he was discovered. + +But my lord took Mr. Wrong-Thoughts-of-Christ, and put him in prison, and +he died there; though it was long first, for he died of a lingering +consumption. + +Self-Love was also taken and committed to custody; but there were many +that were allied to him in Mansoul, so his judgment was deferred. But at +last Mr. Self-Denial stood up, and said: ‘If such villains as these may +be winked at in Mansoul, I will lay down my commission.’ He also took +him from the crowd, and had him among his soldiers, and there he was +brained. But some in Mansoul muttered at it, though none durst speak +plainly, because Emmanuel was in town. But this brave act of Captain +Self-Denial came to the Prince’s ears; so he sent for him, and made him a +lord in Mansoul. My Lord Willbewill also obtained great commendations of +Emmanuel, for what he had done for the town of Mansoul. + +Then my Lord Self-Denial took courage, and set to the pursuing of the +Diabolonians, with my Lord Willbewill; and they took Live-by-Feeling, and +they took Legal-Life, and put them in hold till they died. But Mr. +Unbelief was a nimble Jack: him they could never lay hold of, though they +attempted to do it often. He therefore, and some few more of the +subtlest of the Diabolonian tribe, did yet remain in Mansoul, to the time +that Mansoul left off to dwell any longer in the kingdom of Universe. +But they kept them to their dens and holes: if one of them did appear, or +happen to be seen in any of the streets of the town of Mansoul, the whole +town would be up in arms after them; yea, the very children in Mansoul +would cry out after them as after a thief, and would wish that they might +stone them to death with stones. And now did Mansoul arrive to some good +degree of peace and quiet; her Prince also did abide within her borders; +her captains, also, and her soldiers did their duties; and Mansoul minded +her trade that she had with the country that was afar off; also she was +busy in her manufacture. + +When the town of Mansoul had thus far rid themselves of so many of their +enemies, and the troublers of their peace, the Prince sent to them, and +appointed a day wherein he would, at the market-place, meet the whole +people, and there give them in charge concerning some further matters, +that, if observed, would tend to their further safety and comfort, and to +the condemnation and destruction of their home-bred Diabolonians. So the +day appointed was come, and the townsmen met together; Emmanuel also came +down in his chariot, and all his captains in their state attending him, +on the right hand and on the left. Then was an oyes made for silence, +and, after some mutual carriages of love, the Prince began, and thus +proceeded:— + +‘You, my Mansoul, and the beloved of mine heart, many and great are the +privileges that I have bestowed upon you; I have singled you out from +others, and have chosen you to myself, not for your worthiness, but for +mine own sake. I have also redeemed you, not only from the dread of my +Father’s law, but from the hand of Diabolus. This I have done because I +loved you, and because I have set my heart upon you to do you good. I +have also, that all things, that might hinder thy way to the pleasures of +paradise might be taken out of the way, laid down for thee for thy soul a +plenary satisfaction, and have bought thee to myself; a price not of +corruptible things, as of silver and gold, but a price of blood, mine own +blood, which I have freely spilled upon the ground to make thee mine. So +I have reconciled thee, O my Mansoul, to my Father, and entrusted thee in +the mansion houses that are with my Father in the royal city, where +things are, O my Mansoul, that eye hath not seen, nor hath entered into +the heart of man to conceive. + +‘Besides, O my Mansoul, thou seest what I have done, and how I have taken +thee out of the hands of thine enemies: unto whom thou hadst deeply +revolted from my Father, and by whom thou wast content to be possessed, +and also to be destroyed. I came to thee first by my law, then by my +gospel, to awaken thee, and show thee my glory. And thou knowest what +thou wast, what thou saidst, what thou didst, and how many times thou +rebelledst against my Father and me; yet I left thee not as thou seest +this day, but came to thee, have borne thy manners, have waited upon +thee, and, after all, accepted of thee, even of my mere grace and favour; +and would not suffer thee to be lost, as thou most willingly wouldst have +been. I also compassed thee about, and afflicted thee on every side, +that I might make thee weary of thy ways, and bring down thy heart with +molestation to a willingness to close with thy good and happiness. And +when I had gotten a complete conquest over thee, I turned it to thy +advantage. + +‘Thou seest, also, what a company of my Father’s host I have lodged +within thy borders: captains and rulers, soldiers and men of war, engines +and excellent devices to subdue and bring down thy foes; thou knowest my +meaning, O Mansoul. And they are my servants, and thine, too, Mansoul. +Yea, my design of possessing of thee with them, and the natural tendency +of each of them is to defend, purge, strengthen, and sweeten thee for +myself, O Mansoul, and to make thee meet for my Father’s presence, +blessing, and glory; for thou, my Mansoul, art created to be prepared +unto these. + +‘Thou seest, moreover, my Mansoul, how I have passed by thy backslidings, +and have healed thee. Indeed I was angry with thee, but I have turned +mine anger away from thee, because I loved thee still, and mine anger and +mine indignation is ceased in the destruction of thine enemies, O +Mansoul. Nor did thy goodness fetch me again unto thee, after that I for +thy transgressions have hid my face, and withdrawn my presence from thee. +The way of backsliding was thine, but the way and means of thy recovery +was mine. I invented the means of thy return; it was I that made an +hedge and a wall, when thou wast beginning to turn to things in which I +delighted not. It was I that made thy sweet bitter, thy day night, thy +smooth way thorny, and that also confounded all that sought thy +destruction. It was I that set Mr. Godly-Fear to work in Mansoul. It +was I that stirred up thy conscience and understanding, thy will and thy +affections, after thy great and woful decay. It was I that put life into +thee, O Mansoul, to seek me, that thou mightest find me, and in thy +finding find thine own health, happiness, and salvation. It was I that +fetched the second time the Diabolonians out of Mansoul; and it was I +that overcame them, and that destroyed them before thy face. + +‘And now, my Mansoul, I am returned to thee in peace, and thy +transgressions against me are as if they had not been. Nor shall it be +with thee as in former days, but I will do better for thee than at thy +beginning. + +For yet a little while, O my Mansoul, even after a few more times are +gone over thy head, I will (but be not thou troubled at what I say) take +down this famous town of Mansoul, stick and stone, to the ground. And I +will carry the stones thereof, and the timber thereof, and the walls +thereof, and the dust thereof, and the inhabitants thereof, into mine own +country, even into a kingdom of my Father; and will there set it up in +such strength and glory, as it never did see in the kingdom where now it +is placed. I will even there set it up for my Father’s habitation; for +for that purpose it was at first erected in the kingdom of Universe; and +there will I make it a spectacle of wonder, a monument of mercy, and the +admirer of its own mercy. There shall the natives of Mansoul see all +that, of which they have seen nothing here: there shall they be equal to +those unto whom they have been inferior here. And there shalt thou, O my +Mansoul, have such communion with me, with my Father, and with your Lord +Secretary, as it is not possible here to be enjoyed, nor ever could be, +shouldest thou live in Universe the space of a thousand years. + +‘And there, O my Mansoul, thou shalt be afraid of murderers no more; of +Diabolonians, and their threats, no more. There, there shall be no more +plots, nor contrivances, nor designs against thee, O my Mansoul. There +thou shalt no more hear the evil-tidings, or the noise of the Diabolonian +drum. There thou shalt not see the Diabolonian standard-bearers, nor yet +behold Diabolus’s standard. No Diabolonian mount shall be cast up +against thee there; nor shall there the Diabolonian standard be set up to +make thee afraid. There thou shalt not need captains, engines, soldiers, +and men of war. There thou shalt meet with no sorrow, nor grief, nor +shall it be possible that any Diabolonian should again, for ever, be able +to creep into thy skirts, burrow in thy walls, or be seen again within +thy borders all the days of eternity. Life shall there last longer than +here you are able to desire it should; and yet it shall always be sweet +and new, nor shall any impediment attend it for ever. + +‘There, O Mansoul, thou shalt meet with many of those that have been like +thee, and that have been partakers of thy sorrows; even such as I have +chosen, and redeemed, and set apart, as thou, for my Father’s court and +city-royal. All they will be glad in thee, and thou, when thou seest +them, shalt be glad in thine heart. + +‘There are things, O Mansoul, even things of my Father’s providing, and +mine, that never were seen since the beginning of the world; and they are +laid up with my Father, and sealed up among his treasures for thee, till +thou shalt come thither to enjoy them. I told you before, that I would +remove my Mansoul, and set it up elsewhere; and where I will set it, +there are those that love thee, and those that rejoice in thee now; but +how much more, when they shall see thee exalted to honour! My Father +will then send them for you to fetch you; and their bosoms are chariots +to put you in. And you, O my Mansoul, shall ride upon the wings of the +wind. They will come to convey, conduct, and bring you to that, when +your eyes see more, that will be your desired haven. + +‘And thus, O my Mansoul, I have showed unto thee what shall be done to +thee hereafter, if thou canst hear, if thou canst understand; and now I +will tell thee what at present must be thy duty and practice, until I +come and fetch thee to myself, according as is related in the Scriptures +of truth. + +‘First, I charge thee that thou dost hereafter keep more white and clean +the liveries which I gave thee before my last withdrawing from thee. Do +it, I say, for this will be thy wisdom. They are in themselves fine +linen, but thou must keep them white and clean. This will be your +wisdom, your honour, and will be greatly for my glory. When your +garments are white, the world will count you mine. Also, when your +garments are white, then I am delighted in your ways; for then your +goings to and fro will be like a flash of lightning, that those that are +present must take notice of; also their eyes will be made to dazzle +thereat. Deck thyself, therefore, according to my bidding, and make +thyself by my law straight steps for thy feet; so shall thy King greatly +desire thy beauty, for he is thy Lord, and worship thou him. + +‘Now, that thou mayest keep them as I bid thee, I have, as I before did +tell thee, provided for thee an open fountain to wash thy garments in. +Look, therefore, that thou wash often in my fountain, and go not in +defiled garments; for as it is to my dishonour and my disgrace, so it +will be to thy discomfort, when you shall walk in filthy garments. Let +not, therefore, my garments, your garments, the garments that I gave +thee, be defiled or spotted by the flesh. Keep thy garments always +white, and let thy head lack no ointment. + +‘My Mansoul, I have ofttimes delivered thee from the designs, plots, +attempts, and conspiracies of Diabolus; and for all this I ask thee +nothing, but that thou render not to me evil for my good; but that thou +bear in mind my love, and the continuation of my kindness to my beloved +Mansoul, so as to provoke thee to walk in thy measure according to the +benefit bestowed on thee. Of old, the sacrifices were bound with cords +to the horns of the altar. Consider what is said to thee, O my blessed +Mansoul. + +‘O my Mansoul, I have lived, I have died, I live, and will die no more +for thee. I live, that thou mayest not die. Because I live, thou shalt +live also. I reconciled thee to my Father by the blood of my cross; and +being reconciled, thou shalt live through me. I will pray for thee; I +will fight for thee; I will yet do thee good. + +‘Nothing can hurt thee but sin; nothing can grieve me but sin; nothing +can make thee base before thy foes but sin: take heed of sin, my Mansoul. + +‘And dost thou know why I at first, and do still, suffer Diabolonians to +dwell in thy walls, O Mansoul? It is to keep thee wakening, to try thy +love, to make thee watchful, and to cause thee yet to prize my noble +captains, their soldiers, and my mercy. + +‘It is also, that yet thou mayest be made to remember what a deplorable +condition thou once wast in. I mean when, not some, but all did dwell, +not in thy walls, but in thy castle, and in thy stronghold, O Mansoul. + +‘O my Mansoul, should I slay all them within, many there be without, that +would bring thee into bondage; for were all these within cut off, those +without would find thee sleeping; and then, as in a moment, they would +swallow up my Mansoul. I therefore left them in thee, not to do thee +hurt (the which they yet will, if thou hearken to them, and serve them,) +but to do thee good, the which they must, if thou watch and fight against +them. Know, therefore, that whatever they shall tempt thee to, my design +is, that they should drive thee, not further off, but nearer to my +father, to learn thee war, to make petitioning desirable to thee, and to +make thee little in thine own eyes. Hearken diligently to this, my +Mansoul. + +‘Show me, then, thy love, my Mansoul, and let not those that are within +thy walls, take thy affections off from him that hath redeemed thy soul. +Yea, let the sight of a Diabolonian heighten thy love to me. I came +once, and twice, and thrice, to save thee from the poison of those arrows +that would have wrought thy death: stand for me, thy Friend, my Mansoul, +against the Diabolonians, and I will stand for thee before my Father, and +all his court. Love me against temptation, and I will love thee +notwithstanding thine infirmities. + +‘O my Mansoul, remember what my captains, my soldiers, and mine engines +have done for thee. They have fought for thee, they have suffered by +thee, they have borne much at thy hands to do thee good, O Mansoul. +Hadst thou not had them to help thee, Diabolus had certainly made a hand +of thee. Nourish them, therefore, my Mansoul. When thou dost well, they +will be well; when thou dost ill, they will be ill, and sick, and weak. +Make not my captains sick, O Mansoul; for if they be sick, thou canst not +be well; if they be weak, thou canst not be strong; if they be faint, +thou canst not be stout and valiant for thy King, O Mansoul. Nor must +thou think always to live by sense: thou must live upon my word. Thou +must believe, O my Mansoul, when I am from thee, that yet I love thee, +and bear thee upon mine heart for ever. + +‘Remember, therefore, O my Mansoul, that thou art beloved of me: as I +have, therefore, taught thee to watch, to fight, to pray, and to make war +against my foes; so now I command thee to believe that my love is +constant to thee. O my Mansoul, how have I set my heart, my love upon +thee! Watch. Behold, I lay none other burden upon thee, than what thou +hast already. Hold fast, till I come.’ + + + + +FOOTNOTES + + +{0} Unfortunately the illustrations are still in copyright in the UK +(where I live), and so have not been included. They will be included +when they come out of copyright in the UK.—DP. + + + + +***END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK THE HOLY WAR MADE BY SHADDAI UPON +DIABOLUS*** + + +******* This file should be named 395-0.txt or 395-0.zip ******* + + +This and all associated files of various formats will be found in: +http://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/3/9/395 + + + +Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions +will be renamed. + +Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no +one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation +(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without +permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules, +set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to +copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to +protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project +Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you +charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you +do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the +rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose +such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and +research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do +practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is +subject to the trademark license, especially commercial +redistribution. + + + +*** START: FULL LICENSE *** + +THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE +PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK + +To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free +distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work +(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project +Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project +Gutenberg-tm License available with this file or online at + www.gutenberg.org/license. + + +Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm +electronic works + +1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm +electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to +and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property +(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all +the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy +all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession. +If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the +terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or +entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8. + +1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be +used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who +agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few +things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works +even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See +paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement +and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic +works. See paragraph 1.E below. + +1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation" +or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the +collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an +individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are +located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from +copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative +works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg +are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project +Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by +freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of +this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with +the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by +keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project +Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others. + +1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern +what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in +a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check +the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement +before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or +creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project +Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning +the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United +States. + +1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg: + +1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate +access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently +whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the +phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project +Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed, +copied or distributed: + +This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with +almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or +re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included +with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org + +1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived +from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is +posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied +and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees +or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work +with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the +work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 +through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the +Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or +1.E.9. + +1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted +with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution +must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional +terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked +to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the +permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work. + +1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm +License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this +work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm. + +1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this +electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without +prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with +active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project +Gutenberg-tm License. + +1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary, +compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any +word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or +distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than +"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version +posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org), +you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a +copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon +request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other +form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm +License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1. + +1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying, +performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works +unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9. + +1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing +access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided +that + +- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from + the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method + you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is + owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he + has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the + Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments + must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you + prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax + returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and + sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the + address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to + the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation." + +- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies + you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he + does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm + License. You must require such a user to return or + destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium + and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of + Project Gutenberg-tm works. + +- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any + money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the + electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days + of receipt of the work. + +- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free + distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works. + +1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm +electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set +forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from +both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael +Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the +Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below. + +1.F. + +1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable +effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread +public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm +collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic +works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain +"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or +corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual +property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a +computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by +your equipment. + +1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right +of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project +Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project +Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all +liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal +fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT +LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE +PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE +TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE +LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR +INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH +DAMAGE. + +1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a +defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can +receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a +written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you +received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with +your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with +the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a +refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity +providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to +receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy +is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further +opportunities to fix the problem. + +1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth +in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO OTHER +WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO +WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE. + +1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied +warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages. +If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the +law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be +interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by +the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any +provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions. + +1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the +trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone +providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance +with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production, +promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works, +harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees, +that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do +or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm +work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any +Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause. + + +Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm + +Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of +electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers +including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists +because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from +people in all walks of life. + +Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the +assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's +goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will +remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project +Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure +and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations. +To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation +and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4 +and the Foundation information page at www.gutenberg.org + + +Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive +Foundation + +The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit +501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the +state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal +Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification +number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg +Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent +permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws. + +The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S. +Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered +throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at 809 +North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887. Email +contact links and up to date contact information can be found at the +Foundation's web site and official page at www.gutenberg.org/contact + +For additional contact information: + Dr. Gregory B. Newby + Chief Executive and Director + gbnewby@pglaf.org + +Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg +Literary Archive Foundation + +Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide +spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of +increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be +freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest +array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations +($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt +status with the IRS. + +The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating +charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United +States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a +considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up +with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations +where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To +SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any +particular state visit www.gutenberg.org/donate + +While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we +have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition +against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who +approach us with offers to donate. + +International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make +any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from +outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff. + +Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation +methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other +ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations. +To donate, please visit: www.gutenberg.org/donate + + +Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic +works. + +Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm +concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared +with anyone. For forty years, he produced and distributed Project +Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support. + +Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed +editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S. +unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily +keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition. + +Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility: + + www.gutenberg.org + +This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm, +including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary +Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to +subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks. diff --git a/395-0.zip b/395-0.zip Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000..baaafcf --- /dev/null +++ b/395-0.zip diff --git a/395-h.zip b/395-h.zip Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000..6cb0ca6 --- /dev/null +++ b/395-h.zip diff --git a/395-h/395-h.htm b/395-h/395-h.htm new file mode 100644 index 0000000..6e8a410 --- /dev/null +++ b/395-h/395-h.htm @@ -0,0 +1,10029 @@ +<!DOCTYPE html + PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Strict//EN" + "http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-strict.dtd"> +<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xml:lang="en" lang="en"> +<head> +<meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=US-ASCII" /> +<title>The Holy War made by Shaddai upon Diabolus, by John Bunyan</title> + <style type="text/css"> +/*<![CDATA[ XML blockout */ +<!-- + P { margin-top: .75em; + margin-bottom: .75em; + } + P.gutsumm { margin-left: 5%;} + P.poetry {margin-left: 3%; } + .GutSmall { font-size: 0.7em; } + H1, H2 { + text-align: center; + margin-top: 2em; + margin-bottom: 2em; + } + H3, H4, H5 { + text-align: center; + margin-top: 1em; + margin-bottom: 1em; + } + BODY{margin-left: 10%; + margin-right: 10%; + } + table { border-collapse: collapse; } +table {margin-left:auto; margin-right:auto;} + td { vertical-align: top; border: 1px solid black;} + td p { margin: 0.2em; } + .blkquot {margin-left: 4em; margin-right: 4em;} /* block indent */ + + .smcap {font-variant: small-caps;} + + .pagenum {position: absolute; + left: 92%; + font-size: small; + text-align: right; + font-weight: normal; + color: gray; + } + img { border: none; } + img.dc { float: left; width: 50px; height: 50px; } + p.gutindent { margin-left: 2em; } + div.gapspace { height: 0.8em; } + div.gapline { height: 0.8em; width: 100%; border-top: 1px solid;} + div.gapmediumline { height: 0.3em; width: 40%; margin-left:30%; + border-top: 1px solid; } + div.gapmediumdoubleline { height: 0.3em; width: 40%; margin-left:30%; + border-top: 1px solid; border-bottom: 1px solid;} + div.gapshortdoubleline { height: 0.3em; width: 20%; + margin-left: 40%; border-top: 1px solid; + border-bottom: 1px solid; } + div.gapdoubleline { height: 0.3em; width: 50%; + margin-left: 25%; border-top: 1px solid; + border-bottom: 1px solid;} + div.gapshortline { height: 0.3em; width: 20%; margin-left:40%; + border-top: 1px solid; } + .citation {vertical-align: super; + font-size: .8em; + text-decoration: none;} + img.floatleft { float: left; + margin-right: 1em; + margin-top: 0.5em; margin-bottom: 0.5em; } + img.floatright { float: right; + margin-left: 1em; margin-top: 0.5em; + margin-bottom: 0.5em; } + img.clearcenter {display: block; + margin-left: auto; + margin-right: auto; margin-top: 0.5em; + margin-bottom: 0.5em} + --> + /* XML end ]]>*/ + </style> +</head> +<body> +<pre> + +The Project Gutenberg eBook, The Holy War made by Shaddai upon Diabolus, +by John Bunyan + + +This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with +almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or +re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included +with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org + + + + + +Title: The Holy War made by Shaddai upon Diabolus + + +Author: John Bunyan + + + +Release Date: February 9, 2013 [eBook #395] +[This file was first posted on December 7, 1995] + +Language: English + +Character set encoding: ISO-646-US (US-ASCII) + + +***START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK THE HOLY WAR MADE BY SHADDAI UPON +DIABOLUS*** +</pre> +<p>Transcribed from the 1907 Religious Tract Society edition by +David Price, email ccx074@pglaf.org</p> +<h1>THE HOLY WAR MADE<br /> +BY SHADDI UPON<br /> +DIABOLUS <span class="GutSmall">FOR THE</span><br /> +<span class="GutSmall">REGAINING OF THE METROPOLIS</span><br /> +<span class="GutSmall">OF THE WORLD OR THE LOSING</span><br /> +<span class="GutSmall">AND TAKING AGAIN OF THE TOWN</span><br /> +<span class="GutSmall">OF MANSOUL. BY JOHN +BUNYAN</span></h1> +<div class="gapspace"> </div> +<p style="text-align: center"><span class="GutSmall">WITH +THREE</span><br /> +<span class="GutSmall">COLOURED ILLUSTRATIONS</span><br /> +BY VICTOR PROUT <a name="citation0"></a><a href="#footnote0" +class="citation">[0]</a></p> +<div class="gapspace"> </div> +<p style="text-align: center">“I have used +similitudes.” Hosea xii. 10</p> +<div class="gapspace"> </div> +<p style="text-align: center"> +<a href="images/p0b.jpg"> +<img alt= +"Decorative design" +title= +"Decorative design" +src="images/p0s.jpg" /> +</a></p> +<p style="text-align: center">London<br /> +THE RELIGIOUS TRACT SOCIETY<br /> +4 Bouverie Street and 65 St Paul’s Churchyard<br /> +1907</p> +<div class="gapspace"> </div> +<p style="text-align: center"><span class="GutSmall">PRINTED +BY</span><br /> +<span class="GutSmall">HAZELL, WATSON AND VINEY, LD.</span><br /> +<span class="GutSmall">LONDON AND AYLESBURY.</span></p> +<h2>PREFACE.</h2> +<p><span class="smcap"><i>In</i></span><i> the year 1682 there +was published by Dorman Newman</i>, ‘<i>at the King’s +Arms in the Poultry</i>,’<i> and Benjamin Alsop</i>, +‘<i>at the Angel and Bible in the Poultry</i>,’<i> a +volume entitled</i> ‘<i>The Holy War</i>, <i>made by +Shaddai upon Diabolus for the regaining of the Metropolis of the +World; or the Losing and Taking again of the Town of +Mansoul</i>.’<i> It was the work of John Bunyan</i>, +<i>who</i>, <i>sixteen years before</i>, <i>had published the +story of his own spiritual struggle under the title of</i> +‘<i>Grace abounding to the Chief of Sinners</i>’;<i> +and</i>, <i>but four years before</i>, <i>had produced</i> +‘<i>The Pilgrim’s Progress</i>’ (<i>Part +I</i>). <i>Bunyan had speedily followed the issue of +the</i> ‘<i>Pilgrim’s Progress</i>’ <i>with +the</i> ‘<i>Life and Death of Mr. Badman</i>,’<i> +picture of English life and character as he had seen it</i>, +<i>grimly faithful to fact</i>. <i>In</i> ‘<i>The +Holy War</i>’<i> Bunyan returned to allegory</i>. +<i>As a piece of literature the book is in no way inferior to +the</i> ‘<i>Pilgrim’s Progress</i>.’<i> +If Bunyan had written nothing else</i>, ‘<i>The Holy +War</i>’ <i>would have sufficed to establish his claim to a +place amongst the masters of English prose</i>. <i>As an +appeal to the conscience it is not a whit less effective than +the</i> ‘<i>Pilgrim’s Progress</i>’; <i>but in +the power of seizing and retaining the reader’s attention +it is scarcely so successful</i>. <i>Nevertheless Macaulay +held that</i> ‘<i>if there had been no</i> +“<i>Pilgrim’s Progress</i>” “<i>The Holy +War</i>” <i>would have been the first of religious +allegories</i>.’</p> +<p><i>In working out the details of</i> ‘<i>The Holy +War</i>’ <i>Bunyan seems to have kept in mind his own +experience</i>. <i>The fortifications of the city</i>, +<i>the movements of the opposing forces</i>, <i>the changes in +the municipal offices of Mansoul were reproductions of scenes and +events that had but recently gone on under Bunyan’s +eyes</i>. <i>He adapted them with extraordinary success to +the presentation both of the doctrines of grace and of the +temptations which attend the Christian life</i>. <i>The +characters and the incidents are</i>, <i>in effect</i>, <i>the +characters and incidents of every age</i>. <i>It is this +which gives to the story of Mansoul its undying freshness</i>, +<i>and suits it to the needs of men in all climes</i>. +‘<i>The Holy War</i>’ <i>has been translated into +many languages</i>, <i>including some of those with the scantiest +of literature</i>. <i>Indeed</i>, <i>as this edition is +being prepared for the press</i>, <i>assistance is being rendered +by the Religious Tract Society in the printing of</i> +‘<i>The Holy War</i>’ <i>in Kongo</i>.</p> +<p style="text-align: right"><i>A. R. BUCKLAND</i>.</p> +<h2>TO THE READER.</h2> +<blockquote><p> ’Tis strange to me, that +they that love to tell<br /> +Things done of old, yea, and that do excel<br /> +Their equals in historiology,<br /> +Speak not of Mansoul’s wars, but let them lie<br /> +Dead, like old fables, or such worthless things,<br /> +That to the reader no advantage brings:<br /> +When men, let them make what they will their own,<br /> +Till they know this, are to themselves unknown.<br /> + Of stories, I well know, there’s divers +sorts,<br /> +Some foreign, some domestic; and reports<br /> +Are thereof made as fancy leads the writers:<br /> +(By books a man may guess at the inditers.)<br /> +Some will again of that which never was,<br /> +Nor will be, feign (and that without a cause)<br /> +Such matter, raise such mountains, tell such things<br /> +Of men, of laws, of countries, and of kings;<br /> +And in their story seem to be so sage,<br /> +And with such gravity clothe every page,<br /> +That though their frontispiece says all is vain,<br /> +Yet to their way disciples they obtain.<br /> + But, readers, I have somewhat else to do,<br /> +Than with vain stories thus to trouble you.<br /> +What here I say, some men do know so well,<br /> +They can with tears and joy the story tell.<br /> + The town of Mansoul is well known to many,<br /> +Nor are her troubles doubted of by any<br /> +That are acquainted with those Histories<br /> +That Mansoul and her wars anatomize.<br /> + Then lend thine ear to what I do relate,<br /> +Touching the town of Mansoul and her state:<br /> +How she was lost, took captive, made a slave:<br /> +And how against him set, that should her save;<br /> +Yea, how by hostile ways she did oppose<br /> +Her Lord, and with his enemy did close.<br /> +For they are true: he that will them deny<br /> +Must needs the best of records vilify.<br /> +For my part, I myself was in the town,<br /> +Both when ’twas set up, and when pulling down.<br /> +I saw Diabolus in his possession,<br /> +And Mansoul also under his oppression.<br /> +Yea, I was there when she own’d him for lord,<br /> +And to him did submit with one accord.<br /> + When Mansoul trampled upon things divine,<br /> +And wallowed in filth as doth a swine;<br /> +When she betook herself unto her arms,<br /> +Fought her Emmanuel, despis’d his charms;<br /> +Then I was there, and did rejoice to see<br /> +Diabolus and Mansoul so agree.<br /> + Let no men, then, count me a fable-maker,<br /> +Nor make my name or credit a partaker<br /> +Of their derision: what is here in view,<br /> +Of mine own knowledge, I dare say is true.<br /> + I saw the Prince’s armed men come down<br /> +By troops, by thousands, to besiege the town;<br /> +I saw the captains, heard the trumpets sound,<br /> +And how his forces covered all the ground.<br /> +Yea, how they set themselves in battle-’ray,<br /> +I shall remember to my dying day.<br /> + I saw the colours waving in the wind,<br /> +And they within to mischief how combin’d<br /> +To ruin Mansoul, and to make away<br /> +Her primum mobile without delay.<br /> + I saw the mounts cast up against the town,<br /> +And how the slings were placed to beat it down:<br /> +I heard the stones fly whizzing by mine ears,<br /> +(What longer kept in mind than got in fears?)<br /> +I heard them fall, and saw what work they made.<br /> +And how old Mors did cover with his shade<br /> +The face of Mansoul; and I heard her cry,<br /> +‘Woe worth the day, in dying I shall die!’<br /> + I saw the battering-rams, and how they +play’d<br /> +To beat open Ear-gate; and I was afraid<br /> +Not only Ear-gate, but the very town<br /> +Would by those battering-rams be beaten down.<br /> +I saw the fights, and heard the captains shout,<br /> +And in each battle saw who faced about;<br /> +I saw who wounded were, and who were slain;<br /> +And who, when dead, would come to life again.<br /> + I heard the cries of those that wounded were,<br /> +(While others fought like men bereft of fear,)<br /> +And while the cry, ‘Kill, kill,’ was in mine ears,<br +/> +The gutters ran, not so with blood as tears.<br /> + Indeed, the captains did not always fight,<br /> +But then they would molest us day and night;<br /> +Their cry, ‘Up, fall on, let us take the town,’<br /> +Kept us from sleeping, or from lying down.<br /> + I was there when the gates were broken ope,<br /> +And saw how Mansoul then was stripp’d of hope;<br /> +I saw the captains march into the town,<br /> +How there they fought, and did their foes cut down.<br /> + I heard the Prince bid Boanerges go<br /> +Up to the castle, and there seize his foe;<br /> +And saw him and his fellows bring him down,<br /> +In chains of great contempt quite through the town.<br /> + I saw Emmanuel, when he possess’d<br /> +His town of Mansoul; and how greatly blest<br /> +A town his gallant town of Mansoul was,<br /> +When she received his pardon, loved his laws.<br /> + When the Diabolonians were caught,<br /> +When tried, and when to execution brought,<br /> +Then I was there; yea, I was standing by<br /> +When Mansoul did the rebels crucify.<br /> + I also saw Mansoul clad all in white,<br /> +I heard her Prince call her his heart’s delight.<br /> +I saw him put upon her chains of gold,<br /> +And rings, and bracelets, goodly to behold.<br /> + What shall I say? I heard the people’s +cries,<br /> +And saw the Prince wipe tears from Mansoul’s eyes.<br /> +And heard the groans, and saw the joy of many:<br /> +Tell you of all, I neither will, nor can I.<br /> +But by what here I say, you well may see<br /> +That Mansoul’s matchless wars no fables be.<br /> + Mansoul, the desire of both princes was:<br /> +One keep his gain would, t’other gain his loss.<br /> +Diabolus would cry, ‘The town is mine!’<br /> +Emmanuel would plead a right divine<br /> +Unto his Mansoul: then to blows they go,<br /> +And Mansoul cries, ‘These wars will me undo.’<br /> + Mansoul! her wars seemed endless in her eyes;<br /> +She’s lost by one, becomes another’s prize:<br /> +And he again that lost her last would swear,<br /> +‘Have her I will, or her in pieces tear.’<br /> + Mansoul! it was the very seat of war;<br /> +Wherefore her troubles greater were by far<br /> +Than only where the noise of war is heard,<br /> +Or where the shaking of a sword is fear’d;<br /> +Or only where small skirmishes are fought,<br /> +Or where the fancy fighteth with a thought.<br /> + She saw the swords of fighting men made red,<br /> +And heard the cries of those with them wounded:<br /> +Must not her frights, then, be much more by far<br /> +Than theirs that to such doings strangers are?<br /> +Or theirs that hear the beating of a drum,<br /> +But not made fly for fear from house and home?<br /> + Mansoul not only heard the trumpet’s sound,<br +/> +But saw her gallants gasping on the ground:<br /> +Wherefore we must not think that she could rest<br /> +With them, whose greatest earnest is but jest:<br /> +Or where the blust’ring threat’ning of great wars<br +/> +Do end in parlies, or in wording jars.<br /> +Mansoul! her mighty wars, they did portend<br /> +Her weal or woe, and that world without end:<br /> +Wherefore she must be more concern’d than they<br /> +Whose fears begin, and end the selfsame day;<br /> +Or where none other harm doth come to him<br /> +That is engaged, but loss of life or limb,<br /> +As all must needs confess that now do dwell<br /> +In Universe, and can this story tell.<br /> + Count me not, then, with them that, to amaze<br /> +The people, set them on the stars to gaze,<br /> +Insinuating with much confidence,<br /> +That each of them is now the residence<br /> +Of some brave creatures: yea, a world they will<br /> +Have in each star, though it be past their skill<br /> +To make it manifest to any man,<br /> +That reason hath, or tell his fingers can.<br /> + But I have too long held thee in the porch,<br /> +And kept thee from the sunshine with a torch,<br /> +Well, now go forward, step within the door,<br /> +And there behold five hundred times much more<br /> +Of all sorts of such inward rarities<br /> +As please the mind will, and will feed the eyes<br /> +With those, which, if a Christian, thou wilt see<br /> +Not small, but things of greatest moment be.<br /> + Nor do thou go to work without my key;<br /> +(In mysteries men soon do lose their way;)<br /> +And also turn it right, if thou wouldst know<br /> +My riddle, and wouldst with my heifer plough;<br /> +It lies there in the window. Fare thee well,<br /> +My next may be to ring thy passing-bell.</p> +<p style="text-align: right"><span class="smcap">John +Bunyan</span>.</p> +</blockquote> +<h2>AN ADVERTISEMENT TO THE READER.</h2> +<blockquote><p> <span class="smcap">Some</span> +say the ‘Pilgrim’s Progress’ is not mine,<br /> +Insinuating as if I would shine<br /> +In name and fame by the worth of another,<br /> +Like some made rich by robbing of their brother.<br /> +Or that so fond I am of being sire,<br /> +I’ll father bastards; or, if need require,<br /> +I’ll tell a lie in print to get applause.<br /> +I scorn it: John such dirt-heap never was,<br /> +Since God converted him. Let this suffice<br /> +To show why I my ‘Pilgrim’ patronize.<br /> + It came from mine own heart, so to my head,<br /> +And thence into my fingers trickled;<br /> +Then to my pen, from whence immediately<br /> +On paper I did dribble it daintily.<br /> + Manner and matter, too, was all mine own,<br /> +Nor was it unto any mortal known<br /> +Till I had done it; nor did any then<br /> +By books, by wits, by tongues, or hand, or pen,<br /> +Add five words to it, or write half a line<br /> +Thereof: the whole, and every whit is mine.<br /> + Also for <span class="GutSmall">THIS</span>, thine +eye is now upon,<br /> +The matter in this manner came from none<br /> +But the same heart, and head, fingers, and pen,<br /> +As did the other. Witness all good men;<br /> +For none in all the world, without a lie,<br /> +Can say that this is mine, excepting I<br /> + I write not this of my ostentation,<br /> +Nor ‘cause I seek of men their commendation;<br /> +I do it to keep them from such surmise,<br /> +As tempt them will my name to scandalize.<br /> +Witness my name, if anagram’d to thee,<br /> +The letters make—‘Nu hony in a B.’</p> +<p style="text-align: right"><span class="smcap">John +Bunyan</span>.</p> +</blockquote> +<h2>A RELATION OF THE HOLY WAR.</h2> +<p><span class="smcap">In</span> my travels, as I walked through +many regions and countries, it was my chance to happen into that +famous continent of Universe. A very large and spacious +country it is: it lieth between the two poles, and just amidst +the four points of the heavens. It is a place well watered, +and richly adorned with hills and valleys, bravely situate, and +for the most part, at least where I was, very fruitful, also well +peopled, and a very sweet air.</p> +<p>The people are not all of one complexion, nor yet of one +language, mode, or way of religion, but differ as much as, it is +said, do the planets themselves. Some are right, and some +are wrong, even as it happeneth to be in lesser regions.</p> +<p>In this country, as I said, it was my lot to travel; and there +travel I did, and that so long, even till I learned much of their +mother tongue, together with the customs and manners of them +among whom I was. And, to speak truth, I was much delighted +to see and hear many things which I saw and heard among them; +yea, I had, to be sure, even lived and died a native among them, +(so was I taken with them and their doings,) had not my master +sent for me home to his house, there to do business for him, and +to oversee business done.</p> +<p>Now there is in this gallant country of Universe a fair and +delicate town, a corporation called Mansoul; a town for its +building so curious, for its situation so commodious, for its +privileges so advantageous, (I mean with reference to its +origin,) that I may say of it, as was said before of the +continent in which it is placed, There is not its equal under the +whole heaven.</p> +<p>As to the situation of this town, it lieth just between the +two worlds; and the first founder and builder of it, so far as by +the best and most authentic records I can gather, was one +Shaddai; and he built it for his own delight. He made it +the mirror and glory of all that he made, even the top-piece, +beyond anything else that he did in that country. Yea, so +goodly a town was Mansoul when first built, that it is said by +some, the gods, at the setting up thereof, came down to see it, +and sang for joy. And as he made it goodly to behold, so +also mighty to have dominion over all the country round +about. Yea, all were commanded to acknowledge Mansoul for +their metropolitan, all were enjoined to do homage to it. +Aye, the town itself had positive commission and power from her +King to demand service of all, and also to subdue any that +anyways denied to do it.</p> +<p>There was reared up in the midst of this town a most famous +and stately palace; for strength, it might be called a castle; +for pleasantness, a paradise; for largeness, a place so copious +as to contain all the world. This place the King Shaddai +intended but for himself alone, and not another with him; partly +because of his own delights, and partly because he would not that +the terror of strangers should be upon the town. This place +Shaddai made also a garrison of, but committed the keeping of it +only to the men of the town.</p> +<p>The walls of the town were well built, yea, so fast and firm +were they knit and compact together, that, had it not been for +the townsmen themselves, they could not have been shaken or +broken for ever. For here lay the excellent wisdom of him +that builded Mansoul, that the walls could never be broken down +nor hurt by the most mighty adverse potentate, unless the +townsmen gave consent thereto.</p> +<p>This famous town of Mansoul had five gates, in at which to +come, out at which to go; and these were made likewise answerable +to the walls, to wit, impregnable, and such as could never be +opened nor forced but by the will and leave of those +within. The names of the gates were these: Ear-gate, +Eye-gate, Mouth-gate, Nose-gate, and Feel-gate.</p> +<p>Other things there were that belonged to the town of Mansoul, +which if you adjoin to these, will yet give farther demonstration +to all, of the glory and strength of the place. It had +always a sufficiency of provision within its walls; it had the +best, most wholesome, and excellent law that then was extant in +the world. There was not a rascal, rogue, or traitorous +person then within its walls; they were all true men, and fast +joined together; and this, you know, is a great matter. And +to all these, it had always (so long as it had the goodness to +keep true to Shaddai the King) his countenance, his protection, +and it was his delight, etc.</p> +<p>Well, upon a time, there was one Diabolus, a mighty giant, +made an assault upon this famous town of Mansoul, to take it, and +make it his own habitation. This giant was king of the +blacks, and a most raving prince he was. We will, if you +please, first discourse of the origin of this Diabolus, and then +of his taking of this famous town of Mansoul.</p> +<p>This Diabolus is indeed a great and mighty prince, and yet +both poor and beggarly. As to his origin, he was at first +one of the servants of King Shaddai, made, and taken, and put by +him into most high and mighty place; yea, was put into such +principalities as belonged to the best of his territories and +dominions. This Diabolus was made ‘son of the +morning,’ and a brave place he had of it: it brought him +much glory, and gave him much brightness, an income that might +have contented his Luciferian heart, had it not been insatiable, +and enlarged as hell itself.</p> +<p>Well, he seeing himself thus exalted to greatness and honour, +and raging in his mind for higher state and degree, what doth he +but begins to think with himself how he might be set up as lord +over all, and have the sole power under Shaddai. (Now that +did the King reserve for his Son, yea, and had already bestowed +it upon him.) Wherefore he first consults with himself what +had best to be done; and then breaks his mind to some other of +his companions, to the which they also agreed. So, in fine, +they came to this issue that they should make an attempt upon the +King’s Son to destroy him, that the inheritance might be +theirs. Well, to be short, the treason, as I said, was +concluded, the time appointed, the word given, the rebels +rendezvoused, and the assault attempted. Now the King and +his Son being all and always eye, could not but discern all +passages in his dominions; and he, having always love for his Son +as for himself, could not at what he saw but be greatly provoked +and offended: wherefore what does he, but takes them in the very +nick and first trip that they made towards their design, convicts +them of the treason, horrid rebellion, and conspiracy that they +had devised, and now attempted to put into practice, and casts +them altogether out of all place of trust, benefit, honour, and +preferment. This done, he banishes them the court, turns +them down into the horrible pits, as fast bound in chains, never +more to expect the least favour from his hands, but to abide the +judgment that he had appointed, and that for ever.</p> +<p>Now they being thus cast out of all place of trust, profit, +and honour, and also knowing that they had lost their +prince’s favour for ever, (being banished his court, and +cast down to the horrible pits,) you may he sure they would now +add to their former pride what malice and rage against Shaddai, +and against his Son, they could. Wherefore, roving and +ranging in much fury from place to place, if, perhaps, they might +find something that was the King’s, by spoiling of that, to +revenge themselves on him; at last they happened into this +spacious country of Universe, and steer their course towards the +town of Mansoul; and considering that that town was one of the +chief works and delights of King Shaddai, what do they but, after +counsel taken, make an assault upon that. I say, they knew +that Mansoul belonged unto Shaddai; for they were there when he +built it and beautified it for himself. So when they had +found the place, they shouted horribly for joy, and roared on it +as a lion upon the prey, saying, ‘Now we have found the +prize, and how to be revenged on King Shaddai for what he hath +done to us.’ So they sat down and called a council of +war, and considered with themselves what ways and methods they +had best to engage in for the winning to themselves this famous +town of Mansoul, and these four things were then propounded to be +considered of.</p> +<p>First. Whether they had best all of them to show +themselves in this design to the town of Mansoul.</p> +<p>Secondly. Whether they had best to go and sit down +against Mansoul in their now ragged and beggarly guise.</p> +<p>Thirdly. Whether they had best show to Mansoul their +intentions, and what design they came about, or whether to +assault it with words and ways of deceit.</p> +<p>Fourthly. Whether they had not best to some of their +companions to give out private orders to take the advantage, if +they see one or more of the principal townsmen, to shoot them, if +thereby they shall judge their cause and design will the better +be promoted.</p> +<p>1. It was answered to the first of these proposals in the +negative, to wit, that it would not be best that all should show +themselves before the town, because the appearance of many of +them might alarm and frighten the town; whereas a few or but one +of them was not so likely to do it. And to enforce this +advice to take place it was added further, that if Mansoul was +frighted, or did take the alarm, ‘It is impossible,’ +said Diabolus (for he spake now), ‘that we should take the +town: for that none can enter into it without its own +consent. Let, therefore, but few, or but one, assault +Mansoul; and in mine opinion,’ said Diabolus, ‘let me +be he.’ Wherefore to this they all agreed.</p> +<p>2. And then to the second proposal they came, namely, Whether +they had best go and sit down before Mansoul in their now ragged +and beggarly guise. To which it was answered also in the +negative, By no means; and that because, though the town of +Mansoul had been made to know, and to have to do, before now, +with things that are invisible, they did never as yet see any of +their fellow-creatures in so sad and rascally condition as they; +and this was the advice of that fierce Alecto. Then said +Apollyon, ‘The advice is pertinent; for even one of us +appearing to them as we are now, must needs both beget and +multiply such thoughts in them as will both put them into a +consternation of spirit, and necessitate them to put themselves +upon their guard. And if so,’ said he, ‘then, +as my Lord Diabolus said but now, it is in vain for us to think +of taking the town.’ Then said that mighty giant +Beelzebub, ‘The advice that already is given is safe; for +though the men of Mansoul have seen such things as we once were, +yet hitherto they did never behold such things as we now are; and +it is best, in mine opinion, to come upon them in such a guise as +is common to, and most familiar among them.’ To this, +when they had consented, the next thing to be considered was, in +what shape, hue, or guise Diabolus had best to show himself when +he went about to make Mansoul his own. Then one said one +thing, and another the contrary. At last Lucifer answered, +that, in his opinion, it was best that his lordship should assume +the body of some of those creatures that they of the town had +dominion over; ‘for,’ quoth he, ‘these are not +only familiar to them, but, being under them, they will never +imagine that an attempt should by them be made upon the town; +and, to blind all, let him assume the body of one of those beasts +that Mansoul deems to be wiser than any of the rest.’ +This advice was applauded of all: so it was determined that the +giant Diabolus should assume the dragon, for that he was in those +days as familiar with the town of Mansoul as now is the bird with +the boy; for nothing that was in its primitive state was at all +amazing to them. Then they proceeded to the third thing, +which was:</p> +<p>3. Whether they had best to show their intentions, or the +design of his coming, to Mansoul, or no. This also was +answered in the negative, because of the weight that was in the +former reasons, to wit, for that Mansoul were a strong people, a +strong people in a strong town, whose wall and gates were +impregnable, (to say nothing of their castle,) nor can they by +any means be won but by their own consent. +‘Besides,’ said Legion, (for he gave answer to this,) +‘a discovery of our intentions may make them send to their +king for aid; and if that be done, I know quickly what time of +day it will be with us. Therefore let us assault them in +all pretended fairness, covering our intentions with all manner +of lies, flatteries, delusive words; feigning things that never +will be, and promising that to them that they shall never +find. This is the way to win Mansoul, and to make them of +themselves open their gates to us; yea, and to desire us too to +come in to them. And the reason why I think that this +project will do is, because the people of Mansoul now are, every +one, simple and innocent, all honest and true; nor do they as yet +know what it is to be assaulted with fraud, guile, and +hypocrisy. They are strangers to lying and dissembling +lips; wherefore we cannot, if thus we be disguised, by them at +all be discerned; our lies shall go for true sayings, and our +dissimulations for upright dealings. What we promise them +they will in that believe us, especially if, in all our lies and +feigned words, we pretend great love to them, and that our design +is only their advantage and honour.’ Now there was +not one bit of a reply against this; this went as current down as +doth the water down a steep descent. Wherefore they go to +consider of the last proposal, which was:</p> +<p>4. Whether they had not best to give out orders to some of +their company to shoot some one or more of the principal of the +townsmen, if they judge that their cause may be promoted +thereby. This was carried in the affirmative, and the man +that was designed by this stratagem to be destroyed was one Mr. +Resistance, otherwise called Captain Resistance. And a +great man in Mansoul this Captain Resistance was, and a man that +the giant Diabolus and his band more feared than they feared the +whole town of Mansoul besides. Now who should be the actor +to do the murder? That was the next, and they appointed one +Tisiphone, a fury of the lake, to do it.</p> +<p>They thus having ended their council of war, rose up, and +essayed to do as they had determined; they marched towards +Mansoul, but all in a manner invisible, save one, only one; nor +did he approach the town in his own likeness, but under the shade +and in the body of the dragon.</p> +<p>So they drew up and sat down before Ear-gate, for that was the +place of hearing for all without the town, as Eye-gate was the +place of perspection. So, as I said, he came up with his +train to the gate, and laid his ambuscado for Captain Resistance +within bow-shot of the town. This done, the giant ascended +up close to the gate, and called to the town of Mansoul for +audience. Nor took he any with him but one Ill-pause, who +was his orator in all difficult matters. Now, as I said, he +being come up to the gate, (as the manner of those times was,) +sounded his trumpet for audience; at which the chief of the town +of Mansoul, such as my Lord Innocent, my Lord Willbewill, my Lord +Mayor, Mr. Recorder, and Captain Resistance, came down to the +wall to see who was there, and what was the matter. And my +Lord Willbewill, when he had looked over and saw who stood at the +gate, demanded what he was, wherefore he was come, and why he +roused the town of Mansoul with so unusual a sound.</p> +<p>Diabolus, then, as if he had been a lamb, began his oration, +and said: ‘Gentlemen of the famous town of Mansoul, I am, +as you may perceive, no far dweller from you, but near, and one +that is bound by the king to do you my homage and what service I +can; wherefore, that I may be faithful to myself and to you, I +have somewhat of concern to impart unto you. Wherefore, +grant me your audience, and hear me patiently. And first, I +will assure you, it is not myself, but you—not mine, but +your advantage that I seek by what I now do, as will full well be +made manifest, by that I have opened my mind unto you. For, +gentlemen, I am (to tell you the truth) come to show you how you +may obtain great and ample deliverance from a bondage that, +unawares to yourselves, you are captivated and enslaved +under.’ At this the town of Mansoul began to prick up +its ears. And ‘What is it? Pray what is +it?’ thought they. And he said, ‘I have +somewhat to say to you concerning your King, concerning his law, +and also touching yourselves. Touching your King, I know he +is great and potent; but yet all that he hath said to you is +neither true nor yet for your advantage. 1. It is not true, +for that wherewith he hath hitherto awed you, shall not come to +pass, nor be fulfilled, though you do the thing that he hath +forbidden. But if there was danger, what a slavery is it to +live always in fear of the greatest of punishments, for doing so +small and trivial a thing as eating of a little fruit is. +2. Touching his laws, this I say further, they are both +unreasonable, intricate, and intolerable. Unreasonable, as +was hinted before; for that the punishment is not proportioned to +the offence: there is great difference and disproportion between +the life and an apple; yet the one must go for the other by the +law of your Shaddai. But it is also intricate, in that he +saith, first, you may eat of all; and yet after forbids the +eating of one. And then, in the last place, it must needs +be intolerable, forasmuch as that fruit which you are forbidden +to eat of (if you are forbidden any) is that, and that alone, +which is able, by your eating, to minister to you a good as yet +unknown by you. This is manifest by the very name of the +tree; it is called the “tree of knowledge of good and +evil;” and have you that knowledge as yet? No, no; nor can +you conceive how good, how pleasant, and how much to be desired +to make one wise it is, so long as you stand by your King’s +commandment. Why should you be holden in ignorance and +blindness? Why should you not be enlarged in knowledge and +understanding? And now, O ye inhabitants of the famous town +of Mansoul, to speak more particularly to yourselves you are not +a free people! You are kept both in bondage and slavery, +and that by a grievous threat; no reason being annexed but, +“So I will have it; so it shall be.” And is it +not grievous to think on, that that very thing which you are +forbidden to do might you but do it, would yield you both wisdom +and honour? for then your eyes will be opened, and you shall be +as gods. Now, since this is thus,’ quoth he, +‘can you be kept by any prince in more slavery and in +greater bondage than you are under this day? You are made +underlings, and are wrapped up in inconveniences, as I have well +made appear. For what bondage greater than to be kept in +blindness? Will not reason tell you that it is better to +have eyes than to be without them? and so to be at liberty to be +better than to be shut up in a dark and stinking cave?’</p> +<p>And just now, while Diabolus was speaking these words to +Mansoul, Tisiphone shot at Captain Resistance, where he stood on +the gate, and mortally wounded him in the head; so that he, to +the amazement of the townsmen, and the encouragement of Diabolus, +fell down dead quite over the wall. Now, when Captain +Resistance was dead, (and he was the only man of war in the +town,) poor Mansoul was wholly left naked of courage, nor had she +now any heart to resist. But this was as the devil would +have it. Then stood forth he, Mr. Ill-pause, that Diabolus +brought with him, who was his orator; and he addressed himself to +speak to the town of Mansoul; the tenour of whose speech here +follows:—</p> +<p>‘Gentlemen,’ quoth he, ‘it is my +master’s happiness that he has this day a quiet and +teachable auditory; and it is hoped by us that we shall prevail +with you not to cast off good advice. My master has a very +great love for you; and although, as he very well knows, that he +runs the hazard of the anger of King Shaddai, yet love to you +will make him do more than that. Nor doth there need that a +word more should be spoken to confirm for truth what he hath +said; there is not a word but carries with it self-evidence in +its bowels; the very name of the tree may put an end to all +controversy in this matter. I therefore, at this time, +shall only add this advice to you, under and by the leave of my +lord;’ (and with that he made Diabolus a very low congee;) +‘consider his words, look on the tree and the promising +fruit thereof; remember also that yet you know but little, and +that this is the way to know more: and if your reasons be not +conquered to accept of such good counsel, you are not the men +that I took you to be.’</p> +<p>But when the townsfolk saw that the tree was good for food, +and that it was pleasant to the eye, and a tree to be desired to +make one wise, they did as old Ill-pause advised; they took and +did eat thereof. Now this I should have told you before, +that even then, when this Ill-pause was making his speech to the +townsmen, my Lord Innocency (whether by a shot from the camp of +the giant, or from some sinking qualm that suddenly took him, or +whether by the stinking breath of that treacherous villain old +Ill-pause, for so I am most apt to think) sunk down in the place +where he stood, nor could be brought to life again. Thus +these two brave men died—brave men, I call them; for they +were the beauty and glory of Mansoul, so long as they lived +therein; nor did there now remain any more a noble spirit in +Mansoul; they all fell down and yielded obedience to Diabolus; +and became his slaves and vassals, as you shall hear.</p> +<p>Now these being dead, what do the rest of the townsfolk, but, +as men that had found a fool’s paradise, they presently, as +afore was hinted, fall to prove the truth of the giant’s +words. And, first, they did as Ill-pause had taught them; +they looked, they considered they were taken with the forbidden +fruit; they took thereof, and did eat; and having eaten, they +became immediately drunken therewith. So they open the +gate, both Ear-gate and Eye-gate, and let in Diabolus with all +his bands, quite forgetting their good Shaddai, his law, and the +judgment that he had annexed, with solemn threatening, to the +breach thereof.</p> +<p>Diabolus, having now obtained entrance in at the gates of the +town, marches up to the middle thereof, to make his conquest as +sure as he could; and finding, by this time, the affections of +the people warmly inclining to him, he, as thinking it was best +striking while the iron is hot, made this further deceivable +speech unto them, saying, ‘Alas, my poor Mansoul! I +have done thee indeed this service, as to promote thee to honour, +and to greaten thy liberty; but, alas! alas! poor Mansoul, thou +wantest now one to defend thee; for assure thyself that when +Shaddai shall hear what is done, he will come; for sorry will he +be that thou hast broken his bonds, and cast his cords away from +thee. What wilt thou do? Wilt thou, after +enlargement, suffer thy privileges to be invaded and taken away, +or what wilt resolve with thyself?’</p> +<p>Then they all with one consent said to this bramble, ‘Do +thou reign over us.’ So he accepted the motion, and +became the king of the town of Mansoul. This being done, +the next thing was to give him possession of the castle, and so +of the whole strength of the town. Wherefore, into the +castle he goes; it was that which Shaddai built in Mansoul for +his own delight and pleasure; this now was become a den and hold +for the giant Diabolus.</p> +<p>Now, having got possession of this stately palace or castle, +what doth he but makes it a garrison for himself, and strengthens +and fortifies it with all sorts of provision, against the King +Shaddai, or those that should endeavour the regaining of it to +him and his obedience again.</p> +<p>This done, but not thinking himself yet secure enough, in the +next place he bethinks himself of new modelling the town; and so +he does, setting up one, and putting down another at +pleasure. Wherefore my Lord Mayor, whose name was my Lord +Understanding, and Mr. Recorder, whose name was Mr. Conscience, +these he put out of place and power.</p> +<p>As for my Lord Mayor, though he was an understanding man, and +one too that had complied with the rest of the town of Mansoul in +admitting the giant into the town, yet Diabolus thought not fit +to let him abide in his former lustre and glory, because he was a +seeing man. Wherefore he darkened him, not only by taking +from him his office and power, but by building a high and strong +tower, just between the sun’s reflections and the windows +of my lord’s palace; by which means his house and all, and +the whole of his habitation, were made as dark as darkness +itself. And thus, being alienated from the light, he became +as one that was born blind. To this, his house, my lord was +confined as to a prison; nor might he, upon his parole, go +farther than within his own bounds. And now, had he had a +heart to do for Mansoul, what could he do for it, or wherein +could he be profitable to her? So then, so long as Mansoul +was under the power and government of Diabolus, (and so long it +was under him, as it was obedient to him, which was even until by +a war it was rescued out of his hand,) so long my Lord Mayor was +rather an impediment in, than an advantage to the famous town of +Mansoul.</p> +<p>As for Mr. Recorder, before the town was taken, he was a man +well read in the laws of his king, and also a man of courage and +faithfulness to speak truth at every occasion; and he had a +tongue as bravely hung as he had a head filled with +judgment. Now, this man Diabolus could by no means abide, +because, though he gave his consent to his coming into the town, +yet he could not, by all the wiles, trials, stratagems, and +devices that he could use, make him wholly his own. True, +he was much degenerated from his former king, and also much +pleased with many of the giant’s laws and service; but all +this would not do, forasmuch as he was not wholly his. He +would now and then think upon Shaddai, and have dread of his law +upon him, and then he would speak against Diabolus with a voice +as great as when a lion roareth. Yea, and would also at +certain times, when his fits were upon him, (for you must know +that sometimes he had terrible fits,) make the whole town of +Mansoul shake with his voice: and therefore the now king of +Mansoul could not abide him.</p> +<p>Diabolus, therefore, feared the Recorder more than any that +was left alive in the town of Mansoul, because, as I said, his +words did shake the whole town; they were like the rattling +thunder, and also like thunder-claps. Since, therefore, the +giant could not make him wholly his own, what doth he do but +studies all that he could to debauch the old gentleman, and by +debauchery to stupefy his mind, and more harden his heart in the +ways of vanity. And as he attempted, so he accomplished his +design: he debauched the man, and by little and little so drew +him into sin and wickedness, that at last he was not only +debauched, as at first, and so by consequence defiled, but was +almost (at last, I say) past all conscience of sin. And +this was the farthest Diabolus could go. Wherefore he +bethinks him of another project, and that was, to persuade the +men of the town that Mr. Recorder was mad, and so not to be +regarded. And for this he urged his fits, and said, +‘If he be himself, why doth he not do thus always? +But,’ quoth he, ‘as all mad folks have their fits, +and in them their raving language, so hath this old and doating +gentleman.’</p> +<p>Thus, by one means or another, he quickly got Mansoul to +slight, neglect, and despise whatever Mr. Recorder could +say. For, besides what already you have heard, Diabolus had +a way to make the old gentleman, when he was merry, unsay and +deny what he in his fits had affirmed. And, indeed, this +was the next way to make himself ridiculous, and to cause that no +man should regard him. Also now he never spake freely for +King Shaddai, but also by force and constraint. Besides, he +would at one time be hot against that at which, at another, he +would hold his peace; so uneven was he now in his doings. +Sometimes he would be as if fast asleep, and again sometimes as +dead, even then when the whole town of Mansoul was in her career +after vanity, and in her dance after the giant’s pipe.</p> +<p>Wherefore, sometimes when Mansoul did use to be frighted with +the thundering voice of the Recorder that was, and when they did +tell Diabolus of it, he would answer, that what the old gentleman +said was neither of love to him nor pity to them, but of a +foolish fondness that he had to be prating; and so would hush, +still, and put all to quiet again. And that he might leave +no argument unurged that might tend to make them secure, he said, +and said it often, ‘O Mansoul! consider that, +notwithstanding the old gentleman’s rage, and the rattle of +his high and thundering words, you hear nothing of Shaddai +himself;’ when, liar and deceiver that he was, every outcry +of Mr. Recorder against the sin of Mansoul was the voice of God +in him to them. But he goes on, and says, ‘You see +that he values not the loss nor rebellion of the town of Mansoul, +nor will he trouble himself with calling his town to a reckoning +for their giving themselves to me. He knows that though you +were his, now you are lawfully mine; so, leaving us one to +another, he now hath shaken his hands of us.</p> +<p>‘Moreover, O Mansoul!’ quoth he, ‘consider +how I have served you, even to the uttermost of my power; and +that with the best that I have, could get, or procure for you in +all the world: besides, I dare say that the laws and customs that +you now are under, and by which you do homage to me, do yield you +more solace and content than did the paradise that at first you +possessed. Your liberty also, as yourselves do very well +know, has been greatly widened and enlarged by me; whereas I +found you a penned-up people. I have not laid any restraint +upon you; you have no law, statute, or judgment of mine to fright +you; I call none of you to account for your doings, except the +madman—you know who I mean; I have granted you to live, +each man like a prince in his own, even with as little control +from me as I myself have from you.’</p> +<p>And thus would Diabolus hush up and quiet the town of Mansoul, +when the Recorder that was, did at times molest them: yea, and +with such cursed orations as these, would set the whole town in a +rage and fury against the old gentleman. Yea, the rascal +crew at some times would be for destroying him. They have +often wished, in my hearing, that he had lived a thousand miles +off from them: his company, his words, yea, the sight of him, and +specially when they remembered how in old times he did use to +threaten and condemn them, (for all he was now so debauched,) did +terrify and afflict them sore.</p> +<p>But all wishes were vain, for I do not know how, unless by the +power of Shaddai, and his wisdom, he was preserved in being +amongst them. Besides, his house was as strong as a castle, +and stood hard by a stronghold of the town: moreover, if at any +time any of the crew or rabble attempted to make him away, he +could pull up the sluices, and let in such floods as would drown +all round about him.</p> +<p>But to leave Mr. Recorder, and to come to my Lord Willbewill, +another of the gentry of the famous town of Mansoul. This +Willbewill was as high-born as any man in Mansoul, and was as +much, if not more, a freeholder than many of them were; besides, +if I remember my tale aright, he had some privileges peculiar to +himself in the famous town of Mansoul. Now, together with +these, he was a man of great strength, resolution, and courage, +nor in his occasion could any turn him away. But I say, +whether he was proud of his estate, privileges, strength, or +what, (but sure it was through pride of something,) he scorns now +to be a slave in Mansoul; and therefore resolves to bear office +under Diabolus, that he might (such an one as he was) be a petty +ruler and governor in Mansoul. And, headstrong man that he +was! thus he began betimes; for this man, when Diabolus did make +his oration at Ear-gate, was one of the first that was for +consenting to his words, and for accepting his counsel at +wholesome, and that was for the opening of the gate, and for +letting him into the town; wherefore Diabolus had a kindness for +him, and therefore he designed for him a place. And +perceiving the valour and stoutness of the man, he coveted to +have him for one of his great ones, to act and do in matters of +the highest concern.</p> +<p>So he sent for him, and talked with him of that secret matter +that lay in his breast, but there needed not much persuasion in +the case. For as at first he was willing that Diabolus +should be let into the town, so now he was as willing to serve +him there. When the tyrant, therefore, perceived the +willingness of my lord to serve him, and that his mind stood +bending that way, he forthwith made him the captain of the +castle, governor of the wall, and keeper of the gates of Mansoul: +yea, there was a clause in his commission, that nothing without +him should be done in all the town of Mansoul. So that now, +next to Diabolus himself, who but my Lord Willbewill in all the +town of Mansoul! nor could anything now be done, but at his will +and pleasure, throughout the town of Mansoul. He had also +one Mr. Mind for his clerk, a man to speak on every way like his +master: for he and his lord were in principle one, and in +practice not far asunder. And now was Mansoul brought under +to purpose, and made to fulfil the lusts of the will, and of the +mind.</p> +<p>But it will not out of my thoughts what a desperate one this +Willbewill was when power was put into his hand. First, he +flatly denied that he owed any suit or service to his former +prince and liege lord. This done, in the next place he took +an oath, and swore fidelity to his great master Diabolus, and +then, being stated and settled in his places, offices, +advancements, and preferments, oh! you cannot think, unless you +had seen it, the strange work that this workman made in the town +of Mansoul.</p> +<p>First, he maligned Mr. Recorder to death; he would neither +endure to see him, nor hear the words of his mouth; he would shut +his eyes when he saw him, and stop his ears when he heard him +speak. Also he could not endure that so much as a fragment +of the law of Shaddai should be anywhere seen in the town. +For example, his clerk, Mr. Mind, had some old, rent, and torn +parchments of the law of Shaddai in his house, but when +Willbewill saw them, he cast them behind his back. True, +Mr. Recorder had some of the laws in his study; but my lord could +by no means come at them. He also thought and said, that +the windows of my old Lord Mayor’s house were always too +light for the profit of the town of Mansoul. The light of a +candle he could not endure. Now nothing at all pleased +Willbewill but what pleased Diabolus his lord.</p> +<p>There was none like him to trumpet about the streets the brave +nature, the wise conduct, and great glory of the king +Diabolus. He would range and rove throughout all the +streets of Mansoul to cry up his illustrious lord, and would make +himself even as an abject, among the base and rascal crew, to cry +up his valiant prince. And I say, when and wheresoever he +found these vassals, he would even make himself as one of +them. In all ill courses he would act without bidding, and +do mischief without commandment.</p> +<p>The Lord Willbewill also had a deputy under him, and his name +was Mr. Affection, one that was also greatly debauched in his +principles, and answerable thereto in his life: he was wholly +given to the flesh, and therefore they called him +Vile-Affection. Now there was he and one Carnal-Lust, the +daughter of Mr. Mind, (like to like,) that fell in love, and made +a match, and were married; and, as I take it, they had several +children, as Impudent, Blackmouth, and Hate-Reproof. These +three were black boys. And besides these they had three +daughters, as Scorn-Truth and Slight-God, and the name of the +youngest was Revenge. These were all married in the town, +and also begot and yielded many bad brats, too many to be here +inserted. But to pass by this.</p> +<p>When the giant had thus engarrisoned himself in the town of +Mansoul, and had put down and set up whom he thought good, he +betakes himself to defacing. Now there was in the +market-place in Mansoul, and also upon the gates of the castle, +an image of the blessed King Shaddai. This image was so +exactly engraven, (and it was engraven in gold,) that it did the +most resemble Shaddai himself of anything that then was extant in +the world. This he basely commanded to be defaced, and it +was as basely done by the hand of Mr. No-Truth. Now you +must know that, as Diabolus had commanded, and that by the hand +of Mr. No-Truth, the image of Shaddai was defaced, he likewise +gave order that the same Mr. No-Truth should set up in its stead +the horrid and formidable image of Diabolus, to the great +contempt of the former King, and debasing of his town of +Mansoul.</p> +<p>Moreover, Diabolus made havoc of all remains of the laws and +statutes of Shaddai that could be found in the town of Mansoul; +to wit, such as contained either the doctrines of morals, with +all civil and natural documents. Also relative severities +he sought to extinguish. To be short, there was nothing of +the remains of good in Mansoul which he and Willbewill sought not +to destroy; for their design was to turn Mansoul into a brute, +and to make it like to the sensual sow, by the hand of Mr. +No-Truth.</p> +<p>When he had destroyed what law and good orders he could, then +further to effect his design, namely, to alienate Mansoul from +Shaddai her King, he commands, and they set up his own vain +edicts, statutes, and commandments, in all places of resort or +concourse in Mansoul, to wit, such as gave liberty to the lusts +of the flesh, the lusts of the eyes, and the pride of life, which +are not of Shaddai, but of the world. He encouraged, +countenanced, and promoted lasciviousness, and all ungodliness +there. Yea, much more did Diabolus to encourage wickedness +in the town of Mansoul; he promised them peace, content, joy, and +bliss, in doing his commands, and that they should never be +called to an account for their not doing the contrary. And +let this serve to give a taste to them that love to hear tell of +what is done beyond their knowledge afar off in other +countries.</p> +<p>Now Mansoul being wholly at his beck, and brought wholly to +his bow, nothing was heard or seen therein but that which tended +to set up him.</p> +<p>But now he, having disabled the Lord Mayor and Mr. Recorder +from bearing of office in Mansoul, and seeing that the town, +before he came to it, was the most ancient of corporations in the +world, and fearing, if he did not maintain greatness, they at any +time should object that he had done them an injury; therefore, I +say, (that they might see that he did not intend to lessen their +grandeur, or to take from them any of their advantageous things,) +he did choose for them a Lord Mayor and a Recorder himself, and +such as contented them at the heart, and such also as pleased him +wondrous well.</p> +<p>The name of the Mayor that was of Diabolus’ making was +the Lord Lustings, a man that had neither eyes nor ears. +All that he did, whether as a man or an officer, he did it +naturally, as doth the beast. And that which made him yet +the more ignoble, though not to Mansoul, yet to them that beheld +and were grieved for its ruin, was, that he never could favour +good, but evil.</p> +<p>The Recorder was one whose name was Forget-Good, and a very +sorry fellow he was. He could remember nothing but +mischief, and to do it with delight. He was naturally prone +to do things that were hurtful, even hurtful to the town of +Mansoul, and to all the dwellers there. These two, +therefore, by their power and practice, examples, and smiles upon +evil, did much more grammar and settle the common people in +hurtful ways. For who doth not perceive that when those +that sit aloft are vile and corrupt themselves, they corrupt the +whole region and country where they are?</p> +<p>Besides these, Diabolus made several burgesses and aldermen in +Mansoul, such as out of whom the town, when it needed, might +choose them officers, governors, and magistrates. And these +are the names of the chief of them: Mr. Incredulity, Mr. Haughty, +Mr. Swearing, Mr. Whoring, Mr. Hard-Heart, Mr. Pitiless, Mr. +Fury, Mr. No-Truth, Mr. Stand-to-Lies, Mr. False-Peace, Mr. +Drunkenness, Mr. Cheating, Mr. Atheism—thirteen in +all. Mr. Incredulity is the eldest, and Mr. Atheism the +youngest of the company.</p> +<p>There was also an election of common councilmen and others, as +bailiffs, sergeants, constables, and others; but all of them like +to those afore-named, being either fathers, brothers, cousins, or +nephews to them, whose names, for brevity’s sake, I omit to +mention.</p> +<p>When the giant had thus far proceeded in his work, in the next +place, he betook him to build some strongholds in the town, and +he built three that seemed to be impregnable. The first he +called the Hold of Defiance, because it was made to command the +whole town, and to keep it from the knowledge of its ancient +King. The second he called Midnight Hold, because it was +built on purpose to keep Mansoul from the true knowledge of +itself. The third was called Sweet-Sin Hold, because by +that he fortified Mansoul against all desires of good. The +first of these holds stood close by Eye-gate, that, as much might +be, light might be darkened there; the second was built hard by +the old castle, to the end that that might be made more blind, if +possible; and the third stood in the market-place.</p> +<p>He that Diabolus made governor over the first of these was one +Spite-God, a most blasphemous wretch: he came with the whole +rabble of them that came against Mansoul at first, and was +himself one of themselves. He that was made the governor of +Midnight Hold was one Love-no-Light; he was also of them that +came first against the town. And he that was made the +governor of the hold called Sweet-Sin Hold was one whose name was +Love-Flesh: he was also a very lewd fellow, but not of that +country where the other are bound. This fellow could find +more sweetness when he stood sucking of a lust than he did in all +the paradise of God.</p> +<p>And now Diabolus thought himself safe. He had taken +Mansoul, he had engarrisoned himself therein; he had put down the +old officers, and had set up new ones; he had defaced the image +of Shaddai, and had set up his own; he had spoiled the old law +books, and had promoted his own vain lies; he had made him new +magistrates, and set up new aldermen; he had builded him new +holds, and had manned them for himself: and all this he did to +make himself secure, in case the good Shaddai, or his Son, should +come to make an incursion upon him.</p> +<p>Now you may well think, that long before this time, word, by +some one or other, could not but be carried to the good King +Shaddai, how his Mansoul, in the continent of Universe, was lost; +and that the runagate giant Diabolus, once one of his +Majesty’s servants, had, in rebellion against the King, +made sure thereof for himself. Yea, tidings were carried +and brought to the King thereof, and that to a very +circumstance.</p> +<p>At first, how Diabolus came upon Mansoul (they being a simple +people and innocent) with craft, subtlety, lies, and guile. +<i>Item</i>, that he had treacherously slain the right noble and +valiant captain, their Captain Resistance, as he stood upon the +gate with the rest of the townsmen. <i>Item</i>, how my +brave Lord Innocent fell down dead (with grief, some say, or with +being poisoned with the stinking breath of one Ill-Pause, as say +others) at the hearing of his just lord and rightful prince, +Shaddai, so abused by the mouth of so filthy a Diabolian as that +varlet Ill-Pause was. The messenger further told, that +after this Ill-Pause had made a short oration to the townsmen in +behalf of Diabolus, his master; the simple town, believing that +what was said was true, with one consent did open Ear-gate, the +chief gate of the corporation, and did let him, with his crew, +into a possession of the famous town of Mansoul. He further +showed how Diabolus had served the Lord Mayor and Mr. Recorder, +to wit, that he had put them from all place of power and +trust. <i>Item</i>, he showed also that my Lord Willbewill +was turned a very rebel, and runagate, and that so was one Mr. +Mind, his clerk; and that they two did range and revel it all the +town over, and teach the wicked ones their ways. He said, +moreover, that this Willbewill was put into great trust, and +particularly that Diabolus had put into Willbewill’s hand +all the strong places in Mansoul; and that Mr. Affection was made +my Lord Willbewill’s deputy in his most rebellious +affairs. ‘Yea,’ said the messenger, ‘this +monster, Lord Willbewill, has openly disavowed his King Shaddai, +and hath horribly given his faith and plighted his troth to +Diabolus.’</p> +<p>‘Also,’ said the messenger, ‘besides all +this, the new king, or rather rebellious tyrant, over the once +famous, but now perishing town of Mansoul, has set up a Lord +Mayor and a Recorder of his own. For Mayor, he has set up +one Mr. Lustings; and for Recorder, Mr. Forget-Good; two of the +vilest of all the town of Mansoul.’ This faithful +messenger also proceeded, and told what a sort of new burgesses +Diabolus had made; also that he had built several strong forts, +towers, and strongholds in Mansoul. He told, too, the which +I had almost forgot, how Diabolus had put the town of Mansoul +into arms, the better to capacitate them, on his behalf, to make +resistance against Shaddai their King, should he come to reduce +them to their former obedience.</p> +<p>Now this tidings-teller did not deliver his relation of things +in private, but in open court, the King and his Son, high lords, +chief captains, and nobles, being all there present to +hear. But by that they had heard the whole of the story, it +would have amazed one to have seen, had he been there to behold +it, what sorrow and grief, and compunction of spirit, there was +among all sorts, to think that famous Mansoul was now taken: only +the King and his Son foresaw all this long before, yea, and +sufficiently provided for the relief of Mansoul, though they told +not everybody thereof. Yet because they also would have a +share in condoling of the Misery of Mansoul, therefore they also +did, and that at a rate of the highest degree, bewail the losing +of Mansoul. The King said plainly that it grieved him at +the heart, and you may be sure that his Son was not a whit behind +him. Thus gave they conviction to all about them that they +had love and compassion for the famous town of Mansoul. +Well, when the King and his Son were retired into the privy +chamber, there they again consulted about what they had designed +before, to wit, that as Mansoul should in time be suffered to be +lost, so as certainly it should be recovered again; recovered, I +say, in such a way, as that both the King and his Son would get +themselves eternal fame and glory thereby. Wherefore, after +this consult, the Son of Shaddai (a sweet and comely Person, and +one that had always great affection for those that were in +affliction, but one that had mortal enmity in his heart against +Diabolus, because he was designed for it, and because he sought +his crown and dignity)—this Son of Shaddai, I say, having +stricken hands with his Father and promised that he would be his +servant to recover his Mansoul again, stood by his resolution, +nor would he repent of the same. The purport of which +agreement was this: to wit, that at a certain time, prefixed by +both, the King’s Son should take a journey into the country +of Universe, and there, in a way of justice and equity, by making +amends for the follies of Mansoul, he should lay a foundation of +perfect deliverance from Diabolus and from his tyranny.</p> +<p>Moreover Emmanuel resolved to make, at a time convenient, a +war upon the giant Diabolus, even while he was possessed of the +town of Mansoul; and that he would fairly by strength of hand +drive him out of his hold, his nest, and take it to himself to be +his habitation.</p> +<p>This now being resolved upon, order was given to the Lord +Chief Secretary to draw up a fair record of what was determined, +and to cause that it should be published in all the corners of +the kingdom of Universe. A short breviate of the contents +thereof you may, if you please, take here as follows:</p> +<p>‘Let all men know who are concerned, that the Son of +Shaddai, the great King, is engaged by covenant to his Father to +bring his Mansoul to him again; yea, and to put Mansoul, too, +through the power of his matchless love, into a far better and +more happy condition than it was in before it was taken by +Diabolus.’</p> +<p>These papers, therefore, were published in several places, to +the no little molestation of the tyrant Diabolus; ‘for +now,’ thought he, ‘I shall be molested, and my +habitation will be taken from me.’</p> +<p>But when this matter, I mean this purpose of the King and his +Son, did at first take air at court, who can tell how the high +lords, chief captains, and noble princes that were there, were +taken with the business! First, they whispered it one to +another, and after that it began to ring out through the +King’s palace, all wondering at the glorious design that +between the King and his Son was on foot for the miserable town +of Mansoul. Yea, the courtiers could scarce do anything +either for the King or kingdom, but they would mix, with the +doing thereof, a noise of the love of the King and his Son, that +they had for the town of Mansoul.</p> +<p>Nor could these lords, high captains, and princes be content +to keep this news at court; yea, before the records thereof were +perfected, themselves came down and told it in Universe. At +last it came to the ears, as I said, of Diabolus, to his no +little discontent; for you must think it would perplex him to +hear of such a design against him. Well, but after a few +casts in his mind, he concluded upon these four things.</p> +<p>First, that this news, these good tidings, (if possible,) +should be kept from the ears of the town of Mansoul; +‘for,’ said he, ‘if they should once come to +the knowledge that Shaddai, their former King, and Emmanuel his +Son, are contriving good for the town of Mansoul, what can be +expected by me, but that Mansoul will make a revolt from under my +hand and government, and return again to him?’</p> +<p>Now, to accomplish this his design, he renews his flattery +with my Lord Willbewill, and also gives him strict charge and +command, that he should keep watch by day and by night at all the +gates of the town, especially Ear-gate and Eye-gate; ‘for I +hear of a design,’ quoth he, ‘a design to make us all +traitors, and that Mansoul must be reduced to its first bondage +again. I hope they are but flying stories,’ quoth he; +‘however, let no such news by any means be let into +Mansoul, lest the people be dejected thereat. I think, my +lord, it can be no welcome news to you; I am sure it is none to +me; and I think that, at this time, it should be all our wisdom +and care to nip the head of all such rumours as shall tend to +trouble our people. Wherefore I desire, my lord, that you +will in this matter do as I say. Let there be strong guards +daily kept at every gate of the town. Stop also and examine +from whence such come that you perceive do from far come hither +to trade, nor let them by any means be admitted into Mansoul, +unless you shall plainly perceive that they are favourers of our +excellent government. I command, moreover,’ said +Diabolus, ‘that there be spies continually walking up and +down the town of Mansoul, and let them have power to suppress and +destroy any that they shall perceive to be plotting against us, +or that shall prate of what by Shaddai and Emmanuel is +intended.’</p> +<p>This, therefore, was accordingly done; my Lord Willbewill +hearkened to his lord and master, went willingly after the +commandment, and, with all the diligence he could, kept any that +would from going out abroad, or that sought to bring these +tidings to Mansoul, from coming into the town.</p> +<p>Secondly, this done, in the next place, Diabolus, that he +might make Mansoul as sure as he could, frames and imposes a new +oath and horrible covenant upon the townsfolk:—To wit, that +they should never desert him nor his government, nor yet betray +him, nor seek to alter his laws; but that they should own, +confess, stand by, and acknowledge him for their rightful king, +in defiance to any that do or hereafter shall, by any pretence, +law, or title whatever, lay claim to the town of Mansoul; +thinking, belike, that Shaddai had not power to absolve them from +this covenant with death, and agreement with hell. Nor did +the silly Mansoul stick or boggle at all at this most monstrous +engagement; but, as if it had been a sprat in the mouth of a +whale, they swallowed it without any chewing. Were they +troubled at all? Nay, they rather bragged and boasted of +their so brave fidelity to the tyrant, their pretended king, +swearing that they would never be changelings, nor forsake their +old lord for a new. Thus did Diabolus tie poor Mansoul +fast.</p> +<p>Thirdly. But jealousy, that never thinks itself strong +enough, put him, in the next place, upon another exploit, which +was, yet more, if possible, to debauch this town of +Mansoul. Wherefore he caused, by the hand of one Mr. Filth, +an odious, nasty, lascivious piece of beastliness to be drawn up +in writing, and to be set upon the castle gates; whereby he +granted and gave license to all his true and trusty sons in +Mansoul to do whatsoever their lustful appetites prompted them to +do; and that no man was to let, hinder, or control them, upon +pain of incurring the displeasure of their prince.</p> +<p>Now this he did for these reasons:—</p> +<p>1. That the town of Mansoul might be yet made weaker and +weaker, and so more unable, should tidings come that their +redemption was designed, to believe, hope, or consent to the +truth thereof; for reason says, The bigger the sinner, the less +grounds of hopes of mercy.</p> +<p>2. The second reason was, if perhaps Emmanuel, the Son of +Shaddai their King, by seeing the horrible and profane doings of +the town of Mansoul, might repent, though entered into a covenant +of redeeming them, of pursuing that covenant of their redemption; +for he knew that Shaddai was holy, and that his Son Emmanuel was +holy; yea, he knew it by woeful experience, for for his iniquity +and sin was Diabolus cast from the highest orbs. Wherefore +what more rational than for him to conclude that thus, for sin, +it might fare with Mansoul? But fearing also lest this knot +should break, he bethinks himself of another, to wit:—</p> +<p>Fourthly. To endeavour to possess all hearts in the town +of Mansoul that Shaddai was raising an army, to come to overthrow +and utterly to destroy this town of Mansoul. And this he +did to forestall any tidings that might come to their ears of +their deliverance: ‘For,’ thought he, ‘if I +first bruit this, the tidings that shall come after will all be +swallowed up of this; for what else will Mansoul say, when they +shall hear that they must be delivered, but that the true meaning +is, Shaddai intends to destroy them? Wherefore he summons +the whole town into the market-place, and there, with deceitful +tongue, thus he addressed himself unto them:—</p> +<p>‘Gentlemen, and my very good friends, you are all, as +you know, my legal subjects, and men of the famous town of +Mansoul. You know how, from the first day that I have been +with you until now, I have behaved myself among you, and what +liberty and great privileges you have enjoyed under my +government, I hope to your honour and mine, and also to your +content and delight. Now, my famous Mansoul, a noise of +trouble there is abroad, of trouble to the town of Mansoul; sorry +I am thereof for your sakes: for I received but now by the post +from my Lord Lucifer, (and he useth to have good intelligence,) +that your old King Shaddai is raising an army to come against +you, to destroy you root and branch; and this, O Mansoul, is now +the cause that at this time I have called you together, namely, +to advise what in this juncture is best to be done. For my +part, I am but one, and can with ease shift for myself, did I +list to seek my own case, and to leave my Mansoul in all the +danger; but my heart is so firmly united to you, and so unwilling +am I to leave you, that I am willing to stand and fall with you, +to the utmost hazard that shall befall me. What say you, O +my Mansoul? Will you now desert your old friend, or do you +think of standing by me?’</p> +<p>Then, as one man, with one mouth, they cried out together, +‘Let him die the death that will not.’</p> +<p>Then said Diabolus again, ‘It is in vain for us to hope +for quarter, for this King knows not how to show it. True, +perhaps, he, at his first sitting down before us, will talk of +and pretend to mercy, that thereby, with the more ease, and less +trouble, he may again make himself the master of Mansoul. +Whatever, therefore, he shall say, believe not one syllable or +tittle of it; for all such language is but to overcome us, and to +make us, while we wallow in our blood, the trophies of his +merciless victory. My mind is, therefore, that we resolve +to the last man to resist him, and not to believe him upon any +terms, for in at that door will come our danger. But shall +we be flattered out of our lives? I hope you know more of +the rudiments of politics than to suffer yourselves so pitifully +to be served.</p> +<p>‘But suppose he should, if he get us to yield, save some +of our lives, or the lives of some of them that are underlings in +Mansoul, what help will that be to you that are the chief of the +town, especially you whom I have set up and whose greatness has +been procured by you through your faithful sticking to me? +And suppose, again, that he should give quarter to every one of +you, be sure he will bring you into that bondage under which you +were captivated before, or a worse, and then what good will your +lives do you? Shall you with him live in pleasure as you do +now? No, no; you must be bound by laws that will pinch you, +and be made to do that which at present is hateful to you. +I am for you, if you are for me; and it is better to die +valiantly than to live like pitiful slaves. But, I say, the +life of a slave will be counted a life too good for Mansoul +now. Blood, blood, nothing but blood is in every blast of +Shaddai’s trumpet against poor Mansoul now. Pray, be +concerned; I hear he is coming. Up, and stand to your arms +that now, while you have any leisure, I may learn you some feats +of war. Armour for you I have, and by me it is; yea, and it +is sufficient for Mansoul from top to toe; nor can you be hurt by +what his force can do, if you shall keep it well girt and +fastened about you. Come, therefore, to my castle, and +welcome, and harness yourselves for the war. There is +helmet, breastplate, sword, and shield, and what not, that will +make you fight like men.</p> +<p>‘1. My helmet, otherwise called an head-piece, is in +hope of doing well at last, what lives soever you live. +This is that which they had who said, that they should have +peace, though they walked in the wickedness of their heart, to +add drunkenness to thirst. A piece of approved armour this +is, and whoever has it, and can hold it, so long no arrow, dart, +sword, or shield can hurt him. This, therefore, keep on, +and thou wilt keep off many a blow, my Mansoul.</p> +<p>‘2. My breastplate is a breastplate of iron. I had +it forged in mine own country, and all my soldiers are armed +therewith. In plain language, it is a hard heart, a heart +as hard as iron, and as much past feeling as a stone; the which +if you get and keep, neither mercy shall win you, nor judgment +fright you. This therefore, is a piece of armour most +necessary for all to put on that hate Shaddai, and that would +fight against him under my banner.</p> +<p>‘3. My sword is a tongue that is set on fire of hell, +and that can bend itself to speak evil of Shaddai, his Son, his +ways, and people. Use this; it has been tried a thousand +times twice told. Whoever hath it, keeps it, and makes that +use of it as I would have him, can never be conquered by mine +enemy.</p> +<p>‘4. My, shield is unbelief, or calling into question the +truth of the word, or all the sayings that speak of the judgment +that Shaddai has appointed for wicked men. Use this shield; +many attempts he has made upon it, and sometimes, it is true, it +has been bruised; but they that have writ of the wars of Emmanuel +against my servants, have testified that he could do no mighty +work there because of their unbelief. Now, to handle this +weapon of mine aright, it is not to believe things because they +are true, of what sort or by whomsoever asserted. If he +speaks of judgment, care not for it; if he speaks of mercy, care +not for it; if he promises, if he swears that he would do to +Mansoul, if it turns, no hurt, but good, regard not what is said, +question the truth of all, for it is to wield the shield of +unbelief aright, and as my servants ought and do; and he that +doth otherwise loves me not, nor do I count him but an enemy to +me.</p> +<p>‘5. Another part or piece,’ said Diabolus, +‘of mine excellent armour is a dumb and prayerless spirit, +a spirit that scorns to cry for mercy: wherefore be you, my +Mansoul, sure that you make use of this. What! cry for +quarter! Never do that, if you would be mine. I know +you are stout men, and am sure that I have clad you with that +which is armour of proof. Wherefore, to cry to Shaddai for +mercy, let that be far from you. Besides all this, I have a +maul, firebrands, arrows, and death, all good hand-weapons, and +such as will do execution.’</p> +<p>After he had thus furnished his men with armour and arms, he +addressed himself to them in such like words as these: +‘Remember,’ quoth he, ‘that I am your rightful +king, and that you have taken an oath and entered into covenant +to be true to me and my cause: I say, remember this, and show +yourselves stout and valiant men of Mansoul. Remember also +the kindness that I have always showed to you, and that without +your petition I have granted to you external things; wherefore +the privileges, grants, immunities, profits, and honours +wherewith I have endowed you do call for, at your hands, returns +of loyalty, my lion-like men of Mansoul: and when so fit a time +to show it as when another shall seek to take my dominion over +you into his own hands? One word more, and I have +done. Can we but stand, and overcome this one shock or +brunt, I doubt not but in little time all the world will be ours; +and when that day comes, my true hearts, I will make you kings, +princes, and captains, and what brave days shall we have +then!’</p> +<p>Diabolus having thus armed and forearmed his servants and +vassals in Mansoul against their good and lawful King Shaddai, in +the next place, he doubleth his guards at the gates of the town, +and he takes himself to the castle, which was his +stronghold. His vassals also, to show their wills, and +supposed (but ignoble) gallantry, exercise themselves in their +arms every day, and teach one another feats of war; they also +defied their enemies, and sang up the praises of their tyrant; +they threatened also what men they would be if ever things should +rise so high as a war between Shaddai and their king.</p> +<p>Now all this time the good King, the King Shaddai, was +preparing to send an army to recover the town of Mansoul again +from under the tyranny of their pretended king Diabolus; but he +thought good, at first, not to send them by the hand and conduct +of brave Emmanuel his Son, but under the hand of some of his +servants, to see first by them the temper of Mansoul, and whether +by them they would be won to the obedience of their King. +The army consisted of above forty thousand, all true men, for +they came from the King’s own court, and were those of his +own choosing.</p> +<p>They came up to Mansoul under the conduct of four stout +generals, each man being a captain of ten thousand men, and these +are their names and their ensigns. The name of the first +was Boanerges, the name of the second was Captain Conviction, the +name of the third was Captain Judgment, and the name of the +fourth was Captain Execution. These were the captains that +Shaddai sent to regain Mansoul.</p> +<p>These four captains, as was said, the King thought fit, in the +first place, to send to Mansoul, to make an attempt upon it; for +indeed generally in all his wars he did use to send these four +captains in the van, for they were very stout and rough-hewn men, +men that were fit to break the ice, and to make their way by dint +of sword, and their men were like themselves.</p> +<p>To each of these captains the King gave a banner, that it +might be displayed, because of the goodness of his cause, and +because of the right that he had to Mansoul.</p> +<p>First, to Captain Boanerges, for he was the chief, to him, I +say, were given ten thousand men. His ensign was Mr. +Thunder; he bare the black colours, and his scutcheon was the +three burning thunderbolts.</p> +<p>The second captain was Captain Conviction; to him also were +given ten thousand men. His ensign’s name was Mr. +Sorrow; he did bear the pale colours, and his scutcheon was the +book of the law wide open, from whence issued a flame of +fire.</p> +<p>The third captain was Captain Judgment; to him were given ten +thousand men. His ensign’s name was Mr. Terror; he +bare the red colours, and his scutcheon was a burning fiery +furnace.</p> +<p>The fourth captain was Captain Execution; to him were given +ten thousand men. His ensign was one Mr. Justice; he also +bare the red colours, and his scutcheon was a fruitless tree, +with an axe lying at the root thereof.</p> +<p>These four captains, as I said, had every one of them under +his command ten thousand men, all of good fidelity to the King, +and stout at their military actions.</p> +<p>Well, the captains and their forces, their men and under +officers, being had upon a day by Shaddai into the field, and +there called all over by their names, were then and there put +into such harness as became their degree and that service which +now they were going about for their King.</p> +<p>Now, when the King had mustered his forces, (for it is he that +mustereth the host to the battle,) he gave unto the captains +their several commissions, with charge and commandment in the +audience of all the soldiers, that they should take heed +faithfully and courageously to do and execute the same. +Their commissions were, for the substance of them, the same in +form, though, as to name, title, place and degree of the +captains, there might be some, but very small variation. +And here let me give you an account of the matter and sum +contained in their commission.</p> +<blockquote><p><i>A Commission from the great Shaddai</i>, +<i>King of Mansoul</i>, <i>to his trusty and noble Captain</i>, +<i>the Captain Boanerges</i>, <i>for his making War upon the town +of Mansoul</i>.</p> +<p>‘O, thou Boanerges, one of my stout and thundering +captains over one ten thousand of my valiant and faithful +servants, go thou in my name, with this thy force, to the +miserable town of Mansoul; and when thou comest thither, offer +them first conditions of peace; and command them that, casting +off the yoke and tyranny of the wicked Diabolus, they return to +me, their rightful Prince and Lord. Command them also that +they cleanse themselves from all that is his in the town of +Mansoul, and look to thyself, that thou hast good satisfaction +touching the truth of their obedience. Thus when thou hast +commanded them, (if they in truth submit thereto,) then do thou, +to the uttermost of thy power, what in thee lies to set up for me +a garrison in the famous town of Mansoul; nor do thou hurt the +least native that moveth or breatheth therein, if they will +submit themselves to me, but treat thou such as if they were thy +friend or brother; for all such I love, and they shall be dear +unto me, and tell them that I will take a time to come unto them, +and to let them know that I am merciful.</p> +<p>‘But if they shall, notwithstanding thy summons and the +producing of thy authority, resist, stand out against thee, and +rebel, then do I command thee to make use of all thy cunning, +power, might, and force, to bring them under by strength of +hand. Farewell.’</p> +</blockquote> +<p>Thus you see the sum of their commissions; for, as I said +before, for the substance of them, they were the same that the +rest of the noble captains had.</p> +<p>Wherefore they, having received each commander his authority +at the hand of their King, the day being appointed, and the place +of their rendezvous prefixed, each commander appeared in such +gallantry as became his cause and calling. So, after a new +entertainment from Shaddai, with flying colours they set forward +to march towards the famous town of Mansoul. Captain +Boanerges led the van, Captain Conviction and Captain Judgment +made up the main body, and Captain Execution brought up the +rear. They then, having a great way to go, (for the town of +Mansoul was far off from the court of Shaddai,) marched through +the regions and countries of many people, not hurting or abusing +any, but blessing wherever they came. They also lived upon +the King’s cost in all the way they went.</p> +<p>Having travelled thus for many days, at last they came within +sight of Mansoul; the which when they saw, the captains could for +their hearts do no less than for a while bewail the condition of +the town; for they quickly saw how that it was prostrate to the +will of Diabolus, and to his ways and designs.</p> +<p>Well, to be short, the captains came up before the town, march +up to Ear-gate, sit down there (for that was the place of +hearing). So, when they had pitched their tents and +entrenched themselves, they addressed themselves to make their +assault.</p> +<p>Now the townsfolk at first, beholding so gallant a company, so +bravely accoutred, and so excellently disciplined, having on +their glittering armour, and displaying of their flying colours, +could not but come out of their houses and gaze. But the +cunning fox Diabolus, fearing that the people, after this sight, +should, on a sudden summons, open the gates to the captains, came +down with all haste from the castle, and made them retire into +the body of the town, who, when he had them there, made this +lying and deceivable speech unto them:</p> +<p>‘Gentlemen,’ quoth he, ‘although you are my +trusty and well-beloved friends, yet I cannot but a little chide +you for your late uncircumspect action, in going out to gaze on +that great and mighty force that but yesterday sat down before, +and have now entrenched themselves in order to the maintaining of +a siege against the famous town of Mansoul. Do you know who +they are, whence they come, and what is their purpose in sitting +down before the town of Mansoul? They are they of whom I +have told you long ago, that they would come to destroy this +town, and against whom I have been at the cost to arm you with +<i>cap-a-pie</i> for your body, besides great fortifications for +your mind. Wherefore, then, did you not rather, even at the +first appearance of them, cry out, “Fire the +beacons!” and give the whole town an alarm concerning them, +that we might all have been in a posture of defence, and been +ready to have received them with the highest acts of +defiance? Then had you showed yourselves men to my liking; +whereas, by what you have done, you have made me half +afraid—I say, half afraid—that when they and we shall +come to push a pike, I shall find you want courage to stand it +out any longer. Wherefore have I commanded a watch, and +that you should double your guards at the gates? Wherefore +have I endeavoured to make you as hard as iron, and your hearts +as a piece of the nether millstone? Was it, think you, that +you might show yourselves women, and that you might go out like a +company of innocents to gaze on your mortal foes? Fie, fie! +put yourselves into a posture of defence, beat up the drum, +gather together in warlike manner, that our foes may know that, +before they shall conquer this corporation, there are valiant men +in the town of Mansoul.</p> +<p>‘I will leave off now to chide, and will not further +rebuke you; but I charge you, that henceforwards you let me see +no more such actions. Let not henceforward a man of you, +without order first obtained from me, so much as show his head +over the wall of the town of Mansoul. You have now heard +me; do as I have commanded, and you shall cause me that I dwell +securely with you, and that I take care, as for myself, so for +your safety and honour also. Farewell.’</p> +<p>Now were the townsmen strangely altered; they were as men +stricken with a panic fear; they ran to and fro through the +streets of the town of Mansoul, crying out, ‘Help, help! +the men that turn the world upside down are come hither +also.’ Nor could any of them be quiet after; but +still, as men bereft of wit, they cried out, ‘The +destroyers of our peace and people are come.’ This +went down with Diabolus. ‘Ah,’ quoth he to +himself, ‘this I like well: now it is as I would have it; +now you show your obedience to your prince. Hold you but +here, and then let them take the town if they can.’</p> +<p>Well, before the King’s forces had sat before Mansoul +three days, Captain Boanerges commanded his trumpeter to go down +to Ear-gate, and there, in the name of the great Shaddai, to +summon Mansoul to give audience to the message that he, in his +Master’s name, was to them commanded to deliver. So +the trumpeter, whose name was Take-heed-what-you-hear, went up, +as he was commanded, to Ear-gate, and there sounded his trumpet +for a hearing; but there was none that appeared that gave answer +or regard, for so had Diabolus commanded. So the trumpeter +returned to his captain, and told him what he had done, and also +how he had sped; whereat the captain was grieved, but bid the +trumpeter go to his tent.</p> +<p>Again Captain Boanerges sendeth his trumpeter to Ear-gate, to +sound as before for a hearing; but they again kept close, came +not out, nor would they give him an answer, so observant were +they of the command of Diabolus their king.</p> +<p>Then the captains and other field officers called a council of +war, to consider what further was to be done for the gaining of +the town of Mansoul; and, after some close and thorough debate +upon the contents of their commissions, they concluded yet to +give to the town, by the hand of the fore-named trumpeter, +another summons to hear; but if that shall be refused, said they, +and that the town shall stand it out still, then they determined, +and bid the trumpeter tell them so, that they would endeavour, by +what means they could, to compel them by force to the obedience +of their King.</p> +<p>So Captain Boanerges commanded his trumpeter to go up to +Ear-gate again, and, in the name of the great King Shaddai, to +give it a very loud summons to come down without delay to +Ear-gate, there to give audience to the King’s most noble +captains. So the trumpeter went, and did as he was +commanded: he went up to Ear-gate, and sounded his trumpet, and +gave a third summons to Mansoul. He said, moreover, that if +this they should still refuse to do, the captains of his prince +would with might come down upon them, and endeavour to reduce +them to their obedience by force.</p> +<p>Then stood up my Lord Willbewill, who was the governor of the +town, (this Willbewill was that apostate of whom mention was made +before,) and the keeper of the gates of Mansoul. He +therefore, with big and ruffling words, demanded of the trumpeter +who he was, whence he came, and what was the cause of his making +so hideous a noise at the gate, and speaking such insufferable +words against the town of Mansoul.</p> +<p>The trumpeter answered, ‘I am servant to the most noble +captain, Captain Boanerges, general of the forces of the great +King Shaddai, against whom both thyself, with the whole town of +Mansoul, have rebelled, and lift up the heel; and my master, the +captain, hath a special message to this town, and to thee, as a +member thereof; the which if you of Mansoul shall peaceably hear, +so; and if not, you must take what follows.’</p> +<p>Then said the Lord Willbewill, ‘I will carry thy words +to my lord, and will know what he will say.’</p> +<p>But the trumpeter soon replied, saying. ‘Our +message is not to the giant Diabolus, but to the miserable town +of Mansoul; nor shall we at all regard what answer by him is +made, nor yet by any for him. We are sent to this town to +recover it from under his cruel tyranny, and to persuade it to +submit, as in former times it did, to the most excellent King +Shaddai.’</p> +<p>Then said the Lord Willbewill, ‘I will do your errand to +the town.’</p> +<p>The trumpeter then replied, ‘Sir, do not deceive us, +lest, in so doing, you deceive yourselves much more.’ +He added, moreover, ‘For we are resolved, if in peaceable +manner you do not submit yourselves, then to make a war upon you, +and to bring you under by force. And of the truth of what I +now say, this shall be a sign unto you,—you shall see the +black flag, with its hot, burning thunder-bolts, set upon the +mount to-morrow, as a token of defiance against your prince, and +of our resolutions to reduce you to your Lord and rightful +King.’</p> +<p>So the said Lord Willbewill returned from off the wall, and +the trumpeter came into the camp. When the trumpeter was +come into the camp, the captains and officers of the mighty King +Shaddai came together to know if he had obtained a hearing, and +what was the effect of his errand. So the trumpeter told, +saying, ‘When I had sounded my trumpet, and had called +aloud to the town for a hearing, my Lord Willbewill, the governor +of the town, and he that hath charge of the gates, came up when +he heard me sound, and, looking over the wall, he asked me what I +was, whence I came, and what was the cause of my making this +noise. So I told him my errand, and by whose authority I +brought it. “Then,” said he, “I will tell +it to the governor and to Mansoul;” and then I returned to +my lords.’</p> +<p>Then said the brave Boanerges, ‘Let us yet for a while +lie still in our trenches, and see what these rebels will +do.’</p> +<p>Now when the time drew nigh that audience by Mansoul must be +given to the brave Boanerges and his companions, it was commanded +that all the men of war throughout the whole camp of Shaddai +should as one man stand to their arms, and make themselves ready, +if the town of Mansoul shall hear, to receive it forthwith to +mercy; but if not, to force a subjection. So the day being +come, the trumpeters sounded, and that throughout the whole camp, +that the men of war might be in a readiness for that which then +should be the work of the day. But when they that were in +the town of Mansoul heard the sound of the trumpets throughout +the camp of Shaddai, and thinking no other but that it must be in +order to storm the corporation, they at first were put to great +consternation of spirit; but after they a little were settled +again, they also made what preparation they could for a war, if +they did storm; else, to secure themselves.</p> +<p>Well, when the utmost time was come, Boanerges was resolved to +hear their answer; wherefore he sent out his trumpeter again to +summon Mansoul to a hearing of the message that they had brought +from Shaddai.</p> +<p>So he went and sounded, and the townsmen came up, but made +Ear-gate as sure as they could. Now when they were come up +to the top of the wall, Captain Boanerges desired to see the Lord +Mayor; but my Lord Incredulity was then Lord Mayor, for he came +in the room of my Lord Lustings. So Incredulity came up and +showed himself over the wall; but when the Captain Boanerges had +set his eyes upon him, he cried out aloud, ‘This is not he: +where is my Lord Understanding, the ancient Lord Mayor of the +town of Mansoul? for to him I would deliver my +message.’</p> +<p>Then said the giant (for Diabolus was also come down) to the +captain, ‘Mr. Captain, you have by your boldness given to +Mansoul at least four summonses to subject herself to your King, +by whose authority I know not, nor will I dispute that now. +I ask, therefore, what is the reason of all this ado, or what +would you be at if you knew yourselves?’</p> +<p>Then Captain Boanerges, whose were the black colours, and +whose scutcheon was the three burning thunderbolts, taking no +notice of the giant or of his speech, thus addressed himself to +the town of Mansoul: ‘Be it known unto you, O unhappy and +rebellious Mansoul, that the most gracious King, the great King +Shaddai, my Master, hath sent me unto you with commission’ +(and so he showed to the town his broad seal) ‘to reduce +you to his obedience; and he hath commanded me, in case you yield +upon my summons, to carry it to you as if you were my friends or +brethren; but he also hath bid, that if, after summons to submit +you still stand out and rebel, we should endeavour to take you by +force.’</p> +<p>Then stood forth Captain Conviction, and said, (his were the +pale colours, and for a scutcheon he had the book of the law wide +open, etc.,) ‘Hear, O Mansoul! Thou, O Mansoul, wast +once famous for innocency, but now thou art degenerated into lies +and deceit. Thou hast heard what my brother, the Captain +Boanerges, hath said; and it is your wisdom, and will be your +happiness, to stoop to, and accept of conditions of peace and +mercy when offered, specially when offered by one against whom +thou hast rebelled, and one who is of power to tear thee in +pieces, for so is Shaddai, our King; nor, when he is angry, can +anything stand before him. If you say you have not sinned, +or acted rebellion against our King, the whole of your doings +since the day that you cast off his service (and there was the +beginning of your sin) will sufficiently testify against +you. What else means your hearkening to the tyrant, and +your receiving him for your king? What means else your +rejecting of the laws of Shaddai, and your obeying of +Diabolus? Yea, what means this your taking up of arms +against, and the shutting of your gates upon us, the faithful +servants of your King? Be ruled then, and accept of my +brother’s invitation, and overstand not the time of mercy, +but agree with thine adversary quickly. Ah, Mansoul! suffer +not thyself to be kept from mercy, and to be run into a thousand +miseries, by the flattering wiles of Diabolus. Perhaps that +piece of deceit may attempt to make you believe that we seek our +own profit in this our service, but know it is obedience to our +King, and love to your happiness, that is the cause of this +undertaking of ours.</p> +<p>‘Again I say to thee, O Mansoul, consider if it be not +amazing grace that Shaddai should so humble himself as he doth: +now he, by us, reasons with you, in a way of entreaty and sweet +persuasions, that you would subject yourselves to him. Has +he that need of you that we are sure you have of him? No, +no; but he is merciful, and will not that Mansoul should die, but +turn to him and live.’</p> +<p>Then stood forth Captain Judgment, whose were the red colours, +and for a scutcheon he had the burning fiery furnace, and he +said, ‘O ye, the inhabitants of the town of Mansoul, that +have lived so long in rebellion and acts of treason against the +King Shaddai, know that we come not to-day to this place, in this +manner, with our message of our own minds, or to revenge our own +quarrel; it is the King, my Master, that hath sent us to reduce +you to your obedience to him; the which if you refuse in a +peaceable way to yield, we have commission to compel you +thereto. And never think of yourselves, nor yet suffer the +tyrant Diabolus to persuade you to think, that our King, by his +power, is not able to bring you down, and to lay you under his +feet; for he is the former of all things, and if he touches the +mountains, they smoke. Nor will the gate of the +King’s clemency stand always open; for the day that shall +burn like an oven is before him; yea, it hasteth greatly, it +slumbereth not.</p> +<p>‘O Mansoul, is it little in thine eyes that our King +doth offer thee mercy, and that after so many provocations? +Yea, he still holdeth out his golden sceptre to thee, and will +not yet suffer his gate to be shut against thee: wilt thou +provoke him to do it? If so, consider of what I say; to +thee it is opened no more for ever. If thou sayest thou +shalt not see him, yet judgment is before him; therefore trust +thou in him. Yea, because there is wrath, beware lest he +take thee away with his stroke; then a great ransom cannot +deliver thee. Will he esteem thy riches? No, not +gold, nor all the forces of strength. He hath prepared his +throne for judgment, for he will come with fire, and with his +chariots like a whirlwind, to render his anger with fury, and his +rebukes with flames of fire. Therefore, O Mansoul, take +heed lest, after thou hast fulfilled the judgment of the wicked, +justice and judgment should take hold of thee.’</p> +<p>Now while the Captain Judgment was making this oration to the +town of Mansoul, it was observed by some that Diabolus trembled; +but he proceeded in his parable and said, ‘O thou woful +town of Mansoul, wilt thou not yet set open thy gate to receive +us, the deputies of thy King, and those that would rejoice to see +thee live? Can thine heart endure, or can thy hands be +strong, in the day that he shall deal in judgment with +thee? I say, canst thou endure to be forced to drink, as +one would drink sweet wine, the sea of wrath that our King has +prepared for Diabolus and his angels? Consider, betimes +consider.’</p> +<p>Then stood forth the fourth captain, the noble Captain +Execution, and said, ‘O town of Mansoul, once famous, but +now like the fruitless bough, once the delight of the high ones, +but now a den for Diabolus, hearken also to me, and to the words +that I shall speak to thee in the name of the great +Shaddai. Behold, the axe is laid to the root of the trees: +every tree, therefore, that bringeth not forth good fruit, is +hewn down and cast into the fire.</p> +<p>‘Thou, O town of Mansoul, hast hitherto been this +fruitless tree; thou bearest nought but thorns and briars. +Thy evil fruit bespeaks thee not to be a good tree; thy grapes +are grapes of gall, thy clusters are bitter. Thou hast +rebelled against thy King; and, lo! we, the power and force of +Shaddai, are the axe that is laid to thy root. What sayest +thou? Wilt thou turn? I say again, tell me, before +the first blow is given, wilt thou turn? Our axe must first +be laid <i>to</i> thy root before it be laid <i>at</i> thy root; +it must first be laid <i>to</i> thy root in a way of threatening, +before it is laid <i>at</i> thy root by way of execution; and +between these two is required thy repentance, and this is all the +time that thou hast. What wilt thou do? Wilt thou +turn, or shall I smite? If I fetch my blow, Mansoul, down +you go; for I have commission to lay my axe <i>at</i> as well as +<i>to</i> thy roots, nor will anything but yielding to our King +prevent doing of execution. What art thou fit for, O +Mansoul, if mercy preventeth not, but to be hewn down, and cast +into the fire and burned?</p> +<p>‘O Mansoul, patience and forbearance do not act for +ever: a year, or two, or three, they may; but if thou provoke by +a three years’ rebellion, (and thou hast already done more +than this,) then what follows but, ‘Cut it down’? +nay, ‘After that thou shalt cut it down.’ And +dost thou think that these are but threatenings, or that our King +has not power to execute his words? O Mansoul, thou wilt +find that in the words of our King, when they are by sinners made +little or light of, there is not only threatening, but burning +coals of fire.</p> +<p>‘Thou hast been a cumber-ground long already, and wilt +thou continue so still? Thy sin has brought this army to +thy walls, and shall it bring it in judgment to do execution into +thy town? Thou hast heard what the captains have said, but +as yet thou shuttest thy gates. Speak out, Mansoul; wilt +thou do so still, or wilt thou accept of conditions of +peace?’</p> +<p>These brave speeches of these four noble captains the town of +Mansoul refused to hear; yet a sound thereof did beat against +Ear-gate, though the force thereof could not break it open. +In fine, the town desired a time to prepare their answer to these +demands. The captains then told them, that if they would +throw out to them one Ill-Pause that was in the town, that they +might reward him according to his works, then they would give +them time to consider; but if they would not cast him to them +over the wall of Mansoul, then they would give them none; +‘for,’ said they, ‘we know that, so long as +Ill-Pause draws breath in Mansoul, all good consideration will be +confounded, and nothing but mischief will come +thereon.’</p> +<p>Then Diabolus, who was there present, being loath to lose his +Ill-Pause, because he was his orator, (and yet be sure he had, +could the captains have laid their fingers on him,) was resolved +at this instant to give them answer by himself; but then changing +his mind, he commanded the then Lord Mayor, the Lord Incredulity, +to do it, saying, ‘My lord, do you give these runagates an +answer, and speak out, that Mansoul may hear and understand +you.’</p> +<p>So Incredulity, at Diabolus’ command, began, and said, +‘Gentlemen, you have here, as we do behold, to the +disturbance of our prince and the molestation of the town of +Mansoul, camped against it: but from whence you come, we will not +know; and what you are, we will not believe. Indeed, you +tell us in your terrible speech that you have this authority from +Shaddai, but by what right he commands you to do it, of that we +shall yet be ignorant.</p> +<p>‘You have also, by the authority aforesaid, summoned +this town to desert her lord, and, for protection, to yield up +herself to the great Shaddai, your King; flatteringly telling +her, that if she will do it, he will pass by and not charge her +with her past offences.</p> +<p>‘Further, you have also, to the terror of the town of +Mansoul, threatened with great and sore destructions to punish +this corporation, if she consents not to do as your wills would +have her.</p> +<p>‘Now, captains, from whencesoever you come, and though +your designs be ever so right, yet know ye that neither my Lord +Diabolus, nor I, his servant, Incredulity, nor yet our brave +Mansoul, doth regard either your persons, message, or the King +that you say hath sent you. His power, his greatness, his +vengeance, we fear not; nor will we yield at all to your +summons.</p> +<p>‘As for the war that you threaten to make upon us, we +must therein defend ourselves as well as we can; and know ye, +that we are not without wherewithal to bid defiance to you; and, +in short, (for I will not be tedious,) I tell you, that we take +you to be some vagabond runagate crew, that having shaken off all +obedience to your King, have gotten together in tumultuous +manner, and are ranging from place to place to see if, through +the flatteries you are skilled to make on the one side, and +threats wherewith you think to fright on the other, to make some +silly town, city, or country, desert their place, and leave it to +you; but Mansoul is none of them.</p> +<p>‘To conclude: we dread you not, we fear you not, nor +will we obey your summons. Our gates we will shut upon you, +our place we will keep you out of. Nor will we long thus +suffer you to sit down before us: our people must live in quiet: +your appearance doth disturb them. Wherefore arise with bag +and baggage, and begone, or we will let fly from the walls +against you.’</p> +<p>This oration, made by old Incredulity, was seconded by +desperate Willbewill, in words to this effect: ‘Gentlemen, +we have heard your demands, and the noise of your threats, and +have heard the sound of your summons; but we fear not your force, +we regard not your threats, but will still abide as you found +us. And we command you, that in three days’ time you +cease to appear in these parts, or you shall know what it is once +to dare offer to rouse the lion Diabolus when asleep in his town +of Mansoul.’</p> +<p>The Recorder, whose name was Forget-Good, he also added as +followeth: ‘Gentlemen, my lords, as you see, have with mild +and gentle words answered your rough and angry speeches: they +have, moreover, in my hearing, given you leave quietly to depart +as you came; wherefore, take their kindness and be gone. We +might have come out with force upon you, and have caused you to +feel the dint of our swords; but as we love ease and quiet +ourselves, so we love not to hurt or molest others.’</p> +<p>Then did the town of Mansoul shout for joy, as if by Diabolus +and his crew some great advantage had been gotten of the +captains. They also rang the bells, and made merry, and +danced upon the walls.</p> +<p>Diabolus also returned to the castle, and the Lord Mayor and +Recorder to their place; but the Lord Willbewill took special +care that the gates should be secured with double guards, double +bolts, and double locks and bars; and that Ear-gate especially +might the better be looked to, for that was the gate in at which +the King’s forces sought most to enter. The Lord +Willbewill made one old Mr. Prejudice, an angry and +ill-conditioned fellow, captain of the ward at that gate, and put +under his power sixty men, called deaf men; men advantageous for +that service, forasmuch as they mattered no words of the +captains, nor of the soldiers.</p> +<p>Now when the captains saw the answer of the great ones, and +that they could not get a hearing from the old natives of the +town, and that Mansoul was resolved to give the King’s army +battle, they prepared themselves to receive them, and to try it +out by the power of the arm. And, first, they made their +force more formidable against Ear-gate; for they knew that, +unless they could penetrate that, no good could be done upon the +town. This done, they put the rest of their men in their +places; after which, they gave out the word, which was, +‘<span class="smcap">Ye must be born +again</span>.’ Then they sounded the trumpet; then +they in the town made them answer, with shout against shout, +charge against charge, and so the battle began. Now they in +the town had planted upon the tower over Ear-gate two great guns, +the one called High-mind, and the other Heady. Unto these +two guns they trusted much; they were cast in the castle by +Diabolus’ founder, whose name was Mr. Puff-up, and +mischievous pieces they were. But so vigilant and watchful, +when the captains saw them, were they, that though sometimes +their shot would go by their ears with a whiz, yet they did them +no harm. By these two guns the townsfolk made no question +but greatly to annoy the camp of Shaddai, and well enough to +secure the gate; but they had not much cause to boast of what +execution they did, as by what follows will be gathered.</p> +<p>The famous Mansoul had also some other small pieces in it, of +the which they made use against the camp of Shaddai.</p> +<p>They from the camp also did as stoutly, and with as much of +that as may in truth be called valour, let fly as fast at the +town and at Ear-gate; for they saw that, unless they could break +open Ear-gate, it would be but in vain to batter the wall. +Now the King’s captains had brought with them several +slings, and two or three battering-rams; with their slings, +therefore, they battered the houses and people of the town, and +with their rams they sought to break Ear-gate open.</p> +<p>The camp and the town had several skirmishes and brisk +encounters, while the captains with their engines made many brave +attempts to break open or beat down the tower that was over +Ear-gate, and at the said gate to make their entrance; but +Mansoul stood it out so lustily, through the rage of Diabolus, +the valour of the Lord Willbewill, and the conduct of old +Incredulity, the Mayor, and Mr. Forget-Good, the Recorder, that +the charge and expense of that summer’s wars, on the +King’s side, seemed to be almost quite lost, and the +advantage to return to Mansoul. But when the captains saw +how it was they made a fair retreat, and entrenched themselves in +their winter quarters. Now, in this war, you must needs +think there was much loss on both sides, of which be pleased to +accept of this brief account following.</p> +<p>The King’s captains, when they marched from the court to +come up against Mansoul to war, as they came crossing over the +country, they happened to light upon three young fellows that had +a mind to go for soldiers: proper men they were, and men of +courage and skill, to appearance. Their names were Mr. +Tradition, Mr. Human-Wisdom, and Mr. Man’s-Invention. +So they came up to the captains, and proffered their service to +Shaddai. The captains then told them of their design, and +bid them not to be rash in their offers; but the young men told +them they had considered the thing before, and that hearing they +were upon their march for such a design, came hither on purpose +to meet them, that they might be listed under their +excellencies. Then Captain Boanerges, for that they were +men of courage, listed them into his company, and so away they +went to the war.</p> +<p>Now, when the war was begun, in one of the briskest +skirmishes, so it was, that a company of the Lord +Willbewill’s men sallied out at the sallyport or postern of +the town, and fell in upon the rear of Captain Boanerges’ +men, where these three fellows happened to be; so they took them +prisoners, and away they carried them into the town, where they +had not lain long in durance, but it began to be noised about the +streets of the town what three notable prisoners the Lord +Willbewill’s men had taken, and brought in prisoners out of +the camp of Shaddai. At length tidings thereof were carried +to Diabolus to the castle, to wit what my Lord Willbewill’s +men had done, and whom they had taken prisoners.</p> +<p>Then Diabolus called for Willbewill, to know the certainty of +this matter. So he asked him, and he told him. Then +did the giant send for the prisoners, and, when they were come, +demanded of them who they were, whence they came, and what they +did in the camp of Shaddai; and they told him. Then he sent +them to ward again. Not many days after, he sent for them +to him again, and then asked them if they would be willing to +serve him against their former captains. They then told him +that they did not so much live by religion as by the fates of +fortune; and that since his lordship was willing to entertain +them, they should be willing to serve him. Now while things +were thus in hand, there was one Captain Anything, a great doer, +in the town of Mansoul; and to this Captain Anything did Diabolus +send these men, and a note under his hand, to receive them into +his company, the contents of which letter were thus:</p> +<p>‘Anything, my darling,—The three men that are the +bearers of this letter have a desire to serve me in the war; nor +know I better to whose conduct to commit them than to +thine. Receive them, therefore, in my name, and, as need +shall require, make use of them against Shaddai and his +men. Farewell.’</p> +<p>So they came, and he received them; and he made of two of them +sergeants; but he made Mr. Man’s-Invention his +ancient-bearer. But thus much for this, and now to return +to the camp.</p> +<p>They of the camp did also some execution upon the town; for +they did beat down the roof of the Lord Mayor’s house, and +so laid him more open than he was before. They had almost, +with a sling, slain my Lord Willbewill outright; but he made a +shift to recover again. But they made a notable slaughter +among the aldermen, for with one only shot they cut off six of +them; to wit, Mr. Swearing, Mr. Whoring, Mr. Fury, Mr. +Stand-to-Lies, Mr. Drunkenness, and Mr. Cheating.</p> +<p>They also dismounted the two guns that stood upon the tower +over Ear-gate, and laid them flat in the dirt. I told you +before that the King’s noble captains had drawn off to +their winter quarters, and had there entrenched themselves and +their carriages, so as with the best advantage to their King, and +the greatest annoyance to the enemy, they might give seasonable +and warm alarms to the town of Mansoul. And this design of +them did so hit, that I may say they did almost what they would +to the molestation of the corporation. For now could not +Mansoul sleep securely as before, nor could they now go to their +debaucheries with that quietness as in times past; for they had +from the camp of Shaddai such frequent, warm, and terrifying +alarms, yea, alarms upon alarms, first at one gate and then at +another, and again at all the gates at once, that they were +broken as to former peace. Yea, they had their alarms so +frequently, and that when the nights were at longest, the weather +coldest, and so consequently the season most unseasonable, that +that winter was to the town of Mansoul a winter by itself. +Sometimes the trumpets would sound, and sometimes the slings +would whirl the stones into the town. Sometimes ten +thousand of the King’s soldiers would be running round the +walls of Mansoul at midnight, shouting and lifting up the voice +for the battle. Sometimes, again, some of them in the town +would be wounded, and their cry and lamentable voice would be +heard, to the great molestation of the now languishing town of +Mansoul. Yea, so distressed with those that laid siege +against them were they, that, I dare say, Diabolus, their king, +had in these days his rest much broken.</p> +<p>In these days, as I was informed, new thoughts, and thoughts +that began to run counter one to another, began to possess the +minds of the men of the town of Mansoul. Some would say, +‘There is no living thus.’ Others would then +reply, ‘This will be over shortly.’ Then would +a third stand up and answer, ‘Let us turn to the King +Shaddai, and so put an end to these troubles.’ And a +fourth would come in with a fear, saying, ‘I doubt he will +not receive us.’ The old gentleman, too, the +Recorder, that was so before Diabolus took Mansoul, he also began +to talk aloud, and his words were now to the town of Mansoul as +if they were great claps of thunder. No noise now so +terrible to Mansoul as was his, with the noise of the soldiers +and shoutings of the captains.</p> +<p>Also things began to grow scarce in Mansoul; now the things +that her soul lusted after were departing from her. Upon +all her pleasant things there was a blast, and burning instead of +beauty. Wrinkles now, and some shows of the shadow of +death, were upon the inhabitants of Mansoul. And now, O how +glad would Mansoul have been to have enjoyed quietness and +satisfaction of mind, though joined with the meanest condition in +the world!</p> +<p>The captains also, in the deep of this winter, did send by the +mouth of Boanerges’ trumpeter a summons to Mansoul to yield +up herself to the King, the great King Shaddai. They sent +it once, and twice, and thrice; not knowing but that at some +times there might be in Mansoul some willingness to surrender up +themselves unto them, might they but have the colour of an +invitation to do it under. Yea, so far as I could gather, +the town had been surrendered up to them before now, had it not +been for the opposition of old Incredulity, and the fickleness of +the thoughts of my Lord Willbewill. Diabolus also began to +rave; wherefore Mansoul, as to yielding, was not yet all of one +mind; therefore they still lay distressed under these perplexing +fears.</p> +<p>I told you but now that they of the King’s army had this +winter sent three times to Mansoul to submit herself.</p> +<p>The first time the trumpeter went he went with words of peace, +telling them that the captains, the noble captains of Shaddai, +did pity and bewail the misery of the now perishing town of +Mansoul, and were troubled to see them so much to stand in the +way of their own deliverance. He said, moreover, that the +captains bid him tell them, that if now poor Mansoul would humble +herself and turn, her former rebellions and most notorious +treasons should by their merciful King be forgiven them, yea, and +forgotten too. And having bid them beware that they stood +not in their own way, that they opposed not themselves, nor made +themselves their own losers, he returned again into the camp.</p> +<p>The second time the trumpeter went, he did treat them a little +more roughly; for, after sound of trumpet, he told them that +their continuing in their rebellion did but chafe and heat the +spirit of the captains, and that they were resolved to make a +conquest of Mansoul, or to lay their bones before the town +walls.</p> +<p>He went again the third time, and dealt with them yet more +roughly; telling them that now, since they had been so horribly +profane, he did not know, not certainly know, whether the +captains were inclining to mercy or judgment. +‘Only,’ said he, ‘they commanded me to give you +a summons to open the gates unto them.’ So he +returned, and went into the camp.</p> +<p>These three summonses, and especially the last two, did so +distress the town that they presently call a consultation, the +result of which was this—That my Lord Willbewill should go +up to Ear-gate, and there, with sound of trumpet, call to the +captains of the camp for a parley. Well, the Lord +Willbewill sounded upon the wall; so the captains came up in +their harness, with their ten thousands at their feet. The +townsmen then told the captains that they had heard and +considered their summons, and would come to an agreement with +them, and with their King Shaddai, upon such certain terms, +articles, and propositions as, with and by the order of their +prince, they to them were appointed to propound; to wit, they +would agree upon these grounds to be one people with them.</p> +<p>1. If that those of their own company, as the now Lord Mayor +and their Mr. Forget-Good, with then brave Lord Willbewill, +might, under Shaddai, be still the governors of the town, castle, +and gates of Mansoul.</p> +<p>2. Provided that no man that now serveth under their great +giant Diabolus be by Shaddai cast out of house, harbour, or the +freedom that he hath hitherto enjoyed in the famous town of +Mansoul.</p> +<p>3. That it shall be granted them, that they of the town of +Mansoul shall enjoy certain of their rights and privileges; to +wit, such as have formerly been granted them, and that they have +long lived in the enjoyment of, under the reign of their king +Diabolus, that now is, and long has been, their only lord and +great defender.</p> +<p>4. That no new law, officer, or executioner of law or office, +shall have any power over them, without their own choice and +consent.</p> +<p>‘These be our propositions, or conditions of peace; and +upon these terms,’ said they, ‘we will submit to your +King.’</p> +<p>But when the captains had heard this weak and feeble offer of +the town of Mansoul, and their high and bold demands, they made +to them again, by their noble captain, the Captain Boanerges, +this speech following:</p> +<p>‘O ye inhabitants of the town of Mansoul, when I heard +your trumpet sound for a parley with us, I can truly say I was +glad; but when you said you were willing to submit yourselves to +our King and Lord, then I was yet more glad; but when, by your +silly provisos and foolish cavils, you laid the stumbling-block +of your iniquity before your own faces, then was my gladness +turned into sorrows, and my hopeful beginnings of your return, +into languishing fainting fears.</p> +<p>‘I count that old Ill-Pause, the ancient enemy of +Mansoul, did draw up those proposals that now you present us with +as terms of an agreement; but they deserve not to be admitted to +sound in the ear of any man that pretends to have service for +Shaddai. We do therefore jointly, and that with the highest +disdain, refuse and reject such things, as the greatest of +iniquities.</p> +<p>‘But, O Mansoul, if you will give yourselves into our +hands, or rather into the hands of our King, and will trust him +to make such terms with and for you as shall seem good in his +eyes, (and I dare say they shall be such as you shall find to be +most profitable to you,) then we will receive you, and be at +peace with you; but if you like not to trust yourselves in the +arms of Shaddai our King, then things are but where they were +before, and we know also what we have to do.’</p> +<p>Then cried out old Incredulity, the Lord Mayor, and said, +‘And who, being out of the hands of their enemies, as ye +see we are now, will be so foolish as to put the staff out of +their own hands into the hands of they know not who? I, for +my part, will never yield to so unlimited a proposition. Do +we know the manner and temper of their King? It is said by +some that he will be angry with his subjects if but the breadth +of an hair they chance to step out of the way; and by others, +that he requireth of them much more than they can perform. +Wherefore, it seems, O Mansoul, to be thy wisdom to take good +heed what thou dost in this matter; for if you once yield, you +give up yourselves to another, and so you are no more your +own. Wherefore, to give up yourselves to an unlimited +power, is the greatest folly in the world; for now you indeed may +repent, but can never justly complain. But do you indeed +know, when you are his, which of you he will kill, and which of +you he will save alive; or whether he will not cut off every one +of us, and send out of his own country another new people, and +cause them to inhabit this town?’</p> +<p>This speech of the Lord Mayor undid all, and threw flat to the +ground their hopes of an accord. Wherefore the captains +returned to their trenches, to their tents, and to their men, as +they were; and the Mayor to the castle and to his King.</p> +<p>Now Diabolus had waited for his return, for he had heard that +they had been at their points. So, when he was come into +the chamber of state, Diabolus saluted him +with—‘Welcome, my lord. How went matters +betwixt you to-day?’ So the Lord Incredulity, with a +low congee, told him the whole of the matter, saying, ‘Thus +and thus said the captains of Shaddai, and thus and thus said +I.’ The which when it was told to Diabolus, he was +very glad to hear it, and said, ‘My Lord Mayor, my faithful +Incredulity, I have proved thy fidelity above ten times already, +but never yet found thee false. I do promise thee, if we +rub over this brunt, to prefer thee to a place of honour, a place +far better than to be Lord Mayor of Mansoul. I will make +thee my universal deputy, and thou shalt, next to me, have all +nations under thy hand; yea, and thou shalt lay bands upon them, +that they may not resist thee; nor shall any of our vassals walk +more at liberty, but those that shall be content to walk in thy +fetters.’</p> +<p>Now came the Lord Mayor out from Diabolus, as if he had +obtained a favour indeed. Wherefore to his habitation he +goes in great state, and thinks to feed himself well enough with +hopes, until the time came that his greatness should be +enlarged.</p> +<p>But now, though the Lord Mayor and Diabolus did thus well +agree, yet this repulse to the brave captains put Mansoul into a +mutiny. For while old Incredulity went into the castle to +congratulate his lord with what had passed, the old Lord Mayor, +that was so before Diabolus came to the town, to wit, my Lord +Understanding, and the old Recorder, Mr. Conscience, getting +intelligence of what had passed at Ear-gate, (for you must know +that they might not be suffered to be at that debate, lest they +should then have mutinied for the captains; but, I say, they got +intelligence of what had passed there, and were much concerned +therewith,) wherefore they, getting some of the town together, +began to possess them with the reasonableness of the noble +captains’ demands, and with the bad consequences that would +follow upon the speech of old Incredulity, the Lord Mayor; to wit +how little reverence he showed therein either to the captains or +to their King; also how he implicitly charged them with +unfaithfulness and treachery. ‘For what less,’ +quoth they, ‘could be made of his words, when he said he +would not yield to their proposition; and added, moreover, a +supposition that he would destroy us, when before he had sent us +word that he would show us mercy!’ The multitude, +being now possessed with the conviction of the evil that old +Incredulity had done, began to run together by companies in all +places, and in every corner of the streets of Mansoul; and first +they began to mutter, then to talk openly, and after that they +run to and fro, and cried as they run, ‘Oh the brave +captains of Shaddai! would we were under the government of the +captains, and of Shaddai their King!’ When the Lord +Mayor had intelligence that Mansoul was in an uproar, down he +comes to appease the people, and thought to have quashed their +heat with the bigness and the show of his countenance; but when +they saw him, they came running upon him, and had doubtless done +him a mischief, had he not betaken himself to house. +However, they strongly assaulted the house where he was, to have +pulled it down about his ears; but the place was too strong, so +they failed of that. So he, taking some courage, addressed +himself, out at a window, to the people in this manner:</p> +<p>‘Gentlemen, what is the reason that there is here such +an uproar to-day?’</p> +<p>Then answered my Lord Understanding, ‘It is even because +that thou and thy master have carried it not rightly, and as you +should, to the captains of Shaddai; for in three things you are +faulty. First, in that you would not let Mr. Conscience and +myself be at the hearing of your discourse. Secondly, in +that you propounded such terms of peace to the captains that by +no means could be granted, unless they had intended that their +Shaddai should have been only a titular prince, and that Mansoul +should still have had power by law to have lived in all lewdness +and vanity before him, and so by consequence Diabolus should +still here be king in power, and the other only king in +name. Thirdly, for that thou didst thyself, after the +captains had showed us upon what conditions they would have +received us to mercy, even undo all again with thy unsavoury, +unseasonable, and ungodly speech.’</p> +<p>When old Incredulity had heard this speech, he cried out, +‘Treason! treason! To your arms! to your arms! +O ye, the trusty friends of Diabolus in Mansoul.’</p> +<p><i>Und.</i>—Sir, you may put upon my words what meaning +you please; but I am sure that the captains of such an high lord +as theirs is, deserved a better treatment at your hands.</p> +<p>Then said old Incredulity, ‘This is but little +better. But, Sir,’ quoth he, ‘what I spake I +spake for my prince, for his government, and the quieting of the +people, whom by your unlawful actions you have this day set to +mutiny against us.’</p> +<p>Then replied the old Recorder, whose name was Mr. Conscience, +and said, ‘Sir, you ought not thus to retort upon what my +Lord Understanding hath said. It is evident enough that he +hath spoken the truth, and that you are an enemy to +Mansoul. Be convinced, then, of the evil of your saucy and +malapert language, and of the grief that you have put the +captains to; yea, and of the damages that you have done to +Mansoul thereby. Had you accepted of the conditions, the +sound of the trumpet and the alarm of war had now ceased about +the town of Mansoul; but that dreadful sound abides, and your +want of wisdom in your speech has been the cause of +it.’</p> +<p>Then said old Incredulity, ‘Sir, if I live, I will do +your errand to Diabolus, and there you shall have an answer to +your words. Meanwhile we will seek the good of the town, +and not ask counsel of you.’</p> +<p><i>Und.</i>—Sir, your prince and you are both foreigners +to Mansoul, and not the natives thereof; and who can tell but +that, when you have brought us into greater straits, (when you +also shall see that yourselves can be safe by no other means than +by flight,) you may leave us and shift for yourselves, or set us +on fire, and go away in the smoke, or by the light of our +burning, and so leave us in our ruins?</p> +<p><i>Incred.</i>—Sir, you forget that you are under a +governor, and that you ought to demean yourself like a subject; +and know ye, when my lord the king shall hear of this day’s +work, he will give you but little thanks for your labour.</p> +<p>Now while these gentlemen were thus in their chiding words, +down come from the walls and gates of the town the Lord +Willbewill, Mr. Prejudice, old Ill-Pause, and several of the +new-made aldermen and burgesses, and they asked the reason of the +hubbub and tumult; and with that every man began to tell his own +tale, so that nothing could be heard distinctly. Then was a +silence commanded, and the old fox Incredulity began to +speak. ‘My lord,’ quoth he, ‘here are a +couple of peevish gentlemen, that have, as a fruit of their bad +dispositions, and, as I fear, through the advice of one Mr. +Discontent, tumultuously gathered this company against me this +day, and also attempted to run the town into acts of rebellion +against our prince.’</p> +<p>Then stood up all the Diabolonians that were present, and +affirmed these things to be true.</p> +<p>Now when they that took part with my Lord Understanding and +with Mr. Conscience perceived that they were like to come to the +worst, for that force and power was on the other side, they came +in for their help and relief; so a great company was on both +sides. Then they on Incredulity’s side would have had +the two old gentlemen presently away to prison; but they on the +other side said they should not. Then they began to cry up +parties again: the Diabolonians cried up old Incredulity, +Forget-Good, the new aldermen, and their great one Diabolus; and +the other party, they as fast cried up Shaddai, the captains, his +laws, their mercifulness, and applauded their conditions and +ways. Thus the bickerment went awhile; at last they passed +from words to blows, and now there were knocks on both +sides. The good old gentleman, Mr. Conscience, was knocked +down twice by one of the Diabolonians, whose name was Mr. +Benumbing; and my Lord Understanding had like to have been slain +with an arquebuse, but that he that shot did not take his aim +aright. Nor did the other side wholly escape; for there was +one Mr. Rashhead, a Diabolonian, that had his brains beaten out +by Mr. Mind, the Lord Willbewill’s servant; and it made me +laugh to see how old Mr. Prejudice was kicked and tumbled about +in the dirt; for though, a while since, he was made captain of a +company of the Diabolonians, to the hurt and damage of the town, +yet now they had got him under their feet, and, I’ll assure +you, he had, by some of the Lord Understanding’s party, his +crown cracked to boot. Mr. Anything also, he became a brisk +man in the broil; but both sides were against him, because he was +true to none. Yet he had, for his malapertness, one of his +legs broken, and he that did it wished it had been his +neck. Much more harm was done on both sides, but this must +not be forgotten; it was now a wonder to see my Lord Willbewill +so indifferent as he was: he did not seem to take one side more +than another, only it was perceived that he smiled to see how old +Prejudice was tumbled up and down in the dirt. Also, when +Captain Anything came halting up before him, he seemed to take +but little notice of him.</p> +<p>Now, when the uproar was over, Diabolus sends for my Lord +Understanding and Mr. Conscience, and claps them both up in +prison as the ringleaders and managers of this most heavy, +riotous rout in Mansoul. So now the town began to be quiet +again, and the prisoners were used hardly; yea, he thought to +have made them away, but that the present juncture did not serve +for that purpose, for that war was in all their gates.</p> +<p>But let us return again to our story. The captains, when +they were gone back from the gate, and were come into the camp +again, called a council of war, to consult what was further for +them to do. Now, some said, ‘Let us go up presently, +and fall upon the town;’ but the greatest part thought +rather better it would be to give them another summons to yield; +and the reason why they thought this to be best was, because +that, so far as could be perceived, the town of Mansoul now was +more inclinable than heretofore. ‘And if,’ said +they, ‘while some of them are in a way of inclination, we +should by ruggedness give them distaste, we may set them further +from closing with our summons than we would be willing they +should.’ Wherefore to this advice they agreed, and +called a trumpeter, put words into his mouth, set him his time, +and bid him God speed. Well, many hours were not expired +before the trumpeter addressed himself to his journey. +Wherefore, coming up to the wall of the town, he steereth his +course to Ear-gate, and there sounded, as he was commanded. +They then that were within came out to see what was the matter, +and the trumpeter made them this speech following:</p> +<p>‘O hard-hearted and deplorable town of Mansoul, how long +wilt thou love thy sinful, sinful simplicity, and, ye fools, +delight in your scorning? As yet despise you the offers of +peace and deliverance? As yet will ye refuse the golden +offers of Shaddai, and trust to the lies and falsehoods of +Diabolus? Think you, when Shaddai shall have conquered you, +that the remembrance of these your carriages towards him will +yield you peace and comfort, or that by ruffling language you can +make him afraid as a grasshopper? Doth he entreat you for +fear of you? Do you think that you are stronger than +he? Look to the heavens, and behold and consider the stars, +how high are they? Can you stop the sun from running his +course, and hinder the moon from giving her light? Can you +count the number of the stars, or stay the bottles of +heaven? Can you call for the waters of the sea, and cause +them to cover the face of the ground? Can you behold every +one that is proud, and abase him, and bind their faces in +secret? Yet these are some of the works of our King, in +whose name this day we come up unto you, that you may be brought +under his authority. In his name, therefore, I summon you +again to yield up yourselves to his captains.’</p> +<p>At this summons the Mansoulians seemed to be at a stand, and +knew not what answer to make. Wherefore Diabolus forthwith +appeared, and took upon him to do it himself; and thus he begins, +but turns his speech to them of Mansoul.</p> +<p>‘Gentlemen,’ quoth he, ‘and my faithful +subjects, if it is true that this summoner hath said concerning +the greatness of their King, by his terror you will always be +kept in bondage, and so be made to sneak. Yea, how can you +now, though he is at a distance, endure to think of such a mighty +one? And if not to think of him while at a distance, how +can you endure to be in his presence? I, your prince, am +familiar with you, and you may play with me as you would with a +grasshopper. Consider, therefore, what is for your profit, +and remember the immunities that I have granted you.</p> +<p>‘Farther, if all be true that this man hath said, how +comes it to pass that the subjects of Shaddai are so enslaved in +all places where they come? None in the universe so unhappy +as they, none so trampled upon as they.</p> +<p>‘Consider, my Mansoul: would thou wert as loath to leave +me as I am loath to leave thee. But consider, I say, the +ball is yet at thy foot; liberty you have, if you know how to use +it; yea, a king you have too, if you can tell how to love and +obey him.’</p> +<p>Upon this speech, the town of Mansoul did again harden their +hearts yet more against the captains of Shaddai. The +thoughts of his greatness did quite quash them, and the thoughts +of his holiness sunk them in despair. Wherefore, after a +short consult, they (of the Diabolonian party they were) sent +back this word by the trumpeter, That, for their parts, they were +resolved to stick to their king, but never to yield to Shaddai; +so it was but in vain to give them any further summons, for they +had rather die upon the place than yield. And now things +seemed to be gone quite back, and Mansoul to be out of reach or +call, yet the captains who knew what their Lord could do, would +not yet be beat out of heart; they therefore sent them another +summons, more sharp and severe than the last; but the oftener +they were sent to, to reconcile to Shaddai, the further off they +were. ‘As they called them, so they went from +them—yea, though they called them to the Most +High.’</p> +<p>So they ceased that way to deal with them any more, and +inclined to think of another way. The captains, therefore, +did gather themselves together, to have free conference among +themselves, to know what was yet to be done to gain the town, and +to deliver it from the tyranny of Diabolus; and one said after +this manner, and another after that. Then stood up the +right noble the Captain Conviction, and said, ‘My brethren, +mine opinion is this:</p> +<p>‘First, that we continually play our slings into the +town, and keep it in a continual alarm, molesting them day and +night. By thus doing, we shall stop the growth of their +rampant spirit; for a lion may be tamed by continual +molestation.</p> +<p>‘Secondly, this done, I advise that, in the next place, +we with one consent draw up a petition to our Lord Shaddai, by +which, after we have showed our King the condition of Mansoul and +of affairs here, and have begged his pardon for our no better +success, we will earnestly implore his Majesty’s help, and +that he will please to send us more force and power, and some +gallant and well-spoken commander to head them, that so his +Majesty may not lose the benefit of these his good beginnings, +but may complete his conquest upon the town of +Mansoul.’</p> +<p>To this speech of the noble Captain Conviction they as one man +consented, and agreed that a petition should forthwith be drawn +up, and sent by a fit man away to Shaddai with speed. The +contents of the petition were thus:—</p> +<p>‘Most gracious and glorious King, the Lord of the best +world, and the builder of the town of Mansoul, we have, dread +Sovereign, at thy commandment, put our lives in jeopardy, and at +thy bidding made a war upon the famous town of Mansoul. +When we went up against it, we did, according to our commission, +first offer conditions of peace unto it. But they, great +King, set light by our counsel, and would none of our +reproof. They were for shutting their gates, and for +keeping us out of the town. They also mounted their guns, +they sallied out upon us, and have done us what damage they +could; but we pursued them with alarm upon alarm, requiting them +with such retribution as was meet, and have done some execution +upon the town.</p> +<p>‘Diabolus, Incredulity, and Willbewill are the great +doers against us: now we are in our winter quarters, but so as +that we do yet with an high hand molest and distress the +town.</p> +<p>‘Once, as we think, had we had but one substantial +friend in the town, such as would but have seconded the sound of +our summons as they ought, the people might have yielded +themselves; but there were none but enemies there, nor any to +speak in behalf of our Lord to the town. Wherefore, though +we have done as we could, yet Mansoul abides in a state of +rebellion against thee.</p> +<p>‘Now, King of kings, let it please thee to pardon the +unsuccessfulness of thy servants, who have been no more +advantageous in so desirable a work as the conquering of Mansoul +is. And send, Lord, as we now desire, more forces to +Mansoul, that it may be subdued; and a man to head them, that the +town may both love and fear.</p> +<p>‘We do not thus speak because we are willing to +relinquish the wars, (for we are for laying of our bones against +the place,) but that the town of Mansoul may be won for thy +Majesty. We also pray thy Majesty, for expedition in this +matter, that, after their conquest, we may be at liberty to be +sent about other thy gracious designs. Amen.’</p> +<p>The petition, thus drawn up, was sent away with haste to the +King by the hand of that good man, Mr. Love-to-Mansoul.</p> +<p>When this petition was come to the palace of the King, who +should it be delivered to but to the King’s Son? So +he took it and read it, and because the contents of it pleased +him well, he mended, and also in some things added to the +petition himself. So, after he had made such amendments and +additions as he thought convenient, with his own hand, he carried +it in to the King; to whom, when he had with obeisance delivered +it, he put on authority, and spake to it himself.</p> +<p>Now the King, at the sight of the petition, was glad; but how +much more, think you, when it was seconded by his Son! It +pleased him also to hear that his servants who camped against +Mansoul were so hearty in the work, and so steadfast in their +resolves, and that they had already got some ground upon the +famous town of Mansoul.</p> +<p>Wherefore the King called to him Emmanuel, his Son, who said, +‘Here am I, my Father.’ Then said the King, +‘Thou knowest, as I do myself, the condition of the town of +Mansoul, and what we have purposed, and what thou hast done to +redeem it. Come now, therefore, my Son, and prepare thyself +for the war, for thou shalt go to my camp at Mansoul. Thou +shalt also there prosper and prevail, and conquer the town of +Mansoul.’</p> +<p>Then said the King’s Son, ‘Thy law is within my +heart: I delight to do thy will. This is the day that I +have longed for, and the work that I have waited for all this +while. Grant me, therefore, what force thou shalt in thy +wisdom think meet; and I will go and will deliver from Diabolus, +and from his power, thy perishing town of Mansoul. My heart +has been often pained within me for the miserable town of +Mansoul; but now it is rejoiced, but now it is glad.’</p> +<p>And with that he leaped over the mountains for joy, saying, +‘I have not, in my heart, thought anything too dear for +Mansoul: the day of vengeance is in mine heart for thee, my +Mansoul: and glad am I that thou, my Father, hast made me the +Captain of their salvation. And I will now begin to plague +all those that have been a plague to my town of Mansoul, and will +deliver it from their hand.’</p> +<p>When the King’s Son had said thus to his Father, it +presently flew like lightning round about at court; yea, it there +became the only talk what Emmanuel was to go to do for the famous +town of Mansoul. But you cannot think how the courtiers, +too, were taken with this design of the Prince; yea, so affected +were they with this work, and with the justness of the war, that +the highest lord and greatest peer of the kingdom did covet to +have commissions under Emmanuel, to go to help to recover again +to Shaddai the miserable town of Mansoul.</p> +<p>Then was it concluded that some should go and carry tidings to +the camp, that Emmanuel was to come to recover Mansoul, and that +he would bring along with him so mighty, so impregnable a force, +that he could not be resisted. But, oh! how ready were the +high ones at court to run like lackeys to carry these tidings to +the camp that was at Mansoul. Now, when the captains +perceived that the King would send Emmanuel his Son, and that it +also delighted the Son to be sent on this errand by the great +Shaddai his Father, they also, to show how they were pleased at +the thoughts of his coming gave a shout that made the earth rend +at the sound thereof. Yea, the mountains did answer again +by echo, and Diabolus himself did totter and shake.</p> +<p>For you must know, that though the town of Mansoul itself was +not much, if at all concerned with the project, (for, alas for +them! they were wofully besotted, for they chiefly regarded their +pleasure and their lusts,) yet Diabolus their governor was; for +he had his spies continually abroad, who brought him intelligence +of all things, and they told him what was doing at court against +him, and that Emmanuel would shortly certainly come with a power +to invade him. Nor was there any man at court, nor peer of +the kingdom, that Diabolus so feared as he feared this Prince; +for, if you remember, I showed you before that Diabolus had felt +the weight of his hand already; so that, since it was he that was +to come, this made him the more afraid.</p> +<p>Well, you see how I have told you that the King’s Son +was engaged to come from the court to save Mansoul, and that his +Father had made him the Captain of the forces. The time, +therefore, of his setting forth being now expired, he addressed +himself for his march, and taketh with him, for his power, five +noble captains and their forces.</p> +<p>1. The first was that famous captain, the noble Captain +Credence. His were the red colours, and Mr. Promise bare +them; and for a scutcheon he had the holy lamb and golden shield; +and he had ten thousand men at his feet.</p> +<p>2. The second was that famous captain, the Captain +Good-Hope. His were the blue colours; his standard-bearer +was Mr. Expectation, and for his scutcheon he had the three +golden anchors; and he had ten thousand men at his feet.</p> +<p>3. The third was that valiant captain, the Captain +Charity. His standard-bearer was Mr. Pitiful: his were the +green colours, and for his scutcheon he had three naked orphans +embraced in the bosom; and he had ten thousand men at his +feet.</p> +<p>4. The fourth was that gallant commander, the Captain +Innocent. His standard-bearer was Mr. Harmless: his were +the white colours, and for his scutcheon he had the three golden +doves.</p> +<p>5. The fifth was the truly loyal and well-beloved captain, the +Captain Patience. His standard-bearer was Mr. Suffer-Long: +his were the black colours, and for a scutcheon he had three +arrows through the golden heart.</p> +<p>These were Emmanuel’s captains; these their +standard-bearers, their colours, and their scutcheons; and these +the men under their command. So, as was said, the brave +Prince took his march to go to the town of Mansoul. Captain +Credence led the van, and Captain Patience brought up the rear; +so the other three, with their men, made up the main body, the +Prince himself riding in his chariot at the head of them.</p> +<p>But when they set out for their march, oh, how the trumpets +sounded, their armour glittered, and how the colours waved in the +wind! The Prince’s armour was all of gold, and it +shone like the sun in the firmament; the captains’ armour +was of proof, and was in appearance like the glittering +stars. There were also some from the court that rode +reformades for the love that they had to the King Shaddai, and +for the happy deliverance of the town of Mansoul.</p> +<p>Emmanuel also, when he had thus set forwards to go to recover +the town of Mansoul, took with him, at the commandment of his +Father, fifty-four battering-rams, and twelve slings to whirl +stones withal. Every one of these was made of pure gold, +and these they carried with them, in the heart and body of their +army, all along as they went to Mansoul.</p> +<p>So they marched till they came within less than a league of +the town; there they lay till the first four captains came +thither to acquaint them with matters. Then they took their +journey to go to the town of Mansoul, and unto Mansoul they came; +but when the old soldiers that were in the camp saw that they had +new forces to join with, they again gave such a shout before the +walls of the town of Mansoul, that it put Diabolus into another +fright. So they sat down before the town, not now as the +other four captains did, to wit, against the gates of Mansoul +only; but they environed it round on every side, and beset it +behind and before; so that now, let Mansoul look which way it +will, it saw force and power lie in siege against it. +Besides, there were mounts cast up against it. The Mount +Gracious was on the one side, and Mount Justice was on the +other. Further, there were several small banks and +advance-grounds, as Plain-Truth Hill and No-Sin Banks, where many +of the slings were placed against the town. Upon Mount +Gracious were planted four, and upon Mount Justice were placed as +many, and the rest were conveniently placed in several parts +round about the town. Five of the best battering-rams, that +is, of the biggest of them, were placed upon Mount Hearken, a +mount cast up hard by Ear-gate, with intent to break that +open.</p> +<p>Now when the men of the town saw the multitude of the soldiers +that were come up against the place, and the rams and slings, and +the mounts on which they were planted, together with the +glittering of the armour and the waving of their colours, they +were forced to shift, and shift, and again to shift their +thoughts; but they hardly changed for thoughts more stout, but +rather for thoughts more faint; for though before they thought +themselves sufficiently guarded, yet now they began to think that +no man knew what would be their hap or lot.</p> +<p>When the good Prince Emmanuel had thus beleaguered Mansoul, in +the first place he hangs out the white flag, which he caused to +be set up among the golden slings that were planted upon Mount +Gracious. And this he did for two reasons: 1. To give +notice to Mansoul that he could and would yet be gracious if they +turned to him. 2. And that he might leave them the more +without excuse, should he destroy them, they continuing in their +rebellion.</p> +<p>So the white flag, with the three golden doves in it, was hung +out for two days together, to give them time and space to +consider; but they, as was hinted before, as if they were +unconcerned, made no reply to the favourable signal of the +Prince.</p> +<p>Then he commanded, and they set the red flag upon that mount +called Mount Justice. It was the red flag of Captain +Judgment, whose scutcheon was the burning fiery furnace; and this +also stood waving before them in the wind for several days +together. But look how they carried it under the white +flag, when that was hung out, so did they also when the red one +was; and yet he took no advantage of them.</p> +<p>Then he commanded again that his servants should hang out the +black flag of defiance against them, whose scutcheon was the +three burning thunderbolts; but as unconcerned was Mansoul at +this as at those that went before. But when the Prince saw +that neither mercy nor judgment, nor execution of judgment, would +or could come near the heart of Mansoul, he was touched with much +compunction, and said, ‘Surely this strange carriage of the +town of Mansoul doth rather arise from ignorance of the manner +and feats of war, than from a secret defiance of us, and +abhorrence of their own lives; or if they know the manner of the +war of their own, yet not the rites and ceremonies of the wars in +which we are concerned, when I make wars upon mine enemy +Diabolus.’</p> +<p>Therefore he sent to the town of Mansoul, to let them know +what he meant by those signs and ceremonies of the flag; and also +to know of them which of the things they would choose, whether +grace and mercy, or judgment and the execution of judgment. +All this while they kept their gates shut with locks, bolts, and +bars, as fast as they could. Their guards also were +doubled, and their watch made as strong as they could. +Diabolus also did pluck up what heart he could, to encourage the +town to make resistance.</p> +<p>The townsmen also made answer to the Prince’s messenger, +in substance according to that which follows:—</p> +<p>‘Great Sir,—As to what, by your messenger, you +have signified to us, whether we will accept of your mercy, or +fall by your justice, we are bound by the law and custom of this +place, and can give you no positive answer; for it is against the +law, government, and the prerogative royal of our king, to make +either peace or war without him. But this we will +do,—we will petition that our prince will come down to the +wall, and there give you such treatment as he shall think fit and +profitable for us.’</p> +<p>When the good Prince Emmanuel heard this answer, and saw the +slavery and bondage of the people, and how much content they were +to abide in the chains of the tyrant Diabolus, it grieved him at +the heart; and, indeed, when at any time he perceived that any +were contented under the slavery of the giant, he would be +affected with it.</p> +<p>But to return again to our purpose. After the town had +carried this news to Diabolus, and had told him, moreover, that +the Prince, that lay in the leaguer without the wall, waited upon +them for an answer, he refused, and huffed as well as he could; +but in heart he was afraid.</p> +<p>Then said he, ‘I will go down to the gates myself, and +give him such an answer as I think fit.’ So he went +down to Mouth-gate, and there addressed himself to speak to +Emmanuel, (but in such language as the town understood not,) the +contents whereof were as follows:—</p> +<p>‘O thou great Emmanuel, Lord of all the world, I know +thee, that thou art the Son of the great Shaddai! Wherefore +art thou come to torment me, and to cast me out of my +possession? This town of Mansoul, as thou very well +knowest, is mine, and that by a twofold right. 1. It is mine by +right of conquest; I won it in the open field; and shall the prey +be taken from the mighty, or the lawful captive be +delivered? 2. This town of Mansoul is mine also by their +subjection. They have opened the gates of their town unto +me; they have sworn fidelity to me, and have openly chosen me to +be their king; they have also given their castle into my hands; +yea, they have put the whole strength of Mansoul under me.</p> +<p>‘Moreover, this town of Mansoul hath disavowed thee, +yea, they have cast thy law, thy name, thy image, and all that is +thine, behind their back, and have accepted and set up in their +room my law, my name, my image, and all that ever is mine. +Ask else thy captains, and they will tell thee that Mansoul hath, +in answer to all their summonses, shown love and loyalty to me, +but always disdain, despite, contempt, and scorn to thee and +thine. Now, thou art the Just One and the Holy, and +shouldest do no iniquity. Depart, then, I pray thee, +therefore, from me, and leave me to my just inheritance +peaceably.’</p> +<p>This oration was made in the language of Diabolus himself; for +although he can, to every man, speak in their own language, (else +he could not tempt them all as he does,) yet he has a language +proper to himself, and it is the language of the infernal cave, +or black pit.</p> +<p>Wherefore the town of Mansoul (poor hearts!) understood him +not; nor did they see how he crouched and cringed while he stood +before Emmanuel, their Prince.</p> +<p>Yea, they all this while took him to be one of that power and +force that by no means could be resisted. Wherefore, while +he was thus entreating that he might have yet his residence +there, and that Emmanuel would not take it from him by force, the +inhabitants boasted even of his valour, saying, ‘Who is +able to make war with him?’</p> +<p>Well, when this pretended king had made an end of what he +would say, Emmanuel, the golden Prince, stood up and spake; the +contents of whose words follow:—</p> +<p>‘Thou deceiving one,’ said he, ‘I have, in +my Father’s name, in mine own name, and on the behalf and +for the good of this wretched town of Mansoul, somewhat to say +unto thee. Thou pretendest a right, a lawful right, to the +deplorable town of Mansoul, when it is most apparent to all my +Father’s court that the entrance which thou hast obtained +in at the gates of Mansoul was through thy lie and falsehood; +thou beliedst my Father, thou beliedst his law, and so deceivedst +the people of Mansoul. Thou pretendest that the people have +accepted thee for their king, their captain, and right liege +lord; but that also was by the exercise of deceit and +guile. Now, if lying, wiliness, sinful craft, and all +manner of horrible hypocrisy, will go in my Father’s court +(in which court thou must be tried) for equity and right, then +will I confess unto thee that thou hast made a lawful +conquest. But, alas! what thief, what tyrant, what devil is +there that may not conquer after this sort? But I can make +it appear, O Diabolus, that thou, in all thy pretences to a +conquest of Mansoul, hast nothing of truth to say. Thinkest +thou this to be right, that that didst put the lie upon my +Father, and madest him (to Mansoul) the greatest deluder in the +world? And what sayest thou to thy perverting knowingly the +right purport and intent of the law? Was it good also that +thou madest a prey of the innocency and simplicity of the now +miserable town of Mansoul? Yea, thou didst overcome Mansoul +by promising to them happiness in their transgressions against my +Father’s law, when thou knewest, and couldest not but know, +hadst thou consulted nothing but thine own experience, that that +was the way to undo them. Thou hast also thyself, O thou +master of enmity, of spite defaced my Father’s image in +Mansoul, and set up thy own in its place, to the great contempt +of my Father, the heightening of thy sin, and to the intolerable +damage of the perishing town of Mansoul.</p> +<p>‘Thou hast, moreover, (as if all these were but little +things with thee,) not only deluded and undone this place, but, +by thy lies and fradulent carriage, hast set them against their +own deliverance. How hast thou stirred them up against my +Father’s captains, and made them to fight against those +that were sent of him to deliver them from their bondage! +All these things, and very many more, thou hast done against thy +light, and in contempt of my Father and of his law, yea, and with +design to bring under his displeasure for ever the miserable town +of Mansoul. I am therefore come to avenge the wrong that +thou hast done to my Father, and to deal with thee for the +blasphemies wherewith thou hast made poor Mansoul blaspheme his +name. Yea, upon thy head, thou prince of the infernal cave, +will I requite it.</p> +<p>‘As for myself, O Diabolus, I am come against thee by +lawful power, and to take, by strength of hand, this town of +Mansoul out of thy burning fingers; for this town of Mansoul is +mine, O Diabolus, and that by undoubted right, as all shall see +that will diligently search the most ancient and most authentic +records, and I will plead my title to it, to the confusion of thy +face.</p> +<p>‘First, for the town of Mansoul, my Father built and did +fashion it with his hand. The palace also that is in the +midst of that town, he built it for his own delight. This +town of Mansoul, therefore, is my Father’s, and that by the +best of titles, and he that gainsays the truth of this must lie +against his soul.</p> +<p>‘Secondly, O thou master of the lie, this town of +Mansoul is mine.</p> +<p>‘1. For that I am my Father’s heir, his firstborn, +and the only delight of his heart. I am therefore come up +against thee in mine own right, even to recover mine own +inheritance out of thine hand.</p> +<p>‘2. But further, as I have a right and title to Mansoul +by being my Father’s heir, so I have also by my +Father’s donation. His it was, and he gave it me; nor +have I at any time offended my Father, that he should take it +from me, and give it to thee. Nor have I been forced, by +playing the bankrupt, to sell or set to sale to thee my beloved +town of Mansoul. Mansoul is my desire, my delight, and the +joy of my heart. But,</p> +<p>‘3. Mansoul is mine by right of purchase. I have +bought it, O Diabolus, I have bought it to myself. Now, +since it was my Father’s and mine, as I was his heir, and +since also I have made it mine by virtue of a great purchase, it +followeth that, by all lawful right, the town of Mansoul is mine, +and that thou art an usurper, a tyrant, and traitor, in thy +holding possession thereof. Now, the cause of my purchasing +of it was this: Mansoul had trespassed against my Father; now my +Father had said, that in the day that they broke his law they +should die. Now, it is more possible for heaven and earth +to pass away than for my Father to break his word. +Wherefore when Mansoul had sinned indeed by hearkening to thy +lie, I put in and became a surety to my Father, body for body, +and soul for soul, that I would make amends for Mansoul’s +transgressions, and my Father did accept thereof. So, when +the time appointed was come, I gave body for body, soul for soul, +life for life, blood for blood, and so redeemed my beloved +Mansoul.</p> +<p>‘4. Nor did I do this by halves: my Father’s law +and justice, that were both concerned in the threatening upon +transgression, are both now satisfied, and very well content that +Mansoul should be delivered.</p> +<p>‘5. Nor am I come out this day against thee, but by +commandment of my Father; it was he that said unto me, “Go +down and deliver Mansoul.”</p> +<p>‘Wherefore be it known unto thee, O thou fountain of +deceit, and be it also known to the foolish town of Mansoul, that +I am not come against thee this day without my Father.</p> +<p>‘And now,’ said the golden-headed Prince, ‘I +have a word to the town of Mansoul.’ But so soon as +mention was made that he had a word to speak to the besotted town +of Mansoul, the gates were double-guarded, and all men commanded +not to give him audience. So he proceeded and said, +‘O unhappy town of Mansoul, I cannot but be touched with +pity and compassion for thee. Thou hast accepted of +Diabolus for thy king, and art become a nurse and minister of +Diabolonians against thy sovereign Lord. Thy gates thou +hast opened to him, but hast shut them fast against me; thou hast +given him an hearing, but hast stopped thine ears at my +cry. He brought to thee thy destruction, and thou didst +receive both him and it: I am come to thee bringing salvation, +but thou regardest me not. Besides, thou hast, as with +sacrilegious hands, taken thyself, with all that was mine in +thee, and hast given all to my foe, and to the greatest enemy my +Father has. You have bowed and subjected yourselves to him, +you have vowed and sworn yourselves to be his. Poor +Mansoul! what shall I do unto thee? Shall I save +thee?—shall I destroy thee? What shall I do unto +thee? Shall I fall upon thee, and grind thee to powder, or +make thee a monument of the richest grace? What shall I do +unto thee? Hearken, therefore, thou town of Mansoul, +hearken to my word, and thou shalt live. I am merciful, +Mansoul, and thou shalt find me so: shut me not out of thy +gates.</p> +<p>‘O Mansoul, neither is my commission nor inclination at +all to do thee hurt. Why fliest thou so fast from thy +friend, and stickest so close to thine enemy? Indeed, I +would have thee, because it becomes thee to be sorry for thy sin, +but do not despair of life; this great force is not to hurt thee, +but to deliver thee from thy bondage, and to reduce thee to thy +obedience.</p> +<p>‘My commission, indeed, is to make a war upon Diabolus +thy king, and upon all Diabolonians with him; for he is the +strong man armed that keeps the house, and I will have him out: +his spoils I must divide, his armour I must take from him, his +hold I must cast him out of, and must make it a habitation for +myself. And this, O Mansoul, shall Diabolus know when he +shall be made to follow me in chains, and when Mansoul shall +rejoice to see it so.</p> +<p>‘I could, would I now put forth my might, cause that +forthwith he should leave you and depart; but I have it in my +heart so to deal with him, as that the justice of the war that I +shall make upon him may be seen and acknowledged by all. He +hath taken Mansoul by fraud, and keeps it by violence and deceit, +and I will make him bare and naked in the eyes of all +observers.</p> +<p>‘All my words are true. I am mighty to save, and +will deliver my Mansoul out of his hand.’</p> +<p>This speech was intended chiefly for Mansoul, but Mansoul +would not have the hearing of it. They shut up Ear-gate, +they barricaded it up, they kept it locked and bolted, they set a +guard thereat, and commanded that no Mansoulonian should go out +to him, nor that any from the camp should be admitted into the +town. All this they did, so horribly had Diabolus enchanted +them to do, and seek to do for him, against their rightful Lord +and Prince; wherefore no man, nor voice, nor sound of man that +belonged to the glorious host, was to come into the town.</p> +<p>So when Emmanuel saw that Mansoul was thus involved in sin, he +calls his army together, (since now also his words were +despised,) and gave out a commandment throughout all his host to +be ready against the time appointed. Now, forasmuch as +there was no way lawfully to take the town of Mansoul but to get +in by the gates, and at Ear-gate as the chief, therefore he +commanded his captains and commanders to bring their rams, their +slings and their men, and place them at Eye-gate and Ear-gate, in +order to his taking the town.</p> +<p>When Emmanuel had put all things in a readiness to give +Diabolus battle, he sent again to know of the town of Mansoul, if +in peaceable manner they would yield themselves, or whether they +were yet resolved to put him to try the utmost extremity? +They then, together with Diabolus their king, called a council of +war, and resolved upon certain propositions that should be +offered to Emmanuel, if he will accept thereof, so they agreed; +and then the next was, who should be sent on this errand. +Now, there was in the town of Mansoul an old man, a Diabolonian, +and his name was Mr. Loth-to-stoop, a stiff man in his way, and a +great doer for Diabolus; him, therefore, they sent, and put into +his mouth what he should say. So he went and came to the +camp to Emmanuel, and when he was come, a time was appointed to +give him audience. So at the time he came, and after a +Diabolonian ceremony or two, he thus began and said, ‘Great +sir, that it may be known unto all men how good-natured a prince +my master is, he has sent me to tell your lordship that he is +very willing, rather than go to war, to deliver up into your +hands one half of the town of Mansoul. I am therefore to +know if your Mightiness will accept of this +proposition.’</p> +<p>Then said Emmanuel, ‘The whole is mine by gift and +purchase, wherefore I will never lose one half.’</p> +<p>Then said Mr. Loth-to-stoop, ‘Sir, my master hath said +that he will be content that you shall be the nominal and titular +Lord of all, if he may possess but a part.’</p> +<p>Then Emmanuel answered, ‘The whole is mine really, not +in name and word only; wherefore I will be the sole lord and +possessor of all, or of none at all, of Mansoul.’</p> +<p>Then Mr. Loth-to-stoop said again, ‘Sir, behold the +condescension of my master! He says, that he will be +content, if he may but have assigned to him some place in Mansoul +as a place to live privately in, and you shall be Lord of all the +rest.’</p> +<p>Then said the golden Prince, ‘All that the Father giveth +me shall come to me; and of all that he giveth me I will lose +nothing—no, not a hoof nor a hair. I will not, +therefore, grant him, no, not the least corner of Mansoul to +dwell in; I will have all to myself.’</p> +<p>Then Loth-to-stoop said again, ‘But, sir, suppose that +my Lord should resign the whole town to you, only with this +proviso, that he sometimes, when he comes into this country, may, +for old acquaintance’ sake, be entertained as a wayfaring +man for two days, or ten days or a month, or so. May not +this small matter be granted?’</p> +<p>Then said Emmanuel, ‘No. He came as a wayfaring +man to David, nor did he stay long with him, and yet it had like +to have cost David his soul. I will not consent that he +ever should have any harbour more there.’</p> +<p>Then said Mr. Loth-to-stoop, ‘Sir, you seem to be very +hard. Suppose my master should yield to all that your +lordship hath said, provided that his friends and kindred in +Mansoul may have liberty to trade in the town, and to enjoy their +present dwellings. May not that be granted, sir?’</p> +<p>Then said Emmanuel, ‘No; that is contrary to my +Father’s will; for all, and all manner of Diabolonians that +now are, or that at any time shall be found in Mansoul, shall not +only lose their lands and liberties, but also their +lives.’</p> +<p>Then said Mr. Loth-to-stoop again, ‘But, sir, may not my +master and great lord, by letters, by passengers, by accidental +opportunities, and the like, maintain, if he shall deliver up all +unto thee, some kind of old friendship with Mansoul?’</p> +<p>Emmanuel answered, ‘No, by no means; forasmuch as any +such fellowship, friendship, intimacy, or acquaintance, in what +way, sort, or mode soever maintained, will tend to the corrupting +of Mansoul, the alienating of their affections from me, and the +endangering of their peace with my Father.’</p> +<p>Mr. Loth-to-stoop yet added further, saying, ‘But, great +sir, since my master hath many friends, and those that are dear +to him, in Mansoul, may he not, if he shall depart from them, +even of his bounty and good-nature, bestow upon them, as he sees +fit, some tokens of his love and kindness that he had for them, +to the end that Mansoul, when he is gone, may look upon such +tokens of kindness once received from their old friend, and +remember him who was once their king, and the merry times that +they sometimes enjoyed one with another, while he and they lived +in peace together?’</p> +<p>Then said Emmanuel, ‘No; for if Mansoul come to be mine, +I shall not admit of nor consent that there should be the least +scrap, shred, or dust of Diabolus left behind, as tokens of gifts +bestowed upon any in Mansoul, thereby to call to remembrance the +horrible communion that was betwixt them and him.’</p> +<p>‘Well, sir,’ said Mr. Loth-to-stoop, ‘I have +one thing more to propound, and then I am got to the end of my +commission. Suppose that, when my master is gone from +Mansoul, any that shall yet live in the town should have such +business of high concerns to do, that if they be neglected the +party shall be undone; and suppose, sir, that nobody can help in +that case so well as my master and lord, may not now my master be +sent for upon so urgent an occasion as this? Or if he may +not be admitted into the town, may not he and the person +concerned meet in some of the villages near Mansoul, and there +lay their heads together, and there consult of +matters?’</p> +<p>This was the last of those ensnaring propositions that Mr. +Loth-to-stoop had to propound to Emmanuel on behalf of his master +Diabolus; but Emmanuel would not grant it; for he said, +‘There can be no case, or thing, or matter fall out in +Mansoul, when thy master shall be gone, that may not be solved by +my Father; besides, it will be a great disparagement to my +Father’s wisdom and skill to admit any from Mansoul to go +out to Diabolus for advice, when they are bid before, in +everything, by prayer and supplication to let their requests be +made known to my Father. Further, this, should it be +granted, would be to grant that a door should be set open for +Diabolus, and the Diabolonians in Mansoul, to hatch, and plot, +and bring to pass treasonable designs, to the grief of my Father +and me, and to the utter destruction of Mansoul.’</p> +<p>When Mr. Loth-to-stoop had heard this answer, he took his +leave of Emmanuel, and departed, saying that he would carry word +to his master concerning this whole affair. So he departed, +and came to Diabolus to Mansoul, and told him the whole of the +matter, and how Emmanuel would not admit, no, not by any means, +that he, when he was once gone out, should for ever have anything +more to do either in, or with any that are of the town of +Mansoul. When Mansoul and Diabolus had heard this relation +of things, they with one consent concluded to use their best +endeavour to keep Emmanuel out of Mansoul, and sent old +Ill-Pause, of whom you have heard before, to tell the Prince and +his captains so. So the old gentleman came up to the top of +Ear-gate, and called to the camp for a hearing, who when they +gave audience, he said, ‘I have in commandment from my high +lord to bid you tell it to your Prince Emmanuel, that Mansoul and +their king are resolved to stand and fall together; and that it +is in vain for your Prince to think of ever having Mansoul in his +hand, unless he can take it by force.’ So some went +and told to Emmanuel what old Ill-Pause, a Diabolonian in +Mansoul, had said. Then said the Prince, ‘I must try +the power of my sword, for I will not (for all the rebellions and +repulses that Mansoul has made against me) raise my siege and +depart, but will assuredly take my Mansoul, and deliver it from +the hand of her enemy.’ And with that he gave out a +commandment that Captain Boanerges, Captain Conviction, Captain +Judgment, and Captain Execution should forthwith march up to +Ear-gate with trumpets sounding, colours flying, and with +shouting for the battle. Also he would that Captain +Credence should join himself with them. Emmanuel, moreover, +gave order that Captain Good-Hope and Captain Charity should draw +themselves up before Eye-gate. He bid also that the rest of +his captains and their men should place themselves for the best +of their advantage against the enemy round about the town; and +all was done as he had commanded.</p> +<p>Then he bid that the word should be given forth, and the word +was at that time, ‘<span +class="smcap">Emmanuel</span>.’ Then was an alarm +sounded, and the battering-rams were played, and the slings did +whirl stones into the town amain, and thus the battle +began. Now Diabolus himself did manage the townsmen in the +war, and that at every gate; wherefore their resistance was the +more forcible, hellish, and offensive to Emmanuel. Thus was +the good Prince engaged and entertained by Diabolus and Mansoul +for several days together; and a sight worth seeing it was to +behold how the captains of Shaddai behaved themselves in this +war.</p> +<p>And first for Captain Boanerges, (not to under-value the +rest,) he made three most fierce assaults, one after another, +upon Ear-gate, to the shaking of the posts thereof. Captain +Conviction, he also made up as fast with Boanerges as possibly he +could, and both discerning that the gate began to yield, they +commanded that the rams should still be played against it. +Now, Captain Conviction, going up very near to the gate, was with +great force driven back, and received three wounds in the +mouth. And those that rode reformades, they went about to +encourage the captains.</p> +<p>For the valour of the two captains, made mention of before, +the Prince sent for them to his pavilion, and commanded that a +while they should rest themselves, and that with somewhat they +should be refreshed. Care also was taken for Captain +Conviction, that he should be healed of his wounds. The +Prince also gave to each of them a chain of gold, and bid them +yet be of good courage.</p> +<p>Nor did Captain Good-Hope nor Captain Charity come behind in +this most desperate fight, for they so well did behave themselves +at Eye-gate, that they had almost broken it quite open. +These also had a reward from their Prince, as also had the rest +of the captains, because they did valiantly round about the +town.</p> +<p>In this engagement several of the officers of Diabolus were +slain, and some of the townsmen wounded. For the officers, +there was one Captain Boasting slain. This Boasting thought +that nobody could have shaken the posts of Ear-gate, nor have +shaken the heart of Diabolus. Next to him there was one +Captain Secure slain: this Secure used to say that the blind and +lame in Mansoul were able to keep the gates of the town against +Emmanuel’s army. This Captain Secure did Captain +Conviction cleave down the head with a two-handed sword, when he +received himself three wounds in his mouth.</p> +<p>Besides these there was one Captain Bragman, a very desperate +fellow, and he was captain over a band of those that threw +firebrands, arrows, and death: he also received, by the hand of +Captain Good-Hope at Eye-gate, a mortal wound in the breast.</p> +<p>There was, moreover, one Mr. Feeling; but he was no captain, +but a great stickler to encourage Mansoul to rebellion. He +received a wound in the eye by the hand of one of +Boanerges’ soldiers, and had by the captain himself been +slain, but that he made a sudden retreat.</p> +<p>But I never saw Willbewill so daunted in all my life; he was +not able to do as he was wont, and some say that he also received +a wound in the leg, and that some of the men in the +Prince’s army have certainly seen him limp as he afterwards +walked on the wall.</p> +<p>I shall not give you a particular account of the names of the +soldiers that were slain in the town, for many were maimed, and +wounded, and slain; for when they saw that the posts of Ear-gate +did shake, and Eye-gate was well-nigh broken quite open, and also +that their captains were slain, this took away the hearts of many +of the Diabolonians; they fell also by the force of the shot that +were sent by the golden slings into the midst of the town of +Mansoul.</p> +<p>Of the townsmen, there was one Love-no-Good; he was a +townsman, but a Diabolonian; he also received his mortal wound in +Mansoul, but he died not very soon.</p> +<p>Mr. Ill-Pause also, who was the man that came along with +Diabolus when at first he attempted the taking of Mansoul, he +also received a grievous wound in the head; some say that his +brain-pan was cracked. This I have taken notice of, that he +was never after this able to do that mischief to Mansoul as he +had done in times past. Also old Prejudice and Mr. Anything +fled.</p> +<p>Now, when the battle was over, the Prince commanded that yet +once more the white flag should be set upon Mount Gracious in +sight of the town of Mansoul, to show that yet Emmanuel had grace +for the wretched town of Mansoul.</p> +<p>When Diabolus saw the white flag hung out again, and knowing +that it was not for him, but Mansoul, he cast in his mind to play +another prank, to wit, to see if Emmanuel would raise his siege +and begone, upon promise of reformation. So he comes down +to the gate one evening, a good while after the sun was gone +down, and calls to speak with Emmanuel, who presently came down +to the gate, and Diabolus saith unto him:</p> +<p>‘Forasmuch as thou makest it appear by thy white flag +that thou art wholly given to peace and quiet, I thought meet to +acquaint thee that we are ready to accept thereof upon terms +which thou mayest admit.</p> +<p>‘I know that thou art given to devotion, and that +holiness pleaseth thee; yea, that thy great end in making a war +upon Mansoul is, that it may be a holy habitation. Well, +draw off thy forces from the town, and I will bend Mansoul to thy +bow.</p> +<p>‘First, I will lay down all acts of hostility against +thee, and will be willing to become thy deputy, and will, as I +have formerly been against thee, now serve thee in the town of +Mansoul. And more particularly,</p> +<p>‘1. I will persuade Mansoul to receive thee for their +Lord; and I know that they will do it the sooner when they shall +understand that I am thy deputy.</p> +<p>‘2. I will show them wherein they have erred, and that +transgression stands in the way to life.</p> +<p>‘3. I will show them the holy law unto which they must +conform, even that which they have broken.</p> +<p>‘4. I will press upon them the necessity of a +reformation according to thy law.</p> +<p>‘5. And, moreover, that none of these things may fail, I +myself, at my own proper cost and charge, will set up and +maintain a sufficient ministry, besides lectures, in Mansoul.</p> +<p>‘6. Thou shalt receive, as a token of our subjection to +thee, year by year, what thou shalt think fit to lay and levy +upon us in token of our subjection to thee.’</p> +<p>Then said Emmanuel to him, ‘O full of deceit, how +movable are thy ways! How often hast thou changed and +rechanged, if so be thou mightest still keep possession of my +Mansoul, though, as has been plainly declared before, I am the +right heir thereof! Often hast thou made thy proposals +already, nor is this last a whit better than they. And +failing to deceive when thou showedst thyself in thy black, thou +hast now transformed thyself into an angel of light, and wouldst, +to deceive, be now as a minister of righteousness.</p> +<p>‘But know thou, O Diabolus, that nothing must be +regarded that thou canst propound, for nothing is done by thee +but to deceive. Thou neither hast conscience to God, nor +love to the town of Mansoul; whence, then, should these thy +sayings arise but from sinful craft and deceit? He that can +of list and will propound what he pleases, and that wherewith he +may destroy them that believe him, is to be abandoned, with all +that he shall say. But if righteousness be such a +beauty-spot in thine eyes now, how is it that wickedness was so +closely stuck to by thee before? But this is +by-the-bye.</p> +<p>‘Thou talkest now of a reformation in Mansoul, and that +thou thyself, if I will please, wilt be at the head of that +reformation; all the while knowing that the greatest proficiency +that man can make in the law, and the righteousness thereof, will +amount to no more, for the taking away of the curse from Mansoul, +than just nothing at all; for a law being broken by Mansoul, that +had before, upon a supposition of the breach thereof, a curse +pronounced against him for it of God, can never, by his obeying +of the law, deliver himself therefrom (to say nothing of what a +reformation is like to be set up in Mansoul when the devil is +become corrector of vice). Thou knowest that all that thou +hast now said in this matter is nothing but guile and deceit; and +is, as it was the first, so is it the last card that thou hast to +play. Many there be that do soon discern thee when thou +showest them thy cloven foot; but in thy white, thy light, and in +thy transformation, thou art seen but of a few. But thou +shalt not do thus with my Mansoul, O Diabolus; for I do still +love my Mansoul.</p> +<p>‘Besides, I am not come to put Mansoul upon works to +live thereby; should I do so, I should be like unto thee: but I +am come that by me, and by what I have and shall do for Mansoul, +they may to my Father be reconciled, though by their sin they +have provoked him to anger, and though by the law they cannot +obtain mercy.</p> +<p>‘Thou talkest of subjecting of this town to good, when +none desireth it at thy hands. I am sent by my Father to +possess it myself, and to guide it by the skilfulness of my hands +into such a conformity to him as shall be pleasing in his +sight. I will therefore possess it myself; I will +dispossess and cast thee out; I will set up mine own standard in +the midst of them; I will also govern them by new laws, new +officers, new motives, and new ways; yea, I will pull down this +town, and build it again; and it shall be as though it had not +been, and it shall then be the glory of the whole +universe.’</p> +<p>When Diabolus heard this, and perceived that he was discovered +in all his deceits, he was confounded, and utterly put to a +nonplus; but having in himself the fountain of iniquity, rage, +and malice against both Shaddai and his Son, and the beloved town +of Mansoul, what doth he but strengthen himself what he could to +give fresh battle to the noble Prince Emmanuel? So, then, +now we must have another fight before the town of Mansoul is +taken. Come up, then, to the mountains, you that love to +see military actions, and behold by both sides how the fatal blow +is given, while one seeks to hold, and the other seeks to make +himself master of the famous town of Mansoul.</p> +<p>Diabolus, therefore, having withdrawn himself from the wall to +his force that was in the heart of the town of Mansoul, Emmanuel +also returned to the camp; and both of them, after their divers +ways, put themselves into a posture fit to give battle one to +another.</p> +<p>Diabolus, as filled with despair of retaining in his hands the +famous town of Mansoul, resolved to do what mischief he could +(if, indeed, he could do any) to the army of the Prince and to +the famous town of Mansoul; for, alas! it was not the happiness +of the silly town of Mansoul that was designed by Diabolus, but +the utter ruin and overthrow thereof, as now is enough in +view. Wherefore, he commands his officers that they should +then, when they see that they could hold the town no longer, do +it what harm and mischief they could, rendering and tearing men, +women, and children. ‘For,’ said he, ‘we +had better quite demolish the place, and leave it like a ruinous +heap, than so leave it that it may be an habitation for +Emmanuel.’</p> +<p>Emmanuel again, knowing that the next battle would issue in +his being made master of the place, gave out a royal commandment +to all his officers, high captains, and men of war, to be sure to +show themselves men of war against Diabolus and all Diabolonians; +but favourable, merciful, and meek to the old inhabitants of +Mansoul. ‘Bend, therefore,’ said the noble +Prince, ‘the hottest front of the battle against Diabolus +and his men.’</p> +<p>So the day being come, the command was given, and the +Prince’s men did bravely stand to their arms, and did, as +before, bend their main force against Ear-gate and +Eye-gate. The word was then, ‘Mansoul is won!’ +so they made their assault upon the town. Diabolus also, as +fast as he could, with the main of his power, made resistance +from within; and his high lords and chief captains for a time +fought very cruelly against the Prince’s army.</p> +<p>But after three or four notable charges by the Prince and his +noble captains, Ear-gate was broken open, and the bars and bolts +wherewith it was used to be fast shut up against the Prince, were +broken into a thousand pieces. Then did the Prince’s +trumpets sound, the captains shout, the town shake, and Diabolus +retreat to his hold. Well, when the Prince’s forces +had broken open the gate, himself came up and did set his throne +in it; also he set his standard thereby, upon a mount that before +by his men was cast up to place the mighty slings thereon. +The mount was called Mount Hear-well. There, therefore, the +Prince abode, to wit, hard by the going in at the gate. He +commanded also that the golden slings should yet be played upon +the town, especially against the castle, because for shelter +thither was Diabolus retreated. Now, from Ear-gate the +street was straight even to the house of Mr. Recorder that so was +before Diabolus took the town; and hard by his house stood the +castle, which Diabolus for a long time had made his irksome +den. The captains, therefore, did quickly clear that street +by the use of their slings, so that way was made up to the heart +of the town. Then did the Prince command that Captain +Boanerges, Captain Conviction, and Captain Judgment, should +forthwith march up the town to the old gentleman’s +gate. Then did the captains in the most warlike manner +enter into the town of Mansoul, and marching in with flying +colours, they came up to the Recorder’s house, and that was +almost as strong as was the castle. Battering-rams they +took also with them, to plant against the castle gates. +When they were come to the house of Mr. Conscience, they knocked, +and demanded entrance. Now, the old gentleman, not knowing +as yet fully their design, kept his gates shut all the time of +this fight. Wherefore Boanerges demanded entrance at his +gates; and no man making answer, he gave it one stroke with the +head of a ram, and this made the old gentleman shake, and his +house to tremble and totter. Then came Mr. Recorder down to +the gates, and, as he could, with quivering lips he asked who was +there? Boanerges answered, ‘We are the captains and +commanders of the great Shaddai and of the blessed Emmanuel, his +Son, and we demand possession of your house for the use of our +noble Prince.’ And with that the battering-ram gave +the gate another shake. This made the old gentleman tremble +the more, yet durst he not but open the gate: then the +King’s forces marched in, namely, the three brave captains +mentioned before. Now, the Recorder’s house was a +place of much convenience for Emmanuel, not only because it was +near to the castle and strong, but also because it was large, and +fronted the castle, the den where now Diabolus was, for he was +now afraid to come out of his hold. As for Mr. Recorder, +the captains carried it very reservedly to him; as yet he knew +nothing of the great designs of Emmanuel, so that he did not know +what judgment to make, nor what would be the end of such +thundering beginnings. It was also presently noised in the +town how the Recorder’s house was possessed, his rooms +taken up, and his palace made the seat of the war; and no sooner +was it noised abroad, but they took the alarm as warmly, and gave +it out to others of his friends, and you know, as a snowball +loses nothing by rolling, so in little time the whole town was +possessed that they must expect nothing from the Prince but +destruction; and the ground of the business was this, the +Recorder was afraid, the Recorder trembled, and the captains +carried it strangely to the Recorder. So many came to see, +but when they with their own eyes did behold the captains in the +palace, and their battering-rams ever playing at the castle gates +to beat them down, they were riveted in their fears, and it made +them all in amaze. And, as I said, the man of the house +would increase all this; for whoever came to him, or discoursed +with him, nothing would he talk of, tell them, or hear, but that +death and destruction now attended Mansoul.</p> +<p>‘For,’ quoth the old gentleman, ‘you are all +of you sensible that we all have been traitors to that once +despised, but now famously victorious and glorious Prince +Emmanuel; for he now, as you see, doth not only lie in close +siege about us, but hath forced his entrance in at our +gates. Moreover, Diabolus flees before him; and he hath, as +you behold, made of my house a garrison against the castle where +he is. I, for my part, have transgressed greatly, and he +that is clean, it is well for him. But I say I have +transgressed greatly in keeping silence when I should have +spoken, and in perverting justice when I should have executed the +same. True, I have suffered something at the hand of +Diabolus for taking part with the laws of King Shaddai; but that, +alas! what will that do? Will that make compensation for the +rebellions and treasons that I have done, and have suffered +without gainsaying to be committed in the town of Mansoul? Oh! I +tremble to think what will be the end of this so dreadful and so +ireful a beginning!’</p> +<p>Now, while these brave captains were thus busy in the house of +the old Recorder, Captain Execution was as busy in other parts of +the town, in securing the back streets and the walls. He +also hunted the Lord Willbewill sorely; he suffered him not to +rest in any corner; he pursued him so hard that he drove his men +from him, and made him glad to thrust his head into a hole. +Also this mighty warrior did cut three of the Lord +Willbewill’s officers down to the ground: one was old Mr. +Prejudice, he that had his crown cracked in the mutiny. +This man was made by Lord Willbewill keeper of the Ear-gate, and +fell by the hand of Captain Execution. There was also one +Mr. Backward-to-all-but-naught, and he also was one of Lord +Willbewill’s officers, and was the captain of the two guns +that once were mounted on the top of Ear-gate; he also was cut +down to the ground by the hands of Captain Execution. +Besides these two there was another, a third, and his name was +Captain Treacherous; a vile man this was, but one that Willbewill +did put a great deal of confidence in; but him also did this +Captain Execution cut down to the ground with the rest.</p> +<p>He also made a very great slaughter among my Lord +Willbewill’s soldiers, killing many that were stout and +sturdy, and wounding many that for Diabolus were nimble and +active. But all these were Diabolonians; there was not a +man, a native of Mansoul, hurt.</p> +<p>Other feats of war were also likewise performed by other of +the captains, as at Eye-gate, where Captain Good-Hope and Captain +Charity had a charge, was great execution done; for the Captain +Good-Hope, with his own hands, slew one Captain Blindfold, the +keeper of that gate. This Blindfold was captain of a +thousand men, and they were they that fought with mauls; he also +pursued his men, slew many, and wounded more, and made the rest +hide their heads in corners.</p> +<p>There was also at that gate Mr. Ill-Pause, of whom you have +heard before. He was an old man, and had a beard that +reached down to his girdle: the same was he that was orator to +Diabolus: he did much mischief in the town of Mansoul, and fell +by the hand of Captain Good-Hope.</p> +<p>What shall I say? The Diabolonians in these days lay +dead in every corner, though too many yet were alive in +Mansoul.</p> +<p>Now, the old Recorder and my Lord Understanding, with some +others of the chief of the town, to wit, such as knew they must +stand and fall with the famous town of Mansoul, came together +upon a day, and after consultation had, did jointly agree to draw +up a petition, and to send it to Emmanuel, now while he sat in +the gate of Mansoul. So they drew up their petition to +Emmanuel, the contents whereof were these: That they, the old +inhabitants of the now deplorable town of Mansoul, confessed +their sin, and were sorry that they had offended his princely +Majesty, and prayed that he would spare their lives.</p> +<p>Unto this petition he gave no answer at all, and that did +trouble them yet so much the more. Now, all this while the +captains that were in the Recorder’s house were playing +with the battering-rams at the gates of the castle, to beat them +down. So after some time, labour, and travail, the gate of +the castle that was called Impregnable was beaten open, and +broken into several splinters, and so a way made to go up to the +hold in which Diabolus had hid himself. Then were tidings +sent down to Ear-gate, for Emmanuel still abode there, to let him +know that a way was made in at the gates of the castle of +Mansoul. But, oh! how the trumpets at the tidings sounded +throughout the Prince’s camp, for that now the war was so +near an end, and Mansoul itself of being set free.</p> +<p>Then the Prince arose from the place where he was, and took +with him such of his men of war as were fittest for that +expedition, and marched up the street of Mansoul to the old +Recorder’s house.</p> +<p>Now, the Prince himself was clad all in armour of gold, and so +he marched up the town with his standard borne before him; but he +kept his countenance much reserved all the way as he went, so +that the people could not tell how to gather to themselves love +or hatred by his looks. Now, as he marched up the street, +the townsfolk came out at every door to see, and could not but be +taken with his person and the glory thereof, but wondered at the +reservedness of his countenance; for as yet he spake more to them +by his actions and works than he did by words or smiles. +But also poor Mansoul, (as in such cases all are apt to do,) they +interpreted the carriage of Emmanuel to them as did +Joseph’s brethren his to them, even all the quite contrary +way. ‘For,’ thought they, ‘if Emmanuel +loved us, he would show it to us by word of carriage; but none of +these he doth, therefore Emmanuel hates us. Now, if +Emmanuel hates us, then Mansoul shall be slain, then Mansoul +shall become a dunghill.’ They knew that they had +transgressed his Father’s law, and that against him they +had been in with Diabolus, his enemy. They also knew that +the Prince Emmanuel knew all this; for they were convinced that +he was an angel of God, to know all things that are done in the +earth; and this made them think that their condition was +miserable, and that the good Prince would make them desolate.</p> +<p>‘And,’ thought they, ‘what time so fit to do +this in as now, when he has the bridle of Mansoul in his +hand?’ And this I took special notice of, that the +inhabitants, notwithstanding all this, could not—no, they +could not, when they see him march through the town, but cringe, +bow, bend, and were ready to lick the dust of his feet. +They also wished a thousand times over that he would become their +Prince and Captain, and would become their protection. They +would also one to another talk of the comeliness of his person, +and how much for glory and valour he outstripped the great ones +of the world. But, poor hearts, as to themselves, their +thoughts would chance, and go upon all manner of extremes. +Yea, through the working of them backward and forward, Mansoul +became as a ball tossed, and as a rolling thing before the +whirlwind.</p> +<p>Now, when he was come to the castle gates, he commanded +Diabolus to appear, and to surrender himself into his +hands. But, oh! how loath was the beast to appear! how he +stuck at it! how he shrank! how he cringed! yet out he came to +the Prince. Then Emmanuel commanded, and they took Diabolus +and bound him fast in chains, the better to reserve him to the +judgment that he had appointed for him. But Diabolus stood +up to entreat for himself that Emmanuel would not send him into +the deep, but suffer him to depart out of Mansoul in peace.</p> +<p>When Emmanuel had taken him and bound him in chains, he led +him into the marketplace, and there, before Mansoul, stripped him +of his armour in which he boasted so much before. This now +was one of the acts of triumph of Emmanuel over his enemy; and +all the while that the giant was stripping, the trumpets of the +golden Prince did sound amain; the captains also shouted, and the +soldiers did sing for joy.</p> +<p>Then was Mansoul called upon to behold the beginning of +Emmanuel’s triumph over him in whom they so much had +trusted, and of whom they so much had boasted in the days when he +flattered them.</p> +<p>Thus having made Diabolus naked in the eyes of Mansoul, and +before the commanders of the Prince, in the next place, he +commands that Diabolus should be bound with chains to his chariot +wheels. Then leaving some of his forces, to wit, Captain +Boanerges and Captain Conviction, as a guard for the +castle-gates, that resistance might be made on his behalf, (if +any that heretofore followed Diabolus should make an attempt to +possess it,) he did ride in triumph over him quite through the +town of Mansoul, and so out at and before the gate called +Eye-gate, to the plain where his camp did lie.</p> +<p>But you cannot think, unless you had been there, as I was, +what a shout there was in Emmanuel’s camp when they saw the +tyrant bound by the hand of their noble Prince, and tied to his +chariot wheels!</p> +<p>And they said, ‘He hath led captivity captive, he hath +spoiled principalities and powers. Diabolus is subjected to +the power of his sword, and made the object of all +derision.’</p> +<p>Those also that rode reformades, and that came down to see the +battle, they shouted with that greatness of voice, and sung with +such melodious notes, that they caused them that dwell in the +highest orbs to open their windows, put out their heads, and look +to see the cause of that glory.</p> +<p>The townsmen also, so many of them as saw this sight, were, as +it were, while they looked, betwixt the earth and the +heavens. True, they could not tell what would be the issue +of things as to them; but all things were done in such excellent +methods, and I cannot tell how, but things in the management of +them seemed to cast a smile towards the town, so that their eyes, +their heads, their hearts, and their minds, and all that they +had, were taken and held while they observed Emmanuel’s +order.</p> +<p>So, when the brave Prince had finished this part of his +triumph over Diabolus his foe, he turned him up in the midst of +his contempt and shame, having given him a charge no more to be a +possessor of Mansoul. Then went he from Emmanuel, and out +of the midst of his camp, to inherit the parched places in a salt +land, seeking rest, but finding none.</p> +<p>Now, Captain Boanerges and Captain Conviction were, both of +them, men of very great majesty; their faces were like the faces +of lions, and their words like the roaring of the sea; and they +still quartered in Mr. Conscience’s house, of whom mention +was made before. When, therefore, the high and mighty +Prince had thus far finished his triumph over Diabolus, the +townsmen had more leisure to view and to behold the actions of +these noble captains. But the captains carried it with that +terror and dread in all that they did, (and you may be sure that +they had private instructions so to do,) that they kept the town +under continual heart-aching, and caused (in their apprehension) +the well-being of Mansoul for the future to hang in doubt before +them, so that for some considerable time they neither knew what +rest, or ease, or peace, or hope meant.</p> +<p>Nor did the Prince himself as yet abide in the town of +Mansoul, but in his royal pavilion in the camp, and in the midst +of his Father’s forces. So, at a time convenient, he +sent special orders to Captain Boanerges to summons Mansoul, the +whole of the townsmen, into the castle-yard, and then and there, +before their faces, to take my Lord Understanding, Mr. +Conscience, and that notable one, the Lord Willbewill, and put +them all three in ward, and that they should set a strong guard +upon them there, until his pleasure concerning them was further +known: the which orders, when the captains had put them in +execution, made no small addition to the fears of the town of +Mansoul; for now, to their thinking, were their former fears of +the ruin of Mansoul confirmed. Now, what death they should +die, and how long they should be in dying, was that which most +perplexed their heads and hearts; yea, they were afraid that +Emmanuel would command them all into the deep, the place that the +prince Diabolus was afraid of, for they knew that they had +deserved it. Also to die by the sword in the face of the +town, and in the open way of disgrace, from the hand of so good +and so holy a prince, that, too, troubled them sore. The +town was also greatly troubled for the men that were committed to +ward, for that they were their stay and their guide, and for that +they believed that, if those men were cut off, their execution +would be but the beginning of the ruin of the town of +Mansoul. Wherefore, what do they, but, together with the +men in prison, draw up a petition to the Prince, and sent it to +Emmanuel by the hand of Mr. Would-live. So he went, and +came to the Prince’s quarters, and presented the petition, +the sum of which was this:</p> +<p>‘Great and wonderful Potentate, victor over Diabolus, +and conqueror of the town of Mansoul, We, the miserable +inhabitants of that most woful corporation, do humbly beg that we +may find favour in thy sight, and remember not against us former +transgressions, nor yet the sins of the chief of our town: but +spare us according to the greatness of thy mercy, and let us not +die, but live in thy sight. So shall we be willing to be +thy servants, and, if thou shalt think fit, to gather our meat +under thy table. Amen.’</p> +<p>So the petitioner went, as was said, with his petition to the +Prince; and the Prince took it at his hand, but sent him away +with silence. This still afflicted the town of Mansoul; but +yet, considering that now they must either petition or die, for +now they could not do anything else, therefore they consulted +again, and sent another petition; and this petition was much +after the form and method of the former.</p> +<p>But when the petition was drawn up, By whom should they send +it? was the next question; for they would not send this by him by +whom they sent the first, for they thought that the Prince had +taken some offence at the manner of his deportment before him: so +they attempted to make Captain Conviction their messenger with +it; but he said that he neither durst nor would petition Emmanuel +for traitors, nor be to the Prince an advocate for rebels. +‘Yet withal,’ said he, ‘our Prince is good, and +you may adventure to send it by the hand of one of your town, +provided he went with a rope about his head, and pleaded nothing +but mercy.’</p> +<p>Well, they made, through fear, their delays as long as they +could, and longer than delays were good; but fearing at last the +dangerousness of them, they thought, but with many a fainting in +their minds, to send their petition by Mr. Desires-awake; so they +sent for Mr. Desires-awake. Now he dwelt in a very mean +cottage in Mansoul, and he came at his neighbour’s +request. So they told him what they had done, and what they +would do, concerning petitioning, and that they did desire of him +that he would go therewith to the Prince.</p> +<p>Then said Mr. Desires-awake, ‘Why should not I do the +best I can to save so famous a town as Mansoul from deserved +destruction?’ They therefore delivered the petition +to him, and told him how he must address himself to the Prince, +and wished him ten thousand good speeds. So he comes to the +Prince’s pavilion, as the first, and asked to speak with +his Majesty. So word was carried to Emmanuel, and the +Prince came out to the man. When Mr. Desires-awake saw the +Prince, he fell flat with his face to the ground, and cried out, +‘Oh that Mansoul might live before thee!’ and with +that he presented the petition; the which when the Prince had +read, he turned away for a while and wept; but refraining +himself, he turned again to the man, who all this while lay +crying at his feet, as at the first, and said to him, ‘Go +thy way to thy place, and I will consider of thy +requests.’</p> +<p>Now, you may think that they of Mansoul that had sent him, +what with guilt, and what with fear lest their petition should be +rejected, could not but look with many a long look, and that, +too, with strange workings of heart, to see what would become of +their petition. At last they saw their messenger coming +back. So, when he was come, they asked him how he fared, +what Emmanuel said, and what was become of the petition. +But he told them that he would be silent till he came to the +prison to my Lord Mayor, my Lord Willbewill, and Mr. +Recorder. So he went forwards towards the prison-house, +where the men of Mansoul lay bound. But, oh! what a +multitude flocked after, to hear what the messenger said. +So, when he was come, and had shown himself at the gate of the +prison, my Lord Mayor himself looked as white as a clout; the +Recorder also did quake. But they asked and said, +‘Come, good sir, what did the great Prince say to +you?’ Then said Mr. Desires-awake, ‘When I came +to my Lord’s pavilion, I called, and he came forth. +So I fell prostrate at his feet, and delivered to him my +petition; for the greatness of his person, and the glory of his +countenance, would not suffer me to stand upon my legs. +Now, as he received the petition, I cried, “Oh that Mansoul +might live before thee!” So, when for a while he had +looked thereon, he turned him about, and said to his servant, +“Go thy way to thy place again, and I will consider of thy +requests.”’ The messenger added, moreover, and +said, ‘The Prince to whom you sent me is such a one for +beauty and glory, that whoso sees him must both love and fear +him. I, for my part, can do no less; but I know not what +will be the end of these things.’</p> +<p>At this answer they were all at a stand, both they in prison, +and they that followed the messenger thither to hear the news; +nor knew they what, or what manner of interpretation to put upon +what the Prince had said. Now, when the prison was cleared +of the throng, the prisoners among themselves began to comment +upon Emmanuel’s words. My Lord Mayor said, that the +answer did not look with a rugged face; but Willbewill said that +it betokened evil; and the Recorder, that it was a messenger of +death. Now, they that were left, and that stood behind, and +so could not so well hear what the prisoners said, some of them +catched hold of one piece of a sentence, and some on a bit of +another; some took hold of what the messenger said, and some of +the prisoners’ judgment thereon; so none had the right +understanding of things. But you cannot imagine what work +these people made, and what a confusion there was in Mansoul +now.</p> +<p>For presently they that had heard what was said flew about the +town, one crying one thing, and another the quite contrary; and +both were sure enough they told true; for they did hear, they +said, with their ears what was said, and therefore could not be +deceived. One would say, ‘We must all be +killed;’ another would say, ‘We must all be +saved;’ and a third would say that the Prince would not be +concerned with Mansoul; and a fourth, that the prisoners must be +suddenly put to death. And, as I said, every one stood to +it that he told his tale the rightest, and that all others but he +were out. Wherefore Mansoul had now molestation upon +molestation, nor could any man know on what to rest the sole of +his foot; for one would go by now, and as he went, if he heard +his neighbour tell his tale, to be sure he would tell the quite +contrary, and both would stand in it that he told the +truth. Nay, some of them had got this story by the end, +that the Prince did intend to put Mansoul to the sword. And +now it began to be dark, wherefore poor Mansoul was in sad +perplexity all that night until the morning.</p> +<p>But, so far as I could gather by the best information that I +could get, all this hubbub came through the words that the +Recorder said when he told them that, in his judgment, the +Prince’s answer was a messenger of death. It was this +that fired the town, and that began the fright in Mansoul; for +Mansoul in former times did use to count that Mr. Recorder was a +seer, and that his sentence was equal to the best of orators; and +thus was Mansoul a terror to itself.</p> +<p>And now did they begin to feel what were the effects of +stubborn rebellion, and unlawful resistance against their +Prince. I say, they now began to feel the effects thereof +by guilt and fear, that now had swallowed them up; and who more +involved in the one but they that were most in the other, to wit, +the chief of the town of Mansoul?</p> +<p>To be brief: when the fame of the fright was out of the town, +and the prisoners had a little recovered themselves, they take to +themselves some heart, and think to petition the Prince for life +again. So they did draw up a third petition, the contents +whereof were these:—</p> +<p>‘Prince Emmanuel the Great, Lord of all worlds, and +Master of mercy, we, thy poor, wretched, miserable, dying town of +Mansoul, do confess unto thy great and glorious Majesty that we +have sinned against thy Father and thee, and are no more worthy +to be called thy Mansoul, but rather to be cast into the +pit. If thou wilt slay us, we have deserved it. If +thou wilt condemn us to the deep, we cannot but say thou art +righteous. We cannot complain whatever thou dost, or +however thou carriest it towards us. But, oh! let mercy +reign, and let it be extended to us! Oh! let mercy take +hold upon us, and free us from our transgressions, and we will +sing of thy mercy and of thy judgment. Amen.’</p> +<p>This petition, when drawn up, was designed to be sent to the +Prince as the first. But who should carry it?—that +was the question. Some said, ‘Let him do it that went +with the first,’ but others thought not good to do that, +and that because he sped no better. Now, there was an old +man in the town, and his name was Mr. Good-Deed; a man that bare +only the name, but had nothing of the nature of the thing. +Now, some were for sending him; but the Recorder was by no means +for that. ‘For,’ said he, ‘we now stand +in need of, and are pleading for mercy: wherefore, to send our +petition by a man of this name, will seem to cross the petition +itself. Should we make Mr. Good-Deed our messenger, when +our petition cries for mercy?</p> +<p>‘Besides,’ quoth the old gentleman, ‘should +the Prince now, as he receives the petition, ask him, and say, +“What is thy name?” as nobody knows but he will, and +he should say, “Old Good-Deed,” what, think you, +would Emmanuel say but this? “Ay! is old Good-Deed +yet alive in Mansoul? then let old Good-Deed save you from your +distresses.” And if he says so, I am sure we are +lost; nor can a thousand of old Good-Deeds save +Mansoul.’</p> +<p>After the Recorder had given in his reasons why old Good-Deed +should not go with this petition to Emmanuel, the rest of the +prisoners and chief of Mansoul opposed it also, and so old +Good-Deed was laid aside, and they agreed to send Mr. +Desires-awake again. So they sent for him, and desired him +that he would a second time go with their petition to the Prince, +and he readily told them he would. But they bid him that in +anywise he should take heed that in no word or carriage he gave +offence to the Prince; ‘For by doing so, for ought we can +tell, you may bring Mansoul into utter destruction,’ said +they.</p> +<p>Now Mr. Desires-awake, when he saw that he must go on this +errand, besought that they would grant that Mr. Wet-Eyes might go +with him. Now this Mr. Wet-Eyes was a near neighbour of Mr. +Desires, a poor man, a man of a broken spirit, yet one that could +speak well to a petition; so they granted that he should go with +him. Wherefore, they address themselves to their business: +Mr. Desires put a rope upon his head, and Mr. Wet-Eyes went with +his hands wringing together. Thus they went to the +Prince’s pavilion.</p> +<p>Now, when they went to petition this third time, they were not +without thoughts that, by often coming, they might be a burden to +the Prince. Wherefore, when they were come to the door of +his pavilion, they first made their apology for themselves, and +for their coming to trouble Emmanuel so often; and they said, +that they came not hither to-day for that they delighted in being +troublesome, or for that they delighted to hear themselves talk, +but for that necessity caused them to come to his Majesty. +They could, they said, have no rest day nor night because of +their transgressions against Shaddai and against Emmanuel, his +Son. They also thought that some misbehaviour of Mr. +Desires-awake the last time might give distaste to his Highness, +and so cause that he returned from so merciful a Prince empty, +and without countenance. So, when they had made this +apology, Mr. Desires-awake cast himself prostrate upon the +ground, as at the first, at the feet of the mighty Prince, +saying, ‘Oh! that Mansoul might live before thee!’ +and so he delivered his petition. The Prince then, having +read the petition, turned aside awhile as before, and coming +again to the place where the petitioner lay on the ground, he +demanded what his name was, and of what esteem in the account of +Mansoul, for that he, above all the multitude in Mansoul, should +be sent to him upon such an errand. Then said the man to +the Prince, ‘Oh let not my Lord be angry; and why inquirest +thou after the name of such a dead do—as I am? Pass +by, I pray thee, and take not notice of who I am, because there +is, as thou very well knowest, so great a disproportion between +me and thee. Why the townsmen chose to send me on this +errand to my Lord is best known to themselves, but it could not +be for that they thought that I had favour with my Lord. +For my part, I am out of charity with myself; who, then, should +be in love with me? Yet live I would, and so would I that +my townsmen should; and because both they and myself are guilty +of great transgressions, therefore they have sent me, and I am +come in their names to beg of my Lord for mercy. Let it +please thee, therefore, to incline to mercy; but ask not what thy +servants are.’</p> +<p>Then said the Prince, ‘And what is he that is become thy +companion in this so weighty a matter?’ So Mr. +Desires told Emmanuel that he was a poor neighbour of his, and +one of his most intimate associates. ‘And his +name,’ said he, ‘may it please your most excellent +Majesty, is Wet-Eyes, of the town of Mansoul, I know that there +are many of that name that are naught; but I hope it will be no +offence to my Lord that I have brought my poor neighbour with +me.’</p> +<p>Then Mr. Wet-Eyes fell on his face to the ground, and made +this apology for his coming with his neighbour to his +Lord:—</p> +<p>‘O, my Lord,’ quoth he, ‘what I am I know +not myself, nor whether my name be feigned or true, especially +when I begin to think what some have said, namely, That this name +was given me because Mr. Repentance was my father. Good men +have bad children, and the sincere do oftentimes beget +hypocrites. My mother also called me by this name from the +cradle; but whether because of the moistness of my brain, or +because of the softness of my heart, I cannot tell. I see +dirt in mine own tears, and filthiness in the bottom of my +prayers. But I pray thee (and all this while the gentleman +wept) that thou wouldest not remember against us our +transgressions, nor take offence at the unqualifiedness of thy +servants, but mercifully pass by the sin of Mansoul, and refrain +from the glorifying of thy grace no longer.’</p> +<p>So at his bidding they arose, and both stood trembling before +him, and he spake to them to this purpose:—</p> +<p>‘The town of Mansoul hath grievously rebelled against my +Father, in that they have rejected him from being their King, and +did choose to themselves for their captain a liar, a murderer, +and a runagate slave. For this Diabolus, your pretended +prince, though once so highly accounted of by you, made rebellion +against my Father and me, even in our palace and highest court +there, thinking to become a prince and king. But being +there timely discovered and apprehended, and for his wickedness +bound in chains, and separated to the pit with those that were +his companions, he offered himself to you, and you have received +him.</p> +<p>‘Now this is, and for a long time hath been, a high +affront to my Father; wherefore my Father sent to you a powerful +army to reduce you to your obedience. But you know how +these men, their captains and their counsels, were esteemed of +you, and what they received at your hand. You rebelled +against them, you shut your gates upon them, you bid them battle, +you fought them, and fought for Diabolus against them. So +they sent to my Father for more power, and I, with my men, are +come to subdue you. But as you treated the servants, so you +treated their Lord. You stood up in hostile manner against +me, you shut up your gates against me, you turned the deaf ear to +me, and resisted as long as you could; but now I have made a +conquest of you. Did you cry me mercy so long as you had +hopes that you might prevail against me? But now I have +taken the town, you cry; but why did you not cry before, when the +white flag of my mercy, the red flag of justice, and the black +flag that threatened execution, were set up to cite you to +it? Now I have conquered your Diabolus, you come to me for +favour; but why did you not help me against the mighty? Yet +I will consider your petition, and will answer it so as will be +for my glory.</p> +<p>‘Go, bid Captain Boanerges and Captain Conviction bring +the prisoners out to me into the camp to-morrow, and say you to +Captain Judgment and Captain Execution, “Stay you in the +castle, and take good heed to yourselves that you keep all quiet +in Mansoul until you shall hear further from +me.”’ And with that he turned himself from +them, and went into his royal pavilion again.</p> +<p>So the petitioners, having received this answer from the +Prince, returned, as at the first, to go to their companions +again. But they had not gone far, but thoughts began to +work in their minds that no mercy as yet was intended by the +Prince to Mansoul. So they went to the place where the +prisoners lay bound; but these workings of mind about what would +become of Mansoul had such strong power over them, that by that +they were come unto them that sent them, they were scarce able to +deliver their message.</p> +<p>But they came at length to the gates of the town, (now the +townsmen with earnestness were waiting for their return,) where +many met them, to know what answer was made to the +petition. Then they cried out to those that were sent, +‘What news from the Prince? and what hath Emmanuel +said?’ But they said that they must, as afore, go up +to the prison, and there deliver their message. So away +they went to the prison, with a multitude at their heels. +Now, when they were come to the gates of the prison, they told +the first part of Emmanuel’s speech to the prisoners, to +wit, how he reflected upon their disloyalty to his Father and +himself, and how they had chosen and closed with Diabolus, had +fought for him, hearkened to him, and been ruled by him; but had +despised him and his men. This made the prisoners look +pale; but the messengers proceeded and said, ‘He, the +Prince, said, moreover, that yet he would consider your petition, +and give such answer thereto as would stand with his +glory.’ And as these words were spoken, Mr. Wet-Eyes +gave a great sigh. At this they were all of them struck +into their dumps, and could not tell what to say: fear also +possessed them in a marvellous manner, and death seemed to sit +upon some of their eyebrows. Now, there was in the company +a notable, sharp-witted fellow, a mean man of estate, and his +name was old Inquisitive. This man asked the petitioners if +they had told out every whit of what Emmanuel said, and they +answered, ‘Verily, no.’ Then said Inquisitive, +‘I thought so, indeed. Pray, what was it more that he +said unto you?’ Then they paused awhile; but at last +they brought out all, saying, ‘The Prince bade us bid +Captain Boanerges and Captain Conviction bring the prisoners down +to him to-morrow; and that Captain Judgment and Captain Execution +should take charge of the castle and town till they should hear +further from him. They said also that when the Prince had +commanded them thus to do, he immediately turned his back upon +them, and went into his royal pavilion.</p> +<p>But, oh! how this return, and specially this last clause of +it, that the prisoners must go out to the Prince into the camp, +brake all their loins in pieces! Wherefore, with one voice +they set up a cry that reached up to the heavens. This +done, each of the three prepared himself to die; (and the +Recorder said unto them, ‘This was the thing that I +feared;’) for they concluded that to-morrow, by that the +sun went down, they should be tumbled out of the world. The +whole town also counted of no other, but that, in their time and +order, they must all drink of the same cup. Wherefore the +town of Mansoul spent that night in mourning, and sackcloth and +ashes. The prisoners also, when the time was come for them +to go down before the Prince, dressed themselves in mourning +attire, with ropes upon their heads. The whole town of +Mansoul also showed themselves upon the wall, all clad in +mourning weeds, if, perhaps, the Prince with the sight thereof +might be moved with compassion. But, oh! how the +busy-bodies that were in the town of Mansoul did now concern +themselves! They did run here and there through the streets +of the town by companies, crying out as they ran in tumultuous +wise, one after one manner, and another the quite contrary, to +the almost utter distraction of Mansoul.</p> +<p>Well, the time is come that the prisoners must go down to the +camp, and appear before the Prince. And thus was the manner +of their going down: Captain Boanerges went with a guard before +them, and Captain Conviction came behind, and the prisoners went +down, bound in chains, in the midst. So I say, the +prisoners went in the midst, and the guard went with flying +colours behind and before, but the prisoners went with drooping +spirits.</p> +<p>Or, more particularly, thus: The prisoners went down all in +mourning: they put ropes upon themselves; they went on, smiting +themselves on the breasts, but durst not lift up their eyes to +heaven. Thus they went out at the gate of Mansoul, till +they came into the midst of the Prince’s army, the sight +and glory of which did greatly heighten their affliction. +Nor could they now longer forbear, but cry out aloud, ‘O +unhappy men! O wretched men of Mansoul!’ Their +chains, still mixing their dolorous notes with the cries of the +prisoners, made the noise more lamentable.</p> +<p>So, when they were come to the door of the Prince’s +pavilion, they cast themselves prostrate upon the place; then one +went in and told his Lord that the prisoners were come +down. The Prince then ascended a throne of state, and sent +for the prisoners in; who, when they came, did tremble before +him, also they covered their faces with shame. Now, as they +drew near to the place where he sat, they threw themselves down +before him. Then said the Prince to the Captain Boanerges, +‘Bid the prisoners stand upon their feet.’ Then +they stood trembling before him, and he said, ‘Are you the +men that heretofore were the servants of Shaddai?’ +And they said, ‘Yes, Lord, yes.’ Then said the +Prince again, ‘Are you the men that did suffer yourselves +to be corrupted and defiled by that abominable one, +Diabolus?’ And they said, ‘We did more than +suffer it, Lord; for we chose it of our own mind.’ +The Prince asked further, saying, ‘Could you have been +content that your slavery should have continued under his tyranny +as long as you had lived?’ Then said the prisoners, +‘Yes, Lord, yes; for his ways were pleasing to our flesh, +and we were grown aliens to a better +state.’—‘And did you,’ said he, +‘when I came up against this town of Mansoul, heartily wish +that I might not have the victory over +you?’—‘Yes, Lord, yes,’ said they. +Then said the Prince, ‘And what punishment is it, think +you, that you deserve at my hand, for these and other your high +and mighty sins?’—And they said, ‘Both death +and the deep, Lord; for we have deserved no less.’ He +asked again if they had aught to say for themselves why the +sentence, that they confessed that they had deserved, should not +be passed upon them? And they said, ‘We can say +nothing, Lord: thou art just, for we have sinned.’ +Then said the Prince, ‘And for what are those ropes on your +heads?’ The prisoners answered, ‘These ropes +are to bind us withal to the place of execution, if mercy be not +pleasing in thy sight.’ So he further asked if all +the men in the town of Mansoul were in this confession, as +they? And they answered, ‘All the natives, Lord; but +for the Diabolonians that came into our town when the tyrant got +possession of us, we can say nothing for them.’</p> +<p>Then the Prince commanded that a herald should be called, and +that he should, in the midst and throughout the camp of Emmanuel, +proclaim, and that with sound of trumpet, that the Prince, the +Son of Shaddai, had, in his Father’s name, and for his +Father’s glory, gotten a perfect conquest and victory over +Mansoul; and that the prisoners should follow him, and say +Amen. So, this was done as he had commanded. And +presently the music that was in the upper region sounded +melodiously, the captains that were in the camp shouted, and the +soldiers did sing songs of triumph to the Prince; the colours +waved in the wind, and great joy was everywhere, only it was +wanting as yet in the hearts of the men of Mansoul.</p> +<p>Then the Prince called for the prisoners to come and to stand +again before him, and they came and stood trembling. And he +said unto them, ‘The sins, trespasses, iniquities, that +you, with the whole town of Mansoul, have from time to time +committed against my Father and me, I have power and commandment +from my Father to forgive to the town of Mansoul, and do forgive +you accordingly.’ And having so said, he gave them, +written in parchment, and sealed with seven seals, a large and +general pardon, commanding my Lord Mayor, my Lord Willbewill, and +Mr. Recorder, to proclaim and cause it to be proclaimed +to-morrow, by that the sun is up, throughout the whole town of +Mansoul.</p> +<p>Moreover, the Prince stripped the prisoners of their mourning +weeds, and gave them beauty for ashes, the oil of joy for +mourning, and the garment of praise for the spirit of +heaviness.</p> +<p>Then he gave to each of the three jewels of gold and precious +stones, and took away their ropes, and put chains of gold about +their necks, and ear-rings in their ears. Now, the +prisoners, when they did hear the gracious words of Prince +Emmanuel, and had beheld all that was done unto them, fainted +almost quite away; for the grace, the benefit, the pardon, was +sudden, glorious, and so big, that they were not able, without +staggering, to stand up under it. Yea, my Lord Willbewill +swooned outright; but the Prince stepped to him, put his +everlasting arms under him, embraced him, kissed him, and bid him +be of good cheer, for all should be performed according to his +word. He also did kiss, and embrace, and smile upon the +other two that were Willbewill’s companions, saying, +‘Take these as further tokens of my love, favour, and +compassions to you; and I charge you that you, Mr. Recorder, tell +in the town of Mansoul what you have heard and seen.’</p> +<p>Then were their fetters broken to pieces before their faces, +and cast into the air, and their steps were enlarged under +them. Then they fell down at the feet of the Prince, and +kissed his feet, and wetted them with tears: also they cried out +with a mighty strong voice, saying, ‘Blessed be the glory +of the Lord from this place.’ So they were bid rise +up, and go to the town, and tell to Mansoul what the Prince had +done. He commanded also that one with a pipe and tabor +should go and play before them all the way into the town of +Mansoul. Then was fulfilled what they never looked for, and +they were made to possess that which they never dreamed of.</p> +<p>The Prince also called for the noble Captain Credence, and +commanded that he and some of his officers should march before +the noble men of Mansoul with flying colours into the town. +He gave also unto Captain Credence a charge, that about that time +that the Recorder did read the general pardon in the town of +Mansoul, that at that very time he should with flying colours +march in at Eye-gate with his ten thousands at his feet and that +he should so go until he came by the high street of the town, up +to the castle gates, and that himself should take possession +thereof against his Lord came thither. He commanded, +moreover, that he should bid Captain Judgment and Captain +Execution to leave the stronghold to him, and to withdraw from +Mansoul, and to return into the camp with speed unto the +Prince.</p> +<p>And now was the town of Mansoul also delivered from the terror +of the first four captains and their men.</p> +<p>Well, I told you before how the prisoners were entertained by +the noble Prince Emmanuel, and how they behaved themselves before +him, and how he sent them away to their home with pipe and tabor +going before them. And now you must think that those of the +town that had all this while waited to hear of their death, could +not but be exercised with sadness of mind, and with thoughts that +pricked like thorns. Nor could their thoughts be kept to +any one point; the wind blew with them all this while at great +uncertainties; yea, their hearts were like a balance that had +been disquieted with a shaking hand. But at last, as they +with many a long look looked over the wall of Mansoul, they +thought that they saw some returning to the town; and thought +again, Who should they be, too? Who should they be? +At last they discerned that they were the prisoners: but can you +imagine how their hearts were surprised with wonder, specially +when they perceived also in what equipage and with what honour +they were sent home. They went down to the camp in black, +but they came back to the town in white; they went down to the +camp in ropes, they came back in chains of gold; they went down +to the camp with their feet in fetters, but came back with their +steps enlarged under them; they went also to the camp looking for +death, but they came back from thence with assurance of life; +they went down to the camp with heavy hearts, but came back again +with pipe and tabor playing before them. So as soon as they +were come to Eye-gate, the poor and tottering town of Mansoul +adventured to give a shout; and they gave such a shout as made +the captains in the Prince’s army leap at the sound +thereof. Alas! for them, poor hearts! who could blame them? +since their dead friends were come to life again; for it was to +them as life from the dead to see the ancients of the town of +Mansoul shine in such splendour. They looked for nothing +but the axe and the block; but, behold, joy and gladness, comfort +and consolation, and such melodious notes attending them that was +sufficient to make a sick man well.</p> +<p>So, when they came up, they saluted each other with, +‘Welcome, welcome! and blessed be he that has spared +you!’ They added also, ‘We see it is well with +you; but how must it go with the town of Mansoul? And will +it go well with the town of Mansoul?’ said they. Then +answered them the Recorder and my Lord Mayor, ‘Oh! tidings! +glad tidings! good tidings of good, and of great joy to poor +Mansoul!’ Then they gave another shout, that made the +earth to ring again. After this, they inquired yet more +particularly how things went in the camp, and what message they +had from Emmanuel to the town. So they told them all +passages that had happened to them at the camp, and everything +that the Prince did to them. This made Mansoul wonder at +the wisdom and grace of the Prince Emmanuel. Then they told +them what they had received at his hands for the whole town of +Mansoul, and the Recorder delivered it in these words: +‘<span class="smcap">Pardon</span>, <span +class="smcap">Pardon</span>, <span class="smcap">Pardon</span> +for Mansoul! and this shall Mansoul know to-morrow!’ +Then he commanded, and they went and summoned Mansoul to meet +together in the market-place to-morrow, then to hear their +general pardon read.</p> +<p>But who can think what a turn, what a change, what an +alteration this hint of things did make in the countenance of the +town of Mansoul! No man of Mansoul could sleep that night +for joy; in every house there was joy and music, singing and +making merry: telling and hearing of Mansoul’s happiness +was then all that Mansoul had to do; and this was the burden of +all their song: ‘Oh! more of this at the rising of the sun! +more of this to-morrow!’ ‘Who thought +yesterday,’ would one say, ‘that this day would have +been such a day to us? And who thought, that saw our +prisoners go down in irons, that they would have returned in +chains of gold? Yea, they that judged themselves as they +went to be judged of their judge, were by his mouth acquitted, +not for that they were innocent, but of the Prince’s mercy, +and sent home with pipe and tabor. But is this the common +custom of princes? Do they use to show such kind of favours to +traitors? No; this is only peculiar to Shaddai, and unto +Emmanuel, his Son!’</p> +<p>Now morning drew on apace; wherefore the Lord Mayor, the Lord +Willbewill, and Mr. Recorder came down to the market-place at the +time that the Prince had appointed, where the townsfolk were +waiting for them: and when they came, they came in that attire, +and in that glory that the Prince had put them into the day +before, and the street was lightened with their glory. So +the Mayor, Recorder, and my Lord Willbewill drew down to +Mouth-gate, which was at the lower end of the market-place, +because that of old time was the place where they used to read +public matters. Thither, therefore, they came in their +robes, and their tabrets went before them. Now, the +eagerness of the people to know the full of the matter was +great.</p> +<p>Then the Recorder stood up upon his feet, and, first beckoning +with his hand for silence, he read out with a loud voice the +pardon. But when he came to these words: ‘The Lord, +the Lord God, merciful and gracious, pardoning iniquity, +transgressions, and sins, and to them all manner of sin and +blasphemy shall be forgiven,’ etc., they could not forbear +leaping for joy. For this you must know, that there was +conjoined herewith every man’s name in Mansoul; also the +seals of the pardon made a brave show.</p> +<p>When the Recorder had made an end of reading the pardon, the +townsmen ran up upon the walls of the town, and leaped and +skipped thereon for joy, and bowed themselves seven times with +their faces toward Emmanuel’s pavilion, and shouted out +aloud for joy, and said, ‘Let Emmanuel live for +ever!’ Then order was given to the young men in +Mansoul that they should ring the bells for joy. So the +bells did ring, and the people sing, and the music go in every +house in Mansoul.</p> +<p>When the Prince had sent home the three prisoners of Mansoul +with joy, and pipe and tabor, he commanded his captains, with all +the field officers and soldiers throughout his army, to be ready +in that morning, that the Recorder should read the pardon in +Mansoul, to do his further pleasure. So the morning, as I +have showed, being come, just as the Recorder had made an end of +reading the pardon, Emmanuel commanded that all the trumpets in +the camp should sound, that the colours should be displayed, half +of them upon Mount Gracious, and half of them upon Mount +Justice. He commanded also that all the captains should +show themselves in all their harness, and that the soldiers +should shout for joy. Nor was Captain Credence, though in +the castle, silent in such a day; but he, from the top of the +hold, showed himself with sound of trumpet to Mansoul and to the +Prince’s camp.</p> +<p>Thus have I showed you the manner and way that Emmanuel took +to recover the town of Mansoul from under the hand and power of +the tyrant Diabolus.</p> +<p>Now, when the Prince had completed these, the outward +ceremonies of his joy, he again commanded that his captains and +soldiers should show unto Mansoul some feats of war: so they +presently addressed themselves to this work. But oh! with +what agility, nimbleness, dexterity, and bravery did these +military men discover their skill in feats of war to the now +gazing town of Mansoul!</p> +<p>They marched, they counter-marched; they opened to the right +and left; they divided and subdivided; they closed, they wheeled, +made good their front and rear with their right and left wings, +and twenty things more, with that aptness, and then were all as +the were again, that they took—yea, ravished, the hearts +that were in Mansoul to behold it. But add to this, the +handling of their arms, the managing of their weapons of war, +were marvellously taking to Mansoul and me.</p> +<p>When this action was over, the whole town of Mansoul came out +as one man to the Prince in the camp to thank him, and praise him +for his abundant favour, and to beg that it would please his +grace to come unto Mansoul with his men, and there to take up +their quarters for ever: and this they did in most humble manner, +bowing themselves seven times to the ground before him. +Then said he, ‘All peace be to you.’ So the town came +nigh, and touched with the hand the top of his golden sceptre; +and they said, ‘Oh! that the Prince Emmanuel, with his +captains and men of war, would dwell in Mansoul for ever; and +that his battering-rams and slings might be lodged in her for the +use and service of the Prince, and for the help and strength of +Mansoul. For,’ said they, ‘we have room for +thee, we have room for thy men, we have also room for thy weapons +of war, and a place to make a magazine for thy carriages. +Do it, Emmanuel, and thou shalt be King and Captain in Mansoul +for ever. Yea, govern thou also according to all the desire +of thy soul, and make thou governors and princes under thee of +thy captains and men of war, and we will become thy servants, and +thy laws shall be our direction.’</p> +<p>They added, moreover, and prayed his Majesty to consider +thereof; ‘for,’ said they, ‘if now, after all +this grace bestowed upon us, thy miserable town of Mansoul, thou +shouldest withdraw, thou and thy captains, from us, the town of +Mansoul will die. Yea,’ said they, ‘our blessed +Emmanuel, if thou shouldest depart from us now, now thou hast +done so much good for us, and showed so much mercy unto us, what +will follow but that our joy will be as if it had not been, and +our enemies will a second time come upon us with more rage than +at the first? Wherefore, we beseech thee, O thou, the +desire of our eyes, and the strength and life of our poor town, +accept of this motion that now we have made unto our Lord, and +come and dwell in the midst of us, and let us be thy +people. Besides, Lord, we do not know but that to this day +many Diabolonians may be yet lurking in the town of Mansoul, and +they will betray us, when thou shalt leave us, into the hand of +Diabolus again; and who knows what designs, plots, or +contrivances have passed betwixt them about these things +already? Loath we are to fall again into his horrible +hands. Wherefore, let it please thee to accept of our +palace for thy place of residence, and of the houses of the best +men in our town for the reception of thy soldiers and their +furniture.’</p> +<p>Then said the Prince, ‘If I come to your town, will you +suffer me further to prosecute that which is in mine heart +against mine enemies and yours?—yea, will you help me in +such undertakings?’</p> +<p>They answered, ‘We know not what we shall do; we did not +think once that we should have been such traitors to Shaddai as +we have proved to be. What, then, shall we say to our +Lord? Let him put no trust in his saints; let the Prince +dwell in our castle, and make of our town a garrison; let him set +his noble captains and his warlike soldiers over us; yea, let him +conquer us with his love, and overcome us with his grace, and +then surely shall he be but with us, and help us, as he was and +did that morning that our pardon was read unto us. We shall +comply with this our Lord, and with his ways, and fall in with +his word against the mighty.</p> +<p>‘One word more, and thy servants have done, and in this +will trouble our Lord no more. We know not the depth of the +wisdom of thee, our Prince. Who could have thought, that +had been ruled by his reason, that so much sweet as we do now +enjoy should have come out of those bitter trials wherewith we +were tried at the first! But, Lord, let light go before, +and let love come after: yea, take us by the hand, and lead us by +thy counsels, and let this always abide upon us, that all things +shall be the best for thy servants, and come to our Mansoul, and +do as it pleaseth thee. Or, Lord, come to our Mansoul, do +what thou wilt, so thou keepest us from sinning, and makest us +serviceable to thy Majesty.’</p> +<p>Then said the Prince to the town of Mansoul again, ‘Go, +return to your houses in peace. I will willingly in this +comply with your desires; I will remove my royal pavilion, I will +draw up my forces before Eye-gate to-morrow, and so will march +forwards into the town of Mansoul. I will possess myself of +your castle of Mansoul, and will set my soldiers over you: yea, I +will yet do things in Mansoul that cannot be paralleled in any +nation, country, or kingdom under heaven.’ Then did +the men of Mansoul give a shout, and returned unto their houses +in peace; they also told to their kindred and friends the good +that Emmanuel had promised to Mansoul. ‘And +to-morrow,’ said they, ‘he will march into our town, +and take up his dwelling, he and his men, in Mansoul.’</p> +<p>Then went out the inhabitants of the town of Mansoul with +haste to the green trees and to the meadows, to gather boughs and +flowers, therewith to strew the streets against their Prince, the +Son of Shaddai, should come; they also made garlands and other +fine works to betoken how joyful they were, and should be to +receive their Emmanuel into Mansoul; yea, they strewed the street +quite from Eye-gate to the castle-gate, the place where the +Prince should be. They also prepared for his coming what +music the town of Mansoul would afford, that they might play +before him to the palace, his habitation.</p> +<p>So, at the time appointed he makes his approach to Mansoul, +and the gates were set open for him; there also the ancients and +elders of Mansoul met him to salute him with a thousand +welcomes. Then he arose and entered Mansoul, he and all his +servants. The elders of Mansoul did also go dancing before +him till he came to the castle gates. And this was the +manner of his going up thither:—He was clad in his golden +armour, he rode in his royal chariot, the trumpets sounded about +him, the colours were displayed, his ten thousands went up at his +feet, and the elders of Mansoul danced before him. And now +were the walls of the famous town of Mansoul filled with the +tramplings of the inhabitants thereof, who went up thither to +view the approach of the blessed Prince and his royal army. +Also the casements, windows, balconies, and tops of the houses, +were all now filled with persons of all sorts, to behold how +their town was to be filled with good.</p> +<p>Now, when he was come so far into the town as to the +Recorder’s house, he commanded that one should go to +Captain Credence, to know whether the castle of Mansoul was +prepared to entertain his royal presence (for the preparation of +that was left to that captain), and word was brought that it +was. Then was Captain Credence commanded also to come forth +with his power to meet the Prince, the which was, as he had +commanded, done; and he conducted him into the castle. This +done, the Prince that night did lodge in the castle with his +mighty captains and men of war, to the joy of the town of +Mansoul.</p> +<p>Now, the next care of the townsfolk was, how the captains and +soldiers of the Prince’s army should be quartered among +them; and the care was not how they should shut their hands of +them, but how they should fill their houses with them; for every +man in Mansoul now had that esteem of Emmanuel and his men that +nothing grieved them more than because they were not enlarged +enough, every one of them to receive the whole army of the +Prince; yea, they counted it their glory to be waiting upon them, +and would, in those days, run at their bidding like lackeys.</p> +<p>At last they came to this result:—</p> +<p>1. That Captain Innocency should quarter at Mr. +Reason’s.</p> +<p>2. That Captain Patience should quarter at Mr. +Mind’s. This Mr. Mind was formerly the Lord +Willbewill’s clerk in time of the late rebellion.</p> +<p>3. It was ordered that Captain Charity should quarter at Mr. +Affection’s house.</p> +<p>4. That Captain Good-Hope should quarter at my Lord +Mayor’s. Now, for the house of the Recorder, himself +desired, because his house was next to the castle, and because +from him it was ordered by the Prince that, if need be, the alarm +should be given to Mansoul,—it was, I say, desired by him +that Captain Boanerges and Captain Conviction should take up +their quarters with him, even they and all their men.</p> +<p>5. As for Captain Judgment and Captain Execution, my Lord +Willbewill took them and their men to him, because he was to rule +under the Prince for the good of the town of Mansoul now, as he +had before under the tyrant Diabolus for the hurt and damage +thereof.</p> +<p>6. And throughout the rest of the town were quartered +Emmanuel’s forces; but Captain Credence, with his men, +abode still in the castle. So the Prince, his captains, and +his soldiers, were lodged in the town of Mansoul.</p> +<p>Now, the ancients and elders of the town of Mansoul thought +that they never should have enough of the Prince Emmanuel; his +person, his actions, his words, and behaviour, were so pleasing, +so taking, so desirable to them. Wherefore they prayed him, +that though the castle of Mansoul was his place of residence, +(and they desired that he might dwell there for ever,) yet that +he would often visit the streets, houses, and people of +Mansoul. ‘For,’ said they, ‘dread +Sovereign, thy presence, thy looks, thy smiles, thy words, are +the life, and strength, and sinews of the town of +Mansoul.’</p> +<p>Besides this, they craved that they might have, without +difficulty or interruption, continual access unto him, (so for +that very purpose he commanded that the gates should stand open,) +that they might there see the manner of his doings, the +fortifications of the place, and the royal mansion-house of the +Prince.</p> +<p>When he spake, they all stopped their mouths and gave +audience; and when he walked, it was their delight to imitate him +in his goings.</p> +<p>Now, upon a time, Emmanuel made a feast for the town of +Mansoul; and upon the feasting-day the townsfolk were come to the +castle to partake of his banquet; and he feasted them with all +manner of outlandish food;—food that grew not in the fields +of Mansoul; nor in all the whole Kingdom of Universe; it was food +that came from his Father’s court. And so there was +dish after dish set before them, and they were commanded freely +to eat. But still, when a fresh dish was set before them, +they would whisperingly say to each other, ‘What is +it?’ for they wist not what to call it. They drank +also of the water that was made wine, and were very merry with +him. There was music also all the while at the table; and +man did eat angels’ food, and had honey given him out of +the rock. So Mansoul did eat the food that was peculiar to +the court; yea, they had now thereof to the full.</p> +<p>I must not forget to tell you, that as at this table there +were musicians, so they were not those of the country, nor yet of +the town of Mansoul; but they were the masters of the songs that +were sung at the court of Shaddai.</p> +<p>Now, after the feast was over, Emmanuel was for entertaining +the town of Mansoul with some curious riddles of secrets drawn up +by his Father’s secretary, by the skill and wisdom of +Shaddai; the like to these there is not in any kingdom. +These riddles were made upon the King Shaddai himself, and upon +Emmanuel his Son, and upon his wars and doings with Mansoul.</p> +<p>Emmanuel also expounded unto them some of those riddles +himself; but, oh! how they were lightened! They saw what +they never saw; they could not have thought that such rarities +could have been couched in so few and such ordinary words. +I told you before, whom these riddles did concern; and as they +were opened, the people did evidently see it was so. Yea, +they did gather that the things themselves were a kind of a +portraiture, and that of Emmanuel himself; for when they read in +the scheme where the riddles were writ, and looked in the face of +the Prince, things looked so like the one to the other, that +Mansoul could not forbear but say, ‘This is the lamb! this +is the sacrifice! this is the rock! this is the red cow! this is +the door! and this is the way!’ with a great many other +things more.</p> +<p>And thus he dismissed the town of Mansoul. But can you +imagine how the people of the corporation were taken with this +entertainment! Oh! they were transported with joy, they +were drowned with wonderment, while they saw and understood, and +considered what their Emmanuel entertained them withal, and what +mysteries he opened to them. And when they were at home in +their houses, and in their most retired places, they could not +but sing of him and of his actions. Yea, so taken were the +townsmen now with their Prince, that they would sing of him in +their sleep.</p> +<p>Now, it was in the heart of the Prince Emmanuel to new-model +the town of Mansoul, and to put it into such a condition as might +be most pleasing to him, and that might best stand with the +profit and security of the now flourishing town of Mansoul. +He provided also against insurrections at home, and invasions +from abroad, such love had he for the famous town of Mansoul.</p> +<p>Wherefore he first of all commanded that the great slings that +were brought from his Father’s court, when he came to the +war of Mansoul, should be mounted, some upon the battlements of +the castle, some upon the towers; for there were towers in the +town of Mansoul, towers, new-built by Emmanuel since he came +hither. There was also an instrument, invented by Emmanuel, +that was to throw stones from the castle of Mansoul, out at +Mouth-gate; an instrument that could not be resisted, nor that +would miss of execution. Wherefore, for the wonderful +exploits that it did when used, it went without a name; and it +was committed to the care of, and to be managed by the brave +captain, the Captain Credence, in case of war.</p> +<p>This done, Emmanuel called the Lord Willbewill to him, and +gave him in commandment to take care of the gates, the wall, and +towers in Mansoul; also the Prince gave him the militia into his +hand, and a special charge to withstand all insurrections and +tumults that might be made in Mansoul against the peace of our +Lord the King, and the peace and tranquillity of the town of +Mansoul. He also gave him in commission, that if he found +any of the Diabolonians lurking in any corner of the famous town +of Mansoul, he should forthwith apprehend them, and stay them, or +commit them to safe custody, that they may be proceeded against +according to law.</p> +<p>Then he called unto him the Lord Understanding, who was the +old Lord Mayor, he that was put out of place when Diabolus took +the town, and put him into his former office again, and it became +his place for his lifetime. He bid him also that he should +build him a palace near Eye-gate; and that he should build it in +fashion like a tower for defence. He bid him also that he +should read in the Revelation of Mysteries all the days of his +life, that he might know how to perform his office aright.</p> +<p>He also made Mr. Knowledge the Recorder, not of contempt to +old Mr. Conscience, who had been Recorder before, but for that it +was in his princely mind to confer upon Mr. Conscience another +employ, of which he told the old gentleman he should know more +hereafter.</p> +<p>Then he commanded that the image of Diabolus should be taken +down from the place where it was set up, and that they should +destroy it utterly, beating it into powder, and casting it into +the wind without the town wall; and that the image of Shaddai, +his Father, should be set up again, with his own, upon the castle +gates; and that it should be more fairly drawn than ever, +forasmuch as both his Father and himself were come to Mansoul in +more grace and mercy than heretofore. He would also that +his name should be fairly engraven upon the front of the town, +and that it should be done in the best of gold, for the honour of +the town of Mansoul.</p> +<p>After this was done, Emmanuel gave out a commandment that +those three great Diabolonians should be apprehended, namely, the +two late Lord Mayors, to wit, Mr. Incredulity, Mr. Lustings, and +Mr. Forget-Good, the Recorder. Besides these, there were +some of them that Diabolus made burgesses and aldermen in +Mansoul, that were committed to ward by the hand of the now +valiant and now right noble, the brave Lord Willbewill.</p> +<p>And these were their names: Alderman Atheism, Alderman +Hard-Heart, and Alderman False-Peace. The burgesses were, +Mr. No-Truth, Mr. Pitiless, Mr. Haughty, with the like. +These were committed to close custody, and the gaoler’s +name was Mr. True-Man. This True-Man was one of those that +Emmanuel brought with him from his Father’s court when at +the first he made a war upon Diabolus in the town or Mansoul.</p> +<p>After this, the Prince gave a charge that the three +strongholds that, at the command of Diabolus, the Diabolonians +built in Mansoul, should be demolished and utterly pulled down; +of which holds and their names, with their captains and +governors, you read a little before. But this was long in +doing, because of the largeness of the places, and because the +stones, the timber, the iron, and all rubbish, was to be carried +without the town.</p> +<p>When this was done, the Prince gave order that the Lord Mayor +and aldermen of Mansoul should call a court of judicature for the +trial and execution of the Diabolonians in the corporation now +under the charge of Mr. True-Man, the gaoler.</p> +<p>Now, when the time was come, and the court set, commandment +was sent to Mr. True-Man, the gaoler, to bring the prisoners down +to the bar. Then were the prisoners brought down, pinioned +and chained together, as the custom of the town of Mansoul +was. So, when they were presented before the Lord Mayor, +the Recorder, and the rest of the honourable bench, first, the +jury was empannelled, and then the witnesses sworn. The +names of the jury were these: Mr. Belief, Mr. True-Heart, Mr. +Upright, Mr. Hate-Bad, Mr. Love-God, Mr. See-Truth, Mr. +Heavenly-Mind, Mr. Moderate, Mr. Thankful, Mr. Good-Work, Mr. +Zeal-for-God, and Mr. Humble.</p> +<p>The names of the witnesses were—Mr. Know-All, Mr. +Tell-True, Mr. Hate-Lies, with my Lord Willbewill and his man, if +need were.</p> +<p>So the prisoners were set to the bar. Then said Mr. +Do-Right, (for he was the Town-Clerk,) ‘Set Atheism to the +bar, gaoler.’ So he was set to the bar. Then +said the Clerk, ‘Atheism, hold up thy hand. Thou art +here indicted by the name of Atheism, (an intruder upon the town +of Mansoul,) for that thou hast perniciously and doltishly taught +and maintained that there is no God, and so no heed to be taken +to religion. This thou hast done against the being, honour, +and glory of the King, and against the peace and safety of the +town of Mansoul. What sayest thou? Art thou guilty of +this indictment, or not?</p> +<p><i>Atheism</i>. Not guilty.</p> +<p><i>Crier</i>. Call Mr. Know-All, Mr. Tell-True, and Mr. +Hate-Lies into the court.</p> +<p>So they were called, and they appeared.</p> +<p>Then said the Clerk, ‘You, the witnesses for the King, +look upon the prisoner at the bar; do you know him?’</p> +<p>Then said Mr. Know-All, ‘Yes, my lord, we know him; his +name is Atheism; he has been a very pestilent fellow for many +years in the miserable town of Mansoul.’</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. You are sure you know him?</p> +<p><i>Know</i>. Know him! Yes my lord; I have +heretofore too often been in his company to be at this time +ignorant of him. He is a Diabolonian, the son of a +Diabolonian: I knew his grandfather and his father.</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. Well said. He standeth here indicted +by the name of Atheism, etc., and is charged that he hath +maintained and taught that there is no God, and so no heed need +be taken to any religion. What say you, the King’s +witnesses, to this? Is he guilty or not?</p> +<p><i>Know</i>. My lord, I and he were once in +Villain’s Lane together, and he at that time did briskly +talk of divers opinions; and then and there I heard him say, +that, for his part, he did believe that there was no God. +‘But,’ said he, ‘I can profess one, and be as +religious too, if the company I am in, and the circumstances of +other things,’ said he, ‘shall put me upon +it.’</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. You are sure you heard him say thus?</p> +<p><i>Know</i>. Upon mine oath, I heard him say thus.</p> +<p>Then said the Clerk, ‘Mr. Tell-True, what say you to the +King’s judges touching the prisoner at the bar?’</p> +<p><i>Tell</i>. My lord, I formerly was a great companion +of his, for the which I now repent me, and I have often heard him +say, and that with very great stomachfulness, that he believed +there was neither God, angel, nor spirit.</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. Where did you hear him say so?</p> +<p><i>Tell</i>. In Blackmouth Lane and in +Blasphemer’s Row, and in many other places besides.</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. Have you much knowledge of him?</p> +<p><i>Tell</i>. I know him to be a Diabolonian, the son of +a Diabolonian, and a horrible man to deny a Deity. His +father’s name was Never-be-good, and he had more children +than this Atheism. I have no more to say.</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. Mr. Hate-Lies, look upon the prisoner at +the bar; do you know him?</p> +<p><i>Hate</i>. My lord, this Atheism is one of the vilest +wretches that ever I came near, or had to do with in my +life. I have heard him say that there is no God; I have +heard him say that there is no world to come, no sin, nor +punishment hereafter, and, moreover, I have heard him say that it +was as good to go to a whore-house as to go to hear a sermon.</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. Where did you hear him say these +things?</p> +<p><i>Hate</i>. In Drunkard’s Row, just at +Rascal-Lane’s End, at a house in which Mr. Impiety +lived.</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. Set him by, gaoler, and set Mr. Lustings +to the bar. Mr. Lustings, thou art here indicted by the +name of Lustings, (an intruder upon the town of Mansoul,) for +that thou hast devilishly and traitorously taught, by practice +and filthy words, that it is lawful and profitable to man to give +way to his carnal desires; and that thou, for thy part, hast not, +nor never wilt, deny thyself of any sinful delight as long as thy +name is Lustings. How sayest thou? Art thou guilty of +this indictment, or not?</p> +<p>Then said Mr. Lustings, ‘My lord, I am a man of high +birth, and have been used to pleasures and pastimes of +greatness. I have not been wont to be snubbed for my +doings, but have been left to follow my will as if it were +law. And it seems strange to me that I should this day be +called into question for that, that not only I, but almost all +men, do either secretly or openly countenance, love, and approve +of.’</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. Sir, we concern not ourselves with your +greatness; (though the higher, the better you should have been;) +but we are concerned, and so are you now, about an indictment +preferred against you. How say you? Are you guilty of +it, or not?</p> +<p><i>Lust</i>. Not guilty.</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. Crier, call upon the witnesses to stand +forth and give their evidence.</p> +<p><i>Crier</i>. Gentlemen, you, the witnesses for the +King, come in and give in your evidence for our Lord the King +against the prisoner at the bar.</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. Come, Mr. Know-All, look upon the prisoner +at the bar; do you know him?</p> +<p><i>Know</i>. Yes, my lord, I know him.</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. What is his name?</p> +<p><i>Know</i>. His name is Lustings; he was the son of one +Beastly, and his mother bare him in Flesh Street: she was one +Evil-Concupiscence’s daughter. I knew all the +generation of them.</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. Well said. You have heard his +indictment; what say you to it? Is he guilty of the things +charged against him, or not?</p> +<p><i>Know</i>. My lord, he has, as he saith, been a great +man indeed, and greater in wickedness than by pedigree more than +a thousandfold.</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. But what do you know of his particular +actions, and especially with reference to his indictment?</p> +<p><i>Know</i>. I know him to be a swearer, a liar, a +Sabbath-breaker; I know him to be a fornicator and an unclean +person; I know him to be guilty of abundance of evils. He +has been, to my knowledge, a very filthy man.</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. But where did he use to commit his +wickedness? in some private corners, or more open and +shamelessly?</p> +<p><i>Know</i>. All the town over, my lord.</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. Come, Mr. Tell-True, what have you to say +for our Lord the King against the prisoner at the bar?</p> +<p><i>Tell</i>. My lord, all that the first witness has +said I know to be true, and a great deal more besides.</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. Mr. Lustings, do you hear what these +gentlemen say?</p> +<p><i>Lust</i>. I was ever of opinion that the happiest +life that a man could live on earth was to keep himself back from +nothing that he desired in the world; nor have I been false at +any time to this opinion of mine, but have lived in the love of +my notions all my days. Nor was I ever so churlish, having +found such sweetness in them myself, as to keep the commendations +of them from others.</p> +<p>Then said the Court, ‘There hath proceeded enough from +his own mouth to lay him open to condemnation; wherefore, set him +by, gaoler, and set Mr. Incredulity to the bar.’</p> +<p>Incredulity set to the bar.</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. Mr. Incredulity, thou art here indicted by +the name of Incredulity, (an intruder upon the town of Mansoul,) +for that thou hast feloniously and wickedly, and that when thou +wert an officer in the town of Mansoul, made head against the +captains of the great King Shaddai when they came and demanded +possession of Mansoul; yea, thou didst bid defiance to the name, +forces, and cause of the King, and didst also, as did Diabolus +thy captain, stir up and encourage the town of Mansoul to make +head against and resist the said force of the King. What +sayest thou to this indictment? Art thou guilty of it, or +not?</p> +<p>Then said Incredulity, ‘I know not Shaddai; I love my +old prince; I thought it my duty to be true to my trust, and to +do what I could to possess the minds of the men of Mansoul to do +their utmost to resist strangers and foreigners, and with might +to fight against them. Nor have I, nor shall I, change mine +opinion for fear of trouble, though you at present are possessed +of place and power.’</p> +<p>Then said the Court, ‘The man, as you see, is +incorrigible; he is for maintaining his villainies by stoutness +of words, and his rebellion with impudent confidence; and +therefore set him by, gaoler, and set Mr. Forget-Good to the +bar.</p> +<p>Forget-Good set to the bar.</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. Mr. Forget-Good, thou art here indicted by +the name of Forget-Good, (an intruder upon the town of Mansoul,) +for that thou, when the whole affairs of the town of Mansoul were +in thy hand, didst utterly forget to serve them in what was good, +and didst fall in with the tyrant Diabolus against Shaddai the +King, against his captains, and all his host, to the dishonour of +Shaddai, the breach of his law, and the endangering of the +destruction of the famous town of Mansoul. What sayest thou +to this indictment? Art thou guilty or not guilty?</p> +<p>Then said Forget-Good: ‘Gentlemen, and at this time my +judges, as to the indictment by which I stand of several crimes +accused before you, pray attribute my forgetfulness to mine age, +and not to my wilfulness; to the craziness of my brain, and not +to the carelessness of my mind; and then I hope I may be by your +charity excused from great punishment, though I be +guilty.’</p> +<p>Then said the Court, ‘Forget-Good, Forget-Good, thy +forgetfulness of good was not simply of frailty, but of purpose, +and for that thou didst loathe to keep virtuous things in thy +mind. What was bad thou couldst retain, but what was good +thou couldst not abide to think of; thy age, therefore, and thy +pretended craziness, thou makest use of to blind the court +withal, and as a cloak to cover thy knavery. But let us +hear what the witnesses have to say for the King against the +prisoner at the bar. Is he guilty of this indictment, or +not?’</p> +<p><i>Hate</i>. My lord, I have heard this Forget-Good say, +that he could never abide to think of goodness, no, not for a +quarter of an hour.</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. Where did you hear him say so?</p> +<p><i>Hate</i>. In All-base Lane, at a house next door to +the sign of the Conscience seared with a hot iron.</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. Mr. Know-All, what can you say for our +Lord the King against the prisoner at the bar?</p> +<p><i>Know</i>. My lord, I know this man well. He is +a Diabolonian, the son of a Diabolonian: his father’s name +was Love-Naught; and for him, I have often heard him say, that he +counted the very thoughts of goodness the most burdensome thing +in the world.</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. Where have you heard him say these +words?</p> +<p><i>Know</i>. In Flesh Lane, right opposite to the +church.</p> +<p>Then said the Clerk, ‘Come, Mr. Tell-True, give in your +evidence concerning the prisoner at the bar, about that for which +he stands here, as you see, indicted by this honourable +Court.’</p> +<p><i>Tell</i>. My lord, I have heard him often say he had +rather think of the vilest thing than of what is contained in the +Holy Scriptures.</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. Where did you hear him say such grievous +words?</p> +<p><i>Tell</i>. Where?—in a great many places, +particularly in Nauseous Street, in the house of one Shameless, +and in Filth Lane, at the sign of the Reprobate, next door to the +Descent into the Pit.</p> +<p><i>Court</i>. Gentlemen, you have heard the indictment, +his plea, and the testimony of the witnesses. Gaoler, set +Mr. Hard-Heart to the bar.</p> +<p>He is set to the bar.</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. Mr. Hard-Heart, thou art here indicted by +the name of Hard-Heart, (an intruder upon the town of Mansoul,) +for that thou didst most desperately and wickedly possess the +town of Mansoul with impenitency and obdurateness; and didst keep +them from remorse and sorrow for their evils, all the time of +their apostacy from and rebellion against the blessed King +Shaddai. What sayest thou to this indictment? Art +thou guilty, or not guilty?</p> +<p><i>Hard</i>. My lord, I never knew what remorse or +sorrow meant in all my life. I am impenetrable. I +care for no man; nor can I be pierced with men’s griefs; +their groans will not enter into my heart. Whomsoever I +mischief, whomsoever I wrong, to me it is music, when to others +mourning.</p> +<p><i>Court</i>. You see the man is a right Diabolonian, +and has convicted himself. Set him by, gaoler, and set Mr. +False-Peace to the bar.</p> +<p>False-Peace set to the bar.</p> +<p>‘Mr. False-Peace, thou art here indicted by the name of +False-Peace, (an intruder upon the town of Mansoul,) for that +thou didst most wickedly and satanically bring, hold, and keep +the town of Mansoul, both in her apostacy and in her hellish +rebellion, in a false, groundless, and dangerous peace, and +damnable security, to the dishonour of the King, the +transgression of his law, and the great damage of the town of +Mansoul. What sayest thou? Art thou guilty of this +indictment, or not?</p> +<p>Then said Mr. False-Peace: ‘Gentlemen, and you now +appointed to be my judges, I acknowledge that my name is Mr. +Peace; but that my name is False-Peace I utterly deny. If +your honours shall please to send for any that do intimately know +me, or for the midwife that laid my mother of me, or for the +gossips that were at my christening, they will, any or all of +them, prove that my name is not False-Peace, but Peace. +Wherefore I cannot plead to this indictment, forasmuch as my name +is not inserted therein; and as is my true name, so are also my +conditions. I was always a man that loved to live at quiet, +and what I loved myself, that I thought others might love +also. Wherefore, when I saw any of my neighbours to labour +under a disquieted mind, I endeavoured to help them what I could; +and instances of this good temper of mine many I could give; +as,</p> +<p>‘1. When, at the beginning, our town of Mansoul did +decline the ways of Shaddai, they, some of them, afterwards began +to have disquieting reflections upon themselves for what they had +done; but I, as one troubled to see them disquieted, presently +sought out means to get them quiet again.</p> +<p>‘2. When the ways of the old world, and of Sodom, were +in fashion, if anything happened to molest those that were for +the customs of the present times, I laboured to make them quiet +again, and to cause them to act without molestation.</p> +<p>‘3. To come nearer home: when the wars fell out between +Shaddai and Diabolus, if at any time I saw any of the town of +Mansoul afraid of destruction, I often used, by some way, device, +invention, or other, to labour to bring them to peace +again. Wherefore, since I have been always a man of so +virtuous a temper as some say a peace-maker is, and if a +peace-maker be so deserving a man as some have been bold to +attest he is, then let me, gentlemen, be accounted by you, who +have a great name for justice and equity in Mansoul, for a man +that deserveth not this inhuman way of treatment, but liberty, +and also a license to seek damage of those that have been my +accusers.’</p> +<p>Then said the clerk, ‘Crier, make a +proclamation.’</p> +<p><i>Crier</i>. Oyes! Forasmuch as the prisoner at +the bar hath denied his name to be that which is mentioned in the +indictment, the Court requireth that if there be any in this +place that can give information to the Court of the original and +right name of the prisoner, they would come forth and give in +their evidence; for the prisoner stands upon his own +innocency.</p> +<p>Then came two into the court, and desired that they might have +leave to speak what they knew concerning the prisoner at the bar: +the name of the one was Search-Truth, and the name of the other +Vouch-Truth. So the Court demanded of these men if they +knew the prisoner, and what they could say concerning him, +‘for he stands,’ said they, ‘upon his own +vindication.’</p> +<p>Then said Mr. Search-Truth, ‘My Lord, +I—’</p> +<p><i>Court</i>. Hold! give him his oath.</p> +<p>Then they sware him. So he proceeded.</p> +<p><i>Search</i>. My lord, I know and have known this man +from a child, and can attest that his name is False-Peace. +I know his father; his name was Mr. Flatter: and his mother, +before she was married, was called by the name of Mrs. Sooth-Up: +and these two, when they came together, lived not long without +this son; and when he was born, they called his name +False-Peace. I was his play-fellow, only I was somewhat +older than he; and when his mother did use to call him home from +his play, she used to say, ‘False-Peace, False-Peace, come +home quick, or I’ll fetch you.’ Yea, I knew him +when he sucked; and though I was then but little, yet I can +remember that when his mother did use to sit at the door with +him, or did play with him in her arms, she would call him, twenty +times together, ‘My little False-Peace! my pretty +False-Peace!’ and, ‘Oh! my sweet rogue, +False-Peace!’ and again, ‘Oh! my little bird, +False-Peace!’ and ‘How do I love my +child!’ The gossips also know it is thus, though he +has had the face to deny it in open court.</p> +<p>Then Mr. Vouch-Truth was called upon to speak what he knew of +him. So they sware him.</p> +<p>Then said Mr. Vouch-Truth, ‘My lord, all that the former +witness hath said is true. His name is False-Peace, the son +of Mr. Flatter, and of Mrs. Sooth-Up, his mother: and I have in +former times seen him angry with those that have called him +anything else but False-Peace, for he would say that all such did +mock and nickname him; but this was in the time when Mr. +False-Peace was a great man, and when the Diabolonians were the +brave men in Mansoul.</p> +<p><i>Court</i>. Gentlemen, you have heard what these two +men have sworn against the prisoner at the bar. And now, +Mr. False-Peace, to you: you have denied your name to be +False-Peace, yet you see that these honest men have sworn that +that is your name. As to your plea, in that you are quite +besides the matter of your indictment, you are not by it charged +for evil-doing because you are a man of peace, or a peace-maker +among your neighbours; but for that you did wickedly and +satanically bring, keep, and hold the town of Mansoul, both under +its apostasy from, and in its rebellion against its King, in a +false, lying, and damnable peace, contrary to the law of Shaddai, +and to the hazard of the destruction of the then miserable town +of Mansoul. All that you have pleaded for yourself is, that +you have denied your name, etc.; but here, you see, we have +witnesses to prove that you are the man. For the peace that +you so much boast of making among your neighbours, know that +peace that is not a companion of truth and holiness, but that +which is without this foundation, is grounded upon a lie, and is +both deceitful and damnable, as also the great Shaddai hath +said. Thy plea, therefore, has not delivered thee from what +by the indictment thou art charged with, but rather it doth +fasten all upon thee. But thou shalt have very fair +play. Let us call the witnesses that are to testify as to +matter of fact, and see what they have to say for our Lord the +King against the prisoner at the bar.</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. Mr. Know-All, what say you for our Lord +the King against the prisoner at the bar?</p> +<p><i>Know</i>. My lord, this man hath of a long time made +it, to my knowledge, his business to keep the town of Mansoul in +a sinful quietness in the midst of all her lewdness, filthiness, +and turmoils, and hath said, and that in my hearing, Come, come, +let us fly from all trouble, on what ground soever it comes, and +let us be for a quiet and peaceable life, though it wanteth a +good foundation.</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. Come, Mr. Hate-Lies, what have you to +say?</p> +<p><i>Hate</i>. My lord, I have heard him say, that peace, +though in a way of unrighteousness, is better than trouble with +truth.</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. Where did you hear him say this?</p> +<p><i>Hate</i>. I heard him say it in Folly-yard, at the +house of one Mr. Simple, next door to the sign of the +Self-deceiver. Yea, he hath said this to my knowledge +twenty times in that place.</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. We may spare further witness; this +evidence is plain and full. Set him by, gaoler, and set Mr. +No-Truth to the bar. Mr. No-Truth, thou art here indicted +by the name of No-Truth, (an intruder upon the town of Mansoul,) +for that thou hast always, to the dishonour of Shaddai, and the +endangering of the utter ruin of the famous town of Mansoul, set +thyself to deface, and utterly to spoil, all the remainders of +the law and image of Shaddai that have been found in Mansoul +after her deep apostasy from her king to Diabolus, the envious +tyrant. What sayest thou, art thou guilty of this +indictment, or not?</p> +<p><i>No</i>. Not guilty, my lord.</p> +<p>Then the witnesses were called, and Mr. Know-All did first +give in his evidence against him.</p> +<p><i>Know</i>. My lord, this man was at the pulling down +of the image of Shaddai; yea, this is he that did it with his own +hands. I myself stood by and saw him do it, and he did it +at the commandment of Diabolus. Yea, this Mr. No-Truth did +more than this, he did also set up the horned image of the beast +Diabolus in the same place. This also is he that, at the +bidding of Diabolus, did rend and tear, and cause to be consumed, +all that he could of the remainders of the law of the King, even +whatever he could lay his hands on in Mansoul.</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. Who saw him do this besides yourself?</p> +<p><i>Hate</i>. I did, my lord, and so did many more +besides; for this was not done by stealth, or in a corner, but in +the open view of all; yea, he chose himself to do it publicly, +for he delighted in the doing of it.</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. Mr. No-Truth, how could you have the face +to plead not guilty, when you were so manifestly the doer of all +this wickedness?</p> +<p><i>No</i>. Sir, I thought I must say something, and as +my name is, so I speak. I have been advantaged thereby +before now, and did not know but by speaking no truth, I might +have reaped the same benefit now.</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. Set him by, gaoler, and set Mr. Pitiless +to the bar. Mr. Pitiless, thou art here indicted by the +name of Pitiless, (an intruder upon the town of Mansoul,) for +that thou didst most traitorously and wickedly shut up all bowels +of compassion, and wouldest not suffer poor Mansoul to condole +her own misery when she had apostatised from her rightful King, +but didst evade, and at all times turn her mind awry from those +thoughts that had in them a tendency to lead her to +repentance. What sayest thou to this indictment? +Guilty or not guilty?</p> +<p>‘Not guilty of pitilessness: all I did was to cheer up, +according to my name, for my name is not Pitiless, but Cheer-up; +and I could not abide to see Mansoul inclined to +melancholy.’</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. How! do you deny your name, and say it is +not Pitiless, but Cheer-up? Call for the witnesses. What +say you, the witnesses, to this plea?</p> +<p><i>Know</i>. My lord, his name is Pitiless; so he hath +written himself in all papers of concern wherein he has had to +do. But these Diabolonians love to counterfeit their names: +Mr. Covetousness covers himself with the name of Good-Husbandry, +or the like; Mr. Pride can, when need is, call himself Mr. Neat, +Mr. Handsome, or the like; and so of all the rest of them.</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. Mr. Tell-True, what say you?</p> +<p><i>Tell</i>. His name is Pitiless, my lord. I have +known him from a child, and he hath done all that wickedness +whereof he stands charged in the indictment; but there is a +company of them that are not acquainted with the danger of +damning, therefore they call all those melancholy that have +serious thoughts how that state should be shunned by them.</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. Set Mr. Haughty to the bar, gaoler. +Mr. Haughty, thou art here indicted by the name of Haughty, (an +intruder upon the town of Mansoul,) for that thou didst most +traitorously and devilishly teach the town of Mansoul to carry it +loftily and stoutly against the summons that was given them by +the captains of the King Shaddai. Thou didst also teach the +town of Mansoul to speak contemptuously and vilifyingly of their +great King Shaddai; and didst moreover encourage, both by words +and examples, Mansoul, to take up arms both against the King and +his son Emmanuel. How sayest thou, art thou guilty of this +indictment, or not?</p> +<p><i>Haughty</i>. Gentlemen, I have always been a man of +courage and valour, and have not used, when under the greatest +clouds, to sneak or hang down the head like a bulrush; nor did it +at all at any time please me to see men veil their bonnets to +those that have opposed them; yea, though their adversaries +seemed to have ten times the advantage of them. I did not +use to consider who was my foe, nor what the cause was in which I +was engaged. It was enough to me if I carried it bravely, +fought like a man, and came off a victor.</p> +<p><i>Court</i>. Mr. Haughty, you are not here indicted for +that you have been a valiant man, nor for your courage and +stoutness in times of distress, but for that you have made use of +this your pretended valour to draw the town of Mansoul into acts +of rebellion both against the great King, and Emmanuel his +Son. This is the crime and the thing wherewith thou art +charged in and by the indictment.</p> +<p>But he made no answer to that.</p> +<p>Now when the Court had thus far proceeded against the +prisoners at the bar, then they put them over to the verdict of +their jury, to whom they did apply themselves after this +manner:</p> +<p>‘Gentlemen of the jury, you have been here, and have +seen these men; you have heard their indictments, their pleas, +and what the witnesses have testified against them: now what +remains, is, that you do forthwith withdraw yourselves to some +place, where without confusion you may consider of what verdict, +in a way of truth and righteousness, you ought to bring in for +the King against them, and so bring it in accordingly.’</p> +<p>Then the jury, to wit, Mr. Belief, Mr. True-Heart, Mr. +Upright, Mr. Hate-bad, Mr. Love-God, Mr. See-Truth, Mr. +Heavenly-Mind, Mr. Moderate, Mr. Thankful, Mr. Humble, Mr. +Good-Work, and Mr. Zeal-for-God, withdrew themselves in order to +their work. Now when they were shut up by themselves, they +fell to discourse among themselves in order to the drawing up of +their verdict.</p> +<p>And thus Mr. Belief (for he was the foreman) began: +‘Gentlemen,’ quoth he, ‘for the men, the +prisoners at the bar, for my part I believe that they all deserve +death.’ ‘Very right,’ said Mr. +True-Heart; ‘I am wholly of your opinion.’ +‘Oh what a mercy is it,’ said Mr. Hate-Bad, +‘that such villains as these are apprehended!’ +‘Ay! ay!’ said Mr. Love-God, ‘this is one of +the joyfullest days that ever I saw in my life.’ Then +said Mr. See-Truth, ‘I know that if we judge them to death, +our verdict shall stand before Shaddai himself’ +‘Nor do I at all question it,’ said Mr. +Heavenly-Mind; he said, moreover, ‘When all such beasts as +these are cast out of Mansoul, what a goodly town will it be +then!’ ‘Then,’ said Mr. Moderate, +‘it is not my manner to pass my judgment with rashness; but +for these their crimes are so notorious, and the witness so +palpable, that that man must be wilfully blind who saith the +prisoners ought not to die.’ ‘Blessed be +God,’ said Mr. Thankful, ‘that the traitors are in +safe custody.’ ‘And I join with you in this +upon my bare knees,’ said Mr. Humble. ‘I am +glad also,’ said Mr. Good-Work. Then said the warm +man, and true-hearted Mr. Zeal-for-God, ‘Cut them off; they +have been the plague, and have sought the destruction of +Mansoul.’</p> +<p>Thus, therefore, being all agreed in their verdict, they come +instantly into the Court.</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. Gentlemen of the jury, answer all to your +names: Mr. Belief, one; Mr. True-Heart, two; Mr. Upright, three; +Mr. Hate-Bad, four; Mr. Love-God, five; Mr. See-Truth, six; Mr. +Heavenly-mind, seven; Mr. Moderate, eight; Mr. Thankful, nine; +Mr. Humble, ten; Mr. Good-Work, eleven; and Mr. Zeal-for-God, +twelve. Good men and true, stand together in your verdict: +are you all agreed?</p> +<p><i>Jury</i>. Yes, my lord.</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. Who shall speak for you?</p> +<p><i>Jury</i>. Our foreman.</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. You, the gentlemen of the jury, being +empannelled for our Lord the King, to serve here in a matter of +life and death, have heard the trials of each of these men, the +prisoners at the bar: what say you? are they guilty of that, and +those crimes for which they stand here indicted, or are they not +guilty?</p> +<p><i>Foreman</i>. Guilty, my lord.</p> +<p><i>Clerk</i>. Look to your prisoners, gaoler.</p> +<p>This was done in the morning, and in the afternoon they +received the sentence of death according to the law.</p> +<p>The gaoler, therefore, having received such a charge, put them +all in the inward prison, to preserve them there till the day of +execution, which was to be the next day in the morning.</p> +<p>But now to see how it happened, one of the prisoners, +Incredulity by name, in the interim betwixt the sentence and the +time of execution, brake prison and made his escape, and gets him +away quite out of the town of Mansoul, and lay lurking in such +places and holes as he might, until he should again have +opportunity to do the town of Mansoul a mischief for their thus +handling of him as they did.</p> +<p>Now when Mr. Trueman, the gaoler, perceived that he had lost +his prisoner, he was in a heavy taking, because that prisoner +was, to speak on, the very worst of all the gang: wherefore first +he goes and acquaints my Lord Mayor, Mr. Recorder, and my Lord +Willbewill, with the matter, and to get of them an order to make +search for him throughout the town of Mansoul. So an order +he got, and search was made, but no such man could now be found +in all the town of Mansoul.</p> +<p>All that could be gathered was, that he had lurked a while +about the outside of the town, and that here and there one or +other had a glimpse of him as he did make his escape out of +Mansoul; one or two also did affirm that they saw him without the +town, going apace quite over the plain. Now when he was +quite gone, it was affirmed by one Mr. Did-see, that he ranged +all over dry places, till he met with Diabolus, his friend, and +where should they meet one another but just upon Hell-gate +hill.</p> +<p>But oh! what a lamentable story did the old gentleman tell to +Diabolus concerning what sad alteration Emmanuel had made in +Mansoul!</p> +<p>As, first, how Mansoul had, after some delays, received a +general pardon at the hands of Emmanuel, and that they had +invited him into the town, and that they had given him the castle +for his possession. He said, moreover, that they had called +his soldiers into the town, coveted who should quarter the most +of them; they also entertained him with the timbrel, song, and +dance. ‘But that,’ said Incredulity, +‘which is the sorest vexation to me is, that he hath pulled +down, O father, thy image, and set up his own; pulled down thy +officers and set up his own. Yea, and Willbewill, that +rebel, who, one would have thought, should never have turned from +us, he is now in as great favour with Emmanuel as ever he was +with thee. But, besides all this, this Willbewill has +received a special commission from his master to search for, to +apprehend, and to put to death all, and all manner of +Diabolonians that he shall find in Mansoul: yea, and this +Willbewill has taken and committed to prison already eight of my +Lord’s most trusty friends in Mansoul. Nay, further, +my Lord, with grief I speak it, they have been all arraigned, +condemned, and, I doubt, before this executed in Mansoul. I +told my Lord of eight, and myself was the ninth, who should +assuredly have drunk of the same cup, but that through craft, I, +as thou seest, have made mine escape from them.’</p> +<p>When Diabolus had heard this lamentable story, he yelled and +snuffed up the wind like a dragon, and made the sky to look dark +with his roaring; he also sware that he would try to be revenged +on Mansoul for this. So they, both he and his old friend +Incredulity, concluded to enter into great consultation, how they +might get the town of Mansoul again.</p> +<p>Now, before this time, the day was come in which the prisoners +in Mansoul were to be executed. So they were brought to the +cross, and that by Mansoul, in most solemn manner; for the Prince +said that this should be done by the hand of the town of Mansoul, +‘that I may see,’ said he, ‘the forwardness of +my now redeemed Mansoul to keep my word, and to do my +commandments; and that I may bless Mansoul in doing this +deed. Proof of sincerity pleases me well; let Mansoul +therefore first lay their hands upon these Diabolonians to +destroy them.’</p> +<p>So the town of Mansoul slew them, according to the word of +their Prince; but when the prisoners were brought to the cross to +die, you can hardly believe what troublesome work Mansoul had of +it to put the Diabolonians to death; for the men, knowing that +they must die, and every of them having implacable enmity in +their hearts to Mansoul, what did they but took courage at the +cross, and there resisted the men of the town of Mansoul? +Wherefore the men of Mansoul were forced to cry out for help to +the captains and men of war. Now the great Shaddai had a +secretary in the town, and he was a great lover of the men of +Mansoul, and he was at the place of execution also; so he, +hearing the men of Mansoul cry out against the strugglings and +unruliness of the prisoners, rose up from his place, and came and +put his hands upon the hands of the men of Mansoul. So they +crucified the Diabolonians that had been a plague, a grief, and +an offence to the town of Mansoul.</p> +<p>Now, when this good work was done, the Prince came down to +see, to visit, and to speak comfortably to the men of Mansoul, +and to strengthen their hands in such work. And he said to +them that, by this act of theirs he had proved them, and found +them to be lovers of his person, observers of his laws, and such +as had also respect to his honour. He said, moreover, (to +show them that they by this should not be losers, nor their town +weakened by the loss of them,) that he would make them another +captain, and that of one of themselves. And that this +captain should be the ruler of a thousand, for the good and +benefit of the now flourishing town of Mansoul.</p> +<p>So he called one to him whose name was Waiting, and bid him, +‘Go quickly up to the castle gate, and inquire there for +one Mr. Experience, that waiteth upon that noble captain, the +Captain Credence, and bid him come hither to me.’ So +the messenger that waited upon the good Prince Emmanuel went and +said as he was commanded. Now the young gentleman was +waiting to see the captain train and muster his men in the castle +yard. Then said Mr. Waiting to him, ‘Sir, the Prince +would that you should come down to his highness +forthwith.’ So he brought him down to Emmanuel, and +he came and made obeisance before him. Now the men of the +town knew Mr. Experience well, for he was born and bred in +Mansoul; they also knew him to be a man of conduct, of valour, +and a person prudent in matters; he was also a comely person, +well-spoken, and very successful in his undertakings.</p> +<p>Wherefore the hearts of the townsmen were transported with joy +when they saw that the Prince himself was so taken with Mr. +Experience, that he would needs make him a captain over a band of +men.</p> +<p>So with one consent they bowed the knee before Emmanuel, and +with a shout said, ‘Let Emmanuel live for +ever!’ Then said the Prince to the young gentleman, +whose name was Mr. Experience, ‘I have thought good to +confer upon thee a place of trust and honour in this my town of +Mansoul.’ Then the young man bowed his head and +worshipped. ‘It is,’ said Emmanuel, ‘that +thou shouldest be a captain, a captain over a thousand men in my +beloved town of Mansoul.’ Then said the captain, +‘Let the King live!’ So the Prince gave out +orders forthwith to the King’s secretary, that he should +draw up for Mr. Experience a commission to make him a captain +over a thousand men. ‘And let it be brought to +me,’ said he, ‘that I may set to my +seal.’ So it was done as it was commanded. The +commission was drawn up, brought to Emmanuel, and he set his seal +thereto. Then, by the hand of Mr. Waiting, he sent it away +to the captain.</p> +<p>Now as soon as the captain had received his commission, he +sounded his trumpet for volunteers, and young men came to him +apace; yea, the greatest and chief men in the town sent their +sons, to be listed under his command. Thus Captain +Experience came under command to Emmanuel, for the good of the +town of Mansoul. He had for his lieutenant one Mr. Skilful, +and for his cornet one Mr. Memory. His under officers I +need not name. His colours were the white colours for the +town of Mansoul; and his scutcheon was the dead lion and dead +bear. So the Prince returned to his royal palace again.</p> +<p>Now when he was returned thither, the elders of the town of +Mansoul, to wit, the Lord Mayor, the Recorder, and the Lord +Willbewill, went to congratulate him, and in special way to thank +him for his love, care, and the tender compassion which he showed +to his ever-obliged town of Mansoul. So after a while, and +some sweet communion between them, the townsmen having solemnly +ended their ceremony, returned to their place again.</p> +<p>Emmanuel also at this time appointed them a day wherein he +would renew their charter, yea, wherein he would renew and +enlarge it, mending several faults therein, that Mansoul’s +yoke might be yet more easy. And this he did without any +desire of theirs, even of his own frankness and noble mind. +So when he had sent for and seen their old one, he laid it by, +and said, ‘Now that which decayeth and waxeth old is ready +to vanish away.’ He said, moreover, ‘The town +of Mansoul shall have another, a better, a new one, more steady +and firm by far.’ An epitome hereof take as +follows:—</p> +<p>‘Emmanuel, Prince of Peace, and a great lover of the +town of Mansoul, I do in the name of my Father, and of mine own +clemency, give, grant, and bequeath to my beloved town of +Mansoul.</p> +<p>‘First. Free, full, and everlasting forgiveness of +all wrongs, injuries, and offences done by them against my +Father, me, their neighbour, or themselves.</p> +<p>‘Second. I do give them the holy law and my +testament, with all that therein is contained, for their +everlasting comfort and consolation.</p> +<p>‘Third. I do also give them a portion of the +self-same grace and goodness that dwells in my Father’s +heart and mine.</p> +<p>‘Fourth. I do give, grant, and bestow upon them +freely, the world and what is therein, for their good; and they +shall have that power over them, as shall stand with the honour +of my Father, my glory, and their comfort: yea, I grant them the +benefits of life and death, and of things present, and things to +come. This privilege no other city, town, or corporation, +shall have, but my Mansoul only.</p> +<p>‘Fifth. I do give and grant them leave, and free +access to me in my palace at all seasons—to my palace above +or below—there to make known their wants to me, and I give +them, moreover, a promise that I will hear and redress all their +grievances.</p> +<p>‘Sixth. I do give, grant to, and invest the town +of Mansoul with full power and authority to seek out, take, +enslave, and destroy all, and all manner of Diabolonians that at +any time, from whencesoever, shall be found straggling in or +about the town of Mansoul.</p> +<p>‘Seventh. I do further grant to my beloved town of +Mansoul, that they shall have authority not to suffer any +foreigner, or stranger, or their seed, to be free in, and of the +blessed town of Mansoul, nor to share in the excellent privileges +thereof. But that all the grants, privileges, and +immunities that I bestow upon the famous town of Mansoul, shall +be for those the old natives, and true inhabitants thereof; to +them, I say, and to their right seed after them.</p> +<p>‘But all Diabolonians, of what sort, birth, country, or +kingdom soever, shall be debarred a share therein.’</p> +<p>So when the town of Mansoul had received at the hand of +Emmanuel their gracious charter, (which in itself is infinitely +more large than by this lean epitome is set before you,) they +carried it to audience, that is, to the market place, and there +Mr. Recorder read it in the presence of all the people. +This being done, it was had back to the castle gates, and there +fairly engraven upon the doors thereof, and laid in letters of +gold, to the end that the town of Mansoul, with all the people +thereof, might have it always in their view, or might go where +they might see what a blessed freedom their Prince had bestowed +upon them, that their joy might be increased in themselves, and +their love renewed to their great and good Emmanuel.</p> +<p>But what joy, what comfort, what consolation, think you, did +now possess the hearts of the men of Mansoul! The bells +rung, the minstrels played, the people danced, the captains +shouted, the colours waved in the wind, and the silver trumpets +sounded; and the Diabolonians now were glad to hide their heads, +for they looked like them that had been long dead.</p> +<p>When this was over, the Prince sent again for the elders of +the town of Mansoul, and communed with them about a ministry that +he intended to establish among them; such a ministry that might +open unto them, and that might instruct them in the things that +did concern their present and future state.</p> +<p>‘For,’ said he, ‘you, of yourselves, unless +you have teachers and guides, will not be able to know, and, if +not to know, to be sure not to do the will of my +Father.’</p> +<p>At this news, when the elders of Mansoul brought it to the +people, the whole town came running together, (for it pleased +them well, as whatever the Prince now did pleased the people,) +and all with one consent implored his Majesty that he would +forthwith establish such a ministry among them as might teach +them both law and judgment, statute and commandment; that they +might be documented in all good and wholesome things. So he +told them that he would grant them their requests, and would +establish two among them; one that was of his Father’s +court, and one that was a native of Mansoul.</p> +<p>‘He that is from the court,’ said he, ‘is a +person of no less quality and dignity than my Father and I; and +he is the Lord Chief Secretary of my Father’s house: for he +is, and always has been, the chief dictator of all my +Father’s laws, a person altogether well skilled in all +mysteries, and knowledge of mysteries, as is my Father, or as +myself is. Indeed he is one with us in nature, and also as +to loving of, and being faithful to, and in the eternal concerns +of the town of Mansoul.</p> +<p>‘And this is he,’ said the Prince, ‘that +must be your chief teacher; for it is he, and he only, that can +teach you clearly in all high and supernatural things. He, +and he only, it is that knows the ways and methods of my Father +at court, nor can any like him show how the heart of my Father is +at all times, in all things, upon all occasions, towards Mansoul; +for as no man knows the things of a man but that spirit of a man +which is in him, so the things of my Father knows no man but this +his high and mighty Secretary. Nor can any, as he, tell +Mansoul how and what they shall do to keep themselves in the love +of my Father. He also it is that can bring lost things to +your remembrance, and that can tell you things to come. +This teacher, therefore, must of necessity have the pre-eminence, +both in your affections and judgment, before your other teacher; +his personal dignity, the excellency of his teaching, also the +great dexterity that he hath to help you to make and draw up +petitions to my Father for your help, and to his pleasing, must +lay obligations upon you to love him, fear him, and to take heed +that you grieve him not.</p> +<p>‘This person can put life and vigour into all he says; +yea, and can also put it into your heart. This person can +make seers of you, and can make you tell what shall be +hereafter. By this person you must frame all your petitions +to my Father and me; and without his advice and counsel first +obtained, let nothing enter into the town or castle of Mansoul, +for that may disgust and grieve this noble person.</p> +<p>‘Take heed, I say, that you do not grieve this minister; +for if you do, he may fight against you; and should he once be +moved by you to set himself against you in battle array, that +will distress you more than if twelve legions should from my +Father’s court be sent to make war upon you.</p> +<p>‘But, as I said, if you shall hearken unto him, and +shall love him; if you shall devote yourselves to his teaching, +and shall seek to have converse, and to maintain communion with +him, you shall find him ten times better than is the whole world +to any; yea, he will shed abroad the love of my Father in your +hearts, and Mansoul will be the wisest, and most blessed of all +people.’</p> +<p>Then did the Prince call unto him the old gentleman, who +before had been the Recorder of Mansoul, Mr. Conscience by name, +and told him, That, forasmuch as he was well skilled in the law +and government of the town of Mansoul, and was also well-spoken, +and could pertinently deliver to them his Master’s will in +all terrene and domestic matters, therefore he would also make +him a minister for, in, and to the goodly town of Mansoul, in all +the laws, statutes, and judgments of the famous town of +Mansoul. ‘And thou must,’ said the Prince, +‘confine thyself to the teaching of moral virtues, to civil +and natural duties; but thou must not attempt to presume to be a +revealer of those high and supernatural mysteries that are kept +close in the bosom of Shaddai, my Father: for those things knows +no man, nor can any reveal them but my Father’s Secretary +only.</p> +<p>‘Thou art a native of the town of Mansoul, but the Lord +Secretary is a native with my Father; wherefore, as thou hast +knowledge of the laws and customs of the corporation, so he of +the things and will of my Father.</p> +<p>‘Wherefore, O Mr. Conscience, although I have made thee +a minister and a preacher to the town of Mansoul, yet as to the +things which the Lord Secretary knoweth, and shall teach to this +people, there thou must be his scholar and a learner, even as the +rest of Mansoul are.</p> +<p>‘Thou must therefore, in all high and supernatural +things, go to him for information and knowledge; for though there +be a spirit in man, this person’s inspiration must give him +understanding. Wherefore, O thou Mr. Recorder, keep low and +be humble, and remember that the Diabolonians that kept not their +first charge, but left their own standing, are now made prisoners +in the pit. Be therefore content with thy station.</p> +<p>‘I have made thee my Father’s vicegerent on earth, +in such things of which I have made mention before: and thou, +take thou power to teach them to Mansoul, yea, and to impose them +with whips and chastisements, if they shall not willingly hearken +to do thy commandments.</p> +<p>‘And, Mr. Recorder, because thou art old, and through +many abuses made feeble; therefore I give thee leave and license +to go when thou wilt to my fountain, my conduit, and there to +drink freely of the blood of my grape, for my conduit doth always +run wine. Thus doing, thou shalt drive from thine heart and +stomach all foul, gross, and hurtful humours. It will also +lighten thine eyes, and will strengthen thy memory for the +reception and keeping of all that the King’s most noble +Secretary teacheth.’</p> +<p>When the Prince had thus put Mr. Recorder (that once so was) +into the place and office of a minister to Mansoul, and the man +had thankfully accepted thereof, then did Emmanuel address +himself in a particular speech to the townsmen themselves.</p> +<p>‘Behold,’ said the Prince to Mansoul, ‘my +love and care towards you; I have added to all that is past, this +mercy, to appoint you preachers; the most noble Secretary to +teach you in all high and sublime mysteries; and this +gentleman,’ pointing to Mr. Conscience, ‘is to teach +you in all things human and domestic, for therein lieth his +work. He is not, by what I have said, debarred of telling +to Mansoul anything that he hath heard and received at the mouth +of the lord high Secretary; only he shall not attempt to presume +to pretend to be a revealer of those high mysteries himself; for +the breaking of them up, and the discovery of them to Mansoul +lieth only in the power, authority, and skill of the lord high +Secretary himself. Talk of them he may, and so may the rest +of the town of Mansoul; yea, and may, as occasion gives them +opportunity, press them upon each other for the benefit of the +whole. These things, therefore, I would have you observe +and do, for it is for your life, and the lengthening of your +days.</p> +<p>‘And one thing more to my beloved Mr. Recorder, and to +all the town of Mansoul: You must not dwell in, nor stay upon, +anything of that which he hath in commission to teach you, as to +your trust and expectation of the next world; (of the next world, +I say, for I purpose to give another to Mansoul, when this with +them is worn out;) but for that you must wholly and solely have +recourse to, and make stay upon his doctrine that is your Teacher +after the first order. Yea, Mr. Recorder himself must not +look for life from that which he himself revealeth; his +dependence for that must be founded in the doctrine of the other +preacher. Let Mr. Recorder also take heed that he receive +not any doctrine, or point of doctrine, that is not communicated +to him by his Superior Teacher, nor yet within the precincts of +his own formal knowledge.’</p> +<p>Now, after the Prince had thus settled things in the famous +town of Mansoul, he proceeded to give to the elders of the +corporation a necessary caution, to wit, how they should carry it +to the high and noble captains that he had, from his +Father’s court, sent or brought with him, to the famous +town of Mansoul.</p> +<p>‘These captains,’ said he, ‘do love the town +of Mansoul, and they are picked men, picked out of abundance, as +men that best suit, and that will most faithfully serve in the +wars of Shaddai against the Diabolonians, for the preservation of +the town of Mansoul. ‘I charge you therefore,’ +said he, ‘O ye inhabitants of the now flourishing town of +Mansoul, that you carry it not ruggedly or untowardly to my +captains, or their men; since, as I said, they are picked and +choice men—men chosen out of many for the good of the town +of Mansoul. I say, I charge you, that you carry it not +untowardly to them: for though they have the hearts and faces of +lions, when at any time they shall be called forth to engage and +fight with the King’s foes, and the enemies of the town of +Mansoul; yet a little discountenance cast upon them from the town +of Mansoul will deject and cast down their faces, will weaken and +take away their courage. Do not, therefore, O my beloved, +carry it unkindly to my valiant captains and courageous men of +war, but love them, nourish them, succour them, and lay them in +your bosoms; and they will not only fight for you, but cause to +fly from you all those the Diabolonians that seek, and will, if +possible, be, your utter destruction.</p> +<p>‘If, therefore, any of them should at any time be sick +or weak, and so not able to perform that office of love, which, +with all their hearts, they are willing to do (and will do also +when well and in health), slight them not, nor despise them, but +rather strengthen them and encourage them, though weak and ready +to die, for they are your fence, and your guard, your wall, your +gates, your locks, and your bars. And although, when they +are weak, they can do but little, but rather need to be helped by +you, than that you should then expect great things from them, +yet, when well, you know what exploits, what feats and warlike +achievements they are able to do, and will perform for you.</p> +<p>‘Besides, if they be weak, the town of Mansoul cannot be +strong; if they be strong, then Mansoul cannot be weak; your +safety, therefore, doth lie in their health, and in your +countenancing them. Remember, also, that if they be sick, +they catch that disease of the town of Mansoul itself.</p> +<p>‘These things I have said unto you because I love your +welfare and your honour: observe, therefore, O my Mansoul, to be +punctual in all things that I have given in charge unto you, and +that not only as a town corporate, and so to your officers and +guard, and guides in chief, but to you as you are a people whose +well-being, as single persons, depends on the observation of the +orders and commandments of their Lord.</p> +<p>‘Next, O my Mansoul, I do warn you of that, of which, +notwithstanding that reformation that at present is wrought among +you, you have need to be warned about: wherefore hearken +diligently unto me. I am now sure, and you will know +hereafter, that there are yet of the Diabolonians remaining in +the town of Mansoul, Diabolonians that are sturdy and implacable, +and that do already while I am with you, and that will yet more +when I am from you, study, plot, contrive, invent, and jointly +attempt to bring you to desolation, and so to a state far worse +than that of the Egyptian bondage; they are the avowed friends of +Diabolus, therefore look about you. They used heretofore to +lodge with their Prince in the Castle, when Incredulity was the +Lord Mayor of this town; but since my coming hither, they lie +more in the outsides and walls, and have made themselves dens, +and caves, and holes, and strongholds therein. Wherefore, O +Mansoul! thy work, as to this, will be so much the more difficult +and hard; that is, to take, mortify, and put them to death +according to the will of my Father. Nor can you utterly rid +yourselves of them, unless you should pull down the walls of your +town, the which I am by no means willing you should. Do you +ask me, What shall we do then? Why, be you diligent, and +quit you like men; observe their holes; find out their haunts; +assault them, and make no peace with them. Wherever they +haunt, lurk, or abide, and what terms of peace soever they offer +you, abhor, and all shall be well betwixt you and me. And +that you may the better know them from those that are the natives +of Mansoul, I will give you this brief schedule of the names of +the chief of them; and they are these that follow:—The Lord +Fornication, the Lord Adultery, the Lord Murder, the Lord Anger, +the Lord Lasciviousness, the Lord Deceit, the Lord Evil-Eye, Mr. +Drunkenness, Mr. Revelling, Mr. Idolatry, Mr. Witch-craft, Mr. +Variance, Mr. Emulation, Mr. Wrath, Mr. Strife, Mr. Sedition, and +Mr. Heresy. These are some of the chief, O Mansoul! of +those that will seek to overthrow thee for ever. These, I +say, are the skulkers in Mansoul; but look thou well into the law +of thy King, and there thou shalt find their physiognomy, and +such other characteristical notes of them, by which they +certainly may be known.</p> +<p>‘These, O my Mansoul, (and I would gladly that you +should certainly know it,) if they be suffered to run and range +about the town as they would, will quickly, like vipers, eat out +your bowels; yea, poison your captains, cut the sinews of your +soldiers, break the bars and bolts of your gates, and turn your +now most flourishing Mansoul into a barren and desolate +wilderness, and ruinous heap. Wherefore, that you may take +courage to yourselves to apprehend these villains wherever you +find them, I give to you, my Lord Mayor, my Lord Willbewill, and +Mr. Recorder, with all the inhabitants of the town of Mansoul, +full power and commission to seek out, to take, and to cause to +be put to death by the cross, all, and all manner of +Diabolonians, when and wherever you shall find them to lurk +within, or to range without the walls of the town of Mansoul.</p> +<p>‘I told you before that I had placed a standing ministry +among you; not that you have but these with you, for my first +four captains who came against the master and lord of the +Diabolonians that was in Mansoul, they can, and if need be, and +if they be required, will not only privately inform, but publicly +preach to the corporation both good and wholesome doctrine, and +such as shall lead you in the way. Yea, they will set up a +weekly, yea, if need be, a daily lecture in thee, O Mansoul! and +will instruct thee in such profitable lessons, that, if heeded, +will do thee good at the end. And take good heed that you +spare not the men that you have a commission to take and +crucify.</p> +<p>‘Now, as I have set before your eyes the vagrants and +runagates by name, so I will tell you, that among yourselves, +some of them shall creep in to beguile you, even such as would +seem, and that in appearance are, very rife and hot for +religion. And they, if you watch not, will do you a +mischief, such an one as at present you cannot think of.</p> +<p>‘These, as I said, will show themselves to you in +another hue than those under description before. Wherefore, +Mansoul, watch and be sober, and suffer not thyself to be +betrayed.’</p> +<p>When the Prince had thus far new modelled the town of Mansoul, +and had instructed them in such matters as were profitable for +them to know, then he appointed another day in which he intended, +when the townsfolk came together, to bestow a further badge of +honour upon the town of Mansoul,—a badge that should +distinguish them from all the people, kindreds, and tongues that +dwell in the kingdom of Universe. Now it was not long +before the day appointed was come, and the Prince and his people +met in the King’s palace, where first Emmanuel made a short +speech unto them, and then did for them as he had said, and unto +them as he had promised.</p> +<p>‘My Mansoul,’ said he, ‘that which I now am +about to do, is to make you known to the world to be mine, and to +distinguish you also in your own eyes, from all false traitors +that may creep in among you.’</p> +<p>Then he commanded that those that waited upon him should go +and bring forth out of his treasury those white and glistening +robes ‘that I,’ said he, ‘have provided and +laid up in store for my Mansoul.’ So the white +garments were fetched out of his treasury, and laid forth to the +eyes of the people. Moreover, it was granted to them that +they should take them and put them on, ‘according,’ +said he, ‘to your size and stature.’ So the +people were put into white, into fine linen, white and clean.</p> +<p>Then said the Prince unto them, ‘This, O Mansoul, is my +livery, and the badge by which mine are known from the servants +of others. Yea, it is that which I grant to all that are +mine, and without which no man is permitted to see my face. +Wear them, therefore, for my sake, who gave them unto you; and +also if you would be known by the world to be mine.’</p> +<p>But now! can you think how Mansoul shone? It was fair as +the sun, clear as the moon, and terrible as an army with +banners.</p> +<p>The Prince added further, and said, ‘No prince, +potentate, or mighty one of Universe, giveth this livery but +myself: behold, therefore, as I said before, you shall be known +by it to be mine.</p> +<p>‘And now,’ said he, ‘I have given you my +livery, let me give you also in commandment concerning them; and +be sure that you take good heed to my words.</p> +<p>‘First. Wear them daily, day by day, lest you +should at sometimes appear to others as if you were none of +mine.</p> +<p>‘Second. Keep them always white; for if they be +soiled, it is dishonour to me.</p> +<p>‘Third. Wherefore gird them up from the ground, +and let them not lag with dust and dirt.</p> +<p>‘Fourth. Take heed that you lose them not, lest +you walk naked, and they see your shame.</p> +<p>‘Fifth. But if you should sully them, if you +should defile them, the which I am greatly unwilling you should, +and the prince Diabolus will be glad if you would, then speed you +to do that which is written in my law, that yet you may stand, +and befall before me, and before my throne. Also, this is +the way to cause that I may not leave you, nor forsake you while +here, but may dwell in this town of Mansoul for ever.’</p> +<p>And now was Mansoul, and the inhabitants of it, as the signet +upon Emmanuel’s right hand. Where was there now a +town, a city, a corporation, that could compare with Mansoul! a +town redeemed from the hand, and from the power of Diabolus! a +town that the King Shaddai loved, and that he sent Emmanuel to +regain from the Prince of the infernal cave; yea, a town that +Emmanuel loved to dwell in, and that he chose for his royal +habitation; a town that he fortified for himself, and made strong +by the force of his army. What shall I say, Mansoul has now +a most excellent Prince, golden captains and men of war, weapons +proved, and garments as white as snow. Nor are these +benefits to be counted little, but great; can the town of Mansoul +esteem them so, and improve them to that end and purpose for +which they are bestowed upon them?</p> +<p>When the Prince had thus completed the modelling of the town, +to show that he had great delight in the work of his hands and +took pleasure in the good that he had wrought for the famous and +flourishing Mansoul, he commanded, and they set his standard upon +the battlements of the castle. And then,</p> +<p>First. He gave them frequent visits; not a day now but +the elders of Mansoul must come to him, or he to them, into his +palace. Now they must walk and talk together of all the +great things that he had done, and yet further promised to do, +for the town of Mansoul. Thus would he often do with the +Lord Mayor, my Lord Willbewill, and the honest subordinate +preacher Mr. Conscience, and Mr. Recorder. But oh, how +graciously, how lovingly, how courteously, and tenderly did this +blessed Prince now carry it towards the town of Mansoul! In +all the streets, gardens, orchards, and other places where he +came, to be sure the poor should have his blessing and +benediction; yea, he would kiss them, and if they were ill he +would lay hands on them, and make them well. The captains, +also, he would daily, yea, sometimes hourly, encourage with his +presence and goodly words. For you must know that a smile +from him upon them would put more vigour, more life, and +stoutness into them, than would anything else under heaven.</p> +<p>The Prince would now also feast them, and be with them +continually: hardly a week would pass but a banquet must be had +betwixt him and them. You may remember that, some pages +before, we make mention of one feast that they had together; but +now to feast them was a thing more common: every day with Mansoul +was a feast-day now. Nor did he, when they returned to +their places, send them empty away, either they must have a ring, +a gold chain, a bracelet, a white stone, or something; so dear +was Mansoul to him now; so lovely was Mansoul in his eyes.</p> +<p>Second. When the elders and townsmen did not come to +him, he would send in much plenty of provision unto them; meat +that came from court, wine and bread that were prepared for his +Father’s table; yea, such delicates would he send unto +them, and therewith would so cover their table, that whoever saw +it confessed that the like could not be seen in any kingdom.</p> +<p>Third. If Mansoul did not frequently visit him as he +desired they should, he would walk out to them, knock at their +doors, and desire entrance, that amity might be maintained +betwixt them and him; if they did hear and open to him, as +commonly they would, if they were at home, then would he renew +his former love, and confirm it too with some new tokens, and +signs of continued favour.</p> +<p>And was it not now amazing to behold, that in that very place +where sometimes Diabolus had his abode, and entertained his +Diabolonians to the almost utter destruction of Mansoul, the +Prince of princes should sit eating and drinking with them, while +all his mighty captains, men of war, trumpeters, with the +singing-men and singing-women of his Father, stood round about to +wait upon them! Now did Mansoul’s cup run over, now +did her conduits run sweet wine, now did she eat the finest of +the wheat, and drink milk and honey out of the rock! Now, +she said, How great is his goodness! for since I found favour in +his eyes, how honourable have I been!</p> +<p>The blessed Prince did also ordain a new officer in the town, +and a goodly person he was; his name was Mr. God’s-Peace: +this man was set over my Lord Willbewill, my Lord Mayor, Mr. +Recorder, the subordinate preacher, Mr. Mind, and over all the +natives of the town of Mansoul. Himself was not a native of +it, but came with the Prince Emmanuel from the court. He +was a great acquaintance of Captain Credence and Captain +Good-Hope; some say they were kin, and I am of that opinion +too. This man, as I said, was made governor of the town in +general, especially over the castle, and Captain Credence was to +help him there. And I made great observation of it, that so +long as all things went in Mansoul as this sweet-natured +gentleman would, the town was in most happy condition. Now +there were no jars, no chiding, no interferings, no unfaithful +doings in all the town of Mansoul; every man in Mansoul kept +close to his own employment. The gentry, the officers, the +soldiers, and all in place observed their order. And as for +the women and children of the town, they followed their business +joyfully; they would work and sing, work and sing, from morning +till night: so that quite through the town of Mansoul now nothing +was to be found but harmony, quietness, joy, and health. +And this lasted all that summer.</p> +<p>But there was a man in the town of Mansoul, and his name was +Mr. Carnal-Security; this man did, after all this mercy bestowed +on this corporation, bring the town of Mansoul into great and +grievous slavery and bondage. A brief account of him and of +his doings take as followeth:—</p> +<p>When Diabolus at first took possession of the town of Mansoul, +he brought thither, with himself, a great number of Diabolonians, +men of his own conditions. Now among these there was one +whose name was Mr. Self-Conceit, and a notable brisk man he was, +as any that in those days did possess the town of Mansoul. +Diabolus, then, perceiving this man to be active and bold, sent +him upon many desperate designs, the which he managed better, and +more to the pleasing of his lord, than most that came with him +from the dens could do. Wherefore, finding him so fit for +his purpose, he preferred him, and made him next to the great +Lord Willbewill, of whom we have written so much before. +Now the Lord Willbewill being in those days very well pleased +with him, and with his achievements, gave him his daughter, the +Lady Fear-Nothing, to wife. Now, of my Lady Fear-nothing, +did this Mr. Self-Conceit beget this gentleman, Mr. +Carnal-Security. Wherefore, there being then in Mansoul +those strange kinds of mixtures, it was hard for them, in some +cases, to find out who were natives, who not, for Mr. +Carnal-Security sprang from my Lord Willbewill by mother’s +side, though he had for his father a Diabolonian by nature.</p> +<p>Well, this Carnal-Security took much after his father and +mother; he was self-conceited, he feared nothing, he was also a +very busy man: nothing of news, nothing of doctrine, nothing of +alteration, or talk of alteration, could at any time be on foot +in Mansoul, but be sure Mr. Carnal-Security would be at the head +or tail of it: but, to be sure, he would decline those that he +deemed the weakest, and stood always with them in his way of +standing, that he supposed was the strongest side.</p> +<p>Now, when Shaddai the mighty, and Emmanuel his Son, made war +upon Mansoul, to take it, this Mr. Carnal-Security was then in +town, and was a great doer among the people, encouraging them in +their rebellion, putting them upon hardening themselves in their +resisting the King’s forces: but when he saw that the town +of Mansoul was taken, and converted to the use of the glorious +Prince Emmanuel; and when he also saw what was become of +Diabolus, and how he was unroosted, and made to quit the castle +in the greatest contempt and scorn; and that the town of Mansoul +was well lined with captains, engines of war, and men, and also +provision; what doth he but slyly wheel about also; and as he had +served Diabolus against the good Prince, so he feigned that he +would serve the Prince against his foes.</p> +<p>And having got some little smattering of Emmanuel’s +things by the end, being bold, he ventures himself into the +company of the townsmen, any attempts also to chat among +them. Now he knew that the power and strength of the town +of Mansoul was great, and that it could not but be pleasing to +the people, if he cried up their might and their glory. +Wherefore he beginneth his tale with the power and strength of +Mansoul, and affirmed that it was impregnable; now magnifying +their captains and their slings, and their rams; then crying up +their fortifications and strongholds; and, lastly, the assurances +that they had from their Prince, that Mansoul should be happy for +ever. But when he saw that some of the men of the town were +tickled and taken with his discourse, he makes it his business, +and walking from street to street, house to house, and man to +man, he at last brought Mansoul to dance after his pipe, and to +grow almost as carnally secure as himself; so from talking they +went to feasting, and from feasting to sporting; and so to some +other matters. Now Emmanuel was yet in the town of Mansoul, +and he wisely observed their doings. My Lord Mayor, my Lord +Willbewill, and Mr. Recorder were also all taken with the words +of this tattling Diabolonian gentleman, forgetting that their +Prince had given them warning before to take heed that they were +not beguiled with any Diabolonian sleight; he had further told +them that the security of the now flourishing town of Mansoul did +not so much lie in her present fortifications and force, as in +her so using of what she had, as might oblige her Emmanuel to +abide within her castle. For the right doctrine of Emmanuel +was, that the town of Mansoul should take heed that they forgot +not his Father’s love and his; also, that they should so +demean themselves as to continue to keep themselves +therein. Now this was not the way to do it, namely, to fall +in love with one of the Diabolonians, and with such an one too as +Mr. Carnal-Security was, and to be led up and down by the nose by +him; they should have heard their Prince, feared their Prince, +loved their Prince, and have stoned this naughty pack to death, +and took care to have walked in the ways of their Prince’s +prescribing: for then should their peace have been as a river, +when their righteousness had been like the waves of the sea.</p> +<p>Now when Emmanuel perceived that through the policy of Mr. +Carnal-Security the hearts of the men of Mansoul were chilled and +abated in their practical love to him,</p> +<p>First. He bemoans them, and, condoles their state with +the Secretary, saying, ‘Oh that my people had hearkened +unto me, and that Mansoul had walked in my ways! I would +have fed them with the finest of the wheat; and with honey out of +the rock would I have sustained them.’ This done, he +said in his heart, ‘I will return to the court, and go to +my place, till Mansoul shall consider and acknowledge their +offence.’ And he did so, and the cause and manner of +his going away from them was, that Mansoul declined him, as is +manifest in these particulars.</p> +<p>‘1. They left off their former way of visiting him, they +came not to his royal palace as afore.</p> +<p>‘2. They did not regard, nor yet take notice, that he +came or came not to visit them.</p> +<p>‘3. The love-feasts that had wont to be between their +Prince and them, though he made them still, and called them to +them, yet they neglected to come to them, or to be delighted with +them.</p> +<p>‘4. They waited not for his counsels, but began to be +headstrong and confident in themselves, concluding that now they +were strong and invincible, and that Mansoul was secure, and +beyond all reach of the foe, and that her state must needs be +unalterable for ever.’</p> +<p>Now, as was said, Emmanuel perceiving that by the craft of Mr. +Carnal-Security, the town of Mansoul was taken off from their +dependence upon him, and upon his Father by him, and set upon +what by them was bestowed upon it; he first, as I said, bemoaned +their state, then he used means to make them understand that the +way that they went on in was dangerous: for he sent my Lord High +Secretary to them, to forbid them such ways; but twice when he +came to them, he found them at dinner in Mr. +Carnal-Security’s parlour; and perceiving also that they +were not willing to reason about matters concerning their good, +he took grief and went his way; the which when he had told to the +Prince Emmanuel, he took offence, and was grieved also, and so +made provision to return to his Father’s court.</p> +<p>Now, the methods of his withdrawing, as I was saying before, +were thus:—</p> +<p>‘1. Even while he was yet with them in Mansoul, he kept +himself close, and more retired than formerly.</p> +<p>‘2. His speech was not now, if he came in their company, +so pleasant and familiar as formerly.</p> +<p>‘3. Nor did he, as in times past, send to Mansoul, from +his table, those dainty bits which he was wont to do.</p> +<p>‘4. Nor when they came to visit him, as now and then +they would, would he be so easily spoken with as they found him +to be in times past. They might now knock once, yea, twice, +but he would seem not at all to regard them; whereas formerly at +the sound of their feet he would up and run, and meet them +halfway, and take them too, and lay them in his bosom.’</p> +<p>But thus Emmanuel carried it now, and by this his carriage he +sought to make them bethink themselves, and return to him. +But, alas! they did not consider, they did not know his ways, +they regarded not, they were not touched with these, nor with the +true remembrance of former favours. Wherefore what does he +but in private manner withdraw himself, first from his palace, +then to the gate of the town, and so away from Mansoul he goes, +till they should acknowledge their offence, and more earnestly +seek his face. Mr. God’s-Peace also laid down his +commission, and would for the present act no longer in the town +of Mansoul.</p> +<p>Thus they walked contrary to him, and he again, by way of +retaliation, walked contrary to them. But, alas! by this +time they were so hardened in their way, and had so drunk in the +doctrine of Mr. Carnal-Security, that the departing of their +Prince touched them not, nor was he remembered by them when gone; +and so, of consequence, his absence not condoled by them.</p> +<p>Now, there was a day wherein this old gentleman, Mr. +Carnal-Security, did again make a feast for the town of Mansoul; +and there was at that time in the town one Mr. Godly-Fear, one +now but little set by, though formerly one of great +request. This man, old Carnal-Security, had a mind, if +possible, to gull, and debauch, and abuse, as he did the rest, +and therefore he now bids him to the feast with his +neighbours. So the day being come, they prepare, and he +goes and appears with the rest of the guests; and being all set +at the table, they did eat and drink, and were merry, even all +but this one man: for Mr. Godly-Fear sat like a stranger, and did +neither eat nor was merry. The which, when Mr. +Carnal-Security perceived, he presently addressed himself in a +speech thus to him:—</p> +<p>‘Mr. Godly-Fear, are you not well? You seem to be +ill of body or mind, or both. I have a cordial of Mr. +Forget-Good’s making, the which, sir, if you will take a +dram of, I hope it may make you bonny and blithe, and so make you +more fit for us, feasting companions.’</p> +<p>Unto whom the good old gentleman discreetly replied, +‘Sir, I thank you for all things courteous and civil; but +for your cordial I have no list thereto. But a word to the +natives of Mansoul: You, the elders and chief of Mansoul, to me +it is strange to see you so jocund and merry, when the town of +Mansoul is in such woeful case.’</p> +<p>Then said Mr. Carnal-Security, ‘You want sleep, good +air, I doubt. If you please, lie down, and take a nap, and +we meanwhile will be merry.’</p> +<p>Then said the good man as follows: ‘Sir, if you were not +destitute of an honest heart, you could not do as you have done +and do.’</p> +<p>Then said Mr. Carnal-Security, ‘Why?’</p> +<p><i>Godly</i>. Nay, pray interrupt me not. It is +true the town of Mansoul was strong, and, with a <i>proviso</i>, +impregnable; but you, the townsmen, have weakened it, and it now +lies obnoxious to its foes. Nor is it a time to flatter, or +be silent; it is you, Mr. Carnal-Security, that have wilily +stripped Mansoul, and driven her glory from her; you have pulled +down her towers, you have broken down her gates, you have spoiled +her locks and bars.</p> +<p>And now, to explain myself: from that time that my lords of +Mansoul, and you, sir, grew so great, from that time the Strength +of Mansoul has been offended, and now he is arisen and is +gone. If any shall question the truth of my words, I will +answer him by this, and suchlike questions. ‘Where is +the Prince Emmanuel? When did a man or woman in Mansoul see +him? When did you hear from him, or taste any of his dainty +bits?’ You are now a feasting with this Diabolonian +monster, but he is not your Prince. I say, therefore, +though enemies from without, had you taken heed, could not have +made a prey of you, yet since you have sinned against your +Prince, your enemies within have been too hard for you.</p> +<p>Then said Mr. Carnal-Security, ‘Fie! fie! Mr. +Godly-Fear, fie!—will you never shake off your +<i>timorousness</i>? Are you afraid of being +sparrow-blasted? Who hath hurt you? Behold, I am on +your side; only you are for doubting, and I am for being +confident. Besides, is this a time to be sad in? A +feast is made for mirth; why, then, do you now, to your shame, +and our trouble, break out into such passionate melancholy +language, when you should eat and drink, and be merry?’</p> +<p>Then said Mr. Godly-Fear again, ‘I may well be sad, for +Emmanuel is gone from Mansoul. I say again, he is gone, and +you, sir, are the man that has driven him away; yea, he is gone +without so much as acquainting the nobles of Mansoul with his +going; and if that is not a sign of his anger, I am not +acquainted with the methods of godliness.</p> +<p>‘And now, my lords and gentlemen, for my speech is still +to you, your gradual declining from him did provoke him gradually +to depart from you, the which he did for some time, if perhaps +you would have been made sensible thereby, and have been renewed +by humbling yourselves; but when he saw that none would regard, +nor lay these fearful beginnings of his anger and judgment to +heart, he went away from this place; and this I saw with mine +eye. Wherefore now, while you boast, your strength is gone; +you are like the man that had lost his locks that before did wave +about his shoulders. You may, with this lord of your feast, +shake yourselves, and conclude to do as at other times; but since +without him you can do nothing, and he is departed from you, turn +your feast into a sigh, and your mirth into +lamentation.’</p> +<p>Then the subordinate preacher, old Mr. Conscience by name, he +that of old was Recorder of Mansoul, being startled at what was +said, began to second it thus:—</p> +<p>‘Indeed, my brethren,’ quoth he, ‘I fear +that Mr. Godly-Fear tells us true: I, for my part, have not seen +my Prince a long season. I cannot remember the day, for my +part; nor can I answer Mr. Godly-Fear’s question. I +doubt, I am afraid that all is nought with Mansoul.’</p> +<p><i>Godly</i>. Nay, I know that you shall not find him in +Mansoul, for he is departed and gone; yea, and gone for the +faults of the elders, and for that they rewarded his grace with +unsufferable unkindness.</p> +<p>Then did the subordinate preacher look as if he would fall +down dead at the table; also all there present, except the man of +the house, began to look pale and wan. But having a little +recovered themselves, and jointly agreeing to believe Mr. +Godly-Fear and his sayings, they began to consult what was best +to be done, (now Mr. Carnal-Security was gone into his +withdrawing-room, for he liked not such dumpish doings,) both to +the man of the house for drawing them into evil, and also to +recover Emmanuel’s love.</p> +<p>And, with that, that saying of their Prince came very hot into +their minds, which he had bidden them do to such as were false +prophets that should arise to delude the town of Mansoul. +So they took Mr. Carnal-Security (concluding that he must be he) +and burned his house upon him with fire; for he also was a +Diabolonian by nature.</p> +<p>So when this was passed and over, they bespeed themselves to +look for Emmanuel their Prince; and they sought him, but they +found him not. Then were they more confirmed in the truth +of Mr. Godly-Fear’s sayings, and began also severely to +reflect upon themselves for their so vile and ungodly doings; for +they concluded now that it was through them that their Prince had +left them.</p> +<p>Then they agreed and went to my Lord Secretary, (him whom +before they refused to hear—him whom they had grieved with +their doings,) to know of him, for he was a seer, and could tell +where Emmanuel was, and how they might direct a petition to +him. But the Lord Secretary would not admit them to a +conference about this matter, nor would admit them to his royal +place of abode, nor come out to them to show them his face or +intelligence.</p> +<p>And now was it a day gloomy and dark, a day of clouds and of +thick darkness with Mansoul. Now they saw that they had +been foolish, and began to perceive what the company and prattle +of Mr. Carnal-Security had done, and what desperate damage his +swaggering words had brought poor Mansoul into. But what +further it was likely to cost them they were ignorant of. +Now Mr. Godly-Fear began again to be in repute with the men of +the town; yea, they were ready to look upon him as a prophet.</p> +<p>Well, when the Sabbath day was come, they went to hear their +subordinate preacher; but oh, how he did thunder and lighten this +day! His text was that in the prophet Jonah: ‘They +that observe lying vanities forsake their own mercy.’ +But there was then such power and authority in that sermon, and +such a dejection seen in the countenances of the people that day, +that the like hath seldom been heard or seen. The people, +when sermon was done, were scarce able to go to their homes, or +to betake themselves to their employs the week after; they were +so sermon-smitten, and also so sermon-sick by being smitten, that +they knew not what to do.</p> +<p>He did not only show to Mansoul their sin, but did tremble +before them, under the sense of his own, still crying out of +himself, as he preached to them, ‘Unhappy man that I am! +that I should do so wicked a thing! That I, a preacher! +whom the Prince did set up to teach to Mansoul his law, should +myself live senseless and sottishly here, and be one of the first +found in transgression! This transgression also fell within +my precincts; I should have cried out against the wickedness; but +I let Mansoul lie wallowing in it, until it had driven Emmanuel +from its borders!’ With these things he also charged +all the lords and gentry of Mansoul, to the almost distracting of +them.</p> +<p>About this time, also, there was a great sickness in the town +of Mansoul, and most of the inhabitants were greatly +afflicted. Yea, the captains also, and men of war, were +brought thereby to a languishing condition, and that for a long +time together; so that in case of an invasion, nothing could to +purpose now have been done, either by the townsmen or field +officers. Oh, how many pale faces, weak hands, feeble +knees, and staggering men were now seen to walk the streets of +Mansoul! Here were groans, there pants, and yonder lay +those that were ready to faint.</p> +<p>The garments, too, which Emmanuel had given them were but in a +sorry case; some were rent, some were torn, and all in a nasty +condition; some also did hang so loosely upon them, that the next +bush they came at was ready to pluck them off.</p> +<p>After some time spent in this sad and desolate condition, the +subordinate preacher called for a day of fasting, and to humble +themselves for being so wicked against the great Shaddai and his +Son. And he desired that Captain Boanerges would +preach. So he consented to do it; and the day being come, +and his text was this, ‘Cut it down, why cumbereth it the +ground?’ And a very smart sermon he made upon the +place. First, he showed what was the occasion of the words, +namely, because the fig-tree was barren; then he showed what was +contained in the sentence, namely, repentance, or utter +desolation. He then showed, also, by whose authority this +sentence was pronounced, and that was by Shaddai himself. +And, lastly, he showed the reasons of the point, and then +concluded his sermon. But he was very pertinent in the +application, insomuch that he made poor Mansoul tremble. +For this sermon, as well as the former, wrought much upon the +hearts of the men of Mansoul; yea, it greatly helped to keep +awake those that were roused by the preaching that went +before. So that now throughout the whole town, there was +little or nothing to be heard or seen but sorrow, and mourning, +and woe.</p> +<p>Now, after sermon, they got together and consulted what was +best to be done. ‘But,’ said the subordinate +preacher, ‘I will do nothing of mine own head, without +advising with my neighbour Mr. Godly-Fear. For if he had +aforehand understood more of the mind of our Prince than we, I do +not know but he also may have it now, even now we are turning +again to virtue.’</p> +<p>So they called and sent for Mr. Godly-Fear, and he forthwith +appeared. Then they desired that he would further show his +opinion about what they had best to do. Then said the old +gentleman as followeth: ‘It is my opinion that this town of +Mansoul should, in this day of her distress, draw up and send an +humble petition to their offended Prince Emmanuel, that he, in +his favour and grace, will turn again unto you, and not keep +anger for ever.’</p> +<p>When the townsmen had heard this speech, they did, with one +consent, agree to his advice; so they did presently draw up their +request, and the next was, But who shall carry it? At last +they did all agree to send it by my Lord Mayor. So he +accepted of the service, and addressed himself to his journey; +and went and came to the court of Shaddai, whither Emmanuel the +Prince of Mansoul was gone. But the gate was shut, and a +strict watch kept thereat; so that the petitioner was forced to +stand without for a great while together. Then he desired +that some would go into the Prince and tell him who stood at the +gate, and what his business was. So one went and told to +Shaddai, and to Emmanuel his Son, that the Lord Mayor of the town +of Mansoul stood without at the gate of the King’s court, +desiring to be admitted into the presence of the Prince, the +King’s Son. He also told what was the Lord +Mayor’s errand, both to the King and his Son +Emmanuel. But the Prince would not come down, nor admit +that the gate should be opened to him, but sent him an answer to +this effect: ‘They have turned their back unto me, and not +their face; but now in the time of their trouble they say to me, +Arise, and save us. But can they not now go to Mr. +Carnal-Security, to whom they went when they turned from me, and +make him their leader, their lord, and their protection now in +their trouble; why now in their trouble do they visit me, since +in their prosperity they went astray?’</p> +<p>The answer made my Lord Mayor look black in the face; it +troubled, it perplexed, it rent him sore. And now he began +again to see what it was to be familiar with Diabolonians, such +as Mr. Carnal-Security was. When he saw that at court, as +yet, there was little help to be expected, either for himself or +friends in Mansoul, he smote upon his breast, and returned +weeping, and all the way bewailing the lamentable state of +Mansoul.</p> +<p>Well, when he was come within sight of the town, the elders +and chief of the people of Mansoul went out at the gate to meet +him, and to salute him, and to know how he sped at court. +But he told them his tale in so doleful a manner, that they all +cried out, and mourned, and wept. Wherefore they threw +ashes and dust upon their heads, and put sackcloth upon their +loins, and went crying out through the town of Mansoul; the +which, when the rest of the townsfolk saw, they all mourned and +wept. This, therefore, was a day of rebuke and trouble, and +of anguish to the town of Mansoul, and also of great +distress.</p> +<p>After some time, when they had somewhat refrained themselves, +they came together to consult again what by them was yet to be +done; and they asked advice, as they did before, of that reverend +Mr. Godly-Fear, who told them that there was no way better than +to do as they had done, nor would he that they should be +discouraged at all with that they had met with at court; yea, +though several of their petitions should be answered with nought +but silence or rebuke: ‘For,’ said he, ‘it is +the way of the wise Shaddai to make men wait and to exercise +patience, and it should be the way of them in want, to be willing +to stay his leisure.</p> +<p>Then they took courage, and sent again and again, and again, +and again; for there was not now one day, nor an hour that went +over Mansoul’s head, wherein a man might not have met upon +the road one or other riding post, sounding the horn from Mansoul +to the court of the King Shaddai; and all with letters +petitionary in behalf of, and for the Prince’s return to +Mansoul. The road, I say, was now full of messengers, going +and returning, and meeting one another; some from the court, and +some from Mansoul; and this was the work of the miserable town of +Mansoul, all that long, that sharp, that cold and tedious +winter.</p> +<p>Now if you have not forgot, you may yet remember that I told +you before, that after Emmanuel had taken Mansoul, yea, and after +that he had new modelled the town, there remained in several +lurking places of the corporation many of the old Diabolonians, +that either came with the tyrant when he invaded and took the +town, or that had there, by reason of unlawful mixtures, their +birth and breeding, and bringing up. And their holes, dens, +and lurking places were in, under, or about the wall of the +town. Some of their names are the Lord Fornication, the +Lord Adultery, the Lord Murder, the Lord Anger, the Lord +Lasciviousness, the Lord Deceit, the Lord Evil-eye, the Lord +Blasphemy, and that horrible villain, the old and dangerous Lord +Covetousness. These, as I told you, with many more, had yet +their abode in the town of Mansoul, and that after that Emmanuel +had driven their prince Diabolus out of the castle.</p> +<p>Against these the good Prince did grant a commission to the +Lord Willbewill and others, yea, to the whole town of Mansoul, to +seek, take, secure, and destroy any or all that they could lay +hands of, for that they were Diabolonians by nature, enemies to +the Prince, and those that sought to ruin the blessed town of +Mansoul. But the town of Mansoul did not pursue this +warrant, but neglected to look after, to apprehend, to secure, +and to destroy these Diabolonians. Wherefore what do these +villains but by degrees take courage to put forth their heads, +and to show themselves to the inhabitants of the town. Yea, +and as I was told, some of the men of Mansoul grew too familiar +with some of them, to the sorrow of the corporation, as you yet +will hear more of in time and place.</p> +<p>Well, when the Diabolonian lords that were left perceived that +Mansoul had, through sinning, offended Emmanuel their Prince, and +that he had withdrawn himself and was gone, what do they but plot +the ruin of the town of Mansoul. So upon a time they met +together at the hold of one Mr. Mischief, who was also a +Diabolonian, and there consulted how they might deliver up +Mansoul into the hands of Diabolus again. Now some advised +one way, and some another, every man according to his own +liking. At last my Lord Lasciviousness propounded, whether +it might not be best, in the first place, for some of those that +were Diabolonians in Mansoul, to adventure to offer themselves +for servants to some of the natives of the town; +‘for,’ said he, ‘if they so do, and Mansoul +shall accept of them, they may for us, and for Diabolus our Lord, +make the taking of the town of Mansoul more easy than otherwise +it will be.’ But then stood up the Lord Murder, and +said, ‘This may not be done at this time; for Mansoul is +now in a kind of a rage, because by our friend, Mr. +Carnal-Security, she hath been once ensnared already, and made to +offend against her Prince; and how shall she reconcile herself +unto her lord again, but by the heads of these men? +Besides, we know that they have in commission to take and slay us +wherever they shall find us; let us, therefore, be wise as foxes: +when we are dead, we can do them no hurt; but while we live, we +may.’ Thus, when they had tossed the matter to and +fro, they jointly agreed that a letter should forthwith be sent +away to Diabolus in their name, by which the state of the town of +Mansoul should be showed him, and how much it is under the frowns +of their Prince. ‘We may also,’ said some, +‘let him know our intentions, and ask of him his advice in +the case.’</p> +<p>So a letter was presently framed, the contents of which were +these:—</p> +<p>‘To our great lord, the Prince Diabolus, dwelling below +in the infernal cave:</p> +<p>‘O great father, and mighty Prince Diabolus, we, the +true Diabolonians yet remaining in the rebellious town of +Mansoul, having received our beings from thee, and our +nourishment at thy hands, cannot with content and quiet endure to +behold, as we do this day, how thou art dispraised, disgraced, +and reproached among the inhabitants of this town; nor is thy +long absence at all delightful to us, because greatly to our +detriment.</p> +<p>‘The reason of this our writing unto our lord, is for +that we are not altogether without hope that this town may become +thy habitation again; for it is greatly declined from its Prince +Emmanuel; and he is uprisen, and is departed from them: yea, and +though they send, and send, and send, and send after him to +return to them, yet can they not prevail, nor get good words from +him.</p> +<p>‘There has been also of late, and is yet remaining, a +very great sickness and fainting among them; and that not only +upon the poorer sort of the town, but upon the lords, captains, +and chief gentry of the place, (we only who are of the +Diabolonians by nature remain well, lively, and strong,) so that +through their great transgression on the one hand, and their +dangerous sickness on the other, we judge they lie open to thy +hand and power. If, therefore, it shall stand with thy +horrible cunning, and with the cunning of the rest of the princes +with thee, to come and make an attempt to take Mansoul again, +send us word, and we shall to our utmost power be ready to +deliver it into thy hand. Or if what we have said shall not +by thy fatherhood be thought best and most meet to be done, send +us thy mind in a few words, and we are all ready to follow thy +counsel to the hazarding of our lives, and what else we have.</p> +<p>‘Given under our hands the day and date above-written, +after a close consultation at the house of Mr. Mischief, who yet +is alive and hath his place in our desirable town of +Mansoul.’</p> +<p>When Mr. Profane (for he was the carrier) was come with his +letter to Hell-Gate Hill, he knocked at the brazen gates for +entrance. Then did Cerberus, the porter, for he is the +keeper of that gate, open to Mr. Profane, to whom he delivered +his letter, which he had brought from the Diabolonians in +Mansoul. So he carried it in, and presented it to Diabolus +his lord, and said, ‘Tidings, my lord, from Mansoul, from +our trusty friends in Mansoul.’</p> +<p>Then came together from all places of the den Beelzebub, +Lucifer, Apollyon, with the rest of the rabblement there, to hear +what news from Mansoul. So the letter was broken up and +read, and Cerberus he stood by. When the letter was openly +read, and the contents thereof spread into all the corners of the +den, command was given that, without let or stop, +dead-man’s bell should be rung for joy. So the bell +was rung, and the princes rejoiced that Mansoul was likely to +come to ruin. Now, the clapper of the bell went, ‘The +town of Mansoul is coming to dwell with us: make room for the +town of Mansoul.’ This bell therefore they did ring, +because they did hope that they should have Mansoul again.</p> +<p>Now, when they had performed this their horrible ceremony, +they got together again to consult what answer to send to their +friends in Mansoul; and some advised one thing, and some another: +but at length, because the business required haste, they left the +whole business to the prince Diabolus, judging him the most +proper lord of the place. So he drew up a letter as he +thought fit, in answer to what Mr. Profane had brought, and sent +it to the Diabolonians that did dwell in Mansoul, by the same +hand that had brought theirs to him; and these were the contents +thereof:—</p> +<p>‘To our offspring, the high and mighty Diabolonians that +yet dwell in the town of Mansoul, Diabolus, the great prince of +Mansoul, wisheth a prosperous issue and conclusion of those many +brave enterprises, conspiracies, and designs, that you, of your +love and respect to our honour, have in your hearts to attempt to +do against Mansoul. Beloved children and disciples, my Lord +Fornication, Adultery, and the rest, we have here, in our +desolate den, received, to our highest joy and content, your +welcome letter, by the hand of our trusty Mr. Profane; and to +show how acceptable your tidings were, we rang out our bell for +gladness; for we rejoiced as much as we could, when we perceived +that yet we had friends in Mansoul, and such as sought our honour +and revenge in the ruin of the town of Mansoul. We also +rejoiced to hear that they are in a degenerated condition, and +that they have offended their Prince, and that he is gone. +Their sickness also pleaseth us, as does also your health, might, +and strength. Glad also would we be, right horribly +beloved, could we get this town into our clutches again. +Nor will we be sparing of spending our wit, our cunning, our +craft, and hellish inventions to bring to a wished conclusion +this your brave beginning in order thereto.</p> +<p>‘And take this for your comfort, (our birth, and our +offspring,) that shall we again surprise it and take it, we will +attempt to put all your foes to the sword, and will make you the +great lords and captains of the place. Nor need you fear, +if ever we get it again, that we after that shall be cast out any +more; for we will come with more strength, and so lay far more +fast hold than at the first we did. Besides, it is the law +of that Prince that now they own, that if we get them a second +time, they shall be ours for ever.</p> +<p>‘Do you, therefore, our trusty Diabolonians, yet more +pry into, and endeavour to spy out the weakness of the town of +Mansoul. We also would that you yourselves do attempt to +weaken them more and more. Send us word also by what means +you think we had best to attempt the regaining thereof: namely, +whether by persuasion to a vain and loose life; or, whether by +tempting them to doubt and despair; or, whether by blowing up of +the town by the gunpowder of pride, and self-conceit. Do +you also, O ye brave Diabolonians, and true sons of the pit, be +always in a readiness to make a most hideous assault within, when +we shall be ready to storm it without. Now speed you in +your project, and we in our desires, to the utmost power of our +gates, which is the wish of your great Diabolus, Mansoul’s +enemy, and him that trembles when he thinks of judgment to +come. All the blessings of the pit be upon you, and so we +close up our letter.</p> +<p>‘Given at the pit’s mouth, by the joint consent of +all the princes of darkness, to be sent, to the force and power +that we have yet remaining in Mansoul, by the hand of Mr. +Profane, by me, Diabolus.’</p> +<p>This letter, as was said, was sent to Mansoul, to the +Diabolonians that yet remained there, and that yet inhabited the +wall, from the dark dungeon of Diabolus, by the hand of Mr. +Profane, by whom they also in Mansoul sent theirs to the +pit. Now, when this Mr. Profane had made his return, and +was come to Mansoul again, he went and came as he was wont to the +house of Mr. Mischief, for there was the conclave, and the place +where the contrivers were met. Now, when they saw that +their messenger was returned safe and sound, they were greatly +gladded thereat. Then he presented them with his letter +which he had brought from Diabolus for them; the which, when they +had read and considered, did much augment their gladness. +They asked him after the welfare of their friends, as how their +Lord Diabolus, Lucifer, and Beelzebub did, with the rest of those +of the den. To which this Profane made answer, ‘Well, +well, my lords; they are well, even as well as can be in their +place. They also,’ said he, ‘did ring for joy +at the reading of your letter, as you well perceived by this when +you read it.’</p> +<p>Now, as was said, when they had read their letter, and +perceived that it encouraged them in their work, they fell to +their way of contriving again, namely, how they might complete +their Diabolonian design upon Mansoul. And the first thing +that they agreed upon was to keep all things from Mansoul as +close as they could. ‘Let it not be known, let not +Mansoul be acquainted with what we design against +it.’ The next thing was, how, or by what means, they +should try to bring to pass the ruin and overthrow of Mansoul; +and one said after this manner, and another said after +that. Then stood up Mr. Deceit, and said, ‘My right +Diabolonian friends, our lords, and the high ones of the deep +dungeon, do propound unto us these three ways.</p> +<p>‘1. Whether we had best to seek its ruin by making +Mansoul loose and vain.</p> +<p>‘2. Or whether by driving them to doubt and despair.</p> +<p>‘3. Or whether by endeavouring to blow them up by the +gunpowder of pride and self-conceit.</p> +<p>‘Now, I think, if we shall tempt them to pride, that may +do something; and if we tempt them to wantonness, that may +help. But, in my mind, if we could drive them into +desperation, that would knock the nail on the head; for then we +should have them, in the first place, question the truth of the +love of the heart of their Prince towards them, and that will +disgust him much. This, if it works well, will make them +leave off quickly their way of sending petitions to him; then +farewell earnest solicitations for help and supply; for then this +conclusion lies naturally before them, “As good do nothing, +as do to no purpose.”’ So to Mr. Deceit they +unanimously did consent.</p> +<p>Then the next question was, But how shall we do to bring this +our project to pass? and it was answered by the same +gentleman—that this might be the best way to do it: +‘Even let,’ quoth he, ‘so many of our friends +as are willing to venture themselves for the promoting of their +prince’s cause, disguise themselves with apparel, change +their names, and go into the market like far country-men, and +proffer to let themselves for servants to the famous town of +Mansoul, and let them pretend to do for their masters as +beneficially as may be; for by so doing they may, if Mansoul +shall hire them, in little time so corrupt and defile the +corporation, that her now Prince shall be not only further +offended with them, but in conclusion shall spue them out of his +mouth. And when this is done, our prince Diabolus shall +prey upon them with ease: yea, of themselves they shall fall into +the mouth of the eater.’</p> +<p>This project was no sooner propounded, but was as highly +accepted, and forward were all Diabolonians now to engage in so +delicate an enterprise: but it was not thought fit that all +should do thus; wherefore they pitched upon two or three, namely, +the Lord Covetousness, the Lord Lasciviousness, and the Lord +Anger. The Lord Covetousness called himself by the name of +Prudent-Thrifty; the Lord Lasciviousness called himself by the +name of Harmless-Mirth; and the Lord Anger called himself by the +name of Good-Zeal.</p> +<p>So upon a market-day they came into the market-place, three +lusty fellows they were to look on, and they were clothed in +sheep’s russet, which was also now in a manner as white as +were the white robes of the men of Mansoul. Now the men +could speak the language of Mansoul well. So when they were +come into the market-place, and had offered to let themselves to +the townsmen, they were presently taken up; for they asked but +little wages, and promised to do their masters great service.</p> +<p>Mr. Mind hired Prudent-Thrifty, and Mr. Godly-Fear hired +Good-Zeal. True, this fellow Harmless-Mirth did hang a +little in hand, and could not so soon get him a master as the +others did, because the town of Mansoul was now in Lent, but +after a while, because Lent was almost out, the Lord Willbewill +hired Harmless-Mirth to be both his waiting man and his lackey: +and thus they got them masters.</p> +<p>These villains now being got thus far into the houses of the +men of Mansoul, quickly began to do great mischief therein; for, +being filthy, arch, and sly, they quickly corrupted the families +where they were; yea, they tainted their masters much, especially +this Prudent-Thrifty, and him they call Harmless-Mirth. +True, he that went under the visor of Good-Zeal, was not so well +liked of his master; for he quickly found that he was but a +counterfeit rascal; the which when the fellow perceived, with +speed he made his escape from the house, or I doubt not but his +master had hanged him.</p> +<p>Well, when these vagabonds had thus far carried on their +design, and had corrupted the town as much as they could, in the +next place they considered with themselves at what time their +prince Diabolus without, and themselves within the town, should +make an attempt to seize upon Mansoul; and they all agreed upon +this, that a market-day would be best for that work; for +why? Then will the townsfolk be busy in their ways: and +always take this for a rule, when people are most busy in the +world, they least fear a surprise. ‘We also +then,’ said they, ‘shall be able with less suspicion +to gather ourselves together for the work of our friends and +lords; yea, and in such a day, if we shall attempt our work, and +miss it, we may, when they shall give us the rout, the better +hide ourselves in the crowd, and escape.’</p> +<p>These things being thus far agreed upon by them, they wrote +another letter to Diabolus, and sent it by the hand to Mr. +Profane, the contents of which were these:—</p> +<p>‘The lords of Looseness send to the great and high +Diabolus from our dens, caves, holes, and strongholds, in and +about the wall of the town of Mansoul, greeting:</p> +<p>‘Our great lord, and the nourisher of our lives, +Diabolus—how glad we were when we heard of your +fatherhood’s readiness to comply with us, and help forward +our design in our attempts to ruin Mansoul, none can tell but +those who, as we do, set themselves against all appearance of +good, when and wheresoever we find it.</p> +<p>‘Touching the encouragement that your greatness is +pleased to give us to continue to devise, contrive, and study the +utter desolation of Mansoul, that we are not solicitous about: +for we know right well that it cannot but be pleasing and +profitable to us to see our enemies, and them that seek our +lives, die at our feet, or fly before us. We therefore are +still contriving, and that to the best of our cunning, to make +this work most facile and easy to your lordships, and to us.</p> +<p>‘First, we considered of that most hellishly cunning, +compacted, threefold project, that by you was propounded to us in +your last; and have concluded, that though to blow them up with +the gunpowder of pride would do well, and to do it by tempting +them to be loose and vain will help on, yet to contrive to bring +them into the gulf of desperation, we think will do best of +all. Now we, who are at your beck, have thought or two ways +to do this: first we, for our parts, will make them as vile as we +can, and then you with us, at a time appointed, shall be ready to +fall upon them with the utmost force. And of all the +nations that are at your whistle, we think that an army of +doubters may be the most likely to attack and overcome the town +of Mansoul. Thus shall we overcome these enemies, else the +pit shall open her mouth upon them, and desperation shall thrust +them down into it. We have also, to effect this so much by +us desired design, sent already three of our trusty Diabolonians +among them; they are disguised in garb, they have changed their +names, and are now accepted of them; namely, Covetousness, +Lasciviousness, and Anger. The name of Covetousness is +changed to Prudent-Thrifty, and him Mr. Mind has hired, and is +almost become as bad as our friend. Lasciviousness has +changed his name to Harmless-Mirth, and he is got to be the Lord +Willbewill’s lackey; but he has made his master very +wanton. Anger changed his name into Good-Zeal, and was +entertained by Mr. Godly-Fear; but the peevish old gentleman took +pepper in the nose, and turned our companion out of his +house. Nay, he has informed us since that he ran away from +him, or else his old master had hanged him up for his labour.</p> +<p>‘Now these have much helped forward our work and design +upon Mansoul; for notwithstanding the spite and quarrelsome +temper of the old gentleman last mentioned, the other two ply +their business well, and are likely to ripen the work apace.</p> +<p>‘Our next project is, that it be concluded that you come +upon the town upon a market-day, and that when they are upon the +heat of their business; for then, to be sure, they will be most +secure, and least think that an assault will be made upon +them. They will also at such a time be less able to defend +themselves, and to offend you in the prosecution of our +design. And we your trusty (and we are sure your beloved) +ones shall, when you shall make your furious assault without, be +ready to second the business within. So shall we, in all +likelihood, be able to put Mansoul to utter confusion, and to +swallow them up before they can come to themselves. If your +serpentine heads, most subtile dragons, and our highly esteemed +lords can find out a better way than this, let us quickly know +your minds.</p> +<p>‘To the monsters of the infernal cave, from the house of +Mr. Mischief in Mansoul, by the hand of Mr. Profane.’</p> +<p>Now all the while that the raging runagates and hellish +Diabolonians were thus contriving the ruin of the town of +Mansoul, they (namely, the poor town itself) was in a sad and +woeful case; partly because they had so grievously offended +Shaddai and his Son, and partly because that the enemies thereby +got strength within them afresh; and also because, though they +had by many petitions made suit to the Prince Emmanuel, and to +his Father Shaddai by him, for their pardon and favour, yet +hitherto obtained they not one smile; but contrariwise, through +the craft and subtilty of the domestic Diabolonians, their cloud +was made to grow blacker and blacker, and their Emmanuel to stand +at further distance.</p> +<p>The sickness also did still greatly rage in Mansoul, both +among the captains and the inhabitants of the town; and their +enemies only were now lively and strong, and likely to become the +head, whilst Mansoul was made the tail.</p> +<p>By this time the letter last mentioned, that was written by +the Diabolonians that yet lurked in the town of Mansoul, was +conveyed to Diabolus in the black den, by the hand of Mr. +Profane. He carried the letter by Hell-Gate Hill as afore, +and conveyed it by Cerberus to his lord.</p> +<p>But when Cerberus and Mr. Profane did meet, they were +presently as great as beggars, and thus they fell into discourse +about Mansoul, and about the project against her.</p> +<p>‘Ah! old friend,’ quoth Cerberus, ‘art thou +come to Hell-Gate Hill again? By St. Mary, I am glad to see +thee!’</p> +<p><i>Prof.</i> Yes, my lord, I am come again about the +concerns of the town of Mansoul.</p> +<p><i>Cerb.</i> Prithee, tell me what condition is that +town of Mansoul in at present?</p> +<p><i>Prof.</i> In a brave condition, my lord, for us, and +for my lords, the lords of this place, I trow for they are +greatly decayed as to godliness, and that is as well as our heart +can wish; their Lord is greatly out with them, and that doth also +please us well. We have already also a foot in their dish, +for our Diabolonian friends are laid in their bosoms, and what do +we lack but to be masters of the place! Besides, our trusty +friends in Mansoul are daily plotting to betray it to the lords +of this town; also the sickness rages bitterly among them; and +that which makes up all, we hope at last to prevail.’</p> +<p>Then said the dog of Hell-Gate, ‘No time like this to +assault them. I wish that the enterprise be followed close, +and that the success desired may be soon effected: yea, I wish it +for the poor Diabolonians’ sakes, that live in the +continual fear of their lives in that traitorous town of +Mansoul.’</p> +<p><i>Prof.</i> The contrivance is almost finished, the +lords in Mansoul that are Diabolonians are at it day and night, +and the other are like silly doves; they want heart to be +concerned with their state and to consider that ruin is at +hand. Besides you may, yea, must think, when you put all +things together, that there are many reasons that prevail with +Diabolus to make what haste he can.</p> +<p><i>Cerb.</i> Thou hast said as it is; I am glad things +are at this pass. Go in, my brave Profane, to my lords, +they will give thee for thy welcome as good a <i>coranto</i> as +the whole of this kingdom will afford. I have sent thy +letter in already.</p> +<p>Then Mr. Profane went into the den, and his lord Diabolus met +him, and saluted him with, ‘Welcome, my trusty servant: I +have been made glad with thy letter.’ The rest of the +lords of the pit gave him also their salutations. Then +Profane, after obeisance made to them all, said, ‘Let +Mansoul be given to my lord Diabolus, and let him be her king for +ever.’ And with that, the hollow belly and yawning +gorge of hell gave so loud and hideous a groan, (for that is the +music of that place,) that it made the mountains about it totter, +as if they would fall in pieces.</p> +<p>Now, after they had read and considered the letter, they +consulted what answer to return; and the first that did speak to +it was Lucifer.</p> +<p>Then said he, ‘The first project of the Diabolonians in +Mansoul is likely to be lucky, and to take; namely, that they +will, by all the ways and means they can, make Mansoul yet more +vile and filthy: no way to destroy a soul like this. Our +old friend Balaam went this way and prospered many years ago; let +this therefore stand with us for a maxim, and be to Diabolonians +for a general rule in all ages; for nothing can make this to fail +but grace, in which I would hope that this town has no +share. But whether to fall upon them on a market-day, +because of their cumber in business, that I would should be under +debate. And there is more reason why this head should be +debated, than why some other should; because upon this will turn +the whole of what we shall attempt. If we time not our +business well, our whole project may fail. Our friends, the +Diabolonians, say that a market-day is best; for then will +Mansoul be most busy, and have fewest thoughts of a +surprise. But what if also they should double their guards +on those days? (and methinks nature and reason should teach them +to do it;) and what if they should keep such a watch on those +days as the necessity of their present case doth require? yea, +what if their men should be always in arms on those days? then +you may, my lords, be disappointed in your attempts, and may +bring our friends in the town to utter danger of unavoidable +ruin.’</p> +<p>Then said the great Beelzebub, ‘There is something in +what my lord hath said; but his conjecture may, or may not fall +out. Nor hath my lord laid it down as that which must not +be receded from; for I know that he said it only to provoke to a +warm debate thereabout. Therefore we must understand, if we +can, whether the town of Mansoul has such sense and knowledge of +her decayed state, and of the design that we have on foot against +her, as doth provoke her to set watch and ward at her gates, and +to double them on market-days. But if, after inquiry made, +it shall be found that they are asleep, then any day will do, but +a market-day is best; and this is my judgment in this +case.’</p> +<p>Then quoth Diabolus, ‘How should we know this?’ +and it was answered, ‘Inquire about it at the mouth of Mr. +Profane.’ So Profane was called in, and asked the +question, and he made his answer as follows:—</p> +<p><i>Prof.</i> My lords, so far as I can gather, this is +at present the condition of the town of Mansoul: they are decayed +in their faith and love; Emmanuel, their Prince, has given them +the back; they send often by petition to fetch him again, but he +maketh not haste to answer their request, nor is there much +reformation among them.</p> +<p><i>Diab.</i> I am glad that they are backward in a +reformation, but yet I am afraid of their petitioning. +However, their looseness of life is a sign that there is not much +heart in what they do, and without the heart things are little +worth. But go on, my masters; I will divert you, my lords, +no longer.</p> +<p><i>Beel.</i> If the case be so with Mansoul, as Mr. +Profane has described it to be, it will be no great matter what +day we assault it; not their prayers, nor their power will do +them much service.</p> +<p>When Beelzebub had ended his oration, then Apollyon did +begin. ‘My opinion,’ said he, ‘concerning +this matter, is, that we go on fair and softly, not doing things +in a hurry. Let our friends in Mansoul go on still to +pollute and defile it, by seeking to draw it yet more into sin +(for there is nothing like sin to devour Mansoul). If this +be done, and it takes effect, Mansoul, of itself, will leave off +to watch, to petition, or anything else that should tend to her +security and safety; for she will forget her Emmanuel, she will +not desire his company, and can she be gotten thus to live, her +Prince will not come to her in haste. Our trusty friend, +Mr. Carnal-Security, with one of his tricks did drive him out of +the town; and why may not my Lord Covetousness, and my Lord +Lasciviousness, by what they may do, keep him out of the +town? And this I will tell you, (not because you know it +not,) that two or three Diabolonians, if entertained and +countenanced by the town of Mansoul, will do more to the keeping +of Emmanuel from them, and towards making the town of Mansoul +your own, than can an army of a legion that should be sent out +from us to withstand him. Let, therefore, this first +project that our friends in Mansoul have set on foot, be strongly +and diligently carried on, with all cunning and craft imaginable; +and let them send continually, under one guise or another, more +and other of their men to play with the people of Mansoul; and +then, perhaps, we shall not need to be at the charge of making a +war upon them; or if that must of necessity be done, yet the more +sinful they are, the more unable, to be sure, they will be to +resist us, and then the more easily we shall overcome them. +And besides, suppose (and that is the worst that can be supposed) +that Emmanuel should come to them again, why may not the same +means, or the like, drive him from them once more? Yea, why +may he not, by their lapse into that sin again, be driven from +them for ever, for the sake of which he was at the first driven +from them for a season? And if this should happen, then +away go with him his rams, his slings, his captains, his +soldiers, and he leaveth Mansoul naked and bare. Yea, will +not this town, when she sees herself utterly forsaken of her +Prince, of her own accord open her gates again unto you, and make +of you as in the days of old? But this must be done by +time, a few days will not effect so great a work as +this.’</p> +<p>So soon as Apollyon had made an end of speaking, Diabolus +began to blow out his own malice, and to plead his own cause; and +he said, ‘My lords, and powers of the cave, my true and +trusty friends, I have with much impatience, as becomes me, given +ear to your long and tedious orations. But my furious +gorge, and empty paunch, so lusteth after a repossession of my +famous town of Mansoul, that whatever comes out, I can wait no +longer to see the events of lingering projects. I must, and +that without further delay, seek, by all means I can, to fill my +insatiable gulf with the soul and body of the town of +Mansoul. Therefore lend me your heads, your hearts, and +your help, now I am going to recover my town of +Mansoul.’</p> +<p>When the lords and princes of the pit saw the flaming desire +that was in Diabolus to devour the miserable town of Mansoul, +they left off to raise any more objections, but consented to lend +him what strength they could, though had Apollyon’s advice +been taken, they had far more fearfully distressed the town of +Mansoul. But, I say, they were willing to lend him what +strength they could, not knowing what need they might have of +him, when they should engage for themselves, as he. +Wherefore they fell to advising about the next thing propounded, +namely, what soldiers they were, and also how many, with whom +Diabolus should go against the town of Mansoul to take it; and +after some debate, it was concluded, according as in the letter +the Diabolonians had suggested, that none were more fit for that +expedition than an army of terrible doubters. They +therefore concluded to send against Mansoul an army of sturdy +doubters. The number thought fit to be employed in that +service was between twenty and thirty thousand. So then the +result of that great council of those high and mighty lords +was—That Diabolus should even now, out of hand, beat up his +drum for men in the land of Doubting, which land lieth upon the +confines of the place called Hell-Gate Hill, for men that might +be employed by him against the miserable town of Mansoul. +It was also concluded, that these lords themselves should help +him in the war, and that they would to that end head and manage +his men. So they drew up a letter, and sent back to the +Diabolonians that lurked in Mansoul, and that waited for the +back-coming of Mr. Profane, to signify to them into what method +and forwardness they at present had put their design. The +contents whereof now follow:—</p> +<p>‘From the dark and horrible dungeon of hell, Diabolus +with all the society of the princes of darkness, sends to our +trusty ones, in and about the walls of the town of Mansoul, now +impatiently waiting for our most devilish answer to their +venomous and most poisonous design against the town of +Mansoul.</p> +<p>‘Our native ones, in whom from day to day we boast, and +in whose actions all the year long we do greatly delight +ourselves, we received your welcome, because highly esteemed +letter, at the hand of our trusty and greatly beloved, the old +gentleman, Mr. Profane. And do give you to understand, that +when we had broken it up, and had read the contents thereof, to +your amazing memory be it spoken, our yawning hollow-bellied +place, where we are, made so hideous and yelling a noise for joy, +that the mountains that stand round about Hell-Gate Hill, had +like to have been shaken to pieces at the sound thereof.</p> +<p>‘We could also do no less than admire your faithfulness +to us, with the greatness of that subtilty that now hath showed +itself to be in your heads to serve us against the town of +Mansoul. For you have invented for us so excellent a method +for our proceeding against that rebellious people, a more +effectual cannot be thought of by all the wits of hell. The +proposals, therefore, which now, at last, you have sent us, since +we saw them, we have done little else but highly approved and +admired them.</p> +<p>‘Nay, we shall, to encourage you in the profundity of +your craft, let you know, that, at a full assembly and conclave +of our princes and principalities of this place, your project was +discoursed and tossed from one side of our cave to the other by +their mightinesses; but a better, and as was by themselves +judged, a more fit and proper way by all their wits, could not be +invented, to surprise, take, and make our own, the rebellious +town of Mansoul.</p> +<p>‘Wherefore, in fine, all that was said that varied from +what you had in your letter propounded, fell of itself to the +ground, and yours only was stuck to by Diabolus, the prince; yea, +his gaping gorge and yawning paunch was on fire to put your +invention into execution.</p> +<p>‘We therefore give you to understand that our stout, +furious, and unmerciful Diabolus is raising, for your relief, and +the ruin of the rebellious town of Mansoul, more than twenty +thousand doubters to come against that people. They are all +stout and sturdy men, and men that of old have been accustomed to +war, and that can therefore well endure the drum. I say, he +is doing this work of his with all the possible speed he can; for +his heart and spirit is engaged in it. We desire, +therefore, that, as you have hitherto stuck to us, and given us +both advice and encouragement thus far, you still will prosecute +our design; nor shall you lose, but be gainers thereby; yea, we +intend to make you the lords of Mansoul.</p> +<p>‘One thing may not by any means be omitted, that is, +those with us do desire that every one of you that are in Mansoul +would still use all your power, cunning, and skill, with delusive +persuasions, yet to draw the town of Mansoul into more sin and +wickedness, even that sin may be finished and bring forth +death.</p> +<p>‘For thus it is concluded with us, that the more vile, +sinful, and debauched the town of Mansoul is, more backward will +be their Emmanuel to come to their help, either by presence or +other relief; yea, the more sinful, the more weak, and so the +more unable will they be to make resistance when we shall make +our assault upon them to swallow them up. Yea, that may +cause that their mighty Shaddai himself may cast them out of his +protection; yea, and send for his captains and soldiers home, +with his slings and rams, and leave them naked and bare; and then +the town of Mansoul will of itself open to us, and fall as the +fig into the mouth of the eater. Yea, to be sure that we +then with a great deal of ease shall come upon her and overcome +her.</p> +<p>‘As to the time of our coming upon Mansoul, we, as yet, +have not fully resolved upon that, though at present some of us +think as you, that a market-day, or a market-day at night, will +certainly be the best. However, do you be ready, and when +you shall hear our roaring drum without, do you be as busy to +make the most horrible confusion within. So shall Mansoul +certainly be distressed before and behind, and shall not know +which way to betake herself for help. My Lord Lucifer, my +Lord Beelzebub, my Lord Apollyon, my Lord Legion, with the rest, +salute you, as does also my Lord Diabolus; and we wish both you, +with all that you do, or shall possess, the very self-same fruit +and success for their doing as we ourselves at present enjoy for +ours.</p> +<p>‘From our dreadful confines in the most fearful pit, we +salute you, and so do those many legions here with us, wishing +you may be as hellishly prosperous as we desire to be +ourselves. By the letter-carrier, Mr. Profane.’</p> +<p>Then Mr. Profane addressed himself for his return to Mansoul, +with his errand from the horrible pit to the Diabolonians that +dwelt in that town. So he came up the stairs from the deep +to the mouth of the cave where Cerberus was. Now when +Cerberus saw him, he asked how did matters go below, about and +against the town of Mansoul.</p> +<p><i>Prof.</i> Things go as well as we can expect. +The letter that I carried thither was highly approved, and well +liked by all my lords, and I am returning to tell our +Diabolonians so. I have an answer to it here in my bosom, +that I am sure will make our masters that sent me glad; for the +contents thereof are to encourage them to pursue their design to +the utmost, and to be ready also to fall on within, when they +shall see my Lord Diabolus beleaguering the town of Mansoul.</p> +<p><i>Cerb.</i> But does he intend to go against them +himself?</p> +<p><i>Prof.</i> Does he! Ay! and he will take along +with him more than twenty thousand, all sturdy Doubters, and men +of war, picked men from the land of Doubting, to serve him in the +expedition.</p> +<p>Then was Cerberus glad, and said, ‘And is there such +brave preparations a-making to go against the miserable town of +Mansoul? And would I might be put at the head of a thousand +of them, that I might also show my valour against the famous town +of Mansoul.’</p> +<p><i>Prof.</i> Your wish may come to pass; you look like +one that has mettle enough, and my lord will have with him those +that are valiant and stout. But my business requires +haste.</p> +<p><i>Cerb.</i> Ay, so it does. Speed thee to the +town of Mansoul, with all the deepest mischiefs that this place +can afford thee. And when thou shalt come to the house of +Mr. Mischief, the place where the Diabolonians meet to plot, tell +them that Cerberus doth wish them his service, and that if he +may, he will with the army come up against the famous town of +Mansoul.</p> +<p><i>Prof.</i> That I will. And I know that my lords +that are there will be glad to hear it, and to see you also.</p> +<p>So after a few more such kind of compliments, Mr. Profane took +his leave of his friend Cerberus; and Cerberus again, with a +thousand of their pit-wishes, bid him haste, with all speed, to +his masters. The which when he had heard, he made +obeisance, and began to gather up his heels to run.</p> +<p>Thus, therefore, he returned, and went and came to Mansoul; +and going, as afore, to the house of Mr. Mischief, there he found +the Diabolonians assembled, and waiting for his return. Now +when he was come, and had presented himself, he also delivered to +them his letter, and adjoined this compliment to them therewith: +‘My lords, from the confines of the pit, the high and +mighty principalities and powers of the den salute you here, the +true Diabolonians of the town of Mansoul. Wishing you +always the most proper of their benedictions, for the great +service, high attempts, and brave achievements that you have put +yourselves upon, for the restoring to our prince Diabolus the +famous town of Mansoul.’</p> +<p>This was therefore the present state of the miserable town of +Mansoul: she had offended her Prince, and he was gone; she had +encouraged the powers of hell, by her foolishness, to come +against her to seek her utter destruction.</p> +<p>True, the town of Mansoul was somewhat made sensible of her +sin, but the Diabolonians were gotten into her bowels; she cried, +but Emmanuel was gone, and her cries did not fetch him as yet +again. Besides, she knew not now whether, ever or never, he +would return and come to his Mansoul again; nor did they know the +power and industry of the enemy, nor how forward they were to put +in execution that plot of hell that they had devised against +her.</p> +<p>They did, indeed, still send petition after petition to the +Prince, but he answered all with silence. They did neglect +reformation, and that was as Diabolus would have it; for he knew, +if they regarded iniquity in their heart, their King would not +hear their prayer; they therefore did still grow weaker and +weaker, and were as a rolling thing before the whirlwind. +They cried to their King for help, and laid Diabolonians in their +bosoms: what therefore should a King do to them? Yea, there +seemed now to be a mixture in Mansoul; the Diabolonians and the +Mansoulians would walk the streets together. Yea, they +began to seek their peace; for they thought that, since the +sickness had been so mortal in Mansoul, it was in vain to go to +handygripes with them. Besides, the weakness of Mansoul was +the strength of their enemies; and the sins of Mansoul, the +advantage of the Diabolonians. The foes of Mansoul did also +now begin to promise themselves the town for a possession: there +was no great difference now betwixt Mansoulians and Diabolonians: +both seemed to be masters of Mansoul. Yea, the Diabolonians +increased and grew, but the town of Mansoul diminished +greatly. There were more than eleven thousand men, women, +and children that died by the sickness in Mansoul.</p> +<p>But now, as Shaddai would have it, there was one whose name +was Mr. Prywell, a great lover of the people of Mansoul. +And he, as his manner was, did go listening up and down in +Mansoul to see, and to hear, if at any time he might, whether +there was any design against it or no. For he was always a +jealous man, and feared some mischief sometime would befal it, +either from the Diabolonians within, or from some power +without. Now upon a time it so happened, as Mr. Prywell +went listening here and there, that he lighted upon a place +called Vilehill, in Mansoul, where Diabolonians used to meet; so +hearing a muttering, (you must know that it was in the night,) he +softly drew near to hear; nor had he stood long under the +house-end, (for there stood a house there,) but he heard one +confidently affirm, that it was not, or would not be long before +Diabolus should possess himself again of Mansoul; and that then +the Diabolonians did intend to put all Mansoulians to the sword, +and would kill and destroy the King’s captains, and drive +all his soldiers out of the town. He said, moreover, that +he knew there were above twenty thousand fighting men prepared by +Diabolus for the accomplishing of this design, and that it would +not be months before they all should see it.</p> +<p>When Mr. Prywell had heard this story, he did quickly believe +it was true: wherefore he went forthwith to my Lord Mayor’s +house, and acquainted him therewith; who, sending for the +subordinate preacher, brake the business to him; and he as soon +gave the alarm to the town; for he was now the chief preacher in +Mansoul, because, as yet, my Lord Secretary was ill at +ease. And this was the way that the subordinate preacher +did take to alarm the town therewith. The same hour he +caused the lecture bell to be rung; so the people came together: +he gave them then a short exhortation to watchfulness, and made +Mr. Prywell’s news the argument thereof. +‘For,’ said he, ‘an horrible plot is contrived +against Mansoul, even to massacre us all in a day, nor is this +story to be slighted; for Mr. Prywell is the author +thereof. Mr. Prywell was always a lover of Mansoul, a sober +and judicious man, a man that is no tattler, nor raiser of false +reports, but one that loves to look into the very bottom of +matters, and talks nothing of news, but by very solid +arguments.</p> +<p>‘I will call him, and you shall hear him your own +selves;’ so he called him, and he came and told his tale so +punctually, and affirmed its truth with such ample grounds, that +Mansoul fell presently under a conviction of the truth of what he +said. The preacher did also back him, saying, ‘Sirs, +it is not irrational for us to believe it, for we have provoked +Shaddai to anger, and have sinned Emmanuel out of the town; we +have had too much correspondence with Diabolonians, and have +forsaken our former mercies: no marvel then, if the enemy both +within and without should design and plot our ruin; and what time +like this to do it? The sickness is now in the town, and we +have been made weak thereby. Many a good meaning man is +dead, and the Diabolonians of late grow stronger and +stronger.</p> +<p>‘Besides,’ quoth the subordinate preacher, +‘I have received from this good truth-teller this one +inkling further, that he understood by those that he overheard, +that several letters have lately passed between the furies and +the Diabolonians in order to our destruction.’ When +Mansoul heard all this, and not being able to gainsay it, they +lift up their voice and wept. Mr. Prywell did also, in the +presence of the townsmen, confirm all that their subordinate +preacher had said. Wherefore they now set afresh to bewail +their folly, and to a doubling of petitions to Shaddai and his +Son. They also brake the business to the captains, high +commanders, and men of war in the town of Mansoul, entreating +them to use the means to be strong, and to take good courage; and +that they would look after their harness, and make themselves +ready to give Diabolus battle by night and by day, shall he come, +as they are informed he will, to beleaguer the town of +Mansoul.</p> +<p>When the captains heard this, they being always true lovers of +the town of Mansoul, what do they but like so many Samsons they +shake themselves, and come together to consult and contrive how +to defeat those bold and hellish contrivances that were upon the +wheel by the means of Diabolus and his friends against the now +sickly, weakly, and much impoverished town of Mansoul; and they +agreed upon these following particulars:—</p> +<p>1. That the gates of Mansoul should be kept shut, and made +fast with bars and locks, and that all persons that went out, or +came in, should be very strictly examined by the captains of the +guards, ‘to the end,’ said they, ‘that those +that are managers of the plot amongst us, may, either coming or +going, be taken; and that we may also find out who are the great +contrivers, amongst us, of our ruin.’</p> +<p>2. The next thing was, that a strict search should be made for +all kind of Diabolonians throughout the whole town of Mansoul; +and that every man’s house from top to bottom should be +looked into, and that, too, house by house, that if possible a +further discovery might be made of all such among them as had a +hand in these designs.</p> +<p>3. It was further concluded upon, that wheresoever or with +whomsoever any of the Diabolonians were found, that even those of +the town of Mansoul that had given them house and harbour, should +to their shame, and the warning of others, take penance in the +open place.</p> +<p>4. It was, moreover, resolved by the famous town of Mansoul, +that a public fast, and a day of humiliation, should be kept +throughout the whole corporation, to the justifying of their +Prince, the abasing of themselves before him for their +transgressions against him, and against Shaddai, his +Father. It was further resolved, that all such in Mansoul +as did not on that day endeavour to keep that fast, and to humble +themselves for their faults, but that should mind their worldly +employs, or be found wandering up and down the streets, should be +taken for Diabolonians, and should suffer as Diabolonians for +such their wicked doings.</p> +<p>5. It was further concluded then, that with what speed, and +with what warmth of mind they could, they would renew their +humiliation for sin, and their petitions to Shaddai for help; +they also resolved, to send tidings to the court of all that Mr. +Prywell had told them.</p> +<p>6. It was also determined, that thanks should be given by the +town of Mansoul to Mr. Prywell, for his diligent seeking of the +welfare of their town: and further, that forasmuch as he was so +naturally inclined to seek their good, and also to undermine +their foes, they gave him a commission of scout-master-general, +for the good of the town of Mansoul.</p> +<p>When the corporation, with their captains, had thus concluded, +they did as they had said; they shut up their gates, they made +for Diabolonians strict search, they made those with whom any +were found to take penance in the open place: they kept their +fast, and renewed their petitions to their Prince, and Mr. +Prywell managed his charge and the trust that Mansoul had put in +his hands, with great conscience and good fidelity; for he gave +himself wholly up to his employ, and that not only within the +town, but he went out to pry, to see, and to hear.</p> +<p>And not many days after he provided for his journey, and went +towards Hell-Gate Hill, into the country where the Doubters were, +where he heard of all that had been talked of in Mansoul, and he +perceived also that Diabolus was almost ready for his march, +etc. So he came back with speed, and, calling the captains +and elders of Mansoul together, he told them where he had been, +what he had heard, and what he had seen. Particularly, he +told them that Diabolus was almost ready for his march, and that +he had made old Mr. Incredulity, that once brake prison in +Mansoul, the general of his army; that his army consisted all of +Doubters, and that their number was above twenty thousand. +He told, moreover, that Diabolus did intend to bring with him the +chief princes of the infernal pit, and that he would make them +chief captains over his Doubters. He told them, moreover, +that it was certainly true that several of the black den would, +with Diabolus, ride reformades to reduce the town of Mansoul to +the obedience of Diabolus, their prince.</p> +<p>He said, moreover, that he understood by the Doubters, among +whom he had been, that the reason why old Incredulity was made +general of the whole army, was because none truer than he to the +tyrant; and because he had an implacable spite against the +welfare of the town of Mansoul. Besides, said he, he +remembers the affronts that Mansoul has given him, and he is +resolved to be revenged of them.</p> +<p>But the black princes shall be made high commanders, only +Incredulity shall be over them all; because, which I had almost +forgot, he can more easily, and more dexterously, beleaguer the +town of Mansoul, than can any of the princes besides.</p> +<p>Now, when the captains of Mansoul, with the elders of the +town, had heard the tidings that Mr. Prywell did bring, they +thought it expedient, without further delay, to put into +execution the laws that against the Diabolonians their Prince had +made for them, and given them in commandment to manage against +them. Wherefore, forthwith a diligent and impartial search +was made in all houses in Mansoul, for all and all manner of +Diabolonians. Now, in the house of Mr. Mind, and in the +house of the great Lord Willbewill, were two Diabolonians +found. In Mr. Mind’s house was one Lord Covetousness +found; but he had changed his name to Prudent-Thrifty. In +my Lord Willbewill’s house, one Lasciviousness was found; +but he had changed his name to Harmless-Mirth. These two +the captains and elders of the town of Mansoul took, and +committed them to custody under the hand of Mr. Trueman, the +gaoler; and this man handled them so severely, and loaded them so +well with irons, that in time they both fell into a very deep +consumption, and died in the prison-house; their masters also, +according to the agreement of the captains and elders, were +brought to take penance in the open place to their shame, and for +a warning to the rest of the town of Mansoul.</p> +<p>Now, this was the manner of penance in those days: the persons +offending being made sensible of the evil of their doings, were +enjoined open confession of their faults, and a strict amendment +of their lives.</p> +<p>After this, the captains and elders of Mansoul sought yet to +find out more Diabolonians, wherever they lurked, whether in +dens, caves, holes, vaults, or where else they could, in or about +the wall or town of Mansoul. But though they could plainly +see their footing, and so follow them by their track and smell to +their holds, even to the mouths of their caves and dens, yet take +them, hold them, and do justice upon them, they could not; their +ways were so crooked, their holds so strong, and they so quick to +take sanctuary there.</p> +<p>But Mansoul did now with so stiff an hand rule over the +Diabolonians that were left, that they were glad to shrink into +corners: time was when they durst walk openly, and in the day; +but now they were forced to embrace privacy and the night: time +was when a Mansoulian was their companion; but now they counted +them deadly enemies. This good change did Mr. +Prywell’s intelligence make in the famous town of +Mansoul.</p> +<p>By this time, Diabolus had finished his army which he intended +to bring with him for the ruin of Mansoul; and had set over them +captains, and other field officers, such as liked his furious +stomach best: himself was lord paramount, Incredulity was general +of his army, their highest captains shall be named afterwards; +but now for their officers, colours, and scutcheons.</p> +<p>1. Their first captain was Captain Rage: he was captain over +the election doubters, his were the red colours; his +standard-bearer was Mr. Destructive, and the great red dragon he +had for his scutcheon.</p> +<p>2. The second captain was Captain Fury: he was captain over +the vocation doubters; his standard-bearer was Mr. Darkness, his +colours were those that were pale, and he had for his scutcheon +the fiery flying serpent.</p> +<p>3. The third captain was Captain Damnation: he was captain +over the grace doubters; his were the red colours, Mr. No-Life +bare them, and he had for his scutcheon the black den.</p> +<p>4. The fourth captain was Captain Insatiable; he was captain +over the faith doubters: his were the red colours, Mr. Devourer +bare them, and he had for a scutcheon the yawning jaws.</p> +<p>5. The fifth captain was Captain Brimstone: he was captain +over the perseverance doubters; his also were the red colours, +Mr. Burning bare them, and his scutcheon was the blue and +stinking flame.</p> +<p>6. The sixth captain was Captain Torment: he was captain over +the resurrection doubters; his colours were those that were pale; +Mr. Gnaw was his standard-bearer, and he had the black worm for +his scutcheon.</p> +<p>7. The seventh captain was Captain No-Ease; he was captain +over the salvation doubters; his were the red colours, Mr. +Restless bare them, and his scutcheon was the ghastly picture of +death.</p> +<p>8. The eighth captain was the Captain Sepulchre: he was +captain over the glory doubters; his also were the pale colours, +Mr. Corruption was his standard-bearer, and he had for his +scutcheon a skull, and dead men’s bones.</p> +<p>9. The ninth captain was Captain Past-Hope; he was captain of +those that are called the felicity doubters; his standard-bearer +was Mr. Despair; his also were the red colours, and his scutcheon +was a hot iron and the hard heart.</p> +<p>These were his captains, and these were their forces, these +were their standards, these were their colours, and these were +their scutcheons. Now, over these did the great Diabolus +make superior captains, and they were in number seven: as, +namely, the Lord Beelzebub, the Lord Lucifer, the Lord Legion, +the Lord Apollyon, the Lord Python, the Lord Cerberus, and the +Lord Belial; these seven he set over the captains, and +Incredulity was lord-general, and, Diabolus was king. The +reformades also, such as were like themselves, were made some of +them captains of hundreds, and some of them captains of +more. And thus was the army of Incredulity completed.</p> +<p>So they set out at Hell-Gate Hill, for there they had their +rendezvous, from whence they came with a straight course upon +their march toward the town of Mansoul. Now, as was hinted +before, the town had, as Shaddai would have it, received from the +mouth of Mr. Prywell the alarm of their coming before. +Wherefore they set a strong watch at the gates, and had also +doubled their guards: they also mounted their slings in good +places, where they might conveniently cast out their great stones +to the annoyance of their furious enemy.</p> +<p>Nor could those Diabolonians that were in the town do that +hurt as was designed they should; for Mansoul was now +awake. But alas! poor people, they were sorely affrighted +at the first appearance of their foes, and at their sitting down +before the town, especially when they heard the roaring of their +drum. This, to speak truth, was amazingly hideous to hear; +it frighted all men seven miles round, if they were but awake and +heard it. The streaming of their colours was also terrible +and dejecting to behold.</p> +<p>When Diabolus was come up against the town, first he made his +approach to Ear-gate, and gave it a furious assault, supposing, +as it seems, that his friends in Mansoul had been ready to do the +work within; but care was taken of that before, by the vigilance +of the captains. Wherefore, missing of the help that he +expected from them, and finding his army warmly attended with the +stones that the slingers did sling, (for that I will say for the +captains, that considering the weakness that yet was upon them by +reason of the long sickness that had annoyed the town of Mansoul, +they did gallantly behave themselves,) he was forced to make some +retreat from Mansoul, and to entrench himself and his men in the +field without the reach of the slings of the town.</p> +<p>Now having entrenched himself, he did cast up four mounts +against the town: the first he called Mount Diabolus, putting his +own name thereon, the more to affright the town of Mansoul; the +other three he called thus—Mount Alecto, Mount Megara, and +Mount Tisiphone; for these are the names of the dreadful furies +of hell. Thus he began to play his game with Mansoul, and +to serve it as doth the lion his prey, even to make it fall +before his terror. But, as I said, the captains and +soldiers resisted so stoutly, and did do such execution with +their stones, that they made him, though against stomach, to +retreat, wherefore Mansoul began to take courage.</p> +<p>Now upon Mount Diabolus, which was raised on the north side of +the town, there did the tyrant set up his standard, and a fearful +thing it was to behold; for he had wrought in it by devilish art, +after the manner of a scutcheon, a flaming flame fearful to +behold, and the picture of Mansoul burning in it.</p> +<p>When Diabolus had thus done, he commanded that his drummer +should every night approach the walls of the town of Mansoul, and +so to beat a parley; the command was to do it at nights, for in +the daytime they annoyed him with their slings; for the tyrant +said, that he had a mind to parley with the now trembling town of +Mansoul, and he commanded that the drums should beat every night, +that through weariness they might at last, if possible, (at the +first they were unwilling yet,) be forced to do it.</p> +<p>So this drummer did as commanded: he arose, and did beat his +drum. But when his drum did go, if one looked toward the +town of Mansoul, ‘Behold darkness and sorrow, and the light +was darkened in the heaven thereof.’ No noise was +ever heard upon earth more terrible, except the voice of Shaddai +when he speaketh. But how did Mansoul tremble! it now +looked for nothing but forthwith to be swallowed up.</p> +<p>When this drummer had beaten for a parley, he made this speech +to Mansoul: ‘My master has bid me tell you, that if you +will willingly submit, you shall have the good of the earth; but +if you shall be stubborn, he is resolved to take you by +force.’ But by that the fugitive had done beating his +drum, the people of Mansoul had betaken themselves to the +captains that were in the castle, so that there was none to +regard, nor to give this drummer an answer; so he proceeded no +further that night, but returned again to his master to the +camp.</p> +<p>When Diabolus saw that by drumming he could not work out +Mansoul to his will, the next night he sendeth his drummer +without his drum, still to let the townsmen know that he had a +mind to parley with them. But when all came to all, his +parley was turned into a summons to the town to deliver up +themselves: but they gave him neither heed nor hearing: for they +remembered what at first it cost them to hear him a few +words.</p> +<p>The next night he sends again, and then who should be his +messenger to Mansoul but the terrible Captain Sepulchre; so +Captain Sepulchre came up to the walls of Mansoul, and made this +oration to the town:—</p> +<p>‘O ye inhabitants of the rebellious town of +Mansoul! I summon you in the name of the Prince Diabolus, +that, without any more ado, you set open the gates of your town, +and admit the great lord to come in. But if you shall still +rebel, when we have taken to us the town by force, we will +swallow you up as the grave; wherefore if you will hearken to my +summons, say so, and if not then let me know.</p> +<p>‘The reason of this my summons,’ quoth he, +‘is, for that my lord is your undoubted prince and lord, as +you yourselves have formerly owned. Nor shall that assault +that was given to my lord, when Emmanuel dealt so dishonourably +by him, prevail with him to lose his right, and to forbear to +attempt to recover his own. Consider, then, O Mansoul, with +thyself, wilt thou show thyself peaceable, or no? If thou +shalt quietly yield up thyself, then our old friendship shall be +renewed; but if thou shalt yet refuse and rebel, then expect +nothing but fire and sword.’</p> +<p>When the languishing town of Mansoul had heard this summoner +and his summons, they were yet more put to their dumps, but made +to the captain no answer at all; so away he went as he came.</p> +<p>But, after some consultation among themselves, as also with +some of their captains, they applied themselves afresh to the +Lord Secretary for counsel and advice from him; for this Lord +Secretary was their chief preacher, (as also is mentioned some +pages before,) only now he was ill at ease; and of him they +begged favour in these two or three things—</p> +<p>1. That he would look comfortably upon them, and not keep +himself so much retired from them as formerly. Also, that +he would be prevailed with to give them a hearing, while they +should make known their miserable condition to him. But to +this he told them as before, that ‘as yet he was but ill at +ease, and therefore could not do as he had formerly +done.’</p> +<p>2. The second thing that they desired was, that he would be +pleased to give them his advice about their now so important +affairs, for that Diabolus was come and set down before the town +with no less than twenty thousand doubters. They said, +moreover, that both he and his captains were cruel men, and that +they were afraid of them. But to this he said, ‘You +must look to the law of the Prince, and there see what is laid +upon you to do.’</p> +<p>3. Then they desired that his highness would help them to +frame a petition to Shaddai, and unto Emmanuel his Son, and that +he would set his own hand thereto as a token that he was one with +them in it: ‘For,’ said they, ‘my Lord, many a +one have we sent, but can get no answer of peace; but now, +surely, one with thy hand unto it may obtain good for +Mansoul.’</p> +<p>But all the answer that he gave to this was, ‘that they +had offended their Emmanuel, and had also grieved himself, and +that therefore they must as yet partake of their own +devices.’</p> +<p>This answer of the Lord Secretary fell like a millstone upon +them; yea, it crushed them so that they could not tell what to +do; yet they durst not comply with the demands of Diabolus, nor +with the demands of his captain. So then here were the +straits that the town of Mansoul was betwixt, when the enemy came +upon her: her foes were ready to swallow her up, and her friends +did forbear to help her.</p> +<p>Then stood up my Lord Mayor, whose name was my Lord +Understanding, and he began to pick and pick, until he had picked +comfort out of that seemingly bitter saying of the Lord +Secretary; for thus he descanted upon it: ‘First,’ +said he, ‘this unavoidably follows upon the saying of my +Lord, “that we must yet suffer for our sins.” +Secondly, But,’ quoth he, ‘the words yet sound as if +at last we should be saved from our enemies, and that after a few +more sorrows, Emmanuel will come and be our help.’ +Now the Lord Mayor was the more critical in his dealing with the +Secretary’s words, because my lord was more than a prophet, +and because none of his words were such, but that at all times +they were most exactly significant; and the townsmen were allowed +to pry into them, and to expound them to their best +advantage.</p> +<p>So they took their leaves of my lord, and returned, and went, +and came to the captains, to whom they did tell what my Lord High +Secretary had said; who, when they had heard it, were all of the +same opinion as was my Lord Mayor himself. The captains, +therefore, began to take some courage unto them, and to prepare +to make some brave attempt upon the camp of the enemy, and to +destroy all that were Diabolonians, with the roving doubters that +the tyrant had brought with him to destroy the poor town of +Mansoul.</p> +<p>So all betook themselves forthwith to their places—the +Captains to theirs, the Lord Mayor to his, the subordinate +preacher to his, and my Lord Willbewill to his. The +captains longed to be at some work for their prince; for they +delighted in warlike achievements. The next day, therefore, +they came together and consulted; and after consultation had, +they resolved to give an answer to the captain of Diabolus with +slings; and so they did at the rising of the sun on the morrow; +for Diabolus had adventured to come nearer again, but the +sling-stones were to him and his like hornets. For as there +is nothing to the town of Mansoul so terrible as the roaring of +Diabolus’s drum, so there is nothing to Diabolus so +terrible as the well playing of Emmanuel’s slings. +Wherefore Diabolus was forced to make another retreat, yet +further off from the famous town of Mansoul. Then did the +Lord Mayor of Mansoul cause the bells to be rung, ‘and that +thanks should be sent to the Lord High Secretary by the mouth of +the subordinate preacher; for that by his words the captains and +elders of Mansoul had been strengthened against +Diabolus.’</p> +<p>When Diabolus saw that his captains and soldiers, high lords +and renowned, were frightened, and beaten down by the stones that +came from the golden slings of the Prince of the town of Mansoul, +he bethought himself, and said, ‘I will try to catch them +by fawning, I will try to flatter them into my net.’</p> +<p>Wherefore, after a while, he came down again to the wall, not +now with his drum, nor with Captain Sepulchre; but having all +besugared his lips, he seemed to be a very sweet-mouthed, +peaceable prince, designing nothing for humour’s sake, nor +to be revenged on Mansoul for injuries by them done to him; but +the welfare, and good, and advantage of the town and people +therein was now, as he said, his only design. Wherefore, +after he had called for audience, and desired that the townsfolk +would give it to him, he proceeded in his oration, and +said:—</p> +<p>‘Oh, the desire of my heart, the famous town of Mansoul! +how many nights have I watched, and how many weary steps have I +taken, if perhaps I might do thee good! Far be it, far be +it from me to desire to make a war upon you; if ye will but +willingly and quietly deliver up yourselves unto me. You +know that you were mine of old. Remember also, that so long +as you enjoyed me for your lord, and that I enjoyed you for my +subjects, you wanted for nothing of all the delights of the +earth, that I, your lord and prince, could get for you, or that I +could invent to make you bonny and blithe withal. Consider, +you never had so many hard, dark, troublesome, and +heart-afflicting hours, while you were mine, as you have had +since you revolted from me; nor shall you ever have peace again, +until you and I become one as before. But, be but prevailed +with to embrace me again, and I will grant, yea, enlarge your old +charter with abundance of privileges; so that your license and +liberty shall be to take, hold, enjoy, and make your own all that +is pleasant from the east to the west. Nor shall any of +those incivilities, wherewith you have offended me, be ever +charged upon you by me, so long as the sun and moon endure. +Nor shall any of those dear friends of mine that now, for the +fear of you, lie lurking in dens, and holes, and caves in +Mansoul, be hurtful to you any more; yea, they shall be your +servants, and shall minister unto you of their substance, and of +whatever shall come to hand. I need speak no more; you know +them, and have sometime since been much delighted in their +company. Why, then, should we abide at such odds? Let +us renew our old acquaintance and friendship again.</p> +<p>‘Bear with your friend; I take the liberty at this time +to speak thus freely unto you. The love that I have to you +presses me to do it, as also does the zeal of my heart for my +friends with you: put me not therefore to further trouble, nor +yourselves to further fears and frights. Have you I will, +in a way of peace or war; nor do you flatter yourselves with the +power and force of your captains, or that your Emmanuel will +shortly come in to your help; for such strength will do you no +pleasure.</p> +<p>‘I am come against you with a stout and valiant army, +and all the chief princes of the den are even at the head of +it. Besides, my captains are swifter than eagles, stronger +than lions, and more greedy of prey than are the evening +wolves. What is Og of Bashan! what is Goliath of Gath! and +what are an hundred more of them, to one of the least of my +captains! How, then, shall Mansoul think to escape my hand +and force?’</p> +<p>Diabolus having thus handed his flattering, fawning, +deceitful, and lying speech to the famous town of Mansoul, the +Lord Mayor replied to him as follows: ‘O Diabolus, prince +of darkness, and master of all deceit; thy lying flatteries we +have had and made sufficient probation of, and have tasted too +deeply of that destructive cup already. Should we therefore +again hearken unto thee, and so break the commandments of our +great Shaddai, to join in affinity with thee, would not our +Prince reject us, and cast us off for ever? And, being cast +off by him, can the place that he has prepared for thee be a +place of rest for us? Besides, O thou that art empty and +void of all truth, we are rather ready to die by thy hand, than +to fall in with thy flattering and lying deceits.’</p> +<p>When the tyrant saw that there was little to be got by +parleying with my Lord Mayor, he fell into an hellish rage, and +resolved that again, with his army of doubters, he would another +time assault the town of Mansoul.</p> +<p>So he called for his drummer, who beat up for his men (and +while he did beat, Mansoul did shake) to be in a readiness to +give battle to the corporation: then Diabolus drew near with his +army, and thus disposed of his men. Captain Cruel and +Captain Torment, these he drew up and placed against Feel-gate, +and commanded them to sit down there for the war. And he +also appointed that, if need were, Captain No-Ease should come in +to their relief. At Nose-gate he placed the Captain +Brimstone and Captain Sepulchre, and bid them look well to their +ward, on that side of the town of Mansoul. But at Eye-gate +he placed that grim-faced one, the Captain Past-Hope, and there +also now he did set up his terrible standard.</p> +<p>Now Captain Insatiable, he was to look to the carriages of +Diabolus, and was also appointed to take into custody that, or +those persons and things, that should at any time as prey be +taken from the enemy.</p> +<p>Now Mouth-gate the inhabitants of Mansoul kept for a +sally-port; wherefore that they kept strong; for that it was it +by and out at which the townsfolk did send their petitions to +Emmanuel their Prince. That also was the gate from the top +of which the captains did play their slings at the enemies; for +that gate stood somewhat ascending, so that the placing of them +there, and the letting of them fly from that place, did much +execution against the tyrant’s army. Wherefore, for +these causes, with others, Diabolus sought, if possible, to land +up Mouth-gate with dirt.</p> +<p>Now, as Diabolus was busy and industrious in preparing to make +his assault upon the town of Mansoul, without, so the captains +and soldiers in the corporation were as busy in preparing within; +they mounted their slings, they set up their banners, they +sounded their trumpets, and put themselves in such order as was +judged most for the annoyance of the enemy, and for the advantage +of Mansoul, and gave to their soldiers orders to be ready at the +sound of the trumpet for war. The Lord Willbewill also, he +took the charge of watching against the rebels within, and to do +what he could to take them while without, or to stifle them +within their caves, dens, and holes in the town-wall of +Mansoul. And, to speak the truth of him, ever since he took +penance for his fault, he has showed as much honesty and bravery +of spirit as any he in Mansoul; for he took one Jolly, and his +brother Griggish, the two sons of his servant Harmless-Mirth, +(for to that day, though the father was committed to ward, the +sons had a dwelling in the house of my lord,)—I say, he +took them, and with his own hands put them to the cross. +And this was the reason why he hanged them up: after their father +was put into the hands of Mr. True-Man the gaoler, they, his +sons, began to play his pranks, and to be ticking and toying with +the daughters of their lord; nay, it was jealoused that they were +too familiar with them, the which was brought to his +lordship’s ear. Now his lordship being unwilling +unadvisedly to put any man to death, did not suddenly fall upon +them, but set watch and spies to see if the thing was true; of +the which he was soon informed, for his two servants, whose names +were Find-Out and Tell-All, catched them together in uncivil +manner more than once or twice, and went and told their +lord. So when my Lord Willbewill had sufficient ground to +believe the thing was true, he takes the two young Diabolonians, +(for such they were, for their father was a Diabolonian born,) +and has them to Eye-gate, where he raised a very high cross, just +in the face of Diabolus, and of his army, and there he hanged the +young villains, in defiance to Captain Past-Hope, and of the +horrible standard of the tyrant.</p> +<p>Now this Christian act of the brave Lord Willbewill did +greatly abash Captain Past-Hope, discouraged the army of +Diabolus, put fear into the Diabolonian runagates in Mansoul, and +put strength and courage into the captains that belonged to +Emmanuel, the Prince; for they without did gather, and that by +this very act of my Lord, that Mansoul was resolved to fight, and +that the Diabolonians within the town could not do such things as +Diabolus had hopes they would. Nor was this the only proof +of the brave Lord Willbewill’s honesty to the town, nor of +his loyalty to his Prince, as will afterwards appear.</p> +<p>Now, when the children of Prudent-Thrifty, who dwelt with Mr. +Mind, (for Thrift left children with Mr. Mind, when he was also +committed to prison, and their names were Gripe and Rake-All; +these he begat of Mr. Mind’s bastard daughter, whose name +was Mrs. Hold-fast-Bad;)—I say, when his children perceived +how the Lord Willbewill had served them that dwelt with him, what +do they but, lest they should drink of the same cup, endeavour to +make their escape. But Mr. Mind, being wary of it, took +them and put them in hold in his house till morning; (for this +was done over night;) and remembering that by the law of Mansoul +all Diabolonians were to die, (and to be sure they were at least +by father’s side such, and some say by mother’s side +too,) what does he but takes them and puts them in chains, and +carries them to the selfsame place where my lord hanged his two +before, and there he hanged them.</p> +<p>The townsmen also took great encouragement at this act of Mr. +Mind, and did what they could to have taken some more of these +Diabolonian troublers of Mansoul; but at that time the rest lay +so squat and close, that they could not be apprehended; so they +set against them a diligent watch, and went every man to his +place.</p> +<p>I told you a little before, that Diabolus and his army were +somewhat abashed and discouraged at the sight of what my Lord +Willbewill did, when he hanged up those two young Diabolonians; +but his discouragement quickly turned itself into furious madness +and rage against the town of Mansoul, and fight it he +would. Also the townsmen and captains within, they had +their hopes and their expectations heightened, believing at last +the day would be theirs; so they feared them the less. +Their subordinate preacher, too, made a sermon about it; and he +took that theme for his text, ‘Gad, a troop shall overcome +him: but he shall overcome at the last.’ Whence he +showed, that though Mansoul should be sorely put to it at the +first, yet the victory should most certainly be Mansoul’s +at the last.</p> +<p>So Diabolus commanded that his drummer should beat a charge +against the town; and the captains also that were in the town +sounded a charge against them, but they had no drum: they were +trumpets of silver with which they sounded against them. +Then they which were of the camp of Diabolus came down to the +town to take it, and the captains in the castle, with the +slingers at Mouth-gate, played upon them amain. And now +there was nothing heard in the camp of Diabolus but horrible rage +and blasphemy; but in the town good words, prayer, and singing of +psalms. The enemy replied with horrible objections, and the +terribleness of their drum; but the town made answer with the +slapping of their slings, and the melodious noise of their +trumpets. And thus the fight lasted for several days +together, only now and then they had some small intermission, in +the which the townsmen refreshed themselves, and the captains +made ready for another assault.</p> +<p>The captains of Emmanuel were clad in silver armour, and the +soldiers in that which was of proof; the soldiers of Diabolus +were clad in iron which was made to give place to +Emmanuel’s engine-shot. In the town, some were hurt, +and some were greatly wounded. Now, the worst of it was, a +chirurgeon was scarce in Mansoul, for that Emmanuel at present +was absent. Howbeit, with the leaves of a tree the wounded +were kept from dying; yet their wounds did greatly putrefy, and +some did grievously stink. Of the townsmen, these were +wounded, namely, my Lord Reason; he was wounded in the +head. Another that was wounded was the brave Lord Mayor; he +was wounded in the eye. Another that was wounded was Mr. +Mind; he received his wound about the stomach. The honest +subordinate preacher also, he received a shot not far off the +heart but none of these were mortal.</p> +<p>Many also of the inferior sort were not only wounded but slain +outright.</p> +<p>Now, in the camp of Diabolus were wounded and slain a +considerable number; for instance, Captain Rage, he was wounded, +and so was Captain Cruel. Captain Damnation was made to +retreat, and to intrench himself further off of Mansoul. +The standard also of Diabolus was beaten down, and his +standard-bearer, Captain Much-Hurt, had his brains beat out with +a sling-stone, to the no little grief and shame of his prince +Diabolus.</p> +<p>Many also of the doubters were slain outright, though enough +of them were left alive to make Mansoul shake and totter. +Now the victory that day being turned to Mansoul, did put great +valour into the townsmen and captains, and did cover +Diabolus’s camp with a cloud, but withal it made them far +more furious. So the next day Mansoul rested, and commanded +that the bells should be rung; the trumpets also joyfully +sounded, and the captains shouted round the town.</p> +<p>My Lord Willbewill also was not idle, but did notable service +within against the domestics, or the Diabolonians that were in +the town, not only by keeping them in awe, for he lighted on one +at last whose name was Mr. Anything, a fellow of whom mention was +made before; for it was he, if you remember, that brought the +three fellows to Diabolus, whom the Diabolonians took out of +Captain Boanerges’s companies, and that persuaded them to +list themselves under the tyrant, to fight against the army of +Shaddai. My Lord Willbewill did also take a notable +Diabolonian, whose name was Loose-Foot: this Loose-Foot was a +scout to the vagabonds in Mansoul, and that did use to carry +tidings out of Mansoul to the camp, and out of the camp to those +of the enemies in Mansoul. Both these my lord sent away +safe to Mr. True-Man, the gaoler, with a commandment to keep them +in irons; for he intended then to have them out to be crucified, +when it would be for the best to the corporation, and most for +the discouragement of the camp of the enemies.</p> +<p>My Lord Mayor also, though he could not stir about so much as +formerly, because of the wound that he lately received, yet gave +he out orders to all that were the natives of Mansoul, to look to +their watch, and stand upon their guard, and, as occasion should +offer, to prove themselves men.</p> +<p>Mr. Conscience, the preacher, he also did his utmost to keep +all his good documents alive upon the hearts of the people of +Mansoul.</p> +<p>Well, awhile after, the captains and stout ones of the town of +Mansoul agreed and resolved upon a time to make a sally out upon +the camp of Diabolus, and this must be done in the night; and +there was the folly of Mansoul, (for the night is always the best +for the enemy, but the worst for Mansoul to fight in,) but yet +they would do it, their courage was so high; their last victory +also still stuck in their memories.</p> +<p>So the night appointed being come, the Prince’s brave +captains cast lots who should lead the van in this new and +desperate expedition against Diabolus, and against his +Diabolonian army; and the lot fell to Captain Credence, to +Captain Experience, and to Captain Good-Hope, to lead the forlorn +hope. (This Captain Experience the Prince created such when +himself did reside in the town of Mansoul.) So, as I said, +they made their sally out upon the army that lay in the siege +against them; and their hap was to fall in with the main body of +their enemies. Now Diabolus and his men being expertly +accustomed to night-work, took the alarm presently, and were as +ready to give them battle, as if they had sent them word of their +coming. Wherefore to it they went amain, and blows were +hard on every side; the hell drum also was beat most furiously, +while the trumpets of the Prince most sweetly sounded. And +thus the battle was joined; and Captain Insatiable looked to the +enemy’s carriages, and waited when he should receive some +prey.</p> +<p>The Prince’s captains fought it stoutly, beyond what +indeed could be expected they should; they wounded many; they +made the whole army of Diabolus to make a retreat. But I +cannot tell how, but the brave Captain Credence, Captain +Good-Hope, and Captain Experience, as they were upon the pursuit, +cutting down, and following hard after the enemy in the rear, +Captain Credence stumbled and fell, by which fall he caught so +great a hurt, that he could not rise till Captain Experience did +help him up, at which their men were put in disorder. The +captain also was so full of pain, that he could not forbear but +aloud to cry out: at this, the other two captains fainted, +supposing that Captain Credence had received his mortal wound; +their men also were more disordered, and had no list to +fight. Now Diabolus being very observing, though at this +time as yet he was put to the worst, perceiving that a halt was +made among the men that were the pursuers, what does he but, +taking it for granted that the captains were either wounded or +dead, he therefore makes at first a stand, then faces about, and +so comes up upon the Prince’s army with as much of his fury +as hell could help him to; and his hap was to fall in just among +the three captains, Captain Credence, Captain Good-Hope, and +Captain Experience, and did cut, wound, and pierce them so +dreadfully, that what through discouragement, what through +disorder, and what through the wounds that they had received, and +also the loss of much blood, they scarce were able, though they +had for their power the three best hands in Mansoul, to get safe +into the hold again.</p> +<p>Now, when the body of the Prince’s army saw how these +three captains were put to the worst, they thought it their +wisdom to make as safe and good a retreat as they could, and so +returned by the sally-port again; and so there was an end of this +present action. But Diabolus was so flushed with this +night’s work, that he promised himself, in few days, an +easy and complete conquest over the town of Mansoul; wherefore, +on the day following, he comes up to the sides thereof with great +boldness, and demands entrance, and that forthwith they deliver +themselves up to his government. The Diabolonians, too, +that were within, they began to be somewhat brisk, as we shall +show afterward.</p> +<p>But the valiant Lord Mayor replied, that what he got he must +get by force; for as long as Emmanuel, their Prince, was alive, +(though he at present was not so with them as they wished,) they +should never consent to yield Mansoul up to another.</p> +<p>And with that the Lord Willbewill stood up, and said, +‘Diabolus, thou master of the den, and enemy to all that is +good, we poor inhabitants of the town of Mansoul are too well +acquainted with thy rule and government, and with the end of +those things that for certain will follow submitting to thee, to +do it. Wherefore though while we were without knowledge we +suffered thee to take us, (as the bird that saw not the snare +fell into the hands of the fowler,) yet since we have been turned +from darkness to light, we have also been turned from the power +of Satan to God. And though through thy subtlety, and also +the subtlety of the Diabolonians within, we have sustained much +loss, and also plunged ourselves into much perplexity, yet give +up ourselves, lay down our arms, and yield to so horrid a tyrant +as thou, we shall not; die upon the place we choose rather to +do. Besides, we have hopes that in time deliverance will +come from court unto us, and therefore we yet will maintain a war +against thee.’</p> +<p>This brave speech of the Lord Willbewill, with that also of +the Lord Mayor, did somewhat abate the boldness of Diabolus, +though it kindled the fury of his rage. It also succoured +the townsmen and captains; yea, it was as a plaster to the brave +Captain Credence’s wound; for you must know that a brave +speech now (when the captains of the town with their men of war +came home routed, and when the enemy took courage and boldness at +the success that he had obtained to draw up to the walls, and +demand entrance, as he did) was in season, and also +advantageous.</p> +<p>The Lord Willbewill also did play the man within; for while +the captains and soldiers were in the field, he was in arms in +the town, and wherever by him there was a Diabolonian found, they +were forced to feel the weight of his heavy hand, and also the +edge of his penetrating sword: many therefore of the Diabolonians +he wounded, as the Lord Cavil, the Lord Brisk, the Lord +Pragmatic, and the Lord Murmur; several also of the meaner sort +he did sorely maim; though there cannot at this time an account +be given you of any that he slew outright. The cause, or +rather the advantage that my Lord Willbewill had at this time to +do thus, was for that the captains were gone out to fight the +enemy in the field. ‘For now,’ thought the +Diabolonians within, ‘is our time to stir and make an +uproar in the town.’ What do they therefore but +quickly get themselves into a body, and fall forthwith to +hurricaning in Mansoul, as if now nothing but whirlwind and +tempest should be there. Wherefore, as I said, he takes +this opportunity to fall in among them with his men, cutting and +slashing with courage that was undaunted; at which the +Diabolonians with all haste dispersed themselves to their holds, +and my lord to his place as before.</p> +<p>This brave act of my lord did somewhat revenge the wrong done +by Diabolus to the captains, and also did let them know that +Mansoul was not to be parted with for the loss of a victory or +two; wherefore the wing of the tyrant was clipped again, as to +boasting,—I mean in comparison of what he would have done, +if the Diabolonians had put the town to the same plight to which +he had put the captains.</p> +<p>Well, Diabolus yet resolves to have the other bout with +Mansoul. ‘For,’ thought he, ‘since I beat +them once, I may beat them twice.’ Wherefore he +commanded his men to be ready at such an hour of the night, to +make a fresh assault upon the town; and he gave it out in special +that they should bend all their force against Feel-gate, and +attempt to break into the town through that. The word that +then he did give to his officers and soldiers was +Hell-fire. ‘And,’ said he, ‘if we break +in upon them, as I wish we do, either with some, or with all our +force, let them that break in look to it, that they forget not +the word. And let nothing be heard in the town of Mansoul +but, “Hell-fire! Hell-fire! +Hell-fire!”’ The drummer was also to beat +without ceasing, and the standard-bearers were to display their +colours; the soldiers, too, were to put on what courage they +could, and to see that they played manfully their parts against +the town.</p> +<p>So when night was come, and all things by the tyrant made +ready for the work, he suddenly makes his assault upon Feel-gate, +and after he had awhile struggled there, he throws the gate wide +open: for the truth is, those gates were but weak, and so most +easily made to yield. When Diabolus had thus far made his +attempt, he placed his captains (namely, Torment and No-Ease) +there; so he attempted to press forward, but the Prince’s +captains came down upon him, and made his entrance more difficult +than he desired. And, to speak truth, they made what +resistance they could; but the three of their best and most +valiant captains being wounded, and by their wounds made much +incapable of doing the town that service they would, (and all the +rest having more than their hands full of the doubters, and their +captains that did follow Diabolus,) they were overpowered with +force, nor could they keep them out of the town. Wherefore +the Prince’s men and their captains betook themselves to +the castle, as to the stronghold of the town: and this they did +partly for their own security, partly for the security of the +town, and partly, or rather chiefly, to preserve to Emmanuel the +prerogative-royal of Mansoul; for so was the castle of +Mansoul.</p> +<p>The captains therefore being fled into the castle, the enemy, +without much resistance, possess themselves of the rest of the +town, and spreading themselves as they went into every corner, +they cried out as they marched, according to the command of the +tyrant, ‘Hell-fire! Hell-fire! Hell-fire!’ so that +nothing for a while throughout the town of Mansoul could be heard +but the direful noise of ‘Hell-fire!’ together with +the roaring of Diabolus’s drum. And now did the +clouds hang black over Mansoul, nor to reason did anything but +ruin seem to attend it. Diabolus also quartered his +soldiers in the houses of the inhabitants of the town of +Mansoul. Yea, the subordinate preacher’s house was as +full of these outlandish doubters as ever it could hold, and so +was my Lord Mayor’s, and my Lord Willbewill’s +also. Yea, where was there a corner, a cottage, a barn, or +a hogstye, that now was not full of these vermin? Yea, they +turned the men of the town out of their houses, and would lie in +their beds, and sit at their tables themselves. Ah, poor +Mansoul! now thou feelest the fruits of sin, yea, what venom was +in the flattering words of Mr. Carnal-Security! They made +great havoc of whatever they laid their hands on; yea, they fired +the town in several places; many young children also were by them +dashed in pieces; and those that were yet unborn they destroyed +in their mothers’ wombs: for you must needs think that it +could not now be otherwise; for what conscience, what pity, what +bowels of compassion can any expect at the hands of outlandish +doubters? Many in Mansoul that were women, both young and +old, they forced, ravished, and beastlike abused, so that they +swooned, miscarried, and many of them died, and so lay at the top +of every street, and in all by-places of the town.</p> +<p>And now did Mansoul seem to be nothing but a den of dragons, +an emblem of hell, and a place of total darkness. Now did +Mansoul lie almost like the barren wilderness; nothing but +nettles, briars, thorns, weeds, and stinking things seemed now to +cover the face of Mansoul. I told you before, how that +these Diabolonian doubters turned the men of Mansoul out of their +beds, and now I will add, they wounded them, they mauled them, +yea, and almost brained many of them. Many did I say, yea +most, if not all of them. Mr. Conscience they so wounded, +yea, and his wounds so festered, that he could have no ease day +nor night, but lay as if continually upon a rack; but that +Shaddai rules all, certainly they had slain him outright. +Mr. Lord Mayor they so abused that they almost put out his eyes; +and had not my Lord Willbewill got into the castle, they intended +to have chopped him all to pieces; for they did look upon him, as +his heart now stood, to be one of the very worst that was in +Mansoul against Diabolus and his crew. And indeed he hath +shown himself a man, and more of his exploits you will hear of +afterwards.</p> +<p>Now, a man might have walked for days together in Mansoul, and +scarcely have seen one in the town that looked like a religious +man. Oh, the fearful state of Mansoul now! now every corner +swarmed with outlandish doubters; red-coats and black-coats +walked the town by clusters, and filled up all the houses with +hideous noises, vain songs, lying stories, and blasphemous +language against Shaddai and his Son. Now also those +Diabolonians that lurked in the walls and dens and holes that +were in the town of Mansoul, came forth and showed themselves; +yea, walked with open face in company with the doubters that were +in Mansoul. Yea, they had more boldness now to walk the +streets, to haunt the houses, and to show themselves abroad, than +had any of the honest inhabitants of the now woful town of +Mansoul.</p> +<p>But Diabolus and his outlandish men were not at peace in +Mansoul; for they were not there entertained as were the captains +and forces of Emmanuel: the townsmen did browbeat them what they +could; nor did they partake or make stroy of any of the +necessaries of Mansoul, but that which they seized on against the +townsmen’s will: what they could, they hid from them, and +what they could not, they had with an ill-will. They, poor +hearts! had rather have had their room than their company; but +they were at present their captives, and their captives for the +present they were forced to be. But, I say, they +discountenanced them as much as they were able, and showed them +all the dislike that they could.</p> +<p>The captains also from the castle did hold them in continual +play with their slings, to the chafing and fretting of the minds +of the enemies. True, Diabolus made a great many attempts +to have broken open the gates of the castle, but Mr. Godly-Fear +was made the keeper of that; and he was a man of that courage, +conduct, and valour, that it was in vain, as long as life lasted +within him, to think to do that work, though mostly desired; +wherefore all the attempts that Diabolus made against him were +fruitless. I have wished sometimes that that man had had +the whole rule of the town of Mansoul.</p> +<p>Well, this was the condition of the town of Mansoul for about +two years and a half: the body of the town was the seat of war, +the people of the town were driven into holes, and the glory of +Mansoul was laid in the dust. What rest, then, could be to +the inhabitants, what peace could Mansoul have, and what sun +could shine upon it? Had the enemy lain so long without in +the plain against the town, it had been enough to have famished +them: but now, when they shall be within, when the town shall be +their tent, their trench and fort against the castle that was in +the town; when the town shall be against the town, and shall +serve to be a defence to the enemies of her strength and life: I +say, when they shall make use of the forts and town-holds to +secure themselves in, even till they shall take, spoil, and +demolish the castle,—this was terrible! and yet this was +now the state of the town of Mansoul.</p> +<p>After the town of Mansoul had been in this sad and lamentable +condition, for so long a time as I have told you, and no +petitions that they presented their Prince with, all this while, +could prevail, the inhabitants of the town, namely, the elders +and chief of Mansoul, gathered together, and, after some time +spent in condoling their miserable state and this miserable +judgment coming upon them, they agreed together to draw up yet +another petition, and to send it away to Emmanuel for +relief. But Mr. Godly-Fear stood up and answered, that he +knew that his Lord the Prince never did nor ever would receive a +petition for these matters, from the hand of any whoever, unless +the Lord Secretary’s hand was to it; ‘and +this,’ quoth he, ‘is the reason that you prevailed +not all this while.’ Then they said they would draw +up one, and get the Lord Secretary’s hand unto it. +But Mr. Godly-Fear answered again, that he knew also that the +Lord Secretary would not set his hand to any petition that +himself had not an hand in composing and drawing up. +‘And besides,’ said he, ‘the Prince doth know +my Lord Secretary’s hand from all the hands in the world; +wherefore he cannot be deceived by any pretence whatever. +Wherefore my advice is that you go to my Lord, and implore him to +lend you his aid.’ (Now he did yet abide in the +castle, where all the captains and men-at-arms were.)</p> +<p>So they heartily thanked Mr. Godly-Fear, took his counsel, and +did as he had bidden them. So they went and came to my +Lord, and made known the cause of their coming to him; namely, +that since Mansoul was in so deplorable a condition, his Highness +would be pleased to undertake to draw up a petition for them to +Emmanuel, the Son of the mighty Shaddai, and to their King and +his Father by him.</p> +<p>Then said the Secretary to them, ‘What petition is it +that you would have me draw up for you?’ But they +said, ‘Our Lord knows best the state and condition of the +town of Mansoul; and how we are backslidden and degenerated from +the Prince: thou also knowest who is come up to war against us, +and how Mansoul is now the seat of war. My Lord knows, +moreover, what barbarous usages our men, women, and children have +suffered at their hands; and how our homebred Diabolonians do +walk now with more boldness than dare the townsmen in the streets +of Mansoul. Let our Lord therefore, according to the wisdom +of God that is in him, draw up a petition for his poor servants +to our Prince Emmanuel.’ ‘Well,’ said the +Lord Secretary, ‘I will draw up a petition for you, and +will also set my hand thereto.’ Then said they, +‘But when shall we call for it at the hands of our +Lord?’ But he answered, ‘Yourselves must be +present at the doing of it; yea, you must put your desires to +it. True, the hand and pen shall be mine, but the ink and +paper must be yours; else how can you say it is your +petition? Nor have I need to petition for myself, because I +have not offended.’ He also added as followeth: ‘No +petition goes from me in my name to the Prince, and so to his +Father by him, but when the people that are chiefly concerned +therein do join in heart and soul in the matter, for that must be +inserted therein.’</p> +<p>So they did heartily agree with the sentence of the Lord, and +a petition was forthwith drawn up for them. But now, who +should carry it? that was next. But the Secretary advised +that Captain Credence should carry it; for he was a well-spoken +man. They therefore called for him, and propounded to him +the business. ‘Well,’ said the captain, +‘I gladly accept of the motion; and though I am lame, I +will do this business for you with as much speed, and as well as +I can.’</p> +<p>The contents of the petition were to this purpose</p> +<p>‘O our Lord, and Sovereign Prince Emmanuel, the potent, +the long-suffering Prince! grace is poured into thy lips, and to +thee belong mercy and forgiveness, though we have rebelled +against thee. We, who are no more worthy to be called thy +Mansoul, nor yet fit to partake of common benefits, do beseech +thee, and thy Father by thee, to do away our +transgressions. We confess that thou mightest cast us away +for them; but do it not for thy name’s sake: let the Lord +rather take an opportunity, at our miserable condition, to let +out his bowels and compassions to us. We are compassed on +every side, Lord; our own backslidings reprove us; our +Diabolonians within our town fright us; and the army of the angel +of the bottomless pit distresses us. Thy grace can be our +salvation, and whither to go but to thee we know not.</p> +<p>‘Furthermore, O gracious Prince, we have weakened our +captains, and they are discouraged, sick, and, of late, some of +them grievously worsted and beaten out of the field by the power +and force of the tyrant. Yea, even those of our captains, +in whose valour we did formerly use to put most of our +confidence, they are as wounded men. Besides, Lord, our +enemies are lively, and they are strong; they vaunt and boast +themselves, and do threaten to part us among themselves for a +booty. They are fallen also upon us, Lord, with many +thousand doubters, such as with whom we cannot tell what to do; +they are all grim-looked and unmerciful ones, and they bid +defiance to us and thee.</p> +<p>‘Our wisdom is gone, our power is gone, because thou art +departed from us; nor have we what we may call ours but sin, +shame, and confusion of face for sin. Take pity upon us, O +Lord, take pity upon us, thy miserable town of Mansoul, and save +us out of the hands of our enemies. Amen.’</p> +<p>This petition, as was touched afore, was handed by the Lord +Secretary, and carried to the court by the brave and most stout +Captain Credence. Now he carried it out at Mouth-gate, (for +that, as I said, was the sally-port of the town,) and he went and +came to Emmanuel with it. Now how it came out, I do not +know; but for certain it did, and that so far as to reach the +ears of Diabolus. Thus I conclude, because that the tyrant +had it presently by the end, and charged the town of Mansoul with +it, saying, ‘Thou rebellious and stubborn-hearted Mansoul, +I will make thee to leave off petitioning. Art thou yet for +petitioning? I will make thee to leave.’ Yea, +he also knew who the messenger was that carried the petition to +the Prince, and it made him both to fear and rage.</p> +<p>Wherefore he commanded that his drum should be beat again, a +thing that Mansoul could not abide to hear: but when Diabolus +will have his drum beat, Mansoul must abide the noise. +Well, the drum was beat, and the Diabolonians were gathered +together.</p> +<p>Then said Diabolus, ‘O ye stout Diabolonians, be it +known unto you, that there is treachery hatched against us in the +rebellious town of Mansoul; for albeit the town is in our +possession, as you see, yet these miserable Mansoulians have +attempted to dare, and have been so hardy as yet to send to the +court to Emmanuel for help. This I give you to understand, +that ye may yet know how to carry it to the wretched town of +Mansoul. Wherefore, O my trusty Diabolonians, I command +that yet more and more ye distress this town of Mansoul, and vex +it with your wiles, ravish their women, deflower their virgins, +slay their children, brain their ancients, fire their town, and +what other mischief you can; and let this be the reward of the +Mansoulians from me, for their desperate rebellions against +me.’</p> +<p>This, you see, was the charge; but something stepped in +betwixt that and execution, for as yet there was but little more +done than to rage.</p> +<p>Moreover, when Diabolus had done thus, he went the next way up +to the castle gates, and demanded that, upon pain of death, the +gates should be opened to him, and that entrance should be given +him and his men that followed after. To whom Mr. Godly-Fear +replied, (for he it was that had the charge of that gate,) that +the gate should not be opened unto him, nor to the men that +followed after him. He said, moreover, that Mansoul, when +she had suffered awhile, should be made perfect, strengthened, +settled.</p> +<p>Then said Diabolus, ‘Deliver me, then, the men that have +petitioned against me, especially Captain Credence, that carried +it to your Prince; deliver that varlet into my hands, and I will +depart from the town.’</p> +<p>Then up starts a Diabolonian, whose name was Mr. Fooling, and +said, ‘My lord offereth you fair: it is better for you that +one man perish, than that your whole Mansoul should be +undone.’</p> +<p>But Mr. Godly-Fear made him this replication, ‘How long +will Mansoul be kept out of the dungeon, when she hath given up +her faith to Diabolus! As good lose the town, as lose +Captain Credence; for if one be gone the other must +follow.’ But to that Mr. Fooling said nothing.</p> +<p>Then did my Lord Mayor reply, and said, ‘O thou +devouring tyrant, be it known unto thee, we shall hearken to none +of thy words; we are resolved to resist thee as long as a +captain, a man, a sling, and a stone to throw at thee shall be +found in the town of Mansoul.’ But Diabolus answered, +‘Do you hope, do you wait, do you look for help and +deliverance? You have sent to Emmanuel, but your wickedness +sticks too close in your skirts, to let innocent prayers come out +of your lips. Think you that you shall be prevailers and +prosper in this design? You will fail in your wish, you +will fail in your attempts; for it is not only I, but your +Emmanuel is against you: yea, it is he that hath sent me against +you to subdue you. For what, then, do you hope? or by what +means will you escape?’</p> +<p>Then said the Lord Mayor, ‘We have sinned indeed; but +that shall be no help to thee, for our Emmanuel hath said it, and +that in great faithfulness, “and him that cometh to me I +will in no wise cast out.” He hath also told us, O +our enemy, that “all manner of sin and blasphemy shall be +forgiven” to the sons of men. Therefore we dare not +despair, but will look for, wait for, and hope for deliverance +still.’</p> +<p>Now, by this time, Captain Credence was returned and come from +the court from Emmanuel to the castle of Mansoul, and he returned +to them with a packet. So my Lord Mayor, hearing that +Captain Credence was come, withdrew himself from the noise of the +roaring of the tyrant, and left him to yell at the wall of the +town, or against the gates of the castle. So he came up to +the captain’s lodgings, and saluting him, he asked him of +his welfare, and what was the best news at court. But when +he asked Captain Credence that, the water stood in his +eyes. Then said the captain, ‘Cheer up, my lord, for +all will be well in time.’ And with that he first +produced his packet, and laid it by; but that the Lord Mayor, and +the rest of the captains, took for sign of good tidings. +Now a season of grace being come, he sent for all the captains +and elders of the town, that were here and there in their +lodgings in the castle and upon their guard, to let them know +that Captain Credence was returned from the court, and that he +had something in general, and something in special, to +communicate to them. So they all came up to him, and +saluted him, and asked him concerning his journey, and what was +the best news at the court. And he answered them as he had +done the Lord Mayor before, that all would be well at last. +Now, when the captain had thus saluted them, he opened his +packet, and thence did draw out his several notes for those that +he had sent for.</p> +<p>And the first note was for my Lord Mayor, wherein was +signified:—That the Prince Emmanuel had taken it well that +my Lord Mayor had been so true and trusty in his office, and the +great concerns that lay upon him for the town and people of +Mansoul. Also, he bid him to know, that he took it well +that he had been so bold for his Prince Emmanuel, and had engaged +so faithfully in his cause against Diabolus. He also +signified, at the close of his letter, that he should shortly +receive his reward.</p> +<p>The second note that came out, was for the noble Lord +Willbewill, wherein there was signified:—That his Prince +Emmanuel did well understand how valiant and courageous he had +been for the honour of his Lord, now in his absence, and when his +name was under contempt by Diabolus. There was signified +also, that his Prince had taken it well that he had been so +faithful to the town of Mansoul, in his keeping of so strict a +hand and eye over and so strict a rein upon the neck of the +Diabolonians, that did still lie lurking in their several holes +in the famous town of Mansoul. He signified, moreover, how +that he understood that my Lord had, with his own hand, done +great execution upon some of the chief of the rebels there, to +the great discouragement of the adverse party and to the good +example of the whole town of Mansoul; and that shortly his +lordship should have his reward.</p> +<p>The third note came out for the subordinate preacher, wherein +was signified:—That his Prince took it well from him, that +he had so honestly and so faithfully performed his office, and +executed the trust committed to him by his Lord, while he +exhorted, rebuked, and forewarned Mansoul according to the laws +of the town. He signified, moreover, that he took it well +at his hand that he called to fasting, to sackcloth, and ashes, +when Mansoul was under her revolt. Also, that he called for +the aid of the Captain Boanerges to help in so weighty a work; +and that shortly he also should receive his reward.</p> +<p>The fourth note came out for Mr. Godly-Fear, wherein his Lord +thus signified:—That his Lordship observed, that he was the +first of all the men in Mansoul that detected Mr. Carnal-Security +as the only one that, through his subtlety and cunning, had +obtained for Diabolus a defection and decay of goodness in the +blessed town of Mansoul. Moreover, his Lord gave him to +understand, that he still remembered his tears and mourning for +the state of Mansoul. It was also observed, by the same +note, that his Lord took notice of his detecting of this Mr. +Carnal-Security, at his own table among his guests, in his own +house, and that in the midst of his jolliness, even while he was +seeking to perfect his villanies against the town of +Mansoul. Emmanuel also took notice that this reverend +person, Mr. Godly-Fear, stood stoutly to it, at the gates of the +castle, against all the threats and attempts of the tyrant; and +that he had put the townsmen in a way to make their petition to +their Prince, so as that he might accept thereof, and as they +might obtain an answer of peace; and that therefore shortly he +should receive his reward.</p> +<p>After all this, there was yet produced a note which was +written to the whole town of Mansoul, whereby they +perceived—That their Lord took notice of their so often +repeating of petitions to him; and that they should see more of +the fruits of such their doings in time to come. Their +Prince did also therein tell them, that he took it well, that +their heart and mind, now at last, abode fixed upon him and his +ways, though Diabolus had made such inroads upon them; and that +neither flatteries on the one hand, nor hardships on the other, +could make them yield to serve his cruel designs. There was +also inserted at the bottom of this note—That his Lordship +had left the town of Mansoul in the hands of the Lord Secretary, +and under the conduct of Captain Credence, saying, ‘Beware +that you yet yield yourselves unto their governance; and in due +time you shall receive your reward.’</p> +<p>So, after the brave Captain Credence had delivered his notes +to those to whom they belonged, he retired himself to my Lord +Secretary’s lodgings, and there spends time in conversing +with him; for they too were very great one with another, and did +indeed know more how things would go with Mansoul than did all +the townsmen besides. The Lord Secretary also loved the +Captain Credence dearly; yea, many a good bit was sent him from +my Lord’s table; also, he might have a show of countenance, +when the rest of Mansoul lay under the clouds: so, after some +time for converse was spent, the captain betook himself to his +chambers to rest. But it was not long after when my Lord +did send for the captain again; so the captain came to him, and +they greeted one another with usual salutations. Then said +the captain to the Lord Secretary, ‘What hath my Lord to +say to his servant?’ So the Lord Secretary took him +and had him aside, and after a sign or two of more favour, he +said, ‘I have made thee the Lord’s lieutenant over +all the forces in Mansoul; so that, from this day forward, all +men in Mansoul shall be at thy word; and thou shalt be he that +shall lead in, and that shall lead out Mansoul. Thou shalt +therefore manage, according to thy place, the war for thy Prince, +and for the town of Mansoul, against the force and power of +Diabolus; and at thy command shall the rest of the captains +be.’</p> +<p>Now the townsmen began to perceive what interest the captain +had, both with the court, and also with the Lord Secretary in +Mansoul; for no man before could speed when sent, nor bring such +good news from Emmanuel as he. Wherefore what do they, +after some lamentation that they made no more use of him in their +distresses, but send by their subordinate preacher to the Lord +Secretary, to desire him that all that ever they were and had +might be put under the government, care, custody, and conduct of +Captain Credence.</p> +<p>So their preacher went and did his errand, and received this +answer from the mouth of his Lord: that Captain Credence should +be the great doer in all the King’s army, against the +King’s enemies, and also for the welfare of Mansoul. +So he bowed to the ground, and thanked his Lordship, and returned +and told his news to the townsfolk. But all this was done +with all imaginable secrecy, because the foes had yet great +strength in the town. But to return to our story again.</p> +<p>When Diabolus saw himself thus boldly confronted by the Lord +Mayor, and perceived the stoutness of Mr. Godly-Fear, he fell +into a rage, and forthwith called a council of war, that he might +be revenged on Mansoul. So all the princes of the pit came +together, and old Incredulity at the head of them, with all the +captains of his army. So they consult what to do. Now +the effect and conclusion of the council that day was how they +might take the castle, because they could not conclude themselves +masters of the town so long as that was in the possession of +their enemies.</p> +<p>So one advised this way, and another advised that; but when +they could not agree in their verdict, Apollyon, that president +of the council, stood up, and thus he began: ‘My +brotherhood,’ quoth he, ‘I have two things to +propound unto you; and my first is this. Let us withdraw +ourselves from the town into the plain again, for our presence +here will do us no good, because the castle is yet in our +enemies’ hands; nor is it possible that we should take +that, so long as so many brave captains are in it, and that this +bold fellow, Godly-Fear, is made the keeper of the gates of +it. Now, when we have withdrawn ourselves into the plain, +they, of their own accord, will be glad of some little ease; and +it may be, of their own accord, they again may begin to be +remiss, and even their so being will give them a bigger blow than +we can possibly give them ourselves. But if that should +fail, our going forth of the town may draw the captains out after +us; and you know what it cost them when we fought them in the +field before. Besides, can we but draw them out into the +field, we may lay an ambush behind the town, which shall, when +they are come forth abroad, rush in and take possession of the +castle.’</p> +<p>But Beelzebub stood up, and replied, saying: ‘It is +impossible to draw them all off from the castle; some, you may be +sure, will lie there to keep that; wherefore it will be but in +vain thus to attempt, unless we were sure that they will all come +out.’ He therefore concluded that what was done must +be done by some other means. And the most likely means that +the greatest of their heads could invent, was that which Apollyon +had advised to before, namely, to get the townsmen again to +sin. ‘For,’ said he, ‘it is not our being +in the town, nor in the field, nor our fighting, nor our killing +of their men, that can make us the masters of Mansoul; for so +long as one in the town is able to lift up his finger against us, +Emmanuel will take their parts; and if he shall take their parts, +we know what time of day it will be with us. Wherefore, for +my part,’ quoth he, ‘there is, in my judgment, no way +to bring them into bondage to us, like inventing a way to make +them sin. Had we,’ said he, ‘left all our +doubters at home, we had done as well as we have done now, unless +we could have made them the masters and governors of the castle; +for doubters at a distance are but like objections refelled with +arguments. Indeed, can we but get them into the hold, and +make them possessors of that, the day will be our own. Let +us, therefore, withdraw ourselves into the plain, (not expecting +that the captains in Mansoul should follow us,) but yet, I say, +let us do this, and before we so do, let us advise again with our +trusty Diabolonians that are yet in their holds of Mansoul, and +set them to work to betray the town to us; for they indeed must +do it, or it will be left undone for ever.’ By these +sayings of Beelzebub, (for I think it was he that gave this +counsel,) the whole conclave was forced to be of his opinion, +namely, that the way to get the castle was to get the town to +sin. Then they fell to inventing by what means they might +do this thing.</p> +<p>Then Lucifer stood up, and said: ‘The counsel of +Beelzebub is pertinent. Now, the way to bring this to pass, +in mine opinion, is this: let us withdraw our force from the town +of Mansoul; let us do this, and let us terrify them no more, +either with summons, or threats, or with the noise of our drum, +or any other awakening means. Only let us lie in the field +at a distance, and be as if we regarded them not; for frights, I +see, do but awaken them, and make them more stand to their +arms. I have also another stratagem in my head: you know +Mansoul is a market-town, and a town that delights in commerce; +what, therefore, if some of our Diabolonians shall feign +themselves far-country men, and shall go out and bring to the +market of Mansoul some of our wares to sell; and what matter at +what rates they sell their wares, though it be but for half the +worth? Now, let those that thus shall trade in their market +be those that are witty and true to us, and I will lay my crown +to pawn it will do. There are two that are come to my +thoughts already, that I think will be arch at this work, and +they are Mr. Penny-wise-pound-foolish, and Mr. +Get-i’the-hundred-and-lose-i’the-shire; nor is this +man with the long name at all inferior to the other. What, +also, if you join with them Mr. Sweet-world and Mr. Present-good; +they are men that are civil and cunning, but our true friends and +helpers. Let these, with as many more, engage in this +business for us, and let Mansoul be taken up in much business, +and let them grow full and rich, and this is the way to get +ground of them. Remember ye not that thus we prevailed upon +Laodicea, and how many at present do we hold in this snare? +Now, when they begin to grow full, they will forget their misery; +and if we shall not affright them, they may happen to fall +asleep, and so be got to neglect their town watch, their castle +watch, as well as their watch at the gates.</p> +<p>‘Yea, may we not, by this means, so cumber Mansoul with +abundance, that they shall be forced to make of their castle a +warehouse, instead of a garrison fortified against us, and a +receptacle for men of war. Thus, if we get our goods and +commodities thither, I reckon that the castle is more than half +ours. Besides, could we so order it that it shall be filled +with such kind of wares, then if we made a sudden assault upon +them, it would be hard for the captains to take shelter +there. Do you not know that of the parable, “The +deceitfulness of riches choke the word”? and again, +“When the heart is over-charged with surfeiting and +drunkenness, and the cares of this life,” all mischief +comes upon them at unawares?</p> +<p>‘Furthermore, my lords,’ quoth he, ‘you very +well know that it is not easy for a people to be filled with our +things, and not to have some of our Diabolonians as retainers to +their houses and services. Where is a Mansoulian that is +full of this world, that has not for his servants and +waiting-men, Mr. Profuse, or Mr. Prodigality, or some other of +our Diabolonian gang, as Mr. Voluptuous, Mr. Pragmatical, Mr. +Ostentation, or the like? Now these can take the castle of +Mansoul, or blow it up, or make it unfit for a garrison for +Emmanuel, and any of these will do. Yea, these, for aught I +know, may do it for us sooner than an army of twenty thousand +men. Wherefore, to end as I began, my advice is, that we +quietly withdraw ourselves, not offering any further force, or +forcible attempts, upon the castle, at least at this time; and +let us set on foot our new project, and let us see if that will +not make them destroy themselves.’</p> +<p>This advice was highly applauded by them all, and was +accounted the very masterpiece of hell, namely, to choke Mansoul +with a fulness of this world, and to surfeit her heart with the +good things thereof. But see how things meet +together! Just as this Diabolonian council was broken up, +Captain Credence received a letter from Emmanuel, the contents of +which were these: That upon the third day he would meet him in +the field in the plains about Mansoul. ‘Meet me in +the field!’ quoth the Captain; ‘what meaneth my lord +by this? I know not what he meaneth by meeting me in the +field.’ So he took the note in his hand, and did +carry it to my Lord Secretary, to ask his thoughts thereupon; for +my Lord was a seer in all matters concerning the King, and also +for the good and comfort of the town of Mansoul. So he +showed my Lord the note, and desired his opinion thereof. +‘For my part,’ quoth Captain Credence, ‘I know +not the meaning thereof.’ So my lord did take and +read it and, after a little pause, he said, ‘The +Diabolonians have had against Mansoul a great consultation +to-day; they have, I say, this day been contriving the utter ruin +of the town; and the result of their council is, to set Mansoul +into such a way which, if taken, will surely make her destroy +herself. And, to this end, they are making ready for their +own departure out of the town, intending to betake themselves to +the field again,’ and there to lie till they shall see +whether this their project will take or no. But be thou +ready with the men of thy Lord, (for on the third day they will +be in the plain,) there to fall upon the Diabolonians; for the +Prince will by that time be in the field; yea, by that it is +break of day, sun-rising, or before, and that with a mighty force +against them. So he shall be before them, and thou shalt be +behind them, and betwixt you both their army shall be +destroyed.’</p> +<p>When Captain Credence heard this, away goes he to the rest of +the captains, and tells them what a note he had a while since +received from the hand of Emmanuel. ‘And,’ said +he, ‘that which was dark therein hath my lord the Lord +Secretary expounded unto me.’ He told them, moreover, +what by himself and by them must be done to answer the mind of +their Lord. Then were the captains glad; and Captain +Credence commanded that all the King’s trumpeters should +ascend to the battlements of the castle, and there, in the +audience of Diabolus and of the whole town of Mansoul, make the +best music that heart could invent. The trumpeters then did +as they were commanded. They got themselves up to the top +of the castle, and thus they began to sound. Then did +Diabolus start, and said, ‘What can be the meaning of this? +they neither sound Boot-and-saddle, nor Horse-and-away, nor a +charge. What do these madmen mean that yet they should be +so merry and glad?’ Then answered one of themselves +and said, ‘This is for joy that their Prince Emmanuel is +coming to relieve the town of Mansoul; and to this end he is at +the head of an army, and that this relief is near.’</p> +<p>The men of Mansoul also were greatly concerned at this +melodious charm of the trumpets; they said, yea, they answered +one another, saying, ‘This can be no harm to us; surely +this can be no harm to us.’ Then said the +Diabolonians, ‘What had we best to do?’ and it was +answered, ‘It was best to quit the town;’ and +‘that,’ said one, ‘ye may do in pursuance of +your last counsel, and by so doing also be better able to give +the enemy battle, should an army from without come upon us. +So, on the second day, they withdrew themselves from Mansoul, and +abode in the plains without; but they encamped themselves before +Eye-gate, in what terrene and terrible manner they could. +The reason why they would not abide in the town (besides the +reasons that were debated in their late conclave) was, for that +they were not possessed of the stronghold, and +‘because,’ said they, ‘we shall have more +convenience to fight, and also to fly, if need be, when we are +encamped in the open plains.’ Besides, the town would +have been a pit for them rather than a place of defence, had the +Prince come up and inclosed them fast therein. Therefore +they betook themselves to the field, that they might also be out +of the reach of the slings, by which they were much annoyed all +the while that they were in the town.</p> +<p>Well, the time that the captains were to fall upon the +Diabolonians being come, they eagerly prepared themselves for +action; for Captain Credence had told the captains over night, +that they should meet their Prince in the field to-morrow. +This, therefore, made them yet far more desirous to be engaging +the enemy; for ‘You shall see the Prince in the field +to-morrow’ was like oil to a flaming fire, for of a long +time they had been at a distance: they therefore were for this +the more earnest and desirous of the work. So, as I said, +the hour being come, Captain Credence, with the rest of the men +of war, drew out their forces before it was day by the sally-port +of the town. And, being all ready, Captain Credence went up +to the head of the army, and gave to the rest of the captains the +word, and so they to their under-officers and soldiers: the word +was ‘The sword of the Prince Emmanuel, and the shield of +Captain Credence;’ which is, in the Mansoulian tongue, +‘The word of God and faith.’ Then the captains +fell on, and began roundly to front, and flank, and rear +Diabolus’s camp.</p> +<p>Now, they left Captain Experience in the town, because he was +yet ill of his wounds, which the Diabolonians had given him in +the last fight. But when he perceived that the captains +were at it, what does he but, calling for his crutches with +haste, gets up, and away he goes to the battle, saying, +‘Shall I lie here, when my brethren are in the fight, and +when Emmanuel, the Prince, will show himself in the field to his +servants?’ But when the enemy saw the man come with +his crutches, they were daunted yet the more; ‘for,’ +thought they, ‘what spirit has possessed these Mansoulians, +that they fight us upon their crutches?’ Well, the +captains, as I said, fell on, and did bravely handle their +weapons, still crying out and shouting, as they laid on blows, +‘The sword of the Prince Emmanuel, and the shield of +Captain Credence!’</p> +<p>Now, when Diabolus saw that the captains were come out, and +that so valiantly they surrounded his men, he concluded that, for +the present, nothing from them was to be looked for but blows, +and the dints of their ‘two-edged sword.’</p> +<p>Wherefore he also falls on upon the Prince’s army with +all his deadly force: so the battle was joined. Now who was +it that at first Diabolus met with in the fight, but Captain +Credence on the one hand, and the Lord Willbewill on the other: +now Willbewill’s blows were like the blows of a giant, for +that man had a strong arm, and he fell in upon the election +doubters, for they were the life-guard of Diabolus, and he kept +them in play a good while, cutting and battering shrewdly. +Now when Captain Credence saw my lord engaged, he did stoutly +fall on, on the other hand, upon the same company also; so they +put them to great disorder. Now Captain Good-Hope had +engaged the vocation doubters, and they were sturdy men; but the +captain was a valiant man: Captain Experience did also send him +some aid; so he made the vocation doubters to retreat. The +rest of the armies were hotly engaged, and that on every side, +and the Diabolonians did fight stoutly. Then did my Lord +Secretary command that the slings from the castle should be +played; and his men could throw stones at an hair’s +breadth. But, after a while, those that were made to fly +before the captains of the Prince, did begin to rally again, and +they came up stoutly upon the rear of the Prince’s army: +wherefore the Prince’s army began to faint; but, +remembering that they should see the face of their Prince +by-and-by, they took courage, and a very fierce battle was +fought. Then shouted the captains, saying, ‘The sword +of the Prince Emmanuel, and the shield of Captain +Credence!’ and with that Diabolus gave back, thinking that +more aid had been come. But no Emmanuel as yet +appeared. Moreover, the battle did hang in doubt; and they +made a little retreat on both sides. Now, in the time of +respite, Captain Credence bravely encouraged his men to stand to +it; and Diabolus did the like, as well as he could. But +Captain Credence made a brave speech to his soldiers, the +contents whereof here follow:—</p> +<p>‘Gentlemen soldiers, and my brethren in this design, it +rejoiceth me much to see in the field for our Prince, this day, +so stout and so valiant an army, and such faithful lovers of +Mansoul. You have hitherto, as hath become you, shown +yourselves men of truth and courage against the Diabolonian +forces; so that, for all their boast, they have not yet much +cause to boast of their gettings. Now take to yourselves +your wonted courage, and show yourselves men even this once only; +for in a few minutes after the next engagement, this time, you +shall see your Prince show himself in the field; for we must make +this second assault upon this tyrant Diabolus, and then Emmanuel +comes.’</p> +<p>No sooner had the captain made this speech to his soldiers, +but one Mr. Speedy came post to the captain from the Prince, to +tell him that Emmanuel was at hand. This news when the +captain had received, he communicated to the other +field-officers, and they again to their soldiers and men of +war. Wherefore, like men raised from the dead, so the +captains and their men arose, made up to the enemy, and cried as +before, ‘The sword of the Prince Emmanuel, and the shield +of Captain Credence!’</p> +<p>The Diabolonians also bestirred themselves, and made +resistance as well as they could; but in this last engagement the +Diabolonians lost their courage, and many of the doubters fell +down dead to the ground. Now, when they had been in heat of +battle about an hour or more, Captain Credence lift up his eyes +and saw, and, behold, Emmanuel came; and he came with colours +flying, trumpets sounding, and the feet of his men scarce touched +the ground, they hasted with that celerity towards the captains +that were engaged. Then did Credence wind with his men to +the townward, and gave to Diabolus the field: so Emmanuel came +upon him on the one side, and the enemies’ place was +betwixt them both. Then again they fell to it afresh; and +now it was but a little while more but Emmanuel and Captain +Credence met, still trampling down the slain as they came.</p> +<p>But when the captains saw that the Prince was come, and that +he fell upon the Diabolonians on the other side, and that Captain +Credence and his Highness had got them up betwixt them, they +shouted, (they so shouted that the ground rent again,) saying, +‘The sword of Emmanuel, and the shield of Captain +Credence!’ Now, when Diabolus saw that he and his +forces were so hard beset by the Prince and his princely army, +what does he, and the lords of the pit that were with him, but +make their escape, and forsake their army, and leave them to fall +by the hand of Emmanuel, and of his noble Captain Credence: so +they fell all down slain before them, before the Prince, and +before his royal army; there was not left so much as one doubter +alive; they lay spread upon the ground dead men, as one would +spread dung upon the land.</p> +<p>When the battle was over, all things came into order in the +camp. Then the captains and elders of Mansoul came together +to salute Emmanuel, while without the corporation: so they +saluted him, and welcomed him, and that with a thousand welcomes, +for that he was come to the borders of Mansoul again. So he +smiled upon them, and said, ‘Peace be to you.’ +Then they addressed themselves to go to the town; they went then +to go up to Mansoul, they, the Prince, with all the new forces +that now he had brought with him to the war. Also all the +gates of the town were set open for his reception, so glad were +they of his blessed return. And this was the manner and +order of this going of his into Mansoul:</p> +<p>First. As I said, all the gates of the town were set +open, yea, the gates of the castle also; the elders, too, of the +town of Mansoul placed themselves at the gates of the town, to +salute him at his entrance thither: and so they did; for, as he +drew near, and approached towards the gates, they said, +‘Lift up your heads, O ye gates; and be ye lift up, ye +everlasting doors; and the King of glory shall come +in.’ And they answered again, ‘Who is the King +of glory?’ and they made return to themselves, ‘The +Lord, strong and mighty; the Lord mighty in battle. Lift up +your heads, O ye gates; even lift them up, ye everlasting +doors,’ etc.</p> +<p>Secondly. It was ordered also, by those of Mansoul, that +all the way from the town gates to those of the castle, his +blessed Majesty should be entertained with the song, by them that +had the best skill in music in all the town of Mansoul: then did +the elders, and the rest of the men of Mansoul, answer one +another as Emmanuel entered the town, till he came at the castle +gates, with songs and sound of trumpets, saying, ‘They have +seen thy goings, O God; even the goings of my God, my King, in +the sanctuary. So the singers went before, the players on +instruments followed after, and among them were the damsels +playing on timbrels.’</p> +<p>Thirdly. Then the captains, (for I would speak a word of +them,) they in their order waited on the Prince, as he entered +into the gates of Mansoul. Captain Credence went before, +and Captain Good-Hope with him; Captain Charity came behind with +other of his companions, and Captain Patience followed after all; +and the rest of the captains, some on the right hand, and some on +the left, accompanied Emmanuel into Mansoul. And all the +while the colours were displayed, the trumpets sounded, and +continual shoutings were among the soldiers. The Prince +himself rode into the town in his armour, which was all of beaten +gold, and in his chariot—the pillars of it were of silver, +the bottom thereof of gold, the covering of it was of purple, the +midst thereof being paved with love for the daughters of the town +of Mansoul.</p> +<p>Fourthly. When the Prince was come to the entrance of +Mansoul, he found all the streets strewed with lilies and +flowers, curiously decked with boughs and branches from the green +trees that stood round about the town. Every door also was +filled with persons, who had adorned every one their fore-part +against their house with something of variety and singular +excellency, to entertain him withal as he passed in the streets: +they also themselves, as Emmanuel passed by, did welcome him with +shouts and acclamations of joy, saying, ‘Blessed be the +Prince that cometh in the name of his Father Shaddai.’</p> +<p>Fifthly. At the castle gates the elders of Mansoul, +namely, the Lord Mayor, the Lord Willbewill, the subordinate +preacher, Mr. Knowledge, and Mr. Mind, with other of the gentry +of the place, saluted Emmanuel again. They bowed before +him, they kissed the dust of his feet, they thanked, they +blessed, and praised his Highness for not taking advantage +against them for their sins, but rather had pity upon them in +their misery, and returned to them with mercies, and to build up +their Mansoul for ever. Thus was he had up straightway to +the castle; for that was the royal palace, and the place where +his honour was to dwell; the which was ready prepared for his +Highness by the presence of the Lord Secretary, and the work of +Captain Credence. So he entered in.</p> +<p>Sixthly. Then the people and commonalty of the town of +Mansoul came to him into the castle to mourn, and to weep, and to +lament for their wickedness, by which they had forced him out of +the town. So when they were come, bowed themselves to the +ground seven times; they also wept, they wept aloud, and asked +forgiveness of the Prince, and prayed that he would again, as of +old, confirm his love to Mansoul.</p> +<p>To the which the great Prince replied, ‘Weep not, but go +your way, eat the fat, and drink the sweet, and send portions to +them for whom nought is prepared; for the joy of your Lord is +your strength. I am returned to Mansoul with mercies, and +my name shall be set up, exalted, and magnified by +it.’ He also took these inhabitants, and kissed them, +and laid them in his bosom.</p> +<p>Moreover, he gave to the elders of Mansoul, and to each town +officer, a chain of gold and a signet. He also sent to +their wives earrings and jewels, and bracelets, and other +things. He also bestowed upon the true-born children of +Mansoul many precious things.</p> +<p>When Emmanuel, the Prince, had done all these things for the +famous town of Mansoul, then he said unto them, first, +‘Wash your garments, then put on your ornaments, and then +come to me into the castle of Mansoul.’ So they went +to the fountain that was set open for Judah and Jerusalem to wash +in; and there they washed, and there they made their +‘garments white,’ and came again to the Prince into +the castle, and thus they stood before him.</p> +<p>And now there was music and dancing throughout the whole town +of Mansoul, and that because their Prince had again granted to +them his presence and the light of his countenance; the bells +also did ring, and the sun shone comfortably upon them for a +great while together.</p> +<p>The town of Mansoul did also now more thoroughly seek the +destruction and ruin of all remaining Diabolonians that abode in +the walls, and the dens that they had in the town of Mansoul; for +there was of them that had, to this day, escaped with life and +limb from the hand of their suppressors in the famous town of +Mansoul.</p> +<p>But my Lord Willbewill was a greater terror to them now than +ever he had been before; forasmuch as his heart was yet more +fully bent to seek, contrive, and pursue them to the death; he +pursued them night and day, and did put them now to sore +distress, as will afterwards appear.</p> +<p>After things were thus far put into order in the famous town +of Mansoul, care was taken, and order given by the blessed Prince +Emmanuel, that the townsmen should, without further delay, +appoint some to go forth into the plain to bury the dead that +were there,—the dead that fell by the sword of Emmanuel, +and by the shield of the Captain Credence,—lest the fumes +and ill savours that would arise from them might infect the air, +and so annoy the famous town of Mansoul. This also was a +reason of this order, namely, that, as much as in Mansoul lay, +they might cut off the name, and being, and remembrance of those +enemies from the thought of the famous town of Mansoul and its +inhabitants.</p> +<p>So order was given out by the Lord Mayor, that wise and trusty +friend of the town of Mansoul, that persons should be employed +about this necessary business; and Mr. Godly-Fear, and one Mr. +Upright, were to be overseers about this matter: so persons were +put under them to work in the fields, and to bury the slain that +lay dead in the plains. And these were their places of +employment: some were to make the graves, some to bury the dead, +and some were to go to and fro in the plains, and also round +about the borders of Mansoul, to see if a skull, or a bone, or a +piece of a bone of a doubter, was yet to be found above ground +anywhere near the corporation; and if any were found, it was +ordered, that the searchers that searched should set up a mark +thereby, and a sign, that those that were appointed to bury them +might find it, and bury it out of sight, that the name and +remembrance of a Diabolonian doubter might be blotted out from +under heaven; and that the children, and they that were to be +born in Mansoul, might not know, if possible, what a skull, what +a bone, or a piece of a bone of a doubter was. So the +buriers, and those that were appointed for that purpose, did as +they were commanded: they buried the doubters, and all the skulls +and bones, and pieces of bones of doubters, wherever they found +them; and so they cleansed the plains. Now also Mr. +God’s-Peace took up his commission, and acted again as in +former days.</p> +<p>Thus they buried in the plains about Mansoul the election +doubters, the vocation doubters, the grace doubters, the +perseverance doubters, the resurrection doubters, the salvation +doubters, and the glory doubters; whose captains were Captain +Rage, Captain Cruel, Captain Damnation, Captain Insatiable, +Captain Brimstone, Captain Torment, Captain No-Ease, Captain +Sepulchre, and Captain Past-Hope; and old Incredulity was, under +Diabolus, their general. There were also the seven heads of +their army; and they were the Lord Beelzebub, the Lord Lucifer, +the Lord Legion, the Lord Apollyon, the Lord Python, the Lord +Cerberus, and the Lord Belial. But the princes and the +captains, with old Incredulity, their general, did all of them +make their escape: so their men fell down slain by the power of +the Prince’s forces, and by the hands of the men of the +town of Mansoul. They also were buried as is afore related, +to the exceeding great joy of the now famous town of +Mansoul. They that buried them buried also with them their +arms, which were cruel instruments of death: (their weapons were +arrows, darts, mauls, firebrands, and the like). They +buried also their armour, their colours, banners, with the +standard of Diabolus, and what else soever they could find that +did but smell of a Diabolonian doubter.</p> +<p>Now when the tyrant had arrived at Hell-Gate Hill, with his +old friend Incredulity, they immediately descended the den, and +having there with their fellows for a while condoled their +misfortune and great loss that they sustained against the town of +Mansoul, they fell at length into a passion, and revenged they +would be for the loss that they sustained before the town of +Mansoul. Wherefore they presently call a council to +contrive yet further what was to be done against the famous town +of Mansoul; for their yawning paunches could not wait to see the +result of their Lord Lucifer’s and their Lord +Apollyon’s counsel that they had given before; for their +raging gorge thought every day, even as long as a short for ever, +until they were filled with the body and soul, with the flesh and +bones, and with all the delicates of Mansoul. They +therefore resolve to make another attempt upon the town of +Mansoul, and that by an army mixed and made up partly of +doubters, and partly of blood-men. A more particular +account now take of both.</p> +<p>The doubters are such as have their name from their nature, as +well as from the land and kingdom where they are born: their +nature is to put a question upon every one of the truths of +Emmanuel; and their country is called the land of Doubting, and +that land lieth off, and farthest remote to the north, between +the land of Darkness and that called the ‘valley of the +shadow of death.’ For though the land of Darkness, +and that called ‘the valley of the shadow of death,’ +be sometimes called as if they were one and the self-same place, +yet indeed they are two, lying but a little way asunder, and the +land of Doubting points in, and lieth between them. This is +the land of Doubting; and these that came with Diabolus to ruin +the town of Mansoul are the natives of that country.</p> +<p>The blood-men are a people that have their name derived from +the malignity of their nature, and from the fury that is in them +to execute it upon the town of Mansoul: their land lieth under +the dog-star, and by that they are governed as to their +intellectuals. The name of their country is the province of +Loath-good: the remote parts of it are far distant from the land +of Doubting, yet they do both butt and bound upon the hill called +Hell-Gate Hill. These people are always in league with the +doubters, for they jointly do make question of the faith and +fidelity of the men of the town of Mansoul, and so are both alike +qualified for the service of their prince.</p> +<p>Now of these two countries did Diabolus, by the beating of his +drum, raise another army against the town of Mansoul, of +five-and-twenty thousand strong. There were ten thousand +doubters, and fifteen thousand blood-men, and they were put under +several captains for the war; and old Incredulity was again made +general of the army.</p> +<p>As for the doubters, their captains were five of the seven +that were heads of the last Diabolonian army, and these are their +names: Captain Beelzebub, Captain Lucifer, Captain Apollyon, +Captain Legion, and Captain Cerberus; and the captains that they +had before were some of them made lieutenants, and some ensigns +of the army.</p> +<p>But Diabolus did not count that, in this expedition of his, +these doubters would prove his principal men, for their manhood +had been tried before; also the Mansoulians had put them to the +worst: only he did bring them to multiply a number, and to help, +if need was, at a pinch. But his trust he put in his +blood-men, for that they were all rugged villains, and he knew +that they had done feats heretofore.</p> +<p>As for the blood-men, they also were under command and the +names of their captains were, Captain Cain, Captain Nimrod, +Captain Ishmael, Captain Esau, Captain Saul, Captain Absalom, +Captain Judas, and Captain Pope.</p> +<p>1. Captain Cain was over two bands, namely, the zealous and +the angry blood-men: his standard-bearer bare the red colours, +and his scutcheon was the murdering club.</p> +<p>2. Captain Nimrod was captain over two bands, namely, the +tyrannical and encroaching blood-men: his standard-bearer bare +the red colours, and his scutcheon was the great bloodhound.</p> +<p>3. Captain Ishmael was captain over two bands, namely, the +mocking and scorning blood-men: his standard-bearer bare the red +colours, and his scutcheon was one mocking at Abraham’s +Isaac.</p> +<p>4. Captain Esau was captain over two bands, namely, the +blood-men that grudged that another should have the blessing; +also over the blood-men that are for executing their private +revenge upon others: his standard-bearer bare the red colours, +and his scutcheon was one privately lurking to murder Jacob.</p> +<p>5. Captain Saul was captain over two bands, namely, the +groundlessly jealous and the devilishly furious blood-men: his +standard-bearer bare the red colours, and his scutcheon was three +bloody darts cast at harmless David.</p> +<p>6. Captain Absalom was captain over two bands, namely, over +the blood-men that will kill a father or a friend for the glory +of this world; also over those blood-men that will hold one fair +in hand with words, till they shall have pierced him with their +swords: his standard-bearer did bear the red colours, and his +scutcheon was the son pursuing the father’s blood.</p> +<p>7. Captain Judas was over two bands, namely, the blood-men +that will sell a man’s life for money, and those also that +will betray their friend with a kiss: his standard-bearer bare +the red colours, and his scutcheon was thirty pieces of silver +and the halter.</p> +<p>8. Captain Pope was captain over one band, for all these +spirits are joined in one under him: his standard-bearer bare the +red colours, and his scutcheon was the stake, the flame, and the +good man in it.</p> +<p>Now, the reason why Diabolus did so soon rally another force, +after he had been beaten out of the field, was, for that he put +mighty confidence in this army of blood-men; for he put a great +deal of more trust in them than he did before in his army of +doubters; though they had also often done great service for him +in the strengthening of him in his kingdom. But these +blood-men, he had proved them often, and their sword did seldom +return empty. Besides, he knew that these, like mastiffs, +would fasten upon any; upon father, mother, brother, sister, +prince, or governor, yea upon the Prince of princes. And +that which encouraged him the more was, for that they once did +force Emmanuel out of the kingdom of Universe; ‘And +why,’ thought he, ‘may they not also drive him from +the town of Mansoul?’</p> +<p>So this army of five-and-twenty thousand strong was, by their +general, the great Lord Incredulity, led up against the town of +Mansoul. Now Mr. Prywell, the scoutmaster-general, did +himself go out to spy, and he did bring Mansoul tidings of their +coming. Wherefore they shut up their gates, and put +themselves in a posture of defence against these new Diabolonians +that came up against the town.</p> +<p>So Diabolus brought up his army, and beleaguered the town of +Mansoul; the doubters were placed about Feel-gate, and the +blood-men set down before Eye-gate and Ear-gate.</p> +<p>Now when this army had thus encamped themselves, Incredulity +did, in the name of Diabolus, his own name, and in the name of +the blood-men and the rest that were with him, send a summons as +hot as a red-hot iron to Mansoul, to yield to their demands; +threatening, that if they still stood it out against them, they +would presently burn down Mansoul with fire. For you must +know that, as for the blood-men, they were not so much that +Mansoul should be surrendered, as that Mansoul should be +destroyed, and cut off out of the land of the living. True, +they send to them to surrender; but should they so do, that would +not stench or quench the thirsts of these men. They must +have blood, the blood of Mansoul, else they die; and it is from +hence that they have their name. Wherefore these blood-men +he reserved while now that they might, when all his engines +proved ineffectual, as his last and sure card be played against +the town of Mansoul.</p> +<p>Now, when the townsmen had received this red-hot summons, it +begat in them at present some changing and interchanging +thoughts; but they jointly agreed, in less than half an hour, to +carry the summons to the Prince, the which they did when they had +writ at the bottom of it, ‘Lord, save Mansoul from bloody +men!’</p> +<p>So he took it, and looked upon it, and considered it, and took +notice also of that short petition that the men of Mansoul had +written at the bottom of it, and called to him the noble Captain +Credence, and bid him go and take Captain Patience with him, and +go and take care of that side of Mansoul that was beleaguered by +the blood-men. So they went and did as they were commanded: +the Captain Credence went and took Captain Patience, and they +both secured that side of Mansoul that was besieged by the +blood-men.</p> +<p>Then he commanded that Captain Good-hope and Captain Charity, +and my Lord Willbewill, should take charge of the other side of +the town. ‘And I,’ said the Prince, ‘will +set my standard upon the battlements of your castle, and do you +three watch against the doubters.’ This done, he +again commanded that the brave captain, the Captain Experience, +should draw up his men in the market-place, and that there he +should exercise them day by day before the people of the town of +Mansoul. Now this siege was long, and many a fierce attempt +did the enemy, especially those called the blood-men, make upon +the town of Mansoul; and many a shrewd brush did some of the +townsmen meet with from them, especially Captain Self-Denial, +who, I should have told you before, was commanded to take the +care of Ear-gate and Eye-gate now against the blood-men. +This Captain Self-Denial was a young man, but stout, and a +townsman in Mansoul, as Captain Experience also was. And +Emmanuel, at his second return to Mansoul, made him a captain +over a thousand of the Mansoulians, for the good of the +corporation. This captain, therefore, being an hardy man, +and a man of great courage, and willing to venture himself for +the good of the town of Mansoul, would now and then sally out +upon the blood-men, and give them many notable alarms, and +entered several brisk skirmishes with them, and also did some +execution upon them; but you must think that this could not +easily be done, but he must meet with brushes himself, for he +carried several of their marks in his face; yea, and some in some +other parts of his body.</p> +<p>So, after some time spent for the trial of the faith, and +hope, and love of the town of Mansoul, the Prince Emmanuel upon a +day calls his captains and men of war together, and divides them +into two companies; this done, he commands them at a time +appointed, and that in the morning very early, to sally out upon +the enemy, saying: ‘Let half of you fall upon the doubters, +and half of you fall upon the blood-men. Those of you that +go out against the doubters, kill and slay, and cause to perish +so many of them as by any means you can lay hands on; but for you +that go out against the blood-men, slay them not, but take them +alive.’</p> +<p>So, at the time appointed, betimes in the morning, the +captains went out as they were commanded, against the +enemies. Captain Good-Hope, Captain Charity, and those that +were joined with them, as Captain Innocent and Captain +Experience, went out against the doubters; and Captain Credence, +and Captain Patience, with Captain Self-Denial, and the rest that +were to join with them, went out against the blood-men.</p> +<p>Now, those that went out against the doubters drew up into a +body before the plain, and marched on to bid them battle. +But the doubters, remembering their last success, made a retreat, +not daring to stand the shock, but fled from the Prince’s +men; wherefore they pursued them, and in their pursuit slew many, +but they could not catch them all. Now those that escaped +went some of them home; and the rest by fives, nines, and +seventeens, like wanderers, went straggling up and down the +country, where they upon the barbarous people showed and +exercised many of their Diabolonian actions: nor did these people +rise up in arms against them, but suffered themselves to be +enslaved by them. They would also after this show +themselves in companies before the town of Mansoul, but never to +abide in it; for if Captain Credence, Captain Good-Hope, or +Captain Experience did but show themselves, they fled.</p> +<p>Those that went out against the blood-men did as they were +commanded: they forbore to slay any, but sought to compass them +about. But the blood-men, when they saw that no Emmanuel +was in the field, concluded also that no Emmanuel was in Mansoul; +wherefore they, looking upon what the captains did to be, as they +called it, a fruit of the extravagancy of their wild and foolish +fancies, rather despised them than feared them. But the +captains, minding their business, at last did compass them round; +they also that had routed the doubters came in amain to their +aid: so, in fine, after some little struggling, (for the +blood-men also would have run for it, only now it was too late; +for though they are mischievous and cruel, where they can +overcome, yet all blood-men are chicken-hearted men, when they +once come to see themselves matched and equalled,)—so the +captains took them, and brought them to the Prince.</p> +<p>Now when they were taken, had before the Prince, and examined, +he found them to be of three several counties, though they all +came out of one land.</p> +<p>1. One sort of them came out of Blind-man-shire, and they were +such as did ignorantly what they did.</p> +<p>2. Another sort of them came out of Blind-zeal-shire, and they +did superstitiously what they did.</p> +<p>3. The third sort of them came out of the town of Malice, in +the county of Envy, and they did what they did out of spite and +implacableness.</p> +<p>For the first of these, namely, they that came out of +Blind-man-shire, when they saw where they were, and against whom +they had fought, they trembled and cried, as they stood before +him; and as many of these as asked him mercy, he touched their +lips with his golden sceptre.</p> +<p>They that came out of Blind-zeal-shire, they did not as their +fellows did; for they pleaded that they had a right to do what +they did, because Mansoul was a town whose laws and customs were +diverse from all that dwelt thereabouts. Very few of these +could be brought to see their evil; but those that did, and asked +mercy, they also obtained favour.</p> +<p>Now, they that came out of the town of Malice, that is in the +county of Envy, they neither wept, nor disputed, nor repented, +but stood gnawing their tongues before him for anguish and +madness, because they could not have their will upon +Mansoul. Now these last, with all those of the other two +sorts that did not unfeignedly ask pardon for their +faults,—those he made to enter into sufficient bond to +answer for what they had done against Mansoul, and against her +King, at the great and general assizes to be holden for our Lord +the King, where he himself should appoint for the country and +kingdom of Universe. So they became bound each man for +himself, to come in, when called upon, to answer before our Lord +the King for what they had done as before.</p> +<p>And thus much concerning this second army that was sent by +Diabolus to overthrow Mansoul.</p> +<p>But there were three of those that came from the land of +Doubting, who, after they had wandered and ranged the country a +while, and perceived that they had escaped, were so hardy as to +thrust themselves, knowing that yet there were in the town +Diabolonians,—I say, they were so hardy as to thrust +themselves into Mansoul among them. (Three, did I +say? I think there were four.) Now, to whose house +should these Diabolonian doubters go, but to the house of an old +Diabolonian in Mansoul, whose name was Evil-Questioning, a very +great enemy he was to Mansoul, and a great doer among the +Diabolonians there. Well, to this Evil-Questioning’s +house, as was said, did these Diabolonians come (you may be sure +that they had directions how to find the way thither), so he made +them welcome, pitied their misfortune, and succoured them with +the best that he had in his house. Now, after a little +acquaintance (and it was not long before they had that), this old +Evil-Questioning asked the doubters if they were all of a town +(he knew that they were all of one kingdom), and they answered: +‘No, nor not of one shire neither; for I,’ said one, +‘am an election doubter:’ ‘I,’ said +another, ‘am a vocation doubter:’ then said the +third, ‘I am a salvation doubter:’ and the fourth +said he was a grace doubter. ‘Well,’ quoth the +old gentleman, ‘be of what shire you will, I am persuaded +that you are down, boys: you have the very length of my foot, are +one with my heart, and shall be welcome to me.’ So +they thanked him, and were glad that they had found themselves an +harbour in Mansoul.</p> +<p>Then said Evil-Questioning to them: ‘How many of your +company might there be that came with you to the siege of +Mansoul?’ and they answered: ‘There were but ten +thousand doubters in all, for the rest of the army consisted of +fifteen thousand blood-men. These blood-men,’ quoth +they, ‘border upon our country; but, poor men! as we hear, +they were every one taken by Emmanuel’s +forces.’ ‘Ten thousand!’ quoth the old +gentleman; ‘I will promise you, that is a round +company. But how came it to pass, since you were so mighty +a number, that you fainted, and durst not fight your +foes?’ ‘Our general,’ said they, +‘was the first man that did run for it.’ +‘Pray,’ quoth their landlord, ‘who was that, +your cowardly general?’ ‘He was once the Lord +Mayor of Mansoul,’ said they: ‘but pray call him not +a cowardly general; for whether any from the east to the west has +done more service for our prince Diabolus, than has my Lord +Incredulity, will be a hard question for you to answer. But +had they catched him, they would for certain have hanged him; and +we promise you, hanging is but a bad business.’ Then +said the old gentleman, ‘I would that all the ten thousand +doubters were now well armed in Mansoul, and myself at the head +of them; I would see what I could do.’ +‘Ay,’ said they, ‘that would be well if we +could see that; but wishes, alas! what are they?’ and these +words were spoken aloud. ‘Well,’ said old +Evil-Questioning, ‘take heed that you talk not too loud; +you must be quat and close, and must take care of yourselves +while you are here, or, I will assure you, you will be +snapped.’ ‘Why?’ quoth the +doubters. ‘Why!’ quoth the old gentleman; +‘why! because both the Prince and Lord Secretary, and their +captains and soldiers, are all at present in town; yea, the town +is as full of them as ever it can hold. And besides, there +is one whose name is Willbewill, a most cruel enemy of ours, and +him the Prince has made keeper of the gates, and has commanded +him that, with all the diligence he can, he should look for, +search out, and destroy all, and all manner of +Diabolonians. And if he lighteth upon you, down you go, +though your heads were made of gold.’</p> +<p>And now, to see how it happened, one of the Lord +Willbewill’s faithful soldiers, whose name was Mr. +Diligence, stood all this while listening under old +Evil-Questioning’s eaves, and heard all the talk that had +been betwixt him and the doubters that he entertained under his +roof.</p> +<p>The soldier was a man that my lord had much confidence in, and +that he loved dearly; and that both because he was a man of +courage, and also a man that was unwearied in seeking after +Diabolonians to apprehend them.</p> +<p>Now this man, as I told you, heard all the talk that was +between old Evil-Questioning and these Diabolonians; wherefore +what does he but goes to his lord, and tells him what he had +heard. ‘And sayest thou so, my trusty?’ quoth +my lord. ‘Ay,’ quoth Diligence, ‘that I +do; and if your lordship will be pleased to go with me, you shall +find it as I have said.’ ‘And are they +there?’ quoth my lord. ‘I know Evil-Questioning +well, for he and I were great in the time of our apostasy: but I +know not now where he dwells.’ ‘But I +do,’ said his man, ‘and if your lordship will go, I +will lead you the way to his den.’ ‘Go!’ +quoth my lord, ‘that I will. Come, my Diligence, let +us go find them out.’</p> +<p>So my lord and his man went together the direct way to his +house. Now his man went before to show him his way, and +they went till they came even under old Mr. +Evil-Questioning’s wall. Then said Diligence, +‘Hark! my lord, do you know the old gentleman’s +tongue when you hear it?’ ‘Yes,’ said my +lord, ‘I know it well, but I have not seen him many a +day. This I know, he is cunning; I wish he doth not give us +the slip.’ ‘Let me alone for that,’ said +his servant Diligence. ‘But how shall we find the +door?’ quoth my lord. ‘Let me alone for that, +too,’ said his man. So he had my Lord Willbewill +about, and showed him the way to the door. Then my lord, +without more ado, broke open the door, rushed into the house, and +caught them all five together, even as Diligence his man had told +him. So my lord apprehended them, and led them away, and +committed them to the hand of Mr. Trueman, the gaoler, and +commanded, and he did put them in ward. This done, my Lord +Mayor was acquainted in the morning with what my Lord Willbewill +had done over night, and his lordship rejoiced much at the news, +not only because there were doubters apprehended, but because +that old Evil-Questioning was taken; for he had been a very great +trouble to Mansoul, and much affliction to my Lord Mayor +himself. He had also been sought for often, but no hand +could ever be laid upon him till now.</p> +<p>Well, the next thing was to make preparation to try these five +that by my lord had been apprehended, and that were in the hands +of Mr. Trueman, the gaoler. So the day was set, and the +court called and come together, and the prisoners brought to the +bar. My Lord Willbewill had power to have slain them when +at first he took them, and that without any more ado; but he +thought it at this time more for the honour of the Prince, the +comfort of Mansoul, and the discouragement of the enemy, to bring +them forth to public judgment.</p> +<p>But, I say, Mr. Trueman brought them in chains to the bar; to +the town-hall, for that was the place of judgment. So, to +be short, the jury was panelled, the witnesses sworn, and the +prisoners tried for their lives: the jury was the same that tried +Mr. No-Truth, Pitiless, Haughty, and the rest of their +companions.</p> +<p>And, first, old Questioning himself was set to the bar for he +was the receiver, the entertainer, and comforter of these +doubters, that by nation were outlandish men: then he was bid to +hearken to his charge, and was told that he had liberty to +object, if he had ought to say for himself. So his +indictment was read: the manner and form here follows.</p> +<p>‘Mr. Questioning, Thou art here indicted by the name of +Evil-Questioning, an intruder upon the town of Mansoul, for that +thou art a Diabolonian by nature, and also a hater of the Prince +Emmanuel, and one that hast studied the ruin of the town of +Mansoul. Thou art also here indicted for countenancing the +King’s enemies, after wholesome laws made to the contrary: +for, 1. Thou hast questioned the truth of her doctrine and state: +2. In wishing that ten thousand doubters were in her: 3. In +receiving, in entertaining, and encouraging of her enemies, that +came from their army unto thee. What sayest thou to this +indictment? art thou guilty or not guilty?’</p> +<p>‘My lord,’ quoth he, ‘I know not the meaning +of this indictment, forasmuch as I am not the man concerned in +it; the man that standeth by this charge accused before this +bench is called by the name of Evil-Questioning, which name I +deny to be mine, mine being Honest-Inquiry. The one indeed +sounds like the other; but, I trow, your lordships know that +between these two there is a wide difference; for I hope that a +man, even in the worst of times, and that, too, amongst the worst +of men, may make an honest inquiry after things, without running +the danger of death.’</p> +<p>Then spake my Lord Willbewill, for he was one of the +witnesses: ‘My lord, and you the honourable bench and +magistrates of the town of Mansoul, you all have heard with your +ears that the prisoner at the bar has denied his name, and so +thinks to shift from the charge of the indictment. But I +know him to be the man concerned, and that his proper name is +Evil-Questioning. I have known him, my lord, above these +thirty years, for he and I (a shame it is for me to speak it) +were great acquaintance, when Diabolus, that tyrant, had the +government of Mansoul; and I testify that he is a Diabolonian by +nature, an enemy to our Prince, and a hater of the blessed town +of Mansoul. He has, in times of rebellion, been at and lain +in my house, my lord, not so little as twenty nights together, +and we did use to talk then, for the substance of talk, as he and +his doubters have talked of late: true, I have not seen him many +a day. I suppose that the coming of Emmanuel to Mansoul has +made him change his lodgings, as this indictment has driven him +to change his name; but this is the man, my lord.’</p> +<p>Then said the court unto him, ‘Hast thou any more to +say?’</p> +<p>‘Yes,’ quoth the old gentleman, ‘that I +have; for all that as yet has been said against me, is but by the +mouth of one witness; and it is not lawful for the famous town of +Mansoul, at the mouth of one witness, to put any man to +death.’</p> +<p>Then stood forth Mr. Diligence, and said, ‘My lord, as I +was upon my watch such a night at the head of Bad Street, in this +town, I chanced to hear a muttering within this gentleman’s +house. Then, thought I, what is to do here? So I went +up close, but very softly, to the side of the house to listen, +thinking, as indeed it fell out, that there I might light upon +some Diabolonian conventicle. So, as I said, I drew nearer +and nearer; and when I was got up close to the wall, it was but a +while before I perceived that there were outlandish men in the +house; but I did well understand their speech, for I have been a +traveller myself. Now, hearing such language in such a +tottering cottage as this old gentleman dwelt in, I clapped mine +ear to a hole in the window, and there heard them talk as +followeth. This old Mr. Questioning asked these doubters +what they were, whence they came, and what was their business in +these parts; and they told him to all these questions, yet he did +entertain them. He also asked what numbers there were of +them; and they told him ten thousand men. He then asked +them, why they made no more manly assault upon Mansoul; and they +told him: so he called their general coward, for marching off +when he should have fought for his prince. Further, this +old Evil-Questioning wished, and I heard him wish, would all the +ten thousand doubters were now in Mansoul, and himself at the +head of them. He bid them also to take heed and lie quat; +for if they were taken they must die, although they had heads of +gold.’ Then said the court: ‘Mr. +Evil-Questioning, here is now another witness against you, and +his testimony is full: 1. He swears that you did receive these +men into your house, and that you did nourish them there, though +you knew that they were Diabolonians, and the King’s +enemies. 2. He swears that you did wish ten thousand of +them in Mansoul. 3. He swears that you did give them advice +to be quat and close, lest they were taken by the King’s +servants. All which manifesteth that thou art a +Diabolonian; but hadst thou been a friend to the King, thou +wouldst have apprehended them.’</p> +<p>Then said Evil-Questioning: ‘To the first of these I +answer, The men that came into mine house were strangers, and I +took them in; and is it now become a crime in Mansoul for a man +to entertain strangers? That I did also nourish them is +true; and why should my charity be blamed? As for the +reason why I wished ten thousand of them in Mansoul, I never told +it to the witnesses, nor to themselves. I might wish them +to be taken, and so my wish might mean well to Mansoul, for aught +that any yet knows. I did also bid them take heed that they +fell not into the captains’ hands; but that might be +because I am unwilling that any man should be slain, and not +because I would have the King’s enemies as such +escape.’</p> +<p>My Lord Mayor then replied: ‘That though it was a virtue +to entertain strangers, yet it was treason to entertain the +King’s enemies. And for what else thou hast said, +thou dost by words but labour to evade and defer the execution of +judgment. But could there be no more proved against thee +but that thou art a Diabolonian, thou must for that die the death +by the law; but to be a receiver, a nourisher, a countenancer, +and a harbourer of others of them, yea, of outlandish +Diabolonians, yea, of them that came from far on purpose to cut +off and destroy our Mansoul—this must not be +borne.’</p> +<p>Then said Evil-Questioning: ‘I see how the game will go: +I must die for my name, and for my charity.’ And so +he held his peace.</p> +<p>Then they called the outlandish doubters to the bar, and the +first of them that was arraigned was the election doubter. +So his indictment was read; and because he was an outlandish man, +the substance of it was told him by an interpreter; namely, +‘That he was there charged with being an enemy of Emmanuel +the Prince, a hater of the town of Mansoul, and an opposer of her +most wholesome doctrine.’</p> +<p>Then the judge asked him if he would plead? but he said only +this—That he confessed that he was an election doubter, and +that that was the religion that he had ever been brought up +in. And said, moreover, ‘If I must die for my +religion, I trow, I shall die a martyr, and so I care the +less.’</p> +<p><i>Judge</i>. Then it was replied: ‘To question +election, is to overthrow a great doctrine of the gospel, namely, +the omnisciency, and power, and will of God; to take away the +liberty of God with his creature, to stumble the faith of the +town of Mansoul, and to make salvation to depend upon works, and +not upon grace. It also belied the word, and disquieted the +minds of the men of Mansoul; therefore by the best of laws he +must die.’</p> +<p>Then was the vocation doubter called, and set to the bar; and +his indictment for substance was the same with the other, only he +was particularly charged with denying the calling of Mansoul.</p> +<p>The judge asked him also what he had to say for himself?</p> +<p>So he replied: ‘That he never believed that there was +any such thing as a distinct and powerful call of God to Mansoul; +otherwise than by the general voice of the word, nor by that +neither, otherwise than as it exhorted them to forbear evil, and +to do that which is good, and in so doing a promise of happiness +is annexed.’</p> +<p>Then said the judge: ‘Thou art a Diabolonian, and hast +denied a great part of one of the most experimental truths of the +Prince of the town of Mansoul; for he has called, and she has +heard a most distinct and powerful call of her Emmanuel, by which +she has been quickened, awakened, and possessed with heavenly +grace to desire to have communion with her Prince, to serve him, +and to do his will, and to look for her happiness merely of his +good pleasure. And for thine abhorrence of this good +doctrine, thou must die the death.’</p> +<p>Then the grace doubter was called, and his indictment was read +and he replied thereto: ‘That though he was of the land of +doubting, his father was the offspring of a Pharisee, and lived +in good fashion among his neighbours, and that he taught him to +believe, and believe it I do, and will, that Mansoul shall never +be saved freely by grace.’</p> +<p>Then said the judge: ‘Why, the law of the Prince is +plain: 1. Negatively, “not of works:” 2. Positively, +“by grace you are saved.” And thy religion +settleth in and upon the works of the flesh; for the works of the +law are the works of the flesh. Besides, in saying as thou +hast done, thou hast robbed God of His glory, and given it to a +sinful man; thou hast robbed Christ of the necessity of His +undertaking, and the sufficiency thereof, and hast given both +these to the works of the flesh. Thou hast despised the +work of the Holy Ghost, and hast magnified the will of the flesh, +and of the legal mind. Thou art a Diabolonian, the son of a +Diabolonian; and for thy Diabolonian principles thou must +die.’</p> +<p>The court then, having proceeded thus far with them, sent out +the jury, who forthwith brought them in guilty of death. +Then stood up the Recorder, and addressed himself to the +prisoners: ‘You, the prisoners at the bar, you have been +here indicted, and proved guilty of high crimes against Emmanuel +our Prince, and against the welfare of the famous town of +Mansoul, crimes for which you must be put to death, and die ye +accordingly.’ So they were sentenced to the death of +the cross. The place assigned them for execution, was that +where Diabolus drew up his last army against Mansoul; save only +that old Evil-Questioning was hanged at the top of Bad Street, +just over against his own door.</p> +<p>When the town of Mansoul had thus far rid themselves of their +enemies, and of the troublers of their peace, in the next place a +strict commandment was given out, that yet my Lord Willbewill +should, with Diligence his man, search for, and do his best to +apprehend what town Diabolonians were yet left alive in +Mansoul. The names of several of them were, Mr. Fooling, +Mr. Let-Good-Slip, Mr. Slavish-Fear, Mr. No-Love, Mr. Mistrust, +Mr. Flesh, and Mr. Sloth. It was also commanded, that he +should apprehend Mr. Evil-Questioning’s children, that he +left behind him, and that they should demolish his house. +The children that he left behind him were these: Mr. Doubt, and +he was his eldest son; the next to him was Legal-Life, Unbelief, +Wrong-Thoughts-of-Christ, Clip-Promise, Carnal-Sense, +Live-by-Feeling, Self-Love. All these he had by one wife, +and her name was No-Hope; she was the kinswoman of old +Incredulity, for he was her uncle; and when her father, old Dark, +was dead, he took her and brought her up, and when she was +marriageable, he gave her to this old Evil-Questioning to +wife.</p> +<p>Now the Lord Willbewill did put into execution his commission, +with great Diligence, his man. He took Fooling in the +streets, and hanged him up in Want-wit-Alley, over against his +own house. This Fooling was he that would have had the town +of Mansoul deliver up Captain Credence into the hands of +Diabolus, provided that then he would have withdrawn his force +out of the town. He also took Mr. Let-Good-Slip one day as +he was busy in the market, and executed him according to +law. Now there was an honest poor man in Mansoul, and his +name was Mr. Meditation, one of no great account in the days of +apostasy, but now of repute with the best of the town. This +man, therefore, they were willing to prefer. Now Mr. +Let-Good-Slip had a great deal of wealth heretofore in Mansoul, +and, at Emmanuel’s coming, it was sequestered to the use of +the Prince: this, therefore, was now given to Mr. Meditation, to +improve for the common good, and after him to his son, Mr. +Think-Well; this Think-Well he had by Mrs. Piety his wife, and +she was the daughter of Mr. Recorder.</p> +<p>After this, my lord apprehended Clip-Promise: now because he +was a notorious villain, for by his doings much of the +King’s coin was abused, therefore he was made a public +example. He was arraigned and judged to be first set in the +pillory, then to be whipped by all the children and servants in +Mansoul, and then to be hanged till he was dead. Some may +wonder at the severity of this man’s punishment; but those +that are honest traders in Mansoul, are sensible of the great +abuse that one clipper of promises in little time may do to the +town of Mansoul. And truly my judgment is, that all those +of his name and life should be served even as he.</p> +<p>He also apprehended Carnal-Sense, and put him in hold; but how +it came about, I cannot tell, but he brake prison, and made his +escape: yea, and the bold villain will not yet quit the town, but +lurks in the Diabolonian dens a days, and haunts like a ghost +honest men’s houses a nights. Wherefore, there was a +proclamation set up in the market-place in Mansoul, signifying +that whosoever could discover Carnal-Sense, and apprehend him and +slay him, should be admitted daily to the Prince’s table, +and should be made keeper of the treasure of Mansoul. Many, +therefore, did bend themselves to do this thing, but take him and +slay him they could not, though often he was discovered.</p> +<p>But my lord took Mr. Wrong-Thoughts-of-Christ, and put him in +prison, and he died there; though it was long first, for he died +of a lingering consumption.</p> +<p>Self-Love was also taken and committed to custody; but there +were many that were allied to him in Mansoul, so his judgment was +deferred. But at last Mr. Self-Denial stood up, and said: +‘If such villains as these may be winked at in Mansoul, I +will lay down my commission.’ He also took him from +the crowd, and had him among his soldiers, and there he was +brained. But some in Mansoul muttered at it, though none +durst speak plainly, because Emmanuel was in town. But this +brave act of Captain Self-Denial came to the Prince’s ears; +so he sent for him, and made him a lord in Mansoul. My Lord +Willbewill also obtained great commendations of Emmanuel, for +what he had done for the town of Mansoul.</p> +<p>Then my Lord Self-Denial took courage, and set to the pursuing +of the Diabolonians, with my Lord Willbewill; and they took +Live-by-Feeling, and they took Legal-Life, and put them in hold +till they died. But Mr. Unbelief was a nimble Jack: him +they could never lay hold of, though they attempted to do it +often. He therefore, and some few more of the subtlest of +the Diabolonian tribe, did yet remain in Mansoul, to the time +that Mansoul left off to dwell any longer in the kingdom of +Universe. But they kept them to their dens and holes: if +one of them did appear, or happen to be seen in any of the +streets of the town of Mansoul, the whole town would be up in +arms after them; yea, the very children in Mansoul would cry out +after them as after a thief, and would wish that they might stone +them to death with stones. And now did Mansoul arrive to +some good degree of peace and quiet; her Prince also did abide +within her borders; her captains, also, and her soldiers did +their duties; and Mansoul minded her trade that she had with the +country that was afar off; also she was busy in her +manufacture.</p> +<p>When the town of Mansoul had thus far rid themselves of so +many of their enemies, and the troublers of their peace, the +Prince sent to them, and appointed a day wherein he would, at the +market-place, meet the whole people, and there give them in +charge concerning some further matters, that, if observed, would +tend to their further safety and comfort, and to the condemnation +and destruction of their home-bred Diabolonians. So the day +appointed was come, and the townsmen met together; Emmanuel also +came down in his chariot, and all his captains in their state +attending him, on the right hand and on the left. Then was +an oyes made for silence, and, after some mutual carriages of +love, the Prince began, and thus proceeded:—</p> +<p>‘You, my Mansoul, and the beloved of mine heart, many +and great are the privileges that I have bestowed upon you; I +have singled you out from others, and have chosen you to myself, +not for your worthiness, but for mine own sake. I have also +redeemed you, not only from the dread of my Father’s law, +but from the hand of Diabolus. This I have done because I +loved you, and because I have set my heart upon you to do you +good. I have also, that all things, that might hinder thy +way to the pleasures of paradise might be taken out of the way, +laid down for thee for thy soul a plenary satisfaction, and have +bought thee to myself; a price not of corruptible things, as of +silver and gold, but a price of blood, mine own blood, which I +have freely spilled upon the ground to make thee mine. So I +have reconciled thee, O my Mansoul, to my Father, and entrusted +thee in the mansion houses that are with my Father in the royal +city, where things are, O my Mansoul, that eye hath not seen, nor +hath entered into the heart of man to conceive.</p> +<p>‘Besides, O my Mansoul, thou seest what I have done, and +how I have taken thee out of the hands of thine enemies: unto +whom thou hadst deeply revolted from my Father, and by whom thou +wast content to be possessed, and also to be destroyed. I +came to thee first by my law, then by my gospel, to awaken thee, +and show thee my glory. And thou knowest what thou wast, +what thou saidst, what thou didst, and how many times thou +rebelledst against my Father and me; yet I left thee not as thou +seest this day, but came to thee, have borne thy manners, have +waited upon thee, and, after all, accepted of thee, even of my +mere grace and favour; and would not suffer thee to be lost, as +thou most willingly wouldst have been. I also compassed +thee about, and afflicted thee on every side, that I might make +thee weary of thy ways, and bring down thy heart with molestation +to a willingness to close with thy good and happiness. And +when I had gotten a complete conquest over thee, I turned it to +thy advantage.</p> +<p>‘Thou seest, also, what a company of my Father’s +host I have lodged within thy borders: captains and rulers, +soldiers and men of war, engines and excellent devices to subdue +and bring down thy foes; thou knowest my meaning, O +Mansoul. And they are my servants, and thine, too, +Mansoul. Yea, my design of possessing of thee with them, +and the natural tendency of each of them is to defend, purge, +strengthen, and sweeten thee for myself, O Mansoul, and to make +thee meet for my Father’s presence, blessing, and glory; +for thou, my Mansoul, art created to be prepared unto these.</p> +<p>‘Thou seest, moreover, my Mansoul, how I have passed by +thy backslidings, and have healed thee. Indeed I was angry +with thee, but I have turned mine anger away from thee, because I +loved thee still, and mine anger and mine indignation is ceased +in the destruction of thine enemies, O Mansoul. Nor did thy +goodness fetch me again unto thee, after that I for thy +transgressions have hid my face, and withdrawn my presence from +thee. The way of backsliding was thine, but the way and +means of thy recovery was mine. I invented the means of thy +return; it was I that made an hedge and a wall, when thou wast +beginning to turn to things in which I delighted not. It +was I that made thy sweet bitter, thy day night, thy smooth way +thorny, and that also confounded all that sought thy +destruction. It was I that set Mr. Godly-Fear to work in +Mansoul. It was I that stirred up thy conscience and +understanding, thy will and thy affections, after thy great and +woful decay. It was I that put life into thee, O Mansoul, +to seek me, that thou mightest find me, and in thy finding find +thine own health, happiness, and salvation. It was I that +fetched the second time the Diabolonians out of Mansoul; and it +was I that overcame them, and that destroyed them before thy +face.</p> +<p>‘And now, my Mansoul, I am returned to thee in peace, +and thy transgressions against me are as if they had not +been. Nor shall it be with thee as in former days, but I +will do better for thee than at thy beginning.</p> +<p>For yet a little while, O my Mansoul, even after a few more +times are gone over thy head, I will (but be not thou troubled at +what I say) take down this famous town of Mansoul, stick and +stone, to the ground. And I will carry the stones thereof, +and the timber thereof, and the walls thereof, and the dust +thereof, and the inhabitants thereof, into mine own country, even +into a kingdom of my Father; and will there set it up in such +strength and glory, as it never did see in the kingdom where now +it is placed. I will even there set it up for my +Father’s habitation; for for that purpose it was at first +erected in the kingdom of Universe; and there will I make it a +spectacle of wonder, a monument of mercy, and the admirer of its +own mercy. There shall the natives of Mansoul see all that, +of which they have seen nothing here: there shall they be equal +to those unto whom they have been inferior here. And there +shalt thou, O my Mansoul, have such communion with me, with my +Father, and with your Lord Secretary, as it is not possible here +to be enjoyed, nor ever could be, shouldest thou live in Universe +the space of a thousand years.</p> +<p>‘And there, O my Mansoul, thou shalt be afraid of +murderers no more; of Diabolonians, and their threats, no +more. There, there shall be no more plots, nor +contrivances, nor designs against thee, O my Mansoul. There +thou shalt no more hear the evil-tidings, or the noise of the +Diabolonian drum. There thou shalt not see the Diabolonian +standard-bearers, nor yet behold Diabolus’s standard. +No Diabolonian mount shall be cast up against thee there; nor +shall there the Diabolonian standard be set up to make thee +afraid. There thou shalt not need captains, engines, +soldiers, and men of war. There thou shalt meet with no +sorrow, nor grief, nor shall it be possible that any Diabolonian +should again, for ever, be able to creep into thy skirts, burrow +in thy walls, or be seen again within thy borders all the days of +eternity. Life shall there last longer than here you are +able to desire it should; and yet it shall always be sweet and +new, nor shall any impediment attend it for ever.</p> +<p>‘There, O Mansoul, thou shalt meet with many of those +that have been like thee, and that have been partakers of thy +sorrows; even such as I have chosen, and redeemed, and set apart, +as thou, for my Father’s court and city-royal. All +they will be glad in thee, and thou, when thou seest them, shalt +be glad in thine heart.</p> +<p>‘There are things, O Mansoul, even things of my +Father’s providing, and mine, that never were seen since +the beginning of the world; and they are laid up with my Father, +and sealed up among his treasures for thee, till thou shalt come +thither to enjoy them. I told you before, that I would +remove my Mansoul, and set it up elsewhere; and where I will set +it, there are those that love thee, and those that rejoice in +thee now; but how much more, when they shall see thee exalted to +honour! My Father will then send them for you to fetch you; +and their bosoms are chariots to put you in. And you, O my +Mansoul, shall ride upon the wings of the wind. They will +come to convey, conduct, and bring you to that, when your eyes +see more, that will be your desired haven.</p> +<p>‘And thus, O my Mansoul, I have showed unto thee what +shall be done to thee hereafter, if thou canst hear, if thou +canst understand; and now I will tell thee what at present must +be thy duty and practice, until I come and fetch thee to myself, +according as is related in the Scriptures of truth.</p> +<p>‘First, I charge thee that thou dost hereafter keep more +white and clean the liveries which I gave thee before my last +withdrawing from thee. Do it, I say, for this will be thy +wisdom. They are in themselves fine linen, but thou must +keep them white and clean. This will be your wisdom, your +honour, and will be greatly for my glory. When your +garments are white, the world will count you mine. Also, +when your garments are white, then I am delighted in your ways; +for then your goings to and fro will be like a flash of +lightning, that those that are present must take notice of; also +their eyes will be made to dazzle thereat. Deck thyself, +therefore, according to my bidding, and make thyself by my law +straight steps for thy feet; so shall thy King greatly desire thy +beauty, for he is thy Lord, and worship thou him.</p> +<p>‘Now, that thou mayest keep them as I bid thee, I have, +as I before did tell thee, provided for thee an open fountain to +wash thy garments in. Look, therefore, that thou wash often +in my fountain, and go not in defiled garments; for as it is to +my dishonour and my disgrace, so it will be to thy discomfort, +when you shall walk in filthy garments. Let not, therefore, +my garments, your garments, the garments that I gave thee, be +defiled or spotted by the flesh. Keep thy garments always +white, and let thy head lack no ointment.</p> +<p>‘My Mansoul, I have ofttimes delivered thee from the +designs, plots, attempts, and conspiracies of Diabolus; and for +all this I ask thee nothing, but that thou render not to me evil +for my good; but that thou bear in mind my love, and the +continuation of my kindness to my beloved Mansoul, so as to +provoke thee to walk in thy measure according to the benefit +bestowed on thee. Of old, the sacrifices were bound with +cords to the horns of the altar. Consider what is said to +thee, O my blessed Mansoul.</p> +<p>‘O my Mansoul, I have lived, I have died, I live, and +will die no more for thee. I live, that thou mayest not +die. Because I live, thou shalt live also. I +reconciled thee to my Father by the blood of my cross; and being +reconciled, thou shalt live through me. I will pray for +thee; I will fight for thee; I will yet do thee good.</p> +<p>‘Nothing can hurt thee but sin; nothing can grieve me +but sin; nothing can make thee base before thy foes but sin: take +heed of sin, my Mansoul.</p> +<p>‘And dost thou know why I at first, and do still, suffer +Diabolonians to dwell in thy walls, O Mansoul? It is to +keep thee wakening, to try thy love, to make thee watchful, and +to cause thee yet to prize my noble captains, their soldiers, and +my mercy.</p> +<p>‘It is also, that yet thou mayest be made to remember +what a deplorable condition thou once wast in. I mean when, +not some, but all did dwell, not in thy walls, but in thy castle, +and in thy stronghold, O Mansoul.</p> +<p>‘O my Mansoul, should I slay all them within, many there +be without, that would bring thee into bondage; for were all +these within cut off, those without would find thee sleeping; and +then, as in a moment, they would swallow up my Mansoul. I +therefore left them in thee, not to do thee hurt (the which they +yet will, if thou hearken to them, and serve them,) but to do +thee good, the which they must, if thou watch and fight against +them. Know, therefore, that whatever they shall tempt thee +to, my design is, that they should drive thee, not further off, +but nearer to my father, to learn thee war, to make petitioning +desirable to thee, and to make thee little in thine own +eyes. Hearken diligently to this, my Mansoul.</p> +<p>‘Show me, then, thy love, my Mansoul, and let not those +that are within thy walls, take thy affections off from him that +hath redeemed thy soul. Yea, let the sight of a Diabolonian +heighten thy love to me. I came once, and twice, and +thrice, to save thee from the poison of those arrows that would +have wrought thy death: stand for me, thy Friend, my Mansoul, +against the Diabolonians, and I will stand for thee before my +Father, and all his court. Love me against temptation, and +I will love thee notwithstanding thine infirmities.</p> +<p>‘O my Mansoul, remember what my captains, my soldiers, +and mine engines have done for thee. They have fought for +thee, they have suffered by thee, they have borne much at thy +hands to do thee good, O Mansoul. Hadst thou not had them +to help thee, Diabolus had certainly made a hand of thee. +Nourish them, therefore, my Mansoul. When thou dost well, +they will be well; when thou dost ill, they will be ill, and +sick, and weak. Make not my captains sick, O Mansoul; for +if they be sick, thou canst not be well; if they be weak, thou +canst not be strong; if they be faint, thou canst not be stout +and valiant for thy King, O Mansoul. Nor must thou think +always to live by sense: thou must live upon my word. Thou +must believe, O my Mansoul, when I am from thee, that yet I love +thee, and bear thee upon mine heart for ever.</p> +<p>‘Remember, therefore, O my Mansoul, that thou art +beloved of me: as I have, therefore, taught thee to watch, to +fight, to pray, and to make war against my foes; so now I command +thee to believe that my love is constant to thee. O my +Mansoul, how have I set my heart, my love upon thee! +Watch. Behold, I lay none other burden upon thee, than what +thou hast already. Hold fast, till I come.’</p> +<h2>FOOTNOTES</h2> +<p><a name="footnote0"></a><a href="#citation0" +class="footnote">[0]</a> Unfortunately the illustrations +are still in copyright in the UK (where I live), and so have not +been included. They will be included when they come out of +copyright in the UK.—DP.</p> +<p>***END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK THE HOLY WAR MADE BY SHADDAI UPON +DIABOLUS***</p> +<pre> + + +***** This file should be named 395-h.htm or 395-h.zip****** + + +This and all associated files of various formats will be found in: +http://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/3/9/395 + + + +Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions +will be renamed. + +Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no +one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation +(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without +permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules, +set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to +copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to +protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project +Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you +charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you +do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the +rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose +such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and +research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do +practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is +subject to the trademark license, especially commercial +redistribution. + + + +*** START: FULL LICENSE *** + +THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE +PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK + +To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free +distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work +(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project +Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project +Gutenberg-tm License available with this file or online at + www.gutenberg.org/license. + + +Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm +electronic works + +1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm +electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to +and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property +(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all +the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy +all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession. +If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the +terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or +entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8. + +1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be +used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who +agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few +things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works +even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See +paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement +and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic +works. See paragraph 1.E below. + +1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation" +or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the +collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an +individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are +located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from +copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative +works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg +are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project +Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by +freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of +this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with +the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by +keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project +Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others. + +1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern +what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in +a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check +the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement +before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or +creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project +Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning +the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United +States. + +1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg: + +1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate +access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently +whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the +phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project +Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed, +copied or distributed: + +This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with +almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or +re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included +with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org + +1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived +from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is +posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied +and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees +or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work +with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the +work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 +through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the +Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or +1.E.9. + +1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted +with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution +must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional +terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked +to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the +permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work. + +1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm +License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this +work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm. + +1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this +electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without +prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with +active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project +Gutenberg-tm License. + +1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary, +compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any +word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or +distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than +"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version +posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org), +you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a +copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon +request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other +form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm +License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1. + +1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying, +performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works +unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9. + +1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing +access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided +that + +- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from + the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method + you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is + owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he + has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the + Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments + must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you + prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax + returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and + sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the + address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to + the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation." + +- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies + you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he + does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm + License. You must require such a user to return or + destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium + and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of + Project Gutenberg-tm works. + +- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any + money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the + electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days + of receipt of the work. + +- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free + distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works. + +1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm +electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set +forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from +both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael +Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the +Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below. + +1.F. + +1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable +effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread +public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm +collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic +works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain +"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or +corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual +property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a +computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by +your equipment. + +1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right +of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project +Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project +Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all +liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal +fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT +LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE +PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE +TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE +LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR +INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH +DAMAGE. + +1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a +defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can +receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a +written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you +received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with +your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with +the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a +refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity +providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to +receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy +is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further +opportunities to fix the problem. + +1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth +in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO OTHER +WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO +WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE. + +1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied +warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages. +If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the +law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be +interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by +the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any +provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions. + +1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the +trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone +providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance +with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production, +promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works, +harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees, +that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do +or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm +work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any +Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause. + + +Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm + +Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of +electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers +including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists +because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from +people in all walks of life. + +Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the +assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's +goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will +remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project +Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure +and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations. +To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation +and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4 +and the Foundation information page at www.gutenberg.org + + +Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive +Foundation + +The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit +501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the +state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal +Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification +number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg +Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent +permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws. + +The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S. +Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered +throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at 809 +North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887. Email +contact links and up to date contact information can be found at the +Foundation's web site and official page at www.gutenberg.org/contact + +For additional contact information: + Dr. Gregory B. Newby + Chief Executive and Director + gbnewby@pglaf.org + +Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg +Literary Archive Foundation + +Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide +spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of +increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be +freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest +array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations +($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt +status with the IRS. + +The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating +charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United +States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a +considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up +with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations +where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To +SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any +particular state visit www.gutenberg.org/donate + +While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we +have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition +against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who +approach us with offers to donate. + +International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make +any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from +outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff. + +Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation +methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other +ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations. +To donate, please visit: www.gutenberg.org/donate + + +Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic +works. + +Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm +concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared +with anyone. For forty years, he produced and distributed Project +Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support. + +Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed +editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S. +unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily +keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition. + +Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility: + + www.gutenberg.org + +This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm, +including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary +Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to +subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks. +</pre></body> +</html> diff --git a/395-h/images/p0b.jpg b/395-h/images/p0b.jpg Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000..aef4923 --- /dev/null +++ b/395-h/images/p0b.jpg diff --git a/395-h/images/p0s.jpg b/395-h/images/p0s.jpg Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000..400e5fb --- /dev/null +++ b/395-h/images/p0s.jpg diff --git a/LICENSE.txt b/LICENSE.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000..6312041 --- /dev/null +++ b/LICENSE.txt @@ -0,0 +1,11 @@ +This eBook, including all associated images, markup, improvements, +metadata, and any other content or labor, has been confirmed to be +in the PUBLIC DOMAIN IN THE UNITED STATES. + +Procedures for determining public domain status are described in +the "Copyright How-To" at https://www.gutenberg.org. + +No investigation has been made concerning possible copyrights in +jurisdictions other than the United States. Anyone seeking to utilize +this eBook outside of the United States should confirm copyright +status under the laws that apply to them. diff --git a/README.md b/README.md new file mode 100644 index 0000000..ad1129e --- /dev/null +++ b/README.md @@ -0,0 +1,2 @@ +Project Gutenberg (https://www.gutenberg.org) public repository for +eBook #395 (https://www.gutenberg.org/ebooks/395) diff --git a/old/hlywr10.txt b/old/hlywr10.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000..47a5361 --- /dev/null +++ b/old/hlywr10.txt @@ -0,0 +1,10093 @@ +The Project Gutenberg EBook of The Holy War, by John Bunyan +(#2 in our series by John Bunyan) + +Copyright laws are changing all over the world. Be sure to check the +copyright laws for your country before downloading or redistributing +this or any other Project Gutenberg eBook. + +This header should be the first thing seen when viewing this Project +Gutenberg file. Please do not remove it. Do not change or edit the +header without written permission. + +Please read the "legal small print," and other information about the +eBook and Project Gutenberg at the bottom of this file. Included is +important information about your specific rights and restrictions in +how the file may be used. You can also find out about how to make a +donation to Project Gutenberg, and how to get involved. + + +**Welcome To The World of Free Plain Vanilla Electronic Texts** + +**eBooks Readable By Both Humans and By Computers, Since 1971** + +*****These eBooks Were Prepared By Thousands of Volunteers!***** + + +Title: The Holy War + +Author: John Bunyan + +Release Date: January, 1996 [EBook #395] +[This file was first posted on December 7, 1995] +[Most recently updated: August 18, 2002] + +Edition: 10 + +Language: English + +Character set encoding: ASCII + +*** START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK, THE HOLY WAR *** + + + + +Transcribed from the 1907 Religious Tract Society edition by David +Price, email ccx074@coventry.ac.uk + + + + +THE HOLY WAR + + + + +TO THE READER. + + + +'Tis strange to me, that they that love to tell +Things done of old, yea, and that do excel +Their equals in historiology, +Speak not of Mansoul's wars, but let them lie +Dead, like old fables, or such worthless things, +That to the reader no advantage brings: +When men, let them make what they will their own, +Till they know this, are to themselves unknown. +Of stories, I well know, there's divers sorts, +Some foreign, some domestic; and reports +Are thereof made as fancy leads the writers: +(By books a man may guess at the inditers.) +Some will again of that which never was, +Nor will be, feign (and that without a cause) +Such matter, raise such mountains, tell such things +Of men, of laws, of countries, and of kings; +And in their story seem to be so sage, +And with such gravity clothe every page, +That though their frontispiece says all is vain, +Yet to their way disciples they obtain. +But, readers, I have somewhat else to do, +Than with vain stories thus to trouble you. +What here I say, some men do know so well, +They can with tears and joy the story tell. +The town of Mansoul is well known to many, +Nor are her troubles doubted of by any +That are acquainted with those Histories +That Mansoul and her wars anatomize. +Then lend thine ear to what I do relate, +Touching the town of Mansoul and her state: +How she was lost, took captive, made a slave: +And how against him set, that should her save; +Yea, how by hostile ways she did oppose +Her Lord, and with his enemy did close. +For they are true: he that will them deny +Must needs the best of records vilify. +For my part, I myself was in the town, +Both when 'twas set up, and when pulling down. +I saw Diabolus in his possession, +And Mansoul also under his oppression. +Yea, I was there when she own'd him for lord, +And to him did submit with one accord. +When Mansoul trampled upon things divine, +And wallowed in filth as doth a swine; +When she betook herself unto her arms, +Fought her Emmanuel, despis'd his charms; +Then I was there, and did rejoice to see +Diabolus and Mansoul so agree. +Let no men, then, count me a fable-maker, +Nor make my name or credit a partaker +Of their derision: what is here in view, +Of mine own knowledge, I dare say is true. +I saw the Prince's armed men come down +By troops, by thousands, to besiege the town; +I saw the captains, heard the trumpets sound, +And how his forces covered all the ground. +Yea, how they set themselves in battle-'ray, +I shall remember to my dying day. +I saw the colours waving in the wind, +And they within to mischief how combin'd +To ruin Mansoul, and to make away +Her primum mobile without delay. +I saw the mounts cast up against the town, +And how the slings were placed to beat it down: +I heard the stones fly whizzing by mine ears, +(What longer kept in mind than got in fears?) +I heard them fall, and saw what work they made. +And how old Mors did cover with his shade +The face of Mansoul; and I heard her cry, +'Woe worth the day, in dying I shall die!' +I saw the battering-rams, and how they play'd +To beat open Ear-gate; and I was afraid +Not only Ear-gate, but the very town +Would by those battering-rams be beaten down. +I saw the fights, and heard the captains shout, +And in each battle saw who faced about; +I saw who wounded were, and who were slain; +And who, when dead, would come to life again. +I heard the cries of those that wounded were, +(While others fought like men bereft of fear,) +And while the cry, 'Kill, kill,' was in mine ears, +The gutters ran, not so with blood as tears. +Indeed, the captains did not always fight, +But then they would molest us day and night; +Their cry, 'Up, fall on, let us take the town,' +Kept us from sleeping, or from lying down. +I was there when the gates were broken ope, +And saw how Mansoul then was stripp'd of hope; +I saw the captains march into the town, +How there they fought, and did their foes cut down. +I heard the Prince bid Boanerges go +Up to the castle, and there seize his foe; +And saw him and his fellows bring him down, +In chains of great contempt quite through the town. +I saw Emmanuel, when he possess'd +His town of Mansoul; and how greatly blest +A town his gallant town of Mansoul was, +When she received his pardon, loved his laws. +When the Diabolonians were caught, +When tried, and when to execution brought, +Then I was there; yea, I was standing by +When Mansoul did the rebels crucify. +I also saw Mansoul clad all in white, +I heard her Prince call her his heart's delight. +I saw him put upon her chains of gold, +And rings, and bracelets, goodly to behold. +What shall I say? I heard the people's cries, +And saw the Prince wipe tears from Mansoul's eyes. +And heard the groans, and saw the joy of many: +Tell you of all, I neither will, nor can I. +But by what here I say, you well may see +That Mansoul's matchless wars no fables be. +Mansoul, the desire of both princes was: +One keep his gain would, t'other gain his loss. +Diabolus would cry, 'The town is mine!' +Emmanuel would plead a right divine +Unto his Mansoul: then to blows they go, +And Mansoul cries, 'These wars will me undo.' +Mansoul! her wars seemed endless in her eyes; +She's lost by one, becomes another's prize: +And he again that lost her last would swear, +'Have her I will, or her in pieces tear.' +Mansoul! it was the very seat of war; +Wherefore her troubles greater were by far +Than only where the noise of war is heard, +Or where the shaking of a sword is fear'd; +Or only where small skirmishes are fought, +Or where the fancy fighteth with a thought. +She saw the swords of fighting men made red, +And heard the cries of those with them wounded: +Must not her frights, then, be much more by far +Than theirs that to such doings strangers are? +Or theirs that hear the beating of a drum, +But not made fly for fear from house and home? +Mansoul not only heard the trumpet's sound, +But saw her gallants gasping on the ground: +Wherefore we must not think that she could rest +With them, whose greatest earnest is but jest: +Or where the blust'ring threat'ning of great wars +Do end in parlies, or in wording jars. +Mansoul! her mighty wars, they did portend +Her weal or woe, and that world without end: +Wherefore she must be more concern'd than they +Whose fears begin, and end the selfsame day; +Or where none other harm doth come to him +That is engaged, but loss of life or limb, +As all must needs confess that now do dwell +In Universe, and can this story tell. +Count me not, then, with them that, to amaze +The people, set them on the stars to gaze, +Insinuating with much confidence, +That each of them is now the residence +Of some brave creatures: yea, a world they will +Have in each star, though it be past their skill +To make it manifest to any man, +That reason hath, or tell his fingers can. +But I have too long held thee in the porch, +And kept thee from the sunshine with a torch, +Well, now go forward, step within the door, +And there behold five hundred times much more +Of all sorts of such inward rarities +As please the mind will, and will feed the eyes +With those, which, if a Christian, thou wilt see +Not small, but things of greatest moment be. +Nor do thou go to work without my key; +(In mysteries men soon do lose their way;) +And also turn it right, if thou wouldst know +My riddle, and wouldst with my heifer plough; +It lies there in the window. Fare thee well, +My next may be to ring thy passing-bell. + +JOHN BUNYAN. + + + +AN ADVERTISEMENT TO THE READER. + + + +Some say the 'Pilgrim's Progress' is not mine, +Insinuating as if I would shine +In name and fame by the worth of another, +Like some made rich by robbing of their brother. +Or that so fond I am of being sire, +I'll father bastards; or, if need require, +I'll tell a lie in print to get applause. +I scorn it: John such dirt-heap never was, +Since God converted him. Let this suffice +To show why I my 'Pilgrim' patronize. +It came from mine own heart, so to my head, +And thence into my fingers trickled; +Then to my pen, from whence immediately +On paper I did dribble it daintily. +Manner and matter, too, was all mine own, +Nor was it unto any mortal known +Till I had done it; nor did any then +By books, by wits, by tongues, or hand, or pen, +Add five words to it, or write half a line +Thereof: the whole, and every whit is mine. +Also for THIS, thine eye is now upon, +The matter in this manner came from none +But the same heart, and head, fingers, and pen, +As did the other. Witness all good men; +For none in all the world, without a lie, +Can say that this is mine, excepting I +I write not this of my ostentation, +Nor 'cause I seek of men their commendation; +I do it to keep them from such surmise, +As tempt them will my name to scandalize. +Witness my name, if anagram'd to thee, +The letters make--'Nu hony in a B.' + +JOHN BUNYAN. + + + +A RELATION OF THE HOLY WAR. + + + +In my travels, as I walked through many regions and countries, it +was my chance to happen into that famous continent of Universe. A +very large and spacious country it is: it lieth between the two +poles, and just amidst the four points of the heavens. It is a +place well watered, and richly adorned with hills and valleys, +bravely situate, and for the most part, at least where I was, very +fruitful, also well peopled, and a very sweet air. + +The people are not all of one complexion, nor yet of one language, +mode, or way of religion, but differ as much as, it is said, do the +planets themselves. Some are right, and some are wrong, even as it +happeneth to be in lesser regions. + +In this country, as I said, it was my lot to travel; and there +travel I did, and that so long, even till I learned much of their +mother tongue, together with the customs and manners of them among +whom I was. And, to speak truth, I was much delighted to see and +hear many things which I saw and heard among them; yea, I had, to +be sure, even lived and died a native among them, (so was I taken +with them and their doings,) had not my master sent for me home to +his house, there to do business for him, and to oversee business +done. + +Now there is in this gallant country of Universe a fair and +delicate town, a corporation called Mansoul; a town for its +building so curious, for its situation so commodious, for its +privileges so advantageous, (I mean with reference to its origin,) +that I may say of it, as was said before of the continent in which +it is placed, There is not its equal under the whole heaven. + +As to the situation of this town, it lieth just between the two +worlds; and the first founder and builder of it, so far as by the +best and most authentic records I can gather, was one Shaddai; and +he built it for his own delight. He made it the mirror and glory +of all that he made, even the top-piece, beyond anything else that +he did in that country. Yea, so goodly a town was Mansoul when +first built, that it is said by some, the gods, at the setting up +thereof, came down to see it, and sang for joy. And as he made it +goodly to behold, so also mighty to have dominion over all the +country round about. Yea, all were commanded to acknowledge +Mansoul for their metropolitan, all were enjoined to do homage to +it. Aye, the town itself had positive commission and power from +her King to demand service of all, and also to subdue any that +anyways denied to do it. + +There was reared up in the midst of this town a most famous and +stately palace; for strength, it might be called a castle; for +pleasantness, a paradise; for largeness, a place so copious as to +contain all the world. This place the King Shaddai intended but +for himself alone, and not another with him; partly because of his +own delights, and partly because he would not that the terror of +strangers should be upon the town. This place Shaddai made also a +garrison of, but committed the keeping of it only to the men of the +town. + +The walls of the town were well built, yea, so fast and firm were +they knit and compact together, that, had it not been for the +townsmen themselves, they could not have been shaken or broken for +ever. For here lay the excellent wisdom of him that builded +Mansoul, that the walls could never be broken down nor hurt by the +most mighty adverse potentate, unless the townsmen gave consent +thereto. + +This famous town of Mansoul had five gates, in at which to come, +out at which to go; and these were made likewise answerable to the +walls, to wit, impregnable, and such as could never be opened nor +forced but by the will and leave of those within. The names of the +gates were these: Ear-gate, Eye-gate, Mouth-gate, Nose-gate, and +Feel-gate. + +Other things there were that belonged to the town of Mansoul, which +if you adjoin to these, will yet give farther demonstration to all, +of the glory and strength of the place. It had always a +sufficiency of provision within its walls; it had the best, most +wholesome, and excellent law that then was extant in the world. +There was not a rascal, rogue, or traitorous person then within its +walls; they were all true men, and fast joined together; and this, +you know, is a great matter. And to all these, it had always (so +long as it had the goodness to keep true to Shaddai the King) his +countenance, his protection, and it was his delight, etc. + +Well, upon a time, there was one Diabolus, a mighty giant, made an +assault upon this famous town of Mansoul, to take it, and make it +his own habitation. This giant was king of the blacks, and a most +raving prince he was. We will, if you please, first discourse of +the origin of this Diabolus, and then of his taking of this famous +town of Mansoul. + +This Diabolus is indeed a great and mighty prince, and yet both +poor and beggarly. As to his origin, he was at first one of the +servants of King Shaddai, made, and taken, and put by him into most +high and mighty place; yea, was put into such principalities as +belonged to the best of his territories and dominions. This +Diabolus was made 'son of the morning,' and a brave place he had of +it: it brought him much glory, and gave him much brightness, an +income that might have contented his Luciferian heart, had it not +been insatiable, and enlarged as hell itself. + +Well, he seeing himself thus exalted to greatness and honour, and +raging in his mind for higher state and degree, what doth he but +begins to think with himself how he might be set up as lord over +all, and have the sole power under Shaddai. (Now that did the King +reserve for his Son, yea, and had already bestowed it upon him.) +Wherefore he first consults with himself what had best to be done; +and then breaks his mind to some other of his companions, to the +which they also agreed. So, in fine, they came to this issue that +they should make an attempt upon the King's Son to destroy him, +that the inheritance might be theirs. Well, to be short, the +treason, as I said, was concluded, the time appointed, the word +given, the rebels rendezvoused, and the assault attempted. Now the +King and his Son being all and always eye, could not but discern +all passages in his dominions; and he, having always love for his +Son as for himself, could not at what he saw but be greatly +provoked and offended: wherefore what does he, but takes them in +the very nick and first trip that they made towards their design, +convicts them of the treason, horrid rebellion, and conspiracy that +they had devised, and now attempted to put into practice, and casts +them altogether out of all place of trust, benefit, honour, and +preferment. This done, he banishes them the court, turns them down +into the horrible pits, as fast bound in chains, never more to +expect the least favour from his hands, but to abide the judgment +that he had appointed, and that for ever. + +Now they being thus cast out of all place of trust, profit, and +honour, and also knowing that they had lost their prince's favour +for ever, (being banished his court, and cast down to the horrible +pits,) you may he sure they would now add to their former pride +what malice and rage against Shaddai, and against his Son, they +could. Wherefore, roving and ranging in much fury from place to +place, if, perhaps, they might find something that was the King's, +by spoiling of that, to revenge themselves on him; at last they +happened into this spacious country of Universe, and steer their +course towards the town of Mansoul; and considering that that town +was one of the chief works and delights of King Shaddai, what do +they but, after counsel taken, make an assault upon that. I say, +they knew that Mansoul belonged unto Shaddai; for they were there +when he built it and beautified it for himself. So when they had +found the place, they shouted horribly for joy, and roared on it as +a lion upon the prey, saying, 'Now we have found the prize, and how +to be revenged on King Shaddai for what he hath done to us.' So +they sat down and called a council of war, and considered with +themselves what ways and methods they had best to engage in for the +winning to themselves this famous town of Mansoul, and these four +things were then propounded to be considered of. + +First. Whether they had best all of them to show themselves in +this design to the town of Mansoul. + +Secondly. Whether they had best to go and sit down against Mansoul +in their now ragged and beggarly guise. + +Thirdly. Whether they had best show to Mansoul their intentions, +and what design they came about, or whether to assault it with +words and ways of deceit. + +Fourthly. Whether they had not best to some of their companions to +give out private orders to take the advantage, if they see one or +more of the principal townsmen, to shoot them, if thereby they +shall judge their cause and design will the better be promoted. + +1. It was answered to the first of these proposals in the negative, +to wit, that it would not be best that all should show themselves +before the town, because the appearance of many of them might alarm +and frighten the town; whereas a few or but one of them was not so +likely to do it. And to enforce this advice to take place it was +added further, that if Mansoul was frighted, or did take the alarm, +'It is impossible,' said Diabolus (for he spake now), 'that we +should take the town: for that none can enter into it without its +own consent. Let, therefore, but few, or but one, assault Mansoul; +and in mine opinion,' said Diabolus, 'let me be he.' Wherefore to +this they all agreed. + +2. And then to the second proposal they came, namely, Whether they +had best go and sit down before Mansoul in their now ragged and +beggarly guise. To which it was answered also in the negative, By +no means; and that because, though the town of Mansoul had been +made to know, and to have to do, before now, with things that are +invisible, they did never as yet see any of their fellow-creatures +in so sad and rascally condition as they; and this was the advice +of that fierce Alecto. Then said Apollyon, 'The advice is +pertinent; for even one of us appearing to them as we are now, must +needs both beget and multiply such thoughts in them as will both +put them into a consternation of spirit, and necessitate them to +put themselves upon their guard. And if so,' said he, 'then, as my +Lord Diabolus said but now, it is in vain for us to think of taking +the town.' Then said that mighty giant Beelzebub, 'The advice that +already is given is safe; for though the men of Mansoul have seen +such things as we once were, yet hitherto they did never behold +such things as we now are; and it is best, in mine opinion, to come +upon them in such a guise as is common to, and most familiar among +them.' To this, when they had consented, the next thing to be +considered was, in what shape, hue, or guise Diabolus had best to +show himself when he went about to make Mansoul his own. Then one +said one thing, and another the contrary. At last Lucifer +answered, that, in his opinion, it was best that his lordship +should assume the body of some of those creatures that they of the +town had dominion over; 'for,' quoth he, 'these are not only +familiar to them, but, being under them, they will never imagine +that an attempt should by them be made upon the town; and, to blind +all, let him assume the body of one of those beasts that Mansoul +deems to be wiser than any of the rest.' This advice was applauded +of all: so it was determined that the giant Diabolus should assume +the dragon, for that he was in those days as familiar with the town +of Mansoul as now is the bird with the boy; for nothing that was in +its primitive state was at all amazing to them. Then they +proceeded to the third thing, which was: + +3. Whether they had best to show their intentions, or the design of +his coming, to Mansoul, or no. This also was answered in the +negative, because of the weight that was in the former reasons, to +wit, for that Mansoul were a strong people, a strong people in a +strong town, whose wall and gates were impregnable, (to say nothing +of their castle,) nor can they by any means be won but by their own +consent. 'Besides,' said Legion, (for he gave answer to this,) 'a +discovery of our intentions may make them send to their king for +aid; and if that be done, I know quickly what time of day it will +be with us. Therefore let us assault them in all pretended +fairness, covering our intentions with all manner of lies, +flatteries, delusive words; feigning things that never will be, and +promising that to them that they shall never find. This is the way +to win Mansoul, and to make them of themselves open their gates to +us; yea, and to desire us too to come in to them. And the reason +why I think that this project will do is, because the people of +Mansoul now are, every one, simple and innocent, all honest and +true; nor do they as yet know what it is to be assaulted with +fraud, guile, and hypocrisy. They are strangers to lying and +dissembling lips; wherefore we cannot, if thus we be disguised, by +them at all be discerned; our lies shall go for true sayings, and +our dissimulations for upright dealings. What we promise them they +will in that believe us, especially if, in all our lies and feigned +words, we pretend great love to them, and that our design is only +their advantage and honour.' Now there was not one bit of a reply +against this; this went as current down as doth the water down a +steep descent. Wherefore they go to consider of the last proposal, +which was: + +4. Whether they had not best to give out orders to some of their +company to shoot some one or more of the principal of the townsmen, +if they judge that their cause may be promoted thereby. This was +carried in the affirmative, and the man that was designed by this +stratagem to be destroyed was one Mr. Resistance, otherwise called +Captain Resistance. And a great man in Mansoul this Captain +Resistance was, and a man that the giant Diabolus and his band more +feared than they feared the whole town of Mansoul besides. Now who +should be the actor to do the murder? That was the next, and they +appointed one Tisiphone, a fury of the lake, to do it. + +They thus having ended their council of war, rose up, and essayed +to do as they had determined; they marched towards Mansoul, but all +in a manner invisible, save one, only one; nor did he approach the +town in his own likeness, but under the shade and in the body of +the dragon. + +So they drew up and sat down before Ear-gate, for that was the +place of hearing for all without the town, as Eye-gate was the +place of perspection. So, as I said, he came up with his train to +the gate, and laid his ambuscado for Captain Resistance within bow- +shot of the town. This done, the giant ascended up close to the +gate, and called to the town of Mansoul for audience. Nor took he +any with him but one Ill-pause, who was his orator in all difficult +matters. Now, as I said, he being come up to the gate, (as the +manner of those times was,) sounded his trumpet for audience; at +which the chief of the town of Mansoul, such as my Lord Innocent, +my Lord Willbewill, my Lord Mayor, Mr. Recorder, and Captain +Resistance, came down to the wall to see who was there, and what +was the matter. And my Lord Willbewill, when he had looked over +and saw who stood at the gate, demanded what he was, wherefore he +was come, and why he roused the town of Mansoul with so unusual a +sound. + +Diabolus, then, as if he had been a lamb, began his oration, and +said: 'Gentlemen of the famous town of Mansoul, I am, as you may +perceive, no far dweller from you, but near, and one that is bound +by the king to do you my homage and what service I can; wherefore, +that I may be faithful to myself and to you, I have somewhat of +concern to impart unto you. Wherefore, grant me your audience, and +hear me patiently. And first, I will assure you, it is not myself, +but you--not mine, but your advantage that I seek by what I now do, +as will full well be made manifest, by that I have opened my mind +unto you. For, gentlemen, I am (to tell you the truth) come to +show you how you may obtain great and ample deliverance from a +bondage that, unawares to yourselves, you are captivated and +enslaved under.' At this the town of Mansoul began to prick up its +ears. And 'What is it? Pray what is it?' thought they. And he +said, 'I have somewhat to say to you concerning your King, +concerning his law, and also touching yourselves. Touching your +King, I know he is great and potent; but yet all that he hath said +to you is neither true nor yet for your advantage. 1. It is not +true, for that wherewith he hath hitherto awed you, shall not come +to pass, nor be fulfilled, though you do the thing that he hath +forbidden. But if there was danger, what a slavery is it to live +always in fear of the greatest of punishments, for doing so small +and trivial a thing as eating of a little fruit is. 2. Touching +his laws, this I say further, they are both unreasonable, +intricate, and intolerable. Unreasonable, as was hinted before; +for that the punishment is not proportioned to the offence: there +is great difference and disproportion between the life and an +apple; yet the one must go for the other by the law of your +Shaddai. But it is also intricate, in that he saith, first, you +may eat of all; and yet after forbids the eating of one. And then, +in the last place, it must needs be intolerable, forasmuch as that +fruit which you are forbidden to eat of (if you are forbidden any) +is that, and that alone, which is able, by your eating, to minister +to you a good as yet unknown by you. This is manifest by the very +name of the tree; it is called the "tree of knowledge of good and +evil;" and have you that knowledge as yet? No, no; nor can you +conceive how good, how pleasant, and how much to be desired to make +one wise it is, so long as you stand by your King's commandment. +Why should you be holden in ignorance and blindness? Why should +you not be enlarged in knowledge and understanding? And now, O ye +inhabitants of the famous town of Mansoul, to speak more +particularly to yourselves you are not a free people! You are kept +both in bondage and slavery, and that by a grievous threat; no +reason being annexed but, "So I will have it; so it shall be." And +is it not grievous to think on, that that very thing which you are +forbidden to do might you but do it, would yield you both wisdom +and honour? for then your eyes will be opened, and you shall be as +gods. Now, since this is thus,' quoth he, 'can you be kept by any +prince in more slavery and in greater bondage than you are under +this day? You are made underlings, and are wrapped up in +inconveniences, as I have well made appear. For what bondage +greater than to be kept in blindness? Will not reason tell you +that it is better to have eyes than to be without them? and so to +be at liberty to be better than to be shut up in a dark and +stinking cave?' + +And just now, while Diabolus was speaking these words to Mansoul, +Tisiphone shot at Captain Resistance, where he stood on the gate, +and mortally wounded him in the head; so that he, to the amazement +of the townsmen, and the encouragement of Diabolus, fell down dead +quite over the wall. Now, when Captain Resistance was dead, (and +he was the only man of war in the town,) poor Mansoul was wholly +left naked of courage, nor had she now any heart to resist. But +this was as the devil would have it. Then stood forth he, Mr. Ill- +pause, that Diabolus brought with him, who was his orator; and he +addressed himself to speak to the town of Mansoul; the tenour of +whose speech here follows:- + +'Gentlemen,' quoth he, 'it is my master's happiness that he has +this day a quiet and teachable auditory; and it is hoped by us that +we shall prevail with you not to cast off good advice. My master +has a very great love for you; and although, as he very well knows, +that he runs the hazard of the anger of King Shaddai, yet love to +you will make him do more than that. Nor doth there need that a +word more should be spoken to confirm for truth what he hath said; +there is not a word but carries with it self-evidence in its +bowels; the very name of the tree may put an end to all controversy +in this matter. I therefore, at this time, shall only add this +advice to you, under and by the leave of my lord;' (and with that +he made Diabolus a very low congee;) 'consider his words, look on +the tree and the promising fruit thereof; remember also that yet +you know but little, and that this is the way to know more: and if +your reasons be not conquered to accept of such good counsel, you +are not the men that I took you to be.' + +But when the townsfolk saw that the tree was good for food, and +that it was pleasant to the eye, and a tree to be desired to make +one wise, they did as old Ill-pause advised; they took and did eat +thereof. Now this I should have told you before, that even then, +when this Ill-pause was making his speech to the townsmen, my Lord +Innocency (whether by a shot from the camp of the giant, or from +some sinking qualm that suddenly took him, or whether by the +stinking breath of that treacherous villain old Ill-pause, for so I +am most apt to think) sunk down in the place where he stood, nor +could be brought to life again. Thus these two brave men died-- +brave men, I call them; for they were the beauty and glory of +Mansoul, so long as they lived therein; nor did there now remain +any more a noble spirit in Mansoul; they all fell down and yielded +obedience to Diabolus; and became his slaves and vassals, as you +shall hear. + +Now these being dead, what do the rest of the townsfolk, but, as +men that had found a fool's paradise, they presently, as afore was +hinted, fall to prove the truth of the giant's words. And, first, +they did as Ill-pause had taught them; they looked, they considered +they were taken with the forbidden fruit; they took thereof, and +did eat; and having eaten, they became immediately drunken +therewith. So they open the gate, both Ear-gate and Eye-gate, and +let in Diabolus with all his bands, quite forgetting their good +Shaddai, his law, and the judgment that he had annexed, with solemn +threatening, to the breach thereof. + + Diabolus, having now obtained entrance in at the gates of the +town, marches up to the middle thereof, to make his conquest as +sure as he could; and finding, by this time, the affections of the +people warmly inclining to him, he, as thinking it was best +striking while the iron is hot, made this further deceivable speech +unto them, saying, 'Alas, my poor Mansoul! I have done thee indeed +this service, as to promote thee to honour, and to greaten thy +liberty; but, alas! alas! poor Mansoul, thou wantest now one to +defend thee; for assure thyself that when Shaddai shall hear what +is done, he will come; for sorry will he be that thou hast broken +his bonds, and cast his cords away from thee. What wilt thou do? +Wilt thou, after enlargement, suffer thy privileges to be invaded +and taken away, or what wilt resolve with thyself?' + +Then they all with one consent said to this bramble, 'Do thou reign +over us.' So he accepted the motion, and became the king of the +town of Mansoul. This being done, the next thing was to give him +possession of the castle, and so of the whole strength of the town. +Wherefore, into the castle he goes; it was that which Shaddai built +in Mansoul for his own delight and pleasure; this now was become a +den and hold for the giant Diabolus. + +Now, having got possession of this stately palace or castle, what +doth he but makes it a garrison for himself, and strengthens and +fortifies it with all sorts of provision, against the King Shaddai, +or those that should endeavour the regaining of it to him and his +obedience again. + +This done, but not thinking himself yet secure enough, in the next +place he bethinks himself of new modelling the town; and so he +does, setting up one, and putting down another at pleasure. +Wherefore my Lord Mayor, whose name was my Lord Understanding, and +Mr. Recorder, whose name was Mr. Conscience, these he put out of +place and power. + +As for my Lord Mayor, though he was an understanding man, and one +too that had complied with the rest of the town of Mansoul in +admitting the giant into the town, yet Diabolus thought not fit to +let him abide in his former lustre and glory, because he was a +seeing man. Wherefore he darkened him, not only by taking from him +his office and power, but by building a high and strong tower, just +between the sun's reflections and the windows of my lord's palace; +by which means his house and all, and the whole of his habitation, +were made as dark as darkness itself. And thus, being alienated +from the light, he became as one that was born blind. To this, his +house, my lord was confined as to a prison; nor might he, upon his +parole, go farther than within his own bounds. And now, had he had +a heart to do for Mansoul, what could he do for it, or wherein +could he be profitable to her? So then, so long as Mansoul was +under the power and government of Diabolus, (and so long it was +under him, as it was obedient to him, which was even until by a war +it was rescued out of his hand,) so long my Lord Mayor was rather +an impediment in, than an advantage to the famous town of Mansoul. + +As for Mr. Recorder, before the town was taken, he was a man well +read in the laws of his king, and also a man of courage and +faithfulness to speak truth at every occasion; and he had a tongue +as bravely hung as he had a head filled with judgment. Now, this +man Diabolus could by no means abide, because, though he gave his +consent to his coming into the town, yet he could not, by all the +wiles, trials, stratagems, and devices that he could use, make him +wholly his own. True, he was much degenerated from his former +king, and also much pleased with many of the giant's laws and +service; but all this would not do, forasmuch as he was not wholly +his. He would now and then think upon Shaddai, and have dread of +his law upon him, and then he would speak against Diabolus with a +voice as great as when a lion roareth. Yea, and would also at +certain times, when his fits were upon him, (for you must know that +sometimes he had terrible fits,) make the whole town of Mansoul +shake with his voice: and therefore the now king of Mansoul could +not abide him. + +Diabolus, therefore, feared the Recorder more than any that was +left alive in the town of Mansoul, because, as I said, his words +did shake the whole town; they were like the rattling thunder, and +also like thunder-claps. Since, therefore, the giant could not +make him wholly his own, what doth he do but studies all that he +could to debauch the old gentleman, and by debauchery to stupefy +his mind, and more harden his heart in the ways of vanity. And as +he attempted, so he accomplished his design: he debauched the man, +and by little and little so drew him into sin and wickedness, that +at last he was not only debauched, as at first, and so by +consequence defiled, but was almost (at last, I say) past all +conscience of sin. And this was the farthest Diabolus could go. +Wherefore he bethinks him of another project, and that was, to +persuade the men of the town that Mr. Recorder was mad, and so not +to be regarded. And for this he urged his fits, and said, 'If he +be himself, why doth he not do thus always? But,' quoth he, 'as +all mad folks have their fits, and in them their raving language, +so hath this old and doating gentleman.' + +Thus, by one means or another, he quickly got Mansoul to slight, +neglect, and despise whatever Mr. Recorder could say. For, besides +what already you have heard, Diabolus had a way to make the old +gentleman, when he was merry, unsay and deny what he in his fits +had affirmed. And, indeed, this was the next way to make himself +ridiculous, and to cause that no man should regard him. Also now +he never spake freely for King Shaddai, but also by force and +constraint. Besides, he would at one time be hot against that at +which, at another, he would hold his peace; so uneven was he now in +his doings. Sometimes he would be as if fast asleep, and again +sometimes as dead, even then when the whole town of Mansoul was in +her career after vanity, and in her dance after the giant's pipe. + +Wherefore, sometimes when Mansoul did use to be frighted with the +thundering voice of the Recorder that was, and when they did tell +Diabolus of it, he would answer, that what the old gentleman said +was neither of love to him nor pity to them, but of a foolish +fondness that he had to be prating; and so would hush, still, and +put all to quiet again. And that he might leave no argument +unurged that might tend to make them secure, he said, and said it +often, 'O Mansoul! consider that, notwithstanding the old +gentleman's rage, and the rattle of his high and thundering words, +you hear nothing of Shaddai himself;' when, liar and deceiver that +he was, every outcry of Mr. Recorder against the sin of Mansoul was +the voice of God in him to them. But he goes on, and says, 'You +see that he values not the loss nor rebellion of the town of +Mansoul, nor will he trouble himself with calling his town to a +reckoning for their giving themselves to me. He knows that though +you were his, now you are lawfully mine; so, leaving us one to +another, he now hath shaken his hands of us. + +'Moreover, O Mansoul!' quoth he, 'consider how I have served you, +even to the uttermost of my power; and that with the best that I +have, could get, or procure for you in all the world: besides, I +dare say that the laws and customs that you now are under, and by +which you do homage to me, do yield you more solace and content +than did the paradise that at first you possessed. Your liberty +also, as yourselves do very well know, has been greatly widened and +enlarged by me; whereas I found you a penned-up people. I have not +laid any restraint upon you; you have no law, statute, or judgment +of mine to fright you; I call none of you to account for your +doings, except the madman--you know who I mean; I have granted you +to live, each man like a prince in his own, even with as little +control from me as I myself have from you.' + +And thus would Diabolus hush up and quiet the town of Mansoul, when +the Recorder that was, did at times molest them: yea, and with +such cursed orations as these, would set the whole town in a rage +and fury against the old gentleman. Yea, the rascal crew at some +times would be for destroying him. They have often wished, in my +hearing, that he had lived a thousand miles off from them: his +company, his words, yea, the sight of him, and specially when they +remembered how in old times he did use to threaten and condemn +them, (for all he was now so debauched,) did terrify and afflict +them sore. + +But all wishes were vain, for I do not know how, unless by the +power of Shaddai, and his wisdom, he was preserved in being amongst +them. Besides, his house was as strong as a castle, and stood hard +by a stronghold of the town: moreover, if at any time any of the +crew or rabble attempted to make him away, he could pull up the +sluices, and let in such floods as would drown all round about him. + +But to leave Mr. Recorder, and to come to my Lord Willbewill, +another of the gentry of the famous town of Mansoul. This +Willbewill was as high-born as any man in Mansoul, and was as much, +if not more, a freeholder than many of them were; besides, if I +remember my tale aright, he had some privileges peculiar to himself +in the famous town of Mansoul. Now, together with these, he was a +man of great strength, resolution, and courage, nor in his occasion +could any turn him away. But I say, whether he was proud of his +estate, privileges, strength, or what, (but sure it was through +pride of something,) he scorns now to be a slave in Mansoul; and +therefore resolves to bear office under Diabolus, that he might +(such an one as he was) be a petty ruler and governor in Mansoul. +And, headstrong man that he was! thus he began betimes; for this +man, when Diabolus did make his oration at Ear-gate, was one of the +first that was for consenting to his words, and for accepting his +counsel at wholesome, and that was for the opening of the gate, and +for letting him into the town; wherefore Diabolus had a kindness +for him, and therefore he designed for him a place. And perceiving +the valour and stoutness of the man, he coveted to have him for one +of his great ones, to act and do in matters of the highest concern. + +So he sent for him, and talked with him of that secret matter that +lay in his breast, but there needed not much persuasion in the +case. For as at first he was willing that Diabolus should be let +into the town, so now he was as willing to serve him there. When +the tyrant, therefore, perceived the willingness of my lord to +serve him, and that his mind stood bending that way, he forthwith +made him the captain of the castle, governor of the wall, and +keeper of the gates of Mansoul: yea, there was a clause in his +commission, that nothing without him should be done in all the town +of Mansoul. So that now, next to Diabolus himself, who but my Lord +Willbewill in all the town of Mansoul! nor could anything now be +done, but at his will and pleasure, throughout the town of Mansoul. +He had also one Mr. Mind for his clerk, a man to speak on every way +like his master: for he and his lord were in principle one, and in +practice not far asunder. And now was Mansoul brought under to +purpose, and made to fulfil the lusts of the will, and of the mind. + +But it will not out of my thoughts what a desperate one this +Willbewill was when power was put into his hand. First, he flatly +denied that he owed any suit or service to his former prince and +liege lord. This done, in the next place he took an oath, and +swore fidelity to his great master Diabolus, and then, being stated +and settled in his places, offices, advancements, and preferments, +oh! you cannot think, unless you had seen it, the strange work that +this workman made in the town of Mansoul. + +First, he maligned Mr. Recorder to death; he would neither endure +to see him, nor hear the words of his mouth; he would shut his eyes +when he saw him, and stop his ears when he heard him speak. Also +he could not endure that so much as a fragment of the law of +Shaddai should be anywhere seen in the town. For example, his +clerk, Mr. Mind, had some old, rent, and torn parchments of the law +of Shaddai in his house, but when Willbewill saw them, he cast them +behind his back. True, Mr. Recorder had some of the laws in his +study; but my lord could by no means come at them. He also thought +and said, that the windows of my old Lord Mayor's house were always +too light for the profit of the town of Mansoul. The light of a +candle he could not endure. Now nothing at all pleased Willbewill +but what pleased Diabolus his lord. + +There was none like him to trumpet about the streets the brave +nature, the wise conduct, and great glory of the king Diabolus. He +would range and rove throughout all the streets of Mansoul to cry +up his illustrious lord, and would make himself even as an abject, +among the base and rascal crew, to cry up his valiant prince. And +I say, when and wheresoever he found these vassals, he would even +make himself as one of them. In all ill courses he would act +without bidding, and do mischief without commandment. + +The Lord Willbewill also had a deputy under him, and his name was +Mr. Affection, one that was also greatly debauched in his +principles, and answerable thereto in his life: he was wholly +given to the flesh, and therefore they called him Vile-Affection. +Now there was he and one Carnal-Lust, the daughter of Mr. Mind, +(like to like,) that fell in love, and made a match, and were +married; and, as I take it, they had several children, as Impudent, +Blackmouth, and Hate-Reproof. These three were black boys. And +besides these they had three daughters, as Scorn-Truth and Slight- +God, and the name of the youngest was Revenge. These were all +married in the town, and also begot and yielded many bad brats, too +many to be here inserted. But to pass by this. + +When the giant had thus engarrisoned himself in the town of +Mansoul, and had put down and set up whom he thought good, he +betakes himself to defacing. Now there was in the market-place in +Mansoul, and also upon the gates of the castle, an image of the +blessed King Shaddai. This image was so exactly engraven, (and it +was engraven in gold,) that it did the most resemble Shaddai +himself of anything that then was extant in the world. This he +basely commanded to be defaced, and it was as basely done by the +hand of Mr. No-Truth. Now you must know that, as Diabolus had +commanded, and that by the hand of Mr. No-Truth, the image of +Shaddai was defaced, he likewise gave order that the same Mr. No- +Truth should set up in its stead the horrid and formidable image of +Diabolus, to the great contempt of the former King, and debasing of +his town of Mansoul. + +Moreover, Diabolus made havoc of all remains of the laws and +statutes of Shaddai that could be found in the town of Mansoul; to +wit, such as contained either the doctrines of morals, with all +civil and natural documents. Also relative severities he sought to +extinguish. To be short, there was nothing of the remains of good +in Mansoul which he and Willbewill sought not to destroy; for their +design was to turn Mansoul into a brute, and to make it like to the +sensual sow, by the hand of Mr. No-Truth. + +When he had destroyed what law and good orders he could, then +further to effect his design, namely, to alienate Mansoul from +Shaddai her King, he commands, and they set up his own vain edicts, +statutes, and commandments, in all places of resort or concourse in +Mansoul, to wit, such as gave liberty to the lusts of the flesh, +the lusts of the eyes, and the pride of life, which are not of +Shaddai, but of the world. He encouraged, countenanced, and +promoted lasciviousness, and all ungodliness there. Yea, much more +did Diabolus to encourage wickedness in the town of Mansoul; he +promised them peace, content, joy, and bliss, in doing his +commands, and that they should never be called to an account for +their not doing the contrary. And let this serve to give a taste +to them that love to hear tell of what is done beyond their +knowledge afar off in other countries. + +Now Mansoul being wholly at his beck, and brought wholly to his +bow, nothing was heard or seen therein but that which tended to set +up him. + +But now he, having disabled the Lord Mayor and Mr. Recorder from +bearing of office in Mansoul, and seeing that the town, before he +came to it, was the most ancient of corporations in the world, and +fearing, if he did not maintain greatness, they at any time should +object that he had done them an injury; therefore, I say, (that +they might see that he did not intend to lessen their grandeur, or +to take from them any of their advantageous things,) he did choose +for them a Lord Mayor and a Recorder himself, and such as contented +them at the heart, and such also as pleased him wondrous well. + +The name of the Mayor that was of Diabolus' making was the Lord +Lustings, a man that had neither eyes nor ears. All that he did, +whether as a man or an officer, he did it naturally, as doth the +beast. And that which made him yet the more ignoble, though not to +Mansoul, yet to them that beheld and were grieved for its ruin, +was, that he never could favour good, but evil. + +The Recorder was one whose name was Forget-Good, and a very sorry +fellow he was. He could remember nothing but mischief, and to do +it with delight. He was naturally prone to do things that were +hurtful, even hurtful to the town of Mansoul, and to all the +dwellers there. These two, therefore, by their power and practice, +examples, and smiles upon evil, did much more grammar and settle +the common people in hurtful ways. For who doth not perceive that +when those that sit aloft are vile and corrupt themselves, they +corrupt the whole region and country where they are? + +Besides these, Diabolus made several burgesses and aldermen in +Mansoul, such as out of whom the town, when it needed, might choose +them officers, governors, and magistrates. And these are the names +of the chief of them: Mr. Incredulity, Mr. Haughty, Mr. Swearing, +Mr. Whoring, Mr. Hard-Heart, Mr. Pitiless, Mr. Fury, Mr. No-Truth, +Mr. Stand-to-Lies, Mr. False-Peace, Mr. Drunkenness, Mr. Cheating, +Mr. Atheism--thirteen in all. Mr. Incredulity is the eldest, and +Mr. Atheism the youngest of the company. + +There was also an election of common councilmen and others, as +bailiffs, sergeants, constables, and others; but all of them like +to those afore-named, being either fathers, brothers, cousins, or +nephews to them, whose names, for brevity's sake, I omit to +mention. + +When the giant had thus far proceeded in his work, in the next +place, he betook him to build some strongholds in the town, and he +built three that seemed to be impregnable. The first he called the +Hold of Defiance, because it was made to command the whole town, +and to keep it from the knowledge of its ancient King. The second +he called Midnight Hold, because it was built on purpose to keep +Mansoul from the true knowledge of itself. The third was called +Sweet-Sin Hold, because by that he fortified Mansoul against all +desires of good. The first of these holds stood close by Eye-gate, +that, as much might be, light might be darkened there; the second +was built hard by the old castle, to the end that that might be +made more blind, if possible; and the third stood in the market- +place. + +He that Diabolus made governor over the first of these was one +Spite-God, a most blasphemous wretch: he came with the whole +rabble of them that came against Mansoul at first, and was himself +one of themselves. He that was made the governor of Midnight Hold +was one Love-no-Light; he was also of them that came first against +the town. And he that was made the governor of the hold called +Sweet-Sin Hold was one whose name was Love-Flesh: he was also a +very lewd fellow, but not of that country where the other are +bound. This fellow could find more sweetness when he stood sucking +of a lust than he did in all the paradise of God. + +And now Diabolus thought himself safe. He had taken Mansoul, he +had engarrisoned himself therein; he had put down the old officers, +and had set up new ones; he had defaced the image of Shaddai, and +had set up his own; he had spoiled the old law books, and had +promoted his own vain lies; he had made him new magistrates, and +set up new aldermen; he had builded him new holds, and had manned +them for himself: and all this he did to make himself secure, in +case the good Shaddai, or his Son, should come to make an incursion +upon him. + +Now you may well think, that long before this time, word, by some +one or other, could not but be carried to the good King Shaddai, +how his Mansoul, in the continent of Universe, was lost; and that +the runagate giant Diabolus, once one of his Majesty's servants, +had, in rebellion against the King, made sure thereof for himself. +Yea, tidings were carried and brought to the King thereof, and that +to a very circumstance. + +At first, how Diabolus came upon Mansoul (they being a simple +people and innocent) with craft, subtlety, lies, and guile. Item, +that he had treacherously slain the right noble and valiant +captain, their Captain Resistance, as he stood upon the gate with +the rest of the townsmen. Item, how my brave Lord Innocent fell +down dead (with grief, some say, or with being poisoned with the +stinking breath of one Ill-Pause, as say others) at the hearing of +his just lord and rightful prince, Shaddai, so abused by the mouth +of so filthy a Diabolian as that varlet Ill-Pause was. The +messenger further told, that after this Ill-Pause had made a short +oration to the townsmen in behalf of Diabolus, his master; the +simple town, believing that what was said was true, with one +consent did open Ear-gate, the chief gate of the corporation, and +did let him, with his crew, into a possession of the famous town of +Mansoul. He further showed how Diabolus had served the Lord Mayor +and Mr. Recorder, to wit, that he had put them from all place of +power and trust. Item, he showed also that my Lord Willbewill was +turned a very rebel, and runagate, and that so was one Mr. Mind, +his clerk; and that they two did range and revel it all the town +over, and teach the wicked ones their ways. He said, moreover, +that this Willbewill was put into great trust, and particularly +that Diabolus had put into Willbewill's hand all the strong places +in Mansoul; and that Mr. Affection was made my Lord Willbewill's +deputy in his most rebellious affairs. 'Yea,' said the messenger, +'this monster, Lord Willbewill, has openly disavowed his King +Shaddai, and hath horribly given his faith and plighted his troth +to Diabolus.' + +'Also,' said the messenger, 'besides all this, the new king, or +rather rebellious tyrant, over the once famous, but now perishing +town of Mansoul, has set up a Lord Mayor and a Recorder of his own. +For Mayor, he has set up one Mr. Lustings; and for Recorder, Mr. +Forget-Good; two of the vilest of all the town of Mansoul.' This +faithful messenger also proceeded, and told what a sort of new +burgesses Diabolus had made; also that he had built several strong +forts, towers, and strongholds in Mansoul. He told, too, the which +I had almost forgot, how Diabolus had put the town of Mansoul into +arms, the better to capacitate them, on his behalf, to make +resistance against Shaddai their King, should he come to reduce +them to their former obedience. + +Now this tidings-teller did not deliver his relation of things in +private, but in open court, the King and his Son, high lords, chief +captains, and nobles, being all there present to hear. But by that +they had heard the whole of the story, it would have amazed one to +have seen, had he been there to behold it, what sorrow and grief, +and compunction of spirit, there was among all sorts, to think that +famous Mansoul was now taken: only the King and his Son foresaw +all this long before, yea, and sufficiently provided for the relief +of Mansoul, though they told not everybody thereof. Yet because +they also would have a share in condoling of the Misery of Mansoul, +therefore they also did, and that at a rate of the highest degree, +bewail the losing of Mansoul. The King said plainly that it +grieved him at the heart, and you may be sure that his Son was not +a whit behind him. Thus gave they conviction to all about them +that they had love and compassion for the famous town of Mansoul. +Well, when the King and his Son were retired into the privy +chamber, there they again consulted about what they had designed +before, to wit, that as Mansoul should in time be suffered to be +lost, so as certainly it should be recovered again; recovered, I +say, in such a way, as that both the King and his Son would get +themselves eternal fame and glory thereby. Wherefore, after this +consult, the Son of Shaddai (a sweet and comely Person, and one +that had always great affection for those that were in affliction, +but one that had mortal enmity in his heart against Diabolus, +because he was designed for it, and because he sought his crown and +dignity)--this Son of Shaddai, I say, having stricken hands with +his Father and promised that he would be his servant to recover his +Mansoul again, stood by his resolution, nor would he repent of the +same. The purport of which agreement was this: to wit, that at a +certain time, prefixed by both, the King's Son should take a +journey into the country of Universe, and there, in a way of +justice and equity, by making amends for the follies of Mansoul, he +should lay a foundation of perfect deliverance from Diabolus and +from his tyranny. + +Moreover Emmanuel resolved to make, at a time convenient, a war +upon the giant Diabolus, even while he was possessed of the town of +Mansoul; and that he would fairly by strength of hand drive him out +of his hold, his nest, and take it to himself to be his habitation. + +This now being resolved upon, order was given to the Lord Chief +Secretary to draw up a fair record of what was determined, and to +cause that it should be published in all the corners of the kingdom +of Universe. A short breviate of the contents thereof you may, if +you please, take here as follows: + +'Let all men know who are concerned, that the Son of Shaddai, the +great King, is engaged by covenant to his Father to bring his +Mansoul to him again; yea, and to put Mansoul, too, through the +power of his matchless love, into a far better and more happy +condition than it was in before it was taken by Diabolus.' + +These papers, therefore, were published in several places, to the +no little molestation of the tyrant Diabolus; 'for now,' thought +he, 'I shall be molested, and my habitation will be taken from me.' + +But when this matter, I mean this purpose of the King and his Son, +did at first take air at court, who can tell how the high lords, +chief captains, and noble princes that were there, were taken with +the business! First, they whispered it one to another, and after +that it began to ring out through the King's palace, all wondering +at the glorious design that between the King and his Son was on +foot for the miserable town of Mansoul. Yea, the courtiers could +scarce do anything either for the King or kingdom, but they would +mix, with the doing thereof, a noise of the love of the King and +his Son, that they had for the town of Mansoul. + +Nor could these lords, high captains, and princes be content to +keep this news at court; yea, before the records thereof were +perfected, themselves came down and told it in Universe. At last +it came to the ears, as I said, of Diabolus, to his no little +discontent; for you must think it would perplex him to hear of such +a design against him. Well, but after a few casts in his mind, he +concluded upon these four things. + +First, that this news, these good tidings, (if possible,) should be +kept from the ears of the town of Mansoul; 'for,' said he, 'if they +should once come to the knowledge that Shaddai, their former King, +and Emmanuel his Son, are contriving good for the town of Mansoul, +what can be expected by me, but that Mansoul will make a revolt +from under my hand and government, and return again to him?' + +Now, to accomplish this his design, he renews his flattery with my +Lord Willbewill, and also gives him strict charge and command, that +he should keep watch by day and by night at all the gates of the +town, especially Ear-gate and Eye-gate; 'for I hear of a design,' +quoth he, 'a design to make us all traitors, and that Mansoul must +be reduced to its first bondage again. I hope they are but flying +stories,' quoth he; 'however, let no such news by any means be let +into Mansoul, lest the people be dejected thereat. I think, my +lord, it can be no welcome news to you; I am sure it is none to me; +and I think that, at this time, it should be all our wisdom and +care to nip the head of all such rumours as shall tend to trouble +our people. Wherefore I desire, my lord, that you will in this +matter do as I say. Let there be strong guards daily kept at every +gate of the town. Stop also and examine from whence such come that +you perceive do from far come hither to trade, nor let them by any +means be admitted into Mansoul, unless you shall plainly perceive +that they are favourers of our excellent government. I command, +moreover,' said Diabolus, 'that there be spies continually walking +up and down the town of Mansoul, and let them have power to +suppress and destroy any that they shall perceive to be plotting +against us, or that shall prate of what by Shaddai and Emmanuel is +intended.' + +This, therefore, was accordingly done; my Lord Willbewill hearkened +to his lord and master, went willingly after the commandment, and, +with all the diligence he could, kept any that would from going out +abroad, or that sought to bring these tidings to Mansoul, from +coming into the town. + +Secondly, this done, in the next place, Diabolus, that he might +make Mansoul as sure as he could, frames and imposes a new oath and +horrible covenant upon the townsfolk:- To wit, that they should +never desert him nor his government, nor yet betray him, nor seek +to alter his laws; but that they should own, confess, stand by, and +acknowledge him for their rightful king, in defiance to any that do +or hereafter shall, by any pretence, law, or title whatever, lay +claim to the town of Mansoul; thinking, belike, that Shaddai had +not power to absolve them from this covenant with death, and +agreement with hell. Nor did the silly Mansoul stick or boggle at +all at this most monstrous engagement; but, as if it had been a +sprat in the mouth of a whale, they swallowed it without any +chewing. Were they troubled at all? Nay, they rather bragged and +boasted of their so brave fidelity to the tyrant, their pretended +king, swearing that they would never be changelings, nor forsake +their old lord for a new. Thus did Diabolus tie poor Mansoul fast. + +Thirdly. But jealousy, that never thinks itself strong enough, put +him, in the next place, upon another exploit, which was, yet more, +if possible, to debauch this town of Mansoul. Wherefore he caused, +by the hand of one Mr. Filth, an odious, nasty, lascivious piece of +beastliness to be drawn up in writing, and to be set upon the +castle gates; whereby he granted and gave license to all his true +and trusty sons in Mansoul to do whatsoever their lustful appetites +prompted them to do; and that no man was to let, hinder, or control +them, upon pain of incurring the displeasure of their prince. + +Now this he did for these reasons:- + +1. That the town of Mansoul might be yet made weaker and weaker, +and so more unable, should tidings come that their redemption was +designed, to believe, hope, or consent to the truth thereof; for +reason says, The bigger the sinner, the less grounds of hopes of +mercy. + +2. The second reason was, if perhaps Emmanuel, the Son of Shaddai +their King, by seeing the horrible and profane doings of the town +of Mansoul, might repent, though entered into a covenant of +redeeming them, of pursuing that covenant of their redemption; for +he knew that Shaddai was holy, and that his Son Emmanuel was holy; +yea, he knew it by woeful experience, for for his iniquity and sin +was Diabolus cast from the highest orbs. Wherefore what more +rational than for him to conclude that thus, for sin, it might fare +with Mansoul? But fearing also lest this knot should break, he +bethinks himself of another, to wit:- + +Fourthly. To endeavour to possess all hearts in the town of +Mansoul that Shaddai was raising an army, to come to overthrow and +utterly to destroy this town of Mansoul. And this he did to +forestall any tidings that might come to their ears of their +deliverance: 'For,' thought he, 'if I first bruit this, the +tidings that shall come after will all be swallowed up of this; for +what else will Mansoul say, when they shall hear that they must be +delivered, but that the true meaning is, Shaddai intends to destroy +them? Wherefore he summons the whole town into the market-place, +and there, with deceitful tongue, thus he addressed himself unto +them:- + +'Gentlemen, and my very good friends, you are all, as you know, my +legal subjects, and men of the famous town of Mansoul. You know +how, from the first day that I have been with you until now, I have +behaved myself among you, and what liberty and great privileges you +have enjoyed under my government, I hope to your honour and mine, +and also to your content and delight. Now, my famous Mansoul, a +noise of trouble there is abroad, of trouble to the town of +Mansoul; sorry I am thereof for your sakes: for I received but now +by the post from my Lord Lucifer, (and he useth to have good +intelligence,) that your old King Shaddai is raising an army to +come against you, to destroy you root and branch; and this, O +Mansoul, is now the cause that at this time I have called you +together, namely, to advise what in this juncture is best to be +done. For my part, I am but one, and can with ease shift for +myself, did I list to seek my own case, and to leave my Mansoul in +all the danger; but my heart is so firmly united to you, and so +unwilling am I to leave you, that I am willing to stand and fall +with you, to the utmost hazard that shall befall me. What say you, +O my Mansoul? Will you now desert your old friend, or do you think +of standing by me?' + +Then, as one man, with one mouth, they cried out together, 'Let him +die the death that will not.' + +Then said Diabolus again, 'It is in vain for us to hope for +quarter, for this King knows not how to show it. True, perhaps, +he, at his first sitting down before us, will talk of and pretend +to mercy, that thereby, with the more ease, and less trouble, he +may again make himself the master of Mansoul. Whatever, therefore, +he shall say, believe not one syllable or tittle of it; for all +such language is but to overcome us, and to make us, while we +wallow in our blood, the trophies of his merciless victory. My +mind is, therefore, that we resolve to the last man to resist him, +and not to believe him upon any terms, for in at that door will +come our danger. But shall we be flattered out of our lives? I +hope you know more of the rudiments of politics than to suffer +yourselves so pitifully to be served. + +'But suppose he should, if he get us to yield, save some of our +lives, or the lives of some of them that are underlings in Mansoul, +what help will that be to you that are the chief of the town, +especially you whom I have set up and whose greatness has been +procured by you through your faithful sticking to me? And suppose, +again, that he should give quarter to every one of you, be sure he +will bring you into that bondage under which you were captivated +before, or a worse, and then what good will your lives do you? +Shall you with him live in pleasure as you do now? No, no; you +must be bound by laws that will pinch you, and be made to do that +which at present is hateful to you. I am for you, if you are for +me; and it is better to die valiantly than to live like pitiful +slaves. But, I say, the life of a slave will be counted a life too +good for Mansoul now. Blood, blood, nothing but blood is in every +blast of Shaddai's trumpet against poor Mansoul now. Pray, be +concerned; I hear he is coming. Up, and stand to your arms that +now, while you have any leisure, I may learn you some feats of war. +Armour for you I have, and by me it is; yea, and it is sufficient +for Mansoul from top to toe; nor can you be hurt by what his force +can do, if you shall keep it well girt and fastened about you. +Come, therefore, to my castle, and welcome, and harness yourselves +for the war. There is helmet, breastplate, sword, and shield, and +what not, that will make you fight like men. + +'1. My helmet, otherwise called an head-piece, is in hope of doing +well at last, what lives soever you live. This is that which they +had who said, that they should have peace, though they walked in +the wickedness of their heart, to add drunkenness to thirst. A +piece of approved armour this is, and whoever has it, and can hold +it, so long no arrow, dart, sword, or shield can hurt him. This, +therefore, keep on, and thou wilt keep off many a blow, my Mansoul. + +'2. My breastplate is a breastplate of iron. I had it forged in +mine own country, and all my soldiers are armed therewith. In +plain language, it is a hard heart, a heart as hard as iron, and as +much past feeling as a stone; the which if you get and keep, +neither mercy shall win you, nor judgment fright you. This +therefore, is a piece of armour most necessary for all to put on +that hate Shaddai, and that would fight against him under my +banner. + +'3. My sword is a tongue that is set on fire of hell, and that can +bend itself to speak evil of Shaddai, his Son, his ways, and +people. Use this; it has been tried a thousand times twice told. +Whoever hath it, keeps it, and makes that use of it as I would have +him, can never be conquered by mine enemy. + +'4. My, shield is unbelief, or calling into question the truth of +the word, or all the sayings that speak of the judgment that +Shaddai has appointed for wicked men. Use this shield; many +attempts he has made upon it, and sometimes, it is true, it has +been bruised; but they that have writ of the wars of Emmanuel +against my servants, have testified that he could do no mighty work +there because of their unbelief. Now, to handle this weapon of +mine aright, it is not to believe things because they are true, of +what sort or by whomsoever asserted. If he speaks of judgment, +care not for it; if he speaks of mercy, care not for it; if he +promises, if he swears that he would do to Mansoul, if it turns, no +hurt, but good, regard not what is said, question the truth of all, +for it is to wield the shield of unbelief aright, and as my +servants ought and do; and he that doth otherwise loves me not, nor +do I count him but an enemy to me. + +'5. Another part or piece,' said Diabolus, 'of mine excellent +armour is a dumb and prayerless spirit, a spirit that scorns to cry +for mercy: wherefore be you, my Mansoul, sure that you make use of +this. What! cry for quarter! Never do that, if you would be mine. +I know you are stout men, and am sure that I have clad you with +that which is armour of proof. Wherefore, to cry to Shaddai for +mercy, let that be far from you. Besides all this, I have a maul, +firebrands, arrows, and death, all good hand-weapons, and such as +will do execution.' + +After he had thus furnished his men with armour and arms, he +addressed himself to them in such like words as these: 'Remember,' +quoth he, 'that I am your rightful king, and that you have taken an +oath and entered into covenant to be true to me and my cause: I +say, remember this, and show yourselves stout and valiant men of +Mansoul. Remember also the kindness that I have always showed to +you, and that without your petition I have granted to you external +things; wherefore the privileges, grants, immunities, profits, and +honours wherewith I have endowed you do call for, at your hands, +returns of loyalty, my lion-like men of Mansoul: and when so fit a +time to show it as when another shall seek to take my dominion over +you into his own hands? One word more, and I have done. Can we +but stand, and overcome this one shock or brunt, I doubt not but in +little time all the world will be ours; and when that day comes, my +true hearts, I will make you kings, princes, and captains, and what +brave days shall we have then!' + +Diabolus having thus armed and forearmed his servants and vassals +in Mansoul against their good and lawful King Shaddai, in the next +place, he doubleth his guards at the gates of the town, and he +takes himself to the castle, which was his stronghold. His vassals +also, to show their wills, and supposed (but ignoble) gallantry, +exercise themselves in their arms every day, and teach one another +feats of war; they also defied their enemies, and sang up the +praises of their tyrant; they threatened also what men they would +be if ever things should rise so high as a war between Shaddai and +their king. + +Now all this time the good King, the King Shaddai, was preparing to +send an army to recover the town of Mansoul again from under the +tyranny of their pretended king Diabolus; but he thought good, at +first, not to send them by the hand and conduct of brave Emmanuel +his Son, but under the hand of some of his servants, to see first +by them the temper of Mansoul, and whether by them they would be +won to the obedience of their King. The army consisted of above +forty thousand, all true men, for they came from the King's own +court, and were those of his own choosing. + +They came up to Mansoul under the conduct of four stout generals, +each man being a captain of ten thousand men, and these are their +names and their ensigns. The name of the first was Boanerges, the +name of the second was Captain Conviction, the name of the third +was Captain Judgment, and the name of the fourth was Captain +Execution. These were the captains that Shaddai sent to regain +Mansoul. + +These four captains, as was said, the King thought fit, in the +first place, to send to Mansoul, to make an attempt upon it; for +indeed generally in all his wars he did use to send these four +captains in the van, for they were very stout and rough-hewn men, +men that were fit to break the ice, and to make their way by dint +of sword, and their men were like themselves. + +To each of these captains the King gave a banner, that it might be +displayed, because of the goodness of his cause, and because of the +right that he had to Mansoul. + +First, to Captain Boanerges, for he was the chief, to him, I say, +were given ten thousand men. His ensign was Mr. Thunder; he bare +the black colours, and his scutcheon was the three burning +thunderbolts. + +The second captain was Captain Conviction; to him also were given +ten thousand men. His ensign's name was Mr. Sorrow; he did bear +the pale colours, and his scutcheon was the book of the law wide +open, from whence issued a flame of fire. + +The third captain was Captain Judgment; to him were given ten +thousand men. His ensign's name was Mr. Terror; he bare the red +colours, and his scutcheon was a burning fiery furnace. + +The fourth captain was Captain Execution; to him were given ten +thousand men. His ensign was one Mr. Justice; he also bare the red +colours, and his scutcheon was a fruitless tree, with an axe lying +at the root thereof. + +These four captains, as I said, had every one of them under his +command ten thousand men, all of good fidelity to the King, and +stout at their military actions. + +Well, the captains and their forces, their men and under officers, +being had upon a day by Shaddai into the field, and there called +all over by their names, were then and there put into such harness +as became their degree and that service which now they were going +about for their King. + +Now, when the King had mustered his forces, (for it is he that +mustereth the host to the battle,) he gave unto the captains their +several commissions, with charge and commandment in the audience of +all the soldiers, that they should take heed faithfully and +courageously to do and execute the same. Their commissions were, +for the substance of them, the same in form, though, as to name, +title, place and degree of the captains, there might be some, but +very small variation. And here let me give you an account of the +matter and sum contained in their commission. + + +A Commission from the great Shaddai, King of Mansoul, to his trusty +and noble Captain, the Captain Boanerges, for his making War upon +the town of Mansoul. + + +'O, thou Boanerges, one of my stout and thundering captains over +one ten thousand of my valiant and faithful servants, go thou in my +name, with this thy force, to the miserable town of Mansoul; and +when thou comest thither, offer them first conditions of peace; and +command them that, casting off the yoke and tyranny of the wicked +Diabolus, they return to me, their rightful Prince and Lord. +Command them also that they cleanse themselves from all that is his +in the town of Mansoul, and look to thyself, that thou hast good +satisfaction touching the truth of their obedience. Thus when thou +hast commanded them, (if they in truth submit thereto,) then do +thou, to the uttermost of thy power, what in thee lies to set up +for me a garrison in the famous town of Mansoul; nor do thou hurt +the least native that moveth or breatheth therein, if they will +submit themselves to me, but treat thou such as if they were thy +friend or brother; for all such I love, and they shall be dear unto +me, and tell them that I will take a time to come unto them, and to +let them know that I am merciful. + +'But if they shall, notwithstanding thy summons and the producing +of thy authority, resist, stand out against thee, and rebel, then +do I command thee to make use of all thy cunning, power, might, and +force, to bring them under by strength of hand. Farewell.' + + +Thus you see the sum of their commissions; for, as I said before, +for the substance of them, they were the same that the rest of the +noble captains had. + +Wherefore they, having received each commander his authority at the +hand of their King, the day being appointed, and the place of their +rendezvous prefixed, each commander appeared in such gallantry as +became his cause and calling. So, after a new entertainment from +Shaddai, with flying colours they set forward to march towards the +famous town of Mansoul. Captain Boanerges led the van, Captain +Conviction and Captain Judgment made up the main body, and Captain +Execution brought up the rear. They then, having a great way to +go, (for the town of Mansoul was far off from the court of +Shaddai,) marched through the regions and countries of many people, +not hurting or abusing any, but blessing wherever they came. They +also lived upon the King's cost in all the way they went. + +Having travelled thus for many days, at last they came within sight +of Mansoul; the which when they saw, the captains could for their +hearts do no less than for a while bewail the condition of the +town; for they quickly saw how that it was prostrate to the will of +Diabolus, and to his ways and designs. + +Well, to be short, the captains came up before the town, march up +to Ear-gate, sit down there (for that was the place of hearing). +So, when they had pitched their tents and entrenched themselves, +they addressed themselves to make their assault. + +Now the townsfolk at first, beholding so gallant a company, so +bravely accoutred, and so excellently disciplined, having on their +glittering armour, and displaying of their flying colours, could +not but come out of their houses and gaze. But the cunning fox +Diabolus, fearing that the people, after this sight, should, on a +sudden summons, open the gates to the captains, came down with all +haste from the castle, and made them retire into the body of the +town, who, when he had them there, made this lying and deceivable +speech unto them: + +'Gentlemen,' quoth he, 'although you are my trusty and well-beloved +friends, yet I cannot but a little chide you for your late +uncircumspect action, in going out to gaze on that great and mighty +force that but yesterday sat down before, and have now entrenched +themselves in order to the maintaining of a siege against the +famous town of Mansoul. Do you know who they are, whence they +come, and what is their purpose in sitting down before the town of +Mansoul? They are they of whom I have told you long ago, that they +would come to destroy this town, and against whom I have been at +the cost to arm you with cap-a-pie for your body, besides great +fortifications for your mind. Wherefore, then, did you not rather, +even at the first appearance of them, cry out, "Fire the beacons!" +and give the whole town an alarm concerning them, that we might all +have been in a posture of defence, and been ready to have received +them with the highest acts of defiance? Then had you showed +yourselves men to my liking; whereas, by what you have done, you +have made me half afraid--I say, half afraid--that when they and we +shall come to push a pike, I shall find you want courage to stand +it out any longer. Wherefore have I commanded a watch, and that +you should double your guards at the gates? Wherefore have I +endeavoured to make you as hard as iron, and your hearts as a piece +of the nether millstone? Was it, think you, that you might show +yourselves women, and that you might go out like a company of +innocents to gaze on your mortal foes? Fie, fie! put yourselves +into a posture of defence, beat up the drum, gather together in +warlike manner, that our foes may know that, before they shall +conquer this corporation, there are valiant men in the town of +Mansoul. + +'I will leave off now to chide, and will not further rebuke you; +but I charge you, that henceforwards you let me see no more such +actions. Let not henceforward a man of you, without order first +obtained from me, so much as show his head over the wall of the +town of Mansoul. You have now heard me; do as I have commanded, +and you shall cause me that I dwell securely with you, and that I +take care, as for myself, so for your safety and honour also. +Farewell." + +Now were the townsmen strangely altered; they were as men stricken +with a panic fear; they ran to and fro through the streets of the +town of Mansoul, crying out, 'Help, help! the men that turn the +world upside down are come hither also.' Nor could any of them be +quiet after; but still, as men bereft of wit, they cried out, 'The +destroyers of our peace and people are come.' This went down with +Diabolus. 'Ah,' quoth he to himself, 'this I like well: now it is +as I would have it; now you show your obedience to your prince. +Hold you but here, and then let them take the town if they can.' + +Well, before the King's forces had sat before Mansoul three days, +Captain Boanerges commanded his trumpeter to go down to Ear-gate, +and there, in the name of the great Shaddai, to summon Mansoul to +give audience to the message that he, in his Master's name, was to +them commanded to deliver. So the trumpeter, whose name was Take- +heed-what-you-hear, went up, as he was commanded, to Ear-gate, and +there sounded his trumpet for a hearing; but there was none that +appeared that gave answer or regard, for so had Diabolus commanded. +So the trumpeter returned to his captain, and told him what he had +done, and also how he had sped; whereat the captain was grieved, +but bid the trumpeter go to his tent. + +Again Captain Boanerges sendeth his trumpeter to Ear-gate, to sound +as before for a hearing; but they again kept close, came not out, +nor would they give him an answer, so observant were they of the +command of Diabolus their king. + +Then the captains and other field officers called a council of war, +to consider what further was to be done for the gaining of the town +of Mansoul; and, after some close and thorough debate upon the +contents of their commissions, they concluded yet to give to the +town, by the hand of the fore-named trumpeter, another summons to +hear; but if that shall be refused, said they, and that the town +shall stand it out still, then they determined, and bid the +trumpeter tell them so, that they would endeavour, by what means +they could, to compel them by force to the obedience of their King. + +So Captain Boanerges commanded his trumpeter to go up to Ear-gate +again, and, in the name of the great King Shaddai, to give it a +very loud summons to come down without delay to Ear-gate, there to +give audience to the King's most noble captains. So the trumpeter +went, and did as he was commanded: he went up to Ear-gate, and +sounded his trumpet, and gave a third summons to Mansoul. He said, +moreover, that if this they should still refuse to do, the captains +of his prince would with might come down upon them, and endeavour +to reduce them to their obedience by force. + +Then stood up my Lord Willbewill, who was the governor of the town, +(this Willbewill was that apostate of whom mention was made +before,) and the keeper of the gates of Mansoul. He therefore, +with big and ruffling words, demanded of the trumpeter who he was, +whence he came, and what was the cause of his making so hideous a +noise at the gate, and speaking such insufferable words against the +town of Mansoul. + +The trumpeter answered, 'I am servant to the most noble captain, +Captain Boanerges, general of the forces of the great King Shaddai, +against whom both thyself, with the whole town of Mansoul, have +rebelled, and lift up the heel; and my master, the captain, hath a +special message to this town, and to thee, as a member thereof; the +which if you of Mansoul shall peaceably hear, so; and if not, you +must take what follows.' + +Then said the Lord Willbewill, 'I will carry thy words to my lord, +and will know what he will say.' + +But the trumpeter soon replied, saying. 'Our message is not to the +giant Diabolus, but to the miserable town of Mansoul; nor shall we +at all regard what answer by him is made, nor yet by any for him. +We are sent to this town to recover it from under his cruel +tyranny, and to persuade it to submit, as in former times it did, +to the most excellent King Shaddai.' + +Then said the Lord Willbewill, 'I will do your errand to the town.' + +The trumpeter then replied, 'Sir, do not deceive us, lest, in so +doing, you deceive yourselves much more.' He added, moreover, 'For +we are resolved, if in peaceable manner you do not submit +yourselves, then to make a war upon you, and to bring you under by +force. And of the truth of what I now say, this shall be a sign +unto you,--you shall see the black flag, with its hot, burning +thunder-bolts, set upon the mount to-morrow, as a token of defiance +against your prince, and of our resolutions to reduce you to your +Lord and rightful King.' + +So the said Lord Willbewill returned from off the wall, and the +trumpeter came into the camp. When the trumpeter was come into the +camp, the captains and officers of the mighty King Shaddai came +together to know if he had obtained a hearing, and what was the +effect of his errand. So the trumpeter told, saying, 'When I had +sounded my trumpet, and had called aloud to the town for a hearing, +my Lord Willbewill, the governor of the town, and he that hath +charge of the gates, came up when he heard me sound, and, looking +over the wall, he asked me what I was, whence I came, and what was +the cause of my making this noise. So I told him my errand, and by +whose authority I brought it. "Then," said he, "I will tell it to +the governor and to Mansoul;" and then I returned to my lords.' + +Then said the brave Boanerges, 'Let us yet for a while lie still in +our trenches, and see what these rebels will do.' + +Now when the time drew nigh that audience by Mansoul must be given +to the brave Boanerges and his companions, it was commanded that +all the men of war throughout the whole camp of Shaddai should as +one man stand to their arms, and make themselves ready, if the town +of Mansoul shall hear, to receive it forthwith to mercy; but if +not, to force a subjection. So the day being come, the trumpeters +sounded, and that throughout the whole camp, that the men of war +might be in a readiness for that which then should be the work of +the day. But when they that were in the town of Mansoul heard the +sound of the trumpets throughout the camp of Shaddai, and thinking +no other but that it must be in order to storm the corporation, +they at first were put to great consternation of spirit; but after +they a little were settled again, they also made what preparation +they could for a war, if they did storm; else, to secure +themselves. + +Well, when the utmost time was come, Boanerges was resolved to hear +their answer; wherefore he sent out his trumpeter again to summon +Mansoul to a hearing of the message that they had brought from +Shaddai. + +So he went and sounded, and the townsmen came up, but made Ear-gate +as sure as they could. Now when they were come up to the top of +the wall, Captain Boanerges desired to see the Lord Mayor; but my +Lord Incredulity was then Lord Mayor, for he came in the room of my +Lord Lustings. So Incredulity came up and showed himself over the +wall; but when the Captain Boanerges had set his eyes upon him, he +cried out aloud, 'This is not he: where is my Lord Understanding, +the ancient Lord Mayor of the town of Mansoul? for to him I would +deliver my message.' + +Then said the giant (for Diabolus was also come down) to the +captain, 'Mr. Captain, you have by your boldness given to Mansoul +at least four summonses to subject herself to your King, by whose +authority I know not, nor will I dispute that now. I ask, +therefore, what is the reason of all this ado, or what would you be +at if you knew yourselves?' + +Then Captain Boanerges, whose were the black colours, and whose +scutcheon was the three burning thunderbolts, taking no notice of +the giant or of his speech, thus addressed himself to the town of +Mansoul: 'Be it known unto you, O unhappy and rebellious Mansoul, +that the most gracious King, the great King Shaddai, my Master, +hath sent me unto you with commission' (and so he showed to the +town his broad seal) 'to reduce you to his obedience; and he hath +commanded me, in case you yield upon my summons, to carry it to you +as if you were my friends or brethren; but he also hath bid, that +if, after summons to submit you still stand out and rebel, we +should endeavour to take you by force.' + +Then stood forth Captain Conviction, and said, (his were the pale +colours, and for a scutcheon he had the book of the law wide open, +etc.,) 'Hear, O Mansoul! Thou, O Mansoul, wast once famous for +innocency, but now thou art degenerated into lies and deceit. Thou +hast heard what my brother, the Captain Boanerges, hath said; and +it is your wisdom, and will be your happiness, to stoop to, and +accept of conditions of peace and mercy when offered, specially +when offered by one against whom thou hast rebelled, and one who is +of power to tear thee in pieces, for so is Shaddai, our King; nor, +when he is angry, can anything stand before him. If you say you +have not sinned, or acted rebellion against our King, the whole of +your doings since the day that you cast off his service (and there +was the beginning of your sin) will sufficiently testify against +you. What else means your hearkening to the tyrant, and your +receiving him for your king? What means else your rejecting of the +laws of Shaddai, and your obeying of Diabolus? Yea, what means +this your taking up of arms against, and the shutting of your gates +upon us, the faithful servants of your King? Be ruled then, and +accept of my brother's invitation, and overstand not the time of +mercy, but agree with thine adversary quickly. Ah, Mansoul! suffer +not thyself to be kept from mercy, and to be run into a thousand +miseries, by the flattering wiles of Diabolus. Perhaps that piece +of deceit may attempt to make you believe that we seek our own +profit in this our service, but know it is obedience to our King, +and love to your happiness, that is the cause of this undertaking +of ours. + +'Again I say to thee, O Mansoul, consider if it be not amazing +grace that Shaddai should so humble himself as he doth: now he, by +us, reasons with you, in a way of entreaty and sweet persuasions, +that you would subject yourselves to him. Has he that need of you +that we are sure you have of him? No, no; but he is merciful, and +will not that Mansoul should die, but turn to him and live.' + +Then stood forth Captain Judgment, whose were the red colours, and +for a scutcheon he had the burning fiery furnace, and he said, 'O +ye, the inhabitants of the town of Mansoul, that have lived so long +in rebellion and acts of treason against the King Shaddai, know +that we come not to-day to this place, in this manner, with our +message of our own minds, or to revenge our own quarrel; it is the +King, my Master, that hath sent us to reduce you to your obedience +to him; the which if you refuse in a peaceable way to yield, we +have commission to compel you thereto. And never think of +yourselves, nor yet suffer the tyrant Diabolus to persuade you to +think, that our King, by his power, is not able to bring you down, +and to lay you under his feet; for he is the former of all things, +and if he touches the mountains, they smoke. Nor will the gate of +the King's clemency stand always open; for the day that shall burn +like an oven is before him; yea, it hasteth greatly, it slumbereth +not. + +'O Mansoul, is it little in thine eyes that our King doth offer +thee mercy, and that after so many provocations? Yea, he still +holdeth out his golden sceptre to thee, and will not yet suffer his +gate to be shut against thee: wilt thou provoke him to do it? If +so, consider of what I say; to thee it is opened no more for ever. +If thou sayest thou shalt not see him, yet judgment is before him; +therefore trust thou in him. Yea, because there is wrath, beware +lest he take thee away with his stroke; then a great ransom cannot +deliver thee. Will he esteem thy riches? No, not gold, nor all +the forces of strength. He hath prepared his throne for judgment, +for he will come with fire, and with his chariots like a whirlwind, +to render his anger with fury, and his rebukes with flames of fire. +Therefore, O Mansoul, take heed lest, after thou hast fulfilled the +judgment of the wicked, justice and judgment should take hold of +thee.' + +Now while the Captain Judgment was making this oration to the town +of Mansoul, it was observed by some that Diabolus trembled; but he +proceeded in his parable and said, 'O thou woful town of Mansoul, +wilt thou not yet set open thy gate to receive us, the deputies of +thy King, and those that would rejoice to see thee live? Can thine +heart endure, or can thy hands be strong, in the day that he shall +deal in judgment with thee? I say, canst thou endure to be forced +to drink, as one would drink sweet wine, the sea of wrath that our +King has prepared for Diabolus and his angels? Consider, betimes +consider.' + +Then stood forth the fourth captain, the noble Captain Execution, +and said, 'O town of Mansoul, once famous, but now like the +fruitless bough, once the delight of the high ones, but now a den +for Diabolus, hearken also to me, and to the words that I shall +speak to thee in the name of the great Shaddai. Behold, the axe is +laid to the root of the trees: every tree, therefore, that +bringeth not forth good fruit, is hewn down and cast into the fire. + +'Thou, O town of Mansoul, hast hitherto been this fruitless tree; +thou bearest nought but thorns and briars. Thy evil fruit bespeaks +thee not to be a good tree; thy grapes are grapes of gall, thy +clusters are bitter. Thou hast rebelled against thy King; and, lo! +we, the power and force of Shaddai, are the axe that is laid to thy +root. What sayest thou? Wilt thou turn? I say again, tell me, +before the first blow is given, wilt thou turn? Our axe must first +be laid TO thy root before it be laid AT thy root; it must first be +laid TO thy root in a way of threatening, before it is laid AT thy +root by way of execution; and between these two is required thy +repentance, and this is all the time that thou hast. What wilt +thou do? Wilt thou turn, or shall I smite? If I fetch my blow, +Mansoul, down you go; for I have commission to lay my axe AT as +well as TO thy roots, nor will anything but yielding to our King +prevent doing of execution. What art thou fit for, O Mansoul, if +mercy preventeth not, but to be hewn down, and cast into the fire +and burned? + +'O Mansoul, patience and forbearance do not act for ever: a year, +or two, or three, they may; but if thou provoke by a three years' +rebellion, (and thou hast already done more than this,) then what +follows but, 'Cut it down'? nay, 'After that thou shalt cut it +down.' And dost thou think that these are but threatenings, or +that our King has not power to execute his words? O Mansoul, thou +wilt find that in the words of our King, when they are by sinners +made little or light of, there is not only threatening, but burning +coals of fire. + +'Thou hast been a cumber-ground long already, and wilt thou +continue so still? Thy sin has brought this army to thy walls, and +shall it bring it in judgment to do execution into thy town? Thou +hast heard what the captains have said, but as yet thou shuttest +thy gates. Speak out, Mansoul; wilt thou do so still, or wilt thou +accept of conditions of peace?' + +These brave speeches of these four noble captains the town of +Mansoul refused to hear; yet a sound thereof did beat against Ear- +gate, though the force thereof could not break it open. In fine, +the town desired a time to prepare their answer to these demands. +The captains then told them, that if they would throw out to them +one Ill-Pause that was in the town, that they might reward him +according to his works, then they would give them time to consider; +but if they would not cast him to them over the wall of Mansoul, +then they would give them none; 'for,' said they, 'we know that, so +long as Ill-Pause draws breath in Mansoul, all good consideration +will be confounded, and nothing but mischief will come thereon.' + +Then Diabolus, who was there present, being loath to lose his Ill- +Pause, because he was his orator, (and yet be sure he had, could +the captains have laid their fingers on him,) was resolved at this +instant to give them answer by himself; but then changing his mind, +he commanded the then Lord Mayor, the Lord Incredulity, to do it, +saying, 'My lord, do you give these runagates an answer, and speak +out, that Mansoul may hear and understand you.' + +So Incredulity, at Diabolus' command, began, and said, 'Gentlemen, +you have here, as we do behold, to the disturbance of our prince +and the molestation of the town of Mansoul, camped against it: but +from whence you come, we will not know; and what you are, we will +not believe. Indeed, you tell us in your terrible speech that you +have this authority from Shaddai, but by what right he commands you +to do it, of that we shall yet be ignorant. + +'You have also, by the authority aforesaid, summoned this town to +desert her lord, and, for protection, to yield up herself to the +great Shaddai, your King; flatteringly telling her, that if she +will do it, he will pass by and not charge her with her past +offences. + +'Further, you have also, to the terror of the town of Mansoul, +threatened with great and sore destructions to punish this +corporation, if she consents not to do as your wills would have +her. + +'Now, captains, from whencesoever you come, and though your designs +be ever so right, yet know ye that neither my Lord Diabolus, nor I, +his servant, Incredulity, nor yet our brave Mansoul, doth regard +either your persons, message, or the King that you say hath sent +you. His power, his greatness, his vengeance, we fear not; nor +will we yield at all to your summons. + +'As for the war that you threaten to make upon us, we must therein +defend ourselves as well as we can; and know ye, that we are not +without wherewithal to bid defiance to you; and, in short, (for I +will not be tedious,) I tell you, that we take you to be some +vagabond runagate crew, that having shaken off all obedience to +your King, have gotten together in tumultuous manner, and are +ranging from place to place to see if, through the flatteries you +are skilled to make on the one side, and threats wherewith you +think to fright on the other, to make some silly town, city, or +country, desert their place, and leave it to you; but Mansoul is +none of them. + +'To conclude: we dread you not, we fear you not, nor will we obey +your summons. Our gates we will shut upon you, our place we will +keep you out of. Nor will we long thus suffer you to sit down +before us: our people must live in quiet: your appearance doth +disturb them. Wherefore arise with bag and baggage, and begone, or +we will let fly from the walls against you.' + +This oration, made by old Incredulity, was seconded by desperate +Willbewill, in words to this effect: 'Gentlemen, we have heard +your demands, and the noise of your threats, and have heard the +sound of your summons; but we fear not your force, we regard not +your threats, but will still abide as you found us. And we command +you, that in three days' time you cease to appear in these parts, +or you shall know what it is once to dare offer to rouse the lion +Diabolus when asleep in his town of Mansoul.' + +The Recorder, whose name was Forget-Good, he also added as +followeth: 'Gentlemen, my lords, as you see, have with mild and +gentle words answered your rough and angry speeches: they have, +moreover, in my hearing, given you leave quietly to depart as you +came; wherefore, take their kindness and be gone. We might have +come out with force upon you, and have caused you to feel the dint +of our swords; but as we love ease and quiet ourselves, so we love +not to hurt or molest others.' + +Then did the town of Mansoul shout for joy, as if by Diabolus and +his crew some great advantage had been gotten of the captains. +They also rang the bells, and made merry, and danced upon the +walls. + +Diabolus also returned to the castle, and the Lord Mayor and +Recorder to their place; but the Lord Willbewill took special care +that the gates should be secured with double guards, double bolts, +and double locks and bars; and that Ear-gate especially might the +better be looked to, for that was the gate in at which the King's +forces sought most to enter. The Lord Willbewill made one old Mr. +Prejudice, an angry and ill-conditioned fellow, captain of the ward +at that gate, and put under his power sixty men, called deaf men; +men advantageous for that service, forasmuch as they mattered no +words of the captains, nor of the soldiers. + +Now when the captains saw the answer of the great ones, and that +they could not get a hearing from the old natives of the town, and +that Mansoul was resolved to give the King's army battle, they +prepared themselves to receive them, and to try it out by the power +of the arm. And, first, they made their force more formidable +against Ear-gate; for they knew that, unless they could penetrate +that, no good could be done upon the town. This done, they put the +rest of their men in their places; after which, they gave out the +word, which was, 'YE MUST BE BORN AGAIN.' Then they sounded the +trumpet; then they in the town made them answer, with shout against +shout, charge against charge, and so the battle began. Now they in +the town had planted upon the tower over Ear-gate two great guns, +the one called High-mind, and the other Heady. Unto these two guns +they trusted much; they were cast in the castle by Diabolus' +founder, whose name was Mr. Puff-up, and mischievous pieces they +were. But so vigilant and watchful, when the captains saw them, +were they, that though sometimes their shot would go by their ears +with a whiz, yet they did them no harm. By these two guns the +townsfolk made no question but greatly to annoy the camp of +Shaddai, and well enough to secure the gate; but they had not much +cause to boast of what execution they did, as by what follows will +be gathered. + +The famous Mansoul had also some other small pieces in it, of the +which they made use against the camp of Shaddai. + +They from the camp also did as stoutly, and with as much of that as +may in truth be called valour, let fly as fast at the town and at +Ear-gate; for they saw that, unless they could break open Ear-gate, +it would be but in vain to batter the wall. Now the King's +captains had brought with them several slings, and two or three +battering-rams; with their slings, therefore, they battered the +houses and people of the town, and with their rams they sought to +break Ear-gate open. + +The camp and the town had several skirmishes and brisk encounters, +while the captains with their engines made many brave attempts to +break open or beat down the tower that was over Ear-gate, and at +the said gate to make their entrance; but Mansoul stood it out so +lustily, through the rage of Diabolus, the valour of the Lord +Willbewill, and the conduct of old Incredulity, the Mayor, and Mr. +Forget-Good, the Recorder, that the charge and expense of that +summer's wars, on the King's side, seemed to be almost quite lost, +and the advantage to return to Mansoul. But when the captains saw +how it was they made a fair retreat, and entrenched themselves in +their winter quarters. Now, in this war, you must needs think +there was much loss on both sides, of which be pleased to accept of +this brief account following. + +The King's captains, when they marched from the court to come up +against Mansoul to war, as they came crossing over the country, +they happened to light upon three young fellows that had a mind to +go for soldiers: proper men they were, and men of courage and +skill, to appearance. Their names were Mr. Tradition, Mr. Human- +Wisdom, and Mr. Man's-Invention. So they came up to the captains, +and proffered their service to Shaddai. The captains then told +them of their design, and bid them not to be rash in their offers; +but the young men told them they had considered the thing before, +and that hearing they were upon their march for such a design, came +hither on purpose to meet them, that they might be listed under +their excellencies. Then Captain Boanerges, for that they were men +of courage, listed them into his company, and so away they went to +the war. + +Now, when the war was begun, in one of the briskest skirmishes, so +it was, that a company of the Lord Willbewill's men sallied out at +the sallyport or postern of the town, and fell in upon the rear of +Captain Boanerges' men, where these three fellows happened to be; +so they took them prisoners, and away they carried them into the +town, where they had not lain long in durance, but it began to be +noised about the streets of the town what three notable prisoners +the Lord Willbewill's men had taken, and brought in prisoners out +of the camp of Shaddai. At length tidings thereof were carried to +Diabolus to the castle, to wit what my Lord Willbewill's men had +done, and whom they had taken prisoners. + +Then Diabolus called for Willbewill, to know the certainty of this +matter. So he asked him, and he told him. Then did the giant send +for the prisoners, and, when they were come, demanded of them who +they were, whence they came, and what they did in the camp of +Shaddai; and they told him. Then he sent them to ward again. Not +many days after, he sent for them to him again, and then asked them +if they would be willing to serve him against their former +captains. They then told him that they did not so much live by +religion as by the fates of fortune; and that since his lordship +was willing to entertain them, they should be willing to serve him. +Now while things were thus in hand, there was one Captain Anything, +a great doer, in the town of Mansoul; and to this Captain Anything +did Diabolus send these men, and a note under his hand, to receive +them into his company, the contents of which letter were thus: + +'Anything, my darling,--The three men that are the bearers of this +letter have a desire to serve me in the war; nor know I better to +whose conduct to commit them than to thine. Receive them, +therefore, in my name, and, as need shall require, make use of them +against Shaddai and his men. Farewell.' + +So they came, and he received them; and he made of two of them +sergeants; but he made Mr. Man's-Invention his ancient-bearer. But +thus much for this, and now to return to the camp. + +They of the camp did also some execution upon the town; for they +did beat down the roof of the Lord Mayor's house, and so laid him +more open than he was before. They had almost, with a sling, slain +my Lord Willbewill outright; but he made a shift to recover again. +But they made a notable slaughter among the aldermen, for with one +only shot they cut off six of them; to wit, Mr. Swearing, Mr. +Whoring, Mr. Fury, Mr. Stand-to-Lies, Mr. Drunkenness, and Mr. +Cheating. + +They also dismounted the two guns that stood upon the tower over +Ear-gate, and laid them flat in the dirt. I told you before that +the King's noble captains had drawn off to their winter quarters, +and had there entrenched themselves and their carriages, so as with +the best advantage to their King, and the greatest annoyance to the +enemy, they might give seasonable and warm alarms to the town of +Mansoul. And this design of them did so hit, that I may say they +did almost what they would to the molestation of the corporation. +For now could not Mansoul sleep securely as before, nor could they +now go to their debaucheries with that quietness as in times past; +for they had from the camp of Shaddai such frequent, warm, and +terrifying alarms, yea, alarms upon alarms, first at one gate and +then at another, and again at all the gates at once, that they were +broken as to former peace. Yea, they had their alarms so +frequently, and that when the nights were at longest, the weather +coldest, and so consequently the season most unseasonable, that +that winter was to the town of Mansoul a winter by itself. +Sometimes the trumpets would sound, and sometimes the slings would +whirl the stones into the town. Sometimes ten thousand of the +King's soldiers would be running round the walls of Mansoul at +midnight, shouting and lifting up the voice for the battle. +Sometimes, again, some of them in the town would be wounded, and +their cry and lamentable voice would be heard, to the great +molestation of the now languishing town of Mansoul. Yea, so +distressed with those that laid siege against them were they, that, +I dare say, Diabolus, their king, had in these days his rest much +broken. + +In these days, as I was informed, new thoughts, and thoughts that +began to run counter one to another, began to possess the minds of +the men of the town of Mansoul. Some would say, 'There is no +living thus.' Others would then reply, 'This will be over +shortly.' Then would a third stand up and answer, 'Let us turn to +the King Shaddai, and so put an end to these troubles.' And a +fourth would come in with a fear, saying, 'I doubt he will not +receive us.' The old gentleman, too, the Recorder, that was so +before Diabolus took Mansoul, he also began to talk aloud, and his +words were now to the town of Mansoul as if they were great claps +of thunder. No noise now so terrible to Mansoul as was his, with +the noise of the soldiers and shoutings of the captains. + +Also things began to grow scarce in Mansoul; now the things that +her soul lusted after were departing from her. Upon all her +pleasant things there was a blast, and burning instead of beauty. +Wrinkles now, and some shows of the shadow of death, were upon the +inhabitants of Mansoul. And now, O how glad would Mansoul have +been to have enjoyed quietness and satisfaction of mind, though +joined with the meanest condition in the world! + +The captains also, in the deep of this winter, did send by the +mouth of Boanerges' trumpeter a summons to Mansoul to yield up +herself to the King, the great King Shaddai. They sent it once, +and twice, and thrice; not knowing but that at some times there +might be in Mansoul some willingness to surrender up themselves +unto them, might they but have the colour of an invitation to do it +under. Yea, so far as I could gather, the town had been +surrendered up to them before now, had it not been for the +opposition of old Incredulity, and the fickleness of the thoughts +of my Lord Willbewill. Diabolus also began to rave; wherefore +Mansoul, as to yielding, was not yet all of one mind; therefore +they still lay distressed under these perplexing fears. + +I told you but now that they of the King's army had this winter +sent three times to Mansoul to submit herself. + +The first time the trumpeter went he went with words of peace, +telling them that the captains, the noble captains of Shaddai, did +pity and bewail the misery of the now perishing town of Mansoul, +and were troubled to see them so much to stand in the way of their +own deliverance. He said, moreover, that the captains bid him tell +them, that if now poor Mansoul would humble herself and turn, her +former rebellions and most notorious treasons should by their +merciful King be forgiven them, yea, and forgotten too. And having +bid them beware that they stood not in their own way, that they +opposed not themselves, nor made themselves their own losers, he +returned again into the camp. + +The second time the trumpeter went, he did treat them a little more +roughly; for, after sound of trumpet, he told them that their +continuing in their rebellion did but chafe and heat the spirit of +the captains, and that they were resolved to make a conquest of +Mansoul, or to lay their bones before the town walls. + +He went again the third time, and dealt with them yet more roughly; +telling them that now, since they had been so horribly profane, he +did not know, not certainly know, whether the captains were +inclining to mercy or judgment. 'Only,' said he, 'they commanded +me to give you a summons to open the gates unto them.' So he +returned, and went into the camp. + +These three summonses, and especially the last two, did so distress +the town that they presently call a consultation, the result of +which was this--That my Lord Willbewill should go up to Ear-gate, +and there, with sound of trumpet, call to the captains of the camp +for a parley. Well, the Lord Willbewill sounded upon the wall; so +the captains came up in their harness, with their ten thousands at +their feet. The townsmen then told the captains that they had +heard and considered their summons, and would come to an agreement +with them, and with their King Shaddai, upon such certain terms, +articles, and propositions as, with and by the order of their +prince, they to them were appointed to propound; to wit, they would +agree upon these grounds to be one people with them. + +1. If that those of their own company, as the now Lord Mayor and +their Mr. Forget-Good, with then brave Lord Willbewill, might, +under Shaddai, be still the governors of the town, castle, and +gates of Mansoul. + +2. Provided that no man that now serveth under their great giant +Diabolus be by Shaddai cast out of house, harbour, or the freedom +that he hath hitherto enjoyed in the famous town of Mansoul. + +3. That it shall be granted them, that they of the town of Mansoul +shall enjoy certain of their rights and privileges; to wit, such as +have formerly been granted them, and that they have long lived in +the enjoyment of, under the reign of their king Diabolus, that now +is, and long has been, their only lord and great defender. + +4. That no new law, officer, or executioner of law or office, shall +have any power over them, without their own choice and consent. + +'These be our propositions, or conditions of peace; and upon these +terms,' said they, 'we will submit to your King.' + +But when the captains had heard this weak and feeble offer of the +town of Mansoul, and their high and bold demands, they made to them +again, by their noble captain, the Captain Boanerges, this speech +following: + +'O ye inhabitants of the town of Mansoul, when I heard your trumpet +sound for a parley with us, I can truly say I was glad; but when +you said you were willing to submit yourselves to our King and +Lord, then I was yet more glad; but when, by your silly provisos +and foolish cavils, you laid the stumbling-block of your iniquity +before your own faces, then was my gladness turned into sorrows, +and my hopeful beginnings of your return, into languishing fainting +fears. + +'I count that old Ill-Pause, the ancient enemy of Mansoul, did draw +up those proposals that now you present us with as terms of an +agreement; but they deserve not to be admitted to sound in the ear +of any man that pretends to have service for Shaddai. We do +therefore jointly, and that with the highest disdain, refuse and +reject such things, as the greatest of iniquities. + +'But, O Mansoul, if you will give yourselves into our hands, or +rather into the hands of our King, and will trust him to make such +terms with and for you as shall seem good in his eyes, (and I dare +say they shall be such as you shall find to be most profitable to +you,) then we will receive you, and be at peace with you; but if +you like not to trust yourselves in the arms of Shaddai our King, +then things are but where they were before, and we know also what +we have to do.' + +Then cried out old Incredulity, the Lord Mayor, and said, 'And who, +being out of the hands of their enemies, as ye see we are now, will +be so foolish as to put the staff out of their own hands into the +hands of they know not who? I, for my part, will never yield to so +unlimited a proposition. Do we know the manner and temper of their +King? It is said by some that he will be angry with his subjects +if but the breadth of an hair they chance to step out of the way; +and by others, that he requireth of them much more than they can +perform. Wherefore, it seems, O Mansoul, to be thy wisdom to take +good heed what thou dost in this matter; for if you once yield, you +give up yourselves to another, and so you are no more your own. +Wherefore, to give up yourselves to an unlimited power, is the +greatest folly in the world; for now you indeed may repent, but can +never justly complain. But do you indeed know, when you are his, +which of you he will kill, and which of you he will save alive; or +whether he will not cut off every one of us, and send out of his +own country another new people, and cause them to inhabit this +town?' + +This speech of the Lord Mayor undid all, and threw flat to the +ground their hopes of an accord. Wherefore the captains returned +to their trenches, to their tents, and to their men, as they were; +and the Mayor to the castle and to his King. + +Now Diabolus had waited for his return, for he had heard that they +had been at their points. So, when he was come into the chamber of +state, Diabolus saluted him with--'Welcome, my lord. How went +matters betwixt you to-day?' So the Lord Incredulity, with a low +congee, told him the whole of the matter, saying, 'Thus and thus +said the captains of Shaddai, and thus and thus said I.' The which +when it was told to Diabolus, he was very glad to hear it, and +said, 'My Lord Mayor, my faithful Incredulity, I have proved thy +fidelity above ten times already, but never yet found thee false. +I do promise thee, if we rub over this brunt, to prefer thee to a +place of honour, a place far better than to be Lord Mayor of +Mansoul. I will make thee my universal deputy, and thou shalt, +next to me, have all nations under thy hand; yea, and thou shalt +lay bands upon them, that they may not resist thee; nor shall any +of our vassals walk more at liberty, but those that shall be +content to walk in thy fetters.' + +Now came the Lord Mayor out from Diabolus, as if he had obtained a +favour indeed. Wherefore to his habitation he goes in great state, +and thinks to feed himself well enough with hopes, until the time +came that his greatness should be enlarged. + +But now, though the Lord Mayor and Diabolus did thus well agree, +yet this repulse to the brave captains put Mansoul into a mutiny. +For while old Incredulity went into the castle to congratulate his +lord with what had passed, the old Lord Mayor, that was so before +Diabolus came to the town, to wit, my Lord Understanding, and the +old Recorder, Mr. Conscience, getting intelligence of what had +passed at Ear-gate, (for you must know that they might not be +suffered to be at that debate, lest they should then have mutinied +for the captains; but, I say, they got intelligence of what had +passed there, and were much concerned therewith,) wherefore they, +getting some of the town together, began to possess them with the +reasonableness of the noble captains' demands, and with the bad +consequences that would follow upon the speech of old Incredulity, +the Lord Mayor; to wit how little reverence he showed therein +either to the captains or to their King; also how he implicitly +charged them with unfaithfulness and treachery. 'For what less,' +quoth they, 'could be made of his words, when he said he would not +yield to their proposition; and added, moreover, a supposition that +he would destroy us, when before he had sent us word that he would +show us mercy!' The multitude, being now possessed with the +conviction of the evil that old Incredulity had done, began to run +together by companies in all places, and in every corner of the +streets of Mansoul; and first they began to mutter, then to talk +openly, and after that they run to and fro, and cried as they run, +'Oh the brave captains of Shaddai! would we were under the +government of the captains, and of Shaddai their King!' When the +Lord Mayor had intelligence that Mansoul was in an uproar, down he +comes to appease the people, and thought to have quashed their heat +with the bigness and the show of his countenance; but when they saw +him, they came running upon him, and had doubtless done him a +mischief, had he not betaken himself to house. However, they +strongly assaulted the house where he was, to have pulled it down +about his ears; but the place was too strong, so they failed of +that. So he, taking some courage, addressed himself, out at a +window, to the people in this manner: + +'Gentlemen, what is the reason that there is here such an uproar +to-day?' + +Then answered my Lord Understanding, 'It is even because that thou +and thy master have carried it not rightly, and as you should, to +the captains of Shaddai; for in three things you are faulty. +First, in that you would not let Mr. Conscience and myself be at +the hearing of your discourse. Secondly, in that you propounded +such terms of peace to the captains that by no means could be +granted, unless they had intended that their Shaddai should have +been only a titular prince, and that Mansoul should still have had +power by law to have lived in all lewdness and vanity before him, +and so by consequence Diabolus should still here be king in power, +and the other only king in name. Thirdly, for that thou didst +thyself, after the captains had showed us upon what conditions they +would have received us to mercy, even undo all again with thy +unsavoury, unseasonable, and ungodly speech.' + +When old Incredulity had heard this speech, he cried out, 'Treason! +treason! To your arms! to your arms! O ye, the trusty friends of +Diabolus in Mansoul.' + +Und.--Sir, you may put upon my words what meaning you please; but I +am sure that the captains of such an high lord as theirs is, +deserved a better treatment at your hands. + +Then said old Incredulity, 'This is but little better. But, Sir,' +quoth he, 'what I spake I spake for my prince, for his government, +and the quieting of the people, whom by your unlawful actions you +have this day set to mutiny against us.' + +Then replied the old Recorder, whose name was Mr. Conscience, and +said, 'Sir, you ought not thus to retort upon what my Lord +Understanding hath said. It is evident enough that he hath spoken +the truth, and that you are an enemy to Mansoul. Be convinced, +then, of the evil of your saucy and malapert language, and of the +grief that you have put the captains to; yea, and of the damages +that you have done to Mansoul thereby. Had you accepted of the +conditions, the sound of the trumpet and the alarm of war had now +ceased about the town of Mansoul; but that dreadful sound abides, +and your want of wisdom in your speech has been the cause of it.' + +Then said old Incredulity, 'Sir, if I live, I will do your errand +to Diabolus, and there you shall have an answer to your words. +Meanwhile we will seek the good of the town, and not ask counsel of +you.' + +Und.--Sir, your prince and you are both foreigners to Mansoul, and +not the natives thereof; and who can tell but that, when you have +brought us into greater straits, (when you also shall see that +yourselves can be safe by no other means than by flight,) you may +leave us and shift for yourselves, or set us on fire, and go away +in the smoke, or by the light of our burning, and so leave us in +our ruins? + +Incred.--Sir, you forget that you are under a governor, and that +you ought to demean yourself like a subject; and know ye, when my +lord the king shall hear of this day's work, he will give you but +little thanks for your labour. + +Now while these gentlemen were thus in their chiding words, down +come from the walls and gates of the town the Lord Willbewill, Mr. +Prejudice, old Ill-Pause, and several of the new-made aldermen and +burgesses, and they asked the reason of the hubbub and tumult; and +with that every man began to tell his own tale, so that nothing +could be heard distinctly. Then was a silence commanded, and the +old fox Incredulity began to speak. 'My lord,' quoth he, 'here are +a couple of peevish gentlemen, that have, as a fruit of their bad +dispositions, and, as I fear, through the advice of one Mr. +Discontent, tumultuously gathered this company against me this day, +and also attempted to run the town into acts of rebellion against +our prince.' + +Then stood up all the Diabolonians that were present, and affirmed +these things to be true. + +Now when they that took part with my Lord Understanding and with +Mr. Conscience perceived that they were like to come to the worst, +for that force and power was on the other side, they came in for +their help and relief; so a great company was on both sides. Then +they on Incredulity's side would have had the two old gentlemen +presently away to prison; but they on the other side said they +should not. Then they began to cry up parties again: the +Diabolonians cried up old Incredulity, Forget-Good, the new +aldermen, and their great one Diabolus; and the other party, they +as fast cried up Shaddai, the captains, his laws, their +mercifulness, and applauded their conditions and ways. Thus the +bickerment went awhile; at last they passed from words to blows, +and now there were knocks on both sides. The good old gentleman, +Mr. Conscience, was knocked down twice by one of the Diabolonians, +whose name was Mr. Benumbing; and my Lord Understanding had like to +have been slain with an arquebuse, but that he that shot did not +take his aim aright. Nor did the other side wholly escape; for +there was one Mr. Rashhead, a Diabolonian, that had his brains +beaten out by Mr. Mind, the Lord Willbewill's servant; and it made +me laugh to see how old Mr. Prejudice was kicked and tumbled about +in the dirt; for though, a while since, he was made captain of a +company of the Diabolonians, to the hurt and damage of the town, +yet now they had got him under their feet, and, I'll assure you, he +had, by some of the Lord Understanding's party, his crown cracked +to boot. Mr. Anything also, he became a brisk man in the broil; +but both sides were against him, because he was true to none. Yet +he had, for his malapertness, one of his legs broken, and he that +did it wished it had been his neck. Much more harm was done on +both sides, but this must not be forgotten; it was now a wonder to +see my Lord Willbewill so indifferent as he was: he did not seem +to take one side more than another, only it was perceived that he +smiled to see how old Prejudice was tumbled up and down in the +dirt. Also, when Captain Anything came halting up before him, he +seemed to take but little notice of him. + +Now, when the uproar was over, Diabolus sends for my Lord +Understanding and Mr. Conscience, and claps them both up in prison +as the ringleaders and managers of this most heavy, riotous rout in +Mansoul. So now the town began to be quiet again, and the +prisoners were used hardly; yea, he thought to have made them away, +but that the present juncture did not serve for that purpose, for +that war was in all their gates. + +But let us return again to our story. The captains, when they were +gone back from the gate, and were come into the camp again, called +a council of war, to consult what was further for them to do. Now, +some said, 'Let us go up presently, and fall upon the town;' but +the greatest part thought rather better it would be to give them +another summons to yield; and the reason why they thought this to +be best was, because that, so far as could be perceived, the town +of Mansoul now was more inclinable than heretofore. 'And if,' said +they, 'while some of them are in a way of inclination, we should by +ruggedness give them distaste, we may set them further from closing +with our summons than we would be willing they should.' Wherefore +to this advice they agreed, and called a trumpeter, put words into +his mouth, set him his time, and bid him God speed. Well, many +hours were not expired before the trumpeter addressed himself to +his journey. Wherefore, coming up to the wall of the town, he +steereth his course to Ear-gate, and there sounded, as he was +commanded. They then that were within came out to see what was the +matter, and the trumpeter made them this speech following: + +'O hard-hearted and deplorable town of Mansoul, how long wilt thou +love thy sinful, sinful simplicity, and, ye fools, delight in your +scorning? As yet despise you the offers of peace and deliverance? +As yet will ye refuse the golden offers of Shaddai, and trust to +the lies and falsehoods of Diabolus? Think you, when Shaddai shall +have conquered you, that the remembrance of these your carriages +towards him will yield you peace and comfort, or that by ruffling +language you can make him afraid as a grasshopper? Doth he entreat +you for fear of you? Do you think that you are stronger than he? +Look to the heavens, and behold and consider the stars, how high +are they? Can you stop the sun from running his course, and hinder +the moon from giving her light? Can you count the number of the +stars, or stay the bottles of heaven? Can you call for the waters +of the sea, and cause them to cover the face of the ground? Can +you behold every one that is proud, and abase him, and bind their +faces in secret? Yet these are some of the works of our King, in +whose name this day we come up unto you, that you may be brought +under his authority. In his name, therefore, I summon you again to +yield up yourselves to his captains.' + +At this summons the Mansoulians seemed to be at a stand, and knew +not what answer to make. Wherefore Diabolus forthwith appeared, +and took upon him to do it himself; and thus he begins, but turns +his speech to them of Mansoul. + +'Gentlemen,' quoth he, 'and my faithful subjects, if it is true +that this summoner hath said concerning the greatness of their +King, by his terror you will always be kept in bondage, and so be +made to sneak. Yea, how can you now, though he is at a distance, +endure to think of such a mighty one? And if not to think of him +while at a distance, how can you endure to be in his presence? I, +your prince, am familiar with you, and you may play with me as you +would with a grasshopper. Consider, therefore, what is for your +profit, and remember the immunities that I have granted you. + +'Farther, if all be true that this man hath said, how comes it to +pass that the subjects of Shaddai are so enslaved in all places +where they come? None in the universe so unhappy as they, none so +trampled upon as they. + +'Consider, my Mansoul: would thou wert as loath to leave me as I +am loath to leave thee. But consider, I say, the ball is yet at +thy foot; liberty you have, if you know how to use it; yea, a king +you have too, if you can tell how to love and obey him.' + +Upon this speech, the town of Mansoul did again harden their hearts +yet more against the captains of Shaddai. The thoughts of his +greatness did quite quash them, and the thoughts of his holiness +sunk them in despair. Wherefore, after a short consult, they (of +the Diabolonian party they were) sent back this word by the +trumpeter, That, for their parts, they were resolved to stick to +their king, but never to yield to Shaddai; so it was but in vain to +give them any further summons, for they had rather die upon the +place than yield. And now things seemed to be gone quite back, and +Mansoul to be out of reach or call, yet the captains who knew what +their Lord could do, would not yet be beat out of heart; they +therefore sent them another summons, more sharp and severe than the +last; but the oftener they were sent to, to reconcile to Shaddai, +the further off they were. 'As they called them, so they went from +them--yea, though they called them to the Most High.' + +So they ceased that way to deal with them any more, and inclined to +think of another way. The captains, therefore, did gather +themselves together, to have free conference among themselves, to +know what was yet to be done to gain the town, and to deliver it +from the tyranny of Diabolus; and one said after this manner, and +another after that. Then stood up the right noble the Captain +Conviction, and said, 'My brethren, mine opinion is this: + +'First, that we continually play our slings into the town, and keep +it in a continual alarm, molesting them day and night. By thus +doing, we shall stop the growth of their rampant spirit; for a lion +may be tamed by continual molestation. + +'Secondly, this done, I advise that, in the next place, we with one +consent draw up a petition to our Lord Shaddai, by which, after we +have showed our King the condition of Mansoul and of affairs here, +and have begged his pardon for our no better success, we will +earnestly implore his Majesty's help, and that he will please to +send us more force and power, and some gallant and well-spoken +commander to head them, that so his Majesty may not lose the +benefit of these his good beginnings, but may complete his conquest +upon the town of Mansoul.' + +To this speech of the noble Captain Conviction they as one man +consented, and agreed that a petition should forthwith be drawn up, +and sent by a fit man away to Shaddai with speed. The contents of +the petition were thus:- + +'Most gracious and glorious King, the Lord of the best world, and +the builder of the town of Mansoul, we have, dread Sovereign, at +thy commandment, put our lives in jeopardy, and at thy bidding made +a war upon the famous town of Mansoul. When we went up against it, +we did, according to our commission, first offer conditions of +peace unto it. But they, great King, set light by our counsel, and +would none of our reproof. They were for shutting their gates, and +for keeping us out of the town. They also mounted their guns, they +sallied out upon us, and have done us what damage they could; but +we pursued them with alarm upon alarm, requiting them with such +retribution as was meet, and have done some execution upon the +town. + +'Diabolus, Incredulity, and Willbewill are the great doers against +us: now we are in our winter quarters, but so as that we do yet +with an high hand molest and distress the town. + +'Once, as we think, had we had but one substantial friend in the +town, such as would but have seconded the sound of our summons as +they ought, the people might have yielded themselves; but there +were none but enemies there, nor any to speak in behalf of our Lord +to the town. Wherefore, though we have done as we could, yet +Mansoul abides in a state of rebellion against thee. + +'Now, King of kings, let it please thee to pardon the +unsuccessfulness of thy servants, who have been no more +advantageous in so desirable a work as the conquering of Mansoul +is. And send, Lord, as we now desire, more forces to Mansoul, that +it may be subdued; and a man to head them, that the town may both +love and fear. + +'We do not thus speak because we are willing to relinquish the +wars, (for we are for laying of our bones against the place,) but +that the town of Mansoul may be won for thy Majesty. We also pray +thy Majesty, for expedition in this matter, that, after their +conquest, we may be at liberty to be sent about other thy gracious +designs. Amen.' + +The petition, thus drawn up, was sent away with haste to the King +by the hand of that good man, Mr. Love-to-Mansoul. + +When this petition was come to the palace of the King, who should +it be delivered to but to the King's Son? So he took it and read +it, and because the contents of it pleased him well, he mended, and +also in some things added to the petition himself. So, after he +had made such amendments and additions as he thought convenient, +with his own hand, he carried it in to the King; to whom, when he +had with obeisance delivered it, he put on authority, and spake to +it himself. + +Now the King, at the sight of the petition, was glad; but how much +more, think you, when it was seconded by his Son! It pleased him +also to hear that his servants who camped against Mansoul were so +hearty in the work, and so steadfast in their resolves, and that +they had already got some ground upon the famous town of Mansoul. + +Wherefore the King called to him Emmanuel, his Son, who said, 'Here +am I, my Father.' Then said the King, 'Thou knowest, as I do +myself, the condition of the town of Mansoul, and what we have +purposed, and what thou hast done to redeem it. Come now, +therefore, my Son, and prepare thyself for the war, for thou shalt +go to my camp at Mansoul. Thou shalt also there prosper and +prevail, and conquer the town of Mansoul.' + +Then said the King's Son, 'Thy law is within my heart: I delight +to do thy will. This is the day that I have longed for, and the +work that I have waited for all this while. Grant me, therefore, +what force thou shalt in thy wisdom think meet; and I will go and +will deliver from Diabolus, and from his power, thy perishing town +of Mansoul. My heart has been often pained within me for the +miserable town of Mansoul; but now it is rejoiced, but now it is +glad,' + +And with that he leaped over the mountains for joy, saying, 'I have +not, in my heart, thought anything too dear for Mansoul: the day +of vengeance is in mine heart for thee, my Mansoul: and glad am I +that thou, my Father, hast made me the Captain of their salvation. +And I will now begin to plague all those that have been a plague to +my town of Mansoul, and will deliver it from their hand.' + +When the King's Son had said thus to his Father, it presently flew +like lightning round about at court; yea, it there became the only +talk what Emmanuel was to go to do for the famous town of Mansoul. +But you cannot think how the courtiers, too, were taken with this +design of the Prince; yea, so affected were they with this work, +and with the justness of the war, that the highest lord and +greatest peer of the kingdom did covet to have commissions under +Emmanuel, to go to help to recover again to Shaddai the miserable +town of Mansoul. + +Then was it concluded that some should go and carry tidings to the +camp, that Emmanuel was to come to recover Mansoul, and that he +would bring along with him so mighty, so impregnable a force, that +he could not be resisted. But, oh! how ready were the high ones at +court to run like lackeys to carry these tidings to the camp that +was at Mansoul. Now, when the captains perceived that the King +would send Emmanuel his Son, and that it also delighted the Son to +be sent on this errand by the great Shaddai his Father, they also, +to show how they were pleased at the thoughts of his coming gave a +shout that made the earth rend at the sound thereof. Yea, the +mountains did answer again by echo, and Diabolus himself did totter +and shake. + +For you must know, that though the town of Mansoul itself was not +much, if at all concerned with the project, (for, alas for them! +they were wofully besotted, for they chiefly regarded their +pleasure and their lusts,) yet Diabolus their governor was; for he +had his spies continually abroad, who brought him intelligence of +all things, and they told him what was doing at court against him, +and that Emmanuel would shortly certainly come with a power to +invade him. Nor was there any man at court, nor peer of the +kingdom, that Diabolus so feared as he feared this Prince; for, if +you remember, I showed you before that Diabolus had felt the weight +of his hand already; so that, since it was he that was to come, +this made him the more afraid. + +Well, you see how I have told you that the King's Son was engaged +to come from the court to save Mansoul, and that his Father had +made him the Captain of the forces. The time, therefore, of his +setting forth being now expired, he addressed himself for his +march, and taketh with him, for his power, five noble captains and +their forces. + +1. The first was that famous captain, the noble Captain Credence. +His were the red colours, and Mr. Promise bare them; and for a +scutcheon he had the holy lamb and golden shield; and he had ten +thousand men at his feet. + +2. The second was that famous captain, the Captain Good-Hope. His +were the blue colours; his standard-bearer was Mr. Expectation, and +for his scutcheon he had the three golden anchors; and he had ten +thousand men at his feet. + +3. The third was that valiant captain, the Captain Charity. His +standard-bearer was Mr. Pitiful: his were the green colours, and +for his scutcheon he had three naked orphans embraced in the bosom; +and he had ten thousand men at his feet. + +4. The fourth was that gallant commander, the Captain Innocent. +His standard-bearer was Mr. Harmless: his were the white colours, +and for his scutcheon he had the three golden doves. + +5. The fifth was the truly loyal and well-beloved captain, the +Captain Patience. His standard-bearer was Mr. Suffer-Long: his +were the black colours, and for a scutcheon he had three arrows +through the golden heart. + +These were Emmanuel's captains; these their standard-bearers, their +colours, and their scutcheons; and these the men under their +command. So, as was said, the brave Prince took his march to go to +the town of Mansoul. Captain Credence led the van, and Captain +Patience brought up the rear; so the other three, with their men, +made up the main body, the Prince himself riding in his chariot at +the head of them. + +But when they set out for their march, oh, how the trumpets +sounded, their armour glittered, and how the colours waved in the +wind! The Prince's armour was all of gold, and it shone like the +sun in the firmament; the captains' armour was of proof, and was in +appearance like the glittering stars. There were also some from +the court that rode reformades for the love that they had to the +King Shaddai, and for the happy deliverance of the town of Mansoul. + +Emmanuel also, when he had thus set forwards to go to recover the +town of Mansoul, took with him, at the commandment of his Father, +fifty-four battering-rams, and twelve slings to whirl stones +withal. Every one of these was made of pure gold, and these they +carried with them, in the heart and body of their army, all along +as they went to Mansoul. + +So they marched till they came within less than a league of the +town; there they lay till the first four captains came thither to +acquaint them with matters. Then they took their journey to go to +the town of Mansoul, and unto Mansoul they came; but when the old +soldiers that were in the camp saw that they had new forces to join +with, they again gave such a shout before the walls of the town of +Mansoul, that it put Diabolus into another fright. So they sat +down before the town, not now as the other four captains did, to +wit, against the gates of Mansoul only; but they environed it round +on every side, and beset it behind and before; so that now, let +Mansoul look which way it will, it saw force and power lie in siege +against it. Besides, there were mounts cast up against it. The +Mount Gracious was on the one side, and Mount Justice was on the +other. Further, there were several small banks and advance- +grounds, as Plain-Truth Hill and No-Sin Banks, where many of the +slings were placed against the town. Upon Mount Gracious were +planted four, and upon Mount Justice were placed as many, and the +rest were conveniently placed in several parts round about the +town. Five of the best battering-rams, that is, of the biggest of +them, were placed upon Mount Hearken, a mount cast up hard by Ear- +gate, with intent to break that open. + +Now when the men of the town saw the multitude of the soldiers that +were come up against the place, and the rams and slings, and the +mounts on which they were planted, together with the glittering of +the armour and the waving of their colours, they were forced to +shift, and shift, and again to shift their thoughts; but they +hardly changed for thoughts more stout, but rather for thoughts +more faint; for though before they thought themselves sufficiently +guarded, yet now they began to think that no man knew what would be +their hap or lot. + +When the good Prince Emmanuel had thus beleaguered Mansoul, in the +first place he hangs out the white flag, which he caused to be set +up among the golden slings that were planted upon Mount Gracious. +And this he did for two reasons: 1. To give notice to Mansoul that +he could and would yet be gracious if they turned to him. 2. And +that he might leave them the more without excuse, should he destroy +them, they continuing in their rebellion. + +So the white flag, with the three golden doves in it, was hung out +for two days together, to give them time and space to consider; but +they, as was hinted before, as if they were unconcerned, made no +reply to the favourable signal of the Prince. + +Then he commanded, and they set the red flag upon that mount called +Mount Justice. It was the red flag of Captain Judgment, whose +scutcheon was the burning fiery furnace; and this also stood waving +before them in the wind for several days together. But look how +they carried it under the white flag, when that was hung out, so +did they also when the red one was; and yet he took no advantage of +them. + +Then he commanded again that his servants should hang out the black +flag of defiance against them, whose scutcheon was the three +burning thunderbolts; but as unconcerned was Mansoul at this as at +those that went before. But when the Prince saw that neither mercy +nor judgment, nor execution of judgment, would or could come near +the heart of Mansoul, he was touched with much compunction, and +said, 'Surely this strange carriage of the town of Mansoul doth +rather arise from ignorance of the manner and feats of war, than +from a secret defiance of us, and abhorrence of their own lives; or +if they know the manner of the war of their own, yet not the rites +and ceremonies of the wars in which we are concerned, when I make +wars upon mine enemy Diabolus.' + +Therefore he sent to the town of Mansoul, to let them know what he +meant by those signs and ceremonies of the flag; and also to know +of them which of the things they would choose, whether grace and +mercy, or judgment and the execution of judgment. All this while +they kept their gates shut with locks, bolts, and bars, as fast as +they could. Their guards also were doubled, and their watch made +as strong as they could. Diabolus also did pluck up what heart he +could, to encourage the town to make resistance. + +The townsmen also made answer to the Prince's messenger, in +substance according to that which follows:- + +'Great Sir,--As to what, by your messenger, you have signified to +us, whether we will accept of your mercy, or fall by your justice, +we are bound by the law and custom of this place, and can give you +no positive answer; for it is against the law, government, and the +prerogative royal of our king, to make either peace or war without +him. But this we will do,--we will petition that our prince will +come down to the wall, and there give you such treatment as he +shall think fit and profitable for us.' + +When the good Prince Emmanuel heard this answer, and saw the +slavery and bondage of the people, and how much content they were +to abide in the chains of the tyrant Diabolus, it grieved him at +the heart; and, indeed, when at any time he perceived that any were +contented under the slavery of the giant, he would be affected with +it. + +But to return again to our purpose. After the town had carried +this news to Diabolus, and had told him, moreover, that the Prince, +that lay in the leaguer without the wall, waited upon them for an +answer, he refused, and huffed as well as he could; but in heart he +was afraid. + +Then said he, 'I will go down to the gates myself, and give him +such an answer as I think fit.' So he went down to Mouth-gate, and +there addressed himself to speak to Emmanuel, (but in such language +as the town understood not,) the contents whereof were as follows:- + +'O thou great Emmanuel, Lord of all the world, I know thee, that +thou art the Son of the great Shaddai! Wherefore art thou come to +torment me, and to cast me out of my possession? This town of +Mansoul, as thou very well knowest, is mine, and that by a twofold +right. 1. It is mine by right of conquest; I won it in the open +field; and shall the prey be taken from the mighty, or the lawful +captive be delivered? 2. This town of Mansoul is mine also by +their subjection. They have opened the gates of their town unto +me; they have sworn fidelity to me, and have openly chosen me to be +their king; they have also given their castle into my hands; yea, +they have put the whole strength of Mansoul under me. + +'Moreover, this town of Mansoul hath disavowed thee, yea, they have +cast thy law, thy name, thy image, and all that is thine, behind +their back, and have accepted and set up in their room my law, my +name, my image, and all that ever is mine. Ask else thy captains, +and they will tell thee that Mansoul hath, in answer to all their +summonses, shown love and loyalty to me, but always disdain, +despite, contempt, and scorn to thee and thine. Now, thou art the +Just One and the Holy, and shouldest do no iniquity. Depart, then, +I pray thee, therefore, from me, and leave me to my just +inheritance peaceably.' + +This oration was made in the language of Diabolus himself; for +although he can, to every man, speak in their own language, (else +he could not tempt them all as he does,) yet he has a language +proper to himself, and it is the language of the infernal cave, or +black pit. + +Wherefore the town of Mansoul (poor hearts!) understood him not; +nor did they see how he crouched and cringed while he stood before +Emmanuel, their Prince. + +Yea, they all this while took him to be one of that power and force +that by no means could be resisted. Wherefore, while he was thus +entreating that he might have yet his residence there, and that +Emmanuel would not take it from him by force, the inhabitants +boasted even of his valour, saying, 'Who is able to make war with +him?' + +Well, when this pretended king had made an end of what he would +say, Emmanuel, the golden Prince, stood up and spake; the contents +of whose words follow:- + +'Thou deceiving one,' said he, 'I have, in my Father's name, in +mine own name, and on the behalf and for the good of this wretched +town of Mansoul, somewhat to say unto thee. Thou pretendest a +right, a lawful right, to the deplorable town of Mansoul, when it +is most apparent to all my Father's court that the entrance which +thou hast obtained in at the gates of Mansoul was through thy lie +and falsehood; thou beliedst my Father, thou beliedst his law, and +so deceivedst the people of Mansoul. Thou pretendest that the +people have accepted thee for their king, their captain, and right +liege lord; but that also was by the exercise of deceit and guile. +Now, if lying, wiliness, sinful craft, and all manner of horrible +hypocrisy, will go in my Father's court (in which court thou must +be tried) for equity and right, then will I confess unto thee that +thou hast made a lawful conquest. But, alas! what thief, what +tyrant, what devil is there that may not conquer after this sort? +But I can make it appear, O Diabolus, that thou, in all thy +pretences to a conquest of Mansoul, hast nothing of truth to say. +Thinkest thou this to be right, that that didst put the lie upon my +Father, and madest him (to Mansoul) the greatest deluder in the +world? And what sayest thou to thy perverting knowingly the right +purport and intent of the law? Was it good also that thou madest a +prey of the innocency and simplicity of the now miserable town of +Mansoul? Yea, thou didst overcome Mansoul by promising to them +happiness in their transgressions against my Father's law, when +thou knewest, and couldest not but know, hadst thou consulted +nothing but thine own experience, that that was the way to undo +them. Thou hast also thyself, O thou master of enmity, of spite +defaced my Father's image in Mansoul, and set up thy own in its +place, to the great contempt of my Father, the heightening of thy +sin, and to the intolerable damage of the perishing town of +Mansoul. + +'Thou hast, moreover, (as if all these were but little things with +thee,) not only deluded and undone this place, but, by thy lies and +fradulent carriage, hast set them against their own deliverance. +How hast thou stirred them up against my Father's captains, and +made them to fight against those that were sent of him to deliver +them from their bondage! All these things, and very many more, +thou hast done against thy light, and in contempt of my Father and +of his law, yea, and with design to bring under his displeasure for +ever the miserable town of Mansoul. I am therefore come to avenge +the wrong that thou hast done to my Father, and to deal with thee +for the blasphemies wherewith thou hast made poor Mansoul blaspheme +his name. Yea, upon thy head, thou prince of the infernal cave, +will I requite it. + +'As for myself, O Diabolus, I am come against thee by lawful power, +and to take, by strength of hand, this town of Mansoul out of thy +burning fingers; for this town of Mansoul is mine, O Diabolus, and +that by undoubted right, as all shall see that will diligently +search the most ancient and most authentic records, and I will +plead my title to it, to the confusion of thy face. + +'First, for the town of Mansoul, my Father built and did fashion it +with his hand. The palace also that is in the midst of that town, +he built it for his own delight. This town of Mansoul, therefore, +is my Father's, and that by the best of titles, and he that +gainsays the truth of this must lie against his soul. + +'Secondly, O thou master of the lie, this town of Mansoul is mine. + +'1. For that I am my Father's heir, his firstborn, and the only +delight of his heart. I am therefore come up against thee in mine +own right, even to recover mine own inheritance out of thine hand. + +'2. But further, as I have a right and title to Mansoul by being my +Father's heir, so I have also by my Father's donation. His it was, +and he gave it me; nor have I at any time offended my Father, that +he should take it from me, and give it to thee. Nor have I been +forced, by playing the bankrupt, to sell or set to sale to thee my +beloved town of Mansoul. Mansoul is my desire, my delight, and the +joy of my heart. But, + +'3. Mansoul is mine by right of purchase. I have bought it, O +Diabolus, I have bought it to myself. Now, since it was my +Father's and mine, as I was his heir, and since also I have made it +mine by virtue of a great purchase, it followeth that, by all +lawful right, the town of Mansoul is mine, and that thou art an +usurper, a tyrant, and traitor, in thy holding possession thereof. +Now, the cause of my purchasing of it was this: Mansoul had +trespassed against my Father; now my Father had said, that in the +day that they broke his law they should die. Now, it is more +possible for heaven and earth to pass away than for my Father to +break his word. Wherefore when Mansoul had sinned indeed by +hearkening to thy lie, I put in and became a surety to my Father, +body for body, and soul for soul, that I would make amends for +Mansoul's transgressions, and my Father did accept thereof. So, +when the time appointed was come, I gave body for body, soul for +soul, life for life, blood for blood, and so redeemed my beloved +Mansoul. + +'4. Nor did I do this by halves: my Father's law and justice, that +were both concerned in the threatening upon transgression, are both +now satisfied, and very well content that Mansoul should be +delivered. + +'5. Nor am I come out this day against thee, but by commandment of +my Father; it was he that said unto me, "Go down and deliver +Mansoul." + +'Wherefore be it known unto thee, O thou fountain of deceit, and be +it also known to the foolish town of Mansoul, that I am not come +against thee this day without my Father. + +'And now,' said the golden-headed Prince, 'I have a word to the +town of Mansoul.' But so soon as mention was made that he had a +word to speak to the besotted town of Mansoul, the gates were +double-guarded, and all men commanded not to give him audience. So +he proceeded and said, 'O unhappy town of Mansoul, I cannot but be +touched with pity and compassion for thee. Thou hast accepted of +Diabolus for thy king, and art become a nurse and minister of +Diabolonians against thy sovereign Lord. Thy gates thou hast +opened to him, but hast shut them fast against me; thou hast given +him an hearing, but hast stopped thine ears at my cry. He brought +to thee thy destruction, and thou didst receive both him and it: I +am come to thee bringing salvation, but thou regardest me not. +Besides, thou hast, as with sacrilegious hands, taken thyself, with +all that was mine in thee, and hast given all to my foe, and to the +greatest enemy my Father has. You have bowed and subjected +yourselves to him, you have vowed and sworn yourselves to be his. +Poor Mansoul! what shall I do unto thee? Shall I save thee?--shall +I destroy thee? What shall I do unto thee? Shall I fall upon +thee, and grind thee to powder, or make thee a monument of the +richest grace? What shall I do unto thee? Hearken, therefore, +thou town of Mansoul, hearken to my word, and thou shalt live. I +am merciful, Mansoul, and thou shalt find me so: shut me not out +of thy gates. + +'O Mansoul, neither is my commission nor inclination at all to do +thee hurt. Why fliest thou so fast from thy friend, and stickest +so close to thine enemy? Indeed, I would have thee, because it +becomes thee to be sorry for thy sin, but do not despair of life; +this great force is not to hurt thee, but to deliver thee from thy +bondage, and to reduce thee to thy obedience. + +'My commission, indeed, is to make a war upon Diabolus thy king, +and upon all Diabolonians with him; for he is the strong man armed +that keeps the house, and I will have him out: his spoils I must +divide, his armour I must take from him, his hold I must cast him +out of, and must make it a habitation for myself. And this, O +Mansoul, shall Diabolus know when he shall be made to follow me in +chains, and when Mansoul shall rejoice to see it so. + + 'I could, would I now put forth my might, cause that forthwith he +should leave you and depart; but I have it in my heart so to deal +with him, as that the justice of the war that I shall make upon him +may be seen and acknowledged by all. He hath taken Mansoul by +fraud, and keeps it by violence and deceit, and I will make him +bare and naked in the eyes of all observers. + +'All my words are true. I am mighty to save, and will deliver my +Mansoul out of his hand.' + +This speech was intended chiefly for Mansoul, but Mansoul would not +have the hearing of it. They shut up Ear-gate, they barricaded it +up, they kept it locked and bolted, they set a guard thereat, and +commanded that no Mansoulonian should go out to him, nor that any +from the camp should be admitted into the town. All this they did, +so horribly had Diabolus enchanted them to do, and seek to do for +him, against their rightful Lord and Prince; wherefore no man, nor +voice, nor sound of man that belonged to the glorious host, was to +come into the town. + +So when Emmanuel saw that Mansoul was thus involved in sin, he +calls his army together, (since now also his words were despised,) +and gave out a commandment throughout all his host to be ready +against the time appointed. Now, forasmuch as there was no way +lawfully to take the town of Mansoul but to get in by the gates, +and at Ear-gate as the chief, therefore he commanded his captains +and commanders to bring their rams, their slings and their men, and +place them at Eye-gate and Ear-gate, in order to his taking the +town. + +When Emmanuel had put all things in a readiness to give Diabolus +battle, he sent again to know of the town of Mansoul, if in +peaceable manner they would yield themselves, or whether they were +yet resolved to put him to try the utmost extremity? They then, +together with Diabolus their king, called a council of war, and +resolved upon certain propositions that should be offered to +Emmanuel, if he will accept thereof, so they agreed; and then the +next was, who should be sent on this errand. Now, there was in the +town of Mansoul an old man, a Diabolonian, and his name was Mr. +Loth-to-stoop, a stiff man in his way, and a great doer for +Diabolus; him, therefore, they sent, and put into his mouth what he +should say. So he went and came to the camp to Emmanuel, and when +he was come, a time was appointed to give him audience. So at the +time he came, and after a Diabolonian ceremony or two, he thus +began and said, 'Great sir, that it may be known unto all men how +good-natured a prince my master is, he has sent me to tell your +lordship that he is very willing, rather than go to war, to deliver +up into your hands one half of the town of Mansoul. I am therefore +to know if your Mightiness will accept of this proposition.' + +Then said Emmanuel, 'The whole is mine by gift and purchase, +wherefore I will never lose one half.' + +Then said Mr. Loth-to-stoop, 'Sir, my master hath said that he will +be content that you shall be the nominal and titular Lord of all, +if he may possess but a part.' + +Then Emmanuel answered, 'The whole is mine really, not in name and +word only; wherefore I will be the sole lord and possessor of all, +or of none at all, of Mansoul.' + +Then Mr. Loth-to-stoop said again, 'Sir, behold the condescension +of my master! He says, that he will be content, if he may but have +assigned to him some place in Mansoul as a place to live privately +in, and you shall be Lord of all the rest.' + +Then said the golden Prince, 'All that the Father giveth me shall +come to me; and of all that he giveth me I will lose nothing--no, +not a hoof nor a hair. I will not, therefore, grant him, no, not +the least corner of Mansoul to dwell in; I will have all to +myself.' + +Then Loth-to-stoop said again, 'But, sir, suppose that my Lord +should resign the whole town to you, only with this proviso, that +he sometimes, when he comes into this country, may, for old +acquaintance' sake, be entertained as a wayfaring man for two days, +or ten days or a month, or so. May not this small matter be +granted?' + +Then said Emmanuel, 'No. He came as a wayfaring man to David, nor +did he stay long with him, and yet it had like to have cost David +his soul. I will not consent that he ever should have any harbour +more there.' + +Then said Mr. Loth-to-stoop, 'Sir, you seem to be very hard. +Suppose my master should yield to all that your lordship hath said, +provided that his friends and kindred in Mansoul may have liberty +to trade in the town, and to enjoy their present dwellings. May +not that be granted, sir?' + +Then said Emmanuel, 'No; that is contrary to my Father's will; for +all, and all manner of Diabolonians that now are, or that at any +time shall be found in Mansoul, shall not only lose their lands and +liberties, but also their lives.' + +Then said Mr. Loth-to-stoop again, 'But, sir, may not my master and +great lord, by letters, by passengers, by accidental opportunities, +and the like, maintain, if he shall deliver up all unto thee, some +kind of old friendship with Mansoul?' + +Emmanuel answered, 'No, by no means; forasmuch as any such +fellowship, friendship, intimacy, or acquaintance, in what way, +sort, or mode soever maintained, will tend to the corrupting of +Mansoul, the alienating of their affections from me, and the +endangering of their peace with my Father.' + +Mr. Loth-to-stoop yet added further, saying, 'But, great sir, since +my master hath many friends, and those that are dear to him, in +Mansoul, may he not, if he shall depart from them, even of his +bounty and good-nature, bestow upon them, as he sees fit, some +tokens of his love and kindness that he had for them, to the end +that Mansoul, when he is gone, may look upon such tokens of +kindness once received from their old friend, and remember him who +was once their king, and the merry times that they sometimes +enjoyed one with another, while he and they lived in peace +together?' + +Then said Emmanuel, 'No; for if Mansoul come to be mine, I shall +not admit of nor consent that there should be the least scrap, +shred, or dust of Diabolus left behind, as tokens of gifts bestowed +upon any in Mansoul, thereby to call to remembrance the horrible +communion that was betwixt them and him.' + +'Well, sir,' said Mr. Loth-to-stoop, 'I have one thing more to +propound, and then I am got to the end of my commission. Suppose +that, when my master is gone from Mansoul, any that shall yet live +in the town should have such business of high concerns to do, that +if they be neglected the party shall be undone; and suppose, sir, +that nobody can help in that case so well as my master and lord, +may not now my master be sent for upon so urgent an occasion as +this? Or if he may not be admitted into the town, may not he and +the person concerned meet in some of the villages near Mansoul, and +there lay their heads together, and there consult of matters?' + +This was the last of those ensnaring propositions that Mr. Loth-to- +stoop had to propound to Emmanuel on behalf of his master Diabolus; +but Emmanuel would not grant it; for he said, 'There can be no +case, or thing, or matter fall out in Mansoul, when thy master +shall be gone, that may not be solved by my Father; besides, it +will be a great disparagement to my Father's wisdom and skill to +admit any from Mansoul to go out to Diabolus for advice, when they +are bid before, in everything, by prayer and supplication to let +their requests be made known to my Father. Further, this, should +it be granted, would be to grant that a door should be set open for +Diabolus, and the Diabolonians in Mansoul, to hatch, and plot, and +bring to pass treasonable designs, to the grief of my Father and +me, and to the utter destruction of Mansoul.' + +When Mr. Loth-to-stoop had heard this answer, he took his leave of +Emmanuel, and departed, saying that he would carry word to his +master concerning this whole affair. So he departed, and came to +Diabolus to Mansoul, and told him the whole of the matter, and how +Emmanuel would not admit, no, not by any means, that he, when he +was once gone out, should for ever have anything more to do either +in, or with any that are of the town of Mansoul. When Mansoul and +Diabolus had heard this relation of things, they with one consent +concluded to use their best endeavour to keep Emmanuel out of +Mansoul, and sent old Ill-Pause, of whom you have heard before, to +tell the Prince and his captains so. So the old gentleman came up +to the top of Ear-gate, and called to the camp for a hearing, who +when they gave audience, he said, 'I have in commandment from my +high lord to bid you tell it to your Prince Emmanuel, that Mansoul +and their king are resolved to stand and fall together; and that it +is in vain for your Prince to think of ever having Mansoul in his +hand, unless he can take it by force.' So some went and told to +Emmanuel what old Ill-Pause, a Diabolonian in Mansoul, had said. +Then said the Prince, 'I must try the power of my sword, for I will +not (for all the rebellions and repulses that Mansoul has made +against me) raise my siege and depart, but will assuredly take my +Mansoul, and deliver it from the hand of her enemy.' And with that +he gave out a commandment that Captain Boanerges, Captain +Conviction, Captain Judgment, and Captain Execution should +forthwith march up to Ear-gate with trumpets sounding, colours +flying, and with shouting for the battle. Also he would that +Captain Credence should join himself with them. Emmanuel, +moreover, gave order that Captain Good-Hope and Captain Charity +should draw themselves up before Eye-gate. He bid also that the +rest of his captains and their men should place themselves for the +best of their advantage against the enemy round about the town; and +all was done as he had commanded. + +Then he bid that the word should be given forth, and the word was +at that time, 'EMMANUEL.' Then was an alarm sounded, and the +battering-rams were played, and the slings did whirl stones into +the town amain, and thus the battle began. Now Diabolus himself +did manage the townsmen in the war, and that at every gate; +wherefore their resistance was the more forcible, hellish, and +offensive to Emmanuel. Thus was the good Prince engaged and +entertained by Diabolus and Mansoul for several days together; and +a sight worth seeing it was to behold how the captains of Shaddai +behaved themselves in this war. + +And first for Captain Boanerges, (not to under-value the rest,) he +made three most fierce assaults, one after another, upon Ear-gate, +to the shaking of the posts thereof. Captain Conviction, he also +made up as fast with Boanerges as possibly he could, and both +discerning that the gate began to yield, they commanded that the +rams should still be played against it. Now, Captain Conviction, +going up very near to the gate, was with great force driven back, +and received three wounds in the mouth. And those that rode +reformades, they went about to encourage the captains. + +For the valour of the two captains, made mention of before, the +Prince sent for them to his pavilion, and commanded that a while +they should rest themselves, and that with somewhat they should be +refreshed. Care also was taken for Captain Conviction, that he +should be healed of his wounds. The Prince also gave to each of +them a chain of gold, and bid them yet be of good courage. + +Nor did Captain Good-Hope nor Captain Charity come behind in this +most desperate fight, for they so well did behave themselves at +Eye-gate, that they had almost broken it quite open. These also +had a reward from their Prince, as also had the rest of the +captains, because they did valiantly round about the town. + +In this engagement several of the officers of Diabolus were slain, +and some of the townsmen wounded. For the officers, there was one +Captain Boasting slain. This Boasting thought that nobody could +have shaken the posts of Ear-gate, nor have shaken the heart of +Diabolus. Next to him there was one Captain Secure slain: this +Secure used to say that the blind and lame in Mansoul were able to +keep the gates of the town against Emmanuel's army. This Captain +Secure did Captain Conviction cleave down the head with a two- +handed sword, when he received himself three wounds in his mouth. + +Besides these there was one Captain Bragman, a very desperate +fellow, and he was captain over a band of those that threw +firebrands, arrows, and death: he also received, by the hand of +Captain Good-Hope at Eye-gate, a mortal wound in the breast. + +There was, moreover, one Mr. Feeling; but he was no captain, but a +great stickler to encourage Mansoul to rebellion. He received a +wound in the eye by the hand of one of Boanerges' soldiers, and had +by the captain himself been slain, but that he made a sudden +retreat. + +But I never saw Willbewill so daunted in all my life; he was not +able to do as he was wont, and some say that he also received a +wound in the leg, and that some of the men in the Prince's army +have certainly seen him limp as he afterwards walked on the wall. + +I shall not give you a particular account of the names of the +soldiers that were slain in the town, for many were maimed, and +wounded, and slain; for when they saw that the posts of Ear-gate +did shake, and Eye-gate was well-nigh broken quite open, and also +that their captains were slain, this took away the hearts of many +of the Diabolonians; they fell also by the force of the shot that +were sent by the golden slings into the midst of the town of +Mansoul. + +Of the townsmen, there was one Love-no-Good; he was a townsman, but +a Diabolonian; he also received his mortal wound in Mansoul, but he +died not very soon. + +Mr. Ill-Pause also, who was the man that came along with Diabolus +when at first he attempted the taking of Mansoul, he also received +a grievous wound in the head; some say that his brain-pan was +cracked. This I have taken notice of, that he was never after this +able to do that mischief to Mansoul as he had done in times past. +Also old Prejudice and Mr. Anything fled. + +Now, when the battle was over, the Prince commanded that yet once +more the white flag should be set upon Mount Gracious in sight of +the town of Mansoul, to show that yet Emmanuel had grace for the +wretched town of Mansoul. + +When Diabolus saw the white flag hung out again, and knowing that +it was not for him, but Mansoul, he cast in his mind to play +another prank, to wit, to see if Emmanuel would raise his siege and +begone, upon promise of reformation. So he comes down to the gate +one evening, a good while after the sun was gone down, and calls to +speak with Emmanuel, who presently came down to the gate, and +Diabolus saith unto him: + +'Forasmuch as thou makest it appear by thy white flag that thou art +wholly given to peace and quiet, I thought meet to acquaint thee +that we are ready to accept thereof upon terms which thou mayest +admit. + +'I know that thou art given to devotion, and that holiness pleaseth +thee; yea, that thy great end in making a war upon Mansoul is, that +it may be a holy habitation. Well, draw off thy forces from the +town, and I will bend Mansoul to thy bow. + +'First, I will lay down all acts of hostility against thee, and +will be willing to become thy deputy, and will, as I have formerly +been against thee, now serve thee in the town of Mansoul. And more +particularly, + +'1. I will persuade Mansoul to receive thee for their Lord; and I +know that they will do it the sooner when they shall understand +that I am thy deputy. + +'2. I will show them wherein they have erred, and that +transgression stands in the way to life. + +'3. I will show them the holy law unto which they must conform, +even that which they have broken. + +'4. I will press upon them the necessity of a reformation according +to thy law. + +'5. And, moreover, that none of these things may fail, I myself, at +my own proper cost and charge, will set up and maintain a +sufficient ministry, besides lectures, in Mansoul. + +'6. Thou shalt receive, as a token of our subjection to thee, year +by year, what thou shalt think fit to lay and levy upon us in token +of our subjection to thee.' + +Then said Emmanuel to him, 'O full of deceit, how movable are thy +ways! How often hast thou changed and rechanged, if so be thou +mightest still keep possession of my Mansoul, though, as has been +plainly declared before, I am the right heir thereof! Often hast +thou made thy proposals already, nor is this last a whit better +than they. And failing to deceive when thou showedst thyself in +thy black, thou hast now transformed thyself into an angel of +light, and wouldst, to deceive, be now as a minister of +righteousness. + +'But know thou, O Diabolus, that nothing must be regarded that thou +canst propound, for nothing is done by thee but to deceive. Thou +neither hast conscience to God, nor love to the town of Mansoul; +whence, then, should these thy sayings arise but from sinful craft +and deceit? He that can of list and will propound what he pleases, +and that wherewith he may destroy them that believe him, is to be +abandoned, with all that he shall say. But if righteousness be +such a beauty-spot in thine eyes now, how is it that wickedness was +so closely stuck to by thee before? But this is by-the-bye. + +'Thou talkest now of a reformation in Mansoul, and that thou +thyself, if I will please, wilt be at the head of that reformation; +all the while knowing that the greatest proficiency that man can +make in the law, and the righteousness thereof, will amount to no +more, for the taking away of the curse from Mansoul, than just +nothing at all; for a law being broken by Mansoul, that had before, +upon a supposition of the breach thereof, a curse pronounced +against him for it of God, can never, by his obeying of the law, +deliver himself therefrom (to say nothing of what a reformation is +like to be set up in Mansoul when the devil is become corrector of +vice). Thou knowest that all that thou hast now said in this +matter is nothing but guile and deceit; and is, as it was the +first, so is it the last card that thou hast to play. Many there +be that do soon discern thee when thou showest them thy cloven +foot; but in thy white, thy light, and in thy transformation, thou +art seen but of a few. But thou shalt not do thus with my Mansoul, +O Diabolus; for I do still love my Mansoul. + +'Besides, I am not come to put Mansoul upon works to live thereby; +should I do so, I should be like unto thee: but I am come that by +me, and by what I have and shall do for Mansoul, they may to my +Father be reconciled, though by their sin they have provoked him to +anger, and though by the law they cannot obtain mercy. + +'Thou talkest of subjecting of this town to good, when none +desireth it at thy hands. I am sent by my Father to possess it +myself, and to guide it by the skilfulness of my hands into such a +conformity to him as shall be pleasing in his sight. I will +therefore possess it myself; I will dispossess and cast thee out; I +will set up mine own standard in the midst of them; I will also +govern them by new laws, new officers, new motives, and new ways; +yea, I will pull down this town, and build it again; and it shall +be as though it had not been, and it shall then be the glory of the +whole universe.' + +When Diabolus heard this, and perceived that he was discovered in +all his deceits, he was confounded, and utterly put to a nonplus; +but having in himself the fountain of iniquity, rage, and malice +against both Shaddai and his Son, and the beloved town of Mansoul, +what doth he but strengthen himself what he could to give fresh +battle to the noble Prince Emmanuel? So, then, now we must have +another fight before the town of Mansoul is taken. Come up, then, +to the mountains, you that love to see military actions, and behold +by both sides how the fatal blow is given, while one seeks to hold, +and the other seeks to make himself master of the famous town of +Mansoul. + +Diabolus, therefore, having withdrawn himself from the wall to his +force that was in the heart of the town of Mansoul, Emmanuel also +returned to the camp; and both of them, after their divers ways, +put themselves into a posture fit to give battle one to another. + +Diabolus, as filled with despair of retaining in his hands the +famous town of Mansoul, resolved to do what mischief he could (if, +indeed, he could do any) to the army of the Prince and to the +famous town of Mansoul; for, alas! it was not the happiness of the +silly town of Mansoul that was designed by Diabolus, but the utter +ruin and overthrow thereof, as now is enough in view. Wherefore, +he commands his officers that they should then, when they see that +they could hold the town no longer, do it what harm and mischief +they could, rendering and tearing men, women, and children. 'For,' +said he, 'we had better quite demolish the place, and leave it like +a ruinous heap, than so leave it that it may be an habitation for +Emmanuel.' + +Emmanuel again, knowing that the next battle would issue in his +being made master of the place, gave out a royal commandment to all +his officers, high captains, and men of war, to be sure to show +themselves men of war against Diabolus and all Diabolonians; but +favourable, merciful, and meek to the old inhabitants of Mansoul. +'Bend, therefore,' said the noble Prince, 'the hottest front of the +battle against Diabolus and his men.' + +So the day being come, the command was given, and the Prince's men +did bravely stand to their arms, and did, as before, bend their +main force against Ear-gate and Eye-gate. The word was then, +'Mansoul is won!' so they made their assault upon the town. +Diabolus also, as fast as he could, with the main of his power, +made resistance from within; and his high lords and chief captains +for a time fought very cruelly against the Prince's army. + +But after three or four notable charges by the Prince and his noble +captains, Ear-gate was broken open, and the bars and bolts +wherewith it was used to be fast shut up against the Prince, were +broken into a thousand pieces. Then did the Prince's trumpets +sound, the captains shout, the town shake, and Diabolus retreat to +his hold. Well, when the Prince's forces had broken open the gate, +himself came up and did set his throne in it; also he set his +standard thereby, upon a mount that before by his men was cast up +to place the mighty slings thereon. The mount was called Mount +Hear-well. There, therefore, the Prince abode, to wit, hard by the +going in at the gate. He commanded also that the golden slings +should yet be played upon the town, especially against the castle, +because for shelter thither was Diabolus retreated. Now, from Ear- +gate the street was straight even to the house of Mr. Recorder that +so was before Diabolus took the town; and hard by his house stood +the castle, which Diabolus for a long time had made his irksome +den. The captains, therefore, did quickly clear that street by the +use of their slings, so that way was made up to the heart of the +town. Then did the Prince command that Captain Boanerges, Captain +Conviction, and Captain Judgment, should forthwith march up the +town to the old gentleman's gate. Then did the captains in the +most warlike manner enter into the town of Mansoul, and marching in +with flying colours, they came up to the Recorder's house, and that +was almost as strong as was the castle. Battering-rams they took +also with them, to plant against the castle gates. When they were +come to the house of Mr. Conscience, they knocked, and demanded +entrance. Now, the old gentleman, not knowing as yet fully their +design, kept his gates shut all the time of this fight. Wherefore +Boanerges demanded entrance at his gates; and no man making answer, +he gave it one stroke with the head of a ram, and this made the old +gentleman shake, and his house to tremble and totter. Then came +Mr. Recorder down to the gates, and, as he could, with quivering +lips he asked who was there? Boanerges answered, 'We are the +captains and commanders of the great Shaddai and of the blessed +Emmanuel, his Son, and we demand possession of your house for the +use of our noble Prince.' And with that the battering-ram gave the +gate another shake. This made the old gentleman tremble the more, +yet durst he not but open the gate: then the King's forces marched +in, namely, the three brave captains mentioned before. Now, the +Recorder's house was a place of much convenience for Emmanuel, not +only because it was near to the castle and strong, but also because +it was large, and fronted the castle, the den where now Diabolus +was, for he was now afraid to come out of his hold. As for Mr. +Recorder, the captains carried it very reservedly to him; as yet he +knew nothing of the great designs of Emmanuel, so that he did not +know what judgment to make, nor what would be the end of such +thundering beginnings. It was also presently noised in the town +how the Recorder's house was possessed, his rooms taken up, and his +palace made the seat of the war; and no sooner was it noised +abroad, but they took the alarm as warmly, and gave it out to +others of his friends, and you know, as a snowball loses nothing by +rolling, so in little time the whole town was possessed that they +must expect nothing from the Prince but destruction; and the ground +of the business was this, the Recorder was afraid, the Recorder +trembled, and the captains carried it strangely to the Recorder. +So many came to see, but when they with their own eyes did behold +the captains in the palace, and their battering-rams ever playing +at the castle gates to beat them down, they were riveted in their +fears, and it made them all in amaze. And, as I said, the man of +the house would increase all this; for whoever came to him, or +discoursed with him, nothing would he talk of, tell them, or hear, +but that death and destruction now attended Mansoul. + +'For,' quoth the old gentleman, 'you are all of you sensible that +we all have been traitors to that once despised, but now famously +victorious and glorious Prince Emmanuel; for he now, as you see, +doth not only lie in close siege about us, but hath forced his +entrance in at our gates. Moreover, Diabolus flees before him; and +he hath, as you behold, made of my house a garrison against the +castle where he is. I, for my part, have transgressed greatly, and +he that is clean, it is well for him. But I say I have +transgressed greatly in keeping silence when I should have spoken, +and in perverting justice when I should have executed the same. +True, I have suffered something at the hand of Diabolus for taking +part with the laws of King Shaddai; but that, alas! what will that +do? Will that make compensation for the rebellions and treasons +that I have done, and have suffered without gainsaying to be +committed in the town of Mansoul? Oh! I tremble to think what will +be the end of this so dreadful and so ireful a beginning!' + +Now, while these brave captains were thus busy in the house of the +old Recorder, Captain Execution was as busy in other parts of the +town, in securing the back streets and the walls. He also hunted +the Lord Willbewill sorely; he suffered him not to rest in any +corner; he pursued him so hard that he drove his men from him, and +made him glad to thrust his head into a hole. Also this mighty +warrior did cut three of the Lord Willbewill's officers down to the +ground: one was old Mr. Prejudice, he that had his crown cracked +in the mutiny. This man was made by Lord Willbewill keeper of the +Ear-gate, and fell by the hand of Captain Execution. There was +also one Mr. Backward-to-all-but-naught, and he also was one of +Lord Willbewill's officers, and was the captain of the two guns +that once were mounted on the top of Ear-gate; he also was cut down +to the ground by the hands of Captain Execution. Besides these two +there was another, a third, and his name was Captain Treacherous; a +vile man this was, but one that Willbewill did put a great deal of +confidence in; but him also did this Captain Execution cut down to +the ground with the rest. + +He also made a very great slaughter among my Lord Willbewill's +soldiers, killing many that were stout and sturdy, and wounding +many that for Diabolus were nimble and active. But all these were +Diabolonians; there was not a man, a native of Mansoul, hurt. + +Other feats of war were also likewise performed by other of the +captains, as at Eye-gate, where Captain Good-Hope and Captain +Charity had a charge, was great execution done; for the Captain +Good-Hope, with his own hands, slew one Captain Blindfold, the +keeper of that gate. This Blindfold was captain of a thousand men, +and they were they that fought with mauls; he also pursued his men, +slew many, and wounded more, and made the rest hide their heads in +corners. + +There was also at that gate Mr. Ill-Pause, of whom you have heard +before. He was an old man, and had a beard that reached down to +his girdle: the same was he that was orator to Diabolus: he did +much mischief in the town of Mansoul, and fell by the hand of +Captain Good-Hope. + +What shall I say? The Diabolonians in these days lay dead in every +corner, though too many yet were alive in Mansoul. + +Now, the old Recorder and my Lord Understanding, with some others +of the chief of the town, to wit, such as knew they must stand and +fall with the famous town of Mansoul, came together upon a day, and +after consultation had, did jointly agree to draw up a petition, +and to send it to Emmanuel, now while he sat in the gate of +Mansoul. So they drew up their petition to Emmanuel, the contents +whereof were these: That they, the old inhabitants of the now +deplorable town of Mansoul, confessed their sin, and were sorry +that they had offended his princely Majesty, and prayed that he +would spare their lives. + +Unto this petition he gave no answer at all, and that did trouble +them yet so much the more. Now, all this while the captains that +were in the Recorder's house were playing with the battering-rams +at the gates of the castle, to beat them down. So after some time, +labour, and travail, the gate of the castle that was called +Impregnable was beaten open, and broken into several splinters, and +so a way made to go up to the hold in which Diabolus had hid +himself. Then were tidings sent down to Ear-gate, for Emmanuel +still abode there, to let him know that a way was made in at the +gates of the castle of Mansoul. But, oh! how the trumpets at the +tidings sounded throughout the Prince's camp, for that now the war +was so near an end, and Mansoul itself of being set free. + +Then the Prince arose from the place where he was, and took with +him such of his men of war as were fittest for that expedition, and +marched up the street of Mansoul to the old Recorder's house. + +Now, the Prince himself was clad all in armour of gold, and so he +marched up the town with his standard borne before him; but he kept +his countenance much reserved all the way as he went, so that the +people could not tell how to gather to themselves love or hatred by +his looks. Now, as he marched up the street, the townsfolk came +out at every door to see, and could not but be taken with his +person and the glory thereof, but wondered at the reservedness of +his countenance; for as yet he spake more to them by his actions +and works than he did by words or smiles. But also poor Mansoul, +(as in such cases all are apt to do,) they interpreted the carriage +of Emmanuel to them as did Joseph's brethren his to them, even all +the quite contrary way. 'For,' thought they, 'if Emmanuel loved +us, he would show it to us by word of carriage; but none of these +he doth, therefore Emmanuel hates us. Now, if Emmanuel hates us, +then Mansoul shall be slain, then Mansoul shall become a dunghill.' +They knew that they had transgressed his Father's law, and that +against him they had been in with Diabolus, his enemy. They also +knew that the Prince Emmanuel knew all this; for they were +convinced that he was an angel of God, to know all things that are +done in the earth; and this made them think that their condition +was miserable, and that the good Prince would make them desolate. + +'And,' thought they, 'what time so fit to do this in as now, when +he has the bridle of Mansoul in his hand?' And this I took special +notice of, that the inhabitants, notwithstanding all this, could +not--no, they could not, when they see him march through the town, +but cringe, bow, bend, and were ready to lick the dust of his feet. +They also wished a thousand times over that he would become their +Prince and Captain, and would become their protection. They would +also one to another talk of the comeliness of his person, and how +much for glory and valour he outstripped the great ones of the +world. But, poor hearts, as to themselves, their thoughts would +chance, and go upon all manner of extremes. Yea, through the +working of them backward and forward, Mansoul became as a ball +tossed, and as a rolling thing before the whirlwind. + +Now, when he was come to the castle gates, he commanded Diabolus to +appear, and to surrender himself into his hands. But, oh! how +loath was the beast to appear! how he stuck at it! how he shrank! +how he cringed! yet out he came to the Prince. Then Emmanuel +commanded, and they took Diabolus and bound him fast in chains, the +better to reserve him to the judgment that he had appointed for +him. But Diabolus stood up to entreat for himself that Emmanuel +would not send him into the deep, but suffer him to depart out of +Mansoul in peace. + +When Emmanuel had taken him and bound him in chains, he led him +into the marketplace, and there, before Mansoul, stripped him of +his armour in which he boasted so much before. This now was one of +the acts of triumph of Emmanuel over his enemy; and all the while +that the giant was stripping, the trumpets of the golden Prince did +sound amain; the captains also shouted, and the soldiers did sing +for joy. + +Then was Mansoul called upon to behold the beginning of Emmanuel's +triumph over him in whom they so much had trusted, and of whom they +so much had boasted in the days when he flattered them. + +Thus having made Diabolus naked in the eyes of Mansoul, and before +the commanders of the Prince, in the next place, he commands that +Diabolus should be bound with chains to his chariot wheels. Then +leaving some of his forces, to wit, Captain Boanerges and Captain +Conviction, as a guard for the castle-gates, that resistance might +be made on his behalf, (if any that heretofore followed Diabolus +should make an attempt to possess it,) he did ride in triumph over +him quite through the town of Mansoul, and so out at and before the +gate called Eye-gate, to the plain where his camp did lie. + +But you cannot think, unless you had been there, as I was, what a +shout there was in Emmanuel's camp when they saw the tyrant bound +by the hand of their noble Prince, and tied to his chariot wheels! + +And they said, 'He hath led captivity captive, he hath spoiled +principalities and powers. Diabolus is subjected to the power of +his sword, and made the object of all derision.' + +Those also that rode reformades, and that came down to see the +battle, they shouted with that greatness of voice, and sung with +such melodious notes, that they caused them that dwell in the +highest orbs to open their windows, put out their heads, and look +to see the cause of that glory. + +The townsmen also, so many of them as saw this sight, were, as it +were, while they looked, betwixt the earth and the heavens. True, +they could not tell what would be the issue of things as to them; +but all things were done in such excellent methods, and I cannot +tell how, but things in the management of them seemed to cast a +smile towards the town, so that their eyes, their heads, their +hearts, and their minds, and all that they had, were taken and held +while they observed Emmanuel's order. + +So, when the brave Prince had finished this part of his triumph +over Diabolus his foe, he turned him up in the midst of his +contempt and shame, having given him a charge no more to be a +possessor of Mansoul. Then went he from Emmanuel, and out of the +midst of his camp, to inherit the parched places in a salt land, +seeking rest, but finding none. + +Now, Captain Boanerges and Captain Conviction were, both of them, +men of very great majesty; their faces were like the faces of +lions, and their words like the roaring of the sea; and they still +quartered in Mr. Conscience's house, of whom mention was made +before. When, therefore, the high and mighty Prince had thus far +finished his triumph over Diabolus, the townsmen had more leisure +to view and to behold the actions of these noble captains. But the +captains carried it with that terror and dread in all that they +did, (and you may be sure that they had private instructions so to +do,) that they kept the town under continual heart-aching, and +caused (in their apprehension) the well-being of Mansoul for the +future to hang in doubt before them, so that for some considerable +time they neither knew what rest, or ease, or peace, or hope meant. + +Nor did the Prince himself as yet abide in the town of Mansoul, but +in his royal pavilion in the camp, and in the midst of his Father's +forces. So, at a time convenient, he sent special orders to +Captain Boanerges to summons Mansoul, the whole of the townsmen, +into the castle-yard, and then and there, before their faces, to +take my Lord Understanding, Mr. Conscience, and that notable one, +the Lord Willbewill, and put them all three in ward, and that they +should set a strong guard upon them there, until his pleasure +concerning them was further known: the which orders, when the +captains had put them in execution, made no small addition to the +fears of the town of Mansoul; for now, to their thinking, were +their former fears of the ruin of Mansoul confirmed. Now, what +death they should die, and how long they should be in dying, was +that which most perplexed their heads and hearts; yea, they were +afraid that Emmanuel would command them all into the deep, the +place that the prince Diabolus was afraid of, for they knew that +they had deserved it. Also to die by the sword in the face of the +town, and in the open way of disgrace, from the hand of so good and +so holy a prince, that, too, troubled them sore. The town was also +greatly troubled for the men that were committed to ward, for that +they were their stay and their guide, and for that they believed +that, if those men were cut off, their execution would be but the +beginning of the ruin of the town of Mansoul. Wherefore, what do +they, but, together with the men in prison, draw up a petition to +the Prince, and sent it to Emmanuel by the hand of Mr. Would-live. +So he went, and came to the Prince's quarters, and presented the +petition, the sum of which was this: + +'Great and wonderful Potentate, victor over Diabolus, and conqueror +of the town of Mansoul, We, the miserable inhabitants of that most +woful corporation, do humbly beg that we may find favour in thy +sight, and remember not against us former transgressions, nor yet +the sins of the chief of our town: but spare us according to the +greatness of thy mercy, and let us not die, but live in thy sight. +So shall we be willing to be thy servants, and, if thou shalt think +fit, to gather our meat under thy table. Amen.' + +So the petitioner went, as was said, with his petition to the +Prince; and the Prince took it at his hand, but sent him away with +silence. This still afflicted the town of Mansoul; but yet, +considering that now they must either petition or die, for now they +could not do anything else, therefore they consulted again, and +sent another petition; and this petition was much after the form +and method of the former. + +But when the petition was drawn up, By whom should they send it? +was the next question; for they would not send this by him by whom +they sent the first, for they thought that the Prince had taken +some offence at the manner of his deportment before him: so they +attempted to make Captain Conviction their messenger with it; but +he said that he neither durst nor would petition Emmanuel for +traitors, nor be to the Prince an advocate for rebels. 'Yet +withal,' said he, 'our Prince is good, and you may adventure to +send it by the hand of one of your town, provided he went with a +rope about his head, and pleaded nothing but mercy.' + +Well, they made, through fear, their delays as long as they could, +and longer than delays were good; but fearing at last the +dangerousness of them, they thought, but with many a fainting in +their minds, to send their petition by Mr. Desires-awake; so they +sent for Mr. Desires-awake. Now he dwelt in a very mean cottage in +Mansoul, and he came at his neighbour's request. So they told him +what they had done, and what they would do, concerning petitioning, +and that they did desire of him that he would go therewith to the +Prince. + +Then said Mr. Desires-awake, 'Why should not I do the best I can to +save so famous a town as Mansoul from deserved destruction?' They +therefore delivered the petition to him, and told him how he must +address himself to the Prince, and wished him ten thousand good +speeds. So he comes to the Prince's pavilion, as the first, and +asked to speak with his Majesty. So word was carried to Emmanuel, +and the Prince came out to the man. When Mr. Desires-awake saw the +Prince, he fell flat with his face to the ground, and cried out, +'Oh that Mansoul might live before thee!' and with that he +presented the petition; the which when the Prince had read, he +turned away for a while and wept; but refraining himself, he turned +again to the man, who all this while lay crying at his feet, as at +the first, and said to him, 'Go thy way to thy place, and I will +consider of thy requests.' + +Now, you may think that they of Mansoul that had sent him, what +with guilt, and what with fear lest their petition should be +rejected, could not but look with many a long look, and that, too, +with strange workings of heart, to see what would become of their +petition. At last they saw their messenger coming back. So, when +he was come, they asked him how he fared, what Emmanuel said, and +what was become of the petition. But he told them that he would be +silent till he came to the prison to my Lord Mayor, my Lord +Willbewill, and Mr. Recorder. So he went forwards towards the +prison-house, where the men of Mansoul lay bound. But, oh! what a +multitude flocked after, to hear what the messenger said. So, when +he was come, and had shown himself at the gate of the prison, my +Lord Mayor himself looked as white as a clout; the Recorder also +did quake. But they asked and said, 'Come, good sir, what did the +great Prince say to you?' Then said Mr. Desires-awake, 'When I +came to my Lord's pavilion, I called, and he came forth. So I fell +prostrate at his feet, and delivered to him my petition; for the +greatness of his person, and the glory of his countenance, would +not suffer me to stand upon my legs. Now, as he received the +petition, I cried, "Oh that Mansoul might live before thee!" So, +when for a while he had looked thereon, he turned him about, and +said to his servant, "Go thy way to thy place again, and I will +consider of thy requests."' The messenger added, moreover, and +said, 'The Prince to whom you sent me is such a one for beauty and +glory, that whoso sees him must both love and fear him. I, for my +part, can do no less; but I know not what will be the end of these +things.' + +At this answer they were all at a stand, both they in prison, and +they that followed the messenger thither to hear the news; nor knew +they what, or what manner of interpretation to put upon what the +Prince had said. Now, when the prison was cleared of the throng, +the prisoners among themselves began to comment upon Emmanuel's +words. My Lord Mayor said, that the answer did not look with a +rugged face; but Willbewill said that it betokened evil; and the +Recorder, that it was a messenger of death. Now, they that were +left, and that stood behind, and so could not so well hear what the +prisoners said, some of them catched hold of one piece of a +sentence, and some on a bit of another; some took hold of what the +messenger said, and some of the prisoners' judgment thereon; so +none had the right understanding of things. But you cannot imagine +what work these people made, and what a confusion there was in +Mansoul now. + +For presently they that had heard what was said flew about the +town, one crying one thing, and another the quite contrary; and +both were sure enough they told true; for they did hear, they said, +with their ears what was said, and therefore could not be deceived. +One would say, 'We must all be killed;' another would say, 'We must +all be saved;' and a third would say that the Prince would not be +concerned with Mansoul; and a fourth, that the prisoners must be +suddenly put to death. And, as I said, every one stood to it that +he told his tale the rightest, and that all others but he were out. +Wherefore Mansoul had now molestation upon molestation, nor could +any man know on what to rest the sole of his foot; for one would go +by now, and as he went, if he heard his neighbour tell his tale, to +be sure he would tell the quite contrary, and both would stand in +it that he told the truth. Nay, some of them had got this story by +the end, that the Prince did intend to put Mansoul to the sword. +And now it began to be dark, wherefore poor Mansoul was in sad +perplexity all that night until the morning. + +But, so far as I could gather by the best information that I could +get, all this hubbub came through the words that the Recorder said +when he told them that, in his judgment, the Prince's answer was a +messenger of death. It was this that fired the town, and that +began the fright in Mansoul; for Mansoul in former times did use to +count that Mr. Recorder was a seer, and that his sentence was equal +to the best of orators; and thus was Mansoul a terror to itself. + +And now did they begin to feel what were the effects of stubborn +rebellion, and unlawful resistance against their Prince. I say, +they now began to feel the effects thereof by guilt and fear, that +now had swallowed them up; and who more involved in the one but +they that were most in the other, to wit, the chief of the town of +Mansoul? + +To be brief: when the fame of the fright was out of the town, and +the prisoners had a little recovered themselves, they take to +themselves some heart, and think to petition the Prince for life +again. So they did draw up a third petition, the contents whereof +were these:- + +'Prince Emmanuel the Great, Lord of all worlds, and Master of +mercy, we, thy poor, wretched, miserable, dying town of Mansoul, do +confess unto thy great and glorious Majesty that we have sinned +against thy Father and thee, and are no more worthy to be called +thy Mansoul, but rather to be cast into the pit. If thou wilt slay +us, we have deserved it. If thou wilt condemn us to the deep, we +cannot but say thou art righteous. We cannot complain whatever +thou dost, or however thou carriest it towards us. But, oh! let +mercy reign, and let it be extended to us! Oh! let mercy take hold +upon us, and free us from our transgressions, and we will sing of +thy mercy and of thy judgment. Amen.' + +This petition, when drawn up, was designed to be sent to the Prince +as the first. But who should carry it?--that was the question. +Some said, 'Let him do it that went with the first,' but others +thought not good to do that, and that because he sped no better. +Now, there was an old man in the town, and his name was Mr. Good- +Deed; a man that bare only the name, but had nothing of the nature +of the thing. Now, some were for sending him; but the Recorder was +by no means for that. 'For,' said he, 'we now stand in need of, +and are pleading for mercy: wherefore, to send our petition by a +man of this name, will seem to cross the petition itself. Should +we make Mr. Good-Deed our messenger, when our petition cries for +mercy? + +'Besides,' quoth the old gentleman, 'should the Prince now, as he +receives the petition, ask him, and say, "What is thy name?" as +nobody knows but he will, and he should say, "Old Good-Deed," what, +think you, would Emmanuel say but this? "Ay! is old Good-Deed yet +alive in Mansoul? then let old Good-Deed save you from your +distresses." And if he says so, I am sure we are lost; nor can a +thousand of old Good-Deeds save Mansoul.' + +After the Recorder had given in his reasons why old Good-Deed +should not go with this petition to Emmanuel, the rest of the +prisoners and chief of Mansoul opposed it also, and so old Good- +Deed was laid aside, and they agreed to send Mr. Desires-awake +again. So they sent for him, and desired him that he would a +second time go with their petition to the Prince, and he readily +told them he would. But they bid him that in anywise he should +take heed that in no word or carriage he gave offence to the +Prince; 'For by doing so, for ought we can tell, you may bring +Mansoul into utter destruction,' said they. + +Now Mr. Desires-awake, when he saw that he must go on this errand, +besought that they would grant that Mr. Wet-Eyes might go with him. +Now this Mr. Wet-Eyes was a near neighbour of Mr. Desires, a poor +man, a man of a broken spirit, yet one that could speak well to a +petition; so they granted that he should go with him. Wherefore, +they address themselves to their business: Mr. Desires put a rope +upon his head, and Mr. Wet-Eyes went with his hands wringing +together. Thus they went to the Prince's pavilion. + +Now, when they went to petition this third time, they were not +without thoughts that, by often coming, they might be a burden to +the Prince. Wherefore, when they were come to the door of his +pavilion, they first made their apology for themselves, and for +their coming to trouble Emmanuel so often; and they said, that they +came not hither to-day for that they delighted in being +troublesome, or for that they delighted to hear themselves talk, +but for that necessity caused them to come to his Majesty. They +could, they said, have no rest day nor night because of their +transgressions against Shaddai and against Emmanuel, his Son. They +also thought that some misbehaviour of Mr. Desires-awake the last +time might give distaste to his Highness, and so cause that he +returned from so merciful a Prince empty, and without countenance. +So, when they had made this apology, Mr. Desires-awake cast himself +prostrate upon the ground, as at the first, at the feet of the +mighty Prince, saying, 'Oh! that Mansoul might live before thee!' +and so he delivered his petition. The Prince then, having read the +petition, turned aside awhile as before, and coming again to the +place where the petitioner lay on the ground, he demanded what his +name was, and of what esteem in the account of Mansoul, for that +he, above all the multitude in Mansoul, should be sent to him upon +such an errand. Then said the man to the Prince, 'Oh let not my +Lord be angry; and why inquirest thou after the name of such a dead +do--as I am? Pass by, I pray thee, and take not notice of who I +am, because there is, as thou very well knowest, so great a +disproportion between me and thee. Why the townsmen chose to send +me on this errand to my Lord is best known to themselves, but it +could not be for that they thought that I had favour with my Lord. +For my part, I am out of charity with myself; who, then, should be +in love with me? Yet live I would, and so would I that my townsmen +should; and because both they and myself are guilty of great +transgressions, therefore they have sent me, and I am come in their +names to beg of my Lord for mercy. Let it please thee, therefore, +to incline to mercy; but ask not what thy servants are.' + +Then said the Prince, 'And what is he that is become thy companion +in this so weighty a matter?' So Mr. Desires told Emmanuel that he +was a poor neighbour of his, and one of his most intimate +associates. 'And his name,' said he, 'may it please your most +excellent Majesty, is Wet-Eyes, of the town of Mansoul, I know that +there are many of that name that are naught; but I hope it will be +no offence to my Lord that I have brought my poor neighbour with +me.' + +Then Mr. Wet-Eyes fell on his face to the ground, and made this +apology for his coming with his neighbour to his Lord:- + +'O, my Lord,' quoth he, 'what I am I know not myself, nor whether +my name be feigned or true, especially when I begin to think what +some have said, namely, That this name was given me because Mr. +Repentance was my father. Good men have bad children, and the +sincere do oftentimes beget hypocrites. My mother also called me +by this name from the cradle; but whether because of the moistness +of my brain, or because of the softness of my heart, I cannot tell. +I see dirt in mine own tears, and filthiness in the bottom of my +prayers. But I pray thee (and all this while the gentleman wept) +that thou wouldest not remember against us our transgressions, nor +take offence at the unqualifiedness of thy servants, but mercifully +pass by the sin of Mansoul, and refrain from the glorifying of thy +grace no longer.' + +So at his bidding they arose, and both stood trembling before him, +and he spake to them to this purpose:- + +"The town of Mansoul hath grievously rebelled against my Father, in +that they have rejected him from being their King, and did choose +to themselves for their captain a liar, a murderer, and a runagate +slave. For this Diabolus, your pretended prince, though once so +highly accounted of by you, made rebellion against my Father and +me, even in our palace and highest court there, thinking to become +a prince and king. But being there timely discovered and +apprehended, and for his wickedness bound in chains, and separated +to the pit with those that were his companions, he offered himself +to you, and you have received him. + +'Now this is, and for a long time hath been, a high affront to my +Father; wherefore my Father sent to you a powerful army to reduce +you to your obedience. But you know how these men, their captains +and their counsels, were esteemed of you, and what they received at +your hand. You rebelled against them, you shut your gates upon +them, you bid them battle, you fought them, and fought for Diabolus +against them. So they sent to my Father for more power, and I, +with my men, are come to subdue you. But as you treated the +servants, so you treated their Lord. You stood up in hostile +manner against me, you shut up your gates against me, you turned +the deaf ear to me, and resisted as long as you could; but now I +have made a conquest of you. Did you cry me mercy so long as you +had hopes that you might prevail against me? But now I have taken +the town, you cry; but why did you not cry before, when the white +flag of my mercy, the red flag of justice, and the black flag that +threatened execution, were set up to cite you to it? Now I have +conquered your Diabolus, you come to me for favour; but why did you +not help me against the mighty? Yet I will consider your petition, +and will answer it so as will be for my glory. + +'Go, bid Captain Boanerges and Captain Conviction bring the +prisoners out to me into the camp to-morrow, and say you to Captain +Judgment and Captain Execution, "Stay you in the castle, and take +good heed to yourselves that you keep all quiet in Mansoul until +you shall hear further from me."' And with that he turned himself +from them, and went into his royal pavilion again. + +So the petitioners, having received this answer from the Prince, +returned, as at the first, to go to their companions again. But +they had not gone far, but thoughts began to work in their minds +that no mercy as yet was intended by the Prince to Mansoul. So +they went to the place where the prisoners lay bound; but these +workings of mind about what would become of Mansoul had such strong +power over them, that by that they were come unto them that sent +them, they were scarce able to deliver their message. + +But they came at length to the gates of the town, (now the townsmen +with earnestness were waiting for their return,) where many met +them, to know what answer was made to the petition. Then they +cried out to those that were sent, 'What news from the Prince? and +what hath Emmanuel said?' But they said that they must, as afore, +go up to the prison, and there deliver their message. So away they +went to the prison, with a multitude at their heels. Now, when +they were come to the gates of the prison, they told the first part +of Emmanuel's speech to the prisoners, to wit, how he reflected +upon their disloyalty to his Father and himself, and how they had +chosen and closed with Diabolus, had fought for him, hearkened to +him, and been ruled by him; but had despised him and his men. This +made the prisoners look pale; but the messengers proceeded and +said, 'He, the Prince, said, moreover, that yet he would consider +your petition, and give such answer thereto as would stand with his +glory.' And as these words were spoken, Mr. Wet-Eyes gave a great +sigh. At this they were all of them struck into their dumps, and +could not tell what to say: fear also possessed them in a +marvellous manner, and death seemed to sit upon some of their +eyebrows. Now, there was in the company a notable, sharp-witted +fellow, a mean man of estate, and his name was old Inquisitive. +This man asked the petitioners if they had told out every whit of +what Emmanuel said, and they answered, 'Verily, no.' Then said +Inquisitive, 'I thought so, indeed. Pray, what was it more that he +said unto you?' Then they paused awhile; but at last they brought +out all, saying, 'The Prince bade us bid Captain Boanerges and +Captain Conviction bring the prisoners down to him to-morrow; and +that Captain Judgment and Captain Execution should take charge of +the castle and town till they should hear further from him. They +said also that when the Prince had commanded them thus to do, he +immediately turned his back upon them, and went into his royal +pavilion. + +But, oh! how this return, and specially this last clause of it, +that the prisoners must go out to the Prince into the camp, brake +all their loins in pieces! Wherefore, with one voice they set up a +cry that reached up to the heavens. This done, each of the three +prepared himself to die; (and the Recorder said unto them, 'This +was the thing that I feared;') for they concluded that to-morrow, +by that the sun went down, they should be tumbled out of the world. +The whole town also counted of no other, but that, in their time +and order, they must all drink of the same cup. Wherefore the town +of Mansoul spent that night in mourning, and sackcloth and ashes. +The prisoners also, when the time was come for them to go down +before the Prince, dressed themselves in mourning attire, with +ropes upon their heads. The whole town of Mansoul also showed +themselves upon the wall, all clad in mourning weeds, if, perhaps, +the Prince with the sight thereof might be moved with compassion. +But, oh! how the busy-bodies that were in the town of Mansoul did +now concern themselves! They did run here and there through the +streets of the town by companies, crying out as they ran in +tumultuous wise, one after one manner, and another the quite +contrary, to the almost utter distraction of Mansoul. + +Well, the time is come that the prisoners must go down to the camp, +and appear before the Prince. And thus was the manner of their +going down: Captain Boanerges went with a guard before them, and +Captain Conviction came behind, and the prisoners went down, bound +in chains, in the midst. So I say, the prisoners went in the +midst, and the guard went with flying colours behind and before, +but the prisoners went with drooping spirits. + +Or, more particularly, thus: The prisoners went down all in +mourning: they put ropes upon themselves; they went on, smiting +themselves on the breasts, but durst not lift up their eyes to +heaven. Thus they went out at the gate of Mansoul, till they came +into the midst of the Prince's army, the sight and glory of which +did greatly heighten their affliction. Nor could they now longer +forbear, but cry out aloud, 'O unhappy men! O wretched men of +Mansoul!' Their chains, still mixing their dolorous notes with the +cries of the prisoners, made the noise more lamentable. + +So, when they were come to the door of the Prince's pavilion, they +cast themselves prostrate upon the place; then one went in and told +his Lord that the prisoners were come down. The Prince then +ascended a throne of state, and sent for the prisoners in; who, +when they came, did tremble before him, also they covered their +faces with shame. Now, as they drew near to the place where he +sat, they threw themselves down before him. Then said the Prince +to the Captain Boanerges, 'Bid the prisoners stand upon their +feet.' Then they stood trembling before him, and he said, 'Are you +the men that heretofore were the servants of Shaddai?' And they +said, 'Yes, Lord, yes.' Then said the Prince again, 'Are you the +men that did suffer yourselves to be corrupted and defiled by that +abominable one, Diabolus?' And they said, 'We did more than suffer +it, Lord; for we chose it of our own mind.' The Prince asked +further, saying, 'Could you have been content that your slavery +should have continued under his tyranny as long as you had lived?' +Then said the prisoners, 'Yes, Lord, yes; for his ways were +pleasing to our flesh, and we were grown aliens to a better +state.'--'And did you,' said he, 'when I came up against this town +of Mansoul, heartily wish that I might not have the victory over +you?'--'Yes, Lord, yes,' said they. Then said the Prince, 'And +what punishment is it, think you, that you deserve at my hand, for +these and other your high and mighty sins?'--And they said, 'Both +death and the deep, Lord; for we have deserved no less.' He asked +again if they had aught to say for themselves why the sentence, +that they confessed that they had deserved, should not be passed +upon them? And they said, 'We can say nothing, Lord: thou art +just, for we have sinned.' Then said the Prince, 'And for what are +those ropes on your heads?' The prisoners answered, 'These ropes +are to bind us withal to the place of execution, if mercy be not +pleasing in thy sight.' So he further asked if all the men in the +town of Mansoul were in this confession, as they? And they +answered, 'All the natives, Lord; but for the Diabolonians that +came into our town when the tyrant got possession of us, we can say +nothing for them.' + +Then the Prince commanded that a herald should be called, and that +he should, in the midst and throughout the camp of Emmanuel, +proclaim, and that with sound of trumpet, that the Prince, the Son +of Shaddai, had, in his Father's name, and for his Father's glory, +gotten a perfect conquest and victory over Mansoul; and that the +prisoners should follow him, and say Amen. So, this was done as he +had commanded. And presently the music that was in the upper +region sounded melodiously, the captains that were in the camp +shouted, and the soldiers did sing songs of triumph to the Prince; +the colours waved in the wind, and great joy was everywhere, only +it was wanting as yet in the hearts of the men of Mansoul. + +Then the Prince called for the prisoners to come and to stand again +before him, and they came and stood trembling. And he said unto +them, 'The sins, trespasses, iniquities, that you, with the whole +town of Mansoul, have from time to time committed against my Father +and me, I have power and commandment from my Father to forgive to +the town of Mansoul, and do forgive you accordingly.' And having +so said, he gave them, written in parchment, and sealed with seven +seals, a large and general pardon, commanding my Lord Mayor, my +Lord Willbewill, and Mr. Recorder, to proclaim and cause it to be +proclaimed to-morrow, by that the sun is up, throughout the whole +town of Mansoul. + +Moreover, the Prince stripped the prisoners of their mourning +weeds, and gave them beauty for ashes, the oil of joy for mourning, +and the garment of praise for the spirit of heaviness. + +Then he gave to each of the three jewels of gold and precious +stones, and took away their ropes, and put chains of gold about +their necks, and ear-rings in their ears. Now, the prisoners, when +they did hear the gracious words of Prince Emmanuel, and had beheld +all that was done unto them, fainted almost quite away; for the +grace, the benefit, the pardon, was sudden, glorious, and so big, +that they were not able, without staggering, to stand up under it. +Yea, my Lord Willbewill swooned outright; but the Prince stepped to +him, put his everlasting arms under him, embraced him, kissed him, +and bid him be of good cheer, for all should be performed according +to his word. He also did kiss, and embrace, and smile upon the +other two that were Willbewill's companions, saying, 'Take these as +further tokens of my love, favour, and compassions to you; and I +charge you that you, Mr. Recorder, tell in the town of Mansoul what +you have heard and seen.' + +Then were their fetters broken to pieces before their faces, and +cast into the air, and their steps were enlarged under them. Then +they fell down at the feet of the Prince, and kissed his feet, and +wetted them with tears: also they cried out with a mighty strong +voice, saying, 'Blessed be the glory of the Lord from this place.' +So they were bid rise up, and go to the town, and tell to Mansoul +what the Prince had done. He commanded also that one with a pipe +and tabor should go and play before them all the way into the town +of Mansoul. Then was fulfilled what they never looked for, and +they were made to possess that which they never dreamed of. + +The Prince also called for the noble Captain Credence, and +commanded that he and some of his officers should march before the +noble men of Mansoul with flying colours into the town. He gave +also unto Captain Credence a charge, that about that time that the +Recorder did read the general pardon in the town of Mansoul, that +at that very time he should with flying colours march in at Eye- +gate with his ten thousands at his feet and that he should so go +until he came by the high street of the town, up to the castle +gates, and that himself should take possession thereof against his +Lord came thither. He commanded, moreover, that he should bid +Captain Judgment and Captain Execution to leave the stronghold to +him, and to withdraw from Mansoul, and to return into the camp with +speed unto the Prince. + +And now was the town of Mansoul also delivered from the terror of +the first four captains and their men. + +Well, I told you before how the prisoners were entertained by the +noble Prince Emmanuel, and how they behaved themselves before him, +and how he sent them away to their home with pipe and tabor going +before them. And now you must think that those of the town that +had all this while waited to hear of their death, could not but be +exercised with sadness of mind, and with thoughts that pricked like +thorns. Nor could their thoughts be kept to any one point; the +wind blew with them all this while at great uncertainties; yea, +their hearts were like a balance that had been disquieted with a +shaking hand. But at last, as they with many a long look looked +over the wall of Mansoul, they thought that they saw some returning +to the town; and thought again, Who should they be, too? Who +should they be? At last they discerned that they were the +prisoners: but can you imagine how their hearts were surprised +with wonder, specially when they perceived also in what equipage +and with what honour they were sent home. They went down to the +camp in black, but they came back to the town in white; they went +down to the camp in ropes, they came back in chains of gold; they +went down to the camp with their feet in fetters, but came back +with their steps enlarged under them; they went also to the camp +looking for death, but they came back from thence with assurance of +life; they went down to the camp with heavy hearts, but came back +again with pipe and tabor playing before them. So as soon as they +were come to Eye-gate, the poor and tottering town of Mansoul +adventured to give a shout; and they gave such a shout as made the +captains in the Prince's army leap at the sound thereof. Alas! for +them, poor hearts! who could blame them? since their dead friends +were come to life again; for it was to them as life from the dead +to see the ancients of the town of Mansoul shine in such splendour. +They looked for nothing but the axe and the block; but, behold, joy +and gladness, comfort and consolation, and such melodious notes +attending them that was sufficient to make a sick man well. + +So, when they came up, they saluted each other with, 'Welcome, +welcome! and blessed be he that has spared you!' They added also, +'We see it is well with you; but how must it go with the town of +Mansoul? And will it go well with the town of Mansoul?' said they. +Then answered them the Recorder and my Lord Mayor, 'Oh! tidings! +glad tidings! good tidings of good, and of great joy to poor +Mansoul!' Then they gave another shout, that made the earth to +ring again. After this, they inquired yet more particularly how +things went in the camp, and what message they had from Emmanuel to +the town. So they told them all passages that had happened to them +at the camp, and everything that the Prince did to them. This made +Mansoul wonder at the wisdom and grace of the Prince Emmanuel. +Then they told them what they had received at his hands for the +whole town of Mansoul, and the Recorder delivered it in these +words: ' PARDON, PARDON, PARDON for Mansoul! and this shall +Mansoul know to-morrow!' Then he commanded, and they went and +summoned Mansoul to meet together in the market-place to-morrow, +then to hear their general pardon read. + +But who can think what a turn, what a change, what an alteration +this hint of things did make in the countenance of the town of +Mansoul! No man of Mansoul could sleep that night for joy; in +every house there was joy and music, singing and making merry: +telling and hearing of Mansoul's happiness was then all that +Mansoul had to do; and this was the burden of all their song: 'Oh! +more of this at the rising of the sun! more of this to-morrow!' +'Who thought yesterday,' would one say, 'that this day would have +been such a day to us? And who thought, that saw our prisoners go +down in irons, that they would have returned in chains of gold? +Yea, they that judged themselves as they went to be judged of their +judge, were by his mouth acquitted, not for that they were +innocent, but of the Prince's mercy, and sent home with pipe and +tabor. But is this the common custom of princes? Do they use to +show such kind of favours to traitors? No; this is only peculiar +to Shaddai, and unto Emmanuel, his Son!' + +Now morning drew on apace; wherefore the Lord Mayor, the Lord +Willbewill, and Mr. Recorder came down to the market-place at the +time that the Prince had appointed, where the townsfolk were +waiting for them: and when they came, they came in that attire, +and in that glory that the Prince had put them into the day before, +and the street was lightened with their glory. So the Mayor, +Recorder, and my Lord Willbewill drew down to Mouth-gate, which was +at the lower end of the market-place, because that of old time was +the place where they used to read public matters. Thither, +therefore, they came in their robes, and their tabrets went before +them. Now, the eagerness of the people to know the full of the +matter was great. + +Then the Recorder stood up upon his feet, and, first beckoning with +his hand for silence, he read out with a loud voice the pardon. +But when he came to these words: 'The Lord, the Lord God, merciful +and gracious, pardoning iniquity, transgressions, and sins, and to +them all manner of sin and blasphemy shall be forgiven,' etc., they +could not forbear leaping for joy. For this you must know, that +there was conjoined herewith every man's name in Mansoul; also the +seals of the pardon made a brave show. + +When the Recorder had made an end of reading the pardon, the +townsmen ran up upon the walls of the town, and leaped and skipped +thereon for joy, and bowed themselves seven times with their faces +toward Emmanuel's pavilion, and shouted out aloud for joy, and +said, 'Let Emmanuel live for ever!' Then order was given to the +young men in Mansoul that they should ring the bells for joy. So +the bells did ring, and the people sing, and the music go in every +house in Mansoul. + +When the Prince had sent home the three prisoners of Mansoul with +joy, and pipe and tabor, he commanded his captains, with all the +field officers and soldiers throughout his army, to be ready in +that morning, that the Recorder should read the pardon in Mansoul, +to do his further pleasure. So the morning, as I have showed, +being come, just as the Recorder had made an end of reading the +pardon, Emmanuel commanded that all the trumpets in the camp should +sound, that the colours should be displayed, half of them upon +Mount Gracious, and half of them upon Mount Justice. He commanded +also that all the captains should show themselves in all their +harness, and that the soldiers should shout for joy. Nor was +Captain Credence, though in the castle, silent in such a day; but +he, from the top of the hold, showed himself with sound of trumpet +to Mansoul and to the Prince's camp. + +Thus have I showed you the manner and way that Emmanuel took to +recover the town of Mansoul from under the hand and power of the +tyrant Diabolus. + +Now, when the Prince had completed these, the outward ceremonies of +his joy, he again commanded that his captains and soldiers should +show unto Mansoul some feats of war: so they presently addressed +themselves to this work. But oh! with what agility, nimbleness, +dexterity, and bravery did these military men discover their skill +in feats of war to the now gazing town of Mansoul! + +They marched, they counter-marched; they opened to the right and +left; they divided and subdivided; they closed, they wheeled, made +good their front and rear with their right and left wings, and +twenty things more, with that aptness, and then were all as the +were again, that they took--yea, ravished, the hearts that were in +Mansoul to behold it. But add to this, the handling of their arms, +the managing of their weapons of war, were marvellously taking to +Mansoul and me. + +When this action was over, the whole town of Mansoul came out as +one man to the Prince in the camp to thank him, and praise him for +his abundant favour, and to beg that it would please his grace to +come unto Mansoul with his men, and there to take up their quarters +for ever: and this they did in most humble manner, bowing +themselves seven times to the ground before him. Then said he, +'All peace be to you.' So the town came nigh, and touched with the +hand the top of his golden sceptre; and they said, 'Oh! that the +Prince Emmanuel, with his captains and men of war, would dwell in +Mansoul for ever; and that his battering-rams and slings might be +lodged in her for the use and service of the Prince, and for the +help and strength of Mansoul. For,' said they, 'we have room for +thee, we have room for thy men, we have also room for thy weapons +of war, and a place to make a magazine for thy carriages. Do it, +Emmanuel, and thou shalt be King and Captain in Mansoul for ever. +Yea, govern thou also according to all the desire of thy soul, and +make thou governors and princes under thee of thy captains and men +of war, and we will become thy servants, and thy laws shall be our +direction.' + +They added, moreover, and prayed his Majesty to consider thereof; +'for,' said they, 'if now, after all this grace bestowed upon us, +thy miserable town of Mansoul, thou shouldest withdraw, thou and +thy captains, from us, the town of Mansoul will die. Yea,' said +they, 'our blessed Emmanuel, if thou shouldest depart from us now, +now thou hast done so much good for us, and showed so much mercy +unto us, what will follow but that our joy will be as if it had not +been, and our enemies will a second time come upon us with more +rage than at the first? Wherefore, we beseech thee, O thou, the +desire of our eyes, and the strength and life of our poor town, +accept of this motion that now we have made unto our Lord, and come +and dwell in the midst of us, and let us be thy people. Besides, +Lord, we do not know but that to this day many Diabolonians may be +yet lurking in the town of Mansoul, and they will betray us, when +thou shalt leave us, into the hand of Diabolus again; and who knows +what designs, plots, or contrivances have passed betwixt them about +these things already? Loath we are to fall again into his horrible +hands. Wherefore, let it please thee to accept of our palace for +thy place of residence, and of the houses of the best men in our +town for the reception of thy soldiers and their furniture.' + +Then said the Prince, 'If I come to your town, will you suffer me +further to prosecute that which is in mine heart against mine +enemies and yours?--yea, will you help me in such undertakings?' + +They answered, 'We know not what we shall do; we did not think once +that we should have been such traitors to Shaddai as we have proved +to be. What, then, shall we say to our Lord? Let him put no trust +in his saints; let the Prince dwell in our castle, and make of our +town a garrison; let him set his noble captains and his warlike +soldiers over us; yea, let him conquer us with his love, and +overcome us with his grace, and then surely shall he be but with +us, and help us, as he was and did that morning that our pardon was +read unto us. We shall comply with this our Lord, and with his +ways, and fall in with his word against the mighty. + +'One word more, and thy servants have done, and in this will +trouble our Lord no more. We know not the depth of the wisdom of +thee, our Prince. Who could have thought, that had been ruled by +his reason, that so much sweet as we do now enjoy should have come +out of those bitter trials wherewith we were tried at the first! +But, Lord, let light go before, and let love come after: yea, take +us by the hand, and lead us by thy counsels, and let this always +abide upon us, that all things shall be the best for thy servants, +and come to our Mansoul, and do as it pleaseth thee. Or, Lord, +come to our Mansoul, do what thou wilt, so thou keepest us from +sinning, and makest us serviceable to thy Majesty.' + +Then said the Prince to the town of Mansoul again, 'Go, return to +your houses in peace. I will willingly in this comply with your +desires; I will remove my royal pavilion, I will draw up my forces +before Eye-gate to-morrow, and so will march forwards into the town +of Mansoul. I will possess myself of your castle of Mansoul, and +will set my soldiers over you: yea, I will yet do things in +Mansoul that cannot be paralleled in any nation, country, or +kingdom under heaven.' Then did the men of Mansoul give a shout, +and returned unto their houses in peace; they also told to their +kindred and friends the good that Emmanuel had promised to Mansoul. +'And to-morrow,' said they, 'he will march into our town, and take +up his dwelling, he and his men, in Mansoul.' + +Then went out the inhabitants of the town of Mansoul with haste to +the green trees and to the meadows, to gather boughs and flowers, +therewith to strew the streets against their Prince, the Son of +Shaddai, should come; they also made garlands and other fine works +to betoken how joyful they were, and should be to receive their +Emmanuel into Mansoul; yea, they strewed the street quite from Eye- +gate to the castle-gate, the place where the Prince should be. +They also prepared for his coming what music the town of Mansoul +would afford, that they might play before him to the palace, his +habitation. + +So, at the time appointed he makes his approach to Mansoul, and the +gates were set open for him; there also the ancients and elders of +Mansoul met him to salute him with a thousand welcomes. Then he +arose and entered Mansoul, he and all his servants. The elders of +Mansoul did also go dancing before him till he came to the castle +gates. And this was the manner of his going up thither:- He was +clad in his golden armour, he rode in his royal chariot, the +trumpets sounded about him, the colours were displayed, his ten +thousands went up at his feet, and the elders of Mansoul danced +before him. And now were the walls of the famous town of Mansoul +filled with the tramplings of the inhabitants thereof, who went up +thither to view the approach of the blessed Prince and his royal +army. Also the casements, windows, balconies, and tops of the +houses, were all now filled with persons of all sorts, to behold +how their town was to be filled with good. + +Now, when he was come so far into the town as to the Recorder's +house, he commanded that one should go to Captain Credence, to know +whether the castle of Mansoul was prepared to entertain his royal +presence (for the preparation of that was left to that captain), +and word was brought that it was. Then was Captain Credence +commanded also to come forth with his power to meet the Prince, the +which was, as he had commanded, done; and he conducted him into the +castle. This done, the Prince that night did lodge in the castle +with his mighty captains and men of war, to the joy of the town of +Mansoul. + +Now, the next care of the townsfolk was, how the captains and +soldiers of the Prince's army should be quartered among them; and +the care was not how they should shut their hands of them, but how +they should fill their houses with them; for every man in Mansoul +now had that esteem of Emmanuel and his men that nothing grieved +them more than because they were not enlarged enough, every one of +them to receive the whole army of the Prince; yea, they counted it +their glory to be waiting upon them, and would, in those days, run +at their bidding like lackeys. + +At last they came to this result:- + +1. That Captain Innocency should quarter at Mr. Reason's. + +2. That Captain Patience should quarter at Mr. Mind's. This Mr. +Mind was formerly the Lord Willbewill's clerk in time of the late +rebellion. + +3. It was ordered that Captain Charity should quarter at Mr. +Affection's house. + +4. That Captain Good-Hope should quarter at my Lord Mayor's. Now, +for the house of the Recorder, himself desired, because his house +was next to the castle, and because from him it was ordered by the +Prince that, if need be, the alarm should be given to Mansoul,--it +was, I say, desired by him that Captain Boanerges and Captain +Conviction should take up their quarters with him, even they and +all their men. + +5. As for Captain Judgment and Captain Execution, my Lord +Willbewill took them and their men to him, because he was to rule +under the Prince for the good of the town of Mansoul now, as he had +before under the tyrant Diabolus for the hurt and damage thereof. + +6. And throughout the rest of the town were quartered Emmanuel's +forces; but Captain Credence, with his men, abode still in the +castle. So the Prince, his captains, and his soldiers, were lodged +in the town of Mansoul. + +Now, the ancients and elders of the town of Mansoul thought that +they never should have enough of the Prince Emmanuel; his person, +his actions, his words, and behaviour, were so pleasing, so taking, +so desirable to them. Wherefore they prayed him, that though the +castle of Mansoul was his place of residence, (and they desired +that he might dwell there for ever,) yet that he would often visit +the streets, houses, and people of Mansoul. 'For,' said they, +'dread Sovereign, thy presence, thy looks, thy smiles, thy words, +are the life, and strength, and sinews of the town of Mansoul.' + +Besides this, they craved that they might have, without difficulty +or interruption, continual access unto him, (so for that very +purpose he commanded that the gates should stand open,) that they +might there see the manner of his doings, the fortifications of the +place, and the royal mansion-house of the Prince. + +When he spake, they all stopped their mouths and gave audience; and +when he walked, it was their delight to imitate him in his goings. + +Now, upon a time, Emmanuel made a feast for the town of Mansoul; +and upon the feasting-day the townsfolk were come to the castle to +partake of his banquet; and he feasted them with all manner of +outlandish food;--food that grew not in the fields of Mansoul; nor +in all the whole Kingdom of Universe; it was food that came from +his Father's court. And so there was dish after dish set before +them, and they were commanded freely to eat. But still, when a +fresh dish was set before them, they would whisperingly say to each +other, 'What is it?' for they wist not what to call it. They drank +also of the water that was made wine, and were very merry with him. +There was music also all the while at the table; and man did eat +angels' food, and had honey given him out of the rock. So Mansoul +did eat the food that was peculiar to the court; yea, they had now +thereof to the full. + +I must not forget to tell you, that as at this table there were +musicians, so they were not those of the country, nor yet of the +town of Mansoul; but they were the masters of the songs that were +sung at the court of Shaddai. + +Now, after the feast was over, Emmanuel was for entertaining the +town of Mansoul with some curious riddles of secrets drawn up by +his Father's secretary, by the skill and wisdom of Shaddai; the +like to these there is not in any kingdom. These riddles were made +upon the King Shaddai himself, and upon Emmanuel his Son, and upon +his wars and doings with Mansoul. + +Emmanuel also expounded unto them some of those riddles himself; +but, oh! how they were lightened! They saw what they never saw; +they could not have thought that such rarities could have been +couched in so few and such ordinary words. I told you before, whom +these riddles did concern; and as they were opened, the people did +evidently see it was so. Yea, they did gather that the things +themselves were a kind of a portraiture, and that of Emmanuel +himself; for when they read in the scheme where the riddles were +writ, and looked in the face of the Prince, things looked so like +the one to the other, that Mansoul could not forbear but say, 'This +is the lamb! this is the sacrifice! this is the rock! this is the +red cow! this is the door! and this is the way!' with a great many +other things more. + +And thus he dismissed the town of Mansoul. But can you imagine how +the people of the corporation were taken with this entertainment! +Oh! they were transported with joy, they were drowned with +wonderment, while they saw and understood, and considered what +their Emmanuel entertained them withal, and what mysteries he +opened to them. And when they were at home in their houses, and in +their most retired places, they could not but sing of him and of +his actions. Yea, so taken were the townsmen now with their +Prince, that they would sing of him in their sleep. + +Now, it was in the heart of the Prince Emmanuel to new-model the +town of Mansoul, and to put it into such a condition as might be +most pleasing to him, and that might best stand with the profit and +security of the now flourishing town of Mansoul. He provided also +against insurrections at home, and invasions from abroad, such love +had he for the famous town of Mansoul. + +Wherefore he first of all commanded that the great slings that were +brought from his Father's court, when he came to the war of +Mansoul, should be mounted, some upon the battlements of the +castle, some upon the towers; for there were towers in the town of +Mansoul, towers, new-built by Emmanuel since he came hither. There +was also an instrument, invented by Emmanuel, that was to throw +stones from the castle of Mansoul, out at Mouth-gate; an instrument +that could not be resisted, nor that would miss of execution. +Wherefore, for the wonderful exploits that it did when used, it +went without a name; and it was committed to the care of, and to be +managed by the brave captain, the Captain Credence, in case of war. + +This done, Emmanuel called the Lord Willbewill to him, and gave him +in commandment to take care of the gates, the wall, and towers in +Mansoul; also the Prince gave him the militia into his hand, and a +special charge to withstand all insurrections and tumults that +might be made in Mansoul against the peace of our Lord the King, +and the peace and tranquillity of the town of Mansoul. He also +gave him in commission, that if he found any of the Diabolonians +lurking in any corner of the famous town of Mansoul, he should +forthwith apprehend them, and stay them, or commit them to safe +custody, that they may be proceeded against according to law. + +Then he called unto him the Lord Understanding, who was the old +Lord Mayor, he that was put out of place when Diabolus took the +town, and put him into his former office again, and it became his +place for his lifetime. He bid him also that he should build him a +palace near Eye-gate; and that he should build it in fashion like a +tower for defence. He bid him also that he should read in the +Revelation of Mysteries all the days of his life, that he might +know how to perform his office aright. + +He also made Mr. Knowledge the Recorder, not of contempt to old Mr. +Conscience, who had been Recorder before, but for that it was in +his princely mind to confer upon Mr. Conscience another employ, of +which he told the old gentleman he should know more hereafter. + +Then he commanded that the image of Diabolus should be taken down +from the place where it was set up, and that they should destroy it +utterly, beating it into powder, and casting it into the wind +without the town wall; and that the image of Shaddai, his Father, +should be set up again, with his own, upon the castle gates; and +that it should be more fairly drawn than ever, forasmuch as both +his Father and himself were come to Mansoul in more grace and mercy +than heretofore. He would also that his name should be fairly +engraven upon the front of the town, and that it should be done in +the best of gold, for the honour of the town of Mansoul. + +After this was done, Emmanuel gave out a commandment that those +three great Diabolonians should be apprehended, namely, the two +late Lord Mayors, to wit, Mr. Incredulity, Mr. Lustings, and Mr. +Forget-Good, the Recorder. Besides these, there were some of them +that Diabolus made burgesses and aldermen in Mansoul, that were +committed to ward by the hand of the now valiant and now right +noble, the brave Lord Willbewill. + +And these were their names: Alderman Atheism, Alderman Hard-Heart, +and Alderman False-Peace. The burgesses were, Mr. No-Truth, Mr. +Pitiless, Mr. Haughty, with the like. These were committed to +close custody, and the gaoler's name was Mr. True-Man. This True- +Man was one of those that Emmanuel brought with him from his +Father's court when at the first he made a war upon Diabolus in the +town or Mansoul. + +After this, the Prince gave a charge that the three strongholds +that, at the command of Diabolus, the Diabolonians built in +Mansoul, should be demolished and utterly pulled down; of which +holds and their names, with their captains and governors, you read +a little before. But this was long in doing, because of the +largeness of the places, and because the stones, the timber, the +iron, and all rubbish, was to be carried without the town. + +When this was done, the Prince gave order that the Lord Mayor and +aldermen of Mansoul should call a court of judicature for the trial +and execution of the Diabolonians in the corporation now under the +charge of Mr. True-Man, the gaoler. + +Now, when the time was come, and the court set, commandment was +sent to Mr. True-Man, the gaoler, to bring the prisoners down to +the bar. Then were the prisoners brought down, pinioned and +chained together, as the custom of the town of Mansoul was. So, +when they were presented before the Lord Mayor, the Recorder, and +the rest of the honourable bench, first, the jury was empannelled, +and then the witnesses sworn. The names of the jury were these: +Mr. Belief, Mr. True-Heart, Mr. Upright, Mr. Hate-Bad, Mr. Love- +God, Mr. See-Truth, Mr. Heavenly-Mind, Mr. Moderate, Mr. Thankful, +Mr. Good-Work, Mr. Zeal-for-God, and Mr. Humble. + +The names of the witnesses were--Mr. Know-All, Mr. Tell-True, Mr. +Hate-Lies, with my Lord Willbewill and his man, if need were. + +So the prisoners were set to the bar. Then said Mr. Do-Right, (for +he was the Town-Clerk,) 'Set Atheism to the bar, gaoler.' So he +was set to the bar. Then said the Clerk, 'Atheism, hold up thy +hand. Thou art here indicted by the name of Atheism, (an intruder +upon the town of Mansoul,) for that thou hast perniciously and +doltishly taught and maintained that there is no God, and so no +heed to be taken to religion. This thou hast done against the +being, honour, and glory of the King, and against the peace and +safety of the town of Mansoul. What sayest thou? Art thou guilty +of this indictment, or not? + +Atheism. Not guilty. + +Crier. Call Mr. Know-All, Mr. Tell-True, and Mr. Hate-Lies into +the court. + +So they were called, and they appeared. + +Then said the Clerk, 'You, the witnesses for the King, look upon +the prisoner at the bar; do you know him?' + +Then said Mr. Know-All, 'Yes, my lord, we know him; his name is +Atheism; he has been a very pestilent fellow for many years in the +miserable town of Mansoul.' + +Clerk. You are sure you know him? + +Know. Know him! Yes my lord; I have heretofore too often been in +his company to be at this time ignorant of him. He is a +Diabolonian, the son of a Diabolonian: I knew his grandfather and +his father. + +Clerk. Well said. He standeth here indicted by the name of +Atheism, etc., and is charged that he hath maintained and taught +that there is no God, and so no heed need be taken to any religion. +What say you, the King's witnesses, to this? Is he guilty or not? + +Know. My lord, I and he were once in Villain's Lane together, and +he at that time did briskly talk of divers opinions; and then and +there I heard him say, that, for his part, he did believe that +there was no God. 'But,' said he, 'I can profess one, and be as +religious too, if the company I am in, and the circumstances of +other things,' said he, 'shall put me upon it.' + +Clerk. You are sure you heard him say thus? + +Know. Upon mine oath, I heard him say thus. + +Then said the Clerk, 'Mr. Tell-True, what say you to the King's +judges touching the prisoner at the bar?' + +Tell. My lord, I formerly was a great companion of his, for the +which I now repent me, and I have often heard him say, and that +with very great stomachfulness, that he believed there was neither +God, angel, nor spirit. + +Clerk. Where did you hear him say so? + +Tell. In Blackmouth Lane and in Blasphemer's Row, and in many +other places besides. + +Clerk. Have you much knowledge of him? + +Tell. I know him to be a Diabolonian, the son of a Diabolonian, +and a horrible man to deny a Deity. His father's name was Never- +be-good, and he had more children than this Atheism. I have no +more to say, + +Clerk. Mr. Hate-Lies, look upon the prisoner at the bar; do you +know him? + +Hate. My lord, this Atheism is one of the vilest wretches that +ever I came near, or had to do with in my life. I have heard him +say that there is no God; I have heard him say that there is no +world to come, no sin, nor punishment hereafter, and, moreover, I +have heard him say that it was as good to go to a whore-house as to +go to hear a sermon. + +Clerk. Where did you hear him say these things? + +Hate. In Drunkard's Row, just at Rascal-Lane's End, at a house in +which Mr. Impiety lived. + +Clerk. Set him by, gaoler, and set Mr. Lustings to the bar. Mr. +Lustings, thou art here indicted by the name of Lustings, (an +intruder upon the town of Mansoul,) for that thou hast devilishly +and traitorously taught, by practice and filthy words, that it is +lawful and profitable to man to give way to his carnal desires; and +that thou, for thy part, hast not, nor never wilt, deny thyself of +any sinful delight as long as thy name is Lustings. How sayest +thou? Art thou guilty of this indictment, or not? + +Then said Mr. Lustings, 'My lord, I am a man of high birth, and +have been used to pleasures and pastimes of greatness. I have not +been wont to be snubbed for my doings, but have been left to follow +my will as if it were law. And it seems strange to me that I +should this day be called into question for that, that not only I, +but almost all men, do either secretly or openly countenance, love, +and approve of.' + +Clerk. Sir, we concern not ourselves with your greatness; (though +the higher, the better you should have been;) but we are concerned, +and so are you now, about an indictment preferred against you. How +say you? Are you guilty of it, or not? + +Lust. Not guilty. + +Clerk. Crier, call upon the witnesses to stand forth and give +their evidence. + +Crier. Gentlemen, you, the witnesses for the King, come in and +give in your evidence for our Lord the King against the prisoner at +the bar. + +Clerk. Come, Mr. Know-All, look upon the prisoner at the bar; do +you know him? + +Know. Yes, my lord, I know him. + +Clerk. What is his name? + +Know. His name is Lustings; he was the son of one Beastly, and his +mother bare him in Flesh Street: she was one Evil-Concupiscence's +daughter. I knew all the generation of them. + +Clerk. Well said. You have heard his indictment; what say you to +it? Is he guilty of the things charged against him, or not? + +Know. My lord, he has, as he saith, been a great man indeed, and +greater in wickedness than by pedigree more than a thousandfold. + +Clerk. But what do you know of his particular actions, and +especially with reference to his indictment? + +Know. I know him to be a swearer, a liar, a Sabbath-breaker; I +know him to be a fornicator and an unclean person; I know him to be +guilty of abundance of evils. He has been, to my knowledge, a very +filthy man. + +Clerk. But where did he use to commit his wickedness? in some +private corners, or more open and shamelessly? + +Know. All the town over, my lord. + +Clerk. Come, Mr. Tell-True, what have you to say for our Lord the +King against the prisoner at the bar? + +Tell. My lord, all that the first witness has said I know to be +true, and a great deal more besides. + +Clerk. Mr. Lustings, do you hear what these gentlemen say? + +Lust. I was ever of opinion that the happiest life that a man +could live on earth was to keep himself back from nothing that he +desired in the world; nor have I been false at any time to this +opinion of mine, but have lived in the love of my notions all my +days. Nor was I ever so churlish, having found such sweetness in +them myself, as to keep the commendations of them from others. + +Then said the Court, 'There hath proceeded enough from his own +mouth to lay him open to condemnation; wherefore, set him by, +gaoler, and set Mr. Incredulity to the bar.' + +Incredulity set to the bar. + +Clerk. Mr. Incredulity, thou art here indicted by the name of +Incredulity, (an intruder upon the town of Mansoul,) for that thou +hast feloniously and wickedly, and that when thou wert an officer +in the town of Mansoul, made head against the captains of the great +King Shaddai when they came and demanded possession of Mansoul; +yea, thou didst bid defiance to the name, forces, and cause of the +King, and didst also, as did Diabolus thy captain, stir up and +encourage the town of Mansoul to make head against and resist the +said force of the King. What sayest thou to this indictment? Art +thou guilty of it, or not? + +Then said Incredulity, 'I know not Shaddai; I love my old prince; I +thought it my duty to be true to my trust, and to do what I could +to possess the minds of the men of Mansoul to do their utmost to +resist strangers and foreigners, and with might to fight against +them. Nor have I, nor shall I, change mine opinion for fear of +trouble, though you at present are possessed of place and power.' + +Then said the Court, 'The man, as you see, is incorrigible; he is +for maintaining his villainies by stoutness of words, and his +rebellion with impudent confidence; and therefore set him by, +gaoler, and set Mr. Forget-Good to the bar. + +Forget-Good set to the bar. + +Clerk. Mr. Forget-Good, thou art here indicted by the name of +Forget-Good, (an intruder upon the town of Mansoul,) for that thou, +when the whole affairs of the town of Mansoul were in thy hand, +didst utterly forget to serve them in what was good, and didst fall +in with the tyrant Diabolus against Shaddai the King, against his +captains, and all his host, to the dishonour of Shaddai, the breach +of his law, and the endangering of the destruction of the famous +town of Mansoul. What sayest thou to this indictment? Art thou +guilty or not guilty? + +Then said Forget-Good: 'Gentlemen, and at this time my judges, as +to the indictment by which I stand of several crimes accused before +you, pray attribute my forgetfulness to mine age, and not to my +wilfulness; to the craziness of my brain, and not to the +carelessness of my mind; and then I hope I may be by your charity +excused from great punishment, though I be guilty.' + +Then said the Court, 'Forget-Good, Forget-Good, thy forgetfulness +of good was not simply of frailty, but of purpose, and for that +thou didst loathe to keep virtuous things in thy mind. What was +bad thou couldst retain, but what was good thou couldst not abide +to think of; thy age, therefore, and thy pretended craziness, thou +makest use of to blind the court withal, and as a cloak to cover +thy knavery. But let us hear what the witnesses have to say for +the King against the prisoner at the bar. Is he guilty of this +indictment, or not?' + +Hate. My lord, I have heard this Forget-Good say, that he could +never abide to think of goodness, no, not for a quarter of an hour. + +Clerk. Where did you hear him say so? + +Hate. In All-base Lane, at a house next door to the sign of the +Conscience seared with a hot iron. + +Clerk. Mr. Know-All, what can you say for our Lord the King +against the prisoner at the bar? + +Know. My lord, I know this man well. He is a Diabolonian, the son +of a Diabolonian: his father's name was Love-Naught; and for him, +I have often heard him say, that he counted the very thoughts of +goodness the most burdensome thing in the world. + +Clerk. Where have you heard him say these words? + +Know. In Flesh Lane, right opposite to the church. + +Then said the Clerk, 'Come, Mr. Tell-True, give in your evidence +concerning the prisoner at the bar, about that for which he stands +here, as you see, indicted by this honourable Court.' + +Tell. My lord, I have heard him often say he had rather think of +the vilest thing than of what is contained in the Holy Scriptures. + +Clerk. Where did you hear him say such grievous words? + +Tell. Where?--in a great many places, particularly in Nauseous +Street, in the house of one Shameless, and in Filth Lane, at the +sign of the Reprobate, next door to the Descent into the Pit. + +Court. Gentlemen, you have heard the indictment, his plea, and the +testimony of the witnesses. Gaoler, set Mr. Hard-Heart to the bar. + +He is set to the bar. + +Clerk. Mr. Hard-Heart, thou art here indicted by the name of Hard- +Heart, (an intruder upon the town of Mansoul,) for that thou didst +most desperately and wickedly possess the town of Mansoul with +impenitency and obdurateness; and didst keep them from remorse and +sorrow for their evils, all the time of their apostacy from and +rebellion against the blessed King Shaddai. What sayest thou to +this indictment? Art thou guilty, or not guilty? + +Hard. My lord, I never knew what remorse or sorrow meant in all my +life. I am impenetrable. I care for no man; nor can I be pierced +with men's griefs; their groans will not enter into my heart. +Whomsoever I mischief, whomsoever I wrong, to me it is music, when +to others mourning. + +Court. You see the man is a right Diabolonian, and has convicted +himself. Set him by, gaoler, and set Mr. False-Peace to the bar. + +False-Peace set to the bar. + +"Mr. False-Peace, thou art here indicted by the name of False- +Peace, (an intruder upon the town of Mansoul,) for that thou didst +most wickedly and satanically bring, hold, and keep the town of +Mansoul, both in her apostacy and in her hellish rebellion, in a +false, groundless, and dangerous peace, and damnable security, to +the dishonour of the King, the transgression of his law, and the +great damage of the town of Mansoul. What sayest thou? Art thou +guilty of this indictment, or not? + +Then said Mr. False-Peace: 'Gentlemen, and you now appointed to be +my judges, I acknowledge that my name is Mr. Peace; but that my +name is False-Peace I utterly deny. If your honours shall please +to send for any that do intimately know me, or for the midwife that +laid my mother of me, or for the gossips that were at my +christening, they will, any or all of them, prove that my name is +not False-Peace, but Peace. Wherefore I cannot plead to this +indictment, forasmuch as my name is not inserted therein; and as is +my true name, so are also my conditions. I was always a man that +loved to live at quiet, and what I loved myself, that I thought +others might love also. Wherefore, when I saw any of my neighbours +to labour under a disquieted mind, I endeavoured to help them what +I could; and instances of this good temper of mine many I could +give; as, + +'1. When, at the beginning, our town of Mansoul did decline the +ways of Shaddai, they, some of them, afterwards began to have +disquieting reflections upon themselves for what they had done; but +I, as one troubled to see them disquieted, presently sought out +means to get them quiet again. + +'2. When the ways of the old world, and of Sodom, were in fashion, +if anything happened to molest those that were for the customs of +the present times, I laboured to make them quiet again, and to +cause them to act without molestation. + +'3. To come nearer home: when the wars fell out between Shaddai +and Diabolus, if at any time I saw any of the town of Mansoul +afraid of destruction, I often used, by some way, device, +invention, or other, to labour to bring them to peace again. +Wherefore, since I have been always a man of so virtuous a temper +as some say a peace-maker is, and if a peace-maker be so deserving +a man as some have been bold to attest he is, then let me, +gentlemen, be accounted by you, who have a great name for justice +and equity in Mansoul, for a man that deserveth not this inhuman +way of treatment, but liberty, and also a license to seek damage of +those that have been my accusers.' + +Then said the clerk, 'Crier, make a proclamation.' + +Crier. Oyes! Forasmuch as the prisoner at the bar hath denied his +name to be that which is mentioned in the indictment, the Court +requireth that if there be any in this place that can give +information to the Court of the original and right name of the +prisoner, they would come forth and give in their evidence; for the +prisoner stands upon his own innocency. + +Then came two into the court, and desired that they might have +leave to speak what they knew concerning the prisoner at the bar: +the name of the one was Search-Truth, and the name of the other +Vouch-Truth. So the Court demanded of these men if they knew the +prisoner, and what they could say concerning him, 'for he stands,' +said they, 'upon his own vindication.' + +Then said Mr. Search-Truth, 'My Lord, I--' + +Court. Hold! give him his oath. + +Then they sware him. So he proceeded. + +Search. My lord, I know and have known this man from a child, and +can attest that his name is False-Peace. I know his father; his +name was Mr. Flatter: and his mother, before she was married, was +called by the name of Mrs. Sooth-Up: and these two, when they came +together, lived not long without this son; and when he was born, +they called his name False-Peace. I was his play-fellow, only I +was somewhat older than he; and when his mother did use to call him +home from his play, she used to say, 'False-Peace, False-Peace, +come home quick, or I'll fetch you.' Yea, I knew him when he +sucked; and though I was then but little, yet I can remember that +when his mother did use to sit at the door with him, or did play +with him in her arms, she would call him, twenty times together, +'My little False-Peace! my pretty False-Peace!' and, 'Oh! my sweet +rogue, False-Peace!' and again, 'Oh! my little bird, False-Peace!' +and 'How do I love my child!' The gossips also know it is thus, +though he has had the face to deny it in open court. + +Then Mr. Vouch-Truth was called upon to speak what he knew of him. +So they sware him. + +Then said Mr. Vouch-Truth, 'My lord, all that the former witness +hath said is true. His name is False-Peace, the son of Mr. +Flatter, and of Mrs. Sooth-Up, his mother: and I have in former +times seen him angry with those that have called him anything else +but False-Peace, for he would say that all such did mock and +nickname him; but this was in the time when Mr. False-Peace was a +great man, and when the Diabolonians were the brave men in Mansoul. + +Court. Gentlemen, you have heard what these two men have sworn +against the prisoner at the bar. And now, Mr. False-Peace, to you: +you have denied your name to be False-Peace, yet you see that these +honest men have sworn that that is your name. As to your plea, in +that you are quite besides the matter of your indictment, you are +not by it charged for evil-doing because you are a man of peace, or +a peace-maker among your neighbours; but for that you did wickedly +and satanically bring, keep, and hold the town of Mansoul, both +under its apostasy from, and in its rebellion against its King, in +a false, lying, and damnable peace, contrary to the law of Shaddai, +and to the hazard of the destruction of the then miserable town of +Mansoul. All that you have pleaded for yourself is, that you have +denied your name, etc.; but here, you see, we have witnesses to +prove that you are the man. For the peace that you so much boast +of making among your neighbours, know that peace that is not a +companion of truth and holiness, but that which is without this +foundation, is grounded upon a lie, and is both deceitful and +damnable, as also the great Shaddai hath said. Thy plea, +therefore, has not delivered thee from what by the indictment thou +art charged with, but rather it doth fasten all upon thee. But +thou shalt have very fair play. Let us call the witnesses that are +to testify as to matter of fact, and see what they have to say for +our Lord the King against the prisoner at the bar. + +Clerk. Mr. Know-All, what say you for our Lord the King against +the prisoner at the bar? + +Know. My lord, this man hath of a long time made it, to my +knowledge, his business to keep the town of Mansoul in a sinful +quietness in the midst of all her lewdness, filthiness, and +turmoils, and hath said, and that in my hearing, Come, come, let us +fly from all trouble, on what ground soever it comes, and let us be +for a quiet and peaceable life, though it wanteth a good +foundation. + +Clerk. Come, Mr. Hate-Lies, what have you to say? + +Hate. My lord, I have heard him say, that peace, though in a way +of unrighteousness, is better than trouble with truth. + +Clerk. Where did you hear him say this? + +Hate. I heard him say it in Folly-yard, at the house of one Mr. +Simple, next door to the sign of the Self-deceiver. Yea, he hath +said this to my knowledge twenty times in that place. + +Clerk. We may spare further witness; this evidence is plain and +full. Set him by, gaoler, and set Mr. No-Truth to the bar. Mr. +No-Truth, thou art here indicted by the name of No-Truth, (an +intruder upon the town of Mansoul,) for that thou hast always, to +the dishonour of Shaddai, and the endangering of the utter ruin of +the famous town of Mansoul, set thyself to deface, and utterly to +spoil, all the remainders of the law and image of Shaddai that have +been found in Mansoul after her deep apostasy from her king to +Diabolus, the envious tyrant. What sayest thou, art thou guilty of +this indictment, or not? + +No. Not guilty, my lord. + +Then the witnesses were called, and Mr. Know-All did first give in +his evidence against him. + +Know. My lord, this man was at the pulling down of the image of +Shaddai; yea, this is he that did it with his own hands. I myself +stood by and saw him do it, and he did it at the commandment of +Diabolus. Yea, this Mr. No-Truth did more than this, he did also +set up the horned image of the beast Diabolus in the same place. +This also is he that, at the bidding of Diabolus, did rend and +tear, and cause to be consumed, all that he could of the remainders +of the law of the King, even whatever he could lay his hands on in +Mansoul. + +Clerk. Who saw him do this besides yourself? + +Hate. I did, my lord, and so did many more besides; for this was +not done by stealth, or in a corner, but in the open view of all; +yea, he chose himself to do it publicly, for he delighted in the +doing of it. + +Clerk. Mr. No-Truth, how could you have the face to plead not +guilty, when you were so manifestly the doer of all this +wickedness? + +No. Sir, I thought I must say something, and as my name is, so I +speak. I have been advantaged thereby before now, and did not know +but by speaking no truth, I might have reaped the same benefit now. + +Clerk. Set him by, gaoler, and set Mr. Pitiless to the bar. Mr. +Pitiless, thou art here indicted by the name of Pitiless, (an +intruder upon the town of Mansoul,) for that thou didst most +traitorously and wickedly shut up all bowels of compassion, and +wouldest not suffer poor Mansoul to condole her own misery when she +had apostatised from her rightful King, but didst evade, and at all +times turn her mind awry from those thoughts that had in them a +tendency to lead her to repentance. What sayest thou to this +indictment? Guilty or not guilty? + +'Not guilty of pitilessness: all I did was to cheer up, according +to my name, for my name is not Pitiless, but Cheer-up; and I could +not abide to see Mansoul inclined to melancholy.' + +Clerk. How! do you deny your name, and say it is not Pitiless, but +Cheer-up? Call for the witnesses. What say you, the witnesses, to +this plea? + +Know. My lord, his name is Pitiless; so he hath written himself in +all papers of concern wherein he has had to do. But these +Diabolonians love to counterfeit their names: Mr. Covetousness +covers himself with the name of Good-Husbandry, or the like; Mr. +Pride can, when need is, call himself Mr. Neat, Mr. Handsome, or +the like; and so of all the rest of them. + +Clerk. Mr. Tell-True, what say you? + +Tell. His name is Pitiless, my lord. I have known him from a +child, and he hath done all that wickedness whereof he stands +charged in the indictment; but there is a company of them that are +not acquainted with the danger of damning, therefore they call all +those melancholy that have serious thoughts how that state should +be shunned by them. + +Clerk. Set Mr. Haughty to the bar, gaoler. Mr. Haughty, thou art +here indicted by the name of Haughty, (an intruder upon the town of +Mansoul,) for that thou didst most traitorously and devilishly +teach the town of Mansoul to carry it loftily and stoutly against +the summons that was given them by the captains of the King +Shaddai. Thou didst also teach the town of Mansoul to speak +contemptuously and vilifyingly of their great King Shaddai; and +didst moreover encourage, both by words and examples, Mansoul, to +take up arms both against the King and his son Emmanuel. How +sayest thou, art thou guilty of this indictment, or not? + +Haughty. Gentlemen, I have always been a man of courage and +valour, and have not used, when under the greatest clouds, to sneak +or hang down the head like a bulrush; nor did it at all at any time +please me to see men veil their bonnets to those that have opposed +them; yea, though their adversaries seemed to have ten times the +advantage of them. I did not use to consider who was my foe, nor +what the cause was in which I was engaged. It was enough to me if +I carried it bravely, fought like a man, and came off a victor. + +Court. Mr. Haughty, you are not here indicted for that you have +been a valiant man, nor for your courage and stoutness in times of +distress, but for that you have made use of this your pretended +valour to draw the town of Mansoul into acts of rebellion both +against the great King, and Emmanuel his Son. This is the crime +and the thing wherewith thou art charged in and by the indictment. + +But he made no answer to that. + +Now when the Court had thus far proceeded against the prisoners at +the bar, then they put them over to the verdict of their jury, to +whom they did apply themselves after this manner: + +'Gentlemen of the jury, you have been here, and have seen these +men; you have heard their indictments, their pleas, and what the +witnesses have testified against them: now what remains, is, that +you do forthwith withdraw yourselves to some place, where without +confusion you may consider of what verdict, in a way of truth and +righteousness, you ought to bring in for the King against them, and +so bring it in accordingly.' + +Then the jury, to wit, Mr. Belief, Mr. True-Heart, Mr. Upright, Mr. +Hate-bad, Mr. Love-God, Mr. See-Truth, Mr. Heavenly-Mind, Mr. +Moderate, Mr. Thankful, Mr. Humble, Mr. Good-Work, and Mr. Zeal- +for-God, withdrew themselves in order to their work. Now when they +were shut up by themselves, they fell to discourse among themselves +in order to the drawing up of their verdict. + +And thus Mr. Belief (for he was the foreman) began: 'Gentlemen,' +quoth he, 'for the men, the prisoners at the bar, for my part I +believe that they all deserve death.' 'Very right,' said Mr. True- +Heart; 'I am wholly of your opinion.' 'Oh what a mercy is it,' +said Mr. Hate-Bad, 'that such villains as these are apprehended!' +'Ay! ay!' said Mr. Love-God, 'this is one of the joyfullest days +that ever I saw in my life.' Then said Mr. See-Truth, 'I know that +if we judge them to death, our verdict shall stand before Shaddai +himself' 'Nor do I at all question it,' said Mr. Heavenly-Mind; he +said, moreover, 'When all such beasts as these are cast out of +Mansoul, what a goodly town will it be then!' 'Then,' said Mr. +Moderate, 'it is not my manner to pass my judgment with rashness; +but for these their crimes are so notorious, and the witness so +palpable, that that man must be wilfully blind who saith the +prisoners ought not to die.' 'Blessed be God,' said Mr. Thankful, +'that the traitors are in safe custody.' 'And I join with you in +this upon my bare knees,' said Mr. Humble. 'I am glad also,' said +Mr. Good-Work. Then said the warm man, and true-hearted Mr. Zeal- +for-God, 'Cut them off; they have been the plague, and have sought +the destruction of Mansoul.' + +Thus, therefore, being all agreed in their verdict, they come +instantly into the Court. + +Clerk. Gentlemen of the jury, answer all to your names: Mr. +Belief, one; Mr. True-Heart, two; Mr. Upright, three; Mr. Hate-Bad, +four; Mr. Love-God, five; Mr. See-Truth, six; Mr. Heavenly-mind, +seven; Mr. Moderate, eight; Mr. Thankful, nine; Mr. Humble, ten; +Mr. Good-Work, eleven; and Mr. Zeal-for-God, twelve. Good men and +true, stand together in your verdict: are you all agreed? + +Jury. Yes, my lord. + +Clerk. Who shall speak for you? + +Jury. Our foreman. + +Clerk. You, the gentlemen of the jury, being empannelled for our +Lord the King, to serve here in a matter of life and death, have +heard the trials of each of these men, the prisoners at the bar: +what say you? are they guilty of that, and those crimes for which +they stand here indicted, or are they not guilty? + +Foreman. Guilty, my lord. + +Clerk. Look to your prisoners, gaoler. + +This was done in the morning, and in the afternoon they received +the sentence of death according to the law. + +The gaoler, therefore, having received such a charge, put them all +in the inward prison, to preserve them there till the day of +execution, which was to be the next day in the morning. + +But now to see how it happened, one of the prisoners, Incredulity +by name, in the interim betwixt the sentence and the time of +execution, brake prison and made his escape, and gets him away +quite out of the town of Mansoul, and lay lurking in such places +and holes as he might, until he should again have opportunity to do +the town of Mansoul a mischief for their thus handling of him as +they did. + +Now when Mr. Trueman, the gaoler, perceived that he had lost his +prisoner, he was in a heavy taking, because that prisoner was, to +speak on, the very worst of all the gang: wherefore first he goes +and acquaints my Lord Mayor, Mr. Recorder, and my Lord Willbewill, +with the matter, and to get of them an order to make search for him +throughout the town of Mansoul. So an order he got, and search was +made, but no such man could now be found in all the town of +Mansoul. + +All that could be gathered was, that he had lurked a while about +the outside of the town, and that here and there one or other had a +glimpse of him as he did make his escape out of Mansoul; one or two +also did affirm that they saw him without the town, going apace +quite over the plain. Now when he was quite gone, it was affirmed +by one Mr. Did-see, that he ranged all over dry places, till he met +with Diabolus, his friend, and where should they meet one another +but just upon Hell-gate hill. + +But oh! what a lamentable story did the old gentleman tell to +Diabolus concerning what sad alteration Emmanuel had made in +Mansoul! + +As, first, how Mansoul had, after some delays, received a general +pardon at the hands of Emmanuel, and that they had invited him into +the town, and that they had given him the castle for his +possession. He said, moreover, that they had called his soldiers +into the town, coveted who should quarter the most of them; they +also entertained him with the timbrel, song, and dance. 'But +that,' said Incredulity, 'which is the sorest vexation to me is, +that he hath pulled down, O father, thy image, and set up his own; +pulled down thy officers and set up his own. Yea, and Willbewill, +that rebel, who, one would have thought, should never have turned +from us, he is now in as great favour with Emmanuel as ever he was +with thee. But, besides all this, this Willbewill has received a +special commission from his master to search for, to apprehend, and +to put to death all, and all manner of Diabolonians that he shall +find in Mansoul: yea, and this Willbewill has taken and committed +to prison already eight of my Lord's most trusty friends in +Mansoul. Nay, further, my Lord, with grief I speak it, they have +been all arraigned, condemned, and, I doubt, before this executed +in Mansoul. I told my Lord of eight, and myself was the ninth, who +should assuredly have drunk of the same cup, but that through +craft, I, as thou seest, have made mine escape from them.' + +When Diabolus had heard this lamentable story, he yelled and +snuffed up the wind like a dragon, and made the sky to look dark +with his roaring; he also sware that he would try to be revenged on +Mansoul for this. So they, both he and his old friend Incredulity, +concluded to enter into great consultation, how they might get the +town of Mansoul again. + +Now, before this time, the day was come in which the prisoners in +Mansoul were to be executed. So they were brought to the cross, +and that by Mansoul, in most solemn manner; for the Prince said +that this should be done by the hand of the town of Mansoul, 'that +I may see,' said he, 'the forwardness of my now redeemed Mansoul to +keep my word, and to do my commandments; and that I may bless +Mansoul in doing this deed. Proof of sincerity pleases me well; +let Mansoul therefore first lay their hands upon these Diabolonians +to destroy them.' + +So the town of Mansoul slew them, according to the word of their +Prince; but when the prisoners were brought to the cross to die, +you can hardly believe what troublesome work Mansoul had of it to +put the Diabolonians to death; for the men, knowing that they must +die, and every of them having implacable enmity in their hearts to +Mansoul, what did they but took courage at the cross, and there +resisted the men of the town of Mansoul? Wherefore the men of +Mansoul were forced to cry out for help to the captains and men of +war. Now the great Shaddai had a secretary in the town, and he was +a great lover of the men of Mansoul, and he was at the place of +execution also; so he, hearing the men of Mansoul cry out against +the strugglings and unruliness of the prisoners, rose up from his +place, and came and put his hands upon the hands of the men of +Mansoul. So they crucified the Diabolonians that had been a +plague, a grief, and an offence to the town of Mansoul. + +Now, when this good work was done, the Prince came down to see, to +visit, and to speak comfortably to the men of Mansoul, and to +strengthen their hands in such work. And he said to them that, by +this act of theirs he had proved them, and found them to be lovers +of his person, observers of his laws, and such as had also respect +to his honour. He said, moreover, (to show them that they by this +should not be losers, nor their town weakened by the loss of them,) +that he would make them another captain, and that of one of +themselves. And that this captain should be the ruler of a +thousand, for the good and benefit of the now flourishing town of +Mansoul. + +So he called one to him whose name was Waiting, and bid him, 'Go +quickly up to the castle gate, and inquire there for one Mr. +Experience, that waiteth upon that noble captain, the Captain +Credence, and bid him come hither to me.' So the messenger that +waited upon the good Prince Emmanuel went and said as he was +commanded. Now the young gentleman was waiting to see the captain +train and muster his men in the castle yard. Then said Mr. Waiting +to him, 'Sir, the Prince would that you should come down to his +highness forthwith.' So he brought him down to Emmanuel, and he +came and made obeisance before him. Now the men of the town knew +Mr. Experience well, for he was born and bred in Mansoul; they also +knew him to be a man of conduct, of valour, and a person prudent in +matters; he was also a comely person, well-spoken, and very +successful in his undertakings. + +Wherefore the hearts of the townsmen were transported with joy when +they saw that the Prince himself was so taken with Mr. Experience, +that he would needs make him a captain over a band of men. + +So with one consent they bowed the knee before Emmanuel, and with a +shout said, 'Let Emmanuel live for ever!' Then said the Prince to +the young gentleman, whose name was Mr. Experience, 'I have thought +good to confer upon thee a place of trust and honour in this my +town of Mansoul.' Then the young man bowed his head and +worshipped. 'It is,' said Emmanuel, 'that thou shouldest be a +captain, a captain over a thousand men in my beloved town of +Mansoul.' Then said the captain, 'Let the King live!' So the +Prince gave out orders forthwith to the King's secretary, that he +should draw up for Mr. Experience a commission to make him a +captain over a thousand men. 'And let it be brought to me,' said +he, 'that I may set to my seal.' So it was done as it was +commanded. The commission was drawn up, brought to Emmanuel, and +he set his seal thereto. Then, by the hand of Mr. Waiting, he sent +it away to the captain. + +Now as soon as the captain had received his commission, he sounded +his trumpet for volunteers, and young men came to him apace; yea, +the greatest and chief men in the town sent their sons, to be +listed under his command. Thus Captain Experience came under +command to Emmanuel, for the good of the town of Mansoul. He had +for his lieutenant one Mr. Skilful, and for his cornet one Mr. +Memory. His under officers I need not name. His colours were the +white colours for the town of Mansoul; and his scutcheon was the +dead lion and dead bear. So the Prince returned to his royal +palace again. + +Now when he was returned thither, the elders of the town of +Mansoul, to wit, the Lord Mayor, the Recorder, and the Lord +Willbewill, went to congratulate him, and in special way to thank +him for his love, care, and the tender compassion which he showed +to his ever-obliged town of Mansoul. So after a while, and some +sweet communion between them, the townsmen having solemnly ended +their ceremony, returned to their place again. + +Emmanuel also at this time appointed them a day wherein he would +renew their charter, yea, wherein he would renew and enlarge it, +mending several faults therein, that Mansoul's yoke might be yet +more easy. And this he did without any desire of theirs, even of +his own frankness and noble mind. So when he had sent for and seen +their old one, he laid it by, and said, 'Now that which decayeth +and waxeth old is ready to vanish away.' He said, moreover, 'The +town of Mansoul shall have another, a better, a new one, more +steady and firm by far.' An epitome hereof take as follows:- + +'Emmanuel, Prince of Peace, and a great lover of the town of +Mansoul, I do in the name of my Father, and of mine own clemency, +give, grant, and bequeath to my beloved town of Mansoul. + +'First. Free, full, and everlasting forgiveness of all wrongs, +injuries, and offences done by them against my Father, me, their +neighbour, or themselves. + +'Second. I do give them the holy law and my testament, with all +that therein is contained, for their everlasting comfort and +consolation. + +'Third. I do also give them a portion of the self-same grace and +goodness that dwells in my Father's heart and mine. + +'Fourth. I do give, grant, and bestow upon them freely, the world +and what is therein, for their good; and they shall have that power +over them, as shall stand with the honour of my Father, my glory, +and their comfort: yea, I grant them the benefits of life and +death, and of things present, and things to come. This privilege +no other city, town, or corporation, shall have, but my Mansoul +only. + +'Fifth. I do give and grant them leave, and free access to me in +my palace at all seasons--to my palace above or below--there to +make known their wants to me, and I give them, moreover, a promise +that I will hear and redress all their grievances. + +'Sixth. I do give, grant to, and invest the town of Mansoul with +full power and authority to seek out, take, enslave, and destroy +all, and all manner of Diabolonians that at any time, from +whencesoever, shall be found straggling in or about the town of +Mansoul. + +'Seventh. I do further grant to my beloved town of Mansoul, that +they shall have authority not to suffer any foreigner, or stranger, +or their seed, to be free in, and of the blessed town of Mansoul, +nor to share in the excellent privileges thereof. But that all the +grants, privileges, and immunities that I bestow upon the famous +town of Mansoul, shall be for those the old natives, and true +inhabitants thereof; to them, I say, and to their right seed after +them. + +'But all Diabolonians, of what sort, birth, country, or kingdom +soever, shall be debarred a share therein.' + +So when the town of Mansoul had received at the hand of Emmanuel +their gracious charter, (which in itself is infinitely more large +than by this lean epitome is set before you,) they carried it to +audience, that is, to the market place, and there Mr. Recorder read +it in the presence of all the people. This being done, it was had +back to the castle gates, and there fairly engraven upon the doors +thereof, and laid in letters of gold, to the end that the town of +Mansoul, with all the people thereof, might have it always in their +view, or might go where they might see what a blessed freedom their +Prince had bestowed upon them, that their joy might be increased in +themselves, and their love renewed to their great and good +Emmanuel. + +But what joy, what comfort, what consolation, think you, did now +possess the hearts of the men of Mansoul! The bells rung, the +minstrels played, the people danced, the captains shouted, the +colours waved in the wind, and the silver trumpets sounded; and the +Diabolonians now were glad to hide their heads, for they looked +like them that had been long dead. + +When this was over, the Prince sent again for the elders of the +town of Mansoul, and communed with them about a ministry that he +intended to establish among them; such a ministry that might open +unto them, and that might instruct them in the things that did +concern their present and future state. + +'For,' said he, 'you, of yourselves, unless you have teachers and +guides, will not be able to know, and, if not to know, to be sure +not to do the will of my Father.' + +At this news, when the elders of Mansoul brought it to the people, +the whole town came running together, (for it pleased them well, as +whatever the Prince now did pleased the people,) and all with one +consent implored his Majesty that he would forthwith establish such +a ministry among them as might teach them both law and judgment, +statute and commandment; that they might be documented in all good +and wholesome things. So he told them that he would grant them +their requests, and would establish two among them; one that was of +his Father's court, and one that was a native of Mansoul. + +'He that is from the court,' said he, 'is a person of no less +quality and dignity than my Father and I; and he is the Lord Chief +Secretary of my Father's house: for he is, and always has been, +the chief dictator of all my Father's laws, a person altogether +well skilled in all mysteries, and knowledge of mysteries, as is my +Father, or as myself is. Indeed he is one with us in nature, and +also as to loving of, and being faithful to, and in the eternal +concerns of the town of Mansoul. + +'And this is he,' said the Prince, 'that must be your chief +teacher; for it is he, and he only, that can teach you clearly in +all high and supernatural things. He, and he only, it is that +knows the ways and methods of my Father at court, nor can any like +him show how the heart of my Father is at all times, in all things, +upon all occasions, towards Mansoul; for as no man knows the things +of a man but that spirit of a man which is in him, so the things of +my Father knows no man but this his high and mighty Secretary. Nor +can any, as he, tell Mansoul how and what they shall do to keep +themselves in the love of my Father. He also it is that can bring +lost things to your remembrance, and that can tell you things to +come. This teacher, therefore, must of necessity have the pre- +eminence, both in your affections and judgment, before your other +teacher; his personal dignity, the excellency of his teaching, also +the great dexterity that he hath to help you to make and draw up +petitions to my Father for your help, and to his pleasing, must lay +obligations upon you to love him, fear him, and to take heed that +you grieve him not. + +'This person can put life and vigour into all he says; yea, and can +also put it into your heart. This person can make seers of you, +and can make you tell what shall be hereafter. By this person you +must frame all your petitions to my Father and me; and without his +advice and counsel first obtained, let nothing enter into the town +or castle of Mansoul, for that may disgust and grieve this noble +person. + +'Take heed, I say, that you do not grieve this minister; for if you +do, he may fight against you; and should he once be moved by you to +set himself against you in battle array, that will distress you +more than if twelve legions should from my Father's court be sent +to make war upon you. + +'But, as I said, if you shall hearken unto him, and shall love him; +if you shall devote yourselves to his teaching, and shall seek to +have converse, and to maintain communion with him, you shall find +him ten times better than is the whole world to any; yea, he will +shed abroad the love of my Father in your hearts, and Mansoul will +be the wisest, and most blessed of all people.' + +Then did the Prince call unto him the old gentleman, who before had +been the Recorder of Mansoul, Mr. Conscience by name, and told him, +That, forasmuch as he was well skilled in the law and government of +the town of Mansoul, and was also well-spoken, and could +pertinently deliver to them his Master's will in all terrene and +domestic matters, therefore he would also make him a minister for, +in, and to the goodly town of Mansoul, in all the laws, statutes, +and judgments of the famous town of Mansoul. 'And thou must,' said +the Prince, 'confine thyself to the teaching of moral virtues, to +civil and natural duties; but thou must not attempt to presume to +be a revealer of those high and supernatural mysteries that are +kept close in the bosom of Shaddai, my Father: for those things +knows no man, nor can any reveal them but my Father's Secretary +only. + +'Thou art a native of the town of Mansoul, but the Lord Secretary +is a native with my Father; wherefore, as thou hast knowledge of +the laws and customs of the corporation, so he of the things and +will of my Father. + +'Wherefore, O Mr. Conscience, although I have made thee a minister +and a preacher to the town of Mansoul, yet as to the things which +the Lord Secretary knoweth, and shall teach to this people, there +thou must be his scholar and a learner, even as the rest of Mansoul +are. + +'Thou must therefore, in all high and supernatural things, go to +him for information and knowledge; for though there be a spirit in +man, this person's inspiration must give him understanding. +Wherefore, O thou Mr. Recorder, keep low and be humble, and +remember that the Diabolonians that kept not their first charge, +but left their own standing, are now made prisoners in the pit. Be +therefore content with thy station. + +'I have made thee my Father's vicegerent on earth, in such things +of which I have made mention before: and thou, take thou power to +teach them to Mansoul, yea, and to impose them with whips and +chastisements, if they shall not willingly hearken to do thy +commandments. + +'And, Mr. Recorder, because thou art old, and through many abuses +made feeble; therefore I give thee leave and license to go when +thou wilt to my fountain, my conduit, and there to drink freely of +the blood of my grape, for my conduit doth always run wine. Thus +doing, thou shalt drive from thine heart and stomach all foul, +gross, and hurtful humours. It will also lighten thine eyes, and +will strengthen thy memory for the reception and keeping of all +that the King's most noble Secretary teacheth.' + +When the Prince had thus put Mr. Recorder (that once so was) into +the place and office of a minister to Mansoul, and the man had +thankfully accepted thereof, then did Emmanuel address himself in a +particular speech to the townsmen themselves. + +'Behold,' said the Prince to Mansoul, 'my love and care towards +you; I have added to all that is past, this mercy, to appoint you +preachers; the most noble Secretary to teach you in all high and +sublime mysteries; and this gentleman,' pointing to Mr. Conscience, +'is to teach you in all things human and domestic, for therein +lieth his work. He is not, by what I have said, debarred of +telling to Mansoul anything that he hath heard and received at the +mouth of the lord high Secretary; only he shall not attempt to +presume to pretend to be a revealer of those high mysteries +himself; for the breaking of them up, and the discovery of them to +Mansoul lieth only in the power, authority, and skill of the lord +high Secretary himself. Talk of them he may, and so may the rest +of the town of Mansoul; yea, and may, as occasion gives them +opportunity, press them upon each other for the benefit of the +whole. These things, therefore, I would have you observe and do, +for it is for your life, and the lengthening of your days. + +'And one thing more to my beloved Mr. Recorder, and to all the town +of Mansoul: You must not dwell in, nor stay upon, anything of that +which he hath in commission to teach you, as to your trust and +expectation of the next world; (of the next world, I say, for I +purpose to give another to Mansoul, when this with them is worn +out;) but for that you must wholly and solely have recourse to, and +make stay upon his doctrine that is your Teacher after the first +order. Yea, Mr. Recorder himself must not look for life from that +which he himself revealeth; his dependence for that must be founded +in the doctrine of the other preacher. Let Mr. Recorder also take +heed that he receive not any doctrine, or point of doctrine, that +is not communicated to him by his Superior Teacher, nor yet within +the precincts of his own formal knowledge.' + +Now, after the Prince had thus settled things in the famous town of +Mansoul, he proceeded to give to the elders of the corporation a +necessary caution, to wit, how they should carry it to the high and +noble captains that he had, from his Father's court, sent or +brought with him, to the famous town of Mansoul. + +'These captains,' said he, 'do love the town of Mansoul, and they +are picked men, picked out of abundance, as men that best suit, and +that will most faithfully serve in the wars of Shaddai against the +Diabolonians, for the preservation of the town of Mansoul. 'I +charge you therefore,' said he, 'O ye inhabitants of the now +flourishing town of Mansoul, that you carry it not ruggedly or +untowardly to my captains, or their men; since, as I said, they are +picked and choice men--men chosen out of many for the good of the +town of Mansoul. I say, I charge you, that you carry it not +untowardly to them: for though they have the hearts and faces of +lions, when at any time they shall be called forth to engage and +fight with the King's foes, and the enemies of the town of Mansoul; +yet a little discountenance cast upon them from the town of Mansoul +will deject and cast down their faces, will weaken and take away +their courage. Do not, therefore, O my beloved, carry it unkindly +to my valiant captains and courageous men of war, but love them, +nourish them, succour them, and lay them in your bosoms; and they +will not only fight for you, but cause to fly from you all those +the Diabolonians that seek, and will, if possible, be, your utter +destruction. + +'If, therefore, any of them should at any time be sick or weak, and +so not able to perform that office of love, which, with all their +hearts, they are willing to do (and will do also when well and in +health), slight them not, nor despise them, but rather strengthen +them and encourage them, though weak and ready to die, for they are +your fence, and your guard, your wall, your gates, your locks, and +your bars. And although, when they are weak, they can do but +little, but rather need to be helped by you, than that you should +then expect great things from them, yet, when well, you know what +exploits, what feats and warlike achievements they are able to do, +and will perform for you. + +'Besides, if they be weak, the town of Mansoul cannot be strong; if +they be strong, then Mansoul cannot be weak; your safety, +therefore, doth lie in their health, and in your countenancing +them. Remember, also, that if they be sick, they catch that +disease of the town of Mansoul itself. + +'These things I have said unto you because I love your welfare and +your honour: observe, therefore, O my Mansoul, to be punctual in +all things that I have given in charge unto you, and that not only +as a town corporate, and so to your officers and guard, and guides +in chief, but to you as you are a people whose well-being, as +single persons, depends on the observation of the orders and +commandments of their Lord. + +'Next, O my Mansoul, I do warn you of that, of which, +notwithstanding that reformation that at present is wrought among +you, you have need to be warned about: wherefore hearken +diligently unto me. I am now sure, and you will know hereafter, +that there are yet of the Diabolonians remaining in the town of +Mansoul, Diabolonians that are sturdy and implacable, and that do +already while I am with you, and that will yet more when I am from +you, study, plot, contrive, invent, and jointly attempt to bring +you to desolation, and so to a state far worse than that of the +Egyptian bondage; they are the avowed friends of Diabolus, +therefore look about you. They used heretofore to lodge with their +Prince in the Castle, when Incredulity was the Lord Mayor of this +town; but since my coming hither, they lie more in the outsides and +walls, and have made themselves dens, and caves, and holes, and +strongholds therein. Wherefore, O Mansoul! thy work, as to this, +will be so much the more difficult and hard; that is, to take, +mortify, and put them to death according to the will of my Father. +Nor can you utterly rid yourselves of them, unless you should pull +down the walls of your town, the which I am by no means willing you +should. Do you ask me, What shall we do then? Why, be you +diligent, and quit you like men; observe their holes; find out +their haunts; assault them, and make no peace with them. Wherever +they haunt, lurk, or abide, and what terms of peace soever they +offer you, abhor, and all shall be well betwixt you and me. And +that you may the better know them from those that are the natives +of Mansoul, I will give you this brief schedule of the names of the +chief of them; and they are these that follow:- The Lord +Fornication, the Lord Adultery, the Lord Murder, the Lord Anger, +the Lord Lasciviousness, the Lord Deceit, the Lord Evil-Eye, Mr. +Drunkenness, Mr. Revelling, Mr. Idolatry, Mr. Witch-craft, Mr. +Variance, Mr. Emulation, Mr. Wrath, Mr. Strife, Mr. Sedition, and +Mr. Heresy. These are some of the chief, O Mansoul! of those that +will seek to overthrow thee for ever. These, I say, are the +skulkers in Mansoul; but look thou well into the law of thy King, +and there thou shalt find their physiognomy, and such other +characteristical notes of them, by which they certainly may be +known. + +'These, O my Mansoul, (and I would gladly that you should certainly +know it,) if they be suffered to run and range about the town as +they would, will quickly, like vipers, eat out your bowels; yea, +poison your captains, cut the sinews of your soldiers, break the +bars and bolts of your gates, and turn your now most flourishing +Mansoul into a barren and desolate wilderness, and ruinous heap. +Wherefore, that you may take courage to yourselves to apprehend +these villains wherever you find them, I give to you, my Lord +Mayor, my Lord Willbewill, and Mr. Recorder, with all the +inhabitants of the town of Mansoul, full power and commission to +seek out, to take, and to cause to be put to death by the cross, +all, and all manner of Diabolonians, when and wherever you shall +find them to lurk within, or to range without the walls of the town +of Mansoul. + +'I told you before that I had placed a standing ministry among you; +not that you have but these with you, for my first four captains +who came against the master and lord of the Diabolonians that was +in Mansoul, they can, and if need be, and if they be required, will +not only privately inform, but publicly preach to the corporation +both good and wholesome doctrine, and such as shall lead you in the +way. Yea, they will set up a weekly, yea, if need be, a daily +lecture in thee, O Mansoul! and will instruct thee in such +profitable lessons, that, if heeded, will do thee good at the end. +And take good heed that you spare not the men that you have a +commission to take and crucify. + +'Now, as I have set before your eyes the vagrants and runagates by +name, so I will tell you, that among yourselves, some of them shall +creep in to beguile you, even such as would seem, and that in +appearance are, very rife and hot for religion. And they, if you +watch not, will do you a mischief, such an one as at present you +cannot think of. + +'These, as I said, will show themselves to you in another hue than +those under description before. Wherefore, Mansoul, watch and be +sober, and suffer not thyself to be betrayed.' + +When the Prince had thus far new modelled the town of Mansoul, and +had instructed them in such matters as were profitable for them to +know, then he appointed another day in which he intended, when the +townsfolk came together, to bestow a further badge of honour upon +the town of Mansoul,--a badge that should distinguish them from all +the people, kindreds, and tongues that dwell in the kingdom of +Universe. Now it was not long before the day appointed was come, +and the Prince and his people met in the King's palace, where first +Emmanuel made a short speech unto them, and then did for them as he +had said, and unto them as he had promised. + +'My Mansoul,' said he, 'that which I now am about to do, is to make +you known to the world to be mine, and to distinguish you also in +your own eyes, from all false traitors that may creep in among +you.' + +Then he commanded that those that waited upon him should go and +bring forth out of his treasury those white and glistening robes +'that I,' said he, 'have provided and laid up in store for my +Mansoul.' So the white garments were fetched out of his treasury, +and laid forth to the eyes of the people. Moreover, it was granted +to them that they should take them and put them on, 'according,' +said he, 'to your size and stature.' So the people were put into +white, into fine linen, white and clean. + +Then said the Prince unto them, 'This, O Mansoul, is my livery, and +the badge by which mine are known from the servants of others. +Yea, it is that which I grant to all that are mine, and without +which no man is permitted to see my face. Wear them, therefore, +for my sake, who gave them unto you; and also if you would be known +by the world to be mine.' + +But now! can you think how Mansoul shone? It was fair as the sun, +clear as the moon, and terrible as an army with banners. + +The Prince added further, and said, 'No prince, potentate, or +mighty one of Universe, giveth this livery but myself: behold, +therefore, as I said before, you shall be known by it to be mine. + +'And now,' said he, 'I have given you my livery, let me give you +also in commandment concerning them; and be sure that you take good +heed to my words. + +'First. Wear them daily, day by day, lest you should at sometimes +appear to others as if you were none of mine. + +'Second. Keep them always white; for if they be soiled, it is +dishonour to me. + +'Third. Wherefore gird them up from the ground, and let them not +lag with dust and dirt. + +'Fourth. Take heed that you lose them not, lest you walk naked, +and they see your shame. + +'Fifth. But if you should sully them, if you should defile them, +the which I am greatly unwilling you should, and the prince +Diabolus will be glad if you would, then speed you to do that which +is written in my law, that yet you may stand, and befall before me, +and before my throne. Also, this is the way to cause that I may +not leave you, nor forsake you while here, but may dwell in this +town of Mansoul for ever.' + +And now was Mansoul, and the inhabitants of it, as the signet upon +Emmanuel's right hand. Where was there now a town, a city, a +corporation, that could compare with Mansoul! a town redeemed from +the hand, and from the power of Diabolus! a town that the King +Shaddai loved, and that he sent Emmanuel to regain from the Prince +of the infernal cave; yea, a town that Emmanuel loved to dwell in, +and that he chose for his royal habitation; a town that he +fortified for himself, and made strong by the force of his army. +What shall I say, Mansoul has now a most excellent Prince, golden +captains and men of war, weapons proved, and garments as white as +snow. Nor are these benefits to be counted little, but great; can +the town of Mansoul esteem them so, and improve them to that end +and purpose for which they are bestowed upon them? + +When the Prince had thus completed the modelling of the town, to +show that he had great delight in the work of his hands and took +pleasure in the good that he had wrought for the famous and +flourishing Mansoul, he commanded, and they set his standard upon +the battlements of the castle. And then, + +First. He gave them frequent visits; not a day now but the elders +of Mansoul must come to him, or he to them, into his palace. Now +they must walk and talk together of all the great things that he +had done, and yet further promised to do, for the town of Mansoul. +Thus would he often do with the Lord Mayor, my Lord Willbewill, and +the honest subordinate preacher Mr. Conscience, and Mr. Recorder. +But oh, how graciously, how lovingly, how courteously, and tenderly +did this blessed Prince now carry it towards the town of Mansoul! +In all the streets, gardens, orchards, and other places where he +came, to be sure the poor should have his blessing and benediction; +yea, he would kiss them, and if they were ill he would lay hands on +them, and make them well. The captains, also, he would daily, yea, +sometimes hourly, encourage with his presence and goodly words. +For you must know that a smile from him upon them would put more +vigour, more life, and stoutness into them, than would anything +else under heaven. + +The Prince would now also feast them, and be with them continually: +hardly a week would pass but a banquet must be had betwixt him and +them. You may remember that, some pages before, we make mention of +one feast that they had together; but now to feast them was a thing +more common: every day with Mansoul was a feast-day now. Nor did +he, when they returned to their places, send them empty away, +either they must have a ring, a gold chain, a bracelet, a white +stone, or something; so dear was Mansoul to him now; so lovely was +Mansoul in his eyes. + +Second. When the elders and townsmen did not come to him, he would +send in much plenty of provision unto them; meat that came from +court, wine and bread that were prepared for his Father's table; +yea, such delicates would he send unto them, and therewith would so +cover their table, that whoever saw it confessed that the like +could not be seen in any kingdom. + +Third. If Mansoul did not frequently visit him as he desired they +should, he would walk out to them, knock at their doors, and desire +entrance, that amity might be maintained betwixt them and him; if +they did hear and open to him, as commonly they would, if they were +at home, then would he renew his former love, and confirm it too +with some new tokens, and signs of continued favour. + +And was it not now amazing to behold, that in that very place where +sometimes Diabolus had his abode, and entertained his Diabolonians +to the almost utter destruction of Mansoul, the Prince of princes +should sit eating and drinking with them, while all his mighty +captains, men of war, trumpeters, with the singing-men and singing- +women of his Father, stood round about to wait upon them! Now did +Mansoul's cup run over, now did her conduits run sweet wine, now +did she eat the finest of the wheat, and drink milk and honey out +of the rock! Now, she said, How great is his goodness! for since I +found favour in his eyes, how honourable have I been! + +The blessed Prince did also ordain a new officer in the town, and a +goodly person he was; his name was Mr. God's-Peace: this man was +set over my Lord Willbewill, my Lord Mayor, Mr. Recorder, the +subordinate preacher, Mr. Mind, and over all the natives of the +town of Mansoul. Himself was not a native of it, but came with the +Prince Emmanuel from the court. He was a great acquaintance of +Captain Credence and Captain Good-Hope; some say they were kin, and +I am of that opinion too. This man, as I said, was made governor +of the town in general, especially over the castle, and Captain +Credence was to help him there. And I made great observation of +it, that so long as all things went in Mansoul as this sweet- +natured gentleman would, the town was in most happy condition. Now +there were no jars, no chiding, no interferings, no unfaithful +doings in all the town of Mansoul; every man in Mansoul kept close +to his own employment. The gentry, the officers, the soldiers, and +all in place observed their order. And as for the women and +children of the town, they followed their business joyfully; they +would work and sing, work and sing, from morning till night: so +that quite through the town of Mansoul now nothing was to be found +but harmony, quietness, joy, and health. And this lasted all that +summer. + +But there was a man in the town of Mansoul, and his name was Mr. +Carnal-Security; this man did, after all this mercy bestowed on +this corporation, bring the town of Mansoul into great and grievous +slavery and bondage. A brief account of him and of his doings take +as followeth:- + +When Diabolus at first took possession of the town of Mansoul, he +brought thither, with himself, a great number of Diabolonians, men +of his own conditions. Now among these there was one whose name +was Mr. Self-Conceit, and a notable brisk man he was, as any that +in those days did possess the town of Mansoul. Diabolus, then, +perceiving this man to be active and bold, sent him upon many +desperate designs, the which he managed better, and more to the +pleasing of his lord, than most that came with him from the dens +could do. Wherefore, finding him so fit for his purpose, he +preferred him, and made him next to the great Lord Willbewill, of +whom we have written so much before. Now the Lord Willbewill being +in those days very well pleased with him, and with his +achievements, gave him his daughter, the Lady Fear-Nothing, to +wife. Now, of my Lady Fear-nothing, did this Mr. Self-Conceit +beget this gentleman, Mr. Carnal-Security. Wherefore, there being +then in Mansoul those strange kinds of mixtures, it was hard for +them, in some cases, to find out who were natives, who not, for Mr. +Carnal-Security sprang from my Lord Willbewill by mother's side, +though he had for his father a Diabolonian by nature. + +Well, this Carnal-Security took much after his father and mother; +he was self-conceited, he feared nothing, he was also a very busy +man: nothing of news, nothing of doctrine, nothing of alteration, +or talk of alteration, could at any time be on foot in Mansoul, but +be sure Mr. Carnal-Security would be at the head or tail of it: +but, to be sure, he would decline those that he deemed the weakest, +and stood always with them in his way of standing, that he supposed +was the strongest side. + +Now, when Shaddai the mighty, and Emmanuel his Son, made war upon +Mansoul, to take it, this Mr. Carnal-Security was then in town, and +was a great doer among the people, encouraging them in their +rebellion, putting them upon hardening themselves in their +resisting the King's forces: but when he saw that the town of +Mansoul was taken, and converted to the use of the glorious Prince +Emmanuel; and when he also saw what was become of Diabolus, and how +he was unroosted, and made to quit the castle in the greatest +contempt and scorn; and that the town of Mansoul was well lined +with captains, engines of war, and men, and also provision; what +doth he but slyly wheel about also; and as he had served Diabolus +against the good Prince, so he feigned that he would serve the +Prince against his foes. + +And having got some little smattering of Emmanuel's things by the +end, being bold, he ventures himself into the company of the +townsmen, any attempts also to chat among them. Now he knew that +the power and strength of the town of Mansoul was great, and that +it could not but be pleasing to the people, if he cried up their +might and their glory. Wherefore he beginneth his tale with the +power and strength of Mansoul, and affirmed that it was +impregnable; now magnifying their captains and their slings, and +their rams; then crying up their fortifications and strongholds; +and, lastly, the assurances that they had from their Prince, that +Mansoul should be happy for ever. But when he saw that some of the +men of the town were tickled and taken with his discourse, he makes +it his business, and walking from street to street, house to house, +and man to man, he at last brought Mansoul to dance after his pipe, +and to grow almost as carnally secure as himself; so from talking +they went to feasting, and from feasting to sporting; and so to +some other matters. Now Emmanuel was yet in the town of Mansoul, +and he wisely observed their doings. My Lord Mayor, my Lord +Willbewill, and Mr. Recorder were also all taken with the words of +this tattling Diabolonian gentleman, forgetting that their Prince +had given them warning before to take heed that they were not +beguiled with any Diabolonian sleight; he had further told them +that the security of the now flourishing town of Mansoul did not so +much lie in her present fortifications and force, as in her so +using of what she had, as might oblige her Emmanuel to abide within +her castle. For the right doctrine of Emmanuel was, that the town +of Mansoul should take heed that they forgot not his Father's love +and his; also, that they should so demean themselves as to continue +to keep themselves therein. Now this was not the way to do it, +namely, to fall in love with one of the Diabolonians, and with such +an one too as Mr. Carnal-Security was, and to be led up and down by +the nose by him; they should have heard their Prince, feared their +Prince, loved their Prince, and have stoned this naughty pack to +death, and took care to have walked in the ways of their Prince's +prescribing: for then should their peace have been as a river, +when their righteousness had been like the waves of the sea. + +Now when Emmanuel perceived that through the policy of Mr. Carnal- +Security the hearts of the men of Mansoul were chilled and abated +in their practical love to him, + +First. He bemoans them, and, condoles their state with the +Secretary, saying, 'Oh that my people had hearkened unto me, and +that Mansoul had walked in my ways! I would have fed them with the +finest of the wheat; and with honey out of the rock would I have +sustained them.' This done, he said in his heart, 'I will return +to the court, and go to my place, till Mansoul shall consider and +acknowledge their offence.' And he did so, and the cause and +manner of his going away from them was, that Mansoul declined him, +as is manifest in these particulars. + +'1. They left off their former way of visiting him, they came not +to his royal palace as afore. + +'2. They did not regard, nor yet take notice, that he came or came +not to visit them. + +'3. The love-feasts that had wont to be between their Prince and +them, though he made them still, and called them to them, yet they +neglected to come to them, or to be delighted with them. + +'4. They waited not for his counsels, but began to be headstrong +and confident in themselves, concluding that now they were strong +and invincible, and that Mansoul was secure, and beyond all reach +of the foe, and that her state must needs be unalterable for ever.' + +Now, as was said, Emmanuel perceiving that by the craft of Mr. +Carnal-Security, the town of Mansoul was taken off from their +dependence upon him, and upon his Father by him, and set upon what +by them was bestowed upon it; he first, as I said, bemoaned their +state, then he used means to make them understand that the way that +they went on in was dangerous: for he sent my Lord High Secretary +to them, to forbid them such ways; but twice when he came to them, +he found them at dinner in Mr. Carnal-Security's parlour; and +perceiving also that they were not willing to reason about matters +concerning their good, he took grief and went his way; the which +when he had told to the Prince Emmanuel, he took offence, and was +grieved also, and so made provision to return to his Father's +court. + +Now, the methods of his withdrawing, as I was saying before, were +thus:- + +'1. Even while he was yet with them in Mansoul, he kept himself +close, and more retired than formerly. + +'2. His speech was not now, if he came in their company, so +pleasant and familiar as formerly. + +'3. Nor did he, as in times past, send to Mansoul, from his table, +those dainty bits which he was wont to do. + +'4. Nor when they came to visit him, as now and then they would, +would he be so easily spoken with as they found him to be in times +past. They might now knock once, yea, twice, but he would seem not +at all to regard them; whereas formerly at the sound of their feet +he would up and run, and meet them halfway, and take them too, and +lay them in his bosom.' + +But thus Emmanuel carried it now, and by this his carriage he +sought to make them bethink themselves, and return to him. But, +alas! they did not consider, they did not know his ways, they +regarded not, they were not touched with these, nor with the true +remembrance of former favours. Wherefore what does he but in +private manner withdraw himself, first from his palace, then to the +gate of the town, and so away from Mansoul he goes, till they +should acknowledge their offence, and more earnestly seek his face. +Mr. God's-Peace also laid down his commission, and would for the +present act no longer in the town of Mansoul. + +Thus they walked contrary to him, and he again, by way of +retaliation, walked contrary to them. But, alas! by this time they +were so hardened in their way, and had so drunk in the doctrine of +Mr. Carnal-Security, that the departing of their Prince touched +them not, nor was he remembered by them when gone; and so, of +consequence, his absence not condoled by them. + +Now, there was a day wherein this old gentleman, Mr. Carnal- +Security, did again make a feast for the town of Mansoul; and there +was at that time in the town one Mr. Godly-Fear, one now but little +set by, though formerly one of great request. This man, old +Carnal-Security, had a mind, if possible, to gull, and debauch, and +abuse, as he did the rest, and therefore he now bids him to the +feast with his neighbours. So the day being come, they prepare, +and he goes and appears with the rest of the guests; and being all +set at the table, they did eat and drink, and were merry, even all +but this one man: for Mr. Godly-Fear sat like a stranger, and did +neither eat nor was merry. The which, when Mr. Carnal-Security +perceived, he presently addressed himself in a speech thus to him:- + +'Mr. Godly-Fear, are you not well? You seem to be ill of body or +mind, or both. I have a cordial of Mr. Forget-Good's making, the +which, sir, if you will take a dram of, I hope it may make you +bonny and blithe, and so make you more fit for us, feasting +companions.' + +Unto whom the good old gentleman discreetly replied, 'Sir, I thank +you for all things courteous and civil; but for your cordial I have +no list thereto. But a word to the natives of Mansoul: You, the +elders and chief of Mansoul, to me it is strange to see you so +jocund and merry, when the town of Mansoul is in such woeful case.' + +Then said Mr. Carnal-Security, 'You want sleep, good air, I doubt. +If you please, lie down, and take a nap, and we meanwhile will be +merry.' + +Then said the good man as follows: 'Sir, if you were not destitute +of an honest heart, you could not do as you have done and do.' + +Then said Mr. Carnal-Security, 'Why?' + +Godly. Nay, pray interrupt me not. It is true the town of Mansoul +was strong, and, with a proviso, impregnable; but you, the +townsmen, have weakened it, and it now lies obnoxious to its foes. +Nor is it a time to flatter, or be silent; it is you, Mr. Carnal- +Security, that have wilily stripped Mansoul, and driven her glory +from her; you have pulled down her towers, you have broken down her +gates, you have spoiled her locks and bars. + +And now, to explain myself: from that time that my lords of +Mansoul, and you, sir, grew so great, from that time the Strength +of Mansoul has been offended, and now he is arisen and is gone. If +any shall question the truth of my words, I will answer him by +this, and suchlike questions. 'Where is the Prince Emmanuel? When +did a man or woman in Mansoul see him? When did you hear from him, +or taste any of his dainty bits?' You are now a feasting with this +Diabolonian monster, but he is not your Prince. I say, therefore, +though enemies from without, had you taken heed, could not have +made a prey of you, yet since you have sinned against your Prince, +your enemies within have been too hard for you. + +Then said Mr. Carnal-Security, 'Fie! fie! Mr. Godly-Fear, fie!-- +will you never shake off your timorousness? Are you afraid of +being sparrow-blasted? Who hath hurt you? Behold, I am on your +side; only you are for doubting, and I am for being confident. +Besides, is this a time to be sad in? A feast is made for mirth; +why, then, do you now, to your shame, and our trouble, break out +into such passionate melancholy language, when you should eat and +drink, and be merry?' + +Then said Mr. Godly-Fear again, 'I may well be sad, for Emmanuel is +gone from Mansoul. I say again, he is gone, and you, sir, are the +man that has driven him away; yea, he is gone without so much as +acquainting the nobles of Mansoul with his going; and if that is +not a sign of his anger, I am not acquainted with the methods of +godliness. + +'And now, my lords and gentlemen, for my speech is still to you, +your gradual declining from him did provoke him gradually to depart +from you, the which he did for some time, if perhaps you would have +been made sensible thereby, and have been renewed by humbling +yourselves; but when he saw that none would regard, nor lay these +fearful beginnings of his anger and judgment to heart, he went away +from this place; and this I saw with mine eye. Wherefore now, +while you boast, your strength is gone; you are like the man that +had lost his locks that before did wave about his shoulders. You +may, with this lord of your feast, shake yourselves, and conclude +to do as at other times; but since without him you can do nothing, +and he is departed from you, turn your feast into a sigh, and your +mirth into lamentation.' + +Then the subordinate preacher, old Mr. Conscience by name, he that +of old was Recorder of Mansoul, being startled at what was said, +began to second it thus:- + +'Indeed, my brethren,' quoth he, 'I fear that Mr. Godly-Fear tells +us true: I, for my part, have not seen my Prince a long season. I +cannot remember the day, for my part; nor can I answer Mr. Godly- +Fear's question. I doubt, I am afraid that all is nought with +Mansoul.' + +Godly. Nay, I know that you shall not find him in Mansoul, for he +is departed and gone; yea, and gone for the faults of the elders, +and for that they rewarded his grace with unsufferable unkindness. + +Then did the subordinate preacher look as if he would fall down +dead at the table; also all there present, except the man of the +house, began to look pale and wan. But having a little recovered +themselves, and jointly agreeing to believe Mr. Godly-Fear and his +sayings, they began to consult what was best to be done, (now Mr. +Carnal-Security was gone into his withdrawing-room, for he liked +not such dumpish doings,) both to the man of the house for drawing +them into evil, and also to recover Emmanuel's love. + +And, with that, that saying of their Prince came very hot into +their minds, which he had bidden them do to such as were false +prophets that should arise to delude the town of Mansoul. So they +took Mr. Carnal-Security (concluding that he must be he) and burned +his house upon him with fire; for he also was a Diabolonian by +nature. + +So when this was passed and over, they bespeed themselves to look +for Emmanuel their Prince; and they sought him, but they found him +not. Then were they more confirmed in the truth of Mr. Godly- +Fear's sayings, and began also severely to reflect upon themselves +for their so vile and ungodly doings; for they concluded now that +it was through them that their Prince had left them. + +Then they agreed and went to my Lord Secretary, (him whom before +they refused to hear--him whom they had grieved with their doings,) +to know of him, for he was a seer, and could tell where Emmanuel +was, and how they might direct a petition to him. But the Lord +Secretary would not admit them to a conference about this matter, +nor would admit them to his royal place of abode, nor come out to +them to show them his face or intelligence. + +And now was it a day gloomy and dark, a day of clouds and of thick +darkness with Mansoul. Now they saw that they had been foolish, +and began to perceive what the company and prattle of Mr. Carnal- +Security had done, and what desperate damage his swaggering words +had brought poor Mansoul into. But what further it was likely to +cost them they were ignorant of. Now Mr. Godly-Fear began again to +be in repute with the men of the town; yea, they were ready to look +upon him as a prophet. + +Well, when the Sabbath day was come, they went to hear their +subordinate preacher; but oh, how he did thunder and lighten this +day! His text was that in the prophet Jonah: 'They that observe +lying vanities forsake their own mercy.' But there was then such +power and authority in that sermon, and such a dejection seen in +the countenances of the people that day, that the like hath seldom +been heard or seen. The people, when sermon was done, were scarce +able to go to their homes, or to betake themselves to their employs +the week after; they were so sermon-smitten, and also so sermon- +sick by being smitten, that they knew not what to do. + +He did not only show to Mansoul their sin, but did tremble before +them, under the sense of his own, still crying out of himself, as +he preached to them, 'Unhappy man that I am! that I should do so +wicked a thing! That I, a preacher! whom the Prince did set up to +teach to Mansoul his law, should myself live senseless and +sottishly here, and be one of the first found in transgression! +This transgression also fell within my precincts; I should have +cried out against the wickedness; but I let Mansoul lie wallowing +in it, until it had driven Emmanuel from its borders!' With these +things he also charged all the lords and gentry of Mansoul, to the +almost distracting of them. + +About this time, also, there was a great sickness in the town of +Mansoul, and most of the inhabitants were greatly afflicted. Yea, +the captains also, and men of war, were brought thereby to a +languishing condition, and that for a long time together; so that +in case of an invasion, nothing could to purpose now have been +done, either by the townsmen or field officers. Oh, how many pale +faces, weak hands, feeble knees, and staggering men were now seen +to walk the streets of Mansoul! Here were groans, there pants, and +yonder lay those that were ready to faint. + +The garments, too, which Emmanuel had given them were but in a +sorry case; some were rent, some were torn, and all in a nasty +condition; some also did hang so loosely upon them, that the next +bush they came at was ready to pluck them off. + +After some time spent in this sad and desolate condition, the +subordinate preacher called for a day of fasting, and to humble +themselves for being so wicked against the great Shaddai and his +Son. And he desired that Captain Boanerges would preach. So he +consented to do it; and the day being come, and his text was this, +'Cut it down, why cumbereth it the ground?' And a very smart +sermon he made upon the place. First, he showed what was the +occasion of the words, namely, because the fig-tree was barren; +then he showed what was contained in the sentence, namely, +repentance, or utter desolation. He then showed, also, by whose +authority this sentence was pronounced, and that was by Shaddai +himself. And, lastly, he showed the reasons of the point, and then +concluded his sermon. But he was very pertinent in the +application, insomuch that he made poor Mansoul tremble. For this +sermon, as well as the former, wrought much upon the hearts of the +men of Mansoul; yea, it greatly helped to keep awake those that +were roused by the preaching that went before. So that now +throughout the whole town, there was little or nothing to be heard +or seen but sorrow, and mourning, and woe. + +Now, after sermon, they got together and consulted what was best to +be done. 'But,' said the subordinate preacher, 'I will do nothing +of mine own head, without advising with my neighbour Mr. Godly- +Fear. For if he had aforehand understood more of the mind of our +Prince than we, I do not know but he also may have it now, even now +we are turning again to virtue.' + +So they called and sent for Mr. Godly-Fear, and he forthwith +appeared. Then they desired that he would further show his opinion +about what they had best to do. Then said the old gentleman as +followeth: 'It is my opinion that this town of Mansoul should, in +this day of her distress, draw up and send an humble petition to +their offended Prince Emmanuel, that he, in his favour and grace, +will turn again unto you, and not keep anger for ever.' + +When the townsmen had heard this speech, they did, with one +consent, agree to his advice; so they did presently draw up their +request, and the next was, But who shall carry it? At last they +did all agree to send it by my Lord Mayor. So he accepted of the +service, and addressed himself to his journey; and went and came to +the court of Shaddai, whither Emmanuel the Prince of Mansoul was +gone. But the gate was shut, and a strict watch kept thereat; so +that the petitioner was forced to stand without for a great while +together. Then he desired that some would go into the Prince and +tell him who stood at the gate, and what his business was. So one +went and told to Shaddai, and to Emmanuel his Son, that the Lord +Mayor of the town of Mansoul stood without at the gate of the +King's court, desiring to be admitted into the presence of the +Prince, the King's Son. He also told what was the Lord Mayor's +errand, both to the King and his Son Emmanuel. But the Prince +would not come down, nor admit that the gate should be opened to +him, but sent him an answer to this effect: 'They have turned +their back unto me, and not their face; but now in the time of +their trouble they say to me, Arise, and save us. But can they not +now go to Mr. Carnal-Security, to whom they went when they turned +from me, and make him their leader, their lord, and their +protection now in their trouble; why now in their trouble do they +visit me, since in their prosperity they went astray?' + +The answer made my Lord Mayor look black in the face; it troubled, +it perplexed, it rent him sore. And now he began again to see what +it was to be familiar with Diabolonians, such as Mr. Carnal- +Security was. When he saw that at court, as yet, there was little +help to be expected, either for himself or friends in Mansoul, he +smote upon his breast, and returned weeping, and all the way +bewailing the lamentable state of Mansoul. + +Well, when he was come within sight of the town, the elders and +chief of the people of Mansoul went out at the gate to meet him, +and to salute him, and to know how he sped at court. But he told +them his tale in so doleful a manner, that they all cried out, and +mourned, and wept. Wherefore they threw ashes and dust upon their +heads, and put sackcloth upon their loins, and went crying out +through the town of Mansoul; the which, when the rest of the +townsfolk saw, they all mourned and wept. This, therefore, was a +day of rebuke and trouble, and of anguish to the town of Mansoul, +and also of great distress. + +After some time, when they had somewhat refrained themselves, they +came together to consult again what by them was yet to be done; and +they asked advice, as they did before, of that reverend Mr. Godly- +Fear, who told them that there was no way better than to do as they +had done, nor would he that they should be discouraged at all with +that they had met with at court; yea, though several of their +petitions should be answered with nought but silence or rebuke: +'For,' said he, 'it is the way of the wise Shaddai to make men wait +and to exercise patience, and it should be the way of them in want, +to be willing to stay his leisure. + +Then they took courage, and sent again and again, and again, and +again; for there was not now one day, nor an hour that went over +Mansoul's head, wherein a man might not have met upon the road one +or other riding post, sounding the horn from Mansoul to the court +of the King Shaddai; and all with letters petitionary in behalf of, +and for the Prince's return to Mansoul. The road, I say, was now +full of messengers, going and returning, and meeting one another; +some from the court, and some from Mansoul; and this was the work +of the miserable town of Mansoul, all that long, that sharp, that +cold and tedious winter. + +Now if you have not forgot, you may yet remember that I told you +before, that after Emmanuel had taken Mansoul, yea, and after that +he had new modelled the town, there remained in several lurking +places of the corporation many of the old Diabolonians, that either +came with the tyrant when he invaded and took the town, or that had +there, by reason of unlawful mixtures, their birth and breeding, +and bringing up. And their holes, dens, and lurking places were +in, under, or about the wall of the town. Some of their names are +the Lord Fornication, the Lord Adultery, the Lord Murder, the Lord +Anger, the Lord Lasciviousness, the Lord Deceit, the Lord Evil-eye, +the Lord Blasphemy, and that horrible villain, the old and +dangerous Lord Covetousness. These, as I told you, with many more, +had yet their abode in the town of Mansoul, and that after that +Emmanuel had driven their prince Diabolus out of the castle. + +Against these the good Prince did grant a commission to the Lord +Willbewill and others, yea, to the whole town of Mansoul, to seek, +take, secure, and destroy any or all that they could lay hands of, +for that they were Diabolonians by nature, enemies to the Prince, +and those that sought to ruin the blessed town of Mansoul. But the +town of Mansoul did not pursue this warrant, but neglected to look +after, to apprehend, to secure, and to destroy these Diabolonians. +Wherefore what do these villains but by degrees take courage to put +forth their heads, and to show themselves to the inhabitants of the +town. Yea, and as I was told, some of the men of Mansoul grew too +familiar with some of them, to the sorrow of the corporation, as +you yet will hear more of in time and place. + +Well, when the Diabolonian lords that were left perceived that +Mansoul had, through sinning, offended Emmanuel their Prince, and +that he had withdrawn himself and was gone, what do they but plot +the ruin of the town of Mansoul. So upon a time they met together +at the hold of one Mr. Mischief, who was also a Diabolonian, and +there consulted how they might deliver up Mansoul into the hands of +Diabolus again. Now some advised one way, and some another, every +man according to his own liking. At last my Lord Lasciviousness +propounded, whether it might not be best, in the first place, for +some of those that were Diabolonians in Mansoul, to adventure to +offer themselves for servants to some of the natives of the town; +'for,' said he, 'if they so do, and Mansoul shall accept of them, +they may for us, and for Diabolus our Lord, make the taking of the +town of Mansoul more easy than otherwise it will be.' But then +stood up the Lord Murder, and said, 'This may not be done at this +time; for Mansoul is now in a kind of a rage, because by our +friend, Mr. Carnal-Security, she hath been once ensnared already, +and made to offend against her Prince; and how shall she reconcile +herself unto her lord again, but by the heads of these men? +Besides, we know that they have in commission to take and slay us +wherever they shall find us; let us, therefore, be wise as foxes: +when we are dead, we can do them no hurt; but while we live, we +may.' Thus, when they had tossed the matter to and fro, they +jointly agreed that a letter should forthwith be sent away to +Diabolus in their name, by which the state of the town of Mansoul +should be showed him, and how much it is under the frowns of their +Prince. 'We may also,' said some, 'let him know our intentions, +and ask of him his advice in the case.' + +So a letter was presently framed, the contents of which were +these:- + +'To our great lord, the Prince Diabolus, dwelling below in the +infernal cave: + +'O great father, and mighty Prince Diabolus, we, the true +Diabolonians yet remaining in the rebellious town of Mansoul, +having received our beings from thee, and our nourishment at thy +hands, cannot with content and quiet endure to behold, as we do +this day, how thou art dispraised, disgraced, and reproached among +the inhabitants of this town; nor is thy long absence at all +delightful to us, because greatly to our detriment. + +'The reason of this our writing unto our lord, is for that we are +not altogether without hope that this town may become thy +habitation again; for it is greatly declined from its Prince +Emmanuel; and he is uprisen, and is departed from them: yea, and +though they send, and send, and send, and send after him to return +to them, yet can they not prevail, nor get good words from him. + +'There has been also of late, and is yet remaining, a very great +sickness and fainting among them; and that not only upon the poorer +sort of the town, but upon the lords, captains, and chief gentry of +the place, (we only who are of the Diabolonians by nature remain +well, lively, and strong,) so that through their great +transgression on the one hand, and their dangerous sickness on the +other, we judge they lie open to thy hand and power. If, +therefore, it shall stand with thy horrible cunning, and with the +cunning of the rest of the princes with thee, to come and make an +attempt to take Mansoul again, send us word, and we shall to our +utmost power be ready to deliver it into thy hand. Or if what we +have said shall not by thy fatherhood be thought best and most meet +to be done, send us thy mind in a few words, and we are all ready +to follow thy counsel to the hazarding of our lives, and what else +we have. + +'Given under our hands the day and date above-written, after a +close consultation at the house of Mr. Mischief, who yet is alive +and hath his place in our desirable town of Mansoul.' + +When Mr. Profane (for he was the carrier) was come with his letter +to Hell-Gate Hill, he knocked at the brazen gates for entrance. +Then did Cerberus, the porter, for he is the keeper of that gate, +open to Mr. Profane, to whom he delivered his letter, which he had +brought from the Diabolonians in Mansoul. So he carried it in, and +presented it to Diabolus his lord, and said, 'Tidings, my lord, +from Mansoul, from our trusty friends in Mansoul.' + +Then came together from all places of the den Beelzebub, Lucifer, +Apollyon, with the rest of the rabblement there, to hear what news +from Mansoul. So the letter was broken up and read, and Cerberus +he stood by. When the letter was openly read, and the contents +thereof spread into all the corners of the den, command was given +that, without let or stop, dead-man's bell should be rung for joy. +So the bell was rung, and the princes rejoiced that Mansoul was +likely to come to ruin. Now, the clapper of the bell went, 'The +town of Mansoul is coming to dwell with us: make room for the town +of Mansoul.' This bell therefore they did ring, because they did +hope that they should have Mansoul again. + +Now, when they had performed this their horrible ceremony, they got +together again to consult what answer to send to their friends in +Mansoul; and some advised one thing, and some another: but at +length, because the business required haste, they left the whole +business to the prince Diabolus, judging him the most proper lord +of the place. So he drew up a letter as he thought fit, in answer +to what Mr. Profane had brought, and sent it to the Diabolonians +that did dwell in Mansoul, by the same hand that had brought theirs +to him; and these were the contents thereof:- + +'To our offspring, the high and mighty Diabolonians that yet dwell +in the town of Mansoul, Diabolus, the great prince of Mansoul, +wisheth a prosperous issue and conclusion of those many brave +enterprises, conspiracies, and designs, that you, of your love and +respect to our honour, have in your hearts to attempt to do against +Mansoul. Beloved children and disciples, my Lord Fornication, +Adultery, and the rest, we have here, in our desolate den, +received, to our highest joy and content, your welcome letter, by +the hand of our trusty Mr. Profane; and to show how acceptable your +tidings were, we rang out our bell for gladness; for we rejoiced as +much as we could, when we perceived that yet we had friends in +Mansoul, and such as sought our honour and revenge in the ruin of +the town of Mansoul. We also rejoiced to hear that they are in a +degenerated condition, and that they have offended their Prince, +and that he is gone. Their sickness also pleaseth us, as does also +your health, might, and strength. Glad also would we be, right +horribly beloved, could we get this town into our clutches again. +Nor will we be sparing of spending our wit, our cunning, our craft, +and hellish inventions to bring to a wished conclusion this your +brave beginning in order thereto. + +'And take this for your comfort, (our birth, and our offspring,) +that shall we again surprise it and take it, we will attempt to put +all your foes to the sword, and will make you the great lords and +captains of the place. Nor need you fear, if ever we get it again, +that we after that shall be cast out any more; for we will come +with more strength, and so lay far more fast hold than at the first +we did. Besides, it is the law of that Prince that now they own, +that if we get them a second time, they shall be ours for ever. + +'Do you, therefore, our trusty Diabolonians, yet more pry into, and +endeavour to spy out the weakness of the town of Mansoul. We also +would that you yourselves do attempt to weaken them more and more. +Send us word also by what means you think we had best to attempt +the regaining thereof: namely, whether by persuasion to a vain and +loose life; or, whether by tempting them to doubt and despair; or, +whether by blowing up of the town by the gunpowder of pride, and +self-conceit. Do you also, O ye brave Diabolonians, and true sons +of the pit, be always in a readiness to make a most hideous assault +within, when we shall be ready to storm it without. Now speed you +in your project, and we in our desires, to the utmost power of our +gates, which is the wish of your great Diabolus, Mansoul's enemy, +and him that trembles when he thinks of judgment to come. All the +blessings of the pit be upon you, and so we close up our letter. + +'Given at the pit's mouth, by the joint consent of all the princes +of darkness, to be sent, to the force and power that we have yet +remaining in Mansoul, by the hand of Mr. Profane, by me, Diabolus.' + +This letter, as was said, was sent to Mansoul, to the Diabolonians +that yet remained there, and that yet inhabited the wall, from the +dark dungeon of Diabolus, by the hand of Mr. Profane, by whom they +also in Mansoul sent theirs to the pit. Now, when this Mr. Profane +had made his return, and was come to Mansoul again, he went and +came as he was wont to the house of Mr. Mischief, for there was the +conclave, and the place where the contrivers were met. Now, when +they saw that their messenger was returned safe and sound, they +were greatly gladded thereat. Then he presented them with his +letter which he had brought from Diabolus for them; the which, when +they had read and considered, did much augment their gladness. +They asked him after the welfare of their friends, as how their +Lord Diabolus, Lucifer, and Beelzebub did, with the rest of those +of the den. To which this Profane made answer, 'Well, well, my +lords; they are well, even as well as can be in their place. They +also,' said he, 'did ring for joy at the reading of your letter, as +you well perceived by this when you read it.' + +Now, as was said, when they had read their letter, and perceived +that it encouraged them in their work, they fell to their way of +contriving again, namely, how they might complete their Diabolonian +design upon Mansoul. And the first thing that they agreed upon was +to keep all things from Mansoul as close as they could. 'Let it +not be known, let not Mansoul be acquainted with what we design +against it.' The next thing was, how, or by what means, they +should try to bring to pass the ruin and overthrow of Mansoul; and +one said after this manner, and another said after that. Then +stood up Mr. Deceit, and said, 'My right Diabolonian friends, our +lords, and the high ones of the deep dungeon, do propound unto us +these three ways. + +'1. Whether we had best to seek its ruin by making Mansoul loose +and vain. + +'2. Or whether by driving them to doubt and despair. + +'3. Or whether by endeavouring to blow them up by the gunpowder of +pride and self-conceit. + +'Now, I think, if we shall tempt them to pride, that may do +something; and if we tempt them to wantonness, that may help. But, +in my mind, if we could drive them into desperation, that would +knock the nail on the head; for then we should have them, in the +first place, question the truth of the love of the heart of their +Prince towards them, and that will disgust him much. This, if it +works well, will make them leave off quickly their way of sending +petitions to him; then farewell earnest solicitations for help and +supply; for then this conclusion lies naturally before them, "As +good do nothing, as do to no purpose."' So to Mr. Deceit they +unanimously did consent. + +Then the next question was, But how shall we do to bring this our +project to pass? and it was answered by the same gentleman--that +this might be the best way to do it: 'Even let,' quoth he, 'so +many of our friends as are willing to venture themselves for the +promoting of their prince's cause, disguise themselves with +apparel, change their names, and go into the market like far +country-men, and proffer to let themselves for servants to the +famous town of Mansoul, and let them pretend to do for their +masters as beneficially as may be; for by so doing they may, if +Mansoul shall hire them, in little time so corrupt and defile the +corporation, that her now Prince shall be not only further offended +with them, but in conclusion shall spue them out of his mouth. And +when this is done, our prince Diabolus shall prey upon them with +ease: yea, of themselves they shall fall into the mouth of the +cater.' + +This project was no sooner propounded, but was as highly accepted, +and forward were all Diabolonians now to engage in so delicate an +enterprise: but it was not thought fit that all should do thus; +wherefore they pitched upon two or three, namely, the Lord +Covetousness, the Lord Lasciviousness, and the Lord Anger. The +Lord Covetousness called himself by the name of Prudent-Thrifty; +the Lord Lasciviousness called himself by the name of Harmless- +Mirth; and the Lord Anger called himself by the name of Good-Zeal. + +So upon a market-day they came into the market-place, three lusty +fellows they were to look on, and they were clothed in sheep's +russet, which was also now in a manner as white as were the white +robes of the men of Mansoul. Now the men could speak the language +of Mansoul well. So when they were come into the market-place, and +had offered to let themselves to the townsmen, they were presently +taken up; for they asked but little wages, and promised to do their +masters great service. + +Mr. Mind hired Prudent-Thrifty, and Mr. Godly-Fear hired Good-Zeal. +True, this fellow Harmless-Mirth did hang a little in hand, and +could not so soon get him a master as the others did, because the +town of Mansoul was now in Lent, but after a while, because Lent +was almost out, the Lord Willbewill hired Harmless-Mirth to be both +his waiting man and his lackey: and thus they got them masters. + + These villains now being got thus far into the houses of the men +of Mansoul, quickly began to do great mischief therein; for, being +filthy, arch, and sly, they quickly corrupted the families where +they were; yea, they tainted their masters much, especially this +Prudent-Thrifty, and him they call Harmless-Mirth. True, he that +went under the visor of Good-Zeal, was not so well liked of his +master; for he quickly found that he was but a counterfeit rascal; +the which when the fellow perceived, with speed he made his escape +from the house, or I doubt not but his master had hanged him. + +Well, when these vagabonds had thus far carried on their design, +and had corrupted the town as much as they could, in the next place +they considered with themselves at what time their prince Diabolus +without, and themselves within the town, should make an attempt to +seize upon Mansoul; and they all agreed upon this, that a market- +day would be best for that work; for why? Then will the townsfolk +be busy in their ways: and always take this for a rule, when +people are most busy in the world, they least fear a surprise. 'We +also then,' said they, 'shall be able with less suspicion to gather +ourselves together for the work of our friends and lords; yea, and +in such a day, if we shall attempt our work, and miss it, we may, +when they shall give us the rout, the better hide ourselves in the +crowd, and escape.' + +These things being thus far agreed upon by them, they wrote another +letter to Diabolus, and sent it by the hand to Mr. Profane, the +contents of which were these:- + +'The lords of Looseness send to the great and high Diabolus from +our dens, caves, holes, and strongholds, in and about the wall of +the town of Mansoul, greeting: + +'Our great lord, and the nourisher of our lives, Diabolus--how glad +we were when we heard of your fatherhood's readiness to comply with +us, and help forward our design in our attempts to ruin Mansoul, +none can tell but those who, as we do, set themselves against all +appearance of good, when and wheresoever we find it. + +'Touching the encouragement that your greatness is pleased to give +us to continue to devise, contrive, and study the utter desolation +of Mansoul, that we are not solicitous about: for we know right +well that it cannot but be pleasing and profitable to us to see our +enemies, and them that seek our lives, die at our feet, or fly +before us. We therefore are still contriving, and that to the best +of our cunning, to make this work most facile and easy to your +lordships, and to us. + +'First, we considered of that most hellishly cunning, compacted, +threefold project, that by you was propounded to us in your last; +and have concluded, that though to blow them up with the gunpowder +of pride would do well, and to do it by tempting them to be loose +and vain will help on, yet to contrive to bring them into the gulf +of desperation, we think will do best of all. Now we, who are at +your beck, have thought or two ways to do this: first we, for our +parts, will make them as vile as we can, and then you with us, at a +time appointed, shall be ready to fall upon them with the utmost +force. And of all the nations that are at your whistle, we think +that an army of doubters may be the most likely to attack and +overcome the town of Mansoul. Thus shall we overcome these +enemies, else the pit shall open her mouth upon them, and +desperation shall thrust them down into it. We have also, to +effect this so much by us desired design, sent already three of our +trusty Diabolonians among them; they are disguised in garb, they +have changed their names, and are now accepted of them; namely, +Covetousness, Lasciviousness, and Anger. The name of Covetousness +is changed to Prudent-Thrifty, and him Mr. Mind has hired, and is +almost become as bad as our friend. Lasciviousness has changed his +name to Harmless-Mirth, and he is got to be the Lord Willbewill's +lackey; but he has made his master very wanton. Anger changed his +name into Good-Zeal, and was entertained by Mr. Godly-Fear; but the +peevish old gentleman took pepper in the nose, and turned our +companion out of his house. Nay, he has informed us since that he +ran away from him, or else his old master had hanged him up for his +labour. + +'Now these have much helped forward our work and design upon +Mansoul; for notwithstanding the spite and quarrelsome temper of +the old gentleman last mentioned, the other two ply their business +well, and are likely to ripen the work apace. + +'Our next project is, that it be concluded that you come upon the +town upon a market-day, and that when they are upon the heat of +their business; for then, to be sure, they will be most secure, and +least think that an assault will be made upon them. They will also +at such a time be less able to defend themselves, and to offend you +in the prosecution of our design. And we your trusty (and we are +sure your beloved) ones shall, when you shall make your furious +assault without, be ready to second the business within. So shall +we, in all likelihood, be able to put Mansoul to utter confusion, +and to swallow them up before they can come to themselves. If your +serpentine heads, most subtile dragons, and our highly esteemed +lords can find out a better way than this, let us quickly know your +minds. + +'To the monsters of the infernal cave, from the house of Mr. +Mischief in Mansoul, by the hand of Mr. Profane.' + +Now all the while that the raging runagates and hellish +Diabolonians were thus contriving the ruin of the town of Mansoul, +they (namely, the poor town itself) was in a sad and woeful case; +partly because they had so grievously offended Shaddai and his Son, +and partly because that the enemies thereby got strength within +them afresh; and also because, though they had by many petitions +made suit to the Prince Emmanuel, and to his Father Shaddai by him, +for their pardon and favour, yet hitherto obtained they not one +smile; but contrariwise, through the craft and subtilty of the +domestic Diabolonians, their cloud was made to grow blacker and +blacker, and their Emmanuel to stand at further distance. + +The sickness also did still greatly rage in Mansoul, both among the +captains and the inhabitants of the town; and their enemies only +were now lively and strong, and likely to become the head, whilst +Mansoul was made the tail. + +By this time the letter last mentioned, that was written by the +Diabolonians that yet lurked in the town of Mansoul, was conveyed +to Diabolus in the black den, by the hand of Mr. Profane. He +carried the letter by Hell-Gate Hill as afore, and conveyed it by +Cerberus to his lord. + +But when Cerberus and Mr. Profane did meet, they were presently as +great as beggars, and thus they fell into discourse about Mansoul, +and about the project against her. + +'Ah! old friend,' quoth Cerberus, 'art thou come to Hell-Gate Hill +again? By St. Mary, I am glad to see thee!' + +Prof. Yes, my lord, I am come again about the concerns of the town +of Mansoul. + +Cerb. Prithee, tell me what condition is that town of Mansoul in +at present? + +Prof. In a brave condition, my lord, for us, and for my lords, the +lords of this place, I trow for they are greatly decayed as to +godliness, and that is as well as our heart can wish; their Lord is +greatly out with them, and that doth also please us well. We have +already also a foot in their dish, for our Diabolonian friends are +laid in their bosoms, and what do we lack but to be masters of the +place! Besides, our trusty friends in Mansoul are daily plotting +to betray it to the lords of this town; also the sickness rages +bitterly among them; and that which makes up all, we hope at last +to prevail.' + +Then said the dog of Hell-Gate, 'No time like this to assault them. +I wish that the enterprise be followed close, and that the success +desired may be soon effected: yea, I wish it for the poor +Diabolonians' sakes, that live in the continual fear of their lives +in that traitorous town of Mansoul.' + +Prof. The contrivance is almost finished, the lords in Mansoul +that are Diabolonians are at it day and night, and the other are +like silly doves; they want heart to be concerned with their state +and to consider that ruin is at hand. Besides you may, yea, must +think, when you put all things together, that there are many +reasons that prevail with Diabolus to make what haste he can. + +Cerb. Thou hast said as it is; I am glad things are at this pass. +Go in, my brave Profane, to my lords, they will give thee for thy +welcome as good a coranto as the whole of this kingdom will afford. +I have sent thy letter in already. + +Then Mr. Profane went into the den, and his lord Diabolus met him, +and saluted him with, 'Welcome, my trusty servant: I have been +made glad with thy letter.' The rest of the lords of the pit gave +him also their salutations. Then Profane, after obeisance made to +them all, said, 'Let Mansoul be given to my lord Diabolus, and let +him be her king for ever.' And with that, the hollow belly and +yawning gorge of hell gave so loud and hideous a groan, (for that +is the music of that place,) that it made the mountains about it +totter, as if they would fall in pieces. + +Now, after they had read and considered the letter, they consulted +what answer to return; and the first that did speak to it was +Lucifer. + +Then said he, 'The first project of the Diabolonians in Mansoul is +likely to be lucky, and to take; namely, that they will, by all the +ways and means they can, make Mansoul yet more vile and filthy: no +way to destroy a soul like this. Our old friend Balaam went this +way and prospered many years ago; let this therefore stand with us +for a maxim, and be to Diabolonians for a general rule in all ages; +for nothing can make this to fail but grace, in which I would hope +that this town has no share. But whether to fall upon them on a +market-day, because of their cumber in business, that I would +should be under debate. And there is more reason why this head +should be debated, than why some other should; because upon this +will turn the whole of what we shall attempt. If we time not our +business well, our whole project may fail. Our friends, the +Diabolonians, say that a market-day is best; for then will Mansoul +be most busy, and have fewest thoughts of a surprise. But what if +also they should double their guards on those days? (and methinks +nature and reason should teach them to do it;) and what if they +should keep such a watch on those days as the necessity of their +present case doth require? yea, what if their men should be always +in arms on those days? then you may, my lords, be disappointed in +your attempts, and may bring our friends in the town to utter +danger of unavoidable ruin.' + +Then said the great Beelzebub, 'There is something in what my lord +hath said; but his conjecture may, or may not fall out. Nor hath +my lord laid it down as that which must not be receded from; for I +know that he said it only to provoke to a warm debate thereabout. +Therefore we must understand, if we can, whether the town of +Mansoul has such sense and knowledge of her decayed state, and of +the design that we have on foot against her, as doth provoke her to +set watch and ward at her gates, and to double them on market-days. +But if, after inquiry made, it shall be found that they are asleep, +then any day will do, but a market-day is best; and this is my +judgment in this case.' + +Then quoth Diabolus, 'How should we know this?' and it was +answered, 'Inquire about it at the mouth of Mr. Profane.' So +Profane was called in, and asked the question, and he made his +answer as follows:- + +Prof. My lords, so far as I can gather, this is at present the +condition of the town of Mansoul: they are decayed in their faith +and love; Emmanuel, their Prince, has given them the back; they +send often by petition to fetch him again, but he maketh not haste +to answer their request, nor is there much reformation among them. + +Diab. I am glad that they are backward in a reformation, but yet I +am afraid of their petitioning. However, their looseness of life +is a sign that there is not much heart in what they do, and without +the heart things are little worth. But go on, my masters; I will +divert you, my lords, no longer. + +Beel. If the case be so with Mansoul, as Mr. Profane has described +it to be, it will be no great matter what day we assault it; not +their prayers, nor their power will do them much service. + +When Beelzebub had ended his oration, then Apollyon did begin. 'My +opinion,' said he, 'concerning this matter, is, that we go on fair +and softly, not doing things in a hurry. Let our friends in +Mansoul go on still to pollute and defile it, by seeking to draw it +yet more into sin (for there is nothing like sin to devour +Mansoul). If this be done, and it takes effect, Mansoul, of +itself, will leave off to watch, to petition, or anything else that +should tend to her security and safety; for she will forget her +Emmanuel, she will not desire his company, and can she be gotten +thus to live, her Prince will not come to her in haste. Our trusty +friend, Mr. Carnal-Security, with one of his tricks did drive him +out of the town; and why may not my Lord Covetousness, and my Lord +Lasciviousness, by what they may do, keep him out of the town? And +this I will tell you, (not because you know it not,) that two or +three Diabolonians, if entertained and countenanced by the town of +Mansoul, will do more to the keeping of Emmanuel from them, and +towards making the town of Mansoul your own, than can an army of a +legion that should be sent out from us to withstand him. Let, +therefore, this first project that our friends in Mansoul have set +on foot, be strongly and diligently carried on, with all cunning +and craft imaginable; and let them send continually, under one +guise or another, more and other of their men to play with the +people of Mansoul; and then, perhaps, we shall not need to be at +the charge of making a war upon them; or if that must of necessity +be done, yet the more sinful they are, the more unable, to be sure, +they will be to resist us, and then the more easily we shall +overcome them. And besides, suppose (and that is the worst that +can be supposed) that Emmanuel should come to them again, why may +not the same means, or the like, drive him from them once more? +Yea, why may he not, by their lapse into that sin again, be driven +from them for ever, for the sake of which he was at the first +driven from them for a season? And if this should happen, then +away go with him his rams, his slings, his captains, his soldiers, +and he leaveth Mansoul naked and bare. Yea, will not this town, +when she sees herself utterly forsaken of her Prince, of her own +accord open her gates again unto you, and make of you as in the +days of old? But this must be done by time, a few days will not +effect so great a work as this.' + +So soon as Apollyon had made an end of speaking, Diabolus began to +blow out his own malice, and to plead his own cause; and he said, +'My lords, and powers of the cave, my true and trusty friends, I +have with much impatience, as becomes me, given ear to your long +and tedious orations. But my furious gorge, and empty paunch, so +lusteth after a repossession of my famous town of Mansoul, that +whatever comes out, I can wait no longer to see the events of +lingering projects. I must, and that without further delay, seek, +by all means I can, to fill my insatiable gulf with the soul and +body of the town of Mansoul. Therefore lend me your heads, your +hearts, and your help, now I am going to recover my town of +Mansoul.' + +When the lords and princes of the pit saw the flaming desire that +was in Diabolus to devour the miserable town of Mansoul, they left +off to raise any more objections, but consented to lend him what +strength they could, though had Apollyon's advice been taken, they +had far more fearfully distressed the town of Mansoul. But, I say, +they were willing to lend him what strength they could, not knowing +what need they might have of him, when they should engage for +themselves, as he. Wherefore they fell to advising about the next +thing propounded, namely, what soldiers they were, and also how +many, with whom Diabolus should go against the town of Mansoul to +take it; and after some debate, it was concluded, according as in +the letter the Diabolonians had suggested, that none were more fit +for that expedition than an army of terrible doubters. They +therefore concluded to send against Mansoul an army of sturdy +doubters. The number thought fit to be employed in that service +was between twenty and thirty thousand. So then the result of that +great council of those high and mighty lords was--That Diabolus +should even now, out of hand, beat up his drum for men in the land +of Doubting, which land lieth upon the confines of the place called +Hell-Gate Hill, for men that might be employed by him against the +miserable town of Mansoul. It was also concluded, that these lords +themselves should help him in the war, and that they would to that +end head and manage his men. So they drew up a letter, and sent +back to the Diabolonians that lurked in Mansoul, and that waited +for the back-coming of Mr. Profane, to signify to them into what +method and forwardness they at present had put their design. The +contents whereof now follow:- + +'From the dark and horrible dungeon of hell, Diabolus with all the +society of the princes of darkness, sends to our trusty ones, in +and about the walls of the town of Mansoul, now impatiently waiting +for our most devilish answer to their venomous and most poisonous +design against the town of Mansoul. + +'Our native ones, in whom from day to day we boast, and in whose +actions all the year long we do greatly delight ourselves, we +received your welcome, because highly esteemed letter, at the hand +of our trusty and greatly beloved, the old gentleman, Mr. Profane. +And do give you to understand, that when we had broken it up, and +had read the contents thereof, to your amazing memory be it spoken, +our yawning hollow-bellied place, where we are, made so hideous and +yelling a noise for joy, that the mountains that stand round about +Hell-Gate Hill, had like to have been shaken to pieces at the sound +thereof. + +'We could also do no less than admire your faithfulness to us, with +the greatness of that subtilty that now hath showed itself to be in +your heads to serve us against the town of Mansoul. For you have +invented for us so excellent a method for our proceeding against +that rebellious people, a more effectual cannot be thought of by +all the wits of hell. The proposals, therefore, which now, at +last, you have sent us, since we saw them, we have done little else +but highly approved and admired them. + +'Nay, we shall, to encourage you in the profundity of your craft, +let you know, that, at a full assembly and conclave of our princes +and principalities of this place, your project was discoursed and +tossed from one side of our cave to the other by their +mightinesses; but a better, and as was by themselves judged, a more +fit and proper way by all their wits, could not be invented, to +surprise, take, and make our own, the rebellious town of Mansoul. + +'Wherefore, in fine, all that was said that varied from what you +had in your letter propounded, fell of itself to the ground, and +yours only was stuck to by Diabolus, the prince; yea, his gaping +gorge and yawning paunch was on fire to put your invention into +execution. + +'We therefore give you to understand that our stout, furious, and +unmerciful Diabolus is raising, for your relief, and the ruin of +the rebellious town of Mansoul, more than twenty thousand doubters +to come against that people. They are all stout and sturdy men, +and men that of old have been accustomed to war, and that can +therefore well endure the drum. I say, he is doing this work of +his with all the possible speed he can; for his heart and spirit is +engaged in it. We desire, therefore, that, as you have hitherto +stuck to us, and given us both advice and encouragement thus far, +you still will prosecute our design; nor shall you lose, but be +gainers thereby; yea, we intend to make you the lords of Mansoul. + +'One thing may not by any means be omitted, that is, those with us +do desire that every one of you that are in Mansoul would still use +all your power, cunning, and skill, with delusive persuasions, yet +to draw the town of Mansoul into more sin and wickedness, even that +sin may be finished and bring forth death. + +'For thus it is concluded with us, that the more vile, sinful, and +debauched the town of Mansoul is, more backward will be their +Emmanuel to come to their help, either by presence or other relief; +yea, the more sinful, the more weak, and so the more unable will +they be to make resistance when we shall make our assault upon them +to swallow them up. Yea, that may cause that their mighty Shaddai +himself may cast them out of his protection; yea, and send for his +captains and soldiers home, with his slings and rams, and leave +them naked and bare; and then the town of Mansoul will of itself +open to us, and fall as the fig into the mouth of the eater. Yea, +to be sure. that we then with a great deal of ease shall come upon +her and overcome her. + +'As to the time of our coming upon Mansoul, we, as yet, have not +fully resolved upon that, though at present some of us think as +you, that a market-day, or a market-day at night, will certainly be +the best. However, do you be ready, and when you shall hear our +roaring drum without, do you be as busy to make the most horrible +confusion within. So shall Mansoul certainly be distressed before +and behind, and shall not know which way to betake herself for +help. My Lord Lucifer, my Lord Beelzebub, my Lord Apollyon, my +Lord Legion, with the rest, salute you, as does also my Lord +Diabolus; and we wish both you, with all that you do, or shall +possess, the very self-same fruit and success for their doing as we +ourselves at present enjoy for ours. + +'From our dreadful confines in the most fearful pit, we salute you, +and so do those many legions here with us, wishing you may be as +hellishly prosperous as we desire to be ourselves. By the letter- +carrier, Mr. Profane.' + +Then Mr. Profane addressed himself for his return to Mansoul, with +his errand from the horrible pit to the Diabolonians that dwelt in +that town. So he came up the stairs from the deep to the mouth of +the cave where Cerberus was. Now when Cerberus saw him, he asked +how did matters go below, about and against the town of Mansoul. + +Prof. Things go as well as we can expect. The letter that I +carried thither was highly approved, and well liked by all my +lords, and I am returning to tell our Diabolonians so. I have an +answer to it here in my bosom, that I am sure will make our masters +that sent me glad; for the contents thereof are to encourage them +to pursue their design to the utmost, and to be ready also to fall +on within, when they shall see my Lord Diabolus beleaguering the +town of Mansoul. + +Cerb. But does he intend to go against them himself? + +Prof. Does he! Ay! and he will take along with him more than +twenty thousand, all sturdy Doubters, and men of war, picked men +from the land of Doubting, to serve him in the expedition. + +Then was Cerberus glad, and said, 'And is there such brave +preparations a-making to go against the miserable town of Mansoul? +And would I might be put at the head of a thousand of them, that I +might also show my valour against the famous town of Mansoul.' + +Prof. Your wish may come to pass; you look like one that has +mettle enough, and my lord will have with him those that are +valiant and stout. But my business requires haste. + +Cerb. Ay, so it does. Speed thee to the town of Mansoul, with all +the deepest mischiefs that this place can afford thee. And when +thou shalt come to the house of Mr. Mischief, the place where the +Diabolonians meet to plot, tell them that Cerberus doth wish them +his service, and that if he may, he will with the army come up +against the famous town of Mansoul. + +Prof. That I will. And I know that my lords that are there will +be glad to hear it, and to see you also. + +So after a few more such kind of compliments, Mr. Profane took his +leave of his friend Cerberus; and Cerberus again, with a thousand +of their pit-wishes, bid him haste, with all speed, to his masters. +The which when he had heard, he made obeisance, and began to gather +up his heels to run. + +Thus, therefore, he returned, and went and came to Mansoul; and +going, as afore, to the house of Mr. Mischief, there he found the +Diabolonians assembled, and waiting for his return. Now when he +was come, and had presented himself, he also delivered to them his +letter, and adjoined this compliment to them therewith: 'My lords, +from the confines of the pit, the high and mighty principalities +and powers of the den salute you here, the true Diabolonians of the +town of Mansoul. Wishing you always the most proper of their +benedictions, for the great service, high attempts, and brave +achievements that you have put yourselves upon, for the restoring +to our prince Diabolus the famous town of Mansoul.' + +This was therefore the present state of the miserable town of +Mansoul: she had offended her Prince, and he was gone; she had +encouraged the powers of hell, by her foolishness, to come against +her to seek her utter destruction. + +True, the town of Mansoul was somewhat made sensible of her sin, +but the Diabolonians were gotten into her bowels; she cried, but +Emmanuel was gone, and her cries did not fetch him as yet again. +Besides, she knew not now whether, ever or never, he would return +and come to his Mansoul again; nor did they know the power and +industry of the enemy, nor how forward they were to put in +execution that plot of hell that they had devised against her. + +They did, indeed, still send petition after petition to the Prince, +but he answered all with silence. They did neglect reformation, +and that was as Diabolus would have it; for he knew, if they +regarded iniquity in their heart, their King would not hear their +prayer; they therefore did still grow weaker and weaker, and were +as a rolling thing before the whirlwind. They cried to their King +for help, and laid Diabolonians in their bosoms: what therefore +should a King do to them? Yea, there seemed now to be a mixture in +Mansoul; the Diabolonians and the Mansoulians would walk the +streets together. Yea, they began to seek their peace; for they +thought that, since the sickness had been so mortal in Mansoul, it +was in vain to go to handygripes with them. Besides, the weakness +of Mansoul was the strength of their enemies; and the sins of +Mansoul, the advantage of the Diabolonians. The foes of Mansoul +did also now begin to promise themselves the town for a possession: +there was no great difference now betwixt Mansoulians and +Diabolonians: both seemed to be masters of Mansoul. Yea, the +Diabolonians increased and grew, but the town of Mansoul diminished +greatly. There were more than eleven thousand men, women, and +children that died by the sickness in Mansoul. + +But now, as Shaddai would have it, there was one whose name was Mr. +Prywell, a great lover of the people of Mansoul. And he, as his +manner was, did go listening up and down in Mansoul to see, and to +hear, if at any time he might, whether there was any design against +it or no. For he was always a jealous man, and feared some +mischief sometime would befal it, either from the Diabolonians +within, or from some power without. Now upon a time it so +happened, as Mr. Prywell went listening here and there, that he +lighted upon a place called Vilehill, in Mansoul, where +Diabolonians used to meet; so hearing a muttering, (you must know +that it was in the night,) he softly drew near to hear; nor had he +stood long under the house-end, (for there stood a house there,) +but he heard one confidently affirm, that it was not, or would not +be long before Diabolus should possess himself again of Mansoul; +and that then the Diabolonians did intend to put all Mansoulians to +the sword, and would kill and destroy the King's captains, and +drive all his soldiers out of the town. He said, moreover, that he +knew there were above twenty thousand fighting men prepared by +Diabolus for the accomplishing of this design, and that it would +not be months before they all should see it. + +When Mr. Prywell had heard this story, he did quickly believe it +was true: wherefore he went forthwith to my Lord Mayor's house, +and acquainted him therewith; who, sending for the subordinate +preacher, brake the business to him; and he as soon gave the alarm +to the town; for he was now the chief preacher in Mansoul, because, +as yet, my Lord Secretary was ill at ease. And this was the way +that the subordinate preacher did take to alarm the town therewith. +The same hour he caused the lecture bell to be rung; so the people +came together: he gave them then a short exhortation to +watchfulness, and made Mr. Prywell's news the argument thereof. +'For,' said he, 'an horrible plot is contrived against Mansoul, +even to massacre us all in a day, nor is this story to be slighted; +for Mr. Prywell is the author thereof. Mr. Prywell was always a +lover of Mansoul, a sober and judicious man, a man that is no +tattler, nor raiser of false reports, but one that loves to look +into the very bottom of matters, and talks nothing of news, but by +very solid arguments. + +'I will call him, and you shall hear him your own selves;' so he +called him, and he came and told his tale so punctually, and +affirmed its truth with such ample grounds, that Mansoul fell +presently under a conviction of the truth of what he said. The +preacher did also back him, saying, 'Sirs, it is not irrational for +us to believe it, for we have provoked Shaddai to anger, and have +sinned Emmanuel out of the town; we have had too much +correspondence with Diabolonians, and have forsaken our former +mercies: no marvel then, if the enemy both within and without +should design and plot our ruin; and what time like this to do it? +The sickness is now in the town, and we have been made weak +thereby. Many a good meaning man is dead, and the Diabolonians of +late grow stronger and stronger. + +'Besides,' quoth the subordinate preacher, 'I have received from +this good truth-teller this one inkling further, that he understood +by those that he overheard, that several letters have lately passed +between the furies and the Diabolonians in order to our +destruction.' When Mansoul heard all this, and not being able to +gainsay it, they lift up their voice and wept. Mr. Prywell did +also, in the presence of the townsmen, confirm all that their +subordinate preacher had said. Wherefore they now set afresh to +bewail their folly, and to a doubling of petitions to Shaddai and +his Son. They also brake the business to the captains, high +commanders, and men of war in the town of Mansoul, entreating them +to use the means to be strong, and to take good courage; and that +they would look after their harness, and make themselves ready to +give Diabolus battle by night and by day, shall he come, as they +are informed he will, to beleaguer the town of Mansoul. + +When the captains heard this, they being always true lovers of the +town of Mansoul, what do they but like so many Samsons they shake +themselves, and come together to consult and contrive how to defeat +those bold and hellish contrivances that were upon the wheel by the +means of Diabolus and his friends against the now sickly, weakly, +and much impoverished town of Mansoul; and they agreed upon these +following particulars:- + +1. That the gates of Mansoul should be kept shut, and made fast +with bars and locks, and that all persons that went out, or came +in, should be very strictly examined by the captains of the guards, +'to the end,' said they, 'that those that are managers of the plot +amongst us, may, either coming or going, be taken; and that we may +also find out who are the great contrivers, amongst us, of our +ruin.' + +2. The next thing was, that a strict search should be made for all +kind of Diabolonians throughout the whole town of Mansoul; and that +every man's house from top to bottom should be looked into, and +that, too, house by house, that if possible a further discovery +might be made of all such among them as had a hand in these +designs. + +3. It was further concluded upon, that wheresoever or with +whomsoever any of the Diabolonians were found, that even those of +the town of Mansoul that had given them house and harbour, should +to their shame, and the warning of others, take penance in the open +place. + +4. It was, moreover, resolved by the famous town of Mansoul, that a +public fast, and a day of humiliation, should be kept throughout +the whole corporation, to the justifying of their Prince, the +abasing of themselves before him for their transgressions against +him, and against Shaddai, his Father. It was further resolved, +that all such in Mansoul as did not on that day endeavour to keep +that fast, and to humble themselves for their faults, but that +should mind their worldly employs, or be found wandering up and +down the streets, should be taken for Diabolonians, and should +suffer as Diabolonians for such their wicked doings. + +5. It was further concluded then, that with what speed, and with +what warmth of mind they could, they would renew their humiliation +for sin, and their petitions to Shaddai for help; they also +resolved, to send tidings to the court of all that Mr. Prywell had +told them. + +6. It was also determined, that thanks should be given by the town +of Mansoul to Mr. Prywell, for his diligent seeking of the welfare +of their town: and further, that forasmuch as he was so naturally +inclined to seek their good, and also to undermine their foes, they +gave him a commission of scout-master-general, for the good of the +town of Mansoul. + +When the corporation, with their captains, had thus concluded, they +did as they had said; they shut up their gates, they made for +Diabolonians strict search, they made those with whom any were +found to take penance in the open place: they kept their fast, and +renewed their petitions to their Prince, and Mr. Prywell managed +his charge and the trust that Mansoul had put in his hands, with +great conscience and good fidelity; for he gave himself wholly up +to his employ, and that not only within the town, but he went out +to pry, to see, and to hear. + +And not many days after he provided for his journey, and went +towards Hell-Gate Hill, into the country where the Doubters were, +where he heard of all that had been talked of in Mansoul, and he +perceived also that Diabolus was almost ready for his march, etc. +So he came back with speed, and, calling the captains and elders of +Mansoul together, he told them where he had been, what he had +heard, and what he had seen. Particularly, he told them that +Diabolus was almost ready for his march, and that he had made old +Mr. Incredulity, that once brake prison in Mansoul, the, general of +his army; that his army consisted all of Doubters, and that their +number was above twenty thousand. He told, moreover, that Diabolus +did intend to bring with him the chief princes of the infernal pit, +and that he would make them chief captains over his Doubters. He +told them, moreover, that it was certainly true that several of the +black den would, with Diabolus, ride reformades to reduce the town +of Mansoul to the obedience of Diabolus, their prince. + +He said, moreover, that he understood by the Doubters, among whom +he had been, that the reason why old Incredulity was made general +of the whole army, was because none truer than he to the tyrant; +and because he had an implacable spite against the welfare of the +town of Mansoul. Besides, said he, he remembers the affronts that +Mansoul has given him, and he is resolved to be revenged of them. + +But the black princes shall be made high commanders, only +Incredulity shall be over them all; because, which I had almost +forgot, he can more easily, and more dexterously, beleaguer the +town of Mansoul, than can any of the princes besides. + +Now, when the captains of Mansoul, with the elders of the town, had +heard the tidings that Mr. Prywell did bring, they thought it +expedient, without further delay, to put into execution the laws +that against the Diabolonians their Prince had made for them, and +given them in commandment to manage against them. Wherefore, +forthwith a diligent and impartial search was made in all houses in +Mansoul, for all and all manner of Diabolonians. Now, in the house +of Mr. Mind, and in the house of the great Lord Willbewill, were +two Diabolonians found. In Mr. Mind's house was one Lord +Covetousness found; but he had changed his name to Prudent-Thrifty. +In my Lord Willbewill's house, one Lasciviousness was found; but he +had changed his name to Harmless-Mirth. These two the captains and +elders of the town of Mansoul took, and committed them to custody +under the hand of Mr. Trueman, the gaoler; and this man handled +them so severely, and loaded them so well with irons, that in time +they both fell into a very deep consumption, and died in the +prison-house; their masters also, according to the agreement of the +captains and elders, were brought to take penance in the open place +to their shame, and for a warning to the rest of the town of +Mansoul. + +Now, this was the manner of penance in those days: the persons +offending being made sensible of the evil of their doings, were +enjoined open confession of their faults, and a strict amendment of +their lives. + +After this, the captains and elders of Mansoul sought yet to find +out more Diabolonians, wherever they lurked, whether in dens, +caves, holes, vaults, or where else they could, in or about the +wall or town of Mansoul. But though they could plainly see their +footing, and so follow them by their track and smell to their +holds, even to the mouths of their caves and dens, yet take them, +hold them, and do justice upon them, they could not; their ways +were so crooked, their holds so strong, and they so quick to take +sanctuary there. + +But Mansoul did now with so stiff an hand rule over the +Diabolonians that were left, that they were glad to shrink into +corners: time was when they durst walk openly, and in the day; but +now they were forced to embrace privacy and the night: time was +when a Mansoulian was their companion; but now they counted them +deadly enemies. This good change did Mr. Prywell's intelligence +make in the famous town of Mansoul. + +By this time, Diabolus had finished his army which he intended to +bring with him for the ruin of Mansoul; and had set over them +captains, and other field officers, such as liked his furious +stomach best: himself was lord paramount, Incredulity was general +of his army, their highest captains shall be named afterwards; but +now for their officers, colours, and scutcheons. + +1. Their first captain was Captain Rage: he was captain over the +election doubters, his were the red colours; his standard-bearer +was Mr. Destructive, and the great red dragon he had for his +scutcheon. + +2. The second captain was Captain Fury: he was captain over the +vocation doubters; his standard-bearer was Mr. Darkness, his +colours were those that were pale, and he had for his scutcheon the +fiery flying serpent. + +3. The third captain was Captain Damnation: he was captain over +the grace doubters; his were the red colours, Mr. No-Life bare +them, and he had for his scutcheon the black den. + +4. The fourth captain was Captain Insatiable; he was captain over +the faith doubters: his were the red colours, Mr. Devourer bare +them, and he had for a scutcheon the yawning jaws. + +5. The fifth captain was Captain Brimstone: he was captain over +the perseverance doubters; his also were the red colours, Mr. +Burning bare them, and his scutcheon was the blue and stinking +flame. + +6. The sixth captain was Captain Torment: he was captain over the +resurrection doubters; his colours were those that were pale; Mr. +Gnaw was his standard-bearer, and he had the black worm for his +scutcheon. + +7. The seventh captain was Captain No-Ease; he was captain over the +salvation doubters; his were the red colours, Mr. Restless bare +them, and his scutcheon was the ghastly picture of death. + +8. The eighth captain was the Captain Sepulchre: he was captain +over the glory doubters; his also were the pale colours, Mr. +Corruption was his standard-bearer, and he had for his scutcheon a +skull, and dead men's bones. + +9. The ninth captain was Captain Past-Hope; he was captain of those +that are called the felicity doubters; his standard-bearer was Mr. +Despair; his also were the red colours, and his scutcheon was a hot +iron and the hard heart. + +These were his captains, and these were their forces, these were +their standards, these were their colours, and these were their +scutcheons. Now, over these did the great Diabolus make superior +captains, and they were in number seven: as, namely, the Lord +Beelzebub, the Lord Lucifer, the Lord Legion, the Lord Apollyon, +the Lord Python, the Lord Cerberus, and the Lord Belial; these +seven he set over the captains, and Incredulity was lord-general, +and, Diabolus was king. The reformades also, such as were like +themselves, were made some of them captains of hundreds, and some +of them captains of more. And thus was the army of Incredulity +completed. + +So they set out at Hell-Gate Hill, for there they had their +rendezvous, from whence they came with a straight course upon their +march toward the town of Mansoul. Now, as was hinted before, the +town had, as Shaddai would have it, received from the mouth of Mr. +Prywell the alarm of their coming before. Wherefore they set a +strong watch at the gates, and had also doubled their guards: they +also mounted their slings in good places, where they might +conveniently cast out their great stones to the annoyance of their +furious enemy. + +Nor could those Diabolonians that were in the town do that hurt as +was designed they should; for Mansoul was now awake. But alas! +poor people, they were sorely affrighted at the first appearance of +their foes, and at their sitting down before the town, especially +when they heard the roaring of their drum. This, to speak truth, +was amazingly hideous to hear; it frighted all men seven miles +round, if they were but awake and heard it. The streaming of their +colours was also terrible and dejecting to behold. + +When Diabolus was come up against the town, first he made his +approach to Ear-gate, and gave it a furious assault, supposing, as +it seems, that his friends in Mansoul had been ready to do the work +within; but care was taken of that before, by the vigilance of the +captains. Wherefore, missing of the help that he expected from +them, and finding his army warmly attended with the stones that the +slingers did sling, (for that I will say for the captains, that +considering the weakness that yet was upon them by reason of the +long sickness that had annoyed the town of Mansoul, they did +gallantly behave themselves,) he was forced to make some retreat +from Mansoul, and to entrench himself and his men in the field +without the reach of the slings of the town. + +Now having entrenched himself, he did cast up four mounts against +the town: the first he called Mount Diabolus, putting his own name +thereon, the more to affright the town of Mansoul; the other three +he called thus--Mount Alecto, Mount Megara, and Mount Tisiphone; +for these are the names of the dreadful furies of hell. Thus he +began to play his game with Mansoul, and to serve it as doth the +lion his prey, even to make it fall before his terror. But, as I +said, the captains and soldiers resisted so stoutly, and did do +such execution with their stones, that they made him, though +against stomach, to retreat, wherefore Mansoul began to take +courage. + +Now upon Mount Diabolus, which was raised on the north side of the +town, there did the tyrant set up his standard, and a fearful thing +it was to behold; for he had wrought in it by devilish art, after +the manner of a scutcheon, a flaming flame fearful to behold, and +the picture of Mansoul burning in it. + +When Diabolus had thus done, he commanded that his drummer should +every night approach the walls of the town of Mansoul, and so to +beat a parley; the command was to do it at nights, for in the +daytime they annoyed him with their slings; for the tyrant said, +that he had a mind to parley with the now trembling town of +Mansoul, and he commanded that the drums should beat every night, +that through weariness they might at last, if possible, (at the +first they were unwilling yet,) be forced to do it. + +So this drummer did as commanded: he arose, and did beat his drum. +But when his drum did go, if one looked toward the town of Mansoul, +'Behold darkness and sorrow, and the light was darkened in the +heaven thereof.' No noise was ever heard upon earth more terrible, +except the voice of Shaddai when he speaketh. But how did Mansoul +tremble! it now looked for nothing but forthwith to be swallowed +up. + +When this drummer had beaten for a parley, he made this speech to +Mansoul: 'My master has bid me tell you, that if you will +willingly submit, you shall have the good of the earth; but if you +shall be stubborn, he is resolved to take you by force.' But by +that the fugitive had done beating his drum, the people of Mansoul +had betaken themselves to the captains that were in the castle, so +that there was none to regard, nor to give this drummer an answer; +so he proceeded no further that night, but returned again to his +master to the camp. + +When Diabolus saw that by drumming he could not work out Mansoul to +his will, the next night he sendeth his drummer without his drum, +still to let the townsmen know that he had a mind to parley with +them. But when all came to all, his parley was turned into a +summons to the town to deliver up themselves: but they gave him +neither heed nor hearing: for they remembered what at first it +cost them to hear him a few words. + +The next night he sends again, and then who should be his messenger +to Mansoul but the terrible Captain Sepulchre; so Captain Sepulchre +came up to the walls of Mansoul, and made this oration to the +town:- + +'O ye inhabitants of the rebellious town of Mansoul! I summon you +in the name of the Prince Diabolus, that, without any more ado, you +set open the gates of your town, and admit the great lord to come +in. But if you shall still rebel, when we have taken to us the +town by force, we will swallow you up as the grave; wherefore if +you will hearken to my summons, say so, and if not then let me +know. + +'The reason of this my summons,' quoth he, 'is, for that my lord is +your undoubted prince and lord, as you yourselves have formerly +owned. Nor shall that assault that was given to my lord, when +Emmanuel dealt so dishonourably by him, prevail with him to lose +his right, and to forbear to attempt to recover his own. Consider, +then, O Mansoul, with thyself, wilt thou show thyself peaceable, or +no? If thou shalt quietly yield up thyself, then our old +friendship shall be renewed; but if thou shalt yet refuse and +rebel, then expect nothing but fire and sword.' + +When the languishing town of Mansoul had heard this summoner and +his summons, they were yet more put to their dumps, but made to the +captain no answer at all; so away he went as he came. + +But, after some consultation among themselves, as also with some of +their captains, they applied themselves afresh to the Lord +Secretary for counsel and advice from him; for this Lord Secretary +was their chief preacher, (as also is mentioned some pages before,) +only now he was ill at ease; and of him they begged favour in these +two or three things - + +1. That he would look comfortably upon them, and not keep himself +so much retired from them as formerly. Also, that he would be +prevailed with to give them a hearing, while they should make known +their miserable condition to him. But to this he told them as +before, that 'as yet he was but ill at ease, and therefore could +not do as he had formerly done.' + +2. The second thing that they desired was, that he would be pleased +to give them his advice about their now so important affairs, for +that Diabolus was come and set down before the town with no less +than twenty thousand doubters. They said, moreover, that both he +and his captains were cruel men, and that they were afraid of them. +But to this he said, 'You must look to the law of the Prince, and +there see what is laid upon you to do.' + +3. Then they desired that his highness would help them to frame a +petition to Shaddai, and unto Emmanuel his Son, and that he would +set his own hand thereto as a token that he was one with them in +it: 'For,' said they, 'my Lord, many a one have we sent, but can +get no answer of peace; but now, surely, one with thy hand unto it +may obtain good for Mansoul.' + +But all the answer that he gave to this was, 'that they had +offended their Emmanuel, and had also grieved himself, and that +therefore they must as yet partake of their own devices.' + +This answer of the Lord Secretary fell like a millstone upon them; +yea, it crushed them so that they could not tell what to do; yet +they durst not comply with the demands of Diabolus, nor with the +demands of his captain. So then here were the straits that the +town of Mansoul was betwixt, when the enemy came upon her: her +foes were ready to swallow her up, and her friends did forbear to +help her. + +Then stood up my Lord Mayor, whose name was my Lord Understanding, +and he began to pick and pick, until he had picked comfort out of +that seemingly bitter saying of the Lord Secretary; for thus he +descanted upon it: 'First,' said he, 'this unavoidably follows +upon the saying of my Lord, "that we must yet suffer for our sins." +Secondly, But,' quoth he, 'the words yet sound as if at last we +should be saved from our enemies, and that after a few more +sorrows, Emmanuel will come and be our help.' Now the Lord Mayor +was the more critical in his dealing with the Secretary's words, +because my lord was more than a prophet, and because none of his +words were such, but that at all times they were most exactly +significant; and the townsmen were allowed to pry into them, and to +expound them to their best advantage. + +So they took their leaves of my lord, and returned, and went, and +came to the captains, to whom they did tell what my Lord High +Secretary had said; who, when they had heard it, were all of the +same opinion as was my Lord Mayor himself. The captains, +therefore, began to take some courage unto them, and to prepare to +make some brave attempt upon the camp of the enemy, and to destroy +all that were Diabolonians, with the roving doubters that the +tyrant had brought with him to destroy the poor town of Mansoul. + +So all betook themselves forthwith to their places--the Captains to +theirs, the Lord Mayor to his, the subordinate preacher to his, and +my Lord Willbewill to his. The captains longed to be at some work +for their prince; for they delighted in warlike achievements. The +next day, therefore, they came together and consulted; and after +consultation had, they resolved to give an answer to the captain of +Diabolus with slings; and so they did at the rising of the sun on +the morrow; for Diabolus had adventured to come nearer again, but +the sling-stones were to him and his like hornets. For as there is +nothing to the town of Mansoul so terrible as the roaring of +Diabolus's drum, so there is nothing to Diabolus so terrible as the +well playing of Emmanuel's slings. Wherefore Diabolus was forced +to make another retreat, yet further off from the famous town of +Mansoul. Then did the Lord Mayor of Mansoul cause the bells to be +rung, 'and that thanks should be sent to the Lord High Secretary by +the mouth of the subordinate preacher; for that by his words the +captains and elders of Mansoul had been strengthened against +Diabolus.' + +When Diabolus saw that his captains and soldiers, high lords and +renowned, were frightened, and beaten down by the stones that came +from the golden slings of the Prince of the town of Mansoul, he +bethought himself, and said, 'I will try to catch them by fawning, +I will try to flatter them into my net.' + +Wherefore, after a while, he came down again to the wall, not now +with his drum, nor with Captain Sepulchre; but having all besugared +his lips, he seemed to be a very sweet-mouthed, peaceable prince, +designing nothing for humour's sake, nor to be revenged on Mansoul +for injuries by them done to him; but the welfare, and good, and +advantage of the town and people therein was now, as he said, his +only design. Wherefore, after he had called for audience, and +desired that the townsfolk would give it to him, he proceeded in +his oration, and said:- + +'Oh, the desire of my heart, the famous town of Mansoul! how many +nights have I watched, and how many weary steps have I taken, if +perhaps I might do thee good! Far be it, far be it from me to +desire to make a war upon you; if ye will but willingly and quietly +deliver up yourselves unto me. You know that you were mine of old. +Remember also, that so long as you enjoyed me for your lord, and +that I enjoyed you for my subjects, you wanted for nothing of all +the delights of the earth, that I, your lord and prince, could get +for you, or that I could invent to make you bonny and blithe +withal. Consider, you never had so many hard, dark, troublesome, +and heart-afflicting hours, while you were mine, as you have had +since you revolted from me; nor shall you ever have peace again, +until you and I become one as before. But, be but prevailed with +to embrace me again, and I will grant, yea, enlarge your old +charter with abundance of privileges; so that your license and +liberty shall be to take, hold, enjoy, and make your own all that +is pleasant from the east to the west. Nor shall any of those +incivilities, wherewith you have offended me, be ever charged upon +you by me, so long as the sun and moon endure. Nor shall any of +those dear friends of mine that now, for the fear of you, lie +lurking in dens, and holes, and caves in Mansoul, be hurtful to you +any more; yea, they shall be your servants, and shall minister unto +you of their substance, and of whatever shall come to hand. I need +speak no more; you know them, and have sometime since been much +delighted in their company. Why, then, should we abide at such +odds? Let us renew our old acquaintance and friendship again. + +'Bear with your friend; I take the liberty at this time to speak +thus freely unto you. The love that I have to you presses me to do +it, as also does the zeal of my heart for my friends with you: put +me not therefore to further trouble, nor yourselves to further +fears and frights. Have you I will, in a way of peace or war; nor +do you flatter yourselves with the power and force of your +captains, or that your Emmanuel will shortly come in to your help; +for such strength will do you no pleasure. + +'I am come against you with a stout and valiant army, and all the +chief princes of the den are even at the head of it. Besides, my +captains are swifter than eagles, stronger than lions, and more +greedy of prey than are the evening wolves. What is Og of Bashan! +what is Goliath of Gath! and what are an hundred more of them, to +one of the least of my captains! How, then, shall Mansoul think to +escape my hand and force?' + +Diabolus having thus handed his flattering, fawning, deceitful, and +lying speech to the famous town of Mansoul, the Lord Mayor replied +to him as follows: 'O Diabolus, prince of darkness, and master of +all deceit; thy lying flatteries we have had and made sufficient +probation of, and have tasted too deeply of that destructive cup +already. Should we therefore again hearken unto thee, and so break +the commandments of our great Shaddai, to join in affinity with +thee, would not our Prince reject us, and cast us off for ever? +And, being cast off by him, can the place that he has prepared for +thee be a place of rest for us? Besides, O thou that art empty and +void of all truth, we are rather ready to die by thy hand, than to +fall in with thy flattering and lying deceits.' + +When the tyrant saw that there was little to be got by parleying +with my Lord Mayor, he fell into an hellish rage, and resolved that +again, with his army of doubters, he would another time assault the +town of Mansoul. + +So he called for his drummer, who beat up for his men (and while he +did beat, Mansoul did shake) to be in a readiness to give battle to +the corporation: then Diabolus drew near with his army, and thus +disposed of his men. Captain Cruel and Captain Torment, these he +drew up and placed against Feel-gate, and commanded them to sit +down there for the war. And he also appointed that, if need were, +Captain No-Ease should come in to their relief. At Nose-gate he +placed the Captain Brimstone and Captain Sepulchre, and bid them +look well to their ward, on that side of the town of Mansoul. But +at Eye-gate he placed that grim-faced one, the Captain Past-Hope, +and there also now he did set up his terrible standard. + +Now Captain Insatiable, he was to look to the carriages of +Diabolus, and was also appointed to take into custody that, or +those persons and things, that should at any time as prey be taken +from the enemy. + +Now Mouth-gate the inhabitants of Mansoul kept for a sally-port; +wherefore that they kept strong; for that it was it by and out at +which the townsfolk did send their petitions to Emmanuel their +Prince. That also was the gate from the top of which the captains +did play their slings at the enemies; for that gate stood somewhat +ascending, so that the placing of them there, and the letting of +them fly from that place, did much execution against the tyrant's +army. Wherefore, for these causes, with others, Diabolus sought, +if possible, to land up Mouth-gate with dirt. + +Now, as Diabolus was busy and industrious in preparing to make his +assault upon the town of Mansoul, without, so the captains and +soldiers in the corporation were as busy in preparing within; they +mounted their slings, they set up their banners, they sounded their +trumpets, and put themselves in such order as was judged most for +the annoyance of the enemy, and for the advantage of Mansoul, and +gave to their soldiers orders to be ready at the sound of the +trumpet for war. The Lord Willbewill also, he took the charge of +watching against the rebels within, and to do what he could to take +them while without, or to stifle them within their caves, dens, and +holes in the town-wall of Mansoul. And, to speak the truth of him, +ever since he took penance for his fault, he has showed as much +honesty and bravery of spirit as any he in Mansoul; for he took one +Jolly, and his brother Griggish, the two sons of his servant +Harmless-Mirth, (for to that day, though the father was committed +to ward, the sons had a dwelling in the house of my lord,)--I say, +he took them, and with his own hands put them to the cross. And +this was the reason why he hanged them up: after their father was +put into the hands of Mr. True-Man the gaoler, they, his sons, +began to play his pranks, and to be ticking and toying with the +daughters of their lord; nay, it was jealoused that they were too +familiar with them, the which was brought to his lordship's ear. +Now his lordship being unwilling unadvisedly to put any man to +death, did not suddenly fall upon them, but set watch and spies to +see if the thing was true; of the which he was soon informed, for +his two servants, whose names were Find-Out and Tell-All, catched +them together in uncivil manner more than once or twice, and went +and told their lord. So when my Lord Willbewill had sufficient +ground to believe the thing was true, he takes the two young +Diabolonians, (for such they were, for their father was a +Diabolonian born,) and has them to Eye-gate, where he raised a very +high cross, just in the face of Diabolus, and of his army, and +there he hanged the young villains, in defiance to Captain Past- +Hope, and of the horrible standard of the tyrant. + +Now this Christian act of the brave Lord Willbewill did greatly +abash Captain Past-Hope, discouraged the army of Diabolus, put fear +into the Diabolonian runagates in Mansoul, and put strength and +courage into the captains that belonged to Emmanuel, the Prince; +for they without did gather, and that by this very act of my Lord, +that Mansoul was resolved to fight, and that the Diabolonians +within the town could not do such things as Diabolus had hopes they +would. Nor was this the only proof of the brave Lord Willbewill's +honesty to the town, nor of his loyalty to his Prince, as will +afterwards appear. + +Now, when the children of Prudent-Thrifty, who dwelt with Mr. Mind, +(for Thrift left children with Mr. Mind, when he was also committed +to prison, and their names were Gripe and Rake-All; these he begat +of Mr. Mind's bastard daughter, whose name was Mrs. Hold-fast- +Bad;)--I say, when his children perceived how the Lord Willbewill +had served them that dwelt with him, what do they but, lest they +should drink of the same cup, endeavour to make their escape. But +Mr. Mind, being wary of it, took them and put them in hold in his +house till morning; (for this was done over night;) and remembering +that by the law of Mansoul all Diabolonians were to die, (and to be +sure they were at least by father's side such, and some say by +mother's side too,) what does he but takes them and puts them in +chains, and carries them to the selfsame place where my lord hanged +his two before, and there he hanged them. + +The townsmen also took great encouragement at this act of Mr. Mind, +and did what they could to have taken some more of these +Diabolonian troublers of Mansoul; but at that time the rest lay so +squat and close, that they could not be apprehended; so they set +against them a diligent watch, and went every man to his place. + +I told you a little before, that Diabolus and his army were +somewhat abashed and discouraged at the sight of what my Lord +Willbewill did, when he hanged up those two young Diabolonians; but +his discouragement quickly turned itself into furious madness and +rage against the town of Mansoul, and fight it he would. Also the +townsmen and captains within, they had their hopes and their +expectations heightened, believing at last the day would be theirs; +so they feared them the less. Their subordinate preacher, too, +made a sermon about it; and he took that theme for his text, 'Gad, +a troop shall overcome him: but he shall overcome at the last.' +Whence he showed, that though Mansoul should be sorely put to it at +the first, yet the victory should most certainly be Mansoul's at +the last. + +So Diabolus commanded that his drummer should beat a charge against +the town; and the captains also that were in the town sounded a +charge against them, but they had no drum: they were trumpets of +silver with which they sounded against them. Then they which were +of the camp of Diabolus came down to the town to take it, and the +captains in the castle, with the slingers at Mouth-gate, played +upon them amain. And now there was nothing heard in the camp of +Diabolus but horrible rage and blasphemy; but in the town good +words, prayer, and singing of psalms. The enemy replied with +horrible objections, and the terribleness of their drum; but the +town made answer with the slapping of their slings, and the +melodious noise of their trumpets. And thus the fight lasted for +several days together, only now and then they had some small +intermission, in the which the townsmen refreshed themselves, and +the captains made ready for another assault. + +The captains of Emmanuel were clad in silver armour, and the +soldiers in that which was of proof; the soldiers of Diabolus were +clad in iron which was made to give place to Emmanuel's engine- +shot. In the town, some were hurt, and some were greatly wounded. +Now, the worst of it was, a chirurgeon was scarce in Mansoul, for +that Emmanuel at present was absent. Howbeit, with the leaves of a +tree the wounded were kept from dying; yet their wounds did greatly +putrefy, and some did grievously stink. Of the townsmen, these +were wounded, namely, my Lord Reason; he was wounded in the head. +Another that was wounded was the brave Lord Mayor; he was wounded +in the eye. Another that was wounded was Mr. Mind; he received his +wound about the stomach. The honest subordinate preacher also, he +received a shot not far off the heart but none of these were +mortal. + +Many also of the inferior sort were not only wounded but slain +outright. + +Now, in the camp of Diabolus were wounded and slain a considerable +number; for instance, Captain Rage, he was wounded, and so was +Captain Cruel. Captain Damnation was made to retreat, and to +intrench himself further off of Mansoul. The standard also of +Diabolus was beaten down, and his standard-bearer, Captain Much- +Hurt, had his brains beat out with a sling-stone, to the no little +grief and shame of his prince Diabolus. + +Many also of the doubters were slain outright, though enough of +them were left alive to make Mansoul shake and totter. Now the +victory that day being turned to Mansoul, did put great valour into +the townsmen and captains, and did cover Diabolus's camp with a +cloud, but withal it made them far more furious. So the next day +Mansoul rested, and commanded that the bells should be rung; the +trumpets also joyfully sounded, and the captains shouted round the +town. + +My Lord Willbewill also was not idle, but did notable service +within against the domestics, or the Diabolonians that were in the +town, not only by keeping them in awe, for he lighted on one at +last whose name was Mr. Anything, a fellow of whom mention was made +before; for it was he, if you remember, that brought the three +fellows to Diabolus, whom the Diabolonians took out of Captain +Boanerges's companies, and that persuaded them to list themselves +under the tyrant, to fight against the army of Shaddai. My Lord +Willbewill did also take a notable Diabolonian, whose name was +Loose-Foot: this Loose-Foot was a scout to the vagabonds in +Mansoul, and that did use to carry tidings out of Mansoul to the +camp, and out of the camp to those of the enemies in Mansoul. Both +these my lord sent away safe to Mr. True-Man, the gaoler, with a +commandment to keep them in irons; for he intended then to have +them out to be crucified, when it would be for the best to the +corporation, and most for the discouragement of the camp of the +enemies. + +My Lord Mayor also, though he could not stir about so much as +formerly, because of the wound that he lately received, yet gave he +out orders to all that were the natives of Mansoul, to look to +their watch, and stand upon their guard, and, as occasion should +offer, to prove themselves men. + +Mr. Conscience, the preacher, he also did his utmost to keep all +his good documents alive upon the hearts of the people of Mansoul. + +Well, awhile after, the captains and stout ones of the town of +Mansoul agreed and resolved upon a time to make a sally out upon +the camp of Diabolus, and this must be done in the night; and there +was the folly of Mansoul, (for the night is always the best for the +enemy, but the worst for Mansoul to fight in,) but yet they would +do it, their courage was so high; their last victory also still +stuck in their memories. + +So the night appointed being come, the Prince's brave captains cast +lots who should lead the van in this new and desperate expedition +against Diabolus, and against his Diabolonian army; and the lot +fell to Captain Credence, to Captain Experience, and to Captain +Good-Hope, to lead the forlorn hope. (This Captain Experience the +Prince created such when himself did reside in the town of +Mansoul.) So, as I said, they made their sally out upon the army +that lay in the siege against them; and their hap was to fall in +with the main body of their enemies. Now Diabolus and his men +being expertly accustomed to night-work, took the alarm presently, +and were as ready to give them battle, as if they had sent them +word of their coming. Wherefore to it they went amain, and blows +were hard on every side; the hell drum also was beat most +furiously, while the trumpets of the Prince most sweetly sounded. +And thus the battle was joined; and Captain Insatiable looked to +the enemy's carriages, and waited when he should receive some prey. + +The Prince's captains fought it stoutly, beyond what indeed could +be expected they should; they wounded many; they made the whole +army of Diabolus to make a retreat. But I cannot tell how, but the +brave Captain Credence, Captain Good-Hope, and Captain Experience, +as they were upon the pursuit, cutting down, and following hard +after the enemy in the rear, Captain Credence stumbled and fell, by +which fall he caught so great a hurt, that he could not rise till +Captain Experience did help him up, at which their men were put in +disorder. The captain also was so full of pain, that he could not +forbear but aloud to cry out: at this, the other two captains +fainted, supposing that Captain Credence had received his mortal +wound; their men also were more disordered, and had no list to +fight. Now Diabolus being very observing, though at this time as +yet he was put to the worst, perceiving that a halt was made among +the men that were the pursuers, what does he but, taking it for +granted that the captains were either wounded or dead, he therefore +makes at first a stand, then faces about, and so comes up upon the +Prince's army with as much of his fury as hell could help him to; +and his hap was to fall in just among the three captains, Captain +Credence, Captain Good-Hope, and Captain Experience, and did cut, +wound, and pierce them so dreadfully, that what through +discouragement, what through disorder, and what through the wounds +that they had received, and also the loss of much blood, they +scarce were able, though they had for their power the three best +hands in Mansoul, to get safe into the hold again. + +Now, when the body of the Prince's army saw how these three +captains were put to the worst, they thought it their wisdom to +make as safe and good a retreat as they could, and so returned by +the sally-port again; and so there was an end of this present +action. But Diabolus was so flushed with this night's work, that +he promised himself, in few days, an easy and complete conquest +over the town of Mansoul; wherefore, on the day following, he comes +up to the sides thereof with great boldness, and demands entrance, +and that forthwith they deliver themselves up to his government. +The Diabolonians, too, that were within, they began to be somewhat +brisk, as we shall show afterward. + +But the valiant Lord Mayor replied, that what he got he must get by +force; for as long as Emmanuel, their Prince, was alive, (though he +at present was not so with them as they wished,) they should never +consent to yield Mansoul up to another. + +And with that the Lord Willbewill stood up, and said, 'Diabolus, +thou master of the den, and enemy to all that is good, we poor +inhabitants of the town of Mansoul are too well acquainted with thy +rule and government, and with the end of those things that for +certain will follow submitting to thee, to do it. Wherefore though +while we were without knowledge we suffered thee to take us, (as +the bird that saw not the snare fell into the hands of the fowler,) +yet since we have been turned from darkness to light, we have also +been turned from the power of Satan to God. And though through thy +subtlety, and also the subtlety of the Diabolonians within, we have +sustained much loss, and also plunged ourselves into much +perplexity, yet give up ourselves, lay down our arms, and yield to +so horrid a tyrant as thou, we shall not; die upon the place we +choose rather to do. Besides, we have hopes that in time +deliverance will come from court unto us, and therefore we yet will +maintain a war against thee.' + +This brave speech of the Lord Willbewill, with that also of the +Lord Mayor, did somewhat abate the boldness of Diabolus, though it +kindled the fury of his rage. It also succoured the townsmen and +captains; yea, it was as a plaster to the brave Captain Credence's +wound; for you must know that a brave speech now (when the captains +of the town with their men of war came home routed, and when the +enemy took courage and boldness at the success that he had obtained +to draw up to the walls, and demand entrance, as he did) was in +season, and also advantageous. + +The Lord Willbewill also did play the man within; for while the +captains and soldiers were in the field, he was in arms in the +town, and wherever by him there was a Diabolonian found, they were +forced to feel the weight of his heavy hand, and also the edge of +his penetrating sword: many therefore of the Diabolonians he +wounded, as the Lord Cavil, the Lord Brisk, the Lord Pragmatic, and +the Lord Murmur; several also of the meaner sort he did sorely +maim; though there cannot at this time an account be given you of +any that he slew outright. The cause, or rather the advantage that +my Lord Willbewill had at this time to do thus, was for that the +captains were gone out to fight the enemy in the field. 'For now,' +thought the Diabolonians within, 'is our time to stir and make an +uproar in the town.' What do they therefore but quickly get +themselves into a body, and fall forthwith to hurricaning in +Mansoul, as if now nothing but whirlwind and tempest should be +there. Wherefore, as I said, he takes this opportunity to fall in +among them with his men, cutting and slashing with courage that was +undaunted; at which the Diabolonians with all haste dispersed +themselves to their holds, and my lord to his place as before. + +This brave act of my lord did somewhat revenge the wrong done by +Diabolus to the captains, and also did let them know that Mansoul +was not to be parted with for the loss of a victory or two; +wherefore the wing of the tyrant was clipped again, as to +boasting,--I mean in comparison of what he would have done, if the +Diabolonians had put the town to the same plight to which he had +put the captains. + +Well, Diabolus yet resolves to have the other bout with Mansoul. +'For,' thought he, 'since I beat them once, I may beat them twice.' +Wherefore he commanded his men to be ready at such an hour of the +night, to make a fresh assault upon the town; and he gave it out in +special that they should bend all their force against Feel-gate, +and attempt to break into the town through that. The word that +then he did give to his officers and soldiers was Hell-fire. +'And,' said he, 'if we break in upon them, as I wish we do, either +with some, or with all our force, let them that break in look to +it, that they forget not the word. And let nothing be heard in the +town of Mansoul but, "Hell-fire! Hell-fire! Hell-fire!"' The +drummer was also to beat without ceasing, and the standard-bearers +were to display their colours; the soldiers, too, were to put on +what courage they could, and to see that they played manfully their +parts against the town. + +So when night was come, and all things by the tyrant made ready for +the work, he suddenly makes his assault upon Feel-gate, and after +he had awhile struggled there, he throws the gate wide open: for +the truth is, those gates were but weak, and so most easily made to +yield. When Diabolus had thus far made his attempt, he placed his +captains (namely, Torment and No-Ease) there; so he attempted to +press forward, but the Prince's captains came down upon him, and +made his entrance more difficult than he desired. And, to speak +truth, they made what resistance they could; but the three of their +best and most valiant captains being wounded, and by their wounds +made much incapable of doing the town that service they would, (and +all the rest having more than their hands full of the doubters, and +their captains that did follow Diabolus,) they were overpowered +with force, nor could they keep them out of the town. Wherefore +the Prince's men and their captains betook themselves to the +castle, as to the stronghold of the town: and this they did partly +for their own security, partly for the security of the town, and +partly, or rather chiefly, to preserve to Emmanuel the prerogative- +royal of Mansoul; for so was the castle of Mansoul. + +The captains therefore being fled into the castle, the enemy, +without much resistance, possess themselves of the rest of the +town, and spreading themselves as they went into every corner, they +cried out as they marched, according to the command of the tyrant, +'Hell-fire! Hell-fire! Hell-fire!' so that nothing for a while +throughout the town of Mansoul could be heard but the direful noise +of 'Hell-fire!' together with the roaring of Diabolus's drum. And +now did the clouds hang black over Mansoul, nor to reason did +anything but ruin seem to attend it. Diabolus also quartered his +soldiers in the houses of the inhabitants of the town of Mansoul. +Yea, the subordinate preacher's house was as full of these +outlandish doubters as ever it could hold, and so was my Lord +Mayor's, and my Lord Willbewill's also. Yea, where was there a +corner, a cottage, a barn, or a hogstye, that now was not full of +these vermin? Yea, they turned the men of the town out of their +houses, and would lie in their beds, and sit at their tables +themselves. Ah, poor Mansoul! now thou feelest the fruits of sin, +yea, what venom was in the flattering words of Mr. Carnal-Security! +They made great havoc of whatever they laid their hands on; yea, +they fired the town in several places; many young children also +were by them dashed in pieces; and those that were yet unborn they +destroyed in their mothers' wombs: for you must needs think that +it could not now be otherwise; for what conscience, what pity, what +bowels of compassion can any expect at the hands of outlandish +doubters? Many in Mansoul that were women, both young and old, +they forced, ravished, and beastlike abused, so that they swooned, +miscarried, and many of them died, and so lay at the top of every +street, and in all by-places of the town. + +And now did Mansoul seem to be nothing but a den of dragons, an +emblem of hell, and a place of total darkness. Now did Mansoul lie +almost like the barren wilderness; nothing but nettles, briars, +thorns, weeds, and stinking things seemed now to cover the face of +Mansoul. I told you before, how that these Diabolonian doubters +turned the men of Mansoul out of their beds, and now I will add, +they wounded them, they mauled them, yea, and almost brained many +of them. Many did I say, yea most, if not all of them. Mr. +Conscience they so wounded, yea, and his wounds so festered, that +he could have no ease day nor night, but lay as if continually upon +a rack; but that Shaddai rules all, certainly they had slain him +outright. Mr. Lord Mayor they so abused that they almost put out +his eyes; and had not my Lord Willbewill got into the castle, they +intended to have chopped him all to pieces; for they did look upon +him, as his heart now stood, to be one of the very worst that was +in Mansoul against Diabolus and his crew. And indeed he hath shown +himself a man, and more of his exploits you will hear of +afterwards. + +Now, a man might have walked for days together in Mansoul, and +scarcely have seen one in the town that looked like a religious +man. Oh, the fearful state of Mansoul now! now every corner +swarmed with outlandish doubters; red-coats and black-coats walked +the town by clusters, and filled up all the houses with hideous +noises, vain songs, lying stories, and blasphemous language against +Shaddai and his Son. Now also those Diabolonians that lurked in +the walls and dens and holes that were in the town of Mansoul, came +forth and showed themselves; yea, walked with open face in company +with the doubters that were in Mansoul. Yea, they had more +boldness now to walk the streets, to haunt the houses, and to show +themselves abroad, than had any of the honest inhabitants of the +now woful town of Mansoul. + +But Diabolus and his outlandish men were not at peace in Mansoul; +for they were not there entertained as were the captains and forces +of Emmanuel: the townsmen did browbeat them what they could; nor +did they partake or make stroy of any of the necessaries of +Mansoul, but that which they seized on against the townsmen's will: +what they could, they hid from them, and what they could not, they +had with an ill-will. They, poor hearts! had rather have had their +room than their company; but they were at present their captives, +and their captives for the present they were forced to be. But, I +say, they discountenanced them as much as they were able, and +showed them all the dislike that they could. + +The captains also from the castle did hold them in continual play +with their slings, to the chafing and fretting of the minds of the +enemies. True, Diabolus made a great many attempts to have broken +open the gates of the castle, but Mr. Godly-Fear was made the +keeper of that; and he was a man of that courage, conduct, and +valour, that it was in vain, as long as life lasted within him, to +think to do that work, though mostly desired; wherefore all the +attempts that Diabolus made against him were fruitless. I have +wished sometimes that that man had had the whole rule of the town +of Mansoul. + +Well, this was the condition of the town of Mansoul for about two +years and a half: the body of the town was the seat of war, the +people of the town were driven into holes, and the glory of Mansoul +was laid in the dust. What rest, then, could be to the +inhabitants, what peace could Mansoul have, and what sun could +shine upon it? Had the enemy lain so long without in the plain +against the town, it had been enough to have famished them: but +now, when they shall be within, when the town shall be their tent, +their trench and fort against the castle that was in the town; when +the town shall be against the town, and shall serve to be a defence +to the enemies of her strength and life: I say, when they shall +make use of the forts and town-holds to secure themselves in, even +till they shall take, spoil, and demolish the castle,--this was +terrible! and yet this was now the state of the town of Mansoul. + +After the town of Mansoul had been in this sad and lamentable +condition, for so long a time as I have told you, and no petitions +that they presented their Prince with, all this while, could +prevail, the inhabitants of the town, namely, the elders and chief +of Mansoul, gathered together, and, after some time spent in +condoling their miserable state and this miserable judgment coming +upon them, they agreed together to draw up yet another petition, +and to send it away to Emmanuel for relief. But Mr. Godly-Fear +stood up and answered, that he knew that his Lord the Prince never +did nor ever would receive a petition for these matters, from the +hand of any whoever, unless the Lord Secretary's hand was to it; +'and this,' quoth he, 'is the reason that you prevailed not all +this while.' Then they said they would draw up one, and get the +Lord Secretary's hand unto it. But Mr. Godly-Fear answered again, +that he knew also that the Lord Secretary would not set his hand to +any petition that himself had not an hand in composing and drawing +up. 'And besides,' said he, 'the Prince doth know my Lord +Secretary's hand from all the hands in the world; wherefore he +cannot be deceived by any pretence whatever. Wherefore my advice +is that you go to my Lord, and implore him to lend you his aid.' +(Now he did yet abide in the castle, where all the captains and +men-at-arms were.) + +So they heartily thanked Mr. Godly-Fear, took his counsel, and did +as he had bidden them. So they went and came to my Lord, and made +known the cause of their coming to him; namely, that since Mansoul +was in so deplorable a condition, his Highness would be pleased to +undertake to draw up a petition for them to Emmanuel, the Son of +the mighty Shaddai, and to their King and his Father by him. + +Then said the Secretary to them, 'What petition is it that you +would have me draw up for you?' But they said, 'Our Lord knows +best the state and condition of the town of Mansoul; and how we are +backslidden and degenerated from the Prince: thou also knowest who +is come up to war against us, and how Mansoul is now the seat of +war. My Lord knows, moreover, what barbarous usages our men, +women, and children have suffered at their hands; and how our +homebred Diabolonians do walk now with more boldness than dare the +townsmen in the streets of Mansoul. Let our Lord therefore, +according to the wisdom of God that is in him, draw up a petition +for his poor servants to our Prince Emmanuel.' 'Well,' said the +Lord Secretary, 'I will draw up a petition for you, and will also +set my hand thereto.' Then said they, 'But when shall we call for +it at the hands of our Lord?' But he answered, 'Yourselves must be +present at the doing of it; yea, you must put your desires to it. +True, the hand and pen shall be mine, but the ink and paper must be +yours; else how can you say it is your petition? Nor have I need +to petition for myself, because I have not offended.' He also added +as followeth: 'No petition goes from me in my name to the Prince, +and so to his Father by him, but when the people that are chiefly +concerned therein do join in heart and soul in the matter, for that +must be inserted therein.' + +So they did heartily agree with the sentence of the Lord, and a +petition was forthwith drawn up for them. But now, who should +carry it? that was next. But the Secretary advised that Captain +Credence should carry it; for he was a well-spoken man. They +therefore called for him, and propounded to him the business. +'Well,' said the captain, 'I gladly accept of the motion; and +though I am lame, I will do this business for you with as much +speed, and as well as I can.' + +The contents of the petition were to this purpose + +'O our Lord, and Sovereign Prince Emmanuel, the potent, the long- +suffering Prince! grace is poured into thy lips, and to thee belong +mercy and forgiveness, though we have rebelled against thee. We, +who are no more worthy to be called thy Mansoul, nor yet fit to +partake of common benefits, do beseech thee, and thy Father by +thee, to do away our transgressions. We confess that thou mightest +cast us away for them; but do it not for thy name's sake: let the +Lord rather take an opportunity, at our miserable condition, to let +out his bowels and compassions to us. We are compassed on every +side, Lord; our own backslidings reprove us; our Diabolonians +within our town fright us; and the army of the angel of the +bottomless pit distresses us. Thy grace can be our salvation, and +whither to go but to thee we know not. + +'Furthermore, O gracious Prince, we have weakened our captains, and +they are discouraged, sick, and, of late, some of them grievously +worsted and beaten out of the field by the power and force of the +tyrant. Yea, even those of our captains, in whose valour we did +formerly use to put most of our confidence, they are as wounded +men. Besides, Lord, our enemies are lively, and they are strong; +they vaunt and boast themselves, and do threaten to part us among +themselves for a booty. They are fallen also upon us, Lord, with +many thousand doubters, such as with whom we cannot tell what to +do; they are all grim-looked and unmerciful ones, and they bid +defiance to us and thee. + +'Our wisdom is gone, our power is gone, because thou art departed +from us; nor have we what we may call ours but sin, shame, and +confusion of face for sin. Take pity upon us, O Lord, take pity +upon us, thy miserable town of Mansoul, and save us out of the +hands of our enemies. Amen.' + +This petition, as was touched afore, was handed by the Lord +Secretary, and carried to the court by the brave and most stout +Captain Credence. Now he carried it out at Mouth-gate, (for that, +as I said, was the sally-port of the town,) and he went and came to +Emmanuel with it. Now how it came out, I do not know; but for +certain it did, and that so far as to reach the ears of Diabolus. +Thus I conclude, because that the tyrant had it presently by the +end, and charged the town of Mansoul with it, saying, 'Thou +rebellious and stubborn-hearted Mansoul, I will make thee to leave +off petitioning. Art thou yet for petitioning? I will make thee +to leave.' Yea, he also knew who the messenger was that carried +the petition to the Prince, and it made him both to fear and rage. + +Wherefore he commanded that his drum should be beat again, a thing +that Mansoul could not abide to hear: but when Diabolus will have +his drum beat, Mansoul must abide the noise. Well, the drum was +beat, and the Diabolonians were gathered together. + +Then said Diabolus, 'O ye stout Diabolonians, be it known unto you, +that there is treachery hatched against us in the rebellious town +of Mansoul; for albeit the town is in our possession, as you see, +yet these miserable Mansoulians have attempted to dare, and have +been so hardy as yet to send to the court to Emmanuel for help. +This I give you to understand, that ye may yet know how to carry it +to the wretched town of Mansoul. Wherefore, O my trusty +Diabolonians, I command that yet more and more ye distress this +town of Mansoul, and vex it with your wiles, ravish their women, +deflower their virgins, slay their children, brain their ancients, +fire their town, and what other mischief you can; and let this be +the reward of the Mansoulians from me, for their desperate +rebellions against me.' + +This, you see, was the charge; but something stepped in betwixt +that and execution, for as yet there was but little more done than +to rage. + +Moreover, when Diabolus had done thus, he went the next way up to +the castle gates, and demanded that, upon pain of death, the gates +should be opened to him, and that entrance should be given him and +his men that followed after. To whom Mr. Godly-Fear replied, (for +he it was that had the charge of that gate,) that the gate should +not be opened unto him, nor to the men that followed after him. He +said, moreover, that Mansoul, when she had suffered awhile, should +be made perfect, strengthened, settled. + +Then said Diabolus, 'Deliver me, then, the men that have petitioned +against me, especially Captain Credence, that carried it to your +Prince; deliver that varlet into my hands, and I will depart from +the town.' + +Then up starts a Diabolonian, whose name was Mr. Fooling, and said, +'My lord offereth you fair: it is better for you that one man +perish, than that your whole Mansoul should be undone.' + +But Mr. Godly-Fear made him this replication, 'How long will +Mansoul be kept out of the dungeon, when she hath given up her +faith to Diabolus! As good lose the town, as lose Captain +Credence; for if one be gone the other must follow.' But to that +Mr. Fooling said nothing. + +Then did my Lord Mayor reply, and said, 'O thou devouring tyrant, +be it known unto thee, we shall hearken to none of thy words; we +are resolved to resist thee as long as a captain, a man, a sling, +and a stone to throw at thee shall be found in the town of +Mansoul.' But Diabolus answered, 'Do you hope, do you wait, do you +look for help and deliverance? You have sent to Emmanuel, but your +wickedness sticks too close in your skirts, to let innocent prayers +come out of your lips. Think you that you shall be prevailers and +prosper in this design? You will fail in your wish, you will fail +in your attempts; for it is not only I, but your Emmanuel is +against you: yea, it is he that hath sent me against you to subdue +you. For what, then, do you hope? or by what means will you +escape?' + +Then said the Lord Mayor, 'We have sinned indeed; but that shall be +no help to thee, for our Emmanuel hath said it, and that in great +faithfulness, "and him that cometh to me I will in no wise cast +out." He hath also told us, O our enemy, that "all manner of sin +and blasphemy shall be forgiven" to the sons of men. Therefore we +dare not despair, but will look for, wait for, and hope for +deliverance still.' + +Now, by this time, Captain Credence was returned and come from the +court from Emmanuel to the castle of Mansoul, and he returned to +them with a packet. So my Lord Mayor, hearing that Captain +Credence was come, withdrew himself from the noise of the roaring +of the tyrant, and left him to yell at the wall of the town, or +against the gates of the castle. So he came up to the captain's +lodgings, and saluting him, he asked him of his welfare, and what +was the best news at court. But when he asked Captain Credence +that, the water stood in his eyes. Then said the captain, 'Cheer +up, my lord, for all will be well in time.' And with that he first +produced his packet, and laid it by; but that the Lord Mayor, and +the rest of the captains, took for sign of good tidings. Now a +season of grace being come, he sent for all the captains and elders +of the town, that were here and there in their lodgings in the +castle and upon their guard, to let them know that Captain Credence +was returned from the court, and that he had something in general, +and something in special, to communicate to them. So they all came +up to him, and saluted him, and asked him concerning his journey, +and what was the best news at the court. And he answered them as +he had done the Lord Mayor before, that all would be well at last. +Now, when the captain had thus saluted them, he opened his packet, +and thence did draw out his several notes for those that he had +sent for. + +And the first note was for my Lord Mayor, wherein was signified:- +That the Prince Emmanuel had taken it well that my Lord Mayor had +been so true and trusty in his office, and the great concerns that +lay upon him for the town and people of Mansoul. Also, he bid him +to know, that he took it well that he had been so bold for his +Prince Emmanuel, and had engaged so faithfully in his cause against +Diabolus. He also signified, at the close of his letter, that he +should shortly receive his reward. + +The second note that came out, was for the noble Lord Willbewill, +wherein there was signified:- That his Prince Emmanuel did well +understand how valiant and courageous he had been for the honour of +his Lord, now in his absence, and when his name was under contempt +by Diabolus. There was signified also, that his Prince had taken +it well that he had been so faithful to the town of Mansoul, in his +keeping of so strict a hand and eye over and so strict a rein upon +the neck of the Diabolonians, that did still lie lurking in their +several holes in the famous town of Mansoul. He signified, +moreover, how that he understood that my Lord had, with his own +hand, done great execution upon some of the chief of the rebels +there, to the great discouragement of the adverse party and to the +good example of the whole town of Mansoul; and that shortly his +lordship should have his reward. + +The third note came out for the subordinate preacher, wherein was +signified:- That his Prince took it well from him, that he had so +honestly and so faithfully performed his office, and executed the +trust committed to him by his Lord, while he exhorted, rebuked, and +forewarned Mansoul according to the laws of the town. He +signified, moreover, that he took it well at his hand that he +called to fasting, to sackcloth, and ashes, when Mansoul was under +her revolt. Also, that he called for the aid of the Captain +Boanerges to help in so weighty a work; and that shortly he also +should receive his reward. + +The fourth note came out for Mr. Godly-Fear, wherein his Lord thus +signified:- That his Lordship observed, that he was the first of +all the men in Mansoul that detected Mr. Carnal-Security as the +only one that, through his subtlety and cunning, had obtained for +Diabolus a defection and decay of goodness in the blessed town of +Mansoul. Moreover, his Lord gave him to understand, that he still +remembered his tears and mourning for the state of Mansoul. It was +also observed, by the same note, that his Lord took notice of his +detecting of this Mr. Carnal-Security, at his own table among his +guests, in his own house, and that in the midst of his jolliness, +even while he was seeking to perfect his villanies against the town +of Mansoul. Emmanuel also took notice that this reverend person, +Mr. Godly-Fear, stood stoutly to it, at the gates of the castle, +against all the threats and attempts of the tyrant; and that he had +put the townsmen in a way to make their petition to their Prince, +so as that he might accept thereof, and as they might obtain an +answer of peace; and that therefore shortly he should receive his +reward. + +After all this, there was yet produced a note which was written to +the whole town of Mansoul, whereby they perceived--That their Lord +took notice of their so often repeating of petitions to him; and +that they should see more of the fruits of such their doings in +time to come. Their Prince did also therein tell them, that he +took it well, that their heart and mind, now at last, abode fixed +upon him and his ways, though Diabolus had made such inroads upon +them; and that neither flatteries on the one hand, nor hardships on +the other, could make them yield to serve his cruel designs. There +was also inserted at the bottom of this note--That his Lordship had +left the town of Mansoul in the hands of the Lord Secretary, and +under the conduct of Captain Credence, saying, 'Beware that you yet +yield yourselves unto their governance; and in due time you shall +receive your reward.' + +So, after the brave Captain Credence had delivered his notes to +those to whom they belonged, he retired himself to my Lord +Secretary's lodgings, and there spends time in conversing with him; +for they too were very great one with another, and did indeed know +more how things would go with Mansoul than did all the townsmen +besides. The Lord Secretary also loved the Captain Credence +dearly; yea, many a good bit was sent him from my Lord's table; +also, he might have a show of countenance, when the rest of Mansoul +lay under the clouds: so, after some time for converse was spent, +the captain betook himself to his chambers to rest. But it was not +long after when my Lord did send for the captain again; so the +captain came to him, and they greeted one another with usual +salutations. Then said the captain to the Lord Secretary, 'What +hath my Lord to say to his servant?' So the Lord Secretary took +him and had him aside, and after a sign or two of more favour, he +said, 'I have made thee the Lord's lieutenant over all the forces +in Mansoul; so that, from this day forward, all men in Mansoul +shall be at thy word; and thou shalt be he that shall lead in, and +that shall lead out Mansoul. Thou shalt therefore manage, +according to thy place, the war for thy Prince, and for the town of +Mansoul, against the force and power of Diabolus; and at thy +command shall the rest of the captains be.' + +Now the townsmen began to perceive what interest the captain had, +both with the court, and also with the Lord Secretary in Mansoul; +for no man before could speed when sent, nor bring such good news +from Emmanuel as he. Wherefore what do they, after some +lamentation that they made no more use of him in their distresses, +but send by their subordinate preacher to the Lord Secretary, to +desire him that all that ever they were and had might be put under +the government, care, custody, and conduct of Captain Credence. + +So their preacher went and did his errand, and received this answer +from the mouth of his Lord: that Captain Credence should be the +great doer in all the King's army, against the King's enemies, and +also for the welfare of Mansoul. So he bowed to the ground, and +thanked his Lordship, and returned and told his news to the +townsfolk. But all this was done with all imaginable secrecy, +because the foes had yet great strength in the town. But to return +to our story again. + +When Diabolus saw himself thus boldly confronted by the Lord Mayor, +and perceived the stoutness of Mr. Godly-Fear, he fell into a rage, +and forthwith called a council of war, that he might be revenged on +Mansoul. So all the princes of the pit came together, and old +Incredulity at the head of them, with all the captains of his army. +So they consult what to do. Now the effect and conclusion of the +council that day was how they might take the castle, because they +could not conclude themselves masters of the town so long as that +was in the possession of their enemies. + +So one advised this way, and another advised that; but when they +could not agree in their verdict, Apollyon, that president of the +council, stood up, and thus he began: 'My brotherhood,' quoth he, +'I have two things to propound unto you; and my first is this. Let +us withdraw ourselves from the town into the plain again, for our +presence here will do us no good, because the castle is yet in our +enemies' hands; nor is it possible that we should take that, so +long as so many brave captains are in it, and that this bold +fellow, Godly-Fear, is made the keeper of the gates of it. Now, +when we have withdrawn ourselves into the plain, they, of their own +accord, will be glad of some little ease; and it may be, of their +own accord, they again may begin to be remiss, and even their so +being will give them a bigger blow than we can possibly give them +ourselves. But if that should fail, our going forth of the town +may draw the captains out after us; and you know what it cost them +when we fought them in the field before. Besides, can we but draw +them out into the field, we may lay an ambush behind the town, +which shall, when they are come forth abroad, rush in and take +possession of the castle.' + +But Beelzebub stood up, and replied, saying: 'It is impossible to +draw them all off from the castle; some, you may be sure, will lie +there to keep that; wherefore it will be but in vain thus to +attempt, unless we were sure that they will all come out.' He +therefore concluded that what was done must be done by some other +means. And the most likely means that the greatest of their heads +could invent, was that which Apollyon had advised to before, +namely, to get the townsmen again to sin. 'For,' said he, 'it is +not our being in the town, nor in the field, nor our fighting, nor +our killing of their men, that can make us the masters of Mansoul; +for so long as one in the town is able to lift up his finger +against us, Emmanuel will take their parts; and if he shall take +their parts, we know what time of day it will be with us. +Wherefore, for my part,' quoth he, 'there is, in my judgment, no +way to bring them into bondage to us, like inventing a way to make +them sin. Had we,' said he, 'left all our doubters at home, we had +done as well as we have done now, unless we could have made them +the masters and governors of the castle; for doubters at a distance +are but like objections refelled with arguments. Indeed, can we +but get them into the hold, and make them possessors of that, the +day will be our own. Let us, therefore, withdraw ourselves into +the plain, (not expecting that the captains in Mansoul should +follow us,) but yet, I say, let us do this, and before we so do, +let us advise again with our trusty Diabolonians that are yet in +their holds of Mansoul, and set them to work to betray the town to +us; for they indeed must do it, or it will be left undone for +ever.' By these sayings of Beelzebub, (for I think it was he that +gave this counsel,) the whole conclave was forced to be of his +opinion, namely, that the way to get the castle was to get the town +to sin. Then they fell to inventing by what means they might do +this thing. + +Then Lucifer stood up, and said: 'The counsel of Beelzebub is +pertinent. Now, the way to bring this to pass, in mine opinion, is +this: let us withdraw our force from the town of Mansoul; let us +do this, and let us terrify them no more, either with summons, or +threats, or with the noise of our drum, or any other awakening +means. Only let us lie in the field at a distance, and be as if we +regarded them not; for frights, I see, do but awaken them, and make +them more stand to their arms. I have also another stratagem in my +head: you know Mansoul is a market-town, and a town that delights +in commerce; what, therefore, if some of our Diabolonians shall +feign themselves far-country men, and shall go out and bring to the +market of Mansoul some of our wares to sell; and what matter at +what rates they sell their wares, though it be but for half the +worth? Now, let those that thus shall trade in their market be +those that are witty and true to us, and I will lay my crown to +pawn it will do. There are two that are come to my thoughts +already, that I think will be arch at this work, and they are Mr. +Penny-wise-pound-foolish, and Mr. Get-i'the-hundred-and-lose-i'the- +shire; nor is this man with the long name at all inferior to the +other. What, also, if you join with them Mr. Sweet-world and Mr. +Present-good; they are men that are civil and cunning, but our true +friends and helpers. Let these, with as many more, engage in this +business for us, and let Mansoul be taken up in much business, and +let them grow full and rich, and this is the way to get ground of +them. Remember ye not that thus we prevailed upon Laodicea, and +how many at present do we hold in this snare? Now, when they begin +to grow full, they will forget their misery; and if we shall not +affright them, they may happen to fall asleep, and so be got to +neglect their town watch, their castle watch, as well as their +watch at the gates. + +'Yea, may we not, by this means, so cumber Mansoul with abundance, +that they shall be forced to make of their castle a warehouse, +instead of a garrison fortified against us, and a receptacle for +men of war. Thus, if we get our goods and commodities thither, I +reckon that the castle is more than half ours. Besides, could we +so order it that it shall be filled with such kind of wares, then +if we made a sudden assault upon them, it would be hard for the +captains to take shelter there. Do you not know that of the +parable, "The deceitfulness of riches choke the word"? and again, +"When the heart is over-charged with surfeiting and drunkenness, +and the cares of this life," all mischief comes upon them at +unawares? + +'Furthermore, my lords,' quoth he, 'you very well know that it is +not easy for a people to be filled with our things, and not to have +some of our Diabolonians as retainers to their houses and services. +Where is a Mansoulian that is full of this world, that has not for +his servants and waiting-men, Mr. Profuse, or Mr. Prodigality, or +some other of our Diabolonian gang, as Mr. Voluptuous, Mr. +Pragmatical, Mr. Ostentation, or the like? Now these can take the +castle of Mansoul, or blow it up, or make it unfit for a garrison +for Emmanuel, and any of these will do. Yea, these, for aught I +know, may do it for us sooner than an army of twenty thousand men. +Wherefore, to end as I began, my advice is, that we quietly +withdraw ourselves, not offering any further force, or forcible +attempts, upon the castle, at least at this time; and let us set on +foot our new project, and let us see if that will not make them +destroy themselves.' + +This advice was highly applauded by them all, and was accounted the +very masterpiece of hell, namely, to choke Mansoul with a fulness +of this world, and to surfeit her heart with the good things +thereof. But see how things meet together! Just as this +Diabolonian council was broken up, Captain Credence received a +letter from Emmanuel, the contents of which were these: That upon +the third day he would meet him in the field in the plains about +Mansoul. 'Meet me in the field!' quoth the Captain; 'what meaneth +my lord by this? I know not what he meaneth by meeting me in the +field.' So he took the note in his hand, and did carry it to my +Lord Secretary, to ask his thoughts thereupon; for my Lord was a +seer in all matters concerning the King, and also for the good and +comfort of the town of Mansoul. So he showed my Lord the note, and +desired his opinion thereof. 'For my part,' quoth Captain +Credence, 'I know not the meaning thereof.' So my lord did take +and read it and, after a little pause, he said, 'The Diabolonians +have had against Mansoul a great consultation to-day; they have, I +say, this day been contriving the utter ruin of the town; and the +result of their council is, to set Mansoul into such a way which, +if taken, will surely make her destroy herself. And, to this end, +they are making ready for their own departure out of the town, +intending to betake themselves to the field again,' and there to +lie till they shall see whether this their project will take or no. +But be thou ready with the men of thy Lord, (for on the third day +they will be in the plain,) there to fall upon the Diabolonians; +for the Prince will by that time be in the field; yea, by that it +is break of day, sun-rising, or before, and that with a mighty +force against them. So he shall be before them, and thou shalt be +behind them, and betwixt you both their army shall be destroyed.' + +When Captain Credence heard this, away goes he to the rest of the +captains, and tells them what a note he had a while since received +from the hand of Emmanuel. 'And,' said he, 'that which was dark +therein hath my lord the Lord Secretary expounded unto me.' He +told them, moreover, what by himself and by them must be done to +answer the mind of their Lord. Then were the captains glad; and +Captain Credence commanded that all the King's trumpeters should +ascend to the battlements of the castle, and there, in the audience +of Diabolus and of the whole town of Mansoul, make the best music +that heart could invent. The trumpeters then did as they were +commanded. They got themselves up to the top of the castle, and +thus they began to sound. Then did Diabolus start, and said, 'What +can be the meaning of this? they neither sound Boot-and-saddle, nor +Horse-and-away, nor a charge. What do these madmen mean that yet +they should be so merry and glad?' Then answered one of themselves +and said, 'This is for joy that their Prince Emmanuel is coming to +relieve the town of Mansoul; and to this end he is at the head of +an army, and that this relief is near.' + +The men of Mansoul also were greatly concerned at this melodious +charm of the trumpets; they said, yea, they answered one another, +saying, 'This can be no harm to us; surely this can be no harm to +us.' Then said the Diabolonians, 'What had we best to do?' and it +was answered, 'It was best to quit the town;' and 'that,' said one, +'ye may do in pursuance of your last counsel, and by so doing also +be better able to give the enemy battle, should an army from +without come upon us. So, on the second day, they withdrew +themselves from Mansoul, and abode in the plains without; but they +encamped themselves before Eye-gate, in what terrene and terrible +manner they could. The reason why they would not abide in the town +(besides the reasons that were debated in their late conclave) was, +for that they were not possessed of the stronghold, and 'because,' +said they, 'we shall have more convenience to fight, and also to +fly, if need be, when we are encamped in the open plains.' +Besides, the town would have been a pit for them rather than a +place of defence, had the Prince come up and inclosed them fast +therein. Therefore they betook themselves to the field, that they +might also be out of the reach of the slings, by which they were +much annoyed all the while that they were in the town. + +Well, the time that the captains were to fall upon the Diabolonians +being come, they eagerly prepared themselves for action; for +Captain Credence had told the captains over night, that they should +meet their Prince in the field to-morrow. This, therefore, made +them yet far more desirous to be engaging the enemy; for 'You shall +see the Prince in the field to-morrow' was like oil to a flaming +fire, for of a long time they had been at a distance: they +therefore were for this the more earnest and desirous of the work. +So, as I said, the hour being come, Captain Credence, with the rest +of the men of war, drew out their forces before it was day by the +sally-port of the town. And, being all ready, Captain Credence +went up to the head of the army, and gave to the rest of the +captains the word, and so they to their under-officers and +soldiers: the word was 'The sword of the Prince Emmanuel, and the +shield of Captain Credence;' which is, in the Mansoulian tongue, +'The word of God and faith.' Then the captains fell on, and began +roundly to front, and flank, and rear Diabolus's camp. + +Now, they left Captain Experience in the town, because he was yet +ill of his wounds, which the Diabolonians had given him in the last +fight. But when he perceived that the captains were at it, what +does he but, calling for his crutches with haste, gets up, and away +he goes to the battle, saying, 'Shall I lie here, when my brethren +are in the fight, and when Emmanuel, the Prince, will show himself +in the field to his servants?' But when the enemy saw the man come +with his crutches, they were daunted yet the more; 'for,' thought +they, 'what spirit has possessed these Mansoulians, that they fight +us upon their crutches?' Well, the captains, as I said, fell on, +and did bravely handle their weapons, still crying out and +shouting, as they laid on blows, 'The sword of the Prince Emmanuel, +and the shield of Captain Credence!' + +Now, when Diabolus saw that the captains were come out, and that so +valiantly they surrounded his men, he concluded that, for the +present, nothing from them was to be looked for but blows, and the +dints of their 'two-edged sword.' + +Wherefore he also falls on upon the Prince's army with all his +deadly force: so the battle was joined. Now who was it that at +first Diabolus met with in the fight, but Captain Credence on the +one hand, and the Lord Willbewill on the other: now Willbewill's +blows were like the blows of a giant, for that man had a strong +arm, and he fell in upon the election doubters, for they were the +life-guard of Diabolus, and he kept them in play a good while, +cutting and battering shrewdly. Now when Captain Credence saw my +lord engaged, he did stoutly fall on, on the other hand, upon the +same company also; so they put them to great disorder. Now Captain +Good-Hope had engaged the vocation doubters, and they were sturdy +men; but the captain was a valiant man: Captain Experience did +also send him some aid; so he made the vocation doubters to +retreat. The rest of the armies were hotly engaged, and that on +every side, and the Diabolonians did fight stoutly. Then did my +Lord Secretary command that the slings from the castle should be +played; and his men could throw stones at an hair's breadth. But, +after a while, those that were made to fly before the captains of +the Prince, did begin to rally again, and they came up stoutly upon +the rear of the Prince's army: wherefore the Prince's army began +to faint; but, remembering that they should see the face of their +Prince by-and-by, they took courage, and a very fierce battle was +fought. Then shouted the captains, saying, 'The sword of the +Prince Emmanuel, and the shield of Captain Credence!' and with that +Diabolus gave back, thinking that more aid had been come. But no +Emmanuel as yet appeared. Moreover, the battle did hang in doubt; +and they made a little retreat on both sides. Now, in the time of +respite, Captain Credence bravely encouraged his men to stand to +it; and Diabolus did the like, as well as he could. But Captain +Credence made a brave speech to his soldiers, the contents whereof +here follow:- + +'Gentlemen soldiers, and my brethren in this design, it rejoiceth +me much to see in the field for our Prince, this day, so stout and +so valiant an army, and such faithful lovers of Mansoul. You have +hitherto, as hath become you, shown yourselves men of truth and +courage against the Diabolonian forces; so that, for all their +boast, they have not yet much cause to boast of their gettings. +Now take to yourselves your wonted courage, and show yourselves men +even this once only; for in a few minutes after the next +engagement, this time, you shall see your Prince show himself in +the field; for we must make this second assault upon this tyrant +Diabolus, and then Emmanuel comes.' + +No sooner had the captain made this speech to his soldiers, but one +Mr. Speedy came post to the captain from the Prince, to tell him +that Emmanuel was at hand. This news when the captain had +received, he communicated to the other field-officers, and they +again to their soldiers and men of war. Wherefore, like men raised +from the dead, so the captains and their men arose, made up to the +enemy, and cried as before, 'The sword of the Prince Emmanuel, and +the shield of Captain Credence!' + +The Diabolonians also bestirred themselves, and made resistance as +well as they could; but in this last engagement the Diabolonians +lost their courage, and many of the doubters fell down dead to the +ground. Now, when they had been in heat of battle about an hour or +more, Captain Credence lift up his eyes and saw, and, behold, +Emmanuel came; and he came with colours flying, trumpets sounding, +and the feet of his men scarce touched the ground, they hasted with +that celerity towards the captains that were engaged. Then did +Credence wind with his men to the townward, and gave to Diabolus +the field: so Emmanuel came upon him on the one side, and the +enemies' place was betwixt them both. Then again they fell to it +afresh; and now it was but a little while more but Emmanuel and +Captain Credence met, still trampling down the slain as they came. + +But when the captains saw that the Prince was come, and that he +fell upon the Diabolonians on the other side, and that Captain +Credence and his Highness had got them up betwixt them, they +shouted, (they so shouted that the ground rent again,) saying, 'The +sword of Emmanuel, and the shield of Captain Credence!' Now, when +Diabolus saw that he and his forces were so hard beset by the +Prince and his princely army, what does he, and the lords of the +pit that were with him, but make their escape, and forsake their +army, and leave them to fall by the hand of Emmanuel, and of his +noble Captain Credence: so they fell all down slain before them, +before the Prince, and before his royal army; there was not left so +much as one doubter alive; they lay spread upon the ground dead +men, as one would spread dung upon the land. + +When the battle was over, all things came into order in the camp. +Then the captains and elders of Mansoul came together to salute +Emmanuel, while without the corporation: so they saluted him, and +welcomed him, and that with a thousand welcomes, for that he was +come to the borders of Mansoul again. So he smiled upon them, and +said, 'Peace be to you.' Then they addressed themselves to go to +the town; they went then to go up to Mansoul, they, the Prince, +with all the new forces that now he had brought with him to the +war. Also all the gates of the town were set open for his +reception, so glad were they of his blessed return. And this was +the manner and order of this going of his into Mansoul: + +First. As I said, all the gates of the town were set open, yea, +the gates of the castle also; the elders, too, of the town of +Mansoul placed themselves at the gates of the town, to salute him +at his entrance thither: and so they did; for, as he drew near, +and approached towards the gates, they said, 'Lift up your heads, O +ye gates; and be ye lift up, ye everlasting doors; and the King of +glory shall come in.' And they answered again, 'Who is the King of +glory?' and they made return to themselves, 'The Lord, strong and +mighty; the Lord mighty in battle. Lift up your heads, O ye gates; +even lift them up, ye everlasting doors,' etc. + +Secondly. It was ordered also, by those of Mansoul, that all the +way from the town gates to those of the castle, his blessed Majesty +should be entertained with the song, by them that had the best +skill in music in all the town of Mansoul: then did the elders, +and the rest of the men of Mansoul, answer one another as Emmanuel +entered the town, till he came at the castle gates, with songs and +sound of trumpets, saying, 'They have seen thy goings, O God; even +the goings of my God, my King, in the sanctuary. So the singers +went before, the players on instruments followed after, and among +them were the damsels playing on timbrels.' + +Thirdly. Then the captains, (for I would speak a word of them,) +they in their order waited on the Prince, as he entered into the +gates of Mansoul. Captain Credence went before, and Captain Good- +Hope with him; Captain Charity came behind with other of his +companions, and Captain Patience followed after all; and the rest +of the captains, some on the right hand, and some on the left, +accompanied Emmanuel into Mansoul. And all the while the colours +were displayed, the trumpets sounded, and continual shoutings were +among the soldiers. The Prince himself rode into the town in his +armour, which was all of beaten gold, and in his chariot--the +pillars of it were of silver, the bottom thereof of gold, the +covering of it was of purple, the midst thereof being paved with +love for the daughters of the town of Mansoul. + +Fourthly. When the Prince was come to the entrance of Mansoul, he +found all the streets strewed with lilies and flowers, curiously +decked with boughs and branches from the green trees that stood +round about the town. Every door also was filled with persons, who +had adorned every one their fore-part against their house with +something of variety and singular excellency, to entertain him +withal as he passed in the streets: they also themselves, as +Emmanuel passed by, did welcome him with shouts and acclamations of +joy, saying, 'Blessed be the Prince that cometh in the name of his +Father Shaddai.' + +Fifthly. At the castle gates the elders of Mansoul, namely, the +Lord Mayor, the Lord Willbewill, the subordinate preacher, Mr. +Knowledge, and Mr. Mind, with other of the gentry of the place, +saluted Emmanuel again. They bowed before him, they kissed the +dust of his feet, they thanked, they blessed, and praised his +Highness for not taking advantage against them for their sins, but +rather had pity upon them in their misery, and returned to them +with mercies, and to build up their Mansoul for ever. Thus was he +had up straightway to the castle; for that was the royal palace, +and the place where his honour was to dwell; the which was ready +prepared for his Highness by the presence of the Lord Secretary, +and the work of Captain Credence. So he entered in. + +Sixthly. Then the people and commonalty of the town of Mansoul +came to him into the castle to mourn, and to weep, and to lament +for their wickedness, by which they had forced him out of the town. +So when they were come, bowed themselves to the ground seven times; +they also wept, they wept aloud, and asked forgiveness of the +Prince, and prayed that he would again, as of old, confirm his love +to Mansoul. + +To the which the great Prince replied, 'Weep not, but go your way, +eat the fat, and drink the sweet, and send portions to them for +whom nought is prepared; for the joy of your Lord is your strength. +I am returned to Mansoul with mercies, and my name shall be set up, +exalted, and magnified by it.' He also took these inhabitants, and +kissed them, and laid them in his bosom. + +Moreover, he gave to the elders of Mansoul, and to each town +officer, a chain of gold and a signet. He also sent to their wives +earrings and jewels, and bracelets, and other things. He also +bestowed upon the true-born children of Mansoul many precious +things. + +When Emmanuel, the Prince, had done all these things for the famous +town of Mansoul, then he said unto them, first, 'Wash your +garments, then put on your ornaments, and then come to me into the +castle of Mansoul.' So they went to the fountain that was set open +for Judah and Jerusalem to wash in; and there they washed, and +there they made their 'garments white,' and came again to the +Prince into the castle, and thus they stood before him. + +And now there was music and dancing throughout the whole town of +Mansoul, and that because their Prince had again granted to them +his presence and the light of his countenance; the bells also did +ring, and the sun shone comfortably upon them for a great while +together. + +The town of Mansoul did also now more thoroughly seek the +destruction and ruin of all remaining Diabolonians that abode in +the walls, and the dens that they had in the town of Mansoul; for +there was of them that had, to this day, escaped with life and limb +from the hand of their suppressors in the famous town of Mansoul. + +But my Lord Willbewill was a greater terror to them now than ever +he had been before; forasmuch as his heart was yet more fully bent +to seek, contrive, and pursue them to the death; he pursued them +night and day, and did put them now to sore distress, as will +afterwards appear. + +After things were thus far put into order in the famous town of +Mansoul, care was taken, and order given by the blessed Prince +Emmanuel, that the townsmen should, without further delay, appoint +some to go forth into the plain to bury the dead that were there,-- +the dead that fell by the sword of Emmanuel, and by the shield of +the Captain Credence,--lest the fumes and ill savours that would +arise from them might infect the air, and so annoy the famous town +of Mansoul. This also was a reason of this order, namely, that, as +much as in Mansoul lay, they might cut off the name, and being, and +remembrance of those enemies from the thought of the famous town of +Mansoul and its inhabitants. + +So order was given out by the Lord Mayor, that wise and trusty +friend of the town of Mansoul, that persons should be employed +about this necessary business; and Mr. Godly-Fear, and one Mr. +Upright, were to be overseers about this matter: so persons were +put under them to work in the fields, and to bury the slain that +lay dead in the plains. And these were their places of employment: +some were to make the graves, some to bury the dead, and some were +to go to and fro in the plains, and also round about the borders of +Mansoul, to see if a skull, or a bone, or a piece of a bone of a +doubter, was yet to be found above ground anywhere near the +corporation; and if any were found, it was ordered, that the +searchers that searched should set up a mark thereby, and a sign, +that those that were appointed to bury them might find it, and bury +it out of sight, that the name and remembrance of a Diabolonian +doubter might be blotted out from under heaven; and that the +children, and they that were to be born in Mansoul, might not know, +if possible, what a skull, what a bone, or a piece of a bone of a +doubter was. So the buriers, and those that were appointed for +that purpose, did as they were commanded: they buried the +doubters, and all the skulls and bones, and pieces of bones of +doubters, wherever they found them; and so they cleansed the +plains. Now also Mr. God's-Peace took up his commission, and acted +again as in former days. + +Thus they buried in the plains about Mansoul the election doubters, +the vocation doubters, the grace doubters, the perseverance +doubters, the resurrection doubters, the salvation doubters, and +the glory doubters; whose captains were Captain Rage, Captain +Cruel, Captain Damnation, Captain Insatiable, Captain Brimstone, +Captain Torment, Captain No-Ease, Captain Sepulchre, and Captain +Past-Hope; and old Incredulity was, under Diabolus, their general. +There were also the seven heads of their army; and they were the +Lord Beelzebub, the Lord Lucifer, the Lord Legion, the Lord +Apollyon, the Lord Python, the Lord Cerberus, and the Lord Belial. +But the princes and the captains, with old Incredulity, their +general, did all of them make their escape: so their men fell down +slain by the power of the Prince's forces, and by the hands of the +men of the town of Mansoul. They also were buried as is afore +related, to the exceeding great joy of the now famous town of +Mansoul. They that buried them buried also with them their arms, +which were cruel instruments of death: (their weapons were arrows, +darts, mauls, firebrands, and the like). They buried also their +armour, their colours, banners, with the standard of Diabolus, and +what else soever they could find that did but smell of a +Diabolonian doubter. + +Now when the tyrant had arrived at Hell-Gate Hill, with his old +friend Incredulity, they immediately descended the den, and having +there with their fellows for a while condoled their misfortune and +great loss that they sustained against the town of Mansoul, they +fell at length into a passion, and revenged they would be for the +loss that they sustained before the town of Mansoul. Wherefore +they presently call a council to contrive yet further what was to +be done against the famous town of Mansoul; for their yawning +paunches could not wait to see the result of their Lord Lucifer's +and their Lord Apollyon's counsel that they had given before; for +their raging gorge thought every day, even as long as a short for +ever, until they were filled with the body and soul, with the flesh +and bones, and with all the delicates of Mansoul. They therefore +resolve to make another attempt upon the town of Mansoul, and that +by an army mixed and made up partly of doubters, and partly of +blood-men. A more particular account now take of both. + +The doubters are such as have their name from their nature, as well +as from the land and kingdom where they are born: their nature is +to put a question upon every one of the truths of Emmanuel; and +their country is called the land of Doubting, and that land lieth +off, and farthest remote to the north, between the land of Darkness +and that called the 'valley of the shadow of death.' For though +the land of Darkness, and that called 'the valley of the shadow of +death,' be sometimes called as if they were one and the self-same +place, yet indeed they are two, lying but a little way asunder, and +the land of Doubting points in, and lieth between them. This is +the land of Doubting; and these that came with Diabolus to ruin the +town of Mansoul are the natives of that country. + +The blood-men are a people that have their name derived from the +malignity of their nature, and from the fury that is in them to +execute it upon the town of Mansoul: their land lieth under the +dog-star, and by that they are governed as to their intellectuals. +The name of their country is the province of Loath-good: the +remote parts of it are far distant from the land of Doubting, yet +they do both butt and bound upon the hill called Hell-Gate Hill. +These people are always in league with the doubters, for they +jointly do make question of the faith and fidelity of the men of +the town of Mansoul, and so are both alike qualified for the +service of their prince. + +Now of these two countries did Diabolus, by the beating of his +drum, raise another army against the town of Mansoul, of five-and- +twenty thousand strong. There were ten thousand doubters, and +fifteen thousand blood-men, and they were put under several +captains for the war; and old Incredulity was again made general of +the army. + +As for the doubters, their captains were five of the seven that +were heads of the last Diabolonian army, and these are their names: +Captain Beelzebub, Captain Lucifer, Captain Apollyon, Captain +Legion, and Captain Cerberus; and the captains that they had before +were some of them made lieutenants, and some ensigns of the army. + +But Diabolus did not count that, in this expedition of his, these +doubters would prove his principal men, for their manhood had been +tried before; also the Mansoulians had put them to the worst: only +he did bring them to multiply a number, and to help, if need was, +at a pinch. But his trust he put in his blood-men, for that they +were all rugged villains, and he knew that they had done feats +heretofore. + +As for the blood-men, they also were under command and the names of +their captains were, Captain Cain, Captain Nimrod, Captain Ishmael, +Captain Esau, Captain Saul, Captain Absalom, Captain Judas, and +Captain Pope. + +1. Captain Cain was over two bands, namely, the zealous and the +angry blood-men: his standard-bearer bare the red colours, and his +scutcheon was the murdering club. + +2. Captain Nimrod was captain over two bands, namely, the +tyrannical and encroaching blood-men: his standard-bearer bare the +red colours, and his scutcheon was the great bloodhound. + +3. Captain Ishmael was captain over two bands, namely, the mocking +and scorning blood-men: his standard-bearer bare the red colours, +and his scutcheon was one mocking at Abraham's Isaac. + +4. Captain Esau was captain over two bands, namely, the blood-men +that grudged that another should have the blessing; also over the +blood-men that are for executing their private revenge upon others: +his standard-bearer bare the red colours, and his scutcheon was one +privately lurking to murder Jacob. + +5. Captain Saul was captain over two bands, namely, the +groundlessly jealous and the devilishly furious blood-men: his +standard-bearer bare the red colours, and his scutcheon was three +bloody darts cast at harmless David. + +6. Captain Absalom was captain over two bands, namely, over the +blood-men that will kill a father or a friend for the glory of this +world; also over those blood-men that will hold one fair in hand +with words, till they shall have pierced him with their swords: +his standard-bearer did bear the red colours, and his scutcheon was +the son pursuing the father's blood. + +7. Captain Judas was over two bands, namely, the blood-men that +will sell a man's life for money, and those also that will betray +their friend with a kiss: his standard-bearer bare the red +colours, and his scutcheon was thirty pieces of silver and the +halter. + +8. Captain Pope was captain over one band, for all these spirits +are joined in one under him: his standard-bearer bare the red +colours, and his scutcheon was the stake, the flame, and the good +man in it. + +Now, the reason why Diabolus did so soon rally another force, after +he had been beaten out of the field, was, for that he put mighty +confidence in this army of blood-men; for he put a great deal of +more trust in them than he did before in his army of doubters; +though they had also often done great service for him in the +strengthening of him in his kingdom. But these blood-men, he had +proved them often, and their sword did seldom return empty. +Besides, he knew that these, like mastiffs, would fasten upon any; +upon father, mother, brother, sister, prince, or governor, yea upon +the Prince of princes. And that which encouraged him the more was, +for that they once did force Emmanuel out of the kingdom of +Universe; 'And why,' thought he, 'may they not also drive him from +the town of Mansoul?' + +So this army of five-and-twenty thousand strong was, by their +general, the great Lord Incredulity, led up against the town of +Mansoul. Now Mr. Prywell, the scoutmaster-general, did himself go +out to spy, and he did bring Mansoul tidings of their coming. +Wherefore they shut up their gates, and put themselves in a posture +of defence against these new Diabolonians that came up against the +town. + +So Diabolus brought up his army, and beleaguered the town of +Mansoul; the doubters were placed about Feel-gate, and the blood- +men set down before Eye-gate and Ear-gate. + +Now when this army had thus encamped themselves, Incredulity did, +in the name of Diabolus, his own name, and in the name of the +blood-men and the rest that were with him, send a summons as hot as +a red-hot iron to Mansoul, to yield to their demands; threatening, +that if they still stood it out against them, they would presently +burn down Mansoul with fire. For you must know that, as for the +blood-men, they were not so much that Mansoul should be +surrendered, as that Mansoul should be destroyed, and cut off out +of the land of the living. True, they send to them to surrender; +but should they so do, that would not stench or quench the thirsts +of these men. They must have blood, the blood of Mansoul, else +they die; and it is from hence that they have their name. +Wherefore these blood-men he reserved while now that they might, +when all his engines proved ineffectual, as his last and sure card +be played against the town of Mansoul. + +Now, when the townsmen had received this red-hot summons, it begat +in them at present some changing and interchanging thoughts; but +they jointly agreed, in less than half an hour, to carry the +summons to the Prince, the which they did when they had writ at the +bottom of it, 'Lord, save Mansoul from bloody men!' + +So he took it, and looked upon it, and considered it, and took +notice also of that short petition that the men of Mansoul had +written at the bottom of it, and called to him the noble Captain +Credence, and bid him go and take Captain Patience with him, and go +and take care of that side of Mansoul that was beleaguered by the +blood-men. So they went and did as they were commanded: the +Captain Credence went and took Captain Patience, and they both +secured that side of Mansoul that was besieged by the blood-men. + +Then he commanded that Captain Good-hope and Captain Charity, and +my Lord Willbewill, should take charge of the other side of the +town. 'And I,' said the Prince, 'will set my standard upon the +battlements of your castle, and do you three watch against the +doubters.' This done, he again commanded that the brave captain, +the Captain Experience, should draw up his men in the market-place, +and that there he should exercise them day by day before the people +of the town of Mansoul. Now this siege was long, and many a fierce +attempt did the enemy, especially those called the blood-men, make +upon the town of Mansoul; and many a shrewd brush did some of the +townsmen meet with from them, especially Captain Self-Denial, who, +I should have told you before, was commanded to take the care of +Ear-gate and Eye-gate now against the blood-men. This Captain +Self-Denial was a young man, but stout, and a townsman in Mansoul, +as Captain Experience also was. And Emmanuel, at his second return +to Mansoul, made him a captain over a thousand of the Mansoulians, +for the good of the corporation. This captain, therefore, being an +hardy man, and a man of great courage, and willing to venture +himself for the good of the town of Mansoul, would now and then +sally out upon the blood-men, and give them many notable alarms, +and entered several brisk skirmishes with them, and also did some +execution upon them; but you must think that this could not easily +be done, but he must meet with brushes himself, for he carried +several of their marks in his face; yea, and some in some other +parts of his body. + +So, after some time spent for the trial of the faith, and hope, and +love of the town of Mansoul, the Prince Emmanuel upon a day calls +his captains and men of war together, and divides them into two +companies; this done, he commands them at a time appointed, and +that in the morning very early, to sally out upon the enemy, +saying: 'Let half of you fall upon the doubters, and half of you +fall upon the blood-men. Those of you that go out against the +doubters, kill and slay, and cause to perish so many of them as by +any means you can lay hands on; but for you that go out against the +blood-men, slay them not, but take them alive.' + +So, at the time appointed, betimes in the morning, the captains +went out as they were commanded, against the enemies. Captain +Good-Hope, Captain Charity, and those that were joined with them, +as Captain Innocent and Captain Experience, went out against the +doubters; and Captain Credence, and Captain Patience, with Captain +Self-Denial, and the rest that were to join with them, went out +against the blood-men. + +Now, those that went out against the doubters drew up into a body +before the plain, and marched on to bid them battle. But the +doubters, remembering their last success, made a retreat, not +daring to stand the shock, but fled from the Prince's men; +wherefore they pursued them, and in their pursuit slew many, but +they could not catch them all. Now those that escaped went some of +them home; and the rest by fives, nines, and seventeens, like +wanderers, went straggling up and down the country, where they upon +the barbarous people showed and exercised many of their Diabolonian +actions: nor did these people rise up in arms against them, but +suffered themselves to be enslaved by them. They would also after +this show themselves in companies before the town of Mansoul, but +never to abide in it; for if Captain Credence, Captain Good-Hope, +or Captain Experience did but show themselves, they fled. + +Those that went out against the blood-men did as they were +commanded: they forbore to slay any, but sought to compass them +about. But the blood-men, when they saw that no Emmanuel was in +the field, concluded also that no Emmanuel was in Mansoul; +wherefore they, looking upon what the captains did to be, as they +called it, a fruit of the extravagancy of their wild and foolish +fancies, rather despised them than feared them. But the captains, +minding their business, at last did compass them round; they also +that had routed the doubters came in amain to their aid: so, in +fine, after some little struggling, (for the blood-men also would +have run for it, only now it was too late; for though they are +mischievous and cruel, where they can overcome, yet all blood-men +are chicken-hearted men, when they once come to see themselves +matched and equalled,)--so the captains took them, and brought them +to the Prince. + +Now when they were taken, had before the Prince, and examined, he +found them to be of three several counties, though they all came +out of one land. + +1. One sort of them came out of Blind-man-shire, and they were such +as did ignorantly what they did. + +2. Another sort of them came out of Blind-zeal-shire, and they did +superstitiously what they did. + +3. The third sort of them came out of the town of Malice, in the +county of Envy, and they did what they did out of spite and +implacableness. + +For the first of these, namely, they that came out of Blind-man- +shire, when they saw where they were, and against whom they had +fought, they trembled and cried, as they stood before him; and as +many of these as asked him mercy, he touched their lips with his +golden sceptre. + +They that came out of Blind-zeal-shire, they did not as their +fellows did; for they pleaded that they had a right to do what they +did, because Mansoul was a town whose laws and customs were diverse +from all that dwelt thereabouts. Very few of these could be +brought to see their evil; but those that did, and asked mercy, +they also obtained favour. + +Now, they that came out of the town of Malice, that is in the +county of Envy, they neither wept, nor disputed, nor repented, but +stood gnawing their tongues before him for anguish and madness, +because they could not have their will upon Mansoul. Now these +last, with all those of the other two sorts that did not +unfeignedly ask pardon for their faults,--those he made to enter +into sufficient bond to answer for what they had done against +Mansoul, and against her King, at the great and general assizes to +be holden for our Lord the King, where he himself should appoint +for the country and kingdom of Universe. So they became bound each +man for himself, to come in, when called upon, to answer before our +Lord the King for what they had done as before. + +And thus much concerning this second army that was sent by Diabolus +to overthrow Mansoul. + +But there were three of those that came from the land of Doubting, +who, after they had wandered and ranged the country a while, and +perceived that they had escaped, were so hardy as to thrust +themselves, knowing that yet there were in the town Diabolonians,-- +I say, they were so hardy as to thrust themselves into Mansoul +among them. (Three, did I say? I think there were four.) Now, to +whose house should these Diabolonian doubters go, but to the house +of an old Diabolonian in Mansoul, whose name was Evil-Questioning, +a very great enemy he was to Mansoul, and a great doer among the +Diabolonians there. Well, to this Evil-Questioning's house, as was +said, did these Diabolonians come (you may be sure that they had +directions how to find the way thither), so he made them welcome, +pitied their misfortune, and succoured them with the best that he +had in his house. Now, after a little acquaintance (and it was not +long before they had that), this old Evil-Questioning asked the +doubters if they were all of a town (he knew that they were all of +one kingdom), and they answered: 'No, nor not of one shire +neither; for I,' said one, 'am an election doubter:' 'I,' said +another, 'am a vocation doubter:' then said the third, 'I am a +salvation doubter:' and the fourth said he was a grace doubter. +'Well,' quoth the old gentleman, 'be of what shire you will, I am +persuaded that you are down, boys: you have the very length of my +foot, are one with my heart, and shall be welcome to me.' So they +thanked him, and were glad that they had found themselves an +harbour in Mansoul. + +Then said Evil-Questioning to them: 'How many of your company +might there be that came with you to the siege of Mansoul?' and +they answered: 'There were but ten thousand doubters in all, for +the rest of the army consisted of fifteen thousand blood-men. +These blood-men,' quoth they, 'border upon our country; but, poor +men! as we hear, they were every one taken by Emmanuel's forces.' +'Ten thousand!' quoth the old gentleman; 'I will promise you, that +is a round company. But how came it to pass, since you were so +mighty a number, that you fainted, and durst not fight your foes?' +'Our general,' said they, 'was the first man that did run for it.' +'Pray,' quoth their landlord, 'who was that, your cowardly +general?' 'He was once the Lord Mayor of Mansoul,' said they: +'but pray call him not a cowardly general; for whether any from the +east to the west has done more service for our prince Diabolus, +than has my Lord Incredulity, will be a hard question for you to +answer. But had they catched him, they would for certain have +hanged him; and we promise you, hanging is but a bad business.' +Then said the old gentleman, 'I would that all the ten thousand +doubters were now well armed in Mansoul, and myself at the head of +them; I would see what I could do.' 'Ay,' said they, 'that would +be well if we could see that; but wishes, alas! what are they?' and +these words were spoken aloud. 'Well,' said old Evil-Questioning, +'take heed that you talk not too loud; you must be quat and close, +and must take care of yourselves while you are here, or, I will +assure you, you will be snapped.' 'Why?' quoth the doubters. +'Why!' quoth the old gentleman; 'why! because both the Prince and +Lord Secretary, and their captains and soldiers, are all at present +in town; yea, the town is as full of them as ever it can hold. And +besides, there is one whose name is Willbewill, a most cruel enemy +of ours, and him the Prince has made keeper of the gates, and has +commanded him that, with all the diligence he can, he should look +for, search out, and destroy all, and all manner of Diabolonians. +And if he lighteth upon you, down you go, though your heads were +made of gold.' + +And now, to see how it happened, one of the Lord Willbewill's +faithful soldiers, whose name was Mr. Diligence, stood all this +while listening under old Evil-Questioning's eaves, and heard all +the talk that had been betwixt him and the doubters that he +entertained under his roof. + +The soldier was a man that my lord had much confidence in, and that +he loved dearly; and that both because he was a man of courage, and +also a man that was unwearied in seeking after Diabolonians to +apprehend them. + +Now this man, as I told you, heard all the talk that was between +old Evil-Questioning and these Diabolonians; wherefore what does he +but goes to his lord, and tells him what he had heard. 'And sayest +thou so, my trusty?' quoth my lord. 'Ay,' quoth Diligence, 'that I +do; and if your lordship will be pleased to go with me, you shall +find it as I have said.' 'And are they there?' quoth my lord. 'I +know Evil-Questioning well, for he and I were great in the time of +our apostasy: but I know not now where he dwells.' 'But I do,' +said his man, 'and if your lordship will go, I will lead you the +way to his den.' 'Go!' quoth my lord, 'that I will. Come, my +Diligence, let us go find them out.' + +So my lord and his man went together the direct way to his house. +Now his man went before to show him his way, and they went till +they came even under old Mr. Evil-Questioning's wall. Then said +Diligence, 'Hark! my lord, do you know the old gentleman's tongue +when you hear it?' 'Yes,' said my lord, 'I know it well, but I +have not seen him many a day. This I know, he is cunning; I wish +he doth not give us the slip.' 'Let me alone for that,' said his +servant Diligence. 'But how shall we find the door?' quoth my +lord. 'Let me alone for that, too,' said his man. So he had my +Lord Willbewill about, and showed him the way to the door. Then my +lord, without more ado, broke open the door, rushed into the house, +and caught them all five together, even as Diligence his man had +told him. So my lord apprehended them, and led them away, and +committed them to the hand of Mr. Trueman, the gaoler, and +commanded, and he did put them in ward. This done, my Lord Mayor +was acquainted in the morning with what my Lord Willbewill had done +over night, and his lordship rejoiced much at the news, not only +because there were doubters apprehended, but because that old Evil- +Questioning was taken; for he had been a very great trouble to +Mansoul, and much affliction to my Lord Mayor himself. He had also +been sought for often, but no hand could ever be laid upon him till +now. + +Well, the next thing was to make preparation to try these five that +by my lord had been apprehended, and that were in the hands of Mr. +Trueman, the gaoler. So the day was set, and the court called and +come together, and the prisoners brought to the bar. My Lord +Willbewill had power to have slain them when at first he took them, +and that without any more ado; but he thought it at this time more +for the honour of the Prince, the comfort of Mansoul, and the +discouragement of the enemy, to bring them forth to public +judgment. + +But, I say, Mr. Trueman brought them in chains to the bar; to the +town-hall, for that was the place of judgment. So, to be short, +the jury was panelled, the witnesses sworn, and the prisoners tried +for their lives: the jury was the same that tried Mr. No-Truth, +Pitiless, Haughty, and the rest of their companions. + +And, first, old Questioning himself was set to the bar for he was +the receiver, the entertainer, and comforter of these doubters, +that by nation were outlandish men: then he was bid to hearken to +his charge, and was told that he had liberty to object, if he had +ought to say for himself. So his indictment was read: the manner +and form here follows. + +'Mr. Questioning, Thou art here indicted by the name of Evil- +Questioning, an intruder upon the town of Mansoul, for that thou +art a Diabolonian by nature, and also a hater of the Prince +Emmanuel, and one that hast studied the ruin of the town of +Mansoul. Thou art also here indicted for countenancing the King's +enemies, after wholesome laws made to the contrary: for, 1. Thou +hast questioned the truth of her doctrine and state: 2. In wishing +that ten thousand doubters were in her: 3. In receiving, in +entertaining, and encouraging of her enemies, that came from their +army unto thee. What sayest thou to this indictment? art thou +guilty or not guilty?' + +'My lord,' quoth he, 'I know not the meaning of this indictment, +forasmuch as I am not the man concerned in it; the man that +standeth by this charge accused before this bench is called by the +name of Evil-Questioning, which name I deny to be mine, mine being +Honest-Inquiry. The one indeed sounds like the other; but, I trow, +your lordships know that between these two there is a wide +difference; for I hope that a man, even in the worst of times, and +that, too, amongst the worst of men, may make an honest inquiry +after things, without running the danger of death.' + +Then spake my Lord Willbewill, for he was one of the witnesses: +'My lord, and you the honourable bench and magistrates of the town +of Mansoul, you all have heard with your ears that the prisoner at +the bar has denied his name, and so thinks to shift from the charge +of the indictment. But I know him to be the man concerned, and +that his proper name is Evil-Questioning. I have known him, my +lord, above these thirty years, for he and I (a shame it is for me +to speak it) were great acquaintance, when Diabolus, that tyrant, +had the government of Mansoul; and I testify that he is a +Diabolonian by nature, an enemy to our Prince, and a hater of the +blessed town of Mansoul. He has, in times of rebellion, been at +and lain in my house, my lord, not so little as twenty nights +together, and we did use to talk then, for the substance of talk, +as he and his doubters have talked of late: true, I have not seen +him many a day. I suppose that the coming of Emmanuel to Mansoul +has made him change his lodgings, as this indictment has driven him +to change his name; but this is the man, my lord.' + +Then said the court unto him, 'Hast thou any more to say?' + +'Yes,' quoth the old gentleman, 'that I have; for all that as yet +has been said against me, is but by the mouth of one witness; and +it is not lawful for the famous town of Mansoul, at the mouth of +one witness, to put any man to death.' + +Then stood forth Mr. Diligence, and said, 'My lord, as I was upon +my watch such a night at the head of Bad Street, in this town, I +chanced to hear a muttering within this gentleman's house. Then, +thought I, what is to do here? So I went up close, but very +softly, to the side of the house to listen, thinking, as indeed it +fell out, that there I might light upon some Diabolonian +conventicle. So, as I said, I drew nearer and nearer; and when I +was got up close to the wall, it was but a while before I perceived +that there were outlandish men in the house; but I did well +understand their speech, for I have been a traveller myself. Now, +hearing such language in such a tottering cottage as this old +gentleman dwelt in, I clapped mine ear to a hole in the window, and +there heard them talk as followeth. This old Mr. Questioning asked +these doubters what they were, whence they came, and what was their +business in these parts; and they told him to all these questions, +yet he did entertain them. He also asked what numbers there were +of them; and they told him ten thousand men. He then asked them, +why they made no more manly assault upon Mansoul; and they told +him: so he called their general coward, for marching off when he +should have fought for his prince. Further, this old Evil- +Questioning wished, and I heard him wish, would all the ten +thousand doubters were now in Mansoul, and himself at the head of +them. He bid them also to take heed and lie quat; for if they were +taken they must die, although they had heads of gold.' Then said +the court: 'Mr. Evil-Questioning, here is now another witness +against you, and his testimony is full: 1. He swears that you did +receive these men into your house, and that you did nourish them +there, though you knew that they were Diabolonians, and the King's +enemies. 2. He swears that you did wish ten thousand of them in +Mansoul. 3. He swears that you did give them advice to be quat and +close, lest they were taken by the King's servants. All which +manifesteth that thou art a Diabolonian; but hadst thou been a +friend to the King, thou wouldst have apprehended them.' + +Then said Evil-Questioning: 'To the first of these I answer, The +men that came into mine house were strangers, and I took them in; +and is it now become a crime in Mansoul for a man to entertain +strangers? That I did also nourish them is true; and why should my +charity be blamed? As for the reason why I wished ten thousand of +them in Mansoul, I never told it to the witnesses, nor to +themselves. I might wish them to be taken, and so my wish might +mean well to Mansoul, for aught that any yet knows. I did also bid +them take heed that they fell not into the captains' hands; but +that might be because I am unwilling that any man should be slain, +and not because I would have the King's enemies as such escape.' + +My Lord Mayor then replied: 'That though it was a virtue to +entertain strangers, yet it was treason to entertain the King's +enemies. And for what else thou hast said, thou dost by words but +labour to evade and defer the execution of judgment. But could +there be no more proved against thee but that thou art a +Diabolonian, thou must for that die the death by the law; but to be +a receiver, a nourisher, a countenancer, and a harbourer of others +of them, yea, of outlandish Diabolonians, yea, of them that came +from far on purpose to cut off and destroy our Mansoul--this must +not be borne.' + +Then said Evil-Questioning: 'I see how the game will go: I must +die for my name, and for my charity.' And so he held his peace. + +Then they called the outlandish doubters to the bar, and the first +of them that was arraigned was the election doubter. So his +indictment was read; and because he was an outlandish man, the +substance of it was told him by an interpreter; namely, 'That he +was there charged with being an enemy of Emmanuel the Prince, a +hater of the town of Mansoul, and an opposer of her most wholesome +doctrine.' + +Then the judge asked him if he would plead? but he said only this-- +That he confessed that he was an election doubter, and that that +was the religion that he had ever been brought up in. And said, +moreover, 'If I must die for my religion, I trow, I shall die a +martyr, and so I care the less.' + +Judge. Then it was replied: 'To question election, is to +overthrow a great doctrine of the gospel, namely, the omnisciency, +and power, and will of God; to take away the liberty of God with +his creature, to stumble the faith of the town of Mansoul, and to +make salvation to depend upon works, and not upon grace. It also +belied the word, and disquieted the minds of the men of Mansoul; +therefore by the best of laws he must die.' + +Then was the vocation doubter called, and set to the bar; and his +indictment for substance was the same with the other, only he was +particularly charged with denying the calling of Mansoul. + +The judge asked him also what he had to say for himself? + +So he replied: 'That he never believed that there was any such +thing as a distinct and powerful call of God to Mansoul; otherwise +than by the general voice of the word, nor by that neither, +otherwise than as it exhorted them to forbear evil, and to do that +which is good, and in so doing a promise of happiness is annexed.' + +Then said the judge: 'Thou art a Diabolonian, and hast denied a +great part of one of the most experimental truths of the Prince of +the town of Mansoul; for he has called, and she has heard a most +distinct and powerful call of her Emmanuel, by which she has been +quickened, awakened, and possessed with heavenly grace to desire to +have communion with her Prince, to serve him, and to do his will, +and to look for her happiness merely of his good pleasure. And for +thine abhorrence of this good doctrine, thou must die the death.' + +Then the grace doubter was called, and his indictment was read and +he replied thereto: 'That though he was of the land of doubting, +his father was the offspring of a Pharisee, and lived in good +fashion among his neighbours, and that he taught him to believe, +and believe it I do, and will, that Mansoul shall never be saved +freely by grace.' + +Then said the judge: 'Why, the law of the Prince is plain: 1. +Negatively, "not of works:" 2. Positively, "by grace you are +saved." And thy religion settleth in and upon the works of the +flesh; for the works of the law are the works of the flesh. +Besides, in saying as thou hast done, thou hast robbed God of His +glory, and given it to a sinful man; thou hast robbed Christ of the +necessity of His undertaking, and the sufficiency thereof, and hast +given both these to the works of the flesh. Thou hast despised the +work of the Holy Ghost, and hast magnified the will of the flesh, +and of the legal mind. Thou art a Diabolonian, the son of a +Diabolonian; and for thy Diabolonian principles thou must die.' + +The court then, having proceeded thus far with them, sent out the +jury, who forthwith brought them in guilty of death. Then stood up +the Recorder, and addressed himself to the prisoners: 'You, the +prisoners at the bar, you have been here indicted, and proved +guilty of high crimes against Emmanuel our Prince, and against the +welfare of the famous town of Mansoul, crimes for which you must be +put to death, and die ye accordingly.' So they were sentenced to +the death of the cross. The place assigned them for execution, was +that where Diabolus drew up his last army against Mansoul; save +only that old Evil-Questioning was hanged at the top of Bad Street, +just over against his own door. + +When the town of Mansoul had thus far rid themselves of their +enemies, and of the troublers of their peace, in the next place a +strict commandment was given out, that yet my Lord Willbewill +should, with Diligence his man, search for, and do his best to +apprehend what town Diabolonians were yet left alive in Mansoul. +The names of several of them were, Mr. Fooling, Mr. Let-Good-Slip, +Mr. Slavish-Fear, Mr. No-Love, Mr. Mistrust, Mr. Flesh, and Mr. +Sloth. It was also commanded, that he should apprehend Mr. Evil- +Questioning's children, that he left behind him, and that they +should demolish his house. The children that he left behind him +were these: Mr. Doubt, and he was his eldest son; the next to him +was Legal-Life, Unbelief, Wrong-Thoughts-of-Christ, Clip-Promise, +Carnal-Sense, Live-by-Feeling, Self-Love. All these he had by one +wife, and her name was No-Hope; she was the kinswoman of old +Incredulity, for he was her uncle; and when her father, old Dark, +was dead, he took her and brought her up, and when she was +marriageable, he gave her to this old Evil-Questioning to wife. + +Now the Lord Willbewill did put into execution his commission, with +great Diligence, his man. He took Fooling in the streets, and +hanged him up in Want-wit-Alley, over against his own house. This +Fooling was he that would have had the town of Mansoul deliver up +Captain Credence into the hands of Diabolus, provided that then he +would have withdrawn his force out of the town. He also took Mr. +Let-Good-Slip one day as he was busy in the market, and executed +him according to law. Now there was an honest poor man in Mansoul, +and his name was Mr. Meditation, one of no great account in the +days of apostasy, but now of repute with the best of the town. +This man, therefore, they were willing to prefer. Now Mr. Let- +Good-Slip had a great deal of wealth heretofore in Mansoul, and, at +Emmanuel's coming, it was sequestered to the use of the Prince: +this, therefore, was now given to Mr. Meditation, to improve for +the common good, and after him to his son, Mr. Think-Well; this +Think-Well he had by Mrs. Piety his wife, and she was the daughter +of Mr. Recorder. + +After this, my lord apprehended Clip-Promise: now because he was a +notorious villain, for by his doings much of the King's coin was +abused, therefore he was made a public example. He was arraigned +and judged to be first set in the pillory, then to be whipped by +all the children and servants in Mansoul, and then to be hanged +till he was dead. Some may wonder at the severity of this man's +punishment; but those that are honest traders in Mansoul, are +sensible of the great abuse that one clipper of promises in little +time may do to the town of Mansoul. And truly my judgment is, that +all those of his name and life should be served even as he. + +He also apprehended Carnal-Sense, and put him in hold; but how it +came about, I cannot tell, but he brake prison, and made his +escape: yea, and the bold villain will not yet quit the town, but +lurks in the Diabolonian dens a days, and haunts like a ghost +honest men's houses a nights. Wherefore, there was a proclamation +set up in the market-place in Mansoul, signifying that whosoever +could discover Carnal-Sense, and apprehend him and slay him, should +be admitted daily to the Prince's table, and should be made keeper +of the treasure of Mansoul. Many, therefore, did bend themselves +to do this thing, but take him and slay him they could not, though +often he was discovered. + +But my lord took Mr. Wrong-Thoughts-of-Christ, and put him in +prison, and he died there; though it was long first, for he died of +a lingering consumption. + +Self-Love was also taken and committed to custody; but there were +many that were allied to him in Mansoul, so his judgment was +deferred. But at last Mr. Self-Denial stood up, and said: 'If +such villains as these may be winked at in Mansoul, I will lay down +my commission.' He also took him from the crowd, and had him among +his soldiers, and there he was brained. But some in Mansoul +muttered at it, though none durst speak plainly, because Emmanuel +was in town. But this brave act of Captain Self-Denial came to the +Prince's ears; so he sent for him, and made him a lord in Mansoul. +My Lord Willbewill also obtained great commendations of Emmanuel, +for what he had done for the town of Mansoul. + +Then my Lord Self-Denial took courage, and set to the pursuing of +the Diabolonians, with my Lord Willbewill; and they took Live-by- +Feeling, and they took Legal-Life, and put them in hold till they +died. But Mr. Unbelief was a nimble Jack: him they could never +lay hold of, though they attempted to do it often. He therefore, +and some few more of the subtlest of the Diabolonian tribe, did yet +remain in Mansoul, to the time that Mansoul left off to dwell any +longer in the kingdom of Universe. But they kept them to their +dens and holes: if one of them did appear, or happen to be seen in +any of the streets of the town of Mansoul, the whole town would be +up in arms after them; yea, the very children in Mansoul would cry +out after them as after a thief, and would wish that they might +stone them to death with stones. And now did Mansoul arrive to +some good degree of peace and quiet; her Prince also did abide +within her borders; her captains, also, and her soldiers did their +duties; and Mansoul minded her trade that she had with the country +that was afar off; also she was busy in her manufacture. + +When the town of Mansoul had thus far rid themselves of so many of +their enemies, and the troublers of their peace, the Prince sent to +them, and appointed a day wherein he would, at the market-place, +meet the whole people, and there give them in charge concerning +some further matters, that, if observed, would tend to their +further safety and comfort, and to the condemnation and destruction +of their home-bred Diabolonians. So the day appointed was come, +and the townsmen met together; Emmanuel also came down in his +chariot, and all his captains in their state attending him, on the +right hand and on the left. Then was an oyes made for silence, +and, after some mutual carriages of love, the Prince began, and +thus proceeded:- + +'You, my Mansoul, and the beloved of mine heart, many and great are +the privileges that I have bestowed upon you; I have singled you +out from others, and have chosen you to myself, not for your +worthiness, but for mine own sake. I have also redeemed you, not +only from the dread of my Father's law, but from the hand of +Diabolus. This I have done because I loved you, and because I have +set my heart upon you to do you good. I have also, that all +things, that might hinder thy way to the pleasures of paradise +might be taken out of the way, laid down for thee for thy soul a +plenary satisfaction, and have bought thee to myself; a price not +of corruptible things, as of silver and gold, but a price of blood, +mine own blood, which I have freely spilled upon the ground to make +thee mine. So I have reconciled thee, O my Mansoul, to my Father, +and entrusted thee in the mansion houses that are with my Father in +the royal city, where things are, O my Mansoul, that eye hath not +seen, nor hath entered into the heart of man to conceive. + +'Besides, O my Mansoul, thou seest what I have done, and how I have +taken thee out of the hands of thine enemies: unto whom thou hadst +deeply revolted from my Father, and by whom thou wast content to be +possessed, and also to be destroyed. I came to thee first by my +law, then by my gospel, to awaken thee, and show thee my glory. +And thou knowest what thou wast, what thou saidst, what thou didst, +and how many times thou rebelledst against my Father and me; yet I +left thee not as thou seest this day, but came to thee, have borne +thy manners, have waited upon thee, and, after all, accepted of +thee, even of my mere grace and favour; and would not suffer thee +to be lost, as thou most willingly wouldst have been. I also +compassed thee about, and afflicted thee on every side, that I +might make thee weary of thy ways, and bring down thy heart with +molestation to a willingness to close with thy good and happiness. +And when I had gotten a complete conquest over thee, I turned it to +thy advantage. + +'Thou seest, also, what a company of my Father's host I have lodged +within thy borders: captains and rulers, soldiers and men of war, +engines and excellent devices to subdue and bring down thy foes; +thou knowest my meaning, O Mansoul. And they are my servants, and +thine, too, Mansoul. Yea, my design of possessing of thee with +them, and the natural tendency of each of them is to defend, purge, +strengthen, and sweeten thee for myself, O Mansoul, and to make +thee meet for my Father's presence, blessing, and glory; for thou, +my Mansoul, art created to be prepared unto these. + +'Thou seest, moreover, my Mansoul, how I have passed by thy +backslidings, and have healed thee. Indeed I was angry with thee, +but I have turned mine anger away from thee, because I loved thee +still, and mine anger and mine indignation is ceased in the +destruction of thine enemies, O Mansoul. Nor did thy goodness +fetch me again unto thee, after that I for thy transgressions have +hid my face, and withdrawn my presence from thee. The way of +backsliding was thine, but the way and means of thy recovery was +mine. I invented the means of thy return; it was I that made an +hedge and a wall, when thou wast beginning to turn to things in +which I delighted not. It was I that made thy sweet bitter, thy +day night, thy smooth way thorny, and that also confounded all that +sought thy destruction. It was I that set Mr. Godly-Fear to work +in Mansoul. It was I that stirred up thy conscience and +understanding, thy will and thy affections, after thy great and +woful decay. It was I that put life into thee, O Mansoul, to seek +me, that thou mightest find me, and in thy finding find thine own +health, happiness, and salvation. It was I that fetched the second +time the Diabolonians out of Mansoul; and it was I that overcame +them, and that destroyed them before thy face. + +'And now, my Mansoul, I am returned to thee in peace, and thy +transgressions against me are as if they had not been. Nor shall +it be with thee as in former days, but I will do better for thee +than at thy beginning. + +For yet a little while, O my Mansoul, even after a few more times +are gone over thy head, I will (but be not thou troubled at what I +say) take down this famous town of Mansoul, stick and stone, to the +ground. And I will carry the stones thereof, and the timber +thereof, and the walls thereof, and the dust thereof, and the +inhabitants thereof, into mine own country, even into a kingdom of +my Father; and will there set it up in such strength and glory, as +it never did see in the kingdom where now it is placed. I will +even there set it up for my Father's habitation; for for that +purpose it was at first erected in the kingdom of Universe; and +there will I make it a spectacle of wonder, a monument of mercy, +and the admirer of its own mercy. There shall the natives of +Mansoul see all that, of which they have seen nothing here: there +shall they be equal to those unto whom they have been inferior +here. And there shalt thou, O my Mansoul, have such communion with +me, with my Father, and with your Lord Secretary, as it is not +possible here to be enjoyed, nor ever could be, shouldest thou live +in Universe the space of a thousand years. + +'And there, O my Mansoul, thou shalt be afraid of murderers no +more; of Diabolonians, and their threats, no more. There, there +shall be no more plots, nor contrivances, nor designs against thee, +O my Mansoul. There thou shalt no more hear the evil-tidings, or +the noise of the Diabolonian drum. There thou shalt not see the +Diabolonian standard-bearers, nor yet behold Diabolus's standard. +No Diabolonian mount shall be cast up against thee there; nor shall +there the Diabolonian standard be set up to make thee afraid. +There thou shalt not need captains, engines, soldiers, and men of +war. There thou shalt meet with no sorrow, nor grief, nor shall it +be possible that any Diabolonian should again, for ever, be able to +creep into thy skirts, burrow in thy walls, or be seen again within +thy borders all the days of eternity. Life shall there last longer +than here you are able to desire it should; and yet it shall always +be sweet and new, nor shall any impediment attend it for ever. + +'There, O Mansoul, thou shalt meet with many of those that have +been like thee, and that have been partakers of thy sorrows; even +such as I have chosen, and redeemed, and set apart, as thou, for my +Father's court and city-royal. All they will be glad in thee, and +thou, when thou seest them, shalt be glad in thine heart. + +'There are things, O Mansoul, even things of my Father's providing, +and mine, that never were seen since the beginning of the world; +and they are laid up with my Father, and sealed up among his +treasures for thee, till thou shalt come thither to enjoy them. I +told you before, that I would remove my Mansoul, and set it up +elsewhere; and where I will set it, there are those that love thee, +and those that rejoice in thee now; but how much more, when they +shall see thee exalted to honour! My Father will then send them +for you to fetch you; and their bosoms are chariots to put you in. +And you, O my Mansoul, shall ride upon the wings of the wind. They +will come to convey, conduct, and bring you to that, when your eyes +see more, that will be your desired haven. + +'And thus, O my Mansoul, I have showed unto thee what shall be done +to thee hereafter, if thou canst hear, if thou canst understand; +and now I will tell thee what at present must be thy duty and +practice, until I come and fetch thee to myself, according as is +related in the Scriptures of truth. + +'First, I charge thee that thou dost hereafter keep more white and +clean the liveries which I gave thee before my last withdrawing +from thee. Do it, I say, for this will be thy wisdom. They are in +themselves fine linen, but thou must keep them white and clean. +This will be your wisdom, your honour, and will be greatly for my +glory. When your garments are white, the world will count you +mine. Also, when your garments are white, then I am delighted in +your ways; for then your goings to and fro will be like a flash of +lightning, that those that are present must take notice of; also +their eyes will be made to dazzle thereat. Deck thyself, +therefore, according to my bidding, and make thyself by my law +straight steps for thy feet; so shall thy King greatly desire thy +beauty, for he is thy Lord, and worship thou him. + +'Now, that thou mayest keep them as I bid thee, I have, as I before +did tell thee, provided for thee an open fountain to wash thy +garments in. Look, therefore, that thou wash often in my fountain, +and go not in defiled garments; for as it is to my dishonour and my +disgrace, so it will be to thy discomfort, when you shall walk in +filthy garments. Let not, therefore, my garments, your garments, +the garments that I gave thee, be defiled or spotted by the flesh. +Keep thy garments always white, and let thy head lack no ointment. + +'My Mansoul, I have ofttimes delivered thee from the designs, +plots, attempts, and conspiracies of Diabolus; and for all this I +ask thee nothing, but that thou render not to me evil for my good; +but that thou bear in mind my love, and the continuation of my +kindness to my beloved Mansoul, so as to provoke thee to walk in +thy measure according to the benefit bestowed on thee. Of old, the +sacrifices were bound with coords to the horns of the altar. +Consider what is said to thee, O my blessed Mansoul. + +'O my Mansoul, I have lived, I have died, I live, and will die no +more for thee. I live, that thou mayest not die. Because I live, +thou shalt live also. I reconciled thee to my Father by the blood +of my cross; and being reconciled, thou shalt live through me. I +will pray for thee; I will fight for thee; I will yet do thee good. + +'Nothing can hurt thee but sin; nothing can grieve me but sin; +nothing can make thee base before thy foes but sin: take heed of +sin, my Mansoul. + +'And dost thou know why I at first, and do still, suffer +Diabolonians to dwell in thy walls, O Mansoul? It is to keep thee +wakening, to try thy love, to make thee watchful, and to cause thee +yet to prize my noble captains, their soldiers, and my mercy. + +'It is also, that yet thou mayest be made to remember what a +deplorable condition thou once wast in. I mean when, not some, but +all did dwell, not in thy walls, but in thy castle, and in thy +stronghold, O Mansoul. + +'O my Mansoul, should I slay all them within, many there be +without, that would bring thee into bondage; for were all these +within cut off, those without would find thee sleeping; and then, +as in a moment, they would swallow up my Mansoul. I therefore left +them in thee, not to do thee hurt (the which they yet will, if thou +hearken to them, and serve them,) but to do thee good, the which +they must, if thou watch and fight against them. Know, therefore, +that whatever they shall tempt thee to, my design is, that they +should drive thee, not further off, but nearer to my father, to +learn thee war, to make petitioning desirable to thee, and to make +thee little in thine own eyes. Hearken diligently to this, my +Mansoul. + +'Show me, then, thy love, my Mansoul, and let not those that are +within thy walls, take thy affections off from him that hath +redeemed thy soul. Yea, let the sight of a Diabolonian heighten +thy love to me. I came once, and twice, and thrice, to save thee +from the poison of those arrows that would have wrought thy death: +stand for me, thy Friend, my Mansoul, against the Diabolonians, and +I will stand for thee before my Father, and all his court. Love me +against temptation, and I will love thee notwithstanding thine +infirmities. + +'O my Mansoul, remember what my captains, my soldiers, and mine +engines have done for thee. They have fought for thee, they have +suffered by thee, they have borne much at thy hands to do thee +good, O Mansoul. Hadst thou not had them to help thee, Diabolus +had certainly made a hand of thee. Nourish them, therefore, my +Mansoul. When thou dost well, they will be well; when thou dost +ill, they will be ill, and sick, and weak. Make not my captains +sick, O Mansoul; for if they be sick, thou canst not be well; if +they be weak, thou canst not be strong; if they be faint, thou +canst not be stout and valiant for thy King, O Mansoul. Nor must +thou think always to live by sense: thou must live upon my word. +Thou must believe, O my Mansoul, when I am from thee, that yet I +love thee, and bear thee upon mine heart for ever. + +'Remember, therefore, O my Mansoul, that thou art beloved of me: +as I have, therefore, taught thee to watch, to fight, to pray, and +to make war against my foes; so now I command thee to believe that +my love is constant to thee. O my Mansoul, how have I set my +heart, my love upon thee! Watch. Behold, I lay none other burden +upon thee, than what thou hast already. Hold fast, till I come.' + + + + +*** END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK, THE HOLY WAR *** + +This file should be named hlywr10.txt or hlywr10.zip +Corrected EDITIONS of our eBooks get a new NUMBER, hlywr11.txt +VERSIONS based on separate sources get new LETTER, hlywr10a.txt + +Project Gutenberg eBooks are often created from several printed +editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the US +unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we usually do not +keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition. + +We are now trying to release all our eBooks one year in advance +of the official release dates, leaving time for better editing. +Please be encouraged to tell us about any error or corrections, +even years after the official publication date. + +Please note neither this listing nor its contents are final til +midnight of the last day of the month of any such announcement. +The official release date of all Project Gutenberg eBooks is at +Midnight, Central Time, of the last day of the stated month. A +preliminary version may often be posted for suggestion, comment +and editing by those who wish to do so. + +Most people start at our Web sites at: +http://gutenberg.net or +http://promo.net/pg + +These Web sites include award-winning information about Project +Gutenberg, including how to donate, how to help produce our new +eBooks, and how to subscribe to our email newsletter (free!). + + +Those of you who want to download any eBook before announcement +can get to them as follows, and just download by date. This is +also a good way to get them instantly upon announcement, as the +indexes our cataloguers produce obviously take a while after an +announcement goes out in the Project Gutenberg Newsletter. + +http://www.ibiblio.org/gutenberg/etext04 or +ftp://ftp.ibiblio.org/pub/docs/books/gutenberg/etext04 + +Or /etext03, 02, 01, 00, 99, 98, 97, 96, 95, 94, 93, 92, 92, 91 or 90 + +Just search by the first five letters of the filename you want, +as it appears in our Newsletters. + + +Information about Project Gutenberg (one page) + +We produce about two million dollars for each hour we work. The +time it takes us, a rather conservative estimate, is fifty hours +to get any eBook selected, entered, proofread, edited, copyright +searched and analyzed, the copyright letters written, etc. Our +projected audience is one hundred million readers. If the value +per text is nominally estimated at one dollar then we produce $2 +million dollars per hour in 2002 as we release over 100 new text +files per month: 1240 more eBooks in 2001 for a total of 4000+ +We are already on our way to trying for 2000 more eBooks in 2002 +If they reach just 1-2% of the world's population then the total +will reach over half a trillion eBooks given away by year's end. + +The Goal of Project Gutenberg is to Give Away 1 Trillion eBooks! +This is ten thousand titles each to one hundred million readers, +which is only about 4% of the present number of computer users. + +Here is the briefest record of our progress (* means estimated): + +eBooks Year Month + + 1 1971 July + 10 1991 January + 100 1994 January + 1000 1997 August + 1500 1998 October + 2000 1999 December + 2500 2000 December + 3000 2001 November + 4000 2001 October/November + 6000 2002 December* + 9000 2003 November* +10000 2004 January* + + +The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation has been created +to secure a future for Project Gutenberg into the next millennium. + +We need your donations more than ever! + +As of February, 2002, contributions are being solicited from people +and organizations in: Alabama, Alaska, Arkansas, Connecticut, +Delaware, District of Columbia, Florida, Georgia, Hawaii, Illinois, +Indiana, Iowa, Kansas, Kentucky, Louisiana, Maine, Massachusetts, +Michigan, Mississippi, Missouri, Montana, Nebraska, Nevada, New +Hampshire, New Jersey, New Mexico, New York, North Carolina, Ohio, +Oklahoma, Oregon, Pennsylvania, Rhode Island, South Carolina, South +Dakota, Tennessee, Texas, Utah, Vermont, Virginia, Washington, West +Virginia, Wisconsin, and Wyoming. + +We have filed in all 50 states now, but these are the only ones +that have responded. + +As the requirements for other states are met, additions to this list +will be made and fund raising will begin in the additional states. +Please feel free to ask to check the status of your state. + +In answer to various questions we have received on this: + +We are constantly working on finishing the paperwork to legally +request donations in all 50 states. If your state is not listed and +you would like to know if we have added it since the list you have, +just ask. + +While we cannot solicit donations from people in states where we are +not yet registered, we know of no prohibition against accepting +donations from donors in these states who approach us with an offer to +donate. + +International donations are accepted, but we don't know ANYTHING about +how to make them tax-deductible, or even if they CAN be made +deductible, and don't have the staff to handle it even if there are +ways. + +Donations by check or money order may be sent to: + +Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation +PMB 113 +1739 University Ave. +Oxford, MS 38655-4109 + +Contact us if you want to arrange for a wire transfer or payment +method other than by check or money order. + +The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation has been approved by +the US Internal Revenue Service as a 501(c)(3) organization with EIN +[Employee Identification Number] 64-622154. Donations are +tax-deductible to the maximum extent permitted by law. As fund-raising +requirements for other states are met, additions to this list will be +made and fund-raising will begin in the additional states. + +We need your donations more than ever! + +You can get up to date donation information online at: + +http://www.gutenberg.net/donation.html + + +*** + +If you can't reach Project Gutenberg, +you can always email directly to: + +Michael S. Hart <hart@pobox.com> + +Prof. Hart will answer or forward your message. + +We would prefer to send you information by email. + + +**The Legal Small Print** + + +(Three Pages) + +***START**THE SMALL PRINT!**FOR PUBLIC DOMAIN EBOOKS**START*** +Why is this "Small Print!" statement here? You know: lawyers. +They tell us you might sue us if there is something wrong with +your copy of this eBook, even if you got it for free from +someone other than us, and even if what's wrong is not our +fault. So, among other things, this "Small Print!" statement +disclaims most of our liability to you. It also tells you how +you may distribute copies of this eBook if you want to. + +*BEFORE!* YOU USE OR READ THIS EBOOK +By using or reading any part of this PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm +eBook, you indicate that you understand, agree to and accept +this "Small Print!" statement. If you do not, you can receive +a refund of the money (if any) you paid for this eBook by +sending a request within 30 days of receiving it to the person +you got it from. If you received this eBook on a physical +medium (such as a disk), you must return it with your request. + +ABOUT PROJECT GUTENBERG-TM EBOOKS +This PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm eBook, like most PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm eBooks, +is a "public domain" work distributed by Professor Michael S. Hart +through the Project Gutenberg Association (the "Project"). +Among other things, this means that no one owns a United States copyright +on or for this work, so the Project (and you!) can copy and +distribute it in the United States without permission and +without paying copyright royalties. Special rules, set forth +below, apply if you wish to copy and distribute this eBook +under the "PROJECT GUTENBERG" trademark. + +Please do not use the "PROJECT GUTENBERG" trademark to market +any commercial products without permission. + +To create these eBooks, the Project expends considerable +efforts to identify, transcribe and proofread public domain +works. Despite these efforts, the Project's eBooks and any +medium they may be on may contain "Defects". Among other +things, Defects may take the form of incomplete, inaccurate or +corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other +intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged +disk or other eBook medium, a computer virus, or computer +codes that damage or cannot be read by your equipment. + +LIMITED WARRANTY; DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES +But for the "Right of Replacement or Refund" described below, +[1] Michael Hart and the Foundation (and any other party you may +receive this eBook from as a PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm eBook) disclaims +all liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including +legal fees, and [2] YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE OR +UNDER STRICT LIABILITY, OR FOR BREACH OF WARRANTY OR CONTRACT, +INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE +OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES, EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE +POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. + +If you discover a Defect in this eBook within 90 days of +receiving it, you can receive a refund of the money (if any) +you paid for it by sending an explanatory note within that +time to the person you received it from. If you received it +on a physical medium, you must return it with your note, and +such person may choose to alternatively give you a replacement +copy. If you received it electronically, such person may +choose to alternatively give you a second opportunity to +receive it electronically. + +THIS EBOOK IS OTHERWISE PROVIDED TO YOU "AS-IS". NO OTHER +WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, ARE MADE TO YOU AS +TO THE EBOOK OR ANY MEDIUM IT MAY BE ON, INCLUDING BUT NOT +LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A +PARTICULAR PURPOSE. + +Some states do not allow disclaimers of implied warranties or +the exclusion or limitation of consequential damages, so the +above disclaimers and exclusions may not apply to you, and you +may have other legal rights. + +INDEMNITY +You will indemnify and hold Michael Hart, the Foundation, +and its trustees and agents, and any volunteers associated +with the production and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm +texts harmless, from all liability, cost and expense, including +legal fees, that arise directly or indirectly from any of the +following that you do or cause: [1] distribution of this eBook, +[2] alteration, modification, or addition to the eBook, +or [3] any Defect. + +DISTRIBUTION UNDER "PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm" +You may distribute copies of this eBook electronically, or by +disk, book or any other medium if you either delete this +"Small Print!" and all other references to Project Gutenberg, +or: + +[1] Only give exact copies of it. Among other things, this + requires that you do not remove, alter or modify the + eBook or this "small print!" statement. You may however, + if you wish, distribute this eBook in machine readable + binary, compressed, mark-up, or proprietary form, + including any form resulting from conversion by word + processing or hypertext software, but only so long as + *EITHER*: + + [*] The eBook, when displayed, is clearly readable, and + does *not* contain characters other than those + intended by the author of the work, although tilde + (~), asterisk (*) and underline (_) characters may + be used to convey punctuation intended by the + author, and additional characters may be used to + indicate hypertext links; OR + + [*] The eBook may be readily converted by the reader at + no expense into plain ASCII, EBCDIC or equivalent + form by the program that displays the eBook (as is + the case, for instance, with most word processors); + OR + + [*] You provide, or agree to also provide on request at + no additional cost, fee or expense, a copy of the + eBook in its original plain ASCII form (or in EBCDIC + or other equivalent proprietary form). + +[2] Honor the eBook refund and replacement provisions of this + "Small Print!" statement. + +[3] Pay a trademark license fee to the Foundation of 20% of the + gross profits you derive calculated using the method you + already use to calculate your applicable taxes. If you + don't derive profits, no royalty is due. Royalties are + payable to "Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation" + the 60 days following each date you prepare (or were + legally required to prepare) your annual (or equivalent + periodic) tax return. Please contact us beforehand to + let us know your plans and to work out the details. + +WHAT IF YOU *WANT* TO SEND MONEY EVEN IF YOU DON'T HAVE TO? +Project Gutenberg is dedicated to increasing the number of +public domain and licensed works that can be freely distributed +in machine readable form. + +The Project gratefully accepts contributions of money, time, +public domain materials, or royalty free copyright licenses. +Money should be paid to the: +"Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation." + +If you are interested in contributing scanning equipment or +software or other items, please contact Michael Hart at: +hart@pobox.com + +[Portions of this eBook's header and trailer may be reprinted only +when distributed free of all fees. Copyright (C) 2001, 2002 by +Michael S. Hart. Project Gutenberg is a TradeMark and may not be +used in any sales of Project Gutenberg eBooks or other materials be +they hardware or software or any other related product without +express permission.] + +*END THE SMALL PRINT! FOR PUBLIC DOMAIN EBOOKS*Ver.02/11/02*END* + diff --git a/old/hlywr10.zip b/old/hlywr10.zip Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000..60deca4 --- /dev/null +++ b/old/hlywr10.zip diff --git a/old/hlywr10h.htm b/old/hlywr10h.htm new file mode 100644 index 0000000..dd3a605 --- /dev/null +++ b/old/hlywr10h.htm @@ -0,0 +1,9715 @@ +<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01//EN"> +<html> +<head> +<meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=US-ASCII"> +<title>The Holy War</title> +</head> +<body> +<h2> +<a href="#startoftext">The Holy War, by John Bunyan</a> +</h2> +<pre> +The Project Gutenberg EBook of The Holy War, by John Bunyan +(#2 in our series by John Bunyan) + +Copyright laws are changing all over the world. Be sure to check the +copyright laws for your country before downloading or redistributing +this or any other Project Gutenberg eBook. + +This header should be the first thing seen when viewing this Project +Gutenberg file. Please do not remove it. Do not change or edit the +header without written permission. + +Please read the "legal small print," and other information about the +eBook and Project Gutenberg at the bottom of this file. Included is +important information about your specific rights and restrictions in +how the file may be used. You can also find out about how to make a +donation to Project Gutenberg, and how to get involved. + + +**Welcome To The World of Free Plain Vanilla Electronic Texts** + +**eBooks Readable By Both Humans and By Computers, Since 1971** + +*****These eBooks Were Prepared By Thousands of Volunteers!***** + + +Title: The Holy War + +Author: John Bunyan + +Release Date: January, 1996 [EBook #395] +[This file was first posted on December 7, 1995] +[Most recently updated: August 18, 2002] + +Edition: 10 + +Language: English + +Character set encoding: ASCII +</pre> +<p> +<a name="startoftext"></a> +Transcribed from the 1907 Religious Tract Society edition by David Price, +email ccx074@coventry.ac.uk<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +THE HOLY WAR<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +TO THE READER.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +’Tis strange to me, that they that love to tell<br> +Things done of old, yea, and that do excel<br> +Their equals in historiology,<br> +Speak not of Mansoul’s wars, but let them lie<br> +Dead, like old fables, or such worthless things,<br> +That to the reader no advantage brings:<br> +When men, let them make what they will their own,<br> +Till they know this, are to themselves unknown.<br> +Of stories, I well know, there’s divers sorts,<br> +Some foreign, some domestic; and reports<br> +Are thereof made as fancy leads the writers:<br> +(By books a man may guess at the inditers.)<br> +Some will again of that which never was,<br> +Nor will be, feign (and that without a cause)<br> +Such matter, raise such mountains, tell such things<br> +Of men, of laws, of countries, and of kings;<br> +And in their story seem to be so sage,<br> +And with such gravity clothe every page,<br> +That though their frontispiece says all is vain,<br> +Yet to their way disciples they obtain.<br> +But, readers, I have somewhat else to do,<br> +Than with vain stories thus to trouble you.<br> +What here I say, some men do know so well,<br> +They can with tears and joy the story tell.<br> +The town of Mansoul is well known to many,<br> +Nor are her troubles doubted of by any<br> +That are acquainted with those Histories<br> +That Mansoul and her wars anatomize.<br> +Then lend thine ear to what I do relate,<br> +Touching the town of Mansoul and her state:<br> +How she was lost, took captive, made a slave:<br> +And how against him set, that should her save;<br> +Yea, how by hostile ways she did oppose<br> +Her Lord, and with his enemy did close.<br> +For they are true: he that will them deny<br> +Must needs the best of records vilify.<br> +For my part, I myself was in the town,<br> +Both when ’twas set up, and when pulling down.<br> +I saw Diabolus in his possession,<br> +And Mansoul also under his oppression.<br> +Yea, I was there when she own’d him for lord,<br> +And to him did submit with one accord.<br> +When Mansoul trampled upon things divine,<br> +And wallowed in filth as doth a swine;<br> +When she betook herself unto her arms,<br> +Fought her Emmanuel, despis’d his charms;<br> +Then I was there, and did rejoice to see<br> +Diabolus and Mansoul so agree.<br> +Let no men, then, count me a fable-maker,<br> +Nor make my name or credit a partaker<br> +Of their derision: what is here in view,<br> +Of mine own knowledge, I dare say is true.<br> +I saw the Prince’s armed men come down<br> +By troops, by thousands, to besiege the town;<br> +I saw the captains, heard the trumpets sound,<br> +And how his forces covered all the ground.<br> +Yea, how they set themselves in battle-’ray,<br> +I shall remember to my dying day.<br> +I saw the colours waving in the wind,<br> +And they within to mischief how combin’d<br> +To ruin Mansoul, and to make away<br> +Her primum mobile without delay.<br> +I saw the mounts cast up against the town,<br> +And how the slings were placed to beat it down:<br> +I heard the stones fly whizzing by mine ears,<br> +(What longer kept in mind than got in fears?)<br> +I heard them fall, and saw what work they made.<br> +And how old Mors did cover with his shade<br> +The face of Mansoul; and I heard her cry,<br> +‘Woe worth the day, in dying I shall die!’<br> +I saw the battering-rams, and how they play’d<br> +To beat open Ear-gate; and I was afraid<br> +Not only Ear-gate, but the very town<br> +Would by those battering-rams be beaten down.<br> +I saw the fights, and heard the captains shout,<br> +And in each battle saw who faced about;<br> +I saw who wounded were, and who were slain;<br> +And who, when dead, would come to life again.<br> +I heard the cries of those that wounded were,<br> +(While others fought like men bereft of fear,)<br> +And while the cry, ‘Kill, kill,’ was in mine ears,<br> +The gutters ran, not so with blood as tears.<br> +Indeed, the captains did not always fight,<br> +But then they would molest us day and night;<br> +Their cry, ‘Up, fall on, let us take the town,’<br> +Kept us from sleeping, or from lying down.<br> +I was there when the gates were broken ope,<br> +And saw how Mansoul then was stripp’d of hope;<br> +I saw the captains march into the town,<br> +How there they fought, and did their foes cut down.<br> +I heard the Prince bid Boanerges go<br> +Up to the castle, and there seize his foe;<br> +And saw him and his fellows bring him down,<br> +In chains of great contempt quite through the town.<br> +I saw Emmanuel, when he possess’d<br> +His town of Mansoul; and how greatly blest<br> +A town his gallant town of Mansoul was,<br> +When she received his pardon, loved his laws.<br> +When the Diabolonians were caught,<br> +When tried, and when to execution brought,<br> +Then I was there; yea, I was standing by<br> +When Mansoul did the rebels crucify.<br> +I also saw Mansoul clad all in white,<br> +I heard her Prince call her his heart’s delight.<br> +I saw him put upon her chains of gold,<br> +And rings, and bracelets, goodly to behold.<br> +What shall I say? I heard the people’s cries,<br> +And saw the Prince wipe tears from Mansoul’s eyes.<br> +And heard the groans, and saw the joy of many:<br> +Tell you of all, I neither will, nor can I.<br> +But by what here I say, you well may see<br> +That Mansoul’s matchless wars no fables be.<br> +Mansoul, the desire of both princes was:<br> +One keep his gain would, t’other gain his loss.<br> +Diabolus would cry, ‘The town is mine!’<br> +Emmanuel would plead a right divine<br> +Unto his Mansoul: then to blows they go,<br> +And Mansoul cries, ‘These wars will me undo.’<br> +Mansoul! her wars seemed endless in her eyes;<br> +She’s lost by one, becomes another’s prize:<br> +And he again that lost her last would swear,<br> +‘Have her I will, or her in pieces tear.’<br> +Mansoul! it was the very seat of war;<br> +Wherefore her troubles greater were by far<br> +Than only where the noise of war is heard,<br> +Or where the shaking of a sword is fear’d;<br> +Or only where small skirmishes are fought,<br> +Or where the fancy fighteth with a thought.<br> +She saw the swords of fighting men made red,<br> +And heard the cries of those with them wounded:<br> +Must not her frights, then, be much more by far<br> +Than theirs that to such doings strangers are?<br> +Or theirs that hear the beating of a drum,<br> +But not made fly for fear from house and home?<br> +Mansoul not only heard the trumpet’s sound,<br> +But saw her gallants gasping on the ground:<br> +Wherefore we must not think that she could rest<br> +With them, whose greatest earnest is but jest:<br> +Or where the blust’ring threat’ning of great wars<br> +Do end in parlies, or in wording jars.<br> +Mansoul! her mighty wars, they did portend<br> +Her weal or woe, and that world without end:<br> +Wherefore she must be more concern’d than they<br> +Whose fears begin, and end the selfsame day;<br> +Or where none other harm doth come to him<br> +That is engaged, but loss of life or limb,<br> +As all must needs confess that now do dwell<br> +In Universe, and can this story tell.<br> +Count me not, then, with them that, to amaze<br> +The people, set them on the stars to gaze,<br> +Insinuating with much confidence,<br> +That each of them is now the residence<br> +Of some brave creatures: yea, a world they will<br> +Have in each star, though it be past their skill<br> +To make it manifest to any man,<br> +That reason hath, or tell his fingers can.<br> +But I have too long held thee in the porch,<br> +And kept thee from the sunshine with a torch,<br> +Well, now go forward, step within the door,<br> +And there behold five hundred times much more<br> +Of all sorts of such inward rarities<br> +As please the mind will, and will feed the eyes<br> +With those, which, if a Christian, thou wilt see<br> +Not small, but things of greatest moment be.<br> +Nor do thou go to work without my key;<br> +(In mysteries men soon do lose their way;)<br> +And also turn it right, if thou wouldst know<br> +My riddle, and wouldst with my heifer plough;<br> +It lies there in the window. Fare thee well,<br> +My next may be to ring thy passing-bell.<br> +<br> +JOHN BUNYAN.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +AN ADVERTISEMENT TO THE READER.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +Some say the ‘Pilgrim’s Progress’ is not mine,<br> +Insinuating as if I would shine<br> +In name and fame by the worth of another,<br> +Like some made rich by robbing of their brother.<br> +Or that so fond I am of being sire,<br> +I’ll father bastards; or, if need require,<br> +I’ll tell a lie in print to get applause.<br> +I scorn it: John such dirt-heap never was,<br> +Since God converted him. Let this suffice<br> +To show why I my ‘Pilgrim’ patronize.<br> +It came from mine own heart, so to my head,<br> +And thence into my fingers trickled;<br> +Then to my pen, from whence immediately<br> +On paper I did dribble it daintily.<br> +Manner and matter, too, was all mine own,<br> +Nor was it unto any mortal known<br> +Till I had done it; nor did any then<br> +By books, by wits, by tongues, or hand, or pen,<br> +Add five words to it, or write half a line<br> +Thereof: the whole, and every whit is mine.<br> +Also for THIS, thine eye is now upon,<br> +The matter in this manner came from none<br> +But the same heart, and head, fingers, and pen,<br> +As did the other. Witness all good men;<br> +For none in all the world, without a lie,<br> +Can say that this is mine, excepting I<br> +I write not this of my ostentation,<br> +Nor ‘cause I seek of men their commendation;<br> +I do it to keep them from such surmise,<br> +As tempt them will my name to scandalize.<br> +Witness my name, if anagram’d to thee,<br> +The letters make - ‘Nu hony in a B.’<br> +<br> +JOHN BUNYAN.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +A RELATION OF THE HOLY WAR.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +In my travels, as I walked through many regions and countries, it was +my chance to happen into that famous continent of Universe. A +very large and spacious country it is: it lieth between the two poles, +and just amidst the four points of the heavens. It is a place +well watered, and richly adorned with hills and valleys, bravely situate, +and for the most part, at least where I was, very fruitful, also well +peopled, and a very sweet air.<br> +<br> +The people are not all of one complexion, nor yet of one language, mode, +or way of religion, but differ as much as, it is said, do the planets +themselves. Some are right, and some are wrong, even as it happeneth +to be in lesser regions.<br> +<br> +In this country, as I said, it was my lot to travel; and there travel +I did, and that so long, even till I learned much of their mother tongue, +together with the customs and manners of them among whom I was. +And, to speak truth, I was much delighted to see and hear many things +which I saw and heard among them; yea, I had, to be sure, even lived +and died a native among them, (so was I taken with them and their doings,) +had not my master sent for me home to his house, there to do business +for him, and to oversee business done.<br> +<br> +Now there is in this gallant country of Universe a fair and delicate +town, a corporation called Mansoul; a town for its building so curious, +for its situation so commodious, for its privileges so advantageous, +(I mean with reference to its origin,) that I may say of it, as was +said before of the continent in which it is placed, There is not its +equal under the whole heaven.<br> +<br> +As to the situation of this town, it lieth just between the two worlds; +and the first founder and builder of it, so far as by the best and most +authentic records I can gather, was one Shaddai; and he built it for +his own delight. He made it the mirror and glory of all that he +made, even the top-piece, beyond anything else that he did in that country. +Yea, so goodly a town was Mansoul when first built, that it is said +by some, the gods, at the setting up thereof, came down to see it, and +sang for joy. And as he made it goodly to behold, so also mighty +to have dominion over all the country round about. Yea, all were +commanded to acknowledge Mansoul for their metropolitan, all were enjoined +to do homage to it. Aye, the town itself had positive commission +and power from her King to demand service of all, and also to subdue +any that anyways denied to do it.<br> +<br> +There was reared up in the midst of this town a most famous and stately +palace; for strength, it might be called a castle; for pleasantness, +a paradise; for largeness, a place so copious as to contain all the +world. This place the King Shaddai intended but for himself alone, +and not another with him; partly because of his own delights, and partly +because he would not that the terror of strangers should be upon the +town. This place Shaddai made also a garrison of, but committed +the keeping of it only to the men of the town.<br> +<br> +The walls of the town were well built, yea, so fast and firm were they +knit and compact together, that, had it not been for the townsmen themselves, +they could not have been shaken or broken for ever. For here lay +the excellent wisdom of him that builded Mansoul, that the walls could +never be broken down nor hurt by the most mighty adverse potentate, +unless the townsmen gave consent thereto.<br> +<br> +This famous town of Mansoul had five gates, in at which to come, out +at which to go; and these were made likewise answerable to the walls, +to wit, impregnable, and such as could never be opened nor forced but +by the will and leave of those within. The names of the gates +were these: Ear-gate, Eye-gate, Mouth-gate, Nose-gate, and Feel-gate.<br> +<br> +Other things there were that belonged to the town of Mansoul, which +if you adjoin to these, will yet give farther demonstration to all, +of the glory and strength of the place. It had always a sufficiency +of provision within its walls; it had the best, most wholesome, and +excellent law that then was extant in the world. There was not +a rascal, rogue, or traitorous person then within its walls; they were +all true men, and fast joined together; and this, you know, is a great +matter. And to all these, it had always (so long as it had the +goodness to keep true to Shaddai the King) his countenance, his protection, +and it was his delight, etc.<br> +<br> +Well, upon a time, there was one Diabolus, a mighty giant, made an assault +upon this famous town of Mansoul, to take it, and make it his own habitation. +This giant was king of the blacks, and a most raving prince he was. +We will, if you please, first discourse of the origin of this Diabolus, +and then of his taking of this famous town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +This Diabolus is indeed a great and mighty prince, and yet both poor +and beggarly. As to his origin, he was at first one of the servants +of King Shaddai, made, and taken, and put by him into most high and +mighty place; yea, was put into such principalities as belonged to the +best of his territories and dominions. This Diabolus was made +‘son of the morning,’ and a brave place he had of it: it +brought him much glory, and gave him much brightness, an income that +might have contented his Luciferian heart, had it not been insatiable, +and enlarged as hell itself.<br> +<br> +Well, he seeing himself thus exalted to greatness and honour, and raging +in his mind for higher state and degree, what doth he but begins to +think with himself how he might be set up as lord over all, and have +the sole power under Shaddai. (Now that did the King reserve for +his Son, yea, and had already bestowed it upon him.) Wherefore +he first consults with himself what had best to be done; and then breaks +his mind to some other of his companions, to the which they also agreed. +So, in fine, they came to this issue that they should make an attempt +upon the King’s Son to destroy him, that the inheritance might +be theirs. Well, to be short, the treason, as I said, was concluded, +the time appointed, the word given, the rebels rendezvoused, and the +assault attempted. Now the King and his Son being all and always +eye, could not but discern all passages in his dominions; and he, having +always love for his Son as for himself, could not at what he saw but +be greatly provoked and offended: wherefore what does he, but takes +them in the very nick and first trip that they made towards their design, +convicts them of the treason, horrid rebellion, and conspiracy that +they had devised, and now attempted to put into practice, and casts +them altogether out of all place of trust, benefit, honour, and preferment. +This done, he banishes them the court, turns them down into the horrible +pits, as fast bound in chains, never more to expect the least favour +from his hands, but to abide the judgment that he had appointed, and +that for ever.<br> +<br> +Now they being thus cast out of all place of trust, profit, and honour, +and also knowing that they had lost their prince’s favour for +ever, (being banished his court, and cast down to the horrible pits,) +you may he sure they would now add to their former pride what malice +and rage against Shaddai, and against his Son, they could. Wherefore, +roving and ranging in much fury from place to place, if, perhaps, they +might find something that was the King’s, by spoiling of that, +to revenge themselves on him; at last they happened into this spacious +country of Universe, and steer their course towards the town of Mansoul; +and considering that that town was one of the chief works and delights +of King Shaddai, what do they but, after counsel taken, make an assault +upon that. I say, they knew that Mansoul belonged unto Shaddai; +for they were there when he built it and beautified it for himself. +So when they had found the place, they shouted horribly for joy, and +roared on it as a lion upon the prey, saying, ‘Now we have found +the prize, and how to be revenged on King Shaddai for what he hath done +to us.’ So they sat down and called a council of war, and +considered with themselves what ways and methods they had best to engage +in for the winning to themselves this famous town of Mansoul, and these +four things were then propounded to be considered of.<br> +<br> +First. Whether they had best all of them to show themselves in +this design to the town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +Secondly. Whether they had best to go and sit down against Mansoul +in their now ragged and beggarly guise.<br> +<br> +Thirdly. Whether they had best show to Mansoul their intentions, +and what design they came about, or whether to assault it with words +and ways of deceit.<br> +<br> +Fourthly. Whether they had not best to some of their companions +to give out private orders to take the advantage, if they see one or +more of the principal townsmen, to shoot them, if thereby they shall +judge their cause and design will the better be promoted.<br> +<br> +1. It was answered to the first of these proposals in the negative, +to wit, that it would not be best that all should show themselves before +the town, because the appearance of many of them might alarm and frighten +the town; whereas a few or but one of them was not so likely to do it. +And to enforce this advice to take place it was added further, that +if Mansoul was frighted, or did take the alarm, ‘It is impossible,’ +said Diabolus (for he spake now), ‘that we should take the town: +for that none can enter into it without its own consent. Let, +therefore, but few, or but one, assault Mansoul; and in mine opinion,’ +said Diabolus, ‘let me be he.’ Wherefore to this they +all agreed.<br> +<br> +2. And then to the second proposal they came, namely, Whether they had +best go and sit down before Mansoul in their now ragged and beggarly +guise. To which it was answered also in the negative, By no means; +and that because, though the town of Mansoul had been made to know, +and to have to do, before now, with things that are invisible, they +did never as yet see any of their fellow-creatures in so sad and rascally +condition as they; and this was the advice of that fierce Alecto. +Then said Apollyon, ‘The advice is pertinent; for even one of +us appearing to them as we are now, must needs both beget and multiply +such thoughts in them as will both put them into a consternation of +spirit, and necessitate them to put themselves upon their guard. +And if so,’ said he, ‘then, as my Lord Diabolus said but +now, it is in vain for us to think of taking the town.’ +Then said that mighty giant Beelzebub, ‘The advice that already +is given is safe; for though the men of Mansoul have seen such things +as we once were, yet hitherto they did never behold such things as we +now are; and it is best, in mine opinion, to come upon them in such +a guise as is common to, and most familiar among them.’ +To this, when they had consented, the next thing to be considered was, +in what shape, hue, or guise Diabolus had best to show himself when +he went about to make Mansoul his own. Then one said one thing, +and another the contrary. At last Lucifer answered, that, in his +opinion, it was best that his lordship should assume the body of some +of those creatures that they of the town had dominion over; ‘for,’ +quoth he, ‘these are not only familiar to them, but, being under +them, they will never imagine that an attempt should by them be made +upon the town; and, to blind all, let him assume the body of one of +those beasts that Mansoul deems to be wiser than any of the rest.’ +This advice was applauded of all: so it was determined that the giant +Diabolus should assume the dragon, for that he was in those days as +familiar with the town of Mansoul as now is the bird with the boy; for +nothing that was in its primitive state was at all amazing to them. +Then they proceeded to the third thing, which was:<br> +<br> +3. Whether they had best to show their intentions, or the design of +his coming, to Mansoul, or no. This also was answered in the negative, +because of the weight that was in the former reasons, to wit, for that +Mansoul were a strong people, a strong people in a strong town, whose +wall and gates were impregnable, (to say nothing of their castle,) nor +can they by any means be won but by their own consent. ‘Besides,’ +said Legion, (for he gave answer to this,) ‘a discovery of our +intentions may make them send to their king for aid; and if that be +done, I know quickly what time of day it will be with us. Therefore +let us assault them in all pretended fairness, covering our intentions +with all manner of lies, flatteries, delusive words; feigning things +that never will be, and promising that to them that they shall never +find. This is the way to win Mansoul, and to make them of themselves +open their gates to us; yea, and to desire us too to come in to them. +And the reason why I think that this project will do is, because the +people of Mansoul now are, every one, simple and innocent, all honest +and true; nor do they as yet know what it is to be assaulted with fraud, +guile, and hypocrisy. They are strangers to lying and dissembling +lips; wherefore we cannot, if thus we be disguised, by them at all be +discerned; our lies shall go for true sayings, and our dissimulations +for upright dealings. What we promise them they will in that believe +us, especially if, in all our lies and feigned words, we pretend great +love to them, and that our design is only their advantage and honour.’ +Now there was not one bit of a reply against this; this went as current +down as doth the water down a steep descent. Wherefore they go +to consider of the last proposal, which was:<br> +<br> +4. Whether they had not best to give out orders to some of their company +to shoot some one or more of the principal of the townsmen, if they +judge that their cause may be promoted thereby. This was carried +in the affirmative, and the man that was designed by this stratagem +to be destroyed was one Mr. Resistance, otherwise called Captain Resistance. +And a great man in Mansoul this Captain Resistance was, and a man that +the giant Diabolus and his band more feared than they feared the whole +town of Mansoul besides. Now who should be the actor to do the +murder? That was the next, and they appointed one Tisiphone, a +fury of the lake, to do it.<br> +<br> +They thus having ended their council of war, rose up, and essayed to +do as they had determined; they marched towards Mansoul, but all in +a manner invisible, save one, only one; nor did he approach the town +in his own likeness, but under the shade and in the body of the dragon.<br> +<br> +So they drew up and sat down before Ear-gate, for that was the place +of hearing for all without the town, as Eye-gate was the place of perspection. +So, as I said, he came up with his train to the gate, and laid his ambuscado +for Captain Resistance within bow-shot of the town. This done, +the giant ascended up close to the gate, and called to the town of Mansoul +for audience. Nor took he any with him but one Ill-pause, who +was his orator in all difficult matters. Now, as I said, he being +come up to the gate, (as the manner of those times was,) sounded his +trumpet for audience; at which the chief of the town of Mansoul, such +as my Lord Innocent, my Lord Willbewill, my Lord Mayor, Mr. Recorder, +and Captain Resistance, came down to the wall to see who was there, +and what was the matter. And my Lord Willbewill, when he had looked +over and saw who stood at the gate, demanded what he was, wherefore +he was come, and why he roused the town of Mansoul with so unusual a +sound.<br> +<br> +Diabolus, then, as if he had been a lamb, began his oration, and said: +‘Gentlemen of the famous town of Mansoul, I am, as you may perceive, +no far dweller from you, but near, and one that is bound by the king +to do you my homage and what service I can; wherefore, that I may be +faithful to myself and to you, I have somewhat of concern to impart +unto you. Wherefore, grant me your audience, and hear me patiently. +And first, I will assure you, it is not myself, but you - not mine, +but your advantage that I seek by what I now do, as will full well be +made manifest, by that I have opened my mind unto you. For, gentlemen, +I am (to tell you the truth) come to show you how you may obtain great +and ample deliverance from a bondage that, unawares to yourselves, you +are captivated and enslaved under.’ At this the town of +Mansoul began to prick up its ears. And ‘What is it? +Pray what is it?’ thought they. And he said, ‘I have +somewhat to say to you concerning your King, concerning his law, and +also touching yourselves. Touching your King, I know he is great +and potent; but yet all that he hath said to you is neither true nor +yet for your advantage. 1. It is not true, for that wherewith +he hath hitherto awed you, shall not come to pass, nor be fulfilled, +though you do the thing that he hath forbidden. But if there was +danger, what a slavery is it to live always in fear of the greatest +of punishments, for doing so small and trivial a thing as eating of +a little fruit is. 2. Touching his laws, this I say further, they +are both unreasonable, intricate, and intolerable. Unreasonable, +as was hinted before; for that the punishment is not proportioned to +the offence: there is great difference and disproportion between the +life and an apple; yet the one must go for the other by the law of your +Shaddai. But it is also intricate, in that he saith, first, you +may eat of all; and yet after forbids the eating of one. And then, +in the last place, it must needs be intolerable, forasmuch as that fruit +which you are forbidden to eat of (if you are forbidden any) is that, +and that alone, which is able, by your eating, to minister to you a +good as yet unknown by you. This is manifest by the very name +of the tree; it is called the “tree of knowledge of good and evil;” +and have you that knowledge as yet? No, no; nor can you conceive how +good, how pleasant, and how much to be desired to make one wise it is, +so long as you stand by your King’s commandment. Why should +you be holden in ignorance and blindness? Why should you not be +enlarged in knowledge and understanding? And now, O ye inhabitants +of the famous town of Mansoul, to speak more particularly to yourselves +you are not a free people! You are kept both in bondage and slavery, +and that by a grievous threat; no reason being annexed but, “So +I will have it; so it shall be.” And is it not grievous +to think on, that that very thing which you are forbidden to do might +you but do it, would yield you both wisdom and honour? for then your +eyes will be opened, and you shall be as gods. Now, since this +is thus,’ quoth he, ‘can you be kept by any prince in more +slavery and in greater bondage than you are under this day? You +are made underlings, and are wrapped up in inconveniences, as I have +well made appear. For what bondage greater than to be kept in +blindness? Will not reason tell you that it is better to have +eyes than to be without them? and so to be at liberty to be better than +to be shut up in a dark and stinking cave?’<br> +<br> +And just now, while Diabolus was speaking these words to Mansoul, Tisiphone +shot at Captain Resistance, where he stood on the gate, and mortally +wounded him in the head; so that he, to the amazement of the townsmen, +and the encouragement of Diabolus, fell down dead quite over the wall. +Now, when Captain Resistance was dead, (and he was the only man of war +in the town,) poor Mansoul was wholly left naked of courage, nor had +she now any heart to resist. But this was as the devil would have +it. Then stood forth he, Mr. Ill-pause, that Diabolus brought +with him, who was his orator; and he addressed himself to speak to the +town of Mansoul; the tenour of whose speech here follows:-<br> +<br> +‘Gentlemen,’ quoth he, ‘it is my master’s happiness +that he has this day a quiet and teachable auditory; and it is hoped +by us that we shall prevail with you not to cast off good advice. +My master has a very great love for you; and although, as he very well +knows, that he runs the hazard of the anger of King Shaddai, yet love +to you will make him do more than that. Nor doth there need that +a word more should be spoken to confirm for truth what he hath said; +there is not a word but carries with it self-evidence in its bowels; +the very name of the tree may put an end to all controversy in this +matter. I therefore, at this time, shall only add this advice +to you, under and by the leave of my lord;’ (and with that he +made Diabolus a very low congee;) ‘consider his words, look on +the tree and the promising fruit thereof; remember also that yet you +know but little, and that this is the way to know more: and if your +reasons be not conquered to accept of such good counsel, you are not +the men that I took you to be.’<br> +<br> +But when the townsfolk saw that the tree was good for food, and that +it was pleasant to the eye, and a tree to be desired to make one wise, +they did as old Ill-pause advised; they took and did eat thereof. +Now this I should have told you before, that even then, when this Ill-pause +was making his speech to the townsmen, my Lord Innocency (whether by +a shot from the camp of the giant, or from some sinking qualm that suddenly +took him, or whether by the stinking breath of that treacherous villain +old Ill-pause, for so I am most apt to think) sunk down in the place +where he stood, nor could be brought to life again. Thus these +two brave men died - brave men, I call them; for they were the beauty +and glory of Mansoul, so long as they lived therein; nor did there now +remain any more a noble spirit in Mansoul; they all fell down and yielded +obedience to Diabolus; and became his slaves and vassals, as you shall +hear.<br> +<br> +Now these being dead, what do the rest of the townsfolk, but, as men +that had found a fool’s paradise, they presently, as afore was +hinted, fall to prove the truth of the giant’s words. And, +first, they did as Ill-pause had taught them; they looked, they considered +they were taken with the forbidden fruit; they took thereof, and did +eat; and having eaten, they became immediately drunken therewith. +So they open the gate, both Ear-gate and Eye-gate, and let in Diabolus +with all his bands, quite forgetting their good Shaddai, his law, and +the judgment that he had annexed, with solemn threatening, to the breach +thereof.<br> +<br> + Diabolus, having now obtained entrance in at the gates of the +town, marches up to the middle thereof, to make his conquest as sure +as he could; and finding, by this time, the affections of the people +warmly inclining to him, he, as thinking it was best striking while +the iron is hot, made this further deceivable speech unto them, saying, +‘Alas, my poor Mansoul! I have done thee indeed this service, +as to promote thee to honour, and to greaten thy liberty; but, alas! +alas! poor Mansoul, thou wantest now one to defend thee; for assure +thyself that when Shaddai shall hear what is done, he will come; for +sorry will he be that thou hast broken his bonds, and cast his cords +away from thee. What wilt thou do? Wilt thou, after enlargement, +suffer thy privileges to be invaded and taken away, or what wilt resolve +with thyself?’<br> +<br> +Then they all with one consent said to this bramble, ‘Do thou +reign over us.’ So he accepted the motion, and became the +king of the town of Mansoul. This being done, the next thing was +to give him possession of the castle, and so of the whole strength of +the town. Wherefore, into the castle he goes; it was that which +Shaddai built in Mansoul for his own delight and pleasure; this now +was become a den and hold for the giant Diabolus.<br> +<br> +Now, having got possession of this stately palace or castle, what doth +he but makes it a garrison for himself, and strengthens and fortifies +it with all sorts of provision, against the King Shaddai, or those that +should endeavour the regaining of it to him and his obedience again.<br> +<br> +This done, but not thinking himself yet secure enough, in the next place +he bethinks himself of new modelling the town; and so he does, setting +up one, and putting down another at pleasure. Wherefore my Lord +Mayor, whose name was my Lord Understanding, and Mr. Recorder, whose +name was Mr. Conscience, these he put out of place and power.<br> +<br> +As for my Lord Mayor, though he was an understanding man, and one too +that had complied with the rest of the town of Mansoul in admitting +the giant into the town, yet Diabolus thought not fit to let him abide +in his former lustre and glory, because he was a seeing man. Wherefore +he darkened him, not only by taking from him his office and power, but +by building a high and strong tower, just between the sun’s reflections +and the windows of my lord’s palace; by which means his house +and all, and the whole of his habitation, were made as dark as darkness +itself. And thus, being alienated from the light, he became as +one that was born blind. To this, his house, my lord was confined +as to a prison; nor might he, upon his parole, go farther than within +his own bounds. And now, had he had a heart to do for Mansoul, +what could he do for it, or wherein could he be profitable to her? +So then, so long as Mansoul was under the power and government of Diabolus, +(and so long it was under him, as it was obedient to him, which was +even until by a war it was rescued out of his hand,) so long my Lord +Mayor was rather an impediment in, than an advantage to the famous town +of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +As for Mr. Recorder, before the town was taken, he was a man well read +in the laws of his king, and also a man of courage and faithfulness +to speak truth at every occasion; and he had a tongue as bravely hung +as he had a head filled with judgment. Now, this man Diabolus +could by no means abide, because, though he gave his consent to his +coming into the town, yet he could not, by all the wiles, trials, stratagems, +and devices that he could use, make him wholly his own. True, +he was much degenerated from his former king, and also much pleased +with many of the giant’s laws and service; but all this would +not do, forasmuch as he was not wholly his. He would now and then +think upon Shaddai, and have dread of his law upon him, and then he +would speak against Diabolus with a voice as great as when a lion roareth. +Yea, and would also at certain times, when his fits were upon him, (for +you must know that sometimes he had terrible fits,) make the whole town +of Mansoul shake with his voice: and therefore the now king of Mansoul +could not abide him.<br> +<br> +Diabolus, therefore, feared the Recorder more than any that was left +alive in the town of Mansoul, because, as I said, his words did shake +the whole town; they were like the rattling thunder, and also like thunder-claps. +Since, therefore, the giant could not make him wholly his own, what +doth he do but studies all that he could to debauch the old gentleman, +and by debauchery to stupefy his mind, and more harden his heart in +the ways of vanity. And as he attempted, so he accomplished his +design: he debauched the man, and by little and little so drew him into +sin and wickedness, that at last he was not only debauched, as at first, +and so by consequence defiled, but was almost (at last, I say) past +all conscience of sin. And this was the farthest Diabolus could +go. Wherefore he bethinks him of another project, and that was, +to persuade the men of the town that Mr. Recorder was mad, and so not +to be regarded. And for this he urged his fits, and said, ‘If +he be himself, why doth he not do thus always? But,’ quoth +he, ‘as all mad folks have their fits, and in them their raving +language, so hath this old and doating gentleman.’<br> +<br> +Thus, by one means or another, he quickly got Mansoul to slight, neglect, +and despise whatever Mr. Recorder could say. For, besides what +already you have heard, Diabolus had a way to make the old gentleman, +when he was merry, unsay and deny what he in his fits had affirmed. +And, indeed, this was the next way to make himself ridiculous, and to +cause that no man should regard him. Also now he never spake freely +for King Shaddai, but also by force and constraint. Besides, he +would at one time be hot against that at which, at another, he would +hold his peace; so uneven was he now in his doings. Sometimes +he would be as if fast asleep, and again sometimes as dead, even then +when the whole town of Mansoul was in her career after vanity, and in +her dance after the giant’s pipe.<br> +<br> +Wherefore, sometimes when Mansoul did use to be frighted with the thundering +voice of the Recorder that was, and when they did tell Diabolus of it, +he would answer, that what the old gentleman said was neither of love +to him nor pity to them, but of a foolish fondness that he had to be +prating; and so would hush, still, and put all to quiet again. +And that he might leave no argument unurged that might tend to make +them secure, he said, and said it often, ‘O Mansoul! consider +that, notwithstanding the old gentleman’s rage, and the rattle +of his high and thundering words, you hear nothing of Shaddai himself;’ +when, liar and deceiver that he was, every outcry of Mr. Recorder against +the sin of Mansoul was the voice of God in him to them. But he +goes on, and says, ‘You see that he values not the loss nor rebellion +of the town of Mansoul, nor will he trouble himself with calling his +town to a reckoning for their giving themselves to me. He knows +that though you were his, now you are lawfully mine; so, leaving us +one to another, he now hath shaken his hands of us.<br> +<br> +‘Moreover, O Mansoul!’ quoth he, ‘consider how I have +served you, even to the uttermost of my power; and that with the best +that I have, could get, or procure for you in all the world: besides, +I dare say that the laws and customs that you now are under, and by +which you do homage to me, do yield you more solace and content than +did the paradise that at first you possessed. Your liberty also, +as yourselves do very well know, has been greatly widened and enlarged +by me; whereas I found you a penned-up people. I have not laid +any restraint upon you; you have no law, statute, or judgment of mine +to fright you; I call none of you to account for your doings, except +the madman - you know who I mean; I have granted you to live, each man +like a prince in his own, even with as little control from me as I myself +have from you.’<br> +<br> +And thus would Diabolus hush up and quiet the town of Mansoul, when +the Recorder that was, did at times molest them: yea, and with such +cursed orations as these, would set the whole town in a rage and fury +against the old gentleman. Yea, the rascal crew at some times +would be for destroying him. They have often wished, in my hearing, +that he had lived a thousand miles off from them: his company, his words, +yea, the sight of him, and specially when they remembered how in old +times he did use to threaten and condemn them, (for all he was now so +debauched,) did terrify and afflict them sore.<br> +<br> +But all wishes were vain, for I do not know how, unless by the power +of Shaddai, and his wisdom, he was preserved in being amongst them. +Besides, his house was as strong as a castle, and stood hard by a stronghold +of the town: moreover, if at any time any of the crew or rabble attempted +to make him away, he could pull up the sluices, and let in such floods +as would drown all round about him.<br> +<br> +But to leave Mr. Recorder, and to come to my Lord Willbewill, another +of the gentry of the famous town of Mansoul. This Willbewill was +as high-born as any man in Mansoul, and was as much, if not more, a +freeholder than many of them were; besides, if I remember my tale aright, +he had some privileges peculiar to himself in the famous town of Mansoul. +Now, together with these, he was a man of great strength, resolution, +and courage, nor in his occasion could any turn him away. But +I say, whether he was proud of his estate, privileges, strength, or +what, (but sure it was through pride of something,) he scorns now to +be a slave in Mansoul; and therefore resolves to bear office under Diabolus, +that he might (such an one as he was) be a petty ruler and governor +in Mansoul. And, headstrong man that he was! thus he began betimes; +for this man, when Diabolus did make his oration at Ear-gate, was one +of the first that was for consenting to his words, and for accepting +his counsel at wholesome, and that was for the opening of the gate, +and for letting him into the town; wherefore Diabolus had a kindness +for him, and therefore he designed for him a place. And perceiving +the valour and stoutness of the man, he coveted to have him for one +of his great ones, to act and do in matters of the highest concern.<br> +<br> +So he sent for him, and talked with him of that secret matter that lay +in his breast, but there needed not much persuasion in the case. +For as at first he was willing that Diabolus should be let into the +town, so now he was as willing to serve him there. When the tyrant, +therefore, perceived the willingness of my lord to serve him, and that +his mind stood bending that way, he forthwith made him the captain of +the castle, governor of the wall, and keeper of the gates of Mansoul: +yea, there was a clause in his commission, that nothing without him +should be done in all the town of Mansoul. So that now, next to +Diabolus himself, who but my Lord Willbewill in all the town of Mansoul! +nor could anything now be done, but at his will and pleasure, throughout +the town of Mansoul. He had also one Mr. Mind for his clerk, a +man to speak on every way like his master: for he and his lord were +in principle one, and in practice not far asunder. And now was +Mansoul brought under to purpose, and made to fulfil the lusts of the +will, and of the mind.<br> +<br> +But it will not out of my thoughts what a desperate one this Willbewill +was when power was put into his hand. First, he flatly denied +that he owed any suit or service to his former prince and liege lord. +This done, in the next place he took an oath, and swore fidelity to +his great master Diabolus, and then, being stated and settled in his +places, offices, advancements, and preferments, oh! you cannot think, +unless you had seen it, the strange work that this workman made in the +town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +First, he maligned Mr. Recorder to death; he would neither endure to +see him, nor hear the words of his mouth; he would shut his eyes when +he saw him, and stop his ears when he heard him speak. Also he +could not endure that so much as a fragment of the law of Shaddai should +be anywhere seen in the town. For example, his clerk, Mr. Mind, +had some old, rent, and torn parchments of the law of Shaddai in his +house, but when Willbewill saw them, he cast them behind his back. +True, Mr. Recorder had some of the laws in his study; but my lord could +by no means come at them. He also thought and said, that the windows +of my old Lord Mayor’s house were always too light for the profit +of the town of Mansoul. The light of a candle he could not endure. +Now nothing at all pleased Willbewill but what pleased Diabolus his +lord.<br> +<br> +There was none like him to trumpet about the streets the brave nature, +the wise conduct, and great glory of the king Diabolus. He would +range and rove throughout all the streets of Mansoul to cry up his illustrious +lord, and would make himself even as an abject, among the base and rascal +crew, to cry up his valiant prince. And I say, when and wheresoever +he found these vassals, he would even make himself as one of them. +In all ill courses he would act without bidding, and do mischief without +commandment.<br> +<br> +The Lord Willbewill also had a deputy under him, and his name was Mr. +Affection, one that was also greatly debauched in his principles, and +answerable thereto in his life: he was wholly given to the flesh, and +therefore they called him Vile-Affection. Now there was he and +one Carnal-Lust, the daughter of Mr. Mind, (like to like,) that fell +in love, and made a match, and were married; and, as I take it, they +had several children, as Impudent, Blackmouth, and Hate-Reproof. +These three were black boys. And besides these they had three +daughters, as Scorn-Truth and Slight-God, and the name of the youngest +was Revenge. These were all married in the town, and also begot +and yielded many bad brats, too many to be here inserted. But +to pass by this.<br> +<br> +When the giant had thus engarrisoned himself in the town of Mansoul, +and had put down and set up whom he thought good, he betakes himself +to defacing. Now there was in the market-place in Mansoul, and +also upon the gates of the castle, an image of the blessed King Shaddai. +This image was so exactly engraven, (and it was engraven in gold,) that +it did the most resemble Shaddai himself of anything that then was extant +in the world. This he basely commanded to be defaced, and it was +as basely done by the hand of Mr. No-Truth. Now you must know +that, as Diabolus had commanded, and that by the hand of Mr. No-Truth, +the image of Shaddai was defaced, he likewise gave order that the same +Mr. No-Truth should set up in its stead the horrid and formidable image +of Diabolus, to the great contempt of the former King, and debasing +of his town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +Moreover, Diabolus made havoc of all remains of the laws and statutes +of Shaddai that could be found in the town of Mansoul; to wit, such +as contained either the doctrines of morals, with all civil and natural +documents. Also relative severities he sought to extinguish. +To be short, there was nothing of the remains of good in Mansoul which +he and Willbewill sought not to destroy; for their design was to turn +Mansoul into a brute, and to make it like to the sensual sow, by the +hand of Mr. No-Truth.<br> +<br> +When he had destroyed what law and good orders he could, then further +to effect his design, namely, to alienate Mansoul from Shaddai her King, +he commands, and they set up his own vain edicts, statutes, and commandments, +in all places of resort or concourse in Mansoul, to wit, such as gave +liberty to the lusts of the flesh, the lusts of the eyes, and the pride +of life, which are not of Shaddai, but of the world. He encouraged, +countenanced, and promoted lasciviousness, and all ungodliness there. +Yea, much more did Diabolus to encourage wickedness in the town of Mansoul; +he promised them peace, content, joy, and bliss, in doing his commands, +and that they should never be called to an account for their not doing +the contrary. And let this serve to give a taste to them that +love to hear tell of what is done beyond their knowledge afar off in +other countries.<br> +<br> +Now Mansoul being wholly at his beck, and brought wholly to his bow, +nothing was heard or seen therein but that which tended to set up him.<br> +<br> +But now he, having disabled the Lord Mayor and Mr. Recorder from bearing +of office in Mansoul, and seeing that the town, before he came to it, +was the most ancient of corporations in the world, and fearing, if he +did not maintain greatness, they at any time should object that he had +done them an injury; therefore, I say, (that they might see that he +did not intend to lessen their grandeur, or to take from them any of +their advantageous things,) he did choose for them a Lord Mayor and +a Recorder himself, and such as contented them at the heart, and such +also as pleased him wondrous well.<br> +<br> +The name of the Mayor that was of Diabolus’ making was the Lord +Lustings, a man that had neither eyes nor ears. All that he did, +whether as a man or an officer, he did it naturally, as doth the beast. +And that which made him yet the more ignoble, though not to Mansoul, +yet to them that beheld and were grieved for its ruin, was, that he +never could favour good, but evil.<br> +<br> +The Recorder was one whose name was Forget-Good, and a very sorry fellow +he was. He could remember nothing but mischief, and to do it with +delight. He was naturally prone to do things that were hurtful, +even hurtful to the town of Mansoul, and to all the dwellers there. +These two, therefore, by their power and practice, examples, and smiles +upon evil, did much more grammar and settle the common people in hurtful +ways. For who doth not perceive that when those that sit aloft +are vile and corrupt themselves, they corrupt the whole region and country +where they are?<br> +<br> +Besides these, Diabolus made several burgesses and aldermen in Mansoul, +such as out of whom the town, when it needed, might choose them officers, +governors, and magistrates. And these are the names of the chief +of them: Mr. Incredulity, Mr. Haughty, Mr. Swearing, Mr. Whoring, Mr. +Hard-Heart, Mr. Pitiless, Mr. Fury, Mr. No-Truth, Mr. Stand-to-Lies, +Mr. False-Peace, Mr. Drunkenness, Mr. Cheating, Mr. Atheism - thirteen +in all. Mr. Incredulity is the eldest, and Mr. Atheism the youngest +of the company.<br> +<br> +There was also an election of common councilmen and others, as bailiffs, +sergeants, constables, and others; but all of them like to those afore-named, +being either fathers, brothers, cousins, or nephews to them, whose names, +for brevity’s sake, I omit to mention.<br> +<br> +When the giant had thus far proceeded in his work, in the next place, +he betook him to build some strongholds in the town, and he built three +that seemed to be impregnable. The first he called the Hold of +Defiance, because it was made to command the whole town, and to keep +it from the knowledge of its ancient King. The second he called +Midnight Hold, because it was built on purpose to keep Mansoul from +the true knowledge of itself. The third was called Sweet-Sin Hold, +because by that he fortified Mansoul against all desires of good. +The first of these holds stood close by Eye-gate, that, as much might +be, light might be darkened there; the second was built hard by the +old castle, to the end that that might be made more blind, if possible; +and the third stood in the market-place.<br> +<br> +He that Diabolus made governor over the first of these was one Spite-God, +a most blasphemous wretch: he came with the whole rabble of them that +came against Mansoul at first, and was himself one of themselves. +He that was made the governor of Midnight Hold was one Love-no-Light; +he was also of them that came first against the town. And he that +was made the governor of the hold called Sweet-Sin Hold was one whose +name was Love-Flesh: he was also a very lewd fellow, but not of that +country where the other are bound. This fellow could find more +sweetness when he stood sucking of a lust than he did in all the paradise +of God.<br> +<br> +And now Diabolus thought himself safe. He had taken Mansoul, he +had engarrisoned himself therein; he had put down the old officers, +and had set up new ones; he had defaced the image of Shaddai, and had +set up his own; he had spoiled the old law books, and had promoted his +own vain lies; he had made him new magistrates, and set up new aldermen; +he had builded him new holds, and had manned them for himself: and all +this he did to make himself secure, in case the good Shaddai, or his +Son, should come to make an incursion upon him.<br> +<br> +Now you may well think, that long before this time, word, by some one +or other, could not but be carried to the good King Shaddai, how his +Mansoul, in the continent of Universe, was lost; and that the runagate +giant Diabolus, once one of his Majesty’s servants, had, in rebellion +against the King, made sure thereof for himself. Yea, tidings +were carried and brought to the King thereof, and that to a very circumstance.<br> +<br> +At first, how Diabolus came upon Mansoul (they being a simple people +and innocent) with craft, subtlety, lies, and guile. <i>Item</i>, +that he had treacherously slain the right noble and valiant captain, +their Captain Resistance, as he stood upon the gate with the rest of +the townsmen. <i>Item</i>, how my brave Lord Innocent fell down +dead (with grief, some say, or with being poisoned with the stinking +breath of one Ill-Pause, as say others) at the hearing of his just lord +and rightful prince, Shaddai, so abused by the mouth of so filthy a +Diabolian as that varlet Ill-Pause was. The messenger further +told, that after this Ill-Pause had made a short oration to the townsmen +in behalf of Diabolus, his master; the simple town, believing that what +was said was true, with one consent did open Ear-gate, the chief gate +of the corporation, and did let him, with his crew, into a possession +of the famous town of Mansoul. He further showed how Diabolus +had served the Lord Mayor and Mr. Recorder, to wit, that he had put +them from all place of power and trust. <i>Item</i>, he showed +also that my Lord Willbewill was turned a very rebel, and runagate, +and that so was one Mr. Mind, his clerk; and that they two did range +and revel it all the town over, and teach the wicked ones their ways. +He said, moreover, that this Willbewill was put into great trust, and +particularly that Diabolus had put into Willbewill’s hand all +the strong places in Mansoul; and that Mr. Affection was made my Lord +Willbewill’s deputy in his most rebellious affairs. ‘Yea,’ +said the messenger, ‘this monster, Lord Willbewill, has openly +disavowed his King Shaddai, and hath horribly given his faith and plighted +his troth to Diabolus.’<br> +<br> +‘Also,’ said the messenger, ‘besides all this, the +new king, or rather rebellious tyrant, over the once famous, but now +perishing town of Mansoul, has set up a Lord Mayor and a Recorder of +his own. For Mayor, he has set up one Mr. Lustings; and for Recorder, +Mr. Forget-Good; two of the vilest of all the town of Mansoul.’ +This faithful messenger also proceeded, and told what a sort of new +burgesses Diabolus had made; also that he had built several strong forts, +towers, and strongholds in Mansoul. He told, too, the which I +had almost forgot, how Diabolus had put the town of Mansoul into arms, +the better to capacitate them, on his behalf, to make resistance against +Shaddai their King, should he come to reduce them to their former obedience.<br> +<br> +Now this tidings-teller did not deliver his relation of things in private, +but in open court, the King and his Son, high lords, chief captains, +and nobles, being all there present to hear. But by that they +had heard the whole of the story, it would have amazed one to have seen, +had he been there to behold it, what sorrow and grief, and compunction +of spirit, there was among all sorts, to think that famous Mansoul was +now taken: only the King and his Son foresaw all this long before, yea, +and sufficiently provided for the relief of Mansoul, though they told +not everybody thereof. Yet because they also would have a share +in condoling of the Misery of Mansoul, therefore they also did, and +that at a rate of the highest degree, bewail the losing of Mansoul. +The King said plainly that it grieved him at the heart, and you may +be sure that his Son was not a whit behind him. Thus gave they +conviction to all about them that they had love and compassion for the +famous town of Mansoul. Well, when the King and his Son were retired +into the privy chamber, there they again consulted about what they had +designed before, to wit, that as Mansoul should in time be suffered +to be lost, so as certainly it should be recovered again; recovered, +I say, in such a way, as that both the King and his Son would get themselves +eternal fame and glory thereby. Wherefore, after this consult, +the Son of Shaddai (a sweet and comely Person, and one that had always +great affection for those that were in affliction, but one that had +mortal enmity in his heart against Diabolus, because he was designed +for it, and because he sought his crown and dignity) - this Son of Shaddai, +I say, having stricken hands with his Father and promised that he would +be his servant to recover his Mansoul again, stood by his resolution, +nor would he repent of the same. The purport of which agreement +was this: to wit, that at a certain time, prefixed by both, the King’s +Son should take a journey into the country of Universe, and there, in +a way of justice and equity, by making amends for the follies of Mansoul, +he should lay a foundation of perfect deliverance from Diabolus and +from his tyranny.<br> +<br> +Moreover Emmanuel resolved to make, at a time convenient, a war upon +the giant Diabolus, even while he was possessed of the town of Mansoul; +and that he would fairly by strength of hand drive him out of his hold, +his nest, and take it to himself to be his habitation.<br> +<br> +This now being resolved upon, order was given to the Lord Chief Secretary +to draw up a fair record of what was determined, and to cause that it +should be published in all the corners of the kingdom of Universe. +A short breviate of the contents thereof you may, if you please, take +here as follows:<br> +<br> +‘Let all men know who are concerned, that the Son of Shaddai, +the great King, is engaged by covenant to his Father to bring his Mansoul +to him again; yea, and to put Mansoul, too, through the power of his +matchless love, into a far better and more happy condition than it was +in before it was taken by Diabolus.’<br> +<br> +These papers, therefore, were published in several places, to the no +little molestation of the tyrant Diabolus; ‘for now,’ thought +he, ‘I shall be molested, and my habitation will be taken from +me.’<br> +<br> +But when this matter, I mean this purpose of the King and his Son, did +at first take air at court, who can tell how the high lords, chief captains, +and noble princes that were there, were taken with the business! +First, they whispered it one to another, and after that it began to +ring out through the King’s palace, all wondering at the glorious +design that between the King and his Son was on foot for the miserable +town of Mansoul. Yea, the courtiers could scarce do anything either +for the King or kingdom, but they would mix, with the doing thereof, +a noise of the love of the King and his Son, that they had for the town +of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +Nor could these lords, high captains, and princes be content to keep +this news at court; yea, before the records thereof were perfected, +themselves came down and told it in Universe. At last it came +to the ears, as I said, of Diabolus, to his no little discontent; for +you must think it would perplex him to hear of such a design against +him. Well, but after a few casts in his mind, he concluded upon +these four things.<br> +<br> +First, that this news, these good tidings, (if possible,) should be +kept from the ears of the town of Mansoul; ‘for,’ said he, +‘if they should once come to the knowledge that Shaddai, their +former King, and Emmanuel his Son, are contriving good for the town +of Mansoul, what can be expected by me, but that Mansoul will make a +revolt from under my hand and government, and return again to him?’<br> +<br> +Now, to accomplish this his design, he renews his flattery with my Lord +Willbewill, and also gives him strict charge and command, that he should +keep watch by day and by night at all the gates of the town, especially +Ear-gate and Eye-gate; ‘for I hear of a design,’ quoth he, +‘a design to make us all traitors, and that Mansoul must be reduced +to its first bondage again. I hope they are but flying stories,’ +quoth he; ‘however, let no such news by any means be let into +Mansoul, lest the people be dejected thereat. I think, my lord, +it can be no welcome news to you; I am sure it is none to me; and I +think that, at this time, it should be all our wisdom and care to nip +the head of all such rumours as shall tend to trouble our people. +Wherefore I desire, my lord, that you will in this matter do as I say. +Let there be strong guards daily kept at every gate of the town. +Stop also and examine from whence such come that you perceive do from +far come hither to trade, nor let them by any means be admitted into +Mansoul, unless you shall plainly perceive that they are favourers of +our excellent government. I command, moreover,’ said Diabolus, +‘that there be spies continually walking up and down the town +of Mansoul, and let them have power to suppress and destroy any that +they shall perceive to be plotting against us, or that shall prate of +what by Shaddai and Emmanuel is intended.’<br> +<br> +This, therefore, was accordingly done; my Lord Willbewill hearkened +to his lord and master, went willingly after the commandment, and, with +all the diligence he could, kept any that would from going out abroad, +or that sought to bring these tidings to Mansoul, from coming into the +town.<br> +<br> +Secondly, this done, in the next place, Diabolus, that he might make +Mansoul as sure as he could, frames and imposes a new oath and horrible +covenant upon the townsfolk:- To wit, that they should never desert +him nor his government, nor yet betray him, nor seek to alter his laws; +but that they should own, confess, stand by, and acknowledge him for +their rightful king, in defiance to any that do or hereafter shall, +by any pretence, law, or title whatever, lay claim to the town of Mansoul; +thinking, belike, that Shaddai had not power to absolve them from this +covenant with death, and agreement with hell. Nor did the silly +Mansoul stick or boggle at all at this most monstrous engagement; but, +as if it had been a sprat in the mouth of a whale, they swallowed it +without any chewing. Were they troubled at all? Nay, they +rather bragged and boasted of their so brave fidelity to the tyrant, +their pretended king, swearing that they would never be changelings, +nor forsake their old lord for a new. Thus did Diabolus tie poor +Mansoul fast.<br> +<br> +Thirdly. But jealousy, that never thinks itself strong enough, +put him, in the next place, upon another exploit, which was, yet more, +if possible, to debauch this town of Mansoul. Wherefore he caused, +by the hand of one Mr. Filth, an odious, nasty, lascivious piece of +beastliness to be drawn up in writing, and to be set upon the castle +gates; whereby he granted and gave license to all his true and trusty +sons in Mansoul to do whatsoever their lustful appetites prompted them +to do; and that no man was to let, hinder, or control them, upon pain +of incurring the displeasure of their prince.<br> +<br> +Now this he did for these reasons:-<br> +<br> +1. That the town of Mansoul might be yet made weaker and weaker, and +so more unable, should tidings come that their redemption was designed, +to believe, hope, or consent to the truth thereof; for reason says, +The bigger the sinner, the less grounds of hopes of mercy.<br> +<br> +2. The second reason was, if perhaps Emmanuel, the Son of Shaddai their +King, by seeing the horrible and profane doings of the town of Mansoul, +might repent, though entered into a covenant of redeeming them, of pursuing +that covenant of their redemption; for he knew that Shaddai was holy, +and that his Son Emmanuel was holy; yea, he knew it by woeful experience, +for for his iniquity and sin was Diabolus cast from the highest orbs. +Wherefore what more rational than for him to conclude that thus, for +sin, it might fare with Mansoul? But fearing also lest this knot +should break, he bethinks himself of another, to wit:-<br> +<br> +Fourthly. To endeavour to possess all hearts in the town of Mansoul +that Shaddai was raising an army, to come to overthrow and utterly to +destroy this town of Mansoul. And this he did to forestall any +tidings that might come to their ears of their deliverance: ‘For,’ +thought he, ‘if I first bruit this, the tidings that shall come +after will all be swallowed up of this; for what else will Mansoul say, +when they shall hear that they must be delivered, but that the true +meaning is, Shaddai intends to destroy them? Wherefore he summons +the whole town into the market-place, and there, with deceitful tongue, +thus he addressed himself unto them:-<br> +<br> +‘Gentlemen, and my very good friends, you are all, as you know, +my legal subjects, and men of the famous town of Mansoul. You +know how, from the first day that I have been with you until now, I +have behaved myself among you, and what liberty and great privileges +you have enjoyed under my government, I hope to your honour and mine, +and also to your content and delight. Now, my famous Mansoul, +a noise of trouble there is abroad, of trouble to the town of Mansoul; +sorry I am thereof for your sakes: for I received but now by the post +from my Lord Lucifer, (and he useth to have good intelligence,) that +your old King Shaddai is raising an army to come against you, to destroy +you root and branch; and this, O Mansoul, is now the cause that at this +time I have called you together, namely, to advise what in this juncture +is best to be done. For my part, I am but one, and can with ease +shift for myself, did I list to seek my own case, and to leave my Mansoul +in all the danger; but my heart is so firmly united to you, and so unwilling +am I to leave you, that I am willing to stand and fall with you, to +the utmost hazard that shall befall me. What say you, O my Mansoul? +Will you now desert your old friend, or do you think of standing by +me?’<br> +<br> +Then, as one man, with one mouth, they cried out together, ‘Let +him die the death that will not.’<br> +<br> +Then said Diabolus again, ‘It is in vain for us to hope for quarter, +for this King knows not how to show it. True, perhaps, he, at +his first sitting down before us, will talk of and pretend to mercy, +that thereby, with the more ease, and less trouble, he may again make +himself the master of Mansoul. Whatever, therefore, he shall say, +believe not one syllable or tittle of it; for all such language is but +to overcome us, and to make us, while we wallow in our blood, the trophies +of his merciless victory. My mind is, therefore, that we resolve +to the last man to resist him, and not to believe him upon any terms, +for in at that door will come our danger. But shall we be flattered +out of our lives? I hope you know more of the rudiments of politics +than to suffer yourselves so pitifully to be served.<br> +<br> +‘But suppose he should, if he get us to yield, save some of our +lives, or the lives of some of them that are underlings in Mansoul, +what help will that be to you that are the chief of the town, especially +you whom I have set up and whose greatness has been procured by you +through your faithful sticking to me? And suppose, again, that +he should give quarter to every one of you, be sure he will bring you +into that bondage under which you were captivated before, or a worse, +and then what good will your lives do you? Shall you with him +live in pleasure as you do now? No, no; you must be bound by laws +that will pinch you, and be made to do that which at present is hateful +to you. I am for you, if you are for me; and it is better to die +valiantly than to live like pitiful slaves. But, I say, the life +of a slave will be counted a life too good for Mansoul now. Blood, +blood, nothing but blood is in every blast of Shaddai’s trumpet +against poor Mansoul now. Pray, be concerned; I hear he is coming. +Up, and stand to your arms that now, while you have any leisure, I may +learn you some feats of war. Armour for you I have, and by me +it is; yea, and it is sufficient for Mansoul from top to toe; nor can +you be hurt by what his force can do, if you shall keep it well girt +and fastened about you. Come, therefore, to my castle, and welcome, +and harness yourselves for the war. There is helmet, breastplate, +sword, and shield, and what not, that will make you fight like men.<br> +<br> +‘1. My helmet, otherwise called an head-piece, is in hope of doing +well at last, what lives soever you live. This is that which they +had who said, that they should have peace, though they walked in the +wickedness of their heart, to add drunkenness to thirst. A piece +of approved armour this is, and whoever has it, and can hold it, so +long no arrow, dart, sword, or shield can hurt him. This, therefore, +keep on, and thou wilt keep off many a blow, my Mansoul.<br> +<br> +‘2. My breastplate is a breastplate of iron. I had it forged +in mine own country, and all my soldiers are armed therewith. +In plain language, it is a hard heart, a heart as hard as iron, and +as much past feeling as a stone; the which if you get and keep, neither +mercy shall win you, nor judgment fright you. This therefore, +is a piece of armour most necessary for all to put on that hate Shaddai, +and that would fight against him under my banner.<br> +<br> +‘3. My sword is a tongue that is set on fire of hell, and that +can bend itself to speak evil of Shaddai, his Son, his ways, and people. +Use this; it has been tried a thousand times twice told. Whoever +hath it, keeps it, and makes that use of it as I would have him, can +never be conquered by mine enemy.<br> +<br> +‘4. My, shield is unbelief, or calling into question the truth +of the word, or all the sayings that speak of the judgment that Shaddai +has appointed for wicked men. Use this shield; many attempts he +has made upon it, and sometimes, it is true, it has been bruised; but +they that have writ of the wars of Emmanuel against my servants, have +testified that he could do no mighty work there because of their unbelief. +Now, to handle this weapon of mine aright, it is not to believe things +because they are true, of what sort or by whomsoever asserted. +If he speaks of judgment, care not for it; if he speaks of mercy, care +not for it; if he promises, if he swears that he would do to Mansoul, +if it turns, no hurt, but good, regard not what is said, question the +truth of all, for it is to wield the shield of unbelief aright, and +as my servants ought and do; and he that doth otherwise loves me not, +nor do I count him but an enemy to me.<br> +<br> +‘5. Another part or piece,’ said Diabolus, ‘of mine +excellent armour is a dumb and prayerless spirit, a spirit that scorns +to cry for mercy: wherefore be you, my Mansoul, sure that you make use +of this. What! cry for quarter! Never do that, if you would +be mine. I know you are stout men, and am sure that I have clad +you with that which is armour of proof. Wherefore, to cry to Shaddai +for mercy, let that be far from you. Besides all this, I have +a maul, firebrands, arrows, and death, all good hand-weapons, and such +as will do execution.’<br> +<br> +After he had thus furnished his men with armour and arms, he addressed +himself to them in such like words as these: ‘Remember,’ +quoth he, ‘that I am your rightful king, and that you have taken +an oath and entered into covenant to be true to me and my cause: I say, +remember this, and show yourselves stout and valiant men of Mansoul. +Remember also the kindness that I have always showed to you, and that +without your petition I have granted to you external things; wherefore +the privileges, grants, immunities, profits, and honours wherewith I +have endowed you do call for, at your hands, returns of loyalty, my +lion-like men of Mansoul: and when so fit a time to show it as when +another shall seek to take my dominion over you into his own hands? +One word more, and I have done. Can we but stand, and overcome +this one shock or brunt, I doubt not but in little time all the world +will be ours; and when that day comes, my true hearts, I will make you +kings, princes, and captains, and what brave days shall we have then!’<br> +<br> +Diabolus having thus armed and forearmed his servants and vassals in +Mansoul against their good and lawful King Shaddai, in the next place, +he doubleth his guards at the gates of the town, and he takes himself +to the castle, which was his stronghold. His vassals also, to +show their wills, and supposed (but ignoble) gallantry, exercise themselves +in their arms every day, and teach one another feats of war; they also +defied their enemies, and sang up the praises of their tyrant; they +threatened also what men they would be if ever things should rise so +high as a war between Shaddai and their king.<br> +<br> +Now all this time the good King, the King Shaddai, was preparing to +send an army to recover the town of Mansoul again from under the tyranny +of their pretended king Diabolus; but he thought good, at first, not +to send them by the hand and conduct of brave Emmanuel his Son, but +under the hand of some of his servants, to see first by them the temper +of Mansoul, and whether by them they would be won to the obedience of +their King. The army consisted of above forty thousand, all true +men, for they came from the King’s own court, and were those of +his own choosing.<br> +<br> +They came up to Mansoul under the conduct of four stout generals, each +man being a captain of ten thousand men, and these are their names and +their ensigns. The name of the first was Boanerges, the name of +the second was Captain Conviction, the name of the third was Captain +Judgment, and the name of the fourth was Captain Execution. These +were the captains that Shaddai sent to regain Mansoul.<br> +<br> +These four captains, as was said, the King thought fit, in the first +place, to send to Mansoul, to make an attempt upon it; for indeed generally +in all his wars he did use to send these four captains in the van, for +they were very stout and rough-hewn men, men that were fit to break +the ice, and to make their way by dint of sword, and their men were +like themselves.<br> +<br> +To each of these captains the King gave a banner, that it might be displayed, +because of the goodness of his cause, and because of the right that +he had to Mansoul.<br> +<br> +First, to Captain Boanerges, for he was the chief, to him, I say, were +given ten thousand men. His ensign was Mr. Thunder; he bare the +black colours, and his scutcheon was the three burning thunderbolts.<br> +<br> +The second captain was Captain Conviction; to him also were given ten +thousand men. His ensign’s name was Mr. Sorrow; he did bear +the pale colours, and his scutcheon was the book of the law wide open, +from whence issued a flame of fire.<br> +<br> +The third captain was Captain Judgment; to him were given ten thousand +men. His ensign’s name was Mr. Terror; he bare the red colours, +and his scutcheon was a burning fiery furnace.<br> +<br> +The fourth captain was Captain Execution; to him were given ten thousand +men. His ensign was one Mr. Justice; he also bare the red colours, +and his scutcheon was a fruitless tree, with an axe lying at the root +thereof.<br> +<br> +These four captains, as I said, had every one of them under his command +ten thousand men, all of good fidelity to the King, and stout at their +military actions.<br> +<br> +Well, the captains and their forces, their men and under officers, being +had upon a day by Shaddai into the field, and there called all over +by their names, were then and there put into such harness as became +their degree and that service which now they were going about for their +King.<br> +<br> +Now, when the King had mustered his forces, (for it is he that mustereth +the host to the battle,) he gave unto the captains their several commissions, +with charge and commandment in the audience of all the soldiers, that +they should take heed faithfully and courageously to do and execute +the same. Their commissions were, for the substance of them, the +same in form, though, as to name, title, place and degree of the captains, +there might be some, but very small variation. And here let me +give you an account of the matter and sum contained in their commission.<br> +<br> +<br> +<i>A Commission from the great Shaddai, King of Mansoul, to his trusty +and noble Captain, the Captain Boanerges, for his making War upon the +town of Mansoul</i>.<br> +<br> +<br> +‘O, thou Boanerges, one of my stout and thundering captains over +one ten thousand of my valiant and faithful servants, go thou in my +name, with this thy force, to the miserable town of Mansoul; and when +thou comest thither, offer them first conditions of peace; and command +them that, casting off the yoke and tyranny of the wicked Diabolus, +they return to me, their rightful Prince and Lord. Command them +also that they cleanse themselves from all that is his in the town of +Mansoul, and look to thyself, that thou hast good satisfaction touching +the truth of their obedience. Thus when thou hast commanded them, +(if they in truth submit thereto,) then do thou, to the uttermost of +thy power, what in thee lies to set up for me a garrison in the famous +town of Mansoul; nor do thou hurt the least native that moveth or breatheth +therein, if they will submit themselves to me, but treat thou such as +if they were thy friend or brother; for all such I love, and they shall +be dear unto me, and tell them that I will take a time to come unto +them, and to let them know that I am merciful.<br> +<br> +‘But if they shall, notwithstanding thy summons and the producing +of thy authority, resist, stand out against thee, and rebel, then do +I command thee to make use of all thy cunning, power, might, and force, +to bring them under by strength of hand. Farewell.’<br> +<br> +<br> +Thus you see the sum of their commissions; for, as I said before, for +the substance of them, they were the same that the rest of the noble +captains had.<br> +<br> +Wherefore they, having received each commander his authority at the +hand of their King, the day being appointed, and the place of their +rendezvous prefixed, each commander appeared in such gallantry as became +his cause and calling. So, after a new entertainment from Shaddai, +with flying colours they set forward to march towards the famous town +of Mansoul. Captain Boanerges led the van, Captain Conviction +and Captain Judgment made up the main body, and Captain Execution brought +up the rear. They then, having a great way to go, (for the town +of Mansoul was far off from the court of Shaddai,) marched through the +regions and countries of many people, not hurting or abusing any, but +blessing wherever they came. They also lived upon the King’s +cost in all the way they went.<br> +<br> +Having travelled thus for many days, at last they came within sight +of Mansoul; the which when they saw, the captains could for their hearts +do no less than for a while bewail the condition of the town; for they +quickly saw how that it was prostrate to the will of Diabolus, and to +his ways and designs.<br> +<br> +Well, to be short, the captains came up before the town, march up to +Ear-gate, sit down there (for that was the place of hearing). +So, when they had pitched their tents and entrenched themselves, they +addressed themselves to make their assault.<br> +<br> +Now the townsfolk at first, beholding so gallant a company, so bravely +accoutred, and so excellently disciplined, having on their glittering +armour, and displaying of their flying colours, could not but come out +of their houses and gaze. But the cunning fox Diabolus, fearing +that the people, after this sight, should, on a sudden summons, open +the gates to the captains, came down with all haste from the castle, +and made them retire into the body of the town, who, when he had them +there, made this lying and deceivable speech unto them:<br> +<br> +‘Gentlemen,’ quoth he, ‘although you are my trusty +and well-beloved friends, yet I cannot but a little chide you for your +late uncircumspect action, in going out to gaze on that great and mighty +force that but yesterday sat down before, and have now entrenched themselves +in order to the maintaining of a siege against the famous town of Mansoul. +Do you know who they are, whence they come, and what is their purpose +in sitting down before the town of Mansoul? They are they of whom +I have told you long ago, that they would come to destroy this town, +and against whom I have been at the cost to arm you with <i>cap-a-pie</i> +for your body, besides great fortifications for your mind. Wherefore, +then, did you not rather, even at the first appearance of them, cry +out, “Fire the beacons!” and give the whole town an alarm +concerning them, that we might all have been in a posture of defence, +and been ready to have received them with the highest acts of defiance? +Then had you showed yourselves men to my liking; whereas, by what you +have done, you have made me half afraid - I say, half afraid - that +when they and we shall come to push a pike, I shall find you want courage +to stand it out any longer. Wherefore have I commanded a watch, +and that you should double your guards at the gates? Wherefore +have I endeavoured to make you as hard as iron, and your hearts as a +piece of the nether millstone? Was it, think you, that you might +show yourselves women, and that you might go out like a company of innocents +to gaze on your mortal foes? Fie, fie! put yourselves into a posture +of defence, beat up the drum, gather together in warlike manner, that +our foes may know that, before they shall conquer this corporation, +there are valiant men in the town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +‘I will leave off now to chide, and will not further rebuke you; +but I charge you, that henceforwards you let me see no more such actions. +Let not henceforward a man of you, without order first obtained from +me, so much as show his head over the wall of the town of Mansoul. +You have now heard me; do as I have commanded, and you shall cause me +that I dwell securely with you, and that I take care, as for myself, +so for your safety and honour also. Farewell.”<br> +<br> +Now were the townsmen strangely altered; they were as men stricken with +a panic fear; they ran to and fro through the streets of the town of +Mansoul, crying out, ‘Help, help! the men that turn the world +upside down are come hither also.’ Nor could any of them +be quiet after; but still, as men bereft of wit, they cried out, ‘The +destroyers of our peace and people are come.’ This went +down with Diabolus. ‘Ah,’ quoth he to himself, ‘this +I like well: now it is as I would have it; now you show your obedience +to your prince. Hold you but here, and then let them take the +town if they can.’<br> +<br> +Well, before the King’s forces had sat before Mansoul three days, +Captain Boanerges commanded his trumpeter to go down to Ear-gate, and +there, in the name of the great Shaddai, to summon Mansoul to give audience +to the message that he, in his Master’s name, was to them commanded +to deliver. So the trumpeter, whose name was Take-heed-what-you-hear, +went up, as he was commanded, to Ear-gate, and there sounded his trumpet +for a hearing; but there was none that appeared that gave answer or +regard, for so had Diabolus commanded. So the trumpeter returned +to his captain, and told him what he had done, and also how he had sped; +whereat the captain was grieved, but bid the trumpeter go to his tent.<br> +<br> +Again Captain Boanerges sendeth his trumpeter to Ear-gate, to sound +as before for a hearing; but they again kept close, came not out, nor +would they give him an answer, so observant were they of the command +of Diabolus their king.<br> +<br> +Then the captains and other field officers called a council of war, +to consider what further was to be done for the gaining of the town +of Mansoul; and, after some close and thorough debate upon the contents +of their commissions, they concluded yet to give to the town, by the +hand of the fore-named trumpeter, another summons to hear; but if that +shall be refused, said they, and that the town shall stand it out still, +then they determined, and bid the trumpeter tell them so, that they +would endeavour, by what means they could, to compel them by force to +the obedience of their King.<br> +<br> +So Captain Boanerges commanded his trumpeter to go up to Ear-gate again, +and, in the name of the great King Shaddai, to give it a very loud summons +to come down without delay to Ear-gate, there to give audience to the +King’s most noble captains. So the trumpeter went, and did +as he was commanded: he went up to Ear-gate, and sounded his trumpet, +and gave a third summons to Mansoul. He said, moreover, that if +this they should still refuse to do, the captains of his prince would +with might come down upon them, and endeavour to reduce them to their +obedience by force.<br> +<br> +Then stood up my Lord Willbewill, who was the governor of the town, +(this Willbewill was that apostate of whom mention was made before,) +and the keeper of the gates of Mansoul. He therefore, with big +and ruffling words, demanded of the trumpeter who he was, whence he +came, and what was the cause of his making so hideous a noise at the +gate, and speaking such insufferable words against the town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +The trumpeter answered, ‘I am servant to the most noble captain, +Captain Boanerges, general of the forces of the great King Shaddai, +against whom both thyself, with the whole town of Mansoul, have rebelled, +and lift up the heel; and my master, the captain, hath a special message +to this town, and to thee, as a member thereof; the which if you of +Mansoul shall peaceably hear, so; and if not, you must take what follows.’<br> +<br> +Then said the Lord Willbewill, ‘I will carry thy words to my lord, +and will know what he will say.’<br> +<br> +But the trumpeter soon replied, saying. ‘Our message is +not to the giant Diabolus, but to the miserable town of Mansoul; nor +shall we at all regard what answer by him is made, nor yet by any for +him. We are sent to this town to recover it from under his cruel +tyranny, and to persuade it to submit, as in former times it did, to +the most excellent King Shaddai.’<br> +<br> +Then said the Lord Willbewill, ‘I will do your errand to the town.’<br> +<br> +The trumpeter then replied, ‘Sir, do not deceive us, lest, in +so doing, you deceive yourselves much more.’ He added, moreover, +‘For we are resolved, if in peaceable manner you do not submit +yourselves, then to make a war upon you, and to bring you under by force. +And of the truth of what I now say, this shall be a sign unto you, - +you shall see the black flag, with its hot, burning thunder-bolts, set +upon the mount to-morrow, as a token of defiance against your prince, +and of our resolutions to reduce you to your Lord and rightful King.’<br> +<br> +So the said Lord Willbewill returned from off the wall, and the trumpeter +came into the camp. When the trumpeter was come into the camp, +the captains and officers of the mighty King Shaddai came together to +know if he had obtained a hearing, and what was the effect of his errand. +So the trumpeter told, saying, ‘When I had sounded my trumpet, +and had called aloud to the town for a hearing, my Lord Willbewill, +the governor of the town, and he that hath charge of the gates, came +up when he heard me sound, and, looking over the wall, he asked me what +I was, whence I came, and what was the cause of my making this noise. +So I told him my errand, and by whose authority I brought it. +“Then,” said he, “I will tell it to the governor and +to Mansoul;” and then I returned to my lords.’<br> +<br> +Then said the brave Boanerges, ‘Let us yet for a while lie still +in our trenches, and see what these rebels will do.’<br> +<br> +Now when the time drew nigh that audience by Mansoul must be given to +the brave Boanerges and his companions, it was commanded that all the +men of war throughout the whole camp of Shaddai should as one man stand +to their arms, and make themselves ready, if the town of Mansoul shall +hear, to receive it forthwith to mercy; but if not, to force a subjection. +So the day being come, the trumpeters sounded, and that throughout the +whole camp, that the men of war might be in a readiness for that which +then should be the work of the day. But when they that were in +the town of Mansoul heard the sound of the trumpets throughout the camp +of Shaddai, and thinking no other but that it must be in order to storm +the corporation, they at first were put to great consternation of spirit; +but after they a little were settled again, they also made what preparation +they could for a war, if they did storm; else, to secure themselves.<br> +<br> +Well, when the utmost time was come, Boanerges was resolved to hear +their answer; wherefore he sent out his trumpeter again to summon Mansoul +to a hearing of the message that they had brought from Shaddai.<br> +<br> +So he went and sounded, and the townsmen came up, but made Ear-gate +as sure as they could. Now when they were come up to the top of +the wall, Captain Boanerges desired to see the Lord Mayor; but my Lord +Incredulity was then Lord Mayor, for he came in the room of my Lord +Lustings. So Incredulity came up and showed himself over the wall; +but when the Captain Boanerges had set his eyes upon him, he cried out +aloud, ‘This is not he: where is my Lord Understanding, the ancient +Lord Mayor of the town of Mansoul? for to him I would deliver my message.’<br> +<br> +Then said the giant (for Diabolus was also come down) to the captain, +‘Mr. Captain, you have by your boldness given to Mansoul +at least four summonses to subject herself to your King, by whose authority +I know not, nor will I dispute that now. I ask, therefore, what +is the reason of all this ado, or what would you be at if you knew yourselves?’<br> +<br> +Then Captain Boanerges, whose were the black colours, and whose scutcheon +was the three burning thunderbolts, taking no notice of the giant or +of his speech, thus addressed himself to the town of Mansoul: ‘Be +it known unto you, O unhappy and rebellious Mansoul, that the most gracious +King, the great King Shaddai, my Master, hath sent me unto you with +commission’ (and so he showed to the town his broad seal) ‘to +reduce you to his obedience; and he hath commanded me, in case you yield +upon my summons, to carry it to you as if you were my friends or brethren; +but he also hath bid, that if, after summons to submit you still stand +out and rebel, we should endeavour to take you by force.’<br> +<br> +Then stood forth Captain Conviction, and said, (his were the pale colours, +and for a scutcheon he had the book of the law wide open, etc.,) ‘Hear, +O Mansoul! Thou, O Mansoul, wast once famous for innocency, but +now thou art degenerated into lies and deceit. Thou hast heard +what my brother, the Captain Boanerges, hath said; and it is your wisdom, +and will be your happiness, to stoop to, and accept of conditions of +peace and mercy when offered, specially when offered by one against +whom thou hast rebelled, and one who is of power to tear thee in pieces, +for so is Shaddai, our King; nor, when he is angry, can anything stand +before him. If you say you have not sinned, or acted rebellion +against our King, the whole of your doings since the day that you cast +off his service (and there was the beginning of your sin) will sufficiently +testify against you. What else means your hearkening to the tyrant, +and your receiving him for your king? What means else your rejecting +of the laws of Shaddai, and your obeying of Diabolus? Yea, what +means this your taking up of arms against, and the shutting of your +gates upon us, the faithful servants of your King? Be ruled then, +and accept of my brother’s invitation, and overstand not the time +of mercy, but agree with thine adversary quickly. Ah, Mansoul! +suffer not thyself to be kept from mercy, and to be run into a thousand +miseries, by the flattering wiles of Diabolus. Perhaps that piece +of deceit may attempt to make you believe that we seek our own profit +in this our service, but know it is obedience to our King, and love +to your happiness, that is the cause of this undertaking of ours.<br> +<br> +‘Again I say to thee, O Mansoul, consider if it be not amazing +grace that Shaddai should so humble himself as he doth: now he, by us, +reasons with you, in a way of entreaty and sweet persuasions, that you +would subject yourselves to him. Has he that need of you that +we are sure you have of him? No, no; but he is merciful, and will +not that Mansoul should die, but turn to him and live.’<br> +<br> +Then stood forth Captain Judgment, whose were the red colours, and for +a scutcheon he had the burning fiery furnace, and he said, ‘O +ye, the inhabitants of the town of Mansoul, that have lived so long +in rebellion and acts of treason against the King Shaddai, know that +we come not to-day to this place, in this manner, with our message of +our own minds, or to revenge our own quarrel; it is the King, my Master, +that hath sent us to reduce you to your obedience to him; the which +if you refuse in a peaceable way to yield, we have commission to compel +you thereto. And never think of yourselves, nor yet suffer the +tyrant Diabolus to persuade you to think, that our King, by his power, +is not able to bring you down, and to lay you under his feet; for he +is the former of all things, and if he touches the mountains, they smoke. +Nor will the gate of the King’s clemency stand always open; for +the day that shall burn like an oven is before him; yea, it hasteth +greatly, it slumbereth not.<br> +<br> +‘O Mansoul, is it little in thine eyes that our King doth offer +thee mercy, and that after so many provocations? Yea, he still +holdeth out his golden sceptre to thee, and will not yet suffer his +gate to be shut against thee: wilt thou provoke him to do it? +If so, consider of what I say; to thee it is opened no more for ever. +If thou sayest thou shalt not see him, yet judgment is before him; therefore +trust thou in him. Yea, because there is wrath, beware lest he +take thee away with his stroke; then a great ransom cannot deliver thee. +Will he esteem thy riches? No, not gold, nor all the forces of +strength. He hath prepared his throne for judgment, for he will +come with fire, and with his chariots like a whirlwind, to render his +anger with fury, and his rebukes with flames of fire. Therefore, +O Mansoul, take heed lest, after thou hast fulfilled the judgment of +the wicked, justice and judgment should take hold of thee.’<br> +<br> +Now while the Captain Judgment was making this oration to the town of +Mansoul, it was observed by some that Diabolus trembled; but he proceeded +in his parable and said, ‘O thou woful town of Mansoul, wilt thou +not yet set open thy gate to receive us, the deputies of thy King, and +those that would rejoice to see thee live? Can thine heart endure, +or can thy hands be strong, in the day that he shall deal in judgment +with thee? I say, canst thou endure to be forced to drink, as +one would drink sweet wine, the sea of wrath that our King has prepared +for Diabolus and his angels? Consider, betimes consider.’<br> +<br> +Then stood forth the fourth captain, the noble Captain Execution, and +said, ‘O town of Mansoul, once famous, but now like the fruitless +bough, once the delight of the high ones, but now a den for Diabolus, +hearken also to me, and to the words that I shall speak to thee in the +name of the great Shaddai. Behold, the axe is laid to the root +of the trees: every tree, therefore, that bringeth not forth good fruit, +is hewn down and cast into the fire.<br> +<br> +‘Thou, O town of Mansoul, hast hitherto been this fruitless tree; +thou bearest nought but thorns and briars. Thy evil fruit bespeaks +thee not to be a good tree; thy grapes are grapes of gall, thy clusters +are bitter. Thou hast rebelled against thy King; and, lo! we, +the power and force of Shaddai, are the axe that is laid to thy root. +What sayest thou? Wilt thou turn? I say again, tell me, +before the first blow is given, wilt thou turn? Our axe must first +be laid <i>to</i> thy root before it be laid <i>at</i> thy root; it +must first be laid <i>to</i> thy root in a way of threatening, before +it is laid <i>at</i> thy root by way of execution; and between these +two is required thy repentance, and this is all the time that thou hast. +What wilt thou do? Wilt thou turn, or shall I smite? If +I fetch my blow, Mansoul, down you go; for I have commission to lay +my axe <i>at</i> as well as <i>to</i> thy roots, nor will anything but +yielding to our King prevent doing of execution. What art thou +fit for, O Mansoul, if mercy preventeth not, but to be hewn down, and +cast into the fire and burned?<br> +<br> +‘O Mansoul, patience and forbearance do not act for ever: a year, +or two, or three, they may; but if thou provoke by a three years’ +rebellion, (and thou hast already done more than this,) then what follows +but, ‘Cut it down’? nay, ‘After that thou shalt cut +it down.’ And dost thou think that these are but threatenings, +or that our King has not power to execute his words? O Mansoul, +thou wilt find that in the words of our King, when they are by sinners +made little or light of, there is not only threatening, but burning +coals of fire.<br> +<br> +‘Thou hast been a cumber-ground long already, and wilt thou continue +so still? Thy sin has brought this army to thy walls, and shall +it bring it in judgment to do execution into thy town? Thou hast +heard what the captains have said, but as yet thou shuttest thy gates. +Speak out, Mansoul; wilt thou do so still, or wilt thou accept of conditions +of peace?’<br> +<br> +These brave speeches of these four noble captains the town of Mansoul +refused to hear; yet a sound thereof did beat against Ear-gate, though +the force thereof could not break it open. In fine, the town desired +a time to prepare their answer to these demands. The captains +then told them, that if they would throw out to them one Ill-Pause that +was in the town, that they might reward him according to his works, +then they would give them time to consider; but if they would not cast +him to them over the wall of Mansoul, then they would give them none; +‘for,’ said they, ‘we know that, so long as Ill-Pause +draws breath in Mansoul, all good consideration will be confounded, +and nothing but mischief will come thereon.’<br> +<br> +Then Diabolus, who was there present, being loath to lose his Ill-Pause, +because he was his orator, (and yet be sure he had, could the captains +have laid their fingers on him,) was resolved at this instant to give +them answer by himself; but then changing his mind, he commanded the +then Lord Mayor, the Lord Incredulity, to do it, saying, ‘My lord, +do you give these runagates an answer, and speak out, that Mansoul may +hear and understand you.’<br> +<br> +So Incredulity, at Diabolus’ command, began, and said, ‘Gentlemen, +you have here, as we do behold, to the disturbance of our prince and +the molestation of the town of Mansoul, camped against it: but from +whence you come, we will not know; and what you are, we will not believe. +Indeed, you tell us in your terrible speech that you have this authority +from Shaddai, but by what right he commands you to do it, of that we +shall yet be ignorant.<br> +<br> +‘You have also, by the authority aforesaid, summoned this town +to desert her lord, and, for protection, to yield up herself to the +great Shaddai, your King; flatteringly telling her, that if she will +do it, he will pass by and not charge her with her past offences.<br> +<br> +‘Further, you have also, to the terror of the town of Mansoul, +threatened with great and sore destructions to punish this corporation, +if she consents not to do as your wills would have her.<br> +<br> +‘Now, captains, from whencesoever you come, and though your designs +be ever so right, yet know ye that neither my Lord Diabolus, nor I, +his servant, Incredulity, nor yet our brave Mansoul, doth regard either +your persons, message, or the King that you say hath sent you. +His power, his greatness, his vengeance, we fear not; nor will we yield +at all to your summons.<br> +<br> +‘As for the war that you threaten to make upon us, we must therein +defend ourselves as well as we can; and know ye, that we are not without +wherewithal to bid defiance to you; and, in short, (for I will not be +tedious,) I tell you, that we take you to be some vagabond runagate +crew, that having shaken off all obedience to your King, have gotten +together in tumultuous manner, and are ranging from place to place to +see if, through the flatteries you are skilled to make on the one side, +and threats wherewith you think to fright on the other, to make some +silly town, city, or country, desert their place, and leave it to you; +but Mansoul is none of them.<br> +<br> +‘To conclude: we dread you not, we fear you not, nor will we obey +your summons. Our gates we will shut upon you, our place we will +keep you out of. Nor will we long thus suffer you to sit down +before us: our people must live in quiet: your appearance doth disturb +them. Wherefore arise with bag and baggage, and begone, or we +will let fly from the walls against you.’<br> +<br> +This oration, made by old Incredulity, was seconded by desperate Willbewill, +in words to this effect: ‘Gentlemen, we have heard your demands, +and the noise of your threats, and have heard the sound of your summons; +but we fear not your force, we regard not your threats, but will still +abide as you found us. And we command you, that in three days’ +time you cease to appear in these parts, or you shall know what it is +once to dare offer to rouse the lion Diabolus when asleep in his town +of Mansoul.’<br> +<br> +The Recorder, whose name was Forget-Good, he also added as followeth: +‘Gentlemen, my lords, as you see, have with mild and gentle words +answered your rough and angry speeches: they have, moreover, in my hearing, +given you leave quietly to depart as you came; wherefore, take their +kindness and be gone. We might have come out with force upon you, +and have caused you to feel the dint of our swords; but as we love ease +and quiet ourselves, so we love not to hurt or molest others.’<br> +<br> +Then did the town of Mansoul shout for joy, as if by Diabolus and his +crew some great advantage had been gotten of the captains. They +also rang the bells, and made merry, and danced upon the walls.<br> +<br> +Diabolus also returned to the castle, and the Lord Mayor and Recorder +to their place; but the Lord Willbewill took special care that the gates +should be secured with double guards, double bolts, and double locks +and bars; and that Ear-gate especially might the better be looked to, +for that was the gate in at which the King’s forces sought most +to enter. The Lord Willbewill made one old Mr. Prejudice, an angry +and ill-conditioned fellow, captain of the ward at that gate, and put +under his power sixty men, called deaf men; men advantageous for that +service, forasmuch as they mattered no words of the captains, nor of +the soldiers.<br> +<br> +Now when the captains saw the answer of the great ones, and that they +could not get a hearing from the old natives of the town, and that Mansoul +was resolved to give the King’s army battle, they prepared themselves +to receive them, and to try it out by the power of the arm. And, +first, they made their force more formidable against Ear-gate; for they +knew that, unless they could penetrate that, no good could be done upon +the town. This done, they put the rest of their men in their places; +after which, they gave out the word, which was, ‘YE MUST BE BORN +AGAIN.’ Then they sounded the trumpet; then they in the +town made them answer, with shout against shout, charge against charge, +and so the battle began. Now they in the town had planted upon +the tower over Ear-gate two great guns, the one called High-mind, and +the other Heady. Unto these two guns they trusted much; they were +cast in the castle by Diabolus’ founder, whose name was Mr. Puff-up, +and mischievous pieces they were. But so vigilant and watchful, +when the captains saw them, were they, that though sometimes their shot +would go by their ears with a whiz, yet they did them no harm. +By these two guns the townsfolk made no question but greatly to annoy +the camp of Shaddai, and well enough to secure the gate; but they had +not much cause to boast of what execution they did, as by what follows +will be gathered.<br> +<br> +The famous Mansoul had also some other small pieces in it, of the which +they made use against the camp of Shaddai.<br> +<br> +They from the camp also did as stoutly, and with as much of that as +may in truth be called valour, let fly as fast at the town and at Ear-gate; +for they saw that, unless they could break open Ear-gate, it would be +but in vain to batter the wall. Now the King’s captains +had brought with them several slings, and two or three battering-rams; +with their slings, therefore, they battered the houses and people of +the town, and with their rams they sought to break Ear-gate open.<br> +<br> +The camp and the town had several skirmishes and brisk encounters, while +the captains with their engines made many brave attempts to break open +or beat down the tower that was over Ear-gate, and at the said gate +to make their entrance; but Mansoul stood it out so lustily, through +the rage of Diabolus, the valour of the Lord Willbewill, and the conduct +of old Incredulity, the Mayor, and Mr. Forget-Good, the Recorder, that +the charge and expense of that summer’s wars, on the King’s +side, seemed to be almost quite lost, and the advantage to return to +Mansoul. But when the captains saw how it was they made a fair +retreat, and entrenched themselves in their winter quarters. Now, +in this war, you must needs think there was much loss on both sides, +of which be pleased to accept of this brief account following.<br> +<br> +The King’s captains, when they marched from the court to come +up against Mansoul to war, as they came crossing over the country, they +happened to light upon three young fellows that had a mind to go for +soldiers: proper men they were, and men of courage and skill, to appearance. +Their names were Mr. Tradition, Mr. Human-Wisdom, and Mr. Man’s-Invention. +So they came up to the captains, and proffered their service to Shaddai. +The captains then told them of their design, and bid them not to be +rash in their offers; but the young men told them they had considered +the thing before, and that hearing they were upon their march for such +a design, came hither on purpose to meet them, that they might be listed +under their excellencies. Then Captain Boanerges, for that they +were men of courage, listed them into his company, and so away they +went to the war.<br> +<br> +Now, when the war was begun, in one of the briskest skirmishes, so it +was, that a company of the Lord Willbewill’s men sallied out at +the sallyport or postern of the town, and fell in upon the rear of Captain +Boanerges’ men, where these three fellows happened to be; so they +took them prisoners, and away they carried them into the town, where +they had not lain long in durance, but it began to be noised about the +streets of the town what three notable prisoners the Lord Willbewill’s +men had taken, and brought in prisoners out of the camp of Shaddai. +At length tidings thereof were carried to Diabolus to the castle, to +wit what my Lord Willbewill’s men had done, and whom they had +taken prisoners.<br> +<br> +Then Diabolus called for Willbewill, to know the certainty of this matter. +So he asked him, and he told him. Then did the giant send for +the prisoners, and, when they were come, demanded of them who they were, +whence they came, and what they did in the camp of Shaddai; and they +told him. Then he sent them to ward again. Not many days +after, he sent for them to him again, and then asked them if they would +be willing to serve him against their former captains. They then +told him that they did not so much live by religion as by the fates +of fortune; and that since his lordship was willing to entertain them, +they should be willing to serve him. Now while things were thus +in hand, there was one Captain Anything, a great doer, in the town of +Mansoul; and to this Captain Anything did Diabolus send these men, and +a note under his hand, to receive them into his company, the contents +of which letter were thus:<br> +<br> +‘Anything, my darling, - The three men that are the bearers of +this letter have a desire to serve me in the war; nor know I better +to whose conduct to commit them than to thine. Receive them, therefore, +in my name, and, as need shall require, make use of them against Shaddai +and his men. Farewell.’<br> +<br> +So they came, and he received them; and he made of two of them sergeants; +but he made Mr. Man’s-Invention his ancient-bearer. But +thus much for this, and now to return to the camp.<br> +<br> +They of the camp did also some execution upon the town; for they did +beat down the roof of the Lord Mayor’s house, and so laid him +more open than he was before. They had almost, with a sling, slain +my Lord Willbewill outright; but he made a shift to recover again. +But they made a notable slaughter among the aldermen, for with one only +shot they cut off six of them; to wit, Mr. Swearing, Mr. Whoring, Mr. +Fury, Mr. Stand-to-Lies, Mr. Drunkenness, and Mr. Cheating.<br> +<br> +They also dismounted the two guns that stood upon the tower over Ear-gate, +and laid them flat in the dirt. I told you before that the King’s +noble captains had drawn off to their winter quarters, and had there +entrenched themselves and their carriages, so as with the best advantage +to their King, and the greatest annoyance to the enemy, they might give +seasonable and warm alarms to the town of Mansoul. And this design +of them did so hit, that I may say they did almost what they would to +the molestation of the corporation. For now could not Mansoul +sleep securely as before, nor could they now go to their debaucheries +with that quietness as in times past; for they had from the camp of +Shaddai such frequent, warm, and terrifying alarms, yea, alarms upon +alarms, first at one gate and then at another, and again at all the +gates at once, that they were broken as to former peace. Yea, +they had their alarms so frequently, and that when the nights were at +longest, the weather coldest, and so consequently the season most unseasonable, +that that winter was to the town of Mansoul a winter by itself. +Sometimes the trumpets would sound, and sometimes the slings would whirl +the stones into the town. Sometimes ten thousand of the King’s +soldiers would be running round the walls of Mansoul at midnight, shouting +and lifting up the voice for the battle. Sometimes, again, some +of them in the town would be wounded, and their cry and lamentable voice +would be heard, to the great molestation of the now languishing town +of Mansoul. Yea, so distressed with those that laid siege against +them were they, that, I dare say, Diabolus, their king, had in these +days his rest much broken.<br> +<br> +In these days, as I was informed, new thoughts, and thoughts that began +to run counter one to another, began to possess the minds of the men +of the town of Mansoul. Some would say, ‘There is no living +thus.’ Others would then reply, ‘This will be over +shortly.’ Then would a third stand up and answer, ‘Let +us turn to the King Shaddai, and so put an end to these troubles.’ +And a fourth would come in with a fear, saying, ‘I doubt he will +not receive us.’ The old gentleman, too, the Recorder, that +was so before Diabolus took Mansoul, he also began to talk aloud, and +his words were now to the town of Mansoul as if they were great claps +of thunder. No noise now so terrible to Mansoul as was his, with +the noise of the soldiers and shoutings of the captains.<br> +<br> +Also things began to grow scarce in Mansoul; now the things that her +soul lusted after were departing from her. Upon all her pleasant +things there was a blast, and burning instead of beauty. Wrinkles +now, and some shows of the shadow of death, were upon the inhabitants +of Mansoul. And now, O how glad would Mansoul have been to have +enjoyed quietness and satisfaction of mind, though joined with the meanest +condition in the world!<br> +<br> +The captains also, in the deep of this winter, did send by the mouth +of Boanerges’ trumpeter a summons to Mansoul to yield up herself +to the King, the great King Shaddai. They sent it once, and twice, +and thrice; not knowing but that at some times there might be in Mansoul +some willingness to surrender up themselves unto them, might they but +have the colour of an invitation to do it under. Yea, so far as +I could gather, the town had been surrendered up to them before now, +had it not been for the opposition of old Incredulity, and the fickleness +of the thoughts of my Lord Willbewill. Diabolus also began to +rave; wherefore Mansoul, as to yielding, was not yet all of one mind; +therefore they still lay distressed under these perplexing fears.<br> +<br> +I told you but now that they of the King’s army had this winter +sent three times to Mansoul to submit herself.<br> +<br> +The first time the trumpeter went he went with words of peace, telling +them that the captains, the noble captains of Shaddai, did pity and +bewail the misery of the now perishing town of Mansoul, and were troubled +to see them so much to stand in the way of their own deliverance. +He said, moreover, that the captains bid him tell them, that if now +poor Mansoul would humble herself and turn, her former rebellions and +most notorious treasons should by their merciful King be forgiven them, +yea, and forgotten too. And having bid them beware that they stood +not in their own way, that they opposed not themselves, nor made themselves +their own losers, he returned again into the camp.<br> +<br> +The second time the trumpeter went, he did treat them a little more +roughly; for, after sound of trumpet, he told them that their continuing +in their rebellion did but chafe and heat the spirit of the captains, +and that they were resolved to make a conquest of Mansoul, or to lay +their bones before the town walls.<br> +<br> +He went again the third time, and dealt with them yet more roughly; +telling them that now, since they had been so horribly profane, he did +not know, not certainly know, whether the captains were inclining to +mercy or judgment. ‘Only,’ said he, ‘they commanded +me to give you a summons to open the gates unto them.’ So +he returned, and went into the camp.<br> +<br> +These three summonses, and especially the last two, did so distress +the town that they presently call a consultation, the result of which +was this - That my Lord Willbewill should go up to Ear-gate, and there, +with sound of trumpet, call to the captains of the camp for a parley. +Well, the Lord Willbewill sounded upon the wall; so the captains came +up in their harness, with their ten thousands at their feet. The +townsmen then told the captains that they had heard and considered their +summons, and would come to an agreement with them, and with their King +Shaddai, upon such certain terms, articles, and propositions as, with +and by the order of their prince, they to them were appointed to propound; +to wit, they would agree upon these grounds to be one people with them.<br> +<br> +1. If that those of their own company, as the now Lord Mayor and their +Mr. Forget-Good, with then brave Lord Willbewill, might, under Shaddai, +be still the governors of the town, castle, and gates of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +2. Provided that no man that now serveth under their great giant Diabolus +be by Shaddai cast out of house, harbour, or the freedom that he hath +hitherto enjoyed in the famous town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +3. That it shall be granted them, that they of the town of Mansoul shall +enjoy certain of their rights and privileges; to wit, such as have formerly +been granted them, and that they have long lived in the enjoyment of, +under the reign of their king Diabolus, that now is, and long has been, +their only lord and great defender.<br> +<br> +4. That no new law, officer, or executioner of law or office, shall +have any power over them, without their own choice and consent.<br> +<br> +‘These be our propositions, or conditions of peace; and upon these +terms,’ said they, ‘we will submit to your King.’<br> +<br> +But when the captains had heard this weak and feeble offer of the town +of Mansoul, and their high and bold demands, they made to them again, +by their noble captain, the Captain Boanerges, this speech following:<br> +<br> +‘O ye inhabitants of the town of Mansoul, when I heard your trumpet +sound for a parley with us, I can truly say I was glad; but when you +said you were willing to submit yourselves to our King and Lord, then +I was yet more glad; but when, by your silly provisos and foolish cavils, +you laid the stumbling-block of your iniquity before your own faces, +then was my gladness turned into sorrows, and my hopeful beginnings +of your return, into languishing fainting fears.<br> +<br> +‘I count that old Ill-Pause, the ancient enemy of Mansoul, did +draw up those proposals that now you present us with as terms of an +agreement; but they deserve not to be admitted to sound in the ear of +any man that pretends to have service for Shaddai. We do therefore +jointly, and that with the highest disdain, refuse and reject such things, +as the greatest of iniquities.<br> +<br> +‘But, O Mansoul, if you will give yourselves into our hands, or +rather into the hands of our King, and will trust him to make such terms +with and for you as shall seem good in his eyes, (and I dare say they +shall be such as you shall find to be most profitable to you,) then +we will receive you, and be at peace with you; but if you like not to +trust yourselves in the arms of Shaddai our King, then things are but +where they were before, and we know also what we have to do.’<br> +<br> +Then cried out old Incredulity, the Lord Mayor, and said, ‘And +who, being out of the hands of their enemies, as ye see we are now, +will be so foolish as to put the staff out of their own hands into the +hands of they know not who? I, for my part, will never yield to +so unlimited a proposition. Do we know the manner and temper of +their King? It is said by some that he will be angry with his +subjects if but the breadth of an hair they chance to step out of the +way; and by others, that he requireth of them much more than they can +perform. Wherefore, it seems, O Mansoul, to be thy wisdom to take +good heed what thou dost in this matter; for if you once yield, you +give up yourselves to another, and so you are no more your own. +Wherefore, to give up yourselves to an unlimited power, is the greatest +folly in the world; for now you indeed may repent, but can never justly +complain. But do you indeed know, when you are his, which of you +he will kill, and which of you he will save alive; or whether he will +not cut off every one of us, and send out of his own country another +new people, and cause them to inhabit this town?’<br> +<br> +This speech of the Lord Mayor undid all, and threw flat to the ground +their hopes of an accord. Wherefore the captains returned to their +trenches, to their tents, and to their men, as they were; and the Mayor +to the castle and to his King.<br> +<br> +Now Diabolus had waited for his return, for he had heard that they had +been at their points. So, when he was come into the chamber of +state, Diabolus saluted him with - ‘Welcome, my lord. How +went matters betwixt you to-day?’ So the Lord Incredulity, +with a low congee, told him the whole of the matter, saying, ‘Thus +and thus said the captains of Shaddai, and thus and thus said I.’ +The which when it was told to Diabolus, he was very glad to hear it, +and said, ‘My Lord Mayor, my faithful Incredulity, I have proved +thy fidelity above ten times already, but never yet found thee false. +I do promise thee, if we rub over this brunt, to prefer thee to a place +of honour, a place far better than to be Lord Mayor of Mansoul. +I will make thee my universal deputy, and thou shalt, next to me, have +all nations under thy hand; yea, and thou shalt lay bands upon them, +that they may not resist thee; nor shall any of our vassals walk more +at liberty, but those that shall be content to walk in thy fetters.’<br> +<br> +Now came the Lord Mayor out from Diabolus, as if he had obtained a favour +indeed. Wherefore to his habitation he goes in great state, and +thinks to feed himself well enough with hopes, until the time came that +his greatness should be enlarged.<br> +<br> +But now, though the Lord Mayor and Diabolus did thus well agree, yet +this repulse to the brave captains put Mansoul into a mutiny. +For while old Incredulity went into the castle to congratulate his lord +with what had passed, the old Lord Mayor, that was so before Diabolus +came to the town, to wit, my Lord Understanding, and the old Recorder, +Mr. Conscience, getting intelligence of what had passed at Ear-gate, +(for you must know that they might not be suffered to be at that debate, +lest they should then have mutinied for the captains; but, I say, they +got intelligence of what had passed there, and were much concerned therewith,) +wherefore they, getting some of the town together, began to possess +them with the reasonableness of the noble captains’ demands, and +with the bad consequences that would follow upon the speech of old Incredulity, +the Lord Mayor; to wit how little reverence he showed therein either +to the captains or to their King; also how he implicitly charged them +with unfaithfulness and treachery. ‘For what less,’ +quoth they, ‘could be made of his words, when he said he would +not yield to their proposition; and added, moreover, a supposition that +he would destroy us, when before he had sent us word that he would show +us mercy!’ The multitude, being now possessed with the conviction +of the evil that old Incredulity had done, began to run together by +companies in all places, and in every corner of the streets of Mansoul; +and first they began to mutter, then to talk openly, and after that +they run to and fro, and cried as they run, ‘Oh the brave captains +of Shaddai! would we were under the government of the captains, and +of Shaddai their King!’ When the Lord Mayor had intelligence +that Mansoul was in an uproar, down he comes to appease the people, +and thought to have quashed their heat with the bigness and the show +of his countenance; but when they saw him, they came running upon him, +and had doubtless done him a mischief, had he not betaken himself to +house. However, they strongly assaulted the house where he was, +to have pulled it down about his ears; but the place was too strong, +so they failed of that. So he, taking some courage, addressed +himself, out at a window, to the people in this manner:<br> +<br> +‘Gentlemen, what is the reason that there is here such an uproar +to-day?’<br> +<br> +Then answered my Lord Understanding, ‘It is even because that +thou and thy master have carried it not rightly, and as you should, +to the captains of Shaddai; for in three things you are faulty. +First, in that you would not let Mr. Conscience and myself be at the +hearing of your discourse. Secondly, in that you propounded such +terms of peace to the captains that by no means could be granted, unless +they had intended that their Shaddai should have been only a titular +prince, and that Mansoul should still have had power by law to have +lived in all lewdness and vanity before him, and so by consequence Diabolus +should still here be king in power, and the other only king in name. +Thirdly, for that thou didst thyself, after the captains had showed +us upon what conditions they would have received us to mercy, even undo +all again with thy unsavoury, unseasonable, and ungodly speech.’<br> +<br> +When old Incredulity had heard this speech, he cried out, ‘Treason! +treason! To your arms! to your arms! O ye, the trusty friends +of Diabolus in Mansoul.’<br> +<br> +<i>Und</i>. - Sir, you may put upon my words what meaning you please; +but I am sure that the captains of such an high lord as theirs is, deserved +a better treatment at your hands.<br> +<br> +Then said old Incredulity, ‘This is but little better. But, +Sir,’ quoth he, ‘what I spake I spake for my prince, for +his government, and the quieting of the people, whom by your unlawful +actions you have this day set to mutiny against us.’<br> +<br> +Then replied the old Recorder, whose name was Mr. Conscience, and said, +‘Sir, you ought not thus to retort upon what my Lord Understanding +hath said. It is evident enough that he hath spoken the truth, +and that you are an enemy to Mansoul. Be convinced, then, of the +evil of your saucy and malapert language, and of the grief that you +have put the captains to; yea, and of the damages that you have done +to Mansoul thereby. Had you accepted of the conditions, the sound +of the trumpet and the alarm of war had now ceased about the town of +Mansoul; but that dreadful sound abides, and your want of wisdom in +your speech has been the cause of it.’<br> +<br> +Then said old Incredulity, ‘Sir, if I live, I will do your errand +to Diabolus, and there you shall have an answer to your words. +Meanwhile we will seek the good of the town, and not ask counsel of +you.’<br> +<br> +<i>Und</i>. - Sir, your prince and you are both foreigners to Mansoul, +and not the natives thereof; and who can tell but that, when you have +brought us into greater straits, (when you also shall see that yourselves +can be safe by no other means than by flight,) you may leave us and +shift for yourselves, or set us on fire, and go away in the smoke, or +by the light of our burning, and so leave us in our ruins?<br> +<br> +<i>Incred</i>. - Sir, you forget that you are under a governor, and +that you ought to demean yourself like a subject; and know ye, when +my lord the king shall hear of this day’s work, he will give you +but little thanks for your labour.<br> +<br> +Now while these gentlemen were thus in their chiding words, down come +from the walls and gates of the town the Lord Willbewill, Mr. Prejudice, +old Ill-Pause, and several of the new-made aldermen and burgesses, and +they asked the reason of the hubbub and tumult; and with that every +man began to tell his own tale, so that nothing could be heard distinctly. +Then was a silence commanded, and the old fox Incredulity began to speak. +‘My lord,’ quoth he, ‘here are a couple of peevish +gentlemen, that have, as a fruit of their bad dispositions, and, as +I fear, through the advice of one Mr. Discontent, tumultuously gathered +this company against me this day, and also attempted to run the town +into acts of rebellion against our prince.’<br> +<br> +Then stood up all the Diabolonians that were present, and affirmed these +things to be true.<br> +<br> +Now when they that took part with my Lord Understanding and with Mr. +Conscience perceived that they were like to come to the worst, for that +force and power was on the other side, they came in for their help and +relief; so a great company was on both sides. Then they on Incredulity’s +side would have had the two old gentlemen presently away to prison; +but they on the other side said they should not. Then they began +to cry up parties again: the Diabolonians cried up old Incredulity, +Forget-Good, the new aldermen, and their great one Diabolus; and the +other party, they as fast cried up Shaddai, the captains, his laws, +their mercifulness, and applauded their conditions and ways. Thus +the bickerment went awhile; at last they passed from words to blows, +and now there were knocks on both sides. The good old gentleman, +Mr. Conscience, was knocked down twice by one of the Diabolonians, whose +name was Mr. Benumbing; and my Lord Understanding had like to have been +slain with an arquebuse, but that he that shot did not take his aim +aright. Nor did the other side wholly escape; for there was one +Mr. Rashhead, a Diabolonian, that had his brains beaten out by Mr. Mind, +the Lord Willbewill’s servant; and it made me laugh to see how +old Mr. Prejudice was kicked and tumbled about in the dirt; for though, +a while since, he was made captain of a company of the Diabolonians, +to the hurt and damage of the town, yet now they had got him under their +feet, and, I’ll assure you, he had, by some of the Lord Understanding’s +party, his crown cracked to boot. Mr. Anything also, he became +a brisk man in the broil; but both sides were against him, because he +was true to none. Yet he had, for his malapertness, one of his +legs broken, and he that did it wished it had been his neck. Much +more harm was done on both sides, but this must not be forgotten; it +was now a wonder to see my Lord Willbewill so indifferent as he was: +he did not seem to take one side more than another, only it was perceived +that he smiled to see how old Prejudice was tumbled up and down in the +dirt. Also, when Captain Anything came halting up before him, +he seemed to take but little notice of him.<br> +<br> +Now, when the uproar was over, Diabolus sends for my Lord Understanding +and Mr. Conscience, and claps them both up in prison as the ringleaders +and managers of this most heavy, riotous rout in Mansoul. So now +the town began to be quiet again, and the prisoners were used hardly; +yea, he thought to have made them away, but that the present juncture +did not serve for that purpose, for that war was in all their gates.<br> +<br> +But let us return again to our story. The captains, when they +were gone back from the gate, and were come into the camp again, called +a council of war, to consult what was further for them to do. +Now, some said, ‘Let us go up presently, and fall upon the town;’ +but the greatest part thought rather better it would be to give them +another summons to yield; and the reason why they thought this to be +best was, because that, so far as could be perceived, the town of Mansoul +now was more inclinable than heretofore. ‘And if,’ +said they, ‘while some of them are in a way of inclination, we +should by ruggedness give them distaste, we may set them further from +closing with our summons than we would be willing they should.’ +Wherefore to this advice they agreed, and called a trumpeter, put words +into his mouth, set him his time, and bid him God speed. Well, +many hours were not expired before the trumpeter addressed himself to +his journey. Wherefore, coming up to the wall of the town, he +steereth his course to Ear-gate, and there sounded, as he was commanded. +They then that were within came out to see what was the matter, and +the trumpeter made them this speech following:<br> +<br> +‘O hard-hearted and deplorable town of Mansoul, how long wilt +thou love thy sinful, sinful simplicity, and, ye fools, delight in your +scorning? As yet despise you the offers of peace and deliverance? +As yet will ye refuse the golden offers of Shaddai, and trust to the +lies and falsehoods of Diabolus? Think you, when Shaddai shall +have conquered you, that the remembrance of these your carriages towards +him will yield you peace and comfort, or that by ruffling language you +can make him afraid as a grasshopper? Doth he entreat you for +fear of you? Do you think that you are stronger than he? +Look to the heavens, and behold and consider the stars, how high are +they? Can you stop the sun from running his course, and hinder +the moon from giving her light? Can you count the number of the +stars, or stay the bottles of heaven? Can you call for the waters +of the sea, and cause them to cover the face of the ground? Can +you behold every one that is proud, and abase him, and bind their faces +in secret? Yet these are some of the works of our King, in whose +name this day we come up unto you, that you may be brought under his +authority. In his name, therefore, I summon you again to yield +up yourselves to his captains.’<br> +<br> +At this summons the Mansoulians seemed to be at a stand, and knew not +what answer to make. Wherefore Diabolus forthwith appeared, and +took upon him to do it himself; and thus he begins, but turns his speech +to them of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +‘Gentlemen,’ quoth he, ‘and my faithful subjects, +if it is true that this summoner hath said concerning the greatness +of their King, by his terror you will always be kept in bondage, and +so be made to sneak. Yea, how can you now, though he is at a distance, +endure to think of such a mighty one? And if not to think of him +while at a distance, how can you endure to be in his presence? +I, your prince, am familiar with you, and you may play with me as you +would with a grasshopper. Consider, therefore, what is for your +profit, and remember the immunities that I have granted you.<br> +<br> +‘Farther, if all be true that this man hath said, how comes it +to pass that the subjects of Shaddai are so enslaved in all places where +they come? None in the universe so unhappy as they, none so trampled +upon as they.<br> +<br> +‘Consider, my Mansoul: would thou wert as loath to leave me as +I am loath to leave thee. But consider, I say, the ball is yet +at thy foot; liberty you have, if you know how to use it; yea, a king +you have too, if you can tell how to love and obey him.’<br> +<br> +Upon this speech, the town of Mansoul did again harden their hearts +yet more against the captains of Shaddai. The thoughts of his +greatness did quite quash them, and the thoughts of his holiness sunk +them in despair. Wherefore, after a short consult, they (of the +Diabolonian party they were) sent back this word by the trumpeter, That, +for their parts, they were resolved to stick to their king, but never +to yield to Shaddai; so it was but in vain to give them any further +summons, for they had rather die upon the place than yield. And +now things seemed to be gone quite back, and Mansoul to be out of reach +or call, yet the captains who knew what their Lord could do, would not +yet be beat out of heart; they therefore sent them another summons, +more sharp and severe than the last; but the oftener they were sent +to, to reconcile to Shaddai, the further off they were. ‘As +they called them, so they went from them - yea, though they called them +to the Most High.’<br> +<br> +So they ceased that way to deal with them any more, and inclined to +think of another way. The captains, therefore, did gather themselves +together, to have free conference among themselves, to know what was +yet to be done to gain the town, and to deliver it from the tyranny +of Diabolus; and one said after this manner, and another after that. +Then stood up the right noble the Captain Conviction, and said, ‘My +brethren, mine opinion is this:<br> +<br> +‘First, that we continually play our slings into the town, and +keep it in a continual alarm, molesting them day and night. By +thus doing, we shall stop the growth of their rampant spirit; for a +lion may be tamed by continual molestation.<br> +<br> +‘Secondly, this done, I advise that, in the next place, we with +one consent draw up a petition to our Lord Shaddai, by which, after +we have showed our King the condition of Mansoul and of affairs here, +and have begged his pardon for our no better success, we will earnestly +implore his Majesty’s help, and that he will please to send us +more force and power, and some gallant and well-spoken commander to +head them, that so his Majesty may not lose the benefit of these his +good beginnings, but may complete his conquest upon the town of Mansoul.’<br> +<br> +To this speech of the noble Captain Conviction they as one man consented, +and agreed that a petition should forthwith be drawn up, and sent by +a fit man away to Shaddai with speed. The contents of the petition +were thus:-<br> +<br> +‘Most gracious and glorious King, the Lord of the best world, +and the builder of the town of Mansoul, we have, dread Sovereign, at +thy commandment, put our lives in jeopardy, and at thy bidding made +a war upon the famous town of Mansoul. When we went up against +it, we did, according to our commission, first offer conditions of peace +unto it. But they, great King, set light by our counsel, and would +none of our reproof. They were for shutting their gates, and for +keeping us out of the town. They also mounted their guns, they +sallied out upon us, and have done us what damage they could; but we +pursued them with alarm upon alarm, requiting them with such retribution +as was meet, and have done some execution upon the town.<br> +<br> +‘Diabolus, Incredulity, and Willbewill are the great doers against +us: now we are in our winter quarters, but so as that we do yet with +an high hand molest and distress the town.<br> +<br> +‘Once, as we think, had we had but one substantial friend in the +town, such as would but have seconded the sound of our summons as they +ought, the people might have yielded themselves; but there were none +but enemies there, nor any to speak in behalf of our Lord to the town. +Wherefore, though we have done as we could, yet Mansoul abides in a +state of rebellion against thee.<br> +<br> +‘Now, King of kings, let it please thee to pardon the unsuccessfulness +of thy servants, who have been no more advantageous in so desirable +a work as the conquering of Mansoul is. And send, Lord, as we +now desire, more forces to Mansoul, that it may be subdued; and a man +to head them, that the town may both love and fear.<br> +<br> +‘We do not thus speak because we are willing to relinquish the +wars, (for we are for laying of our bones against the place,) but that +the town of Mansoul may be won for thy Majesty. We also pray thy +Majesty, for expedition in this matter, that, after their conquest, +we may be at liberty to be sent about other thy gracious designs. +Amen.’<br> +<br> +The petition, thus drawn up, was sent away with haste to the King by +the hand of that good man, Mr. Love-to-Mansoul.<br> +<br> +When this petition was come to the palace of the King, who should it +be delivered to but to the King’s Son? So he took it and +read it, and because the contents of it pleased him well, he mended, +and also in some things added to the petition himself. So, after +he had made such amendments and additions as he thought convenient, +with his own hand, he carried it in to the King; to whom, when he had +with obeisance delivered it, he put on authority, and spake to it himself.<br> +<br> +Now the King, at the sight of the petition, was glad; but how much more, +think you, when it was seconded by his Son! It pleased him also +to hear that his servants who camped against Mansoul were so hearty +in the work, and so steadfast in their resolves, and that they had already +got some ground upon the famous town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +Wherefore the King called to him Emmanuel, his Son, who said, ‘Here +am I, my Father.’ Then said the King, ‘Thou knowest, +as I do myself, the condition of the town of Mansoul, and what we have +purposed, and what thou hast done to redeem it. Come now, therefore, +my Son, and prepare thyself for the war, for thou shalt go to my camp +at Mansoul. Thou shalt also there prosper and prevail, and conquer +the town of Mansoul.’<br> +<br> +Then said the King’s Son, ‘Thy law is within my heart: I +delight to do thy will. This is the day that I have longed for, +and the work that I have waited for all this while. Grant me, +therefore, what force thou shalt in thy wisdom think meet; and I will +go and will deliver from Diabolus, and from his power, thy perishing +town of Mansoul. My heart has been often pained within me for +the miserable town of Mansoul; but now it is rejoiced, but now it is +glad,’<br> +<br> +And with that he leaped over the mountains for joy, saying, ‘I +have not, in my heart, thought anything too dear for Mansoul: the day +of vengeance is in mine heart for thee, my Mansoul: and glad am I that +thou, my Father, hast made me the Captain of their salvation. +And I will now begin to plague all those that have been a plague to +my town of Mansoul, and will deliver it from their hand.’<br> +<br> +When the King’s Son had said thus to his Father, it presently +flew like lightning round about at court; yea, it there became the only +talk what Emmanuel was to go to do for the famous town of Mansoul. +But you cannot think how the courtiers, too, were taken with this design +of the Prince; yea, so affected were they with this work, and with the +justness of the war, that the highest lord and greatest peer of the +kingdom did covet to have commissions under Emmanuel, to go to help +to recover again to Shaddai the miserable town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +Then was it concluded that some should go and carry tidings to the camp, +that Emmanuel was to come to recover Mansoul, and that he would bring +along with him so mighty, so impregnable a force, that he could not +be resisted. But, oh! how ready were the high ones at court to +run like lackeys to carry these tidings to the camp that was at Mansoul. +Now, when the captains perceived that the King would send Emmanuel his +Son, and that it also delighted the Son to be sent on this errand by +the great Shaddai his Father, they also, to show how they were pleased +at the thoughts of his coming gave a shout that made the earth rend +at the sound thereof. Yea, the mountains did answer again by echo, +and Diabolus himself did totter and shake.<br> +<br> +For you must know, that though the town of Mansoul itself was not much, +if at all concerned with the project, (for, alas for them! they were +wofully besotted, for they chiefly regarded their pleasure and their +lusts,) yet Diabolus their governor was; for he had his spies continually +abroad, who brought him intelligence of all things, and they told him +what was doing at court against him, and that Emmanuel would shortly +certainly come with a power to invade him. Nor was there any man +at court, nor peer of the kingdom, that Diabolus so feared as he feared +this Prince; for, if you remember, I showed you before that Diabolus +had felt the weight of his hand already; so that, since it was he that +was to come, this made him the more afraid.<br> +<br> +Well, you see how I have told you that the King’s Son was engaged +to come from the court to save Mansoul, and that his Father had made +him the Captain of the forces. The time, therefore, of his setting +forth being now expired, he addressed himself for his march, and taketh +with him, for his power, five noble captains and their forces.<br> +<br> +1. The first was that famous captain, the noble Captain Credence. +His were the red colours, and Mr. Promise bare them; and for a scutcheon +he had the holy lamb and golden shield; and he had ten thousand men +at his feet.<br> +<br> +2. The second was that famous captain, the Captain Good-Hope. +His were the blue colours; his standard-bearer was Mr. Expectation, +and for his scutcheon he had the three golden anchors; and he had ten +thousand men at his feet.<br> +<br> +3. The third was that valiant captain, the Captain Charity. His +standard-bearer was Mr. Pitiful: his were the green colours, and for +his scutcheon he had three naked orphans embraced in the bosom; and +he had ten thousand men at his feet.<br> +<br> +4. The fourth was that gallant commander, the Captain Innocent. +His standard-bearer was Mr. Harmless: his were the white colours, and +for his scutcheon he had the three golden doves.<br> +<br> +5. The fifth was the truly loyal and well-beloved captain, the Captain +Patience. His standard-bearer was Mr. Suffer-Long: his were the +black colours, and for a scutcheon he had three arrows through the golden +heart.<br> +<br> +These were Emmanuel’s captains; these their standard-bearers, +their colours, and their scutcheons; and these the men under their command. +So, as was said, the brave Prince took his march to go to the town of +Mansoul. Captain Credence led the van, and Captain Patience brought +up the rear; so the other three, with their men, made up the main body, +the Prince himself riding in his chariot at the head of them.<br> +<br> +But when they set out for their march, oh, how the trumpets sounded, +their armour glittered, and how the colours waved in the wind! +The Prince’s armour was all of gold, and it shone like the sun +in the firmament; the captains’ armour was of proof, and was in +appearance like the glittering stars. There were also some from +the court that rode reformades for the love that they had to the King +Shaddai, and for the happy deliverance of the town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +Emmanuel also, when he had thus set forwards to go to recover the town +of Mansoul, took with him, at the commandment of his Father, fifty-four +battering-rams, and twelve slings to whirl stones withal. Every +one of these was made of pure gold, and these they carried with them, +in the heart and body of their army, all along as they went to Mansoul.<br> +<br> +So they marched till they came within less than a league of the town; +there they lay till the first four captains came thither to acquaint +them with matters. Then they took their journey to go to the town +of Mansoul, and unto Mansoul they came; but when the old soldiers that +were in the camp saw that they had new forces to join with, they again +gave such a shout before the walls of the town of Mansoul, that it put +Diabolus into another fright. So they sat down before the town, +not now as the other four captains did, to wit, against the gates of +Mansoul only; but they environed it round on every side, and beset it +behind and before; so that now, let Mansoul look which way it will, +it saw force and power lie in siege against it. Besides, there +were mounts cast up against it. The Mount Gracious was on the +one side, and Mount Justice was on the other. Further, there were +several small banks and advance-grounds, as Plain-Truth Hill and No-Sin +Banks, where many of the slings were placed against the town. +Upon Mount Gracious were planted four, and upon Mount Justice were placed +as many, and the rest were conveniently placed in several parts round +about the town. Five of the best battering-rams, that is, of the +biggest of them, were placed upon Mount Hearken, a mount cast up hard +by Ear-gate, with intent to break that open.<br> +<br> +Now when the men of the town saw the multitude of the soldiers that +were come up against the place, and the rams and slings, and the mounts +on which they were planted, together with the glittering of the armour +and the waving of their colours, they were forced to shift, and shift, +and again to shift their thoughts; but they hardly changed for thoughts +more stout, but rather for thoughts more faint; for though before they +thought themselves sufficiently guarded, yet now they began to think +that no man knew what would be their hap or lot.<br> +<br> +When the good Prince Emmanuel had thus beleaguered Mansoul, in the first +place he hangs out the white flag, which he caused to be set up among +the golden slings that were planted upon Mount Gracious. And this +he did for two reasons: 1. To give notice to Mansoul that he could and +would yet be gracious if they turned to him. 2. And that he might +leave them the more without excuse, should he destroy them, they continuing +in their rebellion.<br> +<br> +So the white flag, with the three golden doves in it, was hung out for +two days together, to give them time and space to consider; but they, +as was hinted before, as if they were unconcerned, made no reply to +the favourable signal of the Prince.<br> +<br> +Then he commanded, and they set the red flag upon that mount called +Mount Justice. It was the red flag of Captain Judgment, whose +scutcheon was the burning fiery furnace; and this also stood waving +before them in the wind for several days together. But look how +they carried it under the white flag, when that was hung out, so did +they also when the red one was; and yet he took no advantage of them.<br> +<br> +Then he commanded again that his servants should hang out the black +flag of defiance against them, whose scutcheon was the three burning +thunderbolts; but as unconcerned was Mansoul at this as at those that +went before. But when the Prince saw that neither mercy nor judgment, +nor execution of judgment, would or could come near the heart of Mansoul, +he was touched with much compunction, and said, ‘Surely this strange +carriage of the town of Mansoul doth rather arise from ignorance of +the manner and feats of war, than from a secret defiance of us, and +abhorrence of their own lives; or if they know the manner of the war +of their own, yet not the rites and ceremonies of the wars in which +we are concerned, when I make wars upon mine enemy Diabolus.’<br> +<br> +Therefore he sent to the town of Mansoul, to let them know what he meant +by those signs and ceremonies of the flag; and also to know of them +which of the things they would choose, whether grace and mercy, or judgment +and the execution of judgment. All this while they kept their +gates shut with locks, bolts, and bars, as fast as they could. +Their guards also were doubled, and their watch made as strong as they +could. Diabolus also did pluck up what heart he could, to encourage +the town to make resistance.<br> +<br> +The townsmen also made answer to the Prince’s messenger, in substance +according to that which follows:-<br> +<br> +‘Great Sir, - As to what, by your messenger, you have signified +to us, whether we will accept of your mercy, or fall by your justice, +we are bound by the law and custom of this place, and can give you no +positive answer; for it is against the law, government, and the prerogative +royal of our king, to make either peace or war without him. But +this we will do, - we will petition that our prince will come down to +the wall, and there give you such treatment as he shall think fit and +profitable for us.’<br> +<br> +When the good Prince Emmanuel heard this answer, and saw the slavery +and bondage of the people, and how much content they were to abide in +the chains of the tyrant Diabolus, it grieved him at the heart; and, +indeed, when at any time he perceived that any were contented under +the slavery of the giant, he would be affected with it.<br> +<br> +But to return again to our purpose. After the town had carried +this news to Diabolus, and had told him, moreover, that the Prince, +that lay in the leaguer without the wall, waited upon them for an answer, +he refused, and huffed as well as he could; but in heart he was afraid.<br> +<br> +Then said he, ‘I will go down to the gates myself, and give him +such an answer as I think fit.’ So he went down to Mouth-gate, +and there addressed himself to speak to Emmanuel, (but in such language +as the town understood not,) the contents whereof were as follows:-<br> +<br> +‘O thou great Emmanuel, Lord of all the world, I know thee, that +thou art the Son of the great Shaddai! Wherefore art thou come +to torment me, and to cast me out of my possession? This town +of Mansoul, as thou very well knowest, is mine, and that by a twofold +right. 1. It is mine by right of conquest; I won it in the open field; +and shall the prey be taken from the mighty, or the lawful captive be +delivered? 2. This town of Mansoul is mine also by their subjection. +They have opened the gates of their town unto me; they have sworn fidelity +to me, and have openly chosen me to be their king; they have also given +their castle into my hands; yea, they have put the whole strength of +Mansoul under me.<br> +<br> +‘Moreover, this town of Mansoul hath disavowed thee, yea, they +have cast thy law, thy name, thy image, and all that is thine, behind +their back, and have accepted and set up in their room my law, my name, +my image, and all that ever is mine. Ask else thy captains, and +they will tell thee that Mansoul hath, in answer to all their summonses, +shown love and loyalty to me, but always disdain, despite, contempt, +and scorn to thee and thine. Now, thou art the Just One and the +Holy, and shouldest do no iniquity. Depart, then, I pray thee, +therefore, from me, and leave me to my just inheritance peaceably.’<br> +<br> +This oration was made in the language of Diabolus himself; for although +he can, to every man, speak in their own language, (else he could not +tempt them all as he does,) yet he has a language proper to himself, +and it is the language of the infernal cave, or black pit.<br> +<br> +Wherefore the town of Mansoul (poor hearts!) understood him not; nor +did they see how he crouched and cringed while he stood before Emmanuel, +their Prince.<br> +<br> +Yea, they all this while took him to be one of that power and force +that by no means could be resisted. Wherefore, while he was thus +entreating that he might have yet his residence there, and that Emmanuel +would not take it from him by force, the inhabitants boasted even of +his valour, saying, ‘Who is able to make war with him?’<br> +<br> +Well, when this pretended king had made an end of what he would say, +Emmanuel, the golden Prince, stood up and spake; the contents of whose +words follow:-<br> +<br> +‘Thou deceiving one,’ said he, ‘I have, in my Father’s +name, in mine own name, and on the behalf and for the good of this wretched +town of Mansoul, somewhat to say unto thee. Thou pretendest a +right, a lawful right, to the deplorable town of Mansoul, when it is +most apparent to all my Father’s court that the entrance which +thou hast obtained in at the gates of Mansoul was through thy lie and +falsehood; thou beliedst my Father, thou beliedst his law, and so deceivedst +the people of Mansoul. Thou pretendest that the people have accepted +thee for their king, their captain, and right liege lord; but that also +was by the exercise of deceit and guile. Now, if lying, wiliness, +sinful craft, and all manner of horrible hypocrisy, will go in my Father’s +court (in which court thou must be tried) for equity and right, then +will I confess unto thee that thou hast made a lawful conquest. +But, alas! what thief, what tyrant, what devil is there that may not +conquer after this sort? But I can make it appear, O Diabolus, +that thou, in all thy pretences to a conquest of Mansoul, hast nothing +of truth to say. Thinkest thou this to be right, that that didst +put the lie upon my Father, and madest him (to Mansoul) the greatest +deluder in the world? And what sayest thou to thy perverting knowingly +the right purport and intent of the law? Was it good also that +thou madest a prey of the innocency and simplicity of the now miserable +town of Mansoul? Yea, thou didst overcome Mansoul by promising +to them happiness in their transgressions against my Father’s +law, when thou knewest, and couldest not but know, hadst thou consulted +nothing but thine own experience, that that was the way to undo them. +Thou hast also thyself, O thou master of enmity, of spite defaced my +Father’s image in Mansoul, and set up thy own in its place, to +the great contempt of my Father, the heightening of thy sin, and to +the intolerable damage of the perishing town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +‘Thou hast, moreover, (as if all these were but little things +with thee,) not only deluded and undone this place, but, by thy lies +and fradulent carriage, hast set them against their own deliverance. +How hast thou stirred them up against my Father’s captains, and +made them to fight against those that were sent of him to deliver them +from their bondage! All these things, and very many more, thou +hast done against thy light, and in contempt of my Father and of his +law, yea, and with design to bring under his displeasure for ever the +miserable town of Mansoul. I am therefore come to avenge the wrong +that thou hast done to my Father, and to deal with thee for the blasphemies +wherewith thou hast made poor Mansoul blaspheme his name. Yea, +upon thy head, thou prince of the infernal cave, will I requite it.<br> +<br> +‘As for myself, O Diabolus, I am come against thee by lawful power, +and to take, by strength of hand, this town of Mansoul out of thy burning +fingers; for this town of Mansoul is mine, O Diabolus, and that by undoubted +right, as all shall see that will diligently search the most ancient +and most authentic records, and I will plead my title to it, to the +confusion of thy face.<br> +<br> +‘First, for the town of Mansoul, my Father built and did fashion +it with his hand. The palace also that is in the midst of that +town, he built it for his own delight. This town of Mansoul, therefore, +is my Father’s, and that by the best of titles, and he that gainsays +the truth of this must lie against his soul.<br> +<br> +‘Secondly, O thou master of the lie, this town of Mansoul is mine.<br> +<br> +‘1. For that I am my Father’s heir, his firstborn, and the +only delight of his heart. I am therefore come up against thee +in mine own right, even to recover mine own inheritance out of thine +hand.<br> +<br> +‘2. But further, as I have a right and title to Mansoul by being +my Father’s heir, so I have also by my Father’s donation. +His it was, and he gave it me; nor have I at any time offended my Father, +that he should take it from me, and give it to thee. Nor have +I been forced, by playing the bankrupt, to sell or set to sale to thee +my beloved town of Mansoul. Mansoul is my desire, my delight, +and the joy of my heart. But,<br> +<br> +‘3. Mansoul is mine by right of purchase. I have bought +it, O Diabolus, I have bought it to myself. Now, since it was +my Father’s and mine, as I was his heir, and since also I have +made it mine by virtue of a great purchase, it followeth that, by all +lawful right, the town of Mansoul is mine, and that thou art an usurper, +a tyrant, and traitor, in thy holding possession thereof. Now, +the cause of my purchasing of it was this: Mansoul had trespassed against +my Father; now my Father had said, that in the day that they broke his +law they should die. Now, it is more possible for heaven and earth +to pass away than for my Father to break his word. Wherefore when +Mansoul had sinned indeed by hearkening to thy lie, I put in and became +a surety to my Father, body for body, and soul for soul, that I would +make amends for Mansoul’s transgressions, and my Father did accept +thereof. So, when the time appointed was come, I gave body for +body, soul for soul, life for life, blood for blood, and so redeemed +my beloved Mansoul.<br> +<br> +‘4. Nor did I do this by halves: my Father’s law and justice, +that were both concerned in the threatening upon transgression, are +both now satisfied, and very well content that Mansoul should be delivered.<br> +<br> +‘5. Nor am I come out this day against thee, but by commandment +of my Father; it was he that said unto me, “Go down and deliver +Mansoul.”<br> +<br> +‘Wherefore be it known unto thee, O thou fountain of deceit, and +be it also known to the foolish town of Mansoul, that I am not come +against thee this day without my Father.<br> +<br> +‘And now,’ said the golden-headed Prince, ‘I have +a word to the town of Mansoul.’ But so soon as mention was +made that he had a word to speak to the besotted town of Mansoul, the +gates were double-guarded, and all men commanded not to give him audience. +So he proceeded and said, ‘O unhappy town of Mansoul, I cannot +but be touched with pity and compassion for thee. Thou hast accepted +of Diabolus for thy king, and art become a nurse and minister of Diabolonians +against thy sovereign Lord. Thy gates thou hast opened to him, +but hast shut them fast against me; thou hast given him an hearing, +but hast stopped thine ears at my cry. He brought to thee thy +destruction, and thou didst receive both him and it: I am come to thee +bringing salvation, but thou regardest me not. Besides, thou hast, +as with sacrilegious hands, taken thyself, with all that was mine in +thee, and hast given all to my foe, and to the greatest enemy my Father +has. You have bowed and subjected yourselves to him, you have +vowed and sworn yourselves to be his. Poor Mansoul! what shall +I do unto thee? Shall I save thee? - shall I destroy thee? +What shall I do unto thee? Shall I fall upon thee, and grind thee +to powder, or make thee a monument of the richest grace? What +shall I do unto thee? Hearken, therefore, thou town of Mansoul, +hearken to my word, and thou shalt live. I am merciful, Mansoul, +and thou shalt find me so: shut me not out of thy gates.<br> +<br> +‘O Mansoul, neither is my commission nor inclination at all to +do thee hurt. Why fliest thou so fast from thy friend, and stickest +so close to thine enemy? Indeed, I would have thee, because it +becomes thee to be sorry for thy sin, but do not despair of life; this +great force is not to hurt thee, but to deliver thee from thy bondage, +and to reduce thee to thy obedience.<br> +<br> +‘My commission, indeed, is to make a war upon Diabolus thy king, +and upon all Diabolonians with him; for he is the strong man armed that +keeps the house, and I will have him out: his spoils I must divide, +his armour I must take from him, his hold I must cast him out of, and +must make it a habitation for myself. And this, O Mansoul, shall +Diabolus know when he shall be made to follow me in chains, and when +Mansoul shall rejoice to see it so.<br> +<br> + ‘I could, would I now put forth my might, cause that forthwith +he should leave you and depart; but I have it in my heart so to deal +with him, as that the justice of the war that I shall make upon him +may be seen and acknowledged by all. He hath taken Mansoul by +fraud, and keeps it by violence and deceit, and I will make him bare +and naked in the eyes of all observers.<br> +<br> +‘All my words are true. I am mighty to save, and will deliver +my Mansoul out of his hand.’<br> +<br> +This speech was intended chiefly for Mansoul, but Mansoul would not +have the hearing of it. They shut up Ear-gate, they barricaded +it up, they kept it locked and bolted, they set a guard thereat, and +commanded that no Mansoulonian should go out to him, nor that any from +the camp should be admitted into the town. All this they did, +so horribly had Diabolus enchanted them to do, and seek to do for him, +against their rightful Lord and Prince; wherefore no man, nor voice, +nor sound of man that belonged to the glorious host, was to come into +the town.<br> +<br> +So when Emmanuel saw that Mansoul was thus involved in sin, he calls +his army together, (since now also his words were despised,) and gave +out a commandment throughout all his host to be ready against the time +appointed. Now, forasmuch as there was no way lawfully to take +the town of Mansoul but to get in by the gates, and at Ear-gate as the +chief, therefore he commanded his captains and commanders to bring their +rams, their slings and their men, and place them at Eye-gate and Ear-gate, +in order to his taking the town.<br> +<br> +When Emmanuel had put all things in a readiness to give Diabolus battle, +he sent again to know of the town of Mansoul, if in peaceable manner +they would yield themselves, or whether they were yet resolved to put +him to try the utmost extremity? They then, together with Diabolus +their king, called a council of war, and resolved upon certain propositions +that should be offered to Emmanuel, if he will accept thereof, so they +agreed; and then the next was, who should be sent on this errand. +Now, there was in the town of Mansoul an old man, a Diabolonian, and +his name was Mr. Loth-to-stoop, a stiff man in his way, and a great +doer for Diabolus; him, therefore, they sent, and put into his mouth +what he should say. So he went and came to the camp to Emmanuel, +and when he was come, a time was appointed to give him audience. +So at the time he came, and after a Diabolonian ceremony or two, he +thus began and said, ‘Great sir, that it may be known unto all +men how good-natured a prince my master is, he has sent me to tell your +lordship that he is very willing, rather than go to war, to deliver +up into your hands one half of the town of Mansoul. I am therefore +to know if your Mightiness will accept of this proposition.’<br> +<br> +Then said Emmanuel, ‘The whole is mine by gift and purchase, wherefore +I will never lose one half.’<br> +<br> +Then said Mr. Loth-to-stoop, ‘Sir, my master hath said that he +will be content that you shall be the nominal and titular Lord of all, +if he may possess but a part.’<br> +<br> +Then Emmanuel answered, ‘The whole is mine really, not in name +and word only; wherefore I will be the sole lord and possessor of all, +or of none at all, of Mansoul.’<br> +<br> +Then Mr. Loth-to-stoop said again, ‘Sir, behold the condescension +of my master! He says, that he will be content, if he may but +have assigned to him some place in Mansoul as a place to live privately +in, and you shall be Lord of all the rest.’<br> +<br> +Then said the golden Prince, ‘All that the Father giveth me shall +come to me; and of all that he giveth me I will lose nothing - no, not +a hoof nor a hair. I will not, therefore, grant him, no, not the +least corner of Mansoul to dwell in; I will have all to myself.’<br> +<br> +Then Loth-to-stoop said again, ‘But, sir, suppose that my Lord +should resign the whole town to you, only with this proviso, that he +sometimes, when he comes into this country, may, for old acquaintance’ +sake, be entertained as a wayfaring man for two days, or ten days or +a month, or so. May not this small matter be granted?’<br> +<br> +Then said Emmanuel, ‘No. He came as a wayfaring man to David, +nor did he stay long with him, and yet it had like to have cost David +his soul. I will not consent that he ever should have any harbour +more there.’<br> +<br> +Then said Mr. Loth-to-stoop, ‘Sir, you seem to be very hard. +Suppose my master should yield to all that your lordship hath said, +provided that his friends and kindred in Mansoul may have liberty to +trade in the town, and to enjoy their present dwellings. May not +that be granted, sir?’<br> +<br> +Then said Emmanuel, ‘No; that is contrary to my Father’s +will; for all, and all manner of Diabolonians that now are, or that +at any time shall be found in Mansoul, shall not only lose their lands +and liberties, but also their lives.’<br> +<br> +Then said Mr. Loth-to-stoop again, ‘But, sir, may not my master +and great lord, by letters, by passengers, by accidental opportunities, +and the like, maintain, if he shall deliver up all unto thee, some kind +of old friendship with Mansoul?’<br> +<br> +Emmanuel answered, ‘No, by no means; forasmuch as any such fellowship, +friendship, intimacy, or acquaintance, in what way, sort, or mode soever +maintained, will tend to the corrupting of Mansoul, the alienating of +their affections from me, and the endangering of their peace with my +Father.’<br> +<br> +Mr. Loth-to-stoop yet added further, saying, ‘But, great sir, +since my master hath many friends, and those that are dear to him, in +Mansoul, may he not, if he shall depart from them, even of his bounty +and good-nature, bestow upon them, as he sees fit, some tokens of his +love and kindness that he had for them, to the end that Mansoul, when +he is gone, may look upon such tokens of kindness once received from +their old friend, and remember him who was once their king, and the +merry times that they sometimes enjoyed one with another, while he and +they lived in peace together?’<br> +<br> +Then said Emmanuel, ‘No; for if Mansoul come to be mine, I shall +not admit of nor consent that there should be the least scrap, shred, +or dust of Diabolus left behind, as tokens of gifts bestowed upon any +in Mansoul, thereby to call to remembrance the horrible communion that +was betwixt them and him.’<br> +<br> +‘Well, sir,’ said Mr. Loth-to-stoop, ‘I have one thing +more to propound, and then I am got to the end of my commission. +Suppose that, when my master is gone from Mansoul, any that shall yet +live in the town should have such business of high concerns to do, that +if they be neglected the party shall be undone; and suppose, sir, that +nobody can help in that case so well as my master and lord, may not +now my master be sent for upon so urgent an occasion as this? +Or if he may not be admitted into the town, may not he and the person +concerned meet in some of the villages near Mansoul, and there lay their +heads together, and there consult of matters?’<br> +<br> +This was the last of those ensnaring propositions that Mr. Loth-to-stoop +had to propound to Emmanuel on behalf of his master Diabolus; but Emmanuel +would not grant it; for he said, ‘There can be no case, or thing, +or matter fall out in Mansoul, when thy master shall be gone, that may +not be solved by my Father; besides, it will be a great disparagement +to my Father’s wisdom and skill to admit any from Mansoul to go +out to Diabolus for advice, when they are bid before, in everything, +by prayer and supplication to let their requests be made known to my +Father. Further, this, should it be granted, would be to grant +that a door should be set open for Diabolus, and the Diabolonians in +Mansoul, to hatch, and plot, and bring to pass treasonable designs, +to the grief of my Father and me, and to the utter destruction of Mansoul.’<br> +<br> +When Mr. Loth-to-stoop had heard this answer, he took his leave of Emmanuel, +and departed, saying that he would carry word to his master concerning +this whole affair. So he departed, and came to Diabolus to Mansoul, +and told him the whole of the matter, and how Emmanuel would not admit, +no, not by any means, that he, when he was once gone out, should for +ever have anything more to do either in, or with any that are of the +town of Mansoul. When Mansoul and Diabolus had heard this relation +of things, they with one consent concluded to use their best endeavour +to keep Emmanuel out of Mansoul, and sent old Ill-Pause, of whom you +have heard before, to tell the Prince and his captains so. So +the old gentleman came up to the top of Ear-gate, and called to the +camp for a hearing, who when they gave audience, he said, ‘I have +in commandment from my high lord to bid you tell it to your Prince Emmanuel, +that Mansoul and their king are resolved to stand and fall together; +and that it is in vain for your Prince to think of ever having Mansoul +in his hand, unless he can take it by force.’ So some went +and told to Emmanuel what old Ill-Pause, a Diabolonian in Mansoul, had +said. Then said the Prince, ‘I must try the power of my +sword, for I will not (for all the rebellions and repulses that Mansoul +has made against me) raise my siege and depart, but will assuredly take +my Mansoul, and deliver it from the hand of her enemy.’ +And with that he gave out a commandment that Captain Boanerges, Captain +Conviction, Captain Judgment, and Captain Execution should forthwith +march up to Ear-gate with trumpets sounding, colours flying, and with +shouting for the battle. Also he would that Captain Credence should +join himself with them. Emmanuel, moreover, gave order that Captain +Good-Hope and Captain Charity should draw themselves up before Eye-gate. +He bid also that the rest of his captains and their men should place +themselves for the best of their advantage against the enemy round about +the town; and all was done as he had commanded.<br> +<br> +Then he bid that the word should be given forth, and the word was at +that time, ‘EMMANUEL.’ Then was an alarm sounded, +and the battering-rams were played, and the slings did whirl stones +into the town amain, and thus the battle began. Now Diabolus himself +did manage the townsmen in the war, and that at every gate; wherefore +their resistance was the more forcible, hellish, and offensive to Emmanuel. +Thus was the good Prince engaged and entertained by Diabolus and Mansoul +for several days together; and a sight worth seeing it was to behold +how the captains of Shaddai behaved themselves in this war.<br> +<br> +And first for Captain Boanerges, (not to under-value the rest,) he made +three most fierce assaults, one after another, upon Ear-gate, to the +shaking of the posts thereof. Captain Conviction, he also made +up as fast with Boanerges as possibly he could, and both discerning +that the gate began to yield, they commanded that the rams should still +be played against it. Now, Captain Conviction, going up very near +to the gate, was with great force driven back, and received three wounds +in the mouth. And those that rode reformades, they went about +to encourage the captains.<br> +<br> +For the valour of the two captains, made mention of before, the Prince +sent for them to his pavilion, and commanded that a while they should +rest themselves, and that with somewhat they should be refreshed. +Care also was taken for Captain Conviction, that he should be healed +of his wounds. The Prince also gave to each of them a chain of +gold, and bid them yet be of good courage.<br> +<br> +Nor did Captain Good-Hope nor Captain Charity come behind in this most +desperate fight, for they so well did behave themselves at Eye-gate, +that they had almost broken it quite open. These also had a reward +from their Prince, as also had the rest of the captains, because they +did valiantly round about the town.<br> +<br> +In this engagement several of the officers of Diabolus were slain, and +some of the townsmen wounded. For the officers, there was one +Captain Boasting slain. This Boasting thought that nobody could +have shaken the posts of Ear-gate, nor have shaken the heart of Diabolus. +Next to him there was one Captain Secure slain: this Secure used to +say that the blind and lame in Mansoul were able to keep the gates of +the town against Emmanuel’s army. This Captain Secure did +Captain Conviction cleave down the head with a two-handed sword, when +he received himself three wounds in his mouth.<br> +<br> +Besides these there was one Captain Bragman, a very desperate fellow, +and he was captain over a band of those that threw firebrands, arrows, +and death: he also received, by the hand of Captain Good-Hope at Eye-gate, +a mortal wound in the breast.<br> +<br> +There was, moreover, one Mr. Feeling; but he was no captain, but a great +stickler to encourage Mansoul to rebellion. He received a wound +in the eye by the hand of one of Boanerges’ soldiers, and had +by the captain himself been slain, but that he made a sudden retreat.<br> +<br> +But I never saw Willbewill so daunted in all my life; he was not able +to do as he was wont, and some say that he also received a wound in +the leg, and that some of the men in the Prince’s army have certainly +seen him limp as he afterwards walked on the wall.<br> +<br> +I shall not give you a particular account of the names of the soldiers +that were slain in the town, for many were maimed, and wounded, and +slain; for when they saw that the posts of Ear-gate did shake, and Eye-gate +was well-nigh broken quite open, and also that their captains were slain, +this took away the hearts of many of the Diabolonians; they fell also +by the force of the shot that were sent by the golden slings into the +midst of the town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +Of the townsmen, there was one Love-no-Good; he was a townsman, but +a Diabolonian; he also received his mortal wound in Mansoul, but he +died not very soon.<br> +<br> +Mr. Ill-Pause also, who was the man that came along with Diabolus when +at first he attempted the taking of Mansoul, he also received a grievous +wound in the head; some say that his brain-pan was cracked. This +I have taken notice of, that he was never after this able to do that +mischief to Mansoul as he had done in times past. Also old Prejudice +and Mr. Anything fled.<br> +<br> +Now, when the battle was over, the Prince commanded that yet once more +the white flag should be set upon Mount Gracious in sight of the town +of Mansoul, to show that yet Emmanuel had grace for the wretched town +of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +When Diabolus saw the white flag hung out again, and knowing that it +was not for him, but Mansoul, he cast in his mind to play another prank, +to wit, to see if Emmanuel would raise his siege and begone, upon promise +of reformation. So he comes down to the gate one evening, a good +while after the sun was gone down, and calls to speak with Emmanuel, +who presently came down to the gate, and Diabolus saith unto him:<br> +<br> +‘Forasmuch as thou makest it appear by thy white flag that thou +art wholly given to peace and quiet, I thought meet to acquaint thee +that we are ready to accept thereof upon terms which thou mayest admit.<br> +<br> +‘I know that thou art given to devotion, and that holiness pleaseth +thee; yea, that thy great end in making a war upon Mansoul is, that +it may be a holy habitation. Well, draw off thy forces from the +town, and I will bend Mansoul to thy bow.<br> +<br> +‘First, I will lay down all acts of hostility against thee, and +will be willing to become thy deputy, and will, as I have formerly been +against thee, now serve thee in the town of Mansoul. And more +particularly,<br> +<br> +‘1. I will persuade Mansoul to receive thee for their Lord; and +I know that they will do it the sooner when they shall understand that +I am thy deputy.<br> +<br> +‘2. I will show them wherein they have erred, and that transgression +stands in the way to life.<br> +<br> +‘3. I will show them the holy law unto which they must conform, +even that which they have broken.<br> +<br> +‘4. I will press upon them the necessity of a reformation according +to thy law.<br> +<br> +‘5. And, moreover, that none of these things may fail, I myself, +at my own proper cost and charge, will set up and maintain a sufficient +ministry, besides lectures, in Mansoul.<br> +<br> +‘6. Thou shalt receive, as a token of our subjection to thee, +year by year, what thou shalt think fit to lay and levy upon us in token +of our subjection to thee.’<br> +<br> +Then said Emmanuel to him, ‘O full of deceit, how movable are +thy ways! How often hast thou changed and rechanged, if so be +thou mightest still keep possession of my Mansoul, though, as has been +plainly declared before, I am the right heir thereof! Often hast +thou made thy proposals already, nor is this last a whit better than +they. And failing to deceive when thou showedst thyself in thy +black, thou hast now transformed thyself into an angel of light, and +wouldst, to deceive, be now as a minister of righteousness.<br> +<br> +‘But know thou, O Diabolus, that nothing must be regarded that +thou canst propound, for nothing is done by thee but to deceive. +Thou neither hast conscience to God, nor love to the town of Mansoul; +whence, then, should these thy sayings arise but from sinful craft and +deceit? He that can of list and will propound what he pleases, +and that wherewith he may destroy them that believe him, is to be abandoned, +with all that he shall say. But if righteousness be such a beauty-spot +in thine eyes now, how is it that wickedness was so closely stuck to +by thee before? But this is by-the-bye.<br> +<br> +‘Thou talkest now of a reformation in Mansoul, and that thou thyself, +if I will please, wilt be at the head of that reformation; all the while +knowing that the greatest proficiency that man can make in the law, +and the righteousness thereof, will amount to no more, for the taking +away of the curse from Mansoul, than just nothing at all; for a law +being broken by Mansoul, that had before, upon a supposition of the +breach thereof, a curse pronounced against him for it of God, can never, +by his obeying of the law, deliver himself therefrom (to say nothing +of what a reformation is like to be set up in Mansoul when the devil +is become corrector of vice). Thou knowest that all that thou +hast now said in this matter is nothing but guile and deceit; and is, +as it was the first, so is it the last card that thou hast to play. +Many there be that do soon discern thee when thou showest them thy cloven +foot; but in thy white, thy light, and in thy transformation, thou art +seen but of a few. But thou shalt not do thus with my Mansoul, +O Diabolus; for I do still love my Mansoul.<br> +<br> +‘Besides, I am not come to put Mansoul upon works to live thereby; +should I do so, I should be like unto thee: but I am come that by me, +and by what I have and shall do for Mansoul, they may to my Father be +reconciled, though by their sin they have provoked him to anger, and +though by the law they cannot obtain mercy.<br> +<br> +‘Thou talkest of subjecting of this town to good, when none desireth +it at thy hands. I am sent by my Father to possess it myself, +and to guide it by the skilfulness of my hands into such a conformity +to him as shall be pleasing in his sight. I will therefore possess +it myself; I will dispossess and cast thee out; I will set up mine own +standard in the midst of them; I will also govern them by new laws, +new officers, new motives, and new ways; yea, I will pull down this +town, and build it again; and it shall be as though it had not been, +and it shall then be the glory of the whole universe.’<br> +<br> +When Diabolus heard this, and perceived that he was discovered in all +his deceits, he was confounded, and utterly put to a nonplus; but having +in himself the fountain of iniquity, rage, and malice against both Shaddai +and his Son, and the beloved town of Mansoul, what doth he but strengthen +himself what he could to give fresh battle to the noble Prince Emmanuel? +So, then, now we must have another fight before the town of Mansoul +is taken. Come up, then, to the mountains, you that love to see +military actions, and behold by both sides how the fatal blow is given, +while one seeks to hold, and the other seeks to make himself master +of the famous town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +Diabolus, therefore, having withdrawn himself from the wall to his force +that was in the heart of the town of Mansoul, Emmanuel also returned +to the camp; and both of them, after their divers ways, put themselves +into a posture fit to give battle one to another.<br> +<br> +Diabolus, as filled with despair of retaining in his hands the famous +town of Mansoul, resolved to do what mischief he could (if, indeed, +he could do any) to the army of the Prince and to the famous town of +Mansoul; for, alas! it was not the happiness of the silly town of Mansoul +that was designed by Diabolus, but the utter ruin and overthrow thereof, +as now is enough in view. Wherefore, he commands his officers +that they should then, when they see that they could hold the town no +longer, do it what harm and mischief they could, rendering and tearing +men, women, and children. ‘For,’ said he, ‘we +had better quite demolish the place, and leave it like a ruinous heap, +than so leave it that it may be an habitation for Emmanuel.’<br> +<br> +Emmanuel again, knowing that the next battle would issue in his being +made master of the place, gave out a royal commandment to all his officers, +high captains, and men of war, to be sure to show themselves men of +war against Diabolus and all Diabolonians; but favourable, merciful, +and meek to the old inhabitants of Mansoul. ‘Bend, therefore,’ +said the noble Prince, ‘the hottest front of the battle against +Diabolus and his men.’<br> +<br> +So the day being come, the command was given, and the Prince’s +men did bravely stand to their arms, and did, as before, bend their +main force against Ear-gate and Eye-gate. The word was then, ‘Mansoul +is won!’ so they made their assault upon the town. Diabolus +also, as fast as he could, with the main of his power, made resistance +from within; and his high lords and chief captains for a time fought +very cruelly against the Prince’s army.<br> +<br> +But after three or four notable charges by the Prince and his noble +captains, Ear-gate was broken open, and the bars and bolts wherewith +it was used to be fast shut up against the Prince, were broken into +a thousand pieces. Then did the Prince’s trumpets sound, +the captains shout, the town shake, and Diabolus retreat to his hold. +Well, when the Prince’s forces had broken open the gate, himself +came up and did set his throne in it; also he set his standard thereby, +upon a mount that before by his men was cast up to place the mighty +slings thereon. The mount was called Mount Hear-well. There, +therefore, the Prince abode, to wit, hard by the going in at the gate. +He commanded also that the golden slings should yet be played upon the +town, especially against the castle, because for shelter thither was +Diabolus retreated. Now, from Ear-gate the street was straight +even to the house of Mr. Recorder that so was before Diabolus took the +town; and hard by his house stood the castle, which Diabolus for a long +time had made his irksome den. The captains, therefore, did quickly +clear that street by the use of their slings, so that way was made up +to the heart of the town. Then did the Prince command that Captain +Boanerges, Captain Conviction, and Captain Judgment, should forthwith +march up the town to the old gentleman’s gate. Then did +the captains in the most warlike manner enter into the town of Mansoul, +and marching in with flying colours, they came up to the Recorder’s +house, and that was almost as strong as was the castle. Battering-rams +they took also with them, to plant against the castle gates. When +they were come to the house of Mr. Conscience, they knocked, and demanded +entrance. Now, the old gentleman, not knowing as yet fully their +design, kept his gates shut all the time of this fight. Wherefore +Boanerges demanded entrance at his gates; and no man making answer, +he gave it one stroke with the head of a ram, and this made the old +gentleman shake, and his house to tremble and totter. Then came +Mr. Recorder down to the gates, and, as he could, with quivering lips +he asked who was there? Boanerges answered, ‘We are the +captains and commanders of the great Shaddai and of the blessed Emmanuel, +his Son, and we demand possession of your house for the use of our noble +Prince.’ And with that the battering-ram gave the gate another +shake. This made the old gentleman tremble the more, yet durst +he not but open the gate: then the King’s forces marched in, namely, +the three brave captains mentioned before. Now, the Recorder’s +house was a place of much convenience for Emmanuel, not only because +it was near to the castle and strong, but also because it was large, +and fronted the castle, the den where now Diabolus was, for he was now +afraid to come out of his hold. As for Mr. Recorder, the captains +carried it very reservedly to him; as yet he knew nothing of the great +designs of Emmanuel, so that he did not know what judgment to make, +nor what would be the end of such thundering beginnings. It was +also presently noised in the town how the Recorder’s house was +possessed, his rooms taken up, and his palace made the seat of the war; +and no sooner was it noised abroad, but they took the alarm as warmly, +and gave it out to others of his friends, and you know, as a snowball +loses nothing by rolling, so in little time the whole town was possessed +that they must expect nothing from the Prince but destruction; and the +ground of the business was this, the Recorder was afraid, the Recorder +trembled, and the captains carried it strangely to the Recorder. +So many came to see, but when they with their own eyes did behold the +captains in the palace, and their battering-rams ever playing at the +castle gates to beat them down, they were riveted in their fears, and +it made them all in amaze. And, as I said, the man of the house +would increase all this; for whoever came to him, or discoursed with +him, nothing would he talk of, tell them, or hear, but that death and +destruction now attended Mansoul.<br> +<br> +‘For,’ quoth the old gentleman, ‘you are all of you +sensible that we all have been traitors to that once despised, but now +famously victorious and glorious Prince Emmanuel; for he now, as you +see, doth not only lie in close siege about us, but hath forced his +entrance in at our gates. Moreover, Diabolus flees before him; +and he hath, as you behold, made of my house a garrison against the +castle where he is. I, for my part, have transgressed greatly, +and he that is clean, it is well for him. But I say I have transgressed +greatly in keeping silence when I should have spoken, and in perverting +justice when I should have executed the same. True, I have suffered +something at the hand of Diabolus for taking part with the laws of King +Shaddai; but that, alas! what will that do? Will that make compensation +for the rebellions and treasons that I have done, and have suffered +without gainsaying to be committed in the town of Mansoul? Oh! I tremble +to think what will be the end of this so dreadful and so ireful a beginning!’<br> +<br> +Now, while these brave captains were thus busy in the house of the old +Recorder, Captain Execution was as busy in other parts of the town, +in securing the back streets and the walls. He also hunted the +Lord Willbewill sorely; he suffered him not to rest in any corner; he +pursued him so hard that he drove his men from him, and made him glad +to thrust his head into a hole. Also this mighty warrior did cut +three of the Lord Willbewill’s officers down to the ground: one +was old Mr. Prejudice, he that had his crown cracked in the mutiny. +This man was made by Lord Willbewill keeper of the Ear-gate, and fell +by the hand of Captain Execution. There was also one Mr. Backward-to-all-but-naught, +and he also was one of Lord Willbewill’s officers, and was the +captain of the two guns that once were mounted on the top of Ear-gate; +he also was cut down to the ground by the hands of Captain Execution. +Besides these two there was another, a third, and his name was Captain +Treacherous; a vile man this was, but one that Willbewill did put a +great deal of confidence in; but him also did this Captain Execution +cut down to the ground with the rest.<br> +<br> +He also made a very great slaughter among my Lord Willbewill’s +soldiers, killing many that were stout and sturdy, and wounding many +that for Diabolus were nimble and active. But all these were Diabolonians; +there was not a man, a native of Mansoul, hurt.<br> +<br> +Other feats of war were also likewise performed by other of the captains, +as at Eye-gate, where Captain Good-Hope and Captain Charity had a charge, +was great execution done; for the Captain Good-Hope, with his own hands, +slew one Captain Blindfold, the keeper of that gate. This Blindfold +was captain of a thousand men, and they were they that fought with mauls; +he also pursued his men, slew many, and wounded more, and made the rest +hide their heads in corners.<br> +<br> +There was also at that gate Mr. Ill-Pause, of whom you have heard before. +He was an old man, and had a beard that reached down to his girdle: +the same was he that was orator to Diabolus: he did much mischief in +the town of Mansoul, and fell by the hand of Captain Good-Hope.<br> +<br> +What shall I say? The Diabolonians in these days lay dead in every +corner, though too many yet were alive in Mansoul.<br> +<br> +Now, the old Recorder and my Lord Understanding, with some others of +the chief of the town, to wit, such as knew they must stand and fall +with the famous town of Mansoul, came together upon a day, and after +consultation had, did jointly agree to draw up a petition, and to send +it to Emmanuel, now while he sat in the gate of Mansoul. So they +drew up their petition to Emmanuel, the contents whereof were these: +That they, the old inhabitants of the now deplorable town of Mansoul, +confessed their sin, and were sorry that they had offended his princely +Majesty, and prayed that he would spare their lives.<br> +<br> +Unto this petition he gave no answer at all, and that did trouble them +yet so much the more. Now, all this while the captains that were +in the Recorder’s house were playing with the battering-rams at +the gates of the castle, to beat them down. So after some time, +labour, and travail, the gate of the castle that was called Impregnable +was beaten open, and broken into several splinters, and so a way made +to go up to the hold in which Diabolus had hid himself. Then were +tidings sent down to Ear-gate, for Emmanuel still abode there, to let +him know that a way was made in at the gates of the castle of Mansoul. +But, oh! how the trumpets at the tidings sounded throughout the Prince’s +camp, for that now the war was so near an end, and Mansoul itself of +being set free.<br> +<br> +Then the Prince arose from the place where he was, and took with him +such of his men of war as were fittest for that expedition, and marched +up the street of Mansoul to the old Recorder’s house.<br> +<br> +Now, the Prince himself was clad all in armour of gold, and so he marched +up the town with his standard borne before him; but he kept his countenance +much reserved all the way as he went, so that the people could not tell +how to gather to themselves love or hatred by his looks. Now, +as he marched up the street, the townsfolk came out at every door to +see, and could not but be taken with his person and the glory thereof, +but wondered at the reservedness of his countenance; for as yet he spake +more to them by his actions and works than he did by words or smiles. +But also poor Mansoul, (as in such cases all are apt to do,) they interpreted +the carriage of Emmanuel to them as did Joseph’s brethren his +to them, even all the quite contrary way. ‘For,’ thought +they, ‘if Emmanuel loved us, he would show it to us by word of +carriage; but none of these he doth, therefore Emmanuel hates us. +Now, if Emmanuel hates us, then Mansoul shall be slain, then Mansoul +shall become a dunghill.’ They knew that they had transgressed +his Father’s law, and that against him they had been in with Diabolus, +his enemy. They also knew that the Prince Emmanuel knew all this; +for they were convinced that he was an angel of God, to know all things +that are done in the earth; and this made them think that their condition +was miserable, and that the good Prince would make them desolate.<br> +<br> +‘And,’ thought they, ‘what time so fit to do this +in as now, when he has the bridle of Mansoul in his hand?’ +And this I took special notice of, that the inhabitants, notwithstanding +all this, could not - no, they could not, when they see him march through +the town, but cringe, bow, bend, and were ready to lick the dust of +his feet. They also wished a thousand times over that he would +become their Prince and Captain, and would become their protection. +They would also one to another talk of the comeliness of his person, +and how much for glory and valour he outstripped the great ones of the +world. But, poor hearts, as to themselves, their thoughts would +chance, and go upon all manner of extremes. Yea, through the working +of them backward and forward, Mansoul became as a ball tossed, and as +a rolling thing before the whirlwind.<br> +<br> +Now, when he was come to the castle gates, he commanded Diabolus to +appear, and to surrender himself into his hands. But, oh! how +loath was the beast to appear! how he stuck at it! how he shrank! how +he cringed! yet out he came to the Prince. Then Emmanuel commanded, +and they took Diabolus and bound him fast in chains, the better to reserve +him to the judgment that he had appointed for him. But Diabolus +stood up to entreat for himself that Emmanuel would not send him into +the deep, but suffer him to depart out of Mansoul in peace.<br> +<br> +When Emmanuel had taken him and bound him in chains, he led him into +the marketplace, and there, before Mansoul, stripped him of his armour +in which he boasted so much before. This now was one of the acts +of triumph of Emmanuel over his enemy; and all the while that the giant +was stripping, the trumpets of the golden Prince did sound amain; the +captains also shouted, and the soldiers did sing for joy.<br> +<br> +Then was Mansoul called upon to behold the beginning of Emmanuel’s +triumph over him in whom they so much had trusted, and of whom they +so much had boasted in the days when he flattered them.<br> +<br> +Thus having made Diabolus naked in the eyes of Mansoul, and before the +commanders of the Prince, in the next place, he commands that Diabolus +should be bound with chains to his chariot wheels. Then leaving +some of his forces, to wit, Captain Boanerges and Captain Conviction, +as a guard for the castle-gates, that resistance might be made on his +behalf, (if any that heretofore followed Diabolus should make an attempt +to possess it,) he did ride in triumph over him quite through the town +of Mansoul, and so out at and before the gate called Eye-gate, to the +plain where his camp did lie.<br> +<br> +But you cannot think, unless you had been there, as I was, what a shout +there was in Emmanuel’s camp when they saw the tyrant bound by +the hand of their noble Prince, and tied to his chariot wheels!<br> +<br> +And they said, ‘He hath led captivity captive, he hath spoiled +principalities and powers. Diabolus is subjected to the power +of his sword, and made the object of all derision.’<br> +<br> +Those also that rode reformades, and that came down to see the battle, +they shouted with that greatness of voice, and sung with such melodious +notes, that they caused them that dwell in the highest orbs to open +their windows, put out their heads, and look to see the cause of that +glory.<br> +<br> +The townsmen also, so many of them as saw this sight, were, as it were, +while they looked, betwixt the earth and the heavens. True, they +could not tell what would be the issue of things as to them; but all +things were done in such excellent methods, and I cannot tell how, but +things in the management of them seemed to cast a smile towards the +town, so that their eyes, their heads, their hearts, and their minds, +and all that they had, were taken and held while they observed Emmanuel’s +order.<br> +<br> +So, when the brave Prince had finished this part of his triumph over +Diabolus his foe, he turned him up in the midst of his contempt and +shame, having given him a charge no more to be a possessor of Mansoul. +Then went he from Emmanuel, and out of the midst of his camp, to inherit +the parched places in a salt land, seeking rest, but finding none.<br> +<br> +Now, Captain Boanerges and Captain Conviction were, both of them, men +of very great majesty; their faces were like the faces of lions, and +their words like the roaring of the sea; and they still quartered in +Mr. Conscience’s house, of whom mention was made before. +When, therefore, the high and mighty Prince had thus far finished his +triumph over Diabolus, the townsmen had more leisure to view and to +behold the actions of these noble captains. But the captains carried +it with that terror and dread in all that they did, (and you may be +sure that they had private instructions so to do,) that they kept the +town under continual heart-aching, and caused (in their apprehension) +the well-being of Mansoul for the future to hang in doubt before them, +so that for some considerable time they neither knew what rest, or ease, +or peace, or hope meant.<br> +<br> +Nor did the Prince himself as yet abide in the town of Mansoul, but +in his royal pavilion in the camp, and in the midst of his Father’s +forces. So, at a time convenient, he sent special orders to Captain +Boanerges to summons Mansoul, the whole of the townsmen, into the castle-yard, +and then and there, before their faces, to take my Lord Understanding, +Mr. Conscience, and that notable one, the Lord Willbewill, and put them +all three in ward, and that they should set a strong guard upon them +there, until his pleasure concerning them was further known: the which +orders, when the captains had put them in execution, made no small addition +to the fears of the town of Mansoul; for now, to their thinking, were +their former fears of the ruin of Mansoul confirmed. Now, what +death they should die, and how long they should be in dying, was that +which most perplexed their heads and hearts; yea, they were afraid that +Emmanuel would command them all into the deep, the place that the prince +Diabolus was afraid of, for they knew that they had deserved it. +Also to die by the sword in the face of the town, and in the open way +of disgrace, from the hand of so good and so holy a prince, that, too, +troubled them sore. The town was also greatly troubled for the +men that were committed to ward, for that they were their stay and their +guide, and for that they believed that, if those men were cut off, their +execution would be but the beginning of the ruin of the town of Mansoul. +Wherefore, what do they, but, together with the men in prison, draw +up a petition to the Prince, and sent it to Emmanuel by the hand of +Mr. Would-live. So he went, and came to the Prince’s quarters, +and presented the petition, the sum of which was this:<br> +<br> +‘Great and wonderful Potentate, victor over Diabolus, and conqueror +of the town of Mansoul, We, the miserable inhabitants of that most woful +corporation, do humbly beg that we may find favour in thy sight, and +remember not against us former transgressions, nor yet the sins of the +chief of our town: but spare us according to the greatness of thy mercy, +and let us not die, but live in thy sight. So shall we be willing +to be thy servants, and, if thou shalt think fit, to gather our meat +under thy table. Amen.’<br> +<br> +So the petitioner went, as was said, with his petition to the Prince; +and the Prince took it at his hand, but sent him away with silence. +This still afflicted the town of Mansoul; but yet, considering that +now they must either petition or die, for now they could not do anything +else, therefore they consulted again, and sent another petition; and +this petition was much after the form and method of the former.<br> +<br> +But when the petition was drawn up, By whom should they send it? was +the next question; for they would not send this by him by whom they +sent the first, for they thought that the Prince had taken some offence +at the manner of his deportment before him: so they attempted to make +Captain Conviction their messenger with it; but he said that he neither +durst nor would petition Emmanuel for traitors, nor be to the Prince +an advocate for rebels. ‘Yet withal,’ said he, ‘our +Prince is good, and you may adventure to send it by the hand of one +of your town, provided he went with a rope about his head, and pleaded +nothing but mercy.’<br> +<br> +Well, they made, through fear, their delays as long as they could, and +longer than delays were good; but fearing at last the dangerousness +of them, they thought, but with many a fainting in their minds, to send +their petition by Mr. Desires-awake; so they sent for Mr. Desires-awake. +Now he dwelt in a very mean cottage in Mansoul, and he came at his neighbour’s +request. So they told him what they had done, and what they would +do, concerning petitioning, and that they did desire of him that he +would go therewith to the Prince.<br> +<br> +Then said Mr. Desires-awake, ‘Why should not I do the best I can +to save so famous a town as Mansoul from deserved destruction?’ +They therefore delivered the petition to him, and told him how he must +address himself to the Prince, and wished him ten thousand good speeds. +So he comes to the Prince’s pavilion, as the first, and asked +to speak with his Majesty. So word was carried to Emmanuel, and +the Prince came out to the man. When Mr. Desires-awake saw the +Prince, he fell flat with his face to the ground, and cried out, ‘Oh +that Mansoul might live before thee!’ and with that he presented +the petition; the which when the Prince had read, he turned away for +a while and wept; but refraining himself, he turned again to the man, +who all this while lay crying at his feet, as at the first, and said +to him, ‘Go thy way to thy place, and I will consider of thy requests.’<br> +<br> +Now, you may think that they of Mansoul that had sent him, what with +guilt, and what with fear lest their petition should be rejected, could +not but look with many a long look, and that, too, with strange workings +of heart, to see what would become of their petition. At last +they saw their messenger coming back. So, when he was come, they +asked him how he fared, what Emmanuel said, and what was become of the +petition. But he told them that he would be silent till he came +to the prison to my Lord Mayor, my Lord Willbewill, and Mr. Recorder. +So he went forwards towards the prison-house, where the men of Mansoul +lay bound. But, oh! what a multitude flocked after, to hear what +the messenger said. So, when he was come, and had shown himself +at the gate of the prison, my Lord Mayor himself looked as white as +a clout; the Recorder also did quake. But they asked and said, +‘Come, good sir, what did the great Prince say to you?’ +Then said Mr. Desires-awake, ‘When I came to my Lord’s pavilion, +I called, and he came forth. So I fell prostrate at his feet, +and delivered to him my petition; for the greatness of his person, and +the glory of his countenance, would not suffer me to stand upon my legs. +Now, as he received the petition, I cried, “Oh that Mansoul might +live before thee!” So, when for a while he had looked thereon, +he turned him about, and said to his servant, “Go thy way to thy +place again, and I will consider of thy requests.”’ +The messenger added, moreover, and said, ‘The Prince to whom you +sent me is such a one for beauty and glory, that whoso sees him must +both love and fear him. I, for my part, can do no less; but I +know not what will be the end of these things.’<br> +<br> +At this answer they were all at a stand, both they in prison, and they +that followed the messenger thither to hear the news; nor knew they +what, or what manner of interpretation to put upon what the Prince had +said. Now, when the prison was cleared of the throng, the prisoners +among themselves began to comment upon Emmanuel’s words. +My Lord Mayor said, that the answer did not look with a rugged face; +but Willbewill said that it betokened evil; and the Recorder, that it +was a messenger of death. Now, they that were left, and that stood +behind, and so could not so well hear what the prisoners said, some +of them catched hold of one piece of a sentence, and some on a bit of +another; some took hold of what the messenger said, and some of the +prisoners’ judgment thereon; so none had the right understanding +of things. But you cannot imagine what work these people made, +and what a confusion there was in Mansoul now.<br> +<br> +For presently they that had heard what was said flew about the town, +one crying one thing, and another the quite contrary; and both were +sure enough they told true; for they did hear, they said, with their +ears what was said, and therefore could not be deceived. One would +say, ‘We must all be killed;’ another would say, ‘We +must all be saved;’ and a third would say that the Prince would +not be concerned with Mansoul; and a fourth, that the prisoners must +be suddenly put to death. And, as I said, every one stood to it +that he told his tale the rightest, and that all others but he were +out. Wherefore Mansoul had now molestation upon molestation, nor +could any man know on what to rest the sole of his foot; for one would +go by now, and as he went, if he heard his neighbour tell his tale, +to be sure he would tell the quite contrary, and both would stand in +it that he told the truth. Nay, some of them had got this story +by the end, that the Prince did intend to put Mansoul to the sword. +And now it began to be dark, wherefore poor Mansoul was in sad perplexity +all that night until the morning.<br> +<br> +But, so far as I could gather by the best information that I could get, +all this hubbub came through the words that the Recorder said when he +told them that, in his judgment, the Prince’s answer was a messenger +of death. It was this that fired the town, and that began the +fright in Mansoul; for Mansoul in former times did use to count that +Mr. Recorder was a seer, and that his sentence was equal to the best +of orators; and thus was Mansoul a terror to itself.<br> +<br> +And now did they begin to feel what were the effects of stubborn rebellion, +and unlawful resistance against their Prince. I say, they now +began to feel the effects thereof by guilt and fear, that now had swallowed +them up; and who more involved in the one but they that were most in +the other, to wit, the chief of the town of Mansoul?<br> +<br> +To be brief: when the fame of the fright was out of the town, and the +prisoners had a little recovered themselves, they take to themselves +some heart, and think to petition the Prince for life again. So +they did draw up a third petition, the contents whereof were these:-<br> +<br> +‘Prince Emmanuel the Great, Lord of all worlds, and Master of +mercy, we, thy poor, wretched, miserable, dying town of Mansoul, do +confess unto thy great and glorious Majesty that we have sinned against +thy Father and thee, and are no more worthy to be called thy Mansoul, +but rather to be cast into the pit. If thou wilt slay us, we have +deserved it. If thou wilt condemn us to the deep, we cannot but +say thou art righteous. We cannot complain whatever thou dost, +or however thou carriest it towards us. But, oh! let mercy reign, +and let it be extended to us! Oh! let mercy take hold upon us, +and free us from our transgressions, and we will sing of thy mercy and +of thy judgment. Amen.’<br> +<br> +This petition, when drawn up, was designed to be sent to the Prince +as the first. But who should carry it? - that was the question. +Some said, ‘Let him do it that went with the first,’ but +others thought not good to do that, and that because he sped no better. +Now, there was an old man in the town, and his name was Mr. Good-Deed; +a man that bare only the name, but had nothing of the nature of the +thing. Now, some were for sending him; but the Recorder was by +no means for that. ‘For,’ said he, ‘we now stand +in need of, and are pleading for mercy: wherefore, to send our petition +by a man of this name, will seem to cross the petition itself. +Should we make Mr. Good-Deed our messenger, when our petition cries +for mercy?<br> +<br> +‘Besides,’ quoth the old gentleman, ‘should the Prince +now, as he receives the petition, ask him, and say, “What is thy +name?” as nobody knows but he will, and he should say, “Old +Good-Deed,” what, think you, would Emmanuel say but this? +“Ay! is old Good-Deed yet alive in Mansoul? then let old Good-Deed +save you from your distresses.” And if he says so, I am +sure we are lost; nor can a thousand of old Good-Deeds save Mansoul.’<br> +<br> +After the Recorder had given in his reasons why old Good-Deed should +not go with this petition to Emmanuel, the rest of the prisoners and +chief of Mansoul opposed it also, and so old Good-Deed was laid aside, +and they agreed to send Mr. Desires-awake again. So they sent +for him, and desired him that he would a second time go with their petition +to the Prince, and he readily told them he would. But they bid +him that in anywise he should take heed that in no word or carriage +he gave offence to the Prince; ‘For by doing so, for ought we +can tell, you may bring Mansoul into utter destruction,’ said +they.<br> +<br> +Now Mr. Desires-awake, when he saw that he must go on this errand, besought +that they would grant that Mr. Wet-Eyes might go with him. Now +this Mr. Wet-Eyes was a near neighbour of Mr. Desires, a poor man, a +man of a broken spirit, yet one that could speak well to a petition; +so they granted that he should go with him. Wherefore, they address +themselves to their business: Mr. Desires put a rope upon his head, +and Mr. Wet-Eyes went with his hands wringing together. Thus they +went to the Prince’s pavilion.<br> +<br> +Now, when they went to petition this third time, they were not without +thoughts that, by often coming, they might be a burden to the Prince. +Wherefore, when they were come to the door of his pavilion, they first +made their apology for themselves, and for their coming to trouble Emmanuel +so often; and they said, that they came not hither to-day for that they +delighted in being troublesome, or for that they delighted to hear themselves +talk, but for that necessity caused them to come to his Majesty. +They could, they said, have no rest day nor night because of their transgressions +against Shaddai and against Emmanuel, his Son. They also thought +that some misbehaviour of Mr. Desires-awake the last time might give +distaste to his Highness, and so cause that he returned from so merciful +a Prince empty, and without countenance. So, when they had made +this apology, Mr. Desires-awake cast himself prostrate upon the ground, +as at the first, at the feet of the mighty Prince, saying, ‘Oh! +that Mansoul might live before thee!’ and so he delivered his +petition. The Prince then, having read the petition, turned aside +awhile as before, and coming again to the place where the petitioner +lay on the ground, he demanded what his name was, and of what esteem +in the account of Mansoul, for that he, above all the multitude in Mansoul, +should be sent to him upon such an errand. Then said the man to +the Prince, ‘Oh let not my Lord be angry; and why inquirest thou +after the name of such a dead do - as I am? Pass by, I pray thee, +and take not notice of who I am, because there is, as thou very well +knowest, so great a disproportion between me and thee. Why the +townsmen chose to send me on this errand to my Lord is best known to +themselves, but it could not be for that they thought that I had favour +with my Lord. For my part, I am out of charity with myself; who, +then, should be in love with me? Yet live I would, and so would +I that my townsmen should; and because both they and myself are guilty +of great transgressions, therefore they have sent me, and I am come +in their names to beg of my Lord for mercy. Let it please thee, +therefore, to incline to mercy; but ask not what thy servants are.’<br> +<br> +Then said the Prince, ‘And what is he that is become thy companion +in this so weighty a matter?’ So Mr. Desires told Emmanuel +that he was a poor neighbour of his, and one of his most intimate associates. +‘And his name,’ said he, ‘may it please your most +excellent Majesty, is Wet-Eyes, of the town of Mansoul, I know that +there are many of that name that are naught; but I hope it will be no +offence to my Lord that I have brought my poor neighbour with me.’<br> +<br> +Then Mr. Wet-Eyes fell on his face to the ground, and made this apology +for his coming with his neighbour to his Lord:-<br> +<br> +‘O, my Lord,’ quoth he, ‘what I am I know not myself, +nor whether my name be feigned or true, especially when I begin to think +what some have said, namely, That this name was given me because Mr. +Repentance was my father. Good men have bad children, and the +sincere do oftentimes beget hypocrites. My mother also called +me by this name from the cradle; but whether because of the moistness +of my brain, or because of the softness of my heart, I cannot tell. +I see dirt in mine own tears, and filthiness in the bottom of my prayers. +But I pray thee (and all this while the gentleman wept) that thou wouldest +not remember against us our transgressions, nor take offence at the +unqualifiedness of thy servants, but mercifully pass by the sin of Mansoul, +and refrain from the glorifying of thy grace no longer.’<br> +<br> +So at his bidding they arose, and both stood trembling before him, and +he spake to them to this purpose:-<br> +<br> +“The town of Mansoul hath grievously rebelled against my Father, +in that they have rejected him from being their King, and did choose +to themselves for their captain a liar, a murderer, and a runagate slave. +For this Diabolus, your pretended prince, though once so highly accounted +of by you, made rebellion against my Father and me, even in our palace +and highest court there, thinking to become a prince and king. +But being there timely discovered and apprehended, and for his wickedness +bound in chains, and separated to the pit with those that were his companions, +he offered himself to you, and you have received him.<br> +<br> +‘Now this is, and for a long time hath been, a high affront to +my Father; wherefore my Father sent to you a powerful army to reduce +you to your obedience. But you know how these men, their captains +and their counsels, were esteemed of you, and what they received at +your hand. You rebelled against them, you shut your gates upon +them, you bid them battle, you fought them, and fought for Diabolus +against them. So they sent to my Father for more power, and I, +with my men, are come to subdue you. But as you treated the servants, +so you treated their Lord. You stood up in hostile manner against +me, you shut up your gates against me, you turned the deaf ear to me, +and resisted as long as you could; but now I have made a conquest of +you. Did you cry me mercy so long as you had hopes that you might +prevail against me? But now I have taken the town, you cry; but +why did you not cry before, when the white flag of my mercy, the red +flag of justice, and the black flag that threatened execution, were +set up to cite you to it? Now I have conquered your Diabolus, +you come to me for favour; but why did you not help me against the mighty? +Yet I will consider your petition, and will answer it so as will be +for my glory.<br> +<br> +‘Go, bid Captain Boanerges and Captain Conviction bring the prisoners +out to me into the camp to-morrow, and say you to Captain Judgment and +Captain Execution, “Stay you in the castle, and take good heed +to yourselves that you keep all quiet in Mansoul until you shall hear +further from me.”’ And with that he turned himself +from them, and went into his royal pavilion again.<br> +<br> +So the petitioners, having received this answer from the Prince, returned, +as at the first, to go to their companions again. But they had +not gone far, but thoughts began to work in their minds that no mercy +as yet was intended by the Prince to Mansoul. So they went to +the place where the prisoners lay bound; but these workings of mind +about what would become of Mansoul had such strong power over them, +that by that they were come unto them that sent them, they were scarce +able to deliver their message.<br> +<br> +But they came at length to the gates of the town, (now the townsmen +with earnestness were waiting for their return,) where many met them, +to know what answer was made to the petition. Then they cried +out to those that were sent, ‘What news from the Prince? and what +hath Emmanuel said?’ But they said that they must, as afore, +go up to the prison, and there deliver their message. So away +they went to the prison, with a multitude at their heels. Now, +when they were come to the gates of the prison, they told the first +part of Emmanuel’s speech to the prisoners, to wit, how he reflected +upon their disloyalty to his Father and himself, and how they had chosen +and closed with Diabolus, had fought for him, hearkened to him, and +been ruled by him; but had despised him and his men. This made +the prisoners look pale; but the messengers proceeded and said, ‘He, +the Prince, said, moreover, that yet he would consider your petition, +and give such answer thereto as would stand with his glory.’ +And as these words were spoken, Mr. Wet-Eyes gave a great sigh. +At this they were all of them struck into their dumps, and could not +tell what to say: fear also possessed them in a marvellous manner, and +death seemed to sit upon some of their eyebrows. Now, there was +in the company a notable, sharp-witted fellow, a mean man of estate, +and his name was old Inquisitive. This man asked the petitioners +if they had told out every whit of what Emmanuel said, and they answered, +‘Verily, no.’ Then said Inquisitive, ‘I thought +so, indeed. Pray, what was it more that he said unto you?’ +Then they paused awhile; but at last they brought out all, saying, ‘The +Prince bade us bid Captain Boanerges and Captain Conviction bring the +prisoners down to him to-morrow; and that Captain Judgment and Captain +Execution should take charge of the castle and town till they should +hear further from him. They said also that when the Prince had +commanded them thus to do, he immediately turned his back upon them, +and went into his royal pavilion.<br> +<br> +But, oh! how this return, and specially this last clause of it, that +the prisoners must go out to the Prince into the camp, brake all their +loins in pieces! Wherefore, with one voice they set up a cry that +reached up to the heavens. This done, each of the three prepared +himself to die; (and the Recorder said unto them, ‘This was the +thing that I feared;’) for they concluded that to-morrow, by that +the sun went down, they should be tumbled out of the world. The +whole town also counted of no other, but that, in their time and order, +they must all drink of the same cup. Wherefore the town of Mansoul +spent that night in mourning, and sackcloth and ashes. The prisoners +also, when the time was come for them to go down before the Prince, +dressed themselves in mourning attire, with ropes upon their heads. +The whole town of Mansoul also showed themselves upon the wall, all +clad in mourning weeds, if, perhaps, the Prince with the sight thereof +might be moved with compassion. But, oh! how the busy-bodies that +were in the town of Mansoul did now concern themselves! They did +run here and there through the streets of the town by companies, crying +out as they ran in tumultuous wise, one after one manner, and another +the quite contrary, to the almost utter distraction of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +Well, the time is come that the prisoners must go down to the camp, +and appear before the Prince. And thus was the manner of their +going down: Captain Boanerges went with a guard before them, and Captain +Conviction came behind, and the prisoners went down, bound in chains, +in the midst. So I say, the prisoners went in the midst, and the +guard went with flying colours behind and before, but the prisoners +went with drooping spirits.<br> +<br> +Or, more particularly, thus: The prisoners went down all in mourning: +they put ropes upon themselves; they went on, smiting themselves on +the breasts, but durst not lift up their eyes to heaven. Thus +they went out at the gate of Mansoul, till they came into the midst +of the Prince’s army, the sight and glory of which did greatly +heighten their affliction. Nor could they now longer forbear, +but cry out aloud, ‘O unhappy men! O wretched men of Mansoul!’ +Their chains, still mixing their dolorous notes with the cries of the +prisoners, made the noise more lamentable.<br> +<br> +So, when they were come to the door of the Prince’s pavilion, +they cast themselves prostrate upon the place; then one went in and +told his Lord that the prisoners were come down. The Prince then +ascended a throne of state, and sent for the prisoners in; who, when +they came, did tremble before him, also they covered their faces with +shame. Now, as they drew near to the place where he sat, they +threw themselves down before him. Then said the Prince to the +Captain Boanerges, ‘Bid the prisoners stand upon their feet.’ +Then they stood trembling before him, and he said, ‘Are you the +men that heretofore were the servants of Shaddai?’ And they +said, ‘Yes, Lord, yes.’ Then said the Prince again, +‘Are you the men that did suffer yourselves to be corrupted and +defiled by that abominable one, Diabolus?’ And they said, +‘We did more than suffer it, Lord; for we chose it of our own +mind.’ The Prince asked further, saying, ‘Could you +have been content that your slavery should have continued under his +tyranny as long as you had lived?’ Then said the prisoners, +‘Yes, Lord, yes; for his ways were pleasing to our flesh, and +we were grown aliens to a better state.’ - ‘And did you,’ +said he, ‘when I came up against this town of Mansoul, heartily +wish that I might not have the victory over you?’ - ‘Yes, +Lord, yes,’ said they. Then said the Prince, ‘And +what punishment is it, think you, that you deserve at my hand, for these +and other your high and mighty sins?’ - And they said, ‘Both +death and the deep, Lord; for we have deserved no less.’ +He asked again if they had aught to say for themselves why the sentence, +that they confessed that they had deserved, should not be passed upon +them? And they said, ‘We can say nothing, Lord: thou art +just, for we have sinned.’ Then said the Prince, ‘And +for what are those ropes on your heads?’ The prisoners answered, +‘These ropes are to bind us withal to the place of execution, +if mercy be not pleasing in thy sight.’ So he further asked +if all the men in the town of Mansoul were in this confession, as they? +And they answered, ‘All the natives, Lord; but for the Diabolonians +that came into our town when the tyrant got possession of us, we can +say nothing for them.’<br> +<br> +Then the Prince commanded that a herald should be called, and that he +should, in the midst and throughout the camp of Emmanuel, proclaim, +and that with sound of trumpet, that the Prince, the Son of Shaddai, +had, in his Father’s name, and for his Father’s glory, gotten +a perfect conquest and victory over Mansoul; and that the prisoners +should follow him, and say Amen. So, this was done as he had commanded. +And presently the music that was in the upper region sounded melodiously, +the captains that were in the camp shouted, and the soldiers did sing +songs of triumph to the Prince; the colours waved in the wind, and great +joy was everywhere, only it was wanting as yet in the hearts of the +men of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +Then the Prince called for the prisoners to come and to stand again +before him, and they came and stood trembling. And he said unto +them, ‘The sins, trespasses, iniquities, that you, with the whole +town of Mansoul, have from time to time committed against my Father +and me, I have power and commandment from my Father to forgive to the +town of Mansoul, and do forgive you accordingly.’ And having +so said, he gave them, written in parchment, and sealed with seven seals, +a large and general pardon, commanding my Lord Mayor, my Lord Willbewill, +and Mr. Recorder, to proclaim and cause it to be proclaimed to-morrow, +by that the sun is up, throughout the whole town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +Moreover, the Prince stripped the prisoners of their mourning weeds, +and gave them beauty for ashes, the oil of joy for mourning, and the +garment of praise for the spirit of heaviness.<br> +<br> +Then he gave to each of the three jewels of gold and precious stones, +and took away their ropes, and put chains of gold about their necks, +and ear-rings in their ears. Now, the prisoners, when they did +hear the gracious words of Prince Emmanuel, and had beheld all that +was done unto them, fainted almost quite away; for the grace, the benefit, +the pardon, was sudden, glorious, and so big, that they were not able, +without staggering, to stand up under it. Yea, my Lord Willbewill +swooned outright; but the Prince stepped to him, put his everlasting +arms under him, embraced him, kissed him, and bid him be of good cheer, +for all should be performed according to his word. He also did +kiss, and embrace, and smile upon the other two that were Willbewill’s +companions, saying, ‘Take these as further tokens of my love, +favour, and compassions to you; and I charge you that you, Mr. Recorder, +tell in the town of Mansoul what you have heard and seen.’<br> +<br> +Then were their fetters broken to pieces before their faces, and cast +into the air, and their steps were enlarged under them. Then they +fell down at the feet of the Prince, and kissed his feet, and wetted +them with tears: also they cried out with a mighty strong voice, saying, +‘Blessed be the glory of the Lord from this place.’ +So they were bid rise up, and go to the town, and tell to Mansoul what +the Prince had done. He commanded also that one with a pipe and +tabor should go and play before them all the way into the town of Mansoul. +Then was fulfilled what they never looked for, and they were made to +possess that which they never dreamed of.<br> +<br> +The Prince also called for the noble Captain Credence, and commanded +that he and some of his officers should march before the noble men of +Mansoul with flying colours into the town. He gave also unto Captain +Credence a charge, that about that time that the Recorder did read the +general pardon in the town of Mansoul, that at that very time he should +with flying colours march in at Eye-gate with his ten thousands at his +feet and that he should so go until he came by the high street of the +town, up to the castle gates, and that himself should take possession +thereof against his Lord came thither. He commanded, moreover, +that he should bid Captain Judgment and Captain Execution to leave the +stronghold to him, and to withdraw from Mansoul, and to return into +the camp with speed unto the Prince.<br> +<br> +And now was the town of Mansoul also delivered from the terror of the +first four captains and their men.<br> +<br> +Well, I told you before how the prisoners were entertained by the noble +Prince Emmanuel, and how they behaved themselves before him, and how +he sent them away to their home with pipe and tabor going before them. +And now you must think that those of the town that had all this while +waited to hear of their death, could not but be exercised with sadness +of mind, and with thoughts that pricked like thorns. Nor could +their thoughts be kept to any one point; the wind blew with them all +this while at great uncertainties; yea, their hearts were like a balance +that had been disquieted with a shaking hand. But at last, as +they with many a long look looked over the wall of Mansoul, they thought +that they saw some returning to the town; and thought again, Who should +they be, too? Who should they be? At last they discerned +that they were the prisoners: but can you imagine how their hearts were +surprised with wonder, specially when they perceived also in what equipage +and with what honour they were sent home. They went down to the +camp in black, but they came back to the town in white; they went down +to the camp in ropes, they came back in chains of gold; they went down +to the camp with their feet in fetters, but came back with their steps +enlarged under them; they went also to the camp looking for death, but +they came back from thence with assurance of life; they went down to +the camp with heavy hearts, but came back again with pipe and tabor +playing before them. So as soon as they were come to Eye-gate, +the poor and tottering town of Mansoul adventured to give a shout; and +they gave such a shout as made the captains in the Prince’s army +leap at the sound thereof. Alas! for them, poor hearts! who could +blame them? since their dead friends were come to life again; for it +was to them as life from the dead to see the ancients of the town of +Mansoul shine in such splendour. They looked for nothing but the +axe and the block; but, behold, joy and gladness, comfort and consolation, +and such melodious notes attending them that was sufficient to make +a sick man well.<br> +<br> +So, when they came up, they saluted each other with, ‘Welcome, +welcome! and blessed be he that has spared you!’ They added +also, ‘We see it is well with you; but how must it go with the +town of Mansoul? And will it go well with the town of Mansoul?’ +said they. Then answered them the Recorder and my Lord Mayor, +‘Oh! tidings! glad tidings! good tidings of good, and of great +joy to poor Mansoul!’ Then they gave another shout, that +made the earth to ring again. After this, they inquired yet more +particularly how things went in the camp, and what message they had +from Emmanuel to the town. So they told them all passages that +had happened to them at the camp, and everything that the Prince did +to them. This made Mansoul wonder at the wisdom and grace of the +Prince Emmanuel. Then they told them what they had received at +his hands for the whole town of Mansoul, and the Recorder delivered +it in these words: ‘ PARDON, PARDON, PARDON for Mansoul! and this +shall Mansoul know to-morrow!’ Then he commanded, and they +went and summoned Mansoul to meet together in the market-place to-morrow, +then to hear their general pardon read.<br> +<br> +But who can think what a turn, what a change, what an alteration this +hint of things did make in the countenance of the town of Mansoul! +No man of Mansoul could sleep that night for joy; in every house there +was joy and music, singing and making merry: telling and hearing of +Mansoul’s happiness was then all that Mansoul had to do; and this +was the burden of all their song: ‘Oh! more of this at the rising +of the sun! more of this to-morrow!’ ‘Who thought +yesterday,’ would one say, ‘that this day would have been +such a day to us? And who thought, that saw our prisoners go down +in irons, that they would have returned in chains of gold? Yea, +they that judged themselves as they went to be judged of their judge, +were by his mouth acquitted, not for that they were innocent, but of +the Prince’s mercy, and sent home with pipe and tabor. But +is this the common custom of princes? Do they use to show such kind +of favours to traitors? No; this is only peculiar to Shaddai, +and unto Emmanuel, his Son!’<br> +<br> +Now morning drew on apace; wherefore the Lord Mayor, the Lord Willbewill, +and Mr. Recorder came down to the market-place at the time that the +Prince had appointed, where the townsfolk were waiting for them: and +when they came, they came in that attire, and in that glory that the +Prince had put them into the day before, and the street was lightened +with their glory. So the Mayor, Recorder, and my Lord Willbewill +drew down to Mouth-gate, which was at the lower end of the market-place, +because that of old time was the place where they used to read public +matters. Thither, therefore, they came in their robes, and their +tabrets went before them. Now, the eagerness of the people to +know the full of the matter was great.<br> +<br> +Then the Recorder stood up upon his feet, and, first beckoning with +his hand for silence, he read out with a loud voice the pardon. +But when he came to these words: ‘The Lord, the Lord God, merciful +and gracious, pardoning iniquity, transgressions, and sins, and to them +all manner of sin and blasphemy shall be forgiven,’ etc., they +could not forbear leaping for joy. For this you must know, that +there was conjoined herewith every man’s name in Mansoul; also +the seals of the pardon made a brave show.<br> +<br> +When the Recorder had made an end of reading the pardon, the townsmen +ran up upon the walls of the town, and leaped and skipped thereon for +joy, and bowed themselves seven times with their faces toward Emmanuel’s +pavilion, and shouted out aloud for joy, and said, ‘Let Emmanuel +live for ever!’ Then order was given to the young men in +Mansoul that they should ring the bells for joy. So the bells +did ring, and the people sing, and the music go in every house in Mansoul.<br> +<br> +When the Prince had sent home the three prisoners of Mansoul with joy, +and pipe and tabor, he commanded his captains, with all the field officers +and soldiers throughout his army, to be ready in that morning, that +the Recorder should read the pardon in Mansoul, to do his further pleasure. +So the morning, as I have showed, being come, just as the Recorder had +made an end of reading the pardon, Emmanuel commanded that all the trumpets +in the camp should sound, that the colours should be displayed, half +of them upon Mount Gracious, and half of them upon Mount Justice. +He commanded also that all the captains should show themselves in all +their harness, and that the soldiers should shout for joy. Nor +was Captain Credence, though in the castle, silent in such a day; but +he, from the top of the hold, showed himself with sound of trumpet to +Mansoul and to the Prince’s camp.<br> +<br> +Thus have I showed you the manner and way that Emmanuel took to recover +the town of Mansoul from under the hand and power of the tyrant Diabolus.<br> +<br> +Now, when the Prince had completed these, the outward ceremonies of +his joy, he again commanded that his captains and soldiers should show +unto Mansoul some feats of war: so they presently addressed themselves +to this work. But oh! with what agility, nimbleness, dexterity, +and bravery did these military men discover their skill in feats of +war to the now gazing town of Mansoul!<br> +<br> +They marched, they counter-marched; they opened to the right and left; +they divided and subdivided; they closed, they wheeled, made good their +front and rear with their right and left wings, and twenty things more, +with that aptness, and then were all as the were again, that they took +- yea, ravished, the hearts that were in Mansoul to behold it. +But add to this, the handling of their arms, the managing of their weapons +of war, were marvellously taking to Mansoul and me.<br> +<br> +When this action was over, the whole town of Mansoul came out as one +man to the Prince in the camp to thank him, and praise him for his abundant +favour, and to beg that it would please his grace to come unto Mansoul +with his men, and there to take up their quarters for ever: and this +they did in most humble manner, bowing themselves seven times to the +ground before him. Then said he, ‘All peace be to you.’ +So the town came nigh, and touched with the hand the top of his golden +sceptre; and they said, ‘Oh! that the Prince Emmanuel, with his +captains and men of war, would dwell in Mansoul for ever; and that his +battering-rams and slings might be lodged in her for the use and service +of the Prince, and for the help and strength of Mansoul. For,’ +said they, ‘we have room for thee, we have room for thy men, we +have also room for thy weapons of war, and a place to make a magazine +for thy carriages. Do it, Emmanuel, and thou shalt be King and +Captain in Mansoul for ever. Yea, govern thou also according to +all the desire of thy soul, and make thou governors and princes under +thee of thy captains and men of war, and we will become thy servants, +and thy laws shall be our direction.’<br> +<br> +They added, moreover, and prayed his Majesty to consider thereof; ‘for,’ +said they, ‘if now, after all this grace bestowed upon us, thy +miserable town of Mansoul, thou shouldest withdraw, thou and thy captains, +from us, the town of Mansoul will die. Yea,’ said they, +‘our blessed Emmanuel, if thou shouldest depart from us now, now +thou hast done so much good for us, and showed so much mercy unto us, +what will follow but that our joy will be as if it had not been, and +our enemies will a second time come upon us with more rage than at the +first? Wherefore, we beseech thee, O thou, the desire of our eyes, +and the strength and life of our poor town, accept of this motion that +now we have made unto our Lord, and come and dwell in the midst of us, +and let us be thy people. Besides, Lord, we do not know but that +to this day many Diabolonians may be yet lurking in the town of Mansoul, +and they will betray us, when thou shalt leave us, into the hand of +Diabolus again; and who knows what designs, plots, or contrivances have +passed betwixt them about these things already? Loath we are to +fall again into his horrible hands. Wherefore, let it please thee +to accept of our palace for thy place of residence, and of the houses +of the best men in our town for the reception of thy soldiers and their +furniture.’<br> +<br> +Then said the Prince, ‘If I come to your town, will you suffer +me further to prosecute that which is in mine heart against mine enemies +and yours? - yea, will you help me in such undertakings?’<br> +<br> +They answered, ‘We know not what we shall do; we did not think +once that we should have been such traitors to Shaddai as we have proved +to be. What, then, shall we say to our Lord? Let him put +no trust in his saints; let the Prince dwell in our castle, and make +of our town a garrison; let him set his noble captains and his warlike +soldiers over us; yea, let him conquer us with his love, and overcome +us with his grace, and then surely shall he be but with us, and help +us, as he was and did that morning that our pardon was read unto us. +We shall comply with this our Lord, and with his ways, and fall in with +his word against the mighty.<br> +<br> +‘One word more, and thy servants have done, and in this will trouble +our Lord no more. We know not the depth of the wisdom of thee, +our Prince. Who could have thought, that had been ruled by his +reason, that so much sweet as we do now enjoy should have come out of +those bitter trials wherewith we were tried at the first! But, +Lord, let light go before, and let love come after: yea, take us by +the hand, and lead us by thy counsels, and let this always abide upon +us, that all things shall be the best for thy servants, and come to +our Mansoul, and do as it pleaseth thee. Or, Lord, come to our +Mansoul, do what thou wilt, so thou keepest us from sinning, and makest +us serviceable to thy Majesty.’<br> +<br> +Then said the Prince to the town of Mansoul again, ‘Go, return +to your houses in peace. I will willingly in this comply with +your desires; I will remove my royal pavilion, I will draw up my forces +before Eye-gate to-morrow, and so will march forwards into the town +of Mansoul. I will possess myself of your castle of Mansoul, and +will set my soldiers over you: yea, I will yet do things in Mansoul +that cannot be paralleled in any nation, country, or kingdom under heaven.’ +Then did the men of Mansoul give a shout, and returned unto their houses +in peace; they also told to their kindred and friends the good that +Emmanuel had promised to Mansoul. ‘And to-morrow,’ +said they, ‘he will march into our town, and take up his dwelling, +he and his men, in Mansoul.’<br> +<br> +Then went out the inhabitants of the town of Mansoul with haste to the +green trees and to the meadows, to gather boughs and flowers, therewith +to strew the streets against their Prince, the Son of Shaddai, should +come; they also made garlands and other fine works to betoken how joyful +they were, and should be to receive their Emmanuel into Mansoul; yea, +they strewed the street quite from Eye-gate to the castle-gate, the +place where the Prince should be. They also prepared for his coming +what music the town of Mansoul would afford, that they might play before +him to the palace, his habitation.<br> +<br> +So, at the time appointed he makes his approach to Mansoul, and the +gates were set open for him; there also the ancients and elders of Mansoul +met him to salute him with a thousand welcomes. Then he arose +and entered Mansoul, he and all his servants. The elders of Mansoul +did also go dancing before him till he came to the castle gates. +And this was the manner of his going up thither:- He was clad in his +golden armour, he rode in his royal chariot, the trumpets sounded about +him, the colours were displayed, his ten thousands went up at his feet, +and the elders of Mansoul danced before him. And now were the +walls of the famous town of Mansoul filled with the tramplings of the +inhabitants thereof, who went up thither to view the approach of the +blessed Prince and his royal army. Also the casements, windows, +balconies, and tops of the houses, were all now filled with persons +of all sorts, to behold how their town was to be filled with good.<br> +<br> +Now, when he was come so far into the town as to the Recorder’s +house, he commanded that one should go to Captain Credence, to know +whether the castle of Mansoul was prepared to entertain his royal presence +(for the preparation of that was left to that captain), and word was +brought that it was. Then was Captain Credence commanded also +to come forth with his power to meet the Prince, the which was, as he +had commanded, done; and he conducted him into the castle. This +done, the Prince that night did lodge in the castle with his mighty +captains and men of war, to the joy of the town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +Now, the next care of the townsfolk was, how the captains and soldiers +of the Prince’s army should be quartered among them; and the care +was not how they should shut their hands of them, but how they should +fill their houses with them; for every man in Mansoul now had that esteem +of Emmanuel and his men that nothing grieved them more than because +they were not enlarged enough, every one of them to receive the whole +army of the Prince; yea, they counted it their glory to be waiting upon +them, and would, in those days, run at their bidding like lackeys.<br> +<br> +At last they came to this result:-<br> +<br> +1. That Captain Innocency should quarter at Mr. Reason’s.<br> +<br> +2. That Captain Patience should quarter at Mr. Mind’s. This +Mr. Mind was formerly the Lord Willbewill’s clerk in time of the +late rebellion.<br> +<br> +3. It was ordered that Captain Charity should quarter at Mr. Affection’s +house.<br> +<br> +4. That Captain Good-Hope should quarter at my Lord Mayor’s. +Now, for the house of the Recorder, himself desired, because his house +was next to the castle, and because from him it was ordered by the Prince +that, if need be, the alarm should be given to Mansoul, - it was, I +say, desired by him that Captain Boanerges and Captain Conviction should +take up their quarters with him, even they and all their men.<br> +<br> +5. As for Captain Judgment and Captain Execution, my Lord Willbewill +took them and their men to him, because he was to rule under the Prince +for the good of the town of Mansoul now, as he had before under the +tyrant Diabolus for the hurt and damage thereof.<br> +<br> +6. And throughout the rest of the town were quartered Emmanuel’s +forces; but Captain Credence, with his men, abode still in the castle. +So the Prince, his captains, and his soldiers, were lodged in the town +of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +Now, the ancients and elders of the town of Mansoul thought that they +never should have enough of the Prince Emmanuel; his person, his actions, +his words, and behaviour, were so pleasing, so taking, so desirable +to them. Wherefore they prayed him, that though the castle of +Mansoul was his place of residence, (and they desired that he might +dwell there for ever,) yet that he would often visit the streets, houses, +and people of Mansoul. ‘For,’ said they, ‘dread +Sovereign, thy presence, thy looks, thy smiles, thy words, are the life, +and strength, and sinews of the town of Mansoul.’<br> +<br> +Besides this, they craved that they might have, without difficulty or +interruption, continual access unto him, (so for that very purpose he +commanded that the gates should stand open,) that they might there see +the manner of his doings, the fortifications of the place, and the royal +mansion-house of the Prince.<br> +<br> +When he spake, they all stopped their mouths and gave audience; and +when he walked, it was their delight to imitate him in his goings.<br> +<br> +Now, upon a time, Emmanuel made a feast for the town of Mansoul; and +upon the feasting-day the townsfolk were come to the castle to partake +of his banquet; and he feasted them with all manner of outlandish food; +- food that grew not in the fields of Mansoul; nor in all the whole +Kingdom of Universe; it was food that came from his Father’s court. +And so there was dish after dish set before them, and they were commanded +freely to eat. But still, when a fresh dish was set before them, +they would whisperingly say to each other, ‘What is it?’ +for they wist not what to call it. They drank also of the water +that was made wine, and were very merry with him. There was music +also all the while at the table; and man did eat angels’ food, +and had honey given him out of the rock. So Mansoul did eat the +food that was peculiar to the court; yea, they had now thereof to the +full.<br> +<br> +I must not forget to tell you, that as at this table there were musicians, +so they were not those of the country, nor yet of the town of Mansoul; +but they were the masters of the songs that were sung at the court of +Shaddai.<br> +<br> +Now, after the feast was over, Emmanuel was for entertaining the town +of Mansoul with some curious riddles of secrets drawn up by his Father’s +secretary, by the skill and wisdom of Shaddai; the like to these there +is not in any kingdom. These riddles were made upon the King Shaddai +himself, and upon Emmanuel his Son, and upon his wars and doings with +Mansoul.<br> +<br> +Emmanuel also expounded unto them some of those riddles himself; but, +oh! how they were lightened! They saw what they never saw; they +could not have thought that such rarities could have been couched in +so few and such ordinary words. I told you before, whom these +riddles did concern; and as they were opened, the people did evidently +see it was so. Yea, they did gather that the things themselves +were a kind of a portraiture, and that of Emmanuel himself; for when +they read in the scheme where the riddles were writ, and looked in the +face of the Prince, things looked so like the one to the other, that +Mansoul could not forbear but say, ‘This is the lamb! this is +the sacrifice! this is the rock! this is the red cow! this is the door! +and this is the way!’ with a great many other things more.<br> +<br> +And thus he dismissed the town of Mansoul. But can you imagine +how the people of the corporation were taken with this entertainment! +Oh! they were transported with joy, they were drowned with wonderment, +while they saw and understood, and considered what their Emmanuel entertained +them withal, and what mysteries he opened to them. And when they +were at home in their houses, and in their most retired places, they +could not but sing of him and of his actions. Yea, so taken were +the townsmen now with their Prince, that they would sing of him in their +sleep.<br> +<br> +Now, it was in the heart of the Prince Emmanuel to new-model the town +of Mansoul, and to put it into such a condition as might be most pleasing +to him, and that might best stand with the profit and security of the +now flourishing town of Mansoul. He provided also against insurrections +at home, and invasions from abroad, such love had he for the famous +town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +Wherefore he first of all commanded that the great slings that were +brought from his Father’s court, when he came to the war of Mansoul, +should be mounted, some upon the battlements of the castle, some upon +the towers; for there were towers in the town of Mansoul, towers, new-built +by Emmanuel since he came hither. There was also an instrument, +invented by Emmanuel, that was to throw stones from the castle of Mansoul, +out at Mouth-gate; an instrument that could not be resisted, nor that +would miss of execution. Wherefore, for the wonderful exploits +that it did when used, it went without a name; and it was committed +to the care of, and to be managed by the brave captain, the Captain +Credence, in case of war.<br> +<br> +This done, Emmanuel called the Lord Willbewill to him, and gave him +in commandment to take care of the gates, the wall, and towers in Mansoul; +also the Prince gave him the militia into his hand, and a special charge +to withstand all insurrections and tumults that might be made in Mansoul +against the peace of our Lord the King, and the peace and tranquillity +of the town of Mansoul. He also gave him in commission, that if +he found any of the Diabolonians lurking in any corner of the famous +town of Mansoul, he should forthwith apprehend them, and stay them, +or commit them to safe custody, that they may be proceeded against according +to law.<br> +<br> +Then he called unto him the Lord Understanding, who was the old Lord +Mayor, he that was put out of place when Diabolus took the town, and +put him into his former office again, and it became his place for his +lifetime. He bid him also that he should build him a palace near +Eye-gate; and that he should build it in fashion like a tower for defence. +He bid him also that he should read in the Revelation of Mysteries all +the days of his life, that he might know how to perform his office aright.<br> +<br> +He also made Mr. Knowledge the Recorder, not of contempt to old Mr. +Conscience, who had been Recorder before, but for that it was in his +princely mind to confer upon Mr. Conscience another employ, of which +he told the old gentleman he should know more hereafter.<br> +<br> +Then he commanded that the image of Diabolus should be taken down from +the place where it was set up, and that they should destroy it utterly, +beating it into powder, and casting it into the wind without the town +wall; and that the image of Shaddai, his Father, should be set up again, +with his own, upon the castle gates; and that it should be more fairly +drawn than ever, forasmuch as both his Father and himself were come +to Mansoul in more grace and mercy than heretofore. He would also +that his name should be fairly engraven upon the front of the town, +and that it should be done in the best of gold, for the honour of the +town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +After this was done, Emmanuel gave out a commandment that those three +great Diabolonians should be apprehended, namely, the two late Lord +Mayors, to wit, Mr. Incredulity, Mr. Lustings, and Mr. Forget-Good, +the Recorder. Besides these, there were some of them that Diabolus +made burgesses and aldermen in Mansoul, that were committed to ward +by the hand of the now valiant and now right noble, the brave Lord Willbewill.<br> +<br> +And these were their names: Alderman Atheism, Alderman Hard-Heart, and +Alderman False-Peace. The burgesses were, Mr. No-Truth, Mr. Pitiless, +Mr. Haughty, with the like. These were committed to close custody, +and the gaoler’s name was Mr. True-Man. This True-Man was +one of those that Emmanuel brought with him from his Father’s +court when at the first he made a war upon Diabolus in the town or Mansoul.<br> +<br> +After this, the Prince gave a charge that the three strongholds that, +at the command of Diabolus, the Diabolonians built in Mansoul, should +be demolished and utterly pulled down; of which holds and their names, +with their captains and governors, you read a little before. But +this was long in doing, because of the largeness of the places, and +because the stones, the timber, the iron, and all rubbish, was to be +carried without the town.<br> +<br> +When this was done, the Prince gave order that the Lord Mayor and aldermen +of Mansoul should call a court of judicature for the trial and execution +of the Diabolonians in the corporation now under the charge of Mr. True-Man, +the gaoler.<br> +<br> +Now, when the time was come, and the court set, commandment was sent +to Mr. True-Man, the gaoler, to bring the prisoners down to the bar. +Then were the prisoners brought down, pinioned and chained together, +as the custom of the town of Mansoul was. So, when they were presented +before the Lord Mayor, the Recorder, and the rest of the honourable +bench, first, the jury was empannelled, and then the witnesses sworn. +The names of the jury were these: Mr. Belief, Mr. True-Heart, Mr. Upright, +Mr. Hate-Bad, Mr. Love-God, Mr. See-Truth, Mr. Heavenly-Mind, Mr. Moderate, +Mr. Thankful, Mr. Good-Work, Mr. Zeal-for-God, and Mr. Humble.<br> +<br> +The names of the witnesses were - Mr. Know-All, Mr. Tell-True, Mr. Hate-Lies, +with my Lord Willbewill and his man, if need were.<br> +<br> +So the prisoners were set to the bar. Then said Mr. Do-Right, +(for he was the Town-Clerk,) ‘Set Atheism to the bar, gaoler.’ +So he was set to the bar. Then said the Clerk, ‘Atheism, +hold up thy hand. Thou art here indicted by the name of Atheism, +(an intruder upon the town of Mansoul,) for that thou hast perniciously +and doltishly taught and maintained that there is no God, and so no +heed to be taken to religion. This thou hast done against the +being, honour, and glory of the King, and against the peace and safety +of the town of Mansoul. What sayest thou? Art thou guilty +of this indictment, or not?<br> +<br> +<i>Atheism</i>. Not guilty.<br> +<br> +<i>Crier</i>. Call Mr. Know-All, Mr. Tell-True, and Mr. Hate-Lies +into the court.<br> +<br> +So they were called, and they appeared.<br> +<br> +Then said the Clerk, ‘You, the witnesses for the King, look upon +the prisoner at the bar; do you know him?’<br> +<br> +Then said Mr. Know-All, ‘Yes, my lord, we know him; his name is +Atheism; he has been a very pestilent fellow for many years in the miserable +town of Mansoul.’<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. You are sure you know him?<br> +<br> +<i>Know</i>. Know him! Yes my lord; I have heretofore too +often been in his company to be at this time ignorant of him. +He is a Diabolonian, the son of a Diabolonian: I knew his grandfather +and his father.<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. Well said. He standeth here indicted by the +name of Atheism, etc., and is charged that he hath maintained and taught +that there is no God, and so no heed need be taken to any religion. +What say you, the King’s witnesses, to this? Is he guilty +or not?<br> +<br> +<i>Know</i>. My lord, I and he were once in Villain’s Lane +together, and he at that time did briskly talk of divers opinions; and +then and there I heard him say, that, for his part, he did believe that +there was no God. ‘But,’ said he, ‘I can profess +one, and be as religious too, if the company I am in, and the circumstances +of other things,’ said he, ‘shall put me upon it.’<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. You are sure you heard him say thus?<br> +<br> +<i>Know</i>. Upon mine oath, I heard him say thus.<br> +<br> +Then said the Clerk, ‘Mr. Tell-True, what say you to the King’s +judges touching the prisoner at the bar?’<br> +<br> +<i>Tell</i>. My lord, I formerly was a great companion of his, +for the which I now repent me, and I have often heard him say, and that +with very great stomachfulness, that he believed there was neither God, +angel, nor spirit.<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. Where did you hear him say so?<br> +<br> +<i>Tell</i>. In Blackmouth Lane and in Blasphemer’s Row, +and in many other places besides.<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. Have you much knowledge of him?<br> +<br> +<i>Tell</i>. I know him to be a Diabolonian, the son of a Diabolonian, +and a horrible man to deny a Deity. His father’s name was +Never-be-good, and he had more children than this Atheism. I have +no more to say,<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. Mr. Hate-Lies, look upon the prisoner at the bar; +do you know him?<br> +<br> +<i>Hate</i>. My lord, this Atheism is one of the vilest wretches +that ever I came near, or had to do with in my life. I have heard +him say that there is no God; I have heard him say that there is no +world to come, no sin, nor punishment hereafter, and, moreover, I have +heard him say that it was as good to go to a whore-house as to go to +hear a sermon.<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. Where did you hear him say these things?<br> +<br> +<i>Hate</i>. In Drunkard’s Row, just at Rascal-Lane’s +End, at a house in which Mr. Impiety lived.<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. Set him by, gaoler, and set Mr. Lustings to the +bar. Mr. Lustings, thou art here indicted by the name of Lustings, +(an intruder upon the town of Mansoul,) for that thou hast devilishly +and traitorously taught, by practice and filthy words, that it is lawful +and profitable to man to give way to his carnal desires; and that thou, +for thy part, hast not, nor never wilt, deny thyself of any sinful delight +as long as thy name is Lustings. How sayest thou? Art thou +guilty of this indictment, or not?<br> +<br> +Then said Mr. Lustings, ‘My lord, I am a man of high birth, and +have been used to pleasures and pastimes of greatness. I have +not been wont to be snubbed for my doings, but have been left to follow +my will as if it were law. And it seems strange to me that I should +this day be called into question for that, that not only I, but almost +all men, do either secretly or openly countenance, love, and approve +of.’<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. Sir, we concern not ourselves with your greatness; +(though the higher, the better you should have been;) but we are concerned, +and so are you now, about an indictment preferred against you. +How say you? Are you guilty of it, or not?<br> +<br> +<i>Lust</i>. Not guilty.<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. Crier, call upon the witnesses to stand forth and +give their evidence.<br> +<br> +<i>Crier</i>. Gentlemen, you, the witnesses for the King, come +in and give in your evidence for our Lord the King against the prisoner +at the bar.<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. Come, Mr. Know-All, look upon the prisoner at the +bar; do you know him?<br> +<br> +<i>Know</i>. Yes, my lord, I know him.<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. What is his name?<br> +<br> +<i>Know</i>. His name is Lustings; he was the son of one Beastly, +and his mother bare him in Flesh Street: she was one Evil-Concupiscence’s +daughter. I knew all the generation of them.<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. Well said. You have heard his indictment; +what say you to it? Is he guilty of the things charged against +him, or not?<br> +<br> +<i>Know</i>. My lord, he has, as he saith, been a great man indeed, +and greater in wickedness than by pedigree more than a thousandfold.<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. But what do you know of his particular actions, +and especially with reference to his indictment?<br> +<br> +<i>Know</i>. I know him to be a swearer, a liar, a Sabbath-breaker; +I know him to be a fornicator and an unclean person; I know him to be +guilty of abundance of evils. He has been, to my knowledge, a +very filthy man.<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. But where did he use to commit his wickedness? in +some private corners, or more open and shamelessly?<br> +<br> +<i>Know</i>. All the town over, my lord.<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. Come, Mr. Tell-True, what have you to say for our +Lord the King against the prisoner at the bar?<br> +<br> +<i>Tell</i>. My lord, all that the first witness has said I know +to be true, and a great deal more besides.<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. Mr. Lustings, do you hear what these gentlemen say?<br> +<br> +<i>Lust</i>. I was ever of opinion that the happiest life that +a man could live on earth was to keep himself back from nothing that +he desired in the world; nor have I been false at any time to this opinion +of mine, but have lived in the love of my notions all my days. +Nor was I ever so churlish, having found such sweetness in them myself, +as to keep the commendations of them from others.<br> +<br> +Then said the Court, ‘There hath proceeded enough from his own +mouth to lay him open to condemnation; wherefore, set him by, gaoler, +and set Mr. Incredulity to the bar.’<br> +<br> +Incredulity set to the bar.<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. Mr. Incredulity, thou art here indicted by the name +of Incredulity, (an intruder upon the town of Mansoul,) for that thou +hast feloniously and wickedly, and that when thou wert an officer in +the town of Mansoul, made head against the captains of the great King +Shaddai when they came and demanded possession of Mansoul; yea, thou +didst bid defiance to the name, forces, and cause of the King, and didst +also, as did Diabolus thy captain, stir up and encourage the town of +Mansoul to make head against and resist the said force of the King. +What sayest thou to this indictment? Art thou guilty of it, or +not?<br> +<br> +Then said Incredulity, ‘I know not Shaddai; I love my old prince; +I thought it my duty to be true to my trust, and to do what I could +to possess the minds of the men of Mansoul to do their utmost to resist +strangers and foreigners, and with might to fight against them. +Nor have I, nor shall I, change mine opinion for fear of trouble, though +you at present are possessed of place and power.’<br> +<br> +Then said the Court, ‘The man, as you see, is incorrigible; he +is for maintaining his villainies by stoutness of words, and his rebellion +with impudent confidence; and therefore set him by, gaoler, and set +Mr. Forget-Good to the bar.<br> +<br> +Forget-Good set to the bar.<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. Mr. Forget-Good, thou art here indicted by the name +of Forget-Good, (an intruder upon the town of Mansoul,) for that thou, +when the whole affairs of the town of Mansoul were in thy hand, didst +utterly forget to serve them in what was good, and didst fall in with +the tyrant Diabolus against Shaddai the King, against his captains, +and all his host, to the dishonour of Shaddai, the breach of his law, +and the endangering of the destruction of the famous town of Mansoul. +What sayest thou to this indictment? Art thou guilty or not guilty?<br> +<br> +Then said Forget-Good: ‘Gentlemen, and at this time my judges, +as to the indictment by which I stand of several crimes accused before +you, pray attribute my forgetfulness to mine age, and not to my wilfulness; +to the craziness of my brain, and not to the carelessness of my mind; +and then I hope I may be by your charity excused from great punishment, +though I be guilty.’<br> +<br> +Then said the Court, ‘Forget-Good, Forget-Good, thy forgetfulness +of good was not simply of frailty, but of purpose, and for that thou +didst loathe to keep virtuous things in thy mind. What was bad +thou couldst retain, but what was good thou couldst not abide to think +of; thy age, therefore, and thy pretended craziness, thou makest use +of to blind the court withal, and as a cloak to cover thy knavery. +But let us hear what the witnesses have to say for the King against +the prisoner at the bar. Is he guilty of this indictment, or not?’<br> +<br> +<i>Hate</i>. My lord, I have heard this Forget-Good say, that +he could never abide to think of goodness, no, not for a quarter of +an hour.<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. Where did you hear him say so?<br> +<br> +<i>Hate</i>. In All-base Lane, at a house next door to the sign +of the Conscience seared with a hot iron.<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. Mr. Know-All, what can you say for our Lord the +King against the prisoner at the bar?<br> +<br> +<i>Know</i>. My lord, I know this man well. He is a Diabolonian, +the son of a Diabolonian: his father’s name was Love-Naught; and +for him, I have often heard him say, that he counted the very thoughts +of goodness the most burdensome thing in the world.<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. Where have you heard him say these words?<br> +<br> +<i>Know</i>. In Flesh Lane, right opposite to the church.<br> +<br> +Then said the Clerk, ‘Come, Mr. Tell-True, give in your evidence +concerning the prisoner at the bar, about that for which he stands here, +as you see, indicted by this honourable Court.’<br> +<br> +<i>Tell</i>. My lord, I have heard him often say he had rather +think of the vilest thing than of what is contained in the Holy Scriptures.<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. Where did you hear him say such grievous words?<br> +<br> +<i>Tell</i>. Where? - in a great many places, particularly in +Nauseous Street, in the house of one Shameless, and in Filth Lane, at +the sign of the Reprobate, next door to the Descent into the Pit.<br> +<br> +<i>Court</i>. Gentlemen, you have heard the indictment, his plea, +and the testimony of the witnesses. Gaoler, set Mr. Hard-Heart +to the bar.<br> +<br> +He is set to the bar.<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. Mr. Hard-Heart, thou art here indicted by the name +of Hard-Heart, (an intruder upon the town of Mansoul,) for that thou +didst most desperately and wickedly possess the town of Mansoul with +impenitency and obdurateness; and didst keep them from remorse and sorrow +for their evils, all the time of their apostacy from and rebellion against +the blessed King Shaddai. What sayest thou to this indictment? +Art thou guilty, or not guilty?<br> +<br> +<i>Hard</i>. My lord, I never knew what remorse or sorrow meant +in all my life. I am impenetrable. I care for no man; nor +can I be pierced with men’s griefs; their groans will not enter +into my heart. Whomsoever I mischief, whomsoever I wrong, to me +it is music, when to others mourning.<br> +<br> +<i>Court</i>. You see the man is a right Diabolonian, and has +convicted himself. Set him by, gaoler, and set Mr. False-Peace +to the bar.<br> +<br> +False-Peace set to the bar.<br> +<br> +“Mr. False-Peace, thou art here indicted by the name of False-Peace, +(an intruder upon the town of Mansoul,) for that thou didst most wickedly +and satanically bring, hold, and keep the town of Mansoul, both in her +apostacy and in her hellish rebellion, in a false, groundless, and dangerous +peace, and damnable security, to the dishonour of the King, the transgression +of his law, and the great damage of the town of Mansoul. What +sayest thou? Art thou guilty of this indictment, or not?<br> +<br> +Then said Mr. False-Peace: ‘Gentlemen, and you now appointed to +be my judges, I acknowledge that my name is Mr. Peace; but that my name +is False-Peace I utterly deny. If your honours shall please to +send for any that do intimately know me, or for the midwife that laid +my mother of me, or for the gossips that were at my christening, they +will, any or all of them, prove that my name is not False-Peace, but +Peace. Wherefore I cannot plead to this indictment, forasmuch +as my name is not inserted therein; and as is my true name, so are also +my conditions. I was always a man that loved to live at quiet, +and what I loved myself, that I thought others might love also. +Wherefore, when I saw any of my neighbours to labour under a disquieted +mind, I endeavoured to help them what I could; and instances of this +good temper of mine many I could give; as,<br> +<br> +‘1. When, at the beginning, our town of Mansoul did decline the +ways of Shaddai, they, some of them, afterwards began to have disquieting +reflections upon themselves for what they had done; but I, as one troubled +to see them disquieted, presently sought out means to get them quiet +again.<br> +<br> +‘2. When the ways of the old world, and of Sodom, were in fashion, +if anything happened to molest those that were for the customs of the +present times, I laboured to make them quiet again, and to cause them +to act without molestation.<br> +<br> +‘3. To come nearer home: when the wars fell out between Shaddai +and Diabolus, if at any time I saw any of the town of Mansoul afraid +of destruction, I often used, by some way, device, invention, or other, +to labour to bring them to peace again. Wherefore, since I have +been always a man of so virtuous a temper as some say a peace-maker +is, and if a peace-maker be so deserving a man as some have been bold +to attest he is, then let me, gentlemen, be accounted by you, who have +a great name for justice and equity in Mansoul, for a man that deserveth +not this inhuman way of treatment, but liberty, and also a license to +seek damage of those that have been my accusers.’<br> +<br> +Then said the clerk, ‘Crier, make a proclamation.’<br> +<br> +<i>Crier</i>. Oyes! Forasmuch as the prisoner at the bar +hath denied his name to be that which is mentioned in the indictment, +the Court requireth that if there be any in this place that can give +information to the Court of the original and right name of the prisoner, +they would come forth and give in their evidence; for the prisoner stands +upon his own innocency.<br> +<br> +Then came two into the court, and desired that they might have leave +to speak what they knew concerning the prisoner at the bar: the name +of the one was Search-Truth, and the name of the other Vouch-Truth. +So the Court demanded of these men if they knew the prisoner, and what +they could say concerning him, ‘for he stands,’ said they, +‘upon his own vindication.’<br> +<br> +Then said Mr. Search-Truth, ‘My Lord, I - ’<br> +<br> +<i>Court</i>. Hold! give him his oath.<br> +<br> +Then they sware him. So he proceeded.<br> +<br> +<i>Search</i>. My lord, I know and have known this man from a +child, and can attest that his name is False-Peace. I know his +father; his name was Mr. Flatter: and his mother, before she was married, +was called by the name of Mrs. Sooth-Up: and these two, when they came +together, lived not long without this son; and when he was born, they +called his name False-Peace. I was his play-fellow, only I was +somewhat older than he; and when his mother did use to call him home +from his play, she used to say, ‘False-Peace, False-Peace, come +home quick, or I’ll fetch you.’ Yea, I knew him when +he sucked; and though I was then but little, yet I can remember that +when his mother did use to sit at the door with him, or did play with +him in her arms, she would call him, twenty times together, ‘My +little False-Peace! my pretty False-Peace!’ and, ‘Oh! my +sweet rogue, False-Peace!’ and again, ‘Oh! my little bird, +False-Peace!’ and ‘How do I love my child!’ +The gossips also know it is thus, though he has had the face to deny +it in open court.<br> +<br> +Then Mr. Vouch-Truth was called upon to speak what he knew of him. +So they sware him.<br> +<br> +Then said Mr. Vouch-Truth, ‘My lord, all that the former witness +hath said is true. His name is False-Peace, the son of Mr. Flatter, +and of Mrs. Sooth-Up, his mother: and I have in former times seen him +angry with those that have called him anything else but False-Peace, +for he would say that all such did mock and nickname him; but this was +in the time when Mr. False-Peace was a great man, and when the Diabolonians +were the brave men in Mansoul.<br> +<br> +<i>Court</i>. Gentlemen, you have heard what these two men have +sworn against the prisoner at the bar. And now, Mr. False-Peace, +to you: you have denied your name to be False-Peace, yet you see that +these honest men have sworn that that is your name. As to your +plea, in that you are quite besides the matter of your indictment, you +are not by it charged for evil-doing because you are a man of peace, +or a peace-maker among your neighbours; but for that you did wickedly +and satanically bring, keep, and hold the town of Mansoul, both under +its apostasy from, and in its rebellion against its King, in a false, +lying, and damnable peace, contrary to the law of Shaddai, and to the +hazard of the destruction of the then miserable town of Mansoul. +All that you have pleaded for yourself is, that you have denied your +name, etc.; but here, you see, we have witnesses to prove that you are +the man. For the peace that you so much boast of making among +your neighbours, know that peace that is not a companion of truth and +holiness, but that which is without this foundation, is grounded upon +a lie, and is both deceitful and damnable, as also the great Shaddai +hath said. Thy plea, therefore, has not delivered thee from what +by the indictment thou art charged with, but rather it doth fasten all +upon thee. But thou shalt have very fair play. Let us call +the witnesses that are to testify as to matter of fact, and see what +they have to say for our Lord the King against the prisoner at the bar.<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. Mr. Know-All, what say you for our Lord the King +against the prisoner at the bar?<br> +<br> +<i>Know</i>. My lord, this man hath of a long time made it, to +my knowledge, his business to keep the town of Mansoul in a sinful quietness +in the midst of all her lewdness, filthiness, and turmoils, and hath +said, and that in my hearing, Come, come, let us fly from all trouble, +on what ground soever it comes, and let us be for a quiet and peaceable +life, though it wanteth a good foundation.<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. Come, Mr. Hate-Lies, what have you to say?<br> +<br> +<i>Hate</i>. My lord, I have heard him say, that peace, though +in a way of unrighteousness, is better than trouble with truth.<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. Where did you hear him say this?<br> +<br> +<i>Hate</i>. I heard him say it in Folly-yard, at the house of +one Mr. Simple, next door to the sign of the Self-deceiver. Yea, +he hath said this to my knowledge twenty times in that place.<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. We may spare further witness; this evidence is plain +and full. Set him by, gaoler, and set Mr. No-Truth to the bar. +Mr. No-Truth, thou art here indicted by the name of No-Truth, (an intruder +upon the town of Mansoul,) for that thou hast always, to the dishonour +of Shaddai, and the endangering of the utter ruin of the famous town +of Mansoul, set thyself to deface, and utterly to spoil, all the remainders +of the law and image of Shaddai that have been found in Mansoul after +her deep apostasy from her king to Diabolus, the envious tyrant. +What sayest thou, art thou guilty of this indictment, or not?<br> +<br> +<i>No</i>. Not guilty, my lord.<br> +<br> +Then the witnesses were called, and Mr. Know-All did first give in his +evidence against him.<br> +<br> +<i>Know</i>. My lord, this man was at the pulling down of the +image of Shaddai; yea, this is he that did it with his own hands. +I myself stood by and saw him do it, and he did it at the commandment +of Diabolus. Yea, this Mr. No-Truth did more than this, he did +also set up the horned image of the beast Diabolus in the same place. +This also is he that, at the bidding of Diabolus, did rend and tear, +and cause to be consumed, all that he could of the remainders of the +law of the King, even whatever he could lay his hands on in Mansoul.<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. Who saw him do this besides yourself?<br> +<br> +<i>Hate</i>. I did, my lord, and so did many more besides; for +this was not done by stealth, or in a corner, but in the open view of +all; yea, he chose himself to do it publicly, for he delighted in the +doing of it.<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. Mr. No-Truth, how could you have the face to plead +not guilty, when you were so manifestly the doer of all this wickedness?<br> +<br> +<i>No</i>. Sir, I thought I must say something, and as my name +is, so I speak. I have been advantaged thereby before now, and +did not know but by speaking no truth, I might have reaped the same +benefit now.<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. Set him by, gaoler, and set Mr. Pitiless to the +bar. Mr. Pitiless, thou art here indicted by the name of Pitiless, +(an intruder upon the town of Mansoul,) for that thou didst most traitorously +and wickedly shut up all bowels of compassion, and wouldest not suffer +poor Mansoul to condole her own misery when she had apostatised from +her rightful King, but didst evade, and at all times turn her mind awry +from those thoughts that had in them a tendency to lead her to repentance. +What sayest thou to this indictment? Guilty or not guilty?<br> +<br> +‘Not guilty of pitilessness: all I did was to cheer up, according +to my name, for my name is not Pitiless, but Cheer-up; and I could not +abide to see Mansoul inclined to melancholy.’<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. How! do you deny your name, and say it is not Pitiless, +but Cheer-up? Call for the witnesses. What say you, the witnesses, +to this plea?<br> +<br> +<i>Know</i>. My lord, his name is Pitiless; so he hath written +himself in all papers of concern wherein he has had to do. But +these Diabolonians love to counterfeit their names: Mr. Covetousness +covers himself with the name of Good-Husbandry, or the like; Mr. Pride +can, when need is, call himself Mr. Neat, Mr. Handsome, or the like; +and so of all the rest of them.<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. Mr. Tell-True, what say you?<br> +<br> +<i>Tell</i>. His name is Pitiless, my lord. I have known +him from a child, and he hath done all that wickedness whereof he stands +charged in the indictment; but there is a company of them that are not +acquainted with the danger of damning, therefore they call all those +melancholy that have serious thoughts how that state should be shunned +by them.<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. Set Mr. Haughty to the bar, gaoler. Mr. Haughty, +thou art here indicted by the name of Haughty, (an intruder upon the +town of Mansoul,) for that thou didst most traitorously and devilishly +teach the town of Mansoul to carry it loftily and stoutly against the +summons that was given them by the captains of the King Shaddai. +Thou didst also teach the town of Mansoul to speak contemptuously and +vilifyingly of their great King Shaddai; and didst moreover encourage, +both by words and examples, Mansoul, to take up arms both against the +King and his son Emmanuel. How sayest thou, art thou guilty of +this indictment, or not?<br> +<br> +<i>Haughty</i>. Gentlemen, I have always been a man of courage +and valour, and have not used, when under the greatest clouds, to sneak +or hang down the head like a bulrush; nor did it at all at any time +please me to see men veil their bonnets to those that have opposed them; +yea, though their adversaries seemed to have ten times the advantage +of them. I did not use to consider who was my foe, nor what the +cause was in which I was engaged. It was enough to me if I carried +it bravely, fought like a man, and came off a victor.<br> +<br> +<i>Court</i>. Mr. Haughty, you are not here indicted for that +you have been a valiant man, nor for your courage and stoutness in times +of distress, but for that you have made use of this your pretended valour +to draw the town of Mansoul into acts of rebellion both against the +great King, and Emmanuel his Son. This is the crime and the thing +wherewith thou art charged in and by the indictment.<br> +<br> +But he made no answer to that.<br> +<br> +Now when the Court had thus far proceeded against the prisoners at the +bar, then they put them over to the verdict of their jury, to whom they +did apply themselves after this manner:<br> +<br> +‘Gentlemen of the jury, you have been here, and have seen these +men; you have heard their indictments, their pleas, and what the witnesses +have testified against them: now what remains, is, that you do forthwith +withdraw yourselves to some place, where without confusion you may consider +of what verdict, in a way of truth and righteousness, you ought to bring +in for the King against them, and so bring it in accordingly.’<br> +<br> +Then the jury, to wit, Mr. Belief, Mr. True-Heart, Mr. Upright, Mr. +Hate-bad, Mr. Love-God, Mr. See-Truth, Mr. Heavenly-Mind, Mr. Moderate, +Mr. Thankful, Mr. Humble, Mr. Good-Work, and Mr. Zeal-for-God, withdrew +themselves in order to their work. Now when they were shut up +by themselves, they fell to discourse among themselves in order to the +drawing up of their verdict.<br> +<br> +And thus Mr. Belief (for he was the foreman) began: ‘Gentlemen,’ +quoth he, ‘for the men, the prisoners at the bar, for my part +I believe that they all deserve death.’ ‘Very right,’ +said Mr. True-Heart; ‘I am wholly of your opinion.’ +‘Oh what a mercy is it,’ said Mr. Hate-Bad, ‘that +such villains as these are apprehended!’ ‘Ay! ay!’ +said Mr. Love-God, ‘this is one of the joyfullest days that ever +I saw in my life.’ Then said Mr. See-Truth, ‘I know +that if we judge them to death, our verdict shall stand before Shaddai +himself’ ‘Nor do I at all question it,’ said +Mr. Heavenly-Mind; he said, moreover, ‘When all such beasts as +these are cast out of Mansoul, what a goodly town will it be then!’ +‘Then,’ said Mr. Moderate, ‘it is not my manner to +pass my judgment with rashness; but for these their crimes are so notorious, +and the witness so palpable, that that man must be wilfully blind who +saith the prisoners ought not to die.’ ‘Blessed be +God,’ said Mr. Thankful, ‘that the traitors are in safe +custody.’ ‘And I join with you in this upon my bare +knees,’ said Mr. Humble. ‘I am glad also,’ said +Mr. Good-Work. Then said the warm man, and true-hearted Mr. Zeal-for-God, +‘Cut them off; they have been the plague, and have sought the +destruction of Mansoul.’<br> +<br> +Thus, therefore, being all agreed in their verdict, they come instantly +into the Court.<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. Gentlemen of the jury, answer all to your names: +Mr. Belief, one; Mr. True-Heart, two; Mr. Upright, three; Mr. Hate-Bad, +four; Mr. Love-God, five; Mr. See-Truth, six; Mr. Heavenly-mind, seven; +Mr. Moderate, eight; Mr. Thankful, nine; Mr. Humble, ten; Mr. Good-Work, +eleven; and Mr. Zeal-for-God, twelve. Good men and true, stand +together in your verdict: are you all agreed?<br> +<br> +<i>Jury</i>. Yes, my lord.<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. Who shall speak for you?<br> +<br> +<i>Jury</i>. Our foreman.<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. You, the gentlemen of the jury, being empannelled +for our Lord the King, to serve here in a matter of life and death, +have heard the trials of each of these men, the prisoners at the bar: +what say you? are they guilty of that, and those crimes for which they +stand here indicted, or are they not guilty?<br> +<br> +<i>Foreman</i>. Guilty, my lord.<br> +<br> +<i>Clerk</i>. Look to your prisoners, gaoler.<br> +<br> +This was done in the morning, and in the afternoon they received the +sentence of death according to the law.<br> +<br> +The gaoler, therefore, having received such a charge, put them all in +the inward prison, to preserve them there till the day of execution, +which was to be the next day in the morning.<br> +<br> +But now to see how it happened, one of the prisoners, Incredulity by +name, in the interim betwixt the sentence and the time of execution, +brake prison and made his escape, and gets him away quite out of the +town of Mansoul, and lay lurking in such places and holes as he might, +until he should again have opportunity to do the town of Mansoul a mischief +for their thus handling of him as they did.<br> +<br> +Now when Mr. Trueman, the gaoler, perceived that he had lost his prisoner, +he was in a heavy taking, because that prisoner was, to speak on, the +very worst of all the gang: wherefore first he goes and acquaints my +Lord Mayor, Mr. Recorder, and my Lord Willbewill, with the matter, and +to get of them an order to make search for him throughout the town of +Mansoul. So an order he got, and search was made, but no such +man could now be found in all the town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +All that could be gathered was, that he had lurked a while about the +outside of the town, and that here and there one or other had a glimpse +of him as he did make his escape out of Mansoul; one or two also did +affirm that they saw him without the town, going apace quite over the +plain. Now when he was quite gone, it was affirmed by one Mr. +Did-see, that he ranged all over dry places, till he met with Diabolus, +his friend, and where should they meet one another but just upon Hell-gate +hill.<br> +<br> +But oh! what a lamentable story did the old gentleman tell to Diabolus +concerning what sad alteration Emmanuel had made in Mansoul!<br> +<br> +As, first, how Mansoul had, after some delays, received a general pardon +at the hands of Emmanuel, and that they had invited him into the town, +and that they had given him the castle for his possession. He +said, moreover, that they had called his soldiers into the town, coveted +who should quarter the most of them; they also entertained him with +the timbrel, song, and dance. ‘But that,’ said Incredulity, +‘which is the sorest vexation to me is, that he hath pulled down, +O father, thy image, and set up his own; pulled down thy officers and +set up his own. Yea, and Willbewill, that rebel, who, one would +have thought, should never have turned from us, he is now in as great +favour with Emmanuel as ever he was with thee. But, besides all +this, this Willbewill has received a special commission from his master +to search for, to apprehend, and to put to death all, and all manner +of Diabolonians that he shall find in Mansoul: yea, and this Willbewill +has taken and committed to prison already eight of my Lord’s most +trusty friends in Mansoul. Nay, further, my Lord, with grief I +speak it, they have been all arraigned, condemned, and, I doubt, before +this executed in Mansoul. I told my Lord of eight, and myself +was the ninth, who should assuredly have drunk of the same cup, but +that through craft, I, as thou seest, have made mine escape from them.’<br> +<br> +When Diabolus had heard this lamentable story, he yelled and snuffed +up the wind like a dragon, and made the sky to look dark with his roaring; +he also sware that he would try to be revenged on Mansoul for this. +So they, both he and his old friend Incredulity, concluded to enter +into great consultation, how they might get the town of Mansoul again.<br> +<br> +Now, before this time, the day was come in which the prisoners in Mansoul +were to be executed. So they were brought to the cross, and that +by Mansoul, in most solemn manner; for the Prince said that this should +be done by the hand of the town of Mansoul, ‘that I may see,’ +said he, ‘the forwardness of my now redeemed Mansoul to keep my +word, and to do my commandments; and that I may bless Mansoul in doing +this deed. Proof of sincerity pleases me well; let Mansoul therefore +first lay their hands upon these Diabolonians to destroy them.’<br> +<br> +So the town of Mansoul slew them, according to the word of their Prince; +but when the prisoners were brought to the cross to die, you can hardly +believe what troublesome work Mansoul had of it to put the Diabolonians +to death; for the men, knowing that they must die, and every of them +having implacable enmity in their hearts to Mansoul, what did they but +took courage at the cross, and there resisted the men of the town of +Mansoul? Wherefore the men of Mansoul were forced to cry out for +help to the captains and men of war. Now the great Shaddai had +a secretary in the town, and he was a great lover of the men of Mansoul, +and he was at the place of execution also; so he, hearing the men of +Mansoul cry out against the strugglings and unruliness of the prisoners, +rose up from his place, and came and put his hands upon the hands of +the men of Mansoul. So they crucified the Diabolonians that had +been a plague, a grief, and an offence to the town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +Now, when this good work was done, the Prince came down to see, to visit, +and to speak comfortably to the men of Mansoul, and to strengthen their +hands in such work. And he said to them that, by this act of theirs +he had proved them, and found them to be lovers of his person, observers +of his laws, and such as had also respect to his honour. He said, +moreover, (to show them that they by this should not be losers, nor +their town weakened by the loss of them,) that he would make them another +captain, and that of one of themselves. And that this captain +should be the ruler of a thousand, for the good and benefit of the now +flourishing town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +So he called one to him whose name was Waiting, and bid him, ‘Go +quickly up to the castle gate, and inquire there for one Mr. Experience, +that waiteth upon that noble captain, the Captain Credence, and bid +him come hither to me.’ So the messenger that waited upon +the good Prince Emmanuel went and said as he was commanded. Now +the young gentleman was waiting to see the captain train and muster +his men in the castle yard. Then said Mr. Waiting to him, ‘Sir, +the Prince would that you should come down to his highness forthwith.’ +So he brought him down to Emmanuel, and he came and made obeisance before +him. Now the men of the town knew Mr. Experience well, for he +was born and bred in Mansoul; they also knew him to be a man of conduct, +of valour, and a person prudent in matters; he was also a comely person, +well-spoken, and very successful in his undertakings.<br> +<br> +Wherefore the hearts of the townsmen were transported with joy when +they saw that the Prince himself was so taken with Mr. Experience, that +he would needs make him a captain over a band of men.<br> +<br> +So with one consent they bowed the knee before Emmanuel, and with a +shout said, ‘Let Emmanuel live for ever!’ Then said +the Prince to the young gentleman, whose name was Mr. Experience, ‘I +have thought good to confer upon thee a place of trust and honour in +this my town of Mansoul.’ Then the young man bowed his head +and worshipped. ‘It is,’ said Emmanuel, ‘that +thou shouldest be a captain, a captain over a thousand men in my beloved +town of Mansoul.’ Then said the captain, ‘Let the +King live!’ So the Prince gave out orders forthwith to the +King’s secretary, that he should draw up for Mr. Experience a +commission to make him a captain over a thousand men. ‘And +let it be brought to me,’ said he, ‘that I may set to my +seal.’ So it was done as it was commanded. The commission +was drawn up, brought to Emmanuel, and he set his seal thereto. +Then, by the hand of Mr. Waiting, he sent it away to the captain.<br> +<br> +Now as soon as the captain had received his commission, he sounded his +trumpet for volunteers, and young men came to him apace; yea, the greatest +and chief men in the town sent their sons, to be listed under his command. +Thus Captain Experience came under command to Emmanuel, for the good +of the town of Mansoul. He had for his lieutenant one Mr. Skilful, +and for his cornet one Mr. Memory. His under officers I need not +name. His colours were the white colours for the town of Mansoul; +and his scutcheon was the dead lion and dead bear. So the Prince +returned to his royal palace again.<br> +<br> +Now when he was returned thither, the elders of the town of Mansoul, +to wit, the Lord Mayor, the Recorder, and the Lord Willbewill, went +to congratulate him, and in special way to thank him for his love, care, +and the tender compassion which he showed to his ever-obliged town of +Mansoul. So after a while, and some sweet communion between them, +the townsmen having solemnly ended their ceremony, returned to their +place again.<br> +<br> +Emmanuel also at this time appointed them a day wherein he would renew +their charter, yea, wherein he would renew and enlarge it, mending several +faults therein, that Mansoul’s yoke might be yet more easy. +And this he did without any desire of theirs, even of his own frankness +and noble mind. So when he had sent for and seen their old one, +he laid it by, and said, ‘Now that which decayeth and waxeth old +is ready to vanish away.’ He said, moreover, ‘The +town of Mansoul shall have another, a better, a new one, more steady +and firm by far.’ An epitome hereof take as follows:-<br> +<br> +‘Emmanuel, Prince of Peace, and a great lover of the town of Mansoul, +I do in the name of my Father, and of mine own clemency, give, grant, +and bequeath to my beloved town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +‘First. Free, full, and everlasting forgiveness of all wrongs, +injuries, and offences done by them against my Father, me, their neighbour, +or themselves.<br> +<br> +‘Second. I do give them the holy law and my testament, with +all that therein is contained, for their everlasting comfort and consolation.<br> +<br> +‘Third. I do also give them a portion of the self-same grace +and goodness that dwells in my Father’s heart and mine.<br> +<br> +‘Fourth. I do give, grant, and bestow upon them freely, +the world and what is therein, for their good; and they shall have that +power over them, as shall stand with the honour of my Father, my glory, +and their comfort: yea, I grant them the benefits of life and death, +and of things present, and things to come. This privilege no other +city, town, or corporation, shall have, but my Mansoul only.<br> +<br> +‘Fifth. I do give and grant them leave, and free access +to me in my palace at all seasons - to my palace above or below - there +to make known their wants to me, and I give them, moreover, a promise +that I will hear and redress all their grievances.<br> +<br> +‘Sixth. I do give, grant to, and invest the town of Mansoul +with full power and authority to seek out, take, enslave, and destroy +all, and all manner of Diabolonians that at any time, from whencesoever, +shall be found straggling in or about the town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +‘Seventh. I do further grant to my beloved town of Mansoul, +that they shall have authority not to suffer any foreigner, or stranger, +or their seed, to be free in, and of the blessed town of Mansoul, nor +to share in the excellent privileges thereof. But that all the +grants, privileges, and immunities that I bestow upon the famous town +of Mansoul, shall be for those the old natives, and true inhabitants +thereof; to them, I say, and to their right seed after them.<br> +<br> +‘But all Diabolonians, of what sort, birth, country, or kingdom +soever, shall be debarred a share therein.’<br> +<br> +So when the town of Mansoul had received at the hand of Emmanuel their +gracious charter, (which in itself is infinitely more large than by +this lean epitome is set before you,) they carried it to audience, that +is, to the market place, and there Mr. Recorder read it in the presence +of all the people. This being done, it was had back to the castle +gates, and there fairly engraven upon the doors thereof, and laid in +letters of gold, to the end that the town of Mansoul, with all the people +thereof, might have it always in their view, or might go where they +might see what a blessed freedom their Prince had bestowed upon them, +that their joy might be increased in themselves, and their love renewed +to their great and good Emmanuel.<br> +<br> +But what joy, what comfort, what consolation, think you, did now possess +the hearts of the men of Mansoul! The bells rung, the minstrels +played, the people danced, the captains shouted, the colours waved in +the wind, and the silver trumpets sounded; and the Diabolonians now +were glad to hide their heads, for they looked like them that had been +long dead.<br> +<br> +When this was over, the Prince sent again for the elders of the town +of Mansoul, and communed with them about a ministry that he intended +to establish among them; such a ministry that might open unto them, +and that might instruct them in the things that did concern their present +and future state.<br> +<br> +‘For,’ said he, ‘you, of yourselves, unless you have +teachers and guides, will not be able to know, and, if not to know, +to be sure not to do the will of my Father.’<br> +<br> +At this news, when the elders of Mansoul brought it to the people, the +whole town came running together, (for it pleased them well, as whatever +the Prince now did pleased the people,) and all with one consent implored +his Majesty that he would forthwith establish such a ministry among +them as might teach them both law and judgment, statute and commandment; +that they might be documented in all good and wholesome things. +So he told them that he would grant them their requests, and would establish +two among them; one that was of his Father’s court, and one that +was a native of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +‘He that is from the court,’ said he, ‘is a person +of no less quality and dignity than my Father and I; and he is the Lord +Chief Secretary of my Father’s house: for he is, and always has +been, the chief dictator of all my Father’s laws, a person altogether +well skilled in all mysteries, and knowledge of mysteries, as is my +Father, or as myself is. Indeed he is one with us in nature, and +also as to loving of, and being faithful to, and in the eternal concerns +of the town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +‘And this is he,’ said the Prince, ‘that must be your +chief teacher; for it is he, and he only, that can teach you clearly +in all high and supernatural things. He, and he only, it is that +knows the ways and methods of my Father at court, nor can any like him +show how the heart of my Father is at all times, in all things, upon +all occasions, towards Mansoul; for as no man knows the things of a +man but that spirit of a man which is in him, so the things of my Father +knows no man but this his high and mighty Secretary. Nor can any, +as he, tell Mansoul how and what they shall do to keep themselves in +the love of my Father. He also it is that can bring lost things +to your remembrance, and that can tell you things to come. This +teacher, therefore, must of necessity have the pre-eminence, both in +your affections and judgment, before your other teacher; his personal +dignity, the excellency of his teaching, also the great dexterity that +he hath to help you to make and draw up petitions to my Father for your +help, and to his pleasing, must lay obligations upon you to love him, +fear him, and to take heed that you grieve him not.<br> +<br> +‘This person can put life and vigour into all he says; yea, and +can also put it into your heart. This person can make seers of +you, and can make you tell what shall be hereafter. By this person +you must frame all your petitions to my Father and me; and without his +advice and counsel first obtained, let nothing enter into the town or +castle of Mansoul, for that may disgust and grieve this noble person.<br> +<br> +‘Take heed, I say, that you do not grieve this minister; for if +you do, he may fight against you; and should he once be moved by you +to set himself against you in battle array, that will distress you more +than if twelve legions should from my Father’s court be sent to +make war upon you.<br> +<br> +‘But, as I said, if you shall hearken unto him, and shall love +him; if you shall devote yourselves to his teaching, and shall seek +to have converse, and to maintain communion with him, you shall find +him ten times better than is the whole world to any; yea, he will shed +abroad the love of my Father in your hearts, and Mansoul will be the +wisest, and most blessed of all people.’<br> +<br> +Then did the Prince call unto him the old gentleman, who before had +been the Recorder of Mansoul, Mr. Conscience by name, and told him, +That, forasmuch as he was well skilled in the law and government of +the town of Mansoul, and was also well-spoken, and could pertinently +deliver to them his Master’s will in all terrene and domestic +matters, therefore he would also make him a minister for, in, and to +the goodly town of Mansoul, in all the laws, statutes, and judgments +of the famous town of Mansoul. ‘And thou must,’ said +the Prince, ‘confine thyself to the teaching of moral virtues, +to civil and natural duties; but thou must not attempt to presume to +be a revealer of those high and supernatural mysteries that are kept +close in the bosom of Shaddai, my Father: for those things knows no +man, nor can any reveal them but my Father’s Secretary only.<br> +<br> +‘Thou art a native of the town of Mansoul, but the Lord Secretary +is a native with my Father; wherefore, as thou hast knowledge of the +laws and customs of the corporation, so he of the things and will of +my Father.<br> +<br> +‘Wherefore, O Mr. Conscience, although I have made thee a minister +and a preacher to the town of Mansoul, yet as to the things which the +Lord Secretary knoweth, and shall teach to this people, there thou must +be his scholar and a learner, even as the rest of Mansoul are.<br> +<br> +‘Thou must therefore, in all high and supernatural things, go +to him for information and knowledge; for though there be a spirit in +man, this person’s inspiration must give him understanding. +Wherefore, O thou Mr. Recorder, keep low and be humble, and remember +that the Diabolonians that kept not their first charge, but left their +own standing, are now made prisoners in the pit. Be therefore +content with thy station.<br> +<br> +‘I have made thee my Father’s vicegerent on earth, in such +things of which I have made mention before: and thou, take thou power +to teach them to Mansoul, yea, and to impose them with whips and chastisements, +if they shall not willingly hearken to do thy commandments.<br> +<br> +‘And, Mr. Recorder, because thou art old, and through many abuses +made feeble; therefore I give thee leave and license to go when thou +wilt to my fountain, my conduit, and there to drink freely of the blood +of my grape, for my conduit doth always run wine. Thus doing, +thou shalt drive from thine heart and stomach all foul, gross, and hurtful +humours. It will also lighten thine eyes, and will strengthen +thy memory for the reception and keeping of all that the King’s +most noble Secretary teacheth.’<br> +<br> +When the Prince had thus put Mr. Recorder (that once so was) into the +place and office of a minister to Mansoul, and the man had thankfully +accepted thereof, then did Emmanuel address himself in a particular +speech to the townsmen themselves.<br> +<br> +‘Behold,’ said the Prince to Mansoul, ‘my love and +care towards you; I have added to all that is past, this mercy, to appoint +you preachers; the most noble Secretary to teach you in all high and +sublime mysteries; and this gentleman,’ pointing to Mr. Conscience, +‘is to teach you in all things human and domestic, for therein +lieth his work. He is not, by what I have said, debarred of telling +to Mansoul anything that he hath heard and received at the mouth of +the lord high Secretary; only he shall not attempt to presume to pretend +to be a revealer of those high mysteries himself; for the breaking of +them up, and the discovery of them to Mansoul lieth only in the power, +authority, and skill of the lord high Secretary himself. Talk +of them he may, and so may the rest of the town of Mansoul; yea, and +may, as occasion gives them opportunity, press them upon each other +for the benefit of the whole. These things, therefore, I would +have you observe and do, for it is for your life, and the lengthening +of your days.<br> +<br> +‘And one thing more to my beloved Mr. Recorder, and to all the +town of Mansoul: You must not dwell in, nor stay upon, anything of that +which he hath in commission to teach you, as to your trust and expectation +of the next world; (of the next world, I say, for I purpose to give +another to Mansoul, when this with them is worn out;) but for that you +must wholly and solely have recourse to, and make stay upon his doctrine +that is your Teacher after the first order. Yea, Mr. Recorder +himself must not look for life from that which he himself revealeth; +his dependence for that must be founded in the doctrine of the other +preacher. Let Mr. Recorder also take heed that he receive not +any doctrine, or point of doctrine, that is not communicated to him +by his Superior Teacher, nor yet within the precincts of his own formal +knowledge.’<br> +<br> +Now, after the Prince had thus settled things in the famous town of +Mansoul, he proceeded to give to the elders of the corporation a necessary +caution, to wit, how they should carry it to the high and noble captains +that he had, from his Father’s court, sent or brought with him, +to the famous town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +‘These captains,’ said he, ‘do love the town of Mansoul, +and they are picked men, picked out of abundance, as men that best suit, +and that will most faithfully serve in the wars of Shaddai against the +Diabolonians, for the preservation of the town of Mansoul. ‘I +charge you therefore,’ said he, ‘O ye inhabitants of the +now flourishing town of Mansoul, that you carry it not ruggedly or untowardly +to my captains, or their men; since, as I said, they are picked and +choice men - men chosen out of many for the good of the town of Mansoul. +I say, I charge you, that you carry it not untowardly to them: for though +they have the hearts and faces of lions, when at any time they shall +be called forth to engage and fight with the King’s foes, and +the enemies of the town of Mansoul; yet a little discountenance cast +upon them from the town of Mansoul will deject and cast down their faces, +will weaken and take away their courage. Do not, therefore, O +my beloved, carry it unkindly to my valiant captains and courageous +men of war, but love them, nourish them, succour them, and lay them +in your bosoms; and they will not only fight for you, but cause to fly +from you all those the Diabolonians that seek, and will, if possible, +be, your utter destruction.<br> +<br> +‘If, therefore, any of them should at any time be sick or weak, +and so not able to perform that office of love, which, with all their +hearts, they are willing to do (and will do also when well and in health), +slight them not, nor despise them, but rather strengthen them and encourage +them, though weak and ready to die, for they are your fence, and your +guard, your wall, your gates, your locks, and your bars. And although, +when they are weak, they can do but little, but rather need to be helped +by you, than that you should then expect great things from them, yet, +when well, you know what exploits, what feats and warlike achievements +they are able to do, and will perform for you.<br> +<br> +‘Besides, if they be weak, the town of Mansoul cannot be strong; +if they be strong, then Mansoul cannot be weak; your safety, therefore, +doth lie in their health, and in your countenancing them. Remember, +also, that if they be sick, they catch that disease of the town of Mansoul +itself.<br> +<br> +‘These things I have said unto you because I love your welfare +and your honour: observe, therefore, O my Mansoul, to be punctual in +all things that I have given in charge unto you, and that not only as +a town corporate, and so to your officers and guard, and guides in chief, +but to you as you are a people whose well-being, as single persons, +depends on the observation of the orders and commandments of their Lord.<br> +<br> +‘Next, O my Mansoul, I do warn you of that, of which, notwithstanding +that reformation that at present is wrought among you, you have need +to be warned about: wherefore hearken diligently unto me. I am +now sure, and you will know hereafter, that there are yet of the Diabolonians +remaining in the town of Mansoul, Diabolonians that are sturdy and implacable, +and that do already while I am with you, and that will yet more when +I am from you, study, plot, contrive, invent, and jointly attempt to +bring you to desolation, and so to a state far worse than that of the +Egyptian bondage; they are the avowed friends of Diabolus, therefore +look about you. They used heretofore to lodge with their Prince +in the Castle, when Incredulity was the Lord Mayor of this town; but +since my coming hither, they lie more in the outsides and walls, and +have made themselves dens, and caves, and holes, and strongholds therein. +Wherefore, O Mansoul! thy work, as to this, will be so much the more +difficult and hard; that is, to take, mortify, and put them to death +according to the will of my Father. Nor can you utterly rid yourselves +of them, unless you should pull down the walls of your town, the which +I am by no means willing you should. Do you ask me, What shall +we do then? Why, be you diligent, and quit you like men; observe +their holes; find out their haunts; assault them, and make no peace +with them. Wherever they haunt, lurk, or abide, and what terms +of peace soever they offer you, abhor, and all shall be well betwixt +you and me. And that you may the better know them from those that +are the natives of Mansoul, I will give you this brief schedule of the +names of the chief of them; and they are these that follow:- The Lord +Fornication, the Lord Adultery, the Lord Murder, the Lord Anger, the +Lord Lasciviousness, the Lord Deceit, the Lord Evil-Eye, Mr. Drunkenness, +Mr. Revelling, Mr. Idolatry, Mr. Witch-craft, Mr. Variance, Mr. Emulation, +Mr. Wrath, Mr. Strife, Mr. Sedition, and Mr. Heresy. These are +some of the chief, O Mansoul! of those that will seek to overthrow thee +for ever. These, I say, are the skulkers in Mansoul; but look +thou well into the law of thy King, and there thou shalt find their +physiognomy, and such other characteristical notes of them, by which +they certainly may be known.<br> +<br> +‘These, O my Mansoul, (and I would gladly that you should certainly +know it,) if they be suffered to run and range about the town as they +would, will quickly, like vipers, eat out your bowels; yea, poison your +captains, cut the sinews of your soldiers, break the bars and bolts +of your gates, and turn your now most flourishing Mansoul into a barren +and desolate wilderness, and ruinous heap. Wherefore, that you +may take courage to yourselves to apprehend these villains wherever +you find them, I give to you, my Lord Mayor, my Lord Willbewill, and +Mr. Recorder, with all the inhabitants of the town of Mansoul, full +power and commission to seek out, to take, and to cause to be put to +death by the cross, all, and all manner of Diabolonians, when and wherever +you shall find them to lurk within, or to range without the walls of +the town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +‘I told you before that I had placed a standing ministry among +you; not that you have but these with you, for my first four captains +who came against the master and lord of the Diabolonians that was in +Mansoul, they can, and if need be, and if they be required, will not +only privately inform, but publicly preach to the corporation both good +and wholesome doctrine, and such as shall lead you in the way. +Yea, they will set up a weekly, yea, if need be, a daily lecture in +thee, O Mansoul! and will instruct thee in such profitable lessons, +that, if heeded, will do thee good at the end. And take good heed +that you spare not the men that you have a commission to take and crucify.<br> +<br> +‘Now, as I have set before your eyes the vagrants and runagates +by name, so I will tell you, that among yourselves, some of them shall +creep in to beguile you, even such as would seem, and that in appearance +are, very rife and hot for religion. And they, if you watch not, +will do you a mischief, such an one as at present you cannot think of.<br> +<br> +‘These, as I said, will show themselves to you in another hue +than those under description before. Wherefore, Mansoul, watch +and be sober, and suffer not thyself to be betrayed.’<br> +<br> +When the Prince had thus far new modelled the town of Mansoul, and had +instructed them in such matters as were profitable for them to know, +then he appointed another day in which he intended, when the townsfolk +came together, to bestow a further badge of honour upon the town of +Mansoul, - a badge that should distinguish them from all the people, +kindreds, and tongues that dwell in the kingdom of Universe. Now +it was not long before the day appointed was come, and the Prince and +his people met in the King’s palace, where first Emmanuel made +a short speech unto them, and then did for them as he had said, and +unto them as he had promised.<br> +<br> +‘My Mansoul,’ said he, ‘that which I now am about +to do, is to make you known to the world to be mine, and to distinguish +you also in your own eyes, from all false traitors that may creep in +among you.’<br> +<br> +Then he commanded that those that waited upon him should go and bring +forth out of his treasury those white and glistening robes ‘that +I,’ said he, ‘have provided and laid up in store for my +Mansoul.’ So the white garments were fetched out of his +treasury, and laid forth to the eyes of the people. Moreover, +it was granted to them that they should take them and put them on, ‘according,’ +said he, ‘to your size and stature.’ So the people +were put into white, into fine linen, white and clean.<br> +<br> +Then said the Prince unto them, ‘This, O Mansoul, is my livery, +and the badge by which mine are known from the servants of others. +Yea, it is that which I grant to all that are mine, and without which +no man is permitted to see my face. Wear them, therefore, for +my sake, who gave them unto you; and also if you would be known by the +world to be mine.’<br> +<br> +But now! can you think how Mansoul shone? It was fair as the sun, +clear as the moon, and terrible as an army with banners.<br> +<br> +The Prince added further, and said, ‘No prince, potentate, or +mighty one of Universe, giveth this livery but myself: behold, therefore, +as I said before, you shall be known by it to be mine.<br> +<br> +‘And now,’ said he, ‘I have given you my livery, let +me give you also in commandment concerning them; and be sure that you +take good heed to my words.<br> +<br> +‘First. Wear them daily, day by day, lest you should at +sometimes appear to others as if you were none of mine.<br> +<br> +‘Second. Keep them always white; for if they be soiled, +it is dishonour to me.<br> +<br> +‘Third. Wherefore gird them up from the ground, and let +them not lag with dust and dirt.<br> +<br> +‘Fourth. Take heed that you lose them not, lest you walk +naked, and they see your shame.<br> +<br> +‘Fifth. But if you should sully them, if you should defile +them, the which I am greatly unwilling you should, and the prince Diabolus +will be glad if you would, then speed you to do that which is written +in my law, that yet you may stand, and befall before me, and before +my throne. Also, this is the way to cause that I may not leave +you, nor forsake you while here, but may dwell in this town of Mansoul +for ever.’<br> +<br> +And now was Mansoul, and the inhabitants of it, as the signet upon Emmanuel’s +right hand. Where was there now a town, a city, a corporation, +that could compare with Mansoul! a town redeemed from the hand, and +from the power of Diabolus! a town that the King Shaddai loved, and +that he sent Emmanuel to regain from the Prince of the infernal cave; +yea, a town that Emmanuel loved to dwell in, and that he chose for his +royal habitation; a town that he fortified for himself, and made strong +by the force of his army. What shall I say, Mansoul has now a +most excellent Prince, golden captains and men of war, weapons proved, +and garments as white as snow. Nor are these benefits to be counted +little, but great; can the town of Mansoul esteem them so, and improve +them to that end and purpose for which they are bestowed upon them?<br> +<br> +When the Prince had thus completed the modelling of the town, to show +that he had great delight in the work of his hands and took pleasure +in the good that he had wrought for the famous and flourishing Mansoul, +he commanded, and they set his standard upon the battlements of the +castle. And then,<br> +<br> +First. He gave them frequent visits; not a day now but the elders +of Mansoul must come to him, or he to them, into his palace. Now +they must walk and talk together of all the great things that he had +done, and yet further promised to do, for the town of Mansoul. +Thus would he often do with the Lord Mayor, my Lord Willbewill, and +the honest subordinate preacher Mr. Conscience, and Mr. Recorder. +But oh, how graciously, how lovingly, how courteously, and tenderly +did this blessed Prince now carry it towards the town of Mansoul! +In all the streets, gardens, orchards, and other places where he came, +to be sure the poor should have his blessing and benediction; yea, he +would kiss them, and if they were ill he would lay hands on them, and +make them well. The captains, also, he would daily, yea, sometimes +hourly, encourage with his presence and goodly words. For you +must know that a smile from him upon them would put more vigour, more +life, and stoutness into them, than would anything else under heaven.<br> +<br> +The Prince would now also feast them, and be with them continually: +hardly a week would pass but a banquet must be had betwixt him and them. +You may remember that, some pages before, we make mention of one feast +that they had together; but now to feast them was a thing more common: +every day with Mansoul was a feast-day now. Nor did he, when they +returned to their places, send them empty away, either they must have +a ring, a gold chain, a bracelet, a white stone, or something; so dear +was Mansoul to him now; so lovely was Mansoul in his eyes.<br> +<br> +Second. When the elders and townsmen did not come to him, he would +send in much plenty of provision unto them; meat that came from court, +wine and bread that were prepared for his Father’s table; yea, +such delicates would he send unto them, and therewith would so cover +their table, that whoever saw it confessed that the like could not be +seen in any kingdom.<br> +<br> +Third. If Mansoul did not frequently visit him as he desired they +should, he would walk out to them, knock at their doors, and desire +entrance, that amity might be maintained betwixt them and him; if they +did hear and open to him, as commonly they would, if they were at home, +then would he renew his former love, and confirm it too with some new +tokens, and signs of continued favour.<br> +<br> +And was it not now amazing to behold, that in that very place where +sometimes Diabolus had his abode, and entertained his Diabolonians to +the almost utter destruction of Mansoul, the Prince of princes should +sit eating and drinking with them, while all his mighty captains, men +of war, trumpeters, with the singing-men and singing-women of his Father, +stood round about to wait upon them! Now did Mansoul’s cup +run over, now did her conduits run sweet wine, now did she eat the finest +of the wheat, and drink milk and honey out of the rock! Now, she +said, How great is his goodness! for since I found favour in his eyes, +how honourable have I been!<br> +<br> +The blessed Prince did also ordain a new officer in the town, and a +goodly person he was; his name was Mr. God’s-Peace: this man was +set over my Lord Willbewill, my Lord Mayor, Mr. Recorder, the subordinate +preacher, Mr. Mind, and over all the natives of the town of Mansoul. +Himself was not a native of it, but came with the Prince Emmanuel from +the court. He was a great acquaintance of Captain Credence and +Captain Good-Hope; some say they were kin, and I am of that opinion +too. This man, as I said, was made governor of the town in general, +especially over the castle, and Captain Credence was to help him there. +And I made great observation of it, that so long as all things went +in Mansoul as this sweet-natured gentleman would, the town was in most +happy condition. Now there were no jars, no chiding, no interferings, +no unfaithful doings in all the town of Mansoul; every man in Mansoul +kept close to his own employment. The gentry, the officers, the +soldiers, and all in place observed their order. And as for the +women and children of the town, they followed their business joyfully; +they would work and sing, work and sing, from morning till night: so +that quite through the town of Mansoul now nothing was to be found but +harmony, quietness, joy, and health. And this lasted all that +summer.<br> +<br> +But there was a man in the town of Mansoul, and his name was Mr. Carnal-Security; +this man did, after all this mercy bestowed on this corporation, bring +the town of Mansoul into great and grievous slavery and bondage. +A brief account of him and of his doings take as followeth:-<br> +<br> +When Diabolus at first took possession of the town of Mansoul, he brought +thither, with himself, a great number of Diabolonians, men of his own +conditions. Now among these there was one whose name was Mr. Self-Conceit, +and a notable brisk man he was, as any that in those days did possess +the town of Mansoul. Diabolus, then, perceiving this man to be +active and bold, sent him upon many desperate designs, the which he +managed better, and more to the pleasing of his lord, than most that +came with him from the dens could do. Wherefore, finding him so +fit for his purpose, he preferred him, and made him next to the great +Lord Willbewill, of whom we have written so much before. Now the +Lord Willbewill being in those days very well pleased with him, and +with his achievements, gave him his daughter, the Lady Fear-Nothing, +to wife. Now, of my Lady Fear-nothing, did this Mr. Self-Conceit +beget this gentleman, Mr. Carnal-Security. Wherefore, there being +then in Mansoul those strange kinds of mixtures, it was hard for them, +in some cases, to find out who were natives, who not, for Mr. Carnal-Security +sprang from my Lord Willbewill by mother’s side, though he had +for his father a Diabolonian by nature.<br> +<br> +Well, this Carnal-Security took much after his father and mother; he +was self-conceited, he feared nothing, he was also a very busy man: +nothing of news, nothing of doctrine, nothing of alteration, or talk +of alteration, could at any time be on foot in Mansoul, but be sure +Mr. Carnal-Security would be at the head or tail of it: but, to be sure, +he would decline those that he deemed the weakest, and stood always +with them in his way of standing, that he supposed was the strongest +side.<br> +<br> +Now, when Shaddai the mighty, and Emmanuel his Son, made war upon Mansoul, +to take it, this Mr. Carnal-Security was then in town, and was a great +doer among the people, encouraging them in their rebellion, putting +them upon hardening themselves in their resisting the King’s forces: +but when he saw that the town of Mansoul was taken, and converted to +the use of the glorious Prince Emmanuel; and when he also saw what was +become of Diabolus, and how he was unroosted, and made to quit the castle +in the greatest contempt and scorn; and that the town of Mansoul was +well lined with captains, engines of war, and men, and also provision; +what doth he but slyly wheel about also; and as he had served Diabolus +against the good Prince, so he feigned that he would serve the Prince +against his foes.<br> +<br> +And having got some little smattering of Emmanuel’s things by +the end, being bold, he ventures himself into the company of the townsmen, +any attempts also to chat among them. Now he knew that the power +and strength of the town of Mansoul was great, and that it could not +but be pleasing to the people, if he cried up their might and their +glory. Wherefore he beginneth his tale with the power and strength +of Mansoul, and affirmed that it was impregnable; now magnifying their +captains and their slings, and their rams; then crying up their fortifications +and strongholds; and, lastly, the assurances that they had from their +Prince, that Mansoul should be happy for ever. But when he saw +that some of the men of the town were tickled and taken with his discourse, +he makes it his business, and walking from street to street, house to +house, and man to man, he at last brought Mansoul to dance after his +pipe, and to grow almost as carnally secure as himself; so from talking +they went to feasting, and from feasting to sporting; and so to some +other matters. Now Emmanuel was yet in the town of Mansoul, and +he wisely observed their doings. My Lord Mayor, my Lord Willbewill, +and Mr. Recorder were also all taken with the words of this tattling +Diabolonian gentleman, forgetting that their Prince had given them warning +before to take heed that they were not beguiled with any Diabolonian +sleight; he had further told them that the security of the now flourishing +town of Mansoul did not so much lie in her present fortifications and +force, as in her so using of what she had, as might oblige her Emmanuel +to abide within her castle. For the right doctrine of Emmanuel +was, that the town of Mansoul should take heed that they forgot not +his Father’s love and his; also, that they should so demean themselves +as to continue to keep themselves therein. Now this was not the +way to do it, namely, to fall in love with one of the Diabolonians, +and with such an one too as Mr. Carnal-Security was, and to be led up +and down by the nose by him; they should have heard their Prince, feared +their Prince, loved their Prince, and have stoned this naughty pack +to death, and took care to have walked in the ways of their Prince’s +prescribing: for then should their peace have been as a river, when +their righteousness had been like the waves of the sea.<br> +<br> +Now when Emmanuel perceived that through the policy of Mr. Carnal-Security +the hearts of the men of Mansoul were chilled and abated in their practical +love to him,<br> +<br> +First. He bemoans them, and, condoles their state with the Secretary, +saying, ‘Oh that my people had hearkened unto me, and that Mansoul +had walked in my ways! I would have fed them with the finest of +the wheat; and with honey out of the rock would I have sustained them.’ +This done, he said in his heart, ‘I will return to the court, +and go to my place, till Mansoul shall consider and acknowledge their +offence.’ And he did so, and the cause and manner of his +going away from them was, that Mansoul declined him, as is manifest +in these particulars.<br> +<br> +‘1. They left off their former way of visiting him, they came +not to his royal palace as afore.<br> +<br> +‘2. They did not regard, nor yet take notice, that he came or +came not to visit them.<br> +<br> +‘3. The love-feasts that had wont to be between their Prince and +them, though he made them still, and called them to them, yet they neglected +to come to them, or to be delighted with them.<br> +<br> +‘4. They waited not for his counsels, but began to be headstrong +and confident in themselves, concluding that now they were strong and +invincible, and that Mansoul was secure, and beyond all reach of the +foe, and that her state must needs be unalterable for ever.’<br> +<br> +Now, as was said, Emmanuel perceiving that by the craft of Mr. Carnal-Security, +the town of Mansoul was taken off from their dependence upon him, and +upon his Father by him, and set upon what by them was bestowed upon +it; he first, as I said, bemoaned their state, then he used means to +make them understand that the way that they went on in was dangerous: +for he sent my Lord High Secretary to them, to forbid them such ways; +but twice when he came to them, he found them at dinner in Mr. Carnal-Security’s +parlour; and perceiving also that they were not willing to reason about +matters concerning their good, he took grief and went his way; the which +when he had told to the Prince Emmanuel, he took offence, and was grieved +also, and so made provision to return to his Father’s court.<br> +<br> +Now, the methods of his withdrawing, as I was saying before, were thus:-<br> +<br> +‘1. Even while he was yet with them in Mansoul, he kept himself +close, and more retired than formerly.<br> +<br> +‘2. His speech was not now, if he came in their company, so pleasant +and familiar as formerly.<br> +<br> +‘3. Nor did he, as in times past, send to Mansoul, from his table, +those dainty bits which he was wont to do.<br> +<br> +‘4. Nor when they came to visit him, as now and then they would, +would he be so easily spoken with as they found him to be in times past. +They might now knock once, yea, twice, but he would seem not at all +to regard them; whereas formerly at the sound of their feet he would +up and run, and meet them halfway, and take them too, and lay them in +his bosom.’<br> +<br> +But thus Emmanuel carried it now, and by this his carriage he sought +to make them bethink themselves, and return to him. But, alas! +they did not consider, they did not know his ways, they regarded not, +they were not touched with these, nor with the true remembrance of former +favours. Wherefore what does he but in private manner withdraw +himself, first from his palace, then to the gate of the town, and so +away from Mansoul he goes, till they should acknowledge their offence, +and more earnestly seek his face. Mr. God’s-Peace also laid +down his commission, and would for the present act no longer in the +town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +Thus they walked contrary to him, and he again, by way of retaliation, +walked contrary to them. But, alas! by this time they were so +hardened in their way, and had so drunk in the doctrine of Mr. Carnal-Security, +that the departing of their Prince touched them not, nor was he remembered +by them when gone; and so, of consequence, his absence not condoled +by them.<br> +<br> +Now, there was a day wherein this old gentleman, Mr. Carnal-Security, +did again make a feast for the town of Mansoul; and there was at that +time in the town one Mr. Godly-Fear, one now but little set by, though +formerly one of great request. This man, old Carnal-Security, +had a mind, if possible, to gull, and debauch, and abuse, as he did +the rest, and therefore he now bids him to the feast with his neighbours. +So the day being come, they prepare, and he goes and appears with the +rest of the guests; and being all set at the table, they did eat and +drink, and were merry, even all but this one man: for Mr. Godly-Fear +sat like a stranger, and did neither eat nor was merry. The which, +when Mr. Carnal-Security perceived, he presently addressed himself in +a speech thus to him:-<br> +<br> +‘Mr. Godly-Fear, are you not well? You seem to be ill of +body or mind, or both. I have a cordial of Mr. Forget-Good’s +making, the which, sir, if you will take a dram of, I hope it may make +you bonny and blithe, and so make you more fit for us, feasting companions.’<br> +<br> +Unto whom the good old gentleman discreetly replied, ‘Sir, I thank +you for all things courteous and civil; but for your cordial I have +no list thereto. But a word to the natives of Mansoul: You, the +elders and chief of Mansoul, to me it is strange to see you so jocund +and merry, when the town of Mansoul is in such woeful case.’<br> +<br> +Then said Mr. Carnal-Security, ‘You want sleep, good air, I doubt. +If you please, lie down, and take a nap, and we meanwhile will be merry.’<br> +<br> +Then said the good man as follows: ‘Sir, if you were not destitute +of an honest heart, you could not do as you have done and do.’<br> +<br> +Then said Mr. Carnal-Security, ‘Why?’<br> +<br> +<i>Godly</i>. Nay, pray interrupt me not. It is true the +town of Mansoul was strong, and, with a <i>proviso</i>, impregnable; +but you, the townsmen, have weakened it, and it now lies obnoxious to +its foes. Nor is it a time to flatter, or be silent; it is you, +Mr. Carnal-Security, that have wilily stripped Mansoul, and driven her +glory from her; you have pulled down her towers, you have broken down +her gates, you have spoiled her locks and bars.<br> +<br> +And now, to explain myself: from that time that my lords of Mansoul, +and you, sir, grew so great, from that time the Strength of Mansoul +has been offended, and now he is arisen and is gone. If any shall +question the truth of my words, I will answer him by this, and suchlike +questions. ‘Where is the Prince Emmanuel? When did +a man or woman in Mansoul see him? When did you hear from him, +or taste any of his dainty bits?’ You are now a feasting +with this Diabolonian monster, but he is not your Prince. I say, +therefore, though enemies from without, had you taken heed, could not +have made a prey of you, yet since you have sinned against your Prince, +your enemies within have been too hard for you.<br> +<br> +Then said Mr. Carnal-Security, ‘Fie! fie! Mr. Godly-Fear, +fie! - will you never shake off your <i>timorousness</i>? Are +you afraid of being sparrow-blasted? Who hath hurt you? +Behold, I am on your side; only you are for doubting, and I am for being +confident. Besides, is this a time to be sad in? A feast +is made for mirth; why, then, do you now, to your shame, and our trouble, +break out into such passionate melancholy language, when you should +eat and drink, and be merry?’<br> +<br> +Then said Mr. Godly-Fear again, ‘I may well be sad, for Emmanuel +is gone from Mansoul. I say again, he is gone, and you, sir, are +the man that has driven him away; yea, he is gone without so much as +acquainting the nobles of Mansoul with his going; and if that is not +a sign of his anger, I am not acquainted with the methods of godliness.<br> +<br> +‘And now, my lords and gentlemen, for my speech is still to you, +your gradual declining from him did provoke him gradually to depart +from you, the which he did for some time, if perhaps you would have +been made sensible thereby, and have been renewed by humbling yourselves; +but when he saw that none would regard, nor lay these fearful beginnings +of his anger and judgment to heart, he went away from this place; and +this I saw with mine eye. Wherefore now, while you boast, your +strength is gone; you are like the man that had lost his locks that +before did wave about his shoulders. You may, with this lord of +your feast, shake yourselves, and conclude to do as at other times; +but since without him you can do nothing, and he is departed from you, +turn your feast into a sigh, and your mirth into lamentation.’<br> +<br> +Then the subordinate preacher, old Mr. Conscience by name, he that of +old was Recorder of Mansoul, being startled at what was said, began +to second it thus:-<br> +<br> +‘Indeed, my brethren,’ quoth he, ‘I fear that Mr. +Godly-Fear tells us true: I, for my part, have not seen my Prince a +long season. I cannot remember the day, for my part; nor can I +answer Mr. Godly-Fear’s question. I doubt, I am afraid that +all is nought with Mansoul.’<br> +<br> +<i>Godly</i>. Nay, I know that you shall not find him in Mansoul, +for he is departed and gone; yea, and gone for the faults of the elders, +and for that they rewarded his grace with unsufferable unkindness.<br> +<br> +Then did the subordinate preacher look as if he would fall down dead +at the table; also all there present, except the man of the house, began +to look pale and wan. But having a little recovered themselves, +and jointly agreeing to believe Mr. Godly-Fear and his sayings, they +began to consult what was best to be done, (now Mr. Carnal-Security +was gone into his withdrawing-room, for he liked not such dumpish doings,) +both to the man of the house for drawing them into evil, and also to +recover Emmanuel’s love.<br> +<br> +And, with that, that saying of their Prince came very hot into their +minds, which he had bidden them do to such as were false prophets that +should arise to delude the town of Mansoul. So they took Mr. Carnal-Security +(concluding that he must be he) and burned his house upon him with fire; +for he also was a Diabolonian by nature.<br> +<br> +So when this was passed and over, they bespeed themselves to look for +Emmanuel their Prince; and they sought him, but they found him not. +Then were they more confirmed in the truth of Mr. Godly-Fear’s +sayings, and began also severely to reflect upon themselves for their +so vile and ungodly doings; for they concluded now that it was through +them that their Prince had left them.<br> +<br> +Then they agreed and went to my Lord Secretary, (him whom before they +refused to hear - him whom they had grieved with their doings,) to know +of him, for he was a seer, and could tell where Emmanuel was, and how +they might direct a petition to him. But the Lord Secretary would +not admit them to a conference about this matter, nor would admit them +to his royal place of abode, nor come out to them to show them his face +or intelligence.<br> +<br> +And now was it a day gloomy and dark, a day of clouds and of thick darkness +with Mansoul. Now they saw that they had been foolish, and began +to perceive what the company and prattle of Mr. Carnal-Security had +done, and what desperate damage his swaggering words had brought poor +Mansoul into. But what further it was likely to cost them they +were ignorant of. Now Mr. Godly-Fear began again to be in repute +with the men of the town; yea, they were ready to look upon him as a +prophet.<br> +<br> +Well, when the Sabbath day was come, they went to hear their subordinate +preacher; but oh, how he did thunder and lighten this day! His +text was that in the prophet Jonah: ‘They that observe lying vanities +forsake their own mercy.’ But there was then such power +and authority in that sermon, and such a dejection seen in the countenances +of the people that day, that the like hath seldom been heard or seen. +The people, when sermon was done, were scarce able to go to their homes, +or to betake themselves to their employs the week after; they were so +sermon-smitten, and also so sermon-sick by being smitten, that they +knew not what to do.<br> +<br> +He did not only show to Mansoul their sin, but did tremble before them, +under the sense of his own, still crying out of himself, as he preached +to them, ‘Unhappy man that I am! that I should do so wicked a +thing! That I, a preacher! whom the Prince did set up to teach +to Mansoul his law, should myself live senseless and sottishly here, +and be one of the first found in transgression! This transgression +also fell within my precincts; I should have cried out against the wickedness; +but I let Mansoul lie wallowing in it, until it had driven Emmanuel +from its borders!’ With these things he also charged all +the lords and gentry of Mansoul, to the almost distracting of them.<br> +<br> +About this time, also, there was a great sickness in the town of Mansoul, +and most of the inhabitants were greatly afflicted. Yea, the captains +also, and men of war, were brought thereby to a languishing condition, +and that for a long time together; so that in case of an invasion, nothing +could to purpose now have been done, either by the townsmen or field +officers. Oh, how many pale faces, weak hands, feeble knees, and +staggering men were now seen to walk the streets of Mansoul! Here +were groans, there pants, and yonder lay those that were ready to faint.<br> +<br> +The garments, too, which Emmanuel had given them were but in a sorry +case; some were rent, some were torn, and all in a nasty condition; +some also did hang so loosely upon them, that the next bush they came +at was ready to pluck them off.<br> +<br> +After some time spent in this sad and desolate condition, the subordinate +preacher called for a day of fasting, and to humble themselves for being +so wicked against the great Shaddai and his Son. And he desired +that Captain Boanerges would preach. So he consented to do it; +and the day being come, and his text was this, ‘Cut it down, why +cumbereth it the ground?’ And a very smart sermon he made +upon the place. First, he showed what was the occasion of the +words, namely, because the fig-tree was barren; then he showed what +was contained in the sentence, namely, repentance, or utter desolation. +He then showed, also, by whose authority this sentence was pronounced, +and that was by Shaddai himself. And, lastly, he showed the reasons +of the point, and then concluded his sermon. But he was very pertinent +in the application, insomuch that he made poor Mansoul tremble. +For this sermon, as well as the former, wrought much upon the hearts +of the men of Mansoul; yea, it greatly helped to keep awake those that +were roused by the preaching that went before. So that now throughout +the whole town, there was little or nothing to be heard or seen but +sorrow, and mourning, and woe.<br> +<br> +Now, after sermon, they got together and consulted what was best to +be done. ‘But,’ said the subordinate preacher, ‘I +will do nothing of mine own head, without advising with my neighbour +Mr. Godly-Fear. For if he had aforehand understood more of the +mind of our Prince than we, I do not know but he also may have it now, +even now we are turning again to virtue.’<br> +<br> +So they called and sent for Mr. Godly-Fear, and he forthwith appeared. +Then they desired that he would further show his opinion about what +they had best to do. Then said the old gentleman as followeth: ‘It +is my opinion that this town of Mansoul should, in this day of her distress, +draw up and send an humble petition to their offended Prince Emmanuel, +that he, in his favour and grace, will turn again unto you, and not +keep anger for ever.’<br> +<br> +When the townsmen had heard this speech, they did, with one consent, +agree to his advice; so they did presently draw up their request, and +the next was, But who shall carry it? At last they did all agree +to send it by my Lord Mayor. So he accepted of the service, and +addressed himself to his journey; and went and came to the court of +Shaddai, whither Emmanuel the Prince of Mansoul was gone. But +the gate was shut, and a strict watch kept thereat; so that the petitioner +was forced to stand without for a great while together. Then he +desired that some would go into the Prince and tell him who stood at +the gate, and what his business was. So one went and told to Shaddai, +and to Emmanuel his Son, that the Lord Mayor of the town of Mansoul +stood without at the gate of the King’s court, desiring to be +admitted into the presence of the Prince, the King’s Son. +He also told what was the Lord Mayor’s errand, both to the King +and his Son Emmanuel. But the Prince would not come down, nor +admit that the gate should be opened to him, but sent him an answer +to this effect: ‘They have turned their back unto me, and not +their face; but now in the time of their trouble they say to me, Arise, +and save us. But can they not now go to Mr. Carnal-Security, to +whom they went when they turned from me, and make him their leader, +their lord, and their protection now in their trouble; why now in their +trouble do they visit me, since in their prosperity they went astray?’<br> +<br> +The answer made my Lord Mayor look black in the face; it troubled, it +perplexed, it rent him sore. And now he began again to see what +it was to be familiar with Diabolonians, such as Mr. Carnal-Security +was. When he saw that at court, as yet, there was little help +to be expected, either for himself or friends in Mansoul, he smote upon +his breast, and returned weeping, and all the way bewailing the lamentable +state of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +Well, when he was come within sight of the town, the elders and chief +of the people of Mansoul went out at the gate to meet him, and to salute +him, and to know how he sped at court. But he told them his tale +in so doleful a manner, that they all cried out, and mourned, and wept. +Wherefore they threw ashes and dust upon their heads, and put sackcloth +upon their loins, and went crying out through the town of Mansoul; the +which, when the rest of the townsfolk saw, they all mourned and wept. +This, therefore, was a day of rebuke and trouble, and of anguish to +the town of Mansoul, and also of great distress.<br> +<br> +After some time, when they had somewhat refrained themselves, they came +together to consult again what by them was yet to be done; and they +asked advice, as they did before, of that reverend Mr. Godly-Fear, who +told them that there was no way better than to do as they had done, +nor would he that they should be discouraged at all with that they had +met with at court; yea, though several of their petitions should be +answered with nought but silence or rebuke: ‘For,’ said +he, ‘it is the way of the wise Shaddai to make men wait and to +exercise patience, and it should be the way of them in want, to be willing +to stay his leisure.<br> +<br> +Then they took courage, and sent again and again, and again, and again; +for there was not now one day, nor an hour that went over Mansoul’s +head, wherein a man might not have met upon the road one or other riding +post, sounding the horn from Mansoul to the court of the King Shaddai; +and all with letters petitionary in behalf of, and for the Prince’s +return to Mansoul. The road, I say, was now full of messengers, +going and returning, and meeting one another; some from the court, and +some from Mansoul; and this was the work of the miserable town of Mansoul, +all that long, that sharp, that cold and tedious winter.<br> +<br> +Now if you have not forgot, you may yet remember that I told you before, +that after Emmanuel had taken Mansoul, yea, and after that he had new +modelled the town, there remained in several lurking places of the corporation +many of the old Diabolonians, that either came with the tyrant when +he invaded and took the town, or that had there, by reason of unlawful +mixtures, their birth and breeding, and bringing up. And their +holes, dens, and lurking places were in, under, or about the wall of +the town. Some of their names are the Lord Fornication, the Lord +Adultery, the Lord Murder, the Lord Anger, the Lord Lasciviousness, +the Lord Deceit, the Lord Evil-eye, the Lord Blasphemy, and that horrible +villain, the old and dangerous Lord Covetousness. These, as I +told you, with many more, had yet their abode in the town of Mansoul, +and that after that Emmanuel had driven their prince Diabolus out of +the castle.<br> +<br> +Against these the good Prince did grant a commission to the Lord Willbewill +and others, yea, to the whole town of Mansoul, to seek, take, secure, +and destroy any or all that they could lay hands of, for that they were +Diabolonians by nature, enemies to the Prince, and those that sought +to ruin the blessed town of Mansoul. But the town of Mansoul did +not pursue this warrant, but neglected to look after, to apprehend, +to secure, and to destroy these Diabolonians. Wherefore what do +these villains but by degrees take courage to put forth their heads, +and to show themselves to the inhabitants of the town. Yea, and +as I was told, some of the men of Mansoul grew too familiar with some +of them, to the sorrow of the corporation, as you yet will hear more +of in time and place.<br> +<br> +Well, when the Diabolonian lords that were left perceived that Mansoul +had, through sinning, offended Emmanuel their Prince, and that he had +withdrawn himself and was gone, what do they but plot the ruin of the +town of Mansoul. So upon a time they met together at the hold +of one Mr. Mischief, who was also a Diabolonian, and there consulted +how they might deliver up Mansoul into the hands of Diabolus again. +Now some advised one way, and some another, every man according to his +own liking. At last my Lord Lasciviousness propounded, whether +it might not be best, in the first place, for some of those that were +Diabolonians in Mansoul, to adventure to offer themselves for servants +to some of the natives of the town; ‘for,’ said he, ‘if +they so do, and Mansoul shall accept of them, they may for us, and for +Diabolus our Lord, make the taking of the town of Mansoul more easy +than otherwise it will be.’ But then stood up the Lord Murder, +and said, ‘This may not be done at this time; for Mansoul is now +in a kind of a rage, because by our friend, Mr. Carnal-Security, she +hath been once ensnared already, and made to offend against her Prince; +and how shall she reconcile herself unto her lord again, but by the +heads of these men? Besides, we know that they have in commission +to take and slay us wherever they shall find us; let us, therefore, +be wise as foxes: when we are dead, we can do them no hurt; but while +we live, we may.’ Thus, when they had tossed the matter +to and fro, they jointly agreed that a letter should forthwith be sent +away to Diabolus in their name, by which the state of the town of Mansoul +should be showed him, and how much it is under the frowns of their Prince. +‘We may also,’ said some, ‘let him know our intentions, +and ask of him his advice in the case.’<br> +<br> +So a letter was presently framed, the contents of which were these:-<br> +<br> +‘To our great lord, the Prince Diabolus, dwelling below in the +infernal cave:<br> +<br> +‘O great father, and mighty Prince Diabolus, we, the true Diabolonians +yet remaining in the rebellious town of Mansoul, having received our +beings from thee, and our nourishment at thy hands, cannot with content +and quiet endure to behold, as we do this day, how thou art dispraised, +disgraced, and reproached among the inhabitants of this town; nor is +thy long absence at all delightful to us, because greatly to our detriment.<br> +<br> +‘The reason of this our writing unto our lord, is for that we +are not altogether without hope that this town may become thy habitation +again; for it is greatly declined from its Prince Emmanuel; and he is +uprisen, and is departed from them: yea, and though they send, and send, +and send, and send after him to return to them, yet can they not prevail, +nor get good words from him.<br> +<br> +‘There has been also of late, and is yet remaining, a very great +sickness and fainting among them; and that not only upon the poorer +sort of the town, but upon the lords, captains, and chief gentry of +the place, (we only who are of the Diabolonians by nature remain well, +lively, and strong,) so that through their great transgression on the +one hand, and their dangerous sickness on the other, we judge they lie +open to thy hand and power. If, therefore, it shall stand with +thy horrible cunning, and with the cunning of the rest of the princes +with thee, to come and make an attempt to take Mansoul again, send us +word, and we shall to our utmost power be ready to deliver it into thy +hand. Or if what we have said shall not by thy fatherhood be thought +best and most meet to be done, send us thy mind in a few words, and +we are all ready to follow thy counsel to the hazarding of our lives, +and what else we have.<br> +<br> +‘Given under our hands the day and date above-written, after a +close consultation at the house of Mr. Mischief, who yet is alive and +hath his place in our desirable town of Mansoul.’<br> +<br> +When Mr. Profane (for he was the carrier) was come with his letter to +Hell-Gate Hill, he knocked at the brazen gates for entrance. Then +did Cerberus, the porter, for he is the keeper of that gate, open to +Mr. Profane, to whom he delivered his letter, which he had brought from +the Diabolonians in Mansoul. So he carried it in, and presented +it to Diabolus his lord, and said, ‘Tidings, my lord, from Mansoul, +from our trusty friends in Mansoul.’<br> +<br> +Then came together from all places of the den Beelzebub, Lucifer, Apollyon, +with the rest of the rabblement there, to hear what news from Mansoul. +So the letter was broken up and read, and Cerberus he stood by. +When the letter was openly read, and the contents thereof spread into +all the corners of the den, command was given that, without let or stop, +dead-man’s bell should be rung for joy. So the bell was +rung, and the princes rejoiced that Mansoul was likely to come to ruin. +Now, the clapper of the bell went, ‘The town of Mansoul is coming +to dwell with us: make room for the town of Mansoul.’ This +bell therefore they did ring, because they did hope that they should +have Mansoul again.<br> +<br> +Now, when they had performed this their horrible ceremony, they got +together again to consult what answer to send to their friends in Mansoul; +and some advised one thing, and some another: but at length, because +the business required haste, they left the whole business to the prince +Diabolus, judging him the most proper lord of the place. So he +drew up a letter as he thought fit, in answer to what Mr. Profane had +brought, and sent it to the Diabolonians that did dwell in Mansoul, +by the same hand that had brought theirs to him; and these were the +contents thereof:-<br> +<br> +‘To our offspring, the high and mighty Diabolonians that yet dwell +in the town of Mansoul, Diabolus, the great prince of Mansoul, wisheth +a prosperous issue and conclusion of those many brave enterprises, conspiracies, +and designs, that you, of your love and respect to our honour, have +in your hearts to attempt to do against Mansoul. Beloved children +and disciples, my Lord Fornication, Adultery, and the rest, we have +here, in our desolate den, received, to our highest joy and content, +your welcome letter, by the hand of our trusty Mr. Profane; and to show +how acceptable your tidings were, we rang out our bell for gladness; +for we rejoiced as much as we could, when we perceived that yet we had +friends in Mansoul, and such as sought our honour and revenge in the +ruin of the town of Mansoul. We also rejoiced to hear that they +are in a degenerated condition, and that they have offended their Prince, +and that he is gone. Their sickness also pleaseth us, as does +also your health, might, and strength. Glad also would we be, +right horribly beloved, could we get this town into our clutches again. +Nor will we be sparing of spending our wit, our cunning, our craft, +and hellish inventions to bring to a wished conclusion this your brave +beginning in order thereto.<br> +<br> +‘And take this for your comfort, (our birth, and our offspring,) +that shall we again surprise it and take it, we will attempt to put +all your foes to the sword, and will make you the great lords and captains +of the place. Nor need you fear, if ever we get it again, that +we after that shall be cast out any more; for we will come with more +strength, and so lay far more fast hold than at the first we did. +Besides, it is the law of that Prince that now they own, that if we +get them a second time, they shall be ours for ever.<br> +<br> +‘Do you, therefore, our trusty Diabolonians, yet more pry into, +and endeavour to spy out the weakness of the town of Mansoul. +We also would that you yourselves do attempt to weaken them more and +more. Send us word also by what means you think we had best to +attempt the regaining thereof: namely, whether by persuasion to a vain +and loose life; or, whether by tempting them to doubt and despair; or, +whether by blowing up of the town by the gunpowder of pride, and self-conceit. +Do you also, O ye brave Diabolonians, and true sons of the pit, be always +in a readiness to make a most hideous assault within, when we shall +be ready to storm it without. Now speed you in your project, and +we in our desires, to the utmost power of our gates, which is the wish +of your great Diabolus, Mansoul’s enemy, and him that trembles +when he thinks of judgment to come. All the blessings of the pit +be upon you, and so we close up our letter.<br> +<br> +‘Given at the pit’s mouth, by the joint consent of all the +princes of darkness, to be sent, to the force and power that we have +yet remaining in Mansoul, by the hand of Mr. Profane, by me, Diabolus.’<br> +<br> +This letter, as was said, was sent to Mansoul, to the Diabolonians that +yet remained there, and that yet inhabited the wall, from the dark dungeon +of Diabolus, by the hand of Mr. Profane, by whom they also in Mansoul +sent theirs to the pit. Now, when this Mr. Profane had made his +return, and was come to Mansoul again, he went and came as he was wont +to the house of Mr. Mischief, for there was the conclave, and the place +where the contrivers were met. Now, when they saw that their messenger +was returned safe and sound, they were greatly gladded thereat. +Then he presented them with his letter which he had brought from Diabolus +for them; the which, when they had read and considered, did much augment +their gladness. They asked him after the welfare of their friends, +as how their Lord Diabolus, Lucifer, and Beelzebub did, with the rest +of those of the den. To which this Profane made answer, ‘Well, +well, my lords; they are well, even as well as can be in their place. +They also,’ said he, ‘did ring for joy at the reading of +your letter, as you well perceived by this when you read it.’<br> +<br> +Now, as was said, when they had read their letter, and perceived that +it encouraged them in their work, they fell to their way of contriving +again, namely, how they might complete their Diabolonian design upon +Mansoul. And the first thing that they agreed upon was to keep +all things from Mansoul as close as they could. ‘Let it +not be known, let not Mansoul be acquainted with what we design against +it.’ The next thing was, how, or by what means, they should +try to bring to pass the ruin and overthrow of Mansoul; and one said +after this manner, and another said after that. Then stood up +Mr. Deceit, and said, ‘My right Diabolonian friends, our lords, +and the high ones of the deep dungeon, do propound unto us these three +ways.<br> +<br> +‘1. Whether we had best to seek its ruin by making Mansoul loose +and vain.<br> +<br> +‘2. Or whether by driving them to doubt and despair.<br> +<br> +‘3. Or whether by endeavouring to blow them up by the gunpowder +of pride and self-conceit.<br> +<br> +‘Now, I think, if we shall tempt them to pride, that may do something; +and if we tempt them to wantonness, that may help. But, in my +mind, if we could drive them into desperation, that would knock the +nail on the head; for then we should have them, in the first place, +question the truth of the love of the heart of their Prince towards +them, and that will disgust him much. This, if it works well, +will make them leave off quickly their way of sending petitions to him; +then farewell earnest solicitations for help and supply; for then this +conclusion lies naturally before them, “As good do nothing, as +do to no purpose.”’ So to Mr. Deceit they unanimously +did consent.<br> +<br> +Then the next question was, But how shall we do to bring this our project +to pass? and it was answered by the same gentleman - that this might +be the best way to do it: ‘Even let,’ quoth he, ‘so +many of our friends as are willing to venture themselves for the promoting +of their prince’s cause, disguise themselves with apparel, change +their names, and go into the market like far country-men, and proffer +to let themselves for servants to the famous town of Mansoul, and let +them pretend to do for their masters as beneficially as may be; for +by so doing they may, if Mansoul shall hire them, in little time so +corrupt and defile the corporation, that her now Prince shall be not +only further offended with them, but in conclusion shall spue them out +of his mouth. And when this is done, our prince Diabolus shall +prey upon them with ease: yea, of themselves they shall fall into the +mouth of the cater.’<br> +<br> +This project was no sooner propounded, but was as highly accepted, and +forward were all Diabolonians now to engage in so delicate an enterprise: +but it was not thought fit that all should do thus; wherefore they pitched +upon two or three, namely, the Lord Covetousness, the Lord Lasciviousness, +and the Lord Anger. The Lord Covetousness called himself by the +name of Prudent-Thrifty; the Lord Lasciviousness called himself by the +name of Harmless-Mirth; and the Lord Anger called himself by the name +of Good-Zeal.<br> +<br> +So upon a market-day they came into the market-place, three lusty fellows +they were to look on, and they were clothed in sheep’s russet, +which was also now in a manner as white as were the white robes of the +men of Mansoul. Now the men could speak the language of Mansoul +well. So when they were come into the market-place, and had offered +to let themselves to the townsmen, they were presently taken up; for +they asked but little wages, and promised to do their masters great +service.<br> +<br> +Mr. Mind hired Prudent-Thrifty, and Mr. Godly-Fear hired Good-Zeal. +True, this fellow Harmless-Mirth did hang a little in hand, and could +not so soon get him a master as the others did, because the town of +Mansoul was now in Lent, but after a while, because Lent was almost +out, the Lord Willbewill hired Harmless-Mirth to be both his waiting +man and his lackey: and thus they got them masters.<br> +<br> + These villains now being got thus far into the houses of the men +of Mansoul, quickly began to do great mischief therein; for, being filthy, +arch, and sly, they quickly corrupted the families where they were; +yea, they tainted their masters much, especially this Prudent-Thrifty, +and him they call Harmless-Mirth. True, he that went under the +visor of Good-Zeal, was not so well liked of his master; for he quickly +found that he was but a counterfeit rascal; the which when the fellow +perceived, with speed he made his escape from the house, or I doubt +not but his master had hanged him.<br> +<br> +Well, when these vagabonds had thus far carried on their design, and +had corrupted the town as much as they could, in the next place they +considered with themselves at what time their prince Diabolus without, +and themselves within the town, should make an attempt to seize upon +Mansoul; and they all agreed upon this, that a market-day would be best +for that work; for why? Then will the townsfolk be busy in their +ways: and always take this for a rule, when people are most busy in +the world, they least fear a surprise. ‘We also then,’ +said they, ‘shall be able with less suspicion to gather ourselves +together for the work of our friends and lords; yea, and in such a day, +if we shall attempt our work, and miss it, we may, when they shall give +us the rout, the better hide ourselves in the crowd, and escape.’<br> +<br> +These things being thus far agreed upon by them, they wrote another +letter to Diabolus, and sent it by the hand to Mr. Profane, the contents +of which were these:-<br> +<br> +‘The lords of Looseness send to the great and high Diabolus from +our dens, caves, holes, and strongholds, in and about the wall of the +town of Mansoul, greeting:<br> +<br> +‘Our great lord, and the nourisher of our lives, Diabolus - how +glad we were when we heard of your fatherhood’s readiness to comply +with us, and help forward our design in our attempts to ruin Mansoul, +none can tell but those who, as we do, set themselves against all appearance +of good, when and wheresoever we find it.<br> +<br> +‘Touching the encouragement that your greatness is pleased to +give us to continue to devise, contrive, and study the utter desolation +of Mansoul, that we are not solicitous about: for we know right well +that it cannot but be pleasing and profitable to us to see our enemies, +and them that seek our lives, die at our feet, or fly before us. +We therefore are still contriving, and that to the best of our cunning, +to make this work most facile and easy to your lordships, and to us.<br> +<br> +‘First, we considered of that most hellishly cunning, compacted, +threefold project, that by you was propounded to us in your last; and +have concluded, that though to blow them up with the gunpowder of pride +would do well, and to do it by tempting them to be loose and vain will +help on, yet to contrive to bring them into the gulf of desperation, +we think will do best of all. Now we, who are at your beck, have +thought or two ways to do this: first we, for our parts, will make them +as vile as we can, and then you with us, at a time appointed, shall +be ready to fall upon them with the utmost force. And of all the +nations that are at your whistle, we think that an army of doubters +may be the most likely to attack and overcome the town of Mansoul. +Thus shall we overcome these enemies, else the pit shall open her mouth +upon them, and desperation shall thrust them down into it. We +have also, to effect this so much by us desired design, sent already +three of our trusty Diabolonians among them; they are disguised in garb, +they have changed their names, and are now accepted of them; namely, +Covetousness, Lasciviousness, and Anger. The name of Covetousness +is changed to Prudent-Thrifty, and him Mr. Mind has hired, and is almost +become as bad as our friend. Lasciviousness has changed his name +to Harmless-Mirth, and he is got to be the Lord Willbewill’s lackey; +but he has made his master very wanton. Anger changed his name +into Good-Zeal, and was entertained by Mr. Godly-Fear; but the peevish +old gentleman took pepper in the nose, and turned our companion out +of his house. Nay, he has informed us since that he ran away from +him, or else his old master had hanged him up for his labour.<br> +<br> +‘Now these have much helped forward our work and design upon Mansoul; +for notwithstanding the spite and quarrelsome temper of the old gentleman +last mentioned, the other two ply their business well, and are likely +to ripen the work apace.<br> +<br> +‘Our next project is, that it be concluded that you come upon +the town upon a market-day, and that when they are upon the heat of +their business; for then, to be sure, they will be most secure, and +least think that an assault will be made upon them. They will +also at such a time be less able to defend themselves, and to offend +you in the prosecution of our design. And we your trusty (and +we are sure your beloved) ones shall, when you shall make your furious +assault without, be ready to second the business within. So shall +we, in all likelihood, be able to put Mansoul to utter confusion, and +to swallow them up before they can come to themselves. If your +serpentine heads, most subtile dragons, and our highly esteemed lords +can find out a better way than this, let us quickly know your minds.<br> +<br> +‘To the monsters of the infernal cave, from the house of Mr. Mischief +in Mansoul, by the hand of Mr. Profane.’<br> +<br> +Now all the while that the raging runagates and hellish Diabolonians +were thus contriving the ruin of the town of Mansoul, they (namely, +the poor town itself) was in a sad and woeful case; partly because they +had so grievously offended Shaddai and his Son, and partly because that +the enemies thereby got strength within them afresh; and also because, +though they had by many petitions made suit to the Prince Emmanuel, +and to his Father Shaddai by him, for their pardon and favour, yet hitherto +obtained they not one smile; but contrariwise, through the craft and +subtilty of the domestic Diabolonians, their cloud was made to grow +blacker and blacker, and their Emmanuel to stand at further distance.<br> +<br> +The sickness also did still greatly rage in Mansoul, both among the +captains and the inhabitants of the town; and their enemies only were +now lively and strong, and likely to become the head, whilst Mansoul +was made the tail.<br> +<br> +By this time the letter last mentioned, that was written by the Diabolonians +that yet lurked in the town of Mansoul, was conveyed to Diabolus in +the black den, by the hand of Mr. Profane. He carried the letter +by Hell-Gate Hill as afore, and conveyed it by Cerberus to his lord.<br> +<br> +But when Cerberus and Mr. Profane did meet, they were presently as great +as beggars, and thus they fell into discourse about Mansoul, and about +the project against her.<br> +<br> +‘Ah! old friend,’ quoth Cerberus, ‘art thou come to +Hell-Gate Hill again? By St. Mary, I am glad to see thee!’<br> +<br> +<i>Prof</i>. Yes, my lord, I am come again about the concerns +of the town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +<i>Cerb</i>. Prithee, tell me what condition is that town of Mansoul +in at present?<br> +<br> +<i>Prof</i>. In a brave condition, my lord, for us, and for my +lords, the lords of this place, I trow for they are greatly decayed +as to godliness, and that is as well as our heart can wish; their Lord +is greatly out with them, and that doth also please us well. We +have already also a foot in their dish, for our Diabolonian friends +are laid in their bosoms, and what do we lack but to be masters of the +place! Besides, our trusty friends in Mansoul are daily plotting +to betray it to the lords of this town; also the sickness rages bitterly +among them; and that which makes up all, we hope at last to prevail.’<br> +<br> +Then said the dog of Hell-Gate, ‘No time like this to assault +them. I wish that the enterprise be followed close, and that the +success desired may be soon effected: yea, I wish it for the poor Diabolonians’ +sakes, that live in the continual fear of their lives in that traitorous +town of Mansoul.’<br> +<br> +<i>Prof</i>. The contrivance is almost finished, the lords in +Mansoul that are Diabolonians are at it day and night, and the other +are like silly doves; they want heart to be concerned with their state +and to consider that ruin is at hand. Besides you may, yea, must +think, when you put all things together, that there are many reasons +that prevail with Diabolus to make what haste he can.<br> +<br> +<i>Cerb</i>. Thou hast said as it is; I am glad things are at +this pass. Go in, my brave Profane, to my lords, they will give +thee for thy welcome as good a <i>coranto</i> as the whole of this kingdom +will afford. I have sent thy letter in already.<br> +<br> +Then Mr. Profane went into the den, and his lord Diabolus met him, and +saluted him with, ‘Welcome, my trusty servant: I have been made +glad with thy letter.’ The rest of the lords of the pit +gave him also their salutations. Then Profane, after obeisance +made to them all, said, ‘Let Mansoul be given to my lord Diabolus, +and let him be her king for ever.’ And with that, the hollow +belly and yawning gorge of hell gave so loud and hideous a groan, (for +that is the music of that place,) that it made the mountains about it +totter, as if they would fall in pieces.<br> +<br> +Now, after they had read and considered the letter, they consulted what +answer to return; and the first that did speak to it was Lucifer.<br> +<br> +Then said he, ‘The first project of the Diabolonians in Mansoul +is likely to be lucky, and to take; namely, that they will, by all the +ways and means they can, make Mansoul yet more vile and filthy: no way +to destroy a soul like this. Our old friend Balaam went this way +and prospered many years ago; let this therefore stand with us for a +maxim, and be to Diabolonians for a general rule in all ages; for nothing +can make this to fail but grace, in which I would hope that this town +has no share. But whether to fall upon them on a market-day, because +of their cumber in business, that I would should be under debate. +And there is more reason why this head should be debated, than why some +other should; because upon this will turn the whole of what we shall +attempt. If we time not our business well, our whole project may +fail. Our friends, the Diabolonians, say that a market-day is +best; for then will Mansoul be most busy, and have fewest thoughts of +a surprise. But what if also they should double their guards on +those days? (and methinks nature and reason should teach them to do +it;) and what if they should keep such a watch on those days as the +necessity of their present case doth require? yea, what if their men +should be always in arms on those days? then you may, my lords, be disappointed +in your attempts, and may bring our friends in the town to utter danger +of unavoidable ruin.’<br> +<br> +Then said the great Beelzebub, ‘There is something in what my +lord hath said; but his conjecture may, or may not fall out. Nor +hath my lord laid it down as that which must not be receded from; for +I know that he said it only to provoke to a warm debate thereabout. +Therefore we must understand, if we can, whether the town of Mansoul +has such sense and knowledge of her decayed state, and of the design +that we have on foot against her, as doth provoke her to set watch and +ward at her gates, and to double them on market-days. But if, +after inquiry made, it shall be found that they are asleep, then any +day will do, but a market-day is best; and this is my judgment in this +case.’<br> +<br> +Then quoth Diabolus, ‘How should we know this?’ and it was +answered, ‘Inquire about it at the mouth of Mr. Profane.’ +So Profane was called in, and asked the question, and he made his answer +as follows:-<br> +<br> +<i>Prof</i>. My lords, so far as I can gather, this is at present +the condition of the town of Mansoul: they are decayed in their faith +and love; Emmanuel, their Prince, has given them the back; they send +often by petition to fetch him again, but he maketh not haste to answer +their request, nor is there much reformation among them.<br> +<br> +<i>Diab</i>. I am glad that they are backward in a reformation, +but yet I am afraid of their petitioning. However, their looseness +of life is a sign that there is not much heart in what they do, and +without the heart things are little worth. But go on, my masters; +I will divert you, my lords, no longer.<br> +<br> +<i>Beel</i>. If the case be so with Mansoul, as Mr. Profane has +described it to be, it will be no great matter what day we assault it; +not their prayers, nor their power will do them much service.<br> +<br> +When Beelzebub had ended his oration, then Apollyon did begin. +‘My opinion,’ said he, ‘concerning this matter, is, +that we go on fair and softly, not doing things in a hurry. Let +our friends in Mansoul go on still to pollute and defile it, by seeking +to draw it yet more into sin (for there is nothing like sin to devour +Mansoul). If this be done, and it takes effect, Mansoul, of itself, +will leave off to watch, to petition, or anything else that should tend +to her security and safety; for she will forget her Emmanuel, she will +not desire his company, and can she be gotten thus to live, her Prince +will not come to her in haste. Our trusty friend, Mr. Carnal-Security, +with one of his tricks did drive him out of the town; and why may not +my Lord Covetousness, and my Lord Lasciviousness, by what they may do, +keep him out of the town? And this I will tell you, (not because +you know it not,) that two or three Diabolonians, if entertained and +countenanced by the town of Mansoul, will do more to the keeping of +Emmanuel from them, and towards making the town of Mansoul your own, +than can an army of a legion that should be sent out from us to withstand +him. Let, therefore, this first project that our friends in Mansoul +have set on foot, be strongly and diligently carried on, with all cunning +and craft imaginable; and let them send continually, under one guise +or another, more and other of their men to play with the people of Mansoul; +and then, perhaps, we shall not need to be at the charge of making a +war upon them; or if that must of necessity be done, yet the more sinful +they are, the more unable, to be sure, they will be to resist us, and +then the more easily we shall overcome them. And besides, suppose +(and that is the worst that can be supposed) that Emmanuel should come +to them again, why may not the same means, or the like, drive him from +them once more? Yea, why may he not, by their lapse into that +sin again, be driven from them for ever, for the sake of which he was +at the first driven from them for a season? And if this should +happen, then away go with him his rams, his slings, his captains, his +soldiers, and he leaveth Mansoul naked and bare. Yea, will not +this town, when she sees herself utterly forsaken of her Prince, of +her own accord open her gates again unto you, and make of you as in +the days of old? But this must be done by time, a few days will +not effect so great a work as this.’<br> +<br> +So soon as Apollyon had made an end of speaking, Diabolus began to blow +out his own malice, and to plead his own cause; and he said, ‘My +lords, and powers of the cave, my true and trusty friends, I have with +much impatience, as becomes me, given ear to your long and tedious orations. +But my furious gorge, and empty paunch, so lusteth after a repossession +of my famous town of Mansoul, that whatever comes out, I can wait no +longer to see the events of lingering projects. I must, and that +without further delay, seek, by all means I can, to fill my insatiable +gulf with the soul and body of the town of Mansoul. Therefore +lend me your heads, your hearts, and your help, now I am going to recover +my town of Mansoul.’<br> +<br> +When the lords and princes of the pit saw the flaming desire that was +in Diabolus to devour the miserable town of Mansoul, they left off to +raise any more objections, but consented to lend him what strength they +could, though had Apollyon’s advice been taken, they had far more +fearfully distressed the town of Mansoul. But, I say, they were +willing to lend him what strength they could, not knowing what need +they might have of him, when they should engage for themselves, as he. +Wherefore they fell to advising about the next thing propounded, namely, +what soldiers they were, and also how many, with whom Diabolus should +go against the town of Mansoul to take it; and after some debate, it +was concluded, according as in the letter the Diabolonians had suggested, +that none were more fit for that expedition than an army of terrible +doubters. They therefore concluded to send against Mansoul an +army of sturdy doubters. The number thought fit to be employed +in that service was between twenty and thirty thousand. So then +the result of that great council of those high and mighty lords was +- That Diabolus should even now, out of hand, beat up his drum for men +in the land of Doubting, which land lieth upon the confines of the place +called Hell-Gate Hill, for men that might be employed by him against +the miserable town of Mansoul. It was also concluded, that these +lords themselves should help him in the war, and that they would to +that end head and manage his men. So they drew up a letter, and +sent back to the Diabolonians that lurked in Mansoul, and that waited +for the back-coming of Mr. Profane, to signify to them into what method +and forwardness they at present had put their design. The contents +whereof now follow:-<br> +<br> +‘From the dark and horrible dungeon of hell, Diabolus with all +the society of the princes of darkness, sends to our trusty ones, in +and about the walls of the town of Mansoul, now impatiently waiting +for our most devilish answer to their venomous and most poisonous design +against the town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +‘Our native ones, in whom from day to day we boast, and in whose +actions all the year long we do greatly delight ourselves, we received +your welcome, because highly esteemed letter, at the hand of our trusty +and greatly beloved, the old gentleman, Mr. Profane. And do give +you to understand, that when we had broken it up, and had read the contents +thereof, to your amazing memory be it spoken, our yawning hollow-bellied +place, where we are, made so hideous and yelling a noise for joy, that +the mountains that stand round about Hell-Gate Hill, had like to have +been shaken to pieces at the sound thereof.<br> +<br> +‘We could also do no less than admire your faithfulness to us, +with the greatness of that subtilty that now hath showed itself to be +in your heads to serve us against the town of Mansoul. For you +have invented for us so excellent a method for our proceeding against +that rebellious people, a more effectual cannot be thought of by all +the wits of hell. The proposals, therefore, which now, at last, +you have sent us, since we saw them, we have done little else but highly +approved and admired them.<br> +<br> +‘Nay, we shall, to encourage you in the profundity of your craft, +let you know, that, at a full assembly and conclave of our princes and +principalities of this place, your project was discoursed and tossed +from one side of our cave to the other by their mightinesses; but a +better, and as was by themselves judged, a more fit and proper way by +all their wits, could not be invented, to surprise, take, and make our +own, the rebellious town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +‘Wherefore, in fine, all that was said that varied from what you +had in your letter propounded, fell of itself to the ground, and yours +only was stuck to by Diabolus, the prince; yea, his gaping gorge and +yawning paunch was on fire to put your invention into execution.<br> +<br> +‘We therefore give you to understand that our stout, furious, +and unmerciful Diabolus is raising, for your relief, and the ruin of +the rebellious town of Mansoul, more than twenty thousand doubters to +come against that people. They are all stout and sturdy men, and +men that of old have been accustomed to war, and that can therefore +well endure the drum. I say, he is doing this work of his with +all the possible speed he can; for his heart and spirit is engaged in +it. We desire, therefore, that, as you have hitherto stuck to +us, and given us both advice and encouragement thus far, you still will +prosecute our design; nor shall you lose, but be gainers thereby; yea, +we intend to make you the lords of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +‘One thing may not by any means be omitted, that is, those with +us do desire that every one of you that are in Mansoul would still use +all your power, cunning, and skill, with delusive persuasions, yet to +draw the town of Mansoul into more sin and wickedness, even that sin +may be finished and bring forth death.<br> +<br> +‘For thus it is concluded with us, that the more vile, sinful, +and debauched the town of Mansoul is, more backward will be their Emmanuel +to come to their help, either by presence or other relief; yea, the +more sinful, the more weak, and so the more unable will they be to make +resistance when we shall make our assault upon them to swallow them +up. Yea, that may cause that their mighty Shaddai himself may +cast them out of his protection; yea, and send for his captains and +soldiers home, with his slings and rams, and leave them naked and bare; +and then the town of Mansoul will of itself open to us, and fall as +the fig into the mouth of the eater. Yea, to be sure. that we +then with a great deal of ease shall come upon her and overcome her.<br> +<br> +‘As to the time of our coming upon Mansoul, we, as yet, have not +fully resolved upon that, though at present some of us think as you, +that a market-day, or a market-day at night, will certainly be the best. +However, do you be ready, and when you shall hear our roaring drum without, +do you be as busy to make the most horrible confusion within. +So shall Mansoul certainly be distressed before and behind, and shall +not know which way to betake herself for help. My Lord Lucifer, +my Lord Beelzebub, my Lord Apollyon, my Lord Legion, with the rest, +salute you, as does also my Lord Diabolus; and we wish both you, with +all that you do, or shall possess, the very self-same fruit and success +for their doing as we ourselves at present enjoy for ours.<br> +<br> +‘From our dreadful confines in the most fearful pit, we salute +you, and so do those many legions here with us, wishing you may be as +hellishly prosperous as we desire to be ourselves. By the letter-carrier, +Mr. Profane.’<br> +<br> +Then Mr. Profane addressed himself for his return to Mansoul, with his +errand from the horrible pit to the Diabolonians that dwelt in that +town. So he came up the stairs from the deep to the mouth of the +cave where Cerberus was. Now when Cerberus saw him, he asked how +did matters go below, about and against the town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +<i>Prof</i>. Things go as well as we can expect. The letter +that I carried thither was highly approved, and well liked by all my +lords, and I am returning to tell our Diabolonians so. I have +an answer to it here in my bosom, that I am sure will make our masters +that sent me glad; for the contents thereof are to encourage them to +pursue their design to the utmost, and to be ready also to fall on within, +when they shall see my Lord Diabolus beleaguering the town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +<i>Cerb</i>. But does he intend to go against them himself?<br> +<br> +<i>Prof</i>. Does he! Ay! and he will take along with him +more than twenty thousand, all sturdy Doubters, and men of war, picked +men from the land of Doubting, to serve him in the expedition.<br> +<br> +Then was Cerberus glad, and said, ‘And is there such brave preparations +a-making to go against the miserable town of Mansoul? And would +I might be put at the head of a thousand of them, that I might also +show my valour against the famous town of Mansoul.’<br> +<br> +<i>Prof</i>. Your wish may come to pass; you look like one that +has mettle enough, and my lord will have with him those that are valiant +and stout. But my business requires haste.<br> +<br> +<i>Cerb</i>. Ay, so it does. Speed thee to the town of Mansoul, +with all the deepest mischiefs that this place can afford thee. +And when thou shalt come to the house of Mr. Mischief, the place where +the Diabolonians meet to plot, tell them that Cerberus doth wish them +his service, and that if he may, he will with the army come up against +the famous town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +<i>Prof</i>. That I will. And I know that my lords that +are there will be glad to hear it, and to see you also.<br> +<br> +So after a few more such kind of compliments, Mr. Profane took his leave +of his friend Cerberus; and Cerberus again, with a thousand of their +pit-wishes, bid him haste, with all speed, to his masters. The +which when he had heard, he made obeisance, and began to gather up his +heels to run.<br> +<br> +Thus, therefore, he returned, and went and came to Mansoul; and going, +as afore, to the house of Mr. Mischief, there he found the Diabolonians +assembled, and waiting for his return. Now when he was come, and +had presented himself, he also delivered to them his letter, and adjoined +this compliment to them therewith: ‘My lords, from the confines +of the pit, the high and mighty principalities and powers of the den +salute you here, the true Diabolonians of the town of Mansoul. +Wishing you always the most proper of their benedictions, for the great +service, high attempts, and brave achievements that you have put yourselves +upon, for the restoring to our prince Diabolus the famous town of Mansoul.’<br> +<br> +This was therefore the present state of the miserable town of Mansoul: +she had offended her Prince, and he was gone; she had encouraged the +powers of hell, by her foolishness, to come against her to seek her +utter destruction.<br> +<br> +True, the town of Mansoul was somewhat made sensible of her sin, but +the Diabolonians were gotten into her bowels; she cried, but Emmanuel +was gone, and her cries did not fetch him as yet again. Besides, +she knew not now whether, ever or never, he would return and come to +his Mansoul again; nor did they know the power and industry of the enemy, +nor how forward they were to put in execution that plot of hell that +they had devised against her.<br> +<br> +They did, indeed, still send petition after petition to the Prince, +but he answered all with silence. They did neglect reformation, +and that was as Diabolus would have it; for he knew, if they regarded +iniquity in their heart, their King would not hear their prayer; they +therefore did still grow weaker and weaker, and were as a rolling thing +before the whirlwind. They cried to their King for help, and laid +Diabolonians in their bosoms: what therefore should a King do to them? +Yea, there seemed now to be a mixture in Mansoul; the Diabolonians and +the Mansoulians would walk the streets together. Yea, they began +to seek their peace; for they thought that, since the sickness had been +so mortal in Mansoul, it was in vain to go to handygripes with them. +Besides, the weakness of Mansoul was the strength of their enemies; +and the sins of Mansoul, the advantage of the Diabolonians. The +foes of Mansoul did also now begin to promise themselves the town for +a possession: there was no great difference now betwixt Mansoulians +and Diabolonians: both seemed to be masters of Mansoul. Yea, the +Diabolonians increased and grew, but the town of Mansoul diminished +greatly. There were more than eleven thousand men, women, and +children that died by the sickness in Mansoul.<br> +<br> +But now, as Shaddai would have it, there was one whose name was Mr. +Prywell, a great lover of the people of Mansoul. And he, as his +manner was, did go listening up and down in Mansoul to see, and to hear, +if at any time he might, whether there was any design against it or +no. For he was always a jealous man, and feared some mischief +sometime would befal it, either from the Diabolonians within, or from +some power without. Now upon a time it so happened, as Mr. Prywell +went listening here and there, that he lighted upon a place called Vilehill, +in Mansoul, where Diabolonians used to meet; so hearing a muttering, +(you must know that it was in the night,) he softly drew near to hear; +nor had he stood long under the house-end, (for there stood a house +there,) but he heard one confidently affirm, that it was not, or would +not be long before Diabolus should possess himself again of Mansoul; +and that then the Diabolonians did intend to put all Mansoulians to +the sword, and would kill and destroy the King’s captains, and +drive all his soldiers out of the town. He said, moreover, that +he knew there were above twenty thousand fighting men prepared by Diabolus +for the accomplishing of this design, and that it would not be months +before they all should see it.<br> +<br> +When Mr. Prywell had heard this story, he did quickly believe it was +true: wherefore he went forthwith to my Lord Mayor’s house, and +acquainted him therewith; who, sending for the subordinate preacher, +brake the business to him; and he as soon gave the alarm to the town; +for he was now the chief preacher in Mansoul, because, as yet, my Lord +Secretary was ill at ease. And this was the way that the subordinate +preacher did take to alarm the town therewith. The same hour he +caused the lecture bell to be rung; so the people came together: he +gave them then a short exhortation to watchfulness, and made Mr. Prywell’s +news the argument thereof. ‘For,’ said he, ‘an +horrible plot is contrived against Mansoul, even to massacre us all +in a day, nor is this story to be slighted; for Mr. Prywell is the author +thereof. Mr. Prywell was always a lover of Mansoul, a sober and +judicious man, a man that is no tattler, nor raiser of false reports, +but one that loves to look into the very bottom of matters, and talks +nothing of news, but by very solid arguments.<br> +<br> +‘I will call him, and you shall hear him your own selves;’ +so he called him, and he came and told his tale so punctually, and affirmed +its truth with such ample grounds, that Mansoul fell presently under +a conviction of the truth of what he said. The preacher did also +back him, saying, ‘Sirs, it is not irrational for us to believe +it, for we have provoked Shaddai to anger, and have sinned Emmanuel +out of the town; we have had too much correspondence with Diabolonians, +and have forsaken our former mercies: no marvel then, if the enemy both +within and without should design and plot our ruin; and what time like +this to do it? The sickness is now in the town, and we have been +made weak thereby. Many a good meaning man is dead, and the Diabolonians +of late grow stronger and stronger.<br> +<br> +‘Besides,’ quoth the subordinate preacher, ‘I have +received from this good truth-teller this one inkling further, that +he understood by those that he overheard, that several letters have +lately passed between the furies and the Diabolonians in order to our +destruction.’ When Mansoul heard all this, and not being +able to gainsay it, they lift up their voice and wept. Mr. Prywell +did also, in the presence of the townsmen, confirm all that their subordinate +preacher had said. Wherefore they now set afresh to bewail their +folly, and to a doubling of petitions to Shaddai and his Son. +They also brake the business to the captains, high commanders, and men +of war in the town of Mansoul, entreating them to use the means to be +strong, and to take good courage; and that they would look after their +harness, and make themselves ready to give Diabolus battle by night +and by day, shall he come, as they are informed he will, to beleaguer +the town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +When the captains heard this, they being always true lovers of the town +of Mansoul, what do they but like so many Samsons they shake themselves, +and come together to consult and contrive how to defeat those bold and +hellish contrivances that were upon the wheel by the means of Diabolus +and his friends against the now sickly, weakly, and much impoverished +town of Mansoul; and they agreed upon these following particulars:-<br> +<br> +1. That the gates of Mansoul should be kept shut, and made fast with +bars and locks, and that all persons that went out, or came in, should +be very strictly examined by the captains of the guards, ‘to the +end,’ said they, ‘that those that are managers of the plot +amongst us, may, either coming or going, be taken; and that we may also +find out who are the great contrivers, amongst us, of our ruin.’<br> +<br> +2. The next thing was, that a strict search should be made for all kind +of Diabolonians throughout the whole town of Mansoul; and that every +man’s house from top to bottom should be looked into, and that, +too, house by house, that if possible a further discovery might be made +of all such among them as had a hand in these designs.<br> +<br> +3. It was further concluded upon, that wheresoever or with whomsoever +any of the Diabolonians were found, that even those of the town of Mansoul +that had given them house and harbour, should to their shame, and the +warning of others, take penance in the open place.<br> +<br> +4. It was, moreover, resolved by the famous town of Mansoul, that a +public fast, and a day of humiliation, should be kept throughout the +whole corporation, to the justifying of their Prince, the abasing of +themselves before him for their transgressions against him, and against +Shaddai, his Father. It was further resolved, that all such in +Mansoul as did not on that day endeavour to keep that fast, and to humble +themselves for their faults, but that should mind their worldly employs, +or be found wandering up and down the streets, should be taken for Diabolonians, +and should suffer as Diabolonians for such their wicked doings.<br> +<br> +5. It was further concluded then, that with what speed, and with what +warmth of mind they could, they would renew their humiliation for sin, +and their petitions to Shaddai for help; they also resolved, to send +tidings to the court of all that Mr. Prywell had told them.<br> +<br> +6. It was also determined, that thanks should be given by the town of +Mansoul to Mr. Prywell, for his diligent seeking of the welfare of their +town: and further, that forasmuch as he was so naturally inclined to +seek their good, and also to undermine their foes, they gave him a commission +of scout-master-general, for the good of the town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +When the corporation, with their captains, had thus concluded, they +did as they had said; they shut up their gates, they made for Diabolonians +strict search, they made those with whom any were found to take penance +in the open place: they kept their fast, and renewed their petitions +to their Prince, and Mr. Prywell managed his charge and the trust that +Mansoul had put in his hands, with great conscience and good fidelity; +for he gave himself wholly up to his employ, and that not only within +the town, but he went out to pry, to see, and to hear.<br> +<br> +And not many days after he provided for his journey, and went towards +Hell-Gate Hill, into the country where the Doubters were, where he heard +of all that had been talked of in Mansoul, and he perceived also that +Diabolus was almost ready for his march, etc. So he came back +with speed, and, calling the captains and elders of Mansoul together, +he told them where he had been, what he had heard, and what he had seen. +Particularly, he told them that Diabolus was almost ready for his march, +and that he had made old Mr. Incredulity, that once brake prison in +Mansoul, the, general of his army; that his army consisted all of Doubters, +and that their number was above twenty thousand. He told, moreover, +that Diabolus did intend to bring with him the chief princes of the +infernal pit, and that he would make them chief captains over his Doubters. +He told them, moreover, that it was certainly true that several of the +black den would, with Diabolus, ride reformades to reduce the town of +Mansoul to the obedience of Diabolus, their prince.<br> +<br> +He said, moreover, that he understood by the Doubters, among whom he +had been, that the reason why old Incredulity was made general of the +whole army, was because none truer than he to the tyrant; and because +he had an implacable spite against the welfare of the town of Mansoul. +Besides, said he, he remembers the affronts that Mansoul has given him, +and he is resolved to be revenged of them.<br> +<br> +But the black princes shall be made high commanders, only Incredulity +shall be over them all; because, which I had almost forgot, he can more +easily, and more dexterously, beleaguer the town of Mansoul, than can +any of the princes besides.<br> +<br> +Now, when the captains of Mansoul, with the elders of the town, had +heard the tidings that Mr. Prywell did bring, they thought it expedient, +without further delay, to put into execution the laws that against the +Diabolonians their Prince had made for them, and given them in commandment +to manage against them. Wherefore, forthwith a diligent and impartial +search was made in all houses in Mansoul, for all and all manner of +Diabolonians. Now, in the house of Mr. Mind, and in the house +of the great Lord Willbewill, were two Diabolonians found. In +Mr. Mind’s house was one Lord Covetousness found; but he had changed +his name to Prudent-Thrifty. In my Lord Willbewill’s house, +one Lasciviousness was found; but he had changed his name to Harmless-Mirth. +These two the captains and elders of the town of Mansoul took, and committed +them to custody under the hand of Mr. Trueman, the gaoler; and this +man handled them so severely, and loaded them so well with irons, that +in time they both fell into a very deep consumption, and died in the +prison-house; their masters also, according to the agreement of the +captains and elders, were brought to take penance in the open place +to their shame, and for a warning to the rest of the town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +Now, this was the manner of penance in those days: the persons offending +being made sensible of the evil of their doings, were enjoined open +confession of their faults, and a strict amendment of their lives.<br> +<br> +After this, the captains and elders of Mansoul sought yet to find out +more Diabolonians, wherever they lurked, whether in dens, caves, holes, +vaults, or where else they could, in or about the wall or town of Mansoul. +But though they could plainly see their footing, and so follow them +by their track and smell to their holds, even to the mouths of their +caves and dens, yet take them, hold them, and do justice upon them, +they could not; their ways were so crooked, their holds so strong, and +they so quick to take sanctuary there.<br> +<br> +But Mansoul did now with so stiff an hand rule over the Diabolonians +that were left, that they were glad to shrink into corners: time was +when they durst walk openly, and in the day; but now they were forced +to embrace privacy and the night: time was when a Mansoulian was their +companion; but now they counted them deadly enemies. This good +change did Mr. Prywell’s intelligence make in the famous town +of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +By this time, Diabolus had finished his army which he intended to bring +with him for the ruin of Mansoul; and had set over them captains, and +other field officers, such as liked his furious stomach best: himself +was lord paramount, Incredulity was general of his army, their highest +captains shall be named afterwards; but now for their officers, colours, +and scutcheons.<br> +<br> +1. Their first captain was Captain Rage: he was captain over the election +doubters, his were the red colours; his standard-bearer was Mr. Destructive, +and the great red dragon he had for his scutcheon.<br> +<br> +2. The second captain was Captain Fury: he was captain over the vocation +doubters; his standard-bearer was Mr. Darkness, his colours were those +that were pale, and he had for his scutcheon the fiery flying serpent.<br> +<br> +3. The third captain was Captain Damnation: he was captain over the +grace doubters; his were the red colours, Mr. No-Life bare them, and +he had for his scutcheon the black den.<br> +<br> +4. The fourth captain was Captain Insatiable; he was captain over the +faith doubters: his were the red colours, Mr. Devourer bare them, and +he had for a scutcheon the yawning jaws.<br> +<br> +5. The fifth captain was Captain Brimstone: he was captain over the +perseverance doubters; his also were the red colours, Mr. Burning bare +them, and his scutcheon was the blue and stinking flame.<br> +<br> +6. The sixth captain was Captain Torment: he was captain over the resurrection +doubters; his colours were those that were pale; Mr. Gnaw was his standard-bearer, +and he had the black worm for his scutcheon.<br> +<br> +7. The seventh captain was Captain No-Ease; he was captain over the +salvation doubters; his were the red colours, Mr. Restless bare them, +and his scutcheon was the ghastly picture of death.<br> +<br> +8. The eighth captain was the Captain Sepulchre: he was captain over +the glory doubters; his also were the pale colours, Mr. Corruption was +his standard-bearer, and he had for his scutcheon a skull, and dead +men’s bones.<br> +<br> +9. The ninth captain was Captain Past-Hope; he was captain of those +that are called the felicity doubters; his standard-bearer was Mr. Despair; +his also were the red colours, and his scutcheon was a hot iron and +the hard heart.<br> +<br> +These were his captains, and these were their forces, these were their +standards, these were their colours, and these were their scutcheons. +Now, over these did the great Diabolus make superior captains, and they +were in number seven: as, namely, the Lord Beelzebub, the Lord Lucifer, +the Lord Legion, the Lord Apollyon, the Lord Python, the Lord Cerberus, +and the Lord Belial; these seven he set over the captains, and Incredulity +was lord-general, and, Diabolus was king. The reformades also, +such as were like themselves, were made some of them captains of hundreds, +and some of them captains of more. And thus was the army of Incredulity +completed.<br> +<br> +So they set out at Hell-Gate Hill, for there they had their rendezvous, +from whence they came with a straight course upon their march toward +the town of Mansoul. Now, as was hinted before, the town had, +as Shaddai would have it, received from the mouth of Mr. Prywell the +alarm of their coming before. Wherefore they set a strong watch +at the gates, and had also doubled their guards: they also mounted their +slings in good places, where they might conveniently cast out their +great stones to the annoyance of their furious enemy.<br> +<br> +Nor could those Diabolonians that were in the town do that hurt as was +designed they should; for Mansoul was now awake. But alas! poor +people, they were sorely affrighted at the first appearance of their +foes, and at their sitting down before the town, especially when they +heard the roaring of their drum. This, to speak truth, was amazingly +hideous to hear; it frighted all men seven miles round, if they were +but awake and heard it. The streaming of their colours was also +terrible and dejecting to behold.<br> +<br> +When Diabolus was come up against the town, first he made his approach +to Ear-gate, and gave it a furious assault, supposing, as it seems, +that his friends in Mansoul had been ready to do the work within; but +care was taken of that before, by the vigilance of the captains. +Wherefore, missing of the help that he expected from them, and finding +his army warmly attended with the stones that the slingers did sling, +(for that I will say for the captains, that considering the weakness +that yet was upon them by reason of the long sickness that had annoyed +the town of Mansoul, they did gallantly behave themselves,) he was forced +to make some retreat from Mansoul, and to entrench himself and his men +in the field without the reach of the slings of the town.<br> +<br> +Now having entrenched himself, he did cast up four mounts against the +town: the first he called Mount Diabolus, putting his own name thereon, +the more to affright the town of Mansoul; the other three he called +thus - Mount Alecto, Mount Megara, and Mount Tisiphone; for these are +the names of the dreadful furies of hell. Thus he began to play +his game with Mansoul, and to serve it as doth the lion his prey, even +to make it fall before his terror. But, as I said, the captains +and soldiers resisted so stoutly, and did do such execution with their +stones, that they made him, though against stomach, to retreat, wherefore +Mansoul began to take courage.<br> +<br> +Now upon Mount Diabolus, which was raised on the north side of the town, +there did the tyrant set up his standard, and a fearful thing it was +to behold; for he had wrought in it by devilish art, after the manner +of a scutcheon, a flaming flame fearful to behold, and the picture of +Mansoul burning in it.<br> +<br> +When Diabolus had thus done, he commanded that his drummer should every +night approach the walls of the town of Mansoul, and so to beat a parley; +the command was to do it at nights, for in the daytime they annoyed +him with their slings; for the tyrant said, that he had a mind to parley +with the now trembling town of Mansoul, and he commanded that the drums +should beat every night, that through weariness they might at last, +if possible, (at the first they were unwilling yet,) be forced to do +it.<br> +<br> +So this drummer did as commanded: he arose, and did beat his drum. +But when his drum did go, if one looked toward the town of Mansoul, +‘Behold darkness and sorrow, and the light was darkened in the +heaven thereof.’ No noise was ever heard upon earth more +terrible, except the voice of Shaddai when he speaketh. But how +did Mansoul tremble! it now looked for nothing but forthwith to be swallowed +up.<br> +<br> +When this drummer had beaten for a parley, he made this speech to Mansoul: +‘My master has bid me tell you, that if you will willingly submit, +you shall have the good of the earth; but if you shall be stubborn, +he is resolved to take you by force.’ But by that the fugitive +had done beating his drum, the people of Mansoul had betaken themselves +to the captains that were in the castle, so that there was none to regard, +nor to give this drummer an answer; so he proceeded no further that +night, but returned again to his master to the camp.<br> +<br> +When Diabolus saw that by drumming he could not work out Mansoul to +his will, the next night he sendeth his drummer without his drum, still +to let the townsmen know that he had a mind to parley with them. +But when all came to all, his parley was turned into a summons to the +town to deliver up themselves: but they gave him neither heed nor hearing: +for they remembered what at first it cost them to hear him a few words.<br> +<br> +The next night he sends again, and then who should be his messenger +to Mansoul but the terrible Captain Sepulchre; so Captain Sepulchre +came up to the walls of Mansoul, and made this oration to the town:-<br> +<br> +‘O ye inhabitants of the rebellious town of Mansoul! I summon +you in the name of the Prince Diabolus, that, without any more ado, +you set open the gates of your town, and admit the great lord to come +in. But if you shall still rebel, when we have taken to us the +town by force, we will swallow you up as the grave; wherefore if you +will hearken to my summons, say so, and if not then let me know.<br> +<br> +‘The reason of this my summons,’ quoth he, ‘is, for +that my lord is your undoubted prince and lord, as you yourselves have +formerly owned. Nor shall that assault that was given to my lord, +when Emmanuel dealt so dishonourably by him, prevail with him to lose +his right, and to forbear to attempt to recover his own. Consider, +then, O Mansoul, with thyself, wilt thou show thyself peaceable, or +no? If thou shalt quietly yield up thyself, then our old friendship +shall be renewed; but if thou shalt yet refuse and rebel, then expect +nothing but fire and sword.’<br> +<br> +When the languishing town of Mansoul had heard this summoner and his +summons, they were yet more put to their dumps, but made to the captain +no answer at all; so away he went as he came.<br> +<br> +But, after some consultation among themselves, as also with some of +their captains, they applied themselves afresh to the Lord Secretary +for counsel and advice from him; for this Lord Secretary was their chief +preacher, (as also is mentioned some pages before,) only now he was +ill at ease; and of him they begged favour in these two or three things +-<br> +<br> +1. That he would look comfortably upon them, and not keep himself so +much retired from them as formerly. Also, that he would be prevailed +with to give them a hearing, while they should make known their miserable +condition to him. But to this he told them as before, that ‘as +yet he was but ill at ease, and therefore could not do as he had formerly +done.’<br> +<br> +2. The second thing that they desired was, that he would be pleased +to give them his advice about their now so important affairs, for that +Diabolus was come and set down before the town with no less than twenty +thousand doubters. They said, moreover, that both he and his captains +were cruel men, and that they were afraid of them. But to this +he said, ‘You must look to the law of the Prince, and there see +what is laid upon you to do.’<br> +<br> +3. Then they desired that his highness would help them to frame a petition +to Shaddai, and unto Emmanuel his Son, and that he would set his own +hand thereto as a token that he was one with them in it: ‘For,’ +said they, ‘my Lord, many a one have we sent, but can get no answer +of peace; but now, surely, one with thy hand unto it may obtain good +for Mansoul.’<br> +<br> +But all the answer that he gave to this was, ‘that they had offended +their Emmanuel, and had also grieved himself, and that therefore they +must as yet partake of their own devices.’<br> +<br> +This answer of the Lord Secretary fell like a millstone upon them; yea, +it crushed them so that they could not tell what to do; yet they durst +not comply with the demands of Diabolus, nor with the demands of his +captain. So then here were the straits that the town of Mansoul +was betwixt, when the enemy came upon her: her foes were ready to swallow +her up, and her friends did forbear to help her.<br> +<br> +Then stood up my Lord Mayor, whose name was my Lord Understanding, and +he began to pick and pick, until he had picked comfort out of that seemingly +bitter saying of the Lord Secretary; for thus he descanted upon it: +‘First,’ said he, ‘this unavoidably follows upon the +saying of my Lord, “that we must yet suffer for our sins.” +Secondly, But,’ quoth he, ‘the words yet sound as if at +last we should be saved from our enemies, and that after a few more +sorrows, Emmanuel will come and be our help.’ Now the Lord +Mayor was the more critical in his dealing with the Secretary’s +words, because my lord was more than a prophet, and because none of +his words were such, but that at all times they were most exactly significant; +and the townsmen were allowed to pry into them, and to expound them +to their best advantage.<br> +<br> +So they took their leaves of my lord, and returned, and went, and came +to the captains, to whom they did tell what my Lord High Secretary had +said; who, when they had heard it, were all of the same opinion as was +my Lord Mayor himself. The captains, therefore, began to take +some courage unto them, and to prepare to make some brave attempt upon +the camp of the enemy, and to destroy all that were Diabolonians, with +the roving doubters that the tyrant had brought with him to destroy +the poor town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +So all betook themselves forthwith to their places - the Captains to +theirs, the Lord Mayor to his, the subordinate preacher to his, and +my Lord Willbewill to his. The captains longed to be at some work +for their prince; for they delighted in warlike achievements. +The next day, therefore, they came together and consulted; and after +consultation had, they resolved to give an answer to the captain of +Diabolus with slings; and so they did at the rising of the sun on the +morrow; for Diabolus had adventured to come nearer again, but the sling-stones +were to him and his like hornets. For as there is nothing to the +town of Mansoul so terrible as the roaring of Diabolus’s drum, +so there is nothing to Diabolus so terrible as the well playing of Emmanuel’s +slings. Wherefore Diabolus was forced to make another retreat, +yet further off from the famous town of Mansoul. Then did the +Lord Mayor of Mansoul cause the bells to be rung, ‘and that thanks +should be sent to the Lord High Secretary by the mouth of the subordinate +preacher; for that by his words the captains and elders of Mansoul had +been strengthened against Diabolus.’<br> +<br> +When Diabolus saw that his captains and soldiers, high lords and renowned, +were frightened, and beaten down by the stones that came from the golden +slings of the Prince of the town of Mansoul, he bethought himself, and +said, ‘I will try to catch them by fawning, I will try to flatter +them into my net.’<br> +<br> +Wherefore, after a while, he came down again to the wall, not now with +his drum, nor with Captain Sepulchre; but having all besugared his lips, +he seemed to be a very sweet-mouthed, peaceable prince, designing nothing +for humour’s sake, nor to be revenged on Mansoul for injuries +by them done to him; but the welfare, and good, and advantage of the +town and people therein was now, as he said, his only design. +Wherefore, after he had called for audience, and desired that the townsfolk +would give it to him, he proceeded in his oration, and said:-<br> +<br> +‘Oh, the desire of my heart, the famous town of Mansoul! how many +nights have I watched, and how many weary steps have I taken, if perhaps +I might do thee good! Far be it, far be it from me to desire to +make a war upon you; if ye will but willingly and quietly deliver up +yourselves unto me. You know that you were mine of old. +Remember also, that so long as you enjoyed me for your lord, and that +I enjoyed you for my subjects, you wanted for nothing of all the delights +of the earth, that I, your lord and prince, could get for you, or that +I could invent to make you bonny and blithe withal. Consider, +you never had so many hard, dark, troublesome, and heart-afflicting +hours, while you were mine, as you have had since you revolted from +me; nor shall you ever have peace again, until you and I become one +as before. But, be but prevailed with to embrace me again, and +I will grant, yea, enlarge your old charter with abundance of privileges; +so that your license and liberty shall be to take, hold, enjoy, and +make your own all that is pleasant from the east to the west. +Nor shall any of those incivilities, wherewith you have offended me, +be ever charged upon you by me, so long as the sun and moon endure. +Nor shall any of those dear friends of mine that now, for the fear of +you, lie lurking in dens, and holes, and caves in Mansoul, be hurtful +to you any more; yea, they shall be your servants, and shall minister +unto you of their substance, and of whatever shall come to hand. +I need speak no more; you know them, and have sometime since been much +delighted in their company. Why, then, should we abide at such +odds? Let us renew our old acquaintance and friendship again.<br> +<br> +‘Bear with your friend; I take the liberty at this time to speak +thus freely unto you. The love that I have to you presses me to +do it, as also does the zeal of my heart for my friends with you: put +me not therefore to further trouble, nor yourselves to further fears +and frights. Have you I will, in a way of peace or war; nor do +you flatter yourselves with the power and force of your captains, or +that your Emmanuel will shortly come in to your help; for such strength +will do you no pleasure.<br> +<br> +‘I am come against you with a stout and valiant army, and all +the chief princes of the den are even at the head of it. Besides, +my captains are swifter than eagles, stronger than lions, and more greedy +of prey than are the evening wolves. What is Og of Bashan! what +is Goliath of Gath! and what are an hundred more of them, to one of +the least of my captains! How, then, shall Mansoul think to escape +my hand and force?’<br> +<br> +Diabolus having thus handed his flattering, fawning, deceitful, and +lying speech to the famous town of Mansoul, the Lord Mayor replied to +him as follows: ‘O Diabolus, prince of darkness, and master of +all deceit; thy lying flatteries we have had and made sufficient probation +of, and have tasted too deeply of that destructive cup already. +Should we therefore again hearken unto thee, and so break the commandments +of our great Shaddai, to join in affinity with thee, would not our Prince +reject us, and cast us off for ever? And, being cast off by him, +can the place that he has prepared for thee be a place of rest for us? +Besides, O thou that art empty and void of all truth, we are rather +ready to die by thy hand, than to fall in with thy flattering and lying +deceits.’<br> +<br> +When the tyrant saw that there was little to be got by parleying with +my Lord Mayor, he fell into an hellish rage, and resolved that again, +with his army of doubters, he would another time assault the town of +Mansoul.<br> +<br> +So he called for his drummer, who beat up for his men (and while he +did beat, Mansoul did shake) to be in a readiness to give battle to +the corporation: then Diabolus drew near with his army, and thus disposed +of his men. Captain Cruel and Captain Torment, these he drew up +and placed against Feel-gate, and commanded them to sit down there for +the war. And he also appointed that, if need were, Captain No-Ease +should come in to their relief. At Nose-gate he placed the Captain +Brimstone and Captain Sepulchre, and bid them look well to their ward, +on that side of the town of Mansoul. But at Eye-gate he placed +that grim-faced one, the Captain Past-Hope, and there also now he did +set up his terrible standard.<br> +<br> +Now Captain Insatiable, he was to look to the carriages of Diabolus, +and was also appointed to take into custody that, or those persons and +things, that should at any time as prey be taken from the enemy.<br> +<br> +Now Mouth-gate the inhabitants of Mansoul kept for a sally-port; wherefore +that they kept strong; for that it was it by and out at which the townsfolk +did send their petitions to Emmanuel their Prince. That also was +the gate from the top of which the captains did play their slings at +the enemies; for that gate stood somewhat ascending, so that the placing +of them there, and the letting of them fly from that place, did much +execution against the tyrant’s army. Wherefore, for these +causes, with others, Diabolus sought, if possible, to land up Mouth-gate +with dirt.<br> +<br> +Now, as Diabolus was busy and industrious in preparing to make his assault +upon the town of Mansoul, without, so the captains and soldiers in the +corporation were as busy in preparing within; they mounted their slings, +they set up their banners, they sounded their trumpets, and put themselves +in such order as was judged most for the annoyance of the enemy, and +for the advantage of Mansoul, and gave to their soldiers orders to be +ready at the sound of the trumpet for war. The Lord Willbewill +also, he took the charge of watching against the rebels within, and +to do what he could to take them while without, or to stifle them within +their caves, dens, and holes in the town-wall of Mansoul. And, +to speak the truth of him, ever since he took penance for his fault, +he has showed as much honesty and bravery of spirit as any he in Mansoul; +for he took one Jolly, and his brother Griggish, the two sons of his +servant Harmless-Mirth, (for to that day, though the father was committed +to ward, the sons had a dwelling in the house of my lord,) - I say, +he took them, and with his own hands put them to the cross. And +this was the reason why he hanged them up: after their father was put +into the hands of Mr. True-Man the gaoler, they, his sons, began to +play his pranks, and to be ticking and toying with the daughters of +their lord; nay, it was jealoused that they were too familiar with them, +the which was brought to his lordship’s ear. Now his lordship +being unwilling unadvisedly to put any man to death, did not suddenly +fall upon them, but set watch and spies to see if the thing was true; +of the which he was soon informed, for his two servants, whose names +were Find-Out and Tell-All, catched them together in uncivil manner +more than once or twice, and went and told their lord. So when +my Lord Willbewill had sufficient ground to believe the thing was true, +he takes the two young Diabolonians, (for such they were, for their +father was a Diabolonian born,) and has them to Eye-gate, where he raised +a very high cross, just in the face of Diabolus, and of his army, and +there he hanged the young villains, in defiance to Captain Past-Hope, +and of the horrible standard of the tyrant.<br> +<br> +Now this Christian act of the brave Lord Willbewill did greatly abash +Captain Past-Hope, discouraged the army of Diabolus, put fear into the +Diabolonian runagates in Mansoul, and put strength and courage into +the captains that belonged to Emmanuel, the Prince; for they without +did gather, and that by this very act of my Lord, that Mansoul was resolved +to fight, and that the Diabolonians within the town could not do such +things as Diabolus had hopes they would. Nor was this the only +proof of the brave Lord Willbewill’s honesty to the town, nor +of his loyalty to his Prince, as will afterwards appear.<br> +<br> +Now, when the children of Prudent-Thrifty, who dwelt with Mr. Mind, +(for Thrift left children with Mr. Mind, when he was also committed +to prison, and their names were Gripe and Rake-All; these he begat of +Mr. Mind’s bastard daughter, whose name was Mrs. Hold-fast-Bad;) +- I say, when his children perceived how the Lord Willbewill had served +them that dwelt with him, what do they but, lest they should drink of +the same cup, endeavour to make their escape. But Mr. Mind, being +wary of it, took them and put them in hold in his house till morning; +(for this was done over night;) and remembering that by the law of Mansoul +all Diabolonians were to die, (and to be sure they were at least by +father’s side such, and some say by mother’s side too,) +what does he but takes them and puts them in chains, and carries them +to the selfsame place where my lord hanged his two before, and there +he hanged them.<br> +<br> +The townsmen also took great encouragement at this act of Mr. Mind, +and did what they could to have taken some more of these Diabolonian +troublers of Mansoul; but at that time the rest lay so squat and close, +that they could not be apprehended; so they set against them a diligent +watch, and went every man to his place.<br> +<br> +I told you a little before, that Diabolus and his army were somewhat +abashed and discouraged at the sight of what my Lord Willbewill did, +when he hanged up those two young Diabolonians; but his discouragement +quickly turned itself into furious madness and rage against the town +of Mansoul, and fight it he would. Also the townsmen and captains +within, they had their hopes and their expectations heightened, believing +at last the day would be theirs; so they feared them the less. +Their subordinate preacher, too, made a sermon about it; and he took +that theme for his text, ‘Gad, a troop shall overcome him: but +he shall overcome at the last.’ Whence he showed, that though +Mansoul should be sorely put to it at the first, yet the victory should +most certainly be Mansoul’s at the last.<br> +<br> +So Diabolus commanded that his drummer should beat a charge against +the town; and the captains also that were in the town sounded a charge +against them, but they had no drum: they were trumpets of silver with +which they sounded against them. Then they which were of the camp +of Diabolus came down to the town to take it, and the captains in the +castle, with the slingers at Mouth-gate, played upon them amain. +And now there was nothing heard in the camp of Diabolus but horrible +rage and blasphemy; but in the town good words, prayer, and singing +of psalms. The enemy replied with horrible objections, and the +terribleness of their drum; but the town made answer with the slapping +of their slings, and the melodious noise of their trumpets. And +thus the fight lasted for several days together, only now and then they +had some small intermission, in the which the townsmen refreshed themselves, +and the captains made ready for another assault.<br> +<br> +The captains of Emmanuel were clad in silver armour, and the soldiers +in that which was of proof; the soldiers of Diabolus were clad in iron +which was made to give place to Emmanuel’s engine-shot. +In the town, some were hurt, and some were greatly wounded. Now, +the worst of it was, a chirurgeon was scarce in Mansoul, for that Emmanuel +at present was absent. Howbeit, with the leaves of a tree the +wounded were kept from dying; yet their wounds did greatly putrefy, +and some did grievously stink. Of the townsmen, these were wounded, +namely, my Lord Reason; he was wounded in the head. Another that +was wounded was the brave Lord Mayor; he was wounded in the eye. +Another that was wounded was Mr. Mind; he received his wound about the +stomach. The honest subordinate preacher also, he received a shot +not far off the heart but none of these were mortal.<br> +<br> +Many also of the inferior sort were not only wounded but slain outright.<br> +<br> +Now, in the camp of Diabolus were wounded and slain a considerable number; +for instance, Captain Rage, he was wounded, and so was Captain Cruel. +Captain Damnation was made to retreat, and to intrench himself further +off of Mansoul. The standard also of Diabolus was beaten down, +and his standard-bearer, Captain Much-Hurt, had his brains beat out +with a sling-stone, to the no little grief and shame of his prince Diabolus.<br> +<br> +Many also of the doubters were slain outright, though enough of them +were left alive to make Mansoul shake and totter. Now the victory +that day being turned to Mansoul, did put great valour into the townsmen +and captains, and did cover Diabolus’s camp with a cloud, but +withal it made them far more furious. So the next day Mansoul +rested, and commanded that the bells should be rung; the trumpets also +joyfully sounded, and the captains shouted round the town.<br> +<br> +My Lord Willbewill also was not idle, but did notable service within +against the domestics, or the Diabolonians that were in the town, not +only by keeping them in awe, for he lighted on one at last whose name +was Mr. Anything, a fellow of whom mention was made before; for it was +he, if you remember, that brought the three fellows to Diabolus, whom +the Diabolonians took out of Captain Boanerges’s companies, and +that persuaded them to list themselves under the tyrant, to fight against +the army of Shaddai. My Lord Willbewill did also take a notable +Diabolonian, whose name was Loose-Foot: this Loose-Foot was a scout +to the vagabonds in Mansoul, and that did use to carry tidings out of +Mansoul to the camp, and out of the camp to those of the enemies in +Mansoul. Both these my lord sent away safe to Mr. True-Man, the +gaoler, with a commandment to keep them in irons; for he intended then +to have them out to be crucified, when it would be for the best to the +corporation, and most for the discouragement of the camp of the enemies.<br> +<br> +My Lord Mayor also, though he could not stir about so much as formerly, +because of the wound that he lately received, yet gave he out orders +to all that were the natives of Mansoul, to look to their watch, and +stand upon their guard, and, as occasion should offer, to prove themselves +men.<br> +<br> +Mr. Conscience, the preacher, he also did his utmost to keep all his +good documents alive upon the hearts of the people of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +Well, awhile after, the captains and stout ones of the town of Mansoul +agreed and resolved upon a time to make a sally out upon the camp of +Diabolus, and this must be done in the night; and there was the folly +of Mansoul, (for the night is always the best for the enemy, but the +worst for Mansoul to fight in,) but yet they would do it, their courage +was so high; their last victory also still stuck in their memories.<br> +<br> +So the night appointed being come, the Prince’s brave captains +cast lots who should lead the van in this new and desperate expedition +against Diabolus, and against his Diabolonian army; and the lot fell +to Captain Credence, to Captain Experience, and to Captain Good-Hope, +to lead the forlorn hope. (This Captain Experience the Prince +created such when himself did reside in the town of Mansoul.) +So, as I said, they made their sally out upon the army that lay in the +siege against them; and their hap was to fall in with the main body +of their enemies. Now Diabolus and his men being expertly accustomed +to night-work, took the alarm presently, and were as ready to give them +battle, as if they had sent them word of their coming. Wherefore +to it they went amain, and blows were hard on every side; the hell drum +also was beat most furiously, while the trumpets of the Prince most +sweetly sounded. And thus the battle was joined; and Captain Insatiable +looked to the enemy’s carriages, and waited when he should receive +some prey.<br> +<br> +The Prince’s captains fought it stoutly, beyond what indeed could +be expected they should; they wounded many; they made the whole army +of Diabolus to make a retreat. But I cannot tell how, but the +brave Captain Credence, Captain Good-Hope, and Captain Experience, as +they were upon the pursuit, cutting down, and following hard after the +enemy in the rear, Captain Credence stumbled and fell, by which fall +he caught so great a hurt, that he could not rise till Captain Experience +did help him up, at which their men were put in disorder. The +captain also was so full of pain, that he could not forbear but aloud +to cry out: at this, the other two captains fainted, supposing that +Captain Credence had received his mortal wound; their men also were +more disordered, and had no list to fight. Now Diabolus being +very observing, though at this time as yet he was put to the worst, +perceiving that a halt was made among the men that were the pursuers, +what does he but, taking it for granted that the captains were either +wounded or dead, he therefore makes at first a stand, then faces about, +and so comes up upon the Prince’s army with as much of his fury +as hell could help him to; and his hap was to fall in just among the +three captains, Captain Credence, Captain Good-Hope, and Captain Experience, +and did cut, wound, and pierce them so dreadfully, that what through +discouragement, what through disorder, and what through the wounds that +they had received, and also the loss of much blood, they scarce were +able, though they had for their power the three best hands in Mansoul, +to get safe into the hold again.<br> +<br> +Now, when the body of the Prince’s army saw how these three captains +were put to the worst, they thought it their wisdom to make as safe +and good a retreat as they could, and so returned by the sally-port +again; and so there was an end of this present action. But Diabolus +was so flushed with this night’s work, that he promised himself, +in few days, an easy and complete conquest over the town of Mansoul; +wherefore, on the day following, he comes up to the sides thereof with +great boldness, and demands entrance, and that forthwith they deliver +themselves up to his government. The Diabolonians, too, that were +within, they began to be somewhat brisk, as we shall show afterward.<br> +<br> +But the valiant Lord Mayor replied, that what he got he must get by +force; for as long as Emmanuel, their Prince, was alive, (though he +at present was not so with them as they wished,) they should never consent +to yield Mansoul up to another.<br> +<br> +And with that the Lord Willbewill stood up, and said, ‘Diabolus, +thou master of the den, and enemy to all that is good, we poor inhabitants +of the town of Mansoul are too well acquainted with thy rule and government, +and with the end of those things that for certain will follow submitting +to thee, to do it. Wherefore though while we were without knowledge +we suffered thee to take us, (as the bird that saw not the snare fell +into the hands of the fowler,) yet since we have been turned from darkness +to light, we have also been turned from the power of Satan to God. +And though through thy subtlety, and also the subtlety of the Diabolonians +within, we have sustained much loss, and also plunged ourselves into +much perplexity, yet give up ourselves, lay down our arms, and yield +to so horrid a tyrant as thou, we shall not; die upon the place we choose +rather to do. Besides, we have hopes that in time deliverance +will come from court unto us, and therefore we yet will maintain a war +against thee.’<br> +<br> +This brave speech of the Lord Willbewill, with that also of the Lord +Mayor, did somewhat abate the boldness of Diabolus, though it kindled +the fury of his rage. It also succoured the townsmen and captains; +yea, it was as a plaster to the brave Captain Credence’s wound; +for you must know that a brave speech now (when the captains of the +town with their men of war came home routed, and when the enemy took +courage and boldness at the success that he had obtained to draw up +to the walls, and demand entrance, as he did) was in season, and also +advantageous.<br> +<br> +The Lord Willbewill also did play the man within; for while the captains +and soldiers were in the field, he was in arms in the town, and wherever +by him there was a Diabolonian found, they were forced to feel the weight +of his heavy hand, and also the edge of his penetrating sword: many +therefore of the Diabolonians he wounded, as the Lord Cavil, the Lord +Brisk, the Lord Pragmatic, and the Lord Murmur; several also of the +meaner sort he did sorely maim; though there cannot at this time an +account be given you of any that he slew outright. The cause, +or rather the advantage that my Lord Willbewill had at this time to +do thus, was for that the captains were gone out to fight the enemy +in the field. ‘For now,’ thought the Diabolonians +within, ‘is our time to stir and make an uproar in the town.’ +What do they therefore but quickly get themselves into a body, and fall +forthwith to hurricaning in Mansoul, as if now nothing but whirlwind +and tempest should be there. Wherefore, as I said, he takes this +opportunity to fall in among them with his men, cutting and slashing +with courage that was undaunted; at which the Diabolonians with all +haste dispersed themselves to their holds, and my lord to his place +as before.<br> +<br> +This brave act of my lord did somewhat revenge the wrong done by Diabolus +to the captains, and also did let them know that Mansoul was not to +be parted with for the loss of a victory or two; wherefore the wing +of the tyrant was clipped again, as to boasting, - I mean in comparison +of what he would have done, if the Diabolonians had put the town to +the same plight to which he had put the captains.<br> +<br> +Well, Diabolus yet resolves to have the other bout with Mansoul. +‘For,’ thought he, ‘since I beat them once, I may +beat them twice.’ Wherefore he commanded his men to be ready +at such an hour of the night, to make a fresh assault upon the town; +and he gave it out in special that they should bend all their force +against Feel-gate, and attempt to break into the town through that. +The word that then he did give to his officers and soldiers was Hell-fire. +‘And,’ said he, ‘if we break in upon them, as I wish +we do, either with some, or with all our force, let them that break +in look to it, that they forget not the word. And let nothing +be heard in the town of Mansoul but, “Hell-fire! Hell-fire! +Hell-fire!”’ The drummer was also to beat without +ceasing, and the standard-bearers were to display their colours; the +soldiers, too, were to put on what courage they could, and to see that +they played manfully their parts against the town.<br> +<br> +So when night was come, and all things by the tyrant made ready for +the work, he suddenly makes his assault upon Feel-gate, and after he +had awhile struggled there, he throws the gate wide open: for the truth +is, those gates were but weak, and so most easily made to yield. +When Diabolus had thus far made his attempt, he placed his captains +(namely, Torment and No-Ease) there; so he attempted to press forward, +but the Prince’s captains came down upon him, and made his entrance +more difficult than he desired. And, to speak truth, they made +what resistance they could; but the three of their best and most valiant +captains being wounded, and by their wounds made much incapable of doing +the town that service they would, (and all the rest having more than +their hands full of the doubters, and their captains that did follow +Diabolus,) they were overpowered with force, nor could they keep them +out of the town. Wherefore the Prince’s men and their captains +betook themselves to the castle, as to the stronghold of the town: and +this they did partly for their own security, partly for the security +of the town, and partly, or rather chiefly, to preserve to Emmanuel +the prerogative-royal of Mansoul; for so was the castle of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +The captains therefore being fled into the castle, the enemy, without +much resistance, possess themselves of the rest of the town, and spreading +themselves as they went into every corner, they cried out as they marched, +according to the command of the tyrant, ‘Hell-fire! Hell-fire! +Hell-fire!’ so that nothing for a while throughout the town of +Mansoul could be heard but the direful noise of ‘Hell-fire!’ +together with the roaring of Diabolus’s drum. And now did +the clouds hang black over Mansoul, nor to reason did anything but ruin +seem to attend it. Diabolus also quartered his soldiers in the +houses of the inhabitants of the town of Mansoul. Yea, the subordinate +preacher’s house was as full of these outlandish doubters as ever +it could hold, and so was my Lord Mayor’s, and my Lord Willbewill’s +also. Yea, where was there a corner, a cottage, a barn, or a hogstye, +that now was not full of these vermin? Yea, they turned the men +of the town out of their houses, and would lie in their beds, and sit +at their tables themselves. Ah, poor Mansoul! now thou feelest +the fruits of sin, yea, what venom was in the flattering words of Mr. +Carnal-Security! They made great havoc of whatever they laid their +hands on; yea, they fired the town in several places; many young children +also were by them dashed in pieces; and those that were yet unborn they +destroyed in their mothers’ wombs: for you must needs think that +it could not now be otherwise; for what conscience, what pity, what +bowels of compassion can any expect at the hands of outlandish doubters? +Many in Mansoul that were women, both young and old, they forced, ravished, +and beastlike abused, so that they swooned, miscarried, and many of +them died, and so lay at the top of every street, and in all by-places +of the town.<br> +<br> +And now did Mansoul seem to be nothing but a den of dragons, an emblem +of hell, and a place of total darkness. Now did Mansoul lie almost +like the barren wilderness; nothing but nettles, briars, thorns, weeds, +and stinking things seemed now to cover the face of Mansoul. I +told you before, how that these Diabolonian doubters turned the men +of Mansoul out of their beds, and now I will add, they wounded them, +they mauled them, yea, and almost brained many of them. Many did +I say, yea most, if not all of them. Mr. Conscience they so wounded, +yea, and his wounds so festered, that he could have no ease day nor +night, but lay as if continually upon a rack; but that Shaddai rules +all, certainly they had slain him outright. Mr. Lord Mayor they +so abused that they almost put out his eyes; and had not my Lord Willbewill +got into the castle, they intended to have chopped him all to pieces; +for they did look upon him, as his heart now stood, to be one of the +very worst that was in Mansoul against Diabolus and his crew. +And indeed he hath shown himself a man, and more of his exploits you +will hear of afterwards.<br> +<br> +Now, a man might have walked for days together in Mansoul, and scarcely +have seen one in the town that looked like a religious man. Oh, +the fearful state of Mansoul now! now every corner swarmed with outlandish +doubters; red-coats and black-coats walked the town by clusters, and +filled up all the houses with hideous noises, vain songs, lying stories, +and blasphemous language against Shaddai and his Son. Now also +those Diabolonians that lurked in the walls and dens and holes that +were in the town of Mansoul, came forth and showed themselves; yea, +walked with open face in company with the doubters that were in Mansoul. +Yea, they had more boldness now to walk the streets, to haunt the houses, +and to show themselves abroad, than had any of the honest inhabitants +of the now woful town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +But Diabolus and his outlandish men were not at peace in Mansoul; for +they were not there entertained as were the captains and forces of Emmanuel: +the townsmen did browbeat them what they could; nor did they partake +or make stroy of any of the necessaries of Mansoul, but that which they +seized on against the townsmen’s will: what they could, they hid +from them, and what they could not, they had with an ill-will. +They, poor hearts! had rather have had their room than their company; +but they were at present their captives, and their captives for the +present they were forced to be. But, I say, they discountenanced +them as much as they were able, and showed them all the dislike that +they could.<br> +<br> +The captains also from the castle did hold them in continual play with +their slings, to the chafing and fretting of the minds of the enemies. +True, Diabolus made a great many attempts to have broken open the gates +of the castle, but Mr. Godly-Fear was made the keeper of that; and he +was a man of that courage, conduct, and valour, that it was in vain, +as long as life lasted within him, to think to do that work, though +mostly desired; wherefore all the attempts that Diabolus made against +him were fruitless. I have wished sometimes that that man had +had the whole rule of the town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +Well, this was the condition of the town of Mansoul for about two years +and a half: the body of the town was the seat of war, the people of +the town were driven into holes, and the glory of Mansoul was laid in +the dust. What rest, then, could be to the inhabitants, what peace +could Mansoul have, and what sun could shine upon it? Had the +enemy lain so long without in the plain against the town, it had been +enough to have famished them: but now, when they shall be within, when +the town shall be their tent, their trench and fort against the castle +that was in the town; when the town shall be against the town, and shall +serve to be a defence to the enemies of her strength and life: I say, +when they shall make use of the forts and town-holds to secure themselves +in, even till they shall take, spoil, and demolish the castle, - this +was terrible! and yet this was now the state of the town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +After the town of Mansoul had been in this sad and lamentable condition, +for so long a time as I have told you, and no petitions that they presented +their Prince with, all this while, could prevail, the inhabitants of +the town, namely, the elders and chief of Mansoul, gathered together, +and, after some time spent in condoling their miserable state and this +miserable judgment coming upon them, they agreed together to draw up +yet another petition, and to send it away to Emmanuel for relief. +But Mr. Godly-Fear stood up and answered, that he knew that his Lord +the Prince never did nor ever would receive a petition for these matters, +from the hand of any whoever, unless the Lord Secretary’s hand +was to it; ‘and this,’ quoth he, ‘is the reason that +you prevailed not all this while.’ Then they said they would +draw up one, and get the Lord Secretary’s hand unto it. +But Mr. Godly-Fear answered again, that he knew also that the Lord Secretary +would not set his hand to any petition that himself had not an hand +in composing and drawing up. ‘And besides,’ said he, +‘the Prince doth know my Lord Secretary’s hand from all +the hands in the world; wherefore he cannot be deceived by any pretence +whatever. Wherefore my advice is that you go to my Lord, and implore +him to lend you his aid.’ (Now he did yet abide in the castle, +where all the captains and men-at-arms were.)<br> +<br> +So they heartily thanked Mr. Godly-Fear, took his counsel, and did as +he had bidden them. So they went and came to my Lord, and made +known the cause of their coming to him; namely, that since Mansoul was +in so deplorable a condition, his Highness would be pleased to undertake +to draw up a petition for them to Emmanuel, the Son of the mighty Shaddai, +and to their King and his Father by him.<br> +<br> +Then said the Secretary to them, ‘What petition is it that you +would have me draw up for you?’ But they said, ‘Our +Lord knows best the state and condition of the town of Mansoul; and +how we are backslidden and degenerated from the Prince: thou also knowest +who is come up to war against us, and how Mansoul is now the seat of +war. My Lord knows, moreover, what barbarous usages our men, women, +and children have suffered at their hands; and how our homebred Diabolonians +do walk now with more boldness than dare the townsmen in the streets +of Mansoul. Let our Lord therefore, according to the wisdom of +God that is in him, draw up a petition for his poor servants to our +Prince Emmanuel.’ ‘Well,’ said the Lord Secretary, +‘I will draw up a petition for you, and will also set my hand +thereto.’ Then said they, ‘But when shall we call +for it at the hands of our Lord?’ But he answered, ‘Yourselves +must be present at the doing of it; yea, you must put your desires to +it. True, the hand and pen shall be mine, but the ink and paper +must be yours; else how can you say it is your petition? Nor have +I need to petition for myself, because I have not offended.’ He +also added as followeth: ‘No petition goes from me in my name +to the Prince, and so to his Father by him, but when the people that +are chiefly concerned therein do join in heart and soul in the matter, +for that must be inserted therein.’<br> +<br> +So they did heartily agree with the sentence of the Lord, and a petition +was forthwith drawn up for them. But now, who should carry it? +that was next. But the Secretary advised that Captain Credence +should carry it; for he was a well-spoken man. They therefore +called for him, and propounded to him the business. ‘Well,’ +said the captain, ‘I gladly accept of the motion; and though I +am lame, I will do this business for you with as much speed, and as +well as I can.’<br> +<br> +The contents of the petition were to this purpose<br> +<br> +‘O our Lord, and Sovereign Prince Emmanuel, the potent, the long-suffering +Prince! grace is poured into thy lips, and to thee belong mercy and +forgiveness, though we have rebelled against thee. We, who are +no more worthy to be called thy Mansoul, nor yet fit to partake of common +benefits, do beseech thee, and thy Father by thee, to do away our transgressions. +We confess that thou mightest cast us away for them; but do it not for +thy name’s sake: let the Lord rather take an opportunity, at our +miserable condition, to let out his bowels and compassions to us. +We are compassed on every side, Lord; our own backslidings reprove us; +our Diabolonians within our town fright us; and the army of the angel +of the bottomless pit distresses us. Thy grace can be our salvation, +and whither to go but to thee we know not.<br> +<br> +‘Furthermore, O gracious Prince, we have weakened our captains, +and they are discouraged, sick, and, of late, some of them grievously +worsted and beaten out of the field by the power and force of the tyrant. +Yea, even those of our captains, in whose valour we did formerly use +to put most of our confidence, they are as wounded men. Besides, +Lord, our enemies are lively, and they are strong; they vaunt and boast +themselves, and do threaten to part us among themselves for a booty. +They are fallen also upon us, Lord, with many thousand doubters, such +as with whom we cannot tell what to do; they are all grim-looked and +unmerciful ones, and they bid defiance to us and thee.<br> +<br> +‘Our wisdom is gone, our power is gone, because thou art departed +from us; nor have we what we may call ours but sin, shame, and confusion +of face for sin. Take pity upon us, O Lord, take pity upon us, +thy miserable town of Mansoul, and save us out of the hands of our enemies. +Amen.’<br> +<br> +This petition, as was touched afore, was handed by the Lord Secretary, +and carried to the court by the brave and most stout Captain Credence. +Now he carried it out at Mouth-gate, (for that, as I said, was the sally-port +of the town,) and he went and came to Emmanuel with it. Now how +it came out, I do not know; but for certain it did, and that so far +as to reach the ears of Diabolus. Thus I conclude, because that +the tyrant had it presently by the end, and charged the town of Mansoul +with it, saying, ‘Thou rebellious and stubborn-hearted Mansoul, +I will make thee to leave off petitioning. Art thou yet for petitioning? +I will make thee to leave.’ Yea, he also knew who the messenger +was that carried the petition to the Prince, and it made him both to +fear and rage.<br> +<br> +Wherefore he commanded that his drum should be beat again, a thing that +Mansoul could not abide to hear: but when Diabolus will have his drum +beat, Mansoul must abide the noise. Well, the drum was beat, and +the Diabolonians were gathered together.<br> +<br> +Then said Diabolus, ‘O ye stout Diabolonians, be it known unto +you, that there is treachery hatched against us in the rebellious town +of Mansoul; for albeit the town is in our possession, as you see, yet +these miserable Mansoulians have attempted to dare, and have been so +hardy as yet to send to the court to Emmanuel for help. This I +give you to understand, that ye may yet know how to carry it to the +wretched town of Mansoul. Wherefore, O my trusty Diabolonians, +I command that yet more and more ye distress this town of Mansoul, and +vex it with your wiles, ravish their women, deflower their virgins, +slay their children, brain their ancients, fire their town, and what +other mischief you can; and let this be the reward of the Mansoulians +from me, for their desperate rebellions against me.’<br> +<br> +This, you see, was the charge; but something stepped in betwixt that +and execution, for as yet there was but little more done than to rage.<br> +<br> +Moreover, when Diabolus had done thus, he went the next way up to the +castle gates, and demanded that, upon pain of death, the gates should +be opened to him, and that entrance should be given him and his men +that followed after. To whom Mr. Godly-Fear replied, (for he it +was that had the charge of that gate,) that the gate should not be opened +unto him, nor to the men that followed after him. He said, moreover, +that Mansoul, when she had suffered awhile, should be made perfect, +strengthened, settled.<br> +<br> +Then said Diabolus, ‘Deliver me, then, the men that have petitioned +against me, especially Captain Credence, that carried it to your Prince; +deliver that varlet into my hands, and I will depart from the town.’<br> +<br> +Then up starts a Diabolonian, whose name was Mr. Fooling, and said, +‘My lord offereth you fair: it is better for you that one man +perish, than that your whole Mansoul should be undone.’<br> +<br> +But Mr. Godly-Fear made him this replication, ‘How long will Mansoul +be kept out of the dungeon, when she hath given up her faith to Diabolus! +As good lose the town, as lose Captain Credence; for if one be gone +the other must follow.’ But to that Mr. Fooling said nothing.<br> +<br> +Then did my Lord Mayor reply, and said, ‘O thou devouring tyrant, +be it known unto thee, we shall hearken to none of thy words; we are +resolved to resist thee as long as a captain, a man, a sling, and a +stone to throw at thee shall be found in the town of Mansoul.’ +But Diabolus answered, ‘Do you hope, do you wait, do you look +for help and deliverance? You have sent to Emmanuel, but your +wickedness sticks too close in your skirts, to let innocent prayers +come out of your lips. Think you that you shall be prevailers +and prosper in this design? You will fail in your wish, you will +fail in your attempts; for it is not only I, but your Emmanuel is against +you: yea, it is he that hath sent me against you to subdue you. +For what, then, do you hope? or by what means will you escape?’<br> +<br> +Then said the Lord Mayor, ‘We have sinned indeed; but that shall +be no help to thee, for our Emmanuel hath said it, and that in great +faithfulness, “and him that cometh to me I will in no wise cast +out.” He hath also told us, O our enemy, that “all +manner of sin and blasphemy shall be forgiven” to the sons of +men. Therefore we dare not despair, but will look for, wait for, +and hope for deliverance still.’<br> +<br> +Now, by this time, Captain Credence was returned and come from the court +from Emmanuel to the castle of Mansoul, and he returned to them with +a packet. So my Lord Mayor, hearing that Captain Credence was +come, withdrew himself from the noise of the roaring of the tyrant, +and left him to yell at the wall of the town, or against the gates of +the castle. So he came up to the captain’s lodgings, and +saluting him, he asked him of his welfare, and what was the best news +at court. But when he asked Captain Credence that, the water stood +in his eyes. Then said the captain, ‘Cheer up, my lord, +for all will be well in time.’ And with that he first produced +his packet, and laid it by; but that the Lord Mayor, and the rest of +the captains, took for sign of good tidings. Now a season of grace +being come, he sent for all the captains and elders of the town, that +were here and there in their lodgings in the castle and upon their guard, +to let them know that Captain Credence was returned from the court, +and that he had something in general, and something in special, to communicate +to them. So they all came up to him, and saluted him, and asked +him concerning his journey, and what was the best news at the court. +And he answered them as he had done the Lord Mayor before, that all +would be well at last. Now, when the captain had thus saluted +them, he opened his packet, and thence did draw out his several notes +for those that he had sent for.<br> +<br> +And the first note was for my Lord Mayor, wherein was signified:- That +the Prince Emmanuel had taken it well that my Lord Mayor had been so +true and trusty in his office, and the great concerns that lay upon +him for the town and people of Mansoul. Also, he bid him to know, +that he took it well that he had been so bold for his Prince Emmanuel, +and had engaged so faithfully in his cause against Diabolus. He +also signified, at the close of his letter, that he should shortly receive +his reward.<br> +<br> +The second note that came out, was for the noble Lord Willbewill, wherein +there was signified:- That his Prince Emmanuel did well understand how +valiant and courageous he had been for the honour of his Lord, now in +his absence, and when his name was under contempt by Diabolus. +There was signified also, that his Prince had taken it well that he +had been so faithful to the town of Mansoul, in his keeping of so strict +a hand and eye over and so strict a rein upon the neck of the Diabolonians, +that did still lie lurking in their several holes in the famous town +of Mansoul. He signified, moreover, how that he understood that +my Lord had, with his own hand, done great execution upon some of the +chief of the rebels there, to the great discouragement of the adverse +party and to the good example of the whole town of Mansoul; and that +shortly his lordship should have his reward.<br> +<br> +The third note came out for the subordinate preacher, wherein was signified:- +That his Prince took it well from him, that he had so honestly and so +faithfully performed his office, and executed the trust committed to +him by his Lord, while he exhorted, rebuked, and forewarned Mansoul +according to the laws of the town. He signified, moreover, that +he took it well at his hand that he called to fasting, to sackcloth, +and ashes, when Mansoul was under her revolt. Also, that he called +for the aid of the Captain Boanerges to help in so weighty a work; and +that shortly he also should receive his reward.<br> +<br> +The fourth note came out for Mr. Godly-Fear, wherein his Lord thus signified:- +That his Lordship observed, that he was the first of all the men in +Mansoul that detected Mr. Carnal-Security as the only one that, through +his subtlety and cunning, had obtained for Diabolus a defection and +decay of goodness in the blessed town of Mansoul. Moreover, his +Lord gave him to understand, that he still remembered his tears and +mourning for the state of Mansoul. It was also observed, by the +same note, that his Lord took notice of his detecting of this Mr. Carnal-Security, +at his own table among his guests, in his own house, and that in the +midst of his jolliness, even while he was seeking to perfect his villanies +against the town of Mansoul. Emmanuel also took notice that this +reverend person, Mr. Godly-Fear, stood stoutly to it, at the gates of +the castle, against all the threats and attempts of the tyrant; and +that he had put the townsmen in a way to make their petition to their +Prince, so as that he might accept thereof, and as they might obtain +an answer of peace; and that therefore shortly he should receive his +reward.<br> +<br> +After all this, there was yet produced a note which was written to the +whole town of Mansoul, whereby they perceived - That their Lord took +notice of their so often repeating of petitions to him; and that they +should see more of the fruits of such their doings in time to come. +Their Prince did also therein tell them, that he took it well, that +their heart and mind, now at last, abode fixed upon him and his ways, +though Diabolus had made such inroads upon them; and that neither flatteries +on the one hand, nor hardships on the other, could make them yield to +serve his cruel designs. There was also inserted at the bottom +of this note - That his Lordship had left the town of Mansoul in the +hands of the Lord Secretary, and under the conduct of Captain Credence, +saying, ‘Beware that you yet yield yourselves unto their governance; +and in due time you shall receive your reward.’<br> +<br> +So, after the brave Captain Credence had delivered his notes to those +to whom they belonged, he retired himself to my Lord Secretary’s +lodgings, and there spends time in conversing with him; for they too +were very great one with another, and did indeed know more how things +would go with Mansoul than did all the townsmen besides. The Lord +Secretary also loved the Captain Credence dearly; yea, many a good bit +was sent him from my Lord’s table; also, he might have a show +of countenance, when the rest of Mansoul lay under the clouds: so, after +some time for converse was spent, the captain betook himself to his +chambers to rest. But it was not long after when my Lord did send +for the captain again; so the captain came to him, and they greeted +one another with usual salutations. Then said the captain to the +Lord Secretary, ‘What hath my Lord to say to his servant?’ +So the Lord Secretary took him and had him aside, and after a sign or +two of more favour, he said, ‘I have made thee the Lord’s +lieutenant over all the forces in Mansoul; so that, from this day forward, +all men in Mansoul shall be at thy word; and thou shalt be he that shall +lead in, and that shall lead out Mansoul. Thou shalt therefore +manage, according to thy place, the war for thy Prince, and for the +town of Mansoul, against the force and power of Diabolus; and at thy +command shall the rest of the captains be.’<br> +<br> +Now the townsmen began to perceive what interest the captain had, both +with the court, and also with the Lord Secretary in Mansoul; for no +man before could speed when sent, nor bring such good news from Emmanuel +as he. Wherefore what do they, after some lamentation that they +made no more use of him in their distresses, but send by their subordinate +preacher to the Lord Secretary, to desire him that all that ever they +were and had might be put under the government, care, custody, and conduct +of Captain Credence.<br> +<br> +So their preacher went and did his errand, and received this answer +from the mouth of his Lord: that Captain Credence should be the great +doer in all the King’s army, against the King’s enemies, +and also for the welfare of Mansoul. So he bowed to the ground, +and thanked his Lordship, and returned and told his news to the townsfolk. +But all this was done with all imaginable secrecy, because the foes +had yet great strength in the town. But to return to our story +again.<br> +<br> +When Diabolus saw himself thus boldly confronted by the Lord Mayor, +and perceived the stoutness of Mr. Godly-Fear, he fell into a rage, +and forthwith called a council of war, that he might be revenged on +Mansoul. So all the princes of the pit came together, and old +Incredulity at the head of them, with all the captains of his army. +So they consult what to do. Now the effect and conclusion of the +council that day was how they might take the castle, because they could +not conclude themselves masters of the town so long as that was in the +possession of their enemies.<br> +<br> +So one advised this way, and another advised that; but when they could +not agree in their verdict, Apollyon, that president of the council, +stood up, and thus he began: ‘My brotherhood,’ quoth he, +‘I have two things to propound unto you; and my first is this. +Let us withdraw ourselves from the town into the plain again, for our +presence here will do us no good, because the castle is yet in our enemies’ +hands; nor is it possible that we should take that, so long as so many +brave captains are in it, and that this bold fellow, Godly-Fear, is +made the keeper of the gates of it. Now, when we have withdrawn +ourselves into the plain, they, of their own accord, will be glad of +some little ease; and it may be, of their own accord, they again may +begin to be remiss, and even their so being will give them a bigger +blow than we can possibly give them ourselves. But if that should +fail, our going forth of the town may draw the captains out after us; +and you know what it cost them when we fought them in the field before. +Besides, can we but draw them out into the field, we may lay an ambush +behind the town, which shall, when they are come forth abroad, rush +in and take possession of the castle.’<br> +<br> +But Beelzebub stood up, and replied, saying: ‘It is impossible +to draw them all off from the castle; some, you may be sure, will lie +there to keep that; wherefore it will be but in vain thus to attempt, +unless we were sure that they will all come out.’ He therefore +concluded that what was done must be done by some other means. +And the most likely means that the greatest of their heads could invent, +was that which Apollyon had advised to before, namely, to get the townsmen +again to sin. ‘For,’ said he, ‘it is not our +being in the town, nor in the field, nor our fighting, nor our killing +of their men, that can make us the masters of Mansoul; for so long as +one in the town is able to lift up his finger against us, Emmanuel will +take their parts; and if he shall take their parts, we know what time +of day it will be with us. Wherefore, for my part,’ quoth +he, ‘there is, in my judgment, no way to bring them into bondage +to us, like inventing a way to make them sin. Had we,’ said +he, ‘left all our doubters at home, we had done as well as we +have done now, unless we could have made them the masters and governors +of the castle; for doubters at a distance are but like objections refelled +with arguments. Indeed, can we but get them into the hold, and +make them possessors of that, the day will be our own. Let us, +therefore, withdraw ourselves into the plain, (not expecting that the +captains in Mansoul should follow us,) but yet, I say, let us do this, +and before we so do, let us advise again with our trusty Diabolonians +that are yet in their holds of Mansoul, and set them to work to betray +the town to us; for they indeed must do it, or it will be left undone +for ever.’ By these sayings of Beelzebub, (for I think it +was he that gave this counsel,) the whole conclave was forced to be +of his opinion, namely, that the way to get the castle was to get the +town to sin. Then they fell to inventing by what means they might +do this thing.<br> +<br> +Then Lucifer stood up, and said: ‘The counsel of Beelzebub is +pertinent. Now, the way to bring this to pass, in mine opinion, +is this: let us withdraw our force from the town of Mansoul; let us +do this, and let us terrify them no more, either with summons, or threats, +or with the noise of our drum, or any other awakening means. Only +let us lie in the field at a distance, and be as if we regarded them +not; for frights, I see, do but awaken them, and make them more stand +to their arms. I have also another stratagem in my head: you know +Mansoul is a market-town, and a town that delights in commerce; what, +therefore, if some of our Diabolonians shall feign themselves far-country +men, and shall go out and bring to the market of Mansoul some of our +wares to sell; and what matter at what rates they sell their wares, +though it be but for half the worth? Now, let those that thus +shall trade in their market be those that are witty and true to us, +and I will lay my crown to pawn it will do. There are two that +are come to my thoughts already, that I think will be arch at this work, +and they are Mr. Penny-wise-pound-foolish, and Mr. Get-i’the-hundred-and-lose-i’the-shire; +nor is this man with the long name at all inferior to the other. +What, also, if you join with them Mr. Sweet-world and Mr. Present-good; +they are men that are civil and cunning, but our true friends and helpers. +Let these, with as many more, engage in this business for us, and let +Mansoul be taken up in much business, and let them grow full and rich, +and this is the way to get ground of them. Remember ye not that +thus we prevailed upon Laodicea, and how many at present do we hold +in this snare? Now, when they begin to grow full, they will forget +their misery; and if we shall not affright them, they may happen to +fall asleep, and so be got to neglect their town watch, their castle +watch, as well as their watch at the gates.<br> +<br> +‘Yea, may we not, by this means, so cumber Mansoul with abundance, +that they shall be forced to make of their castle a warehouse, instead +of a garrison fortified against us, and a receptacle for men of war. +Thus, if we get our goods and commodities thither, I reckon that the +castle is more than half ours. Besides, could we so order it that +it shall be filled with such kind of wares, then if we made a sudden +assault upon them, it would be hard for the captains to take shelter +there. Do you not know that of the parable, “The deceitfulness +of riches choke the word”? and again, “When the heart is +over-charged with surfeiting and drunkenness, and the cares of this +life,” all mischief comes upon them at unawares?<br> +<br> +‘Furthermore, my lords,’ quoth he, ‘you very well +know that it is not easy for a people to be filled with our things, +and not to have some of our Diabolonians as retainers to their houses +and services. Where is a Mansoulian that is full of this world, +that has not for his servants and waiting-men, Mr. Profuse, or Mr. Prodigality, +or some other of our Diabolonian gang, as Mr. Voluptuous, Mr. Pragmatical, +Mr. Ostentation, or the like? Now these can take the castle of +Mansoul, or blow it up, or make it unfit for a garrison for Emmanuel, +and any of these will do. Yea, these, for aught I know, may do +it for us sooner than an army of twenty thousand men. Wherefore, +to end as I began, my advice is, that we quietly withdraw ourselves, +not offering any further force, or forcible attempts, upon the castle, +at least at this time; and let us set on foot our new project, and let +us see if that will not make them destroy themselves.’<br> +<br> +This advice was highly applauded by them all, and was accounted the +very masterpiece of hell, namely, to choke Mansoul with a fulness of +this world, and to surfeit her heart with the good things thereof. +But see how things meet together! Just as this Diabolonian council +was broken up, Captain Credence received a letter from Emmanuel, the +contents of which were these: That upon the third day he would meet +him in the field in the plains about Mansoul. ‘Meet me in +the field!’ quoth the Captain; ‘what meaneth my lord by +this? I know not what he meaneth by meeting me in the field.’ +So he took the note in his hand, and did carry it to my Lord Secretary, +to ask his thoughts thereupon; for my Lord was a seer in all matters +concerning the King, and also for the good and comfort of the town of +Mansoul. So he showed my Lord the note, and desired his opinion +thereof. ‘For my part,’ quoth Captain Credence, ‘I +know not the meaning thereof.’ So my lord did take and read +it and, after a little pause, he said, ‘The Diabolonians have +had against Mansoul a great consultation to-day; they have, I say, this +day been contriving the utter ruin of the town; and the result of their +council is, to set Mansoul into such a way which, if taken, will surely +make her destroy herself. And, to this end, they are making ready +for their own departure out of the town, intending to betake themselves +to the field again,’ and there to lie till they shall see whether +this their project will take or no. But be thou ready with the +men of thy Lord, (for on the third day they will be in the plain,) there +to fall upon the Diabolonians; for the Prince will by that time be in +the field; yea, by that it is break of day, sun-rising, or before, and +that with a mighty force against them. So he shall be before them, +and thou shalt be behind them, and betwixt you both their army shall +be destroyed.’<br> +<br> +When Captain Credence heard this, away goes he to the rest of the captains, +and tells them what a note he had a while since received from the hand +of Emmanuel. ‘And,’ said he, ‘that which was +dark therein hath my lord the Lord Secretary expounded unto me.’ +He told them, moreover, what by himself and by them must be done to +answer the mind of their Lord. Then were the captains glad; and +Captain Credence commanded that all the King’s trumpeters should +ascend to the battlements of the castle, and there, in the audience +of Diabolus and of the whole town of Mansoul, make the best music that +heart could invent. The trumpeters then did as they were commanded. +They got themselves up to the top of the castle, and thus they began +to sound. Then did Diabolus start, and said, ‘What can be +the meaning of this? they neither sound Boot-and-saddle, nor Horse-and-away, +nor a charge. What do these madmen mean that yet they should be +so merry and glad?’ Then answered one of themselves and +said, ‘This is for joy that their Prince Emmanuel is coming to +relieve the town of Mansoul; and to this end he is at the head of an +army, and that this relief is near.’<br> +<br> +The men of Mansoul also were greatly concerned at this melodious charm +of the trumpets; they said, yea, they answered one another, saying, +‘This can be no harm to us; surely this can be no harm to us.’ +Then said the Diabolonians, ‘What had we best to do?’ and +it was answered, ‘It was best to quit the town;’ and ‘that,’ +said one, ‘ye may do in pursuance of your last counsel, and by +so doing also be better able to give the enemy battle, should an army +from without come upon us. So, on the second day, they withdrew +themselves from Mansoul, and abode in the plains without; but they encamped +themselves before Eye-gate, in what terrene and terrible manner they +could. The reason why they would not abide in the town (besides +the reasons that were debated in their late conclave) was, for that +they were not possessed of the stronghold, and ‘because,’ +said they, ‘we shall have more convenience to fight, and also +to fly, if need be, when we are encamped in the open plains.’ +Besides, the town would have been a pit for them rather than a place +of defence, had the Prince come up and inclosed them fast therein. +Therefore they betook themselves to the field, that they might also +be out of the reach of the slings, by which they were much annoyed all +the while that they were in the town.<br> +<br> +Well, the time that the captains were to fall upon the Diabolonians +being come, they eagerly prepared themselves for action; for Captain +Credence had told the captains over night, that they should meet their +Prince in the field to-morrow. This, therefore, made them yet +far more desirous to be engaging the enemy; for ‘You shall see +the Prince in the field to-morrow’ was like oil to a flaming fire, +for of a long time they had been at a distance: they therefore were +for this the more earnest and desirous of the work. So, as I said, +the hour being come, Captain Credence, with the rest of the men of war, +drew out their forces before it was day by the sally-port of the town. +And, being all ready, Captain Credence went up to the head of the army, +and gave to the rest of the captains the word, and so they to their +under-officers and soldiers: the word was ‘The sword of the Prince +Emmanuel, and the shield of Captain Credence;’ which is, in the +Mansoulian tongue, ‘The word of God and faith.’ Then +the captains fell on, and began roundly to front, and flank, and rear +Diabolus’s camp.<br> +<br> +Now, they left Captain Experience in the town, because he was yet ill +of his wounds, which the Diabolonians had given him in the last fight. +But when he perceived that the captains were at it, what does he but, +calling for his crutches with haste, gets up, and away he goes to the +battle, saying, ‘Shall I lie here, when my brethren are in the +fight, and when Emmanuel, the Prince, will show himself in the field +to his servants?’ But when the enemy saw the man come with +his crutches, they were daunted yet the more; ‘for,’ thought +they, ‘what spirit has possessed these Mansoulians, that they +fight us upon their crutches?’ Well, the captains, as I +said, fell on, and did bravely handle their weapons, still crying out +and shouting, as they laid on blows, ‘The sword of the Prince +Emmanuel, and the shield of Captain Credence!’<br> +<br> +Now, when Diabolus saw that the captains were come out, and that so +valiantly they surrounded his men, he concluded that, for the present, +nothing from them was to be looked for but blows, and the dints of their +‘two-edged sword.’<br> +<br> +Wherefore he also falls on upon the Prince’s army with all his +deadly force: so the battle was joined. Now who was it that at +first Diabolus met with in the fight, but Captain Credence on the one +hand, and the Lord Willbewill on the other: now Willbewill’s blows +were like the blows of a giant, for that man had a strong arm, and he +fell in upon the election doubters, for they were the life-guard of +Diabolus, and he kept them in play a good while, cutting and battering +shrewdly. Now when Captain Credence saw my lord engaged, he did +stoutly fall on, on the other hand, upon the same company also; so they +put them to great disorder. Now Captain Good-Hope had engaged +the vocation doubters, and they were sturdy men; but the captain was +a valiant man: Captain Experience did also send him some aid; so he +made the vocation doubters to retreat. The rest of the armies +were hotly engaged, and that on every side, and the Diabolonians did +fight stoutly. Then did my Lord Secretary command that the slings +from the castle should be played; and his men could throw stones at +an hair’s breadth. But, after a while, those that were made +to fly before the captains of the Prince, did begin to rally again, +and they came up stoutly upon the rear of the Prince’s army: wherefore +the Prince’s army began to faint; but, remembering that they should +see the face of their Prince by-and-by, they took courage, and a very +fierce battle was fought. Then shouted the captains, saying, ‘The +sword of the Prince Emmanuel, and the shield of Captain Credence!’ +and with that Diabolus gave back, thinking that more aid had been come. +But no Emmanuel as yet appeared. Moreover, the battle did hang +in doubt; and they made a little retreat on both sides. Now, in +the time of respite, Captain Credence bravely encouraged his men to +stand to it; and Diabolus did the like, as well as he could. But +Captain Credence made a brave speech to his soldiers, the contents whereof +here follow:-<br> +<br> +‘Gentlemen soldiers, and my brethren in this design, it rejoiceth +me much to see in the field for our Prince, this day, so stout and so +valiant an army, and such faithful lovers of Mansoul. You have +hitherto, as hath become you, shown yourselves men of truth and courage +against the Diabolonian forces; so that, for all their boast, they have +not yet much cause to boast of their gettings. Now take to yourselves +your wonted courage, and show yourselves men even this once only; for +in a few minutes after the next engagement, this time, you shall see +your Prince show himself in the field; for we must make this second +assault upon this tyrant Diabolus, and then Emmanuel comes.’<br> +<br> +No sooner had the captain made this speech to his soldiers, but one +Mr. Speedy came post to the captain from the Prince, to tell him that +Emmanuel was at hand. This news when the captain had received, +he communicated to the other field-officers, and they again to their +soldiers and men of war. Wherefore, like men raised from the dead, +so the captains and their men arose, made up to the enemy, and cried +as before, ‘The sword of the Prince Emmanuel, and the shield of +Captain Credence!’<br> +<br> +The Diabolonians also bestirred themselves, and made resistance as well +as they could; but in this last engagement the Diabolonians lost their +courage, and many of the doubters fell down dead to the ground. +Now, when they had been in heat of battle about an hour or more, Captain +Credence lift up his eyes and saw, and, behold, Emmanuel came; and he +came with colours flying, trumpets sounding, and the feet of his men +scarce touched the ground, they hasted with that celerity towards the +captains that were engaged. Then did Credence wind with his men +to the townward, and gave to Diabolus the field: so Emmanuel came upon +him on the one side, and the enemies’ place was betwixt them both. +Then again they fell to it afresh; and now it was but a little while +more but Emmanuel and Captain Credence met, still trampling down the +slain as they came.<br> +<br> +But when the captains saw that the Prince was come, and that he fell +upon the Diabolonians on the other side, and that Captain Credence and +his Highness had got them up betwixt them, they shouted, (they so shouted +that the ground rent again,) saying, ‘The sword of Emmanuel, and +the shield of Captain Credence!’ Now, when Diabolus saw +that he and his forces were so hard beset by the Prince and his princely +army, what does he, and the lords of the pit that were with him, but +make their escape, and forsake their army, and leave them to fall by +the hand of Emmanuel, and of his noble Captain Credence: so they fell +all down slain before them, before the Prince, and before his royal +army; there was not left so much as one doubter alive; they lay spread +upon the ground dead men, as one would spread dung upon the land.<br> +<br> +When the battle was over, all things came into order in the camp. +Then the captains and elders of Mansoul came together to salute Emmanuel, +while without the corporation: so they saluted him, and welcomed him, +and that with a thousand welcomes, for that he was come to the borders +of Mansoul again. So he smiled upon them, and said, ‘Peace +be to you.’ Then they addressed themselves to go to the +town; they went then to go up to Mansoul, they, the Prince, with all +the new forces that now he had brought with him to the war. Also +all the gates of the town were set open for his reception, so glad were +they of his blessed return. And this was the manner and order +of this going of his into Mansoul:<br> +<br> +First. As I said, all the gates of the town were set open, yea, +the gates of the castle also; the elders, too, of the town of Mansoul +placed themselves at the gates of the town, to salute him at his entrance +thither: and so they did; for, as he drew near, and approached towards +the gates, they said, ‘Lift up your heads, O ye gates; and be +ye lift up, ye everlasting doors; and the King of glory shall come in.’ +And they answered again, ‘Who is the King of glory?’ and +they made return to themselves, ‘The Lord, strong and mighty; +the Lord mighty in battle. Lift up your heads, O ye gates; even +lift them up, ye everlasting doors,’ etc.<br> +<br> +Secondly. It was ordered also, by those of Mansoul, that all the +way from the town gates to those of the castle, his blessed Majesty +should be entertained with the song, by them that had the best skill +in music in all the town of Mansoul: then did the elders, and the rest +of the men of Mansoul, answer one another as Emmanuel entered the town, +till he came at the castle gates, with songs and sound of trumpets, +saying, ‘They have seen thy goings, O God; even the goings of +my God, my King, in the sanctuary. So the singers went before, +the players on instruments followed after, and among them were the damsels +playing on timbrels.’<br> +<br> +Thirdly. Then the captains, (for I would speak a word of them,) +they in their order waited on the Prince, as he entered into the gates +of Mansoul. Captain Credence went before, and Captain Good-Hope +with him; Captain Charity came behind with other of his companions, +and Captain Patience followed after all; and the rest of the captains, +some on the right hand, and some on the left, accompanied Emmanuel into +Mansoul. And all the while the colours were displayed, the trumpets +sounded, and continual shoutings were among the soldiers. The +Prince himself rode into the town in his armour, which was all of beaten +gold, and in his chariot - the pillars of it were of silver, the bottom +thereof of gold, the covering of it was of purple, the midst thereof +being paved with love for the daughters of the town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +Fourthly. When the Prince was come to the entrance of Mansoul, +he found all the streets strewed with lilies and flowers, curiously +decked with boughs and branches from the green trees that stood round +about the town. Every door also was filled with persons, who had +adorned every one their fore-part against their house with something +of variety and singular excellency, to entertain him withal as he passed +in the streets: they also themselves, as Emmanuel passed by, did welcome +him with shouts and acclamations of joy, saying, ‘Blessed be the +Prince that cometh in the name of his Father Shaddai.’<br> +<br> +Fifthly. At the castle gates the elders of Mansoul, namely, the +Lord Mayor, the Lord Willbewill, the subordinate preacher, Mr. Knowledge, +and Mr. Mind, with other of the gentry of the place, saluted Emmanuel +again. They bowed before him, they kissed the dust of his feet, +they thanked, they blessed, and praised his Highness for not taking +advantage against them for their sins, but rather had pity upon them +in their misery, and returned to them with mercies, and to build up +their Mansoul for ever. Thus was he had up straightway to the +castle; for that was the royal palace, and the place where his honour +was to dwell; the which was ready prepared for his Highness by the presence +of the Lord Secretary, and the work of Captain Credence. So he +entered in.<br> +<br> +Sixthly. Then the people and commonalty of the town of Mansoul +came to him into the castle to mourn, and to weep, and to lament for +their wickedness, by which they had forced him out of the town. +So when they were come, bowed themselves to the ground seven times; +they also wept, they wept aloud, and asked forgiveness of the Prince, +and prayed that he would again, as of old, confirm his love to Mansoul.<br> +<br> +To the which the great Prince replied, ‘Weep not, but go your +way, eat the fat, and drink the sweet, and send portions to them for +whom nought is prepared; for the joy of your Lord is your strength. +I am returned to Mansoul with mercies, and my name shall be set up, +exalted, and magnified by it.’ He also took these inhabitants, +and kissed them, and laid them in his bosom.<br> +<br> +Moreover, he gave to the elders of Mansoul, and to each town officer, +a chain of gold and a signet. He also sent to their wives earrings +and jewels, and bracelets, and other things. He also bestowed +upon the true-born children of Mansoul many precious things.<br> +<br> +When Emmanuel, the Prince, had done all these things for the famous +town of Mansoul, then he said unto them, first, ‘Wash your garments, +then put on your ornaments, and then come to me into the castle of Mansoul.’ +So they went to the fountain that was set open for Judah and Jerusalem +to wash in; and there they washed, and there they made their ‘garments +white,’ and came again to the Prince into the castle, and thus +they stood before him.<br> +<br> +And now there was music and dancing throughout the whole town of Mansoul, +and that because their Prince had again granted to them his presence +and the light of his countenance; the bells also did ring, and the sun +shone comfortably upon them for a great while together.<br> +<br> +The town of Mansoul did also now more thoroughly seek the destruction +and ruin of all remaining Diabolonians that abode in the walls, and +the dens that they had in the town of Mansoul; for there was of them +that had, to this day, escaped with life and limb from the hand of their +suppressors in the famous town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +But my Lord Willbewill was a greater terror to them now than ever he +had been before; forasmuch as his heart was yet more fully bent to seek, +contrive, and pursue them to the death; he pursued them night and day, +and did put them now to sore distress, as will afterwards appear.<br> +<br> +After things were thus far put into order in the famous town of Mansoul, +care was taken, and order given by the blessed Prince Emmanuel, that +the townsmen should, without further delay, appoint some to go forth +into the plain to bury the dead that were there, - the dead that fell +by the sword of Emmanuel, and by the shield of the Captain Credence, +- lest the fumes and ill savours that would arise from them might infect +the air, and so annoy the famous town of Mansoul. This also was +a reason of this order, namely, that, as much as in Mansoul lay, they +might cut off the name, and being, and remembrance of those enemies +from the thought of the famous town of Mansoul and its inhabitants.<br> +<br> +So order was given out by the Lord Mayor, that wise and trusty friend +of the town of Mansoul, that persons should be employed about this necessary +business; and Mr. Godly-Fear, and one Mr. Upright, were to be overseers +about this matter: so persons were put under them to work in the fields, +and to bury the slain that lay dead in the plains. And these were +their places of employment: some were to make the graves, some to bury +the dead, and some were to go to and fro in the plains, and also round +about the borders of Mansoul, to see if a skull, or a bone, or a piece +of a bone of a doubter, was yet to be found above ground anywhere near +the corporation; and if any were found, it was ordered, that the searchers +that searched should set up a mark thereby, and a sign, that those that +were appointed to bury them might find it, and bury it out of sight, +that the name and remembrance of a Diabolonian doubter might be blotted +out from under heaven; and that the children, and they that were to +be born in Mansoul, might not know, if possible, what a skull, what +a bone, or a piece of a bone of a doubter was. So the buriers, +and those that were appointed for that purpose, did as they were commanded: +they buried the doubters, and all the skulls and bones, and pieces of +bones of doubters, wherever they found them; and so they cleansed the +plains. Now also Mr. God’s-Peace took up his commission, +and acted again as in former days.<br> +<br> +Thus they buried in the plains about Mansoul the election doubters, +the vocation doubters, the grace doubters, the perseverance doubters, +the resurrection doubters, the salvation doubters, and the glory doubters; +whose captains were Captain Rage, Captain Cruel, Captain Damnation, +Captain Insatiable, Captain Brimstone, Captain Torment, Captain No-Ease, +Captain Sepulchre, and Captain Past-Hope; and old Incredulity was, under +Diabolus, their general. There were also the seven heads of their +army; and they were the Lord Beelzebub, the Lord Lucifer, the Lord Legion, +the Lord Apollyon, the Lord Python, the Lord Cerberus, and the Lord +Belial. But the princes and the captains, with old Incredulity, +their general, did all of them make their escape: so their men fell +down slain by the power of the Prince’s forces, and by the hands +of the men of the town of Mansoul. They also were buried as is +afore related, to the exceeding great joy of the now famous town of +Mansoul. They that buried them buried also with them their arms, +which were cruel instruments of death: (their weapons were arrows, darts, +mauls, firebrands, and the like). They buried also their armour, +their colours, banners, with the standard of Diabolus, and what else +soever they could find that did but smell of a Diabolonian doubter.<br> +<br> +Now when the tyrant had arrived at Hell-Gate Hill, with his old friend +Incredulity, they immediately descended the den, and having there with +their fellows for a while condoled their misfortune and great loss that +they sustained against the town of Mansoul, they fell at length into +a passion, and revenged they would be for the loss that they sustained +before the town of Mansoul. Wherefore they presently call a council +to contrive yet further what was to be done against the famous town +of Mansoul; for their yawning paunches could not wait to see the result +of their Lord Lucifer’s and their Lord Apollyon’s counsel +that they had given before; for their raging gorge thought every day, +even as long as a short for ever, until they were filled with the body +and soul, with the flesh and bones, and with all the delicates of Mansoul. +They therefore resolve to make another attempt upon the town of Mansoul, +and that by an army mixed and made up partly of doubters, and partly +of blood-men. A more particular account now take of both.<br> +<br> +The doubters are such as have their name from their nature, as well +as from the land and kingdom where they are born: their nature is to +put a question upon every one of the truths of Emmanuel; and their country +is called the land of Doubting, and that land lieth off, and farthest +remote to the north, between the land of Darkness and that called the +‘valley of the shadow of death.’ For though the land +of Darkness, and that called ‘the valley of the shadow of death,’ +be sometimes called as if they were one and the self-same place, yet +indeed they are two, lying but a little way asunder, and the land of +Doubting points in, and lieth between them. This is the land of +Doubting; and these that came with Diabolus to ruin the town of Mansoul +are the natives of that country.<br> +<br> +The blood-men are a people that have their name derived from the malignity +of their nature, and from the fury that is in them to execute it upon +the town of Mansoul: their land lieth under the dog-star, and by that +they are governed as to their intellectuals. The name of their +country is the province of Loath-good: the remote parts of it are far +distant from the land of Doubting, yet they do both butt and bound upon +the hill called Hell-Gate Hill. These people are always in league +with the doubters, for they jointly do make question of the faith and +fidelity of the men of the town of Mansoul, and so are both alike qualified +for the service of their prince.<br> +<br> +Now of these two countries did Diabolus, by the beating of his drum, +raise another army against the town of Mansoul, of five-and-twenty thousand +strong. There were ten thousand doubters, and fifteen thousand +blood-men, and they were put under several captains for the war; and +old Incredulity was again made general of the army.<br> +<br> +As for the doubters, their captains were five of the seven that were +heads of the last Diabolonian army, and these are their names: Captain +Beelzebub, Captain Lucifer, Captain Apollyon, Captain Legion, and Captain +Cerberus; and the captains that they had before were some of them made +lieutenants, and some ensigns of the army.<br> +<br> +But Diabolus did not count that, in this expedition of his, these doubters +would prove his principal men, for their manhood had been tried before; +also the Mansoulians had put them to the worst: only he did bring them +to multiply a number, and to help, if need was, at a pinch. But +his trust he put in his blood-men, for that they were all rugged villains, +and he knew that they had done feats heretofore.<br> +<br> +As for the blood-men, they also were under command and the names of +their captains were, Captain Cain, Captain Nimrod, Captain Ishmael, +Captain Esau, Captain Saul, Captain Absalom, Captain Judas, and Captain +Pope.<br> +<br> +1. Captain Cain was over two bands, namely, the zealous and the angry +blood-men: his standard-bearer bare the red colours, and his scutcheon +was the murdering club.<br> +<br> +2. Captain Nimrod was captain over two bands, namely, the tyrannical +and encroaching blood-men: his standard-bearer bare the red colours, +and his scutcheon was the great bloodhound.<br> +<br> +3. Captain Ishmael was captain over two bands, namely, the mocking and +scorning blood-men: his standard-bearer bare the red colours, and his +scutcheon was one mocking at Abraham’s Isaac.<br> +<br> +4. Captain Esau was captain over two bands, namely, the blood-men that +grudged that another should have the blessing; also over the blood-men +that are for executing their private revenge upon others: his standard-bearer +bare the red colours, and his scutcheon was one privately lurking to +murder Jacob.<br> +<br> +5. Captain Saul was captain over two bands, namely, the groundlessly +jealous and the devilishly furious blood-men: his standard-bearer bare +the red colours, and his scutcheon was three bloody darts cast at harmless +David.<br> +<br> +6. Captain Absalom was captain over two bands, namely, over the blood-men +that will kill a father or a friend for the glory of this world; also +over those blood-men that will hold one fair in hand with words, till +they shall have pierced him with their swords: his standard-bearer did +bear the red colours, and his scutcheon was the son pursuing the father’s +blood.<br> +<br> +7. Captain Judas was over two bands, namely, the blood-men that will +sell a man’s life for money, and those also that will betray their +friend with a kiss: his standard-bearer bare the red colours, and his +scutcheon was thirty pieces of silver and the halter.<br> +<br> +8. Captain Pope was captain over one band, for all these spirits are +joined in one under him: his standard-bearer bare the red colours, and +his scutcheon was the stake, the flame, and the good man in it.<br> +<br> +Now, the reason why Diabolus did so soon rally another force, after +he had been beaten out of the field, was, for that he put mighty confidence +in this army of blood-men; for he put a great deal of more trust in +them than he did before in his army of doubters; though they had also +often done great service for him in the strengthening of him in his +kingdom. But these blood-men, he had proved them often, and their +sword did seldom return empty. Besides, he knew that these, like +mastiffs, would fasten upon any; upon father, mother, brother, sister, +prince, or governor, yea upon the Prince of princes. And that +which encouraged him the more was, for that they once did force Emmanuel +out of the kingdom of Universe; ‘And why,’ thought he, ‘may +they not also drive him from the town of Mansoul?’<br> +<br> +So this army of five-and-twenty thousand strong was, by their general, +the great Lord Incredulity, led up against the town of Mansoul. +Now Mr. Prywell, the scoutmaster-general, did himself go out to spy, +and he did bring Mansoul tidings of their coming. Wherefore they +shut up their gates, and put themselves in a posture of defence against +these new Diabolonians that came up against the town.<br> +<br> +So Diabolus brought up his army, and beleaguered the town of Mansoul; +the doubters were placed about Feel-gate, and the blood-men set down +before Eye-gate and Ear-gate.<br> +<br> +Now when this army had thus encamped themselves, Incredulity did, in +the name of Diabolus, his own name, and in the name of the blood-men +and the rest that were with him, send a summons as hot as a red-hot +iron to Mansoul, to yield to their demands; threatening, that if they +still stood it out against them, they would presently burn down Mansoul +with fire. For you must know that, as for the blood-men, they +were not so much that Mansoul should be surrendered, as that Mansoul +should be destroyed, and cut off out of the land of the living. +True, they send to them to surrender; but should they so do, that would +not stench or quench the thirsts of these men. They must have +blood, the blood of Mansoul, else they die; and it is from hence that +they have their name. Wherefore these blood-men he reserved while +now that they might, when all his engines proved ineffectual, as his +last and sure card be played against the town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +Now, when the townsmen had received this red-hot summons, it begat in +them at present some changing and interchanging thoughts; but they jointly +agreed, in less than half an hour, to carry the summons to the Prince, +the which they did when they had writ at the bottom of it, ‘Lord, +save Mansoul from bloody men!’<br> +<br> +So he took it, and looked upon it, and considered it, and took notice +also of that short petition that the men of Mansoul had written at the +bottom of it, and called to him the noble Captain Credence, and bid +him go and take Captain Patience with him, and go and take care of that +side of Mansoul that was beleaguered by the blood-men. So they +went and did as they were commanded: the Captain Credence went and took +Captain Patience, and they both secured that side of Mansoul that was +besieged by the blood-men.<br> +<br> +Then he commanded that Captain Good-hope and Captain Charity, and my +Lord Willbewill, should take charge of the other side of the town. +‘And I,’ said the Prince, ‘will set my standard upon +the battlements of your castle, and do you three watch against the doubters.’ +This done, he again commanded that the brave captain, the Captain Experience, +should draw up his men in the market-place, and that there he should +exercise them day by day before the people of the town of Mansoul. +Now this siege was long, and many a fierce attempt did the enemy, especially +those called the blood-men, make upon the town of Mansoul; and many +a shrewd brush did some of the townsmen meet with from them, especially +Captain Self-Denial, who, I should have told you before, was commanded +to take the care of Ear-gate and Eye-gate now against the blood-men. +This Captain Self-Denial was a young man, but stout, and a townsman +in Mansoul, as Captain Experience also was. And Emmanuel, at his +second return to Mansoul, made him a captain over a thousand of the +Mansoulians, for the good of the corporation. This captain, therefore, +being an hardy man, and a man of great courage, and willing to venture +himself for the good of the town of Mansoul, would now and then sally +out upon the blood-men, and give them many notable alarms, and entered +several brisk skirmishes with them, and also did some execution upon +them; but you must think that this could not easily be done, but he +must meet with brushes himself, for he carried several of their marks +in his face; yea, and some in some other parts of his body.<br> +<br> +So, after some time spent for the trial of the faith, and hope, and +love of the town of Mansoul, the Prince Emmanuel upon a day calls his +captains and men of war together, and divides them into two companies; +this done, he commands them at a time appointed, and that in the morning +very early, to sally out upon the enemy, saying: ‘Let half of +you fall upon the doubters, and half of you fall upon the blood-men. +Those of you that go out against the doubters, kill and slay, and cause +to perish so many of them as by any means you can lay hands on; but +for you that go out against the blood-men, slay them not, but take them +alive.’<br> +<br> +So, at the time appointed, betimes in the morning, the captains went +out as they were commanded, against the enemies. Captain Good-Hope, +Captain Charity, and those that were joined with them, as Captain Innocent +and Captain Experience, went out against the doubters; and Captain Credence, +and Captain Patience, with Captain Self-Denial, and the rest that were +to join with them, went out against the blood-men.<br> +<br> +Now, those that went out against the doubters drew up into a body before +the plain, and marched on to bid them battle. But the doubters, +remembering their last success, made a retreat, not daring to stand +the shock, but fled from the Prince’s men; wherefore they pursued +them, and in their pursuit slew many, but they could not catch them +all. Now those that escaped went some of them home; and the rest +by fives, nines, and seventeens, like wanderers, went straggling up +and down the country, where they upon the barbarous people showed and +exercised many of their Diabolonian actions: nor did these people rise +up in arms against them, but suffered themselves to be enslaved by them. +They would also after this show themselves in companies before the town +of Mansoul, but never to abide in it; for if Captain Credence, Captain +Good-Hope, or Captain Experience did but show themselves, they fled.<br> +<br> +Those that went out against the blood-men did as they were commanded: +they forbore to slay any, but sought to compass them about. But +the blood-men, when they saw that no Emmanuel was in the field, concluded +also that no Emmanuel was in Mansoul; wherefore they, looking upon what +the captains did to be, as they called it, a fruit of the extravagancy +of their wild and foolish fancies, rather despised them than feared +them. But the captains, minding their business, at last did compass +them round; they also that had routed the doubters came in amain to +their aid: so, in fine, after some little struggling, (for the blood-men +also would have run for it, only now it was too late; for though they +are mischievous and cruel, where they can overcome, yet all blood-men +are chicken-hearted men, when they once come to see themselves matched +and equalled,) - so the captains took them, and brought them to the +Prince.<br> +<br> +Now when they were taken, had before the Prince, and examined, he found +them to be of three several counties, though they all came out of one +land.<br> +<br> +1. One sort of them came out of Blind-man-shire, and they were such +as did ignorantly what they did.<br> +<br> +2. Another sort of them came out of Blind-zeal-shire, and they did superstitiously +what they did.<br> +<br> +3. The third sort of them came out of the town of Malice, in the county +of Envy, and they did what they did out of spite and implacableness.<br> +<br> +For the first of these, namely, they that came out of Blind-man-shire, +when they saw where they were, and against whom they had fought, they +trembled and cried, as they stood before him; and as many of these as +asked him mercy, he touched their lips with his golden sceptre.<br> +<br> +They that came out of Blind-zeal-shire, they did not as their fellows +did; for they pleaded that they had a right to do what they did, because +Mansoul was a town whose laws and customs were diverse from all that +dwelt thereabouts. Very few of these could be brought to see their +evil; but those that did, and asked mercy, they also obtained favour.<br> +<br> +Now, they that came out of the town of Malice, that is in the county +of Envy, they neither wept, nor disputed, nor repented, but stood gnawing +their tongues before him for anguish and madness, because they could +not have their will upon Mansoul. Now these last, with all those +of the other two sorts that did not unfeignedly ask pardon for their +faults, - those he made to enter into sufficient bond to answer for +what they had done against Mansoul, and against her King, at the great +and general assizes to be holden for our Lord the King, where he himself +should appoint for the country and kingdom of Universe. So they +became bound each man for himself, to come in, when called upon, to +answer before our Lord the King for what they had done as before.<br> +<br> +And thus much concerning this second army that was sent by Diabolus +to overthrow Mansoul.<br> +<br> +But there were three of those that came from the land of Doubting, who, +after they had wandered and ranged the country a while, and perceived +that they had escaped, were so hardy as to thrust themselves, knowing +that yet there were in the town Diabolonians, - I say, they were so +hardy as to thrust themselves into Mansoul among them. (Three, +did I say? I think there were four.) Now, to whose house +should these Diabolonian doubters go, but to the house of an old Diabolonian +in Mansoul, whose name was Evil-Questioning, a very great enemy he was +to Mansoul, and a great doer among the Diabolonians there. Well, +to this Evil-Questioning’s house, as was said, did these Diabolonians +come (you may be sure that they had directions how to find the way thither), +so he made them welcome, pitied their misfortune, and succoured them +with the best that he had in his house. Now, after a little acquaintance +(and it was not long before they had that), this old Evil-Questioning +asked the doubters if they were all of a town (he knew that they were +all of one kingdom), and they answered: ‘No, nor not of one shire +neither; for I,’ said one, ‘am an election doubter:’ +‘I,’ said another, ‘am a vocation doubter:’ +then said the third, ‘I am a salvation doubter:’ and the +fourth said he was a grace doubter. ‘Well,’ quoth +the old gentleman, ‘be of what shire you will, I am persuaded +that you are down, boys: you have the very length of my foot, are one +with my heart, and shall be welcome to me.’ So they thanked +him, and were glad that they had found themselves an harbour in Mansoul.<br> +<br> +Then said Evil-Questioning to them: ‘How many of your company +might there be that came with you to the siege of Mansoul?’ and +they answered: ‘There were but ten thousand doubters in all, for +the rest of the army consisted of fifteen thousand blood-men. +These blood-men,’ quoth they, ‘border upon our country; +but, poor men! as we hear, they were every one taken by Emmanuel’s +forces.’ ‘Ten thousand!’ quoth the old gentleman; +‘I will promise you, that is a round company. But how came +it to pass, since you were so mighty a number, that you fainted, and +durst not fight your foes?’ ‘Our general,’ said +they, ‘was the first man that did run for it.’ ‘Pray,’ +quoth their landlord, ‘who was that, your cowardly general?’ +‘He was once the Lord Mayor of Mansoul,’ said they: ‘but +pray call him not a cowardly general; for whether any from the east +to the west has done more service for our prince Diabolus, than has +my Lord Incredulity, will be a hard question for you to answer. +But had they catched him, they would for certain have hanged him; and +we promise you, hanging is but a bad business.’ Then said +the old gentleman, ‘I would that all the ten thousand doubters +were now well armed in Mansoul, and myself at the head of them; I would +see what I could do.’ ‘Ay,’ said they, ‘that +would be well if we could see that; but wishes, alas! what are they?’ +and these words were spoken aloud. ‘Well,’ said old +Evil-Questioning, ‘take heed that you talk not too loud; you must +be quat and close, and must take care of yourselves while you are here, +or, I will assure you, you will be snapped.’ ‘Why?’ +quoth the doubters. ‘Why!’ quoth the old gentleman; +‘why! because both the Prince and Lord Secretary, and their captains +and soldiers, are all at present in town; yea, the town is as full of +them as ever it can hold. And besides, there is one whose name +is Willbewill, a most cruel enemy of ours, and him the Prince has made +keeper of the gates, and has commanded him that, with all the diligence +he can, he should look for, search out, and destroy all, and all manner +of Diabolonians. And if he lighteth upon you, down you go, though +your heads were made of gold.’<br> +<br> +And now, to see how it happened, one of the Lord Willbewill’s +faithful soldiers, whose name was Mr. Diligence, stood all this while +listening under old Evil-Questioning’s eaves, and heard all the +talk that had been betwixt him and the doubters that he entertained +under his roof.<br> +<br> +The soldier was a man that my lord had much confidence in, and that +he loved dearly; and that both because he was a man of courage, and +also a man that was unwearied in seeking after Diabolonians to apprehend +them.<br> +<br> +Now this man, as I told you, heard all the talk that was between old +Evil-Questioning and these Diabolonians; wherefore what does he but +goes to his lord, and tells him what he had heard. ‘And +sayest thou so, my trusty?’ quoth my lord. ‘Ay,’ +quoth Diligence, ‘that I do; and if your lordship will be pleased +to go with me, you shall find it as I have said.’ ‘And +are they there?’ quoth my lord. ‘I know Evil-Questioning +well, for he and I were great in the time of our apostasy: but I know +not now where he dwells.’ ‘But I do,’ said his +man, ‘and if your lordship will go, I will lead you the way to +his den.’ ‘Go!’ quoth my lord, ‘that I +will. Come, my Diligence, let us go find them out.’<br> +<br> +So my lord and his man went together the direct way to his house. +Now his man went before to show him his way, and they went till they +came even under old Mr. Evil-Questioning’s wall. Then said +Diligence, ‘Hark! my lord, do you know the old gentleman’s +tongue when you hear it?’ ‘Yes,’ said my lord, +‘I know it well, but I have not seen him many a day. This +I know, he is cunning; I wish he doth not give us the slip.’ +‘Let me alone for that,’ said his servant Diligence. +‘But how shall we find the door?’ quoth my lord. ‘Let +me alone for that, too,’ said his man. So he had my Lord +Willbewill about, and showed him the way to the door. Then my +lord, without more ado, broke open the door, rushed into the house, +and caught them all five together, even as Diligence his man had told +him. So my lord apprehended them, and led them away, and committed +them to the hand of Mr. Trueman, the gaoler, and commanded, and he did +put them in ward. This done, my Lord Mayor was acquainted in the +morning with what my Lord Willbewill had done over night, and his lordship +rejoiced much at the news, not only because there were doubters apprehended, +but because that old Evil-Questioning was taken; for he had been a very +great trouble to Mansoul, and much affliction to my Lord Mayor himself. +He had also been sought for often, but no hand could ever be laid upon +him till now.<br> +<br> +Well, the next thing was to make preparation to try these five that +by my lord had been apprehended, and that were in the hands of Mr. Trueman, +the gaoler. So the day was set, and the court called and come +together, and the prisoners brought to the bar. My Lord Willbewill +had power to have slain them when at first he took them, and that without +any more ado; but he thought it at this time more for the honour of +the Prince, the comfort of Mansoul, and the discouragement of the enemy, +to bring them forth to public judgment.<br> +<br> +But, I say, Mr. Trueman brought them in chains to the bar; to the town-hall, +for that was the place of judgment. So, to be short, the jury +was panelled, the witnesses sworn, and the prisoners tried for their +lives: the jury was the same that tried Mr. No-Truth, Pitiless, Haughty, +and the rest of their companions.<br> +<br> +And, first, old Questioning himself was set to the bar for he was the +receiver, the entertainer, and comforter of these doubters, that by +nation were outlandish men: then he was bid to hearken to his charge, +and was told that he had liberty to object, if he had ought to say for +himself. So his indictment was read: the manner and form here +follows.<br> +<br> +‘Mr. Questioning, Thou art here indicted by the name of Evil-Questioning, +an intruder upon the town of Mansoul, for that thou art a Diabolonian +by nature, and also a hater of the Prince Emmanuel, and one that hast +studied the ruin of the town of Mansoul. Thou art also here indicted +for countenancing the King’s enemies, after wholesome laws made +to the contrary: for, 1. Thou hast questioned the truth of her doctrine +and state: 2. In wishing that ten thousand doubters were in her: 3. +In receiving, in entertaining, and encouraging of her enemies, that +came from their army unto thee. What sayest thou to this indictment? +art thou guilty or not guilty?’<br> +<br> +‘My lord,’ quoth he, ‘I know not the meaning of this +indictment, forasmuch as I am not the man concerned in it; the man that +standeth by this charge accused before this bench is called by the name +of Evil-Questioning, which name I deny to be mine, mine being Honest-Inquiry. +The one indeed sounds like the other; but, I trow, your lordships know +that between these two there is a wide difference; for I hope that a +man, even in the worst of times, and that, too, amongst the worst of +men, may make an honest inquiry after things, without running the danger +of death.’<br> +<br> +Then spake my Lord Willbewill, for he was one of the witnesses: ‘My +lord, and you the honourable bench and magistrates of the town of Mansoul, +you all have heard with your ears that the prisoner at the bar has denied +his name, and so thinks to shift from the charge of the indictment. +But I know him to be the man concerned, and that his proper name is +Evil-Questioning. I have known him, my lord, above these thirty +years, for he and I (a shame it is for me to speak it) were great acquaintance, +when Diabolus, that tyrant, had the government of Mansoul; and I testify +that he is a Diabolonian by nature, an enemy to our Prince, and a hater +of the blessed town of Mansoul. He has, in times of rebellion, +been at and lain in my house, my lord, not so little as twenty nights +together, and we did use to talk then, for the substance of talk, as +he and his doubters have talked of late: true, I have not seen him many +a day. I suppose that the coming of Emmanuel to Mansoul has made +him change his lodgings, as this indictment has driven him to change +his name; but this is the man, my lord.’<br> +<br> +Then said the court unto him, ‘Hast thou any more to say?’<br> +<br> +‘Yes,’ quoth the old gentleman, ‘that I have; for +all that as yet has been said against me, is but by the mouth of one +witness; and it is not lawful for the famous town of Mansoul, at the +mouth of one witness, to put any man to death.’<br> +<br> +Then stood forth Mr. Diligence, and said, ‘My lord, as I was upon +my watch such a night at the head of Bad Street, in this town, I chanced +to hear a muttering within this gentleman’s house. Then, +thought I, what is to do here? So I went up close, but very softly, +to the side of the house to listen, thinking, as indeed it fell out, +that there I might light upon some Diabolonian conventicle. So, +as I said, I drew nearer and nearer; and when I was got up close to +the wall, it was but a while before I perceived that there were outlandish +men in the house; but I did well understand their speech, for I have +been a traveller myself. Now, hearing such language in such a +tottering cottage as this old gentleman dwelt in, I clapped mine ear +to a hole in the window, and there heard them talk as followeth. +This old Mr. Questioning asked these doubters what they were, whence +they came, and what was their business in these parts; and they told +him to all these questions, yet he did entertain them. He also +asked what numbers there were of them; and they told him ten thousand +men. He then asked them, why they made no more manly assault upon +Mansoul; and they told him: so he called their general coward, for marching +off when he should have fought for his prince. Further, this old +Evil-Questioning wished, and I heard him wish, would all the ten thousand +doubters were now in Mansoul, and himself at the head of them. +He bid them also to take heed and lie quat; for if they were taken they +must die, although they had heads of gold.’ Then said the +court: ‘Mr. Evil-Questioning, here is now another witness against +you, and his testimony is full: 1. He swears that you did receive these +men into your house, and that you did nourish them there, though you +knew that they were Diabolonians, and the King’s enemies. +2. He swears that you did wish ten thousand of them in Mansoul. +3. He swears that you did give them advice to be quat and close, lest +they were taken by the King’s servants. All which manifesteth +that thou art a Diabolonian; but hadst thou been a friend to the King, +thou wouldst have apprehended them.’<br> +<br> +Then said Evil-Questioning: ‘To the first of these I answer, The +men that came into mine house were strangers, and I took them in; and +is it now become a crime in Mansoul for a man to entertain strangers? +That I did also nourish them is true; and why should my charity be blamed? +As for the reason why I wished ten thousand of them in Mansoul, I never +told it to the witnesses, nor to themselves. I might wish them +to be taken, and so my wish might mean well to Mansoul, for aught that +any yet knows. I did also bid them take heed that they fell not +into the captains’ hands; but that might be because I am unwilling +that any man should be slain, and not because I would have the King’s +enemies as such escape.’<br> +<br> +My Lord Mayor then replied: ‘That though it was a virtue to entertain +strangers, yet it was treason to entertain the King’s enemies. +And for what else thou hast said, thou dost by words but labour to evade +and defer the execution of judgment. But could there be no more +proved against thee but that thou art a Diabolonian, thou must for that +die the death by the law; but to be a receiver, a nourisher, a countenancer, +and a harbourer of others of them, yea, of outlandish Diabolonians, +yea, of them that came from far on purpose to cut off and destroy our +Mansoul - this must not be borne.’<br> +<br> +Then said Evil-Questioning: ‘I see how the game will go: I must +die for my name, and for my charity.’ And so he held his +peace.<br> +<br> +Then they called the outlandish doubters to the bar, and the first of +them that was arraigned was the election doubter. So his indictment +was read; and because he was an outlandish man, the substance of it +was told him by an interpreter; namely, ‘That he was there charged +with being an enemy of Emmanuel the Prince, a hater of the town of Mansoul, +and an opposer of her most wholesome doctrine.’<br> +<br> +Then the judge asked him if he would plead? but he said only this - +That he confessed that he was an election doubter, and that that was +the religion that he had ever been brought up in. And said, moreover, +‘If I must die for my religion, I trow, I shall die a martyr, +and so I care the less.’<br> +<br> +<i>Judge</i>. Then it was replied: ‘To question election, +is to overthrow a great doctrine of the gospel, namely, the omnisciency, +and power, and will of God; to take away the liberty of God with his +creature, to stumble the faith of the town of Mansoul, and to make salvation +to depend upon works, and not upon grace. It also belied the word, +and disquieted the minds of the men of Mansoul; therefore by the best +of laws he must die.’<br> +<br> +Then was the vocation doubter called, and set to the bar; and his indictment +for substance was the same with the other, only he was particularly +charged with denying the calling of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +The judge asked him also what he had to say for himself?<br> +<br> +So he replied: ‘That he never believed that there was any such +thing as a distinct and powerful call of God to Mansoul; otherwise than +by the general voice of the word, nor by that neither, otherwise than +as it exhorted them to forbear evil, and to do that which is good, and +in so doing a promise of happiness is annexed.’<br> +<br> +Then said the judge: ‘Thou art a Diabolonian, and hast denied +a great part of one of the most experimental truths of the Prince of +the town of Mansoul; for he has called, and she has heard a most distinct +and powerful call of her Emmanuel, by which she has been quickened, +awakened, and possessed with heavenly grace to desire to have communion +with her Prince, to serve him, and to do his will, and to look for her +happiness merely of his good pleasure. And for thine abhorrence +of this good doctrine, thou must die the death.’<br> +<br> +Then the grace doubter was called, and his indictment was read and he +replied thereto: ‘That though he was of the land of doubting, +his father was the offspring of a Pharisee, and lived in good fashion +among his neighbours, and that he taught him to believe, and believe +it I do, and will, that Mansoul shall never be saved freely by grace.’<br> +<br> +Then said the judge: ‘Why, the law of the Prince is plain: 1. +Negatively, “not of works:” 2. Positively, “by grace +you are saved.” And thy religion settleth in and upon the +works of the flesh; for the works of the law are the works of the flesh. +Besides, in saying as thou hast done, thou hast robbed God of His glory, +and given it to a sinful man; thou hast robbed Christ of the necessity +of His undertaking, and the sufficiency thereof, and hast given both +these to the works of the flesh. Thou hast despised the work of +the Holy Ghost, and hast magnified the will of the flesh, and of the +legal mind. Thou art a Diabolonian, the son of a Diabolonian; +and for thy Diabolonian principles thou must die.’<br> +<br> +The court then, having proceeded thus far with them, sent out the jury, +who forthwith brought them in guilty of death. Then stood up the +Recorder, and addressed himself to the prisoners: ‘You, the prisoners +at the bar, you have been here indicted, and proved guilty of high crimes +against Emmanuel our Prince, and against the welfare of the famous town +of Mansoul, crimes for which you must be put to death, and die ye accordingly.’ +So they were sentenced to the death of the cross. The place assigned +them for execution, was that where Diabolus drew up his last army against +Mansoul; save only that old Evil-Questioning was hanged at the top of +Bad Street, just over against his own door.<br> +<br> +When the town of Mansoul had thus far rid themselves of their enemies, +and of the troublers of their peace, in the next place a strict commandment +was given out, that yet my Lord Willbewill should, with Diligence his +man, search for, and do his best to apprehend what town Diabolonians +were yet left alive in Mansoul. The names of several of them were, +Mr. Fooling, Mr. Let-Good-Slip, Mr. Slavish-Fear, Mr. No-Love, Mr. Mistrust, +Mr. Flesh, and Mr. Sloth. It was also commanded, that he should +apprehend Mr. Evil-Questioning’s children, that he left behind +him, and that they should demolish his house. The children that +he left behind him were these: Mr. Doubt, and he was his eldest son; +the next to him was Legal-Life, Unbelief, Wrong-Thoughts-of-Christ, +Clip-Promise, Carnal-Sense, Live-by-Feeling, Self-Love. All these +he had by one wife, and her name was No-Hope; she was the kinswoman +of old Incredulity, for he was her uncle; and when her father, old Dark, +was dead, he took her and brought her up, and when she was marriageable, +he gave her to this old Evil-Questioning to wife.<br> +<br> +Now the Lord Willbewill did put into execution his commission, with +great Diligence, his man. He took Fooling in the streets, and +hanged him up in Want-wit-Alley, over against his own house. This +Fooling was he that would have had the town of Mansoul deliver up Captain +Credence into the hands of Diabolus, provided that then he would have +withdrawn his force out of the town. He also took Mr. Let-Good-Slip +one day as he was busy in the market, and executed him according to +law. Now there was an honest poor man in Mansoul, and his name +was Mr. Meditation, one of no great account in the days of apostasy, +but now of repute with the best of the town. This man, therefore, +they were willing to prefer. Now Mr. Let-Good-Slip had a great +deal of wealth heretofore in Mansoul, and, at Emmanuel’s coming, +it was sequestered to the use of the Prince: this, therefore, was now +given to Mr. Meditation, to improve for the common good, and after him +to his son, Mr. Think-Well; this Think-Well he had by Mrs. Piety his +wife, and she was the daughter of Mr. Recorder.<br> +<br> +After this, my lord apprehended Clip-Promise: now because he was a notorious +villain, for by his doings much of the King’s coin was abused, +therefore he was made a public example. He was arraigned and judged +to be first set in the pillory, then to be whipped by all the children +and servants in Mansoul, and then to be hanged till he was dead. +Some may wonder at the severity of this man’s punishment; but +those that are honest traders in Mansoul, are sensible of the great +abuse that one clipper of promises in little time may do to the town +of Mansoul. And truly my judgment is, that all those of his name +and life should be served even as he.<br> +<br> +He also apprehended Carnal-Sense, and put him in hold; but how it came +about, I cannot tell, but he brake prison, and made his escape: yea, +and the bold villain will not yet quit the town, but lurks in the Diabolonian +dens a days, and haunts like a ghost honest men’s houses a nights. +Wherefore, there was a proclamation set up in the market-place in Mansoul, +signifying that whosoever could discover Carnal-Sense, and apprehend +him and slay him, should be admitted daily to the Prince’s table, +and should be made keeper of the treasure of Mansoul. Many, therefore, +did bend themselves to do this thing, but take him and slay him they +could not, though often he was discovered.<br> +<br> +But my lord took Mr. Wrong-Thoughts-of-Christ, and put him in prison, +and he died there; though it was long first, for he died of a lingering +consumption.<br> +<br> +Self-Love was also taken and committed to custody; but there were many +that were allied to him in Mansoul, so his judgment was deferred. +But at last Mr. Self-Denial stood up, and said: ‘If such villains +as these may be winked at in Mansoul, I will lay down my commission.’ +He also took him from the crowd, and had him among his soldiers, and +there he was brained. But some in Mansoul muttered at it, though +none durst speak plainly, because Emmanuel was in town. But this +brave act of Captain Self-Denial came to the Prince’s ears; so +he sent for him, and made him a lord in Mansoul. My Lord Willbewill +also obtained great commendations of Emmanuel, for what he had done +for the town of Mansoul.<br> +<br> +Then my Lord Self-Denial took courage, and set to the pursuing of the +Diabolonians, with my Lord Willbewill; and they took Live-by-Feeling, +and they took Legal-Life, and put them in hold till they died. +But Mr. Unbelief was a nimble Jack: him they could never lay hold of, +though they attempted to do it often. He therefore, and some few +more of the subtlest of the Diabolonian tribe, did yet remain in Mansoul, +to the time that Mansoul left off to dwell any longer in the kingdom +of Universe. But they kept them to their dens and holes: if one +of them did appear, or happen to be seen in any of the streets of the +town of Mansoul, the whole town would be up in arms after them; yea, +the very children in Mansoul would cry out after them as after a thief, +and would wish that they might stone them to death with stones. +And now did Mansoul arrive to some good degree of peace and quiet; her +Prince also did abide within her borders; her captains, also, and her +soldiers did their duties; and Mansoul minded her trade that she had +with the country that was afar off; also she was busy in her manufacture.<br> +<br> +When the town of Mansoul had thus far rid themselves of so many of their +enemies, and the troublers of their peace, the Prince sent to them, +and appointed a day wherein he would, at the market-place, meet the +whole people, and there give them in charge concerning some further +matters, that, if observed, would tend to their further safety and comfort, +and to the condemnation and destruction of their home-bred Diabolonians. +So the day appointed was come, and the townsmen met together; Emmanuel +also came down in his chariot, and all his captains in their state attending +him, on the right hand and on the left. Then was an oyes made +for silence, and, after some mutual carriages of love, the Prince began, +and thus proceeded:-<br> +<br> +‘You, my Mansoul, and the beloved of mine heart, many and great +are the privileges that I have bestowed upon you; I have singled you +out from others, and have chosen you to myself, not for your worthiness, +but for mine own sake. I have also redeemed you, not only from +the dread of my Father’s law, but from the hand of Diabolus. +This I have done because I loved you, and because I have set my heart +upon you to do you good. I have also, that all things, that might +hinder thy way to the pleasures of paradise might be taken out of the +way, laid down for thee for thy soul a plenary satisfaction, and have +bought thee to myself; a price not of corruptible things, as of silver +and gold, but a price of blood, mine own blood, which I have freely +spilled upon the ground to make thee mine. So I have reconciled +thee, O my Mansoul, to my Father, and entrusted thee in the mansion +houses that are with my Father in the royal city, where things are, +O my Mansoul, that eye hath not seen, nor hath entered into the heart +of man to conceive.<br> +<br> +‘Besides, O my Mansoul, thou seest what I have done, and how I +have taken thee out of the hands of thine enemies: unto whom thou hadst +deeply revolted from my Father, and by whom thou wast content to be +possessed, and also to be destroyed. I came to thee first by my +law, then by my gospel, to awaken thee, and show thee my glory. +And thou knowest what thou wast, what thou saidst, what thou didst, +and how many times thou rebelledst against my Father and me; yet I left +thee not as thou seest this day, but came to thee, have borne thy manners, +have waited upon thee, and, after all, accepted of thee, even of my +mere grace and favour; and would not suffer thee to be lost, as thou +most willingly wouldst have been. I also compassed thee about, +and afflicted thee on every side, that I might make thee weary of thy +ways, and bring down thy heart with molestation to a willingness to +close with thy good and happiness. And when I had gotten a complete +conquest over thee, I turned it to thy advantage.<br> +<br> +‘Thou seest, also, what a company of my Father’s host I +have lodged within thy borders: captains and rulers, soldiers and men +of war, engines and excellent devices to subdue and bring down thy foes; +thou knowest my meaning, O Mansoul. And they are my servants, +and thine, too, Mansoul. Yea, my design of possessing of thee +with them, and the natural tendency of each of them is to defend, purge, +strengthen, and sweeten thee for myself, O Mansoul, and to make thee +meet for my Father’s presence, blessing, and glory; for thou, +my Mansoul, art created to be prepared unto these.<br> +<br> +‘Thou seest, moreover, my Mansoul, how I have passed by thy backslidings, +and have healed thee. Indeed I was angry with thee, but I have +turned mine anger away from thee, because I loved thee still, and mine +anger and mine indignation is ceased in the destruction of thine enemies, +O Mansoul. Nor did thy goodness fetch me again unto thee, after +that I for thy transgressions have hid my face, and withdrawn my presence +from thee. The way of backsliding was thine, but the way and means +of thy recovery was mine. I invented the means of thy return; +it was I that made an hedge and a wall, when thou wast beginning to +turn to things in which I delighted not. It was I that made thy +sweet bitter, thy day night, thy smooth way thorny, and that also confounded +all that sought thy destruction. It was I that set Mr. Godly-Fear +to work in Mansoul. It was I that stirred up thy conscience and +understanding, thy will and thy affections, after thy great and woful +decay. It was I that put life into thee, O Mansoul, to seek me, +that thou mightest find me, and in thy finding find thine own health, +happiness, and salvation. It was I that fetched the second time +the Diabolonians out of Mansoul; and it was I that overcame them, and +that destroyed them before thy face.<br> +<br> +‘And now, my Mansoul, I am returned to thee in peace, and thy +transgressions against me are as if they had not been. Nor shall +it be with thee as in former days, but I will do better for thee than +at thy beginning.<br> +<br> +For yet a little while, O my Mansoul, even after a few more times are +gone over thy head, I will (but be not thou troubled at what I say) +take down this famous town of Mansoul, stick and stone, to the ground. +And I will carry the stones thereof, and the timber thereof, and the +walls thereof, and the dust thereof, and the inhabitants thereof, into +mine own country, even into a kingdom of my Father; and will there set +it up in such strength and glory, as it never did see in the kingdom +where now it is placed. I will even there set it up for my Father’s +habitation; for for that purpose it was at first erected in the kingdom +of Universe; and there will I make it a spectacle of wonder, a monument +of mercy, and the admirer of its own mercy. There shall the natives +of Mansoul see all that, of which they have seen nothing here: there +shall they be equal to those unto whom they have been inferior here. +And there shalt thou, O my Mansoul, have such communion with me, with +my Father, and with your Lord Secretary, as it is not possible here +to be enjoyed, nor ever could be, shouldest thou live in Universe the +space of a thousand years.<br> +<br> +‘And there, O my Mansoul, thou shalt be afraid of murderers no +more; of Diabolonians, and their threats, no more. There, there +shall be no more plots, nor contrivances, nor designs against thee, +O my Mansoul. There thou shalt no more hear the evil-tidings, +or the noise of the Diabolonian drum. There thou shalt not see +the Diabolonian standard-bearers, nor yet behold Diabolus’s standard. +No Diabolonian mount shall be cast up against thee there; nor shall +there the Diabolonian standard be set up to make thee afraid. +There thou shalt not need captains, engines, soldiers, and men of war. +There thou shalt meet with no sorrow, nor grief, nor shall it be possible +that any Diabolonian should again, for ever, be able to creep into thy +skirts, burrow in thy walls, or be seen again within thy borders all +the days of eternity. Life shall there last longer than here you +are able to desire it should; and yet it shall always be sweet and new, +nor shall any impediment attend it for ever.<br> +<br> +‘There, O Mansoul, thou shalt meet with many of those that have +been like thee, and that have been partakers of thy sorrows; even such +as I have chosen, and redeemed, and set apart, as thou, for my Father’s +court and city-royal. All they will be glad in thee, and thou, +when thou seest them, shalt be glad in thine heart.<br> +<br> +‘There are things, O Mansoul, even things of my Father’s +providing, and mine, that never were seen since the beginning of the +world; and they are laid up with my Father, and sealed up among his +treasures for thee, till thou shalt come thither to enjoy them. +I told you before, that I would remove my Mansoul, and set it up elsewhere; +and where I will set it, there are those that love thee, and those that +rejoice in thee now; but how much more, when they shall see thee exalted +to honour! My Father will then send them for you to fetch you; +and their bosoms are chariots to put you in. And you, O my Mansoul, +shall ride upon the wings of the wind. They will come to convey, +conduct, and bring you to that, when your eyes see more, that will be +your desired haven.<br> +<br> +‘And thus, O my Mansoul, I have showed unto thee what shall be +done to thee hereafter, if thou canst hear, if thou canst understand; +and now I will tell thee what at present must be thy duty and practice, +until I come and fetch thee to myself, according as is related in the +Scriptures of truth.<br> +<br> +‘First, I charge thee that thou dost hereafter keep more white +and clean the liveries which I gave thee before my last withdrawing +from thee. Do it, I say, for this will be thy wisdom. They +are in themselves fine linen, but thou must keep them white and clean. +This will be your wisdom, your honour, and will be greatly for my glory. +When your garments are white, the world will count you mine. Also, +when your garments are white, then I am delighted in your ways; for +then your goings to and fro will be like a flash of lightning, that +those that are present must take notice of; also their eyes will be +made to dazzle thereat. Deck thyself, therefore, according to +my bidding, and make thyself by my law straight steps for thy feet; +so shall thy King greatly desire thy beauty, for he is thy Lord, and +worship thou him.<br> +<br> +‘Now, that thou mayest keep them as I bid thee, I have, as I before +did tell thee, provided for thee an open fountain to wash thy garments +in. Look, therefore, that thou wash often in my fountain, and +go not in defiled garments; for as it is to my dishonour and my disgrace, +so it will be to thy discomfort, when you shall walk in filthy garments. +Let not, therefore, my garments, your garments, the garments that I +gave thee, be defiled or spotted by the flesh. Keep thy garments +always white, and let thy head lack no ointment.<br> +<br> +‘My Mansoul, I have ofttimes delivered thee from the designs, +plots, attempts, and conspiracies of Diabolus; and for all this I ask +thee nothing, but that thou render not to me evil for my good; but that +thou bear in mind my love, and the continuation of my kindness to my +beloved Mansoul, so as to provoke thee to walk in thy measure according +to the benefit bestowed on thee. Of old, the sacrifices were bound +with coords to the horns of the altar. Consider what is said to +thee, O my blessed Mansoul.<br> +<br> +‘O my Mansoul, I have lived, I have died, I live, and will die +no more for thee. I live, that thou mayest not die. Because +I live, thou shalt live also. I reconciled thee to my Father by +the blood of my cross; and being reconciled, thou shalt live through +me. I will pray for thee; I will fight for thee; I will yet do +thee good.<br> +<br> +‘Nothing can hurt thee but sin; nothing can grieve me but sin; +nothing can make thee base before thy foes but sin: take heed of sin, +my Mansoul.<br> +<br> +‘And dost thou know why I at first, and do still, suffer Diabolonians +to dwell in thy walls, O Mansoul? It is to keep thee wakening, +to try thy love, to make thee watchful, and to cause thee yet to prize +my noble captains, their soldiers, and my mercy.<br> +<br> +‘It is also, that yet thou mayest be made to remember what a deplorable +condition thou once wast in. I mean when, not some, but all did +dwell, not in thy walls, but in thy castle, and in thy stronghold, O +Mansoul.<br> +<br> +‘O my Mansoul, should I slay all them within, many there be without, +that would bring thee into bondage; for were all these within cut off, +those without would find thee sleeping; and then, as in a moment, they +would swallow up my Mansoul. I therefore left them in thee, not +to do thee hurt (the which they yet will, if thou hearken to them, and +serve them,) but to do thee good, the which they must, if thou watch +and fight against them. Know, therefore, that whatever they shall +tempt thee to, my design is, that they should drive thee, not further +off, but nearer to my father, to learn thee war, to make petitioning +desirable to thee, and to make thee little in thine own eyes. +Hearken diligently to this, my Mansoul.<br> +<br> +‘Show me, then, thy love, my Mansoul, and let not those that are +within thy walls, take thy affections off from him that hath redeemed +thy soul. Yea, let the sight of a Diabolonian heighten thy love +to me. I came once, and twice, and thrice, to save thee from the +poison of those arrows that would have wrought thy death: stand for +me, thy Friend, my Mansoul, against the Diabolonians, and I will stand +for thee before my Father, and all his court. Love me against +temptation, and I will love thee notwithstanding thine infirmities.<br> +<br> +‘O my Mansoul, remember what my captains, my soldiers, and mine +engines have done for thee. They have fought for thee, they have +suffered by thee, they have borne much at thy hands to do thee good, +O Mansoul. Hadst thou not had them to help thee, Diabolus had +certainly made a hand of thee. Nourish them, therefore, my Mansoul. +When thou dost well, they will be well; when thou dost ill, they will +be ill, and sick, and weak. Make not my captains sick, O Mansoul; +for if they be sick, thou canst not be well; if they be weak, thou canst +not be strong; if they be faint, thou canst not be stout and valiant +for thy King, O Mansoul. Nor must thou think always to live by +sense: thou must live upon my word. Thou must believe, O my Mansoul, +when I am from thee, that yet I love thee, and bear thee upon mine heart +for ever.<br> +<br> +‘Remember, therefore, O my Mansoul, that thou art beloved of me: +as I have, therefore, taught thee to watch, to fight, to pray, and to +make war against my foes; so now I command thee to believe that my love +is constant to thee. O my Mansoul, how have I set my heart, my +love upon thee! Watch. Behold, I lay none other burden upon +thee, than what thou hast already. Hold fast, till I come.’<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +*** END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK, THE HOLY WAR ***<br> +<pre> + +******This file should be named hlywr10h.htm or hlywr10h.zip****** +Corrected EDITIONS of our EBooks get a new NUMBER, hlywr11h.htm +VERSIONS based on separate sources get new LETTER, hlywr10ah.htm + +Project Gutenberg eBooks are often created from several printed +editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the US +unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we usually do not +keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition. + +We are now trying to release all our eBooks one year in advance +of the official release dates, leaving time for better editing. +Please be encouraged to tell us about any error or corrections, +even years after the official publication date. + +Please note neither this listing nor its contents are final til +midnight of the last day of the month of any such announcement. +The official release date of all Project Gutenberg eBooks is at +Midnight, Central Time, of the last day of the stated month. A +preliminary version may often be posted for suggestion, comment +and editing by those who wish to do so. + +Most people start at our Web sites at: +http://gutenberg.net or +http://promo.net/pg + +These Web sites include award-winning information about Project +Gutenberg, including how to donate, how to help produce our new +eBooks, and how to subscribe to our email newsletter (free!). + + +Those of you who want to download any eBook before announcement +can get to them as follows, and just download by date. This is +also a good way to get them instantly upon announcement, as the +indexes our cataloguers produce obviously take a while after an +announcement goes out in the Project Gutenberg Newsletter. + +http://www.ibiblio.org/gutenberg/etext04 or +ftp://ftp.ibiblio.org/pub/docs/books/gutenberg/etext04 + +Or /etext03, 02, 01, 00, 99, 98, 97, 96, 95, 94, 93, 92, 92, 91 or 90 + +Just search by the first five letters of the filename you want, +as it appears in our Newsletters. + + +Information about Project Gutenberg (one page) + +We produce about two million dollars for each hour we work. The +time it takes us, a rather conservative estimate, is fifty hours +to get any eBook selected, entered, proofread, edited, copyright +searched and analyzed, the copyright letters written, etc. Our +projected audience is one hundred million readers. If the value +per text is nominally estimated at one dollar then we produce $2 +million dollars per hour in 2002 as we release over 100 new text +files per month: 1240 more eBooks in 2001 for a total of 4000+ +We are already on our way to trying for 2000 more eBooks in 2002 +If they reach just 1-2% of the world's population then the total +will reach over half a trillion eBooks given away by year's end. + +The Goal of Project Gutenberg is to Give Away 1 Trillion eBooks! +This is ten thousand titles each to one hundred million readers, +which is only about 4% of the present number of computer users. + +Here is the briefest record of our progress (* means estimated): + +eBooks Year Month + + 1 1971 July + 10 1991 January + 100 1994 January + 1000 1997 August + 1500 1998 October + 2000 1999 December + 2500 2000 December + 3000 2001 November + 4000 2001 October/November + 6000 2002 December* + 9000 2003 November* +10000 2004 January* + + +The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation has been created +to secure a future for Project Gutenberg into the next millennium. + +We need your donations more than ever! + +As of February, 2002, contributions are being solicited from people +and organizations in: Alabama, Alaska, Arkansas, Connecticut, +Delaware, District of Columbia, Florida, Georgia, Hawaii, Illinois, +Indiana, Iowa, Kansas, Kentucky, Louisiana, Maine, Massachusetts, +Michigan, Mississippi, Missouri, Montana, Nebraska, Nevada, New +Hampshire, New Jersey, New Mexico, New York, North Carolina, Ohio, +Oklahoma, Oregon, Pennsylvania, Rhode Island, South Carolina, South +Dakota, Tennessee, Texas, Utah, Vermont, Virginia, Washington, West +Virginia, Wisconsin, and Wyoming. + +We have filed in all 50 states now, but these are the only ones +that have responded. + +As the requirements for other states are met, additions to this list +will be made and fund raising will begin in the additional states. +Please feel free to ask to check the status of your state. + +In answer to various questions we have received on this: + +We are constantly working on finishing the paperwork to legally +request donations in all 50 states. If your state is not listed and +you would like to know if we have added it since the list you have, +just ask. + +While we cannot solicit donations from people in states where we are +not yet registered, we know of no prohibition against accepting +donations from donors in these states who approach us with an offer to +donate. + +International donations are accepted, but we don't know ANYTHING about +how to make them tax-deductible, or even if they CAN be made +deductible, and don't have the staff to handle it even if there are +ways. + +Donations by check or money order may be sent to: + +Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation +PMB 113 +1739 University Ave. +Oxford, MS 38655-4109 + +Contact us if you want to arrange for a wire transfer or payment +method other than by check or money order. + +The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation has been approved by +the US Internal Revenue Service as a 501(c)(3) organization with EIN +[Employee Identification Number] 64-622154. Donations are +tax-deductible to the maximum extent permitted by law. As fund-raising +requirements for other states are met, additions to this list will be +made and fund-raising will begin in the additional states. + +We need your donations more than ever! + +You can get up to date donation information online at: + +http://www.gutenberg.net/donation.html + + +*** + +If you can't reach Project Gutenberg, +you can always email directly to: + +Michael S. Hart hart@pobox.com + +Prof. Hart will answer or forward your message. + +We would prefer to send you information by email. + + +**The Legal Small Print** + + +(Three Pages) + +***START**THE SMALL PRINT!**FOR PUBLIC DOMAIN EBOOKS**START*** +Why is this "Small Print!" statement here? You know: lawyers. +They tell us you might sue us if there is something wrong with +your copy of this eBook, even if you got it for free from +someone other than us, and even if what's wrong is not our +fault. So, among other things, this "Small Print!" statement +disclaims most of our liability to you. It also tells you how +you may distribute copies of this eBook if you want to. + +*BEFORE!* YOU USE OR READ THIS EBOOK +By using or reading any part of this PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm +eBook, you indicate that you understand, agree to and accept +this "Small Print!" statement. If you do not, you can receive +a refund of the money (if any) you paid for this eBook by +sending a request within 30 days of receiving it to the person +you got it from. If you received this eBook on a physical +medium (such as a disk), you must return it with your request. + +ABOUT PROJECT GUTENBERG-TM EBOOKS +This PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm eBook, like most PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm eBooks, +is a "public domain" work distributed by Professor Michael S. Hart +through the Project Gutenberg Association (the "Project"). +Among other things, this means that no one owns a United States copyright +on or for this work, so the Project (and you!) can copy and +distribute it in the United States without permission and +without paying copyright royalties. Special rules, set forth +below, apply if you wish to copy and distribute this eBook +under the "PROJECT GUTENBERG" trademark. + +Please do not use the "PROJECT GUTENBERG" trademark to market +any commercial products without permission. + +To create these eBooks, the Project expends considerable +efforts to identify, transcribe and proofread public domain +works. Despite these efforts, the Project's eBooks and any +medium they may be on may contain "Defects". Among other +things, Defects may take the form of incomplete, inaccurate or +corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other +intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged +disk or other eBook medium, a computer virus, or computer +codes that damage or cannot be read by your equipment. + +LIMITED WARRANTY; DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES +But for the "Right of Replacement or Refund" described below, +[1] Michael Hart and the Foundation (and any other party you may +receive this eBook from as a PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm eBook) disclaims +all liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including +legal fees, and [2] YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE OR +UNDER STRICT LIABILITY, OR FOR BREACH OF WARRANTY OR CONTRACT, +INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE +OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES, EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE +POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. + +If you discover a Defect in this eBook within 90 days of +receiving it, you can receive a refund of the money (if any) +you paid for it by sending an explanatory note within that +time to the person you received it from. If you received it +on a physical medium, you must return it with your note, and +such person may choose to alternatively give you a replacement +copy. If you received it electronically, such person may +choose to alternatively give you a second opportunity to +receive it electronically. + +THIS EBOOK IS OTHERWISE PROVIDED TO YOU "AS-IS". NO OTHER +WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, ARE MADE TO YOU AS +TO THE EBOOK OR ANY MEDIUM IT MAY BE ON, INCLUDING BUT NOT +LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A +PARTICULAR PURPOSE. + +Some states do not allow disclaimers of implied warranties or +the exclusion or limitation of consequential damages, so the +above disclaimers and exclusions may not apply to you, and you +may have other legal rights. + +INDEMNITY +You will indemnify and hold Michael Hart, the Foundation, +and its trustees and agents, and any volunteers associated +with the production and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm +texts harmless, from all liability, cost and expense, including +legal fees, that arise directly or indirectly from any of the +following that you do or cause: [1] distribution of this eBook, +[2] alteration, modification, or addition to the eBook, +or [3] any Defect. + +DISTRIBUTION UNDER "PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm" +You may distribute copies of this eBook electronically, or by +disk, book or any other medium if you either delete this +"Small Print!" and all other references to Project Gutenberg, +or: + +[1] Only give exact copies of it. Among other things, this + requires that you do not remove, alter or modify the + eBook or this "small print!" statement. You may however, + if you wish, distribute this eBook in machine readable + binary, compressed, mark-up, or proprietary form, + including any form resulting from conversion by word + processing or hypertext software, but only so long as + *EITHER*: + + [*] The eBook, when displayed, is clearly readable, and + does *not* contain characters other than those + intended by the author of the work, although tilde + (~), asterisk (*) and underline (_) characters may + be used to convey punctuation intended by the + author, and additional characters may be used to + indicate hypertext links; OR + + [*] The eBook may be readily converted by the reader at + no expense into plain ASCII, EBCDIC or equivalent + form by the program that displays the eBook (as is + the case, for instance, with most word processors); + OR + + [*] You provide, or agree to also provide on request at + no additional cost, fee or expense, a copy of the + eBook in its original plain ASCII form (or in EBCDIC + or other equivalent proprietary form). + +[2] Honor the eBook refund and replacement provisions of this + "Small Print!" statement. + +[3] Pay a trademark license fee to the Foundation of 20% of the + gross profits you derive calculated using the method you + already use to calculate your applicable taxes. If you + don't derive profits, no royalty is due. Royalties are + payable to "Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation" + the 60 days following each date you prepare (or were + legally required to prepare) your annual (or equivalent + periodic) tax return. Please contact us beforehand to + let us know your plans and to work out the details. + +WHAT IF YOU *WANT* TO SEND MONEY EVEN IF YOU DON'T HAVE TO? +Project Gutenberg is dedicated to increasing the number of +public domain and licensed works that can be freely distributed +in machine readable form. + +The Project gratefully accepts contributions of money, time, +public domain materials, or royalty free copyright licenses. +Money should be paid to the: +"Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation." + +If you are interested in contributing scanning equipment or +software or other items, please contact Michael Hart at: +hart@pobox.com + +[Portions of this eBook's header and trailer may be reprinted only +when distributed free of all fees. Copyright (C) 2001, 2002 by +Michael S. Hart. Project Gutenberg is a TradeMark and may not be +used in any sales of Project Gutenberg eBooks or other materials be +they hardware or software or any other related product without +express permission.] + +*END THE SMALL PRINT! FOR PUBLIC DOMAIN EBOOKS*Ver.02/11/02*END* +</pre></body> +</html> diff --git a/old/hlywr10h.zip b/old/hlywr10h.zip Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000..deb3121 --- /dev/null +++ b/old/hlywr10h.zip |
